c4d6112ad61bb7a641f50ed01e8f5d97375a61ae
[exim.git] / doc / doc-docbook / spec.xfpt
1 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2 . This is the primary source of the Exim Manual. It is an xfpt document that is
3 . converted into DocBook XML for subsequent conversion into printable and online
4 . formats. The markup used herein is "standard" xfpt markup, with some extras.
5 . The markup is summarized in a file called Markup.txt.
6 .
7 . WARNING: When you use the .new macro, make sure it appears *before* any
8 . adjacent index items; otherwise you get an empty "paragraph" which causes
9 . unwanted vertical space.
10 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
11
12 .include stdflags
13 .include stdmacs
14
15 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16 . This outputs the standard DocBook boilerplate.
17 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18
19 .docbook
20
21 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22 . These lines are processing instructions for the Simple DocBook Processor that
23 . Philip Hazel has developed as a less cumbersome way of making PostScript and
24 . PDFs than using xmlto and fop. They will be ignored by all other XML
25 . processors.
26 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27
28 .literal xml
29 <?sdop
30 foot_right_recto="&chaptertitle; (&chapternumber;)"
31 foot_right_verso="&chaptertitle; (&chapternumber;)"
32 toc_chapter_blanks="yes,yes"
33 table_warn_overflow="overprint"
34 ?>
35 .literal off
36
37 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38 . This generates the outermost <book> element that wraps the entire document.
39 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40
41 .book
42
43 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
44 . These definitions set some parameters and save some typing.
45 . Update the Copyright year (only) when changing content.
46 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
47
48 .set previousversion "4.92"
49 .include ./local_params
50
51 .set ACL "access control lists (ACLs)"
52 .set I "&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;"
53
54 .macro copyyear
55 2018
56 .endmacro
57
58 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
59 . Additional xfpt markup used by this document, over and above the default
60 . provided in the xfpt library.
61 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
62
63 . --- Override the &$ flag to automatically insert a $ with the variable name.
64
65 .flag &$ $& "<varname>$" "</varname>"
66
67 . --- Short flags for daggers in option headings. They will always be inside
68 . --- an italic string, but we want the daggers to be in Roman.
69
70 .flag &!! "</emphasis>&dagger;<emphasis>"
71 .flag &!? "</emphasis>&Dagger;<emphasis>"
72
73 . --- A macro for an Exim option definition heading, generating a one-line
74 . --- table with four columns. For cases when the option name is given with
75 . --- a space, so that it can be split, a fifth argument is used for the
76 . --- index entry.
77
78 .macro option
79 .arg 5
80 .oindex "&%$5%&"
81 .endarg
82 .arg -5
83 .oindex "&%$1%&"
84 .endarg
85 .itable all 0 0 4 8* left 6* center 6* center 6* right
86 .row "&%$1%&" "Use: &'$2'&" "Type: &'$3'&" "Default: &'$4'&"
87 .endtable
88 .endmacro
89
90 . --- A macro for the common 2-column tables. The width of the first column
91 . --- is suitable for the many tables at the start of the main options chapter;
92 . --- a small number of other 2-column tables override it.
93
94 .macro table2 196pt 254pt
95 .itable none 0 0 2 $1 left $2 left
96 .endmacro
97
98 . --- A macro that generates .row, but puts &I; at the start of the first
99 . --- argument, thus indenting it. Assume a minimum of two arguments, and
100 . --- allow up to four arguments, which is as many as we'll ever need.
101
102 .macro irow
103 .arg 4
104 .row "&I;$1" "$2" "$3" "$4"
105 .endarg
106 .arg -4
107 .arg 3
108 .row "&I;$1" "$2" "$3"
109 .endarg
110 .arg -3
111 .row "&I;$1" "$2"
112 .endarg
113 .endarg
114 .endmacro
115
116 . --- Macros for option, variable, and concept index entries. For a "range"
117 . --- style of entry, use .scindex for the start and .ecindex for the end. The
118 . --- first argument of .scindex and the only argument of .ecindex must be the
119 . --- ID that ties them together.
120
121 .macro cindex
122 &<indexterm role="concept">&
123 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
124 .arg 2
125 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
126 .endarg
127 &</indexterm>&
128 .endmacro
129
130 .macro scindex
131 &<indexterm role="concept" id="$1" class="startofrange">&
132 &<primary>&$2&</primary>&
133 .arg 3
134 &<secondary>&$3&</secondary>&
135 .endarg
136 &</indexterm>&
137 .endmacro
138
139 .macro ecindex
140 &<indexterm role="concept" startref="$1" class="endofrange"/>&
141 .endmacro
142
143 .macro oindex
144 &<indexterm role="option">&
145 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
146 .arg 2
147 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
148 .endarg
149 &</indexterm>&
150 .endmacro
151
152 .macro vindex
153 &<indexterm role="variable">&
154 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
155 .arg 2
156 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
157 .endarg
158 &</indexterm>&
159 .endmacro
160
161 .macro index
162 .echo "** Don't use .index; use .cindex or .oindex or .vindex"
163 .endmacro
164 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
165
166
167 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
168 . The <bookinfo> element is removed from the XML before processing for ASCII
169 . output formats.
170 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
171
172 .literal xml
173 <bookinfo>
174 <title>Specification of the Exim Mail Transfer Agent</title>
175 <titleabbrev>The Exim MTA</titleabbrev>
176 <date>
177 .fulldate
178 </date>
179 <author><firstname>Exim</firstname><surname>Maintainers</surname></author>
180 <authorinitials>EM</authorinitials>
181 <revhistory><revision>
182 .versiondatexml
183 <authorinitials>EM</authorinitials>
184 </revision></revhistory>
185 <copyright><year>
186 .copyyear
187 </year><holder>University of Cambridge</holder></copyright>
188 </bookinfo>
189 .literal off
190
191
192 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
193 . This chunk of literal XML implements index entries of the form "x, see y" and
194 . "x, see also y". However, the DocBook DTD doesn't allow <indexterm> entries
195 . at the top level, so we have to put the .chapter directive first.
196 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
197
198 .chapter "Introduction" "CHID1"
199 .literal xml
200
201 <indexterm role="variable">
202 <primary>$1, $2, etc.</primary>
203 <see><emphasis>numerical variables</emphasis></see>
204 </indexterm>
205 <indexterm role="concept">
206 <primary>address</primary>
207 <secondary>rewriting</secondary>
208 <see><emphasis>rewriting</emphasis></see>
209 </indexterm>
210 <indexterm role="concept">
211 <primary>Bounce Address Tag Validation</primary>
212 <see><emphasis>BATV</emphasis></see>
213 </indexterm>
214 <indexterm role="concept">
215 <primary>Client SMTP Authorization</primary>
216 <see><emphasis>CSA</emphasis></see>
217 </indexterm>
218 <indexterm role="concept">
219 <primary>CR character</primary>
220 <see><emphasis>carriage return</emphasis></see>
221 </indexterm>
222 <indexterm role="concept">
223 <primary>CRL</primary>
224 <see><emphasis>certificate revocation list</emphasis></see>
225 </indexterm>
226 <indexterm role="concept">
227 <primary>delivery</primary>
228 <secondary>failure report</secondary>
229 <see><emphasis>bounce message</emphasis></see>
230 </indexterm>
231 <indexterm role="concept">
232 <primary>dialup</primary>
233 <see><emphasis>intermittently connected hosts</emphasis></see>
234 </indexterm>
235 <indexterm role="concept">
236 <primary>exiscan</primary>
237 <see><emphasis>content scanning</emphasis></see>
238 </indexterm>
239 <indexterm role="concept">
240 <primary>failover</primary>
241 <see><emphasis>fallback</emphasis></see>
242 </indexterm>
243 <indexterm role="concept">
244 <primary>fallover</primary>
245 <see><emphasis>fallback</emphasis></see>
246 </indexterm>
247 <indexterm role="concept">
248 <primary>filter</primary>
249 <secondary>Sieve</secondary>
250 <see><emphasis>Sieve filter</emphasis></see>
251 </indexterm>
252 <indexterm role="concept">
253 <primary>ident</primary>
254 <see><emphasis>RFC 1413</emphasis></see>
255 </indexterm>
256 <indexterm role="concept">
257 <primary>LF character</primary>
258 <see><emphasis>linefeed</emphasis></see>
259 </indexterm>
260 <indexterm role="concept">
261 <primary>maximum</primary>
262 <seealso><emphasis>limit</emphasis></seealso>
263 </indexterm>
264 <indexterm role="concept">
265 <primary>monitor</primary>
266 <see><emphasis>Exim monitor</emphasis></see>
267 </indexterm>
268 <indexterm role="concept">
269 <primary>no_<emphasis>xxx</emphasis></primary>
270 <see>entry for xxx</see>
271 </indexterm>
272 <indexterm role="concept">
273 <primary>NUL</primary>
274 <see><emphasis>binary zero</emphasis></see>
275 </indexterm>
276 <indexterm role="concept">
277 <primary>passwd file</primary>
278 <see><emphasis>/etc/passwd</emphasis></see>
279 </indexterm>
280 <indexterm role="concept">
281 <primary>process id</primary>
282 <see><emphasis>pid</emphasis></see>
283 </indexterm>
284 <indexterm role="concept">
285 <primary>RBL</primary>
286 <see><emphasis>DNS list</emphasis></see>
287 </indexterm>
288 <indexterm role="concept">
289 <primary>redirection</primary>
290 <see><emphasis>address redirection</emphasis></see>
291 </indexterm>
292 <indexterm role="concept">
293 <primary>return path</primary>
294 <seealso><emphasis>envelope sender</emphasis></seealso>
295 </indexterm>
296 <indexterm role="concept">
297 <primary>scanning</primary>
298 <see><emphasis>content scanning</emphasis></see>
299 </indexterm>
300 <indexterm role="concept">
301 <primary>SSL</primary>
302 <see><emphasis>TLS</emphasis></see>
303 </indexterm>
304 <indexterm role="concept">
305 <primary>string</primary>
306 <secondary>expansion</secondary>
307 <see><emphasis>expansion</emphasis></see>
308 </indexterm>
309 <indexterm role="concept">
310 <primary>top bit</primary>
311 <see><emphasis>8-bit characters</emphasis></see>
312 </indexterm>
313 <indexterm role="concept">
314 <primary>variables</primary>
315 <see><emphasis>expansion, variables</emphasis></see>
316 </indexterm>
317 <indexterm role="concept">
318 <primary>zero, binary</primary>
319 <see><emphasis>binary zero</emphasis></see>
320 </indexterm>
321
322 .literal off
323
324
325 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
326 . This is the real start of the first chapter. See the comment above as to why
327 . we can't have the .chapter line here.
328 . chapter "Introduction"
329 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
330
331 Exim is a mail transfer agent (MTA) for hosts that are running Unix or
332 Unix-like operating systems. It was designed on the assumption that it would be
333 run on hosts that are permanently connected to the Internet. However, it can be
334 used on intermittently connected hosts with suitable configuration adjustments.
335
336 Configuration files currently exist for the following operating systems: AIX,
337 BSD/OS (aka BSDI), Darwin (Mac OS X), DGUX, Dragonfly, FreeBSD, GNU/Hurd,
338 GNU/Linux, HI-OSF (Hitachi), HI-UX, HP-UX, IRIX, MIPS RISCOS, NetBSD, OpenBSD,
339 OpenUNIX, QNX, SCO, SCO SVR4.2 (aka UNIX-SV), Solaris (aka SunOS5), SunOS4,
340 Tru64-Unix (formerly Digital UNIX, formerly DEC-OSF1), Ultrix, and UnixWare.
341 Some of these operating systems are no longer current and cannot easily be
342 tested, so the configuration files may no longer work in practice.
343
344 There are also configuration files for compiling Exim in the Cygwin environment
345 that can be installed on systems running Windows. However, this document does
346 not contain any information about running Exim in the Cygwin environment.
347
348 The terms and conditions for the use and distribution of Exim are contained in
349 the file &_NOTICE_&. Exim is distributed under the terms of the GNU General
350 Public Licence, a copy of which may be found in the file &_LICENCE_&.
351
352 The use, supply, or promotion of Exim for the purpose of sending bulk,
353 unsolicited electronic mail is incompatible with the basic aims of Exim,
354 which revolve around the free provision of a service that enhances the quality
355 of personal communications. The author of Exim regards indiscriminate
356 mass-mailing as an antisocial, irresponsible abuse of the Internet.
357
358 Exim owes a great deal to Smail 3 and its author, Ron Karr. Without the
359 experience of running and working on the Smail 3 code, I could never have
360 contemplated starting to write a new MTA. Many of the ideas and user interfaces
361 were originally taken from Smail 3, though the actual code of Exim is entirely
362 new, and has developed far beyond the initial concept.
363
364 Many people, both in Cambridge and around the world, have contributed to the
365 development and the testing of Exim, and to porting it to various operating
366 systems. I am grateful to them all. The distribution now contains a file called
367 &_ACKNOWLEDGMENTS_&, in which I have started recording the names of
368 contributors.
369
370
371 .section "Exim documentation" "SECID1"
372 . Keep this example change bar when updating the documentation!
373
374 .cindex "documentation"
375 This edition of the Exim specification applies to version &version() of Exim.
376 Substantive changes from the &previousversion; edition are marked in some
377 renditions of this document; this paragraph is so marked if the rendition is
378 capable of showing a change indicator.
379
380 This document is very much a reference manual; it is not a tutorial. The reader
381 is expected to have some familiarity with the SMTP mail transfer protocol and
382 with general Unix system administration. Although there are some discussions
383 and examples in places, the information is mostly organized in a way that makes
384 it easy to look up, rather than in a natural order for sequential reading.
385 Furthermore, this manual aims to cover every aspect of Exim in detail, including
386 a number of rarely-used, special-purpose features that are unlikely to be of
387 very wide interest.
388
389 .cindex "books about Exim"
390 An &"easier"& discussion of Exim which provides more in-depth explanatory,
391 introductory, and tutorial material can be found in a book entitled &'The Exim
392 SMTP Mail Server'& (second edition, 2007), published by UIT Cambridge
393 (&url(https://www.uit.co.uk/exim-book/)).
394
395 The book also contains a chapter that gives a general introduction to SMTP and
396 Internet mail. Inevitably, however, the book is unlikely to be fully up-to-date
397 with the latest release of Exim. (Note that the earlier book about Exim,
398 published by O'Reilly, covers Exim 3, and many things have changed in Exim 4.)
399
400 .cindex "Debian" "information sources"
401 If you are using a Debian distribution of Exim, you will find information about
402 Debian-specific features in the file
403 &_/usr/share/doc/exim4-base/README.Debian_&.
404 The command &(man update-exim.conf)& is another source of Debian-specific
405 information.
406
407 .cindex "&_doc/NewStuff_&"
408 .cindex "&_doc/ChangeLog_&"
409 .cindex "change log"
410 As Exim develops, there may be features in newer versions that have not
411 yet made it into this document, which is updated only when the most significant
412 digit of the fractional part of the version number changes. Specifications of
413 new features that are not yet in this manual are placed in the file
414 &_doc/NewStuff_& in the Exim distribution.
415
416 Some features may be classified as &"experimental"&. These may change
417 incompatibly while they are developing, or even be withdrawn. For this reason,
418 they are not documented in this manual. Information about experimental features
419 can be found in the file &_doc/experimental.txt_&.
420
421 All changes to Exim (whether new features, bug fixes, or other kinds of
422 change) are noted briefly in the file called &_doc/ChangeLog_&.
423
424 .cindex "&_doc/spec.txt_&"
425 This specification itself is available as an ASCII file in &_doc/spec.txt_& so
426 that it can easily be searched with a text editor. Other files in the &_doc_&
427 directory are:
428
429 .table2 100pt
430 .row &_OptionLists.txt_& "list of all options in alphabetical order"
431 .row &_dbm.discuss.txt_& "discussion about DBM libraries"
432 .row &_exim.8_& "a man page of Exim's command line options"
433 .row &_experimental.txt_& "documentation of experimental features"
434 .row &_filter.txt_& "specification of the filter language"
435 .row &_Exim3.upgrade_& "upgrade notes from release 2 to release 3"
436 .row &_Exim4.upgrade_& "upgrade notes from release 3 to release 4"
437 .row &_openssl.txt_& "installing a current OpenSSL release"
438 .endtable
439
440 The main specification and the specification of the filtering language are also
441 available in other formats (HTML, PostScript, PDF, and Texinfo). Section
442 &<<SECTavail>>& below tells you how to get hold of these.
443
444
445
446 .section "FTP site and websites" "SECID2"
447 .cindex "website"
448 .cindex "FTP site"
449 The primary site for Exim source distributions is the &%exim.org%& FTP site,
450 available over HTTPS, HTTP and FTP. These services, and the &%exim.org%&
451 website, are hosted at the University of Cambridge.
452
453 .cindex "wiki"
454 .cindex "FAQ"
455 As well as Exim distribution tar files, the Exim website contains a number of
456 differently formatted versions of the documentation. A recent addition to the
457 online information is the Exim wiki (&url(https://wiki.exim.org)),
458 which contains what used to be a separate FAQ, as well as various other
459 examples, tips, and know-how that have been contributed by Exim users.
460 The wiki site should always redirect to the correct place, which is currently
461 provided by GitHub, and is open to editing by anyone with a GitHub account.
462
463 .cindex Bugzilla
464 An Exim Bugzilla exists at &url(https://bugs.exim.org). You can use
465 this to report bugs, and also to add items to the wish list. Please search
466 first to check that you are not duplicating a previous entry.
467 Please do not ask for configuration help in the bug-tracker.
468
469
470 .section "Mailing lists" "SECID3"
471 .cindex "mailing lists" "for Exim users"
472 The following Exim mailing lists exist:
473
474 .table2 140pt
475 .row &'exim-announce@exim.org'& "Moderated, low volume announcements list"
476 .row &'exim-users@exim.org'& "General discussion list"
477 .row &'exim-dev@exim.org'& "Discussion of bugs, enhancements, etc."
478 .row &'exim-cvs@exim.org'& "Automated commit messages from the VCS"
479 .endtable
480
481 You can subscribe to these lists, change your existing subscriptions, and view
482 or search the archives via the mailing lists link on the Exim home page.
483 .cindex "Debian" "mailing list for"
484 If you are using a Debian distribution of Exim, you may wish to subscribe to
485 the Debian-specific mailing list &'pkg-exim4-users@lists.alioth.debian.org'&
486 via this web page:
487 .display
488 &url(https://alioth-lists.debian.net/cgi-bin/mailman/listinfo/pkg-exim4-users)
489 .endd
490 Please ask Debian-specific questions on that list and not on the general Exim
491 lists.
492
493 .section "Bug reports" "SECID5"
494 .cindex "bug reports"
495 .cindex "reporting bugs"
496 Reports of obvious bugs can be emailed to &'bugs@exim.org'& or reported
497 via the Bugzilla (&url(https://bugs.exim.org)). However, if you are unsure
498 whether some behaviour is a bug or not, the best thing to do is to post a
499 message to the &'exim-dev'& mailing list and have it discussed.
500
501
502
503 .section "Where to find the Exim distribution" "SECTavail"
504 .cindex "FTP site"
505 .cindex "HTTPS download site"
506 .cindex "distribution" "FTP site"
507 .cindex "distribution" "https site"
508 The master distribution site for the Exim distribution is
509 .display
510 &url(https://downloads.exim.org/)
511 .endd
512 The service is available over HTTPS, HTTP and FTP.
513 We encourage people to migrate to HTTPS.
514
515 The content served at &url(https://downloads.exim.org/) is identical to the
516 content served at &url(https://ftp.exim.org/pub/exim) and
517 &url(ftp://ftp.exim.org/pub/exim).
518
519 If accessing via a hostname containing &'ftp'&, then the file references that
520 follow are relative to the &_exim_& directories at these sites.
521 If accessing via the hostname &'downloads'& then the subdirectories described
522 here are top-level directories.
523
524 There are now quite a number of independent mirror sites around
525 the world. Those that I know about are listed in the file called &_Mirrors_&.
526
527 Within the top exim directory there are subdirectories called &_exim3_& (for
528 previous Exim 3 distributions), &_exim4_& (for the latest Exim 4
529 distributions), and &_Testing_& for testing versions. In the &_exim4_&
530 subdirectory, the current release can always be found in files called
531 .display
532 &_exim-n.nn.tar.xz_&
533 &_exim-n.nn.tar.gz_&
534 &_exim-n.nn.tar.bz2_&
535 .endd
536 where &'n.nn'& is the highest such version number in the directory. The three
537 files contain identical data; the only difference is the type of compression.
538 The &_.xz_& file is usually the smallest, while the &_.gz_& file is the
539 most portable to old systems.
540
541 .cindex "distribution" "signing details"
542 .cindex "distribution" "public key"
543 .cindex "public key for signed distribution"
544 The distributions will be PGP signed by an individual key of the Release
545 Coordinator. This key will have a uid containing an email address in the
546 &'exim.org'& domain and will have signatures from other people, including
547 other Exim maintainers. We expect that the key will be in the "strong set" of
548 PGP keys. There should be a trust path to that key from the Exim Maintainer's
549 PGP keys, a version of which can be found in the release directory in the file
550 &_Exim-Maintainers-Keyring.asc_&. All keys used will be available in public keyserver pools,
551 such as &'pool.sks-keyservers.net'&.
552
553 At the time of the last update, releases were being made by Jeremy Harris and signed
554 with key &'0xBCE58C8CE41F32DF'&. Other recent keys used for signing are those
555 of Heiko Schlittermann, &'0x26101B62F69376CE'&,
556 and of Phil Pennock, &'0x4D1E900E14C1CC04'&.
557
558 The signatures for the tar bundles are in:
559 .display
560 &_exim-n.nn.tar.xz.asc_&
561 &_exim-n.nn.tar.gz.asc_&
562 &_exim-n.nn.tar.bz2.asc_&
563 .endd
564 For each released version, the log of changes is made available in a
565 separate file in the directory &_ChangeLogs_& so that it is possible to
566 find out what has changed without having to download the entire distribution.
567
568 .cindex "documentation" "available formats"
569 The main distribution contains ASCII versions of this specification and other
570 documentation; other formats of the documents are available in separate files
571 inside the &_exim4_& directory of the FTP site:
572 .display
573 &_exim-html-n.nn.tar.gz_&
574 &_exim-pdf-n.nn.tar.gz_&
575 &_exim-postscript-n.nn.tar.gz_&
576 &_exim-texinfo-n.nn.tar.gz_&
577 .endd
578 These tar files contain only the &_doc_& directory, not the complete
579 distribution, and are also available in &_.bz2_& and &_.xz_& forms.
580
581
582 .section "Limitations" "SECID6"
583 .ilist
584 .cindex "limitations of Exim"
585 .cindex "bang paths" "not handled by Exim"
586 Exim is designed for use as an Internet MTA, and therefore handles addresses in
587 RFC 2822 domain format only. It cannot handle UUCP &"bang paths"&, though
588 simple two-component bang paths can be converted by a straightforward rewriting
589 configuration. This restriction does not prevent Exim from being interfaced to
590 UUCP as a transport mechanism, provided that domain addresses are used.
591 .next
592 .cindex "domainless addresses"
593 .cindex "address" "without domain"
594 Exim insists that every address it handles has a domain attached. For incoming
595 local messages, domainless addresses are automatically qualified with a
596 configured domain value. Configuration options specify from which remote
597 systems unqualified addresses are acceptable. These are then qualified on
598 arrival.
599 .next
600 .cindex "transport" "external"
601 .cindex "external transports"
602 The only external transport mechanisms that are currently implemented are SMTP
603 and LMTP over a TCP/IP network (including support for IPv6). However, a pipe
604 transport is available, and there are facilities for writing messages to files
605 and pipes, optionally in &'batched SMTP'& format; these facilities can be used
606 to send messages to other transport mechanisms such as UUCP, provided they can
607 handle domain-style addresses. Batched SMTP input is also catered for.
608 .next
609 Exim is not designed for storing mail for dial-in hosts. When the volumes of
610 such mail are large, it is better to get the messages &"delivered"& into files
611 (that is, off Exim's queue) and subsequently passed on to the dial-in hosts by
612 other means.
613 .next
614 Although Exim does have basic facilities for scanning incoming messages, these
615 are not comprehensive enough to do full virus or spam scanning. Such operations
616 are best carried out using additional specialized software packages. If you
617 compile Exim with the content-scanning extension, straightforward interfaces to
618 a number of common scanners are provided.
619 .endlist
620
621
622 .section "Runtime configuration" "SECID7"
623 Exim's runtime configuration is held in a single text file that is divided
624 into a number of sections. The entries in this file consist of keywords and
625 values, in the style of Smail 3 configuration files. A default configuration
626 file which is suitable for simple online installations is provided in the
627 distribution, and is described in chapter &<<CHAPdefconfil>>& below.
628
629
630 .section "Calling interface" "SECID8"
631 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "command line interface"
632 Like many MTAs, Exim has adopted the Sendmail command line interface so that it
633 can be a straight replacement for &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& or
634 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& when sending mail, but you do not need to know anything
635 about Sendmail in order to run Exim. For actions other than sending messages,
636 Sendmail-compatible options also exist, but those that produce output (for
637 example, &%-bp%&, which lists the messages in the queue) do so in Exim's own
638 format. There are also some additional options that are compatible with Smail
639 3, and some further options that are new to Exim. Chapter &<<CHAPcommandline>>&
640 documents all Exim's command line options. This information is automatically
641 made into the man page that forms part of the Exim distribution.
642
643 Control of messages in the queue can be done via certain privileged command
644 line options. There is also an optional monitor program called &'eximon'&,
645 which displays current information in an X window, and which contains a menu
646 interface to Exim's command line administration options.
647
648
649
650 .section "Terminology" "SECID9"
651 .cindex "terminology definitions"
652 .cindex "body of message" "definition of"
653 The &'body'& of a message is the actual data that the sender wants to transmit.
654 It is the last part of a message and is separated from the &'header'& (see
655 below) by a blank line.
656
657 .cindex "bounce message" "definition of"
658 When a message cannot be delivered, it is normally returned to the sender in a
659 delivery failure message or a &"non-delivery report"& (NDR). The term
660 &'bounce'& is commonly used for this action, and the error reports are often
661 called &'bounce messages'&. This is a convenient shorthand for &"delivery
662 failure error report"&. Such messages have an empty sender address in the
663 message's &'envelope'& (see below) to ensure that they cannot themselves give
664 rise to further bounce messages.
665
666 The term &'default'& appears frequently in this manual. It is used to qualify a
667 value which is used in the absence of any setting in the configuration. It may
668 also qualify an action which is taken unless a configuration setting specifies
669 otherwise.
670
671 The term &'defer'& is used when the delivery of a message to a specific
672 destination cannot immediately take place for some reason (a remote host may be
673 down, or a user's local mailbox may be full). Such deliveries are &'deferred'&
674 until a later time.
675
676 The word &'domain'& is sometimes used to mean all but the first component of a
677 host's name. It is &'not'& used in that sense here, where it normally refers to
678 the part of an email address following the @ sign.
679
680 .cindex "envelope, definition of"
681 .cindex "sender" "definition of"
682 A message in transit has an associated &'envelope'&, as well as a header and a
683 body. The envelope contains a sender address (to which bounce messages should
684 be delivered), and any number of recipient addresses. References to the
685 sender or the recipients of a message usually mean the addresses in the
686 envelope. An MTA uses these addresses for delivery, and for returning bounce
687 messages, not the addresses that appear in the header lines.
688
689 .cindex "message" "header, definition of"
690 .cindex "header section" "definition of"
691 The &'header'& of a message is the first part of a message's text, consisting
692 of a number of lines, each of which has a name such as &'From:'&, &'To:'&,
693 &'Subject:'&, etc. Long header lines can be split over several text lines by
694 indenting the continuations. The header is separated from the body by a blank
695 line.
696
697 .cindex "local part" "definition of"
698 .cindex "domain" "definition of"
699 The term &'local part'&, which is taken from RFC 2822, is used to refer to the
700 part of an email address that precedes the @ sign. The part that follows the
701 @ sign is called the &'domain'& or &'mail domain'&.
702
703 .cindex "local delivery" "definition of"
704 .cindex "remote delivery, definition of"
705 The terms &'local delivery'& and &'remote delivery'& are used to distinguish
706 delivery to a file or a pipe on the local host from delivery by SMTP over
707 TCP/IP to another host. As far as Exim is concerned, all hosts other than the
708 host it is running on are &'remote'&.
709
710 .cindex "return path" "definition of"
711 &'Return path'& is another name that is used for the sender address in a
712 message's envelope.
713
714 .cindex "queue" "definition of"
715 The term &'queue'& is used to refer to the set of messages awaiting delivery
716 because this term is in widespread use in the context of MTAs. However, in
717 Exim's case, the reality is more like a pool than a queue, because there is
718 normally no ordering of waiting messages.
719
720 .cindex "queue runner" "definition of"
721 The term &'queue runner'& is used to describe a process that scans the queue
722 and attempts to deliver those messages whose retry times have come. This term
723 is used by other MTAs and also relates to the command &%runq%&, but in Exim
724 the waiting messages are normally processed in an unpredictable order.
725
726 .cindex "spool directory" "definition of"
727 The term &'spool directory'& is used for a directory in which Exim keeps the
728 messages in its queue &-- that is, those that it is in the process of
729 delivering. This should not be confused with the directory in which local
730 mailboxes are stored, which is called a &"spool directory"& by some people. In
731 the Exim documentation, &"spool"& is always used in the first sense.
732
733
734
735
736
737
738 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
739 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
740
741 .chapter "Incorporated code" "CHID2"
742 .cindex "incorporated code"
743 .cindex "regular expressions" "library"
744 .cindex "PCRE"
745 .cindex "OpenDMARC"
746 A number of pieces of external code are included in the Exim distribution.
747
748 .ilist
749 Regular expressions are supported in the main Exim program and in the
750 Exim monitor using the freely-distributable PCRE library, copyright
751 &copy; University of Cambridge. The source to PCRE is no longer shipped with
752 Exim, so you will need to use the version of PCRE shipped with your system,
753 or obtain and install the full version of the library from
754 &url(ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/programming/pcre).
755 .next
756 .cindex "cdb" "acknowledgment"
757 Support for the cdb (Constant DataBase) lookup method is provided by code
758 contributed by Nigel Metheringham of (at the time he contributed it) Planet
759 Online Ltd. The implementation is completely contained within the code of Exim.
760 It does not link against an external cdb library. The code contains the
761 following statements:
762
763 .blockquote
764 Copyright &copy; 1998 Nigel Metheringham, Planet Online Ltd
765
766 This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it under
767 the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the Free Software
768 Foundation; either version 2 of the License, or (at your option) any later
769 version.
770 This code implements Dan Bernstein's Constant DataBase (cdb) spec. Information,
771 the spec and sample code for cdb can be obtained from
772 &url(https://cr.yp.to/cdb.html). This implementation borrows
773 some code from Dan Bernstein's implementation (which has no license
774 restrictions applied to it).
775 .endblockquote
776 .next
777 .cindex "SPA authentication"
778 .cindex "Samba project"
779 .cindex "Microsoft Secure Password Authentication"
780 Client support for Microsoft's &'Secure Password Authentication'& is provided
781 by code contributed by Marc Prud'hommeaux. Server support was contributed by
782 Tom Kistner. This includes code taken from the Samba project, which is released
783 under the Gnu GPL.
784 .next
785 .cindex "Cyrus"
786 .cindex "&'pwcheck'& daemon"
787 .cindex "&'pwauthd'& daemon"
788 Support for calling the Cyrus &'pwcheck'& and &'saslauthd'& daemons is provided
789 by code taken from the Cyrus-SASL library and adapted by Alexander S.
790 Sabourenkov. The permission notice appears below, in accordance with the
791 conditions expressed therein.
792
793 .blockquote
794 Copyright &copy; 2001 Carnegie Mellon University. All rights reserved.
795
796 Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
797 modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
798 are met:
799
800 .olist
801 Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
802 notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
803 .next
804 Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
805 notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in
806 the documentation and/or other materials provided with the
807 distribution.
808 .next
809 The name &"Carnegie Mellon University"& must not be used to
810 endorse or promote products derived from this software without
811 prior written permission. For permission or any other legal
812 details, please contact
813 .display
814 Office of Technology Transfer
815 Carnegie Mellon University
816 5000 Forbes Avenue
817 Pittsburgh, PA 15213-3890
818 (412) 268-4387, fax: (412) 268-7395
819 tech-transfer@andrew.cmu.edu
820 .endd
821 .next
822 Redistributions of any form whatsoever must retain the following
823 acknowledgment:
824
825 &"This product includes software developed by Computing Services
826 at Carnegie Mellon University (&url(https://www.cmu.edu/computing/)."&
827
828 CARNEGIE MELLON UNIVERSITY DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES WITH REGARD TO
829 THIS SOFTWARE, INCLUDING ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY
830 AND FITNESS, IN NO EVENT SHALL CARNEGIE MELLON UNIVERSITY BE LIABLE
831 FOR ANY SPECIAL, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR ANY DAMAGES
832 WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS, WHETHER IN
833 AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION, ARISING
834 OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS SOFTWARE.
835 .endlist
836 .endblockquote
837
838 .next
839 .cindex "Exim monitor" "acknowledgment"
840 .cindex "X-windows"
841 .cindex "Athena"
842 The Exim Monitor program, which is an X-Window application, includes
843 modified versions of the Athena StripChart and TextPop widgets.
844 This code is copyright by DEC and MIT, and their permission notice appears
845 below, in accordance with the conditions expressed therein.
846
847 .blockquote
848 Copyright 1987, 1988 by Digital Equipment Corporation, Maynard, Massachusetts,
849 and the Massachusetts Institute of Technology, Cambridge, Massachusetts.
850
851 All Rights Reserved
852
853 Permission to use, copy, modify, and distribute this software and its
854 documentation for any purpose and without fee is hereby granted,
855 provided that the above copyright notice appear in all copies and that
856 both that copyright notice and this permission notice appear in
857 supporting documentation, and that the names of Digital or MIT not be
858 used in advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the
859 software without specific, written prior permission.
860
861 DIGITAL DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES WITH REGARD TO THIS SOFTWARE, INCLUDING
862 ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS, IN NO EVENT SHALL
863 DIGITAL BE LIABLE FOR ANY SPECIAL, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR
864 ANY DAMAGES WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS,
865 WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION,
866 ARISING OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS
867 SOFTWARE.
868 .endblockquote
869
870 .next
871 .cindex "opendmarc" "acknowledgment"
872 The DMARC implementation uses the OpenDMARC library which is Copyrighted by
873 The Trusted Domain Project. Portions of Exim source which use OpenDMARC
874 derived code are indicated in the respective source files. The full OpenDMARC
875 license is provided in the LICENSE.opendmarc file contained in the distributed
876 source code.
877
878 .next
879 Many people have contributed code fragments, some large, some small, that were
880 not covered by any specific license requirements. It is assumed that the
881 contributors are happy to see their code incorporated into Exim under the GPL.
882 .endlist
883
884
885
886
887
888 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
889 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
890
891 .chapter "How Exim receives and delivers mail" "CHID11" &&&
892 "Receiving and delivering mail"
893
894
895 .section "Overall philosophy" "SECID10"
896 .cindex "design philosophy"
897 Exim is designed to work efficiently on systems that are permanently connected
898 to the Internet and are handling a general mix of mail. In such circumstances,
899 most messages can be delivered immediately. Consequently, Exim does not
900 maintain independent queues of messages for specific domains or hosts, though
901 it does try to send several messages in a single SMTP connection after a host
902 has been down, and it also maintains per-host retry information.
903
904
905 .section "Policy control" "SECID11"
906 .cindex "policy control" "overview"
907 Policy controls are now an important feature of MTAs that are connected to the
908 Internet. Perhaps their most important job is to stop MTAs from being abused as
909 &"open relays"& by misguided individuals who send out vast amounts of
910 unsolicited junk and want to disguise its source. Exim provides flexible
911 facilities for specifying policy controls on incoming mail:
912
913 .ilist
914 .cindex "&ACL;" "introduction"
915 Exim 4 (unlike previous versions of Exim) implements policy controls on
916 incoming mail by means of &'Access Control Lists'& (ACLs). Each list is a
917 series of statements that may either grant or deny access. ACLs can be used at
918 several places in the SMTP dialogue while receiving a message from a remote
919 host. However, the most common places are after each RCPT command, and at the
920 very end of the message. The sysadmin can specify conditions for accepting or
921 rejecting individual recipients or the entire message, respectively, at these
922 two points (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). Denial of access results in an SMTP
923 error code.
924 .next
925 An ACL is also available for locally generated, non-SMTP messages. In this
926 case, the only available actions are to accept or deny the entire message.
927 .next
928 When Exim is compiled with the content-scanning extension, facilities are
929 provided in the ACL mechanism for passing the message to external virus and/or
930 spam scanning software. The result of such a scan is passed back to the ACL,
931 which can then use it to decide what to do with the message.
932 .next
933 When a message has been received, either from a remote host or from the local
934 host, but before the final acknowledgment has been sent, a locally supplied C
935 function called &[local_scan()]& can be run to inspect the message and decide
936 whether to accept it or not (see chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&). If the message
937 is accepted, the list of recipients can be modified by the function.
938 .next
939 Using the &[local_scan()]& mechanism is another way of calling external scanner
940 software. The &%SA-Exim%& add-on package works this way. It does not require
941 Exim to be compiled with the content-scanning extension.
942 .next
943 After a message has been accepted, a further checking mechanism is available in
944 the form of the &'system filter'& (see chapter &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>&). This
945 runs at the start of every delivery process.
946 .endlist
947
948
949
950 .section "User filters" "SECID12"
951 .cindex "filter" "introduction"
952 .cindex "Sieve filter"
953 In a conventional Exim configuration, users are able to run private filters by
954 setting up appropriate &_.forward_& files in their home directories. See
955 chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>& (about the &(redirect)& router) for the
956 configuration needed to support this, and the separate document entitled
957 &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'& for user details. Two different kinds
958 of filtering are available:
959
960 .ilist
961 Sieve filters are written in the standard filtering language that is defined
962 by RFC 3028.
963 .next
964 Exim filters are written in a syntax that is unique to Exim, but which is more
965 powerful than Sieve, which it pre-dates.
966 .endlist
967
968 User filters are run as part of the routing process, described below.
969
970
971
972 .section "Message identification" "SECTmessiden"
973 .cindex "message ids" "details of format"
974 .cindex "format" "of message id"
975 .cindex "id of message"
976 .cindex "base62"
977 .cindex "base36"
978 .cindex "Darwin"
979 .cindex "Cygwin"
980 Every message handled by Exim is given a &'message id'& which is sixteen
981 characters long. It is divided into three parts, separated by hyphens, for
982 example &`16VDhn-0001bo-D3`&. Each part is a sequence of letters and digits,
983 normally encoding numbers in base 62. However, in the Darwin operating
984 system (Mac OS X) and when Exim is compiled to run under Cygwin, base 36
985 (avoiding the use of lower case letters) is used instead, because the message
986 id is used to construct filenames, and the names of files in those systems are
987 not always case-sensitive.
988
989 .cindex "pid (process id)" "re-use of"
990 The detail of the contents of the message id have changed as Exim has evolved.
991 Earlier versions relied on the operating system not re-using a process id (pid)
992 within one second. On modern operating systems, this assumption can no longer
993 be made, so the algorithm had to be changed. To retain backward compatibility,
994 the format of the message id was retained, which is why the following rules are
995 somewhat eccentric:
996
997 .ilist
998 The first six characters of the message id are the time at which the message
999 started to be received, to a granularity of one second. That is, this field
1000 contains the number of seconds since the start of the epoch (the normal Unix
1001 way of representing the date and time of day).
1002 .next
1003 After the first hyphen, the next six characters are the id of the process that
1004 received the message.
1005 .next
1006 There are two different possibilities for the final two characters:
1007 .olist
1008 .oindex "&%localhost_number%&"
1009 If &%localhost_number%& is not set, this value is the fractional part of the
1010 time of reception, normally in units of 1/2000 of a second, but for systems
1011 that must use base 36 instead of base 62 (because of case-insensitive file
1012 systems), the units are 1/1000 of a second.
1013 .next
1014 If &%localhost_number%& is set, it is multiplied by 200 (100) and added to
1015 the fractional part of the time, which in this case is in units of 1/200
1016 (1/100) of a second.
1017 .endlist
1018 .endlist
1019
1020 After a message has been received, Exim waits for the clock to tick at the
1021 appropriate resolution before proceeding, so that if another message is
1022 received by the same process, or by another process with the same (re-used)
1023 pid, it is guaranteed that the time will be different. In most cases, the clock
1024 will already have ticked while the message was being received.
1025
1026
1027 .section "Receiving mail" "SECID13"
1028 .cindex "receiving mail"
1029 .cindex "message" "reception"
1030 The only way Exim can receive mail from another host is using SMTP over
1031 TCP/IP, in which case the sender and recipient addresses are transferred using
1032 SMTP commands. However, from a locally running process (such as a user's MUA),
1033 there are several possibilities:
1034
1035 .ilist
1036 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bm%& option, the message is read
1037 non-interactively (usually via a pipe), with the recipients taken from the
1038 command line, or from the body of the message if &%-t%& is also used.
1039 .next
1040 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bS%& option, the message is also read
1041 non-interactively, but in this case the recipients are listed at the start of
1042 the message in a series of SMTP RCPT commands, terminated by a DATA
1043 command. This is called &"batch SMTP"& format,
1044 but it isn't really SMTP. The SMTP commands are just another way of passing
1045 envelope addresses in a non-interactive submission.
1046 .next
1047 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bs%& option, the message is read
1048 interactively, using the SMTP protocol. A two-way pipe is normally used for
1049 passing data between the local process and the Exim process.
1050 This is &"real"& SMTP and is handled in the same way as SMTP over TCP/IP. For
1051 example, the ACLs for SMTP commands are used for this form of submission.
1052 .next
1053 A local process may also make a TCP/IP call to the host's loopback address
1054 (127.0.0.1) or any other of its IP addresses. When receiving messages, Exim
1055 does not treat the loopback address specially. It treats all such connections
1056 in the same way as connections from other hosts.
1057 .endlist
1058
1059
1060 .cindex "message sender, constructed by Exim"
1061 .cindex "sender" "constructed by Exim"
1062 In the three cases that do not involve TCP/IP, the sender address is
1063 constructed from the login name of the user that called Exim and a default
1064 qualification domain (which can be set by the &%qualify_domain%& configuration
1065 option). For local or batch SMTP, a sender address that is passed using the
1066 SMTP MAIL command is ignored. However, the system administrator may allow
1067 certain users (&"trusted users"&) to specify a different sender addresses
1068 unconditionally, or all users to specify certain forms of different sender
1069 address. The &%-f%& option or the SMTP MAIL command is used to specify these
1070 different addresses. See section &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for details of trusted
1071 users, and the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option for a way of allowing untrusted
1072 users to change sender addresses.
1073
1074 Messages received by either of the non-interactive mechanisms are subject to
1075 checking by the non-SMTP ACL if one is defined. Messages received using SMTP
1076 (either over TCP/IP or interacting with a local process) can be checked by a
1077 number of ACLs that operate at different times during the SMTP session. Either
1078 individual recipients or the entire message can be rejected if local policy
1079 requirements are not met. The &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter
1080 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&) is run for all incoming messages.
1081
1082 Exim can be configured not to start a delivery process when a message is
1083 received; this can be unconditional, or depend on the number of incoming SMTP
1084 connections or the system load. In these situations, new messages wait on the
1085 queue until a queue runner process picks them up. However, in standard
1086 configurations under normal conditions, delivery is started as soon as a
1087 message is received.
1088
1089
1090
1091
1092
1093 .section "Handling an incoming message" "SECID14"
1094 .cindex "spool directory" "files that hold a message"
1095 .cindex "file" "how a message is held"
1096 When Exim accepts a message, it writes two files in its spool directory. The
1097 first contains the envelope information, the current status of the message, and
1098 the header lines, and the second contains the body of the message. The names of
1099 the two spool files consist of the message id, followed by &`-H`& for the
1100 file containing the envelope and header, and &`-D`& for the data file.
1101
1102 .cindex "spool directory" "&_input_& sub-directory"
1103 By default, all these message files are held in a single directory called
1104 &_input_& inside the general Exim spool directory. Some operating systems do
1105 not perform very well if the number of files in a directory gets large; to
1106 improve performance in such cases, the &%split_spool_directory%& option can be
1107 used. This causes Exim to split up the input files into 62 sub-directories
1108 whose names are single letters or digits. When this is done, the queue is
1109 processed one sub-directory at a time instead of all at once, which can improve
1110 overall performance even when there are not enough files in each directory to
1111 affect file system performance.
1112
1113 The envelope information consists of the address of the message's sender and
1114 the addresses of the recipients. This information is entirely separate from
1115 any addresses contained in the header lines. The status of the message includes
1116 a list of recipients who have already received the message. The format of the
1117 first spool file is described in chapter &<<CHAPspool>>&.
1118
1119 .cindex "rewriting" "addresses"
1120 Address rewriting that is specified in the rewrite section of the configuration
1121 (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&) is done once and for all on incoming addresses,
1122 both in the header lines and the envelope, at the time the message is accepted.
1123 If during the course of delivery additional addresses are generated (for
1124 example, via aliasing), these new addresses are rewritten as soon as they are
1125 generated. At the time a message is actually delivered (transported) further
1126 rewriting can take place; because this is a transport option, it can be
1127 different for different forms of delivery. It is also possible to specify the
1128 addition or removal of certain header lines at the time the message is
1129 delivered (see chapters &<<CHAProutergeneric>>& and
1130 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
1131
1132
1133
1134 .section "Life of a message" "SECID15"
1135 .cindex "message" "life of"
1136 .cindex "message" "frozen"
1137 A message remains in the spool directory until it is completely delivered to
1138 its recipients or to an error address, or until it is deleted by an
1139 administrator or by the user who originally created it. In cases when delivery
1140 cannot proceed &-- for example when a message can neither be delivered to its
1141 recipients nor returned to its sender, the message is marked &"frozen"& on the
1142 spool, and no more deliveries are attempted.
1143
1144 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
1145 .cindex "message" "thawing frozen"
1146 An administrator can &"thaw"& such messages when the problem has been
1147 corrected, and can also freeze individual messages by hand if necessary. In
1148 addition, an administrator can force a delivery error, causing a bounce message
1149 to be sent.
1150
1151 .oindex "&%timeout_frozen_after%&"
1152 .oindex "&%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&"
1153 There are options called &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%& and
1154 &%timeout_frozen_after%&, which discard frozen messages after a certain time.
1155 The first applies only to frozen bounces, the second to all frozen messages.
1156
1157 .cindex "message" "log file for"
1158 .cindex "log" "file for each message"
1159 While Exim is working on a message, it writes information about each delivery
1160 attempt to its main log file. This includes successful, unsuccessful, and
1161 delayed deliveries for each recipient (see chapter &<<CHAPlog>>&). The log
1162 lines are also written to a separate &'message log'& file for each message.
1163 These logs are solely for the benefit of the administrator and are normally
1164 deleted along with the spool files when processing of a message is complete.
1165 The use of individual message logs can be disabled by setting
1166 &%no_message_logs%&; this might give an improvement in performance on very busy
1167 systems.
1168
1169 .cindex "journal file"
1170 .cindex "file" "journal"
1171 All the information Exim itself needs to set up a delivery is kept in the first
1172 spool file, along with the header lines. When a successful delivery occurs, the
1173 address is immediately written at the end of a journal file, whose name is the
1174 message id followed by &`-J`&. At the end of a delivery run, if there are some
1175 addresses left to be tried again later, the first spool file (the &`-H`& file)
1176 is updated to indicate which these are, and the journal file is then deleted.
1177 Updating the spool file is done by writing a new file and renaming it, to
1178 minimize the possibility of data loss.
1179
1180 Should the system or Exim crash after a successful delivery but before
1181 the spool file has been updated, the journal is left lying around. The next
1182 time Exim attempts to deliver the message, it reads the journal file and
1183 updates the spool file before proceeding. This minimizes the chances of double
1184 deliveries caused by crashes.
1185
1186
1187
1188 .section "Processing an address for delivery" "SECTprocaddress"
1189 .cindex "drivers" "definition of"
1190 .cindex "router" "definition of"
1191 .cindex "transport" "definition of"
1192 The main delivery processing elements of Exim are called &'routers'& and
1193 &'transports'&, and collectively these are known as &'drivers'&. Code for a
1194 number of them is provided in the source distribution, and compile-time options
1195 specify which ones are included in the binary. Runtime options specify which
1196 ones are actually used for delivering messages.
1197
1198 .cindex "drivers" "instance definition"
1199 Each driver that is specified in the runtime configuration is an &'instance'&
1200 of that particular driver type. Multiple instances are allowed; for example,
1201 you can set up several different &(smtp)& transports, each with different
1202 option values that might specify different ports or different timeouts. Each
1203 instance has its own identifying name. In what follows we will normally use the
1204 instance name when discussing one particular instance (that is, one specific
1205 configuration of the driver), and the generic driver name when discussing
1206 the driver's features in general.
1207
1208 A &'router'& is a driver that operates on an address, either determining how
1209 its delivery should happen, by assigning it to a specific transport, or
1210 converting the address into one or more new addresses (for example, via an
1211 alias file). A router may also explicitly choose to fail an address, causing it
1212 to be bounced.
1213
1214 A &'transport'& is a driver that transmits a copy of the message from Exim's
1215 spool to some destination. There are two kinds of transport: for a &'local'&
1216 transport, the destination is a file or a pipe on the local host, whereas for a
1217 &'remote'& transport the destination is some other host. A message is passed
1218 to a specific transport as a result of successful routing. If a message has
1219 several recipients, it may be passed to a number of different transports.
1220
1221 .cindex "preconditions" "definition of"
1222 An address is processed by passing it to each configured router instance in
1223 turn, subject to certain preconditions, until a router accepts the address or
1224 specifies that it should be bounced. We will describe this process in more
1225 detail shortly. First, as a simple example, we consider how each recipient
1226 address in a message is processed in a small configuration of three routers.
1227
1228 To make this a more concrete example, it is described in terms of some actual
1229 routers, but remember, this is only an example. You can configure Exim's
1230 routers in many different ways, and there may be any number of routers in a
1231 configuration.
1232
1233 The first router that is specified in a configuration is often one that handles
1234 addresses in domains that are not recognized specifically by the local host.
1235 Typically these are addresses for arbitrary domains on the Internet. A precondition
1236 is set up which looks for the special domains known to the host (for example,
1237 its own domain name), and the router is run for addresses that do &'not'&
1238 match. Typically, this is a router that looks up domains in the DNS in order to
1239 find the hosts to which this address routes. If it succeeds, the address is
1240 assigned to a suitable SMTP transport; if it does not succeed, the router is
1241 configured to fail the address.
1242
1243 The second router is reached only when the domain is recognized as one that
1244 &"belongs"& to the local host. This router does redirection &-- also known as
1245 aliasing and forwarding. When it generates one or more new addresses from the
1246 original, each of them is routed independently from the start. Otherwise, the
1247 router may cause an address to fail, or it may simply decline to handle the
1248 address, in which case the address is passed to the next router.
1249
1250 The final router in many configurations is one that checks to see if the
1251 address belongs to a local mailbox. The precondition may involve a check to
1252 see if the local part is the name of a login account, or it may look up the
1253 local part in a file or a database. If its preconditions are not met, or if
1254 the router declines, we have reached the end of the routers. When this happens,
1255 the address is bounced.
1256
1257
1258
1259 .section "Processing an address for verification" "SECID16"
1260 .cindex "router" "for verification"
1261 .cindex "verifying address" "overview"
1262 As well as being used to decide how to deliver to an address, Exim's routers
1263 are also used for &'address verification'&. Verification can be requested as
1264 one of the checks to be performed in an ACL for incoming messages, on both
1265 sender and recipient addresses, and it can be tested using the &%-bv%& and
1266 &%-bvs%& command line options.
1267
1268 When an address is being verified, the routers are run in &"verify mode"&. This
1269 does not affect the way the routers work, but it is a state that can be
1270 detected. By this means, a router can be skipped or made to behave differently
1271 when verifying. A common example is a configuration in which the first router
1272 sends all messages to a message-scanning program unless they have been
1273 previously scanned. Thus, the first router accepts all addresses without any
1274 checking, making it useless for verifying. Normally, the &%no_verify%& option
1275 would be set for such a router, causing it to be skipped in verify mode.
1276
1277
1278
1279
1280 .section "Running an individual router" "SECTrunindrou"
1281 .cindex "router" "running details"
1282 .cindex "preconditions" "checking"
1283 .cindex "router" "result of running"
1284 As explained in the example above, a number of preconditions are checked before
1285 running a router. If any are not met, the router is skipped, and the address is
1286 passed to the next router. When all the preconditions on a router &'are'& met,
1287 the router is run. What happens next depends on the outcome, which is one of
1288 the following:
1289
1290 .ilist
1291 &'accept'&: The router accepts the address, and either assigns it to a
1292 transport or generates one or more &"child"& addresses. Processing the
1293 original address ceases
1294 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
1295 unless the &%unseen%& option is set on the router. This option
1296 can be used to set up multiple deliveries with different routing (for example,
1297 for keeping archive copies of messages). When &%unseen%& is set, the address is
1298 passed to the next router. Normally, however, an &'accept'& return marks the
1299 end of routing.
1300
1301 Any child addresses generated by the router are processed independently,
1302 starting with the first router by default. It is possible to change this by
1303 setting the &%redirect_router%& option to specify which router to start at for
1304 child addresses. Unlike &%pass_router%& (see below) the router specified by
1305 &%redirect_router%& may be anywhere in the router configuration.
1306 .next
1307 &'pass'&: The router recognizes the address, but cannot handle it itself. It
1308 requests that the address be passed to another router. By default, the address
1309 is passed to the next router, but this can be changed by setting the
1310 &%pass_router%& option. However, (unlike &%redirect_router%&) the named router
1311 must be below the current router (to avoid loops).
1312 .next
1313 &'decline'&: The router declines to accept the address because it does not
1314 recognize it at all. By default, the address is passed to the next router, but
1315 this can be prevented by setting the &%no_more%& option. When &%no_more%& is
1316 set, all the remaining routers are skipped. In effect, &%no_more%& converts
1317 &'decline'& into &'fail'&.
1318 .next
1319 &'fail'&: The router determines that the address should fail, and queues it for
1320 the generation of a bounce message. There is no further processing of the
1321 original address unless &%unseen%& is set on the router.
1322 .next
1323 &'defer'&: The router cannot handle the address at the present time. (A
1324 database may be offline, or a DNS lookup may have timed out.) No further
1325 processing of the address happens in this delivery attempt. It is tried again
1326 next time the message is considered for delivery.
1327 .next
1328 &'error'&: There is some error in the router (for example, a syntax error in
1329 its configuration). The action is as for defer.
1330 .endlist
1331
1332 If an address reaches the end of the routers without having been accepted by
1333 any of them, it is bounced as unrouteable. The default error message in this
1334 situation is &"unrouteable address"&, but you can set your own message by
1335 making use of the &%cannot_route_message%& option. This can be set for any
1336 router; the value from the last router that &"saw"& the address is used.
1337
1338 Sometimes while routing you want to fail a delivery when some conditions are
1339 met but others are not, instead of passing the address on for further routing.
1340 You can do this by having a second router that explicitly fails the delivery
1341 when the relevant conditions are met. The &(redirect)& router has a &"fail"&
1342 facility for this purpose.
1343
1344
1345 .section "Duplicate addresses" "SECID17"
1346 .cindex "case of local parts"
1347 .cindex "address duplicate, discarding"
1348 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
1349 Once routing is complete, Exim scans the addresses that are assigned to local
1350 and remote transports and discards any duplicates that it finds. During this
1351 check, local parts are treated case-sensitively. This happens only when
1352 actually delivering a message; when testing routers with &%-bt%&, all the
1353 routed addresses are shown.
1354
1355
1356
1357 .section "Router preconditions" "SECTrouprecon"
1358 .cindex "router" "preconditions, order of processing"
1359 .cindex "preconditions" "order of processing"
1360 The preconditions that are tested for each router are listed below, in the
1361 order in which they are tested. The individual configuration options are
1362 described in more detail in chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&.
1363
1364 .ilist
1365 .cindex affix "router precondition"
1366 The &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& options can specify that
1367 the local parts handled by the router may or must have certain prefixes and/or
1368 suffixes. If a mandatory affix (prefix or suffix) is not present, the router is
1369 skipped. These conditions are tested first. When an affix is present, it is
1370 removed from the local part before further processing, including the evaluation
1371 of any other conditions.
1372 .next
1373 Routers can be designated for use only when not verifying an address, that is,
1374 only when routing it for delivery (or testing its delivery routing). If the
1375 &%verify%& option is set false, the router is skipped when Exim is verifying an
1376 address.
1377 Setting the &%verify%& option actually sets two options, &%verify_sender%& and
1378 &%verify_recipient%&, which independently control the use of the router for
1379 sender and recipient verification. You can set these options directly if
1380 you want a router to be used for only one type of verification.
1381 Note that cutthrough delivery is classed as a recipient verification for this purpose.
1382 .next
1383 If the &%address_test%& option is set false, the router is skipped when Exim is
1384 run with the &%-bt%& option to test an address routing. This can be helpful
1385 when the first router sends all new messages to a scanner of some sort; it
1386 makes it possible to use &%-bt%& to test subsequent delivery routing without
1387 having to simulate the effect of the scanner.
1388 .next
1389 Routers can be designated for use only when verifying an address, as
1390 opposed to routing it for delivery. The &%verify_only%& option controls this.
1391 Again, cutthrough delivery counts as a verification.
1392 .next
1393 Individual routers can be explicitly skipped when running the routers to
1394 check an address given in the SMTP EXPN command (see the &%expn%& option).
1395 .next
1396 If the &%domains%& option is set, the domain of the address must be in the set
1397 of domains that it defines.
1398 .next
1399 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
1400 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
1401 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
1402 .cindex affix "router precondition"
1403 If the &%local_parts%& option is set, the local part of the address must be in
1404 the set of local parts that it defines. If &%local_part_prefix%& or
1405 &%local_part_suffix%& is in use, the prefix or suffix is removed from the local
1406 part before this check. If you want to do precondition tests on local parts
1407 that include affixes, you can do so by using a &%condition%& option (see below)
1408 that uses the variables &$local_part$&, &$local_part_prefix$&, and
1409 &$local_part_suffix$& as necessary.
1410 .next
1411 .vindex "&$local_user_uid$&"
1412 .vindex "&$local_user_gid$&"
1413 .vindex "&$home$&"
1414 If the &%check_local_user%& option is set, the local part must be the name of
1415 an account on the local host. If this check succeeds, the uid and gid of the
1416 local user are placed in &$local_user_uid$& and &$local_user_gid$& and the
1417 user's home directory is placed in &$home$&; these values can be used in the
1418 remaining preconditions.
1419 .next
1420 If the &%router_home_directory%& option is set, it is expanded at this point,
1421 because it overrides the value of &$home$&. If this expansion were left till
1422 later, the value of &$home$& as set by &%check_local_user%& would be used in
1423 subsequent tests. Having two different values of &$home$& in the same router
1424 could lead to confusion.
1425 .next
1426 If the &%senders%& option is set, the envelope sender address must be in the
1427 set of addresses that it defines.
1428 .next
1429 If the &%require_files%& option is set, the existence or non-existence of
1430 specified files is tested.
1431 .next
1432 .cindex "customizing" "precondition"
1433 If the &%condition%& option is set, it is evaluated and tested. This option
1434 uses an expanded string to allow you to set up your own custom preconditions.
1435 Expanded strings are described in chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
1436 .endlist
1437
1438
1439 Note that &%require_files%& comes near the end of the list, so you cannot use
1440 it to check for the existence of a file in which to lookup up a domain, local
1441 part, or sender. However, as these options are all expanded, you can use the
1442 &%exists%& expansion condition to make such tests within each condition. The
1443 &%require_files%& option is intended for checking files that the router may be
1444 going to use internally, or which are needed by a specific transport (for
1445 example, &_.procmailrc_&).
1446
1447
1448
1449 .section "Delivery in detail" "SECID18"
1450 .cindex "delivery" "in detail"
1451 When a message is to be delivered, the sequence of events is as follows:
1452
1453 .ilist
1454 If a system-wide filter file is specified, the message is passed to it. The
1455 filter may add recipients to the message, replace the recipients, discard the
1456 message, cause a new message to be generated, or cause the message delivery to
1457 fail. The format of the system filter file is the same as for Exim user filter
1458 files, described in the separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail
1459 filtering'&.
1460 .cindex "Sieve filter" "not available for system filter"
1461 (&*Note*&: Sieve cannot be used for system filter files.)
1462
1463 Some additional features are available in system filters &-- see chapter
1464 &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>& for details. Note that a message is passed to the system
1465 filter only once per delivery attempt, however many recipients it has. However,
1466 if there are several delivery attempts because one or more addresses could not
1467 be immediately delivered, the system filter is run each time. The filter
1468 condition &%first_delivery%& can be used to detect the first run of the system
1469 filter.
1470 .next
1471 Each recipient address is offered to each configured router, in turn, subject to
1472 its preconditions, until one is able to handle it. If no router can handle the
1473 address, that is, if they all decline, the address is failed. Because routers
1474 can be targeted at particular domains, several locally handled domains can be
1475 processed entirely independently of each other.
1476 .next
1477 .cindex "routing" "loops in"
1478 .cindex "loop" "while routing"
1479 A router that accepts an address may assign it to a local or a remote
1480 transport. However, the transport is not run at this time. Instead, the address
1481 is placed on a list for the particular transport, which will be run later.
1482 Alternatively, the router may generate one or more new addresses (typically
1483 from alias, forward, or filter files). New addresses are fed back into this
1484 process from the top, but in order to avoid loops, a router ignores any address
1485 which has an identically-named ancestor that was processed by itself.
1486 .next
1487 When all the routing has been done, addresses that have been successfully
1488 handled are passed to their assigned transports. When local transports are
1489 doing real local deliveries, they handle only one address at a time, but if a
1490 local transport is being used as a pseudo-remote transport (for example, to
1491 collect batched SMTP messages for transmission by some other means) multiple
1492 addresses can be handled. Remote transports can always handle more than one
1493 address at a time, but can be configured not to do so, or to restrict multiple
1494 addresses to the same domain.
1495 .next
1496 Each local delivery to a file or a pipe runs in a separate process under a
1497 non-privileged uid, and these deliveries are run one at a time. Remote
1498 deliveries also run in separate processes, normally under a uid that is private
1499 to Exim (&"the Exim user"&), but in this case, several remote deliveries can be
1500 run in parallel. The maximum number of simultaneous remote deliveries for any
1501 one message is set by the &%remote_max_parallel%& option.
1502 The order in which deliveries are done is not defined, except that all local
1503 deliveries happen before any remote deliveries.
1504 .next
1505 .cindex "queue runner"
1506 When it encounters a local delivery during a queue run, Exim checks its retry
1507 database to see if there has been a previous temporary delivery failure for the
1508 address before running the local transport. If there was a previous failure,
1509 Exim does not attempt a new delivery until the retry time for the address is
1510 reached. However, this happens only for delivery attempts that are part of a
1511 queue run. Local deliveries are always attempted when delivery immediately
1512 follows message reception, even if retry times are set for them. This makes for
1513 better behaviour if one particular message is causing problems (for example,
1514 causing quota overflow, or provoking an error in a filter file).
1515 .next
1516 .cindex "delivery" "retry in remote transports"
1517 Remote transports do their own retry handling, since an address may be
1518 deliverable to one of a number of hosts, each of which may have a different
1519 retry time. If there have been previous temporary failures and no host has
1520 reached its retry time, no delivery is attempted, whether in a queue run or
1521 not. See chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& for details of retry strategies.
1522 .next
1523 If there were any permanent errors, a bounce message is returned to an
1524 appropriate address (the sender in the common case), with details of the error
1525 for each failing address. Exim can be configured to send copies of bounce
1526 messages to other addresses.
1527 .next
1528 .cindex "delivery" "deferral"
1529 If one or more addresses suffered a temporary failure, the message is left on
1530 the queue, to be tried again later. Delivery of these addresses is said to be
1531 &'deferred'&.
1532 .next
1533 When all the recipient addresses have either been delivered or bounced,
1534 handling of the message is complete. The spool files and message log are
1535 deleted, though the message log can optionally be preserved if required.
1536 .endlist
1537
1538
1539
1540
1541 .section "Retry mechanism" "SECID19"
1542 .cindex "delivery" "retry mechanism"
1543 .cindex "retry" "description of mechanism"
1544 .cindex "queue runner"
1545 Exim's mechanism for retrying messages that fail to get delivered at the first
1546 attempt is the queue runner process. You must either run an Exim daemon that
1547 uses the &%-q%& option with a time interval to start queue runners at regular
1548 intervals or use some other means (such as &'cron'&) to start them. If you do
1549 not arrange for queue runners to be run, messages that fail temporarily at the
1550 first attempt will remain in your queue forever. A queue runner process works
1551 its way through the queue, one message at a time, trying each delivery that has
1552 passed its retry time.
1553 You can run several queue runners at once.
1554
1555 Exim uses a set of configured rules to determine when next to retry the failing
1556 address (see chapter &<<CHAPretry>>&). These rules also specify when Exim
1557 should give up trying to deliver to the address, at which point it generates a
1558 bounce message. If no retry rules are set for a particular host, address, and
1559 error combination, no retries are attempted, and temporary errors are treated
1560 as permanent.
1561
1562
1563
1564 .section "Temporary delivery failure" "SECID20"
1565 .cindex "delivery" "temporary failure"
1566 There are many reasons why a message may not be immediately deliverable to a
1567 particular address. Failure to connect to a remote machine (because it, or the
1568 connection to it, is down) is one of the most common. Temporary failures may be
1569 detected during routing as well as during the transport stage of delivery.
1570 Local deliveries may be delayed if NFS files are unavailable, or if a mailbox
1571 is on a file system where the user is over quota. Exim can be configured to
1572 impose its own quotas on local mailboxes; where system quotas are set they will
1573 also apply.
1574
1575 If a host is unreachable for a period of time, a number of messages may be
1576 waiting for it by the time it recovers, and sending them in a single SMTP
1577 connection is clearly beneficial. Whenever a delivery to a remote host is
1578 deferred,
1579 .cindex "hints database" "deferred deliveries"
1580 Exim makes a note in its hints database, and whenever a successful
1581 SMTP delivery has happened, it looks to see if any other messages are waiting
1582 for the same host. If any are found, they are sent over the same SMTP
1583 connection, subject to a configuration limit as to the maximum number in any
1584 one connection.
1585
1586
1587
1588 .section "Permanent delivery failure" "SECID21"
1589 .cindex "delivery" "permanent failure"
1590 .cindex "bounce message" "when generated"
1591 When a message cannot be delivered to some or all of its intended recipients, a
1592 bounce message is generated. Temporary delivery failures turn into permanent
1593 errors when their timeout expires. All the addresses that fail in a given
1594 delivery attempt are listed in a single message. If the original message has
1595 many recipients, it is possible for some addresses to fail in one delivery
1596 attempt and others to fail subsequently, giving rise to more than one bounce
1597 message. The wording of bounce messages can be customized by the administrator.
1598 See chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>& for details.
1599
1600 .cindex "&'X-Failed-Recipients:'& header line"
1601 Bounce messages contain an &'X-Failed-Recipients:'& header line that lists the
1602 failed addresses, for the benefit of programs that try to analyse such messages
1603 automatically.
1604
1605 .cindex "bounce message" "recipient of"
1606 A bounce message is normally sent to the sender of the original message, as
1607 obtained from the message's envelope. For incoming SMTP messages, this is the
1608 address given in the MAIL command. However, when an address is expanded via a
1609 forward or alias file, an alternative address can be specified for delivery
1610 failures of the generated addresses. For a mailing list expansion (see section
1611 &<<SECTmailinglists>>&) it is common to direct bounce messages to the manager
1612 of the list.
1613
1614
1615
1616 .section "Failures to deliver bounce messages" "SECID22"
1617 .cindex "bounce message" "failure to deliver"
1618 If a bounce message (either locally generated or received from a remote host)
1619 itself suffers a permanent delivery failure, the message is left in the queue,
1620 but it is frozen, awaiting the attention of an administrator. There are options
1621 that can be used to make Exim discard such failed messages, or to keep them
1622 for only a short time (see &%timeout_frozen_after%& and
1623 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&).
1624
1625
1626
1627
1628
1629 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
1630 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
1631
1632 .chapter "Building and installing Exim" "CHID3"
1633 .scindex IIDbuex "building Exim"
1634
1635 .section "Unpacking" "SECID23"
1636 Exim is distributed as a gzipped or bzipped tar file which, when unpacked,
1637 creates a directory with the name of the current release (for example,
1638 &_exim-&version()_&) into which the following files are placed:
1639
1640 .table2 140pt
1641 .irow &_ACKNOWLEDGMENTS_& "contains some acknowledgments"
1642 .irow &_CHANGES_& "contains a reference to where changes are &&&
1643 documented"
1644 .irow &_LICENCE_& "the GNU General Public Licence"
1645 .irow &_Makefile_& "top-level make file"
1646 .irow &_NOTICE_& "conditions for the use of Exim"
1647 .irow &_README_& "list of files, directories and simple build &&&
1648 instructions"
1649 .endtable
1650
1651 Other files whose names begin with &_README_& may also be present. The
1652 following subdirectories are created:
1653
1654 .table2 140pt
1655 .irow &_Local_& "an empty directory for local configuration files"
1656 .irow &_OS_& "OS-specific files"
1657 .irow &_doc_& "documentation files"
1658 .irow &_exim_monitor_& "source files for the Exim monitor"
1659 .irow &_scripts_& "scripts used in the build process"
1660 .irow &_src_& "remaining source files"
1661 .irow &_util_& "independent utilities"
1662 .endtable
1663
1664 The main utility programs are contained in the &_src_& directory and are built
1665 with the Exim binary. The &_util_& directory contains a few optional scripts
1666 that may be useful to some sites.
1667
1668
1669 .section "Multiple machine architectures and operating systems" "SECID24"
1670 .cindex "building Exim" "multiple OS/architectures"
1671 The building process for Exim is arranged to make it easy to build binaries for
1672 a number of different architectures and operating systems from the same set of
1673 source files. Compilation does not take place in the &_src_& directory.
1674 Instead, a &'build directory'& is created for each architecture and operating
1675 system.
1676 .cindex "symbolic link" "to build directory"
1677 Symbolic links to the sources are installed in this directory, which is where
1678 the actual building takes place. In most cases, Exim can discover the machine
1679 architecture and operating system for itself, but the defaults can be
1680 overridden if necessary.
1681 .cindex compiler requirements
1682 .cindex compiler version
1683 A C99-capable compiler will be required for the build.
1684
1685
1686 .section "PCRE library" "SECTpcre"
1687 .cindex "PCRE library"
1688 Exim no longer has an embedded PCRE library as the vast majority of
1689 modern systems include PCRE as a system library, although you may need to
1690 install the PCRE package or the PCRE development package for your operating
1691 system. If your system has a normal PCRE installation the Exim build
1692 process will need no further configuration. If the library or the
1693 headers are in an unusual location you will need to either set the PCRE_LIBS
1694 and INCLUDE directives appropriately,
1695 or set PCRE_CONFIG=yes to use the installed &(pcre-config)& command.
1696 If your operating system has no
1697 PCRE support then you will need to obtain and build the current PCRE
1698 from &url(ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/programming/pcre/).
1699 More information on PCRE is available at &url(https://www.pcre.org/).
1700
1701 .section "DBM libraries" "SECTdb"
1702 .cindex "DBM libraries" "discussion of"
1703 .cindex "hints database" "DBM files used for"
1704 Even if you do not use any DBM files in your configuration, Exim still needs a
1705 DBM library in order to operate, because it uses indexed files for its hints
1706 databases. Unfortunately, there are a number of DBM libraries in existence, and
1707 different operating systems often have different ones installed.
1708
1709 .cindex "Solaris" "DBM library for"
1710 .cindex "IRIX, DBM library for"
1711 .cindex "BSD, DBM library for"
1712 .cindex "Linux, DBM library for"
1713 If you are using Solaris, IRIX, one of the modern BSD systems, or a modern
1714 Linux distribution, the DBM configuration should happen automatically, and you
1715 may be able to ignore this section. Otherwise, you may have to learn more than
1716 you would like about DBM libraries from what follows.
1717
1718 .cindex "&'ndbm'& DBM library"
1719 Licensed versions of Unix normally contain a library of DBM functions operating
1720 via the &'ndbm'& interface, and this is what Exim expects by default. Free
1721 versions of Unix seem to vary in what they contain as standard. In particular,
1722 some early versions of Linux have no default DBM library, and different
1723 distributors have chosen to bundle different libraries with their packaged
1724 versions. However, the more recent releases seem to have standardized on the
1725 Berkeley DB library.
1726
1727 Different DBM libraries have different conventions for naming the files they
1728 use. When a program opens a file called &_dbmfile_&, there are several
1729 possibilities:
1730
1731 .olist
1732 A traditional &'ndbm'& implementation, such as that supplied as part of
1733 Solaris, operates on two files called &_dbmfile.dir_& and &_dbmfile.pag_&.
1734 .next
1735 .cindex "&'gdbm'& DBM library"
1736 The GNU library, &'gdbm'&, operates on a single file. If used via its &'ndbm'&
1737 compatibility interface it makes two different hard links to it with names
1738 &_dbmfile.dir_& and &_dbmfile.pag_&, but if used via its native interface, the
1739 filename is used unmodified.
1740 .next
1741 .cindex "Berkeley DB library"
1742 The Berkeley DB package, if called via its &'ndbm'& compatibility interface,
1743 operates on a single file called &_dbmfile.db_&, but otherwise looks to the
1744 programmer exactly the same as the traditional &'ndbm'& implementation.
1745 .next
1746 If the Berkeley package is used in its native mode, it operates on a single
1747 file called &_dbmfile_&; the programmer's interface is somewhat different to
1748 the traditional &'ndbm'& interface.
1749 .next
1750 To complicate things further, there are several very different versions of the
1751 Berkeley DB package. Version 1.85 was stable for a very long time, releases
1752 2.&'x'& and 3.&'x'& were current for a while, but the latest versions when Exim last revamped support were numbered 4.&'x'&.
1753 Maintenance of some of the earlier releases has ceased. All versions of
1754 Berkeley DB could be obtained from
1755 &url(http://www.sleepycat.com/), which is now a redirect to their new owner's
1756 page with far newer versions listed.
1757 It is probably wise to plan to move your storage configurations away from
1758 Berkeley DB format, as today there are smaller and simpler alternatives more
1759 suited to Exim's usage model.
1760 .next
1761 .cindex "&'tdb'& DBM library"
1762 Yet another DBM library, called &'tdb'&, is available from
1763 &url(https://sourceforge.net/projects/tdb/files/). It has its own interface, and also
1764 operates on a single file.
1765 .endlist
1766
1767 .cindex "USE_DB"
1768 .cindex "DBM libraries" "configuration for building"
1769 Exim and its utilities can be compiled to use any of these interfaces. In order
1770 to use any version of the Berkeley DB package in native mode, you must set
1771 USE_DB in an appropriate configuration file (typically
1772 &_Local/Makefile_&). For example:
1773 .code
1774 USE_DB=yes
1775 .endd
1776 Similarly, for gdbm you set USE_GDBM, and for tdb you set USE_TDB. An
1777 error is diagnosed if you set more than one of these.
1778
1779 At the lowest level, the build-time configuration sets none of these options,
1780 thereby assuming an interface of type (1). However, some operating system
1781 configuration files (for example, those for the BSD operating systems and
1782 Linux) assume type (4) by setting USE_DB as their default, and the
1783 configuration files for Cygwin set USE_GDBM. Anything you set in
1784 &_Local/Makefile_&, however, overrides these system defaults.
1785
1786 As well as setting USE_DB, USE_GDBM, or USE_TDB, it may also be
1787 necessary to set DBMLIB, to cause inclusion of the appropriate library, as
1788 in one of these lines:
1789 .code
1790 DBMLIB = -ldb
1791 DBMLIB = -ltdb
1792 .endd
1793 Settings like that will work if the DBM library is installed in the standard
1794 place. Sometimes it is not, and the library's header file may also not be in
1795 the default path. You may need to set INCLUDE to specify where the header
1796 file is, and to specify the path to the library more fully in DBMLIB, as in
1797 this example:
1798 .code
1799 INCLUDE=-I/usr/local/include/db-4.1
1800 DBMLIB=/usr/local/lib/db-4.1/libdb.a
1801 .endd
1802 There is further detailed discussion about the various DBM libraries in the
1803 file &_doc/dbm.discuss.txt_& in the Exim distribution.
1804
1805
1806
1807 .section "Pre-building configuration" "SECID25"
1808 .cindex "building Exim" "pre-building configuration"
1809 .cindex "configuration for building Exim"
1810 .cindex "&_Local/Makefile_&"
1811 .cindex "&_src/EDITME_&"
1812 Before building Exim, a local configuration file that specifies options
1813 independent of any operating system has to be created with the name
1814 &_Local/Makefile_&. A template for this file is supplied as the file
1815 &_src/EDITME_&, and it contains full descriptions of all the option settings
1816 therein. These descriptions are therefore not repeated here. If you are
1817 building Exim for the first time, the simplest thing to do is to copy
1818 &_src/EDITME_& to &_Local/Makefile_&, then read it and edit it appropriately.
1819
1820 There are three settings that you must supply, because Exim will not build
1821 without them. They are the location of the runtime configuration file
1822 (CONFIGURE_FILE), the directory in which Exim binaries will be installed
1823 (BIN_DIRECTORY), and the identity of the Exim user (EXIM_USER and
1824 maybe EXIM_GROUP as well). The value of CONFIGURE_FILE can in fact be
1825 a colon-separated list of filenames; Exim uses the first of them that exists.
1826
1827 There are a few other parameters that can be specified either at build time or
1828 at runtime, to enable the same binary to be used on a number of different
1829 machines. However, if the locations of Exim's spool directory and log file
1830 directory (if not within the spool directory) are fixed, it is recommended that
1831 you specify them in &_Local/Makefile_& instead of at runtime, so that errors
1832 detected early in Exim's execution (such as a malformed configuration file) can
1833 be logged.
1834
1835 .cindex "content scanning" "specifying at build time"
1836 Exim's interfaces for calling virus and spam scanning software directly from
1837 access control lists are not compiled by default. If you want to include these
1838 facilities, you need to set
1839 .code
1840 WITH_CONTENT_SCAN=yes
1841 .endd
1842 in your &_Local/Makefile_&. For details of the facilities themselves, see
1843 chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
1844
1845
1846 .cindex "&_Local/eximon.conf_&"
1847 .cindex "&_exim_monitor/EDITME_&"
1848 If you are going to build the Exim monitor, a similar configuration process is
1849 required. The file &_exim_monitor/EDITME_& must be edited appropriately for
1850 your installation and saved under the name &_Local/eximon.conf_&. If you are
1851 happy with the default settings described in &_exim_monitor/EDITME_&,
1852 &_Local/eximon.conf_& can be empty, but it must exist.
1853
1854 This is all the configuration that is needed in straightforward cases for known
1855 operating systems. However, the building process is set up so that it is easy
1856 to override options that are set by default or by operating-system-specific
1857 configuration files, for example, to change the C compiler, which
1858 defaults to &%gcc%&. See section &<<SECToverride>>& below for details of how to
1859 do this.
1860
1861
1862
1863 .section "Support for iconv()" "SECID26"
1864 .cindex "&[iconv()]& support"
1865 .cindex "RFC 2047"
1866 The contents of header lines in messages may be encoded according to the rules
1867 described RFC 2047. This makes it possible to transmit characters that are not
1868 in the ASCII character set, and to label them as being in a particular
1869 character set. When Exim is inspecting header lines by means of the &%$h_%&
1870 mechanism, it decodes them, and translates them into a specified character set
1871 (default is set at build time). The translation is possible only if the operating system
1872 supports the &[iconv()]& function.
1873
1874 However, some of the operating systems that supply &[iconv()]& do not support
1875 very many conversions. The GNU &%libiconv%& library (available from
1876 &url(https://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv/)) can be installed on such
1877 systems to remedy this deficiency, as well as on systems that do not supply
1878 &[iconv()]& at all. After installing &%libiconv%&, you should add
1879 .code
1880 HAVE_ICONV=yes
1881 .endd
1882 to your &_Local/Makefile_& and rebuild Exim.
1883
1884
1885
1886 .section "Including TLS/SSL encryption support" "SECTinctlsssl"
1887 .cindex "TLS" "including support for TLS"
1888 .cindex "encryption" "including support for"
1889 .cindex "SUPPORT_TLS"
1890 .cindex "OpenSSL" "building Exim with"
1891 .cindex "GnuTLS" "building Exim with"
1892 Exim can be built to support encrypted SMTP connections, using the STARTTLS
1893 command as per RFC 2487. It can also support legacy clients that expect to
1894 start a TLS session immediately on connection to a non-standard port (see the
1895 &%tls_on_connect_ports%& runtime option and the &%-tls-on-connect%& command
1896 line option).
1897
1898 If you want to build Exim with TLS support, you must first install either the
1899 OpenSSL or GnuTLS library. There is no cryptographic code in Exim itself for
1900 implementing SSL.
1901
1902 If OpenSSL is installed, you should set
1903 .code
1904 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1905 TLS_LIBS=-lssl -lcrypto
1906 .endd
1907 in &_Local/Makefile_&. You may also need to specify the locations of the
1908 OpenSSL library and include files. For example:
1909 .code
1910 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1911 TLS_LIBS=-L/usr/local/openssl/lib -lssl -lcrypto
1912 TLS_INCLUDE=-I/usr/local/openssl/include/
1913 .endd
1914 .cindex "pkg-config" "OpenSSL"
1915 If you have &'pkg-config'& available, then instead you can just use:
1916 .code
1917 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1918 USE_OPENSSL_PC=openssl
1919 .endd
1920 .cindex "USE_GNUTLS"
1921 If GnuTLS is installed, you should set
1922 .code
1923 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1924 USE_GNUTLS=yes
1925 TLS_LIBS=-lgnutls -ltasn1 -lgcrypt
1926 .endd
1927 in &_Local/Makefile_&, and again you may need to specify the locations of the
1928 library and include files. For example:
1929 .code
1930 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1931 USE_GNUTLS=yes
1932 TLS_LIBS=-L/usr/gnu/lib -lgnutls -ltasn1 -lgcrypt
1933 TLS_INCLUDE=-I/usr/gnu/include
1934 .endd
1935 .cindex "pkg-config" "GnuTLS"
1936 If you have &'pkg-config'& available, then instead you can just use:
1937 .code
1938 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1939 USE_GNUTLS=yes
1940 USE_GNUTLS_PC=gnutls
1941 .endd
1942
1943 You do not need to set TLS_INCLUDE if the relevant directory is already
1944 specified in INCLUDE. Details of how to configure Exim to make use of TLS are
1945 given in chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&.
1946
1947
1948
1949
1950 .section "Use of tcpwrappers" "SECID27"
1951
1952 .cindex "tcpwrappers, building Exim to support"
1953 .cindex "USE_TCP_WRAPPERS"
1954 .cindex "TCP_WRAPPERS_DAEMON_NAME"
1955 .cindex "tcp_wrappers_daemon_name"
1956 Exim can be linked with the &'tcpwrappers'& library in order to check incoming
1957 SMTP calls using the &'tcpwrappers'& control files. This may be a convenient
1958 alternative to Exim's own checking facilities for installations that are
1959 already making use of &'tcpwrappers'& for other purposes. To do this, you
1960 should set USE_TCP_WRAPPERS in &_Local/Makefile_&, arrange for the file
1961 &_tcpd.h_& to be available at compile time, and also ensure that the library
1962 &_libwrap.a_& is available at link time, typically by including &%-lwrap%& in
1963 EXTRALIBS_EXIM. For example, if &'tcpwrappers'& is installed in &_/usr/local_&,
1964 you might have
1965 .code
1966 USE_TCP_WRAPPERS=yes
1967 CFLAGS=-O -I/usr/local/include
1968 EXTRALIBS_EXIM=-L/usr/local/lib -lwrap
1969 .endd
1970 in &_Local/Makefile_&. The daemon name to use in the &'tcpwrappers'& control
1971 files is &"exim"&. For example, the line
1972 .code
1973 exim : LOCAL 192.168.1. .friendly.domain.example
1974 .endd
1975 in your &_/etc/hosts.allow_& file allows connections from the local host, from
1976 the subnet 192.168.1.0/24, and from all hosts in &'friendly.domain.example'&.
1977 All other connections are denied. The daemon name used by &'tcpwrappers'&
1978 can be changed at build time by setting TCP_WRAPPERS_DAEMON_NAME in
1979 &_Local/Makefile_&, or by setting tcp_wrappers_daemon_name in the
1980 configure file. Consult the &'tcpwrappers'& documentation for
1981 further details.
1982
1983
1984 .section "Including support for IPv6" "SECID28"
1985 .cindex "IPv6" "including support for"
1986 Exim contains code for use on systems that have IPv6 support. Setting
1987 &`HAVE_IPV6=YES`& in &_Local/Makefile_& causes the IPv6 code to be included;
1988 it may also be necessary to set IPV6_INCLUDE and IPV6_LIBS on systems
1989 where the IPv6 support is not fully integrated into the normal include and
1990 library files.
1991
1992 Two different types of DNS record for handling IPv6 addresses have been
1993 defined. AAAA records (analogous to A records for IPv4) are in use, and are
1994 currently seen as the mainstream. Another record type called A6 was proposed
1995 as better than AAAA because it had more flexibility. However, it was felt to be
1996 over-complex, and its status was reduced to &"experimental"&.
1997 Exim used to
1998 have a compile option for including A6 record support but this has now been
1999 withdrawn.
2000
2001
2002
2003 .section "Dynamically loaded lookup module support" "SECTdynamicmodules"
2004 .cindex "lookup modules"
2005 .cindex "dynamic modules"
2006 .cindex ".so building"
2007 On some platforms, Exim supports not compiling all lookup types directly into
2008 the main binary, instead putting some into external modules which can be loaded
2009 on demand.
2010 This permits packagers to build Exim with support for lookups with extensive
2011 library dependencies without requiring all users to install all of those
2012 dependencies.
2013 Most, but not all, lookup types can be built this way.
2014
2015 Set &`LOOKUP_MODULE_DIR`& to the directory into which the modules will be
2016 installed; Exim will only load modules from that directory, as a security
2017 measure. You will need to set &`CFLAGS_DYNAMIC`& if not already defined
2018 for your OS; see &_OS/Makefile-Linux_& for an example.
2019 Some other requirements for adjusting &`EXTRALIBS`& may also be necessary,
2020 see &_src/EDITME_& for details.
2021
2022 Then, for each module to be loaded dynamically, define the relevant
2023 &`LOOKUP_`&<&'lookup_type'&> flags to have the value "2" instead of "yes".
2024 For example, this will build in lsearch but load sqlite and mysql support
2025 on demand:
2026 .code
2027 LOOKUP_LSEARCH=yes
2028 LOOKUP_SQLITE=2
2029 LOOKUP_MYSQL=2
2030 .endd
2031
2032
2033 .section "The building process" "SECID29"
2034 .cindex "build directory"
2035 Once &_Local/Makefile_& (and &_Local/eximon.conf_&, if required) have been
2036 created, run &'make'& at the top level. It determines the architecture and
2037 operating system types, and creates a build directory if one does not exist.
2038 For example, on a Sun system running Solaris 8, the directory
2039 &_build-SunOS5-5.8-sparc_& is created.
2040 .cindex "symbolic link" "to source files"
2041 Symbolic links to relevant source files are installed in the build directory.
2042
2043 If this is the first time &'make'& has been run, it calls a script that builds
2044 a make file inside the build directory, using the configuration files from the
2045 &_Local_& directory. The new make file is then passed to another instance of
2046 &'make'&. This does the real work, building a number of utility scripts, and
2047 then compiling and linking the binaries for the Exim monitor (if configured), a
2048 number of utility programs, and finally Exim itself. The command &`make
2049 makefile`& can be used to force a rebuild of the make file in the build
2050 directory, should this ever be necessary.
2051
2052 If you have problems building Exim, check for any comments there may be in the
2053 &_README_& file concerning your operating system, and also take a look at the
2054 FAQ, where some common problems are covered.
2055
2056
2057
2058 .section 'Output from &"make"&' "SECID283"
2059 The output produced by the &'make'& process for compile lines is often very
2060 unreadable, because these lines can be very long. For this reason, the normal
2061 output is suppressed by default, and instead output similar to that which
2062 appears when compiling the 2.6 Linux kernel is generated: just a short line for
2063 each module that is being compiled or linked. However, it is still possible to
2064 get the full output, by calling &'make'& like this:
2065 .code
2066 FULLECHO='' make -e
2067 .endd
2068 The value of FULLECHO defaults to &"@"&, the flag character that suppresses
2069 command reflection in &'make'&. When you ask for the full output, it is
2070 given in addition to the short output.
2071
2072
2073
2074 .section "Overriding build-time options for Exim" "SECToverride"
2075 .cindex "build-time options, overriding"
2076 The main make file that is created at the beginning of the building process
2077 consists of the concatenation of a number of files which set configuration
2078 values, followed by a fixed set of &'make'& instructions. If a value is set
2079 more than once, the last setting overrides any previous ones. This provides a
2080 convenient way of overriding defaults. The files that are concatenated are, in
2081 order:
2082 .display
2083 &_OS/Makefile-Default_&
2084 &_OS/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>
2085 &_Local/Makefile_&
2086 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>
2087 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'archtype'&>
2088 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>-<&'archtype'&>
2089 &_OS/Makefile-Base_&
2090 .endd
2091 .cindex "&_Local/Makefile_&"
2092 .cindex "building Exim" "operating system type"
2093 .cindex "building Exim" "architecture type"
2094 where <&'ostype'&> is the operating system type and <&'archtype'&> is the
2095 architecture type. &_Local/Makefile_& is required to exist, and the building
2096 process fails if it is absent. The other three &_Local_& files are optional,
2097 and are often not needed.
2098
2099 The values used for <&'ostype'&> and <&'archtype'&> are obtained from scripts
2100 called &_scripts/os-type_& and &_scripts/arch-type_& respectively. If either of
2101 the environment variables EXIM_OSTYPE or EXIM_ARCHTYPE is set, their
2102 values are used, thereby providing a means of forcing particular settings.
2103 Otherwise, the scripts try to get values from the &%uname%& command. If this
2104 fails, the shell variables OSTYPE and ARCHTYPE are inspected. A number
2105 of &'ad hoc'& transformations are then applied, to produce the standard names
2106 that Exim expects. You can run these scripts directly from the shell in order
2107 to find out what values are being used on your system.
2108
2109
2110 &_OS/Makefile-Default_& contains comments about the variables that are set
2111 therein. Some (but not all) are mentioned below. If there is something that
2112 needs changing, review the contents of this file and the contents of the make
2113 file for your operating system (&_OS/Makefile-<ostype>_&) to see what the
2114 default values are.
2115
2116
2117 .cindex "building Exim" "overriding default settings"
2118 If you need to change any of the values that are set in &_OS/Makefile-Default_&
2119 or in &_OS/Makefile-<ostype>_&, or to add any new definitions, you do not
2120 need to change the original files. Instead, you should make the changes by
2121 putting the new values in an appropriate &_Local_& file. For example,
2122 .cindex "Tru64-Unix build-time settings"
2123 when building Exim in many releases of the Tru64-Unix (formerly Digital UNIX,
2124 formerly DEC-OSF1) operating system, it is necessary to specify that the C
2125 compiler is called &'cc'& rather than &'gcc'&. Also, the compiler must be
2126 called with the option &%-std1%&, to make it recognize some of the features of
2127 Standard C that Exim uses. (Most other compilers recognize Standard C by
2128 default.) To do this, you should create a file called &_Local/Makefile-OSF1_&
2129 containing the lines
2130 .code
2131 CC=cc
2132 CFLAGS=-std1
2133 .endd
2134 If you are compiling for just one operating system, it may be easier to put
2135 these lines directly into &_Local/Makefile_&.
2136
2137 Keeping all your local configuration settings separate from the distributed
2138 files makes it easy to transfer them to new versions of Exim simply by copying
2139 the contents of the &_Local_& directory.
2140
2141
2142 .cindex "NIS lookup type" "including support for"
2143 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type" "including support for"
2144 .cindex "LDAP" "including support for"
2145 .cindex "lookup" "inclusion in binary"
2146 Exim contains support for doing LDAP, NIS, NIS+, and other kinds of file
2147 lookup, but not all systems have these components installed, so the default is
2148 not to include the relevant code in the binary. All the different kinds of file
2149 and database lookup that Exim supports are implemented as separate code modules
2150 which are included only if the relevant compile-time options are set. In the
2151 case of LDAP, NIS, and NIS+, the settings for &_Local/Makefile_& are:
2152 .code
2153 LOOKUP_LDAP=yes
2154 LOOKUP_NIS=yes
2155 LOOKUP_NISPLUS=yes
2156 .endd
2157 and similar settings apply to the other lookup types. They are all listed in
2158 &_src/EDITME_&. In many cases the relevant include files and interface
2159 libraries need to be installed before compiling Exim.
2160 .cindex "cdb" "including support for"
2161 However, there are some optional lookup types (such as cdb) for which
2162 the code is entirely contained within Exim, and no external include
2163 files or libraries are required. When a lookup type is not included in the
2164 binary, attempts to configure Exim to use it cause runtime configuration
2165 errors.
2166
2167 .cindex "pkg-config" "lookups"
2168 .cindex "pkg-config" "authenticators"
2169 Many systems now use a tool called &'pkg-config'& to encapsulate information
2170 about how to compile against a library; Exim has some initial support for
2171 being able to use pkg-config for lookups and authenticators. For any given
2172 makefile variable which starts &`LOOKUP_`& or &`AUTH_`&, you can add a new
2173 variable with the &`_PC`& suffix in the name and assign as the value the
2174 name of the package to be queried. The results of querying via the
2175 &'pkg-config'& command will be added to the appropriate Makefile variables
2176 with &`+=`& directives, so your version of &'make'& will need to support that
2177 syntax. For instance:
2178 .code
2179 LOOKUP_SQLITE=yes
2180 LOOKUP_SQLITE_PC=sqlite3
2181 AUTH_GSASL=yes
2182 AUTH_GSASL_PC=libgsasl
2183 AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI=yes
2184 AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI_PC=heimdal-gssapi
2185 .endd
2186
2187 .cindex "Perl" "including support for"
2188 Exim can be linked with an embedded Perl interpreter, allowing Perl
2189 subroutines to be called during string expansion. To enable this facility,
2190 .code
2191 EXIM_PERL=perl.o
2192 .endd
2193 must be defined in &_Local/Makefile_&. Details of this facility are given in
2194 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&.
2195
2196 .cindex "X11 libraries, location of"
2197 The location of the X11 libraries is something that varies a lot between
2198 operating systems, and there may be different versions of X11 to cope
2199 with. Exim itself makes no use of X11, but if you are compiling the Exim
2200 monitor, the X11 libraries must be available.
2201 The following three variables are set in &_OS/Makefile-Default_&:
2202 .code
2203 X11=/usr/X11R6
2204 XINCLUDE=-I$(X11)/include
2205 XLFLAGS=-L$(X11)/lib
2206 .endd
2207 These are overridden in some of the operating-system configuration files. For
2208 example, in &_OS/Makefile-SunOS5_& there is
2209 .code
2210 X11=/usr/openwin
2211 XINCLUDE=-I$(X11)/include
2212 XLFLAGS=-L$(X11)/lib -R$(X11)/lib
2213 .endd
2214 If you need to override the default setting for your operating system, place a
2215 definition of all three of these variables into your
2216 &_Local/Makefile-<ostype>_& file.
2217
2218 .cindex "EXTRALIBS"
2219 If you need to add any extra libraries to the link steps, these can be put in a
2220 variable called EXTRALIBS, which appears in all the link commands, but by
2221 default is not defined. In contrast, EXTRALIBS_EXIM is used only on the
2222 command for linking the main Exim binary, and not for any associated utilities.
2223
2224 .cindex "DBM libraries" "configuration for building"
2225 There is also DBMLIB, which appears in the link commands for binaries that
2226 use DBM functions (see also section &<<SECTdb>>&). Finally, there is
2227 EXTRALIBS_EXIMON, which appears only in the link step for the Exim monitor
2228 binary, and which can be used, for example, to include additional X11
2229 libraries.
2230
2231 .cindex "configuration file" "editing"
2232 The make file copes with rebuilding Exim correctly if any of the configuration
2233 files are edited. However, if an optional configuration file is deleted, it is
2234 necessary to touch the associated non-optional file (that is,
2235 &_Local/Makefile_& or &_Local/eximon.conf_&) before rebuilding.
2236
2237
2238 .section "OS-specific header files" "SECID30"
2239 .cindex "&_os.h_&"
2240 .cindex "building Exim" "OS-specific C header files"
2241 The &_OS_& directory contains a number of files with names of the form
2242 &_os.h-<ostype>_&. These are system-specific C header files that should not
2243 normally need to be changed. There is a list of macro settings that are
2244 recognized in the file &_OS/os.configuring_&, which should be consulted if you
2245 are porting Exim to a new operating system.
2246
2247
2248
2249 .section "Overriding build-time options for the monitor" "SECID31"
2250 .cindex "building Eximon"
2251 A similar process is used for overriding things when building the Exim monitor,
2252 where the files that are involved are
2253 .display
2254 &_OS/eximon.conf-Default_&
2255 &_OS/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>
2256 &_Local/eximon.conf_&
2257 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>
2258 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'archtype'&>
2259 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>-<&'archtype'&>
2260 .endd
2261 .cindex "&_Local/eximon.conf_&"
2262 As with Exim itself, the final three files need not exist, and in this case the
2263 &_OS/eximon.conf-<ostype>_& file is also optional. The default values in
2264 &_OS/eximon.conf-Default_& can be overridden dynamically by setting environment
2265 variables of the same name, preceded by EXIMON_. For example, setting
2266 EXIMON_LOG_DEPTH in the environment overrides the value of
2267 LOG_DEPTH at runtime.
2268 .ecindex IIDbuex
2269
2270
2271 .section "Installing Exim binaries and scripts" "SECID32"
2272 .cindex "installing Exim"
2273 .cindex "BIN_DIRECTORY"
2274 The command &`make install`& runs the &(exim_install)& script with no
2275 arguments. The script copies binaries and utility scripts into the directory
2276 whose name is specified by the BIN_DIRECTORY setting in &_Local/Makefile_&.
2277 .cindex "setuid" "installing Exim with"
2278 The install script copies files only if they are newer than the files they are
2279 going to replace. The Exim binary is required to be owned by root and have the
2280 &'setuid'& bit set, for normal configurations. Therefore, you must run &`make
2281 install`& as root so that it can set up the Exim binary in this way. However, in
2282 some special situations (for example, if a host is doing no local deliveries)
2283 it may be possible to run Exim without making the binary setuid root (see
2284 chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for details).
2285
2286 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
2287 Exim's runtime configuration file is named by the CONFIGURE_FILE setting
2288 in &_Local/Makefile_&. If this names a single file, and the file does not
2289 exist, the default configuration file &_src/configure.default_& is copied there
2290 by the installation script. If a runtime configuration file already exists, it
2291 is left alone. If CONFIGURE_FILE is a colon-separated list, naming several
2292 alternative files, no default is installed.
2293
2294 .cindex "system aliases file"
2295 .cindex "&_/etc/aliases_&"
2296 One change is made to the default configuration file when it is installed: the
2297 default configuration contains a router that references a system aliases file.
2298 The path to this file is set to the value specified by
2299 SYSTEM_ALIASES_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_& (&_/etc/aliases_& by default).
2300 If the system aliases file does not exist, the installation script creates it,
2301 and outputs a comment to the user.
2302
2303 The created file contains no aliases, but it does contain comments about the
2304 aliases a site should normally have. Mail aliases have traditionally been
2305 kept in &_/etc/aliases_&. However, some operating systems are now using
2306 &_/etc/mail/aliases_&. You should check if yours is one of these, and change
2307 Exim's configuration if necessary.
2308
2309 The default configuration uses the local host's name as the only local domain,
2310 and is set up to do local deliveries into the shared directory &_/var/mail_&,
2311 running as the local user. System aliases and &_.forward_& files in users' home
2312 directories are supported, but no NIS or NIS+ support is configured. Domains
2313 other than the name of the local host are routed using the DNS, with delivery
2314 over SMTP.
2315
2316 It is possible to install Exim for special purposes (such as building a binary
2317 distribution) in a private part of the file system. You can do this by a
2318 command such as
2319 .code
2320 make DESTDIR=/some/directory/ install
2321 .endd
2322 This has the effect of pre-pending the specified directory to all the file
2323 paths, except the name of the system aliases file that appears in the default
2324 configuration. (If a default alias file is created, its name &'is'& modified.)
2325 For backwards compatibility, ROOT is used if DESTDIR is not set,
2326 but this usage is deprecated.
2327
2328 .cindex "installing Exim" "what is not installed"
2329 Running &'make install'& does not copy the Exim 4 conversion script
2330 &'convert4r4'&. You will probably run this only once if you are
2331 upgrading from Exim 3. None of the documentation files in the &_doc_&
2332 directory are copied, except for the info files when you have set
2333 INFO_DIRECTORY, as described in section &<<SECTinsinfdoc>>& below.
2334
2335 For the utility programs, old versions are renamed by adding the suffix &_.O_&
2336 to their names. The Exim binary itself, however, is handled differently. It is
2337 installed under a name that includes the version number and the compile number,
2338 for example, &_exim-&version()-1_&. The script then arranges for a symbolic link
2339 called &_exim_& to point to the binary. If you are updating a previous version
2340 of Exim, the script takes care to ensure that the name &_exim_& is never absent
2341 from the directory (as seen by other processes).
2342
2343 .cindex "installing Exim" "testing the script"
2344 If you want to see what the &'make install'& will do before running it for
2345 real, you can pass the &%-n%& option to the installation script by this
2346 command:
2347 .code
2348 make INSTALL_ARG=-n install
2349 .endd
2350 The contents of the variable INSTALL_ARG are passed to the installation
2351 script. You do not need to be root to run this test. Alternatively, you can run
2352 the installation script directly, but this must be from within the build
2353 directory. For example, from the top-level Exim directory you could use this
2354 command:
2355 .code
2356 (cd build-SunOS5-5.5.1-sparc; ../scripts/exim_install -n)
2357 .endd
2358 .cindex "installing Exim" "install script options"
2359 There are two other options that can be supplied to the installation script.
2360
2361 .ilist
2362 &%-no_chown%& bypasses the call to change the owner of the installed binary
2363 to root, and the call to make it a setuid binary.
2364 .next
2365 &%-no_symlink%& bypasses the setting up of the symbolic link &_exim_& to the
2366 installed binary.
2367 .endlist
2368
2369 INSTALL_ARG can be used to pass these options to the script. For example:
2370 .code
2371 make INSTALL_ARG=-no_symlink install
2372 .endd
2373 The installation script can also be given arguments specifying which files are
2374 to be copied. For example, to install just the Exim binary, and nothing else,
2375 without creating the symbolic link, you could use:
2376 .code
2377 make INSTALL_ARG='-no_symlink exim' install
2378 .endd
2379
2380
2381
2382 .section "Installing info documentation" "SECTinsinfdoc"
2383 .cindex "installing Exim" "&'info'& documentation"
2384 Not all systems use the GNU &'info'& system for documentation, and for this
2385 reason, the Texinfo source of Exim's documentation is not included in the main
2386 distribution. Instead it is available separately from the FTP site (see section
2387 &<<SECTavail>>&).
2388
2389 If you have defined INFO_DIRECTORY in &_Local/Makefile_& and the Texinfo
2390 source of the documentation is found in the source tree, running &`make
2391 install`& automatically builds the info files and installs them.
2392
2393
2394
2395 .section "Setting up the spool directory" "SECID33"
2396 .cindex "spool directory" "creating"
2397 When it starts up, Exim tries to create its spool directory if it does not
2398 exist. The Exim uid and gid are used for the owner and group of the spool
2399 directory. Sub-directories are automatically created in the spool directory as
2400 necessary.
2401
2402
2403
2404
2405 .section "Testing" "SECID34"
2406 .cindex "testing" "installation"
2407 Having installed Exim, you can check that the runtime configuration file is
2408 syntactically valid by running the following command, which assumes that the
2409 Exim binary directory is within your PATH environment variable:
2410 .code
2411 exim -bV
2412 .endd
2413 If there are any errors in the configuration file, Exim outputs error messages.
2414 Otherwise it outputs the version number and build date,
2415 the DBM library that is being used, and information about which drivers and
2416 other optional code modules are included in the binary.
2417 Some simple routing tests can be done by using the address testing option. For
2418 example,
2419 .display
2420 &`exim -bt`& <&'local username'&>
2421 .endd
2422 should verify that it recognizes a local mailbox, and
2423 .display
2424 &`exim -bt`& <&'remote address'&>
2425 .endd
2426 a remote one. Then try getting it to deliver mail, both locally and remotely.
2427 This can be done by passing messages directly to Exim, without going through a
2428 user agent. For example:
2429 .code
2430 exim -v postmaster@your.domain.example
2431 From: user@your.domain.example
2432 To: postmaster@your.domain.example
2433 Subject: Testing Exim
2434
2435 This is a test message.
2436 ^D
2437 .endd
2438 The &%-v%& option causes Exim to output some verification of what it is doing.
2439 In this case you should see copies of three log lines, one for the message's
2440 arrival, one for its delivery, and one containing &"Completed"&.
2441
2442 .cindex "delivery" "problems with"
2443 If you encounter problems, look at Exim's log files (&'mainlog'& and
2444 &'paniclog'&) to see if there is any relevant information there. Another source
2445 of information is running Exim with debugging turned on, by specifying the
2446 &%-d%& option. If a message is stuck on Exim's spool, you can force a delivery
2447 with debugging turned on by a command of the form
2448 .display
2449 &`exim -d -M`& <&'exim-message-id'&>
2450 .endd
2451 You must be root or an &"admin user"& in order to do this. The &%-d%& option
2452 produces rather a lot of output, but you can cut this down to specific areas.
2453 For example, if you use &%-d-all+route%& only the debugging information
2454 relevant to routing is included. (See the &%-d%& option in chapter
2455 &<<CHAPcommandline>>& for more details.)
2456
2457 .cindex '&"sticky"& bit'
2458 .cindex "lock files"
2459 One specific problem that has shown up on some sites is the inability to do
2460 local deliveries into a shared mailbox directory, because it does not have the
2461 &"sticky bit"& set on it. By default, Exim tries to create a lock file before
2462 writing to a mailbox file, and if it cannot create the lock file, the delivery
2463 is deferred. You can get round this either by setting the &"sticky bit"& on the
2464 directory, or by setting a specific group for local deliveries and allowing
2465 that group to create files in the directory (see the comments above the
2466 &(local_delivery)& transport in the default configuration file). Another
2467 approach is to configure Exim not to use lock files, but just to rely on
2468 &[fcntl()]& locking instead. However, you should do this only if all user
2469 agents also use &[fcntl()]& locking. For further discussion of locking issues,
2470 see chapter &<<CHAPappendfile>>&.
2471
2472 One thing that cannot be tested on a system that is already running an MTA is
2473 the receipt of incoming SMTP mail on the standard SMTP port. However, the
2474 &%-oX%& option can be used to run an Exim daemon that listens on some other
2475 port, or &'inetd'& can be used to do this. The &%-bh%& option and the
2476 &'exim_checkaccess'& utility can be used to check out policy controls on
2477 incoming SMTP mail.
2478
2479 Testing a new version on a system that is already running Exim can most easily
2480 be done by building a binary with a different CONFIGURE_FILE setting. From
2481 within the runtime configuration, all other file and directory names
2482 that Exim uses can be altered, in order to keep it entirely clear of the
2483 production version.
2484
2485
2486 .section "Replacing another MTA with Exim" "SECID35"
2487 .cindex "replacing another MTA"
2488 Building and installing Exim for the first time does not of itself put it in
2489 general use. The name by which the system's MTA is called by mail user agents
2490 is either &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&, or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& (depending on the
2491 operating system), and it is necessary to make this name point to the &'exim'&
2492 binary in order to get the user agents to pass messages to Exim. This is
2493 normally done by renaming any existing file and making &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&
2494 or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_&
2495 .cindex "symbolic link" "to &'exim'& binary"
2496 a symbolic link to the &'exim'& binary. It is a good idea to remove any setuid
2497 privilege and executable status from the old MTA. It is then necessary to stop
2498 and restart the mailer daemon, if one is running.
2499
2500 .cindex "FreeBSD, MTA indirection"
2501 .cindex "&_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_&"
2502 Some operating systems have introduced alternative ways of switching MTAs. For
2503 example, if you are running FreeBSD, you need to edit the file
2504 &_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_& instead of setting up a symbolic link as just
2505 described. A typical example of the contents of this file for running Exim is
2506 as follows:
2507 .code
2508 sendmail /usr/exim/bin/exim
2509 send-mail /usr/exim/bin/exim
2510 mailq /usr/exim/bin/exim -bp
2511 newaliases /usr/bin/true
2512 .endd
2513 Once you have set up the symbolic link, or edited &_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_&,
2514 your Exim installation is &"live"&. Check it by sending a message from your
2515 favourite user agent.
2516
2517 You should consider what to tell your users about the change of MTA. Exim may
2518 have different capabilities to what was previously running, and there are
2519 various operational differences such as the text of messages produced by
2520 command line options and in bounce messages. If you allow your users to make
2521 use of Exim's filtering capabilities, you should make the document entitled
2522 &'Exim's interface to mail filtering'& available to them.
2523
2524
2525
2526 .section "Upgrading Exim" "SECID36"
2527 .cindex "upgrading Exim"
2528 If you are already running Exim on your host, building and installing a new
2529 version automatically makes it available to MUAs, or any other programs that
2530 call the MTA directly. However, if you are running an Exim daemon, you do need
2531 .cindex restart "on HUP signal"
2532 .cindex signal "HUP, to restart"
2533 to send it a HUP signal, to make it re-execute itself, and thereby pick up the
2534 new binary. You do not need to stop processing mail in order to install a new
2535 version of Exim. The install script does not modify an existing runtime
2536 configuration file.
2537
2538
2539
2540
2541 .section "Stopping the Exim daemon on Solaris" "SECID37"
2542 .cindex "Solaris" "stopping Exim on"
2543 The standard command for stopping the mailer daemon on Solaris is
2544 .code
2545 /etc/init.d/sendmail stop
2546 .endd
2547 If &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& has been turned into a symbolic link, this script
2548 fails to stop Exim because it uses the command &'ps -e'& and greps the output
2549 for the text &"sendmail"&; this is not present because the actual program name
2550 (that is, &"exim"&) is given by the &'ps'& command with these options. A
2551 solution is to replace the line that finds the process id with something like
2552 .code
2553 pid=`cat /var/spool/exim/exim-daemon.pid`
2554 .endd
2555 to obtain the daemon's pid directly from the file that Exim saves it in.
2556
2557 Note, however, that stopping the daemon does not &"stop Exim"&. Messages can
2558 still be received from local processes, and if automatic delivery is configured
2559 (the normal case), deliveries will still occur.
2560
2561
2562
2563
2564 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2565 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2566
2567 .chapter "The Exim command line" "CHAPcommandline"
2568 .scindex IIDclo1 "command line" "options"
2569 .scindex IIDclo2 "options" "command line"
2570 Exim's command line takes the standard Unix form of a sequence of options,
2571 each starting with a hyphen character, followed by a number of arguments. The
2572 options are compatible with the main options of Sendmail, and there are also
2573 some additional options, some of which are compatible with Smail 3. Certain
2574 combinations of options do not make sense, and provoke an error if used.
2575 The form of the arguments depends on which options are set.
2576
2577
2578 .section "Setting options by program name" "SECID38"
2579 .cindex "&'mailq'&"
2580 If Exim is called under the name &'mailq'&, it behaves as if the option &%-bp%&
2581 were present before any other options.
2582 The &%-bp%& option requests a listing of the contents of the mail queue on the
2583 standard output.
2584 This feature is for compatibility with some systems that contain a command of
2585 that name in one of the standard libraries, symbolically linked to
2586 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_&.
2587
2588 .cindex "&'rsmtp'&"
2589 If Exim is called under the name &'rsmtp'& it behaves as if the option &%-bS%&
2590 were present before any other options, for compatibility with Smail. The
2591 &%-bS%& option is used for reading in a number of messages in batched SMTP
2592 format.
2593
2594 .cindex "&'rmail'&"
2595 If Exim is called under the name &'rmail'& it behaves as if the &%-i%& and
2596 &%-oee%& options were present before any other options, for compatibility with
2597 Smail. The name &'rmail'& is used as an interface by some UUCP systems.
2598
2599 .cindex "&'runq'&"
2600 .cindex "queue runner"
2601 If Exim is called under the name &'runq'& it behaves as if the option &%-q%&
2602 were present before any other options, for compatibility with Smail. The &%-q%&
2603 option causes a single queue runner process to be started.
2604
2605 .cindex "&'newaliases'&"
2606 .cindex "alias file" "building"
2607 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "calling Exim as &'newaliases'&"
2608 If Exim is called under the name &'newaliases'& it behaves as if the option
2609 &%-bi%& were present before any other options, for compatibility with Sendmail.
2610 This option is used for rebuilding Sendmail's alias file. Exim does not have
2611 the concept of a single alias file, but can be configured to run a given
2612 command if called with the &%-bi%& option.
2613
2614
2615 .section "Trusted and admin users" "SECTtrustedadmin"
2616 Some Exim options are available only to &'trusted users'& and others are
2617 available only to &'admin users'&. In the description below, the phrases &"Exim
2618 user"& and &"Exim group"& mean the user and group defined by EXIM_USER and
2619 EXIM_GROUP in &_Local/Makefile_& or set by the &%exim_user%& and
2620 &%exim_group%& options. These do not necessarily have to use the name &"exim"&.
2621
2622 .ilist
2623 .cindex "trusted users" "definition of"
2624 .cindex "user" "trusted definition of"
2625 The trusted users are root, the Exim user, any user listed in the
2626 &%trusted_users%& configuration option, and any user whose current group or any
2627 supplementary group is one of those listed in the &%trusted_groups%&
2628 configuration option. Note that the Exim group is not automatically trusted.
2629
2630 .cindex '&"From"& line'
2631 .cindex "envelope from"
2632 .cindex "envelope sender"
2633 Trusted users are always permitted to use the &%-f%& option or a leading
2634 &"From&~"& line to specify the envelope sender of a message that is passed to
2635 Exim through the local interface (see the &%-bm%& and &%-f%& options below).
2636 See the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option for a way of permitting non-trusted
2637 users to set envelope senders.
2638
2639 .cindex "&'From:'& header line"
2640 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line"
2641 .cindex "header lines" "From:"
2642 .cindex "header lines" "Sender:"
2643 For a trusted user, there is never any check on the contents of the &'From:'&
2644 header line, and a &'Sender:'& line is never added. Furthermore, any existing
2645 &'Sender:'& line in incoming local (non-TCP/IP) messages is not removed.
2646
2647 Trusted users may also specify a host name, host address, interface address,
2648 protocol name, ident value, and authentication data when submitting a message
2649 locally. Thus, they are able to insert messages into Exim's queue locally that
2650 have the characteristics of messages received from a remote host. Untrusted
2651 users may in some circumstances use &%-f%&, but can never set the other values
2652 that are available to trusted users.
2653 .next
2654 .cindex "user" "admin definition of"
2655 .cindex "admin user" "definition of"
2656 The admin users are root, the Exim user, and any user that is a member of the
2657 Exim group or of any group listed in the &%admin_groups%& configuration option.
2658 The current group does not have to be one of these groups.
2659
2660 Admin users are permitted to list the queue, and to carry out certain
2661 operations on messages, for example, to force delivery failures. It is also
2662 necessary to be an admin user in order to see the full information provided by
2663 the Exim monitor, and full debugging output.
2664
2665 By default, the use of the &%-M%&, &%-q%&, &%-R%&, and &%-S%& options to cause
2666 Exim to attempt delivery of messages on its queue is restricted to admin users.
2667 However, this restriction can be relaxed by setting the &%prod_requires_admin%&
2668 option false (that is, specifying &%no_prod_requires_admin%&).
2669
2670 Similarly, the use of the &%-bp%& option to list all the messages in the queue
2671 is restricted to admin users unless &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set
2672 false.
2673 .endlist
2674
2675
2676 &*Warning*&: If you configure your system so that admin users are able to
2677 edit Exim's configuration file, you are giving those users an easy way of
2678 getting root. There is further discussion of this issue at the start of chapter
2679 &<<CHAPconf>>&.
2680
2681
2682
2683
2684 .section "Command line options" "SECID39"
2685 Exim's command line options are described in alphabetical order below. If none
2686 of the options that specifies a specific action (such as starting the daemon or
2687 a queue runner, or testing an address, or receiving a message in a specific
2688 format, or listing the queue) are present, and there is at least one argument
2689 on the command line, &%-bm%& (accept a local message on the standard input,
2690 with the arguments specifying the recipients) is assumed. Otherwise, Exim
2691 outputs a brief message about itself and exits.
2692
2693 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2694 . Insert a stylized XML comment here, to identify the start of the command line
2695 . options. This is for the benefit of the Perl script that automatically
2696 . creates a man page for the options.
2697 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2698
2699 .literal xml
2700 <!-- === Start of command line options === -->
2701 .literal off
2702
2703
2704 .vlist
2705 .vitem &%--%&
2706 .oindex "--"
2707 .cindex "options" "command line; terminating"
2708 This is a pseudo-option whose only purpose is to terminate the options and
2709 therefore to cause subsequent command line items to be treated as arguments
2710 rather than options, even if they begin with hyphens.
2711
2712 .vitem &%--help%&
2713 .oindex "&%--help%&"
2714 This option causes Exim to output a few sentences stating what it is.
2715 The same output is generated if the Exim binary is called with no options and
2716 no arguments.
2717
2718 .vitem &%--version%&
2719 .oindex "&%--version%&"
2720 This option is an alias for &%-bV%& and causes version information to be
2721 displayed.
2722
2723 .vitem &%-Ac%& &&&
2724 &%-Am%&
2725 .oindex "&%-Ac%&"
2726 .oindex "&%-Am%&"
2727 These options are used by Sendmail for selecting configuration files and are
2728 ignored by Exim.
2729
2730 .vitem &%-B%&<&'type'&>
2731 .oindex "&%-B%&"
2732 .cindex "8-bit characters"
2733 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "8-bit characters"
2734 This is a Sendmail option for selecting 7 or 8 bit processing. Exim is 8-bit
2735 clean; it ignores this option.
2736
2737 .vitem &%-bd%&
2738 .oindex "&%-bd%&"
2739 .cindex "daemon"
2740 .cindex "SMTP" "listener"
2741 .cindex "queue runner"
2742 This option runs Exim as a daemon, awaiting incoming SMTP connections. Usually
2743 the &%-bd%& option is combined with the &%-q%&<&'time'&> option, to specify
2744 that the daemon should also initiate periodic queue runs.
2745
2746 The &%-bd%& option can be used only by an admin user. If either of the &%-d%&
2747 (debugging) or &%-v%& (verifying) options are set, the daemon does not
2748 disconnect from the controlling terminal. When running this way, it can be
2749 stopped by pressing ctrl-C.
2750
2751 By default, Exim listens for incoming connections to the standard SMTP port on
2752 all the host's running interfaces. However, it is possible to listen on other
2753 ports, on multiple ports, and only on specific interfaces. Chapter
2754 &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& contains a description of the options that control this.
2755
2756 When a listening daemon
2757 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
2758 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
2759 is started without the use of &%-oX%& (that is, without overriding the normal
2760 configuration), it writes its process id to a file called &_exim-daemon.pid_&
2761 in Exim's spool directory. This location can be overridden by setting
2762 PID_FILE_PATH in &_Local/Makefile_&. The file is written while Exim is still
2763 running as root.
2764
2765 When &%-oX%& is used on the command line to start a listening daemon, the
2766 process id is not written to the normal pid file path. However, &%-oP%& can be
2767 used to specify a path on the command line if a pid file is required.
2768
2769 The SIGHUP signal
2770 .cindex "SIGHUP"
2771 .cindex restart "on HUP signal"
2772 .cindex signal "HUP, to restart"
2773 .cindex "daemon" "restarting"
2774 .cindex signal "to reload configuration"
2775 .cindex daemon "reload configuration"
2776 .cindex reload configuration
2777 can be used to cause the daemon to re-execute itself. This should be done
2778 whenever Exim's configuration file, or any file that is incorporated into it by
2779 means of the &%.include%& facility, is changed, and also whenever a new version
2780 of Exim is installed. It is not necessary to do this when other files that are
2781 referenced from the configuration (for example, alias files) are changed,
2782 because these are reread each time they are used.
2783
2784 .vitem &%-bdf%&
2785 .oindex "&%-bdf%&"
2786 This option has the same effect as &%-bd%& except that it never disconnects
2787 from the controlling terminal, even when no debugging is specified.
2788
2789 .vitem &%-be%&
2790 .oindex "&%-be%&"
2791 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
2792 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
2793 Run Exim in expansion testing mode. Exim discards its root privilege, to
2794 prevent ordinary users from using this mode to read otherwise inaccessible
2795 files. If no arguments are given, Exim runs interactively, prompting for lines
2796 of data. Otherwise, it processes each argument in turn.
2797
2798 If Exim was built with USE_READLINE=yes in &_Local/Makefile_&, it tries
2799 to load the &%libreadline%& library dynamically whenever the &%-be%& option is
2800 used without command line arguments. If successful, it uses the &[readline()]&
2801 function, which provides extensive line-editing facilities, for reading the
2802 test data. A line history is supported.
2803
2804 Long expansion expressions can be split over several lines by using backslash
2805 continuations. As in Exim's runtime configuration, white space at the start of
2806 continuation lines is ignored. Each argument or data line is passed through the
2807 string expansion mechanism, and the result is output. Variable values from the
2808 configuration file (for example, &$qualify_domain$&) are available, but no
2809 message-specific values (such as &$message_exim_id$&) are set, because no message
2810 is being processed (but see &%-bem%& and &%-Mset%&).
2811
2812 &*Note*&: If you use this mechanism to test lookups, and you change the data
2813 files or databases you are using, you must exit and restart Exim before trying
2814 the same lookup again. Otherwise, because each Exim process caches the results
2815 of lookups, you will just get the same result as before.
2816
2817 Macro processing is done on lines before string-expansion: new macros can be
2818 defined and macros will be expanded.
2819 Because macros in the config file are often used for secrets, those are only
2820 available to admin users.
2821
2822 .vitem &%-bem%&&~<&'filename'&>
2823 .oindex "&%-bem%&"
2824 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
2825 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
2826 This option operates like &%-be%& except that it must be followed by the name
2827 of a file. For example:
2828 .code
2829 exim -bem /tmp/testmessage
2830 .endd
2831 The file is read as a message (as if receiving a locally-submitted non-SMTP
2832 message) before any of the test expansions are done. Thus, message-specific
2833 variables such as &$message_size$& and &$header_from:$& are available. However,
2834 no &'Received:'& header is added to the message. If the &%-t%& option is set,
2835 recipients are read from the headers in the normal way, and are shown in the
2836 &$recipients$& variable. Note that recipients cannot be given on the command
2837 line, because further arguments are taken as strings to expand (just like
2838 &%-be%&).
2839
2840 .vitem &%-bF%&&~<&'filename'&>
2841 .oindex "&%-bF%&"
2842 .cindex "system filter" "testing"
2843 .cindex "testing" "system filter"
2844 This option is the same as &%-bf%& except that it assumes that the filter being
2845 tested is a system filter. The additional commands that are available only in
2846 system filters are recognized.
2847
2848 .vitem &%-bf%&&~<&'filename'&>
2849 .oindex "&%-bf%&"
2850 .cindex "filter" "testing"
2851 .cindex "testing" "filter file"
2852 .cindex "forward file" "testing"
2853 .cindex "testing" "forward file"
2854 .cindex "Sieve filter" "testing"
2855 This option runs Exim in user filter testing mode; the file is the filter file
2856 to be tested, and a test message must be supplied on the standard input. If
2857 there are no message-dependent tests in the filter, an empty file can be
2858 supplied.
2859
2860 If you want to test a system filter file, use &%-bF%& instead of &%-bf%&. You
2861 can use both &%-bF%& and &%-bf%& on the same command, in order to test a system
2862 filter and a user filter in the same run. For example:
2863 .code
2864 exim -bF /system/filter -bf /user/filter </test/message
2865 .endd
2866 This is helpful when the system filter adds header lines or sets filter
2867 variables that are used by the user filter.
2868
2869 If the test filter file does not begin with one of the special lines
2870 .code
2871 # Exim filter
2872 # Sieve filter
2873 .endd
2874 it is taken to be a normal &_.forward_& file, and is tested for validity under
2875 that interpretation. See sections &<<SECTitenonfilred>>& to
2876 &<<SECTspecitredli>>& for a description of the possible contents of non-filter
2877 redirection lists.
2878
2879 The result of an Exim command that uses &%-bf%&, provided no errors are
2880 detected, is a list of the actions that Exim would try to take if presented
2881 with the message for real. More details of filter testing are given in the
2882 separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&.
2883
2884 When testing a filter file,
2885 .cindex "&""From""& line"
2886 .cindex "envelope from"
2887 .cindex "envelope sender"
2888 .oindex "&%-f%&" "for filter testing"
2889 the envelope sender can be set by the &%-f%& option,
2890 or by a &"From&~"& line at the start of the test message. Various parameters
2891 that would normally be taken from the envelope recipient address of the message
2892 can be set by means of additional command line options (see the next four
2893 options).
2894
2895 .vitem &%-bfd%&&~<&'domain'&>
2896 .oindex "&%-bfd%&"
2897 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
2898 This sets the domain of the recipient address when a filter file is being
2899 tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is the value of
2900 &$qualify_domain$&.
2901
2902 .vitem &%-bfl%&&~<&'local&~part'&>
2903 .oindex "&%-bfl%&"
2904 This sets the local part of the recipient address when a filter file is being
2905 tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is the username of the
2906 process that calls Exim. A local part should be specified with any prefix or
2907 suffix stripped, because that is how it appears to the filter when a message is
2908 actually being delivered.
2909
2910 .vitem &%-bfp%&&~<&'prefix'&>
2911 .oindex "&%-bfp%&"
2912 .cindex affix "filter testing"
2913 This sets the prefix of the local part of the recipient address when a filter
2914 file is being tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is an empty
2915 prefix.
2916
2917 .vitem &%-bfs%&&~<&'suffix'&>
2918 .oindex "&%-bfs%&"
2919 .cindex affix "filter testing"
2920 This sets the suffix of the local part of the recipient address when a filter
2921 file is being tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is an empty
2922 suffix.
2923
2924 .vitem &%-bh%&&~<&'IP&~address'&>
2925 .oindex "&%-bh%&"
2926 .cindex "testing" "incoming SMTP"
2927 .cindex "SMTP" "testing incoming"
2928 .cindex "testing" "relay control"
2929 .cindex "relaying" "testing configuration"
2930 .cindex "policy control" "testing"
2931 .cindex "debugging" "&%-bh%& option"
2932 This option runs a fake SMTP session as if from the given IP address, using the
2933 standard input and output. The IP address may include a port number at the end,
2934 after a full stop. For example:
2935 .code
2936 exim -bh 10.9.8.7.1234
2937 exim -bh fe80::a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678
2938 .endd
2939 When an IPv6 address is given, it is converted into canonical form. In the case
2940 of the second example above, the value of &$sender_host_address$& after
2941 conversion to the canonical form is
2942 &`fe80:0000:0000:0a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678`&.
2943
2944 Comments as to what is going on are written to the standard error file. These
2945 include lines beginning with &"LOG"& for anything that would have been logged.
2946 This facility is provided for testing configuration options for incoming
2947 messages, to make sure they implement the required policy. For example, you can
2948 test your relay controls using &%-bh%&.
2949
2950 &*Warning 1*&:
2951 .cindex "RFC 1413"
2952 You can test features of the configuration that rely on ident (RFC 1413)
2953 information by using the &%-oMt%& option. However, Exim cannot actually perform
2954 an ident callout when testing using &%-bh%& because there is no incoming SMTP
2955 connection.
2956
2957 &*Warning 2*&: Address verification callouts (see section &<<SECTcallver>>&)
2958 are also skipped when testing using &%-bh%&. If you want these callouts to
2959 occur, use &%-bhc%& instead.
2960
2961 Messages supplied during the testing session are discarded, and nothing is
2962 written to any of the real log files. There may be pauses when DNS (and other)
2963 lookups are taking place, and of course these may time out. The &%-oMi%& option
2964 can be used to specify a specific IP interface and port if this is important,
2965 and &%-oMaa%& and &%-oMai%& can be used to set parameters as if the SMTP
2966 session were authenticated.
2967
2968 The &'exim_checkaccess'& utility is a &"packaged"& version of &%-bh%& whose
2969 output just states whether a given recipient address from a given host is
2970 acceptable or not. See section &<<SECTcheckaccess>>&.
2971
2972 Features such as authentication and encryption, where the client input is not
2973 plain text, cannot easily be tested with &%-bh%&. Instead, you should use a
2974 specialized SMTP test program such as
2975 &url(https://www.jetmore.org/john/code/swaks/,swaks).
2976
2977 .vitem &%-bhc%&&~<&'IP&~address'&>
2978 .oindex "&%-bhc%&"
2979 This option operates in the same way as &%-bh%&, except that address
2980 verification callouts are performed if required. This includes consulting and
2981 updating the callout cache database.
2982
2983 .vitem &%-bi%&
2984 .oindex "&%-bi%&"
2985 .cindex "alias file" "building"
2986 .cindex "building alias file"
2987 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-bi%& option"
2988 Sendmail interprets the &%-bi%& option as a request to rebuild its alias file.
2989 Exim does not have the concept of a single alias file, and so it cannot mimic
2990 this behaviour. However, calls to &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& with the &%-bi%& option
2991 tend to appear in various scripts such as NIS make files, so the option must be
2992 recognized.
2993
2994 If &%-bi%& is encountered, the command specified by the &%bi_command%&
2995 configuration option is run, under the uid and gid of the caller of Exim. If
2996 the &%-oA%& option is used, its value is passed to the command as an argument.
2997 The command set by &%bi_command%& may not contain arguments. The command can
2998 use the &'exim_dbmbuild'& utility, or some other means, to rebuild alias files
2999 if this is required. If the &%bi_command%& option is not set, calling Exim with
3000 &%-bi%& is a no-op.
3001
3002 . // Keep :help first, then the rest in alphabetical order
3003 .vitem &%-bI:help%&
3004 .oindex "&%-bI:help%&"
3005 .cindex "querying exim information"
3006 We shall provide various options starting &`-bI:`& for querying Exim for
3007 information. The output of many of these will be intended for machine
3008 consumption. This one is not. The &%-bI:help%& option asks Exim for a
3009 synopsis of supported options beginning &`-bI:`&. Use of any of these
3010 options shall cause Exim to exit after producing the requested output.
3011
3012 .vitem &%-bI:dscp%&
3013 .oindex "&%-bI:dscp%&"
3014 .cindex "DSCP" "values"
3015 This option causes Exim to emit an alphabetically sorted list of all
3016 recognised DSCP names.
3017
3018 .vitem &%-bI:sieve%&
3019 .oindex "&%-bI:sieve%&"
3020 .cindex "Sieve filter" "capabilities"
3021 This option causes Exim to emit an alphabetically sorted list of all supported
3022 Sieve protocol extensions on stdout, one per line. This is anticipated to be
3023 useful for ManageSieve (RFC 5804) implementations, in providing that protocol's
3024 &`SIEVE`& capability response line. As the precise list may depend upon
3025 compile-time build options, which this option will adapt to, this is the only
3026 way to guarantee a correct response.
3027
3028 .vitem &%-bm%&
3029 .oindex "&%-bm%&"
3030 .cindex "local message reception"
3031 This option runs an Exim receiving process that accepts an incoming,
3032 locally-generated message on the standard input. The recipients are given as the
3033 command arguments (except when &%-t%& is also present &-- see below). Each
3034 argument can be a comma-separated list of RFC 2822 addresses. This is the
3035 default option for selecting the overall action of an Exim call; it is assumed
3036 if no other conflicting option is present.
3037
3038 If any addresses in the message are unqualified (have no domain), they are
3039 qualified by the values of the &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%&
3040 options, as appropriate. The &%-bnq%& option (see below) provides a way of
3041 suppressing this for special cases.
3042
3043 Policy checks on the contents of local messages can be enforced by means of
3044 the non-SMTP ACL. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details.
3045
3046 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bm%&"
3047 The return code is zero if the message is successfully accepted. Otherwise, the
3048 action is controlled by the &%-oe%&&'x'& option setting &-- see below.
3049
3050 The format
3051 .cindex "message" "format"
3052 .cindex "format" "message"
3053 .cindex "&""From""& line"
3054 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
3055 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
3056 of the message must be as defined in RFC 2822, except that, for
3057 compatibility with Sendmail and Smail, a line in one of the forms
3058 .code
3059 From sender Fri Jan 5 12:55 GMT 1997
3060 From sender Fri, 5 Jan 97 12:55:01
3061 .endd
3062 (with the weekday optional, and possibly with additional text after the date)
3063 is permitted to appear at the start of the message. There appears to be no
3064 authoritative specification of the format of this line. Exim recognizes it by
3065 matching against the regular expression defined by the &%uucp_from_pattern%&
3066 option, which can be changed if necessary.
3067
3068 .oindex "&%-f%&" "overriding &""From""& line"
3069 The specified sender is treated as if it were given as the argument to the
3070 &%-f%& option, but if a &%-f%& option is also present, its argument is used in
3071 preference to the address taken from the message. The caller of Exim must be a
3072 trusted user for the sender of a message to be set in this way.
3073
3074 .vitem &%-bmalware%&&~<&'filename'&>
3075 .oindex "&%-bmalware%&"
3076 .cindex "testing", "malware"
3077 .cindex "malware scan test"
3078 This debugging option causes Exim to scan the given file or directory
3079 (depending on the used scanner interface),
3080 using the malware scanning framework. The option of &%av_scanner%& influences
3081 this option, so if &%av_scanner%&'s value is dependent upon an expansion then
3082 the expansion should have defaults which apply to this invocation. ACLs are
3083 not invoked, so if &%av_scanner%& references an ACL variable then that variable
3084 will never be populated and &%-bmalware%& will fail.
3085
3086 Exim will have changed working directory before resolving the filename, so
3087 using fully qualified pathnames is advisable. Exim will be running as the Exim
3088 user when it tries to open the file, rather than as the invoking user.
3089 This option requires admin privileges.
3090
3091 The &%-bmalware%& option will not be extended to be more generally useful,
3092 there are better tools for file-scanning. This option exists to help
3093 administrators verify their Exim and AV scanner configuration.
3094
3095 .vitem &%-bnq%&
3096 .oindex "&%-bnq%&"
3097 .cindex "address qualification, suppressing"
3098 By default, Exim automatically qualifies unqualified addresses (those
3099 without domains) that appear in messages that are submitted locally (that
3100 is, not over TCP/IP). This qualification applies both to addresses in
3101 envelopes, and addresses in header lines. Sender addresses are qualified using
3102 &%qualify_domain%&, and recipient addresses using &%qualify_recipient%& (which
3103 defaults to the value of &%qualify_domain%&).
3104
3105 Sometimes, qualification is not wanted. For example, if &%-bS%& (batch SMTP) is
3106 being used to re-submit messages that originally came from remote hosts after
3107 content scanning, you probably do not want to qualify unqualified addresses in
3108 header lines. (Such lines will be present only if you have not enabled a header
3109 syntax check in the appropriate ACL.)
3110
3111 The &%-bnq%& option suppresses all qualification of unqualified addresses in
3112 messages that originate on the local host. When this is used, unqualified
3113 addresses in the envelope provoke errors (causing message rejection) and
3114 unqualified addresses in header lines are left alone.
3115
3116
3117 .vitem &%-bP%&
3118 .oindex "&%-bP%&"
3119 .cindex "configuration options" "extracting"
3120 .cindex "options" "configuration &-- extracting"
3121 If this option is given with no arguments, it causes the values of all Exim's
3122 main configuration options to be written to the standard output. The values
3123 of one or more specific options can be requested by giving their names as
3124 arguments, for example:
3125 .code
3126 exim -bP qualify_domain hold_domains
3127 .endd
3128 .cindex "hiding configuration option values"
3129 .cindex "configuration options" "hiding value of"
3130 .cindex "options" "hiding value of"
3131 However, any option setting that is preceded by the word &"hide"& in the
3132 configuration file is not shown in full, except to an admin user. For other
3133 users, the output is as in this example:
3134 .code
3135 mysql_servers = <value not displayable>
3136 .endd
3137 If &%config%& is given as an argument, the config is
3138 output, as it was parsed, any include file resolved, any comment removed.
3139
3140 If &%config_file%& is given as an argument, the name of the runtime
3141 configuration file is output. (&%configure_file%& works too, for
3142 backward compatibility.)
3143 If a list of configuration files was supplied, the value that is output here
3144 is the name of the file that was actually used.
3145
3146 .cindex "options" "hiding name of"
3147 If the &%-n%& flag is given, then for most modes of &%-bP%& operation the
3148 name will not be output.
3149
3150 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
3151 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
3152 If &%log_file_path%& or &%pid_file_path%& are given, the names of the
3153 directories where log files and daemon pid files are written are output,
3154 respectively. If these values are unset, log files are written in a
3155 sub-directory of the spool directory called &%log%&, and the pid file is
3156 written directly into the spool directory.
3157
3158 If &%-bP%& is followed by a name preceded by &`+`&, for example,
3159 .code
3160 exim -bP +local_domains
3161 .endd
3162 it searches for a matching named list of any type (domain, host, address, or
3163 local part) and outputs what it finds.
3164
3165 .cindex "options" "router &-- extracting"
3166 .cindex "options" "transport &-- extracting"
3167 .cindex "options" "authenticator &-- extracting"
3168 If one of the words &%router%&, &%transport%&, or &%authenticator%& is given,
3169 followed by the name of an appropriate driver instance, the option settings for
3170 that driver are output. For example:
3171 .code
3172 exim -bP transport local_delivery
3173 .endd
3174 The generic driver options are output first, followed by the driver's private
3175 options. A list of the names of drivers of a particular type can be obtained by
3176 using one of the words &%router_list%&, &%transport_list%&, or
3177 &%authenticator_list%&, and a complete list of all drivers with their option
3178 settings can be obtained by using &%routers%&, &%transports%&, or
3179 &%authenticators%&.
3180
3181 .cindex "environment"
3182 If &%environment%& is given as an argument, the set of environment
3183 variables is output, line by line. Using the &%-n%& flag suppresses the value of the
3184 variables.
3185
3186 .cindex "options" "macro &-- extracting"
3187 If invoked by an admin user, then &%macro%&, &%macro_list%& and &%macros%&
3188 are available, similarly to the drivers. Because macros are sometimes used
3189 for storing passwords, this option is restricted.
3190 The output format is one item per line.
3191 For the "-bP macro <name>" form, if no such macro is found
3192 the exit status will be nonzero.
3193
3194 .vitem &%-bp%&
3195 .oindex "&%-bp%&"
3196 .cindex "queue" "listing messages in"
3197 .cindex "listing" "messages in the queue"
3198 This option requests a listing of the contents of the mail queue on the
3199 standard output. If the &%-bp%& option is followed by a list of message ids,
3200 just those messages are listed. By default, this option can be used only by an
3201 admin user. However, the &%queue_list_requires_admin%& option can be set false
3202 to allow any user to see the queue.
3203
3204 Each message in the queue is displayed as in the following example:
3205 .code
3206 25m 2.9K 0t5C6f-0000c8-00 <alice@wonderland.fict.example>
3207 red.king@looking-glass.fict.example
3208 <other addresses>
3209 .endd
3210 .cindex "message" "size in queue listing"
3211 .cindex "size" "of message"
3212 The first line contains the length of time the message has been in the queue
3213 (in this case 25 minutes), the size of the message (2.9K), the unique local
3214 identifier for the message, and the message sender, as contained in the
3215 envelope. For bounce messages, the sender address is empty, and appears as
3216 &"<>"&. If the message was submitted locally by an untrusted user who overrode
3217 the default sender address, the user's login name is shown in parentheses
3218 before the sender address.
3219
3220 .cindex "frozen messages" "in queue listing"
3221 If the message is frozen (attempts to deliver it are suspended) then the text
3222 &"*** frozen ***"& is displayed at the end of this line.
3223
3224 The recipients of the message (taken from the envelope, not the headers) are
3225 displayed on subsequent lines. Those addresses to which the message has already
3226 been delivered are marked with the letter D. If an original address gets
3227 expanded into several addresses via an alias or forward file, the original is
3228 displayed with a D only when deliveries for all of its child addresses are
3229 complete.
3230
3231
3232 .vitem &%-bpa%&
3233 .oindex "&%-bpa%&"
3234 This option operates like &%-bp%&, but in addition it shows delivered addresses
3235 that were generated from the original top level address(es) in each message by
3236 alias or forwarding operations. These addresses are flagged with &"+D"& instead
3237 of just &"D"&.
3238
3239
3240 .vitem &%-bpc%&
3241 .oindex "&%-bpc%&"
3242 .cindex "queue" "count of messages on"
3243 This option counts the number of messages in the queue, and writes the total
3244 to the standard output. It is restricted to admin users, unless
3245 &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set false.
3246
3247
3248 .vitem &%-bpr%&
3249 .oindex "&%-bpr%&"
3250 This option operates like &%-bp%&, but the output is not sorted into
3251 chronological order of message arrival. This can speed it up when there are
3252 lots of messages in the queue, and is particularly useful if the output is
3253 going to be post-processed in a way that doesn't need the sorting.
3254
3255 .vitem &%-bpra%&
3256 .oindex "&%-bpra%&"
3257 This option is a combination of &%-bpr%& and &%-bpa%&.
3258
3259 .vitem &%-bpru%&
3260 .oindex "&%-bpru%&"
3261 This option is a combination of &%-bpr%& and &%-bpu%&.
3262
3263
3264 .vitem &%-bpu%&
3265 .oindex "&%-bpu%&"
3266 This option operates like &%-bp%& but shows only undelivered top-level
3267 addresses for each message displayed. Addresses generated by aliasing or
3268 forwarding are not shown, unless the message was deferred after processing by a
3269 router with the &%one_time%& option set.
3270
3271
3272 .vitem &%-brt%&
3273 .oindex "&%-brt%&"
3274 .cindex "testing" "retry configuration"
3275 .cindex "retry" "configuration testing"
3276 This option is for testing retry rules, and it must be followed by up to three
3277 arguments. It causes Exim to look for a retry rule that matches the values
3278 and to write it to the standard output. For example:
3279 .code
3280 exim -brt bach.comp.mus.example
3281 Retry rule: *.comp.mus.example F,2h,15m; F,4d,30m;
3282 .endd
3283 See chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& for a description of Exim's retry rules. The first
3284 argument, which is required, can be a complete address in the form
3285 &'local_part@domain'&, or it can be just a domain name. If the second argument
3286 contains a dot, it is interpreted as an optional second domain name; if no
3287 retry rule is found for the first argument, the second is tried. This ties in
3288 with Exim's behaviour when looking for retry rules for remote hosts &-- if no
3289 rule is found that matches the host, one that matches the mail domain is
3290 sought. Finally, an argument that is the name of a specific delivery error, as
3291 used in setting up retry rules, can be given. For example:
3292 .code
3293 exim -brt haydn.comp.mus.example quota_3d
3294 Retry rule: *@haydn.comp.mus.example quota_3d F,1h,15m
3295 .endd
3296
3297 .vitem &%-brw%&
3298 .oindex "&%-brw%&"
3299 .cindex "testing" "rewriting"
3300 .cindex "rewriting" "testing"
3301 This option is for testing address rewriting rules, and it must be followed by
3302 a single argument, consisting of either a local part without a domain, or a
3303 complete address with a fully qualified domain. Exim outputs how this address
3304 would be rewritten for each possible place it might appear. See chapter
3305 &<<CHAPrewrite>>& for further details.
3306
3307 .vitem &%-bS%&
3308 .oindex "&%-bS%&"
3309 .cindex "SMTP" "batched incoming"
3310 .cindex "batched SMTP input"
3311 This option is used for batched SMTP input, which is an alternative interface
3312 for non-interactive local message submission. A number of messages can be
3313 submitted in a single run. However, despite its name, this is not really SMTP
3314 input. Exim reads each message's envelope from SMTP commands on the standard
3315 input, but generates no responses. If the caller is trusted, or
3316 &%untrusted_set_sender%& is set, the senders in the SMTP MAIL commands are
3317 believed; otherwise the sender is always the caller of Exim.
3318
3319 The message itself is read from the standard input, in SMTP format (leading
3320 dots doubled), terminated by a line containing just a single dot. An error is
3321 provoked if the terminating dot is missing. A further message may then follow.
3322
3323 As for other local message submissions, the contents of incoming batch SMTP
3324 messages can be checked using the non-SMTP ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&).
3325 Unqualified addresses are automatically qualified using &%qualify_domain%& and
3326 &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate, unless the &%-bnq%& option is used.
3327
3328 Some other SMTP commands are recognized in the input. HELO and EHLO act
3329 as RSET; VRFY, EXPN, ETRN, and HELP act as NOOP;
3330 QUIT quits, ignoring the rest of the standard input.
3331
3332 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bS%&"
3333 If any error is encountered, reports are written to the standard output and
3334 error streams, and Exim gives up immediately. The return code is 0 if no error
3335 was detected; it is 1 if one or more messages were accepted before the error
3336 was detected; otherwise it is 2.
3337
3338 More details of input using batched SMTP are given in section
3339 &<<SECTincomingbatchedSMTP>>&.
3340
3341 .vitem &%-bs%&
3342 .oindex "&%-bs%&"
3343 .cindex "SMTP" "local input"
3344 .cindex "local SMTP input"
3345 This option causes Exim to accept one or more messages by reading SMTP commands
3346 on the standard input, and producing SMTP replies on the standard output. SMTP
3347 policy controls, as defined in ACLs (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) are applied.
3348 Some user agents use this interface as a way of passing locally-generated
3349 messages to the MTA.
3350
3351 In
3352 .cindex "sender" "source of"
3353 this usage, if the caller of Exim is trusted, or &%untrusted_set_sender%& is
3354 set, the senders of messages are taken from the SMTP MAIL commands.
3355 Otherwise the content of these commands is ignored and the sender is set up as
3356 the calling user. Unqualified addresses are automatically qualified using
3357 &%qualify_domain%& and &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate, unless the
3358 &%-bnq%& option is used.
3359
3360 .cindex "inetd"
3361 The
3362 &%-bs%& option is also used to run Exim from &'inetd'&, as an alternative to
3363 using a listening daemon. Exim can distinguish the two cases by checking
3364 whether the standard input is a TCP/IP socket. When Exim is called from
3365 &'inetd'&, the source of the mail is assumed to be remote, and the comments
3366 above concerning senders and qualification do not apply. In this situation,
3367 Exim behaves in exactly the same way as it does when receiving a message via
3368 the listening daemon.
3369
3370 .vitem &%-bt%&
3371 .oindex "&%-bt%&"
3372 .cindex "testing" "addresses"
3373 .cindex "address" "testing"
3374 This option runs Exim in address testing mode, in which each argument is taken
3375 as a recipient address to be tested for deliverability. The results are
3376 written to the standard output. If a test fails, and the caller is not an admin
3377 user, no details of the failure are output, because these might contain
3378 sensitive information such as usernames and passwords for database lookups.
3379
3380 If no arguments are given, Exim runs in an interactive manner, prompting with a
3381 right angle bracket for addresses to be tested.
3382
3383 Unlike the &%-be%& test option, you cannot arrange for Exim to use the
3384 &[readline()]& function, because it is running as &'root'& and there are
3385 security issues.
3386
3387 Each address is handled as if it were the recipient address of a message
3388 (compare the &%-bv%& option). It is passed to the routers and the result is
3389 written to the standard output. However, any router that has
3390 &%no_address_test%& set is bypassed. This can make &%-bt%& easier to use for
3391 genuine routing tests if your first router passes everything to a scanner
3392 program.
3393
3394 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bt%&"
3395 The return code is 2 if any address failed outright; it is 1 if no address
3396 failed outright but at least one could not be resolved for some reason. Return
3397 code 0 is given only when all addresses succeed.
3398
3399 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
3400 &*Note*&: When actually delivering a message, Exim removes duplicate recipient
3401 addresses after routing is complete, so that only one delivery takes place.
3402 This does not happen when testing with &%-bt%&; the full results of routing are
3403 always shown.
3404
3405 &*Warning*&: &%-bt%& can only do relatively simple testing. If any of the
3406 routers in the configuration makes any tests on the sender address of a
3407 message,
3408 .oindex "&%-f%&" "for address testing"
3409 you can use the &%-f%& option to set an appropriate sender when running
3410 &%-bt%& tests. Without it, the sender is assumed to be the calling user at the
3411 default qualifying domain. However, if you have set up (for example) routers
3412 whose behaviour depends on the contents of an incoming message, you cannot test
3413 those conditions using &%-bt%&. The &%-N%& option provides a possible way of
3414 doing such tests.
3415
3416 .vitem &%-bV%&
3417 .oindex "&%-bV%&"
3418 .cindex "version number of Exim"
3419 This option causes Exim to write the current version number, compilation
3420 number, and compilation date of the &'exim'& binary to the standard output.
3421 It also lists the DBM library that is being used, the optional modules (such as
3422 specific lookup types), the drivers that are included in the binary, and the
3423 name of the runtime configuration file that is in use.
3424
3425 As part of its operation, &%-bV%& causes Exim to read and syntax check its
3426 configuration file. However, this is a static check only. It cannot check
3427 values that are to be expanded. For example, although a misspelt ACL verb is
3428 detected, an error in the verb's arguments is not. You cannot rely on &%-bV%&
3429 alone to discover (for example) all the typos in the configuration; some
3430 realistic testing is needed. The &%-bh%& and &%-N%& options provide more
3431 dynamic testing facilities.
3432
3433 .vitem &%-bv%&
3434 .oindex "&%-bv%&"
3435 .cindex "verifying address" "using &%-bv%&"
3436 .cindex "address" "verification"
3437 This option runs Exim in address verification mode, in which each argument is
3438 taken as a recipient address to be verified by the routers. (This does
3439 not involve any verification callouts). During normal operation, verification
3440 happens mostly as a consequence processing a &%verify%& condition in an ACL
3441 (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). If you want to test an entire ACL, possibly
3442 including callouts, see the &%-bh%& and &%-bhc%& options.
3443
3444 If verification fails, and the caller is not an admin user, no details of the
3445 failure are output, because these might contain sensitive information such as
3446 usernames and passwords for database lookups.
3447
3448 If no arguments are given, Exim runs in an interactive manner, prompting with a
3449 right angle bracket for addresses to be verified.
3450
3451 Unlike the &%-be%& test option, you cannot arrange for Exim to use the
3452 &[readline()]& function, because it is running as &'exim'& and there are
3453 security issues.
3454
3455 Verification differs from address testing (the &%-bt%& option) in that routers
3456 that have &%no_verify%& set are skipped, and if the address is accepted by a
3457 router that has &%fail_verify%& set, verification fails. The address is
3458 verified as a recipient if &%-bv%& is used; to test verification for a sender
3459 address, &%-bvs%& should be used.
3460
3461 If the &%-v%& option is not set, the output consists of a single line for each
3462 address, stating whether it was verified or not, and giving a reason in the
3463 latter case. Without &%-v%&, generating more than one address by redirection
3464 causes verification to end successfully, without considering the generated
3465 addresses. However, if just one address is generated, processing continues,
3466 and the generated address must verify successfully for the overall verification
3467 to succeed.
3468
3469 When &%-v%& is set, more details are given of how the address has been handled,
3470 and in the case of address redirection, all the generated addresses are also
3471 considered. Verification may succeed for some and fail for others.
3472
3473 The
3474 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bv%&"
3475 return code is 2 if any address failed outright; it is 1 if no address
3476 failed outright but at least one could not be resolved for some reason. Return
3477 code 0 is given only when all addresses succeed.
3478
3479 If any of the routers in the configuration makes any tests on the sender
3480 address of a message, you should use the &%-f%& option to set an appropriate
3481 sender when running &%-bv%& tests. Without it, the sender is assumed to be the
3482 calling user at the default qualifying domain.
3483
3484 .vitem &%-bvs%&
3485 .oindex "&%-bvs%&"
3486 This option acts like &%-bv%&, but verifies the address as a sender rather
3487 than a recipient address. This affects any rewriting and qualification that
3488 might happen.
3489
3490 .vitem &%-bw%&
3491 .oindex "&%-bw%&"
3492 .cindex "daemon"
3493 .cindex "inetd"
3494 .cindex "inetd" "wait mode"
3495 This option runs Exim as a daemon, awaiting incoming SMTP connections,
3496 similarly to the &%-bd%& option. All port specifications on the command-line
3497 and in the configuration file are ignored. Queue-running may not be specified.
3498
3499 In this mode, Exim expects to be passed a socket as fd 0 (stdin) which is
3500 listening for connections. This permits the system to start up and have
3501 inetd (or equivalent) listen on the SMTP ports, starting an Exim daemon for
3502 each port only when the first connection is received.
3503
3504 If the option is given as &%-bw%&<&'time'&> then the time is a timeout, after
3505 which the daemon will exit, which should cause inetd to listen once more.
3506
3507 .vitem &%-C%&&~<&'filelist'&>
3508 .oindex "&%-C%&"
3509 .cindex "configuration file" "alternate"
3510 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
3511 .cindex "alternate configuration file"
3512 This option causes Exim to find the runtime configuration file from the given
3513 list instead of from the list specified by the CONFIGURE_FILE
3514 compile-time setting. Usually, the list will consist of just a single filename,
3515 but it can be a colon-separated list of names. In this case, the first
3516 file that exists is used. Failure to open an existing file stops Exim from
3517 proceeding any further along the list, and an error is generated.
3518
3519 When this option is used by a caller other than root, and the list is different
3520 from the compiled-in list, Exim gives up its root privilege immediately, and
3521 runs with the real and effective uid and gid set to those of the caller.
3522 However, if a TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, that
3523 file contains a list of full pathnames, one per line, for configuration files
3524 which are trusted. Root privilege is retained for any configuration file so
3525 listed, as long as the caller is the Exim user (or the user specified in the
3526 CONFIGURE_OWNER option, if any), and as long as the configuration file is
3527 not writeable by inappropriate users or groups.
3528
3529 Leaving TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST unset precludes the possibility of testing a
3530 configuration using &%-C%& right through message reception and delivery,
3531 even if the caller is root. The reception works, but by that time, Exim is
3532 running as the Exim user, so when it re-executes to regain privilege for the
3533 delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes privilege to be lost. However, root can
3534 test reception and delivery using two separate commands (one to put a message
3535 in the queue, using &%-odq%&, and another to do the delivery, using &%-M%&).
3536
3537 If ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX is defined &_in Local/Makefile_&, it specifies a
3538 prefix string with which any file named in a &%-C%& command line option
3539 must start. In addition, the filename must not contain the sequence &`/../`&.
3540 However, if the value of the &%-C%& option is identical to the value of
3541 CONFIGURE_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim ignores &%-C%& and proceeds as
3542 usual. There is no default setting for ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX; when it is
3543 unset, any filename can be used with &%-C%&.
3544
3545 ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX can be used to confine alternative configuration files
3546 to a directory to which only root has access. This prevents someone who has
3547 broken into the Exim account from running a privileged Exim with an arbitrary
3548 configuration file.
3549
3550 The &%-C%& facility is useful for ensuring that configuration files are
3551 syntactically correct, but cannot be used for test deliveries, unless the
3552 caller is privileged, or unless it is an exotic configuration that does not
3553 require privilege. No check is made on the owner or group of the files
3554 specified by this option.
3555
3556
3557 .vitem &%-D%&<&'macro'&>=<&'value'&>
3558 .oindex "&%-D%&"
3559 .cindex "macro" "setting on command line"
3560 This option can be used to override macro definitions in the configuration file
3561 (see section &<<SECTmacrodefs>>&). However, like &%-C%&, if it is used by an
3562 unprivileged caller, it causes Exim to give up its root privilege.
3563 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the use of &%-D%& is
3564 completely disabled, and its use causes an immediate error exit.
3565
3566 If WHITELIST_D_MACROS is defined in &_Local/Makefile_& then it should be a
3567 colon-separated list of macros which are considered safe and, if &%-D%& only
3568 supplies macros from this list, and the values are acceptable, then Exim will
3569 not give up root privilege if the caller is root, the Exim run-time user, or
3570 the CONFIGURE_OWNER, if set. This is a transition mechanism and is expected
3571 to be removed in the future. Acceptable values for the macros satisfy the
3572 regexp: &`^[A-Za-z0-9_/.-]*$`&
3573
3574 The entire option (including equals sign if present) must all be within one
3575 command line item. &%-D%& can be used to set the value of a macro to the empty
3576 string, in which case the equals sign is optional. These two commands are
3577 synonymous:
3578 .code
3579 exim -DABC ...
3580 exim -DABC= ...
3581 .endd
3582 To include spaces in a macro definition item, quotes must be used. If you use
3583 quotes, spaces are permitted around the macro name and the equals sign. For
3584 example:
3585 .code
3586 exim '-D ABC = something' ...
3587 .endd
3588 &%-D%& may be repeated up to 10 times on a command line.
3589 Only macro names up to 22 letters long can be set.
3590
3591
3592 .vitem &%-d%&<&'debug&~options'&>
3593 .oindex "&%-d%&"
3594 .cindex "debugging" "list of selectors"
3595 .cindex "debugging" "&%-d%& option"
3596 This option causes debugging information to be written to the standard
3597 error stream. It is restricted to admin users because debugging output may show
3598 database queries that contain password information. Also, the details of users'
3599 filter files should be protected. If a non-admin user uses &%-d%&, Exim
3600 writes an error message to the standard error stream and exits with a non-zero
3601 return code.
3602
3603 When &%-d%& is used, &%-v%& is assumed. If &%-d%& is given on its own, a lot of
3604 standard debugging data is output. This can be reduced, or increased to include
3605 some more rarely needed information, by directly following &%-d%& with a string
3606 made up of names preceded by plus or minus characters. These add or remove sets
3607 of debugging data, respectively. For example, &%-d+filter%& adds filter
3608 debugging, whereas &%-d-all+filter%& selects only filter debugging. Note that
3609 no spaces are allowed in the debug setting. The available debugging categories
3610 are:
3611 .display
3612 &`acl `& ACL interpretation
3613 &`auth `& authenticators
3614 &`deliver `& general delivery logic
3615 &`dns `& DNS lookups (see also resolver)
3616 &`dnsbl `& DNS black list (aka RBL) code
3617 &`exec `& arguments for &[execv()]& calls
3618 &`expand `& detailed debugging for string expansions
3619 &`filter `& filter handling
3620 &`hints_lookup `& hints data lookups
3621 &`host_lookup `& all types of name-to-IP address handling
3622 &`ident `& ident lookup
3623 &`interface `& lists of local interfaces
3624 &`lists `& matching things in lists
3625 &`load `& system load checks
3626 &`local_scan `& can be used by &[local_scan()]& (see chapter &&&
3627 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&)
3628 &`lookup `& general lookup code and all lookups
3629 &`memory `& memory handling
3630 &`noutf8 `& modifier: avoid UTF-8 line-drawing
3631 &`pid `& modifier: add pid to debug output lines
3632 &`process_info `& setting info for the process log
3633 &`queue_run `& queue runs
3634 &`receive `& general message reception logic
3635 &`resolver `& turn on the DNS resolver's debugging output
3636 &`retry `& retry handling
3637 &`rewrite `& address rewriting
3638 &`route `& address routing
3639 &`timestamp `& modifier: add timestamp to debug output lines
3640 &`tls `& TLS logic
3641 &`transport `& transports
3642 &`uid `& changes of uid/gid and looking up uid/gid
3643 &`verify `& address verification logic
3644 &`all `& almost all of the above (see below), and also &%-v%&
3645 .endd
3646 The &`all`& option excludes &`memory`& when used as &`+all`&, but includes it
3647 for &`-all`&. The reason for this is that &`+all`& is something that people
3648 tend to use when generating debug output for Exim maintainers. If &`+memory`&
3649 is included, an awful lot of output that is very rarely of interest is
3650 generated, so it now has to be explicitly requested. However, &`-all`& does
3651 turn everything off.
3652
3653 .cindex "resolver, debugging output"
3654 .cindex "DNS resolver, debugging output"
3655 The &`resolver`& option produces output only if the DNS resolver was compiled
3656 with DEBUG enabled. This is not the case in some operating systems. Also,
3657 unfortunately, debugging output from the DNS resolver is written to stdout
3658 rather than stderr.
3659
3660 The default (&%-d%& with no argument) omits &`expand`&, &`filter`&,
3661 &`interface`&, &`load`&, &`memory`&, &`pid`&, &`resolver`&, and &`timestamp`&.
3662 However, the &`pid`& selector is forced when debugging is turned on for a
3663 daemon, which then passes it on to any re-executed Exims. Exim also
3664 automatically adds the pid to debug lines when several remote deliveries are
3665 run in parallel.
3666
3667 The &`timestamp`& selector causes the current time to be inserted at the start
3668 of all debug output lines. This can be useful when trying to track down delays
3669 in processing.
3670
3671 .cindex debugging "UTF-8 in"
3672 .cindex UTF-8 "in debug output"
3673 The &`noutf8`& selector disables the use of
3674 UTF-8 line-drawing characters to group related information.
3675 When disabled. ascii-art is used instead.
3676 Using the &`+all`& option does not set this modifier,
3677
3678 If the &%debug_print%& option is set in any driver, it produces output whenever
3679 any debugging is selected, or if &%-v%& is used.
3680
3681 .vitem &%-dd%&<&'debug&~options'&>
3682 .oindex "&%-dd%&"
3683 This option behaves exactly like &%-d%& except when used on a command that
3684 starts a daemon process. In that case, debugging is turned off for the
3685 subprocesses that the daemon creates. Thus, it is useful for monitoring the
3686 behaviour of the daemon without creating as much output as full debugging does.
3687
3688 .vitem &%-dropcr%&
3689 .oindex "&%-dropcr%&"
3690 This is an obsolete option that is now a no-op. It used to affect the way Exim
3691 handled CR and LF characters in incoming messages. What happens now is
3692 described in section &<<SECTlineendings>>&.
3693
3694 .vitem &%-E%&
3695 .oindex "&%-E%&"
3696 .cindex "bounce message" "generating"
3697 This option specifies that an incoming message is a locally-generated delivery
3698 failure report. It is used internally by Exim when handling delivery failures
3699 and is not intended for external use. Its only effect is to stop Exim
3700 generating certain messages to the postmaster, as otherwise message cascades
3701 could occur in some situations. As part of the same option, a message id may
3702 follow the characters &%-E%&. If it does, the log entry for the receipt of the
3703 new message contains the id, following &"R="&, as a cross-reference.
3704
3705 .vitem &%-e%&&'x'&
3706 .oindex "&%-e%&&'x'&"
3707 There are a number of Sendmail options starting with &%-oe%& which seem to be
3708 called by various programs without the leading &%o%& in the option. For
3709 example, the &%vacation%& program uses &%-eq%&. Exim treats all options of the
3710 form &%-e%&&'x'& as synonymous with the corresponding &%-oe%&&'x'& options.
3711
3712 .vitem &%-F%&&~<&'string'&>
3713 .oindex "&%-F%&"
3714 .cindex "sender" "name"
3715 .cindex "name" "of sender"
3716 This option sets the sender's full name for use when a locally-generated
3717 message is being accepted. In the absence of this option, the user's &'gecos'&
3718 entry from the password data is used. As users are generally permitted to alter
3719 their &'gecos'& entries, no security considerations are involved. White space
3720 between &%-F%& and the <&'string'&> is optional.
3721
3722 .vitem &%-f%&&~<&'address'&>
3723 .oindex "&%-f%&"
3724 .cindex "sender" "address"
3725 .cindex "address" "sender"
3726 .cindex "trusted users"
3727 .cindex "envelope from"
3728 .cindex "envelope sender"
3729 .cindex "user" "trusted"
3730 This option sets the address of the envelope sender of a locally-generated
3731 message (also known as the return path). The option can normally be used only
3732 by a trusted user, but &%untrusted_set_sender%& can be set to allow untrusted
3733 users to use it.
3734
3735 Processes running as root or the Exim user are always trusted. Other
3736 trusted users are defined by the &%trusted_users%& or &%trusted_groups%&
3737 options. In the absence of &%-f%&, or if the caller is not trusted, the sender
3738 of a local message is set to the caller's login name at the default qualify
3739 domain.
3740
3741 There is one exception to the restriction on the use of &%-f%&: an empty sender
3742 can be specified by any user, trusted or not, to create a message that can
3743 never provoke a bounce. An empty sender can be specified either as an empty
3744 string, or as a pair of angle brackets with nothing between them, as in these
3745 examples of shell commands:
3746 .code
3747 exim -f '<>' user@domain
3748 exim -f "" user@domain
3749 .endd
3750 In addition, the use of &%-f%& is not restricted when testing a filter file
3751 with &%-bf%& or when testing or verifying addresses using the &%-bt%& or
3752 &%-bv%& options.
3753
3754 Allowing untrusted users to change the sender address does not of itself make
3755 it possible to send anonymous mail. Exim still checks that the &'From:'& header
3756 refers to the local user, and if it does not, it adds a &'Sender:'& header,
3757 though this can be overridden by setting &%no_local_from_check%&.
3758
3759 White
3760 .cindex "&""From""& line"
3761 space between &%-f%& and the <&'address'&> is optional (that is, they can be
3762 given as two arguments or one combined argument). The sender of a
3763 locally-generated message can also be set (when permitted) by an initial
3764 &"From&~"& line in the message &-- see the description of &%-bm%& above &-- but
3765 if &%-f%& is also present, it overrides &"From&~"&.
3766
3767 .vitem &%-G%&
3768 .oindex "&%-G%&"
3769 .cindex "submission fixups, suppressing (command-line)"
3770 This option is equivalent to an ACL applying:
3771 .code
3772 control = suppress_local_fixups
3773 .endd
3774 for every message received. Note that Sendmail will complain about such
3775 bad formatting, where Exim silently just does not fix it up. This may change
3776 in future.
3777
3778 As this affects audit information, the caller must be a trusted user to use
3779 this option.
3780
3781 .vitem &%-h%&&~<&'number'&>
3782 .oindex "&%-h%&"
3783 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-h%& option ignored"
3784 This option is accepted for compatibility with Sendmail, but has no effect. (In
3785 Sendmail it overrides the &"hop count"& obtained by counting &'Received:'&
3786 headers.)
3787
3788 .vitem &%-i%&
3789 .oindex "&%-i%&"
3790 .cindex "Solaris" "&'mail'& command"
3791 .cindex "dot" "in incoming non-SMTP message"
3792 This option, which has the same effect as &%-oi%&, specifies that a dot on a
3793 line by itself should not terminate an incoming, non-SMTP message. I can find
3794 no documentation for this option in Solaris 2.4 Sendmail, but the &'mailx'&
3795 command in Solaris 2.4 uses it. See also &%-ti%&.
3796
3797 .vitem &%-L%&&~<&'tag'&>
3798 .oindex "&%-L%&"
3799 .cindex "syslog" "process name; set with flag"
3800 This option is equivalent to setting &%syslog_processname%& in the config
3801 file and setting &%log_file_path%& to &`syslog`&.
3802 Its use is restricted to administrators. The configuration file has to be
3803 read and parsed, to determine access rights, before this is set and takes
3804 effect, so early configuration file errors will not honour this flag.
3805
3806 The tag should not be longer than 32 characters.
3807
3808 .vitem &%-M%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3809 .oindex "&%-M%&"
3810 .cindex "forcing delivery"
3811 .cindex "delivery" "forcing attempt"
3812 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
3813 This option requests Exim to run a delivery attempt on each message in turn. If
3814 any of the messages are frozen, they are automatically thawed before the
3815 delivery attempt. The settings of &%queue_domains%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&,
3816 and &%hold_domains%& are ignored.
3817
3818 Retry
3819 .cindex "hints database" "overriding retry hints"
3820 hints for any of the addresses are overridden &-- Exim tries to deliver even if
3821 the normal retry time has not yet been reached. This option requires the caller
3822 to be an admin user. However, there is an option called &%prod_requires_admin%&
3823 which can be set false to relax this restriction (and also the same requirement
3824 for the &%-q%&, &%-R%&, and &%-S%& options).
3825
3826 The deliveries happen synchronously, that is, the original Exim process does
3827 not terminate until all the delivery attempts have finished. No output is
3828 produced unless there is a serious error. If you want to see what is happening,
3829 use the &%-v%& option as well, or inspect Exim's main log.
3830
3831 .vitem &%-Mar%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>&~<&'address'&>&~...
3832 .oindex "&%-Mar%&"
3833 .cindex "message" "adding recipients"
3834 .cindex "recipient" "adding"
3835 This option requests Exim to add the addresses to the list of recipients of the
3836 message (&"ar"& for &"add recipients"&). The first argument must be a message
3837 id, and the remaining ones must be email addresses. However, if the message is
3838 active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), it is not altered. This option
3839 can be used only by an admin user.
3840
3841 .vitem "&%-MC%&&~<&'transport'&>&~<&'hostname'&>&~<&'sequence&~number'&>&&&
3842 &~<&'message&~id'&>"
3843 .oindex "&%-MC%&"
3844 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
3845 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
3846 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
3847 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3848 by Exim to invoke another instance of itself to deliver a waiting message using
3849 an existing SMTP connection, which is passed as the standard input. Details are
3850 given in chapter &<<CHAPSMTP>>&. This must be the final option, and the caller
3851 must be root or the Exim user in order to use it.
3852
3853 .vitem &%-MCA%&
3854 .oindex "&%-MCA%&"
3855 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3856 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the
3857 connection to the remote host has been authenticated.
3858
3859 .vitem &%-MCD%&
3860 .oindex "&%-MCD%&"
3861 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3862 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the
3863 remote host supports the ESMTP &_DSN_& extension.
3864
3865 .vitem &%-MCG%&&~<&'queue&~name'&>
3866 .oindex "&%-MCG%&"
3867 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3868 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that an
3869 alternate queue is used, named by the following argument.
3870
3871 .vitem &%-MCK%&
3872 .oindex "&%-MCK%&"
3873 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3874 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that a
3875 remote host supports the ESMTP &_CHUNKING_& extension.
3876
3877 .vitem &%-MCP%&
3878 .oindex "&%-MCP%&"
3879 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3880 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the server to
3881 which Exim is connected supports pipelining.
3882
3883 .vitem &%-MCQ%&&~<&'process&~id'&>&~<&'pipe&~fd'&>
3884 .oindex "&%-MCQ%&"
3885 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3886 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option when the original delivery was
3887 started by a queue runner. It passes on the process id of the queue runner,
3888 together with the file descriptor number of an open pipe. Closure of the pipe
3889 signals the final completion of the sequence of processes that are passing
3890 messages through the same SMTP connection.
3891
3892 .vitem &%-MCS%&
3893 .oindex "&%-MCS%&"
3894 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3895 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3896 SMTP SIZE option should be used on messages delivered down the existing
3897 connection.
3898
3899 .vitem &%-MCT%&
3900 .oindex "&%-MCT%&"
3901 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3902 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3903 host to which Exim is connected supports TLS encryption.
3904
3905 .vitem &%-MCt%&&~<&'IP&~address'&>&~<&'port'&>&~<&'cipher'&>
3906 .oindex "&%-MCt%&"
3907 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3908 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3909 connection is being proxied by a parent process for handling TLS encryption.
3910 The arguments give the local address and port being proxied, and the TLS cipher.
3911
3912 .vitem &%-Mc%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3913 .oindex "&%-Mc%&"
3914 .cindex "hints database" "not overridden by &%-Mc%&"
3915 .cindex "delivery" "manually started &-- not forced"
3916 This option requests Exim to run a delivery attempt on each message, in turn,
3917 but unlike the &%-M%& option, it does check for retry hints, and respects any
3918 that are found. This option is not very useful to external callers. It is
3919 provided mainly for internal use by Exim when it needs to re-invoke itself in
3920 order to regain root privilege for a delivery (see chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>&).
3921 However, &%-Mc%& can be useful when testing, in order to run a delivery that
3922 respects retry times and other options such as &%hold_domains%& that are
3923 overridden when &%-M%& is used. Such a delivery does not count as a queue run.
3924 If you want to run a specific delivery as if in a queue run, you should use
3925 &%-q%& with a message id argument. A distinction between queue run deliveries
3926 and other deliveries is made in one or two places.
3927
3928 .vitem &%-Mes%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>
3929 .oindex "&%-Mes%&"
3930 .cindex "message" "changing sender"
3931 .cindex "sender" "changing"
3932 This option requests Exim to change the sender address in the message to the
3933 given address, which must be a fully qualified address or &"<>"& (&"es"& for
3934 &"edit sender"&). There must be exactly two arguments. The first argument must
3935 be a message id, and the second one an email address. However, if the message
3936 is active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not altered.
3937 This option can be used only by an admin user.
3938
3939 .vitem &%-Mf%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3940 .oindex "&%-Mf%&"
3941 .cindex "freezing messages"
3942 .cindex "message" "manually freezing"
3943 This option requests Exim to mark each listed message as &"frozen"&. This
3944 prevents any delivery attempts taking place until the message is &"thawed"&,
3945 either manually or as a result of the &%auto_thaw%& configuration option.
3946 However, if any of the messages are active (in the middle of a delivery
3947 attempt), their status is not altered. This option can be used only by an admin
3948 user.
3949
3950 .vitem &%-Mg%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3951 .oindex "&%-Mg%&"
3952 .cindex "giving up on messages"
3953 .cindex "message" "abandoning delivery attempts"
3954 .cindex "delivery" "abandoning further attempts"
3955 This option requests Exim to give up trying to deliver the listed messages,
3956 including any that are frozen. However, if any of the messages are active,
3957 their status is not altered. For non-bounce messages, a delivery error message
3958 is sent to the sender, containing the text &"cancelled by administrator"&.
3959 Bounce messages are just discarded. This option can be used only by an admin
3960 user.
3961
3962 .vitem &%-Mmad%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3963 .oindex "&%-Mmad%&"
3964 .cindex "delivery" "cancelling all"
3965 This option requests Exim to mark all the recipient addresses in the messages
3966 as already delivered (&"mad"& for &"mark all delivered"&). However, if any
3967 message is active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not
3968 altered. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3969
3970 .vitem &%-Mmd%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>&~<&'address'&>&~...
3971 .oindex "&%-Mmd%&"
3972 .cindex "delivery" "cancelling by address"
3973 .cindex "recipient" "removing"
3974 .cindex "removing recipients"
3975 This option requests Exim to mark the given addresses as already delivered
3976 (&"md"& for &"mark delivered"&). The first argument must be a message id, and
3977 the remaining ones must be email addresses. These are matched to recipient
3978 addresses in the message in a case-sensitive manner. If the message is active
3979 (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not altered. This option
3980 can be used only by an admin user.
3981
3982 .vitem &%-Mrm%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3983 .oindex "&%-Mrm%&"
3984 .cindex "removing messages"
3985 .cindex "abandoning mail"
3986 .cindex "message" "manually discarding"
3987 This option requests Exim to remove the given messages from the queue. No
3988 bounce messages are sent; each message is simply forgotten. However, if any of
3989 the messages are active, their status is not altered. This option can be used
3990 only by an admin user or by the user who originally caused the message to be
3991 placed in the queue.
3992
3993 . .new
3994 . .vitem &%-MS%&
3995 . .oindex "&%-MS%&"
3996 . .cindex REQUIRETLS
3997 . This option is used to request REQUIRETLS processing on the message.
3998 . It is used internally by Exim in conjunction with -E when generating
3999 . a bounce message.
4000 . .wen
4001
4002 .vitem &%-Mset%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
4003 .oindex "&%-Mset%&"
4004 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
4005 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
4006 This option is useful only in conjunction with &%-be%& (that is, when testing
4007 string expansions). Exim loads the given message from its spool before doing
4008 the test expansions, thus setting message-specific variables such as
4009 &$message_size$& and the header variables. The &$recipients$& variable is made
4010 available. This feature is provided to make it easier to test expansions that
4011 make use of these variables. However, this option can be used only by an admin
4012 user. See also &%-bem%&.
4013
4014 .vitem &%-Mt%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
4015 .oindex "&%-Mt%&"
4016 .cindex "thawing messages"
4017 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
4018 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
4019 .cindex "message" "thawing frozen"
4020 This option requests Exim to &"thaw"& any of the listed messages that are
4021 &"frozen"&, so that delivery attempts can resume. However, if any of the
4022 messages are active, their status is not altered. This option can be used only
4023 by an admin user.
4024
4025 .vitem &%-Mvb%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
4026 .oindex "&%-Mvb%&"
4027 .cindex "listing" "message body"
4028 .cindex "message" "listing body of"
4029 This option causes the contents of the message body (-D) spool file to be
4030 written to the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
4031
4032 .vitem &%-Mvc%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
4033 .oindex "&%-Mvc%&"
4034 .cindex "message" "listing in RFC 2822 format"
4035 .cindex "listing" "message in RFC 2822 format"
4036 This option causes a copy of the complete message (header lines plus body) to
4037 be written to the standard output in RFC 2822 format. This option can be used
4038 only by an admin user.
4039
4040 .vitem &%-Mvh%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
4041 .oindex "&%-Mvh%&"
4042 .cindex "listing" "message headers"
4043 .cindex "header lines" "listing"
4044 .cindex "message" "listing header lines"
4045 This option causes the contents of the message headers (-H) spool file to be
4046 written to the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
4047
4048 .vitem &%-Mvl%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
4049 .oindex "&%-Mvl%&"
4050 .cindex "listing" "message log"
4051 .cindex "message" "listing message log"
4052 This option causes the contents of the message log spool file to be written to
4053 the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
4054
4055 .vitem &%-m%&
4056 .oindex "&%-m%&"
4057 This is apparently a synonym for &%-om%& that is accepted by Sendmail, so Exim
4058 treats it that way too.
4059
4060 .vitem &%-N%&
4061 .oindex "&%-N%&"
4062 .cindex "debugging" "&%-N%& option"
4063 .cindex "debugging" "suppressing delivery"
4064 This is a debugging option that inhibits delivery of a message at the transport
4065 level. It implies &%-v%&. Exim goes through many of the motions of delivery &--
4066 it just doesn't actually transport the message, but instead behaves as if it
4067 had successfully done so. However, it does not make any updates to the retry
4068 database, and the log entries for deliveries are flagged with &"*>"& rather
4069 than &"=>"&.
4070
4071 Because &%-N%& discards any message to which it applies, only root or the Exim
4072 user are allowed to use it with &%-bd%&, &%-q%&, &%-R%& or &%-M%&. In other
4073 words, an ordinary user can use it only when supplying an incoming message to
4074 which it will apply. Although transportation never fails when &%-N%& is set, an
4075 address may be deferred because of a configuration problem on a transport, or a
4076 routing problem. Once &%-N%& has been used for a delivery attempt, it sticks to
4077 the message, and applies to any subsequent delivery attempts that may happen
4078 for that message.
4079
4080 .vitem &%-n%&
4081 .oindex "&%-n%&"
4082 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to mean &"no aliasing"&.
4083 For normal modes of operation, it is ignored by Exim.
4084 When combined with &%-bP%& it makes the output more terse (suppresses
4085 option names, environment values and config pretty printing).
4086
4087 .vitem &%-O%&&~<&'data'&>
4088 .oindex "&%-O%&"
4089 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to mean &`set option`&. It is ignored by
4090 Exim.
4091
4092 .vitem &%-oA%&&~<&'file&~name'&>
4093 .oindex "&%-oA%&"
4094 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-oA%& option"
4095 This option is used by Sendmail in conjunction with &%-bi%& to specify an
4096 alternative alias filename. Exim handles &%-bi%& differently; see the
4097 description above.
4098
4099 .vitem &%-oB%&&~<&'n'&>
4100 .oindex "&%-oB%&"
4101 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4102 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4103 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4104 This is a debugging option which limits the maximum number of messages that can
4105 be delivered down one SMTP connection, overriding the value set in any &(smtp)&
4106 transport. If <&'n'&> is omitted, the limit is set to 1.
4107
4108 .vitem &%-odb%&
4109 .oindex "&%-odb%&"
4110 .cindex "background delivery"
4111 .cindex "delivery" "in the background"
4112 This option applies to all modes in which Exim accepts incoming messages,
4113 including the listening daemon. It requests &"background"& delivery of such
4114 messages, which means that the accepting process automatically starts a
4115 delivery process for each message received, but does not wait for the delivery
4116 processes to finish.
4117
4118 When all the messages have been received, the reception process exits,
4119 leaving the delivery processes to finish in their own time. The standard output
4120 and error streams are closed at the start of each delivery process.
4121 This is the default action if none of the &%-od%& options are present.
4122
4123 If one of the queueing options in the configuration file
4124 (&%queue_only%& or &%queue_only_file%&, for example) is in effect, &%-odb%&
4125 overrides it if &%queue_only_override%& is set true, which is the default
4126 setting. If &%queue_only_override%& is set false, &%-odb%& has no effect.
4127
4128 .vitem &%-odf%&
4129 .oindex "&%-odf%&"
4130 .cindex "foreground delivery"
4131 .cindex "delivery" "in the foreground"
4132 This option requests &"foreground"& (synchronous) delivery when Exim has
4133 accepted a locally-generated message. (For the daemon it is exactly the same as
4134 &%-odb%&.) A delivery process is automatically started to deliver the message,
4135 and Exim waits for it to complete before proceeding.
4136
4137 The original Exim reception process does not finish until the delivery
4138 process for the final message has ended. The standard error stream is left open
4139 during deliveries.
4140
4141 However, like &%-odb%&, this option has no effect if &%queue_only_override%& is
4142 false and one of the queueing options in the configuration file is in effect.
4143
4144 If there is a temporary delivery error during foreground delivery, the
4145 message is left in the queue for later delivery, and the original reception
4146 process exits. See chapter &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>& for a way of setting up a
4147 restricted configuration that never queues messages.
4148
4149
4150 .vitem &%-odi%&
4151 .oindex "&%-odi%&"
4152 This option is synonymous with &%-odf%&. It is provided for compatibility with
4153 Sendmail.
4154
4155 .vitem &%-odq%&
4156 .oindex "&%-odq%&"
4157 .cindex "non-immediate delivery"
4158 .cindex "delivery" "suppressing immediate"
4159 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
4160 This option applies to all modes in which Exim accepts incoming messages,
4161 including the listening daemon. It specifies that the accepting process should
4162 not automatically start a delivery process for each message received. Messages
4163 are placed in the queue, and remain there until a subsequent queue runner
4164 process encounters them. There are several configuration options (such as
4165 &%queue_only%&) that can be used to queue incoming messages under certain
4166 conditions. This option overrides all of them and also &%-odqs%&. It always
4167 forces queueing.
4168
4169 .vitem &%-odqs%&
4170 .oindex "&%-odqs%&"
4171 .cindex "SMTP" "delaying delivery"
4172 This option is a hybrid between &%-odb%&/&%-odi%& and &%-odq%&.
4173 However, like &%-odb%& and &%-odi%&, this option has no effect if
4174 &%queue_only_override%& is false and one of the queueing options in the
4175 configuration file is in effect.
4176
4177 When &%-odqs%& does operate, a delivery process is started for each incoming
4178 message, in the background by default, but in the foreground if &%-odi%& is
4179 also present. The recipient addresses are routed, and local deliveries are done
4180 in the normal way. However, if any SMTP deliveries are required, they are not
4181 done at this time, so the message remains in the queue until a subsequent queue
4182 runner process encounters it. Because routing was done, Exim knows which
4183 messages are waiting for which hosts, and so a number of messages for the same
4184 host can be sent in a single SMTP connection. The &%queue_smtp_domains%&
4185 configuration option has the same effect for specific domains. See also the
4186 &%-qq%& option.
4187
4188 .vitem &%-oee%&
4189 .oindex "&%-oee%&"
4190 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4191 If an error is detected while a non-SMTP message is being received (for
4192 example, a malformed address), the error is reported to the sender in a mail
4193 message.
4194
4195 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oee%&"
4196 Provided
4197 this error message is successfully sent, the Exim receiving process
4198 exits with a return code of zero. If not, the return code is 2 if the problem
4199 is that the original message has no recipients, or 1 for any other error.
4200 This is the default &%-oe%&&'x'& option if Exim is called as &'rmail'&.
4201
4202 .vitem &%-oem%&
4203 .oindex "&%-oem%&"
4204 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4205 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oem%&"
4206 This is the same as &%-oee%&, except that Exim always exits with a non-zero
4207 return code, whether or not the error message was successfully sent.
4208 This is the default &%-oe%&&'x'& option, unless Exim is called as &'rmail'&.
4209
4210 .vitem &%-oep%&
4211 .oindex "&%-oep%&"
4212 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4213 If an error is detected while a non-SMTP message is being received, the
4214 error is reported by writing a message to the standard error file (stderr).
4215 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oep%&"
4216 The return code is 1 for all errors.
4217
4218 .vitem &%-oeq%&
4219 .oindex "&%-oeq%&"
4220 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4221 This option is supported for compatibility with Sendmail, but has the same
4222 effect as &%-oep%&.
4223
4224 .vitem &%-oew%&
4225 .oindex "&%-oew%&"
4226 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4227 This option is supported for compatibility with Sendmail, but has the same
4228 effect as &%-oem%&.
4229
4230 .vitem &%-oi%&
4231 .oindex "&%-oi%&"
4232 .cindex "dot" "in incoming non-SMTP message"
4233 This option, which has the same effect as &%-i%&, specifies that a dot on a
4234 line by itself should not terminate an incoming, non-SMTP message. Otherwise, a
4235 single dot does terminate, though Exim does no special processing for other
4236 lines that start with a dot. This option is set by default if Exim is called as
4237 &'rmail'&. See also &%-ti%&.
4238
4239 .vitem &%-oitrue%&
4240 .oindex "&%-oitrue%&"
4241 This option is treated as synonymous with &%-oi%&.
4242
4243 .vitem &%-oMa%&&~<&'host&~address'&>
4244 .oindex "&%-oMa%&"
4245 .cindex "sender" "host address, specifying for local message"
4246 A number of options starting with &%-oM%& can be used to set values associated
4247 with remote hosts on locally-submitted messages (that is, messages not received
4248 over TCP/IP). These options can be used by any caller in conjunction with the
4249 &%-bh%&, &%-be%&, &%-bf%&, &%-bF%&, &%-bt%&, or &%-bv%& testing options. In
4250 other circumstances, they are ignored unless the caller is trusted.
4251
4252 The &%-oMa%& option sets the sender host address. This may include a port
4253 number at the end, after a full stop (period). For example:
4254 .code
4255 exim -bs -oMa 10.9.8.7.1234
4256 .endd
4257 An alternative syntax is to enclose the IP address in square brackets,
4258 followed by a colon and the port number:
4259 .code
4260 exim -bs -oMa [10.9.8.7]:1234
4261 .endd
4262 The IP address is placed in the &$sender_host_address$& variable, and the
4263 port, if present, in &$sender_host_port$&. If both &%-oMa%& and &%-bh%&
4264 are present on the command line, the sender host IP address is taken from
4265 whichever one is last.
4266
4267 .vitem &%-oMaa%&&~<&'name'&>
4268 .oindex "&%-oMaa%&"
4269 .cindex "authentication" "name, specifying for local message"
4270 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMaa%&
4271 option sets the value of &$sender_host_authenticated$& (the authenticator
4272 name). See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of SMTP authentication.
4273 This option can be used with &%-bh%& and &%-bs%& to set up an
4274 authenticated SMTP session without actually using the SMTP AUTH command.
4275
4276 .vitem &%-oMai%&&~<&'string'&>
4277 .oindex "&%-oMai%&"
4278 .cindex "authentication" "id, specifying for local message"
4279 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMai%&
4280 option sets the value of &$authenticated_id$& (the id that was authenticated).
4281 This overrides the default value (the caller's login id, except with &%-bh%&,
4282 where there is no default) for messages from local sources. See chapter
4283 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of authenticated ids.
4284
4285 .vitem &%-oMas%&&~<&'address'&>
4286 .oindex "&%-oMas%&"
4287 .cindex "authentication" "sender, specifying for local message"
4288 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMas%&
4289 option sets the authenticated sender value in &$authenticated_sender$&. It
4290 overrides the sender address that is created from the caller's login id for
4291 messages from local sources, except when &%-bh%& is used, when there is no
4292 default. For both &%-bh%& and &%-bs%&, an authenticated sender that is
4293 specified on a MAIL command overrides this value. See chapter
4294 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of authenticated senders.
4295
4296 .vitem &%-oMi%&&~<&'interface&~address'&>
4297 .oindex "&%-oMi%&"
4298 .cindex "interface" "address, specifying for local message"
4299 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMi%&
4300 option sets the IP interface address value. A port number may be included,
4301 using the same syntax as for &%-oMa%&. The interface address is placed in
4302 &$received_ip_address$& and the port number, if present, in &$received_port$&.
4303
4304 .vitem &%-oMm%&&~<&'message&~reference'&>
4305 .oindex "&%-oMm%&"
4306 .cindex "message reference" "message reference, specifying for local message"
4307 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMm%&
4308 option sets the message reference, e.g. message-id, and is logged during
4309 delivery. This is useful when some kind of audit trail is required to tie
4310 messages together. The format of the message reference is checked and will
4311 abort if the format is invalid. The option will only be accepted if exim is
4312 running in trusted mode, not as any regular user.
4313
4314 The best example of a message reference is when Exim sends a bounce message.
4315 The message reference is the message-id of the original message for which Exim
4316 is sending the bounce.
4317
4318 .vitem &%-oMr%&&~<&'protocol&~name'&>
4319 .oindex "&%-oMr%&"
4320 .cindex "protocol, specifying for local message"
4321 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
4322 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMr%&
4323 option sets the received protocol value that is stored in
4324 &$received_protocol$&. However, it does not apply (and is ignored) when &%-bh%&
4325 or &%-bs%& is used. For &%-bh%&, the protocol is forced to one of the standard
4326 SMTP protocol names (see the description of &$received_protocol$& in section
4327 &<<SECTexpvar>>&). For &%-bs%&, the protocol is always &"local-"& followed by
4328 one of those same names. For &%-bS%& (batched SMTP) however, the protocol can
4329 be set by &%-oMr%&. Repeated use of this option is not supported.
4330
4331 .vitem &%-oMs%&&~<&'host&~name'&>
4332 .oindex "&%-oMs%&"
4333 .cindex "sender" "host name, specifying for local message"
4334 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMs%&
4335 option sets the sender host name in &$sender_host_name$&. When this option is
4336 present, Exim does not attempt to look up a host name from an IP address; it
4337 uses the name it is given.
4338
4339 .vitem &%-oMt%&&~<&'ident&~string'&>
4340 .oindex "&%-oMt%&"
4341 .cindex "sender" "ident string, specifying for local message"
4342 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMt%&
4343 option sets the sender ident value in &$sender_ident$&. The default setting for
4344 local callers is the login id of the calling process, except when &%-bh%& is
4345 used, when there is no default.
4346
4347 .vitem &%-om%&
4348 .oindex "&%-om%&"
4349 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-om%& option ignored"
4350 In Sendmail, this option means &"me too"&, indicating that the sender of a
4351 message should receive a copy of the message if the sender appears in an alias
4352 expansion. Exim always does this, so the option does nothing.
4353
4354 .vitem &%-oo%&
4355 .oindex "&%-oo%&"
4356 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-oo%& option ignored"
4357 This option is ignored. In Sendmail it specifies &"old style headers"&,
4358 whatever that means.
4359
4360 .vitem &%-oP%&&~<&'path'&>
4361 .oindex "&%-oP%&"
4362 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
4363 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
4364 This option is useful only in conjunction with &%-bd%& or &%-q%& with a time
4365 value. The option specifies the file to which the process id of the daemon is
4366 written. When &%-oX%& is used with &%-bd%&, or when &%-q%& with a time is used
4367 without &%-bd%&, this is the only way of causing Exim to write a pid file,
4368 because in those cases, the normal pid file is not used.
4369
4370 .vitem &%-or%&&~<&'time'&>
4371 .oindex "&%-or%&"
4372 .cindex "timeout" "for non-SMTP input"
4373 This option sets a timeout value for incoming non-SMTP messages. If it is not
4374 set, Exim will wait forever for the standard input. The value can also be set
4375 by the &%receive_timeout%& option. The format used for specifying times is
4376 described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&.
4377
4378 .vitem &%-os%&&~<&'time'&>
4379 .oindex "&%-os%&"
4380 .cindex "timeout" "for SMTP input"
4381 .cindex "SMTP" "input timeout"
4382 This option sets a timeout value for incoming SMTP messages. The timeout
4383 applies to each SMTP command and block of data. The value can also be set by
4384 the &%smtp_receive_timeout%& option; it defaults to 5 minutes. The format used
4385 for specifying times is described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&.
4386
4387 .vitem &%-ov%&
4388 .oindex "&%-ov%&"
4389 This option has exactly the same effect as &%-v%&.
4390
4391 .vitem &%-oX%&&~<&'number&~or&~string'&>
4392 .oindex "&%-oX%&"
4393 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
4394 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening interfaces"
4395 .cindex "port" "receiving TCP/IP"
4396 This option is relevant only when the &%-bd%& (start listening daemon) option
4397 is also given. It controls which ports and interfaces the daemon uses. Details
4398 of the syntax, and how it interacts with configuration file options, are given
4399 in chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>&. When &%-oX%& is used to start a daemon, no pid
4400 file is written unless &%-oP%& is also present to specify a pid filename.
4401
4402 .vitem &%-pd%&
4403 .oindex "&%-pd%&"
4404 .cindex "Perl" "starting the interpreter"
4405 This option applies when an embedded Perl interpreter is linked with Exim (see
4406 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&). It overrides the setting of the &%perl_at_start%&
4407 option, forcing the starting of the interpreter to be delayed until it is
4408 needed.
4409
4410 .vitem &%-ps%&
4411 .oindex "&%-ps%&"
4412 .cindex "Perl" "starting the interpreter"
4413 This option applies when an embedded Perl interpreter is linked with Exim (see
4414 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&). It overrides the setting of the &%perl_at_start%&
4415 option, forcing the starting of the interpreter to occur as soon as Exim is
4416 started.
4417
4418 .vitem &%-p%&<&'rval'&>:<&'sval'&>
4419 .oindex "&%-p%&"
4420 For compatibility with Sendmail, this option is equivalent to
4421 .display
4422 &`-oMr`& <&'rval'&> &`-oMs`& <&'sval'&>
4423 .endd
4424 It sets the incoming protocol and host name (for trusted callers). The
4425 host name and its colon can be omitted when only the protocol is to be set.
4426 Note the Exim already has two private options, &%-pd%& and &%-ps%&, that refer
4427 to embedded Perl. It is therefore impossible to set a protocol value of &`d`&
4428 or &`s`& using this option (but that does not seem a real limitation).
4429 Repeated use of this option is not supported.
4430
4431 .vitem &%-q%&
4432 .oindex "&%-q%&"
4433 .cindex "queue runner" "starting manually"
4434 This option is normally restricted to admin users. However, there is a
4435 configuration option called &%prod_requires_admin%& which can be set false to
4436 relax this restriction (and also the same requirement for the &%-M%&, &%-R%&,
4437 and &%-S%& options).
4438
4439 .cindex "queue runner" "description of operation"
4440 If other commandline options do not specify an action,
4441 the &%-q%& option starts one queue runner process. This scans the queue of
4442 waiting messages, and runs a delivery process for each one in turn. It waits
4443 for each delivery process to finish before starting the next one. A delivery
4444 process may not actually do any deliveries if the retry times for the addresses
4445 have not been reached. Use &%-qf%& (see below) if you want to override this.
4446
4447 If
4448 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4449 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4450 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4451 the delivery process spawns other processes to deliver other messages down
4452 passed SMTP connections, the queue runner waits for these to finish before
4453 proceeding.
4454
4455 When all the queued messages have been considered, the original queue runner
4456 process terminates. In other words, a single pass is made over the waiting
4457 mail, one message at a time. Use &%-q%& with a time (see below) if you want
4458 this to be repeated periodically.
4459
4460 Exim processes the waiting messages in an unpredictable order. It isn't very
4461 random, but it is likely to be different each time, which is all that matters.
4462 If one particular message screws up a remote MTA, other messages to the same
4463 MTA have a chance of getting through if they get tried first.
4464
4465 It is possible to cause the messages to be processed in lexical message id
4466 order, which is essentially the order in which they arrived, by setting the
4467 &%queue_run_in_order%& option, but this is not recommended for normal use.
4468
4469 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&>
4470 The &%-q%& option may be followed by one or more flag letters that change its
4471 behaviour. They are all optional, but if more than one is present, they must
4472 appear in the correct order. Each flag is described in a separate item below.
4473
4474 .vitem &%-qq...%&
4475 .oindex "&%-qq%&"
4476 .cindex "queue" "double scanning"
4477 .cindex "queue" "routing"
4478 .cindex "routing" "whole queue before delivery"
4479 An option starting with &%-qq%& requests a two-stage queue run. In the first
4480 stage, the queue is scanned as if the &%queue_smtp_domains%& option matched
4481 every domain. Addresses are routed, local deliveries happen, but no remote
4482 transports are run.
4483
4484 .cindex "hints database" "remembering routing"
4485 The hints database that remembers which messages are waiting for specific hosts
4486 is updated, as if delivery to those hosts had been deferred. After this is
4487 complete, a second, normal queue scan happens, with routing and delivery taking
4488 place as normal. Messages that are routed to the same host should mostly be
4489 delivered down a single SMTP
4490 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4491 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4492 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4493 connection because of the hints that were set up during the first queue scan.
4494 This option may be useful for hosts that are connected to the Internet
4495 intermittently.
4496
4497 .vitem &%-q[q]i...%&
4498 .oindex "&%-qi%&"
4499 .cindex "queue" "initial delivery"
4500 If the &'i'& flag is present, the queue runner runs delivery processes only for
4501 those messages that haven't previously been tried. (&'i'& stands for &"initial
4502 delivery"&.) This can be helpful if you are putting messages in the queue using
4503 &%-odq%& and want a queue runner just to process the new messages.
4504
4505 .vitem &%-q[q][i]f...%&
4506 .oindex "&%-qf%&"
4507 .cindex "queue" "forcing delivery"
4508 .cindex "delivery" "forcing in queue run"
4509 If one &'f'& flag is present, a delivery attempt is forced for each non-frozen
4510 message, whereas without &'f'& only those non-frozen addresses that have passed
4511 their retry times are tried.
4512
4513 .vitem &%-q[q][i]ff...%&
4514 .oindex "&%-qff%&"
4515 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
4516 If &'ff'& is present, a delivery attempt is forced for every message, whether
4517 frozen or not.
4518
4519 .vitem &%-q[q][i][f[f]]l%&
4520 .oindex "&%-ql%&"
4521 .cindex "queue" "local deliveries only"
4522 The &'l'& (the letter &"ell"&) flag specifies that only local deliveries are to
4523 be done. If a message requires any remote deliveries, it remains in the queue
4524 for later delivery.
4525
4526 .vitem &%-q[q][i][f[f]][l][G<name>[/<time>]]]%&
4527 .oindex "&%-qG%&"
4528 .cindex queue named
4529 .cindex "named queues"
4530 .cindex "queue" "delivering specific messages"
4531 If the &'G'& flag and a name is present, the queue runner operates on the
4532 queue with the given name rather than the default queue.
4533 The name should not contain a &'/'& character.
4534 For a periodic queue run (see below)
4535 append to the name a slash and a time value.
4536
4537 If other commandline options specify an action, a &'-qG<name>'& option
4538 will specify a queue to operate on.
4539 For example:
4540 .code
4541 exim -bp -qGquarantine
4542 mailq -qGquarantine
4543 exim -qGoffpeak -Rf @special.domain.example
4544 .endd
4545
4546 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&>&~<&'start&~id'&>&~<&'end&~id'&>
4547 When scanning the queue, Exim can be made to skip over messages whose ids are
4548 lexically less than a given value by following the &%-q%& option with a
4549 starting message id. For example:
4550 .code
4551 exim -q 0t5C6f-0000c8-00
4552 .endd
4553 Messages that arrived earlier than &`0t5C6f-0000c8-00`& are not inspected. If a
4554 second message id is given, messages whose ids are lexically greater than it
4555 are also skipped. If the same id is given twice, for example,
4556 .code
4557 exim -q 0t5C6f-0000c8-00 0t5C6f-0000c8-00
4558 .endd
4559 just one delivery process is started, for that message. This differs from
4560 &%-M%& in that retry data is respected, and it also differs from &%-Mc%& in
4561 that it counts as a delivery from a queue run. Note that the selection
4562 mechanism does not affect the order in which the messages are scanned. There
4563 are also other ways of selecting specific sets of messages for delivery in a
4564 queue run &-- see &%-R%& and &%-S%&.
4565
4566 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&><&'time'&>
4567 .cindex "queue runner" "starting periodically"
4568 .cindex "periodic queue running"
4569 When a time value is present, the &%-q%& option causes Exim to run as a daemon,
4570 starting a queue runner process at intervals specified by the given time value
4571 (whose format is described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&). This form of the
4572 &%-q%& option is commonly combined with the &%-bd%& option, in which case a
4573 single daemon process handles both functions. A common way of starting up a
4574 combined daemon at system boot time is to use a command such as
4575 .code
4576 /usr/exim/bin/exim -bd -q30m
4577 .endd
4578 Such a daemon listens for incoming SMTP calls, and also starts a queue runner
4579 process every 30 minutes.
4580
4581 When a daemon is started by &%-q%& with a time value, but without &%-bd%&, no
4582 pid file is written unless one is explicitly requested by the &%-oP%& option.
4583
4584 .vitem &%-qR%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4585 .oindex "&%-qR%&"
4586 This option is synonymous with &%-R%&. It is provided for Sendmail
4587 compatibility.
4588
4589 .vitem &%-qS%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4590 .oindex "&%-qS%&"
4591 This option is synonymous with &%-S%&.
4592
4593 .vitem &%-R%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4594 .oindex "&%-R%&"
4595 .cindex "queue runner" "for specific recipients"
4596 .cindex "delivery" "to given domain"
4597 .cindex "domain" "delivery to"
4598 The <&'rsflags'&> may be empty, in which case the white space before the string
4599 is optional, unless the string is &'f'&, &'ff'&, &'r'&, &'rf'&, or &'rff'&,
4600 which are the possible values for <&'rsflags'&>. White space is required if
4601 <&'rsflags'&> is not empty.
4602
4603 This option is similar to &%-q%& with no time value, that is, it causes Exim to
4604 perform a single queue run, except that, when scanning the messages on the
4605 queue, Exim processes only those that have at least one undelivered recipient
4606 address containing the given string, which is checked in a case-independent
4607 way. If the <&'rsflags'&> start with &'r'&, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a
4608 regular expression; otherwise it is a literal string.
4609
4610 If you want to do periodic queue runs for messages with specific recipients,
4611 you can combine &%-R%& with &%-q%& and a time value. For example:
4612 .code
4613 exim -q25m -R @special.domain.example
4614 .endd
4615 This example does a queue run for messages with recipients in the given domain
4616 every 25 minutes. Any additional flags that are specified with &%-q%& are
4617 applied to each queue run.
4618
4619 Once a message is selected for delivery by this mechanism, all its addresses
4620 are processed. For the first selected message, Exim overrides any retry
4621 information and forces a delivery attempt for each undelivered address. This
4622 means that if delivery of any address in the first message is successful, any
4623 existing retry information is deleted, and so delivery attempts for that
4624 address in subsequently selected messages (which are processed without forcing)
4625 will run. However, if delivery of any address does not succeed, the retry
4626 information is updated, and in subsequently selected messages, the failing
4627 address will be skipped.
4628
4629 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
4630 If the <&'rsflags'&> contain &'f'& or &'ff'&, the delivery forcing applies to
4631 all selected messages, not just the first; frozen messages are included when
4632 &'ff'& is present.
4633
4634 The &%-R%& option makes it straightforward to initiate delivery of all messages
4635 to a given domain after a host has been down for some time. When the SMTP
4636 command ETRN is accepted by its ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), its default
4637 effect is to run Exim with the &%-R%& option, but it can be configured to run
4638 an arbitrary command instead.
4639
4640 .vitem &%-r%&
4641 .oindex "&%-r%&"
4642 This is a documented (for Sendmail) obsolete alternative name for &%-f%&.
4643
4644 .vitem &%-S%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4645 .oindex "&%-S%&"
4646 .cindex "delivery" "from given sender"
4647 .cindex "queue runner" "for specific senders"
4648 This option acts like &%-R%& except that it checks the string against each
4649 message's sender instead of against the recipients. If &%-R%& is also set, both
4650 conditions must be met for a message to be selected. If either of the options
4651 has &'f'& or &'ff'& in its flags, the associated action is taken.
4652
4653 .vitem &%-Tqt%&&~<&'times'&>
4654 .oindex "&%-Tqt%&"
4655 This is an option that is exclusively for use by the Exim testing suite. It is not
4656 recognized when Exim is run normally. It allows for the setting up of explicit
4657 &"queue times"& so that various warning/retry features can be tested.
4658
4659 .vitem &%-t%&
4660 .oindex "&%-t%&"
4661 .cindex "recipient" "extracting from header lines"
4662 .cindex "&'Bcc:'& header line"
4663 .cindex "&'Cc:'& header line"
4664 .cindex "&'To:'& header line"
4665 When Exim is receiving a locally-generated, non-SMTP message on its standard
4666 input, the &%-t%& option causes the recipients of the message to be obtained
4667 from the &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and &'Bcc:'& header lines in the message instead of
4668 from the command arguments. The addresses are extracted before any rewriting
4669 takes place and the &'Bcc:'& header line, if present, is then removed.
4670
4671 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-t%& option"
4672 If the command has any arguments, they specify addresses to which the message
4673 is &'not'& to be delivered. That is, the argument addresses are removed from
4674 the recipients list obtained from the headers. This is compatible with Smail 3
4675 and in accordance with the documented behaviour of several versions of
4676 Sendmail, as described in man pages on a number of operating systems (e.g.
4677 Solaris 8, IRIX 6.5, HP-UX 11). However, some versions of Sendmail &'add'&
4678 argument addresses to those obtained from the headers, and the O'Reilly
4679 Sendmail book documents it that way. Exim can be made to add argument addresses
4680 instead of subtracting them by setting the option
4681 &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& false.
4682
4683 .cindex "&%Resent-%& header lines" "with &%-t%&"
4684 If there are any &%Resent-%& header lines in the message, Exim extracts
4685 recipients from all &'Resent-To:'&, &'Resent-Cc:'&, and &'Resent-Bcc:'& header
4686 lines instead of from &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and &'Bcc:'&. This is for compatibility
4687 with Sendmail and other MTAs. (Prior to release 4.20, Exim gave an error if
4688 &%-t%& was used in conjunction with &%Resent-%& header lines.)
4689
4690 RFC 2822 talks about different sets of &%Resent-%& header lines (for when a
4691 message is resent several times). The RFC also specifies that they should be
4692 added at the front of the message, and separated by &'Received:'& lines. It is
4693 not at all clear how &%-t%& should operate in the present of multiple sets,
4694 nor indeed exactly what constitutes a &"set"&.
4695 In practice, it seems that MUAs do not follow the RFC. The &%Resent-%& lines
4696 are often added at the end of the header, and if a message is resent more than
4697 once, it is common for the original set of &%Resent-%& headers to be renamed as
4698 &%X-Resent-%& when a new set is added. This removes any possible ambiguity.
4699
4700 .vitem &%-ti%&
4701 .oindex "&%-ti%&"
4702 This option is exactly equivalent to &%-t%& &%-i%&. It is provided for
4703 compatibility with Sendmail.
4704
4705 .vitem &%-tls-on-connect%&
4706 .oindex "&%-tls-on-connect%&"
4707 .cindex "TLS" "use without STARTTLS"
4708 .cindex "TLS" "automatic start"
4709 This option is available when Exim is compiled with TLS support. It forces all
4710 incoming SMTP connections to behave as if the incoming port is listed in the
4711 &%tls_on_connect_ports%& option. See section &<<SECTsupobssmt>>& and chapter
4712 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
4713
4714
4715 .vitem &%-U%&
4716 .oindex "&%-U%&"
4717 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-U%& option ignored"
4718 Sendmail uses this option for &"initial message submission"&, and its
4719 documentation states that in future releases, it may complain about
4720 syntactically invalid messages rather than fixing them when this flag is not
4721 set. Exim ignores this option.
4722
4723 .vitem &%-v%&
4724 .oindex "&%-v%&"
4725 This option causes Exim to write information to the standard error stream,
4726 describing what it is doing. In particular, it shows the log lines for
4727 receiving and delivering a message, and if an SMTP connection is made, the SMTP
4728 dialogue is shown. Some of the log lines shown may not actually be written to
4729 the log if the setting of &%log_selector%& discards them. Any relevant
4730 selectors are shown with each log line. If none are shown, the logging is
4731 unconditional.
4732
4733 .vitem &%-x%&
4734 .oindex "&%-x%&"
4735 AIX uses &%-x%& for a private purpose (&"mail from a local mail program has
4736 National Language Support extended characters in the body of the mail item"&).
4737 It sets &%-x%& when calling the MTA from its &%mail%& command. Exim ignores
4738 this option.
4739
4740 .vitem &%-X%&&~<&'logfile'&>
4741 .oindex "&%-X%&"
4742 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to cause debug information to be sent
4743 to the named file. It is ignored by Exim.
4744
4745 .vitem &%-z%&&~<&'log-line'&>
4746 .oindex "&%-z%&"
4747 This option writes its argument to Exim's logfile.
4748 Use is restricted to administrators; the intent is for operational notes.
4749 Quotes should be used to maintain a multi-word item as a single argument,
4750 under most shells.
4751 .endlist
4752
4753 .ecindex IIDclo1
4754 .ecindex IIDclo2
4755
4756
4757 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4758 . Insert a stylized DocBook comment here, to identify the end of the command
4759 . line options. This is for the benefit of the Perl script that automatically
4760 . creates a man page for the options.
4761 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4762
4763 .literal xml
4764 <!-- === End of command line options === -->
4765 .literal off
4766
4767
4768
4769
4770
4771 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4772 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4773
4774
4775 .chapter "The Exim runtime configuration file" "CHAPconf" &&&
4776 "The runtime configuration file"
4777
4778 .cindex "runtime configuration"
4779 .cindex "configuration file" "general description"
4780 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
4781 .cindex "configuration file" "errors in"
4782 .cindex "error" "in configuration file"
4783 .cindex "return code" "for bad configuration"
4784 Exim uses a single runtime configuration file that is read whenever an Exim
4785 binary is executed. Note that in normal operation, this happens frequently,
4786 because Exim is designed to operate in a distributed manner, without central
4787 control.
4788
4789 If a syntax error is detected while reading the configuration file, Exim
4790 writes a message on the standard error, and exits with a non-zero return code.
4791 The message is also written to the panic log. &*Note*&: Only simple syntax
4792 errors can be detected at this time. The values of any expanded options are
4793 not checked until the expansion happens, even when the expansion does not
4794 actually alter the string.
4795
4796 The name of the configuration file is compiled into the binary for security
4797 reasons, and is specified by the CONFIGURE_FILE compilation option. In
4798 most configurations, this specifies a single file. However, it is permitted to
4799 give a colon-separated list of filenames, in which case Exim uses the first
4800 existing file in the list.
4801
4802 .cindex "EXIM_USER"
4803 .cindex "EXIM_GROUP"
4804 .cindex "CONFIGURE_OWNER"
4805 .cindex "CONFIGURE_GROUP"
4806 .cindex "configuration file" "ownership"
4807 .cindex "ownership" "configuration file"
4808 The runtime configuration file must be owned by root or by the user that is
4809 specified at compile time by the CONFIGURE_OWNER option (if set). The
4810 configuration file must not be world-writeable, or group-writeable unless its
4811 group is the root group or the one specified at compile time by the
4812 CONFIGURE_GROUP option.
4813
4814 &*Warning*&: In a conventional configuration, where the Exim binary is setuid
4815 to root, anybody who is able to edit the runtime configuration file has an
4816 easy way to run commands as root. If you specify a user or group in the
4817 CONFIGURE_OWNER or CONFIGURE_GROUP options, then that user and/or any users
4818 who are members of that group will trivially be able to obtain root privileges.
4819
4820 Up to Exim version 4.72, the runtime configuration file was also permitted to
4821 be writeable by the Exim user and/or group. That has been changed in Exim 4.73
4822 since it offered a simple privilege escalation for any attacker who managed to
4823 compromise the Exim user account.
4824
4825 A default configuration file, which will work correctly in simple situations,
4826 is provided in the file &_src/configure.default_&. If CONFIGURE_FILE
4827 defines just one filename, the installation process copies the default
4828 configuration to a new file of that name if it did not previously exist. If
4829 CONFIGURE_FILE is a list, no default is automatically installed. Chapter
4830 &<<CHAPdefconfil>>& is a &"walk-through"& discussion of the default
4831 configuration.
4832
4833
4834
4835 .section "Using a different configuration file" "SECID40"
4836 .cindex "configuration file" "alternate"
4837 A one-off alternate configuration can be specified by the &%-C%& command line
4838 option, which may specify a single file or a list of files. However, when
4839 &%-C%& is used, Exim gives up its root privilege, unless called by root (or
4840 unless the argument for &%-C%& is identical to the built-in value from
4841 CONFIGURE_FILE), or is listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file and the caller
4842 is the Exim user or the user specified in the CONFIGURE_OWNER setting. &%-C%&
4843 is useful mainly for checking the syntax of configuration files before
4844 installing them. No owner or group checks are done on a configuration file
4845 specified by &%-C%&, if root privilege has been dropped.
4846
4847 Even the Exim user is not trusted to specify an arbitrary configuration file
4848 with the &%-C%& option to be used with root privileges, unless that file is
4849 listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file. This locks out the possibility of
4850 testing a configuration using &%-C%& right through message reception and
4851 delivery, even if the caller is root. The reception works, but by that time,
4852 Exim is running as the Exim user, so when it re-execs to regain privilege for
4853 the delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes privilege to be lost. However, root
4854 can test reception and delivery using two separate commands (one to put a
4855 message in the queue, using &%-odq%&, and another to do the delivery, using
4856 &%-M%&).
4857
4858 If ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX is defined &_in Local/Makefile_&, it specifies a
4859 prefix string with which any file named in a &%-C%& command line option must
4860 start. In addition, the filename must not contain the sequence &"&`/../`&"&.
4861 There is no default setting for ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX; when it is unset, any
4862 filename can be used with &%-C%&.
4863
4864 One-off changes to a configuration can be specified by the &%-D%& command line
4865 option, which defines and overrides values for macros used inside the
4866 configuration file. However, like &%-C%&, the use of this option by a
4867 non-privileged user causes Exim to discard its root privilege.
4868 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the use of &%-D%& is
4869 completely disabled, and its use causes an immediate error exit.
4870
4871 The WHITELIST_D_MACROS option in &_Local/Makefile_& permits the binary builder
4872 to declare certain macro names trusted, such that root privilege will not
4873 necessarily be discarded.
4874 WHITELIST_D_MACROS defines a colon-separated list of macros which are
4875 considered safe and, if &%-D%& only supplies macros from this list, and the
4876 values are acceptable, then Exim will not give up root privilege if the caller
4877 is root, the Exim run-time user, or the CONFIGURE_OWNER, if set. This is a
4878 transition mechanism and is expected to be removed in the future. Acceptable
4879 values for the macros satisfy the regexp: &`^[A-Za-z0-9_/.-]*$`&
4880
4881 Some sites may wish to use the same Exim binary on different machines that
4882 share a file system, but to use different configuration files on each machine.
4883 If CONFIGURE_FILE_USE_NODE is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim first
4884 looks for a file whose name is the configuration filename followed by a dot
4885 and the machine's node name, as obtained from the &[uname()]& function. If this
4886 file does not exist, the standard name is tried. This processing occurs for
4887 each filename in the list given by CONFIGURE_FILE or &%-C%&.
4888
4889 In some esoteric situations different versions of Exim may be run under
4890 different effective uids and the CONFIGURE_FILE_USE_EUID is defined to
4891 help with this. See the comments in &_src/EDITME_& for details.
4892
4893
4894
4895 .section "Configuration file format" "SECTconffilfor"
4896 .cindex "configuration file" "format of"
4897 .cindex "format" "configuration file"
4898 Exim's configuration file is divided into a number of different parts. General
4899 option settings must always appear at the start of the file. The other parts
4900 are all optional, and may appear in any order. Each part other than the first
4901 is introduced by the word &"begin"& followed by at least one literal
4902 space, and the name of the part. The optional parts are:
4903
4904 .ilist
4905 &'ACL'&: Access control lists for controlling incoming SMTP mail (see chapter
4906 &<<CHAPACL>>&).
4907 .next
4908 .cindex "AUTH" "configuration"
4909 &'authenticators'&: Configuration settings for the authenticator drivers. These
4910 are concerned with the SMTP AUTH command (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&).
4911 .next
4912 &'routers'&: Configuration settings for the router drivers. Routers process
4913 addresses and determine how the message is to be delivered (see chapters
4914 &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&&--&<<CHAPredirect>>&).
4915 .next
4916 &'transports'&: Configuration settings for the transport drivers. Transports
4917 define mechanisms for copying messages to destinations (see chapters
4918 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&&--&<<CHAPsmtptrans>>&).
4919 .next
4920 &'retry'&: Retry rules, for use when a message cannot be delivered immediately.
4921 If there is no retry section, or if it is empty (that is, no retry rules are
4922 defined), Exim will not retry deliveries. In this situation, temporary errors
4923 are treated the same as permanent errors. Retry rules are discussed in chapter
4924 &<<CHAPretry>>&.
4925 .next
4926 &'rewrite'&: Global address rewriting rules, for use when a message arrives and
4927 when new addresses are generated during delivery. Rewriting is discussed in
4928 chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&.
4929 .next
4930 &'local_scan'&: Private options for the &[local_scan()]& function. If you
4931 want to use this feature, you must set
4932 .code
4933 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
4934 .endd
4935 in &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim. Details of the &[local_scan()]&
4936 facility are given in chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&.
4937 .endlist
4938
4939 .cindex "configuration file" "leading white space in"
4940 .cindex "configuration file" "trailing white space in"
4941 .cindex "white space" "in configuration file"
4942 Leading and trailing white space in configuration lines is always ignored.
4943
4944 Blank lines in the file, and lines starting with a # character (ignoring
4945 leading white space) are treated as comments and are ignored. &*Note*&: A
4946 # character other than at the beginning of a line is not treated specially,
4947 and does not introduce a comment.
4948
4949 Any non-comment line can be continued by ending it with a backslash. Note that
4950 the general rule for white space means that trailing white space after the
4951 backslash and leading white space at the start of continuation
4952 lines is ignored. Comment lines beginning with # (but not empty lines) may
4953 appear in the middle of a sequence of continuation lines.
4954
4955 A convenient way to create a configuration file is to start from the
4956 default, which is supplied in &_src/configure.default_&, and add, delete, or
4957 change settings as required.
4958
4959 The ACLs, retry rules, and rewriting rules have their own syntax which is
4960 described in chapters &<<CHAPACL>>&, &<<CHAPretry>>&, and &<<CHAPrewrite>>&,
4961 respectively. The other parts of the configuration file have some syntactic
4962 items in common, and these are described below, from section &<<SECTcos>>&
4963 onwards. Before that, the inclusion, macro, and conditional facilities are
4964 described.
4965
4966
4967
4968 .section "File inclusions in the configuration file" "SECID41"
4969 .cindex "inclusions in configuration file"
4970 .cindex "configuration file" "including other files"
4971 .cindex "&`.include`& in configuration file"
4972 .cindex "&`.include_if_exists`& in configuration file"
4973 You can include other files inside Exim's runtime configuration file by
4974 using this syntax:
4975 .display
4976 &`.include`& <&'filename'&>
4977 &`.include_if_exists`& <&'filename'&>
4978 .endd
4979 on a line by itself. Double quotes round the filename are optional. If you use
4980 the first form, a configuration error occurs if the file does not exist; the
4981 second form does nothing for non-existent files.
4982 The first form allows a relative name. It is resolved relative to
4983 the directory of the including file. For the second form an absolute filename
4984 is required.
4985
4986 Includes may be nested to any depth, but remember that Exim reads its
4987 configuration file often, so it is a good idea to keep them to a minimum.
4988 If you change the contents of an included file, you must HUP the daemon,
4989 because an included file is read only when the configuration itself is read.
4990
4991 The processing of inclusions happens early, at a physical line level, so, like
4992 comment lines, an inclusion can be used in the middle of an option setting,
4993 for example:
4994 .code
4995 hosts_lookup = a.b.c \
4996 .include /some/file
4997 .endd
4998 Include processing happens after macro processing (see below). Its effect is to
4999 process the lines of the included file as if they occurred inline where the
5000 inclusion appears.
5001
5002
5003
5004 .section "Macros in the configuration file" "SECTmacrodefs"
5005 .cindex "macro" "description of"
5006 .cindex "configuration file" "macros"
5007 If a line in the main part of the configuration (that is, before the first
5008 &"begin"& line) begins with an upper case letter, it is taken as a macro
5009 definition, and must be of the form
5010 .display
5011 <&'name'&> = <&'rest of line'&>
5012 .endd
5013 The name must consist of letters, digits, and underscores, and need not all be
5014 in upper case, though that is recommended. The rest of the line, including any
5015 continuations, is the replacement text, and has leading and trailing white
5016 space removed. Quotes are not removed. The replacement text can never end with
5017 a backslash character, but this doesn't seem to be a serious limitation.
5018
5019 Macros may also be defined between router, transport, authenticator, or ACL
5020 definitions. They may not, however, be defined within an individual driver or
5021 ACL, or in the &%local_scan%&, retry, or rewrite sections of the configuration.
5022
5023 .section "Macro substitution" "SECID42"
5024 Once a macro is defined, all subsequent lines in the file (and any included
5025 files) are scanned for the macro name; if there are several macros, the line is
5026 scanned for each, in turn, in the order in which the macros are defined. The
5027 replacement text is not re-scanned for the current macro, though it is scanned
5028 for subsequently defined macros. For this reason, a macro name may not contain
5029 the name of a previously defined macro as a substring. You could, for example,
5030 define
5031 .display
5032 &`ABCD_XYZ = `&<&'something'&>
5033 &`ABCD = `&<&'something else'&>
5034 .endd
5035 but putting the definitions in the opposite order would provoke a configuration
5036 error. Macro expansion is applied to individual physical lines from the file,
5037 before checking for line continuation or file inclusion (see above). If a line
5038 consists solely of a macro name, and the expansion of the macro is empty, the
5039 line is ignored. A macro at the start of a line may turn the line into a
5040 comment line or a &`.include`& line.
5041
5042
5043 .section "Redefining macros" "SECID43"
5044 Once defined, the value of a macro can be redefined later in the configuration
5045 (or in an included file). Redefinition is specified by using &'=='& instead of
5046 &'='&. For example:
5047 .code
5048 MAC = initial value
5049 ...
5050 MAC == updated value
5051 .endd
5052 Redefinition does not alter the order in which the macros are applied to the
5053 subsequent lines of the configuration file. It is still the same order in which
5054 the macros were originally defined. All that changes is the macro's value.
5055 Redefinition makes it possible to accumulate values. For example:
5056 .code
5057 MAC = initial value
5058 ...
5059 MAC == MAC and something added
5060 .endd
5061 This can be helpful in situations where the configuration file is built
5062 from a number of other files.
5063
5064 .section "Overriding macro values" "SECID44"
5065 The values set for macros in the configuration file can be overridden by the
5066 &%-D%& command line option, but Exim gives up its root privilege when &%-D%& is
5067 used, unless called by root or the Exim user. A definition on the command line
5068 using the &%-D%& option causes all definitions and redefinitions within the
5069 file to be ignored.
5070
5071
5072
5073 .section "Example of macro usage" "SECID45"
5074 As an example of macro usage, consider a configuration where aliases are looked
5075 up in a MySQL database. It helps to keep the file less cluttered if long
5076 strings such as SQL statements are defined separately as macros, for example:
5077 .code
5078 ALIAS_QUERY = select mailbox from user where \
5079 login='${quote_mysql:$local_part}';
5080 .endd
5081 This can then be used in a &(redirect)& router setting like this:
5082 .code
5083 data = ${lookup mysql{ALIAS_QUERY}}
5084 .endd
5085 In earlier versions of Exim macros were sometimes used for domain, host, or
5086 address lists. In Exim 4 these are handled better by named lists &-- see
5087 section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&.
5088
5089
5090 .section "Builtin macros" "SECTbuiltinmacros"
5091 Exim defines some macros depending on facilities available, which may
5092 differ due to build-time definitions and from one release to another.
5093 All of these macros start with an underscore.
5094 They can be used to conditionally include parts of a configuration
5095 (see below).
5096
5097 The following classes of macros are defined:
5098 .display
5099 &` _HAVE_* `& build-time defines
5100 &` _DRIVER_ROUTER_* `& router drivers
5101 &` _DRIVER_TRANSPORT_* `& transport drivers
5102 &` _DRIVER_AUTHENTICATOR_* `& authenticator drivers
5103 &` _LOG_* `& log_selector values
5104 &` _OPT_MAIN_* `& main config options
5105 &` _OPT_ROUTERS_* `& generic router options
5106 &` _OPT_TRANSPORTS_* `& generic transport options
5107 &` _OPT_AUTHENTICATORS_* `& generic authenticator options
5108 &` _OPT_ROUTER_*_* `& private router options
5109 &` _OPT_TRANSPORT_*_* `& private transport options
5110 &` _OPT_AUTHENTICATOR_*_* `& private authenticator options
5111 .endd
5112
5113 Use an &"exim -bP macros"& command to get the list of macros.
5114
5115
5116 .section "Conditional skips in the configuration file" "SECID46"
5117 .cindex "configuration file" "conditional skips"
5118 .cindex "&`.ifdef`&"
5119 You can use the directives &`.ifdef`&, &`.ifndef`&, &`.elifdef`&,
5120 &`.elifndef`&, &`.else`&, and &`.endif`& to dynamically include or exclude
5121 portions of the configuration file. The processing happens whenever the file is
5122 read (that is, when an Exim binary starts to run).
5123
5124 The implementation is very simple. Instances of the first four directives must
5125 be followed by text that includes the names of one or macros. The condition
5126 that is tested is whether or not any macro substitution has taken place in the
5127 line. Thus:
5128 .code
5129 .ifdef AAA
5130 message_size_limit = 50M
5131 .else
5132 message_size_limit = 100M
5133 .endif
5134 .endd
5135 sets a message size limit of 50M if the macro &`AAA`& is defined
5136 (or &`A`& or &`AA`&), and 100M
5137 otherwise. If there is more than one macro named on the line, the condition
5138 is true if any of them are defined. That is, it is an &"or"& condition. To
5139 obtain an &"and"& condition, you need to use nested &`.ifdef`&s.
5140
5141 Although you can use a macro expansion to generate one of these directives,
5142 it is not very useful, because the condition &"there was a macro substitution
5143 in this line"& will always be true.
5144
5145 Text following &`.else`& and &`.endif`& is ignored, and can be used as comment
5146 to clarify complicated nestings.
5147
5148
5149
5150 .section "Common option syntax" "SECTcos"
5151 .cindex "common option syntax"
5152 .cindex "syntax of common options"
5153 .cindex "configuration file" "common option syntax"
5154 For the main set of options, driver options, and &[local_scan()]& options,
5155 each setting is on a line by itself, and starts with a name consisting of
5156 lower-case letters and underscores. Many options require a data value, and in
5157 these cases the name must be followed by an equals sign (with optional white
5158 space) and then the value. For example:
5159 .code
5160 qualify_domain = mydomain.example.com
5161 .endd
5162 .cindex "hiding configuration option values"
5163 .cindex "configuration options" "hiding value of"
5164 .cindex "options" "hiding value of"
5165 Some option settings may contain sensitive data, for example, passwords for
5166 accessing databases. To stop non-admin users from using the &%-bP%& command
5167 line option to read these values, you can precede the option settings with the
5168 word &"hide"&. For example:
5169 .code
5170 hide mysql_servers = localhost/users/admin/secret-password
5171 .endd
5172 For non-admin users, such options are displayed like this:
5173 .code
5174 mysql_servers = <value not displayable>
5175 .endd
5176 If &"hide"& is used on a driver option, it hides the value of that option on
5177 all instances of the same driver.
5178
5179 The following sections describe the syntax used for the different data types
5180 that are found in option settings.
5181
5182
5183 .section "Boolean options" "SECID47"
5184 .cindex "format" "boolean"
5185 .cindex "boolean configuration values"
5186 .oindex "&%no_%&&'xxx'&"
5187 .oindex "&%not_%&&'xxx'&"
5188 Options whose type is given as boolean are on/off switches. There are two
5189 different ways of specifying such options: with and without a data value. If
5190 the option name is specified on its own without data, the switch is turned on;
5191 if it is preceded by &"no_"& or &"not_"& the switch is turned off. However,
5192 boolean options may be followed by an equals sign and one of the words
5193 &"true"&, &"false"&, &"yes"&, or &"no"&, as an alternative syntax. For example,
5194 the following two settings have exactly the same effect:
5195 .code
5196 queue_only
5197 queue_only = true
5198 .endd
5199 The following two lines also have the same (opposite) effect:
5200 .code
5201 no_queue_only
5202 queue_only = false
5203 .endd
5204 You can use whichever syntax you prefer.
5205
5206
5207
5208
5209 .section "Integer values" "SECID48"
5210 .cindex "integer configuration values"
5211 .cindex "format" "integer"
5212 If an option's type is given as &"integer"&, the value can be given in decimal,
5213 hexadecimal, or octal. If it starts with a digit greater than zero, a decimal
5214 number is assumed. Otherwise, it is treated as an octal number unless it starts
5215 with the characters &"0x"&, in which case the remainder is interpreted as a
5216 hexadecimal number.
5217
5218 If an integer value is followed by the letter K, it is multiplied by 1024; if
5219 it is followed by the letter M, it is multiplied by 1024x1024;
5220 if by the letter G, 1024x1024x1024.
5221 When the values
5222 of integer option settings are output, values which are an exact multiple of
5223 1024 or 1024x1024 are sometimes, but not always, printed using the letters K
5224 and M. The printing style is independent of the actual input format that was
5225 used.
5226
5227
5228 .section "Octal integer values" "SECID49"
5229 .cindex "integer format"
5230 .cindex "format" "octal integer"
5231 If an option's type is given as &"octal integer"&, its value is always
5232 interpreted as an octal number, whether or not it starts with the digit zero.
5233 Such options are always output in octal.
5234
5235
5236 .section "Fixed point numbers" "SECID50"
5237 .cindex "fixed point configuration values"
5238 .cindex "format" "fixed point"
5239 If an option's type is given as &"fixed-point"&, its value must be a decimal
5240 integer, optionally followed by a decimal point and up to three further digits.
5241
5242
5243
5244 .section "Time intervals" "SECTtimeformat"
5245 .cindex "time interval" "specifying in configuration"
5246 .cindex "format" "time interval"
5247 A time interval is specified as a sequence of numbers, each followed by one of
5248 the following letters, with no intervening white space:
5249
5250 .table2 30pt
5251 .irow &%s%& seconds
5252 .irow &%m%& minutes
5253 .irow &%h%& hours
5254 .irow &%d%& days
5255 .irow &%w%& weeks
5256 .endtable
5257
5258 For example, &"3h50m"& specifies 3 hours and 50 minutes. The values of time
5259 intervals are output in the same format. Exim does not restrict the values; it
5260 is perfectly acceptable, for example, to specify &"90m"& instead of &"1h30m"&.
5261
5262
5263
5264 .section "String values" "SECTstrings"
5265 .cindex "string" "format of configuration values"
5266 .cindex "format" "string"
5267 If an option's type is specified as &"string"&, the value can be specified with
5268 or without double-quotes. If it does not start with a double-quote, the value
5269 consists of the remainder of the line plus any continuation lines, starting at
5270 the first character after any leading white space, with trailing white space
5271 removed, and with no interpretation of the characters in the string. Because
5272 Exim removes comment lines (those beginning with #) at an early stage, they can
5273 appear in the middle of a multi-line string. The following two settings are
5274 therefore equivalent:
5275 .code
5276 trusted_users = uucp:mail
5277 trusted_users = uucp:\
5278 # This comment line is ignored
5279 mail
5280 .endd
5281 .cindex "string" "quoted"
5282 .cindex "escape characters in quoted strings"
5283 If a string does start with a double-quote, it must end with a closing
5284 double-quote, and any backslash characters other than those used for line
5285 continuation are interpreted as escape characters, as follows:
5286
5287 .table2 100pt
5288 .irow &`\\`& "single backslash"
5289 .irow &`\n`& "newline"
5290 .irow &`\r`& "carriage return"
5291 .irow &`\t`& "tab"
5292 .irow "&`\`&<&'octal digits'&>" "up to 3 octal digits specify one character"
5293 .irow "&`\x`&<&'hex digits'&>" "up to 2 hexadecimal digits specify one &&&
5294 character"
5295 .endtable
5296
5297 If a backslash is followed by some other character, including a double-quote
5298 character, that character replaces the pair.
5299
5300 Quoting is necessary only if you want to make use of the backslash escapes to
5301 insert special characters, or if you need to specify a value with leading or
5302 trailing spaces. These cases are rare, so quoting is almost never needed in
5303 current versions of Exim. In versions of Exim before 3.14, quoting was required
5304 in order to continue lines, so you may come across older configuration files
5305 and examples that apparently quote unnecessarily.
5306
5307
5308 .section "Expanded strings" "SECID51"
5309 .cindex "expansion" "definition of"
5310 Some strings in the configuration file are subjected to &'string expansion'&,
5311 by which means various parts of the string may be changed according to the
5312 circumstances (see chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&). The input syntax for such strings
5313 is as just described; in particular, the handling of backslashes in quoted
5314 strings is done as part of the input process, before expansion takes place.
5315 However, backslash is also an escape character for the expander, so any
5316 backslashes that are required for that reason must be doubled if they are
5317 within a quoted configuration string.
5318
5319
5320 .section "User and group names" "SECID52"
5321 .cindex "user name" "format of"
5322 .cindex "format" "user name"
5323 .cindex "groups" "name format"
5324 .cindex "format" "group name"
5325 User and group names are specified as strings, using the syntax described
5326 above, but the strings are interpreted specially. A user or group name must
5327 either consist entirely of digits, or be a name that can be looked up using the
5328 &[getpwnam()]& or &[getgrnam()]& function, as appropriate.
5329
5330
5331 .section "List construction" "SECTlistconstruct"
5332 .cindex "list" "syntax of in configuration"
5333 .cindex "format" "list item in configuration"
5334 .cindex "string" "list, definition of"
5335 The data for some configuration options is a list of items, with colon as the
5336 default separator. Many of these options are shown with type &"string list"& in
5337 the descriptions later in this document. Others are listed as &"domain list"&,
5338 &"host list"&, &"address list"&, or &"local part list"&. Syntactically, they
5339 are all the same; however, those other than &"string list"& are subject to
5340 particular kinds of interpretation, as described in chapter
5341 &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>&.
5342
5343 In all these cases, the entire list is treated as a single string as far as the
5344 input syntax is concerned. The &%trusted_users%& setting in section
5345 &<<SECTstrings>>& above is an example. If a colon is actually needed in an item
5346 in a list, it must be entered as two colons. Leading and trailing white space
5347 on each item in a list is ignored. This makes it possible to include items that
5348 start with a colon, and in particular, certain forms of IPv6 address. For
5349 example, the list
5350 .code
5351 local_interfaces = 127.0.0.1 : ::::1
5352 .endd
5353 contains two IP addresses, the IPv4 address 127.0.0.1 and the IPv6 address ::1.
5354
5355 &*Note*&: Although leading and trailing white space is ignored in individual
5356 list items, it is not ignored when parsing the list. The space after the first
5357 colon in the example above is necessary. If it were not there, the list would
5358 be interpreted as the two items 127.0.0.1:: and 1.
5359
5360 .section "Changing list separators" "SECTlistsepchange"
5361 .cindex "list separator" "changing"
5362 .cindex "IPv6" "addresses in lists"
5363 Doubling colons in IPv6 addresses is an unwelcome chore, so a mechanism was
5364 introduced to allow the separator character to be changed. If a list begins
5365 with a left angle bracket, followed by any punctuation character, that
5366 character is used instead of colon as the list separator. For example, the list
5367 above can be rewritten to use a semicolon separator like this:
5368 .code
5369 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; ::1
5370 .endd
5371 This facility applies to all lists, with the exception of the list in
5372 &%log_file_path%&. It is recommended that the use of non-colon separators be
5373 confined to circumstances where they really are needed.
5374
5375 .cindex "list separator" "newline as"
5376 .cindex "newline" "as list separator"
5377 It is also possible to use newline and other control characters (those with
5378 code values less than 32, plus DEL) as separators in lists. Such separators
5379 must be provided literally at the time the list is processed. For options that
5380 are string-expanded, you can write the separator using a normal escape
5381 sequence. This will be processed by the expander before the string is
5382 interpreted as a list. For example, if a newline-separated list of domains is
5383 generated by a lookup, you can process it directly by a line such as this:
5384 .code
5385 domains = <\n ${lookup mysql{.....}}
5386 .endd
5387 This avoids having to change the list separator in such data. You are unlikely
5388 to want to use a control character as a separator in an option that is not
5389 expanded, because the value is literal text. However, it can be done by giving
5390 the value in quotes. For example:
5391 .code
5392 local_interfaces = "<\n 127.0.0.1 \n ::1"
5393 .endd
5394 Unlike printing character separators, which can be included in list items by
5395 doubling, it is not possible to include a control character as data when it is
5396 set as the separator. Two such characters in succession are interpreted as
5397 enclosing an empty list item.
5398
5399
5400
5401 .section "Empty items in lists" "SECTempitelis"
5402 .cindex "list" "empty item in"
5403 An empty item at the end of a list is always ignored. In other words, trailing
5404 separator characters are ignored. Thus, the list in
5405 .code
5406 senders = user@domain :
5407 .endd
5408 contains only a single item. If you want to include an empty string as one item
5409 in a list, it must not be the last item. For example, this list contains three
5410 items, the second of which is empty:
5411 .code
5412 senders = user1@domain : : user2@domain
5413 .endd
5414 &*Note*&: There must be white space between the two colons, as otherwise they
5415 are interpreted as representing a single colon data character (and the list
5416 would then contain just one item). If you want to specify a list that contains
5417 just one, empty item, you can do it as in this example:
5418 .code
5419 senders = :
5420 .endd
5421 In this case, the first item is empty, and the second is discarded because it
5422 is at the end of the list.
5423
5424
5425
5426
5427 .section "Format of driver configurations" "SECTfordricon"
5428 .cindex "drivers" "configuration format"
5429 There are separate parts in the configuration for defining routers, transports,
5430 and authenticators. In each part, you are defining a number of driver
5431 instances, each with its own set of options. Each driver instance is defined by
5432 a sequence of lines like this:
5433 .display
5434 <&'instance name'&>:
5435 <&'option'&>
5436 ...
5437 <&'option'&>
5438 .endd
5439 In the following example, the instance name is &(localuser)&, and it is
5440 followed by three options settings:
5441 .code
5442 localuser:
5443 driver = accept
5444 check_local_user
5445 transport = local_delivery
5446 .endd
5447 For each driver instance, you specify which Exim code module it uses &-- by the
5448 setting of the &%driver%& option &-- and (optionally) some configuration
5449 settings. For example, in the case of transports, if you want a transport to
5450 deliver with SMTP you would use the &(smtp)& driver; if you want to deliver to
5451 a local file you would use the &(appendfile)& driver. Each of the drivers is
5452 described in detail in its own separate chapter later in this manual.
5453
5454 You can have several routers, transports, or authenticators that are based on
5455 the same underlying driver (each must have a different instance name).
5456
5457 The order in which routers are defined is important, because addresses are
5458 passed to individual routers one by one, in order. The order in which
5459 transports are defined does not matter at all. The order in which
5460 authenticators are defined is used only when Exim, as a client, is searching
5461 them to find one that matches an authentication mechanism offered by the
5462 server.
5463
5464 .cindex "generic options"
5465 .cindex "options" "generic &-- definition of"
5466 Within a driver instance definition, there are two kinds of option: &'generic'&
5467 and &'private'&. The generic options are those that apply to all drivers of the
5468 same type (that is, all routers, all transports or all authenticators). The
5469 &%driver%& option is a generic option that must appear in every definition.
5470 .cindex "private options"
5471 The private options are special for each driver, and none need appear, because
5472 they all have default values.
5473
5474 The options may appear in any order, except that the &%driver%& option must
5475 precede any private options, since these depend on the particular driver. For
5476 this reason, it is recommended that &%driver%& always be the first option.
5477
5478 Driver instance names, which are used for reference in log entries and
5479 elsewhere, can be any sequence of letters, digits, and underscores (starting
5480 with a letter) and must be unique among drivers of the same type. A router and
5481 a transport (for example) can each have the same name, but no two router
5482 instances can have the same name. The name of a driver instance should not be
5483 confused with the name of the underlying driver module. For example, the
5484 configuration lines:
5485 .code
5486 remote_smtp:
5487 driver = smtp
5488 .endd
5489 create an instance of the &(smtp)& transport driver whose name is
5490 &(remote_smtp)&. The same driver code can be used more than once, with
5491 different instance names and different option settings each time. A second
5492 instance of the &(smtp)& transport, with different options, might be defined
5493 thus:
5494 .code
5495 special_smtp:
5496 driver = smtp
5497 port = 1234
5498 command_timeout = 10s
5499 .endd
5500 The names &(remote_smtp)& and &(special_smtp)& would be used to reference
5501 these transport instances from routers, and these names would appear in log
5502 lines.
5503
5504 Comment lines may be present in the middle of driver specifications. The full
5505 list of option settings for any particular driver instance, including all the
5506 defaulted values, can be extracted by making use of the &%-bP%& command line
5507 option.
5508
5509
5510
5511
5512
5513
5514 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5515 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5516
5517 .chapter "The default configuration file" "CHAPdefconfil"
5518 .scindex IIDconfiwal "configuration file" "default &""walk through""&"
5519 .cindex "default" "configuration file &""walk through""&"
5520 The default configuration file supplied with Exim as &_src/configure.default_&
5521 is sufficient for a host with simple mail requirements. As an introduction to
5522 the way Exim is configured, this chapter &"walks through"& the default
5523 configuration, giving brief explanations of the settings. Detailed descriptions
5524 of the options are given in subsequent chapters. The default configuration file
5525 itself contains extensive comments about ways you might want to modify the
5526 initial settings. However, note that there are many options that are not
5527 mentioned at all in the default configuration.
5528
5529
5530
5531 .section "Macros" "SECTdefconfmacros"
5532 All macros should be defined before any options.
5533
5534 One macro is specified, but commented out, in the default configuration:
5535 .code
5536 # ROUTER_SMARTHOST=MAIL.HOSTNAME.FOR.CENTRAL.SERVER.EXAMPLE
5537 .endd
5538 If all off-site mail is expected to be delivered to a "smarthost", then set the
5539 hostname here and uncomment the macro. This will affect which router is used
5540 later on. If this is left commented out, then Exim will perform direct-to-MX
5541 deliveries using a &(dnslookup)& router.
5542
5543 In addition to macros defined here, Exim includes a number of built-in macros
5544 to enable configuration to be guarded by a binary built with support for a
5545 given feature. See section &<<SECTbuiltinmacros>>& for more details.
5546
5547
5548 .section "Main configuration settings" "SECTdefconfmain"
5549 The main (global) configuration option settings section must always come first
5550 in the file, after the macros.
5551 The first thing you'll see in the file, after some initial comments, is the line
5552 .code
5553 # primary_hostname =
5554 .endd
5555 This is a commented-out setting of the &%primary_hostname%& option. Exim needs
5556 to know the official, fully qualified name of your host, and this is where you
5557 can specify it. However, in most cases you do not need to set this option. When
5558 it is unset, Exim uses the &[uname()]& system function to obtain the host name.
5559
5560 The first three non-comment configuration lines are as follows:
5561 .code
5562 domainlist local_domains = @
5563 domainlist relay_to_domains =
5564 hostlist relay_from_hosts = 127.0.0.1
5565 .endd
5566 These are not, in fact, option settings. They are definitions of two named
5567 domain lists and one named host list. Exim allows you to give names to lists of
5568 domains, hosts, and email addresses, in order to make it easier to manage the
5569 configuration file (see section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&).
5570
5571 The first line defines a domain list called &'local_domains'&; this is used
5572 later in the configuration to identify domains that are to be delivered
5573 on the local host.
5574
5575 .cindex "@ in a domain list"
5576 There is just one item in this list, the string &"@"&. This is a special form
5577 of entry which means &"the name of the local host"&. Thus, if the local host is
5578 called &'a.host.example'&, mail to &'any.user@a.host.example'& is expected to
5579 be delivered locally. Because the local host's name is referenced indirectly,
5580 the same configuration file can be used on different hosts.
5581
5582 The second line defines a domain list called &'relay_to_domains'&, but the
5583 list itself is empty. Later in the configuration we will come to the part that
5584 controls mail relaying through the local host; it allows relaying to any
5585 domains in this list. By default, therefore, no relaying on the basis of a mail
5586 domain is permitted.
5587
5588 The third line defines a host list called &'relay_from_hosts'&. This list is
5589 used later in the configuration to permit relaying from any host or IP address
5590 that matches the list. The default contains just the IP address of the IPv4
5591 loopback interface, which means that processes on the local host are able to
5592 submit mail for relaying by sending it over TCP/IP to that interface. No other
5593 hosts are permitted to submit messages for relaying.
5594
5595 Just to be sure there's no misunderstanding: at this point in the configuration
5596 we aren't actually setting up any controls. We are just defining some domains
5597 and hosts that will be used in the controls that are specified later.
5598
5599 The next two configuration lines are genuine option settings:
5600 .code
5601 acl_smtp_rcpt = acl_check_rcpt
5602 acl_smtp_data = acl_check_data
5603 .endd
5604 These options specify &'Access Control Lists'& (ACLs) that are to be used
5605 during an incoming SMTP session for every recipient of a message (every RCPT
5606 command), and after the contents of the message have been received,
5607 respectively. The names of the lists are &'acl_check_rcpt'& and
5608 &'acl_check_data'&, and we will come to their definitions below, in the ACL
5609 section of the configuration. The RCPT ACL controls which recipients are
5610 accepted for an incoming message &-- if a configuration does not provide an ACL
5611 to check recipients, no SMTP mail can be accepted. The DATA ACL allows the
5612 contents of a message to be checked.
5613
5614 Two commented-out option settings are next:
5615 .code
5616 # av_scanner = clamd:/tmp/clamd
5617 # spamd_address = 127.0.0.1 783
5618 .endd
5619 These are example settings that can be used when Exim is compiled with the
5620 content-scanning extension. The first specifies the interface to the virus
5621 scanner, and the second specifies the interface to SpamAssassin. Further
5622 details are given in chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
5623
5624 Three more commented-out option settings follow:
5625 .code
5626 # tls_advertise_hosts = *
5627 # tls_certificate = /etc/ssl/exim.crt
5628 # tls_privatekey = /etc/ssl/exim.pem
5629 .endd
5630 These are example settings that can be used when Exim is compiled with
5631 support for TLS (aka SSL) as described in section &<<SECTinctlsssl>>&. The
5632 first one specifies the list of clients that are allowed to use TLS when
5633 connecting to this server; in this case, the wildcard means all clients. The
5634 other options specify where Exim should find its TLS certificate and private
5635 key, which together prove the server's identity to any clients that connect.
5636 More details are given in chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&.
5637
5638 Another two commented-out option settings follow:
5639 .code
5640 # daemon_smtp_ports = 25 : 465 : 587
5641 # tls_on_connect_ports = 465
5642 .endd
5643 .cindex "port" "465 and 587"
5644 .cindex "port" "for message submission"
5645 .cindex "message" "submission, ports for"
5646 .cindex "submissions protocol"
5647 .cindex "smtps protocol"
5648 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
5649 .cindex "SMTP" "submissions protocol"
5650 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
5651 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
5652 These options provide better support for roaming users who wish to use this
5653 server for message submission. They are not much use unless you have turned on
5654 TLS (as described in the previous paragraph) and authentication (about which
5655 more in section &<<SECTdefconfauth>>&).
5656 Mail submission from mail clients (MUAs) should be separate from inbound mail
5657 to your domain (MX delivery) for various good reasons (eg, ability to impose
5658 much saner TLS protocol and ciphersuite requirements without unintended
5659 consequences).
5660 RFC 6409 (previously 4409) specifies use of port 587 for SMTP Submission,
5661 which uses STARTTLS, so this is the &"submission"& port.
5662 RFC 8314 specifies use of port 465 as the &"submissions"& protocol,
5663 which should be used in preference to 587.
5664 You should also consider deploying SRV records to help clients find
5665 these ports.
5666 Older names for &"submissions"& are &"smtps"& and &"ssmtp"&.
5667
5668 Two more commented-out options settings follow:
5669 .code
5670 # qualify_domain =
5671 # qualify_recipient =
5672 .endd
5673 The first of these specifies a domain that Exim uses when it constructs a
5674 complete email address from a local login name. This is often needed when Exim
5675 receives a message from a local process. If you do not set &%qualify_domain%&,
5676 the value of &%primary_hostname%& is used. If you set both of these options,
5677 you can have different qualification domains for sender and recipient
5678 addresses. If you set only the first one, its value is used in both cases.
5679
5680 .cindex "domain literal" "recognizing format"
5681 The following line must be uncommented if you want Exim to recognize
5682 addresses of the form &'user@[10.11.12.13]'& that is, with a &"domain literal"&
5683 (an IP address within square brackets) instead of a named domain.
5684 .code
5685 # allow_domain_literals
5686 .endd
5687 The RFCs still require this form, but many people think that in the modern
5688 Internet it makes little sense to permit mail to be sent to specific hosts by
5689 quoting their IP addresses. This ancient format has been used by people who
5690 try to abuse hosts by using them for unwanted relaying. However, some
5691 people believe there are circumstances (for example, messages addressed to
5692 &'postmaster'&) where domain literals are still useful.
5693
5694 The next configuration line is a kind of trigger guard:
5695 .code
5696 never_users = root
5697 .endd
5698 It specifies that no delivery must ever be run as the root user. The normal
5699 convention is to set up &'root'& as an alias for the system administrator. This
5700 setting is a guard against slips in the configuration.
5701 The list of users specified by &%never_users%& is not, however, the complete
5702 list; the build-time configuration in &_Local/Makefile_& has an option called
5703 FIXED_NEVER_USERS specifying a list that cannot be overridden. The
5704 contents of &%never_users%& are added to this list. By default
5705 FIXED_NEVER_USERS also specifies root.
5706
5707 When a remote host connects to Exim in order to send mail, the only information
5708 Exim has about the host's identity is its IP address. The next configuration
5709 line,
5710 .code
5711 host_lookup = *
5712 .endd
5713 specifies that Exim should do a reverse DNS lookup on all incoming connections,
5714 in order to get a host name. This improves the quality of the logging
5715 information, but if you feel it is too expensive, you can remove it entirely,
5716 or restrict the lookup to hosts on &"nearby"& networks.
5717 Note that it is not always possible to find a host name from an IP address,
5718 because not all DNS reverse zones are maintained, and sometimes DNS servers are
5719 unreachable.
5720
5721 The next two lines are concerned with &'ident'& callbacks, as defined by RFC
5722 1413 (hence their names):
5723 .code
5724 rfc1413_hosts = *
5725 rfc1413_query_timeout = 0s
5726 .endd
5727 These settings cause Exim to avoid ident callbacks for all incoming SMTP calls.
5728 Few hosts offer RFC1413 service these days; calls have to be
5729 terminated by a timeout and this needlessly delays the startup
5730 of an incoming SMTP connection.
5731 If you have hosts for which you trust RFC1413 and need this
5732 information, you can change this.
5733
5734 This line enables an efficiency SMTP option. It is negotiated by clients
5735 and not expected to cause problems but can be disabled if needed.
5736 .code
5737 prdr_enable = true
5738 .endd
5739
5740 When Exim receives messages over SMTP connections, it expects all addresses to
5741 be fully qualified with a domain, as required by the SMTP definition. However,
5742 if you are running a server to which simple clients submit messages, you may
5743 find that they send unqualified addresses. The two commented-out options:
5744 .code
5745 # sender_unqualified_hosts =
5746 # recipient_unqualified_hosts =
5747 .endd
5748 show how you can specify hosts that are permitted to send unqualified sender
5749 and recipient addresses, respectively.
5750
5751 The &%log_selector%& option is used to increase the detail of logging
5752 over the default:
5753 .code
5754 log_selector = +smtp_protocol_error +smtp_syntax_error \
5755 +tls_certificate_verified
5756 .endd
5757
5758 The &%percent_hack_domains%& option is also commented out:
5759 .code
5760 # percent_hack_domains =
5761 .endd
5762 It provides a list of domains for which the &"percent hack"& is to operate.
5763 This is an almost obsolete form of explicit email routing. If you do not know
5764 anything about it, you can safely ignore this topic.
5765
5766 The next two settings in the main part of the default configuration are
5767 concerned with messages that have been &"frozen"& on Exim's queue. When a
5768 message is frozen, Exim no longer continues to try to deliver it. Freezing
5769 occurs when a bounce message encounters a permanent failure because the sender
5770 address of the original message that caused the bounce is invalid, so the
5771 bounce cannot be delivered. This is probably the most common case, but there
5772 are also other conditions that cause freezing, and frozen messages are not
5773 always bounce messages.
5774 .code
5775 ignore_bounce_errors_after = 2d
5776 timeout_frozen_after = 7d
5777 .endd
5778 The first of these options specifies that failing bounce messages are to be
5779 discarded after 2 days in the queue. The second specifies that any frozen
5780 message (whether a bounce message or not) is to be timed out (and discarded)
5781 after a week. In this configuration, the first setting ensures that no failing
5782 bounce message ever lasts a week.
5783
5784 Exim queues it's messages in a spool directory. If you expect to have
5785 large queues, you may consider using this option. It splits the spool
5786 directory into subdirectories to avoid file system degradation from
5787 many files in a single directory, resulting in better performance.
5788 Manual manipulation of queued messages becomes more complex (though fortunately
5789 not often needed).
5790 .code
5791 # split_spool_directory = true
5792 .endd
5793
5794 In an ideal world everybody follows the standards. For non-ASCII
5795 messages RFC 2047 is a standard, allowing a maximum line length of 76
5796 characters. Exim adheres that standard and won't process messages which
5797 violate this standard. (Even ${rfc2047:...} expansions will fail.)
5798 In particular, the Exim maintainers have had multiple reports of
5799 problems from Russian administrators of issues until they disable this
5800 check, because of some popular, yet buggy, mail composition software.
5801 .code
5802 # check_rfc2047_length = false
5803 .endd
5804
5805 If you need to be strictly RFC compliant you may wish to disable the
5806 8BITMIME advertisement. Use this, if you exchange mails with systems
5807 that are not 8-bit clean.
5808 .code
5809 # accept_8bitmime = false
5810 .endd
5811
5812 Libraries you use may depend on specific environment settings. This
5813 imposes a security risk (e.g. PATH). There are two lists:
5814 &%keep_environment%& for the variables to import as they are, and
5815 &%add_environment%& for variables we want to set to a fixed value.
5816 Note that TZ is handled separately, by the $%timezone%$ runtime
5817 option and by the TIMEZONE_DEFAULT buildtime option.
5818 .code
5819 # keep_environment = ^LDAP
5820 # add_environment = PATH=/usr/bin::/bin
5821 .endd
5822
5823
5824 .section "ACL configuration" "SECID54"
5825 .cindex "default" "ACLs"
5826 .cindex "&ACL;" "default configuration"
5827 In the default configuration, the ACL section follows the main configuration.
5828 It starts with the line
5829 .code
5830 begin acl
5831 .endd
5832 and it contains the definitions of two ACLs, called &'acl_check_rcpt'& and
5833 &'acl_check_data'&, that were referenced in the settings of &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&
5834 and &%acl_smtp_data%& above.
5835
5836 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
5837 The first ACL is used for every RCPT command in an incoming SMTP message. Each
5838 RCPT command specifies one of the message's recipients. The ACL statements
5839 are considered in order, until the recipient address is either accepted or
5840 rejected. The RCPT command is then accepted or rejected, according to the
5841 result of the ACL processing.
5842 .code
5843 acl_check_rcpt:
5844 .endd
5845 This line, consisting of a name terminated by a colon, marks the start of the
5846 ACL, and names it.
5847 .code
5848 accept hosts = :
5849 .endd
5850 This ACL statement accepts the recipient if the sending host matches the list.
5851 But what does that strange list mean? It doesn't actually contain any host
5852 names or IP addresses. The presence of the colon puts an empty item in the
5853 list; Exim matches this only if the incoming message did not come from a remote
5854 host, because in that case, the remote hostname is empty. The colon is
5855 important. Without it, the list itself is empty, and can never match anything.
5856
5857 What this statement is doing is to accept unconditionally all recipients in
5858 messages that are submitted by SMTP from local processes using the standard
5859 input and output (that is, not using TCP/IP). A number of MUAs operate in this
5860 manner.
5861 .code
5862 deny message = Restricted characters in address
5863 domains = +local_domains
5864 local_parts = ^[.] : ^.*[@%!/|]
5865
5866 deny message = Restricted characters in address
5867 domains = !+local_domains
5868 local_parts = ^[./|] : ^.*[@%!] : ^.*/\\.\\./
5869 .endd
5870 These statements are concerned with local parts that contain any of the
5871 characters &"@"&, &"%"&, &"!"&, &"/"&, &"|"&, or dots in unusual places.
5872 Although these characters are entirely legal in local parts (in the case of
5873 &"@"& and leading dots, only if correctly quoted), they do not commonly occur
5874 in Internet mail addresses.
5875
5876 The first three have in the past been associated with explicitly routed
5877 addresses (percent is still sometimes used &-- see the &%percent_hack_domains%&
5878 option). Addresses containing these characters are regularly tried by spammers
5879 in an attempt to bypass relaying restrictions, and also by open relay testing
5880 programs. Unless you really need them it is safest to reject these characters
5881 at this early stage. This configuration is heavy-handed in rejecting these
5882 characters for all messages it accepts from remote hosts. This is a deliberate
5883 policy of being as safe as possible.
5884
5885 The first rule above is stricter, and is applied to messages that are addressed
5886 to one of the local domains handled by this host. This is implemented by the
5887 first condition, which restricts it to domains that are listed in the
5888 &'local_domains'& domain list. The &"+"& character is used to indicate a
5889 reference to a named list. In this configuration, there is just one domain in
5890 &'local_domains'&, but in general there may be many.
5891
5892 The second condition on the first statement uses two regular expressions to
5893 block local parts that begin with a dot or contain &"@"&, &"%"&, &"!"&, &"/"&,
5894 or &"|"&. If you have local accounts that include these characters, you will
5895 have to modify this rule.
5896
5897 Empty components (two dots in a row) are not valid in RFC 2822, but Exim
5898 allows them because they have been encountered in practice. (Consider the
5899 common convention of local parts constructed as
5900 &"&'first-initial.second-initial.family-name'&"& when applied to someone like
5901 the author of Exim, who has no second initial.) However, a local part starting
5902 with a dot or containing &"/../"& can cause trouble if it is used as part of a
5903 filename (for example, for a mailing list). This is also true for local parts
5904 that contain slashes. A pipe symbol can also be troublesome if the local part
5905 is incorporated unthinkingly into a shell command line.
5906
5907 The second rule above applies to all other domains, and is less strict. This
5908 allows your own users to send outgoing messages to sites that use slashes
5909 and vertical bars in their local parts. It blocks local parts that begin
5910 with a dot, slash, or vertical bar, but allows these characters within the
5911 local part. However, the sequence &"/../"& is barred. The use of &"@"&, &"%"&,
5912 and &"!"& is blocked, as before. The motivation here is to prevent your users
5913 (or your users' viruses) from mounting certain kinds of attack on remote sites.
5914 .code
5915 accept local_parts = postmaster
5916 domains = +local_domains
5917 .endd
5918 This statement, which has two conditions, accepts an incoming address if the
5919 local part is &'postmaster'& and the domain is one of those listed in the
5920 &'local_domains'& domain list. The &"+"& character is used to indicate a
5921 reference to a named list. In this configuration, there is just one domain in
5922 &'local_domains'&, but in general there may be many.
5923
5924 The presence of this statement means that mail to postmaster is never blocked
5925 by any of the subsequent tests. This can be helpful while sorting out problems
5926 in cases where the subsequent tests are incorrectly denying access.
5927 .code
5928 require verify = sender
5929 .endd
5930 This statement requires the sender address to be verified before any subsequent
5931 ACL statement can be used. If verification fails, the incoming recipient
5932 address is refused. Verification consists of trying to route the address, to
5933 see if a bounce message could be delivered to it. In the case of remote
5934 addresses, basic verification checks only the domain, but &'callouts'& can be
5935 used for more verification if required. Section &<<SECTaddressverification>>&
5936 discusses the details of address verification.
5937 .code
5938 accept hosts = +relay_from_hosts
5939 control = submission
5940 .endd
5941 This statement accepts the address if the message is coming from one of the
5942 hosts that are defined as being allowed to relay through this host. Recipient
5943 verification is omitted here, because in many cases the clients are dumb MUAs
5944 that do not cope well with SMTP error responses. For the same reason, the
5945 second line specifies &"submission mode"& for messages that are accepted. This
5946 is described in detail in section &<<SECTsubmodnon>>&; it causes Exim to fix
5947 messages that are deficient in some way, for example, because they lack a
5948 &'Date:'& header line. If you are actually relaying out from MTAs, you should
5949 probably add recipient verification here, and disable submission mode.
5950 .code
5951 accept authenticated = *
5952 control = submission
5953 .endd
5954 This statement accepts the address if the client host has authenticated itself.
5955 Submission mode is again specified, on the grounds that such messages are most
5956 likely to come from MUAs. The default configuration does not define any
5957 authenticators, though it does include some nearly complete commented-out
5958 examples described in &<<SECTdefconfauth>>&. This means that no client can in
5959 fact authenticate until you complete the authenticator definitions.
5960 .code
5961 require message = relay not permitted
5962 domains = +local_domains : +relay_to_domains
5963 .endd
5964 This statement rejects the address if its domain is neither a local domain nor
5965 one of the domains for which this host is a relay.
5966 .code
5967 require verify = recipient
5968 .endd
5969 This statement requires the recipient address to be verified; if verification
5970 fails, the address is rejected.
5971 .code
5972 # deny message = rejected because $sender_host_address \
5973 # is in a black list at $dnslist_domain\n\
5974 # $dnslist_text
5975 # dnslists = black.list.example
5976 #
5977 # warn dnslists = black.list.example
5978 # add_header = X-Warning: $sender_host_address is in \
5979 # a black list at $dnslist_domain
5980 # log_message = found in $dnslist_domain
5981 .endd
5982 These commented-out lines are examples of how you could configure Exim to check
5983 sending hosts against a DNS black list. The first statement rejects messages
5984 from blacklisted hosts, whereas the second just inserts a warning header
5985 line.
5986 .code
5987 # require verify = csa
5988 .endd
5989 This commented-out line is an example of how you could turn on client SMTP
5990 authorization (CSA) checking. Such checks do DNS lookups for special SRV
5991 records.
5992 .code
5993 accept
5994 .endd
5995 The final statement in the first ACL unconditionally accepts any recipient
5996 address that has successfully passed all the previous tests.
5997 .code
5998 acl_check_data:
5999 .endd
6000 This line marks the start of the second ACL, and names it. Most of the contents
6001 of this ACL are commented out:
6002 .code
6003 # deny malware = *
6004 # message = This message contains a virus \
6005 # ($malware_name).
6006 .endd
6007 These lines are examples of how to arrange for messages to be scanned for
6008 viruses when Exim has been compiled with the content-scanning extension, and a
6009 suitable virus scanner is installed. If the message is found to contain a
6010 virus, it is rejected with the given custom error message.
6011 .code
6012 # warn spam = nobody
6013 # message = X-Spam_score: $spam_score\n\
6014 # X-Spam_score_int: $spam_score_int\n\
6015 # X-Spam_bar: $spam_bar\n\
6016 # X-Spam_report: $spam_report
6017 .endd
6018 These lines are an example of how to arrange for messages to be scanned by
6019 SpamAssassin when Exim has been compiled with the content-scanning extension,
6020 and SpamAssassin has been installed. The SpamAssassin check is run with
6021 &`nobody`& as its user parameter, and the results are added to the message as a
6022 series of extra header line. In this case, the message is not rejected,
6023 whatever the spam score.
6024 .code
6025 accept
6026 .endd
6027 This final line in the DATA ACL accepts the message unconditionally.
6028
6029
6030 .section "Router configuration" "SECID55"
6031 .cindex "default" "routers"
6032 .cindex "routers" "default"
6033 The router configuration comes next in the default configuration, introduced
6034 by the line
6035 .code
6036 begin routers
6037 .endd
6038 Routers are the modules in Exim that make decisions about where to send
6039 messages. An address is passed to each router, in turn, until it is either
6040 accepted, or failed. This means that the order in which you define the routers
6041 matters. Each router is fully described in its own chapter later in this
6042 manual. Here we give only brief overviews.
6043 .code
6044 # domain_literal:
6045 # driver = ipliteral
6046 # domains = !+local_domains
6047 # transport = remote_smtp
6048 .endd
6049 .cindex "domain literal" "default router"
6050 This router is commented out because the majority of sites do not want to
6051 support domain literal addresses (those of the form &'user@[10.9.8.7]'&). If
6052 you uncomment this router, you also need to uncomment the setting of
6053 &%allow_domain_literals%& in the main part of the configuration.
6054
6055 Which router is used next depends upon whether or not the ROUTER_SMARTHOST
6056 macro has been defined, per
6057 .code
6058 .ifdef ROUTER_SMARTHOST
6059 smarthost:
6060 #...
6061 .else
6062 dnslookup:
6063 #...
6064 .endif
6065 .endd
6066
6067 If ROUTER_SMARTHOST has been defined, either at the top of the file or on the
6068 command-line, then we route all non-local mail to that smarthost; otherwise, we'll
6069 perform DNS lookups for direct-to-MX lookup. Any mail which is to a local domain will
6070 skip these routers because of the &%domains%& option.
6071
6072 .code
6073 smarthost:
6074 driver = manualroute
6075 domains = ! +local_domains
6076 transport = smarthost_smtp
6077 route_data = ROUTER_SMARTHOST
6078 ignore_target_hosts = <; 0.0.0.0 ; 127.0.0.0/8 ; ::1
6079 no_more
6080 .endd
6081 This router only handles mail which is not to any local domains; this is
6082 specified by the line
6083 .code
6084 domains = ! +local_domains
6085 .endd
6086 The &%domains%& option lists the domains to which this router applies, but the
6087 exclamation mark is a negation sign, so the router is used only for domains
6088 that are not in the domain list called &'local_domains'& (which was defined at
6089 the start of the configuration). The plus sign before &'local_domains'&
6090 indicates that it is referring to a named list. Addresses in other domains are
6091 passed on to the following routers.
6092
6093 The name of the router driver is &(manualroute)& because we are manually
6094 specifying how mail should be routed onwards, instead of using DNS MX.
6095 While the name of this router instance is arbitrary, the &%driver%& option must
6096 be one of the driver modules that is in the Exim binary.
6097
6098 With no pre-conditions other than &%domains%&, all mail for non-local domains
6099 will be handled by this router, and the &%no_more%& setting will ensure that no
6100 other routers will be used for messages matching the pre-conditions. See
6101 &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for more on how the pre-conditions apply. For messages which
6102 are handled by this router, we provide a hostname to deliver to in &%route_data%&
6103 and the macro supplies the value; the address is then queued for the
6104 &(smarthost_smtp)& transport.
6105
6106 .code
6107 dnslookup:
6108 driver = dnslookup
6109 domains = ! +local_domains
6110 transport = remote_smtp
6111 ignore_target_hosts = 0.0.0.0 : 127.0.0.0/8
6112 no_more
6113 .endd
6114 The &%domains%& option behaves as per smarthost, above.
6115
6116 The name of the router driver is &(dnslookup)&,
6117 and is specified by the &%driver%& option. Do not be confused by the fact that
6118 the name of this router instance is the same as the name of the driver. The
6119 instance name is arbitrary, but the name set in the &%driver%& option must be
6120 one of the driver modules that is in the Exim binary.
6121
6122 The &(dnslookup)& router routes addresses by looking up their domains in the
6123 DNS in order to obtain a list of hosts to which the address is routed. If the
6124 router succeeds, the address is queued for the &(remote_smtp)& transport, as
6125 specified by the &%transport%& option. If the router does not find the domain
6126 in the DNS, no further routers are tried because of the &%no_more%& setting, so
6127 the address fails and is bounced.
6128
6129 The &%ignore_target_hosts%& option specifies a list of IP addresses that are to
6130 be entirely ignored. This option is present because a number of cases have been
6131 encountered where MX records in the DNS point to host names
6132 whose IP addresses are 0.0.0.0 or are in the 127 subnet (typically 127.0.0.1).
6133 Completely ignoring these IP addresses causes Exim to fail to route the
6134 email address, so it bounces. Otherwise, Exim would log a routing problem, and
6135 continue to try to deliver the message periodically until the address timed
6136 out.
6137 .code
6138 system_aliases:
6139 driver = redirect
6140 allow_fail
6141 allow_defer
6142 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/aliases}}
6143 # user = exim
6144 file_transport = address_file
6145 pipe_transport = address_pipe
6146 .endd
6147 Control reaches this and subsequent routers only for addresses in the local
6148 domains. This router checks to see whether the local part is defined as an
6149 alias in the &_/etc/aliases_& file, and if so, redirects it according to the
6150 data that it looks up from that file. If no data is found for the local part,
6151 the value of the &%data%& option is empty, causing the address to be passed to
6152 the next router.
6153
6154 &_/etc/aliases_& is a conventional name for the system aliases file that is
6155 often used. That is why it is referenced by from the default configuration
6156 file. However, you can change this by setting SYSTEM_ALIASES_FILE in
6157 &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim.
6158 .code
6159 userforward:
6160 driver = redirect
6161 check_local_user
6162 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
6163 # local_part_suffix_optional
6164 file = $home/.forward
6165 # allow_filter
6166 no_verify
6167 no_expn
6168 check_ancestor
6169 file_transport = address_file
6170 pipe_transport = address_pipe
6171 reply_transport = address_reply
6172 .endd
6173 This is the most complicated router in the default configuration. It is another
6174 redirection router, but this time it is looking for forwarding data set up by
6175 individual users. The &%check_local_user%& setting specifies a check that the
6176 local part of the address is the login name of a local user. If it is not, the
6177 router is skipped. The two commented options that follow &%check_local_user%&,
6178 namely:
6179 .code
6180 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
6181 # local_part_suffix_optional
6182 .endd
6183 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
6184 show how you can specify the recognition of local part suffixes. If the first
6185 is uncommented, a suffix beginning with either a plus or a minus sign, followed
6186 by any sequence of characters, is removed from the local part and placed in the
6187 variable &$local_part_suffix$&. The second suffix option specifies that the
6188 presence of a suffix in the local part is optional. When a suffix is present,
6189 the check for a local login uses the local part with the suffix removed.
6190
6191 When a local user account is found, the file called &_.forward_& in the user's
6192 home directory is consulted. If it does not exist, or is empty, the router
6193 declines. Otherwise, the contents of &_.forward_& are interpreted as
6194 redirection data (see chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>& for more details).
6195
6196 .cindex "Sieve filter" "enabling in default router"
6197 Traditional &_.forward_& files contain just a list of addresses, pipes, or
6198 files. Exim supports this by default. However, if &%allow_filter%& is set (it
6199 is commented out by default), the contents of the file are interpreted as a set
6200 of Exim or Sieve filtering instructions, provided the file begins with &"#Exim
6201 filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"&, respectively. User filtering is discussed in the
6202 separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&.
6203
6204 The &%no_verify%& and &%no_expn%& options mean that this router is skipped when
6205 verifying addresses, or when running as a consequence of an SMTP EXPN command.
6206 There are two reasons for doing this:
6207
6208 .olist
6209 Whether or not a local user has a &_.forward_& file is not really relevant when
6210 checking an address for validity; it makes sense not to waste resources doing
6211 unnecessary work.
6212 .next
6213 More importantly, when Exim is verifying addresses or handling an EXPN
6214 command during an SMTP session, it is running as the Exim user, not as root.
6215 The group is the Exim group, and no additional groups are set up.
6216 It may therefore not be possible for Exim to read users' &_.forward_& files at
6217 this time.
6218 .endlist
6219
6220 The setting of &%check_ancestor%& prevents the router from generating a new
6221 address that is the same as any previous address that was redirected. (This
6222 works round a problem concerning a bad interaction between aliasing and
6223 forwarding &-- see section &<<SECTredlocmai>>&).
6224
6225 The final three option settings specify the transports that are to be used when
6226 forwarding generates a direct delivery to a file, or to a pipe, or sets up an
6227 auto-reply, respectively. For example, if a &_.forward_& file contains
6228 .code
6229 a.nother@elsewhere.example, /home/spqr/archive
6230 .endd
6231 the delivery to &_/home/spqr/archive_& is done by running the &%address_file%&
6232 transport.
6233 .code
6234 localuser:
6235 driver = accept
6236 check_local_user
6237 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
6238 # local_part_suffix_optional
6239 transport = local_delivery
6240 .endd
6241 The final router sets up delivery into local mailboxes, provided that the local
6242 part is the name of a local login, by accepting the address and assigning it to
6243 the &(local_delivery)& transport. Otherwise, we have reached the end of the
6244 routers, so the address is bounced. The commented suffix settings fulfil the
6245 same purpose as they do for the &(userforward)& router.
6246
6247
6248 .section "Transport configuration" "SECID56"
6249 .cindex "default" "transports"
6250 .cindex "transports" "default"
6251 Transports define mechanisms for actually delivering messages. They operate
6252 only when referenced from routers, so the order in which they are defined does
6253 not matter. The transports section of the configuration starts with
6254 .code
6255 begin transports
6256 .endd
6257 Two remote transports and four local transports are defined.
6258 .code
6259 remote_smtp:
6260 driver = smtp
6261 message_size_limit = ${if > {$max_received_linelength}{998} {1}{0}}
6262 .ifdef _HAVE_DANE
6263 dnssec_request_domains = *
6264 hosts_try_dane = *
6265 .endif
6266 .ifdef _HAVE_PRDR
6267 hosts_try_prdr = *
6268 .endif
6269 .endd
6270 This transport is used for delivering messages over SMTP connections.
6271 The list of remote hosts comes from the router.
6272 The &%message_size_limit%& usage is a hack to avoid sending on messages
6273 with over-long lines. The built-in macro _HAVE_DANE guards configuration
6274 to try to use DNSSEC for all queries and to use DANE for delivery;
6275 see section &<<SECDANE>>& for more details.
6276
6277 The &%hosts_try_prdr%& option enables an efficiency SMTP option. It is
6278 negotiated between client and server and not expected to cause problems
6279 but can be disabled if needed. The built-in macro _HAVE_PRDR guards the
6280 use of the &%hosts_try_prdr%& configuration option.
6281
6282 The other remote transport is used when delivering to a specific smarthost
6283 with whom there must be some kind of existing relationship, instead of the
6284 usual federated system.
6285
6286 .code
6287 smarthost_smtp:
6288 driver = smtp
6289 message_size_limit = ${if > {$max_received_linelength}{998} {1}{0}}
6290 multi_domain
6291 #
6292 .ifdef _HAVE_TLS
6293 # Comment out any of these which you have to, then file a Support
6294 # request with your smarthost provider to get things fixed:
6295 hosts_require_tls = *
6296 tls_verify_hosts = *
6297 # As long as tls_verify_hosts is enabled, this won't matter, but if you
6298 # have to comment it out then this will at least log whether you succeed
6299 # or not:
6300 tls_try_verify_hosts = *
6301 #
6302 # The SNI name should match the name which we'll expect to verify;
6303 # many mail systems don't use SNI and this doesn't matter, but if it does,
6304 # we need to send a name which the remote site will recognize.
6305 # This _should_ be the name which the smarthost operators specified as
6306 # the hostname for sending your mail to.
6307 tls_sni = ROUTER_SMARTHOST
6308 #
6309 .ifdef _HAVE_OPENSSL
6310 tls_require_ciphers = HIGH:!aNULL:@STRENGTH
6311 .endif
6312 .ifdef _HAVE_GNUTLS
6313 tls_require_ciphers = SECURE192:-VERS-SSL3.0:-VERS-TLS1.0:-VERS-TLS1.1
6314 .endif
6315 .endif
6316 .ifdef _HAVE_PRDR
6317 hosts_try_prdr = *
6318 .endif
6319 .endd
6320 After the same &%message_size_limit%& hack, we then specify that this Transport
6321 can handle messages to multiple domains in one run. The assumption here is
6322 that you're routing all non-local mail to the same place and that place is
6323 happy to take all messages from you as quickly as possible.
6324 All other options depend upon built-in macros; if Exim was built without TLS support
6325 then no other options are defined.
6326 If TLS is available, then we configure "stronger than default" TLS ciphersuites
6327 and versions using the &%tls_require_ciphers%& option, where the value to be
6328 used depends upon the library providing TLS.
6329 Beyond that, the options adopt the stance that you should have TLS support available
6330 from your smarthost on today's Internet, so we turn on requiring TLS for the
6331 mail to be delivered, and requiring that the certificate be valid, and match
6332 the expected hostname. The &%tls_sni%& option can be used by service providers
6333 to select an appropriate certificate to present to you and here we re-use the
6334 ROUTER_SMARTHOST macro, because that is unaffected by CNAMEs present in DNS.
6335 You want to specify the hostname which you'll expect to validate for, and that
6336 should not be subject to insecure tampering via DNS results.
6337
6338 For the &%hosts_try_prdr%& option see the previous transport.
6339
6340 All other options are defaulted.
6341 .code
6342 local_delivery:
6343 driver = appendfile
6344 file = /var/mail/$local_part
6345 delivery_date_add
6346 envelope_to_add
6347 return_path_add
6348 # group = mail
6349 # mode = 0660
6350 .endd
6351 This &(appendfile)& transport is used for local delivery to user mailboxes in
6352 traditional BSD mailbox format. By default it runs under the uid and gid of the
6353 local user, which requires the sticky bit to be set on the &_/var/mail_&
6354 directory. Some systems use the alternative approach of running mail deliveries
6355 under a particular group instead of using the sticky bit. The commented options
6356 show how this can be done.
6357
6358 Exim adds three headers to the message as it delivers it: &'Delivery-date:'&,
6359 &'Envelope-to:'& and &'Return-path:'&. This action is requested by the three
6360 similarly-named options above.
6361 .code
6362 address_pipe:
6363 driver = pipe
6364 return_output
6365 .endd
6366 This transport is used for handling deliveries to pipes that are generated by
6367 redirection (aliasing or users' &_.forward_& files). The &%return_output%&
6368 option specifies that any output on stdout or stderr generated by the pipe is to
6369 be returned to the sender.
6370 .code
6371 address_file:
6372 driver = appendfile
6373 delivery_date_add
6374 envelope_to_add
6375 return_path_add
6376 .endd
6377 This transport is used for handling deliveries to files that are generated by
6378 redirection. The name of the file is not specified in this instance of
6379 &(appendfile)&, because it comes from the &(redirect)& router.
6380 .code
6381 address_reply:
6382 driver = autoreply
6383 .endd
6384 This transport is used for handling automatic replies generated by users'
6385 filter files.
6386
6387
6388
6389 .section "Default retry rule" "SECID57"
6390 .cindex "retry" "default rule"
6391 .cindex "default" "retry rule"
6392 The retry section of the configuration file contains rules which affect the way
6393 Exim retries deliveries that cannot be completed at the first attempt. It is
6394 introduced by the line
6395 .code
6396 begin retry
6397 .endd
6398 In the default configuration, there is just one rule, which applies to all
6399 errors:
6400 .code
6401 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,4d,6h
6402 .endd
6403 This causes any temporarily failing address to be retried every 15 minutes for
6404 2 hours, then at intervals starting at one hour and increasing by a factor of
6405 1.5 until 16 hours have passed, then every 6 hours up to 4 days. If an address
6406 is not delivered after 4 days of temporary failure, it is bounced. The time is
6407 measured from first failure, not from the time the message was received.
6408
6409 If the retry section is removed from the configuration, or is empty (that is,
6410 if no retry rules are defined), Exim will not retry deliveries. This turns
6411 temporary errors into permanent errors.
6412
6413
6414 .section "Rewriting configuration" "SECID58"
6415 The rewriting section of the configuration, introduced by
6416 .code
6417 begin rewrite
6418 .endd
6419 contains rules for rewriting addresses in messages as they arrive. There are no
6420 rewriting rules in the default configuration file.
6421
6422
6423
6424 .section "Authenticators configuration" "SECTdefconfauth"
6425 .cindex "AUTH" "configuration"
6426 The authenticators section of the configuration, introduced by
6427 .code
6428 begin authenticators
6429 .endd
6430 defines mechanisms for the use of the SMTP AUTH command. The default
6431 configuration file contains two commented-out example authenticators
6432 which support plaintext username/password authentication using the
6433 standard PLAIN mechanism and the traditional but non-standard LOGIN
6434 mechanism, with Exim acting as the server. PLAIN and LOGIN are enough
6435 to support most MUA software.
6436
6437 The example PLAIN authenticator looks like this:
6438 .code
6439 #PLAIN:
6440 # driver = plaintext
6441 # server_set_id = $auth2
6442 # server_prompts = :
6443 # server_condition = Authentication is not yet configured
6444 # server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_in_cipher }
6445 .endd
6446 And the example LOGIN authenticator looks like this:
6447 .code
6448 #LOGIN:
6449 # driver = plaintext
6450 # server_set_id = $auth1
6451 # server_prompts = <| Username: | Password:
6452 # server_condition = Authentication is not yet configured
6453 # server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_in_cipher }
6454 .endd
6455
6456 The &%server_set_id%& option makes Exim remember the authenticated username
6457 in &$authenticated_id$&, which can be used later in ACLs or routers. The
6458 &%server_prompts%& option configures the &(plaintext)& authenticator so
6459 that it implements the details of the specific authentication mechanism,
6460 i.e. PLAIN or LOGIN. The &%server_advertise_condition%& setting controls
6461 when Exim offers authentication to clients; in the examples, this is only
6462 when TLS or SSL has been started, so to enable the authenticators you also
6463 need to add support for TLS as described in section &<<SECTdefconfmain>>&.
6464
6465 The &%server_condition%& setting defines how to verify that the username and
6466 password are correct. In the examples it just produces an error message.
6467 To make the authenticators work, you can use a string expansion
6468 expression like one of the examples in chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>&.
6469
6470 Beware that the sequence of the parameters to PLAIN and LOGIN differ; the
6471 usercode and password are in different positions.
6472 Chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>& covers both.
6473
6474 .ecindex IIDconfiwal
6475
6476
6477
6478 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6479 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6480
6481 .chapter "Regular expressions" "CHAPregexp"
6482
6483 .cindex "regular expressions" "library"
6484 .cindex "PCRE"
6485 Exim supports the use of regular expressions in many of its options. It
6486 uses the PCRE regular expression library; this provides regular expression
6487 matching that is compatible with Perl 5. The syntax and semantics of
6488 regular expressions is discussed in
6489 online Perl manpages, in
6490 many Perl reference books, and also in
6491 Jeffrey Friedl's &'Mastering Regular Expressions'&, which is published by
6492 O'Reilly (see &url(http://www.oreilly.com/catalog/regex2/)).
6493 . --- the http: URL here redirects to another page with the ISBN in the URL
6494 . --- where trying to use https: just redirects back to http:, so sticking
6495 . --- to the old URL for now. 2018-09-07.
6496
6497 The documentation for the syntax and semantics of the regular expressions that
6498 are supported by PCRE is included in the PCRE distribution, and no further
6499 description is included here. The PCRE functions are called from Exim using
6500 the default option settings (that is, with no PCRE options set), except that
6501 the PCRE_CASELESS option is set when the matching is required to be
6502 case-insensitive.
6503
6504 In most cases, when a regular expression is required in an Exim configuration,
6505 it has to start with a circumflex, in order to distinguish it from plain text
6506 or an &"ends with"& wildcard. In this example of a configuration setting, the
6507 second item in the colon-separated list is a regular expression.
6508 .code
6509 domains = a.b.c : ^\\d{3} : *.y.z : ...
6510 .endd
6511 The doubling of the backslash is required because of string expansion that
6512 precedes interpretation &-- see section &<<SECTlittext>>& for more discussion
6513 of this issue, and a way of avoiding the need for doubling backslashes. The
6514 regular expression that is eventually used in this example contains just one
6515 backslash. The circumflex is included in the regular expression, and has the
6516 normal effect of &"anchoring"& it to the start of the string that is being
6517 matched.
6518
6519 There are, however, two cases where a circumflex is not required for the
6520 recognition of a regular expression: these are the &%match%& condition in a
6521 string expansion, and the &%matches%& condition in an Exim filter file. In
6522 these cases, the relevant string is always treated as a regular expression; if
6523 it does not start with a circumflex, the expression is not anchored, and can
6524 match anywhere in the subject string.
6525
6526 In all cases, if you want a regular expression to match at the end of a string,
6527 you must code the $ metacharacter to indicate this. For example:
6528 .code
6529 domains = ^\\d{3}\\.example
6530 .endd
6531 matches the domain &'123.example'&, but it also matches &'123.example.com'&.
6532 You need to use:
6533 .code
6534 domains = ^\\d{3}\\.example\$
6535 .endd
6536 if you want &'example'& to be the top-level domain. The backslash before the
6537 $ is needed because string expansion also interprets dollar characters.
6538
6539
6540
6541 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6542 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6543
6544 .chapter "File and database lookups" "CHAPfdlookup"
6545 .scindex IIDfidalo1 "file" "lookups"
6546 .scindex IIDfidalo2 "database" "lookups"
6547 .cindex "lookup" "description of"
6548 Exim can be configured to look up data in files or databases as it processes
6549 messages. Two different kinds of syntax are used:
6550
6551 .olist
6552 A string that is to be expanded may contain explicit lookup requests. These
6553 cause parts of the string to be replaced by data that is obtained from the
6554 lookup. Lookups of this type are conditional expansion items. Different results
6555 can be defined for the cases of lookup success and failure. See chapter
6556 &<<CHAPexpand>>&, where string expansions are described in detail.
6557 The key for the lookup is specified as part of the string expansion.
6558 .next
6559 Lists of domains, hosts, and email addresses can contain lookup requests as a
6560 way of avoiding excessively long linear lists. In this case, the data that is
6561 returned by the lookup is often (but not always) discarded; whether the lookup
6562 succeeds or fails is what really counts. These kinds of list are described in
6563 chapter &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>&.
6564 The key for the lookup is given by the context in which the list is expanded.
6565 .endlist
6566
6567 String expansions, lists, and lookups interact with each other in such a way
6568 that there is no order in which to describe any one of them that does not
6569 involve references to the others. Each of these three chapters makes more sense
6570 if you have read the other two first. If you are reading this for the first
6571 time, be aware that some of it will make a lot more sense after you have read
6572 chapters &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>& and &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
6573
6574 .section "Examples of different lookup syntax" "SECID60"
6575 It is easy to confuse the two different kinds of lookup, especially as the
6576 lists that may contain the second kind are always expanded before being
6577 processed as lists. Therefore, they may also contain lookups of the first kind.
6578 Be careful to distinguish between the following two examples:
6579 .code
6580 domains = ${lookup{$sender_host_address}lsearch{/some/file}}
6581 domains = lsearch;/some/file
6582 .endd
6583 The first uses a string expansion, the result of which must be a domain list.
6584 No strings have been specified for a successful or a failing lookup; the
6585 defaults in this case are the looked-up data and an empty string, respectively.
6586 The expansion takes place before the string is processed as a list, and the
6587 file that is searched could contain lines like this:
6588 .code
6589 192.168.3.4: domain1:domain2:...
6590 192.168.1.9: domain3:domain4:...
6591 .endd
6592 When the lookup succeeds, the result of the expansion is a list of domains (and
6593 possibly other types of item that are allowed in domain lists).
6594
6595 In the second example, the lookup is a single item in a domain list. It causes
6596 Exim to use a lookup to see if the domain that is being processed can be found
6597 in the file. The file could contains lines like this:
6598 .code
6599 domain1:
6600 domain2:
6601 .endd
6602 Any data that follows the keys is not relevant when checking that the domain
6603 matches the list item.
6604
6605 It is possible, though no doubt confusing, to use both kinds of lookup at once.
6606 Consider a file containing lines like this:
6607 .code
6608 192.168.5.6: lsearch;/another/file
6609 .endd
6610 If the value of &$sender_host_address$& is 192.168.5.6, expansion of the
6611 first &%domains%& setting above generates the second setting, which therefore
6612 causes a second lookup to occur.
6613
6614 The rest of this chapter describes the different lookup types that are
6615 available. Any of them can be used in any part of the configuration where a
6616 lookup is permitted.
6617
6618
6619 .section "Lookup types" "SECID61"
6620 .cindex "lookup" "types of"
6621 .cindex "single-key lookup" "definition of"
6622 Two different types of data lookup are implemented:
6623
6624 .ilist
6625 The &'single-key'& type requires the specification of a file in which to look,
6626 and a single key to search for. The key must be a non-empty string for the
6627 lookup to succeed. The lookup type determines how the file is searched.
6628 .next
6629 .cindex "query-style lookup" "definition of"
6630 The &'query-style'& type accepts a generalized database query. No particular
6631 key value is assumed by Exim for query-style lookups. You can use whichever
6632 Exim variables you need to construct the database query.
6633 .endlist
6634
6635 The code for each lookup type is in a separate source file that is included in
6636 the binary of Exim only if the corresponding compile-time option is set. The
6637 default settings in &_src/EDITME_& are:
6638 .code
6639 LOOKUP_DBM=yes
6640 LOOKUP_LSEARCH=yes
6641 .endd
6642 which means that only linear searching and DBM lookups are included by default.
6643 For some types of lookup (e.g. SQL databases), you need to install appropriate
6644 libraries and header files before building Exim.
6645
6646
6647
6648
6649 .section "Single-key lookup types" "SECTsinglekeylookups"
6650 .cindex "lookup" "single-key types"
6651 .cindex "single-key lookup" "list of types"
6652 The following single-key lookup types are implemented:
6653
6654 .ilist
6655 .cindex "cdb" "description of"
6656 .cindex "lookup" "cdb"
6657 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6658 &(cdb)&: The given file is searched as a Constant DataBase file, using the key
6659 string without a terminating binary zero. The cdb format is designed for
6660 indexed files that are read frequently and never updated, except by total
6661 re-creation. As such, it is particularly suitable for large files containing
6662 aliases or other indexed data referenced by an MTA. Information about cdb and
6663 tools for building the files can be found in several places:
6664 .display
6665 &url(https://cr.yp.to/cdb.html)
6666 &url(http://www.corpit.ru/mjt/tinycdb.html)
6667 &url(https://packages.debian.org/stable/utils/freecdb)
6668 &url(https://github.com/philpennock/cdbtools) (in Go)
6669 .endd
6670 . --- 2018-09-07: corpit.ru http:-only
6671 A cdb distribution is not needed in order to build Exim with cdb support,
6672 because the code for reading cdb files is included directly in Exim itself.
6673 However, no means of building or testing cdb files is provided with Exim, so
6674 you need to obtain a cdb distribution in order to do this.
6675 .next
6676 .cindex "DBM" "lookup type"
6677 .cindex "lookup" "dbm"
6678 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6679 &(dbm)&: Calls to DBM library functions are used to extract data from the given
6680 DBM file by looking up the record with the given key. A terminating binary
6681 zero is included in the key that is passed to the DBM library. See section
6682 &<<SECTdb>>& for a discussion of DBM libraries.
6683
6684 .cindex "Berkeley DB library" "file format"
6685 For all versions of Berkeley DB, Exim uses the DB_HASH style of database
6686 when building DBM files using the &%exim_dbmbuild%& utility. However, when
6687 using Berkeley DB versions 3 or 4, it opens existing databases for reading with
6688 the DB_UNKNOWN option. This enables it to handle any of the types of database
6689 that the library supports, and can be useful for accessing DBM files created by
6690 other applications. (For earlier DB versions, DB_HASH is always used.)
6691 .next
6692 .cindex "lookup" "dbmjz"
6693 .cindex "lookup" "dbm &-- embedded NULs"
6694 .cindex "sasldb2"
6695 .cindex "dbmjz lookup type"
6696 &(dbmjz)&: This is the same as &(dbm)&, except that the lookup key is
6697 interpreted as an Exim list; the elements of the list are joined together with
6698 ASCII NUL characters to form the lookup key. An example usage would be to
6699 authenticate incoming SMTP calls using the passwords from Cyrus SASL's
6700 &_/etc/sasldb2_& file with the &(gsasl)& authenticator or Exim's own
6701 &(cram_md5)& authenticator.
6702 .next
6703 .cindex "lookup" "dbmnz"
6704 .cindex "lookup" "dbm &-- terminating zero"
6705 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6706 .cindex "Courier"
6707 .cindex "&_/etc/userdbshadow.dat_&"
6708 .cindex "dbmnz lookup type"
6709 &(dbmnz)&: This is the same as &(dbm)&, except that a terminating binary zero
6710 is not included in the key that is passed to the DBM library. You may need this
6711 if you want to look up data in files that are created by or shared with some
6712 other application that does not use terminating zeros. For example, you need to
6713 use &(dbmnz)& rather than &(dbm)& if you want to authenticate incoming SMTP
6714 calls using the passwords from Courier's &_/etc/userdbshadow.dat_& file. Exim's
6715 utility program for creating DBM files (&'exim_dbmbuild'&) includes the zeros
6716 by default, but has an option to omit them (see section &<<SECTdbmbuild>>&).
6717 .next
6718 .cindex "lookup" "dsearch"
6719 .cindex "dsearch lookup type"
6720 &(dsearch)&: The given file must be a directory; this is searched for an entry
6721 whose name is the key by calling the &[lstat()]& function. The key may not
6722 contain any forward slash characters. If &[lstat()]& succeeds, the result of
6723 the lookup is the name of the entry, which may be a file, directory,
6724 symbolic link, or any other kind of directory entry. An example of how this
6725 lookup can be used to support virtual domains is given in section
6726 &<<SECTvirtualdomains>>&.
6727 .next
6728 .cindex "lookup" "iplsearch"
6729 .cindex "iplsearch lookup type"
6730 &(iplsearch)&: The given file is a text file containing keys and data. A key is
6731 terminated by a colon or white space or the end of the line. The keys in the
6732 file must be IP addresses, or IP addresses with CIDR masks. Keys that involve
6733 IPv6 addresses must be enclosed in quotes to prevent the first internal colon
6734 being interpreted as a key terminator. For example:
6735 .code
6736 1.2.3.4: data for 1.2.3.4
6737 192.168.0.0/16: data for 192.168.0.0/16
6738 "abcd::cdab": data for abcd::cdab
6739 "abcd:abcd::/32" data for abcd:abcd::/32
6740 .endd
6741 The key for an &(iplsearch)& lookup must be an IP address (without a mask). The
6742 file is searched linearly, using the CIDR masks where present, until a matching
6743 key is found. The first key that matches is used; there is no attempt to find a
6744 &"best"& match. Apart from the way the keys are matched, the processing for
6745 &(iplsearch)& is the same as for &(lsearch)&.
6746
6747 &*Warning 1*&: Unlike most other single-key lookup types, a file of data for
6748 &(iplsearch)& can &'not'& be turned into a DBM or cdb file, because those
6749 lookup types support only literal keys.
6750
6751 &*Warning 2*&: In a host list, you must always use &(net-iplsearch)& so that
6752 the implicit key is the host's IP address rather than its name (see section
6753 &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&).
6754
6755 .new
6756 &*Warning 3*&: Do not use an IPv4-mapped IPv6 address for a key; use the
6757 IPv4, in dotted-quad form. (Exim converts IPv4-mapped IPv6 addresses to this
6758 notation before executing the lookup.)
6759 .wen
6760 .next
6761 .new
6762 .cindex lookup json
6763 .cindex json "lookup type"
6764 .cindex JSON expansions
6765 &(json)&: The given file is a text file with a JSON structure.
6766 An element of the structure is extracted, defined by the search key.
6767 The key is a list of subelement selectors
6768 (colon-separated by default but changeable in the usual way)
6769 which are applied in turn to select smaller and smaller portions
6770 of the JSON structure.
6771 If a selector is numeric, it must apply to a JSON array; the (zero-based)
6772 nunbered array element is selected.
6773 Otherwise it must apply to a JSON object; the named element is selected.
6774 The final resulting element can be a simple JSON type or a JSON object
6775 or array; for the latter two a string-representation os the JSON
6776 is returned.
6777 For elements of type string, the returned value is de-quoted.
6778 .wen
6779 .next
6780 .cindex "linear search"
6781 .cindex "lookup" "lsearch"
6782 .cindex "lsearch lookup type"
6783 .cindex "case sensitivity" "in lsearch lookup"
6784 &(lsearch)&: The given file is a text file that is searched linearly for a
6785 line beginning with the search key, terminated by a colon or white space or the
6786 end of the line. The search is case-insensitive; that is, upper and lower case
6787 letters are treated as the same. The first occurrence of the key that is found
6788 in the file is used.
6789
6790 White space between the key and the colon is permitted. The remainder of the
6791 line, with leading and trailing white space removed, is the data. This can be
6792 continued onto subsequent lines by starting them with any amount of white
6793 space, but only a single space character is included in the data at such a
6794 junction. If the data begins with a colon, the key must be terminated by a
6795 colon, for example:
6796 .code
6797 baduser: :fail:
6798 .endd
6799 Empty lines and lines beginning with # are ignored, even if they occur in the
6800 middle of an item. This is the traditional textual format of alias files. Note
6801 that the keys in an &(lsearch)& file are literal strings. There is no
6802 wildcarding of any kind.
6803
6804 .cindex "lookup" "lsearch &-- colons in keys"
6805 .cindex "white space" "in lsearch key"
6806 In most &(lsearch)& files, keys are not required to contain colons or #
6807 characters, or white space. However, if you need this feature, it is available.
6808 If a key begins with a doublequote character, it is terminated only by a
6809 matching quote (or end of line), and the normal escaping rules apply to its
6810 contents (see section &<<SECTstrings>>&). An optional colon is permitted after
6811 quoted keys (exactly as for unquoted keys). There is no special handling of
6812 quotes for the data part of an &(lsearch)& line.
6813
6814 .next
6815 .cindex "NIS lookup type"
6816 .cindex "lookup" "NIS"
6817 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6818 &(nis)&: The given file is the name of a NIS map, and a NIS lookup is done with
6819 the given key, without a terminating binary zero. There is a variant called
6820 &(nis0)& which does include the terminating binary zero in the key. This is
6821 reportedly needed for Sun-style alias files. Exim does not recognize NIS
6822 aliases; the full map names must be used.
6823
6824 .next
6825 .cindex "wildlsearch lookup type"
6826 .cindex "lookup" "wildlsearch"
6827 .cindex "nwildlsearch lookup type"
6828 .cindex "lookup" "nwildlsearch"
6829 &(wildlsearch)& or &(nwildlsearch)&: These search a file linearly, like
6830 &(lsearch)&, but instead of being interpreted as a literal string, each key in
6831 the file may be wildcarded. The difference between these two lookup types is
6832 that for &(wildlsearch)&, each key in the file is string-expanded before being
6833 used, whereas for &(nwildlsearch)&, no expansion takes place.
6834
6835 .cindex "case sensitivity" "in (n)wildlsearch lookup"
6836 Like &(lsearch)&, the testing is done case-insensitively. However, keys in the
6837 file that are regular expressions can be made case-sensitive by the use of
6838 &`(-i)`& within the pattern. The following forms of wildcard are recognized:
6839
6840 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
6841 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
6842
6843 .olist
6844 The string may begin with an asterisk to mean &"ends with"&. For example:
6845 .code
6846 *.a.b.c data for anything.a.b.c
6847 *fish data for anythingfish
6848 .endd
6849 .next
6850 The string may begin with a circumflex to indicate a regular expression. For
6851 example, for &(wildlsearch)&:
6852 .code
6853 ^\N\d+\.a\.b\N data for <digits>.a.b
6854 .endd
6855 Note the use of &`\N`& to disable expansion of the contents of the regular
6856 expression. If you are using &(nwildlsearch)&, where the keys are not
6857 string-expanded, the equivalent entry is:
6858 .code
6859 ^\d+\.a\.b data for <digits>.a.b
6860 .endd
6861 The case-insensitive flag is set at the start of compiling the regular
6862 expression, but it can be turned off by using &`(-i)`& at an appropriate point.
6863 For example, to make the entire pattern case-sensitive:
6864 .code
6865 ^(?-i)\d+\.a\.b data for <digits>.a.b
6866 .endd
6867
6868 If the regular expression contains white space or colon characters, you must
6869 either quote it (see &(lsearch)& above), or represent these characters in other
6870 ways. For example, &`\s`& can be used for white space and &`\x3A`& for a
6871 colon. This may be easier than quoting, because if you quote, you have to
6872 escape all the backslashes inside the quotes.
6873
6874 &*Note*&: It is not possible to capture substrings in a regular expression
6875 match for later use, because the results of all lookups are cached. If a lookup
6876 is repeated, the result is taken from the cache, and no actual pattern matching
6877 takes place. The values of all the numeric variables are unset after a
6878 &((n)wildlsearch)& match.
6879
6880 .next
6881 Although I cannot see it being of much use, the general matching function that
6882 is used to implement &((n)wildlsearch)& means that the string may begin with a
6883 lookup name terminated by a semicolon, and followed by lookup data. For
6884 example:
6885 .code
6886 cdb;/some/file data for keys that match the file
6887 .endd
6888 The data that is obtained from the nested lookup is discarded.
6889 .endlist olist
6890
6891 Keys that do not match any of these patterns are interpreted literally. The
6892 continuation rules for the data are the same as for &(lsearch)&, and keys may
6893 be followed by optional colons.
6894
6895 &*Warning*&: Unlike most other single-key lookup types, a file of data for
6896 &((n)wildlsearch)& can &'not'& be turned into a DBM or cdb file, because those
6897 lookup types support only literal keys.
6898
6899 .next
6900 .cindex "lookup" "spf"
6901 If Exim is built with SPF support, manual lookups can be done
6902 (as opposed to the standard ACL condition method.
6903 For details see section &<<SECSPF>>&.
6904 .endlist ilist
6905
6906
6907 .section "Query-style lookup types" "SECTquerystylelookups"
6908 .cindex "lookup" "query-style types"
6909 .cindex "query-style lookup" "list of types"
6910 The supported query-style lookup types are listed below. Further details about
6911 many of them are given in later sections.
6912
6913 .ilist
6914 .cindex "DNS" "as a lookup type"
6915 .cindex "lookup" "DNS"
6916 &(dnsdb)&: This does a DNS search for one or more records whose domain names
6917 are given in the supplied query. The resulting data is the contents of the
6918 records. See section &<<SECTdnsdb>>&.
6919 .next
6920 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
6921 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
6922 &(ibase)&: This does a lookup in an InterBase database.
6923 .next
6924 .cindex "LDAP" "lookup type"
6925 .cindex "lookup" "LDAP"
6926 &(ldap)&: This does an LDAP lookup using a query in the form of a URL, and
6927 returns attributes from a single entry. There is a variant called &(ldapm)&
6928 that permits values from multiple entries to be returned. A third variant
6929 called &(ldapdn)& returns the Distinguished Name of a single entry instead of
6930 any attribute values. See section &<<SECTldap>>&.
6931 .next
6932 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
6933 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
6934 &(mysql)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to a
6935 MySQL database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6936 .next
6937 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type"
6938 .cindex "lookup" "NIS+"
6939 &(nisplus)&: This does a NIS+ lookup using a query that can specify the name of
6940 the field to be returned. See section &<<SECTnisplus>>&.
6941 .next
6942 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
6943 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
6944 &(oracle)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to an
6945 Oracle database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6946 .next
6947 .cindex "lookup" "passwd"
6948 .cindex "passwd lookup type"
6949 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&"
6950 &(passwd)& is a query-style lookup with queries that are just user names. The
6951 lookup calls &[getpwnam()]& to interrogate the system password data, and on
6952 success, the result string is the same as you would get from an &(lsearch)&
6953 lookup on a traditional &_/etc/passwd file_&, though with &`*`& for the
6954 password value. For example:
6955 .code
6956 *:42:42:King Rat:/home/kr:/bin/bash
6957 .endd
6958 .next
6959 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
6960 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
6961 &(pgsql)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to a
6962 PostgreSQL database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6963
6964 .next
6965 .cindex "Redis lookup type"
6966 .cindex lookup Redis
6967 &(redis)&: The format of the query is either a simple get or simple set,
6968 passed to a Redis database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6969
6970 .next
6971 .cindex "sqlite lookup type"
6972 .cindex "lookup" "sqlite"
6973 &(sqlite)&: The format of the query is a filename followed by an SQL statement
6974 that is passed to an SQLite database. See section &<<SECTsqlite>>&.
6975
6976 .next
6977 &(testdb)&: This is a lookup type that is used for testing Exim. It is
6978 not likely to be useful in normal operation.
6979 .next
6980 .cindex "whoson lookup type"
6981 .cindex "lookup" "whoson"
6982 . --- still http:-only, 2018-09-07
6983 &(whoson)&: &'Whoson'& (&url(http://whoson.sourceforge.net)) is a protocol that
6984 allows a server to check whether a particular (dynamically allocated) IP
6985 address is currently allocated to a known (trusted) user and, optionally, to
6986 obtain the identity of the said user. For SMTP servers, &'Whoson'& was popular
6987 at one time for &"POP before SMTP"& authentication, but that approach has been
6988 superseded by SMTP authentication. In Exim, &'Whoson'& can be used to implement
6989 &"POP before SMTP"& checking using ACL statements such as
6990 .code
6991 require condition = \
6992 ${lookup whoson {$sender_host_address}{yes}{no}}
6993 .endd
6994 The query consists of a single IP address. The value returned is the name of
6995 the authenticated user, which is stored in the variable &$value$&. However, in
6996 this example, the data in &$value$& is not used; the result of the lookup is
6997 one of the fixed strings &"yes"& or &"no"&.
6998 .endlist
6999
7000
7001
7002 .section "Temporary errors in lookups" "SECID63"
7003 .cindex "lookup" "temporary error in"
7004 Lookup functions can return temporary error codes if the lookup cannot be
7005 completed. For example, an SQL or LDAP database might be unavailable. For this
7006 reason, it is not advisable to use a lookup that might do this for critical
7007 options such as a list of local domains.
7008
7009 When a lookup cannot be completed in a router or transport, delivery
7010 of the message (to the relevant address) is deferred, as for any other
7011 temporary error. In other circumstances Exim may assume the lookup has failed,
7012 or may give up altogether.
7013
7014
7015
7016 .section "Default values in single-key lookups" "SECTdefaultvaluelookups"
7017 .cindex "wildcard lookups"
7018 .cindex "lookup" "default values"
7019 .cindex "lookup" "wildcard"
7020 .cindex "lookup" "* added to type"
7021 .cindex "default" "in single-key lookups"
7022 In this context, a &"default value"& is a value specified by the administrator
7023 that is to be used if a lookup fails.
7024
7025 &*Note:*& This section applies only to single-key lookups. For query-style
7026 lookups, the facilities of the query language must be used. An attempt to
7027 specify a default for a query-style lookup provokes an error.
7028
7029 If &"*"& is added to a single-key lookup type (for example, &%lsearch*%&)
7030 and the initial lookup fails, the key &"*"& is looked up in the file to
7031 provide a default value. See also the section on partial matching below.
7032
7033 .cindex "*@ with single-key lookup"
7034 .cindex "lookup" "*@ added to type"
7035 .cindex "alias file" "per-domain default"
7036 Alternatively, if &"*@"& is added to a single-key lookup type (for example
7037 &%dbm*@%&) then, if the initial lookup fails and the key contains an @
7038 character, a second lookup is done with everything before the last @ replaced
7039 by *. This makes it possible to provide per-domain defaults in alias files
7040 that include the domains in the keys. If the second lookup fails (or doesn't
7041 take place because there is no @ in the key), &"*"& is looked up.
7042 For example, a &(redirect)& router might contain:
7043 .code
7044 data = ${lookup{$local_part@$domain}lsearch*@{/etc/mix-aliases}}
7045 .endd
7046 Suppose the address that is being processed is &'jane@eyre.example'&. Exim
7047 looks up these keys, in this order:
7048 .code
7049 jane@eyre.example
7050 *@eyre.example
7051 *
7052 .endd
7053 The data is taken from whichever key it finds first. &*Note*&: In an
7054 &(lsearch)& file, this does not mean the first of these keys in the file. A
7055 complete scan is done for each key, and only if it is not found at all does
7056 Exim move on to try the next key.
7057
7058
7059
7060 .section "Partial matching in single-key lookups" "SECTpartiallookup"
7061 .cindex "partial matching"
7062 .cindex "wildcard lookups"
7063 .cindex "lookup" "partial matching"
7064 .cindex "lookup" "wildcard"
7065 .cindex "asterisk" "in search type"
7066 The normal operation of a single-key lookup is to search the file for an exact
7067 match with the given key. However, in a number of situations where domains are
7068 being looked up, it is useful to be able to do partial matching. In this case,
7069 information in the file that has a key starting with &"*."& is matched by any
7070 domain that ends with the components that follow the full stop. For example, if
7071 a key in a DBM file is
7072 .code
7073 *.dates.fict.example
7074 .endd
7075 then when partial matching is enabled this is matched by (amongst others)
7076 &'2001.dates.fict.example'& and &'1984.dates.fict.example'&. It is also matched
7077 by &'dates.fict.example'&, if that does not appear as a separate key in the
7078 file.
7079
7080 &*Note*&: Partial matching is not available for query-style lookups. It is
7081 also not available for any lookup items in address lists (see section
7082 &<<SECTaddresslist>>&).
7083
7084 Partial matching is implemented by doing a series of separate lookups using
7085 keys constructed by modifying the original subject key. This means that it can
7086 be used with any of the single-key lookup types, provided that
7087 partial matching keys
7088 beginning with a special prefix (default &"*."&) are included in the data file.
7089 Keys in the file that do not begin with the prefix are matched only by
7090 unmodified subject keys when partial matching is in use.
7091
7092 Partial matching is requested by adding the string &"partial-"& to the front of
7093 the name of a single-key lookup type, for example, &%partial-dbm%&. When this
7094 is done, the subject key is first looked up unmodified; if that fails, &"*."&
7095 is added at the start of the subject key, and it is looked up again. If that
7096 fails, further lookups are tried with dot-separated components removed from the
7097 start of the subject key, one-by-one, and &"*."& added on the front of what
7098 remains.
7099
7100 A minimum number of two non-* components are required. This can be adjusted
7101 by including a number before the hyphen in the search type. For example,
7102 &%partial3-lsearch%& specifies a minimum of three non-* components in the
7103 modified keys. Omitting the number is equivalent to &"partial2-"&. If the
7104 subject key is &'2250.dates.fict.example'& then the following keys are looked
7105 up when the minimum number of non-* components is two:
7106 .code
7107 2250.dates.fict.example
7108 *.2250.dates.fict.example
7109 *.dates.fict.example
7110 *.fict.example
7111 .endd
7112 As soon as one key in the sequence is successfully looked up, the lookup
7113 finishes.
7114
7115 .cindex "lookup" "partial matching &-- changing prefix"
7116 .cindex "prefix" "for partial matching"
7117 The use of &"*."& as the partial matching prefix is a default that can be
7118 changed. The motivation for this feature is to allow Exim to operate with file
7119 formats that are used by other MTAs. A different prefix can be supplied in
7120 parentheses instead of the hyphen after &"partial"&. For example:
7121 .code
7122 domains = partial(.)lsearch;/some/file
7123 .endd
7124 In this example, if the domain is &'a.b.c'&, the sequence of lookups is
7125 &`a.b.c`&, &`.a.b.c`&, and &`.b.c`& (the default minimum of 2 non-wild
7126 components is unchanged). The prefix may consist of any punctuation characters
7127 other than a closing parenthesis. It may be empty, for example:
7128 .code
7129 domains = partial1()cdb;/some/file
7130 .endd
7131 For this example, if the domain is &'a.b.c'&, the sequence of lookups is
7132 &`a.b.c`&, &`b.c`&, and &`c`&.
7133
7134 If &"partial0"& is specified, what happens at the end (when the lookup with
7135 just one non-wild component has failed, and the original key is shortened right
7136 down to the null string) depends on the prefix:
7137
7138 .ilist
7139 If the prefix has zero length, the whole lookup fails.
7140 .next
7141 If the prefix has length 1, a lookup for just the prefix is done. For
7142 example, the final lookup for &"partial0(.)"& is for &`.`& alone.
7143 .next
7144 Otherwise, if the prefix ends in a dot, the dot is removed, and the
7145 remainder is looked up. With the default prefix, therefore, the final lookup is
7146 for &"*"& on its own.
7147 .next
7148 Otherwise, the whole prefix is looked up.
7149 .endlist
7150
7151
7152 If the search type ends in &"*"& or &"*@"& (see section
7153 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>& above), the search for an ultimate default that
7154 this implies happens after all partial lookups have failed. If &"partial0"& is
7155 specified, adding &"*"& to the search type has no effect with the default
7156 prefix, because the &"*"& key is already included in the sequence of partial
7157 lookups. However, there might be a use for lookup types such as
7158 &"partial0(.)lsearch*"&.
7159
7160 The use of &"*"& in lookup partial matching differs from its use as a wildcard
7161 in domain lists and the like. Partial matching works only in terms of
7162 dot-separated components; a key such as &`*fict.example`&
7163 in a database file is useless, because the asterisk in a partial matching
7164 subject key is always followed by a dot.
7165
7166
7167
7168
7169 .section "Lookup caching" "SECID64"
7170 .cindex "lookup" "caching"
7171 .cindex "caching" "lookup data"
7172 Exim caches all lookup results in order to avoid needless repetition of
7173 lookups. However, because (apart from the daemon) Exim operates as a collection
7174 of independent, short-lived processes, this caching applies only within a
7175 single Exim process. There is no inter-process lookup caching facility.
7176
7177 For single-key lookups, Exim keeps the relevant files open in case there is
7178 another lookup that needs them. In some types of configuration this can lead to
7179 many files being kept open for messages with many recipients. To avoid hitting
7180 the operating system limit on the number of simultaneously open files, Exim
7181 closes the least recently used file when it needs to open more files than its
7182 own internal limit, which can be changed via the &%lookup_open_max%& option.
7183
7184 The single-key lookup files are closed and the lookup caches are flushed at
7185 strategic points during delivery &-- for example, after all routing is
7186 complete.
7187
7188
7189
7190
7191 .section "Quoting lookup data" "SECID65"
7192 .cindex "lookup" "quoting"
7193 .cindex "quoting" "in lookups"
7194 When data from an incoming message is included in a query-style lookup, there
7195 is the possibility of special characters in the data messing up the syntax of
7196 the query. For example, a NIS+ query that contains
7197 .code
7198 [name=$local_part]
7199 .endd
7200 will be broken if the local part happens to contain a closing square bracket.
7201 For NIS+, data can be enclosed in double quotes like this:
7202 .code
7203 [name="$local_part"]
7204 .endd
7205 but this still leaves the problem of a double quote in the data. The rule for
7206 NIS+ is that double quotes must be doubled. Other lookup types have different
7207 rules, and to cope with the differing requirements, an expansion operator
7208 of the following form is provided:
7209 .code
7210 ${quote_<lookup-type>:<string>}
7211 .endd
7212 For example, the safest way to write the NIS+ query is
7213 .code
7214 [name="${quote_nisplus:$local_part}"]
7215 .endd
7216 See chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>& for full coverage of string expansions. The quote
7217 operator can be used for all lookup types, but has no effect for single-key
7218 lookups, since no quoting is ever needed in their key strings.
7219
7220
7221
7222
7223 .section "More about dnsdb" "SECTdnsdb"
7224 .cindex "dnsdb lookup"
7225 .cindex "lookup" "dnsdb"
7226 .cindex "DNS" "as a lookup type"
7227 The &(dnsdb)& lookup type uses the DNS as its database. A simple query consists
7228 of a record type and a domain name, separated by an equals sign. For example,
7229 an expansion string could contain:
7230 .code
7231 ${lookup dnsdb{mx=a.b.example}{$value}fail}
7232 .endd
7233 If the lookup succeeds, the result is placed in &$value$&, which in this case
7234 is used on its own as the result. If the lookup does not succeed, the
7235 &`fail`& keyword causes a &'forced expansion failure'& &-- see section
7236 &<<SECTforexpfai>>& for an explanation of what this means.
7237
7238 The supported DNS record types are A, CNAME, MX, NS, PTR, SOA, SPF, SRV, TLSA
7239 and TXT, and, when Exim is compiled with IPv6 support, AAAA.
7240 If no type is given, TXT is assumed.
7241
7242 For any record type, if multiple records are found, the data is returned as a
7243 concatenation, with newline as the default separator. The order, of course,
7244 depends on the DNS resolver. You can specify a different separator character
7245 between multiple records by putting a right angle-bracket followed immediately
7246 by the new separator at the start of the query. For example:
7247 .code
7248 ${lookup dnsdb{>: a=host1.example}}
7249 .endd
7250 It is permitted to specify a space as the separator character. Further
7251 white space is ignored.
7252 For lookup types that return multiple fields per record,
7253 an alternate field separator can be specified using a comma after the main
7254 separator character, followed immediately by the field separator.
7255
7256 .cindex "PTR record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7257 When the type is PTR,
7258 the data can be an IP address, written as normal; inversion and the addition of
7259 &%in-addr.arpa%& or &%ip6.arpa%& happens automatically. For example:
7260 .code
7261 ${lookup dnsdb{ptr=192.168.4.5}{$value}fail}
7262 .endd
7263 If the data for a PTR record is not a syntactically valid IP address, it is not
7264 altered and nothing is added.
7265
7266 .cindex "MX record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7267 .cindex "SRV record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7268 For an MX lookup, both the preference value and the host name are returned for
7269 each record, separated by a space. For an SRV lookup, the priority, weight,
7270 port, and host name are returned for each record, separated by spaces.
7271 The field separator can be modified as above.
7272
7273 .cindex "TXT record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7274 .cindex "SPF record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7275 For TXT records with multiple items of data, only the first item is returned,
7276 unless a field separator is specified.
7277 To concatenate items without a separator, use a semicolon instead.
7278 For SPF records the
7279 default behaviour is to concatenate multiple items without using a separator.
7280 .code
7281 ${lookup dnsdb{>\n,: txt=a.b.example}}
7282 ${lookup dnsdb{>\n; txt=a.b.example}}
7283 ${lookup dnsdb{spf=example.org}}
7284 .endd
7285 It is permitted to specify a space as the separator character. Further
7286 white space is ignored.
7287
7288 .cindex "SOA record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7289 For an SOA lookup, while no result is obtained the lookup is redone with
7290 successively more leading components dropped from the given domain.
7291 Only the primary-nameserver field is returned unless a field separator is
7292 specified.
7293 .code
7294 ${lookup dnsdb{>:,; soa=a.b.example.com}}
7295 .endd
7296
7297 .section "Dnsdb lookup modifiers" "SECTdnsdb_mod"
7298 .cindex "dnsdb modifiers"
7299 .cindex "modifiers" "dnsdb"
7300 .cindex "options" "dnsdb"
7301 Modifiers for &(dnsdb)& lookups are given by optional keywords,
7302 each followed by a comma,
7303 that may appear before the record type.
7304
7305 The &(dnsdb)& lookup fails only if all the DNS lookups fail. If there is a
7306 temporary DNS error for any of them, the behaviour is controlled by
7307 a defer-option modifier.
7308 The possible keywords are
7309 &"defer_strict"&, &"defer_never"&, and &"defer_lax"&.
7310 With &"strict"& behaviour, any temporary DNS error causes the
7311 whole lookup to defer. With &"never"& behaviour, a temporary DNS error is
7312 ignored, and the behaviour is as if the DNS lookup failed to find anything.
7313 With &"lax"& behaviour, all the queries are attempted, but a temporary DNS
7314 error causes the whole lookup to defer only if none of the other lookups
7315 succeed. The default is &"lax"&, so the following lookups are equivalent:
7316 .code
7317 ${lookup dnsdb{defer_lax,a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
7318 ${lookup dnsdb{a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
7319 .endd
7320 Thus, in the default case, as long as at least one of the DNS lookups
7321 yields some data, the lookup succeeds.
7322
7323 .cindex "DNSSEC" "dns lookup"
7324 Use of &(DNSSEC)& is controlled by a dnssec modifier.
7325 The possible keywords are
7326 &"dnssec_strict"&, &"dnssec_lax"&, and &"dnssec_never"&.
7327 With &"strict"& or &"lax"& DNSSEC information is requested
7328 with the lookup.
7329 With &"strict"& a response from the DNS resolver that
7330 is not labelled as authenticated data
7331 is treated as equivalent to a temporary DNS error.
7332 The default is &"never"&.
7333
7334 See also the &$lookup_dnssec_authenticated$& variable.
7335
7336 .cindex timeout "dns lookup"
7337 .cindex "DNS" timeout
7338 Timeout for the dnsdb lookup can be controlled by a retrans modifier.
7339 The form is &"retrans_VAL"& where VAL is an Exim time specification
7340 (e.g. &"5s"&).
7341 The default value is set by the main configuration option &%dns_retrans%&.
7342
7343 Retries for the dnsdb lookup can be controlled by a retry modifier.
7344 The form if &"retry_VAL"& where VAL is an integer.
7345 The default count is set by the main configuration option &%dns_retry%&.
7346
7347 .cindex caching "of dns lookup"
7348 .cindex TTL "of dns lookup"
7349 .cindex DNS TTL
7350 Dnsdb lookup results are cached within a single process (and its children).
7351 The cache entry lifetime is limited to the smallest time-to-live (TTL)
7352 value of the set of returned DNS records.
7353
7354
7355 .section "Pseudo dnsdb record types" "SECID66"
7356 .cindex "MX record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7357 By default, both the preference value and the host name are returned for
7358 each MX record, separated by a space. If you want only host names, you can use
7359 the pseudo-type MXH:
7360 .code
7361 ${lookup dnsdb{mxh=a.b.example}}
7362 .endd
7363 In this case, the preference values are omitted, and just the host names are
7364 returned.
7365
7366 .cindex "name server for enclosing domain"
7367 Another pseudo-type is ZNS (for &"zone NS"&). It performs a lookup for NS
7368 records on the given domain, but if none are found, it removes the first
7369 component of the domain name, and tries again. This process continues until NS
7370 records are found or there are no more components left (or there is a DNS
7371 error). In other words, it may return the name servers for a top-level domain,
7372 but it never returns the root name servers. If there are no NS records for the
7373 top-level domain, the lookup fails. Consider these examples:
7374 .code
7375 ${lookup dnsdb{zns=xxx.quercite.com}}
7376 ${lookup dnsdb{zns=xxx.edu}}
7377 .endd
7378 Assuming that in each case there are no NS records for the full domain name,
7379 the first returns the name servers for &%quercite.com%&, and the second returns
7380 the name servers for &%edu%&.
7381
7382 You should be careful about how you use this lookup because, unless the
7383 top-level domain does not exist, the lookup always returns some host names. The
7384 sort of use to which this might be put is for seeing if the name servers for a
7385 given domain are on a blacklist. You can probably assume that the name servers
7386 for the high-level domains such as &%com%& or &%co.uk%& are not going to be on
7387 such a list.
7388
7389 .cindex "CSA" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7390 A third pseudo-type is CSA (Client SMTP Authorization). This looks up SRV
7391 records according to the CSA rules, which are described in section
7392 &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&. Although &(dnsdb)& supports SRV lookups directly, this is
7393 not sufficient because of the extra parent domain search behaviour of CSA. The
7394 result of a successful lookup such as:
7395 .code
7396 ${lookup dnsdb {csa=$sender_helo_name}}
7397 .endd
7398 has two space-separated fields: an authorization code and a target host name.
7399 The authorization code can be &"Y"& for yes, &"N"& for no, &"X"& for explicit
7400 authorization required but absent, or &"?"& for unknown.
7401
7402 .cindex "A+" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7403 The pseudo-type A+ performs an AAAA
7404 and then an A lookup. All results are returned; defer processing
7405 (see below) is handled separately for each lookup. Example:
7406 .code
7407 ${lookup dnsdb {>; a+=$sender_helo_name}}
7408 .endd
7409
7410
7411 .section "Multiple dnsdb lookups" "SECID67"
7412 In the previous sections, &(dnsdb)& lookups for a single domain are described.
7413 However, you can specify a list of domains or IP addresses in a single
7414 &(dnsdb)& lookup. The list is specified in the normal Exim way, with colon as
7415 the default separator, but with the ability to change this. For example:
7416 .code
7417 ${lookup dnsdb{one.domain.com:two.domain.com}}
7418 ${lookup dnsdb{a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
7419 ${lookup dnsdb{ptr = <; 1.2.3.4 ; 4.5.6.8}}
7420 .endd
7421 In order to retain backwards compatibility, there is one special case: if
7422 the lookup type is PTR and no change of separator is specified, Exim looks
7423 to see if the rest of the string is precisely one IPv6 address. In this
7424 case, it does not treat it as a list.
7425
7426 The data from each lookup is concatenated, with newline separators by default,
7427 in the same way that multiple DNS records for a single item are handled. A
7428 different separator can be specified, as described above.
7429
7430
7431
7432
7433 .section "More about LDAP" "SECTldap"
7434 .cindex "LDAP" "lookup, more about"
7435 .cindex "lookup" "LDAP"
7436 .cindex "Solaris" "LDAP"
7437 The original LDAP implementation came from the University of Michigan; this has
7438 become &"Open LDAP"&, and there are now two different releases. Another
7439 implementation comes from Netscape, and Solaris 7 and subsequent releases
7440 contain inbuilt LDAP support. Unfortunately, though these are all compatible at
7441 the lookup function level, their error handling is different. For this reason
7442 it is necessary to set a compile-time variable when building Exim with LDAP, to
7443 indicate which LDAP library is in use. One of the following should appear in
7444 your &_Local/Makefile_&:
7445 .code
7446 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=UMICHIGAN
7447 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=OPENLDAP1
7448 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=OPENLDAP2
7449 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=NETSCAPE
7450 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=SOLARIS
7451 .endd
7452 If LDAP_LIB_TYPE is not set, Exim assumes &`OPENLDAP1`&, which has the
7453 same interface as the University of Michigan version.
7454
7455 There are three LDAP lookup types in Exim. These behave slightly differently in
7456 the way they handle the results of a query:
7457
7458 .ilist
7459 &(ldap)& requires the result to contain just one entry; if there are more, it
7460 gives an error.
7461 .next
7462 &(ldapdn)& also requires the result to contain just one entry, but it is the
7463 Distinguished Name that is returned rather than any attribute values.
7464 .next
7465 &(ldapm)& permits the result to contain more than one entry; the attributes
7466 from all of them are returned.
7467 .endlist
7468
7469
7470 For &(ldap)& and &(ldapm)&, if a query finds only entries with no attributes,
7471 Exim behaves as if the entry did not exist, and the lookup fails. The format of
7472 the data returned by a successful lookup is described in the next section.
7473 First we explain how LDAP queries are coded.
7474
7475
7476 .section "Format of LDAP queries" "SECTforldaque"
7477 .cindex "LDAP" "query format"
7478 An LDAP query takes the form of a URL as defined in RFC 2255. For example, in
7479 the configuration of a &(redirect)& router one might have this setting:
7480 .code
7481 data = ${lookup ldap \
7482 {ldap:///cn=$local_part,o=University%20of%20Cambridge,\
7483 c=UK?mailbox?base?}}
7484 .endd
7485 .cindex "LDAP" "with TLS"
7486 The URL may begin with &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`& if your LDAP library supports
7487 secure (encrypted) LDAP connections. The second of these ensures that an
7488 encrypted TLS connection is used.
7489
7490 With sufficiently modern LDAP libraries, Exim supports forcing TLS over regular
7491 LDAP connections, rather than the SSL-on-connect &`ldaps`&.
7492 See the &%ldap_start_tls%& option.
7493
7494 Starting with Exim 4.83, the initialization of LDAP with TLS is more tightly
7495 controlled. Every part of the TLS configuration can be configured by settings in
7496 &_exim.conf_&. Depending on the version of the client libraries installed on
7497 your system, some of the initialization may have required setting options in
7498 &_/etc/ldap.conf_& or &_~/.ldaprc_& to get TLS working with self-signed
7499 certificates. This revealed a nuance where the current UID that exim was
7500 running as could affect which config files it read. With Exim 4.83, these
7501 methods become optional, only taking effect if not specifically set in
7502 &_exim.conf_&.
7503
7504
7505 .section "LDAP quoting" "SECID68"
7506 .cindex "LDAP" "quoting"
7507 Two levels of quoting are required in LDAP queries, the first for LDAP itself
7508 and the second because the LDAP query is represented as a URL. Furthermore,
7509 within an LDAP query, two different kinds of quoting are required. For this
7510 reason, there are two different LDAP-specific quoting operators.
7511
7512 The &%quote_ldap%& operator is designed for use on strings that are part of
7513 filter specifications. Conceptually, it first does the following conversions on
7514 the string:
7515 .code
7516 * => \2A
7517 ( => \28
7518 ) => \29
7519 \ => \5C
7520 .endd
7521 in accordance with RFC 2254. The resulting string is then quoted according
7522 to the rules for URLs, that is, all non-alphanumeric characters except
7523 .code
7524 ! $ ' - . _ ( ) * +
7525 .endd
7526 are converted to their hex values, preceded by a percent sign. For example:
7527 .code
7528 ${quote_ldap: a(bc)*, a<yz>; }
7529 .endd
7530 yields
7531 .code
7532 %20a%5C28bc%5C29%5C2A%2C%20a%3Cyz%3E%3B%20
7533 .endd
7534 Removing the URL quoting, this is (with a leading and a trailing space):
7535 .code
7536 a\28bc\29\2A, a<yz>;
7537 .endd
7538 The &%quote_ldap_dn%& operator is designed for use on strings that are part of
7539 base DN specifications in queries. Conceptually, it first converts the string
7540 by inserting a backslash in front of any of the following characters:
7541 .code
7542 , + " \ < > ;
7543 .endd
7544 It also inserts a backslash before any leading spaces or # characters, and
7545 before any trailing spaces. (These rules are in RFC 2253.) The resulting string
7546 is then quoted according to the rules for URLs. For example:
7547 .code
7548 ${quote_ldap_dn: a(bc)*, a<yz>; }
7549 .endd
7550 yields
7551 .code
7552 %5C%20a(bc)*%5C%2C%20a%5C%3Cyz%5C%3E%5C%3B%5C%20
7553 .endd
7554 Removing the URL quoting, this is (with a trailing space):
7555 .code
7556 \ a(bc)*\, a\<yz\>\;\
7557 .endd
7558 There are some further comments about quoting in the section on LDAP
7559 authentication below.
7560
7561
7562 .section "LDAP connections" "SECID69"
7563 .cindex "LDAP" "connections"
7564 The connection to an LDAP server may either be over TCP/IP, or, when OpenLDAP
7565 is in use, via a Unix domain socket. The example given above does not specify
7566 an LDAP server. A server that is reached by TCP/IP can be specified in a query
7567 by starting it with
7568 .code
7569 ldap://<hostname>:<port>/...
7570 .endd
7571 If the port (and preceding colon) are omitted, the standard LDAP port (389) is
7572 used. When no server is specified in a query, a list of default servers is
7573 taken from the &%ldap_default_servers%& configuration option. This supplies a
7574 colon-separated list of servers which are tried in turn until one successfully
7575 handles a query, or there is a serious error. Successful handling either
7576 returns the requested data, or indicates that it does not exist. Serious errors
7577 are syntactical, or multiple values when only a single value is expected.
7578 Errors which cause the next server to be tried are connection failures, bind
7579 failures, and timeouts.
7580
7581 For each server name in the list, a port number can be given. The standard way
7582 of specifying a host and port is to use a colon separator (RFC 1738). Because
7583 &%ldap_default_servers%& is a colon-separated list, such colons have to be
7584 doubled. For example
7585 .code
7586 ldap_default_servers = ldap1.example.com::145:ldap2.example.com
7587 .endd
7588 If &%ldap_default_servers%& is unset, a URL with no server name is passed
7589 to the LDAP library with no server name, and the library's default (normally
7590 the local host) is used.
7591
7592 If you are using the OpenLDAP library, you can connect to an LDAP server using
7593 a Unix domain socket instead of a TCP/IP connection. This is specified by using
7594 &`ldapi`& instead of &`ldap`& in LDAP queries. What follows here applies only
7595 to OpenLDAP. If Exim is compiled with a different LDAP library, this feature is
7596 not available.
7597
7598 For this type of connection, instead of a host name for the server, a pathname
7599 for the socket is required, and the port number is not relevant. The pathname
7600 can be specified either as an item in &%ldap_default_servers%&, or inline in
7601 the query. In the former case, you can have settings such as
7602 .code
7603 ldap_default_servers = /tmp/ldap.sock : backup.ldap.your.domain
7604 .endd
7605 When the pathname is given in the query, you have to escape the slashes as
7606 &`%2F`& to fit in with the LDAP URL syntax. For example:
7607 .code
7608 ${lookup ldap {ldapi://%2Ftmp%2Fldap.sock/o=...
7609 .endd
7610 When Exim processes an LDAP lookup and finds that the &"hostname"& is really
7611 a pathname, it uses the Unix domain socket code, even if the query actually
7612 specifies &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`&. In particular, no encryption is used for a
7613 socket connection. This behaviour means that you can use a setting of
7614 &%ldap_default_servers%& such as in the example above with traditional &`ldap`&
7615 or &`ldaps`& queries, and it will work. First, Exim tries a connection via
7616 the Unix domain socket; if that fails, it tries a TCP/IP connection to the
7617 backup host.
7618
7619 If an explicit &`ldapi`& type is given in a query when a host name is
7620 specified, an error is diagnosed. However, if there are more items in
7621 &%ldap_default_servers%&, they are tried. In other words:
7622
7623 .ilist
7624 Using a pathname with &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`& forces the use of the Unix domain
7625 interface.
7626 .next
7627 Using &`ldapi`& with a host name causes an error.
7628 .endlist
7629
7630
7631 Using &`ldapi`& with no host or path in the query, and no setting of
7632 &%ldap_default_servers%&, does whatever the library does by default.
7633
7634
7635
7636 .section "LDAP authentication and control information" "SECID70"
7637 .cindex "LDAP" "authentication"
7638 The LDAP URL syntax provides no way of passing authentication and other control
7639 information to the server. To make this possible, the URL in an LDAP query may
7640 be preceded by any number of <&'name'&>=<&'value'&> settings, separated by
7641 spaces. If a value contains spaces it must be enclosed in double quotes, and
7642 when double quotes are used, backslash is interpreted in the usual way inside
7643 them. The following names are recognized:
7644 .display
7645 &`DEREFERENCE`& set the dereferencing parameter
7646 &`NETTIME `& set a timeout for a network operation
7647 &`USER `& set the DN, for authenticating the LDAP bind
7648 &`PASS `& set the password, likewise
7649 &`REFERRALS `& set the referrals parameter
7650 &`SERVERS `& set alternate server list for this query only
7651 &`SIZE `& set the limit for the number of entries returned
7652 &`TIME `& set the maximum waiting time for a query
7653 .endd
7654 The value of the DEREFERENCE parameter must be one of the words &"never"&,
7655 &"searching"&, &"finding"&, or &"always"&. The value of the REFERRALS parameter
7656 must be &"follow"& (the default) or &"nofollow"&. The latter stops the LDAP
7657 library from trying to follow referrals issued by the LDAP server.
7658
7659 .cindex LDAP timeout
7660 .cindex timeout "LDAP lookup"
7661 The name CONNECT is an obsolete name for NETTIME, retained for
7662 backwards compatibility. This timeout (specified as a number of seconds) is
7663 enforced from the client end for operations that can be carried out over a
7664 network. Specifically, it applies to network connections and calls to the
7665 &'ldap_result()'& function. If the value is greater than zero, it is used if
7666 LDAP_OPT_NETWORK_TIMEOUT is defined in the LDAP headers (OpenLDAP), or
7667 if LDAP_X_OPT_CONNECT_TIMEOUT is defined in the LDAP headers (Netscape
7668 SDK 4.1). A value of zero forces an explicit setting of &"no timeout"& for
7669 Netscape SDK; for OpenLDAP no action is taken.
7670
7671 The TIME parameter (also a number of seconds) is passed to the server to
7672 set a server-side limit on the time taken to complete a search.
7673
7674 The SERVERS parameter allows you to specify an alternate list of ldap servers
7675 to use for an individual lookup. The global &%ldap_default_servers%& option provides a
7676 default list of ldap servers, and a single lookup can specify a single ldap
7677 server to use. But when you need to do a lookup with a list of servers that is
7678 different than the default list (maybe different order, maybe a completely
7679 different set of servers), the SERVERS parameter allows you to specify this
7680 alternate list (colon-separated).
7681
7682 Here is an example of an LDAP query in an Exim lookup that uses some of these
7683 values. This is a single line, folded to fit on the page:
7684 .code
7685 ${lookup ldap
7686 {user="cn=manager,o=University of Cambridge,c=UK" pass=secret
7687 ldap:///o=University%20of%20Cambridge,c=UK?sn?sub?(cn=foo)}
7688 {$value}fail}
7689 .endd
7690 The encoding of spaces as &`%20`& is a URL thing which should not be done for
7691 any of the auxiliary data. Exim configuration settings that include lookups
7692 which contain password information should be preceded by &"hide"& to prevent
7693 non-admin users from using the &%-bP%& option to see their values.
7694
7695 The auxiliary data items may be given in any order. The default is no
7696 connection timeout (the system timeout is used), no user or password, no limit
7697 on the number of entries returned, and no time limit on queries.
7698
7699 When a DN is quoted in the USER= setting for LDAP authentication, Exim
7700 removes any URL quoting that it may contain before passing it LDAP. Apparently
7701 some libraries do this for themselves, but some do not. Removing the URL
7702 quoting has two advantages:
7703
7704 .ilist
7705 It makes it possible to use the same &%quote_ldap_dn%& expansion for USER=
7706 DNs as with DNs inside actual queries.
7707 .next
7708 It permits spaces inside USER= DNs.
7709 .endlist
7710
7711 For example, a setting such as
7712 .code
7713 USER=cn=${quote_ldap_dn:$1}
7714 .endd
7715 should work even if &$1$& contains spaces.
7716
7717 Expanded data for the PASS= value should be quoted using the &%quote%&
7718 expansion operator, rather than the LDAP quote operators. The only reason this
7719 field needs quoting is to ensure that it conforms to the Exim syntax, which
7720 does not allow unquoted spaces. For example:
7721 .code
7722 PASS=${quote:$3}
7723 .endd
7724 The LDAP authentication mechanism can be used to check passwords as part of
7725 SMTP authentication. See the &%ldapauth%& expansion string condition in chapter
7726 &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
7727
7728
7729
7730 .section "Format of data returned by LDAP" "SECID71"
7731 .cindex "LDAP" "returned data formats"
7732 The &(ldapdn)& lookup type returns the Distinguished Name from a single entry
7733 as a sequence of values, for example
7734 .code
7735 cn=manager,o=University of Cambridge,c=UK
7736 .endd
7737 The &(ldap)& lookup type generates an error if more than one entry matches the
7738 search filter, whereas &(ldapm)& permits this case, and inserts a newline in
7739 the result between the data from different entries. It is possible for multiple
7740 values to be returned for both &(ldap)& and &(ldapm)&, but in the former case
7741 you know that whatever values are returned all came from a single entry in the
7742 directory.
7743
7744 In the common case where you specify a single attribute in your LDAP query, the
7745 result is not quoted, and does not contain the attribute name. If the attribute
7746 has multiple values, they are separated by commas. Any comma that is
7747 part of an attribute's value is doubled.
7748
7749 If you specify multiple attributes, the result contains space-separated, quoted
7750 strings, each preceded by the attribute name and an equals sign. Within the
7751 quotes, the quote character, backslash, and newline are escaped with
7752 backslashes, and commas are used to separate multiple values for the attribute.
7753 Any commas in attribute values are doubled
7754 (permitting treatment of the values as a comma-separated list).
7755 Apart from the escaping, the string within quotes takes the same form as the
7756 output when a single attribute is requested. Specifying no attributes is the
7757 same as specifying all of an entry's attributes.
7758
7759 Here are some examples of the output format. The first line of each pair is an
7760 LDAP query, and the second is the data that is returned. The attribute called
7761 &%attr1%& has two values, one of them with an embedded comma, whereas
7762 &%attr2%& has only one value. Both attributes are derived from &%attr%&
7763 (they have SUP &%attr%& in their schema definitions).
7764
7765 .code
7766 ldap:///o=base?attr1?sub?(uid=fred)
7767 value1.1,value1,,2
7768
7769 ldap:///o=base?attr2?sub?(uid=fred)
7770 value two
7771
7772 ldap:///o=base?attr?sub?(uid=fred)
7773 value1.1,value1,,2,value two
7774
7775 ldap:///o=base?attr1,attr2?sub?(uid=fred)
7776 attr1="value1.1,value1,,2" attr2="value two"
7777
7778 ldap:///o=base??sub?(uid=fred)
7779 objectClass="top" attr1="value1.1,value1,,2" attr2="value two"
7780 .endd
7781 You can
7782 make use of Exim's &%-be%& option to run expansion tests and thereby check the
7783 results of LDAP lookups.
7784 The &%extract%& operator in string expansions can be used to pick out
7785 individual fields from data that consists of &'key'&=&'value'& pairs.
7786 The &%listextract%& operator should be used to pick out individual values
7787 of attributes, even when only a single value is expected.
7788 The doubling of embedded commas allows you to use the returned data as a
7789 comma separated list (using the "<," syntax for changing the input list separator).
7790
7791
7792
7793
7794 .section "More about NIS+" "SECTnisplus"
7795 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type"
7796 .cindex "lookup" "NIS+"
7797 NIS+ queries consist of a NIS+ &'indexed name'& followed by an optional colon
7798 and field name. If this is given, the result of a successful query is the
7799 contents of the named field; otherwise the result consists of a concatenation
7800 of &'field-name=field-value'& pairs, separated by spaces. Empty values and
7801 values containing spaces are quoted. For example, the query
7802 .code
7803 [name=mg1456],passwd.org_dir
7804 .endd
7805 might return the string
7806 .code
7807 name=mg1456 passwd="" uid=999 gid=999 gcos="Martin Guerre"
7808 home=/home/mg1456 shell=/bin/bash shadow=""
7809 .endd
7810 (split over two lines here to fit on the page), whereas
7811 .code
7812 [name=mg1456],passwd.org_dir:gcos
7813 .endd
7814 would just return
7815 .code
7816 Martin Guerre
7817 .endd
7818 with no quotes. A NIS+ lookup fails if NIS+ returns more than one table entry
7819 for the given indexed key. The effect of the &%quote_nisplus%& expansion
7820 operator is to double any quote characters within the text.
7821
7822
7823
7824 .section "SQL lookups" "SECTsql"
7825 .cindex "SQL lookup types"
7826 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
7827 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
7828 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
7829 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
7830 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
7831 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
7832 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
7833 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
7834 .cindex "Redis lookup type"
7835 .cindex lookup Redis
7836 Exim can support lookups in InterBase, MySQL, Oracle, PostgreSQL, Redis,
7837 and SQLite
7838 databases. Queries for these databases contain SQL statements, so an example
7839 might be
7840 .code
7841 ${lookup mysql{select mailbox from users where id='userx'}\
7842 {$value}fail}
7843 .endd
7844 If the result of the query contains more than one field, the data for each
7845 field in the row is returned, preceded by its name, so the result of
7846 .code
7847 ${lookup pgsql{select home,name from users where id='userx'}\
7848 {$value}}
7849 .endd
7850 might be
7851 .code
7852 home=/home/userx name="Mister X"
7853 .endd
7854 Empty values and values containing spaces are double quoted, with embedded
7855 quotes escaped by a backslash. If the result of the query contains just one
7856 field, the value is passed back verbatim, without a field name, for example:
7857 .code
7858 Mister X
7859 .endd
7860 If the result of the query yields more than one row, it is all concatenated,
7861 with a newline between the data for each row.
7862
7863
7864 .section "More about MySQL, PostgreSQL, Oracle, InterBase, and Redis" "SECID72"
7865 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
7866 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
7867 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
7868 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
7869 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
7870 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
7871 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
7872 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
7873 .cindex "Redis lookup type"
7874 .cindex lookup Redis
7875 If any MySQL, PostgreSQL, Oracle, InterBase or Redis lookups are used, the
7876 &%mysql_servers%&, &%pgsql_servers%&, &%oracle_servers%&, &%ibase_servers%&,
7877 or &%redis_servers%&
7878 option (as appropriate) must be set to a colon-separated list of server
7879 information.
7880 (For MySQL and PostgreSQL, the global option need not be set if all
7881 queries contain their own server information &-- see section
7882 &<<SECTspeserque>>&.)
7883 For all but Redis
7884 each item in the list is a slash-separated list of four
7885 items: host name, database name, user name, and password. In the case of
7886 Oracle, the host name field is used for the &"service name"&, and the database
7887 name field is not used and should be empty. For example:
7888 .code
7889 hide oracle_servers = oracle.plc.example//userx/abcdwxyz
7890 .endd
7891 Because password data is sensitive, you should always precede the setting with
7892 &"hide"&, to prevent non-admin users from obtaining the setting via the &%-bP%&
7893 option. Here is an example where two MySQL servers are listed:
7894 .code
7895 hide mysql_servers = localhost/users/root/secret:\
7896 otherhost/users/root/othersecret
7897 .endd
7898 For MySQL and PostgreSQL, a host may be specified as <&'name'&>:<&'port'&> but
7899 because this is a colon-separated list, the colon has to be doubled. For each
7900 query, these parameter groups are tried in order until a connection is made and
7901 a query is successfully processed. The result of a query may be that no data is
7902 found, but that is still a successful query. In other words, the list of
7903 servers provides a backup facility, not a list of different places to look.
7904
7905 For Redis the global option need not be specified if all queries contain their
7906 own server information &-- see section &<<SECTspeserque>>&.
7907 If specified, the option must be set to a colon-separated list of server
7908 information.
7909 Each item in the list is a slash-separated list of three items:
7910 host, database number, and password.
7911 .olist
7912 The host is required and may be either an IPv4 address and optional
7913 port number (separated by a colon, which needs doubling due to the
7914 higher-level list), or a Unix socket pathname enclosed in parentheses
7915 .next
7916 The database number is optional; if present that number is selected in the backend
7917 .next
7918 The password is optional; if present it is used to authenticate to the backend
7919 .endlist
7920
7921 The &%quote_mysql%&, &%quote_pgsql%&, and &%quote_oracle%& expansion operators
7922 convert newline, tab, carriage return, and backspace to \n, \t, \r, and \b
7923 respectively, and the characters single-quote, double-quote, and backslash
7924 itself are escaped with backslashes.
7925
7926 The &%quote_redis%& expansion operator
7927 escapes whitespace and backslash characters with a backslash.
7928
7929 .section "Specifying the server in the query" "SECTspeserque"
7930 For MySQL, PostgreSQL and Redis lookups (but not currently for Oracle and InterBase),
7931 it is possible to specify a list of servers with an individual query. This is
7932 done by starting the query with
7933 .display
7934 &`servers=`&&'server1:server2:server3:...'&&`;`&
7935 .endd
7936 Each item in the list may take one of two forms:
7937 .olist
7938 If it contains no slashes it is assumed to be just a host name. The appropriate
7939 global option (&%mysql_servers%& or &%pgsql_servers%&) is searched for a host
7940 of the same name, and the remaining parameters (database, user, password) are
7941 taken from there.
7942 .next
7943 If it contains any slashes, it is taken as a complete parameter set.
7944 .endlist
7945 The list of servers is used in exactly the same way as the global list.
7946 Once a connection to a server has happened and a query has been
7947 successfully executed, processing of the lookup ceases.
7948
7949 This feature is intended for use in master/slave situations where updates
7950 are occurring and you want to update the master rather than a slave. If the
7951 master is in the list as a backup for reading, you might have a global setting
7952 like this:
7953 .code
7954 mysql_servers = slave1/db/name/pw:\
7955 slave2/db/name/pw:\
7956 master/db/name/pw
7957 .endd
7958 In an updating lookup, you could then write:
7959 .code
7960 ${lookup mysql{servers=master; UPDATE ...} }
7961 .endd
7962 That query would then be sent only to the master server. If, on the other hand,
7963 the master is not to be used for reading, and so is not present in the global
7964 option, you can still update it by a query of this form:
7965 .code
7966 ${lookup pgsql{servers=master/db/name/pw; UPDATE ...} }
7967 .endd
7968
7969
7970 .section "Special MySQL features" "SECID73"
7971 For MySQL, an empty host name or the use of &"localhost"& in &%mysql_servers%&
7972 causes a connection to the server on the local host by means of a Unix domain
7973 socket. An alternate socket can be specified in parentheses.
7974 An option group name for MySQL option files can be specified in square brackets;
7975 the default value is &"exim"&.
7976 The full syntax of each item in &%mysql_servers%& is:
7977 .display
7978 <&'hostname'&>::<&'port'&>(<&'socket name'&>)[<&'option group'&>]/&&&
7979 <&'database'&>/<&'user'&>/<&'password'&>
7980 .endd
7981 Any of the four sub-parts of the first field can be omitted. For normal use on
7982 the local host it can be left blank or set to just &"localhost"&.
7983
7984 No database need be supplied &-- but if it is absent here, it must be given in
7985 the queries.
7986
7987 If a MySQL query is issued that does not request any data (an insert, update,
7988 or delete command), the result of the lookup is the number of rows affected.
7989
7990 &*Warning*&: This can be misleading. If an update does not actually change
7991 anything (for example, setting a field to the value it already has), the result
7992 is zero because no rows are affected.
7993
7994
7995 .section "Special PostgreSQL features" "SECID74"
7996 PostgreSQL lookups can also use Unix domain socket connections to the database.
7997 This is usually faster and costs less CPU time than a TCP/IP connection.
7998 However it can be used only if the mail server runs on the same machine as the
7999 database server. A configuration line for PostgreSQL via Unix domain sockets
8000 looks like this:
8001 .code
8002 hide pgsql_servers = (/tmp/.s.PGSQL.5432)/db/user/password : ...
8003 .endd
8004 In other words, instead of supplying a host name, a path to the socket is
8005 given. The path name is enclosed in parentheses so that its slashes aren't
8006 visually confused with the delimiters for the other server parameters.
8007
8008 If a PostgreSQL query is issued that does not request any data (an insert,
8009 update, or delete command), the result of the lookup is the number of rows
8010 affected.
8011
8012 .section "More about SQLite" "SECTsqlite"
8013 .cindex "lookup" "SQLite"
8014 .cindex "sqlite lookup type"
8015 SQLite is different to the other SQL lookups because a filename is required in
8016 addition to the SQL query. An SQLite database is a single file, and there is no
8017 daemon as in the other SQL databases. The interface to Exim requires the name
8018 of the file, as an absolute path, to be given at the start of the query. It is
8019 separated from the query by white space. This means that the path name cannot
8020 contain white space. Here is a lookup expansion example:
8021 .code
8022 ${lookup sqlite {/some/thing/sqlitedb \
8023 select name from aliases where id='userx';}}
8024 .endd
8025 In a list, the syntax is similar. For example:
8026 .code
8027 domainlist relay_to_domains = sqlite;/some/thing/sqlitedb \
8028 select * from relays where ip='$sender_host_address';
8029 .endd
8030 The only character affected by the &%quote_sqlite%& operator is a single
8031 quote, which it doubles.
8032
8033 .cindex timeout SQLite
8034 .cindex sqlite "lookup timeout"
8035 The SQLite library handles multiple simultaneous accesses to the database
8036 internally. Multiple readers are permitted, but only one process can
8037 update at once. Attempts to access the database while it is being updated
8038 are rejected after a timeout period, during which the SQLite library
8039 waits for the lock to be released. In Exim, the default timeout is set
8040 to 5 seconds, but it can be changed by means of the &%sqlite_lock_timeout%&
8041 option.
8042
8043 .section "More about Redis" "SECTredis"
8044 .cindex "lookup" "Redis"
8045 .cindex "redis lookup type"
8046 Redis is a non-SQL database. Commands are simple get and set.
8047 Examples:
8048 .code
8049 ${lookup redis{set keyname ${quote_redis:objvalue plus}}}
8050 ${lookup redis{get keyname}}
8051 .endd
8052
8053 As of release 4.91, "lightweight" support for Redis Cluster is available.
8054 Requires &%redis_servers%& list to contain all the servers in the cluster, all
8055 of which must be reachable from the running exim instance. If the cluster has
8056 master/slave replication, the list must contain all the master and slave
8057 servers.
8058
8059 When the Redis Cluster returns a "MOVED" response to a query, Exim does not
8060 immediately follow the redirection but treats the response as a DEFER, moving on
8061 to the next server in the &%redis_servers%& list until the correct server is
8062 reached.
8063
8064 .ecindex IIDfidalo1
8065 .ecindex IIDfidalo2
8066
8067
8068 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
8069 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
8070
8071 .chapter "Domain, host, address, and local part lists" &&&
8072 "CHAPdomhosaddlists" &&&
8073 "Domain, host, and address lists"
8074 .scindex IIDdohoadli "lists of domains; hosts; etc."
8075 A number of Exim configuration options contain lists of domains, hosts,
8076 email addresses, or local parts. For example, the &%hold_domains%& option
8077 contains a list of domains whose delivery is currently suspended. These lists
8078 are also used as data in ACL statements (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), and as
8079 arguments to expansion conditions such as &%match_domain%&.
8080
8081 Each item in one of these lists is a pattern to be matched against a domain,
8082 host, email address, or local part, respectively. In the sections below, the
8083 different types of pattern for each case are described, but first we cover some
8084 general facilities that apply to all four kinds of list.
8085
8086 Note that other parts of Exim use a &'string list'& which does not
8087 support all the complexity available in
8088 domain, host, address and local part lists.
8089
8090
8091
8092 .section "Expansion of lists" "SECTlistexpand"
8093 .cindex "expansion" "of lists"
8094 Each list is expanded as a single string before it is used.
8095
8096 &'Exception: the router headers_remove option, where list-item
8097 splitting is done before string-expansion.'&
8098
8099 The result of
8100 expansion must be a list, possibly containing empty items, which is split up
8101 into separate items for matching. By default, colon is the separator character,
8102 but this can be varied if necessary. See sections &<<SECTlistconstruct>>& and
8103 &<<SECTempitelis>>& for details of the list syntax; the second of these
8104 discusses the way to specify empty list items.
8105
8106
8107 If the string expansion is forced to fail, Exim behaves as if the item it is
8108 testing (domain, host, address, or local part) is not in the list. Other
8109 expansion failures cause temporary errors.
8110
8111 If an item in a list is a regular expression, backslashes, dollars and possibly
8112 other special characters in the expression must be protected against
8113 misinterpretation by the string expander. The easiest way to do this is to use
8114 the &`\N`& expansion feature to indicate that the contents of the regular
8115 expression should not be expanded. For example, in an ACL you might have:
8116 .code
8117 deny senders = \N^\d{8}\w@.*\.baddomain\.example$\N : \
8118 ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/badsenders/bydomain}}
8119 .endd
8120 The first item is a regular expression that is protected from expansion by
8121 &`\N`&, whereas the second uses the expansion to obtain a list of unwanted
8122 senders based on the receiving domain.
8123
8124
8125
8126
8127 .section "Negated items in lists" "SECID76"
8128 .cindex "list" "negation"
8129 .cindex "negation" "in lists"
8130 Items in a list may be positive or negative. Negative items are indicated by a
8131 leading exclamation mark, which may be followed by optional white space. A list
8132 defines a set of items (domains, etc). When Exim processes one of these lists,
8133 it is trying to find out whether a domain, host, address, or local part
8134 (respectively) is in the set that is defined by the list. It works like this:
8135
8136 The list is scanned from left to right. If a positive item is matched, the
8137 subject that is being checked is in the set; if a negative item is matched, the
8138 subject is not in the set. If the end of the list is reached without the
8139 subject having matched any of the patterns, it is in the set if the last item
8140 was a negative one, but not if it was a positive one. For example, the list in
8141 .code
8142 domainlist relay_to_domains = !a.b.c : *.b.c
8143 .endd
8144 matches any domain ending in &'.b.c'& except for &'a.b.c'&. Domains that match
8145 neither &'a.b.c'& nor &'*.b.c'& do not match, because the last item in the
8146 list is positive. However, if the setting were
8147 .code
8148 domainlist relay_to_domains = !a.b.c
8149 .endd
8150 then all domains other than &'a.b.c'& would match because the last item in the
8151 list is negative. In other words, a list that ends with a negative item behaves
8152 as if it had an extra item &`:*`& on the end.
8153
8154 Another way of thinking about positive and negative items in lists is to read
8155 the connector as &"or"& after a positive item and as &"and"& after a negative
8156 item.
8157
8158
8159
8160 .section "File names in lists" "SECTfilnamlis"
8161 .cindex "list" "filename in"
8162 If an item in a domain, host, address, or local part list is an absolute
8163 filename (beginning with a slash character), each line of the file is read and
8164 processed as if it were an independent item in the list, except that further
8165 filenames are not allowed,
8166 and no expansion of the data from the file takes place.
8167 Empty lines in the file are ignored, and the file may also contain comment
8168 lines:
8169
8170 .ilist
8171 For domain and host lists, if a # character appears anywhere in a line of the
8172 file, it and all following characters are ignored.
8173 .next
8174 Because local parts may legitimately contain # characters, a comment in an
8175 address list or local part list file is recognized only if # is preceded by
8176 white space or the start of the line. For example:
8177 .code
8178 not#comment@x.y.z # but this is a comment
8179 .endd
8180 .endlist
8181
8182 Putting a filename in a list has the same effect as inserting each line of the
8183 file as an item in the list (blank lines and comments excepted). However, there
8184 is one important difference: the file is read each time the list is processed,
8185 so if its contents vary over time, Exim's behaviour changes.
8186
8187 If a filename is preceded by an exclamation mark, the sense of any match
8188 within the file is inverted. For example, if
8189 .code
8190 hold_domains = !/etc/nohold-domains
8191 .endd
8192 and the file contains the lines
8193 .code
8194 !a.b.c
8195 *.b.c
8196 .endd
8197 then &'a.b.c'& is in the set of domains defined by &%hold_domains%&, whereas
8198 any domain matching &`*.b.c`& is not.
8199
8200
8201
8202 .section "An lsearch file is not an out-of-line list" "SECID77"
8203 As will be described in the sections that follow, lookups can be used in lists
8204 to provide indexed methods of checking list membership. There has been some
8205 confusion about the way &(lsearch)& lookups work in lists. Because
8206 an &(lsearch)& file contains plain text and is scanned sequentially, it is
8207 sometimes thought that it is allowed to contain wild cards and other kinds of
8208 non-constant pattern. This is not the case. The keys in an &(lsearch)& file are
8209 always fixed strings, just as for any other single-key lookup type.
8210
8211 If you want to use a file to contain wild-card patterns that form part of a
8212 list, just give the filename on its own, without a search type, as described
8213 in the previous section. You could also use the &(wildlsearch)& or
8214 &(nwildlsearch)&, but there is no advantage in doing this.
8215
8216
8217
8218
8219 .section "Named lists" "SECTnamedlists"
8220 .cindex "named lists"
8221 .cindex "list" "named"
8222 A list of domains, hosts, email addresses, or local parts can be given a name
8223 which is then used to refer to the list elsewhere in the configuration. This is
8224 particularly convenient if the same list is required in several different
8225 places. It also allows lists to be given meaningful names, which can improve
8226 the readability of the configuration. For example, it is conventional to define
8227 a domain list called &'local_domains'& for all the domains that are handled
8228 locally on a host, using a configuration line such as
8229 .code
8230 domainlist local_domains = localhost:my.dom.example
8231 .endd
8232 Named lists are referenced by giving their name preceded by a plus sign, so,
8233 for example, a router that is intended to handle local domains would be
8234 configured with the line
8235 .code
8236 domains = +local_domains
8237 .endd
8238 The first router in a configuration is often one that handles all domains
8239 except the local ones, using a configuration with a negated item like this:
8240 .code
8241 dnslookup:
8242 driver = dnslookup
8243 domains = ! +local_domains
8244 transport = remote_smtp
8245 no_more
8246 .endd
8247 The four kinds of named list are created by configuration lines starting with
8248 the words &%domainlist%&, &%hostlist%&, &%addresslist%&, or &%localpartlist%&,
8249 respectively. Then there follows the name that you are defining, followed by an
8250 equals sign and the list itself. For example:
8251 .code
8252 hostlist relay_from_hosts = 192.168.23.0/24 : my.friend.example
8253 addresslist bad_senders = cdb;/etc/badsenders
8254 .endd
8255 A named list may refer to other named lists:
8256 .code
8257 domainlist dom1 = first.example : second.example
8258 domainlist dom2 = +dom1 : third.example
8259 domainlist dom3 = fourth.example : +dom2 : fifth.example
8260 .endd
8261 &*Warning*&: If the last item in a referenced list is a negative one, the
8262 effect may not be what you intended, because the negation does not propagate
8263 out to the higher level. For example, consider:
8264 .code
8265 domainlist dom1 = !a.b
8266 domainlist dom2 = +dom1 : *.b
8267 .endd
8268 The second list specifies &"either in the &%dom1%& list or &'*.b'&"&. The first
8269 list specifies just &"not &'a.b'&"&, so the domain &'x.y'& matches it. That
8270 means it matches the second list as well. The effect is not the same as
8271 .code
8272 domainlist dom2 = !a.b : *.b
8273 .endd
8274 where &'x.y'& does not match. It's best to avoid negation altogether in
8275 referenced lists if you can.
8276
8277 Named lists may have a performance advantage. When Exim is routing an
8278 address or checking an incoming message, it caches the result of tests on named
8279 lists. So, if you have a setting such as
8280 .code
8281 domains = +local_domains
8282 .endd
8283 on several of your routers
8284 or in several ACL statements,
8285 the actual test is done only for the first one. However, the caching works only
8286 if there are no expansions within the list itself or any sublists that it
8287 references. In other words, caching happens only for lists that are known to be
8288 the same each time they are referenced.
8289
8290 By default, there may be up to 16 named lists of each type. This limit can be
8291 extended by changing a compile-time variable. The use of domain and host lists
8292 is recommended for concepts such as local domains, relay domains, and relay
8293 hosts. The default configuration is set up like this.
8294
8295
8296
8297 .section "Named lists compared with macros" "SECID78"
8298 .cindex "list" "named compared with macro"
8299 .cindex "macro" "compared with named list"
8300 At first sight, named lists might seem to be no different from macros in the
8301 configuration file. However, macros are just textual substitutions. If you
8302 write
8303 .code
8304 ALIST = host1 : host2
8305 auth_advertise_hosts = !ALIST
8306 .endd
8307 it probably won't do what you want, because that is exactly the same as
8308 .code
8309 auth_advertise_hosts = !host1 : host2
8310 .endd
8311 Notice that the second host name is not negated. However, if you use a host
8312 list, and write
8313 .code
8314 hostlist alist = host1 : host2
8315 auth_advertise_hosts = ! +alist
8316 .endd
8317 the negation applies to the whole list, and so that is equivalent to
8318 .code
8319 auth_advertise_hosts = !host1 : !host2
8320 .endd
8321
8322
8323 .section "Named list caching" "SECID79"
8324 .cindex "list" "caching of named"
8325 .cindex "caching" "named lists"
8326 While processing a message, Exim caches the result of checking a named list if
8327 it is sure that the list is the same each time. In practice, this means that
8328 the cache operates only if the list contains no $ characters, which guarantees
8329 that it will not change when it is expanded. Sometimes, however, you may have
8330 an expanded list that you know will be the same each time within a given
8331 message. For example:
8332 .code
8333 domainlist special_domains = \
8334 ${lookup{$sender_host_address}cdb{/some/file}}
8335 .endd
8336 This provides a list of domains that depends only on the sending host's IP
8337 address. If this domain list is referenced a number of times (for example,
8338 in several ACL lines, or in several routers) the result of the check is not
8339 cached by default, because Exim does not know that it is going to be the
8340 same list each time.
8341
8342 By appending &`_cache`& to &`domainlist`& you can tell Exim to go ahead and
8343 cache the result anyway. For example:
8344 .code
8345 domainlist_cache special_domains = ${lookup{...
8346 .endd
8347 If you do this, you should be absolutely sure that caching is going to do
8348 the right thing in all cases. When in doubt, leave it out.
8349
8350
8351
8352 .section "Domain lists" "SECTdomainlist"
8353 .cindex "domain list" "patterns for"
8354 .cindex "list" "domain list"
8355 Domain lists contain patterns that are to be matched against a mail domain.
8356 The following types of item may appear in domain lists:
8357
8358 .ilist
8359 .cindex "primary host name"
8360 .cindex "host name" "matched in domain list"
8361 .oindex "&%primary_hostname%&"
8362 .cindex "domain list" "matching primary host name"
8363 .cindex "@ in a domain list"
8364 If a pattern consists of a single @ character, it matches the local host name,
8365 as set by the &%primary_hostname%& option (or defaulted). This makes it
8366 possible to use the same configuration file on several different hosts that
8367 differ only in their names.
8368 .next
8369 .cindex "@[] in a domain list"
8370 .cindex "domain list" "matching local IP interfaces"
8371 .cindex "domain literal"
8372 If a pattern consists of the string &`@[]`& it matches an IP address enclosed
8373 in square brackets (as in an email address that contains a domain literal), but
8374 only if that IP address is recognized as local for email routing purposes. The
8375 &%local_interfaces%& and &%extra_local_interfaces%& options can be used to
8376 control which of a host's several IP addresses are treated as local.
8377 In today's Internet, the use of domain literals is controversial.
8378 .next
8379 .cindex "@mx_any"
8380 .cindex "@mx_primary"
8381 .cindex "@mx_secondary"
8382 .cindex "domain list" "matching MX pointers to local host"
8383 If a pattern consists of the string &`@mx_any`& it matches any domain that
8384 has an MX record pointing to the local host or to any host that is listed in
8385 .oindex "&%hosts_treat_as_local%&"
8386 &%hosts_treat_as_local%&. The items &`@mx_primary`& and &`@mx_secondary`&
8387 are similar, except that the first matches only when a primary MX target is the
8388 local host, and the second only when no primary MX target is the local host,
8389 but a secondary MX target is. &"Primary"& means an MX record with the lowest
8390 preference value &-- there may of course be more than one of them.
8391
8392 The MX lookup that takes place when matching a pattern of this type is
8393 performed with the resolver options for widening names turned off. Thus, for
8394 example, a single-component domain will &'not'& be expanded by adding the
8395 resolver's default domain. See the &%qualify_single%& and &%search_parents%&
8396 options of the &(dnslookup)& router for a discussion of domain widening.
8397
8398 Sometimes you may want to ignore certain IP addresses when using one of these
8399 patterns. You can specify this by following the pattern with &`/ignore=`&<&'ip
8400 list'&>, where <&'ip list'&> is a list of IP addresses. These addresses are
8401 ignored when processing the pattern (compare the &%ignore_target_hosts%& option
8402 on a router). For example:
8403 .code
8404 domains = @mx_any/ignore=127.0.0.1
8405 .endd
8406 This example matches any domain that has an MX record pointing to one of
8407 the local host's IP addresses other than 127.0.0.1.
8408
8409 The list of IP addresses is in fact processed by the same code that processes
8410 host lists, so it may contain CIDR-coded network specifications and it may also
8411 contain negative items.
8412
8413 Because the list of IP addresses is a sublist within a domain list, you have to
8414 be careful about delimiters if there is more than one address. Like any other
8415 list, the default delimiter can be changed. Thus, you might have:
8416 .code
8417 domains = @mx_any/ignore=<;127.0.0.1;0.0.0.0 : \
8418 an.other.domain : ...
8419 .endd
8420 so that the sublist uses semicolons for delimiters. When IPv6 addresses are
8421 involved, it is easiest to change the delimiter for the main list as well:
8422 .code
8423 domains = <? @mx_any/ignore=<;127.0.0.1;::1 ? \
8424 an.other.domain ? ...
8425 .endd
8426 .next
8427 .cindex "asterisk" "in domain list"
8428 .cindex "domain list" "asterisk in"
8429 .cindex "domain list" "matching &""ends with""&"
8430 If a pattern starts with an asterisk, the remaining characters of the pattern
8431 are compared with the terminating characters of the domain. The use of &"*"& in
8432 domain lists differs from its use in partial matching lookups. In a domain
8433 list, the character following the asterisk need not be a dot, whereas partial
8434 matching works only in terms of dot-separated components. For example, a domain
8435 list item such as &`*key.ex`& matches &'donkey.ex'& as well as
8436 &'cipher.key.ex'&.
8437
8438 .next
8439 .cindex "regular expressions" "in domain list"
8440 .cindex "domain list" "matching regular expression"
8441 If a pattern starts with a circumflex character, it is treated as a regular
8442 expression, and matched against the domain using a regular expression matching
8443 function. The circumflex is treated as part of the regular expression.
8444 Email domains are case-independent, so this regular expression match is by
8445 default case-independent, but you can make it case-dependent by starting it
8446 with &`(?-i)`&. References to descriptions of the syntax of regular expressions
8447 are given in chapter &<<CHAPregexp>>&.
8448
8449 &*Warning*&: Because domain lists are expanded before being processed, you
8450 must escape any backslash and dollar characters in the regular expression, or
8451 use the special &`\N`& sequence (see chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&) to specify that
8452 it is not to be expanded (unless you really do want to build a regular
8453 expression by expansion, of course).
8454 .next
8455 .cindex "lookup" "in domain list"
8456 .cindex "domain list" "matching by lookup"
8457 If a pattern starts with the name of a single-key lookup type followed by a
8458 semicolon (for example, &"dbm;"& or &"lsearch;"&), the remainder of the pattern
8459 must be a filename in a suitable format for the lookup type. For example, for
8460 &"cdb;"& it must be an absolute path:
8461 .code
8462 domains = cdb;/etc/mail/local_domains.cdb
8463 .endd
8464 The appropriate type of lookup is done on the file using the domain name as the
8465 key. In most cases, the data that is looked up is not used; Exim is interested
8466 only in whether or not the key is present in the file. However, when a lookup
8467 is used for the &%domains%& option on a router
8468 or a &%domains%& condition in an ACL statement, the data is preserved in the
8469 &$domain_data$& variable and can be referred to in other router options or
8470 other statements in the same ACL.
8471
8472 .next
8473 Any of the single-key lookup type names may be preceded by
8474 &`partial`&<&'n'&>&`-`&, where the <&'n'&> is optional, for example,
8475 .code
8476 domains = partial-dbm;/partial/domains
8477 .endd
8478 This causes partial matching logic to be invoked; a description of how this
8479 works is given in section &<<SECTpartiallookup>>&.
8480
8481 .next
8482 .cindex "asterisk" "in lookup type"
8483 Any of the single-key lookup types may be followed by an asterisk. This causes
8484 a default lookup for a key consisting of a single asterisk to be done if the
8485 original lookup fails. This is not a useful feature when using a domain list to
8486 select particular domains (because any domain would match), but it might have
8487 value if the result of the lookup is being used via the &$domain_data$&
8488 expansion variable.
8489 .next
8490 If the pattern starts with the name of a query-style lookup type followed by a
8491 semicolon (for example, &"nisplus;"& or &"ldap;"&), the remainder of the
8492 pattern must be an appropriate query for the lookup type, as described in
8493 chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. For example:
8494 .code
8495 hold_domains = mysql;select domain from holdlist \
8496 where domain = '${quote_mysql:$domain}';
8497 .endd
8498 In most cases, the data that is looked up is not used (so for an SQL query, for
8499 example, it doesn't matter what field you select). Exim is interested only in
8500 whether or not the query succeeds. However, when a lookup is used for the
8501 &%domains%& option on a router, the data is preserved in the &$domain_data$&
8502 variable and can be referred to in other options.
8503 .next
8504 .cindex "domain list" "matching literal domain name"
8505 If none of the above cases apply, a caseless textual comparison is made
8506 between the pattern and the domain.
8507 .endlist
8508
8509 Here is an example that uses several different kinds of pattern:
8510 .code
8511 domainlist funny_domains = \
8512 @ : \
8513 lib.unseen.edu : \
8514 *.foundation.fict.example : \
8515 \N^[1-2]\d{3}\.fict\.example$\N : \
8516 partial-dbm;/opt/data/penguin/book : \
8517 nis;domains.byname : \
8518 nisplus;[name=$domain,status=local],domains.org_dir
8519 .endd
8520 There are obvious processing trade-offs among the various matching modes. Using
8521 an asterisk is faster than a regular expression, and listing a few names
8522 explicitly probably is too. The use of a file or database lookup is expensive,
8523 but may be the only option if hundreds of names are required. Because the
8524 patterns are tested in order, it makes sense to put the most commonly matched
8525 patterns earlier.
8526
8527
8528
8529 .section "Host lists" "SECThostlist"
8530 .cindex "host list" "patterns in"
8531 .cindex "list" "host list"
8532 Host lists are used to control what remote hosts are allowed to do. For
8533 example, some hosts may be allowed to use the local host as a relay, and some
8534 may be permitted to use the SMTP ETRN command. Hosts can be identified in
8535 two different ways, by name or by IP address. In a host list, some types of
8536 pattern are matched to a host name, and some are matched to an IP address.
8537 You need to be particularly careful with this when single-key lookups are
8538 involved, to ensure that the right value is being used as the key.
8539
8540
8541 .section "Special host list patterns" "SECID80"
8542 .cindex "empty item in hosts list"
8543 .cindex "host list" "empty string in"
8544 If a host list item is the empty string, it matches only when no remote host is
8545 involved. This is the case when a message is being received from a local
8546 process using SMTP on the standard input, that is, when a TCP/IP connection is
8547 not used.
8548
8549 .cindex "asterisk" "in host list"
8550 The special pattern &"*"& in a host list matches any host or no host. Neither
8551 the IP address nor the name is actually inspected.
8552
8553
8554
8555 .section "Host list patterns that match by IP address" "SECThoslispatip"
8556 .cindex "host list" "matching IP addresses"
8557 If an IPv4 host calls an IPv6 host and the call is accepted on an IPv6 socket,
8558 the incoming address actually appears in the IPv6 host as
8559 &`::ffff:`&<&'v4address'&>. When such an address is tested against a host
8560 list, it is converted into a traditional IPv4 address first. (Not all operating
8561 systems accept IPv4 calls on IPv6 sockets, as there have been some security
8562 concerns.)
8563
8564 The following types of pattern in a host list check the remote host by
8565 inspecting its IP address:
8566
8567 .ilist
8568 If the pattern is a plain domain name (not a regular expression, not starting
8569 with *, not a lookup of any kind), Exim calls the operating system function
8570 to find the associated IP address(es). Exim uses the newer
8571 &[getipnodebyname()]& function when available, otherwise &[gethostbyname()]&.
8572 This typically causes a forward DNS lookup of the name. The result is compared
8573 with the IP address of the subject host.
8574
8575 If there is a temporary problem (such as a DNS timeout) with the host name
8576 lookup, a temporary error occurs. For example, if the list is being used in an
8577 ACL condition, the ACL gives a &"defer"& response, usually leading to a
8578 temporary SMTP error code. If no IP address can be found for the host name,
8579 what happens is described in section &<<SECTbehipnot>>& below.
8580
8581 .next
8582 .cindex "@ in a host list"
8583 If the pattern is &"@"&, the primary host name is substituted and used as a
8584 domain name, as just described.
8585
8586 .next
8587 If the pattern is an IP address, it is matched against the IP address of the
8588 subject host. IPv4 addresses are given in the normal &"dotted-quad"& notation.
8589 IPv6 addresses can be given in colon-separated format, but the colons have to
8590 be doubled so as not to be taken as item separators when the default list
8591 separator is used. IPv6 addresses are recognized even when Exim is compiled
8592 without IPv6 support. This means that if they appear in a host list on an
8593 IPv4-only host, Exim will not treat them as host names. They are just addresses
8594 that can never match a client host.
8595
8596 .next
8597 .cindex "@[] in a host list"
8598 If the pattern is &"@[]"&, it matches the IP address of any IP interface on
8599 the local host. For example, if the local host is an IPv4 host with one
8600 interface address 10.45.23.56, these two ACL statements have the same effect:
8601 .code
8602 accept hosts = 127.0.0.1 : 10.45.23.56
8603 accept hosts = @[]
8604 .endd
8605 .next
8606 .cindex "CIDR notation"
8607 If the pattern is an IP address followed by a slash and a mask length (for
8608 example 10.11.42.0/24), it is matched against the IP address of the subject
8609 host under the given mask. This allows, an entire network of hosts to be
8610 included (or excluded) by a single item. The mask uses CIDR notation; it
8611 specifies the number of address bits that must match, starting from the most
8612 significant end of the address.
8613
8614 &*Note*&: The mask is &'not'& a count of addresses, nor is it the high number
8615 of a range of addresses. It is the number of bits in the network portion of the
8616 address. The above example specifies a 24-bit netmask, so it matches all 256
8617 addresses in the 10.11.42.0 network. An item such as
8618 .code
8619 192.168.23.236/31
8620 .endd
8621 matches just two addresses, 192.168.23.236 and 192.168.23.237. A mask value of
8622 32 for an IPv4 address is the same as no mask at all; just a single address
8623 matches.
8624
8625 Here is another example which shows an IPv4 and an IPv6 network:
8626 .code
8627 recipient_unqualified_hosts = 192.168.0.0/16: \
8628 3ffe::ffff::836f::::/48
8629 .endd
8630 The doubling of list separator characters applies only when these items
8631 appear inline in a host list. It is not required when indirecting via a file.
8632 For example:
8633 .code
8634 recipient_unqualified_hosts = /opt/exim/unqualnets
8635 .endd
8636 could make use of a file containing
8637 .code
8638 172.16.0.0/12
8639 3ffe:ffff:836f::/48
8640 .endd
8641 to have exactly the same effect as the previous example. When listing IPv6
8642 addresses inline, it is usually more convenient to use the facility for
8643 changing separator characters. This list contains the same two networks:
8644 .code
8645 recipient_unqualified_hosts = <; 172.16.0.0/12; \
8646 3ffe:ffff:836f::/48
8647 .endd
8648 The separator is changed to semicolon by the leading &"<;"& at the start of the
8649 list.
8650 .endlist
8651
8652
8653
8654 .section "Host list patterns for single-key lookups by host address" &&&
8655 "SECThoslispatsikey"
8656 .cindex "host list" "lookup of IP address"
8657 When a host is to be identified by a single-key lookup of its complete IP
8658 address, the pattern takes this form:
8659 .display
8660 &`net-<`&&'single-key-search-type'&&`>;<`&&'search-data'&&`>`&
8661 .endd
8662 For example:
8663 .code
8664 hosts_lookup = net-cdb;/hosts-by-ip.db
8665 .endd
8666 The text form of the IP address of the subject host is used as the lookup key.
8667 IPv6 addresses are converted to an unabbreviated form, using lower case
8668 letters, with dots as separators because colon is the key terminator in
8669 &(lsearch)& files. [Colons can in fact be used in keys in &(lsearch)& files by
8670 quoting the keys, but this is a facility that was added later.] The data
8671 returned by the lookup is not used.
8672
8673 .cindex "IP address" "masking"
8674 .cindex "host list" "masked IP address"
8675 Single-key lookups can also be performed using masked IP addresses, using
8676 patterns of this form:
8677 .display
8678 &`net<`&&'number'&&`>-<`&&'single-key-search-type'&&`>;<`&&'search-data'&&`>`&
8679 .endd
8680 For example:
8681 .code
8682 net24-dbm;/networks.db
8683 .endd
8684 The IP address of the subject host is masked using <&'number'&> as the mask
8685 length. A textual string is constructed from the masked value, followed by the
8686 mask, and this is used as the lookup key. For example, if the host's IP address
8687 is 192.168.34.6, the key that is looked up for the above example is
8688 &"192.168.34.0/24"&.
8689
8690 When an IPv6 address is converted to a string, dots are normally used instead
8691 of colons, so that keys in &(lsearch)& files need not contain colons (which
8692 terminate &(lsearch)& keys). This was implemented some time before the ability
8693 to quote keys was made available in &(lsearch)& files. However, the more
8694 recently implemented &(iplsearch)& files do require colons in IPv6 keys
8695 (notated using the quoting facility) so as to distinguish them from IPv4 keys.
8696 For this reason, when the lookup type is &(iplsearch)&, IPv6 addresses are
8697 converted using colons and not dots.
8698 .new
8699 In all cases except IPv4-mapped IPv6, full, unabbreviated IPv6
8700 addresses are always used.
8701 The latter are converted to IPv4 addresses, in dotted-quad form.
8702 .wen
8703
8704 Ideally, it would be nice to tidy up this anomalous situation by changing to
8705 colons in all cases, given that quoting is now available for &(lsearch)&.
8706 However, this would be an incompatible change that might break some existing
8707 configurations.
8708
8709 &*Warning*&: Specifying &%net32-%& (for an IPv4 address) or &%net128-%& (for an
8710 IPv6 address) is not the same as specifying just &%net-%& without a number. In
8711 the former case the key strings include the mask value, whereas in the latter
8712 case the IP address is used on its own.
8713
8714
8715
8716 .section "Host list patterns that match by host name" "SECThoslispatnam"
8717 .cindex "host" "lookup failures"
8718 .cindex "unknown host name"
8719 .cindex "host list" "matching host name"
8720 There are several types of pattern that require Exim to know the name of the
8721 remote host. These are either wildcard patterns or lookups by name. (If a
8722 complete hostname is given without any wildcarding, it is used to find an IP
8723 address to match against, as described in section &<<SECThoslispatip>>&
8724 above.)
8725
8726 If the remote host name is not already known when Exim encounters one of these
8727 patterns, it has to be found from the IP address.
8728 Although many sites on the Internet are conscientious about maintaining reverse
8729 DNS data for their hosts, there are also many that do not do this.
8730 Consequently, a name cannot always be found, and this may lead to unwanted
8731 effects. Take care when configuring host lists with wildcarded name patterns.
8732 Consider what will happen if a name cannot be found.
8733
8734 Because of the problems of determining host names from IP addresses, matching
8735 against host names is not as common as matching against IP addresses.
8736
8737 By default, in order to find a host name, Exim first does a reverse DNS lookup;
8738 if no name is found in the DNS, the system function (&[gethostbyaddr()]& or
8739 &[getipnodebyaddr()]& if available) is tried. The order in which these lookups
8740 are done can be changed by setting the &%host_lookup_order%& option. For
8741 security, once Exim has found one or more names, it looks up the IP addresses
8742 for these names and compares them with the IP address that it started with.
8743 Only those names whose IP addresses match are accepted. Any other names are
8744 discarded. If no names are left, Exim behaves as if the host name cannot be
8745 found. In the most common case there is only one name and one IP address.
8746
8747 There are some options that control what happens if a host name cannot be
8748 found. These are described in section &<<SECTbehipnot>>& below.
8749
8750 .cindex "host" "alias for"
8751 .cindex "alias for host"
8752 As a result of aliasing, hosts may have more than one name. When processing any
8753 of the following types of pattern, all the host's names are checked:
8754
8755 .ilist
8756 .cindex "asterisk" "in host list"
8757 If a pattern starts with &"*"& the remainder of the item must match the end of
8758 the host name. For example, &`*.b.c`& matches all hosts whose names end in
8759 &'.b.c'&. This special simple form is provided because this is a very common
8760 requirement. Other kinds of wildcarding require the use of a regular
8761 expression.
8762 .next
8763 .cindex "regular expressions" "in host list"
8764 .cindex "host list" "regular expression in"
8765 If the item starts with &"^"& it is taken to be a regular expression which is
8766 matched against the host name. Host names are case-independent, so this regular
8767 expression match is by default case-independent, but you can make it
8768 case-dependent by starting it with &`(?-i)`&. References to descriptions of the
8769 syntax of regular expressions are given in chapter &<<CHAPregexp>>&. For
8770 example,
8771 .code
8772 ^(a|b)\.c\.d$
8773 .endd
8774 is a regular expression that matches either of the two hosts &'a.c.d'& or
8775 &'b.c.d'&. When a regular expression is used in a host list, you must take care
8776 that backslash and dollar characters are not misinterpreted as part of the
8777 string expansion. The simplest way to do this is to use &`\N`& to mark that
8778 part of the string as non-expandable. For example:
8779 .code
8780 sender_unqualified_hosts = \N^(a|b)\.c\.d$\N : ....
8781 .endd
8782 &*Warning*&: If you want to match a complete host name, you must include the
8783 &`$`& terminating metacharacter in the regular expression, as in the above
8784 example. Without it, a match at the start of the host name is all that is
8785 required.
8786 .endlist
8787
8788
8789
8790
8791 .section "Behaviour when an IP address or name cannot be found" "SECTbehipnot"
8792 .cindex "host" "lookup failures, permanent"
8793 While processing a host list, Exim may need to look up an IP address from a
8794 name (see section &<<SECThoslispatip>>&), or it may need to look up a host name
8795 from an IP address (see section &<<SECThoslispatnam>>&). In either case, the
8796 behaviour when it fails to find the information it is seeking is the same.
8797
8798 &*Note*&: This section applies to permanent lookup failures. It does &'not'&
8799 apply to temporary DNS errors, whose handling is described in the next section.
8800
8801 .cindex "&`+include_unknown`&"
8802 .cindex "&`+ignore_unknown`&"
8803 Exim parses a host list from left to right. If it encounters a permanent
8804 lookup failure in any item in the host list before it has found a match,
8805 Exim treats it as a failure and the default behavior is as if the host
8806 does not match the list. This may not always be what you want to happen.
8807 To change Exim's behaviour, the special items &`+include_unknown`& or
8808 &`+ignore_unknown`& may appear in the list (at top level &-- they are
8809 not recognized in an indirected file).
8810
8811 .ilist
8812 If any item that follows &`+include_unknown`& requires information that
8813 cannot found, Exim behaves as if the host does match the list. For example,
8814 .code
8815 host_reject_connection = +include_unknown:*.enemy.ex
8816 .endd
8817 rejects connections from any host whose name matches &`*.enemy.ex`&, and also
8818 any hosts whose name it cannot find.
8819
8820 .next
8821 If any item that follows &`+ignore_unknown`& requires information that cannot
8822 be found, Exim ignores that item and proceeds to the rest of the list. For
8823 example:
8824 .code
8825 accept hosts = +ignore_unknown : friend.example : \
8826 192.168.4.5
8827 .endd
8828 accepts from any host whose name is &'friend.example'& and from 192.168.4.5,
8829 whether or not its host name can be found. Without &`+ignore_unknown`&, if no
8830 name can be found for 192.168.4.5, it is rejected.
8831 .endlist
8832
8833 Both &`+include_unknown`& and &`+ignore_unknown`& may appear in the same
8834 list. The effect of each one lasts until the next, or until the end of the
8835 list.
8836
8837 .section "Mixing wildcarded host names and addresses in host lists" &&&
8838 "SECTmixwilhos"
8839 .cindex "host list" "mixing names and addresses in"
8840
8841 This section explains the host/ip processing logic with the same concepts
8842 as the previous section, but specifically addresses what happens when a
8843 wildcarded hostname is one of the items in the hostlist.
8844
8845 .ilist
8846 If you have name lookups or wildcarded host names and
8847 IP addresses in the same host list, you should normally put the IP
8848 addresses first. For example, in an ACL you could have:
8849 .code
8850 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7 : *.friend.example
8851 .endd
8852 The reason you normally would order it this way lies in the
8853 left-to-right way that Exim processes lists. It can test IP addresses
8854 without doing any DNS lookups, but when it reaches an item that requires
8855 a host name, it fails if it cannot find a host name to compare with the
8856 pattern. If the above list is given in the opposite order, the
8857 &%accept%& statement fails for a host whose name cannot be found, even
8858 if its IP address is 10.9.8.7.
8859
8860 .next
8861 If you really do want to do the name check first, and still recognize the IP
8862 address, you can rewrite the ACL like this:
8863 .code
8864 accept hosts = *.friend.example
8865 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7
8866 .endd
8867 If the first &%accept%& fails, Exim goes on to try the second one. See chapter
8868 &<<CHAPACL>>& for details of ACLs. Alternatively, you can use
8869 &`+ignore_unknown`&, which was discussed in depth in the first example in
8870 this section.
8871 .endlist
8872
8873
8874 .section "Temporary DNS errors when looking up host information" &&&
8875 "SECTtemdnserr"
8876 .cindex "host" "lookup failures, temporary"
8877 .cindex "&`+include_defer`&"
8878 .cindex "&`+ignore_defer`&"
8879 A temporary DNS lookup failure normally causes a defer action (except when
8880 &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& converts it into a permanent error). However,
8881 host lists can include &`+ignore_defer`& and &`+include_defer`&, analogous to
8882 &`+ignore_unknown`& and &`+include_unknown`&, as described in the previous
8883 section. These options should be used with care, probably only in non-critical
8884 host lists such as whitelists.
8885
8886
8887
8888 .section "Host list patterns for single-key lookups by host name" &&&
8889 "SECThoslispatnamsk"
8890 .cindex "unknown host name"
8891 .cindex "host list" "matching host name"
8892 If a pattern is of the form
8893 .display
8894 <&'single-key-search-type'&>;<&'search-data'&>
8895 .endd
8896 for example
8897 .code
8898 dbm;/host/accept/list
8899 .endd
8900 a single-key lookup is performed, using the host name as its key. If the
8901 lookup succeeds, the host matches the item. The actual data that is looked up
8902 is not used.
8903
8904 &*Reminder*&: With this kind of pattern, you must have host &'names'& as
8905 keys in the file, not IP addresses. If you want to do lookups based on IP
8906 addresses, you must precede the search type with &"net-"& (see section
8907 &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&). There is, however, no reason why you could not use
8908 two items in the same list, one doing an address lookup and one doing a name
8909 lookup, both using the same file.
8910
8911
8912
8913 .section "Host list patterns for query-style lookups" "SECID81"
8914 If a pattern is of the form
8915 .display
8916 <&'query-style-search-type'&>;<&'query'&>
8917 .endd
8918 the query is obeyed, and if it succeeds, the host matches the item. The actual
8919 data that is looked up is not used. The variables &$sender_host_address$& and
8920 &$sender_host_name$& can be used in the query. For example:
8921 .code
8922 hosts_lookup = pgsql;\
8923 select ip from hostlist where ip='$sender_host_address'
8924 .endd
8925 The value of &$sender_host_address$& for an IPv6 address contains colons. You
8926 can use the &%sg%& expansion item to change this if you need to. If you want to
8927 use masked IP addresses in database queries, you can use the &%mask%& expansion
8928 operator.
8929
8930 If the query contains a reference to &$sender_host_name$&, Exim automatically
8931 looks up the host name if it has not already done so. (See section
8932 &<<SECThoslispatnam>>& for comments on finding host names.)
8933
8934 Historical note: prior to release 4.30, Exim would always attempt to find a
8935 host name before running the query, unless the search type was preceded by
8936 &`net-`&. This is no longer the case. For backwards compatibility, &`net-`& is
8937 still recognized for query-style lookups, but its presence or absence has no
8938 effect. (Of course, for single-key lookups, &`net-`& &'is'& important.
8939 See section &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&.)
8940
8941
8942
8943
8944
8945 .section "Address lists" "SECTaddresslist"
8946 .cindex "list" "address list"
8947 .cindex "address list" "empty item"
8948 .cindex "address list" "patterns"
8949 Address lists contain patterns that are matched against mail addresses. There
8950 is one special case to be considered: the sender address of a bounce message is
8951 always empty. You can test for this by providing an empty item in an address
8952 list. For example, you can set up a router to process bounce messages by
8953 using this option setting:
8954 .code
8955 senders = :
8956 .endd
8957 The presence of the colon creates an empty item. If you do not provide any
8958 data, the list is empty and matches nothing. The empty sender can also be
8959 detected by a regular expression that matches an empty string,
8960 and by a query-style lookup that succeeds when &$sender_address$& is empty.
8961
8962 Non-empty items in an address list can be straightforward email addresses. For
8963 example:
8964 .code
8965 senders = jbc@askone.example : hs@anacreon.example
8966 .endd
8967 A certain amount of wildcarding is permitted. If a pattern contains an @
8968 character, but is not a regular expression and does not begin with a
8969 semicolon-terminated lookup type (described below), the local part of the
8970 subject address is compared with the local part of the pattern, which may start
8971 with an asterisk. If the local parts match, the domain is checked in exactly
8972 the same way as for a pattern in a domain list. For example, the domain can be
8973 wildcarded, refer to a named list, or be a lookup:
8974 .code
8975 deny senders = *@*.spamming.site:\
8976 *@+hostile_domains:\
8977 bozo@partial-lsearch;/list/of/dodgy/sites:\
8978 *@dbm;/bad/domains.db
8979 .endd
8980 .cindex "local part" "starting with !"
8981 .cindex "address list" "local part starting with !"
8982 If a local part that begins with an exclamation mark is required, it has to be
8983 specified using a regular expression, because otherwise the exclamation mark is
8984 treated as a sign of negation, as is standard in lists.
8985
8986 If a non-empty pattern that is not a regular expression or a lookup does not
8987 contain an @ character, it is matched against the domain part of the subject
8988 address. The only two formats that are recognized this way are a literal
8989 domain, or a domain pattern that starts with *. In both these cases, the effect
8990 is the same as if &`*@`& preceded the pattern. For example:
8991 .code
8992 deny senders = enemy.domain : *.enemy.domain
8993 .endd
8994
8995 The following kinds of more complicated address list pattern can match any
8996 address, including the empty address that is characteristic of bounce message
8997 senders:
8998
8999 .ilist
9000 .cindex "regular expressions" "in address list"
9001 .cindex "address list" "regular expression in"
9002 If (after expansion) a pattern starts with &"^"&, a regular expression match is
9003 done against the complete address, with the pattern as the regular expression.
9004 You must take care that backslash and dollar characters are not misinterpreted
9005 as part of the string expansion. The simplest way to do this is to use &`\N`&
9006 to mark that part of the string as non-expandable. For example:
9007 .code
9008 deny senders = \N^.*this.*@example\.com$\N : \
9009 \N^\d{8}.+@spamhaus.example$\N : ...
9010 .endd
9011 The &`\N`& sequences are removed by the expansion, so these items do indeed
9012 start with &"^"& by the time they are being interpreted as address patterns.
9013
9014 .next
9015 .cindex "address list" "lookup for complete address"
9016 Complete addresses can be looked up by using a pattern that starts with a
9017 lookup type terminated by a semicolon, followed by the data for the lookup. For
9018 example:
9019 .code
9020 deny senders = cdb;/etc/blocked.senders : \
9021 mysql;select address from blocked where \
9022 address='${quote_mysql:$sender_address}'
9023 .endd
9024 Both query-style and single-key lookup types can be used. For a single-key
9025 lookup type, Exim uses the complete address as the key. However, empty keys are
9026 not supported for single-key lookups, so a match against the empty address
9027 always fails. This restriction does not apply to query-style lookups.
9028
9029 Partial matching for single-key lookups (section &<<SECTpartiallookup>>&)
9030 cannot be used, and is ignored if specified, with an entry being written to the
9031 panic log.
9032 .cindex "*@ with single-key lookup"
9033 However, you can configure lookup defaults, as described in section
9034 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>&, but this is useful only for the &"*@"& type of
9035 default. For example, with this lookup:
9036 .code
9037 accept senders = lsearch*@;/some/file
9038 .endd
9039 the file could contains lines like this:
9040 .code
9041 user1@domain1.example
9042 *@domain2.example
9043 .endd
9044 and for the sender address &'nimrod@jaeger.example'&, the sequence of keys
9045 that are tried is:
9046 .code
9047 nimrod@jaeger.example
9048 *@jaeger.example
9049 *
9050 .endd
9051 &*Warning 1*&: Do not include a line keyed by &"*"& in the file, because that
9052 would mean that every address matches, thus rendering the test useless.
9053
9054 &*Warning 2*&: Do not confuse these two kinds of item:
9055 .code
9056 deny recipients = dbm*@;/some/file
9057 deny recipients = *@dbm;/some/file
9058 .endd
9059 The first does a whole address lookup, with defaulting, as just described,
9060 because it starts with a lookup type. The second matches the local part and
9061 domain independently, as described in a bullet point below.
9062 .endlist
9063
9064
9065 The following kinds of address list pattern can match only non-empty addresses.
9066 If the subject address is empty, a match against any of these pattern types
9067 always fails.
9068
9069
9070 .ilist
9071 .cindex "@@ with single-key lookup"
9072 .cindex "address list" "@@ lookup type"
9073 .cindex "address list" "split local part and domain"
9074 If a pattern starts with &"@@"& followed by a single-key lookup item
9075 (for example, &`@@lsearch;/some/file`&), the address that is being checked is
9076 split into a local part and a domain. The domain is looked up in the file. If
9077 it is not found, there is no match. If it is found, the data that is looked up
9078 from the file is treated as a colon-separated list of local part patterns, each
9079 of which is matched against the subject local part in turn.
9080
9081 .cindex "asterisk" "in address list"
9082 The lookup may be a partial one, and/or one involving a search for a default
9083 keyed by &"*"& (see section &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>&). The local part
9084 patterns that are looked up can be regular expressions or begin with &"*"&, or
9085 even be further lookups. They may also be independently negated. For example,
9086 with
9087 .code
9088 deny senders = @@dbm;/etc/reject-by-domain
9089 .endd
9090 the data from which the DBM file is built could contain lines like
9091 .code
9092 baddomain.com: !postmaster : *
9093 .endd
9094 to reject all senders except &%postmaster%& from that domain.
9095
9096 .cindex "local part" "starting with !"
9097 If a local part that actually begins with an exclamation mark is required, it
9098 has to be specified using a regular expression. In &(lsearch)& files, an entry
9099 may be split over several lines by indenting the second and subsequent lines,
9100 but the separating colon must still be included at line breaks. White space
9101 surrounding the colons is ignored. For example:
9102 .code
9103 aol.com: spammer1 : spammer2 : ^[0-9]+$ :
9104 spammer3 : spammer4
9105 .endd
9106 As in all colon-separated lists in Exim, a colon can be included in an item by
9107 doubling.
9108
9109 If the last item in the list starts with a right angle-bracket, the remainder
9110 of the item is taken as a new key to look up in order to obtain a continuation
9111 list of local parts. The new key can be any sequence of characters. Thus one
9112 might have entries like
9113 .code
9114 aol.com: spammer1 : spammer 2 : >*
9115 xyz.com: spammer3 : >*
9116 *: ^\d{8}$
9117 .endd
9118 in a file that was searched with &%@@dbm*%&, to specify a match for 8-digit
9119 local parts for all domains, in addition to the specific local parts listed for
9120 each domain. Of course, using this feature costs another lookup each time a
9121 chain is followed, but the effort needed to maintain the data is reduced.
9122
9123 .cindex "loop" "in lookups"
9124 It is possible to construct loops using this facility, and in order to catch
9125 them, the chains may be no more than fifty items long.
9126
9127 .next
9128 The @@<&'lookup'&> style of item can also be used with a query-style
9129 lookup, but in this case, the chaining facility is not available. The lookup
9130 can only return a single list of local parts.
9131 .endlist
9132
9133 &*Warning*&: There is an important difference between the address list items
9134 in these two examples:
9135 .code
9136 senders = +my_list
9137 senders = *@+my_list
9138 .endd
9139 In the first one, &`my_list`& is a named address list, whereas in the second
9140 example it is a named domain list.
9141
9142
9143
9144
9145 .section "Case of letters in address lists" "SECTcasletadd"
9146 .cindex "case of local parts"
9147 .cindex "address list" "case forcing"
9148 .cindex "case forcing in address lists"
9149 Domains in email addresses are always handled caselessly, but for local parts
9150 case may be significant on some systems (see &%caseful_local_part%& for how
9151 Exim deals with this when routing addresses). However, RFC 2505 (&'Anti-Spam
9152 Recommendations for SMTP MTAs'&) suggests that matching of addresses to
9153 blocking lists should be done in a case-independent manner. Since most address
9154 lists in Exim are used for this kind of control, Exim attempts to do this by
9155 default.
9156
9157 The domain portion of an address is always lowercased before matching it to an
9158 address list. The local part is lowercased by default, and any string
9159 comparisons that take place are done caselessly. This means that the data in
9160 the address list itself, in files included as plain filenames, and in any file
9161 that is looked up using the &"@@"& mechanism, can be in any case. However, the
9162 keys in files that are looked up by a search type other than &(lsearch)& (which
9163 works caselessly) must be in lower case, because these lookups are not
9164 case-independent.
9165
9166 .cindex "&`+caseful`&"
9167 To allow for the possibility of caseful address list matching, if an item in
9168 an address list is the string &"+caseful"&, the original case of the local
9169 part is restored for any comparisons that follow, and string comparisons are no
9170 longer case-independent. This does not affect the domain, which remains in
9171 lower case. However, although independent matches on the domain alone are still
9172 performed caselessly, regular expressions that match against an entire address
9173 become case-sensitive after &"+caseful"& has been seen.
9174
9175
9176
9177 .section "Local part lists" "SECTlocparlis"
9178 .cindex "list" "local part list"
9179 .cindex "local part" "list"
9180 Case-sensitivity in local part lists is handled in the same way as for address
9181 lists, as just described. The &"+caseful"& item can be used if required. In a
9182 setting of the &%local_parts%& option in a router with &%caseful_local_part%&
9183 set false, the subject is lowercased and the matching is initially
9184 case-insensitive. In this case, &"+caseful"& will restore case-sensitive
9185 matching in the local part list, but not elsewhere in the router. If
9186 &%caseful_local_part%& is set true in a router, matching in the &%local_parts%&
9187 option is case-sensitive from the start.
9188
9189 If a local part list is indirected to a file (see section &<<SECTfilnamlis>>&),
9190 comments are handled in the same way as address lists &-- they are recognized
9191 only if the # is preceded by white space or the start of the line.
9192 Otherwise, local part lists are matched in the same way as domain lists, except
9193 that the special items that refer to the local host (&`@`&, &`@[]`&,
9194 &`@mx_any`&, &`@mx_primary`&, and &`@mx_secondary`&) are not recognized.
9195 Refer to section &<<SECTdomainlist>>& for details of the other available item
9196 types.
9197 .ecindex IIDdohoadli
9198
9199
9200
9201
9202 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
9203 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
9204
9205 .chapter "String expansions" "CHAPexpand"
9206 .scindex IIDstrexp "expansion" "of strings"
9207 Many strings in Exim's runtime configuration are expanded before use. Some of
9208 them are expanded every time they are used; others are expanded only once.
9209
9210 When a string is being expanded it is copied verbatim from left to right except
9211 .cindex expansion "string concatenation"
9212 when a dollar or backslash character is encountered. A dollar specifies the
9213 start of a portion of the string that is interpreted and replaced as described
9214 below in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& onwards. Backslash is used as an
9215 escape character, as described in the following section.
9216
9217 Whether a string is expanded depends upon the context. Usually this is solely
9218 dependent upon the option for which a value is sought; in this documentation,
9219 options for which string expansion is performed are marked with &dagger; after
9220 the data type. ACL rules always expand strings. A couple of expansion
9221 conditions do not expand some of the brace-delimited branches, for security
9222 reasons.
9223
9224
9225
9226 .section "Literal text in expanded strings" "SECTlittext"
9227 .cindex "expansion" "including literal text"
9228 An uninterpreted dollar can be included in an expanded string by putting a
9229 backslash in front of it. A backslash can be used to prevent any special
9230 character being treated specially in an expansion, including backslash itself.
9231 If the string appears in quotes in the configuration file, two backslashes are
9232 required because the quotes themselves cause interpretation of backslashes when
9233 the string is read in (see section &<<SECTstrings>>&).
9234
9235 .cindex "expansion" "non-expandable substrings"
9236 A portion of the string can specified as non-expandable by placing it between
9237 two occurrences of &`\N`&. This is particularly useful for protecting regular
9238 expressions, which often contain backslashes and dollar signs. For example:
9239 .code
9240 deny senders = \N^\d{8}[a-z]@some\.site\.example$\N
9241 .endd
9242 On encountering the first &`\N`&, the expander copies subsequent characters
9243 without interpretation until it reaches the next &`\N`& or the end of the
9244 string.
9245
9246
9247
9248 .section "Character escape sequences in expanded strings" "SECID82"
9249 .cindex "expansion" "escape sequences"
9250 A backslash followed by one of the letters &"n"&, &"r"&, or &"t"& in an
9251 expanded string is recognized as an escape sequence for the character newline,
9252 carriage return, or tab, respectively. A backslash followed by up to three
9253 octal digits is recognized as an octal encoding for a single character, and a
9254 backslash followed by &"x"& and up to two hexadecimal digits is a hexadecimal
9255 encoding.
9256
9257 These escape sequences are also recognized in quoted strings when they are read
9258 in. Their interpretation in expansions as well is useful for unquoted strings,
9259 and for other cases such as looked-up strings that are then expanded.
9260
9261
9262 .section "Testing string expansions" "SECID83"
9263 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
9264 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
9265 .oindex "&%-be%&"
9266 Many expansions can be tested by calling Exim with the &%-be%& option. This
9267 takes the command arguments, or lines from the standard input if there are no
9268 arguments, runs them through the string expansion code, and writes the results
9269 to the standard output. Variables based on configuration values are set up, but
9270 since no message is being processed, variables such as &$local_part$& have no
9271 value. Nevertheless the &%-be%& option can be useful for checking out file and
9272 database lookups, and the use of expansion operators such as &%sg%&, &%substr%&
9273 and &%nhash%&.
9274
9275 Exim gives up its root privilege when it is called with the &%-be%& option, and
9276 instead runs under the uid and gid it was called with, to prevent users from
9277 using &%-be%& for reading files to which they do not have access.
9278
9279 .oindex "&%-bem%&"
9280 If you want to test expansions that include variables whose values are taken
9281 from a message, there are two other options that can be used. The &%-bem%&
9282 option is like &%-be%& except that it is followed by a filename. The file is
9283 read as a message before doing the test expansions. For example:
9284 .code
9285 exim -bem /tmp/test.message '$h_subject:'
9286 .endd
9287 The &%-Mset%& option is used in conjunction with &%-be%& and is followed by an
9288 Exim message identifier. For example:
9289 .code
9290 exim -be -Mset 1GrA8W-0004WS-LQ '$recipients'
9291 .endd
9292 This loads the message from Exim's spool before doing the test expansions, and
9293 is therefore restricted to admin users.
9294
9295
9296 .section "Forced expansion failure" "SECTforexpfai"
9297 .cindex "expansion" "forced failure"
9298 A number of expansions that are described in the following section have
9299 alternative &"true"& and &"false"& substrings, enclosed in brace characters
9300 (which are sometimes called &"curly brackets"&). Which of the two strings is
9301 used depends on some condition that is evaluated as part of the expansion. If,
9302 instead of a &"false"& substring, the word &"fail"& is used (not in braces),
9303 the entire string expansion fails in a way that can be detected by the code
9304 that requested the expansion. This is called &"forced expansion failure"&, and
9305 its consequences depend on the circumstances. In some cases it is no different
9306 from any other expansion failure, but in others a different action may be
9307 taken. Such variations are mentioned in the documentation of the option that is
9308 being expanded.
9309
9310
9311
9312
9313 .section "Expansion items" "SECTexpansionitems"
9314 The following items are recognized in expanded strings. White space may be used
9315 between sub-items that are keywords or substrings enclosed in braces inside an
9316 outer set of braces, to improve readability. &*Warning*&: Within braces,
9317 white space is significant.
9318
9319 .vlist
9320 .vitem &*$*&<&'variable&~name'&>&~or&~&*${*&<&'variable&~name'&>&*}*&
9321 .cindex "expansion" "variables"
9322 Substitute the contents of the named variable, for example:
9323 .code
9324 $local_part
9325 ${domain}
9326 .endd
9327 The second form can be used to separate the name from subsequent alphanumeric
9328 characters. This form (using braces) is available only for variables; it does
9329 &'not'& apply to message headers. The names of the variables are given in
9330 section &<<SECTexpvar>>& below. If the name of a non-existent variable is
9331 given, the expansion fails.
9332
9333 .vitem &*${*&<&'op'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9334 .cindex "expansion" "operators"
9335 The string is first itself expanded, and then the operation specified by
9336 <&'op'&> is applied to it. For example:
9337 .code
9338 ${lc:$local_part}
9339 .endd
9340 The string starts with the first character after the colon, which may be
9341 leading white space. A list of operators is given in section &<<SECTexpop>>&
9342 below. The operator notation is used for simple expansion items that have just
9343 one argument, because it reduces the number of braces and therefore makes the
9344 string easier to understand.
9345
9346 .vitem &*$bheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&*$bh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&
9347 This item inserts &"basic"& header lines. It is described with the &%header%&
9348 expansion item below.
9349
9350
9351 .vitem "&*${acl{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&"
9352 .cindex "expansion" "calling an acl"
9353 .cindex "&%acl%&" "call from expansion"
9354 The name and zero to nine argument strings are first expanded separately. The expanded
9355 arguments are assigned to the variables &$acl_arg1$& to &$acl_arg9$& in order.
9356 Any unused are made empty. The variable &$acl_narg$& is set to the number of
9357 arguments. The named ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) is called
9358 and may use the variables; if another acl expansion is used the values
9359 are restored after it returns. If the ACL sets
9360 a value using a "message =" modifier and returns accept or deny, the value becomes
9361 the result of the expansion.
9362 If no message is set and the ACL returns accept or deny
9363 the expansion result is an empty string.
9364 If the ACL returns defer the result is a forced-fail. Otherwise the expansion fails.
9365
9366
9367 .vitem "&*${authresults{*&<&'authserv-id'&>&*}}*&"
9368 .cindex authentication "results header"
9369 .cindex headers "authentication-results:"
9370 .cindex authentication "expansion item"
9371 This item returns a string suitable for insertion as an
9372 &'Authentication-Results"'&
9373 header line.
9374 The given <&'authserv-id'&> is included in the result; typically this
9375 will be a domain name identifying the system performing the authentications.
9376 Methods that might be present in the result include:
9377 .code
9378 none
9379 iprev
9380 auth
9381 spf
9382 dkim
9383 .endd
9384
9385 Example use (as an ACL modifier):
9386 .code
9387 add_header = :at_start:${authresults {$primary_hostname}}
9388 .endd
9389 This is safe even if no authentication results are available.
9390
9391
9392 .vitem "&*${certextract{*&<&'field'&>&*}{*&<&'certificate'&>&*}&&&
9393 {*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9394 .cindex "expansion" "extracting certificate fields"
9395 .cindex "&%certextract%&" "certificate fields"
9396 .cindex "certificate" "extracting fields"
9397 The <&'certificate'&> must be a variable of type certificate.
9398 The field name is expanded and used to retrieve the relevant field from
9399 the certificate. Supported fields are:
9400 .display
9401 &`version `&
9402 &`serial_number `&
9403 &`subject `& RFC4514 DN
9404 &`issuer `& RFC4514 DN
9405 &`notbefore `& time
9406 &`notafter `& time
9407 &`sig_algorithm `&
9408 &`signature `&
9409 &`subj_altname `& tagged list
9410 &`ocsp_uri `& list
9411 &`crl_uri `& list
9412 .endd
9413 If the field is found,
9414 <&'string2'&> is expanded, and replaces the whole item;
9415 otherwise <&'string3'&> is used. During the expansion of <&'string2'&> the
9416 variable &$value$& contains the value that has been extracted. Afterwards, it
9417 is restored to any previous value it might have had.
9418
9419 If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, the item is replaced by an empty string if the
9420 key is not found. If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
9421 extracted is used.
9422
9423 Some field names take optional modifiers, appended and separated by commas.
9424
9425 The field selectors marked as "RFC4514" above
9426 output a Distinguished Name string which is
9427 not quite
9428 parseable by Exim as a comma-separated tagged list
9429 (the exceptions being elements containing commas).
9430 RDN elements of a single type may be selected by
9431 a modifier of the type label; if so the expansion
9432 result is a list (newline-separated by default).
9433 The separator may be changed by another modifier of
9434 a right angle-bracket followed immediately by the new separator.
9435 Recognised RDN type labels include "CN", "O", "OU" and "DC".
9436
9437 The field selectors marked as "time" above
9438 take an optional modifier of "int"
9439 for which the result is the number of seconds since epoch.
9440 Otherwise the result is a human-readable string
9441 in the timezone selected by the main "timezone" option.
9442
9443 The field selectors marked as "list" above return a list,
9444 newline-separated by default,
9445 (embedded separator characters in elements are doubled).
9446 The separator may be changed by a modifier of
9447 a right angle-bracket followed immediately by the new separator.
9448
9449 The field selectors marked as "tagged" above
9450 prefix each list element with a type string and an equals sign.
9451 Elements of only one type may be selected by a modifier
9452 which is one of "dns", "uri" or "mail";
9453 if so the element tags are omitted.
9454
9455 If not otherwise noted field values are presented in human-readable form.
9456
9457 .vitem "&*${dlfunc{*&<&'file'&>&*}{*&<&'function'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}&&&
9458 {*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&"
9459 .cindex &%dlfunc%&
9460 This expansion dynamically loads and then calls a locally-written C function.
9461 This functionality is available only if Exim is compiled with
9462 .code
9463 EXPAND_DLFUNC=yes
9464 .endd
9465 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. Once loaded, Exim remembers the dynamically loaded
9466 object so that it doesn't reload the same object file in the same Exim process
9467 (but of course Exim does start new processes frequently).
9468
9469 There may be from zero to eight arguments to the function. When compiling
9470 a local function that is to be called in this way, &_local_scan.h_& should be
9471 included. The Exim variables and functions that are defined by that API
9472 are also available for dynamically loaded functions. The function itself
9473 must have the following type:
9474 .code
9475 int dlfunction(uschar **yield, int argc, uschar *argv[])
9476 .endd
9477 Where &`uschar`& is a typedef for &`unsigned char`& in &_local_scan.h_&. The
9478 function should return one of the following values:
9479
9480 &`OK`&: Success. The string that is placed in the variable &'yield'& is put
9481 into the expanded string that is being built.
9482
9483 &`FAIL`&: A non-forced expansion failure occurs, with the error message taken
9484 from &'yield'&, if it is set.
9485
9486 &`FAIL_FORCED`&: A forced expansion failure occurs, with the error message
9487 taken from &'yield'& if it is set.
9488
9489 &`ERROR`&: Same as &`FAIL`&, except that a panic log entry is written.
9490
9491 When compiling a function that is to be used in this way with gcc,
9492 you need to add &%-shared%& to the gcc command. Also, in the Exim build-time
9493 configuration, you must add &%-export-dynamic%& to EXTRALIBS.
9494
9495
9496 .vitem "&*${env{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9497 .cindex "expansion" "extracting value from environment"
9498 .cindex "environment" "values from"
9499 The key is first expanded separately, and leading and trailing white space
9500 removed.
9501 This is then searched for as a name in the environment.
9502 If a variable is found then its value is placed in &$value$&
9503 and <&'string1'&> is expanded, otherwise <&'string2'&> is expanded.
9504
9505 Instead of {<&'string2'&>} the word &"fail"& (not in curly brackets) can
9506 appear, for example:
9507 .code
9508 ${env{USER}{$value} fail }
9509 .endd
9510 This forces an expansion failure (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&);
9511 {<&'string1'&>} must be present for &"fail"& to be recognized.
9512
9513 If {<&'string2'&>} is omitted an empty string is substituted on
9514 search failure.
9515 If {<&'string1'&>} is omitted the search result is substituted on
9516 search success.
9517
9518 The environment is adjusted by the &%keep_environment%& and
9519 &%add_environment%& main section options.
9520
9521
9522 .vitem "&*${extract{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}&&&
9523 {*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9524 .cindex "expansion" "extracting substrings by key"
9525 .cindex "&%extract%&" "substrings by key"
9526 The key and <&'string1'&> are first expanded separately. Leading and trailing
9527 white space is removed from the key (but not from any of the strings). The key
9528 must not be empty and must not consist entirely of digits.
9529 The expanded <&'string1'&> must be of the form:
9530 .display
9531 <&'key1'&> = <&'value1'&> <&'key2'&> = <&'value2'&> ...
9532 .endd
9533 .vindex "&$value$&"
9534 where the equals signs and spaces (but not both) are optional. If any of the
9535 values contain white space, they must be enclosed in double quotes, and any
9536 values that are enclosed in double quotes are subject to escape processing as
9537 described in section &<<SECTstrings>>&. The expanded <&'string1'&> is searched
9538 for the value that corresponds to the key. The search is case-insensitive. If
9539 the key is found, <&'string2'&> is expanded, and replaces the whole item;
9540 otherwise <&'string3'&> is used. During the expansion of <&'string2'&> the
9541 variable &$value$& contains the value that has been extracted. Afterwards, it
9542 is restored to any previous value it might have had.
9543
9544 If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, the item is replaced by an empty string if the
9545 key is not found. If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
9546 extracted is used. Thus, for example, these two expansions are identical, and
9547 yield &"2001"&:
9548 .code
9549 ${extract{gid}{uid=1984 gid=2001}}
9550 ${extract{gid}{uid=1984 gid=2001}{$value}}
9551 .endd
9552 Instead of {<&'string3'&>} the word &"fail"& (not in curly brackets) can
9553 appear, for example:
9554 .code
9555 ${extract{Z}{A=... B=...}{$value} fail }
9556 .endd
9557 This forces an expansion failure (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&);
9558 {<&'string2'&>} must be present for &"fail"& to be recognized.
9559
9560 .vitem "&*${extract json{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}&&&
9561 {*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&" &&&
9562 "&*${extract jsons{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}&&&
9563 {*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9564 .cindex "expansion" "extracting from JSON object"
9565 .cindex JSON expansions
9566 The key and <&'string1'&> are first expanded separately. Leading and trailing
9567 white space is removed from the key (but not from any of the strings). The key
9568 must not be empty and must not consist entirely of digits.
9569 The expanded <&'string1'&> must be of the form:
9570 .display
9571 { <&'"key1"'&> : <&'value1'&> , <&'"key2"'&> , <&'value2'&> ... }
9572 .endd
9573 .vindex "&$value$&"
9574 The braces, commas and colons, and the quoting of the member name are required;
9575 the spaces are optional.
9576 Matching of the key against the member names is done case-sensitively.
9577 For the &"json"& variant,
9578 if a returned value is a JSON string, it retains its leading and
9579 trailing quotes.
9580 .new
9581 For the &"jsons"& variant, which is intended for use with JSON strings, the
9582 leading and trailing quotes are removed from the returned value.
9583 .wen
9584 . XXX should be a UTF-8 compare
9585
9586 The results of matching are handled as above.
9587
9588
9589 .vitem "&*${extract{*&<&'number'&>&*}{*&<&'separators'&>&*}&&&
9590 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9591 .cindex "expansion" "extracting substrings by number"
9592 .cindex "&%extract%&" "substrings by number"
9593 The <&'number'&> argument must consist entirely of decimal digits,
9594 apart from leading and trailing white space, which is ignored.
9595 This is what distinguishes this form of &%extract%& from the previous kind. It
9596 behaves in the same way, except that, instead of extracting a named field, it
9597 extracts from <&'string1'&> the field whose number is given as the first
9598 argument. You can use &$value$& in <&'string2'&> or &`fail`& instead of
9599 <&'string3'&> as before.
9600
9601 The fields in the string are separated by any one of the characters in the
9602 separator string. These may include space or tab characters.
9603 The first field is numbered one. If the number is negative, the fields are
9604 counted from the end of the string, with the rightmost one numbered -1. If the
9605 number given is zero, the entire string is returned. If the modulus of the
9606 number is greater than the number of fields in the string, the result is the
9607 expansion of <&'string3'&>, or the empty string if <&'string3'&> is not
9608 provided. For example:
9609 .code
9610 ${extract{2}{:}{x:42:99:& Mailer::/bin/bash}}
9611 .endd
9612 yields &"42"&, and
9613 .code
9614 ${extract{-4}{:}{x:42:99:& Mailer::/bin/bash}}
9615 .endd
9616 yields &"99"&. Two successive separators mean that the field between them is
9617 empty (for example, the fifth field above).
9618
9619
9620 .vitem "&*${extract json {*&<&'number'&>&*}}&&&
9621 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&" &&&
9622 "&*${extract jsons{*&<&'number'&>&*}}&&&
9623 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9624 .cindex "expansion" "extracting from JSON array"
9625 .cindex JSON expansions
9626 The <&'number'&> argument must consist entirely of decimal digits,
9627 apart from leading and trailing white space, which is ignored.
9628
9629 Field selection and result handling is as above;
9630 there is no choice of field separator.
9631 For the &"json"& variant,
9632 if a returned value is a JSON string, it retains its leading and
9633 trailing quotes.
9634 .new
9635 For the &"jsons"& variant, which is intended for use with JSON strings, the
9636 leading and trailing quotes are removed from the returned value.
9637 .wen
9638
9639
9640 .vitem &*${filter{*&<&'string'&>&*}{*&<&'condition'&>&*}}*&
9641 .cindex "list" "selecting by condition"
9642 .cindex "expansion" "selecting from list by condition"
9643 .vindex "&$item$&"
9644 After expansion, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
9645 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
9646 For each item
9647 in this list, its value is place in &$item$&, and then the condition is
9648 evaluated. If the condition is true, &$item$& is added to the output as an
9649 item in a new list; if the condition is false, the item is discarded. The
9650 separator used for the output list is the same as the one used for the
9651 input, but a separator setting is not included in the output. For example:
9652 .code
9653 ${filter{a:b:c}{!eq{$item}{b}}}
9654 .endd
9655 yields &`a:c`&. At the end of the expansion, the value of &$item$& is restored
9656 to what it was before. See also the &*map*& and &*reduce*& expansion items.
9657
9658
9659 .vitem &*${hash{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9660 .cindex "hash function" "textual"
9661 .cindex "expansion" "textual hash"
9662 This is a textual hashing function, and was the first to be implemented in
9663 early versions of Exim. In current releases, there are other hashing functions
9664 (numeric, MD5, and SHA-1), which are described below.
9665
9666 The first two strings, after expansion, must be numbers. Call them <&'m'&> and
9667 <&'n'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is, if
9668 <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you can
9669 use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
9670 .code
9671 ${hash_<n>_<m>:<string>}
9672 .endd
9673 The second number is optional (in both notations). If <&'n'&> is greater than
9674 or equal to the length of the string, the expansion item returns the string.
9675 Otherwise it computes a new string of length <&'n'&> by applying a hashing
9676 function to the string. The new string consists of characters taken from the
9677 first <&'m'&> characters of the string
9678 .code
9679 abcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyzABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQWRSTUVWXYZ0123456789
9680 .endd
9681 If <&'m'&> is not present the value 26 is used, so that only lower case
9682 letters appear. For example:
9683 .display
9684 &`$hash{3}{monty}} `& yields &`jmg`&
9685 &`$hash{5}{monty}} `& yields &`monty`&
9686 &`$hash{4}{62}{monty python}}`& yields &`fbWx`&
9687 .endd
9688
9689 .vitem "&*$header_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9690 &*$h_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&" &&&
9691 "&*$bheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9692 &*$bh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&" &&&
9693 "&*$lheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9694 &*$lh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&"
9695 "&*$rheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9696 &*$rh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&"
9697 .cindex "expansion" "header insertion"
9698 .vindex "&$header_$&"
9699 .vindex "&$bheader_$&"
9700 .vindex "&$lheader_$&"
9701 .vindex "&$rheader_$&"
9702 .cindex "header lines" "in expansion strings"
9703 .cindex "header lines" "character sets"
9704 .cindex "header lines" "decoding"
9705 Substitute the contents of the named message header line, for example
9706 .code
9707 $header_reply-to:
9708 .endd
9709 The newline that terminates a header line is not included in the expansion, but
9710 internal newlines (caused by splitting the header line over several physical
9711 lines) may be present.
9712
9713 The difference between the four pairs of expansions is in the way
9714 the data in the header line is interpreted.
9715
9716 .ilist
9717 .cindex "white space" "in header lines"
9718 &%rheader%& gives the original &"raw"& content of the header line, with no
9719 processing at all, and without the removal of leading and trailing white space.
9720
9721 .next
9722 .cindex "list" "of header lines"
9723 &%lheader%& gives a colon-separated list, one element per header when there
9724 are multiple headers with a given name.
9725 Any embedded colon characters within an element are doubled, so normal Exim
9726 list-processing facilities can be used.
9727 The terminating newline of each element is removed; in other respects
9728 the content is &"raw"&.
9729
9730 .next
9731 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in header lines"
9732 &%bheader%& removes leading and trailing white space, and then decodes base64
9733 or quoted-printable MIME &"words"& within the header text, but does no
9734 character set translation. If decoding of what looks superficially like a MIME
9735 &"word"& fails, the raw string is returned. If decoding
9736 .cindex "binary zero" "in header line"
9737 produces a binary zero character, it is replaced by a question mark &-- this is
9738 what Exim does for binary zeros that are actually received in header lines.
9739
9740 .next
9741 &%header%& tries to translate the string as decoded by &%bheader%& to a
9742 standard character set. This is an attempt to produce the same string as would
9743 be displayed on a user's MUA. If translation fails, the &%bheader%& string is
9744 returned. Translation is attempted only on operating systems that support the
9745 &[iconv()]& function. This is indicated by the compile-time macro HAVE_ICONV in
9746 a system Makefile or in &_Local/Makefile_&.
9747 .endlist ilist
9748
9749 In a filter file, the target character set for &%header%& can be specified by a
9750 command of the following form:
9751 .code
9752 headers charset "UTF-8"
9753 .endd
9754 This command affects all references to &$h_$& (or &$header_$&) expansions in
9755 subsequently obeyed filter commands. In the absence of this command, the target
9756 character set in a filter is taken from the setting of the &%headers_charset%&
9757 option in the runtime configuration. The value of this option defaults to the
9758 value of HEADERS_CHARSET in &_Local/Makefile_&. The ultimate default is
9759 ISO-8859-1.
9760
9761 Header names follow the syntax of RFC 2822, which states that they may contain
9762 any printing characters except space and colon. Consequently, curly brackets
9763 &'do not'& terminate header names, and should not be used to enclose them as
9764 if they were variables. Attempting to do so causes a syntax error.
9765
9766 Only header lines that are common to all copies of a message are visible to
9767 this mechanism. These are the original header lines that are received with the
9768 message, and any that are added by an ACL statement or by a system
9769 filter. Header lines that are added to a particular copy of a message by a
9770 router or transport are not accessible.
9771
9772 For incoming SMTP messages, no header lines are visible in
9773 ACLs that are obeyed before the data phase completes,
9774 because the header structure is not set up until the message is received.
9775 They are visible in DKIM, PRDR and DATA ACLs.
9776 Header lines that are added in a RCPT ACL (for example)
9777 are saved until the message's incoming header lines are available, at which
9778 point they are added.
9779 When any of the above ACLs ar
9780 running, however, header lines added by earlier ACLs are visible.
9781
9782 Upper case and lower case letters are synonymous in header names. If the
9783 following character is white space, the terminating colon may be omitted, but
9784 this is not recommended, because you may then forget it when it is needed. When
9785 white space terminates the header name, this white space is included in the
9786 expanded string. If the message does not contain the given header, the
9787 expansion item is replaced by an empty string. (See the &%def%& condition in
9788 section &<<SECTexpcond>>& for a means of testing for the existence of a
9789 header.)
9790
9791 If there is more than one header with the same name, they are all concatenated
9792 to form the substitution string, up to a maximum length of 64K. Unless
9793 &%rheader%& is being used, leading and trailing white space is removed from
9794 each header before concatenation, and a completely empty header is ignored. A
9795 newline character is then inserted between non-empty headers, but there is no
9796 newline at the very end. For the &%header%& and &%bheader%& expansion, for
9797 those headers that contain lists of addresses, a comma is also inserted at the
9798 junctions between headers. This does not happen for the &%rheader%& expansion.
9799
9800
9801 .vitem &*${hmac{*&<&'hashname'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}{*&<&'string'&>&*}}*&
9802 .cindex "expansion" "hmac hashing"
9803 .cindex &%hmac%&
9804 This function uses cryptographic hashing (either MD5 or SHA-1) to convert a
9805 shared secret and some text into a message authentication code, as specified in
9806 RFC 2104. This differs from &`${md5:secret_text...}`& or
9807 &`${sha1:secret_text...}`& in that the hmac step adds a signature to the
9808 cryptographic hash, allowing for authentication that is not possible with MD5
9809 or SHA-1 alone. The hash name must expand to either &`md5`& or &`sha1`& at
9810 present. For example:
9811 .code
9812 ${hmac{md5}{somesecret}{$primary_hostname $tod_log}}
9813 .endd
9814 For the hostname &'mail.example.com'& and time 2002-10-17 11:30:59, this
9815 produces:
9816 .code
9817 dd97e3ba5d1a61b5006108f8c8252953
9818 .endd
9819 As an example of how this might be used, you might put in the main part of
9820 an Exim configuration:
9821 .code
9822 SPAMSCAN_SECRET=cohgheeLei2thahw
9823 .endd
9824 In a router or a transport you could then have:
9825 .code
9826 headers_add = \
9827 X-Spam-Scanned: ${primary_hostname} ${message_exim_id} \
9828 ${hmac{md5}{SPAMSCAN_SECRET}\
9829 {${primary_hostname},${message_exim_id},$h_message-id:}}
9830 .endd
9831 Then given a message, you can check where it was scanned by looking at the
9832 &'X-Spam-Scanned:'& header line. If you know the secret, you can check that
9833 this header line is authentic by recomputing the authentication code from the
9834 host name, message ID and the &'Message-id:'& header line. This can be done
9835 using Exim's &%-be%& option, or by other means, for example, by using the
9836 &'hmac_md5_hex()'& function in Perl.
9837
9838
9839 .vitem &*${if&~*&<&'condition'&>&*&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
9840 .cindex "expansion" "conditional"
9841 .cindex "&%if%&, expansion item"
9842 If <&'condition'&> is true, <&'string1'&> is expanded and replaces the whole
9843 item; otherwise <&'string2'&> is used. The available conditions are described
9844 in section &<<SECTexpcond>>& below. For example:
9845 .code
9846 ${if eq {$local_part}{postmaster} {yes}{no} }
9847 .endd
9848 The second string need not be present; if it is not and the condition is not
9849 true, the item is replaced with nothing. Alternatively, the word &"fail"& may
9850 be present instead of the second string (without any curly brackets). In this
9851 case, the expansion is forced to fail if the condition is not true (see section
9852 &<<SECTforexpfai>>&).
9853
9854 If both strings are omitted, the result is the string &`true`& if the condition
9855 is true, and the empty string if the condition is false. This makes it less
9856 cumbersome to write custom ACL and router conditions. For example, instead of
9857 .code
9858 condition = ${if >{$acl_m4}{3}{true}{false}}
9859 .endd
9860 you can use
9861 .code
9862 condition = ${if >{$acl_m4}{3}}
9863 .endd
9864
9865
9866
9867 .vitem &*${imapfolder{*&<&'foldername'&>&*}}*&
9868 .cindex expansion "imap folder"
9869 .cindex "&%imapfolder%& expansion item"
9870 This item converts a (possibly multilevel, or with non-ASCII characters)
9871 folder specification to a Maildir name for filesystem use.
9872 For information on internationalisation support see &<<SECTi18nMDA>>&.
9873
9874
9875
9876 .vitem &*${length{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
9877 .cindex "expansion" "string truncation"
9878 .cindex "&%length%& expansion item"
9879 The &%length%& item is used to extract the initial portion of a string. Both
9880 strings are expanded, and the first one must yield a number, <&'n'&>, say. If
9881 you are using a fixed value for the number, that is, if <&'string1'&> does not
9882 change when expanded, you can use the simpler operator notation that avoids
9883 some of the braces:
9884 .code
9885 ${length_<n>:<string>}
9886 .endd
9887 The result of this item is either the first <&'n'&> bytes or the whole
9888 of <&'string2'&>, whichever is the shorter. Do not confuse &%length%& with
9889 &%strlen%&, which gives the length of a string.
9890 All measurement is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware.
9891
9892
9893 .vitem "&*${listextract{*&<&'number'&>&*}&&&
9894 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9895 .cindex "expansion" "extracting list elements by number"
9896 .cindex "&%listextract%&" "extract list elements by number"
9897 .cindex "list" "extracting elements by number"
9898 The <&'number'&> argument must consist entirely of decimal digits,
9899 apart from an optional leading minus,
9900 and leading and trailing white space (which is ignored).
9901
9902 After expansion, <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
9903 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
9904
9905 The first field of the list is numbered one.
9906 If the number is negative, the fields are
9907 counted from the end of the list, with the rightmost one numbered -1.
9908 The numbered element of the list is extracted and placed in &$value$&,
9909 then <&'string2'&> is expanded as the result.
9910
9911 If the modulus of the
9912 number is zero or greater than the number of fields in the string,
9913 the result is the expansion of <&'string3'&>.
9914
9915 For example:
9916 .code
9917 ${listextract{2}{x:42:99}}
9918 .endd
9919 yields &"42"&, and
9920 .code
9921 ${listextract{-3}{<, x,42,99,& Mailer,,/bin/bash}{result: $value}}
9922 .endd
9923 yields &"result: 42"&.
9924
9925 If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, an empty string is used for string3.
9926 If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
9927 extracted is used.
9928 You can use &`fail`& instead of {<&'string3'&>} as in a string extract.
9929
9930
9931 .vitem "&*${lookup{*&<&'key'&>&*}&~*&<&'search&~type'&>&*&~&&&
9932 {*&<&'file'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9933 This is the first of one of two different types of lookup item, which are both
9934 described in the next item.
9935
9936 .vitem "&*${lookup&~*&<&'search&~type'&>&*&~{*&<&'query'&>&*}&~&&&
9937 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9938 .cindex "expansion" "lookup in"
9939 .cindex "file" "lookups"
9940 .cindex "lookup" "in expanded string"
9941 The two forms of lookup item specify data lookups in files and databases, as
9942 discussed in chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. The first form is used for single-key
9943 lookups, and the second is used for query-style lookups. The <&'key'&>,
9944 <&'file'&>, and <&'query'&> strings are expanded before use.
9945
9946 If there is any white space in a lookup item which is part of a filter command,
9947 a retry or rewrite rule, a routing rule for the &(manualroute)& router, or any
9948 other place where white space is significant, the lookup item must be enclosed
9949 in double quotes. The use of data lookups in users' filter files may be locked
9950 out by the system administrator.
9951
9952 .vindex "&$value$&"
9953 If the lookup succeeds, <&'string1'&> is expanded and replaces the entire item.
9954 During its expansion, the variable &$value$& contains the data returned by the
9955 lookup. Afterwards it reverts to the value it had previously (at the outer
9956 level it is empty). If the lookup fails, <&'string2'&> is expanded and replaces
9957 the entire item. If {<&'string2'&>} is omitted, the replacement is the empty
9958 string on failure. If <&'string2'&> is provided, it can itself be a nested
9959 lookup, thus providing a mechanism for looking up a default value when the
9960 original lookup fails.
9961
9962 If a nested lookup is used as part of <&'string1'&>, &$value$& contains the
9963 data for the outer lookup while the parameters of the second lookup are
9964 expanded, and also while <&'string2'&> of the second lookup is expanded, should
9965 the second lookup fail. Instead of {<&'string2'&>} the word &"fail"& can
9966 appear, and in this case, if the lookup fails, the entire expansion is forced
9967 to fail (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&). If both {<&'string1'&>} and
9968 {<&'string2'&>} are omitted, the result is the looked up value in the case of a
9969 successful lookup, and nothing in the case of failure.
9970
9971 For single-key lookups, the string &"partial"& is permitted to precede the
9972 search type in order to do partial matching, and * or *@ may follow a search
9973 type to request default lookups if the key does not match (see sections
9974 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>& and &<<SECTpartiallookup>>& for details).
9975
9976 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in lookup expansion"
9977 If a partial search is used, the variables &$1$& and &$2$& contain the wild
9978 and non-wild parts of the key during the expansion of the replacement text.
9979 They return to their previous values at the end of the lookup item.
9980
9981 This example looks up the postmaster alias in the conventional alias file:
9982 .code
9983 ${lookup {postmaster} lsearch {/etc/aliases} {$value}}
9984 .endd
9985 This example uses NIS+ to look up the full name of the user corresponding to
9986 the local part of an address, forcing the expansion to fail if it is not found:
9987 .code
9988 ${lookup nisplus {[name=$local_part],passwd.org_dir:gcos} \
9989 {$value}fail}
9990 .endd
9991
9992
9993 .vitem &*${map{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
9994 .cindex "expansion" "list creation"
9995 .vindex "&$item$&"
9996 After expansion, <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
9997 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
9998 For each item
9999 in this list, its value is place in &$item$&, and then <&'string2'&> is
10000 expanded and added to the output as an item in a new list. The separator used
10001 for the output list is the same as the one used for the input, but a separator
10002 setting is not included in the output. For example:
10003 .code
10004 ${map{a:b:c}{[$item]}} ${map{<- x-y-z}{($item)}}
10005 .endd
10006 expands to &`[a]:[b]:[c] (x)-(y)-(z)`&. At the end of the expansion, the
10007 value of &$item$& is restored to what it was before. See also the &*filter*&
10008 and &*reduce*& expansion items.
10009
10010 .vitem &*${nhash{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
10011 .cindex "expansion" "numeric hash"
10012 .cindex "hash function" "numeric"
10013 The three strings are expanded; the first two must yield numbers. Call them
10014 <&'n'&> and <&'m'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is,
10015 if <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you
10016 can use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
10017 .code
10018 ${nhash_<n>_<m>:<string>}
10019 .endd
10020 The second number is optional (in both notations). If there is only one number,
10021 the result is a number in the range 0&--<&'n'&>-1. Otherwise, the string is
10022 processed by a div/mod hash function that returns two numbers, separated by a
10023 slash, in the ranges 0 to <&'n'&>-1 and 0 to <&'m'&>-1, respectively. For
10024 example,
10025 .code
10026 ${nhash{8}{64}{supercalifragilisticexpialidocious}}
10027 .endd
10028 returns the string &"6/33"&.
10029
10030
10031
10032 .vitem &*${perl{*&<&'subroutine'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&
10033 .cindex "Perl" "use in expanded string"
10034 .cindex "expansion" "calling Perl from"
10035 This item is available only if Exim has been built to include an embedded Perl
10036 interpreter. The subroutine name and the arguments are first separately
10037 expanded, and then the Perl subroutine is called with those arguments. No
10038 additional arguments need be given; the maximum number permitted, including the
10039 name of the subroutine, is nine.
10040
10041 The return value of the subroutine is inserted into the expanded string, unless
10042 the return value is &%undef%&. In that case, the expansion fails in the same
10043 way as an explicit &"fail"& on a lookup item. The return value is a scalar.
10044 Whatever you return is evaluated in a scalar context. For example, if you
10045 return the name of a Perl vector, the return value is the size of the vector,
10046 not its contents.
10047
10048 If the subroutine exits by calling Perl's &%die%& function, the expansion fails
10049 with the error message that was passed to &%die%&. More details of the embedded
10050 Perl facility are given in chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&.
10051
10052 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_perl%& which locks
10053 out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
10054
10055
10056 .vitem &*${prvs{*&<&'address'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}{*&<&'keynumber'&>&*}}*&
10057 .cindex "&%prvs%& expansion item"
10058 The first argument is a complete email address and the second is secret
10059 keystring. The third argument, specifying a key number, is optional. If absent,
10060 it defaults to 0. The result of the expansion is a prvs-signed email address,
10061 to be typically used with the &%return_path%& option on an &(smtp)& transport
10062 as part of a bounce address tag validation (BATV) scheme. For more discussion
10063 and an example, see section &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
10064
10065 .vitem "&*${prvscheck{*&<&'address'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}&&&
10066 {*&<&'string'&>&*}}*&"
10067 .cindex "&%prvscheck%& expansion item"
10068 This expansion item is the complement of the &%prvs%& item. It is used for
10069 checking prvs-signed addresses. If the expansion of the first argument does not
10070 yield a syntactically valid prvs-signed address, the whole item expands to the
10071 empty string. When the first argument does expand to a syntactically valid
10072 prvs-signed address, the second argument is expanded, with the prvs-decoded
10073 version of the address and the key number extracted from the address in the
10074 variables &$prvscheck_address$& and &$prvscheck_keynum$&, respectively.
10075
10076 These two variables can be used in the expansion of the second argument to
10077 retrieve the secret. The validity of the prvs-signed address is then checked
10078 against the secret. The result is stored in the variable &$prvscheck_result$&,
10079 which is empty for failure or &"1"& for success.
10080
10081 The third argument is optional; if it is missing, it defaults to an empty
10082 string. This argument is now expanded. If the result is an empty string, the
10083 result of the expansion is the decoded version of the address. This is the case
10084 whether or not the signature was valid. Otherwise, the result of the expansion
10085 is the expansion of the third argument.
10086
10087 All three variables can be used in the expansion of the third argument.
10088 However, once the expansion is complete, only &$prvscheck_result$& remains set.
10089 For more discussion and an example, see section &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
10090
10091 .vitem &*${readfile{*&<&'file&~name'&>&*}{*&<&'eol&~string'&>&*}}*&
10092 .cindex "expansion" "inserting an entire file"
10093 .cindex "file" "inserting into expansion"
10094 .cindex "&%readfile%& expansion item"
10095 The filename and end-of-line string are first expanded separately. The file is
10096 then read, and its contents replace the entire item. All newline characters in
10097 the file are replaced by the end-of-line string if it is present. Otherwise,
10098 newlines are left in the string.
10099 String expansion is not applied to the contents of the file. If you want this,
10100 you must wrap the item in an &%expand%& operator. If the file cannot be read,
10101 the string expansion fails.
10102
10103 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_readfile%& which
10104 locks out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
10105
10106
10107
10108 .vitem "&*${readsocket{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'request'&>&*}&&&
10109 {*&<&'options'&>&*}{*&<&'eol&~string'&>&*}{*&<&'fail&~string'&>&*}}*&"
10110 .cindex "expansion" "inserting from a socket"
10111 .cindex "socket, use of in expansion"
10112 .cindex "&%readsocket%& expansion item"
10113 This item inserts data from a Unix domain or TCP socket into the expanded
10114 string. The minimal way of using it uses just two arguments, as in these
10115 examples:
10116 .code
10117 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}}
10118 ${readsocket{inet:some.host:1234}{request string}}
10119 .endd
10120 For a Unix domain socket, the first substring must be the path to the socket.
10121 For an Internet socket, the first substring must contain &`inet:`& followed by
10122 a host name or IP address, followed by a colon and a port, which can be a
10123 number or the name of a TCP port in &_/etc/services_&. An IP address may
10124 optionally be enclosed in square brackets. This is best for IPv6 addresses. For
10125 example:
10126 .code
10127 ${readsocket{inet:[::1]:1234}{request string}}
10128 .endd
10129 Only a single host name may be given, but if looking it up yields more than
10130 one IP address, they are each tried in turn until a connection is made. For
10131 both kinds of socket, Exim makes a connection, writes the request string
10132 unless it is an empty string; and no terminating NUL is ever sent)
10133 and reads from the socket until an end-of-file
10134 is read. A timeout of 5 seconds is applied. Additional, optional arguments
10135 extend what can be done. Firstly, you can vary the timeout. For example:
10136 .code
10137 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s}}
10138 .endd
10139
10140 The third argument is a list of options, of which the first element is the timeout
10141 and must be present if the argument is given.
10142 Further elements are options of form &'name=value'&.
10143 Two option types is currently recognised: shutdown and tls.
10144 The first defines whether (the default)
10145 or not a shutdown is done on the connection after sending the request.
10146 Example, to not do so (preferred, eg. by some webservers):
10147 .code
10148 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s:shutdown=no}}
10149 .endd
10150 The second, tls, controls the use of TLS on the connection. Example:
10151 .code
10152 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s:tls=yes}}
10153 .endd
10154 The default is to not use TLS.
10155 If it is enabled, a shutdown as descripbed above is never done.
10156
10157 A fourth argument allows you to change any newlines that are in the data
10158 that is read, in the same way as for &%readfile%& (see above). This example
10159 turns them into spaces:
10160 .code
10161 ${readsocket{inet:127.0.0.1:3294}{request string}{3s}{ }}
10162 .endd
10163 As with all expansions, the substrings are expanded before the processing
10164 happens. Errors in these sub-expansions cause the expansion to fail. In
10165 addition, the following errors can occur:
10166
10167 .ilist
10168 Failure to create a socket file descriptor;
10169 .next
10170 Failure to connect the socket;
10171 .next
10172 Failure to write the request string;
10173 .next
10174 Timeout on reading from the socket.
10175 .endlist
10176
10177 By default, any of these errors causes the expansion to fail. However, if
10178 you supply a fifth substring, it is expanded and used when any of the above
10179 errors occurs. For example:
10180 .code
10181 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s}{\n}\
10182 {socket failure}}
10183 .endd
10184 You can test for the existence of a Unix domain socket by wrapping this
10185 expansion in &`${if exists`&, but there is a race condition between that test
10186 and the actual opening of the socket, so it is safer to use the fifth argument
10187 if you want to be absolutely sure of avoiding an expansion error for a
10188 non-existent Unix domain socket, or a failure to connect to an Internet socket.
10189
10190 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_readsocket%& which
10191 locks out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
10192
10193
10194 .vitem &*${reduce{*&<&'string1'&>}{<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
10195 .cindex "expansion" "reducing a list to a scalar"
10196 .cindex "list" "reducing to a scalar"
10197 .vindex "&$value$&"
10198 .vindex "&$item$&"
10199 This operation reduces a list to a single, scalar string. After expansion,
10200 <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by default, but the
10201 separator can be changed in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
10202 Then <&'string2'&> is expanded and
10203 assigned to the &$value$& variable. After this, each item in the <&'string1'&>
10204 list is assigned to &$item$&, in turn, and <&'string3'&> is expanded for each of
10205 them. The result of that expansion is assigned to &$value$& before the next
10206 iteration. When the end of the list is reached, the final value of &$value$& is
10207 added to the expansion output. The &*reduce*& expansion item can be used in a
10208 number of ways. For example, to add up a list of numbers:
10209 .code
10210 ${reduce {<, 1,2,3}{0}{${eval:$value+$item}}}
10211 .endd
10212 The result of that expansion would be &`6`&. The maximum of a list of numbers
10213 can be found:
10214 .code
10215 ${reduce {3:0:9:4:6}{0}{${if >{$item}{$value}{$item}{$value}}}}
10216 .endd
10217 At the end of a &*reduce*& expansion, the values of &$item$& and &$value$& are
10218 restored to what they were before. See also the &*filter*& and &*map*&
10219 expansion items.
10220
10221 .vitem &*$rheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&*$rh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&
10222 This item inserts &"raw"& header lines. It is described with the &%header%&
10223 expansion item in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& above.
10224
10225 .vitem "&*${run{*&<&'command'&>&*&~*&<&'args'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}&&&
10226 {*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
10227 .cindex "expansion" "running a command"
10228 .cindex "&%run%& expansion item"
10229 The command and its arguments are first expanded as one string. The string is
10230 split apart into individual arguments by spaces, and then the command is run
10231 in a separate process, but under the same uid and gid. As in other command
10232 executions from Exim, a shell is not used by default. If the command requires
10233 a shell, you must explicitly code it.
10234
10235 Since the arguments are split by spaces, when there is a variable expansion
10236 which has an empty result, it will cause the situation that the argument will
10237 simply be omitted when the program is actually executed by Exim. If the
10238 script/program requires a specific number of arguments and the expanded
10239 variable could possibly result in this empty expansion, the variable must be
10240 quoted. This is more difficult if the expanded variable itself could result
10241 in a string containing quotes, because it would interfere with the quotes
10242 around the command arguments. A possible guard against this is to wrap the
10243 variable in the &%sg%& operator to change any quote marks to some other
10244 character.
10245
10246 The standard input for the command exists, but is empty. The standard output
10247 and standard error are set to the same file descriptor.
10248 .cindex "return code" "from &%run%& expansion"
10249 .vindex "&$value$&"
10250 If the command succeeds (gives a zero return code) <&'string1'&> is expanded
10251 and replaces the entire item; during this expansion, the standard output/error
10252 from the command is in the variable &$value$&. If the command fails,
10253 <&'string2'&>, if present, is expanded and used. Once again, during the
10254 expansion, the standard output/error from the command is in the variable
10255 &$value$&.
10256
10257 If <&'string2'&> is absent, the result is empty. Alternatively, <&'string2'&>
10258 can be the word &"fail"& (not in braces) to force expansion failure if the
10259 command does not succeed. If both strings are omitted, the result is contents
10260 of the standard output/error on success, and nothing on failure.
10261
10262 .vindex "&$run_in_acl$&"
10263 The standard output/error of the command is put in the variable &$value$&.
10264 In this ACL example, the output of a command is logged for the admin to
10265 troubleshoot:
10266 .code
10267 warn condition = ${run{/usr/bin/id}{yes}{no}}
10268 log_message = Output of id: $value
10269 .endd
10270 If the command requires shell idioms, such as the > redirect operator, the
10271 shell must be invoked directly, such as with:
10272 .code
10273 ${run{/bin/bash -c "/usr/bin/id >/tmp/id"}{yes}{yes}}
10274 .endd
10275
10276 .vindex "&$runrc$&"
10277 The return code from the command is put in the variable &$runrc$&, and this
10278 remains set afterwards, so in a filter file you can do things like this:
10279 .code
10280 if "${run{x y z}{}}$runrc" is 1 then ...
10281 elif $runrc is 2 then ...
10282 ...
10283 endif
10284 .endd
10285 If execution of the command fails (for example, the command does not exist),
10286 the return code is 127 &-- the same code that shells use for non-existent
10287 commands.
10288
10289 &*Warning*&: In a router or transport, you cannot assume the order in which
10290 option values are expanded, except for those preconditions whose order of
10291 testing is documented. Therefore, you cannot reliably expect to set &$runrc$&
10292 by the expansion of one option, and use it in another.
10293
10294 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_run%& which locks
10295 out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
10296
10297
10298 .vitem &*${sg{*&<&'subject'&>&*}{*&<&'regex'&>&*}{*&<&'replacement'&>&*}}*&
10299 .cindex "expansion" "string substitution"
10300 .cindex "&%sg%& expansion item"
10301 This item works like Perl's substitution operator (s) with the global (/g)
10302 option; hence its name. However, unlike the Perl equivalent, Exim does not
10303 modify the subject string; instead it returns the modified string for insertion
10304 into the overall expansion. The item takes three arguments: the subject string,
10305 a regular expression, and a substitution string. For example:
10306 .code
10307 ${sg{abcdefabcdef}{abc}{xyz}}
10308 .endd
10309 yields &"xyzdefxyzdef"&. Because all three arguments are expanded before use,
10310 if any $, } or \ characters are required in the regular expression or in the
10311 substitution string, they have to be escaped. For example:
10312 .code
10313 ${sg{abcdef}{^(...)(...)\$}{\$2\$1}}
10314 .endd
10315 yields &"defabc"&, and
10316 .code
10317 ${sg{1=A 4=D 3=C}{\N(\d+)=\N}{K\$1=}}
10318 .endd
10319 yields &"K1=A K4=D K3=C"&. Note the use of &`\N`& to protect the contents of
10320 the regular expression from string expansion.
10321
10322 The regular expression is compiled in 8-bit mode, working against bytes
10323 rather than any Unicode-aware character handling.
10324
10325
10326 .vitem &*${sort{*&<&'string'&>&*}{*&<&'comparator'&>&*}{*&<&'extractor'&>&*}}*&
10327 .cindex sorting "a list"
10328 .cindex list sorting
10329 .cindex expansion "list sorting"
10330 After expansion, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
10331 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
10332 The <&'comparator'&> argument is interpreted as the operator
10333 of a two-argument expansion condition.
10334 The numeric operators plus ge, gt, le, lt (and ~i variants) are supported.
10335 The comparison should return true when applied to two values
10336 if the first value should sort before the second value.
10337 The <&'extractor'&> expansion is applied repeatedly to elements of the list,
10338 the element being placed in &$item$&,
10339 to give values for comparison.
10340
10341 The item result is a sorted list,
10342 with the original list separator,
10343 of the list elements (in full) of the original.
10344
10345 Examples:
10346 .code
10347 ${sort{3:2:1:4}{<}{$item}}
10348 .endd
10349 sorts a list of numbers, and
10350 .code
10351 ${sort {${lookup dnsdb{>:,,mx=example.com}}} {<} {${listextract{1}{<,$item}}}}
10352 .endd
10353 will sort an MX lookup into priority order.
10354
10355
10356 .vitem &*${substr{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
10357 .cindex "&%substr%& expansion item"
10358 .cindex "substring extraction"
10359 .cindex "expansion" "substring extraction"
10360 The three strings are expanded; the first two must yield numbers. Call them
10361 <&'n'&> and <&'m'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is,
10362 if <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you
10363 can use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
10364 .code
10365 ${substr_<n>_<m>:<string>}
10366 .endd
10367 The second number is optional (in both notations).
10368 If it is absent in the simpler format, the preceding underscore must also be
10369 omitted.
10370
10371 The &%substr%& item can be used to extract more general substrings than
10372 &%length%&. The first number, <&'n'&>, is a starting offset, and <&'m'&> is the
10373 length required. For example
10374 .code
10375 ${substr{3}{2}{$local_part}}
10376 .endd
10377 If the starting offset is greater than the string length the result is the
10378 null string; if the length plus starting offset is greater than the string
10379 length, the result is the right-hand part of the string, starting from the
10380 given offset. The first byte (character) in the string has offset zero.
10381
10382 The &%substr%& expansion item can take negative offset values to count
10383 from the right-hand end of its operand. The last byte (character) is offset -1,
10384 the second-last is offset -2, and so on. Thus, for example,
10385 .code
10386 ${substr{-5}{2}{1234567}}
10387 .endd
10388 yields &"34"&. If the absolute value of a negative offset is greater than the
10389 length of the string, the substring starts at the beginning of the string, and
10390 the length is reduced by the amount of overshoot. Thus, for example,
10391 .code
10392 ${substr{-5}{2}{12}}
10393 .endd
10394 yields an empty string, but
10395 .code
10396 ${substr{-3}{2}{12}}
10397 .endd
10398 yields &"1"&.
10399
10400 When the second number is omitted from &%substr%&, the remainder of the string
10401 is taken if the offset is positive. If it is negative, all bytes (characters) in the
10402 string preceding the offset point are taken. For example, an offset of -1 and
10403 no length, as in these semantically identical examples:
10404 .code
10405 ${substr_-1:abcde}
10406 ${substr{-1}{abcde}}
10407 .endd
10408 yields all but the last character of the string, that is, &"abcd"&.
10409
10410 All measurement is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware.
10411
10412
10413
10414 .vitem "&*${tr{*&<&'subject'&>&*}{*&<&'characters'&>&*}&&&
10415 {*&<&'replacements'&>&*}}*&"
10416 .cindex "expansion" "character translation"
10417 .cindex "&%tr%& expansion item"
10418 This item does single-character (in bytes) translation on its subject string. The second
10419 argument is a list of characters to be translated in the subject string. Each
10420 matching character is replaced by the corresponding character from the
10421 replacement list. For example
10422 .code
10423 ${tr{abcdea}{ac}{13}}
10424 .endd
10425 yields &`1b3de1`&. If there are duplicates in the second character string, the
10426 last occurrence is used. If the third string is shorter than the second, its
10427 last character is replicated. However, if it is empty, no translation takes
10428 place.
10429
10430 All character handling is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware.
10431
10432 .endlist
10433
10434
10435
10436 .section "Expansion operators" "SECTexpop"
10437 .cindex "expansion" "operators"
10438 For expansion items that perform transformations on a single argument string,
10439 the &"operator"& notation is used because it is simpler and uses fewer braces.
10440 The substring is first expanded before the operation is applied to it. The
10441 following operations can be performed:
10442
10443 .vlist
10444 .vitem &*${address:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10445 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2822 address handling"
10446 .cindex "&%address%& expansion item"
10447 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address, as it might appear in a
10448 header line, and the effective address is extracted from it. If the string does
10449 not parse successfully, the result is empty.
10450
10451 The parsing correctly handles SMTPUTF8 Unicode in the string.
10452
10453
10454 .vitem &*${addresses:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10455 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2822 address handling"
10456 .cindex "&%addresses%& expansion item"
10457 The string (after expansion) is interpreted as a list of addresses in RFC
10458 2822 format, such as can be found in a &'To:'& or &'Cc:'& header line. The
10459 operative address (&'local-part@domain'&) is extracted from each item, and the
10460 result of the expansion is a colon-separated list, with appropriate
10461 doubling of colons should any happen to be present in the email addresses.
10462 Syntactically invalid RFC2822 address items are omitted from the output.
10463
10464 It is possible to specify a character other than colon for the output
10465 separator by starting the string with > followed by the new separator
10466 character. For example:
10467 .code
10468 ${addresses:>& Chief <ceo@up.stairs>, sec@base.ment (dogsbody)}
10469 .endd
10470 expands to &`ceo@up.stairs&&sec@base.ment`&. The string is expanded
10471 first, so if the expanded string starts with >, it may change the output
10472 separator unintentionally. This can be avoided by setting the output
10473 separator explicitly:
10474 .code
10475 ${addresses:>:$h_from:}
10476 .endd
10477
10478 Compare the &*address*& (singular)
10479 expansion item, which extracts the working address from a single RFC2822
10480 address. See the &*filter*&, &*map*&, and &*reduce*& items for ways of
10481 processing lists.
10482
10483 To clarify "list of addresses in RFC 2822 format" mentioned above, Exim follows
10484 a strict interpretation of header line formatting. Exim parses the bare,
10485 unquoted portion of an email address and if it finds a comma, treats it as an
10486 email address separator. For the example header line:
10487 .code
10488 From: =?iso-8859-2?Q?Last=2C_First?= <user@example.com>
10489 .endd
10490 The first example below demonstrates that Q-encoded email addresses are parsed
10491 properly if it is given the raw header (in this example, &`$rheader_from:`&).
10492 It does not see the comma because it's still encoded as "=2C". The second
10493 example below is passed the contents of &`$header_from:`&, meaning it gets
10494 de-mimed. Exim sees the decoded "," so it treats it as &*two*& email addresses.
10495 The third example shows that the presence of a comma is skipped when it is
10496 quoted. The fourth example shows SMTPUTF8 handling.
10497 .code
10498 # exim -be '${addresses:From: \
10499 =?iso-8859-2?Q?Last=2C_First?= <user@example.com>}'
10500 user@example.com
10501 # exim -be '${addresses:From: Last, First <user@example.com>}'
10502 Last:user@example.com
10503 # exim -be '${addresses:From: "Last, First" <user@example.com>}'
10504 user@example.com
10505 # exim -be '${addresses:フィル <フィリップ@example.jp>}'
10506 フィリップ@example.jp
10507 .endd
10508
10509 .vitem &*${base32:*&<&'digits'&>&*}*&
10510 .cindex "&%base32%& expansion item"
10511 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 32"
10512 The string must consist entirely of decimal digits. The number is converted to
10513 base 32 and output as a (empty, for zero) string of characters.
10514 Only lowercase letters are used.
10515
10516 .vitem &*${base32d:*&<&'base-32&~digits'&>&*}*&
10517 .cindex "&%base32d%& expansion item"
10518 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 32"
10519 The string must consist entirely of base-32 digits.
10520 The number is converted to decimal and output as a string.
10521
10522 .vitem &*${base62:*&<&'digits'&>&*}*&
10523 .cindex "&%base62%& expansion item"
10524 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 62"
10525 The string must consist entirely of decimal digits. The number is converted to
10526 base 62 and output as a string of six characters, including leading zeros. In
10527 the few operating environments where Exim uses base 36 instead of base 62 for
10528 its message identifiers (because those systems do not have case-sensitive
10529 filenames), base 36 is used by this operator, despite its name. &*Note*&: Just
10530 to be absolutely clear: this is &'not'& base64 encoding.
10531
10532 .vitem &*${base62d:*&<&'base-62&~digits'&>&*}*&
10533 .cindex "&%base62d%& expansion item"
10534 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 62"
10535 The string must consist entirely of base-62 digits, or, in operating
10536 environments where Exim uses base 36 instead of base 62 for its message
10537 identifiers, base-36 digits. The number is converted to decimal and output as a
10538 string.
10539
10540 .vitem &*${base64:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10541 .cindex "expansion" "base64 encoding"
10542 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in string expansion"
10543 .cindex "&%base64%& expansion item"
10544 .cindex certificate "base64 of DER"
10545 This operator converts a string into one that is base64 encoded.
10546
10547 If the string is a single variable of type certificate,
10548 returns the base64 encoding of the DER form of the certificate.
10549
10550
10551 .vitem &*${base64d:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10552 .cindex "expansion" "base64 decoding"
10553 .cindex "base64 decoding" "in string expansion"
10554 .cindex "&%base64d%& expansion item"
10555 This operator converts a base64-encoded string into the un-coded form.
10556
10557
10558 .vitem &*${domain:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10559 .cindex "domain" "extraction"
10560 .cindex "expansion" "domain extraction"
10561 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address and the domain is extracted
10562 from it. If the string does not parse successfully, the result is empty.
10563
10564
10565 .vitem &*${escape:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10566 .cindex "expansion" "escaping non-printing characters"
10567 .cindex "&%escape%& expansion item"
10568 If the string contains any non-printing characters, they are converted to
10569 escape sequences starting with a backslash. Whether characters with the most
10570 significant bit set (so-called &"8-bit characters"&) count as printing or not
10571 is controlled by the &%print_topbitchars%& option.
10572
10573 .vitem &*${escape8bit:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10574 .cindex "expansion" "escaping 8-bit characters"
10575 .cindex "&%escape8bit%& expansion item"
10576 If the string contains and characters with the most significant bit set,
10577 they are converted to escape sequences starting with a backslash.
10578 Backslashes and DEL characters are also converted.
10579
10580
10581 .vitem &*${eval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&&~and&~&*${eval10:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10582 .cindex "expansion" "expression evaluation"
10583 .cindex "expansion" "arithmetic expression"
10584 .cindex "&%eval%& expansion item"
10585 These items supports simple arithmetic and bitwise logical operations in
10586 expansion strings. The string (after expansion) must be a conventional
10587 arithmetic expression, but it is limited to basic arithmetic operators, bitwise
10588 logical operators, and parentheses. All operations are carried out using
10589 integer arithmetic. The operator priorities are as follows (the same as in the
10590 C programming language):
10591 .table2 70pt 300pt
10592 .irow &'highest:'& "not (~), negate (-)"
10593 .irow "" "multiply (*), divide (/), remainder (%)"
10594 .irow "" "plus (+), minus (-)"
10595 .irow "" "shift-left (<<), shift-right (>>)"
10596 .irow "" "and (&&)"
10597 .irow "" "xor (^)"
10598 .irow &'lowest:'& "or (|)"
10599 .endtable
10600 Binary operators with the same priority are evaluated from left to right. White
10601 space is permitted before or after operators.
10602
10603 For &%eval%&, numbers may be decimal, octal (starting with &"0"&) or
10604 hexadecimal (starting with &"0x"&). For &%eval10%&, all numbers are taken as
10605 decimal, even if they start with a leading zero; hexadecimal numbers are not
10606 permitted. This can be useful when processing numbers extracted from dates or
10607 times, which often do have leading zeros.
10608
10609 A number may be followed by &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"& to multiply it by 1024, 1024*1024
10610 or 1024*1024*1024,
10611 respectively. Negative numbers are supported. The result of the computation is
10612 a decimal representation of the answer (without &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"&). For example:
10613
10614 .display
10615 &`${eval:1+1} `& yields 2
10616 &`${eval:1+2*3} `& yields 7
10617 &`${eval:(1+2)*3} `& yields 9
10618 &`${eval:2+42%5} `& yields 4
10619 &`${eval:0xc&amp;5} `& yields 4
10620 &`${eval:0xc|5} `& yields 13
10621 &`${eval:0xc^5} `& yields 9
10622 &`${eval:0xc>>1} `& yields 6
10623 &`${eval:0xc<<1} `& yields 24
10624 &`${eval:~255&amp;0x1234} `& yields 4608
10625 &`${eval:-(~255&amp;0x1234)} `& yields -4608
10626 .endd
10627
10628 As a more realistic example, in an ACL you might have
10629 .code
10630 deny message = Too many bad recipients
10631 condition = \
10632 ${if and { \
10633 {>{$rcpt_count}{10}} \
10634 { \
10635 < \
10636 {$recipients_count} \
10637 {${eval:$rcpt_count/2}} \
10638 } \
10639 }{yes}{no}}
10640 .endd
10641 The condition is true if there have been more than 10 RCPT commands and
10642 fewer than half of them have resulted in a valid recipient.
10643
10644
10645 .vitem &*${expand:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10646 .cindex "expansion" "re-expansion of substring"
10647 The &%expand%& operator causes a string to be expanded for a second time. For
10648 example,
10649 .code
10650 ${expand:${lookup{$domain}dbm{/some/file}{$value}}}
10651 .endd
10652 first looks up a string in a file while expanding the operand for &%expand%&,
10653 and then re-expands what it has found.
10654
10655
10656 .vitem &*${from_utf8:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10657 .cindex "Unicode"
10658 .cindex "UTF-8" "conversion from"
10659 .cindex "expansion" "UTF-8 conversion"
10660 .cindex "&%from_utf8%& expansion item"
10661 The world is slowly moving towards Unicode, although there are no standards for
10662 email yet. However, other applications (including some databases) are starting
10663 to store data in Unicode, using UTF-8 encoding. This operator converts from a
10664 UTF-8 string to an ISO-8859-1 string. UTF-8 code values greater than 255 are
10665 converted to underscores. The input must be a valid UTF-8 string. If it is not,
10666 the result is an undefined sequence of bytes.
10667
10668 Unicode code points with values less than 256 are compatible with ASCII and
10669 ISO-8859-1 (also known as Latin-1).
10670 For example, character 169 is the copyright symbol in both cases, though the
10671 way it is encoded is different. In UTF-8, more than one byte is needed for
10672 characters with code values greater than 127, whereas ISO-8859-1 is a
10673 single-byte encoding (but thereby limited to 256 characters). This makes
10674 translation from UTF-8 to ISO-8859-1 straightforward.
10675
10676
10677 .vitem &*${hash_*&<&'n'&>&*_*&<&'m'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10678 .cindex "hash function" "textual"
10679 .cindex "expansion" "textual hash"
10680 The &%hash%& operator is a simpler interface to the hashing function that can
10681 be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to strings that
10682 change when expanded). The effect is the same as
10683 .code
10684 ${hash{<n>}{<m>}{<string>}}
10685 .endd
10686 See the description of the general &%hash%& item above for details. The
10687 abbreviation &%h%& can be used when &%hash%& is used as an operator.
10688
10689
10690
10691 .vitem &*${hex2b64:*&<&'hexstring'&>&*}*&
10692 .cindex "base64 encoding" "conversion from hex"
10693 .cindex "expansion" "hex to base64"
10694 .cindex "&%hex2b64%& expansion item"
10695 This operator converts a hex string into one that is base64 encoded. This can
10696 be useful for processing the output of the various hashing functions.
10697
10698
10699
10700 .vitem &*${hexquote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10701 .cindex "quoting" "hex-encoded unprintable characters"
10702 .cindex "&%hexquote%& expansion item"
10703 This operator converts non-printable characters in a string into a hex
10704 escape form. Byte values between 33 (!) and 126 (~) inclusive are left
10705 as is, and other byte values are converted to &`\xNN`&, for example, a
10706 byte value 127 is converted to &`\x7f`&.
10707
10708
10709 .vitem &*${ipv6denorm:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10710 .cindex "&%ipv6denorm%& expansion item"
10711 .cindex "IP address" normalisation
10712 This expands an IPv6 address to a full eight-element colon-separated set
10713 of hex digits including leading zeroes.
10714 A trailing ipv4-style dotted-decimal set is converted to hex.
10715 Pure IPv4 addresses are converted to IPv4-mapped IPv6.
10716
10717 .vitem &*${ipv6norm:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10718 .cindex "&%ipv6norm%& expansion item"
10719 .cindex "IP address" normalisation
10720 .cindex "IP address" "canonical form"
10721 This converts an IPv6 address to canonical form.
10722 Leading zeroes of groups are omitted, and the longest
10723 set of zero-valued groups is replaced with a double colon.
10724 A trailing ipv4-style dotted-decimal set is converted to hex.
10725 Pure IPv4 addresses are converted to IPv4-mapped IPv6.
10726
10727
10728 .vitem &*${lc:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10729 .cindex "case forcing in strings"
10730 .cindex "string" "case forcing"
10731 .cindex "lower casing"
10732 .cindex "expansion" "case forcing"
10733 .cindex "&%lc%& expansion item"
10734 This forces the letters in the string into lower-case, for example:
10735 .code
10736 ${lc:$local_part}
10737 .endd
10738 Case is defined per the system C locale.
10739
10740 .vitem &*${length_*&<&'number'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10741 .cindex "expansion" "string truncation"
10742 .cindex "&%length%& expansion item"
10743 The &%length%& operator is a simpler interface to the &%length%& function that
10744 can be used when the parameter is a fixed number (as opposed to a string that
10745 changes when expanded). The effect is the same as
10746 .code
10747 ${length{<number>}{<string>}}
10748 .endd
10749 See the description of the general &%length%& item above for details. Note that
10750 &%length%& is not the same as &%strlen%&. The abbreviation &%l%& can be used
10751 when &%length%& is used as an operator.
10752 All measurement is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware.
10753
10754
10755 .vitem &*${listcount:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10756 .cindex "expansion" "list item count"
10757 .cindex "list" "item count"
10758 .cindex "list" "count of items"
10759 .cindex "&%listcount%& expansion item"
10760 The string is interpreted as a list and the number of items is returned.
10761
10762
10763 .vitem &*${listnamed:*&<&'name'&>&*}*&&~and&~&*${listnamed_*&<&'type'&>&*:*&<&'name'&>&*}*&
10764 .cindex "expansion" "named list"
10765 .cindex "&%listnamed%& expansion item"
10766 The name is interpreted as a named list and the content of the list is returned,
10767 expanding any referenced lists, re-quoting as needed for colon-separation.
10768 If the optional type is given it must be one of "a", "d", "h" or "l"
10769 and selects address-, domain-, host- or localpart- lists to search among respectively.
10770 Otherwise all types are searched in an undefined order and the first
10771 matching list is returned.
10772
10773
10774 .vitem &*${local_part:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10775 .cindex "expansion" "local part extraction"
10776 .cindex "&%local_part%& expansion item"
10777 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address and the local part is
10778 extracted from it. If the string does not parse successfully, the result is
10779 empty.
10780 The parsing correctly handles SMTPUTF8 Unicode in the string.
10781
10782
10783 .vitem &*${mask:*&<&'IP&~address'&>&*/*&<&'bit&~count'&>&*}*&
10784 .cindex "masked IP address"
10785 .cindex "IP address" "masking"
10786 .cindex "CIDR notation"
10787 .cindex "expansion" "IP address masking"
10788 .cindex "&%mask%& expansion item"
10789 If the form of the string to be operated on is not an IP address followed by a
10790 slash and an integer (that is, a network address in CIDR notation), the
10791 expansion fails. Otherwise, this operator converts the IP address to binary,
10792 masks off the least significant bits according to the bit count, and converts
10793 the result back to text, with mask appended. For example,
10794 .code
10795 ${mask:10.111.131.206/28}
10796 .endd
10797 returns the string &"10.111.131.192/28"&. Since this operation is expected to
10798 be mostly used for looking up masked addresses in files, the result for an IPv6
10799 address uses dots to separate components instead of colons, because colon
10800 terminates a key string in lsearch files. So, for example,
10801 .code
10802 ${mask:3ffe:ffff:836f:0a00:000a:0800:200a:c031/99}
10803 .endd
10804 returns the string
10805 .code
10806 3ffe.ffff.836f.0a00.000a.0800.2000.0000/99
10807 .endd
10808 Letters in IPv6 addresses are always output in lower case.
10809
10810
10811 .vitem &*${md5:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10812 .cindex "MD5 hash"
10813 .cindex "expansion" "MD5 hash"
10814 .cindex certificate fingerprint
10815 .cindex "&%md5%& expansion item"
10816 The &%md5%& operator computes the MD5 hash value of the string, and returns it
10817 as a 32-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in lower case.
10818
10819 If the string is a single variable of type certificate,
10820 returns the MD5 hash fingerprint of the certificate.
10821
10822
10823 .vitem &*${nhash_*&<&'n'&>&*_*&<&'m'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10824 .cindex "expansion" "numeric hash"
10825 .cindex "hash function" "numeric"
10826 The &%nhash%& operator is a simpler interface to the numeric hashing function
10827 that can be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to
10828 strings that change when expanded). The effect is the same as
10829 .code
10830 ${nhash{<n>}{<m>}{<string>}}
10831 .endd
10832 See the description of the general &%nhash%& item above for details.
10833
10834
10835 .vitem &*${quote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10836 .cindex "quoting" "in string expansions"
10837 .cindex "expansion" "quoting"
10838 .cindex "&%quote%& expansion item"
10839 The &%quote%& operator puts its argument into double quotes if it
10840 is an empty string or
10841 contains anything other than letters, digits, underscores, dots, and hyphens.
10842 Any occurrences of double quotes and backslashes are escaped with a backslash.
10843 Newlines and carriage returns are converted to &`\n`& and &`\r`&,
10844 respectively For example,
10845 .code
10846 ${quote:ab"*"cd}
10847 .endd
10848 becomes
10849 .code
10850 "ab\"*\"cd"
10851 .endd
10852 The place where this is useful is when the argument is a substitution from a
10853 variable or a message header.
10854
10855 .vitem &*${quote_local_part:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10856 .cindex "&%quote_local_part%& expansion item"
10857 This operator is like &%quote%&, except that it quotes the string only if
10858 required to do so by the rules of RFC 2822 for quoting local parts. For
10859 example, a plus sign would not cause quoting (but it would for &%quote%&).
10860 If you are creating a new email address from the contents of &$local_part$&
10861 (or any other unknown data), you should always use this operator.
10862
10863 This quoting determination is not SMTPUTF8-aware, thus quoting non-ASCII data
10864 will likely use the quoting form.
10865 Thus &'${quote_local_part:フィル}'& will always become &'"フィル"'&.
10866
10867
10868 .vitem &*${quote_*&<&'lookup-type'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10869 .cindex "quoting" "lookup-specific"
10870 This operator applies lookup-specific quoting rules to the string. Each
10871 query-style lookup type has its own quoting rules which are described with
10872 the lookups in chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. For example,
10873 .code
10874 ${quote_ldap:two * two}
10875 .endd
10876 returns
10877 .code
10878 two%20%5C2A%20two
10879 .endd
10880 For single-key lookup types, no quoting is ever necessary and this operator
10881 yields an unchanged string.
10882
10883
10884 .vitem &*${randint:*&<&'n'&>&*}*&
10885 .cindex "random number"
10886 This operator returns a somewhat random number which is less than the
10887 supplied number and is at least 0. The quality of this randomness depends
10888 on how Exim was built; the values are not suitable for keying material.
10889 If Exim is linked against OpenSSL then RAND_pseudo_bytes() is used.
10890 If Exim is linked against GnuTLS then gnutls_rnd(GNUTLS_RND_NONCE) is used,
10891 for versions of GnuTLS with that function.
10892 Otherwise, the implementation may be arc4random(), random() seeded by
10893 srandomdev() or srandom(), or a custom implementation even weaker than
10894 random().
10895
10896
10897 .vitem &*${reverse_ip:*&<&'ipaddr'&>&*}*&
10898 .cindex "expansion" "IP address"
10899 This operator reverses an IP address; for IPv4 addresses, the result is in
10900 dotted-quad decimal form, while for IPv6 addresses the result is in
10901 dotted-nibble hexadecimal form. In both cases, this is the "natural" form
10902 for DNS. For example,
10903 .code
10904 ${reverse_ip:192.0.2.4}
10905 ${reverse_ip:2001:0db8:c42:9:1:abcd:192.0.2.127}
10906 .endd
10907 returns
10908 .code
10909 4.2.0.192
10910 f.7.2.0.0.0.0.c.d.c.b.a.1.0.0.0.9.0.0.0.2.4.c.0.8.b.d.0.1.0.0.2
10911 .endd
10912
10913
10914 .vitem &*${rfc2047:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10915 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2047"
10916 .cindex "RFC 2047" "expansion operator"
10917 .cindex "&%rfc2047%& expansion item"
10918 This operator encodes text according to the rules of RFC 2047. This is an
10919 encoding that is used in header lines to encode non-ASCII characters. It is
10920 assumed that the input string is in the encoding specified by the
10921 &%headers_charset%& option, which gets its default at build time. If the string
10922 contains only characters in the range 33&--126, and no instances of the
10923 characters
10924 .code
10925 ? = ( ) < > @ , ; : \ " . [ ] _
10926 .endd
10927 it is not modified. Otherwise, the result is the RFC 2047 encoding of the
10928 string, using as many &"encoded words"& as necessary to encode all the
10929 characters.
10930
10931
10932 .vitem &*${rfc2047d:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10933 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2047"
10934 .cindex "RFC 2047" "decoding"
10935 .cindex "&%rfc2047d%& expansion item"
10936 This operator decodes strings that are encoded as per RFC 2047. Binary zero
10937 bytes are replaced by question marks. Characters are converted into the
10938 character set defined by &%headers_charset%&. Overlong RFC 2047 &"words"& are
10939 not recognized unless &%check_rfc2047_length%& is set false.
10940
10941 &*Note*&: If you use &%$header%&_&'xxx'&&*:*& (or &%$h%&_&'xxx'&&*:*&) to
10942 access a header line, RFC 2047 decoding is done automatically. You do not need
10943 to use this operator as well.
10944
10945
10946
10947 .vitem &*${rxquote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10948 .cindex "quoting" "in regular expressions"
10949 .cindex "regular expressions" "quoting"
10950 .cindex "&%rxquote%& expansion item"
10951 The &%rxquote%& operator inserts a backslash before any non-alphanumeric
10952 characters in its argument. This is useful when substituting the values of
10953 variables or headers inside regular expressions.
10954
10955
10956 .vitem &*${sha1:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10957 .cindex "SHA-1 hash"
10958 .cindex "expansion" "SHA-1 hashing"
10959 .cindex certificate fingerprint
10960 .cindex "&%sha1%& expansion item"
10961 The &%sha1%& operator computes the SHA-1 hash value of the string, and returns
10962 it as a 40-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
10963
10964 If the string is a single variable of type certificate,
10965 returns the SHA-1 hash fingerprint of the certificate.
10966
10967
10968 .vitem &*${sha256:*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
10969 &*${sha2:*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
10970 &*${sha2_<n>:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10971 .cindex "SHA-256 hash"
10972 .cindex "SHA-2 hash"
10973 .cindex certificate fingerprint
10974 .cindex "expansion" "SHA-256 hashing"
10975 .cindex "&%sha256%& expansion item"
10976 .cindex "&%sha2%& expansion item"
10977 The &%sha256%& operator computes the SHA-256 hash value of the string
10978 and returns
10979 it as a 64-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
10980
10981 If the string is a single variable of type certificate,
10982 returns the SHA-256 hash fingerprint of the certificate.
10983
10984 .new
10985 The operator can also be spelled &%sha2%& and does the same as &%sha256%&
10986 (except for certificates, which are not supported).
10987 Finally, if an underbar
10988 and a number is appended it specifies the output length, selecting a
10989 member of the SHA-2 family of hash functions.
10990 Values of 256, 384 and 512 are accepted, with 256 being the default.
10991 .wen
10992
10993
10994 .vitem &*${sha3:*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
10995 &*${sha3_<n>:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10996 .cindex "SHA3 hash"
10997 .cindex "expansion" "SHA3 hashing"
10998 .cindex "&%sha3%& expansion item"
10999 The &%sha3%& operator computes the SHA3-256 hash value of the string
11000 and returns
11001 it as a 64-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
11002
11003 If a number is appended, separated by an underbar, it specifies
11004 the output length. Values of 224, 256, 384 and 512 are accepted;
11005 with 256 being the default.
11006
11007 The &%sha3%& expansion item is only supported if Exim has been
11008 compiled with GnuTLS 3.5.0 or later,
11009 or OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later.
11010 The macro "_CRYPTO_HASH_SHA3" will be defined if it is supported.
11011
11012
11013 .vitem &*${stat:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11014 .cindex "expansion" "statting a file"
11015 .cindex "file" "extracting characteristics"
11016 .cindex "&%stat%& expansion item"
11017 The string, after expansion, must be a file path. A call to the &[stat()]&
11018 function is made for this path. If &[stat()]& fails, an error occurs and the
11019 expansion fails. If it succeeds, the data from the stat replaces the item, as a
11020 series of <&'name'&>=<&'value'&> pairs, where the values are all numerical,
11021 except for the value of &"smode"&. The names are: &"mode"& (giving the mode as
11022 a 4-digit octal number), &"smode"& (giving the mode in symbolic format as a
11023 10-character string, as for the &'ls'& command), &"inode"&, &"device"&,
11024 &"links"&, &"uid"&, &"gid"&, &"size"&, &"atime"&, &"mtime"&, and &"ctime"&. You
11025 can extract individual fields using the &%extract%& expansion item.
11026
11027 The use of the &%stat%& expansion in users' filter files can be locked out by
11028 the system administrator. &*Warning*&: The file size may be incorrect on 32-bit
11029 systems for files larger than 2GB.
11030
11031 .vitem &*${str2b64:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11032 .cindex "&%str2b64%& expansion item"
11033 Now deprecated, a synonym for the &%base64%& expansion operator.
11034
11035
11036
11037 .vitem &*${strlen:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11038 .cindex "expansion" "string length"
11039 .cindex "string" "length in expansion"
11040 .cindex "&%strlen%& expansion item"
11041 The item is replace by the length of the expanded string, expressed as a
11042 decimal number. &*Note*&: Do not confuse &%strlen%& with &%length%&.
11043 All measurement is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware.
11044
11045
11046 .vitem &*${substr_*&<&'start'&>&*_*&<&'length'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11047 .cindex "&%substr%& expansion item"
11048 .cindex "substring extraction"
11049 .cindex "expansion" "substring expansion"
11050 The &%substr%& operator is a simpler interface to the &%substr%& function that
11051 can be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to strings
11052 that change when expanded). The effect is the same as
11053 .code
11054 ${substr{<start>}{<length>}{<string>}}
11055 .endd
11056 See the description of the general &%substr%& item above for details. The
11057 abbreviation &%s%& can be used when &%substr%& is used as an operator.
11058 All measurement is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware.
11059
11060 .vitem &*${time_eval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11061 .cindex "&%time_eval%& expansion item"
11062 .cindex "time interval" "decoding"
11063 This item converts an Exim time interval such as &`2d4h5m`& into a number of
11064 seconds.
11065
11066 .vitem &*${time_interval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11067 .cindex "&%time_interval%& expansion item"
11068 .cindex "time interval" "formatting"
11069 The argument (after sub-expansion) must be a sequence of decimal digits that
11070 represents an interval of time as a number of seconds. It is converted into a
11071 number of larger units and output in Exim's normal time format, for example,
11072 &`1w3d4h2m6s`&.
11073
11074 .vitem &*${uc:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11075 .cindex "case forcing in strings"
11076 .cindex "string" "case forcing"
11077 .cindex "upper casing"
11078 .cindex "expansion" "case forcing"
11079 .cindex "&%uc%& expansion item"
11080 This forces the letters in the string into upper-case.
11081 Case is defined per the system C locale.
11082
11083 .vitem &*${utf8clean:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11084 .cindex "correction of invalid utf-8 sequences in strings"
11085 .cindex "utf-8" "utf-8 sequences"
11086 .cindex "incorrect utf-8"
11087 .cindex "expansion" "utf-8 forcing"
11088 .cindex "&%utf8clean%& expansion item"
11089 This replaces any invalid utf-8 sequence in the string by the character &`?`&.
11090 In versions of Exim before 4.92, this did not correctly do so for a truncated
11091 final codepoint's encoding, and the character would be silently dropped.
11092 If you must handle detection of this scenario across both sets of Exim behavior,
11093 the complexity will depend upon the task.
11094 For instance, to detect if the first character is multibyte and a 1-byte
11095 extraction can be successfully used as a path component (as is common for
11096 dividing up delivery folders), you might use:
11097 .code
11098 condition = ${if inlist{${utf8clean:${length_1:$local_part}}}{:?}{yes}{no}}
11099 .endd
11100 (which will false-positive if the first character of the local part is a
11101 literal question mark).
11102
11103 .vitem "&*${utf8_domain_to_alabel:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&" &&&
11104 "&*${utf8_domain_from_alabel:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&" &&&
11105 "&*${utf8_localpart_to_alabel:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&" &&&
11106 "&*${utf8_localpart_from_alabel:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&"
11107 .cindex expansion UTF-8
11108 .cindex UTF-8 expansion
11109 .cindex EAI
11110 .cindex internationalisation
11111 .cindex "&%utf8_domain_to_alabel%& expansion item"
11112 .cindex "&%utf8_domain_from_alabel%& expansion item"
11113 .cindex "&%utf8_localpart_to_alabel%& expansion item"
11114 .cindex "&%utf8_localpart_from_alabel%& expansion item"
11115 These convert EAI mail name components between UTF-8 and a-label forms.
11116 For information on internationalisation support see &<<SECTi18nMTA>>&.
11117 .endlist
11118
11119
11120
11121
11122
11123
11124 .section "Expansion conditions" "SECTexpcond"
11125 .scindex IIDexpcond "expansion" "conditions"
11126 The following conditions are available for testing by the &%${if%& construct
11127 while expanding strings:
11128
11129 .vlist
11130 .vitem &*!*&<&'condition'&>
11131 .cindex "expansion" "negating a condition"
11132 .cindex "negation" "in expansion condition"
11133 Preceding any condition with an exclamation mark negates the result of the
11134 condition.
11135
11136 .vitem <&'symbolic&~operator'&>&~&*{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11137 .cindex "numeric comparison"
11138 .cindex "expansion" "numeric comparison"
11139 There are a number of symbolic operators for doing numeric comparisons. They
11140 are:
11141 .display
11142 &`= `& equal
11143 &`== `& equal
11144 &`> `& greater
11145 &`>= `& greater or equal
11146 &`< `& less
11147 &`<= `& less or equal
11148 .endd
11149 For example:
11150 .code
11151 ${if >{$message_size}{10M} ...
11152 .endd
11153 Note that the general negation operator provides for inequality testing. The
11154 two strings must take the form of optionally signed decimal integers,
11155 optionally followed by one of the letters &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"& (in either upper or
11156 lower case), signifying multiplication by 1024, 1024*1024 or 1024*1024*1024, respectively.
11157 As a special case, the numerical value of an empty string is taken as
11158 zero.
11159
11160 In all cases, a relative comparator OP is testing if <&'string1'&> OP
11161 <&'string2'&>; the above example is checking if &$message_size$& is larger than
11162 10M, not if 10M is larger than &$message_size$&.
11163
11164
11165 .vitem &*acl&~{{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'arg1'&>&*}&&&
11166 {*&<&'arg2'&>&*}...}*&
11167 .cindex "expansion" "calling an acl"
11168 .cindex "&%acl%&" "expansion condition"
11169 The name and zero to nine argument strings are first expanded separately. The expanded
11170 arguments are assigned to the variables &$acl_arg1$& to &$acl_arg9$& in order.
11171 Any unused are made empty. The variable &$acl_narg$& is set to the number of
11172 arguments. The named ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) is called
11173 and may use the variables; if another acl expansion is used the values
11174 are restored after it returns. If the ACL sets
11175 a value using a "message =" modifier the variable $value becomes
11176 the result of the expansion, otherwise it is empty.
11177 If the ACL returns accept the condition is true; if deny, false.
11178 If the ACL returns defer the result is a forced-fail.
11179
11180 .vitem &*bool&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11181 .cindex "expansion" "boolean parsing"
11182 .cindex "&%bool%& expansion condition"
11183 This condition turns a string holding a true or false representation into
11184 a boolean state. It parses &"true"&, &"false"&, &"yes"& and &"no"&
11185 (case-insensitively); also integer numbers map to true if non-zero,
11186 false if zero.
11187 An empty string is treated as false.
11188 Leading and trailing whitespace is ignored;
11189 thus a string consisting only of whitespace is false.
11190 All other string values will result in expansion failure.
11191
11192 When combined with ACL variables, this expansion condition will let you
11193 make decisions in one place and act on those decisions in another place.
11194 For example:
11195 .code
11196 ${if bool{$acl_m_privileged_sender} ...
11197 .endd
11198
11199
11200 .vitem &*bool_lax&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11201 .cindex "expansion" "boolean parsing"
11202 .cindex "&%bool_lax%& expansion condition"
11203 Like &%bool%&, this condition turns a string into a boolean state. But
11204 where &%bool%& accepts a strict set of strings, &%bool_lax%& uses the same
11205 loose definition that the Router &%condition%& option uses. The empty string
11206 and the values &"false"&, &"no"& and &"0"& map to false, all others map to
11207 true. Leading and trailing whitespace is ignored.
11208
11209 Note that where &"bool{00}"& is false, &"bool_lax{00}"& is true.
11210
11211 .vitem &*crypteq&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11212 .cindex "expansion" "encrypted comparison"
11213 .cindex "encrypted strings, comparing"
11214 .cindex "&%crypteq%& expansion condition"
11215 This condition is included in the Exim binary if it is built to support any
11216 authentication mechanisms (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&). Otherwise, it is
11217 necessary to define SUPPORT_CRYPTEQ in &_Local/Makefile_& to get &%crypteq%&
11218 included in the binary.
11219
11220 The &%crypteq%& condition has two arguments. The first is encrypted and
11221 compared against the second, which is already encrypted. The second string may
11222 be in the LDAP form for storing encrypted strings, which starts with the
11223 encryption type in curly brackets, followed by the data. If the second string
11224 does not begin with &"{"& it is assumed to be encrypted with &[crypt()]& or
11225 &[crypt16()]& (see below), since such strings cannot begin with &"{"&.
11226 Typically this will be a field from a password file. An example of an encrypted
11227 string in LDAP form is:
11228 .code
11229 {md5}CY9rzUYh03PK3k6DJie09g==
11230 .endd
11231 If such a string appears directly in an expansion, the curly brackets have to
11232 be quoted, because they are part of the expansion syntax. For example:
11233 .code
11234 ${if crypteq {test}{\{md5\}CY9rzUYh03PK3k6DJie09g==}{yes}{no}}
11235 .endd
11236 The following encryption types (whose names are matched case-independently) are
11237 supported:
11238
11239 .ilist
11240 .cindex "MD5 hash"
11241 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in encrypted password"
11242 &%{md5}%& computes the MD5 digest of the first string, and expresses this as
11243 printable characters to compare with the remainder of the second string. If the
11244 length of the comparison string is 24, Exim assumes that it is base64 encoded
11245 (as in the above example). If the length is 32, Exim assumes that it is a
11246 hexadecimal encoding of the MD5 digest. If the length not 24 or 32, the
11247 comparison fails.
11248
11249 .next
11250 .cindex "SHA-1 hash"
11251 &%{sha1}%& computes the SHA-1 digest of the first string, and expresses this as
11252 printable characters to compare with the remainder of the second string. If the
11253 length of the comparison string is 28, Exim assumes that it is base64 encoded.
11254 If the length is 40, Exim assumes that it is a hexadecimal encoding of the
11255 SHA-1 digest. If the length is not 28 or 40, the comparison fails.
11256
11257 .next
11258 .cindex "&[crypt()]&"
11259 &%{crypt}%& calls the &[crypt()]& function, which traditionally used to use
11260 only the first eight characters of the password. However, in modern operating
11261 systems this is no longer true, and in many cases the entire password is used,
11262 whatever its length.
11263
11264 .next
11265 .cindex "&[crypt16()]&"
11266 &%{crypt16}%& calls the &[crypt16()]& function, which was originally created to
11267 use up to 16 characters of the password in some operating systems. Again, in
11268 modern operating systems, more characters may be used.
11269 .endlist
11270 Exim has its own version of &[crypt16()]&, which is just a double call to
11271 &[crypt()]&. For operating systems that have their own version, setting
11272 HAVE_CRYPT16 in &_Local/Makefile_& when building Exim causes it to use the
11273 operating system version instead of its own. This option is set by default in
11274 the OS-dependent &_Makefile_& for those operating systems that are known to
11275 support &[crypt16()]&.
11276
11277 Some years after Exim's &[crypt16()]& was implemented, a user discovered that
11278 it was not using the same algorithm as some operating systems' versions. It
11279 turns out that as well as &[crypt16()]& there is a function called
11280 &[bigcrypt()]& in some operating systems. This may or may not use the same
11281 algorithm, and both of them may be different to Exim's built-in &[crypt16()]&.
11282
11283 However, since there is now a move away from the traditional &[crypt()]&
11284 functions towards using SHA1 and other algorithms, tidying up this area of
11285 Exim is seen as very low priority.
11286
11287 If you do not put a encryption type (in curly brackets) in a &%crypteq%&
11288 comparison, the default is usually either &`{crypt}`& or &`{crypt16}`&, as
11289 determined by the setting of DEFAULT_CRYPT in &_Local/Makefile_&. The default
11290 default is &`{crypt}`&. Whatever the default, you can always use either
11291 function by specifying it explicitly in curly brackets.
11292
11293 .vitem &*def:*&<&'variable&~name'&>
11294 .cindex "expansion" "checking for empty variable"
11295 .cindex "&%def%& expansion condition"
11296 The &%def%& condition must be followed by the name of one of the expansion
11297 variables defined in section &<<SECTexpvar>>&. The condition is true if the
11298 variable does not contain the empty string. For example:
11299 .code
11300 ${if def:sender_ident {from $sender_ident}}
11301 .endd
11302 Note that the variable name is given without a leading &%$%& character. If the
11303 variable does not exist, the expansion fails.
11304
11305 .vitem "&*def:header_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~&~or&~&&&
11306 &~&*def:h_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&"
11307 .cindex "expansion" "checking header line existence"
11308 This condition is true if a message is being processed and the named header
11309 exists in the message. For example,
11310 .code
11311 ${if def:header_reply-to:{$h_reply-to:}{$h_from:}}
11312 .endd
11313 &*Note*&: No &%$%& appears before &%header_%& or &%h_%& in the condition, and
11314 the header name must be terminated by a colon if white space does not follow.
11315
11316 .vitem &*eq&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11317 &*eqi&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11318 .cindex "string" "comparison"
11319 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
11320 .cindex "&%eq%& expansion condition"
11321 .cindex "&%eqi%& expansion condition"
11322 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the two
11323 resulting strings are identical. For &%eq%& the comparison includes the case of
11324 letters, whereas for &%eqi%& the comparison is case-independent, where
11325 case is defined per the system C locale.
11326
11327 .vitem &*exists&~{*&<&'file&~name'&>&*}*&
11328 .cindex "expansion" "file existence test"
11329 .cindex "file" "existence test"
11330 .cindex "&%exists%&, expansion condition"
11331 The substring is first expanded and then interpreted as an absolute path. The
11332 condition is true if the named file (or directory) exists. The existence test
11333 is done by calling the &[stat()]& function. The use of the &%exists%& test in
11334 users' filter files may be locked out by the system administrator.
11335
11336 .vitem &*first_delivery*&
11337 .cindex "delivery" "first"
11338 .cindex "first delivery"
11339 .cindex "expansion" "first delivery test"
11340 .cindex "&%first_delivery%& expansion condition"
11341 This condition, which has no data, is true during a message's first delivery
11342 attempt. It is false during any subsequent delivery attempts.
11343
11344
11345 .vitem "&*forall{*&<&'a list'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&" &&&
11346 "&*forany{*&<&'a list'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&"
11347 .cindex "list" "iterative conditions"
11348 .cindex "expansion" "&*forall*& condition"
11349 .cindex "expansion" "&*forany*& condition"
11350 .vindex "&$item$&"
11351 These conditions iterate over a list. The first argument is expanded to form
11352 the list. By default, the list separator is a colon, but it can be changed by
11353 the normal method (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
11354 The second argument is interpreted as a condition that is to
11355 be applied to each item in the list in turn. During the interpretation of the
11356 condition, the current list item is placed in a variable called &$item$&.
11357 .ilist
11358 For &*forany*&, interpretation stops if the condition is true for any item, and
11359 the result of the whole condition is true. If the condition is false for all
11360 items in the list, the overall condition is false.
11361 .next
11362 For &*forall*&, interpretation stops if the condition is false for any item,
11363 and the result of the whole condition is false. If the condition is true for
11364 all items in the list, the overall condition is true.
11365 .endlist
11366 Note that negation of &*forany*& means that the condition must be false for all
11367 items for the overall condition to succeed, and negation of &*forall*& means
11368 that the condition must be false for at least one item. In this example, the
11369 list separator is changed to a comma:
11370 .code
11371 ${if forany{<, $recipients}{match{$item}{^user3@}}{yes}{no}}
11372 .endd
11373 The value of &$item$& is saved and restored while &*forany*& or &*forall*& is
11374 being processed, to enable these expansion items to be nested.
11375
11376 To scan a named list, expand it with the &*listnamed*& operator.
11377
11378 .new
11379 .vitem "&*forall_json{*&<&'a JSON array'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&" &&&
11380 "&*forany_json{*&<&'a JSON array'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&" &&&
11381 "&*forall_jsons{*&<&'a JSON array'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&" &&&
11382 "&*forany_jsons{*&<&'a JSON array'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&"
11383 .cindex JSON "iterative conditions"
11384 .cindex JSON expansions
11385 .cindex expansion "&*forall_json*& condition"
11386 .cindex expansion "&*forany_json*& condition"
11387 .cindex expansion "&*forall_jsons*& condition"
11388 .cindex expansion "&*forany_jsons*& condition"
11389 As for the above, except that the first argument must, after expansion,
11390 be a JSON array.
11391 The array separator is not changeable.
11392 For the &"jsons"& variants the elements are expected to be JSON strings
11393 and have their quotes removed before the evaluation of the condition.
11394 .wen
11395
11396
11397
11398 .vitem &*ge&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11399 &*gei&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11400 .cindex "string" "comparison"
11401 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
11402 .cindex "&%ge%& expansion condition"
11403 .cindex "&%gei%& expansion condition"
11404 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
11405 string is lexically greater than or equal to the second string. For &%ge%& the
11406 comparison includes the case of letters, whereas for &%gei%& the comparison is
11407 case-independent.
11408 Case and collation order are defined per the system C locale.
11409
11410 .vitem &*gt&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11411 &*gti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11412 .cindex "string" "comparison"
11413 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
11414 .cindex "&%gt%& expansion condition"
11415 .cindex "&%gti%& expansion condition"
11416 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
11417 string is lexically greater than the second string. For &%gt%& the comparison
11418 includes the case of letters, whereas for &%gti%& the comparison is
11419 case-independent.
11420 Case and collation order are defined per the system C locale.
11421
11422 .vitem &*inlist&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11423 &*inlisti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11424 .cindex "string" "comparison"
11425 .cindex "list" "iterative conditions"
11426 Both strings are expanded; the second string is treated as a list of simple
11427 strings; if the first string is a member of the second, then the condition
11428 is true.
11429 For the case-independent &%inlisti%& condition, case is defined per the system C locale.
11430
11431 These are simpler to use versions of the more powerful &*forany*& condition.
11432 Examples, and the &*forany*& equivalents:
11433 .code
11434 ${if inlist{needle}{foo:needle:bar}}
11435 ${if forany{foo:needle:bar}{eq{$item}{needle}}}
11436 ${if inlisti{Needle}{fOo:NeeDLE:bAr}}
11437 ${if forany{fOo:NeeDLE:bAr}{eqi{$item}{Needle}}}
11438 .endd
11439
11440 .vitem &*isip&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
11441 &*isip4&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
11442 &*isip6&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11443 .cindex "IP address" "testing string format"
11444 .cindex "string" "testing for IP address"
11445 .cindex "&%isip%& expansion condition"
11446 .cindex "&%isip4%& expansion condition"
11447 .cindex "&%isip6%& expansion condition"
11448 The substring is first expanded, and then tested to see if it has the form of
11449 an IP address. Both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses are valid for &%isip%&, whereas
11450 &%isip4%& and &%isip6%& test specifically for IPv4 or IPv6 addresses.
11451
11452 For an IPv4 address, the test is for four dot-separated components, each of
11453 which consists of from one to three digits. For an IPv6 address, up to eight
11454 colon-separated components are permitted, each containing from one to four
11455 hexadecimal digits. There may be fewer than eight components if an empty
11456 component (adjacent colons) is present. Only one empty component is permitted.
11457
11458 &*Note*&: The checks used to be just on the form of the address; actual numerical
11459 values were not considered. Thus, for example, 999.999.999.999 passed the IPv4
11460 check.
11461 This is no longer the case.
11462
11463 The main use of these tests is to distinguish between IP addresses and
11464 host names, or between IPv4 and IPv6 addresses. For example, you could use
11465 .code
11466 ${if isip4{$sender_host_address}...
11467 .endd
11468 to test which IP version an incoming SMTP connection is using.
11469
11470 .vitem &*ldapauth&~{*&<&'ldap&~query'&>&*}*&
11471 .cindex "LDAP" "use for authentication"
11472 .cindex "expansion" "LDAP authentication test"
11473 .cindex "&%ldapauth%& expansion condition"
11474 This condition supports user authentication using LDAP. See section
11475 &<<SECTldap>>& for details of how to use LDAP in lookups and the syntax of
11476 queries. For this use, the query must contain a user name and password. The
11477 query itself is not used, and can be empty. The condition is true if the
11478 password is not empty, and the user name and password are accepted by the LDAP
11479 server. An empty password is rejected without calling LDAP because LDAP binds
11480 with an empty password are considered anonymous regardless of the username, and
11481 will succeed in most configurations. See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details
11482 of SMTP authentication, and chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>& for an example of how
11483 this can be used.
11484
11485
11486 .vitem &*le&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11487 &*lei&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11488 .cindex "string" "comparison"
11489 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
11490 .cindex "&%le%& expansion condition"
11491 .cindex "&%lei%& expansion condition"
11492 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
11493 string is lexically less than or equal to the second string. For &%le%& the
11494 comparison includes the case of letters, whereas for &%lei%& the comparison is
11495 case-independent.
11496 Case and collation order are defined per the system C locale.
11497
11498 .vitem &*lt&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11499 &*lti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11500 .cindex "string" "comparison"
11501 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
11502 .cindex "&%lt%& expansion condition"
11503 .cindex "&%lti%& expansion condition"
11504 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
11505 string is lexically less than the second string. For &%lt%& the comparison
11506 includes the case of letters, whereas for &%lti%& the comparison is
11507 case-independent.
11508 Case and collation order are defined per the system C locale.
11509
11510
11511 .vitem &*match&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11512 .cindex "expansion" "regular expression comparison"
11513 .cindex "regular expressions" "match in expanded string"
11514 .cindex "&%match%& expansion condition"
11515 The two substrings are first expanded. The second is then treated as a regular
11516 expression and applied to the first. Because of the pre-expansion, if the
11517 regular expression contains dollar, or backslash characters, they must be
11518 escaped. Care must also be taken if the regular expression contains braces
11519 (curly brackets). A closing brace must be escaped so that it is not taken as a
11520 premature termination of <&'string2'&>. The easiest approach is to use the
11521 &`\N`& feature to disable expansion of the regular expression.
11522 For example,
11523 .code
11524 ${if match {$local_part}{\N^\d{3}\N} ...
11525 .endd
11526 If the whole expansion string is in double quotes, further escaping of
11527 backslashes is also required.
11528
11529 The condition is true if the regular expression match succeeds.
11530 The regular expression is not required to begin with a circumflex
11531 metacharacter, but if there is no circumflex, the expression is not anchored,
11532 and it may match anywhere in the subject, not just at the start. If you want
11533 the pattern to match at the end of the subject, you must include the &`$`&
11534 metacharacter at an appropriate point.
11535 All character handling is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware,
11536 but we might change this in a future Exim release.
11537
11538 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%if%& expansion"
11539 At the start of an &%if%& expansion the values of the numeric variable
11540 substitutions &$1$& etc. are remembered. Obeying a &%match%& condition that
11541 succeeds causes them to be reset to the substrings of that condition and they
11542 will have these values during the expansion of the success string. At the end
11543 of the &%if%& expansion, the previous values are restored. After testing a
11544 combination of conditions using &%or%&, the subsequent values of the numeric
11545 variables are those of the condition that succeeded.
11546
11547 .vitem &*match_address&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11548 .cindex "&%match_address%& expansion condition"
11549 See &*match_local_part*&.
11550
11551 .vitem &*match_domain&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11552 .cindex "&%match_domain%& expansion condition"
11553 See &*match_local_part*&.
11554
11555 .vitem &*match_ip&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11556 .cindex "&%match_ip%& expansion condition"
11557 This condition matches an IP address to a list of IP address patterns. It must
11558 be followed by two argument strings. The first (after expansion) must be an IP
11559 address or an empty string. The second (not expanded) is a restricted host
11560 list that can match only an IP address, not a host name. For example:
11561 .code
11562 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{1.2.3.4:5.6.7.8}{...}{...}}
11563 .endd
11564 The specific types of host list item that are permitted in the list are:
11565
11566 .ilist
11567 An IP address, optionally with a CIDR mask.
11568 .next
11569 A single asterisk, which matches any IP address.
11570 .next
11571 An empty item, which matches only if the IP address is empty. This could be
11572 useful for testing for a locally submitted message or one from specific hosts
11573 in a single test such as
11574 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
11575 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left. This comment applies to
11576 . ==== the use of xmlto plus fop. There's no problem when formatting with
11577 . ==== sdop, with or without the extra indent.
11578 .code
11579 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{:4.3.2.1:...}{...}{...}}
11580 .endd
11581 where the first item in the list is the empty string.
11582 .next
11583 The item @[] matches any of the local host's interface addresses.
11584 .next
11585 Single-key lookups are assumed to be like &"net-"& style lookups in host lists,
11586 even if &`net-`& is not specified. There is never any attempt to turn the IP
11587 address into a host name. The most common type of linear search for
11588 &*match_ip*& is likely to be &*iplsearch*&, in which the file can contain CIDR
11589 masks. For example:
11590 .code
11591 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{iplsearch;/some/file}...
11592 .endd
11593 It is of course possible to use other kinds of lookup, and in such a case, you
11594 do need to specify the &`net-`& prefix if you want to specify a specific
11595 address mask, for example:
11596 .code
11597 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{net24-dbm;/some/file}...
11598 .endd
11599 However, unless you are combining a &%match_ip%& condition with others, it is
11600 just as easy to use the fact that a lookup is itself a condition, and write:
11601 .code
11602 ${lookup{${mask:$sender_host_address/24}}dbm{/a/file}...
11603 .endd
11604 .endlist ilist
11605
11606 Note that <&'string2'&> is not itself subject to string expansion, unless
11607 Exim was built with the EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option.
11608
11609 Consult section &<<SECThoslispatip>>& for further details of these patterns.
11610
11611 .vitem &*match_local_part&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11612 .cindex "domain list" "in expansion condition"
11613 .cindex "address list" "in expansion condition"
11614 .cindex "local part" "list, in expansion condition"
11615 .cindex "&%match_local_part%& expansion condition"
11616 This condition, together with &%match_address%& and &%match_domain%&, make it
11617 possible to test domain, address, and local part lists within expansions. Each
11618 condition requires two arguments: an item and a list to match. A trivial
11619 example is:
11620 .code
11621 ${if match_domain{a.b.c}{x.y.z:a.b.c:p.q.r}{yes}{no}}
11622 .endd
11623 In each case, the second argument may contain any of the allowable items for a
11624 list of the appropriate type. Also, because the second argument
11625 is a standard form of list, it is possible to refer to a named list.
11626 Thus, you can use conditions like this:
11627 .code
11628 ${if match_domain{$domain}{+local_domains}{...
11629 .endd
11630 .cindex "&`+caseful`&"
11631 For address lists, the matching starts off caselessly, but the &`+caseful`&
11632 item can be used, as in all address lists, to cause subsequent items to
11633 have their local parts matched casefully. Domains are always matched
11634 caselessly.
11635
11636 Note that <&'string2'&> is not itself subject to string expansion, unless
11637 Exim was built with the EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option.
11638
11639 &*Note*&: Host lists are &'not'& supported in this way. This is because
11640 hosts have two identities: a name and an IP address, and it is not clear
11641 how to specify cleanly how such a test would work. However, IP addresses can be
11642 matched using &%match_ip%&.
11643
11644 .vitem &*pam&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*:*&<&'string2'&>&*:...}*&
11645 .cindex "PAM authentication"
11646 .cindex "AUTH" "with PAM"
11647 .cindex "Solaris" "PAM support"
11648 .cindex "expansion" "PAM authentication test"
11649 .cindex "&%pam%& expansion condition"
11650 &'Pluggable Authentication Modules'&
11651 (&url(https://mirrors.edge.kernel.org/pub/linux/libs/pam/)) are a facility that is
11652 available in the latest releases of Solaris and in some GNU/Linux
11653 distributions. The Exim support, which is intended for use in conjunction with
11654 the SMTP AUTH command, is available only if Exim is compiled with
11655 .code
11656 SUPPORT_PAM=yes
11657 .endd
11658 in &_Local/Makefile_&. You probably need to add &%-lpam%& to EXTRALIBS, and
11659 in some releases of GNU/Linux &%-ldl%& is also needed.
11660
11661 The argument string is first expanded, and the result must be a
11662 colon-separated list of strings. Leading and trailing white space is ignored.
11663 The PAM module is initialized with the service name &"exim"& and the user name
11664 taken from the first item in the colon-separated data string (<&'string1'&>).
11665 The remaining items in the data string are passed over in response to requests
11666 from the authentication function. In the simple case there will only be one
11667 request, for a password, so the data consists of just two strings.
11668
11669 There can be problems if any of the strings are permitted to contain colon
11670 characters. In the usual way, these have to be doubled to avoid being taken as
11671 separators. If the data is being inserted from a variable, the &%sg%& expansion
11672 item can be used to double any existing colons. For example, the configuration
11673 of a LOGIN authenticator might contain this setting:
11674 .code
11675 server_condition = ${if pam{$auth1:${sg{$auth2}{:}{::}}}}
11676 .endd
11677 For a PLAIN authenticator you could use:
11678 .code
11679 server_condition = ${if pam{$auth2:${sg{$auth3}{:}{::}}}}
11680 .endd
11681 In some operating systems, PAM authentication can be done only from a process
11682 running as root. Since Exim is running as the Exim user when receiving
11683 messages, this means that PAM cannot be used directly in those systems.
11684 . --- 2018-09-07: the pam_exim modified variant has gone, removed claims re using Exim via that
11685
11686
11687 .vitem &*pwcheck&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*:*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11688 .cindex "&'pwcheck'& daemon"
11689 .cindex "Cyrus"
11690 .cindex "expansion" "&'pwcheck'& authentication test"
11691 .cindex "&%pwcheck%& expansion condition"
11692 This condition supports user authentication using the Cyrus &'pwcheck'& daemon.
11693 This is one way of making it possible for passwords to be checked by a process
11694 that is not running as root. &*Note*&: The use of &'pwcheck'& is now
11695 deprecated. Its replacement is &'saslauthd'& (see below).
11696
11697 The pwcheck support is not included in Exim by default. You need to specify
11698 the location of the pwcheck daemon's socket in &_Local/Makefile_& before
11699 building Exim. For example:
11700 .code
11701 CYRUS_PWCHECK_SOCKET=/var/pwcheck/pwcheck
11702 .endd
11703 You do not need to install the full Cyrus software suite in order to use
11704 the pwcheck daemon. You can compile and install just the daemon alone
11705 from the Cyrus SASL library. Ensure that &'exim'& is the only user that has
11706 access to the &_/var/pwcheck_& directory.
11707
11708 The &%pwcheck%& condition takes one argument, which must be the user name and
11709 password, separated by a colon. For example, in a LOGIN authenticator
11710 configuration, you might have this:
11711 .code
11712 server_condition = ${if pwcheck{$auth1:$auth2}}
11713 .endd
11714 Again, for a PLAIN authenticator configuration, this would be:
11715 .code
11716 server_condition = ${if pwcheck{$auth2:$auth3}}
11717 .endd
11718 .vitem &*queue_running*&
11719 .cindex "queue runner" "detecting when delivering from"
11720 .cindex "expansion" "queue runner test"
11721 .cindex "&%queue_running%& expansion condition"
11722 This condition, which has no data, is true during delivery attempts that are
11723 initiated by queue runner processes, and false otherwise.
11724
11725
11726 .vitem &*radius&~{*&<&'authentication&~string'&>&*}*&
11727 .cindex "Radius"
11728 .cindex "expansion" "Radius authentication"
11729 .cindex "&%radius%& expansion condition"
11730 Radius authentication (RFC 2865) is supported in a similar way to PAM. You must
11731 set RADIUS_CONFIG_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_& to specify the location of
11732 the Radius client configuration file in order to build Exim with Radius
11733 support.
11734
11735 With just that one setting, Exim expects to be linked with the &%radiusclient%&
11736 library, using the original API. If you are using release 0.4.0 or later of
11737 this library, you need to set
11738 .code
11739 RADIUS_LIB_TYPE=RADIUSCLIENTNEW
11740 .endd
11741 in &_Local/Makefile_& when building Exim. You can also link Exim with the
11742 &%libradius%& library that comes with FreeBSD. To do this, set
11743 .code
11744 RADIUS_LIB_TYPE=RADLIB
11745 .endd
11746 in &_Local/Makefile_&, in addition to setting RADIUS_CONFIGURE_FILE.
11747 You may also have to supply a suitable setting in EXTRALIBS so that the
11748 Radius library can be found when Exim is linked.
11749
11750 The string specified by RADIUS_CONFIG_FILE is expanded and passed to the
11751 Radius client library, which calls the Radius server. The condition is true if
11752 the authentication is successful. For example:
11753 .code
11754 server_condition = ${if radius{<arguments>}}
11755 .endd
11756
11757
11758 .vitem "&*saslauthd&~{{*&<&'user'&>&*}{*&<&'password'&>&*}&&&
11759 {*&<&'service'&>&*}{*&<&'realm'&>&*}}*&"
11760 .cindex "&'saslauthd'& daemon"
11761 .cindex "Cyrus"
11762 .cindex "expansion" "&'saslauthd'& authentication test"
11763 .cindex "&%saslauthd%& expansion condition"
11764 This condition supports user authentication using the Cyrus &'saslauthd'&
11765 daemon. This replaces the older &'pwcheck'& daemon, which is now deprecated.
11766 Using this daemon is one way of making it possible for passwords to be checked
11767 by a process that is not running as root.
11768
11769 The saslauthd support is not included in Exim by default. You need to specify
11770 the location of the saslauthd daemon's socket in &_Local/Makefile_& before
11771 building Exim. For example:
11772 .code
11773 CYRUS_SASLAUTHD_SOCKET=/var/state/saslauthd/mux
11774 .endd
11775 You do not need to install the full Cyrus software suite in order to use
11776 the saslauthd daemon. You can compile and install just the daemon alone
11777 from the Cyrus SASL library.
11778
11779 Up to four arguments can be supplied to the &%saslauthd%& condition, but only
11780 two are mandatory. For example:
11781 .code
11782 server_condition = ${if saslauthd{{$auth1}{$auth2}}}
11783 .endd
11784 The service and the realm are optional (which is why the arguments are enclosed
11785 in their own set of braces). For details of the meaning of the service and
11786 realm, and how to run the daemon, consult the Cyrus documentation.
11787 .endlist vlist
11788
11789
11790
11791 .section "Combining expansion conditions" "SECID84"
11792 .cindex "expansion" "combining conditions"
11793 Several conditions can be tested at once by combining them using the &%and%&
11794 and &%or%& combination conditions. Note that &%and%& and &%or%& are complete
11795 conditions on their own, and precede their lists of sub-conditions. Each
11796 sub-condition must be enclosed in braces within the overall braces that contain
11797 the list. No repetition of &%if%& is used.
11798
11799
11800 .vlist
11801 .vitem &*or&~{{*&<&'cond1'&>&*}{*&<&'cond2'&>&*}...}*&
11802 .cindex "&""or""& expansion condition"
11803 .cindex "expansion" "&""or""& of conditions"
11804 The sub-conditions are evaluated from left to right. The condition is true if
11805 any one of the sub-conditions is true.
11806 For example,
11807 .code
11808 ${if or {{eq{$local_part}{spqr}}{eq{$domain}{testing.com}}}...
11809 .endd
11810 When a true sub-condition is found, the following ones are parsed but not
11811 evaluated. If there are several &"match"& sub-conditions the values of the
11812 numeric variables afterwards are taken from the first one that succeeds.
11813
11814 .vitem &*and&~{{*&<&'cond1'&>&*}{*&<&'cond2'&>&*}...}*&
11815 .cindex "&""and""& expansion condition"
11816 .cindex "expansion" "&""and""& of conditions"
11817 The sub-conditions are evaluated from left to right. The condition is true if
11818 all of the sub-conditions are true. If there are several &"match"&
11819 sub-conditions, the values of the numeric variables afterwards are taken from
11820 the last one. When a false sub-condition is found, the following ones are
11821 parsed but not evaluated.
11822 .endlist
11823 .ecindex IIDexpcond
11824
11825
11826
11827
11828 .section "Expansion variables" "SECTexpvar"
11829 .cindex "expansion" "variables, list of"
11830 This section contains an alphabetical list of all the expansion variables. Some
11831 of them are available only when Exim is compiled with specific options such as
11832 support for TLS or the content scanning extension.
11833
11834 .vlist
11835 .vitem "&$0$&, &$1$&, etc"
11836 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)"
11837 When a &%match%& expansion condition succeeds, these variables contain the
11838 captured substrings identified by the regular expression during subsequent
11839 processing of the success string of the containing &%if%& expansion item.
11840 In the expansion condition case
11841 they do not retain their values afterwards; in fact, their previous
11842 values are restored at the end of processing an &%if%& item. The numerical
11843 variables may also be set externally by some other matching process which
11844 precedes the expansion of the string. For example, the commands available in
11845 Exim filter files include an &%if%& command with its own regular expression
11846 matching condition.
11847
11848 .vitem "&$acl_arg1$&, &$acl_arg2$&, etc"
11849 Within an acl condition, expansion condition or expansion item
11850 any arguments are copied to these variables,
11851 any unused variables being made empty.
11852
11853 .vitem "&$acl_c...$&"
11854 Values can be placed in these variables by the &%set%& modifier in an ACL. They
11855 can be given any name that starts with &$acl_c$& and is at least six characters
11856 long, but the sixth character must be either a digit or an underscore. For
11857 example: &$acl_c5$&, &$acl_c_mycount$&. The values of the &$acl_c...$&
11858 variables persist throughout the lifetime of an SMTP connection. They can be
11859 used to pass information between ACLs and between different invocations of the
11860 same ACL. When a message is received, the values of these variables are saved
11861 with the message, and can be accessed by filters, routers, and transports
11862 during subsequent delivery.
11863
11864 .vitem "&$acl_m...$&"
11865 These variables are like the &$acl_c...$& variables, except that their values
11866 are reset after a message has been received. Thus, if several messages are
11867 received in one SMTP connection, &$acl_m...$& values are not passed on from one
11868 message to the next, as &$acl_c...$& values are. The &$acl_m...$& variables are
11869 also reset by MAIL, RSET, EHLO, HELO, and after starting a TLS session. When a
11870 message is received, the values of these variables are saved with the message,
11871 and can be accessed by filters, routers, and transports during subsequent
11872 delivery.
11873
11874 .vitem &$acl_narg$&
11875 Within an acl condition, expansion condition or expansion item
11876 this variable has the number of arguments.
11877
11878 .vitem &$acl_verify_message$&
11879 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
11880 After an address verification has failed, this variable contains the failure
11881 message. It retains its value for use in subsequent modifiers. The message can
11882 be preserved by coding like this:
11883 .code
11884 warn !verify = sender
11885 set acl_m0 = $acl_verify_message
11886 .endd
11887 You can use &$acl_verify_message$& during the expansion of the &%message%& or
11888 &%log_message%& modifiers, to include information about the verification
11889 failure.
11890
11891 .vitem &$address_data$&
11892 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
11893 This variable is set by means of the &%address_data%& option in routers. The
11894 value then remains with the address while it is processed by subsequent routers
11895 and eventually a transport. If the transport is handling multiple addresses,
11896 the value from the first address is used. See chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&
11897 for more details. &*Note*&: The contents of &$address_data$& are visible in
11898 user filter files.
11899
11900 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify
11901 a recipient address, the final value is still in the variable for subsequent
11902 conditions and modifiers of the ACL statement. If routing the address caused it
11903 to be redirected to just one address, the child address is also routed as part
11904 of the verification, and in this case the final value of &$address_data$& is
11905 from the child's routing.
11906
11907 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify a
11908 sender address, the final value is also preserved, but this time in
11909 &$sender_address_data$&, to distinguish it from data from a recipient
11910 address.
11911
11912 In both cases (recipient and sender verification), the value does not persist
11913 after the end of the current ACL statement. If you want to preserve
11914 these values for longer, you can save them in ACL variables.
11915
11916 .vitem &$address_file$&
11917 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
11918 When, as a result of aliasing, forwarding, or filtering, a message is directed
11919 to a specific file, this variable holds the name of the file when the transport
11920 is running. At other times, the variable is empty. For example, using the
11921 default configuration, if user &%r2d2%& has a &_.forward_& file containing
11922 .code
11923 /home/r2d2/savemail
11924 .endd
11925 then when the &(address_file)& transport is running, &$address_file$&
11926 contains the text string &`/home/r2d2/savemail`&.
11927 .cindex "Sieve filter" "value of &$address_file$&"
11928 For Sieve filters, the value may be &"inbox"& or a relative folder name. It is
11929 then up to the transport configuration to generate an appropriate absolute path
11930 to the relevant file.
11931
11932 .vitem &$address_pipe$&
11933 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
11934 When, as a result of aliasing or forwarding, a message is directed to a pipe,
11935 this variable holds the pipe command when the transport is running.
11936
11937 .vitem "&$auth1$& &-- &$auth3$&"
11938 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
11939 These variables are used in SMTP authenticators (see chapters
11940 &<<CHAPplaintext>>&&--&<<CHAPtlsauth>>&). Elsewhere, they are empty.
11941
11942 .vitem &$authenticated_id$&
11943 .cindex "authentication" "id"
11944 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
11945 When a server successfully authenticates a client it may be configured to
11946 preserve some of the authentication information in the variable
11947 &$authenticated_id$& (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&). For example, a
11948 user/password authenticator configuration might preserve the user name for use
11949 in the routers. Note that this is not the same information that is saved in
11950 &$sender_host_authenticated$&.
11951
11952 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP connection)
11953 the value of &$authenticated_id$& is normally the login name of the calling
11954 process. However, a trusted user can override this by means of the &%-oMai%&
11955 command line option.
11956 This second case also sets up information used by the
11957 &$authresults$& expansion item.
11958
11959 .vitem &$authenticated_fail_id$&
11960 .cindex "authentication" "fail" "id"
11961 .vindex "&$authenticated_fail_id$&"
11962 When an authentication attempt fails, the variable &$authenticated_fail_id$&
11963 will contain the failed authentication id. If more than one authentication
11964 id is attempted, it will contain only the last one. The variable is
11965 available for processing in the ACL's, generally the quit or notquit ACL.
11966 A message to a local recipient could still be accepted without requiring
11967 authentication, which means this variable could also be visible in all of
11968 the ACL's as well.
11969
11970
11971 .vitem &$authenticated_sender$&
11972 .cindex "sender" "authenticated"
11973 .cindex "authentication" "sender"
11974 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
11975 .vindex "&$authenticated_sender$&"
11976 When acting as a server, Exim takes note of the AUTH= parameter on an incoming
11977 SMTP MAIL command if it believes the sender is sufficiently trusted, as
11978 described in section &<<SECTauthparamail>>&. Unless the data is the string
11979 &"<>"&, it is set as the authenticated sender of the message, and the value is
11980 available during delivery in the &$authenticated_sender$& variable. If the
11981 sender is not trusted, Exim accepts the syntax of AUTH=, but ignores the data.
11982
11983 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
11984 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP connection), the
11985 value of &$authenticated_sender$& is an address constructed from the login
11986 name of the calling process and &$qualify_domain$&, except that a trusted user
11987 can override this by means of the &%-oMas%& command line option.
11988
11989
11990 .vitem &$authentication_failed$&
11991 .cindex "authentication" "failure"
11992 .vindex "&$authentication_failed$&"
11993 This variable is set to &"1"& in an Exim server if a client issues an AUTH
11994 command that does not succeed. Otherwise it is set to &"0"&. This makes it
11995 possible to distinguish between &"did not try to authenticate"&
11996 (&$sender_host_authenticated$& is empty and &$authentication_failed$& is set to
11997 &"0"&) and &"tried to authenticate but failed"& (&$sender_host_authenticated$&
11998 is empty and &$authentication_failed$& is set to &"1"&). Failure includes any
11999 negative response to an AUTH command, including (for example) an attempt to use
12000 an undefined mechanism.
12001
12002 .vitem &$av_failed$&
12003 .cindex "content scanning" "AV scanner failure"
12004 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning
12005 extension. It is set to &"0"& by default, but will be set to &"1"& if any
12006 problem occurs with the virus scanner (specified by &%av_scanner%&) during
12007 the ACL malware condition.
12008
12009 .vitem &$body_linecount$&
12010 .cindex "message body" "line count"
12011 .cindex "body of message" "line count"
12012 .vindex "&$body_linecount$&"
12013 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
12014 number of lines in the message's body. See also &$message_linecount$&.
12015
12016 .vitem &$body_zerocount$&
12017 .cindex "message body" "binary zero count"
12018 .cindex "body of message" "binary zero count"
12019 .cindex "binary zero" "in message body"
12020 .vindex "&$body_zerocount$&"
12021 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
12022 number of binary zero bytes (ASCII NULs) in the message's body.
12023
12024 .vitem &$bounce_recipient$&
12025 .vindex "&$bounce_recipient$&"
12026 This is set to the recipient address of a bounce message while Exim is creating
12027 it. It is useful if a customized bounce message text file is in use (see
12028 chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&).
12029
12030 .vitem &$bounce_return_size_limit$&
12031 .vindex "&$bounce_return_size_limit$&"
12032 This contains the value set in the &%bounce_return_size_limit%& option, rounded
12033 up to a multiple of 1000. It is useful when a customized error message text
12034 file is in use (see chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&).
12035
12036 .vitem &$caller_gid$&
12037 .cindex "gid (group id)" "caller"
12038 .vindex "&$caller_gid$&"
12039 The real group id under which the process that called Exim was running. This is
12040 not the same as the group id of the originator of a message (see
12041 &$originator_gid$&). If Exim re-execs itself, this variable in the new
12042 incarnation normally contains the Exim gid.
12043
12044 .vitem &$caller_uid$&
12045 .cindex "uid (user id)" "caller"
12046 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
12047 The real user id under which the process that called Exim was running. This is
12048 not the same as the user id of the originator of a message (see
12049 &$originator_uid$&). If Exim re-execs itself, this variable in the new
12050 incarnation normally contains the Exim uid.
12051
12052 .vitem &$callout_address$&
12053 .vindex "&$callout_address$&"
12054 After a callout for verification, spamd or malware daemon service, the
12055 address that was connected to.
12056
12057 .vitem &$compile_number$&
12058 .vindex "&$compile_number$&"
12059 The building process for Exim keeps a count of the number
12060 of times it has been compiled. This serves to distinguish different
12061 compilations of the same version of Exim.
12062
12063 .vitem &$config_dir$&
12064 .vindex "&$config_dir$&"
12065 The directory name of the main configuration file. That is, the content of
12066 &$config_file$& with the last component stripped. The value does not
12067 contain the trailing slash. If &$config_file$& does not contain a slash,
12068 &$config_dir$& is ".".
12069
12070 .vitem &$config_file$&
12071 .vindex "&$config_file$&"
12072 The name of the main configuration file Exim is using.
12073
12074 .vitem &$dkim_verify_status$&
12075 Results of DKIM verification.
12076 For details see section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>&.
12077
12078 .vitem &$dkim_cur_signer$& &&&
12079 &$dkim_verify_reason$& &&&
12080 &$dkim_domain$& &&&
12081 &$dkim_identity$& &&&
12082 &$dkim_selector$& &&&
12083 &$dkim_algo$& &&&
12084 &$dkim_canon_body$& &&&
12085 &$dkim_canon_headers$& &&&
12086 &$dkim_copiedheaders$& &&&
12087 &$dkim_bodylength$& &&&
12088 &$dkim_created$& &&&
12089 &$dkim_expires$& &&&
12090 &$dkim_headernames$& &&&
12091 &$dkim_key_testing$& &&&
12092 &$dkim_key_nosubdomains$& &&&
12093 &$dkim_key_srvtype$& &&&
12094 &$dkim_key_granularity$& &&&
12095 &$dkim_key_notes$& &&&
12096 &$dkim_key_length$&
12097 These variables are only available within the DKIM ACL.
12098 For details see section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>&.
12099
12100 .vitem &$dkim_signers$&
12101 .vindex &$dkim_signers$&
12102 When a message has been received this variable contains
12103 a colon-separated list of signer domains and identities for the message.
12104 For details see section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>&.
12105
12106 .vitem &$dnslist_domain$& &&&
12107 &$dnslist_matched$& &&&
12108 &$dnslist_text$& &&&
12109 &$dnslist_value$&
12110 .vindex "&$dnslist_domain$&"
12111 .vindex "&$dnslist_matched$&"
12112 .vindex "&$dnslist_text$&"
12113 .vindex "&$dnslist_value$&"
12114 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
12115 When a DNS (black) list lookup succeeds, these variables are set to contain
12116 the following data from the lookup: the list's domain name, the key that was
12117 looked up, the contents of any associated TXT record, and the value from the
12118 main A record. See section &<<SECID204>>& for more details.
12119
12120 .vitem &$domain$&
12121 .vindex "&$domain$&"
12122 When an address is being routed, or delivered on its own, this variable
12123 contains the domain. Uppercase letters in the domain are converted into lower
12124 case for &$domain$&.
12125
12126 Global address rewriting happens when a message is received, so the value of
12127 &$domain$& during routing and delivery is the value after rewriting. &$domain$&
12128 is set during user filtering, but not during system filtering, because a
12129 message may have many recipients and the system filter is called just once.
12130
12131 When more than one address is being delivered at once (for example, several
12132 RCPT commands in one SMTP delivery), &$domain$& is set only if they all
12133 have the same domain. Transports can be restricted to handling only one domain
12134 at a time if the value of &$domain$& is required at transport time &-- this is
12135 the default for local transports. For further details of the environment in
12136 which local transports are run, see chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
12137
12138 .oindex "&%delay_warning_condition%&"
12139 At the end of a delivery, if all deferred addresses have the same domain, it is
12140 set in &$domain$& during the expansion of &%delay_warning_condition%&.
12141
12142 The &$domain$& variable is also used in some other circumstances:
12143
12144 .ilist
12145 When an ACL is running for a RCPT command, &$domain$& contains the domain of
12146 the recipient address. The domain of the &'sender'& address is in
12147 &$sender_address_domain$& at both MAIL time and at RCPT time. &$domain$& is not
12148 normally set during the running of the MAIL ACL. However, if the sender address
12149 is verified with a callout during the MAIL ACL, the sender domain is placed in
12150 &$domain$& during the expansions of &%hosts%&, &%interface%&, and &%port%& in
12151 the &(smtp)& transport.
12152
12153 .next
12154 When a rewrite item is being processed (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&),
12155 &$domain$& contains the domain portion of the address that is being rewritten;
12156 it can be used in the expansion of the replacement address, for example, to
12157 rewrite domains by file lookup.
12158
12159 .next
12160 With one important exception, whenever a domain list is being scanned,
12161 &$domain$& contains the subject domain. &*Exception*&: When a domain list in
12162 a &%sender_domains%& condition in an ACL is being processed, the subject domain
12163 is in &$sender_address_domain$& and not in &$domain$&. It works this way so
12164 that, in a RCPT ACL, the sender domain list can be dependent on the
12165 recipient domain (which is what is in &$domain$& at this time).
12166
12167 .next
12168 .cindex "ETRN" "value of &$domain$&"
12169 .oindex "&%smtp_etrn_command%&"
12170 When the &%smtp_etrn_command%& option is being expanded, &$domain$& contains
12171 the complete argument of the ETRN command (see section &<<SECTETRN>>&).
12172 .endlist
12173
12174
12175 .vitem &$domain_data$&
12176 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
12177 When the &%domains%& option on a router matches a domain by
12178 means of a lookup, the data read by the lookup is available during the running
12179 of the router as &$domain_data$&. In addition, if the driver routes the
12180 address to a transport, the value is available in that transport. If the
12181 transport is handling multiple addresses, the value from the first address is
12182 used.
12183
12184 &$domain_data$& is also set when the &%domains%& condition in an ACL matches a
12185 domain by means of a lookup. The data read by the lookup is available during
12186 the rest of the ACL statement. In all other situations, this variable expands
12187 to nothing.
12188
12189 .vitem &$exim_gid$&
12190 .vindex "&$exim_gid$&"
12191 This variable contains the numerical value of the Exim group id.
12192
12193 .vitem &$exim_path$&
12194 .vindex "&$exim_path$&"
12195 This variable contains the path to the Exim binary.
12196
12197 .vitem &$exim_uid$&
12198 .vindex "&$exim_uid$&"
12199 This variable contains the numerical value of the Exim user id.
12200
12201 .vitem &$exim_version$&
12202 .vindex "&$exim_version$&"
12203 This variable contains the version string of the Exim build.
12204 The first character is a major version number, currently 4.
12205 Then after a dot, the next group of digits is a minor version number.
12206 There may be other characters following the minor version.
12207 This value may be overridden by the &%exim_version%& main config option.
12208
12209 .vitem &$header_$&<&'name'&>
12210 This is not strictly an expansion variable. It is expansion syntax for
12211 inserting the message header line with the given name. Note that the name must
12212 be terminated by colon or white space, because it may contain a wide variety of
12213 characters. Note also that braces must &'not'& be used.
12214 See the full description in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& above.
12215
12216 .vitem &$headers_added$&
12217 .vindex "&$headers_added$&"
12218 Within an ACL this variable contains the headers added so far by
12219 the ACL modifier add_header (section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&).
12220 The headers are a newline-separated list.
12221
12222 .vitem &$home$&
12223 .vindex "&$home$&"
12224 When the &%check_local_user%& option is set for a router, the user's home
12225 directory is placed in &$home$& when the check succeeds. In particular, this
12226 means it is set during the running of users' filter files. A router may also
12227 explicitly set a home directory for use by a transport; this can be overridden
12228 by a setting on the transport itself.
12229
12230 When running a filter test via the &%-bf%& option, &$home$& is set to the value
12231 of the environment variable HOME, which is subject to the
12232 &%keep_environment%& and &%add_environment%& main config options.
12233
12234 .vitem &$host$&
12235 .vindex "&$host$&"
12236 If a router assigns an address to a transport (any transport), and passes a
12237 list of hosts with the address, the value of &$host$& when the transport starts
12238 to run is the name of the first host on the list. Note that this applies both
12239 to local and remote transports.
12240
12241 .cindex "transport" "filter"
12242 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
12243 For the &(smtp)& transport, if there is more than one host, the value of
12244 &$host$& changes as the transport works its way through the list. In
12245 particular, when the &(smtp)& transport is expanding its options for encryption
12246 using TLS, or for specifying a transport filter (see chapter
12247 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&), &$host$& contains the name of the host to which it
12248 is connected.
12249
12250 When used in the client part of an authenticator configuration (see chapter
12251 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&), &$host$& contains the name of the server to which the
12252 client is connected.
12253
12254
12255 .vitem &$host_address$&
12256 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
12257 This variable is set to the remote host's IP address whenever &$host$& is set
12258 for a remote connection. It is also set to the IP address that is being checked
12259 when the &%ignore_target_hosts%& option is being processed.
12260
12261 .vitem &$host_data$&
12262 .vindex "&$host_data$&"
12263 If a &%hosts%& condition in an ACL is satisfied by means of a lookup, the
12264 result of the lookup is made available in the &$host_data$& variable. This
12265 allows you, for example, to do things like this:
12266 .code
12267 deny hosts = net-lsearch;/some/file
12268 message = $host_data
12269 .endd
12270 .vitem &$host_lookup_deferred$&
12271 .cindex "host name" "lookup, failure of"
12272 .vindex "&$host_lookup_deferred$&"
12273 This variable normally contains &"0"&, as does &$host_lookup_failed$&. When a
12274 message comes from a remote host and there is an attempt to look up the host's
12275 name from its IP address, and the attempt is not successful, one of these
12276 variables is set to &"1"&.
12277
12278 .ilist
12279 If the lookup receives a definite negative response (for example, a DNS lookup
12280 succeeded, but no records were found), &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&.
12281
12282 .next
12283 If there is any kind of problem during the lookup, such that Exim cannot
12284 tell whether or not the host name is defined (for example, a timeout for a DNS
12285 lookup), &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to &"1"&.
12286 .endlist ilist
12287
12288 Looking up a host's name from its IP address consists of more than just a
12289 single reverse lookup. Exim checks that a forward lookup of at least one of the
12290 names it receives from a reverse lookup yields the original IP address. If this
12291 is not the case, Exim does not accept the looked up name(s), and
12292 &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&. Thus, being able to find a name from an
12293 IP address (for example, the existence of a PTR record in the DNS) is not
12294 sufficient on its own for the success of a host name lookup. If the reverse
12295 lookup succeeds, but there is a lookup problem such as a timeout when checking
12296 the result, the name is not accepted, and &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to
12297 &"1"&. See also &$sender_host_name$&.
12298
12299 .cindex authentication "expansion item"
12300 Performing these checks sets up information used by the
12301 &$authresults$& expansion item.
12302
12303
12304 .vitem &$host_lookup_failed$&
12305 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
12306 See &$host_lookup_deferred$&.
12307
12308 .vitem &$host_port$&
12309 .vindex "&$host_port$&"
12310 This variable is set to the remote host's TCP port whenever &$host$& is set
12311 for an outbound connection.
12312
12313 .vitem &$initial_cwd$&
12314 .vindex "&$initial_cwd$&
12315 This variable contains the full path name of the initial working
12316 directory of the current Exim process. This may differ from the current
12317 working directory, as Exim changes this to "/" during early startup, and
12318 to &$spool_directory$& later.
12319
12320 .vitem &$inode$&
12321 .vindex "&$inode$&"
12322 The only time this variable is set is while expanding the &%directory_file%&
12323 option in the &(appendfile)& transport. The variable contains the inode number
12324 of the temporary file which is about to be renamed. It can be used to construct
12325 a unique name for the file.
12326
12327 .vitem &$interface_address$&
12328 .vindex "&$interface_address$&"
12329 This is an obsolete name for &$received_ip_address$&.
12330
12331 .vitem &$interface_port$&
12332 .vindex "&$interface_port$&"
12333 This is an obsolete name for &$received_port$&.
12334
12335 .vitem &$item$&
12336 .vindex "&$item$&"
12337 This variable is used during the expansion of &*forall*& and &*forany*&
12338 conditions (see section &<<SECTexpcond>>&), and &*filter*&, &*map*&, and
12339 &*reduce*& items (see section &<<SECTexpcond>>&). In other circumstances, it is
12340 empty.
12341
12342 .vitem &$ldap_dn$&
12343 .vindex "&$ldap_dn$&"
12344 This variable, which is available only when Exim is compiled with LDAP support,
12345 contains the DN from the last entry in the most recently successful LDAP
12346 lookup.
12347
12348 .vitem &$load_average$&
12349 .vindex "&$load_average$&"
12350 This variable contains the system load average, multiplied by 1000 so that it
12351 is an integer. For example, if the load average is 0.21, the value of the
12352 variable is 210. The value is recomputed every time the variable is referenced.
12353
12354 .vitem &$local_part$&
12355 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
12356 When an address is being routed, or delivered on its own, this
12357 variable contains the local part. When a number of addresses are being
12358 delivered together (for example, multiple RCPT commands in an SMTP
12359 session), &$local_part$& is not set.
12360
12361 Global address rewriting happens when a message is received, so the value of
12362 &$local_part$& during routing and delivery is the value after rewriting.
12363 &$local_part$& is set during user filtering, but not during system filtering,
12364 because a message may have many recipients and the system filter is called just
12365 once.
12366
12367 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
12368 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
12369 .cindex affix variables
12370 If a local part prefix or suffix has been recognized, it is not included in the
12371 value of &$local_part$& during routing and subsequent delivery. The values of
12372 any prefix or suffix are in &$local_part_prefix$& and
12373 &$local_part_suffix$&, respectively.
12374
12375 When a message is being delivered to a file, pipe, or autoreply transport as a
12376 result of aliasing or forwarding, &$local_part$& is set to the local part of
12377 the parent address, not to the filename or command (see &$address_file$& and
12378 &$address_pipe$&).
12379
12380 When an ACL is running for a RCPT command, &$local_part$& contains the
12381 local part of the recipient address.
12382
12383 When a rewrite item is being processed (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&),
12384 &$local_part$& contains the local part of the address that is being rewritten;
12385 it can be used in the expansion of the replacement address, for example.
12386
12387 In all cases, all quoting is removed from the local part. For example, for both
12388 the addresses
12389 .code
12390 "abc:xyz"@test.example
12391 abc\:xyz@test.example
12392 .endd
12393 the value of &$local_part$& is
12394 .code
12395 abc:xyz
12396 .endd
12397 If you use &$local_part$& to create another address, you should always wrap it
12398 inside a quoting operator. For example, in a &(redirect)& router you could
12399 have:
12400 .code
12401 data = ${quote_local_part:$local_part}@new.domain.example
12402 .endd
12403 &*Note*&: The value of &$local_part$& is normally lower cased. If you want
12404 to process local parts in a case-dependent manner in a router, you can set the
12405 &%caseful_local_part%& option (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&).
12406
12407 .vitem &$local_part_data$&
12408 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
12409 When the &%local_parts%& option on a router matches a local part by means of a
12410 lookup, the data read by the lookup is available during the running of the
12411 router as &$local_part_data$&. In addition, if the driver routes the address
12412 to a transport, the value is available in that transport. If the transport is
12413 handling multiple addresses, the value from the first address is used.
12414
12415 &$local_part_data$& is also set when the &%local_parts%& condition in an ACL
12416 matches a local part by means of a lookup. The data read by the lookup is
12417 available during the rest of the ACL statement. In all other situations, this
12418 variable expands to nothing.
12419
12420 .vitem &$local_part_prefix$&
12421 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
12422 .cindex affix variables
12423 When an address is being routed or delivered, and a
12424 specific prefix for the local part was recognized, it is available in this
12425 variable, having been removed from &$local_part$&.
12426
12427 .vitem &$local_part_suffix$&
12428 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
12429 When an address is being routed or delivered, and a
12430 specific suffix for the local part was recognized, it is available in this
12431 variable, having been removed from &$local_part$&.
12432
12433 .vitem &$local_scan_data$&
12434 .vindex "&$local_scan_data$&"
12435 This variable contains the text returned by the &[local_scan()]& function when
12436 a message is received. See chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>& for more details.
12437
12438 .vitem &$local_user_gid$&
12439 .vindex "&$local_user_gid$&"
12440 See &$local_user_uid$&.
12441
12442 .vitem &$local_user_uid$&
12443 .vindex "&$local_user_uid$&"
12444 This variable and &$local_user_gid$& are set to the uid and gid after the
12445 &%check_local_user%& router precondition succeeds. This means that their values
12446 are available for the remaining preconditions (&%senders%&, &%require_files%&,
12447 and &%condition%&), for the &%address_data%& expansion, and for any
12448 router-specific expansions. At all other times, the values in these variables
12449 are &`(uid_t)(-1)`& and &`(gid_t)(-1)`&, respectively.
12450
12451 .vitem &$localhost_number$&
12452 .vindex "&$localhost_number$&"
12453 This contains the expanded value of the
12454 &%localhost_number%& option. The expansion happens after the main options have
12455 been read.
12456
12457 .vitem &$log_inodes$&
12458 .vindex "&$log_inodes$&"
12459 The number of free inodes in the disk partition where Exim's
12460 log files are being written. The value is recalculated whenever the variable is
12461 referenced. If the relevant file system does not have the concept of inodes,
12462 the value of is -1. See also the &%check_log_inodes%& option.
12463
12464 .vitem &$log_space$&
12465 .vindex "&$log_space$&"
12466 The amount of free space (as a number of kilobytes) in the disk
12467 partition where Exim's log files are being written. The value is recalculated
12468 whenever the variable is referenced. If the operating system does not have the
12469 ability to find the amount of free space (only true for experimental systems),
12470 the space value is -1. See also the &%check_log_space%& option.
12471
12472
12473 .vitem &$lookup_dnssec_authenticated$&
12474 .vindex "&$lookup_dnssec_authenticated$&"
12475 This variable is set after a DNS lookup done by
12476 a dnsdb lookup expansion, dnslookup router or smtp transport.
12477 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
12478 It will be empty if &(DNSSEC)& was not requested,
12479 &"no"& if the result was not labelled as authenticated data
12480 and &"yes"& if it was.
12481 Results that are labelled as authoritative answer that match
12482 the &%dns_trust_aa%& configuration variable count also
12483 as authenticated data.
12484
12485 .vitem &$mailstore_basename$&
12486 .vindex "&$mailstore_basename$&"
12487 This variable is set only when doing deliveries in &"mailstore"& format in the
12488 &(appendfile)& transport. During the expansion of the &%mailstore_prefix%&,
12489 &%mailstore_suffix%&, &%message_prefix%&, and &%message_suffix%& options, it
12490 contains the basename of the files that are being written, that is, the name
12491 without the &".tmp"&, &".env"&, or &".msg"& suffix. At all other times, this
12492 variable is empty.
12493
12494 .vitem &$malware_name$&
12495 .vindex "&$malware_name$&"
12496 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the
12497 content-scanning extension. It is set to the name of the virus that was found
12498 when the ACL &%malware%& condition is true (see section &<<SECTscanvirus>>&).
12499
12500 .vitem &$max_received_linelength$&
12501 .vindex "&$max_received_linelength$&"
12502 .cindex "maximum" "line length"
12503 .cindex "line length" "maximum"
12504 This variable contains the number of bytes in the longest line that was
12505 received as part of the message, not counting the line termination
12506 character(s).
12507 It is not valid if the &%spool_files_wireformat%& option is used.
12508
12509 .vitem &$message_age$&
12510 .cindex "message" "age of"
12511 .vindex "&$message_age$&"
12512 This variable is set at the start of a delivery attempt to contain the number
12513 of seconds since the message was received. It does not change during a single
12514 delivery attempt.
12515
12516 .vitem &$message_body$&
12517 .cindex "body of message" "expansion variable"
12518 .cindex "message body" "in expansion"
12519 .cindex "binary zero" "in message body"
12520 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
12521 .oindex "&%message_body_visible%&"
12522 This variable contains the initial portion of a message's body while it is
12523 being delivered, and is intended mainly for use in filter files. The maximum
12524 number of characters of the body that are put into the variable is set by the
12525 &%message_body_visible%& configuration option; the default is 500.
12526
12527 .oindex "&%message_body_newlines%&"
12528 By default, newlines are converted into spaces in &$message_body$&, to make it
12529 easier to search for phrases that might be split over a line break. However,
12530 this can be disabled by setting &%message_body_newlines%& to be true. Binary
12531 zeros are always converted into spaces.
12532
12533 .vitem &$message_body_end$&
12534 .cindex "body of message" "expansion variable"
12535 .cindex "message body" "in expansion"
12536 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
12537 This variable contains the final portion of a message's
12538 body while it is being delivered. The format and maximum size are as for
12539 &$message_body$&.
12540
12541 .vitem &$message_body_size$&
12542 .cindex "body of message" "size"
12543 .cindex "message body" "size"
12544 .vindex "&$message_body_size$&"
12545 When a message is being delivered, this variable contains the size of the body
12546 in bytes. The count starts from the character after the blank line that
12547 separates the body from the header. Newlines are included in the count. See
12548 also &$message_size$&, &$body_linecount$&, and &$body_zerocount$&.
12549
12550 If the spool file is wireformat
12551 (see the &%spool_files_wireformat%& main option)
12552 the CRLF line-terminators are included in the count.
12553
12554 .vitem &$message_exim_id$&
12555 .vindex "&$message_exim_id$&"
12556 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
12557 unique message id that is generated and used by Exim to identify the message.
12558 An id is not created for a message until after its header has been successfully
12559 received. &*Note*&: This is &'not'& the contents of the &'Message-ID:'& header
12560 line; it is the local id that Exim assigns to the message, for example:
12561 &`1BXTIK-0001yO-VA`&.
12562
12563 .vitem &$message_headers$&
12564 .vindex &$message_headers$&
12565 This variable contains a concatenation of all the header lines when a message
12566 is being processed, except for lines added by routers or transports. The header
12567 lines are separated by newline characters. Their contents are decoded in the
12568 same way as a header line that is inserted by &%bheader%&.
12569
12570 .vitem &$message_headers_raw$&
12571 .vindex &$message_headers_raw$&
12572 This variable is like &$message_headers$& except that no processing of the
12573 contents of header lines is done.
12574
12575 .vitem &$message_id$&
12576 This is an old name for &$message_exim_id$&. It is now deprecated.
12577
12578 .vitem &$message_linecount$&
12579 .vindex "&$message_linecount$&"
12580 This variable contains the total number of lines in the header and body of the
12581 message. Compare &$body_linecount$&, which is the count for the body only.
12582 During the DATA and content-scanning ACLs, &$message_linecount$& contains the
12583 number of lines received. Before delivery happens (that is, before filters,
12584 routers, and transports run) the count is increased to include the
12585 &'Received:'& header line that Exim standardly adds, and also any other header
12586 lines that are added by ACLs. The blank line that separates the message header
12587 from the body is not counted.
12588
12589 As with the special case of &$message_size$&, during the expansion of the
12590 appendfile transport's maildir_tag option in maildir format, the value of
12591 &$message_linecount$& is the precise size of the number of newlines in the
12592 file that has been written (minus one for the blank line between the
12593 header and the body).
12594
12595 Here is an example of the use of this variable in a DATA ACL:
12596 .code
12597 deny message = Too many lines in message header
12598 condition = \
12599 ${if <{250}{${eval:$message_linecount - $body_linecount}}}
12600 .endd
12601 In the MAIL and RCPT ACLs, the value is zero because at that stage the
12602 message has not yet been received.
12603
12604 This variable is not valid if the &%spool_files_wireformat%& option is used.
12605
12606 .vitem &$message_size$&
12607 .cindex "size" "of message"
12608 .cindex "message" "size"
12609 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
12610 When a message is being processed, this variable contains its size in bytes. In
12611 most cases, the size includes those headers that were received with the
12612 message, but not those (such as &'Envelope-to:'&) that are added to individual
12613 deliveries as they are written. However, there is one special case: during the
12614 expansion of the &%maildir_tag%& option in the &(appendfile)& transport while
12615 doing a delivery in maildir format, the value of &$message_size$& is the
12616 precise size of the file that has been written. See also
12617 &$message_body_size$&, &$body_linecount$&, and &$body_zerocount$&.
12618
12619 .cindex "RCPT" "value of &$message_size$&"
12620 While running a per message ACL (mail/rcpt/predata), &$message_size$&
12621 contains the size supplied on the MAIL command, or -1 if no size was given. The
12622 value may not, of course, be truthful.
12623
12624 .vitem &$mime_$&&'xxx'&
12625 A number of variables whose names start with &$mime$& are
12626 available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning extension. For
12627 details, see section &<<SECTscanmimepart>>&.
12628
12629 .vitem "&$n0$& &-- &$n9$&"
12630 These variables are counters that can be incremented by means
12631 of the &%add%& command in filter files.
12632
12633 .vitem &$original_domain$&
12634 .vindex "&$domain$&"
12635 .vindex "&$original_domain$&"
12636 When a top-level address is being processed for delivery, this contains the
12637 same value as &$domain$&. However, if a &"child"& address (for example,
12638 generated by an alias, forward, or filter file) is being processed, this
12639 variable contains the domain of the original address (lower cased). This
12640 differs from &$parent_domain$& only when there is more than one level of
12641 aliasing or forwarding. When more than one address is being delivered in a
12642 single transport run, &$original_domain$& is not set.
12643
12644 If a new address is created by means of a &%deliver%& command in a system
12645 filter, it is set up with an artificial &"parent"& address. This has the local
12646 part &'system-filter'& and the default qualify domain.
12647
12648 .vitem &$original_local_part$&
12649 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
12650 .vindex "&$original_local_part$&"
12651 When a top-level address is being processed for delivery, this contains the
12652 same value as &$local_part$&, unless a prefix or suffix was removed from the
12653 local part, because &$original_local_part$& always contains the full local
12654 part. When a &"child"& address (for example, generated by an alias, forward, or
12655 filter file) is being processed, this variable contains the full local part of
12656 the original address.
12657
12658 If the router that did the redirection processed the local part
12659 case-insensitively, the value in &$original_local_part$& is in lower case.
12660 This variable differs from &$parent_local_part$& only when there is more than
12661 one level of aliasing or forwarding. When more than one address is being
12662 delivered in a single transport run, &$original_local_part$& is not set.
12663
12664 If a new address is created by means of a &%deliver%& command in a system
12665 filter, it is set up with an artificial &"parent"& address. This has the local
12666 part &'system-filter'& and the default qualify domain.
12667
12668 .vitem &$originator_gid$&
12669 .cindex "gid (group id)" "of originating user"
12670 .cindex "sender" "gid"
12671 .vindex "&$caller_gid$&"
12672 .vindex "&$originator_gid$&"
12673 This variable contains the value of &$caller_gid$& that was set when the
12674 message was received. For messages received via the command line, this is the
12675 gid of the sending user. For messages received by SMTP over TCP/IP, this is
12676 normally the gid of the Exim user.
12677
12678 .vitem &$originator_uid$&
12679 .cindex "uid (user id)" "of originating user"
12680 .cindex "sender" "uid"
12681 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
12682 .vindex "&$originator_uid$&"
12683 The value of &$caller_uid$& that was set when the message was received. For
12684 messages received via the command line, this is the uid of the sending user.
12685 For messages received by SMTP over TCP/IP, this is normally the uid of the Exim
12686 user.
12687
12688 .vitem &$parent_domain$&
12689 .vindex "&$parent_domain$&"
12690 This variable is similar to &$original_domain$& (see
12691 above), except that it refers to the immediately preceding parent address.
12692
12693 .vitem &$parent_local_part$&
12694 .vindex "&$parent_local_part$&"
12695 This variable is similar to &$original_local_part$&
12696 (see above), except that it refers to the immediately preceding parent address.
12697
12698 .vitem &$pid$&
12699 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of current process"
12700 .vindex "&$pid$&"
12701 This variable contains the current process id.
12702
12703 .vitem &$pipe_addresses$&
12704 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
12705 .cindex "transport" "filter"
12706 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
12707 This is not an expansion variable, but is mentioned here because the string
12708 &`$pipe_addresses`& is handled specially in the command specification for the
12709 &(pipe)& transport (chapter &<<CHAPpipetransport>>&) and in transport filters
12710 (described under &%transport_filter%& in chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
12711 It cannot be used in general expansion strings, and provokes an &"unknown
12712 variable"& error if encountered.
12713
12714 .vitem &$primary_hostname$&
12715 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
12716 This variable contains the value set by &%primary_hostname%& in the
12717 configuration file, or read by the &[uname()]& function. If &[uname()]& returns
12718 a single-component name, Exim calls &[gethostbyname()]& (or
12719 &[getipnodebyname()]& where available) in an attempt to acquire a fully
12720 qualified host name. See also &$smtp_active_hostname$&.
12721
12722
12723 .vitem &$proxy_external_address$& &&&
12724 &$proxy_external_port$& &&&
12725 &$proxy_local_address$& &&&
12726 &$proxy_local_port$& &&&
12727 &$proxy_session$&
12728 These variables are only available when built with Proxy Protocol
12729 or SOCKS5 support.
12730 For details see chapter &<<SECTproxyInbound>>&.
12731
12732 .vitem &$prdr_requested$&
12733 .cindex "PRDR" "variable for"
12734 This variable is set to &"yes"& if PRDR was requested by the client for the
12735 current message, otherwise &"no"&.
12736
12737 .vitem &$prvscheck_address$&
12738 This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
12739 which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
12740 &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
12741
12742 .vitem &$prvscheck_keynum$&
12743 This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
12744 which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
12745 &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
12746
12747 .vitem &$prvscheck_result$&
12748 This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
12749 which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
12750 &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
12751
12752 .vitem &$qualify_domain$&
12753 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
12754 The value set for the &%qualify_domain%& option in the configuration file.
12755
12756 .vitem &$qualify_recipient$&
12757 .vindex "&$qualify_recipient$&"
12758 The value set for the &%qualify_recipient%& option in the configuration file,
12759 or if not set, the value of &$qualify_domain$&.
12760
12761 .vitem &$queue_name$&
12762 .vindex &$queue_name$&
12763 .cindex "named queues"
12764 .cindex queues named
12765 The name of the spool queue in use; empty for the default queue.
12766
12767 .new
12768 .vitem &$r_...$&
12769 .vindex &$r_...$&
12770 .cindex router variables
12771 Values can be placed in these variables by the &%set%& option of a router.
12772 They can be given any name that starts with &$r_$&.
12773 The values persist for the address being handled through subsequent routers
12774 and the eventual transport.
12775 .wen
12776
12777 .vitem &$rcpt_count$&
12778 .vindex "&$rcpt_count$&"
12779 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
12780 RCPT commands received for the current message. If this variable is used in a
12781 RCPT ACL, its value includes the current command.
12782
12783 .vitem &$rcpt_defer_count$&
12784 .vindex "&$rcpt_defer_count$&"
12785 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "count of"
12786 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
12787 RCPT commands in the current message that have previously been rejected with a
12788 temporary (4&'xx'&) response.
12789
12790 .vitem &$rcpt_fail_count$&
12791 .vindex "&$rcpt_fail_count$&"
12792 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
12793 RCPT commands in the current message that have previously been rejected with a
12794 permanent (5&'xx'&) response.
12795
12796 .vitem &$received_count$&
12797 .vindex "&$received_count$&"
12798 This variable contains the number of &'Received:'& header lines in the message,
12799 including the one added by Exim (so its value is always greater than zero). It
12800 is available in the DATA ACL, the non-SMTP ACL, and while routing and
12801 delivering.
12802
12803 .vitem &$received_for$&
12804 .vindex "&$received_for$&"
12805 If there is only a single recipient address in an incoming message, this
12806 variable contains that address when the &'Received:'& header line is being
12807 built. The value is copied after recipient rewriting has happened, but before
12808 the &[local_scan()]& function is run.
12809
12810 .vitem &$received_ip_address$&
12811 .vindex "&$received_ip_address$&"
12812 As soon as an Exim server starts processing an incoming TCP/IP connection, this
12813 variable is set to the address of the local IP interface, and &$received_port$&
12814 is set to the local port number. (The remote IP address and port are in
12815 &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_host_port$&.) When testing with &%-bh%&,
12816 the port value is -1 unless it has been set using the &%-oMi%& command line
12817 option.
12818
12819 As well as being useful in ACLs (including the &"connect"& ACL), these variable
12820 could be used, for example, to make the filename for a TLS certificate depend
12821 on which interface and/or port is being used for the incoming connection. The
12822 values of &$received_ip_address$& and &$received_port$& are saved with any
12823 messages that are received, thus making these variables available at delivery
12824 time.
12825 For outbound connections see &$sending_ip_address$&.
12826
12827 .vitem &$received_port$&
12828 .vindex "&$received_port$&"
12829 See &$received_ip_address$&.
12830
12831 .vitem &$received_protocol$&
12832 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
12833 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the name of the
12834 protocol by which it was received. Most of the names used by Exim are defined
12835 by RFCs 821, 2821, and 3848. They start with &"smtp"& (the client used HELO) or
12836 &"esmtp"& (the client used EHLO). This can be followed by &"s"& for secure
12837 (encrypted) and/or &"a"& for authenticated. Thus, for example, if the protocol
12838 is set to &"esmtpsa"&, the message was received over an encrypted SMTP
12839 connection and the client was successfully authenticated.
12840
12841 Exim uses the protocol name &"smtps"& for the case when encryption is
12842 automatically set up on connection without the use of STARTTLS (see
12843 &%tls_on_connect_ports%&), and the client uses HELO to initiate the
12844 encrypted SMTP session. The name &"smtps"& is also used for the rare situation
12845 where the client initially uses EHLO, sets up an encrypted connection using
12846 STARTTLS, and then uses HELO afterwards.
12847
12848 The &%-oMr%& option provides a way of specifying a custom protocol name for
12849 messages that are injected locally by trusted callers. This is commonly used to
12850 identify messages that are being re-injected after some kind of scanning.
12851
12852 .vitem &$received_time$&
12853 .vindex "&$received_time$&"
12854 This variable contains the date and time when the current message was received,
12855 as a number of seconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
12856
12857 .vitem &$recipient_data$&
12858 .vindex "&$recipient_data$&"
12859 This variable is set after an indexing lookup success in an ACL &%recipients%&
12860 condition. It contains the data from the lookup, and the value remains set
12861 until the next &%recipients%& test. Thus, you can do things like this:
12862 .display
12863 &`require recipients = cdb*@;/some/file`&
12864 &`deny `&&'some further test involving'& &`$recipient_data`&
12865 .endd
12866 &*Warning*&: This variable is set only when a lookup is used as an indexing
12867 method in the address list, using the semicolon syntax as in the example above.
12868 The variable is not set for a lookup that is used as part of the string
12869 expansion that all such lists undergo before being interpreted.
12870
12871 .vitem &$recipient_verify_failure$&
12872 .vindex "&$recipient_verify_failure$&"
12873 In an ACL, when a recipient verification fails, this variable contains
12874 information about the failure. It is set to one of the following words:
12875
12876 .ilist
12877 &"qualify"&: The address was unqualified (no domain), and the message
12878 was neither local nor came from an exempted host.
12879
12880 .next
12881 &"route"&: Routing failed.
12882
12883 .next
12884 &"mail"&: Routing succeeded, and a callout was attempted; rejection occurred at
12885 or before the MAIL command (that is, on initial connection, HELO, or
12886 MAIL).
12887
12888 .next
12889 &"recipient"&: The RCPT command in a callout was rejected.
12890 .next
12891
12892 &"postmaster"&: The postmaster check in a callout was rejected.
12893 .endlist
12894
12895 The main use of this variable is expected to be to distinguish between
12896 rejections of MAIL and rejections of RCPT.
12897
12898 .vitem &$recipients$&
12899 .vindex "&$recipients$&"
12900 This variable contains a list of envelope recipients for a message. A comma and
12901 a space separate the addresses in the replacement text. However, the variable
12902 is not generally available, to prevent exposure of Bcc recipients in
12903 unprivileged users' filter files. You can use &$recipients$& only in these
12904 cases:
12905
12906 .olist
12907 In a system filter file.
12908 .next
12909 In the ACLs associated with the DATA command and with non-SMTP messages, that
12910 is, the ACLs defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&, &%acl_smtp_data%&,
12911 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_not_smtp_start%&, &%acl_not_smtp%&, and
12912 &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&.
12913 .next
12914 From within a &[local_scan()]& function.
12915 .endlist
12916
12917
12918 .vitem &$recipients_count$&
12919 .vindex "&$recipients_count$&"
12920 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the number of
12921 envelope recipients that came with the message. Duplicates are not excluded
12922 from the count. While a message is being received over SMTP, the number
12923 increases for each accepted recipient. It can be referenced in an ACL.
12924
12925
12926 .vitem &$regex_match_string$&
12927 .vindex "&$regex_match_string$&"
12928 This variable is set to contain the matching regular expression after a
12929 &%regex%& ACL condition has matched (see section &<<SECTscanregex>>&).
12930
12931 .vitem "&$regex1$&, &$regex2$&, etc"
12932 .cindex "regex submatch variables (&$1regex$& &$2regex$& etc)"
12933 When a &%regex%& or &%mime_regex%& ACL condition succeeds,
12934 these variables contain the
12935 captured substrings identified by the regular expression.
12936
12937
12938 .vitem &$reply_address$&
12939 .vindex "&$reply_address$&"
12940 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the contents of the
12941 &'Reply-To:'& header line if one exists and it is not empty, or otherwise the
12942 contents of the &'From:'& header line. Apart from the removal of leading
12943 white space, the value is not processed in any way. In particular, no RFC 2047
12944 decoding or character code translation takes place.
12945
12946 .vitem &$return_path$&
12947 .vindex "&$return_path$&"
12948 When a message is being delivered, this variable contains the return path &--
12949 the sender field that will be sent as part of the envelope. It is not enclosed
12950 in <> characters. At the start of routing an address, &$return_path$& has the
12951 same value as &$sender_address$&, but if, for example, an incoming message to a
12952 mailing list has been expanded by a router which specifies a different address
12953 for bounce messages, &$return_path$& subsequently contains the new bounce
12954 address, whereas &$sender_address$& always contains the original sender address
12955 that was received with the message. In other words, &$sender_address$& contains
12956 the incoming envelope sender, and &$return_path$& contains the outgoing
12957 envelope sender.
12958
12959 .vitem &$return_size_limit$&
12960 .vindex "&$return_size_limit$&"
12961 This is an obsolete name for &$bounce_return_size_limit$&.
12962
12963 .vitem &$router_name$&
12964 .cindex "router" "name"
12965 .cindex "name" "of router"
12966 .vindex "&$router_name$&"
12967 During the running of a router this variable contains its name.
12968
12969 .vitem &$runrc$&
12970 .cindex "return code" "from &%run%& expansion"
12971 .vindex "&$runrc$&"
12972 This variable contains the return code from a command that is run by the
12973 &%${run...}%& expansion item. &*Warning*&: In a router or transport, you cannot
12974 assume the order in which option values are expanded, except for those
12975 preconditions whose order of testing is documented. Therefore, you cannot
12976 reliably expect to set &$runrc$& by the expansion of one option, and use it in
12977 another.
12978
12979 .vitem &$self_hostname$&
12980 .oindex "&%self%&" "value of host name"
12981 .vindex "&$self_hostname$&"
12982 When an address is routed to a supposedly remote host that turns out to be the
12983 local host, what happens is controlled by the &%self%& generic router option.
12984 One of its values causes the address to be passed to another router. When this
12985 happens, &$self_hostname$& is set to the name of the local host that the
12986 original router encountered. In other circumstances its contents are null.
12987
12988 .vitem &$sender_address$&
12989 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
12990 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the sender's address
12991 that was received in the message's envelope. The case of letters in the address
12992 is retained, in both the local part and the domain. For bounce messages, the
12993 value of this variable is the empty string. See also &$return_path$&.
12994
12995 .vitem &$sender_address_data$&
12996 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
12997 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
12998 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify a
12999 sender address, the final value is preserved in &$sender_address_data$&, to
13000 distinguish it from data from a recipient address. The value does not persist
13001 after the end of the current ACL statement. If you want to preserve it for
13002 longer, you can save it in an ACL variable.
13003
13004 .vitem &$sender_address_domain$&
13005 .vindex "&$sender_address_domain$&"
13006 The domain portion of &$sender_address$&.
13007
13008 .vitem &$sender_address_local_part$&
13009 .vindex "&$sender_address_local_part$&"
13010 The local part portion of &$sender_address$&.
13011
13012 .vitem &$sender_data$&
13013 .vindex "&$sender_data$&"
13014 This variable is set after a lookup success in an ACL &%senders%& condition or
13015 in a router &%senders%& option. It contains the data from the lookup, and the
13016 value remains set until the next &%senders%& test. Thus, you can do things like
13017 this:
13018 .display
13019 &`require senders = cdb*@;/some/file`&
13020 &`deny `&&'some further test involving'& &`$sender_data`&
13021 .endd
13022 &*Warning*&: This variable is set only when a lookup is used as an indexing
13023 method in the address list, using the semicolon syntax as in the example above.
13024 The variable is not set for a lookup that is used as part of the string
13025 expansion that all such lists undergo before being interpreted.
13026
13027 .vitem &$sender_fullhost$&
13028 .vindex "&$sender_fullhost$&"
13029 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the host
13030 name and IP address in a single string. It ends with the IP address in square
13031 brackets, followed by a colon and a port number if the logging of ports is
13032 enabled. The format of the rest of the string depends on whether the host
13033 issued a HELO or EHLO SMTP command, and whether the host name was verified by
13034 looking up its IP address. (Looking up the IP address can be forced by the
13035 &%host_lookup%& option, independent of verification.) A plain host name at the
13036 start of the string is a verified host name; if this is not present,
13037 verification either failed or was not requested. A host name in parentheses is
13038 the argument of a HELO or EHLO command. This is omitted if it is identical to
13039 the verified host name or to the host's IP address in square brackets.
13040
13041 .vitem &$sender_helo_dnssec$&
13042 .vindex "&$sender_helo_dnssec$&"
13043 This boolean variable is true if a successful HELO verification was
13044 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
13045 done using DNS information the resolver library stated was authenticated data.
13046
13047 .vitem &$sender_helo_name$&
13048 .vindex "&$sender_helo_name$&"
13049 When a message is received from a remote host that has issued a HELO or EHLO
13050 command, the argument of that command is placed in this variable. It is also
13051 set if HELO or EHLO is used when a message is received using SMTP locally via
13052 the &%-bs%& or &%-bS%& options.
13053
13054 .vitem &$sender_host_address$&
13055 .vindex "&$sender_host_address$&"
13056 When a message is received from a remote host using SMTP,
13057 this variable contains that
13058 host's IP address. For locally non-SMTP submitted messages, it is empty.
13059
13060 .vitem &$sender_host_authenticated$&
13061 .vindex "&$sender_host_authenticated$&"
13062 This variable contains the name (not the public name) of the authenticator
13063 driver that successfully authenticated the client from which the message was
13064 received. It is empty if there was no successful authentication. See also
13065 &$authenticated_id$&.
13066
13067 .vitem &$sender_host_dnssec$&
13068 .vindex "&$sender_host_dnssec$&"
13069 If an attempt to populate &$sender_host_name$& has been made
13070 (by reference, &%hosts_lookup%& or
13071 otherwise) then this boolean will have been set true if, and only if, the
13072 resolver library states that both
13073 the reverse and forward DNS were authenticated data. At all
13074 other times, this variable is false.
13075
13076 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
13077 It is likely that you will need to coerce DNSSEC support on in the resolver
13078 library, by setting:
13079 .code
13080 dns_dnssec_ok = 1
13081 .endd
13082
13083 Exim does not perform DNSSEC validation itself, instead leaving that to a
13084 validating resolver (e.g. unbound, or bind with suitable configuration).
13085
13086 If you have changed &%host_lookup_order%& so that &`bydns`& is not the first
13087 mechanism in the list, then this variable will be false.
13088
13089 This requires that your system resolver library support EDNS0 (and that
13090 DNSSEC flags exist in the system headers). If the resolver silently drops
13091 all EDNS0 options, then this will have no effect. OpenBSD's asr resolver
13092 is known to currently ignore EDNS0, documented in CAVEATS of asr_run(3).
13093
13094
13095 .vitem &$sender_host_name$&
13096 .vindex "&$sender_host_name$&"
13097 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the
13098 host's name as obtained by looking up its IP address. For messages received by
13099 other means, this variable is empty.
13100
13101 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
13102 If the host name has not previously been looked up, a reference to
13103 &$sender_host_name$& triggers a lookup (for messages from remote hosts).
13104 A looked up name is accepted only if it leads back to the original IP address
13105 via a forward lookup. If either the reverse or the forward lookup fails to find
13106 any data, or if the forward lookup does not yield the original IP address,
13107 &$sender_host_name$& remains empty, and &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&.
13108
13109 .vindex "&$host_lookup_deferred$&"
13110 However, if either of the lookups cannot be completed (for example, there is a
13111 DNS timeout), &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to &"1"&, and
13112 &$host_lookup_failed$& remains set to &"0"&.
13113
13114 Once &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&, Exim does not try to look up the
13115 host name again if there is a subsequent reference to &$sender_host_name$&
13116 in the same Exim process, but it does try again if &$host_lookup_deferred$&
13117 is set to &"1"&.
13118
13119 Exim does not automatically look up every calling host's name. If you want
13120 maximum efficiency, you should arrange your configuration so that it avoids
13121 these lookups altogether. The lookup happens only if one or more of the
13122 following are true:
13123
13124 .ilist
13125 A string containing &$sender_host_name$& is expanded.
13126 .next
13127 The calling host matches the list in &%host_lookup%&. In the default
13128 configuration, this option is set to *, so it must be changed if lookups are
13129 to be avoided. (In the code, the default for &%host_lookup%& is unset.)
13130 .next
13131 Exim needs the host name in order to test an item in a host list. The items
13132 that require this are described in sections &<<SECThoslispatnam>>& and
13133 &<<SECThoslispatnamsk>>&.
13134 .next
13135 The calling host matches &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& or &%helo_verify_hosts%&.
13136 In this case, the host name is required to compare with the name quoted in any
13137 EHLO or HELO commands that the client issues.
13138 .next
13139 The remote host issues a EHLO or HELO command that quotes one of the
13140 domains in &%helo_lookup_domains%&. The default value of this option is
13141 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
13142 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
13143 .code
13144 helo_lookup_domains = @ : @[]
13145 .endd
13146 which causes a lookup if a remote host (incorrectly) gives the server's name or
13147 IP address in an EHLO or HELO command.
13148 .endlist
13149
13150
13151 .vitem &$sender_host_port$&
13152 .vindex "&$sender_host_port$&"
13153 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the port
13154 number that was used on the remote host.
13155
13156 .vitem &$sender_ident$&
13157 .vindex "&$sender_ident$&"
13158 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the
13159 identification received in response to an RFC 1413 request. When a message has
13160 been received locally, this variable contains the login name of the user that
13161 called Exim.
13162
13163 .vitem &$sender_rate_$&&'xxx'&
13164 A number of variables whose names begin &$sender_rate_$& are set as part of the
13165 &%ratelimit%& ACL condition. Details are given in section
13166 &<<SECTratelimiting>>&.
13167
13168 .vitem &$sender_rcvhost$&
13169 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
13170 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
13171 .vindex "&$sender_rcvhost$&"
13172 This is provided specifically for use in &'Received:'& headers. It starts with
13173 either the verified host name (as obtained from a reverse DNS lookup) or, if
13174 there is no verified host name, the IP address in square brackets. After that
13175 there may be text in parentheses. When the first item is a verified host name,
13176 the first thing in the parentheses is the IP address in square brackets,
13177 followed by a colon and a port number if port logging is enabled. When the
13178 first item is an IP address, the port is recorded as &"port=&'xxxx'&"& inside
13179 the parentheses.
13180
13181 There may also be items of the form &"helo=&'xxxx'&"& if HELO or EHLO
13182 was used and its argument was not identical to the real host name or IP
13183 address, and &"ident=&'xxxx'&"& if an RFC 1413 ident string is available. If
13184 all three items are present in the parentheses, a newline and tab are inserted
13185 into the string, to improve the formatting of the &'Received:'& header.
13186
13187 .vitem &$sender_verify_failure$&
13188 .vindex "&$sender_verify_failure$&"
13189 In an ACL, when a sender verification fails, this variable contains information
13190 about the failure. The details are the same as for
13191 &$recipient_verify_failure$&.
13192
13193 .vitem &$sending_ip_address$&
13194 .vindex "&$sending_ip_address$&"
13195 This variable is set whenever an outgoing SMTP connection to another host has
13196 been set up. It contains the IP address of the local interface that is being
13197 used. This is useful if a host that has more than one IP address wants to take
13198 on different personalities depending on which one is being used. For incoming
13199 connections, see &$received_ip_address$&.
13200
13201 .vitem &$sending_port$&
13202 .vindex "&$sending_port$&"
13203 This variable is set whenever an outgoing SMTP connection to another host has
13204 been set up. It contains the local port that is being used. For incoming
13205 connections, see &$received_port$&.
13206
13207 .vitem &$smtp_active_hostname$&
13208 .vindex "&$smtp_active_hostname$&"
13209 During an incoming SMTP session, this variable contains the value of the active
13210 host name, as specified by the &%smtp_active_hostname%& option. The value of
13211 &$smtp_active_hostname$& is saved with any message that is received, so its
13212 value can be consulted during routing and delivery.
13213
13214 .vitem &$smtp_command$&
13215 .vindex "&$smtp_command$&"
13216 During the processing of an incoming SMTP command, this variable contains the
13217 entire command. This makes it possible to distinguish between HELO and EHLO in
13218 the HELO ACL, and also to distinguish between commands such as these:
13219 .code
13220 MAIL FROM:<>
13221 MAIL FROM: <>
13222 .endd
13223 For a MAIL command, extra parameters such as SIZE can be inspected. For a RCPT
13224 command, the address in &$smtp_command$& is the original address before any
13225 rewriting, whereas the values in &$local_part$& and &$domain$& are taken from
13226 the address after SMTP-time rewriting.
13227
13228 .vitem &$smtp_command_argument$&
13229 .cindex "SMTP" "command, argument for"
13230 .vindex "&$smtp_command_argument$&"
13231 While an ACL is running to check an SMTP command, this variable contains the
13232 argument, that is, the text that follows the command name, with leading white
13233 space removed. Following the introduction of &$smtp_command$&, this variable is
13234 somewhat redundant, but is retained for backwards compatibility.
13235
13236 .vitem &$smtp_command_history$&
13237 .cindex SMTP "command history"
13238 .vindex "&$smtp_command_history$&"
13239 A comma-separated list (with no whitespace) of the most-recent SMTP commands
13240 received, in time-order left to right. Only a limited number of commands
13241 are remembered.
13242
13243 .vitem &$smtp_count_at_connection_start$&
13244 .vindex "&$smtp_count_at_connection_start$&"
13245 This variable is set greater than zero only in processes spawned by the Exim
13246 daemon for handling incoming SMTP connections. The name is deliberately long,
13247 in order to emphasize what the contents are. When the daemon accepts a new
13248 connection, it increments this variable. A copy of the variable is passed to
13249 the child process that handles the connection, but its value is fixed, and
13250 never changes. It is only an approximation of how many incoming connections
13251 there actually are, because many other connections may come and go while a
13252 single connection is being processed. When a child process terminates, the
13253 daemon decrements its copy of the variable.
13254
13255 .vitem "&$sn0$& &-- &$sn9$&"
13256 These variables are copies of the values of the &$n0$& &-- &$n9$& accumulators
13257 that were current at the end of the system filter file. This allows a system
13258 filter file to set values that can be tested in users' filter files. For
13259 example, a system filter could set a value indicating how likely it is that a
13260 message is junk mail.
13261
13262 .vitem &$spam_$&&'xxx'&
13263 A number of variables whose names start with &$spam$& are available when Exim
13264 is compiled with the content-scanning extension. For details, see section
13265 &<<SECTscanspamass>>&.
13266
13267 .vitem &$spf_header_comment$& &&&
13268 &$spf_received$& &&&
13269 &$spf_result$& &&&
13270 &$spf_result_guessed$& &&&
13271 &$spf_smtp_comment$&
13272 These variables are only available if Exim is built with SPF support.
13273 For details see section &<<SECSPF>>&.
13274
13275 .vitem &$spool_directory$&
13276 .vindex "&$spool_directory$&"
13277 The name of Exim's spool directory.
13278
13279 .vitem &$spool_inodes$&
13280 .vindex "&$spool_inodes$&"
13281 The number of free inodes in the disk partition where Exim's spool files are
13282 being written. The value is recalculated whenever the variable is referenced.
13283 If the relevant file system does not have the concept of inodes, the value of
13284 is -1. See also the &%check_spool_inodes%& option.
13285
13286 .vitem &$spool_space$&
13287 .vindex "&$spool_space$&"
13288 The amount of free space (as a number of kilobytes) in the disk partition where
13289 Exim's spool files are being written. The value is recalculated whenever the
13290 variable is referenced. If the operating system does not have the ability to
13291 find the amount of free space (only true for experimental systems), the space
13292 value is -1. For example, to check in an ACL that there is at least 50
13293 megabytes free on the spool, you could write:
13294 .code
13295 condition = ${if > {$spool_space}{50000}}
13296 .endd
13297 See also the &%check_spool_space%& option.
13298
13299
13300 .vitem &$thisaddress$&
13301 .vindex "&$thisaddress$&"
13302 This variable is set only during the processing of the &%foranyaddress%&
13303 command in a filter file. Its use is explained in the description of that
13304 command, which can be found in the separate document entitled &'Exim's
13305 interfaces to mail filtering'&.
13306
13307 .vitem &$tls_in_bits$&
13308 .vindex "&$tls_in_bits$&"
13309 Contains an approximation of the TLS cipher's bit-strength
13310 on the inbound connection; the meaning of
13311 this depends upon the TLS implementation used.
13312 If TLS has not been negotiated, the value will be 0.
13313 The value of this is automatically fed into the Cyrus SASL authenticator
13314 when acting as a server, to specify the "external SSF" (a SASL term).
13315
13316 The deprecated &$tls_bits$& variable refers to the inbound side
13317 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
13318 the outbound.
13319
13320 .vitem &$tls_out_bits$&
13321 .vindex "&$tls_out_bits$&"
13322 Contains an approximation of the TLS cipher's bit-strength
13323 on an outbound SMTP connection; the meaning of
13324 this depends upon the TLS implementation used.
13325 If TLS has not been negotiated, the value will be 0.
13326
13327 .vitem &$tls_in_ourcert$&
13328 .vindex "&$tls_in_ourcert$&"
13329 .cindex certificate variables
13330 This variable refers to the certificate presented to the peer of an
13331 inbound connection when the message was received.
13332 It is only useful as the argument of a
13333 &%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
13334 or a &%def%& condition.
13335
13336 &*Note*&: Under versions of OpenSSL preceding 1.1.1,
13337 when a list of more than one
13338 file is used for &%tls_certificate%&, this variable is not reliable.
13339
13340 .vitem &$tls_in_peercert$&
13341 .vindex "&$tls_in_peercert$&"
13342 This variable refers to the certificate presented by the peer of an
13343 inbound connection when the message was received.
13344 It is only useful as the argument of a
13345 &%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
13346 or a &%def%& condition.
13347 If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
13348 which is not the leaf.
13349
13350 .vitem &$tls_out_ourcert$&
13351 .vindex "&$tls_out_ourcert$&"
13352 This variable refers to the certificate presented to the peer of an
13353 outbound connection. It is only useful as the argument of a
13354 &%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
13355 or a &%def%& condition.
13356
13357 .vitem &$tls_out_peercert$&
13358 .vindex "&$tls_out_peercert$&"
13359 This variable refers to the certificate presented by the peer of an
13360 outbound connection. It is only useful as the argument of a
13361 &%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
13362 or a &%def%& condition.
13363 If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
13364 which is not the leaf.
13365
13366 .vitem &$tls_in_certificate_verified$&
13367 .vindex "&$tls_in_certificate_verified$&"
13368 This variable is set to &"1"& if a TLS certificate was verified when the
13369 message was received, and &"0"& otherwise.
13370
13371 The deprecated &$tls_certificate_verified$& variable refers to the inbound side
13372 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
13373 the outbound.
13374
13375 .vitem &$tls_out_certificate_verified$&
13376 .vindex "&$tls_out_certificate_verified$&"
13377 This variable is set to &"1"& if a TLS certificate was verified when an
13378 outbound SMTP connection was made,
13379 and &"0"& otherwise.
13380
13381 .vitem &$tls_in_cipher$&
13382 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
13383 .vindex "&$tls_cipher$&"
13384 When a message is received from a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
13385 connection, this variable is set to the cipher suite that was negotiated, for
13386 example DES-CBC3-SHA. In other circumstances, in particular, for message
13387 received over unencrypted connections, the variable is empty. Testing
13388 &$tls_in_cipher$& for emptiness is one way of distinguishing between encrypted and
13389 non-encrypted connections during ACL processing.
13390
13391 The deprecated &$tls_cipher$& variable is the same as &$tls_in_cipher$& during message reception,
13392 but in the context of an outward SMTP delivery taking place via the &(smtp)& transport
13393 becomes the same as &$tls_out_cipher$&.
13394
13395 .new
13396 .vitem &$tls_in_cipher_std$&
13397 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher_std$&"
13398 As above, but returning the RFC standard name for the cipher suite.
13399 .wen
13400
13401 .vitem &$tls_out_cipher$&
13402 .vindex "&$tls_out_cipher$&"
13403 This variable is
13404 cleared before any outgoing SMTP connection is made,
13405 and then set to the outgoing cipher suite if one is negotiated. See chapter
13406 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS support and chapter &<<CHAPsmtptrans>>& for
13407 details of the &(smtp)& transport.
13408
13409 ,new
13410 .vitem &$tls_out_cipher_std$&
13411 .vindex "&$tls_out_cipher_std$&"
13412 As above, but returning the RFC standard name for the cipher suite.
13413 .wen
13414
13415 .vitem &$tls_out_dane$&
13416 .vindex &$tls_out_dane$&
13417 DANE active status. See section &<<SECDANE>>&.
13418
13419 .vitem &$tls_in_ocsp$&
13420 .vindex "&$tls_in_ocsp$&"
13421 When a message is received from a remote client connection
13422 the result of any OCSP request from the client is encoded in this variable:
13423 .code
13424 0 OCSP proof was not requested (default value)
13425 1 No response to request
13426 2 Response not verified
13427 3 Verification failed
13428 4 Verification succeeded
13429 .endd
13430
13431 .vitem &$tls_out_ocsp$&
13432 .vindex "&$tls_out_ocsp$&"
13433 When a message is sent to a remote host connection
13434 the result of any OCSP request made is encoded in this variable.
13435 See &$tls_in_ocsp$& for values.
13436
13437 .vitem &$tls_in_peerdn$&
13438 .vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
13439 .vindex "&$tls_peerdn$&"
13440 .cindex certificate "extracting fields"
13441 When a message is received from a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
13442 connection, and Exim is configured to request a certificate from the client,
13443 the value of the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the
13444 &$tls_in_peerdn$& during subsequent processing.
13445 If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
13446 which is not the leaf.
13447
13448 The deprecated &$tls_peerdn$& variable refers to the inbound side
13449 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
13450 the outbound.
13451
13452 .vitem &$tls_out_peerdn$&
13453 .vindex "&$tls_out_peerdn$&"
13454 When a message is being delivered to a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
13455 connection, and Exim is configured to request a certificate from the server,
13456 the value of the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the
13457 &$tls_out_peerdn$& during subsequent processing.
13458 If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
13459 which is not the leaf.
13460
13461 .vitem &$tls_in_sni$&
13462 .vindex "&$tls_in_sni$&"
13463 .vindex "&$tls_sni$&"
13464 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
13465 When a TLS session is being established, if the client sends the Server
13466 Name Indication extension, the value will be placed in this variable.
13467 If the variable appears in &%tls_certificate%& then this option and
13468 some others, described in &<<SECTtlssni>>&,
13469 will be re-expanded early in the TLS session, to permit
13470 a different certificate to be presented (and optionally a different key to be
13471 used) to the client, based upon the value of the SNI extension.
13472
13473 The deprecated &$tls_sni$& variable refers to the inbound side
13474 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
13475 the outbound.
13476
13477 .vitem &$tls_out_sni$&
13478 .vindex "&$tls_out_sni$&"
13479 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
13480 During outbound
13481 SMTP deliveries, this variable reflects the value of the &%tls_sni%& option on
13482 the transport.
13483
13484 .vitem &$tls_out_tlsa_usage$&
13485 .vindex &$tls_out_tlsa_usage$&
13486 Bitfield of TLSA record types found. See section &<<SECDANE>>&.
13487
13488 .vitem &$tod_bsdinbox$&
13489 .vindex "&$tod_bsdinbox$&"
13490 The time of day and the date, in the format required for BSD-style mailbox
13491 files, for example: Thu Oct 17 17:14:09 1995.
13492
13493 .vitem &$tod_epoch$&
13494 .vindex "&$tod_epoch$&"
13495 The time and date as a number of seconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
13496
13497 .vitem &$tod_epoch_l$&
13498 .vindex "&$tod_epoch_l$&"
13499 The time and date as a number of microseconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
13500
13501 .vitem &$tod_full$&
13502 .vindex "&$tod_full$&"
13503 A full version of the time and date, for example: Wed, 16 Oct 1995 09:51:40
13504 +0100. The timezone is always given as a numerical offset from UTC, with
13505 positive values used for timezones that are ahead (east) of UTC, and negative
13506 values for those that are behind (west).
13507
13508 .vitem &$tod_log$&
13509 .vindex "&$tod_log$&"
13510 The time and date in the format used for writing Exim's log files, for example:
13511 1995-10-12 15:32:29, but without a timezone.
13512
13513 .vitem &$tod_logfile$&
13514 .vindex "&$tod_logfile$&"
13515 This variable contains the date in the format yyyymmdd. This is the format that
13516 is used for datestamping log files when &%log_file_path%& contains the &`%D`&
13517 flag.
13518
13519 .vitem &$tod_zone$&
13520 .vindex "&$tod_zone$&"
13521 This variable contains the numerical value of the local timezone, for example:
13522 -0500.
13523
13524 .vitem &$tod_zulu$&
13525 .vindex "&$tod_zulu$&"
13526 This variable contains the UTC date and time in &"Zulu"& format, as specified
13527 by ISO 8601, for example: 20030221154023Z.
13528
13529 .vitem &$transport_name$&
13530 .cindex "transport" "name"
13531 .cindex "name" "of transport"
13532 .vindex "&$transport_name$&"
13533 During the running of a transport, this variable contains its name.
13534
13535 .vitem &$value$&
13536 .vindex "&$value$&"
13537 This variable contains the result of an expansion lookup, extraction operation,
13538 or external command, as described above. It is also used during a
13539 &*reduce*& expansion.
13540
13541 .vitem &$verify_mode$&
13542 .vindex "&$verify_mode$&"
13543 While a router or transport is being run in verify mode or for cutthrough delivery,
13544 contains "S" for sender-verification or "R" for recipient-verification.
13545 Otherwise, empty.
13546
13547 .vitem &$version_number$&
13548 .vindex "&$version_number$&"
13549 The version number of Exim. Same as &$exim_version$&, may be overridden
13550 by the &%exim_version%& main config option.
13551
13552 .vitem &$warn_message_delay$&
13553 .vindex "&$warn_message_delay$&"
13554 This variable is set only during the creation of a message warning about a
13555 delivery delay. Details of its use are explained in section &<<SECTcustwarn>>&.
13556
13557 .vitem &$warn_message_recipients$&
13558 .vindex "&$warn_message_recipients$&"
13559 This variable is set only during the creation of a message warning about a
13560 delivery delay. Details of its use are explained in section &<<SECTcustwarn>>&.
13561 .endlist
13562 .ecindex IIDstrexp
13563
13564
13565
13566 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13567 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13568
13569 .chapter "Embedded Perl" "CHAPperl"
13570 .scindex IIDperl "Perl" "calling from Exim"
13571 Exim can be built to include an embedded Perl interpreter. When this is done,
13572 Perl subroutines can be called as part of the string expansion process. To make
13573 use of the Perl support, you need version 5.004 or later of Perl installed on
13574 your system. To include the embedded interpreter in the Exim binary, include
13575 the line
13576 .code
13577 EXIM_PERL = perl.o
13578 .endd
13579 in your &_Local/Makefile_& and then build Exim in the normal way.
13580
13581
13582 .section "Setting up so Perl can be used" "SECID85"
13583 .oindex "&%perl_startup%&"
13584 Access to Perl subroutines is via a global configuration option called
13585 &%perl_startup%& and an expansion string operator &%${perl ...}%&. If there is
13586 no &%perl_startup%& option in the Exim configuration file then no Perl
13587 interpreter is started and there is almost no overhead for Exim (since none of
13588 the Perl library will be paged in unless used). If there is a &%perl_startup%&
13589 option then the associated value is taken to be Perl code which is executed in
13590 a newly created Perl interpreter.
13591
13592 The value of &%perl_startup%& is not expanded in the Exim sense, so you do not
13593 need backslashes before any characters to escape special meanings. The option
13594 should usually be something like
13595 .code
13596 perl_startup = do '/etc/exim.pl'
13597 .endd
13598 where &_/etc/exim.pl_& is Perl code which defines any subroutines you want to
13599 use from Exim. Exim can be configured either to start up a Perl interpreter as
13600 soon as it is entered, or to wait until the first time it is needed. Starting
13601 the interpreter at the beginning ensures that it is done while Exim still has
13602 its setuid privilege, but can impose an unnecessary overhead if Perl is not in
13603 fact used in a particular run. Also, note that this does not mean that Exim is
13604 necessarily running as root when Perl is called at a later time. By default,
13605 the interpreter is started only when it is needed, but this can be changed in
13606 two ways:
13607
13608 .ilist
13609 .oindex "&%perl_at_start%&"
13610 Setting &%perl_at_start%& (a boolean option) in the configuration requests
13611 a startup when Exim is entered.
13612 .next
13613 The command line option &%-ps%& also requests a startup when Exim is entered,
13614 overriding the setting of &%perl_at_start%&.
13615 .endlist
13616
13617 There is also a command line option &%-pd%& (for delay) which suppresses the
13618 initial startup, even if &%perl_at_start%& is set.
13619
13620 .ilist
13621 .oindex "&%perl_taintmode%&"
13622 .cindex "Perl" "taintmode"
13623 To provide more security executing Perl code via the embedded Perl
13624 interpreter, the &%perl_taintmode%& option can be set. This enables the
13625 taint mode of the Perl interpreter. You are encouraged to set this
13626 option to a true value. To avoid breaking existing installations, it
13627 defaults to false.
13628
13629
13630 .section "Calling Perl subroutines" "SECID86"
13631 When the configuration file includes a &%perl_startup%& option you can make use
13632 of the string expansion item to call the Perl subroutines that are defined
13633 by the &%perl_startup%& code. The operator is used in any of the following
13634 forms:
13635 .code
13636 ${perl{foo}}
13637 ${perl{foo}{argument}}
13638 ${perl{foo}{argument1}{argument2} ... }
13639 .endd
13640 which calls the subroutine &%foo%& with the given arguments. A maximum of eight
13641 arguments may be passed. Passing more than this results in an expansion failure
13642 with an error message of the form
13643 .code
13644 Too many arguments passed to Perl subroutine "foo" (max is 8)
13645 .endd
13646 The return value of the Perl subroutine is evaluated in a scalar context before
13647 it is passed back to Exim to be inserted into the expanded string. If the
13648 return value is &'undef'&, the expansion is forced to fail in the same way as
13649 an explicit &"fail"& on an &%if%& or &%lookup%& item. If the subroutine aborts
13650 by obeying Perl's &%die%& function, the expansion fails with the error message
13651 that was passed to &%die%&.
13652
13653
13654 .section "Calling Exim functions from Perl" "SECID87"
13655 Within any Perl code called from Exim, the function &'Exim::expand_string()'&
13656 is available to call back into Exim's string expansion function. For example,
13657 the Perl code
13658 .code
13659 my $lp = Exim::expand_string('$local_part');
13660 .endd
13661 makes the current Exim &$local_part$& available in the Perl variable &$lp$&.
13662 Note those are single quotes and not double quotes to protect against
13663 &$local_part$& being interpolated as a Perl variable.
13664
13665 If the string expansion is forced to fail by a &"fail"& item, the result of
13666 &'Exim::expand_string()'& is &%undef%&. If there is a syntax error in the
13667 expansion string, the Perl call from the original expansion string fails with
13668 an appropriate error message, in the same way as if &%die%& were used.
13669
13670 .cindex "debugging" "from embedded Perl"
13671 .cindex "log" "writing from embedded Perl"
13672 Two other Exim functions are available for use from within Perl code.
13673 &'Exim::debug_write()'& writes a string to the standard error stream if Exim's
13674 debugging is enabled. If you want a newline at the end, you must supply it.
13675 &'Exim::log_write()'& writes a string to Exim's main log, adding a leading
13676 timestamp. In this case, you should not supply a terminating newline.
13677
13678
13679 .section "Use of standard output and error by Perl" "SECID88"
13680 .cindex "Perl" "standard output and error"
13681 You should not write to the standard error or output streams from within your
13682 Perl code, as it is not defined how these are set up. In versions of Exim
13683 before 4.50, it is possible for the standard output or error to refer to the
13684 SMTP connection during message reception via the daemon. Writing to this stream
13685 is certain to cause chaos. From Exim 4.50 onwards, the standard output and
13686 error streams are connected to &_/dev/null_& in the daemon. The chaos is
13687 avoided, but the output is lost.
13688
13689 .cindex "Perl" "use of &%warn%&"
13690 The Perl &%warn%& statement writes to the standard error stream by default.
13691 Calls to &%warn%& may be embedded in Perl modules that you use, but over which
13692 you have no control. When Exim starts up the Perl interpreter, it arranges for
13693 output from the &%warn%& statement to be written to the Exim main log. You can
13694 change this by including appropriate Perl magic somewhere in your Perl code.
13695 For example, to discard &%warn%& output completely, you need this:
13696 .code
13697 $SIG{__WARN__} = sub { };
13698 .endd
13699 Whenever a &%warn%& is obeyed, the anonymous subroutine is called. In this
13700 example, the code for the subroutine is empty, so it does nothing, but you can
13701 include any Perl code that you like. The text of the &%warn%& message is passed
13702 as the first subroutine argument.
13703 .ecindex IIDperl
13704
13705
13706 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13707 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13708
13709 .chapter "Starting the daemon and the use of network interfaces" &&&
13710 "CHAPinterfaces" &&&
13711 "Starting the daemon"
13712 .cindex "daemon" "starting"
13713 .cindex "interface" "listening"
13714 .cindex "network interface"
13715 .cindex "interface" "network"
13716 .cindex "IP address" "for listening"
13717 .cindex "daemon" "listening IP addresses"
13718 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening interfaces"
13719 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
13720 A host that is connected to a TCP/IP network may have one or more physical
13721 hardware network interfaces. Each of these interfaces may be configured as one
13722 or more &"logical"& interfaces, which are the entities that a program actually
13723 works with. Each of these logical interfaces is associated with an IP address.
13724 In addition, TCP/IP software supports &"loopback"& interfaces (127.0.0.1 in
13725 IPv4 and ::1 in IPv6), which do not use any physical hardware. Exim requires
13726 knowledge about the host's interfaces for use in three different circumstances:
13727
13728 .olist
13729 When a listening daemon is started, Exim needs to know which interfaces
13730 and ports to listen on.
13731 .next
13732 When Exim is routing an address, it needs to know which IP addresses
13733 are associated with local interfaces. This is required for the correct
13734 processing of MX lists by removing the local host and others with the
13735 same or higher priority values. Also, Exim needs to detect cases
13736 when an address is routed to an IP address that in fact belongs to the
13737 local host. Unless the &%self%& router option or the &%allow_localhost%&
13738 option of the smtp transport is set (as appropriate), this is treated
13739 as an error situation.
13740 .next
13741 When Exim connects to a remote host, it may need to know which interface to use
13742 for the outgoing connection.
13743 .endlist
13744
13745
13746 Exim's default behaviour is likely to be appropriate in the vast majority
13747 of cases. If your host has only one interface, and you want all its IP
13748 addresses to be treated in the same way, and you are using only the
13749 standard SMTP port, you should not need to take any special action. The
13750 rest of this chapter does not apply to you.
13751
13752 In a more complicated situation you may want to listen only on certain
13753 interfaces, or on different ports, and for this reason there are a number of
13754 options that can be used to influence Exim's behaviour. The rest of this
13755 chapter describes how they operate.
13756
13757 When a message is received over TCP/IP, the interface and port that were
13758 actually used are set in &$received_ip_address$& and &$received_port$&.
13759
13760
13761
13762 .section "Starting a listening daemon" "SECID89"
13763 When a listening daemon is started (by means of the &%-bd%& command line
13764 option), the interfaces and ports on which it listens are controlled by the
13765 following options:
13766
13767 .ilist
13768 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& contains a list of default ports
13769 or service names.
13770 (For backward compatibility, this option can also be specified in the singular.)
13771 .next
13772 &%local_interfaces%& contains list of interface IP addresses on which to
13773 listen. Each item may optionally also specify a port.
13774 .endlist
13775
13776 The default list separator in both cases is a colon, but this can be changed as
13777 described in section &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&. When IPv6 addresses are involved,
13778 it is usually best to change the separator to avoid having to double all the
13779 colons. For example:
13780 .code
13781 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; \
13782 192.168.23.65 ; \
13783 ::1 ; \
13784 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061
13785 .endd
13786 There are two different formats for specifying a port along with an IP address
13787 in &%local_interfaces%&:
13788
13789 .olist
13790 The port is added onto the address with a dot separator. For example, to listen
13791 on port 1234 on two different IP addresses:
13792 .code
13793 local_interfaces = <; 192.168.23.65.1234 ; \
13794 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061.1234
13795 .endd
13796 .next
13797 The IP address is enclosed in square brackets, and the port is added
13798 with a colon separator, for example:
13799 .code
13800 local_interfaces = <; [192.168.23.65]:1234 ; \
13801 [3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061]:1234
13802 .endd
13803 .endlist
13804
13805 When a port is not specified, the value of &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is used. The
13806 default setting contains just one port:
13807 .code
13808 daemon_smtp_ports = smtp
13809 .endd
13810 If more than one port is listed, each interface that does not have its own port
13811 specified listens on all of them. Ports that are listed in
13812 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& can be identified either by name (defined in
13813 &_/etc/services_&) or by number. However, when ports are given with individual
13814 IP addresses in &%local_interfaces%&, only numbers (not names) can be used.
13815
13816
13817
13818 .section "Special IP listening addresses" "SECID90"
13819 The addresses 0.0.0.0 and ::0 are treated specially. They are interpreted
13820 as &"all IPv4 interfaces"& and &"all IPv6 interfaces"&, respectively. In each
13821 case, Exim tells the TCP/IP stack to &"listen on all IPv&'x'& interfaces"&
13822 instead of setting up separate listening sockets for each interface. The
13823 default value of &%local_interfaces%& is
13824 .code
13825 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0
13826 .endd
13827 when Exim is built without IPv6 support; otherwise it is:
13828 .code
13829 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
13830 .endd
13831 Thus, by default, Exim listens on all available interfaces, on the SMTP port.
13832
13833
13834
13835 .section "Overriding local_interfaces and daemon_smtp_ports" "SECID91"
13836 The &%-oX%& command line option can be used to override the values of
13837 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& and/or &%local_interfaces%& for a particular daemon
13838 instance. Another way of doing this would be to use macros and the &%-D%&
13839 option. However, &%-oX%& can be used by any admin user, whereas modification of
13840 the runtime configuration by &%-D%& is allowed only when the caller is root or
13841 exim.
13842
13843 The value of &%-oX%& is a list of items. The default colon separator can be
13844 changed in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&) if required.
13845 If there are any items that do not
13846 contain dots or colons (that is, are not IP addresses), the value of
13847 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is replaced by the list of those items. If there are any
13848 items that do contain dots or colons, the value of &%local_interfaces%& is
13849 replaced by those items. Thus, for example,
13850 .code
13851 -oX 1225
13852 .endd
13853 overrides &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, but leaves &%local_interfaces%& unchanged,
13854 whereas
13855 .code
13856 -oX 192.168.34.5.1125
13857 .endd
13858 overrides &%local_interfaces%&, leaving &%daemon_smtp_ports%& unchanged.
13859 (However, since &%local_interfaces%& now contains no items without ports, the
13860 value of &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is no longer relevant in this example.)
13861
13862
13863
13864 .section "Support for the submissions (aka SSMTP or SMTPS) protocol" "SECTsupobssmt"
13865 .cindex "submissions protocol"
13866 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
13867 .cindex "smtps protocol"
13868 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
13869 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
13870 Exim supports the use of TLS-on-connect, used by mail clients in the
13871 &"submissions"& protocol, historically also known as SMTPS or SSMTP.
13872 For some years, IETF Standards Track documents only blessed the
13873 STARTTLS-based Submission service (port 587) while common practice was to support
13874 the same feature set on port 465, but using TLS-on-connect.
13875 If your installation needs to provide service to mail clients
13876 (Mail User Agents, MUAs) then you should provide service on both the 587 and
13877 the 465 TCP ports.
13878
13879 If the &%tls_on_connect_ports%& option is set to a list of port numbers or
13880 service names, connections to those ports must first establish TLS, before
13881 proceeding to the application layer use of the SMTP protocol.
13882
13883 The common use of this option is expected to be
13884 .code
13885 tls_on_connect_ports = 465
13886 .endd
13887 per RFC 8314.
13888 There is also a command line option &%-tls-on-connect%&, which forces all ports
13889 to behave in this way when a daemon is started.
13890
13891 &*Warning*&: Setting &%tls_on_connect_ports%& does not of itself cause the
13892 daemon to listen on those ports. You must still specify them in
13893 &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, &%local_interfaces%&, or the &%-oX%& option. (This is
13894 because &%tls_on_connect_ports%& applies to &%inetd%& connections as well as to
13895 connections via the daemon.)
13896
13897
13898
13899
13900 .section "IPv6 address scopes" "SECID92"
13901 .cindex "IPv6" "address scopes"
13902 IPv6 addresses have &"scopes"&, and a host with multiple hardware interfaces
13903 can, in principle, have the same link-local IPv6 address on different
13904 interfaces. Thus, additional information is needed, over and above the IP
13905 address, to distinguish individual interfaces. A convention of using a
13906 percent sign followed by something (often the interface name) has been
13907 adopted in some cases, leading to addresses like this:
13908 .code
13909 fe80::202:b3ff:fe03:45c1%eth0
13910 .endd
13911 To accommodate this usage, a percent sign followed by an arbitrary string is
13912 allowed at the end of an IPv6 address. By default, Exim calls &[getaddrinfo()]&
13913 to convert a textual IPv6 address for actual use. This function recognizes the
13914 percent convention in operating systems that support it, and it processes the
13915 address appropriately. Unfortunately, some older libraries have problems with
13916 &[getaddrinfo()]&. If
13917 .code
13918 IPV6_USE_INET_PTON=yes
13919 .endd
13920 is set in &_Local/Makefile_& (or an OS-dependent Makefile) when Exim is built,
13921 Exim uses &'inet_pton()'& to convert a textual IPv6 address for actual use,
13922 instead of &[getaddrinfo()]&. (Before version 4.14, it always used this
13923 function.) Of course, this means that the additional functionality of
13924 &[getaddrinfo()]& &-- recognizing scoped addresses &-- is lost.
13925
13926 .section "Disabling IPv6" "SECID93"
13927 .cindex "IPv6" "disabling"
13928 Sometimes it happens that an Exim binary that was compiled with IPv6 support is
13929 run on a host whose kernel does not support IPv6. The binary will fall back to
13930 using IPv4, but it may waste resources looking up AAAA records, and trying to
13931 connect to IPv6 addresses, causing delays to mail delivery. If you set the
13932 .oindex "&%disable_ipv6%&"
13933 &%disable_ipv6%& option true, even if the Exim binary has IPv6 support, no IPv6
13934 activities take place. AAAA records are never looked up, and any IPv6 addresses
13935 that are listed in &%local_interfaces%&, data for the &(manualroute)& router,
13936 etc. are ignored. If IP literals are enabled, the &(ipliteral)& router declines
13937 to handle IPv6 literal addresses.
13938
13939 On the other hand, when IPv6 is in use, there may be times when you want to
13940 disable it for certain hosts or domains. You can use the &%dns_ipv4_lookup%&
13941 option to globally suppress the lookup of AAAA records for specified domains,
13942 and you can use the &%ignore_target_hosts%& generic router option to ignore
13943 IPv6 addresses in an individual router.
13944
13945
13946
13947 .section "Examples of starting a listening daemon" "SECID94"
13948 The default case in an IPv6 environment is
13949 .code
13950 daemon_smtp_ports = smtp
13951 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
13952 .endd
13953 This specifies listening on the smtp port on all IPv6 and IPv4 interfaces.
13954 Either one or two sockets may be used, depending on the characteristics of
13955 the TCP/IP stack. (This is complicated and messy; for more information,
13956 read the comments in the &_daemon.c_& source file.)
13957
13958 To specify listening on ports 25 and 26 on all interfaces:
13959 .code
13960 daemon_smtp_ports = 25 : 26
13961 .endd
13962 (leaving &%local_interfaces%& at the default setting) or, more explicitly:
13963 .code
13964 local_interfaces = <; ::0.25 ; ::0.26 \
13965 0.0.0.0.25 ; 0.0.0.0.26
13966 .endd
13967 To listen on the default port on all IPv4 interfaces, and on port 26 on the
13968 IPv4 loopback address only:
13969 .code
13970 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0 : 127.0.0.1.26
13971 .endd
13972 To specify listening on the default port on specific interfaces only:
13973 .code
13974 local_interfaces = 10.0.0.67 : 192.168.34.67
13975 .endd
13976 &*Warning*&: Such a setting excludes listening on the loopback interfaces.
13977
13978
13979
13980 .section "Recognizing the local host" "SECTreclocipadd"
13981 The &%local_interfaces%& option is also used when Exim needs to determine
13982 whether or not an IP address refers to the local host. That is, the IP
13983 addresses of all the interfaces on which a daemon is listening are always
13984 treated as local.
13985
13986 For this usage, port numbers in &%local_interfaces%& are ignored. If either of
13987 the items 0.0.0.0 or ::0 are encountered, Exim gets a complete list of
13988 available interfaces from the operating system, and extracts the relevant
13989 (that is, IPv4 or IPv6) addresses to use for checking.
13990
13991 Some systems set up large numbers of virtual interfaces in order to provide
13992 many virtual web servers. In this situation, you may want to listen for
13993 email on only a few of the available interfaces, but nevertheless treat all
13994 interfaces as local when routing. You can do this by setting
13995 &%extra_local_interfaces%& to a list of IP addresses, possibly including the
13996 &"all"& wildcard values. These addresses are recognized as local, but are not
13997 used for listening. Consider this example:
13998 .code
13999 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; ::1 ; \
14000 192.168.53.235 ; \
14001 3ffe:2101:12:1:a00:20ff:fe86:a061
14002
14003 extra_local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
14004 .endd
14005 The daemon listens on the loopback interfaces and just one IPv4 and one IPv6
14006 address, but all available interface addresses are treated as local when
14007 Exim is routing.
14008
14009 In some environments the local host name may be in an MX list, but with an IP
14010 address that is not assigned to any local interface. In other cases it may be
14011 desirable to treat other host names as if they referred to the local host. Both
14012 these cases can be handled by setting the &%hosts_treat_as_local%& option.
14013 This contains host names rather than IP addresses. When a host is referenced
14014 during routing, either via an MX record or directly, it is treated as the local
14015 host if its name matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, or if any of its IP
14016 addresses match &%local_interfaces%& or &%extra_local_interfaces%&.
14017
14018
14019
14020 .section "Delivering to a remote host" "SECID95"
14021 Delivery to a remote host is handled by the smtp transport. By default, it
14022 allows the system's TCP/IP functions to choose which interface to use (if
14023 there is more than one) when connecting to a remote host. However, the
14024 &%interface%& option can be set to specify which interface is used. See the
14025 description of the smtp transport in chapter &<<CHAPsmtptrans>>& for more
14026 details.
14027
14028
14029
14030
14031 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
14032 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
14033
14034 .chapter "Main configuration" "CHAPmainconfig"
14035 .scindex IIDconfima "configuration file" "main section"
14036 .scindex IIDmaiconf "main configuration"
14037 The first part of the runtime configuration file contains three types of item:
14038
14039 .ilist
14040 Macro definitions: These lines start with an upper case letter. See section
14041 &<<SECTmacrodefs>>& for details of macro processing.
14042 .next
14043 Named list definitions: These lines start with one of the words &"domainlist"&,
14044 &"hostlist"&, &"addresslist"&, or &"localpartlist"&. Their use is described in
14045 section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&.
14046 .next
14047 Main configuration settings: Each setting occupies one line of the file
14048 (with possible continuations). If any setting is preceded by the word
14049 &"hide"&, the &%-bP%& command line option displays its value to admin users
14050 only. See section &<<SECTcos>>& for a description of the syntax of these option
14051 settings.
14052 .endlist
14053
14054 This chapter specifies all the main configuration options, along with their
14055 types and default values. For ease of finding a particular option, they appear
14056 in alphabetical order in section &<<SECTalomo>>& below. However, because there
14057 are now so many options, they are first listed briefly in functional groups, as
14058 an aid to finding the name of the option you are looking for. Some options are
14059 listed in more than one group.
14060
14061 .section "Miscellaneous" "SECID96"
14062 .table2
14063 .row &%bi_command%& "to run for &%-bi%& command line option"
14064 .row &%debug_store%& "do extra internal checks"
14065 .row &%disable_ipv6%& "do no IPv6 processing"
14066 .row &%keep_malformed%& "for broken files &-- should not happen"
14067 .row &%localhost_number%& "for unique message ids in clusters"
14068 .row &%message_body_newlines%& "retain newlines in &$message_body$&"
14069 .row &%message_body_visible%& "how much to show in &$message_body$&"
14070 .row &%mua_wrapper%& "run in &""MUA wrapper""& mode"
14071 .row &%print_topbitchars%& "top-bit characters are printing"
14072 .row &%spool_wireformat%& "use wire-format spool data files when possible"
14073 .row &%timezone%& "force time zone"
14074 .endtable
14075
14076
14077 .section "Exim parameters" "SECID97"
14078 .table2
14079 .row &%exim_group%& "override compiled-in value"
14080 .row &%exim_path%& "override compiled-in value"
14081 .row &%exim_user%& "override compiled-in value"
14082 .row &%primary_hostname%& "default from &[uname()]&"
14083 .row &%split_spool_directory%& "use multiple directories"
14084 .row &%spool_directory%& "override compiled-in value"
14085 .endtable
14086
14087
14088
14089 .section "Privilege controls" "SECID98"
14090 .table2
14091 .row &%admin_groups%& "groups that are Exim admin users"
14092 .row &%commandline_checks_require_admin%& "require admin for various checks"
14093 .row &%deliver_drop_privilege%& "drop root for delivery processes"
14094 .row &%local_from_check%& "insert &'Sender:'& if necessary"
14095 .row &%local_from_prefix%& "for testing &'From:'& for local sender"
14096 .row &%local_from_suffix%& "for testing &'From:'& for local sender"
14097 .row &%local_sender_retain%& "keep &'Sender:'& from untrusted user"
14098 .row &%never_users%& "do not run deliveries as these"
14099 .row &%prod_requires_admin%& "forced delivery requires admin user"
14100 .row &%queue_list_requires_admin%& "queue listing requires admin user"
14101 .row &%trusted_groups%& "groups that are trusted"
14102 .row &%trusted_users%& "users that are trusted"
14103 .endtable
14104
14105
14106
14107 .section "Logging" "SECID99"
14108 .table2
14109 .row &%event_action%& "custom logging"
14110 .row &%hosts_connection_nolog%& "exemption from connect logging"
14111 .row &%log_file_path%& "override compiled-in value"
14112 .row &%log_selector%& "set/unset optional logging"
14113 .row &%log_timezone%& "add timezone to log lines"
14114 .row &%message_logs%& "create per-message logs"
14115 .row &%preserve_message_logs%& "after message completion"
14116 .row &%process_log_path%& "for SIGUSR1 and &'exiwhat'&"
14117 .row &%slow_lookup_log%& "control logging of slow DNS lookups"
14118 .row &%syslog_duplication%& "controls duplicate log lines on syslog"
14119 .row &%syslog_facility%& "set syslog &""facility""& field"
14120 .row &%syslog_pid%& "pid in syslog lines"
14121 .row &%syslog_processname%& "set syslog &""ident""& field"
14122 .row &%syslog_timestamp%& "timestamp syslog lines"
14123 .row &%write_rejectlog%& "control use of message log"
14124 .endtable
14125
14126
14127
14128 .section "Frozen messages" "SECID100"
14129 .table2
14130 .row &%auto_thaw%& "sets time for retrying frozen messages"
14131 .row &%freeze_tell%& "send message when freezing"
14132 .row &%move_frozen_messages%& "to another directory"
14133 .row &%timeout_frozen_after%& "keep frozen messages only so long"
14134 .endtable
14135
14136
14137
14138 .section "Data lookups" "SECID101"
14139 .table2
14140 .row &%ibase_servers%& "InterBase servers"
14141 .row &%ldap_ca_cert_dir%& "dir of CA certs to verify LDAP server's"
14142 .row &%ldap_ca_cert_file%& "file of CA certs to verify LDAP server's"
14143 .row &%ldap_cert_file%& "client cert file for LDAP"
14144 .row &%ldap_cert_key%& "client key file for LDAP"
14145 .row &%ldap_cipher_suite%& "TLS negotiation preference control"
14146 .row &%ldap_default_servers%& "used if no server in query"
14147 .row &%ldap_require_cert%& "action to take without LDAP server cert"
14148 .row &%ldap_start_tls%& "require TLS within LDAP"
14149 .row &%ldap_version%& "set protocol version"
14150 .row &%lookup_open_max%& "lookup files held open"
14151 .row &%mysql_servers%& "default MySQL servers"
14152 .row &%oracle_servers%& "Oracle servers"
14153 .row &%pgsql_servers%& "default PostgreSQL servers"
14154 .row &%sqlite_lock_timeout%& "as it says"
14155 .endtable
14156
14157
14158
14159 .section "Message ids" "SECID102"
14160 .table2
14161 .row &%message_id_header_domain%& "used to build &'Message-ID:'& header"
14162 .row &%message_id_header_text%& "ditto"
14163 .endtable
14164
14165
14166
14167 .section "Embedded Perl Startup" "SECID103"
14168 .table2
14169 .row &%perl_at_start%& "always start the interpreter"
14170 .row &%perl_startup%& "code to obey when starting Perl"
14171 .row &%perl_taintmode%& "enable taint mode in Perl"
14172 .endtable
14173
14174
14175
14176 .section "Daemon" "SECID104"
14177 .table2
14178 .row &%daemon_smtp_ports%& "default ports"
14179 .row &%daemon_startup_retries%& "number of times to retry"
14180 .row &%daemon_startup_sleep%& "time to sleep between tries"
14181 .row &%extra_local_interfaces%& "not necessarily listened on"
14182 .row &%local_interfaces%& "on which to listen, with optional ports"
14183 .row &%pid_file_path%& "override compiled-in value"
14184 .row &%queue_run_max%& "maximum simultaneous queue runners"
14185 .endtable
14186
14187
14188
14189 .section "Resource control" "SECID105"
14190 .table2
14191 .row &%check_log_inodes%& "before accepting a message"
14192 .row &%check_log_space%& "before accepting a message"
14193 .row &%check_spool_inodes%& "before accepting a message"
14194 .row &%check_spool_space%& "before accepting a message"
14195 .row &%deliver_queue_load_max%& "no queue deliveries if load high"
14196 .row &%queue_only_load%& "queue incoming if load high"
14197 .row &%queue_only_load_latch%& "don't re-evaluate load for each message"
14198 .row &%queue_run_max%& "maximum simultaneous queue runners"
14199 .row &%remote_max_parallel%& "parallel SMTP delivery per message"
14200 .row &%smtp_accept_max%& "simultaneous incoming connections"
14201 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& "non-mail commands"
14202 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%& "hosts to which the limit applies"
14203 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_connection%& "messages per connection"
14204 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& "connections from one host"
14205 .row &%smtp_accept_queue%& "queue mail if more connections"
14206 .row &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& "queue if more messages per &&&
14207 connection"
14208 .row &%smtp_accept_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if more connections"
14209 .row &%smtp_check_spool_space%& "from SIZE on MAIL command"
14210 .row &%smtp_connect_backlog%& "passed to TCP/IP stack"
14211 .row &%smtp_load_reserve%& "SMTP from reserved hosts if load high"
14212 .row &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& "these are the reserve hosts"
14213 .endtable
14214
14215
14216
14217 .section "Policy controls" "SECID106"
14218 .table2
14219 .row &%acl_not_smtp%& "ACL for non-SMTP messages"
14220 .row &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& "ACL for non-SMTP MIME parts"
14221 .row &%acl_not_smtp_start%& "ACL for start of non-SMTP message"
14222 .row &%acl_smtp_auth%& "ACL for AUTH"
14223 .row &%acl_smtp_connect%& "ACL for connection"
14224 .row &%acl_smtp_data%& "ACL for DATA"
14225 .row &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& "ACL for DATA, per-recipient"
14226 .row &%acl_smtp_dkim%& "ACL for DKIM verification"
14227 .row &%acl_smtp_etrn%& "ACL for ETRN"
14228 .row &%acl_smtp_expn%& "ACL for EXPN"
14229 .row &%acl_smtp_helo%& "ACL for EHLO or HELO"
14230 .row &%acl_smtp_mail%& "ACL for MAIL"
14231 .row &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& "ACL for AUTH on MAIL command"
14232 .row &%acl_smtp_mime%& "ACL for MIME parts"
14233 .row &%acl_smtp_notquit%& "ACL for non-QUIT terminations"
14234 .row &%acl_smtp_predata%& "ACL for start of data"
14235 .row &%acl_smtp_quit%& "ACL for QUIT"
14236 .row &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& "ACL for RCPT"
14237 .row &%acl_smtp_starttls%& "ACL for STARTTLS"
14238 .row &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& "ACL for VRFY"
14239 .row &%av_scanner%& "specify virus scanner"
14240 .row &%check_rfc2047_length%& "check length of RFC 2047 &""encoded &&&
14241 words""&"
14242 .row &%dns_cname_loops%& "follow CNAMEs returned by resolver"
14243 .row &%dns_csa_search_limit%& "control CSA parent search depth"
14244 .row &%dns_csa_use_reverse%& "en/disable CSA IP reverse search"
14245 .row &%header_maxsize%& "total size of message header"
14246 .row &%header_line_maxsize%& "individual header line limit"
14247 .row &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& "allow syntactic junk from these hosts"
14248 .row &%helo_allow_chars%& "allow illegal chars in HELO names"
14249 .row &%helo_lookup_domains%& "lookup hostname for these HELO names"
14250 .row &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& "HELO soft-checked for these hosts"
14251 .row &%helo_verify_hosts%& "HELO hard-checked for these hosts"
14252 .row &%host_lookup%& "host name looked up for these hosts"
14253 .row &%host_lookup_order%& "order of DNS and local name lookups"
14254 .row &%hosts_proxy%& "use proxy protocol for these hosts"
14255 .row &%host_reject_connection%& "reject connection from these hosts"
14256 .row &%hosts_treat_as_local%& "useful in some cluster configurations"
14257 .row &%local_scan_timeout%& "timeout for &[local_scan()]&"
14258 .row &%message_size_limit%& "for all messages"
14259 .row &%percent_hack_domains%& "recognize %-hack for these domains"
14260 .row &%spamd_address%& "set interface to SpamAssassin"
14261 .row &%strict_acl_vars%& "object to unset ACL variables"
14262 .endtable
14263
14264
14265
14266 .section "Callout cache" "SECID107"
14267 .table2
14268 .row &%callout_domain_negative_expire%& "timeout for negative domain cache &&&
14269 item"
14270 .row &%callout_domain_positive_expire%& "timeout for positive domain cache &&&
14271 item"
14272 .row &%callout_negative_expire%& "timeout for negative address cache item"
14273 .row &%callout_positive_expire%& "timeout for positive address cache item"
14274 .row &%callout_random_local_part%& "string to use for &""random""& testing"
14275 .endtable
14276
14277
14278
14279 .section "TLS" "SECID108"
14280 .table2
14281 .row &%gnutls_compat_mode%& "use GnuTLS compatibility mode"
14282 .row &%gnutls_allow_auto_pkcs11%& "allow GnuTLS to autoload PKCS11 modules"
14283 .row &%openssl_options%& "adjust OpenSSL compatibility options"
14284 .row &%tls_advertise_hosts%& "advertise TLS to these hosts"
14285 .row &%tls_certificate%& "location of server certificate"
14286 .row &%tls_crl%& "certificate revocation list"
14287 .row &%tls_dh_max_bits%& "clamp D-H bit count suggestion"
14288 .row &%tls_dhparam%& "DH parameters for server"
14289 .row &%tls_eccurve%& "EC curve selection for server"
14290 .row &%tls_ocsp_file%& "location of server certificate status proof"
14291 .row &%tls_on_connect_ports%& "specify SSMTP (SMTPS) ports"
14292 .row &%tls_privatekey%& "location of server private key"
14293 .row &%tls_remember_esmtp%& "don't reset after starting TLS"
14294 .row &%tls_require_ciphers%& "specify acceptable ciphers"
14295 .row &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& "try to verify client certificate"
14296 .row &%tls_verify_certificates%& "expected client certificates"
14297 .row &%tls_verify_hosts%& "insist on client certificate verify"
14298 .endtable
14299
14300
14301
14302 .section "Local user handling" "SECID109"
14303 .table2
14304 .row &%finduser_retries%& "useful in NIS environments"
14305 .row &%gecos_name%& "used when creating &'Sender:'&"
14306 .row &%gecos_pattern%& "ditto"
14307 .row &%max_username_length%& "for systems that truncate"
14308 .row &%unknown_login%& "used when no login name found"
14309 .row &%unknown_username%& "ditto"
14310 .row &%uucp_from_pattern%& "for recognizing &""From ""& lines"
14311 .row &%uucp_from_sender%& "ditto"
14312 .endtable
14313
14314
14315
14316 .section "All incoming messages (SMTP and non-SMTP)" "SECID110"
14317 .table2
14318 .row &%header_maxsize%& "total size of message header"
14319 .row &%header_line_maxsize%& "individual header line limit"
14320 .row &%message_size_limit%& "applies to all messages"
14321 .row &%percent_hack_domains%& "recognize %-hack for these domains"
14322 .row &%received_header_text%& "expanded to make &'Received:'&"
14323 .row &%received_headers_max%& "for mail loop detection"
14324 .row &%recipients_max%& "limit per message"
14325 .row &%recipients_max_reject%& "permanently reject excess recipients"
14326 .endtable
14327
14328
14329
14330
14331 .section "Non-SMTP incoming messages" "SECID111"
14332 .table2
14333 .row &%receive_timeout%& "for non-SMTP messages"
14334 .endtable
14335
14336
14337
14338
14339
14340 .section "Incoming SMTP messages" "SECID112"
14341 See also the &'Policy controls'& section above.
14342
14343 .table2
14344 .row &%dkim_verify_signers%& "DKIM domain for which DKIM ACL is run"
14345 .row &%host_lookup%& "host name looked up for these hosts"
14346 .row &%host_lookup_order%& "order of DNS and local name lookups"
14347 .row &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& "may send unqualified recipients"
14348 .row &%rfc1413_hosts%& "make ident calls to these hosts"
14349 .row &%rfc1413_query_timeout%& "zero disables ident calls"
14350 .row &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& "may send unqualified senders"
14351 .row &%smtp_accept_keepalive%& "some TCP/IP magic"
14352 .row &%smtp_accept_max%& "simultaneous incoming connections"
14353 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& "non-mail commands"
14354 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%& "hosts to which the limit applies"
14355 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_connection%& "messages per connection"
14356 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& "connections from one host"
14357 .row &%smtp_accept_queue%& "queue mail if more connections"
14358 .row &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& "queue if more messages per &&&
14359 connection"
14360 .row &%smtp_accept_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if more connections"
14361 .row &%smtp_active_hostname%& "host name to use in messages"
14362 .row &%smtp_banner%& "text for welcome banner"
14363 .row &%smtp_check_spool_space%& "from SIZE on MAIL command"
14364 .row &%smtp_connect_backlog%& "passed to TCP/IP stack"
14365 .row &%smtp_enforce_sync%& "of SMTP command/responses"
14366 .row &%smtp_etrn_command%& "what to run for ETRN"
14367 .row &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& "only one at once"
14368 .row &%smtp_load_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if this load"
14369 .row &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& "before dropping connection"
14370 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& "apply ratelimiting to these hosts"
14371 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_mail%& "ratelimit for MAIL commands"
14372 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_rcpt%& "ratelimit for RCPT commands"
14373 .row &%smtp_receive_timeout%& "per command or data line"
14374 .row &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& "these are the reserve hosts"
14375 .row &%smtp_return_error_details%& "give detail on rejections"
14376 .endtable
14377
14378
14379
14380 .section "SMTP extensions" "SECID113"
14381 .table2
14382 .row &%accept_8bitmime%& "advertise 8BITMIME"
14383 .row &%auth_advertise_hosts%& "advertise AUTH to these hosts"
14384 .row &%chunking_advertise_hosts%& "advertise CHUNKING to these hosts"
14385 .row &%dsn_advertise_hosts%& "advertise DSN extensions to these hosts"
14386 .row &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& "allow &""From ""& from these hosts"
14387 .row &%ignore_fromline_local%& "allow &""From ""& from local SMTP"
14388 .row &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%& "advertise pipelining to these hosts"
14389 .row &%pipelining_connect_advertise_hosts%& "advertise pipelining to these hosts"
14390 .row &%prdr_enable%& "advertise PRDR to all hosts"
14391 .row &%smtputf8_advertise_hosts%& "advertise SMTPUTF8 to these hosts"
14392 .row &%tls_advertise_hosts%& "advertise TLS to these hosts"
14393 .endtable
14394
14395
14396
14397 .section "Processing messages" "SECID114"
14398 .table2
14399 .row &%allow_domain_literals%& "recognize domain literal syntax"
14400 .row &%allow_mx_to_ip%& "allow MX to point to IP address"
14401 .row &%allow_utf8_domains%& "in addresses"
14402 .row &%check_rfc2047_length%& "check length of RFC 2047 &""encoded &&&
14403 words""&"
14404 .row &%delivery_date_remove%& "from incoming messages"
14405 .row &%envelope_to_remove%& "from incoming messages"
14406 .row &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& "affects &%-t%& processing"
14407 .row &%headers_charset%& "default for translations"
14408 .row &%qualify_domain%& "default for senders"
14409 .row &%qualify_recipient%& "default for recipients"
14410 .row &%return_path_remove%& "from incoming messages"
14411 .row &%strip_excess_angle_brackets%& "in addresses"
14412 .row &%strip_trailing_dot%& "at end of addresses"
14413 .row &%untrusted_set_sender%& "untrusted can set envelope sender"
14414 .endtable
14415
14416
14417
14418 .section "System filter" "SECID115"
14419 .table2
14420 .row &%system_filter%& "locate system filter"
14421 .row &%system_filter_directory_transport%& "transport for delivery to a &&&
14422 directory"
14423 .row &%system_filter_file_transport%& "transport for delivery to a file"
14424 .row &%system_filter_group%& "group for filter running"
14425 .row &%system_filter_pipe_transport%& "transport for delivery to a pipe"
14426 .row &%system_filter_reply_transport%& "transport for autoreply delivery"
14427 .row &%system_filter_user%& "user for filter running"
14428 .endtable
14429
14430
14431
14432 .section "Routing and delivery" "SECID116"
14433 .table2
14434 .row &%disable_ipv6%& "do no IPv6 processing"
14435 .row &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& "for broken domains"
14436 .row &%dns_check_names_pattern%& "pre-DNS syntax check"
14437 .row &%dns_dnssec_ok%& "parameter for resolver"
14438 .row &%dns_ipv4_lookup%& "only v4 lookup for these domains"
14439 .row &%dns_retrans%& "parameter for resolver"
14440 .row &%dns_retry%& "parameter for resolver"
14441 .row &%dns_trust_aa%& "DNS zones trusted as authentic"
14442 .row &%dns_use_edns0%& "parameter for resolver"
14443 .row &%hold_domains%& "hold delivery for these domains"
14444 .row &%local_interfaces%& "for routing checks"
14445 .row &%queue_domains%& "no immediate delivery for these"
14446 .row &%queue_only%& "no immediate delivery at all"
14447 .row &%queue_only_file%& "no immediate delivery if file exists"
14448 .row &%queue_only_load%& "no immediate delivery if load is high"
14449 .row &%queue_only_load_latch%& "don't re-evaluate load for each message"
14450 .row &%queue_only_override%& "allow command line to override"
14451 .row &%queue_run_in_order%& "order of arrival"
14452 .row &%queue_run_max%& "of simultaneous queue runners"
14453 .row &%queue_smtp_domains%& "no immediate SMTP delivery for these"
14454 .row &%remote_max_parallel%& "parallel SMTP delivery per message"
14455 .row &%remote_sort_domains%& "order of remote deliveries"
14456 .row &%retry_data_expire%& "timeout for retry data"
14457 .row &%retry_interval_max%& "safety net for retry rules"
14458 .endtable
14459
14460
14461
14462 .section "Bounce and warning messages" "SECID117"
14463 .table2
14464 .row &%bounce_message_file%& "content of bounce"
14465 .row &%bounce_message_text%& "content of bounce"
14466 .row &%bounce_return_body%& "include body if returning message"
14467 .row &%bounce_return_linesize_limit%& "limit on returned message line length"
14468 .row &%bounce_return_message%& "include original message in bounce"
14469 .row &%bounce_return_size_limit%& "limit on returned message"
14470 .row &%bounce_sender_authentication%& "send authenticated sender with bounce"
14471 .row &%dsn_from%& "set &'From:'& contents in bounces"
14472 .row &%errors_copy%& "copy bounce messages"
14473 .row &%errors_reply_to%& "&'Reply-to:'& in bounces"
14474 .row &%delay_warning%& "time schedule"
14475 .row &%delay_warning_condition%& "condition for warning messages"
14476 .row &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%& "discard undeliverable bounces"
14477 .row &%smtp_return_error_details%& "give detail on rejections"
14478 .row &%warn_message_file%& "content of warning message"
14479 .endtable
14480
14481
14482
14483 .section "Alphabetical list of main options" "SECTalomo"
14484 Those options that undergo string expansion before use are marked with
14485 &dagger;.
14486
14487 .option accept_8bitmime main boolean true
14488 .cindex "8BITMIME"
14489 .cindex "8-bit characters"
14490 .cindex "log" "selectors"
14491 .cindex "log" "8BITMIME"
14492 This option causes Exim to send 8BITMIME in its response to an SMTP
14493 EHLO command, and to accept the BODY= parameter on MAIL commands.
14494 However, though Exim is 8-bit clean, it is not a protocol converter, and it
14495 takes no steps to do anything special with messages received by this route.
14496
14497 Historically Exim kept this option off by default, but the maintainers
14498 feel that in today's Internet, this causes more problems than it solves.
14499 It now defaults to true.
14500 A more detailed analysis of the issues is provided by Dan Bernstein:
14501 .display
14502 &url(https://cr.yp.to/smtp/8bitmime.html)
14503 .endd
14504
14505 To log received 8BITMIME status use
14506 .code
14507 log_selector = +8bitmime
14508 .endd
14509
14510 .option acl_not_smtp main string&!! unset
14511 .cindex "&ACL;" "for non-SMTP messages"
14512 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
14513 This option defines the ACL that is run when a non-SMTP message has been
14514 read and is on the point of being accepted. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for
14515 further details.
14516
14517 .option acl_not_smtp_mime main string&!! unset
14518 This option defines the ACL that is run for individual MIME parts of non-SMTP
14519 messages. It operates in exactly the same way as &%acl_smtp_mime%& operates for
14520 SMTP messages.
14521
14522 .option acl_not_smtp_start main string&!! unset
14523 .cindex "&ACL;" "at start of non-SMTP message"
14524 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
14525 This option defines the ACL that is run before Exim starts reading a
14526 non-SMTP message. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14527
14528 .option acl_smtp_auth main string&!! unset
14529 .cindex "&ACL;" "setting up for SMTP commands"
14530 .cindex "AUTH" "ACL for"
14531 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP AUTH command is
14532 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14533
14534 .option acl_smtp_connect main string&!! unset
14535 .cindex "&ACL;" "on SMTP connection"
14536 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP connection is received.
14537 See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14538
14539 .option acl_smtp_data main string&!! unset
14540 .cindex "DATA" "ACL for"
14541 This option defines the ACL that is run after an SMTP DATA command has been
14542 processed and the message itself has been received, but before the final
14543 acknowledgment is sent. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14544
14545 .option acl_smtp_data_prdr main string&!! accept
14546 .cindex "PRDR" "ACL for"
14547 .cindex "DATA" "PRDR ACL for"
14548 .cindex "&ACL;" "PRDR-related"
14549 .cindex "&ACL;" "per-user data processing"
14550 This option defines the ACL that,
14551 if the PRDR feature has been negotiated,
14552 is run for each recipient after an SMTP DATA command has been
14553 processed and the message itself has been received, but before the
14554 acknowledgment is sent. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14555
14556 .option acl_smtp_dkim main string&!! unset
14557 .cindex DKIM "ACL for"
14558 This option defines the ACL that is run for each DKIM signature
14559 (by default, or as specified in the dkim_verify_signers option)
14560 of a received message.
14561 See section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>& for further details.
14562
14563 .option acl_smtp_etrn main string&!! unset
14564 .cindex "ETRN" "ACL for"
14565 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP ETRN command is
14566 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14567
14568 .option acl_smtp_expn main string&!! unset
14569 .cindex "EXPN" "ACL for"
14570 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP EXPN command is
14571 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14572
14573 .option acl_smtp_helo main string&!! unset
14574 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
14575 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
14576 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP EHLO or HELO
14577 command is received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14578
14579
14580 .option acl_smtp_mail main string&!! unset
14581 .cindex "MAIL" "ACL for"
14582 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP MAIL command is
14583 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14584
14585 .option acl_smtp_mailauth main string&!! unset
14586 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
14587 This option defines the ACL that is run when there is an AUTH parameter on
14588 a MAIL command. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details of ACLs, and chapter
14589 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
14590
14591 .option acl_smtp_mime main string&!! unset
14592 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "ACL for"
14593 This option is available when Exim is built with the content-scanning
14594 extension. It defines the ACL that is run for each MIME part in a message. See
14595 section &<<SECTscanmimepart>>& for details.
14596
14597 .option acl_smtp_notquit main string&!! unset
14598 .cindex "not-QUIT, ACL for"
14599 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP session
14600 ends without a QUIT command being received.
14601 See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14602
14603 .option acl_smtp_predata main string&!! unset
14604 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP DATA command is
14605 received, before the message itself is received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for
14606 further details.
14607
14608 .option acl_smtp_quit main string&!! unset
14609 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
14610 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP QUIT command is
14611 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14612
14613 .option acl_smtp_rcpt main string&!! unset
14614 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
14615 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP RCPT command is
14616 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14617
14618 .option acl_smtp_starttls main string&!! unset
14619 .cindex "STARTTLS, ACL for"
14620 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP STARTTLS command is
14621 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14622
14623 .option acl_smtp_vrfy main string&!! unset
14624 .cindex "VRFY" "ACL for"
14625 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP VRFY command is
14626 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14627
14628 .option add_environment main "string list" empty
14629 .cindex "environment" "set values"
14630 This option allows to set individual environment variables that the
14631 currently linked libraries and programs in child processes use.
14632 See &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for the environment of &(pipe)& transports.
14633
14634 .option admin_groups main "string list&!!" unset
14635 .cindex "admin user"
14636 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If the
14637 current group or any of the supplementary groups of an Exim caller is in this
14638 colon-separated list, the caller has admin privileges. If all your system
14639 programmers are in a specific group, for example, you can give them all Exim
14640 admin privileges by putting that group in &%admin_groups%&. However, this does
14641 not permit them to read Exim's spool files (whose group owner is the Exim gid).
14642 To permit this, you have to add individuals to the Exim group.
14643
14644 .option allow_domain_literals main boolean false
14645 .cindex "domain literal"
14646 If this option is set, the RFC 2822 domain literal format is permitted in
14647 email addresses. The option is not set by default, because the domain literal
14648 format is not normally required these days, and few people know about it. It
14649 has, however, been exploited by mail abusers.
14650
14651 Unfortunately, it seems that some DNS black list maintainers are using this
14652 format to report black listing to postmasters. If you want to accept messages
14653 addressed to your hosts by IP address, you need to set
14654 &%allow_domain_literals%& true, and also to add &`@[]`& to the list of local
14655 domains (defined in the named domain list &%local_domains%& in the default
14656 configuration). This &"magic string"& matches the domain literal form of all
14657 the local host's IP addresses.
14658
14659
14660 .option allow_mx_to_ip main boolean false
14661 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to IP address"
14662 It appears that more and more DNS zone administrators are breaking the rules
14663 and putting domain names that look like IP addresses on the right hand side of
14664 MX records. Exim follows the rules and rejects this, giving an error message
14665 that explains the misconfiguration. However, some other MTAs support this
14666 practice, so to avoid &"Why can't Exim do this?"& complaints,
14667 &%allow_mx_to_ip%& exists, in order to enable this heinous activity. It is not
14668 recommended, except when you have no other choice.
14669
14670 .option allow_utf8_domains main boolean false
14671 .cindex "domain" "UTF-8 characters in"
14672 .cindex "UTF-8" "in domain name"
14673 Lots of discussion is going on about internationalized domain names. One
14674 camp is strongly in favour of just using UTF-8 characters, and it seems
14675 that at least two other MTAs permit this. This option allows Exim users to
14676 experiment if they wish.
14677
14678 If it is set true, Exim's domain parsing function allows valid
14679 UTF-8 multicharacters to appear in domain name components, in addition to
14680 letters, digits, and hyphens. However, just setting this option is not
14681 enough; if you want to look up these domain names in the DNS, you must also
14682 adjust the value of &%dns_check_names_pattern%& to match the extended form. A
14683 suitable setting is:
14684 .code
14685 dns_check_names_pattern = (?i)^(?>(?(1)\.|())[a-z0-9\xc0-\xff]\
14686 (?>[-a-z0-9\x80-\xff]*[a-z0-9\x80-\xbf])?)+$
14687 .endd
14688 Alternatively, you can just disable this feature by setting
14689 .code
14690 dns_check_names_pattern =
14691 .endd
14692 That is, set the option to an empty string so that no check is done.
14693
14694
14695 .option auth_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
14696 .cindex "authentication" "advertising"
14697 .cindex "AUTH" "advertising"
14698 If any server authentication mechanisms are configured, Exim advertises them in
14699 response to an EHLO command only if the calling host matches this list.
14700 Otherwise, Exim does not advertise AUTH.
14701 Exim does not accept AUTH commands from clients to which it has not
14702 advertised the availability of AUTH. The advertising of individual
14703 authentication mechanisms can be controlled by the use of the
14704 &%server_advertise_condition%& generic authenticator option on the individual
14705 authenticators. See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for further details.
14706
14707 Certain mail clients (for example, Netscape) require the user to provide a name
14708 and password for authentication if AUTH is advertised, even though it may
14709 not be needed (the host may accept messages from hosts on its local LAN without
14710 authentication, for example). The &%auth_advertise_hosts%& option can be used
14711 to make these clients more friendly by excluding them from the set of hosts to
14712 which Exim advertises AUTH.
14713
14714 .cindex "AUTH" "advertising when encrypted"
14715 If you want to advertise the availability of AUTH only when the connection
14716 is encrypted using TLS, you can make use of the fact that the value of this
14717 option is expanded, with a setting like this:
14718 .code
14719 auth_advertise_hosts = ${if eq{$tls_in_cipher}{}{}{*}}
14720 .endd
14721 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
14722 If &$tls_in_cipher$& is empty, the session is not encrypted, and the result of
14723 the expansion is empty, thus matching no hosts. Otherwise, the result of the
14724 expansion is *, which matches all hosts.
14725
14726
14727 .option auto_thaw main time 0s
14728 .cindex "thawing messages"
14729 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
14730 If this option is set to a time greater than zero, a queue runner will try a
14731 new delivery attempt on any frozen message, other than a bounce message, if
14732 this much time has passed since it was frozen. This may result in the message
14733 being re-frozen if nothing has changed since the last attempt. It is a way of
14734 saying &"keep on trying, even though there are big problems"&.
14735
14736 &*Note*&: This is an old option, which predates &%timeout_frozen_after%& and
14737 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&. It is retained for compatibility, but it is not
14738 thought to be very useful any more, and its use should probably be avoided.
14739
14740
14741 .option av_scanner main string "see below"
14742 This option is available if Exim is built with the content-scanning extension.
14743 It specifies which anti-virus scanner to use. The default value is:
14744 .code
14745 sophie:/var/run/sophie
14746 .endd
14747 If the value of &%av_scanner%& starts with a dollar character, it is expanded
14748 before use. See section &<<SECTscanvirus>>& for further details.
14749
14750
14751 .option bi_command main string unset
14752 .oindex "&%-bi%&"
14753 This option supplies the name of a command that is run when Exim is called with
14754 the &%-bi%& option (see chapter &<<CHAPcommandline>>&). The string value is
14755 just the command name, it is not a complete command line. If an argument is
14756 required, it must come from the &%-oA%& command line option.
14757
14758
14759 .option bounce_message_file main string unset
14760 .cindex "bounce message" "customizing"
14761 .cindex "customizing" "bounce message"
14762 This option defines a template file containing paragraphs of text to be used
14763 for constructing bounce messages. Details of the file's contents are given in
14764 chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&. See also &%warn_message_file%&.
14765
14766
14767 .option bounce_message_text main string unset
14768 When this option is set, its contents are included in the default bounce
14769 message immediately after &"This message was created automatically by mail
14770 delivery software."& It is not used if &%bounce_message_file%& is set.
14771
14772 .option bounce_return_body main boolean true
14773 .cindex "bounce message" "including body"
14774 This option controls whether the body of an incoming message is included in a
14775 bounce message when &%bounce_return_message%& is true. The default setting
14776 causes the entire message, both header and body, to be returned (subject to the
14777 value of &%bounce_return_size_limit%&). If this option is false, only the
14778 message header is included. In the case of a non-SMTP message containing an
14779 error that is detected during reception, only those header lines preceding the
14780 point at which the error was detected are returned.
14781 .cindex "bounce message" "including original"
14782
14783 .option bounce_return_linesize_limit main integer 998
14784 .cindex "size" "of bounce lines, limit"
14785 .cindex "bounce message" "line length limit"
14786 .cindex "limit" "bounce message line length"
14787 This option sets a limit in bytes on the line length of messages
14788 that are returned to senders due to delivery problems,
14789 when &%bounce_return_message%& is true.
14790 The default value corresponds to RFC limits.
14791 If the message being returned has lines longer than this value it is
14792 treated as if the &%bounce_return_size_limit%& (below) restriction was exceeded.
14793
14794 The option also applies to bounces returned when an error is detected
14795 during reception of a message.
14796 In this case lines from the original are truncated.
14797
14798 The option does not apply to messages generated by an &(autoreply)& transport.
14799
14800
14801 .option bounce_return_message main boolean true
14802 If this option is set false, none of the original message is included in
14803 bounce messages generated by Exim. See also &%bounce_return_size_limit%& and
14804 &%bounce_return_body%&.
14805
14806
14807 .option bounce_return_size_limit main integer 100K
14808 .cindex "size" "of bounce, limit"
14809 .cindex "bounce message" "size limit"
14810 .cindex "limit" "bounce message size"
14811 This option sets a limit in bytes on the size of messages that are returned to
14812 senders as part of bounce messages when &%bounce_return_message%& is true. The
14813 limit should be less than the value of the global &%message_size_limit%& and of
14814 any &%message_size_limit%& settings on transports, to allow for the bounce text
14815 that Exim generates. If this option is set to zero there is no limit.
14816
14817 When the body of any message that is to be included in a bounce message is
14818 greater than the limit, it is truncated, and a comment pointing this out is
14819 added at the top. The actual cutoff may be greater than the value given, owing
14820 to the use of buffering for transferring the message in chunks (typically 8K in
14821 size). The idea is to save bandwidth on those undeliverable 15-megabyte
14822 messages.
14823
14824 .option bounce_sender_authentication main string unset
14825 .cindex "bounce message" "sender authentication"
14826 .cindex "authentication" "bounce message"
14827 .cindex "AUTH" "on bounce message"
14828 This option provides an authenticated sender address that is sent with any
14829 bounce messages generated by Exim that are sent over an authenticated SMTP
14830 connection. A typical setting might be:
14831 .code
14832 bounce_sender_authentication = mailer-daemon@my.domain.example
14833 .endd
14834 which would cause bounce messages to be sent using the SMTP command:
14835 .code
14836 MAIL FROM:<> AUTH=mailer-daemon@my.domain.example
14837 .endd
14838 The value of &%bounce_sender_authentication%& must always be a complete email
14839 address.
14840
14841 .option callout_domain_negative_expire main time 3h
14842 .cindex "caching" "callout timeouts"
14843 .cindex "callout" "caching timeouts"
14844 This option specifies the expiry time for negative callout cache data for a
14845 domain. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
14846 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
14847
14848
14849 .option callout_domain_positive_expire main time 7d
14850 This option specifies the expiry time for positive callout cache data for a
14851 domain. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
14852 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
14853
14854
14855 .option callout_negative_expire main time 2h
14856 This option specifies the expiry time for negative callout cache data for an
14857 address. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
14858 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
14859
14860
14861 .option callout_positive_expire main time 24h
14862 This option specifies the expiry time for positive callout cache data for an
14863 address. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
14864 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
14865
14866
14867 .option callout_random_local_part main string&!! "see below"
14868 This option defines the &"random"& local part that can be used as part of
14869 callout verification. The default value is
14870 .code
14871 $primary_hostname-$tod_epoch-testing
14872 .endd
14873 See section &<<CALLaddparcall>>& for details of how this value is used.
14874
14875
14876 .option check_log_inodes main integer 100
14877 See &%check_spool_space%& below.
14878
14879
14880 .option check_log_space main integer 10M
14881 See &%check_spool_space%& below.
14882
14883 .oindex "&%check_rfc2047_length%&"
14884 .cindex "RFC 2047" "disabling length check"
14885 .option check_rfc2047_length main boolean true
14886 RFC 2047 defines a way of encoding non-ASCII characters in headers using a
14887 system of &"encoded words"&. The RFC specifies a maximum length for an encoded
14888 word; strings to be encoded that exceed this length are supposed to use
14889 multiple encoded words. By default, Exim does not recognize encoded words that
14890 exceed the maximum length. However, it seems that some software, in violation
14891 of the RFC, generates overlong encoded words. If &%check_rfc2047_length%& is
14892 set false, Exim recognizes encoded words of any length.
14893
14894
14895 .option check_spool_inodes main integer 100
14896 See &%check_spool_space%& below.
14897
14898
14899 .option check_spool_space main integer 10M
14900 .cindex "checking disk space"
14901 .cindex "disk space, checking"
14902 .cindex "spool directory" "checking space"
14903 The four &%check_...%& options allow for checking of disk resources before a
14904 message is accepted.
14905
14906 .vindex "&$log_inodes$&"
14907 .vindex "&$log_space$&"
14908 .vindex "&$spool_inodes$&"
14909 .vindex "&$spool_space$&"
14910 When any of these options are nonzero, they apply to all incoming messages. If you
14911 want to apply different checks to different kinds of message, you can do so by
14912 testing the variables &$log_inodes$&, &$log_space$&, &$spool_inodes$&, and
14913 &$spool_space$& in an ACL with appropriate additional conditions.
14914
14915
14916 &%check_spool_space%& and &%check_spool_inodes%& check the spool partition if
14917 either value is greater than zero, for example:
14918 .code
14919 check_spool_space = 100M
14920 check_spool_inodes = 100
14921 .endd
14922 The spool partition is the one that contains the directory defined by
14923 SPOOL_DIRECTORY in &_Local/Makefile_&. It is used for holding messages in
14924 transit.
14925
14926 &%check_log_space%& and &%check_log_inodes%& check the partition in which log
14927 files are written if either is greater than zero. These should be set only if
14928 &%log_file_path%& and &%spool_directory%& refer to different partitions.
14929
14930 If there is less space or fewer inodes than requested, Exim refuses to accept
14931 incoming mail. In the case of SMTP input this is done by giving a 452 temporary
14932 error response to the MAIL command. If ESMTP is in use and there was a
14933 SIZE parameter on the MAIL command, its value is added to the
14934 &%check_spool_space%& value, and the check is performed even if
14935 &%check_spool_space%& is zero, unless &%no_smtp_check_spool_space%& is set.
14936
14937 The values for &%check_spool_space%& and &%check_log_space%& are held as a
14938 number of kilobytes (though specified in bytes).
14939 If a non-multiple of 1024 is specified, it is rounded up.
14940
14941 For non-SMTP input and for batched SMTP input, the test is done at start-up; on
14942 failure a message is written to stderr and Exim exits with a non-zero code, as
14943 it obviously cannot send an error message of any kind.
14944
14945 There is a slight performance penalty for these checks.
14946 Versions of Exim preceding 4.88 had these disabled by default;
14947 high-rate installations confident they will never run out of resources
14948 may wish to deliberately disable them.
14949
14950 .option chunking_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
14951 .cindex CHUNKING advertisement
14952 .cindex "RFC 3030" "CHUNKING"
14953 The CHUNKING extension (RFC3030) will be advertised in the EHLO message to
14954 these hosts.
14955 Hosts may use the BDAT command as an alternate to DATA.
14956
14957 .option commandline_checks_require_admin main boolean &`false`&
14958 .cindex "restricting access to features"
14959 This option restricts various basic checking features to require an
14960 administrative user.
14961 This affects most of the &%-b*%& options, such as &%-be%&.
14962
14963 .option debug_store main boolean &`false`&
14964 .cindex debugging "memory corruption"
14965 .cindex memory debugging
14966 This option, when true, enables extra checking in Exim's internal memory
14967 management. For use when a memory corruption issue is being investigated,
14968 it should normally be left as default.
14969
14970 .option daemon_smtp_ports main string &`smtp`&
14971 .cindex "port" "for daemon"
14972 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
14973 This option specifies one or more default SMTP ports on which the Exim daemon
14974 listens. See chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& for details of how it is used. For
14975 backward compatibility, &%daemon_smtp_port%& (singular) is a synonym.
14976
14977 .option daemon_startup_retries main integer 9
14978 .cindex "daemon startup, retrying"
14979 This option, along with &%daemon_startup_sleep%&, controls the retrying done by
14980 the daemon at startup when it cannot immediately bind a listening socket
14981 (typically because the socket is already in use): &%daemon_startup_retries%&
14982 defines the number of retries after the first failure, and
14983 &%daemon_startup_sleep%& defines the length of time to wait between retries.
14984
14985 .option daemon_startup_sleep main time 30s
14986 See &%daemon_startup_retries%&.
14987
14988 .option delay_warning main "time list" 24h
14989 .cindex "warning of delay"
14990 .cindex "delay warning, specifying"
14991 .cindex "queue" "delay warning"
14992 When a message is delayed, Exim sends a warning message to the sender at
14993 intervals specified by this option. The data is a colon-separated list of times
14994 after which to send warning messages. If the value of the option is an empty
14995 string or a zero time, no warnings are sent. Up to 10 times may be given. If a
14996 message has been in the queue for longer than the last time, the last interval
14997 between the times is used to compute subsequent warning times. For example,
14998 with
14999 .code
15000 delay_warning = 4h:8h:24h
15001 .endd
15002 the first message is sent after 4 hours, the second after 8 hours, and
15003 the third one after 24 hours. After that, messages are sent every 16 hours,
15004 because that is the interval between the last two times on the list. If you set
15005 just one time, it specifies the repeat interval. For example, with:
15006 .code
15007 delay_warning = 6h
15008 .endd
15009 messages are repeated every six hours. To stop warnings after a given time, set
15010 a very large time at the end of the list. For example:
15011 .code
15012 delay_warning = 2h:12h:99d
15013 .endd
15014 Note that the option is only evaluated at the time a delivery attempt fails,
15015 which depends on retry and queue-runner configuration.
15016 Typically retries will be configured more frequently than warning messages.
15017
15018 .option delay_warning_condition main string&!! "see below"
15019 .vindex "&$domain$&"
15020 The string is expanded at the time a warning message might be sent. If all the
15021 deferred addresses have the same domain, it is set in &$domain$& during the
15022 expansion. Otherwise &$domain$& is empty. If the result of the expansion is a
15023 forced failure, an empty string, or a string matching any of &"0"&, &"no"& or
15024 &"false"& (the comparison being done caselessly) then the warning message is
15025 not sent. The default is:
15026 .code
15027 delay_warning_condition = ${if or {\
15028 { !eq{$h_list-id:$h_list-post:$h_list-subscribe:}{} }\
15029 { match{$h_precedence:}{(?i)bulk|list|junk} }\
15030 { match{$h_auto-submitted:}{(?i)auto-generated|auto-replied} }\
15031 } {no}{yes}}
15032 .endd
15033 This suppresses the sending of warnings for messages that contain &'List-ID:'&,
15034 &'List-Post:'&, or &'List-Subscribe:'& headers, or have &"bulk"&, &"list"& or
15035 &"junk"& in a &'Precedence:'& header, or have &"auto-generated"& or
15036 &"auto-replied"& in an &'Auto-Submitted:'& header.
15037
15038 .option deliver_drop_privilege main boolean false
15039 .cindex "unprivileged delivery"
15040 .cindex "delivery" "unprivileged"
15041 If this option is set true, Exim drops its root privilege at the start of a
15042 delivery process, and runs as the Exim user throughout. This severely restricts
15043 the kinds of local delivery that are possible, but is viable in certain types
15044 of configuration. There is a discussion about the use of root privilege in
15045 chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>&.
15046
15047 .option deliver_queue_load_max main fixed-point unset
15048 .cindex "load average"
15049 .cindex "queue runner" "abandoning"
15050 When this option is set, a queue run is abandoned if the system load average
15051 becomes greater than the value of the option. The option has no effect on
15052 ancient operating systems on which Exim cannot determine the load average.
15053 See also &%queue_only_load%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
15054
15055
15056 .option delivery_date_remove main boolean true
15057 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
15058 Exim's transports have an option for adding a &'Delivery-date:'& header to a
15059 message when it is delivered, in exactly the same way as &'Return-path:'& is
15060 handled. &'Delivery-date:'& records the actual time of delivery. Such headers
15061 should not be present in incoming messages, and this option causes them to be
15062 removed at the time the message is received, to avoid any problems that might
15063 occur when a delivered message is subsequently sent on to some other recipient.
15064
15065 .option disable_fsync main boolean false
15066 .cindex "&[fsync()]&, disabling"
15067 This option is available only if Exim was built with the compile-time option
15068 ENABLE_DISABLE_FSYNC. When this is not set, a reference to &%disable_fsync%& in
15069 a runtime configuration generates an &"unknown option"& error. You should not
15070 build Exim with ENABLE_DISABLE_FSYNC or set &%disable_fsync%& unless you
15071 really, really, really understand what you are doing. &'No pre-compiled
15072 distributions of Exim should ever make this option available.'&
15073
15074 When &%disable_fsync%& is set true, Exim no longer calls &[fsync()]& to force
15075 updated files' data to be written to disc before continuing. Unexpected events
15076 such as crashes and power outages may cause data to be lost or scrambled.
15077 Here be Dragons. &*Beware.*&
15078
15079
15080 .option disable_ipv6 main boolean false
15081 .cindex "IPv6" "disabling"
15082 If this option is set true, even if the Exim binary has IPv6 support, no IPv6
15083 activities take place. AAAA records are never looked up, and any IPv6 addresses
15084 that are listed in &%local_interfaces%&, data for the &%manualroute%& router,
15085 etc. are ignored. If IP literals are enabled, the &(ipliteral)& router declines
15086 to handle IPv6 literal addresses.
15087
15088
15089 .option dkim_verify_signers main "domain list&!!" $dkim_signers
15090 .cindex DKIM "controlling calls to the ACL"
15091 This option gives a list of DKIM domains for which the DKIM ACL is run.
15092 It is expanded after the message is received; by default it runs
15093 the ACL once for each signature in the message.
15094 See section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>&.
15095
15096
15097 .option dns_again_means_nonexist main "domain list&!!" unset
15098 .cindex "DNS" "&""try again""& response; overriding"
15099 DNS lookups give a &"try again"& response for the DNS errors
15100 &"non-authoritative host not found"& and &"SERVERFAIL"&. This can cause Exim to
15101 keep trying to deliver a message, or to give repeated temporary errors to
15102 incoming mail. Sometimes the effect is caused by a badly set up name server and
15103 may persist for a long time. If a domain which exhibits this problem matches
15104 anything in &%dns_again_means_nonexist%&, it is treated as if it did not exist.
15105 This option should be used with care. You can make it apply to reverse lookups
15106 by a setting such as this:
15107 .code
15108 dns_again_means_nonexist = *.in-addr.arpa
15109 .endd
15110 This option applies to all DNS lookups that Exim does. It also applies when the
15111 &[gethostbyname()]& or &[getipnodebyname()]& functions give temporary errors,
15112 since these are most likely to be caused by DNS lookup problems. The
15113 &(dnslookup)& router has some options of its own for controlling what happens
15114 when lookups for MX or SRV records give temporary errors. These more specific
15115 options are applied after this global option.
15116
15117 .option dns_check_names_pattern main string "see below"
15118 .cindex "DNS" "pre-check of name syntax"
15119 When this option is set to a non-empty string, it causes Exim to check domain
15120 names for characters that are not allowed in host names before handing them to
15121 the DNS resolver, because some resolvers give temporary errors for names that
15122 contain unusual characters. If a domain name contains any unwanted characters,
15123 a &"not found"& result is forced, and the resolver is not called. The check is
15124 done by matching the domain name against a regular expression, which is the
15125 value of this option. The default pattern is
15126 .code
15127 dns_check_names_pattern = \
15128 (?i)^(?>(?(1)\.|())[^\W_](?>[a-z0-9/-]*[^\W_])?)+$
15129 .endd
15130 which permits only letters, digits, slashes, and hyphens in components, but
15131 they must start and end with a letter or digit. Slashes are not, in fact,
15132 permitted in host names, but they are found in certain NS records (which can be
15133 accessed in Exim by using a &%dnsdb%& lookup). If you set
15134 &%allow_utf8_domains%&, you must modify this pattern, or set the option to an
15135 empty string.
15136
15137 .option dns_csa_search_limit main integer 5
15138 This option controls the depth of parental searching for CSA SRV records in the
15139 DNS, as described in more detail in section &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
15140
15141 .option dns_csa_use_reverse main boolean true
15142 This option controls whether or not an IP address, given as a CSA domain, is
15143 reversed and looked up in the reverse DNS, as described in more detail in
15144 section &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
15145
15146 .option dns_cname_loops main integer 1
15147 .cindex DNS "CNAME following"
15148 This option controls the following of CNAME chains, needed if the resolver does
15149 not do it internally.
15150 As of 2018 most should, and the default can be left.
15151 If you have an ancient one, a value of 10 is likely needed.
15152
15153 The default value of one CNAME-follow is needed
15154 thanks to the observed return for an MX request,
15155 given no MX presence but a CNAME to an A, of the CNAME.
15156
15157
15158 .option dns_dnssec_ok main integer -1
15159 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
15160 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
15161 If this option is set to a non-negative number then Exim will initialise the
15162 DNS resolver library to either use or not use DNSSEC, overriding the system
15163 default. A value of 0 coerces DNSSEC off, a value of 1 coerces DNSSEC on.
15164
15165 If the resolver library does not support DNSSEC then this option has no effect.
15166
15167
15168 .option dns_ipv4_lookup main "domain list&!!" unset
15169 .cindex "IPv6" "DNS lookup for AAAA records"
15170 .cindex "DNS" "IPv6 lookup for AAAA records"
15171 .cindex DNS "IPv6 disabling"
15172 When Exim is compiled with IPv6 support and &%disable_ipv6%& is not set, it
15173 looks for IPv6 address records (AAAA records) as well as IPv4 address records
15174 (A records) when trying to find IP addresses for hosts, unless the host's
15175 domain matches this list.
15176
15177 This is a fudge to help with name servers that give big delays or otherwise do
15178 not work for the AAAA record type. In due course, when the world's name
15179 servers have all been upgraded, there should be no need for this option.
15180 .new
15181 Note that all lookups, including those done for verification, are affected;
15182 this will result in verify failure for IPv6 connections or ones using names
15183 only valid for IPv6 addresses.
15184 .wen
15185
15186
15187 .option dns_retrans main time 0s
15188 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
15189 .cindex timeout "dns lookup"
15190 .cindex "DNS" timeout
15191 The options &%dns_retrans%& and &%dns_retry%& can be used to set the
15192 retransmission and retry parameters for DNS lookups. Values of zero (the
15193 defaults) leave the system default settings unchanged. The first value is the
15194 time between retries, and the second is the number of retries. It isn't
15195 totally clear exactly how these settings affect the total time a DNS lookup may
15196 take. I haven't found any documentation about timeouts on DNS lookups; these
15197 parameter values are available in the external resolver interface structure,
15198 but nowhere does it seem to describe how they are used or what you might want
15199 to set in them.
15200 See also the &%slow_lookup_log%& option.
15201
15202
15203 .option dns_retry main integer 0
15204 See &%dns_retrans%& above.
15205
15206
15207 .option dns_trust_aa main "domain list&!!" unset
15208 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
15209 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
15210 If this option is set then lookup results marked with the AA bit
15211 (Authoritative Answer) are trusted the same way as if they were
15212 DNSSEC-verified. The authority section's name of the answer must
15213 match with this expanded domain list.
15214
15215 Use this option only if you talk directly to a resolver that is
15216 authoritative for some zones and does not set the AD (Authentic Data)
15217 bit in the answer. Some DNS servers may have an configuration option to
15218 mark the answers from their own zones as verified (they set the AD bit).
15219 Others do not have this option. It is considered as poor practice using
15220 a resolver that is an authoritative server for some zones.
15221
15222 Use this option only if you really have to (e.g. if you want
15223 to use DANE for remote delivery to a server that is listed in the DNS
15224 zones that your resolver is authoritative for).
15225
15226 If the DNS answer packet has the AA bit set and contains resource record
15227 in the answer section, the name of the first NS record appearing in the
15228 authority section is compared against the list. If the answer packet is
15229 authoritative but the answer section is empty, the name of the first SOA
15230 record in the authoritative section is used instead.
15231
15232 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
15233 .option dns_use_edns0 main integer -1
15234 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
15235 .cindex "DNS" "EDNS0"
15236 .cindex "DNS" "OpenBSD
15237 If this option is set to a non-negative number then Exim will initialise the
15238 DNS resolver library to either use or not use EDNS0 extensions, overriding
15239 the system default. A value of 0 coerces EDNS0 off, a value of 1 coerces EDNS0
15240 on.
15241
15242 If the resolver library does not support EDNS0 then this option has no effect.
15243
15244 OpenBSD's asr resolver routines are known to ignore the EDNS0 option; this
15245 means that DNSSEC will not work with Exim on that platform either, unless Exim
15246 is linked against an alternative DNS client library.
15247
15248
15249 .option drop_cr main boolean false
15250 This is an obsolete option that is now a no-op. It used to affect the way Exim
15251 handled CR and LF characters in incoming messages. What happens now is
15252 described in section &<<SECTlineendings>>&.
15253
15254 .option dsn_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15255 .cindex "bounce messages" "success"
15256 .cindex "DSN" "success"
15257 .cindex "Delivery Status Notification" "success"
15258 DSN extensions (RFC3461) will be advertised in the EHLO message to,
15259 and accepted from, these hosts.
15260 Hosts may use the NOTIFY and ENVID options on RCPT TO commands,
15261 and RET and ORCPT options on MAIL FROM commands.
15262 A NOTIFY=SUCCESS option requests success-DSN messages.
15263 A NOTIFY= option with no argument requests that no delay or failure DSNs
15264 are sent.
15265
15266 .option dsn_from main "string&!!" "see below"
15267 .cindex "&'From:'& header line" "in bounces"
15268 .cindex "bounce messages" "&'From:'& line, specifying"
15269 This option can be used to vary the contents of &'From:'& header lines in
15270 bounces and other automatically generated messages (&"Delivery Status
15271 Notifications"& &-- hence the name of the option). The default setting is:
15272 .code
15273 dsn_from = Mail Delivery System <Mailer-Daemon@$qualify_domain>
15274 .endd
15275 The value is expanded every time it is needed. If the expansion fails, a
15276 panic is logged, and the default value is used.
15277
15278 .option envelope_to_remove main boolean true
15279 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
15280 Exim's transports have an option for adding an &'Envelope-to:'& header to a
15281 message when it is delivered, in exactly the same way as &'Return-path:'& is
15282 handled. &'Envelope-to:'& records the original recipient address from the
15283 message's envelope that caused the delivery to happen. Such headers should not
15284 be present in incoming messages, and this option causes them to be removed at
15285 the time the message is received, to avoid any problems that might occur when a
15286 delivered message is subsequently sent on to some other recipient.
15287
15288
15289 .option errors_copy main "string list&!!" unset
15290 .cindex "bounce message" "copy to other address"
15291 .cindex "copy of bounce message"
15292 Setting this option causes Exim to send bcc copies of bounce messages that it
15293 generates to other addresses. &*Note*&: This does not apply to bounce messages
15294 coming from elsewhere. The value of the option is a colon-separated list of
15295 items. Each item consists of a pattern, terminated by white space, followed by
15296 a comma-separated list of email addresses. If a pattern contains spaces, it
15297 must be enclosed in double quotes.
15298
15299 Each pattern is processed in the same way as a single item in an address list
15300 (see section &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). When a pattern matches the recipient of
15301 the bounce message, the message is copied to the addresses on the list. The
15302 items are scanned in order, and once a matching one is found, no further items
15303 are examined. For example:
15304 .code
15305 errors_copy = spqr@mydomain postmaster@mydomain.example :\
15306 rqps@mydomain hostmaster@mydomain.example,\
15307 postmaster@mydomain.example
15308 .endd
15309 .vindex "&$domain$&"
15310 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
15311 The address list is expanded before use. The expansion variables &$local_part$&
15312 and &$domain$& are set from the original recipient of the error message, and if
15313 there was any wildcard matching in the pattern, the expansion
15314 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%errors_copy%&"
15315 variables &$0$&, &$1$&, etc. are set in the normal way.
15316
15317
15318 .option errors_reply_to main string unset
15319 .cindex "bounce message" "&'Reply-to:'& in"
15320 By default, Exim's bounce and delivery warning messages contain the header line
15321 .display
15322 &`From: Mail Delivery System <Mailer-Daemon@`&&'qualify-domain'&&`>`&
15323 .endd
15324 .oindex &%quota_warn_message%&
15325 where &'qualify-domain'& is the value of the &%qualify_domain%& option.
15326 A warning message that is generated by the &%quota_warn_message%& option in an
15327 &(appendfile)& transport may contain its own &'From:'& header line that
15328 overrides the default.
15329
15330 Experience shows that people reply to bounce messages. If the
15331 &%errors_reply_to%& option is set, a &'Reply-To:'& header is added to bounce
15332 and warning messages. For example:
15333 .code
15334 errors_reply_to = postmaster@my.domain.example
15335 .endd
15336 The value of the option is not expanded. It must specify a valid RFC 2822
15337 address. However, if a warning message that is generated by the
15338 &%quota_warn_message%& option in an &(appendfile)& transport contain its
15339 own &'Reply-To:'& header line, the value of the &%errors_reply_to%& option is
15340 not used.
15341
15342
15343 .option event_action main string&!! unset
15344 .cindex events
15345 This option declares a string to be expanded for Exim's events mechanism.
15346 For details see chapter &<<CHAPevents>>&.
15347
15348
15349 .option exim_group main string "compile-time configured"
15350 .cindex "gid (group id)" "Exim's own"
15351 .cindex "Exim group"
15352 This option changes the gid under which Exim runs when it gives up root
15353 privilege. The default value is compiled into the binary. The value of this
15354 option is used only when &%exim_user%& is also set. Unless it consists entirely
15355 of digits, the string is looked up using &[getgrnam()]&, and failure causes a
15356 configuration error. See chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for a discussion of
15357 security issues.
15358
15359
15360 .option exim_path main string "see below"
15361 .cindex "Exim binary, path name"
15362 This option specifies the path name of the Exim binary, which is used when Exim
15363 needs to re-exec itself. The default is set up to point to the file &'exim'& in
15364 the directory configured at compile time by the BIN_DIRECTORY setting. It
15365 is necessary to change &%exim_path%& if, exceptionally, Exim is run from some
15366 other place.
15367 &*Warning*&: Do not use a macro to define the value of this option, because
15368 you will break those Exim utilities that scan the configuration file to find
15369 where the binary is. (They then use the &%-bP%& option to extract option
15370 settings such as the value of &%spool_directory%&.)
15371
15372
15373 .option exim_user main string "compile-time configured"
15374 .cindex "uid (user id)" "Exim's own"
15375 .cindex "Exim user"
15376 This option changes the uid under which Exim runs when it gives up root
15377 privilege. The default value is compiled into the binary. Ownership of the run
15378 time configuration file and the use of the &%-C%& and &%-D%& command line
15379 options is checked against the values in the binary, not what is set here.
15380
15381 Unless it consists entirely of digits, the string is looked up using
15382 &[getpwnam()]&, and failure causes a configuration error. If &%exim_group%& is
15383 not also supplied, the gid is taken from the result of &[getpwnam()]& if it is
15384 used. See chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for a discussion of security issues.
15385
15386
15387 .option exim_version main string "current version"
15388 .cindex "Exim version"
15389 .cindex customizing "version number"
15390 .cindex "version number of Exim" override
15391 This option allows to override the &$version_number$&/&$exim_version$& Exim reports in
15392 various places. Use with care, this may fool stupid security scanners.
15393
15394
15395 .option extra_local_interfaces main "string list" unset
15396 This option defines network interfaces that are to be considered local when
15397 routing, but which are not used for listening by the daemon. See section
15398 &<<SECTreclocipadd>>& for details.
15399
15400
15401 . Allow this long option name to split; give it unsplit as a fifth argument
15402 . for the automatic .oindex that is generated by .option.
15403
15404 .option "extract_addresses_remove_arguments" main boolean true &&&
15405 extract_addresses_remove_arguments
15406 .oindex "&%-t%&"
15407 .cindex "command line" "addresses with &%-t%&"
15408 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-t%& option"
15409 According to some Sendmail documentation (Sun, IRIX, HP-UX), if any addresses
15410 are present on the command line when the &%-t%& option is used to build an
15411 envelope from a message's &'To:'&, &'Cc:'& and &'Bcc:'& headers, the command
15412 line addresses are removed from the recipients list. This is also how Smail
15413 behaves. However, other Sendmail documentation (the O'Reilly book) states that
15414 command line addresses are added to those obtained from the header lines. When
15415 &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& is true (the default), Exim subtracts
15416 argument headers. If it is set false, Exim adds rather than removes argument
15417 addresses.
15418
15419
15420 .option finduser_retries main integer 0
15421 .cindex "NIS, retrying user lookups"
15422 On systems running NIS or other schemes in which user and group information is
15423 distributed from a remote system, there can be times when &[getpwnam()]& and
15424 related functions fail, even when given valid data, because things time out.
15425 Unfortunately these failures cannot be distinguished from genuine &"not found"&
15426 errors. If &%finduser_retries%& is set greater than zero, Exim will try that
15427 many extra times to find a user or a group, waiting for one second between
15428 retries.
15429
15430 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&" "multiple reading of"
15431 You should not set this option greater than zero if your user information is in
15432 a traditional &_/etc/passwd_& file, because it will cause Exim needlessly to
15433 search the file multiple times for non-existent users, and also cause delay.
15434
15435
15436
15437 .option freeze_tell main "string list, comma separated" unset
15438 .cindex "freezing messages" "sending a message when freezing"
15439 On encountering certain errors, or when configured to do so in a system filter,
15440 ACL, or special router, Exim freezes a message. This means that no further
15441 delivery attempts take place until an administrator thaws the message, or the
15442 &%auto_thaw%&, &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&, or &%timeout_frozen_after%&
15443 feature cause it to be processed. If &%freeze_tell%& is set, Exim generates a
15444 warning message whenever it freezes something, unless the message it is
15445 freezing is a locally-generated bounce message. (Without this exception there
15446 is the possibility of looping.) The warning message is sent to the addresses
15447 supplied as the comma-separated value of this option. If several of the
15448 message's addresses cause freezing, only a single message is sent. If the
15449 freezing was automatic, the reason(s) for freezing can be found in the message
15450 log. If you configure freezing in a filter or ACL, you must arrange for any
15451 logging that you require.
15452
15453
15454 .option gecos_name main string&!! unset
15455 .cindex "HP-UX"
15456 .cindex "&""gecos""& field, parsing"
15457 Some operating systems, notably HP-UX, use the &"gecos"& field in the system
15458 password file to hold other information in addition to users' real names. Exim
15459 looks up this field for use when it is creating &'Sender:'& or &'From:'&
15460 headers. If either &%gecos_pattern%& or &%gecos_name%& are unset, the contents
15461 of the field are used unchanged, except that, if an ampersand is encountered,
15462 it is replaced by the user's login name with the first character forced to
15463 upper case, since this is a convention that is observed on many systems.
15464
15465 When these options are set, &%gecos_pattern%& is treated as a regular
15466 expression that is to be applied to the field (again with && replaced by the
15467 login name), and if it matches, &%gecos_name%& is expanded and used as the
15468 user's name.
15469
15470 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%gecos_name%&"
15471 Numeric variables such as &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. can be used in the expansion to
15472 pick up sub-fields that were matched by the pattern. In HP-UX, where the user's
15473 name terminates at the first comma, the following can be used:
15474 .code
15475 gecos_pattern = ([^,]*)
15476 gecos_name = $1
15477 .endd
15478
15479 .option gecos_pattern main string unset
15480 See &%gecos_name%& above.
15481
15482
15483 .option gnutls_compat_mode main boolean unset
15484 This option controls whether GnuTLS is used in compatibility mode in an Exim
15485 server. This reduces security slightly, but improves interworking with older
15486 implementations of TLS.
15487
15488
15489 .option gnutls_allow_auto_pkcs11 main boolean unset
15490 This option will let GnuTLS (2.12.0 or later) autoload PKCS11 modules with
15491 the p11-kit configuration files in &_/etc/pkcs11/modules/_&.
15492
15493 See
15494 &url(https://www.gnutls.org/manual/gnutls.html#Smart-cards-and-HSMs)
15495 for documentation.
15496
15497
15498
15499 .option headers_charset main string "see below"
15500 This option sets a default character set for translating from encoded MIME
15501 &"words"& in header lines, when referenced by an &$h_xxx$& expansion item. The
15502 default is the value of HEADERS_CHARSET in &_Local/Makefile_&. The
15503 ultimate default is ISO-8859-1. For more details see the description of header
15504 insertions in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>&.
15505
15506
15507
15508 .option header_maxsize main integer "see below"
15509 .cindex "header section" "maximum size of"
15510 .cindex "limit" "size of message header section"
15511 This option controls the overall maximum size of a message's header
15512 section. The default is the value of HEADER_MAXSIZE in
15513 &_Local/Makefile_&; the default for that is 1M. Messages with larger header
15514 sections are rejected.
15515
15516
15517 .option header_line_maxsize main integer 0
15518 .cindex "header lines" "maximum size of"
15519 .cindex "limit" "size of one header line"
15520 This option limits the length of any individual header line in a message, after
15521 all the continuations have been joined together. Messages with individual
15522 header lines that are longer than the limit are rejected. The default value of
15523 zero means &"no limit"&.
15524
15525
15526
15527
15528 .option helo_accept_junk_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15529 .cindex "HELO" "accepting junk data"
15530 .cindex "EHLO" "accepting junk data"
15531 Exim checks the syntax of HELO and EHLO commands for incoming SMTP
15532 mail, and gives an error response for invalid data. Unfortunately, there are
15533 some SMTP clients that send syntactic junk. They can be accommodated by setting
15534 this option. Note that this is a syntax check only. See &%helo_verify_hosts%&
15535 if you want to do semantic checking.
15536 See also &%helo_allow_chars%& for a way of extending the permitted character
15537 set.
15538
15539
15540 .option helo_allow_chars main string unset
15541 .cindex "HELO" "underscores in"
15542 .cindex "EHLO" "underscores in"
15543 .cindex "underscore in EHLO/HELO"
15544 This option can be set to a string of rogue characters that are permitted in
15545 all EHLO and HELO names in addition to the standard letters, digits,
15546 hyphens, and dots. If you really must allow underscores, you can set
15547 .code
15548 helo_allow_chars = _
15549 .endd
15550 Note that the value is one string, not a list.
15551
15552
15553 .option helo_lookup_domains main "domain list&!!" &`@:@[]`&
15554 .cindex "HELO" "forcing reverse lookup"
15555 .cindex "EHLO" "forcing reverse lookup"
15556 If the domain given by a client in a HELO or EHLO command matches this
15557 list, a reverse lookup is done in order to establish the host's true name. The
15558 default forces a lookup if the client host gives the server's name or any of
15559 its IP addresses (in brackets), something that broken clients have been seen to
15560 do.
15561
15562
15563 .option helo_try_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15564 .cindex "HELO verifying" "optional"
15565 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying, optional"
15566 By default, Exim just checks the syntax of HELO and EHLO commands (see
15567 &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& and &%helo_allow_chars%&). However, some sites like
15568 to do more extensive checking of the data supplied by these commands. The ACL
15569 condition &`verify = helo`& is provided to make this possible.
15570 Formerly, it was necessary also to set this option (&%helo_try_verify_hosts%&)
15571 to force the check to occur. From release 4.53 onwards, this is no longer
15572 necessary. If the check has not been done before &`verify = helo`& is
15573 encountered, it is done at that time. Consequently, this option is obsolete.
15574 Its specification is retained here for backwards compatibility.
15575
15576 When an EHLO or HELO command is received, if the calling host matches
15577 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&, Exim checks that the host name given in the HELO or
15578 EHLO command either:
15579
15580 .ilist
15581 is an IP literal matching the calling address of the host, or
15582 .next
15583 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
15584 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
15585 matches the host name that Exim obtains by doing a reverse lookup of the
15586 calling host address, or
15587 .next
15588 when looked up in DNS yields the calling host address.
15589 .endlist
15590
15591 However, the EHLO or HELO command is not rejected if any of the checks
15592 fail. Processing continues, but the result of the check is remembered, and can
15593 be detected later in an ACL by the &`verify = helo`& condition.
15594
15595 If DNS was used for successful verification, the variable
15596 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
15597 &$helo_verify_dnssec$& records the DNSSEC status of the lookups.
15598
15599 .option helo_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15600 .cindex "HELO verifying" "mandatory"
15601 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying, mandatory"
15602 Like &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&, this option is obsolete, and retained only for
15603 backwards compatibility. For hosts that match this option, Exim checks the host
15604 name given in the HELO or EHLO in the same way as for
15605 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&. If the check fails, the HELO or EHLO command is
15606 rejected with a 550 error, and entries are written to the main and reject logs.
15607 If a MAIL command is received before EHLO or HELO, it is rejected with a 503
15608 error.
15609
15610 .option hold_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
15611 .cindex "domain" "delaying delivery"
15612 .cindex "delivery" "delaying certain domains"
15613 This option allows mail for particular domains to be held in the queue
15614 manually. The option is overridden if a message delivery is forced with the
15615 &%-M%&, &%-qf%&, &%-Rf%& or &%-Sf%& options, and also while testing or
15616 verifying addresses using &%-bt%& or &%-bv%&. Otherwise, if a domain matches an
15617 item in &%hold_domains%&, no routing or delivery for that address is done, and
15618 it is deferred every time the message is looked at.
15619
15620 This option is intended as a temporary operational measure for delaying the
15621 delivery of mail while some problem is being sorted out, or some new
15622 configuration tested. If you just want to delay the processing of some
15623 domains until a queue run occurs, you should use &%queue_domains%& or
15624 &%queue_smtp_domains%&, not &%hold_domains%&.
15625
15626 A setting of &%hold_domains%& does not override Exim's code for removing
15627 messages from the queue if they have been there longer than the longest retry
15628 time in any retry rule. If you want to hold messages for longer than the normal
15629 retry times, insert a dummy retry rule with a long retry time.
15630
15631
15632 .option host_lookup main "host list&!!" unset
15633 .cindex "host name" "lookup, forcing"
15634 Exim does not look up the name of a calling host from its IP address unless it
15635 is required to compare against some host list, or the host matches
15636 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& or &%helo_verify_hosts%&, or the host matches this
15637 option (which normally contains IP addresses rather than host names). The
15638 default configuration file contains
15639 .code
15640 host_lookup = *
15641 .endd
15642 which causes a lookup to happen for all hosts. If the expense of these lookups
15643 is felt to be too great, the setting can be changed or removed.
15644
15645 After a successful reverse lookup, Exim does a forward lookup on the name it
15646 has obtained, to verify that it yields the IP address that it started with. If
15647 this check fails, Exim behaves as if the name lookup failed.
15648
15649 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
15650 .vindex "&$sender_host_name$&"
15651 After any kind of failure, the host name (in &$sender_host_name$&) remains
15652 unset, and &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to the string &"1"&. See also
15653 &%dns_again_means_nonexist%&, &%helo_lookup_domains%&, and
15654 &`verify = reverse_host_lookup`& in ACLs.
15655
15656
15657 .option host_lookup_order main "string list" &`bydns:byaddr`&
15658 This option specifies the order of different lookup methods when Exim is trying
15659 to find a host name from an IP address. The default is to do a DNS lookup
15660 first, and then to try a local lookup (using &[gethostbyaddr()]& or equivalent)
15661 if that fails. You can change the order of these lookups, or omit one entirely,
15662 if you want.
15663
15664 &*Warning*&: The &"byaddr"& method does not always yield aliases when there are
15665 multiple PTR records in the DNS and the IP address is not listed in
15666 &_/etc/hosts_&. Different operating systems give different results in this
15667 case. That is why the default tries a DNS lookup first.
15668
15669
15670
15671 .option host_reject_connection main "host list&!!" unset
15672 .cindex "host" "rejecting connections from"
15673 If this option is set, incoming SMTP calls from the hosts listed are rejected
15674 as soon as the connection is made.
15675 This option is obsolete, and retained only for backward compatibility, because
15676 nowadays the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_connect%& can also reject incoming
15677 connections immediately.
15678
15679 The ability to give an immediate rejection (either by this option or using an
15680 ACL) is provided for use in unusual cases. Many hosts will just try again,
15681 sometimes without much delay. Normally, it is better to use an ACL to reject
15682 incoming messages at a later stage, such as after RCPT commands. See
15683 chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&.
15684
15685
15686 .option hosts_connection_nolog main "host list&!!" unset
15687 .cindex "host" "not logging connections from"
15688 This option defines a list of hosts for which connection logging does not
15689 happen, even though the &%smtp_connection%& log selector is set. For example,
15690 you might want not to log SMTP connections from local processes, or from
15691 127.0.0.1, or from your local LAN. This option is consulted in the main loop of
15692 the daemon; you should therefore strive to restrict its value to a short inline
15693 list of IP addresses and networks. To disable logging SMTP connections from
15694 local processes, you must create a host list with an empty item. For example:
15695 .code
15696 hosts_connection_nolog = :
15697 .endd
15698 If the &%smtp_connection%& log selector is not set, this option has no effect.
15699
15700
15701
15702 .option hosts_proxy main "host list&!!" unset
15703 .cindex proxy "proxy protocol"
15704 This option enables use of Proxy Protocol proxies for incoming
15705 connections. For details see section &<<SECTproxyInbound>>&.
15706
15707
15708 .option hosts_treat_as_local main "domain list&!!" unset
15709 .cindex "local host" "domains treated as"
15710 .cindex "host" "treated as local"
15711 If this option is set, any host names that match the domain list are treated as
15712 if they were the local host when Exim is scanning host lists obtained from MX
15713 records
15714 or other sources. Note that the value of this option is a domain list, not a
15715 host list, because it is always used to check host names, not IP addresses.
15716
15717 This option also applies when Exim is matching the special items
15718 &`@mx_any`&, &`@mx_primary`&, and &`@mx_secondary`& in a domain list (see
15719 section &<<SECTdomainlist>>&), and when checking the &%hosts%& option in the
15720 &(smtp)& transport for the local host (see the &%allow_localhost%& option in
15721 that transport). See also &%local_interfaces%&, &%extra_local_interfaces%&, and
15722 chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>&, which contains a discussion about local network
15723 interfaces and recognizing the local host.
15724
15725
15726 .option ibase_servers main "string list" unset
15727 .cindex "InterBase" "server list"
15728 This option provides a list of InterBase servers and associated connection data,
15729 to be used in conjunction with &(ibase)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&).
15730 The option is available only if Exim has been built with InterBase support.
15731
15732
15733
15734 .option ignore_bounce_errors_after main time 10w
15735 .cindex "bounce message" "discarding"
15736 .cindex "discarding bounce message"
15737 This option affects the processing of bounce messages that cannot be delivered,
15738 that is, those that suffer a permanent delivery failure. (Bounce messages that
15739 suffer temporary delivery failures are of course retried in the usual way.)
15740
15741 After a permanent delivery failure, bounce messages are frozen,
15742 because there is no sender to whom they can be returned. When a frozen bounce
15743 message has been in the queue for more than the given time, it is unfrozen at
15744 the next queue run, and a further delivery is attempted. If delivery fails
15745 again, the bounce message is discarded. This makes it possible to keep failed
15746 bounce messages around for a shorter time than the normal maximum retry time
15747 for frozen messages. For example,
15748 .code
15749 ignore_bounce_errors_after = 12h
15750 .endd
15751 retries failed bounce message deliveries after 12 hours, discarding any further
15752 failures. If the value of this option is set to a zero time period, bounce
15753 failures are discarded immediately. Setting a very long time (as in the default
15754 value) has the effect of disabling this option. For ways of automatically
15755 dealing with other kinds of frozen message, see &%auto_thaw%& and
15756 &%timeout_frozen_after%&.
15757
15758
15759 .option ignore_fromline_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15760 .cindex "&""From""& line"
15761 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
15762 Some broken SMTP clients insist on sending a UUCP-like &"From&~"& line before
15763 the headers of a message. By default this is treated as the start of the
15764 message's body, which means that any following headers are not recognized as
15765 such. Exim can be made to ignore it by setting &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& to
15766 match those hosts that insist on sending it. If the sender is actually a local
15767 process rather than a remote host, and is using &%-bs%& to inject the messages,
15768 &%ignore_fromline_local%& must be set to achieve this effect.
15769
15770
15771 .option ignore_fromline_local main boolean false
15772 See &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& above.
15773
15774 .option keep_environment main "string list" unset
15775 .cindex "environment" "values from"
15776 This option contains a string list of environment variables to keep.
15777 You have to trust these variables or you have to be sure that
15778 these variables do not impose any security risk. Keep in mind that
15779 during the startup phase Exim is running with an effective UID 0 in most
15780 installations. As the default value is an empty list, the default
15781 environment for using libraries, running embedded Perl code, or running
15782 external binaries is empty, and does not not even contain PATH or HOME.
15783
15784 Actually the list is interpreted as a list of patterns
15785 (&<<SECTlistexpand>>&), except that it is not expanded first.
15786
15787 WARNING: Macro substitution is still done first, so having a macro
15788 FOO and having FOO_HOME in your &%keep_environment%& option may have
15789 unexpected results. You may work around this using a regular expression
15790 that does not match the macro name: ^[F]OO_HOME$.
15791
15792 Current versions of Exim issue a warning during startup if you do not mention
15793 &%keep_environment%& in your runtime configuration file and if your
15794 current environment is not empty. Future versions may not issue that warning
15795 anymore.
15796
15797 See the &%add_environment%& main config option for a way to set
15798 environment variables to a fixed value. The environment for &(pipe)&
15799 transports is handled separately, see section &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for
15800 details.
15801
15802
15803 .option keep_malformed main time 4d
15804 This option specifies the length of time to keep messages whose spool files
15805 have been corrupted in some way. This should, of course, never happen. At the
15806 next attempt to deliver such a message, it gets removed. The incident is
15807 logged.
15808
15809
15810 .option ldap_ca_cert_dir main string unset
15811 .cindex "LDAP", "TLS CA certificate directory"
15812 .cindex certificate "directory for LDAP"
15813 This option indicates which directory contains CA certificates for verifying
15814 a TLS certificate presented by an LDAP server.
15815 While Exim does not provide a default value, your SSL library may.
15816 Analogous to &%tls_verify_certificates%& but as a client-side option for LDAP
15817 and constrained to be a directory.
15818
15819
15820 .option ldap_ca_cert_file main string unset
15821 .cindex "LDAP", "TLS CA certificate file"
15822 .cindex certificate "file for LDAP"
15823 This option indicates which file contains CA certificates for verifying
15824 a TLS certificate presented by an LDAP server.
15825 While Exim does not provide a default value, your SSL library may.
15826 Analogous to &%tls_verify_certificates%& but as a client-side option for LDAP
15827 and constrained to be a file.
15828
15829
15830 .option ldap_cert_file main string unset
15831 .cindex "LDAP" "TLS client certificate file"
15832 .cindex certificate "file for LDAP"
15833 This option indicates which file contains an TLS client certificate which
15834 Exim should present to the LDAP server during TLS negotiation.
15835 Should be used together with &%ldap_cert_key%&.
15836
15837
15838 .option ldap_cert_key main string unset
15839 .cindex "LDAP" "TLS client key file"
15840 .cindex certificate "key for LDAP"
15841 This option indicates which file contains the secret/private key to use
15842 to prove identity to the LDAP server during TLS negotiation.
15843 Should be used together with &%ldap_cert_file%&, which contains the
15844 identity to be proven.
15845
15846
15847 .option ldap_cipher_suite main string unset
15848 .cindex "LDAP" "TLS cipher suite"
15849 This controls the TLS cipher-suite negotiation during TLS negotiation with
15850 the LDAP server. See &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& for more details of the format of
15851 cipher-suite options with OpenSSL (as used by LDAP client libraries).
15852
15853
15854 .option ldap_default_servers main "string list" unset
15855 .cindex "LDAP" "default servers"
15856 This option provides a list of LDAP servers which are tried in turn when an
15857 LDAP query does not contain a server. See section &<<SECTforldaque>>& for
15858 details of LDAP queries. This option is available only when Exim has been built
15859 with LDAP support.
15860
15861
15862 .option ldap_require_cert main string unset.
15863 .cindex "LDAP" "policy for LDAP server TLS cert presentation"
15864 This should be one of the values "hard", "demand", "allow", "try" or "never".
15865 A value other than one of these is interpreted as "never".
15866 See the entry "TLS_REQCERT" in your system man page for ldap.conf(5).
15867 Although Exim does not set a default, the LDAP library probably defaults
15868 to hard/demand.
15869
15870
15871 .option ldap_start_tls main boolean false
15872 .cindex "LDAP" "whether or not to negotiate TLS"
15873 If set, Exim will attempt to negotiate TLS with the LDAP server when
15874 connecting on a regular LDAP port. This is the LDAP equivalent of SMTP's
15875 "STARTTLS". This is distinct from using "ldaps", which is the LDAP form
15876 of SSL-on-connect.
15877 In the event of failure to negotiate TLS, the action taken is controlled
15878 by &%ldap_require_cert%&.
15879 This option is ignored for &`ldapi`& connections.
15880
15881
15882 .option ldap_version main integer unset
15883 .cindex "LDAP" "protocol version, forcing"
15884 This option can be used to force Exim to set a specific protocol version for
15885 LDAP. If it option is unset, it is shown by the &%-bP%& command line option as
15886 -1. When this is the case, the default is 3 if LDAP_VERSION3 is defined in
15887 the LDAP headers; otherwise it is 2. This option is available only when Exim
15888 has been built with LDAP support.
15889
15890
15891
15892 .option local_from_check main boolean true
15893 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line" "disabling addition of"
15894 .cindex "&'From:'& header line" "disabling checking of"
15895 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP/IP connection) by
15896 an untrusted user, Exim removes any existing &'Sender:'& header line, and
15897 checks that the &'From:'& header line matches the login of the calling user and
15898 the domain specified by &%qualify_domain%&.
15899
15900 &*Note*&: An unqualified address (no domain) in the &'From:'& header in a
15901 locally submitted message is automatically qualified by Exim, unless the
15902 &%-bnq%& command line option is used.
15903
15904 You can use &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%& to permit affixes
15905 on the local part. If the &'From:'& header line does not match, Exim adds a
15906 &'Sender:'& header with an address constructed from the calling user's login
15907 and the default qualify domain.
15908
15909 If &%local_from_check%& is set false, the &'From:'& header check is disabled,
15910 and no &'Sender:'& header is ever added. If, in addition, you want to retain
15911 &'Sender:'& header lines supplied by untrusted users, you must also set
15912 &%local_sender_retain%& to be true.
15913
15914 .cindex "envelope from"
15915 .cindex "envelope sender"
15916 These options affect only the header lines in the message. The envelope sender
15917 is still forced to be the login id at the qualify domain unless
15918 &%untrusted_set_sender%& permits the user to supply an envelope sender.
15919
15920 For messages received over TCP/IP, an ACL can specify &"submission mode"& to
15921 request similar header line checking. See section &<<SECTthesenhea>>&, which
15922 has more details about &'Sender:'& processing.
15923
15924
15925
15926
15927 .option local_from_prefix main string unset
15928 When Exim checks the &'From:'& header line of locally submitted messages for
15929 matching the login id (see &%local_from_check%& above), it can be configured to
15930 ignore certain prefixes and suffixes in the local part of the address. This is
15931 done by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and/or &%local_from_suffix%& to
15932 appropriate lists, in the same form as the &%local_part_prefix%& and
15933 &%local_part_suffix%& router options (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&). For
15934 example, if
15935 .code
15936 local_from_prefix = *-
15937 .endd
15938 is set, a &'From:'& line containing
15939 .code
15940 From: anything-user@your.domain.example
15941 .endd
15942 will not cause a &'Sender:'& header to be added if &'user@your.domain.example'&
15943 matches the actual sender address that is constructed from the login name and
15944 qualify domain.
15945
15946
15947 .option local_from_suffix main string unset
15948 See &%local_from_prefix%& above.
15949
15950
15951 .option local_interfaces main "string list" "see below"
15952 This option controls which network interfaces are used by the daemon for
15953 listening; they are also used to identify the local host when routing. Chapter
15954 &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& contains a full description of this option and the related
15955 options &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, &%extra_local_interfaces%&,
15956 &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, and &%tls_on_connect_ports%&. The default value for
15957 &%local_interfaces%& is
15958 .code
15959 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0
15960 .endd
15961 when Exim is built without IPv6 support; otherwise it is
15962 .code
15963 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
15964 .endd
15965
15966 .option local_scan_timeout main time 5m
15967 .cindex "timeout" "for &[local_scan()]& function"
15968 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "timeout"
15969 This timeout applies to the &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter
15970 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&). Zero means &"no timeout"&. If the timeout is exceeded,
15971 the incoming message is rejected with a temporary error if it is an SMTP
15972 message. For a non-SMTP message, the message is dropped and Exim ends with a
15973 non-zero code. The incident is logged on the main and reject logs.
15974
15975
15976
15977 .option local_sender_retain main boolean false
15978 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line" "retaining from local submission"
15979 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP/IP connection) by
15980 an untrusted user, Exim removes any existing &'Sender:'& header line. If you
15981 do not want this to happen, you must set &%local_sender_retain%&, and you must
15982 also set &%local_from_check%& to be false (Exim will complain if you do not).
15983 See also the ACL modifier &`control = suppress_local_fixups`&. Section
15984 &<<SECTthesenhea>>& has more details about &'Sender:'& processing.
15985
15986
15987
15988
15989 .option localhost_number main string&!! unset
15990 .cindex "host" "locally unique number for"
15991 .cindex "message ids" "with multiple hosts"
15992 .vindex "&$localhost_number$&"
15993 Exim's message ids are normally unique only within the local host. If
15994 uniqueness among a set of hosts is required, each host must set a different
15995 value for the &%localhost_number%& option. The string is expanded immediately
15996 after reading the configuration file (so that a number can be computed from the
15997 host name, for example) and the result of the expansion must be a number in the
15998 range 0&--16 (or 0&--10 on operating systems with case-insensitive file
15999 systems). This is available in subsequent string expansions via the variable
16000 &$localhost_number$&. When &%localhost_number is set%&, the final two
16001 characters of the message id, instead of just being a fractional part of the
16002 time, are computed from the time and the local host number as described in
16003 section &<<SECTmessiden>>&.
16004
16005
16006
16007 .option log_file_path main "string list&!!" "set at compile time"
16008 .cindex "log" "file path for"
16009 This option sets the path which is used to determine the names of Exim's log
16010 files, or indicates that logging is to be to syslog, or both. It is expanded
16011 when Exim is entered, so it can, for example, contain a reference to the host
16012 name. If no specific path is set for the log files at compile or runtime,
16013 or if the option is unset at runtime (i.e. &`log_file_path = `&)
16014 they are written in a sub-directory called &_log_& in Exim's spool directory.
16015 Chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& contains further details about Exim's logging, and
16016 section &<<SECTwhelogwri>>& describes how the contents of &%log_file_path%& are
16017 used. If this string is fixed at your installation (contains no expansion
16018 variables) it is recommended that you do not set this option in the
16019 configuration file, but instead supply the path using LOG_FILE_PATH in
16020 &_Local/Makefile_& so that it is available to Exim for logging errors detected
16021 early on &-- in particular, failure to read the configuration file.
16022
16023
16024 .option log_selector main string unset
16025 .cindex "log" "selectors"
16026 This option can be used to reduce or increase the number of things that Exim
16027 writes to its log files. Its argument is made up of names preceded by plus or
16028 minus characters. For example:
16029 .code
16030 log_selector = +arguments -retry_defer
16031 .endd
16032 A list of possible names and what they control is given in the chapter on
16033 logging, in section &<<SECTlogselector>>&.
16034
16035
16036 .option log_timezone main boolean false
16037 .cindex "log" "timezone for entries"
16038 .vindex "&$tod_log$&"
16039 .vindex "&$tod_zone$&"
16040 By default, the timestamps on log lines are in local time without the
16041 timezone. This means that if your timezone changes twice a year, the timestamps
16042 in log lines are ambiguous for an hour when the clocks go back. One way of
16043 avoiding this problem is to set the timezone to UTC. An alternative is to set
16044 &%log_timezone%& true. This turns on the addition of the timezone offset to
16045 timestamps in log lines. Turning on this option can add quite a lot to the size
16046 of log files because each line is extended by 6 characters. Note that the
16047 &$tod_log$& variable contains the log timestamp without the zone, but there is
16048 another variable called &$tod_zone$& that contains just the timezone offset.
16049
16050
16051 .option lookup_open_max main integer 25
16052 .cindex "too many open files"
16053 .cindex "open files, too many"
16054 .cindex "file" "too many open"
16055 .cindex "lookup" "maximum open files"
16056 .cindex "limit" "open files for lookups"
16057 This option limits the number of simultaneously open files for single-key
16058 lookups that use regular files (that is, &(lsearch)&, &(dbm)&, and &(cdb)&).
16059 Exim normally keeps these files open during routing, because often the same
16060 file is required several times. If the limit is reached, Exim closes the least
16061 recently used file. Note that if you are using the &'ndbm'& library, it
16062 actually opens two files for each logical DBM database, though it still counts
16063 as one for the purposes of &%lookup_open_max%&. If you are getting &"too many
16064 open files"& errors with NDBM, you need to reduce the value of
16065 &%lookup_open_max%&.
16066
16067
16068 .option max_username_length main integer 0
16069 .cindex "length of login name"
16070 .cindex "user name" "maximum length"
16071 .cindex "limit" "user name length"
16072 Some operating systems are broken in that they truncate long arguments to
16073 &[getpwnam()]& to eight characters, instead of returning &"no such user"&. If
16074 this option is set greater than zero, any attempt to call &[getpwnam()]& with
16075 an argument that is longer behaves as if &[getpwnam()]& failed.
16076
16077
16078 .option message_body_newlines main bool false
16079 .cindex "message body" "newlines in variables"
16080 .cindex "newline" "in message body variables"
16081 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
16082 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
16083 By default, newlines in the message body are replaced by spaces when setting
16084 the &$message_body$& and &$message_body_end$& expansion variables. If this
16085 option is set true, this no longer happens.
16086
16087
16088 .option message_body_visible main integer 500
16089 .cindex "body of message" "visible size"
16090 .cindex "message body" "visible size"
16091 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
16092 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
16093 This option specifies how much of a message's body is to be included in the
16094 &$message_body$& and &$message_body_end$& expansion variables.
16095
16096
16097 .option message_id_header_domain main string&!! unset
16098 .cindex "&'Message-ID:'& header line"
16099 If this option is set, the string is expanded and used as the right hand side
16100 (domain) of the &'Message-ID:'& header that Exim creates if a
16101 locally-originated incoming message does not have one. &"Locally-originated"&
16102 means &"not received over TCP/IP."&
16103 Otherwise, the primary host name is used.
16104 Only letters, digits, dot and hyphen are accepted; any other characters are
16105 replaced by hyphens. If the expansion is forced to fail, or if the result is an
16106 empty string, the option is ignored.
16107
16108
16109 .option message_id_header_text main string&!! unset
16110 If this variable is set, the string is expanded and used to augment the text of
16111 the &'Message-id:'& header that Exim creates if a locally-originated incoming
16112 message does not have one. The text of this header is required by RFC 2822 to
16113 take the form of an address. By default, Exim uses its internal message id as
16114 the local part, and the primary host name as the domain. If this option is set,
16115 it is expanded, and provided the expansion is not forced to fail, and does not
16116 yield an empty string, the result is inserted into the header immediately
16117 before the @, separated from the internal message id by a dot. Any characters
16118 that are illegal in an address are automatically converted into hyphens. This
16119 means that variables such as &$tod_log$& can be used, because the spaces and
16120 colons will become hyphens.
16121
16122
16123 .option message_logs main boolean true
16124 .cindex "message logs" "disabling"
16125 .cindex "log" "message log; disabling"
16126 If this option is turned off, per-message log files are not created in the
16127 &_msglog_& spool sub-directory. This reduces the amount of disk I/O required by
16128 Exim, by reducing the number of files involved in handling a message from a
16129 minimum of four (header spool file, body spool file, delivery journal, and
16130 per-message log) to three. The other major I/O activity is Exim's main log,
16131 which is not affected by this option.
16132
16133
16134 .option message_size_limit main string&!! 50M
16135 .cindex "message" "size limit"
16136 .cindex "limit" "message size"
16137 .cindex "size" "of message, limit"
16138 This option limits the maximum size of message that Exim will process. The
16139 value is expanded for each incoming connection so, for example, it can be made
16140 to depend on the IP address of the remote host for messages arriving via
16141 TCP/IP. After expansion, the value must be a sequence of decimal digits,
16142 optionally followed by K or M.
16143
16144 &*Note*&: This limit cannot be made to depend on a message's sender or any
16145 other properties of an individual message, because it has to be advertised in
16146 the server's response to EHLO. String expansion failure causes a temporary
16147 error. A value of zero means no limit, but its use is not recommended. See also
16148 &%bounce_return_size_limit%&.
16149
16150 Incoming SMTP messages are failed with a 552 error if the limit is
16151 exceeded; locally-generated messages either get a stderr message or a delivery
16152 failure message to the sender, depending on the &%-oe%& setting. Rejection of
16153 an oversized message is logged in both the main and the reject logs. See also
16154 the generic transport option &%message_size_limit%&, which limits the size of
16155 message that an individual transport can process.
16156
16157 If you use a virus-scanner and set this option to to a value larger than the
16158 maximum size that your virus-scanner is configured to support, you may get
16159 failures triggered by large mails. The right size to configure for the
16160 virus-scanner depends upon what data is passed and the options in use but it's
16161 probably safest to just set it to a little larger than this value. E.g., with a
16162 default Exim message size of 50M and a default ClamAV StreamMaxLength of 10M,
16163 some problems may result.
16164
16165 A value of 0 will disable size limit checking; Exim will still advertise the
16166 SIZE extension in an EHLO response, but without a limit, so as to permit
16167 SMTP clients to still indicate the message size along with the MAIL verb.
16168
16169
16170 .option move_frozen_messages main boolean false
16171 .cindex "frozen messages" "moving"
16172 This option, which is available only if Exim has been built with the setting
16173 .code
16174 SUPPORT_MOVE_FROZEN_MESSAGES=yes
16175 .endd
16176 in &_Local/Makefile_&, causes frozen messages and their message logs to be
16177 moved from the &_input_& and &_msglog_& directories on the spool to &_Finput_&
16178 and &_Fmsglog_&, respectively. There is currently no support in Exim or the
16179 standard utilities for handling such moved messages, and they do not show up in
16180 lists generated by &%-bp%& or by the Exim monitor.
16181
16182
16183 .option mua_wrapper main boolean false
16184 Setting this option true causes Exim to run in a very restrictive mode in which
16185 it passes messages synchronously to a smart host. Chapter &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&
16186 contains a full description of this facility.
16187
16188
16189
16190 .option mysql_servers main "string list" unset
16191 .cindex "MySQL" "server list"
16192 This option provides a list of MySQL servers and associated connection data, to
16193 be used in conjunction with &(mysql)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&). The
16194 option is available only if Exim has been built with MySQL support.
16195
16196
16197 .option never_users main "string list&!!" unset
16198 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. Local
16199 message deliveries are normally run in processes that are setuid to the
16200 recipient, and remote deliveries are normally run under Exim's own uid and gid.
16201 It is usually desirable to prevent any deliveries from running as root, as a
16202 safety precaution.
16203
16204 When Exim is built, an option called FIXED_NEVER_USERS can be set to a
16205 list of users that must not be used for local deliveries. This list is fixed in
16206 the binary and cannot be overridden by the configuration file. By default, it
16207 contains just the single user name &"root"&. The &%never_users%& runtime option
16208 can be used to add more users to the fixed list.
16209
16210 If a message is to be delivered as one of the users on the fixed list or the
16211 &%never_users%& list, an error occurs, and delivery is deferred. A common
16212 example is
16213 .code
16214 never_users = root:daemon:bin
16215 .endd
16216 Including root is redundant if it is also on the fixed list, but it does no
16217 harm. This option overrides the &%pipe_as_creator%& option of the &(pipe)&
16218 transport driver.
16219
16220
16221 .option openssl_options main "string list" "+no_sslv2 +no_sslv3 +single_dh_use +no_ticket"
16222 .cindex "OpenSSL "compatibility options"
16223 This option allows an administrator to adjust the SSL options applied
16224 by OpenSSL to connections. It is given as a space-separated list of items,
16225 each one to be +added or -subtracted from the current value.
16226
16227 This option is only available if Exim is built against OpenSSL. The values
16228 available for this option vary according to the age of your OpenSSL install.
16229 The &"all"& value controls a subset of flags which are available, typically
16230 the bug workaround options. The &'SSL_CTX_set_options'& man page will
16231 list the values known on your system and Exim should support all the
16232 &"bug workaround"& options and many of the &"modifying"& options. The Exim
16233 names lose the leading &"SSL_OP_"& and are lower-cased.
16234
16235 Note that adjusting the options can have severe impact upon the security of
16236 SSL as used by Exim. It is possible to disable safety checks and shoot
16237 yourself in the foot in various unpleasant ways. This option should not be
16238 adjusted lightly. An unrecognised item will be detected at startup, by
16239 invoking Exim with the &%-bV%& flag.
16240
16241 The option affects Exim operating both as a server and as a client.
16242
16243 Historical note: prior to release 4.80, Exim defaulted this value to
16244 "+dont_insert_empty_fragments", which may still be needed for compatibility
16245 with some clients, but which lowers security by increasing exposure to
16246 some now infamous attacks.
16247
16248 Examples:
16249 .code
16250 # Make both old MS and old Eudora happy:
16251 openssl_options = -all +microsoft_big_sslv3_buffer \
16252 +dont_insert_empty_fragments
16253
16254 # Disable older protocol versions:
16255 openssl_options = +no_sslv2 +no_sslv3
16256 .endd
16257
16258 Possible options may include:
16259 .ilist
16260 &`all`&
16261 .next
16262 &`allow_unsafe_legacy_renegotiation`&
16263 .next
16264 &`cipher_server_preference`&
16265 .next
16266 &`dont_insert_empty_fragments`&
16267 .next
16268 &`ephemeral_rsa`&
16269 .next
16270 &`legacy_server_connect`&
16271 .next
16272 &`microsoft_big_sslv3_buffer`&
16273 .next
16274 &`microsoft_sess_id_bug`&
16275 .next
16276 &`msie_sslv2_rsa_padding`&
16277 .next
16278 &`netscape_challenge_bug`&
16279 .next
16280 &`netscape_reuse_cipher_change_bug`&
16281 .next
16282 &`no_compression`&
16283 .next
16284 &`no_session_resumption_on_renegotiation`&
16285 .next
16286 &`no_sslv2`&
16287 .next
16288 &`no_sslv3`&
16289 .next
16290 &`no_ticket`&
16291 .next
16292 &`no_tlsv1`&
16293 .next
16294 &`no_tlsv1_1`&
16295 .next
16296 &`no_tlsv1_2`&
16297 .next
16298 &`safari_ecdhe_ecdsa_bug`&
16299 .next
16300 &`single_dh_use`&
16301 .next
16302 &`single_ecdh_use`&
16303 .next
16304 &`ssleay_080_client_dh_bug`&
16305 .next
16306 &`sslref2_reuse_cert_type_bug`&
16307 .next
16308 &`tls_block_padding_bug`&
16309 .next
16310 &`tls_d5_bug`&
16311 .next
16312 &`tls_rollback_bug`&
16313 .endlist
16314
16315 As an aside, the &`safari_ecdhe_ecdsa_bug`& item is a misnomer and affects
16316 all clients connecting using the MacOS SecureTransport TLS facility prior
16317 to MacOS 10.8.4, including email clients. If you see old MacOS clients failing
16318 to negotiate TLS then this option value might help, provided that your OpenSSL
16319 release is new enough to contain this work-around. This may be a situation
16320 where you have to upgrade OpenSSL to get buggy clients working.
16321
16322
16323 .option oracle_servers main "string list" unset
16324 .cindex "Oracle" "server list"
16325 This option provides a list of Oracle servers and associated connection data,
16326 to be used in conjunction with &(oracle)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&).
16327 The option is available only if Exim has been built with Oracle support.
16328
16329
16330 .option percent_hack_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
16331 .cindex "&""percent hack""&"
16332 .cindex "source routing" "in email address"
16333 .cindex "address" "source-routed"
16334 The &"percent hack"& is the convention whereby a local part containing a
16335 percent sign is re-interpreted as a new email address, with the percent
16336 replaced by @. This is sometimes called &"source routing"&, though that term is
16337 also applied to RFC 2822 addresses that begin with an @ character. If this
16338 option is set, Exim implements the percent facility for those domains listed,
16339 but no others. This happens before an incoming SMTP address is tested against
16340 an ACL.
16341
16342 &*Warning*&: The &"percent hack"& has often been abused by people who are
16343 trying to get round relaying restrictions. For this reason, it is best avoided
16344 if at all possible. Unfortunately, a number of less security-conscious MTAs
16345 implement it unconditionally. If you are running Exim on a gateway host, and
16346 routing mail through to internal MTAs without processing the local parts, it is
16347 a good idea to reject recipient addresses with percent characters in their
16348 local parts. Exim's default configuration does this.
16349
16350
16351 .option perl_at_start main boolean false
16352 .cindex "Perl"
16353 This option is available only when Exim is built with an embedded Perl
16354 interpreter. See chapter &<<CHAPperl>>& for details of its use.
16355
16356
16357 .option perl_startup main string unset
16358 .cindex "Perl"
16359 This option is available only when Exim is built with an embedded Perl
16360 interpreter. See chapter &<<CHAPperl>>& for details of its use.
16361
16362 .option perl_startup main boolean false
16363 .cindex "Perl"
16364 This Option enables the taint mode of the embedded Perl interpreter.
16365
16366
16367 .option pgsql_servers main "string list" unset
16368 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type" "server list"
16369 This option provides a list of PostgreSQL servers and associated connection
16370 data, to be used in conjunction with &(pgsql)& lookups (see section
16371 &<<SECID72>>&). The option is available only if Exim has been built with
16372 PostgreSQL support.
16373
16374
16375 .option pid_file_path main string&!! "set at compile time"
16376 .cindex "daemon" "pid file path"
16377 .cindex "pid file, path for"
16378 This option sets the name of the file to which the Exim daemon writes its
16379 process id. The string is expanded, so it can contain, for example, references
16380 to the host name:
16381 .code
16382 pid_file_path = /var/log/$primary_hostname/exim.pid
16383 .endd
16384 If no path is set, the pid is written to the file &_exim-daemon.pid_& in Exim's
16385 spool directory.
16386 The value set by the option can be overridden by the &%-oP%& command line
16387 option. A pid file is not written if a &"non-standard"& daemon is run by means
16388 of the &%-oX%& option, unless a path is explicitly supplied by &%-oP%&.
16389
16390
16391 .option pipelining_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
16392 .cindex "PIPELINING" "suppressing advertising"
16393 This option can be used to suppress the advertisement of the SMTP
16394 PIPELINING extension to specific hosts. See also the &*no_pipelining*&
16395 control in section &<<SECTcontrols>>&. When PIPELINING is not advertised and
16396 &%smtp_enforce_sync%& is true, an Exim server enforces strict synchronization
16397 for each SMTP command and response. When PIPELINING is advertised, Exim assumes
16398 that clients will use it; &"out of order"& commands that are &"expected"& do
16399 not count as protocol errors (see &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%&).
16400
16401 .new
16402 .option pipelining_connect_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
16403 .cindex "pipelining" "early connection"
16404 .cindex "pipelining" PIPE_CONNECT
16405 If Exim is built with the SUPPORT_PIPE_CONNECT build option
16406 this option controls which hosts the facility is advertised to
16407 and from which pipeline early-connection (before MAIL) SMTP
16408 commands are acceptable.
16409 When used, the pipelining saves on roundtrip times.
16410
16411 Currently the option name &"X_PIPE_CONNECT"& is used.
16412 .wen
16413
16414
16415 .option prdr_enable main boolean false
16416 .cindex "PRDR" "enabling on server"
16417 This option can be used to enable the Per-Recipient Data Response extension
16418 to SMTP, defined by Eric Hall.
16419 If the option is set, PRDR is advertised by Exim when operating as a server.
16420 If the client requests PRDR, and more than one recipient, for a message
16421 an additional ACL is called for each recipient after the message content
16422 is received. See section &<<SECTPRDRACL>>&.
16423
16424 .option preserve_message_logs main boolean false
16425 .cindex "message logs" "preserving"
16426 If this option is set, message log files are not deleted when messages are
16427 completed. Instead, they are moved to a sub-directory of the spool directory
16428 called &_msglog.OLD_&, where they remain available for statistical or debugging
16429 purposes. This is a dangerous option to set on systems with any appreciable
16430 volume of mail. Use with care!
16431
16432
16433 .option primary_hostname main string "see below"
16434 .cindex "name" "of local host"
16435 .cindex "host" "name of local"
16436 .cindex "local host" "name of"
16437 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
16438 This specifies the name of the current host. It is used in the default EHLO or
16439 HELO command for outgoing SMTP messages (changeable via the &%helo_data%&
16440 option in the &(smtp)& transport), and as the default for &%qualify_domain%&.
16441 The value is also used by default in some SMTP response messages from an Exim
16442 server. This can be changed dynamically by setting &%smtp_active_hostname%&.
16443
16444 If &%primary_hostname%& is not set, Exim calls &[uname()]& to find the host
16445 name. If this fails, Exim panics and dies. If the name returned by &[uname()]&
16446 contains only one component, Exim passes it to &[gethostbyname()]& (or
16447 &[getipnodebyname()]& when available) in order to obtain the fully qualified
16448 version. The variable &$primary_hostname$& contains the host name, whether set
16449 explicitly by this option, or defaulted.
16450
16451
16452 .option print_topbitchars main boolean false
16453 .cindex "printing characters"
16454 .cindex "8-bit characters"
16455 By default, Exim considers only those characters whose codes lie in the range
16456 32&--126 to be printing characters. In a number of circumstances (for example,
16457 when writing log entries) non-printing characters are converted into escape
16458 sequences, primarily to avoid messing up the layout. If &%print_topbitchars%&
16459 is set, code values of 128 and above are also considered to be printing
16460 characters.
16461
16462 This option also affects the header syntax checks performed by the
16463 &(autoreply)& transport, and whether Exim uses RFC 2047 encoding of
16464 the user's full name when constructing From: and Sender: addresses (as
16465 described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&). Setting this option can cause
16466 Exim to generate eight bit message headers that do not conform to the
16467 standards.
16468
16469
16470 .option process_log_path main string unset
16471 .cindex "process log path"
16472 .cindex "log" "process log"
16473 .cindex "&'exiwhat'&"
16474 This option sets the name of the file to which an Exim process writes its
16475 &"process log"& when sent a USR1 signal. This is used by the &'exiwhat'&
16476 utility script. If this option is unset, the file called &_exim-process.info_&
16477 in Exim's spool directory is used. The ability to specify the name explicitly
16478 can be useful in environments where two different Exims are running, using
16479 different spool directories.
16480
16481
16482 .option prod_requires_admin main boolean true
16483 .cindex "restricting access to features"
16484 .oindex "&%-M%&"
16485 .oindex "&%-R%&"
16486 .oindex "&%-q%&"
16487 The &%-M%&, &%-R%&, and &%-q%& command-line options require the caller to be an
16488 admin user unless &%prod_requires_admin%& is set false. See also
16489 &%queue_list_requires_admin%& and &%commandline_checks_require_admin%&.
16490
16491
16492 .option qualify_domain main string "see below"
16493 .cindex "domain" "for qualifying addresses"
16494 .cindex "address" "qualification"
16495 This option specifies the domain name that is added to any envelope sender
16496 addresses that do not have a domain qualification. It also applies to
16497 recipient addresses if &%qualify_recipient%& is not set. Unqualified addresses
16498 are accepted by default only for locally-generated messages. Qualification is
16499 also applied to addresses in header lines such as &'From:'& and &'To:'& for
16500 locally-generated messages, unless the &%-bnq%& command line option is used.
16501
16502 Messages from external sources must always contain fully qualified addresses,
16503 unless the sending host matches &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or
16504 &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& (as appropriate), in which case incoming
16505 addresses are qualified with &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%& as
16506 necessary. Internally, Exim always works with fully qualified envelope
16507 addresses. If &%qualify_domain%& is not set, it defaults to the
16508 &%primary_hostname%& value.
16509
16510
16511 .option qualify_recipient main string "see below"
16512 This option allows you to specify a different domain for qualifying recipient
16513 addresses to the one that is used for senders. See &%qualify_domain%& above.
16514
16515
16516
16517 .option queue_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
16518 .cindex "domain" "specifying non-immediate delivery"
16519 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16520 .cindex "message" "queueing certain domains"
16521 This option lists domains for which immediate delivery is not required.
16522 A delivery process is started whenever a message is received, but only those
16523 domains that do not match are processed. All other deliveries wait until the
16524 next queue run. See also &%hold_domains%& and &%queue_smtp_domains%&.
16525
16526
16527 .option queue_list_requires_admin main boolean true
16528 .cindex "restricting access to features"
16529 .oindex "&%-bp%&"
16530 The &%-bp%& command-line option, which lists the messages that are on the
16531 queue, requires the caller to be an admin user unless
16532 &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set false.
16533 See also &%prod_requires_admin%& and &%commandline_checks_require_admin%&.
16534
16535
16536 .option queue_only main boolean false
16537 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16538 .cindex "message" "queueing unconditionally"
16539 If &%queue_only%& is set, a delivery process is not automatically started
16540 whenever a message is received. Instead, the message waits in the queue for the
16541 next queue run. Even if &%queue_only%& is false, incoming messages may not get
16542 delivered immediately when certain conditions (such as heavy load) occur.
16543
16544 The &%-odq%& command line has the same effect as &%queue_only%&. The &%-odb%&
16545 and &%-odi%& command line options override &%queue_only%& unless
16546 &%queue_only_override%& is set false. See also &%queue_only_file%&,
16547 &%queue_only_load%&, and &%smtp_accept_queue%&.
16548
16549
16550 .option queue_only_file main string unset
16551 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16552 .cindex "message" "queueing by file existence"
16553 This option can be set to a colon-separated list of absolute path names, each
16554 one optionally preceded by &"smtp"&. When Exim is receiving a message,
16555 it tests for the existence of each listed path using a call to &[stat()]&. For
16556 each path that exists, the corresponding queueing option is set.
16557 For paths with no prefix, &%queue_only%& is set; for paths prefixed by
16558 &"smtp"&, &%queue_smtp_domains%& is set to match all domains. So, for example,
16559 .code
16560 queue_only_file = smtp/some/file
16561 .endd
16562 causes Exim to behave as if &%queue_smtp_domains%& were set to &"*"& whenever
16563 &_/some/file_& exists.
16564
16565
16566 .option queue_only_load main fixed-point unset
16567 .cindex "load average"
16568 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16569 .cindex "message" "queueing by load"
16570 If the system load average is higher than this value, incoming messages from
16571 all sources are queued, and no automatic deliveries are started. If this
16572 happens during local or remote SMTP input, all subsequent messages received on
16573 the same SMTP connection are queued by default, whatever happens to the load in
16574 the meantime, but this can be changed by setting &%queue_only_load_latch%&
16575 false.
16576
16577 Deliveries will subsequently be performed by queue runner processes. This
16578 option has no effect on ancient operating systems on which Exim cannot
16579 determine the load average. See also &%deliver_queue_load_max%& and
16580 &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
16581
16582
16583 .option queue_only_load_latch main boolean true
16584 .cindex "load average" "re-evaluating per message"
16585 When this option is true (the default), once one message has been queued
16586 because the load average is higher than the value set by &%queue_only_load%&,
16587 all subsequent messages received on the same SMTP connection are also queued.
16588 This is a deliberate choice; even though the load average may fall below the
16589 threshold, it doesn't seem right to deliver later messages on the same
16590 connection when not delivering earlier ones. However, there are special
16591 circumstances such as very long-lived connections from scanning appliances
16592 where this is not the best strategy. In such cases, &%queue_only_load_latch%&
16593 should be set false. This causes the value of the load average to be
16594 re-evaluated for each message.
16595
16596
16597 .option queue_only_override main boolean true
16598 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16599 When this option is true, the &%-od%&&'x'& command line options override the
16600 setting of &%queue_only%& or &%queue_only_file%& in the configuration file. If
16601 &%queue_only_override%& is set false, the &%-od%&&'x'& options cannot be used
16602 to override; they are accepted, but ignored.
16603
16604
16605 .option queue_run_in_order main boolean false
16606 .cindex "queue runner" "processing messages in order"
16607 If this option is set, queue runs happen in order of message arrival instead of
16608 in an arbitrary order. For this to happen, a complete list of the entire queue
16609 must be set up before the deliveries start. When the queue is all held in a
16610 single directory (the default), a single list is created for both the ordered
16611 and the non-ordered cases. However, if &%split_spool_directory%& is set, a
16612 single list is not created when &%queue_run_in_order%& is false. In this case,
16613 the sub-directories are processed one at a time (in a random order), and this
16614 avoids setting up one huge list for the whole queue. Thus, setting
16615 &%queue_run_in_order%& with &%split_spool_directory%& may degrade performance
16616 when the queue is large, because of the extra work in setting up the single,
16617 large list. In most situations, &%queue_run_in_order%& should not be set.
16618
16619
16620
16621 .option queue_run_max main integer&!! 5
16622 .cindex "queue runner" "maximum number of"
16623 This controls the maximum number of queue runner processes that an Exim daemon
16624 can run simultaneously. This does not mean that it starts them all at once,
16625 but rather that if the maximum number are still running when the time comes to
16626 start another one, it refrains from starting another one. This can happen with
16627 very large queues and/or very sluggish deliveries. This option does not,
16628 however, interlock with other processes, so additional queue runners can be
16629 started by other means, or by killing and restarting the daemon.
16630
16631 Setting this option to zero does not suppress queue runs; rather, it disables
16632 the limit, allowing any number of simultaneous queue runner processes to be
16633 run. If you do not want queue runs to occur, omit the &%-q%&&'xx'& setting on
16634 the daemon's command line.
16635
16636 .cindex queues named
16637 .cindex "named queues"
16638 To set limits for different named queues use
16639 an expansion depending on the &$queue_name$& variable.
16640
16641 .option queue_smtp_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
16642 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16643 .cindex "message" "queueing remote deliveries"
16644 When this option is set, a delivery process is started whenever a message is
16645 received, routing is performed, and local deliveries take place.
16646 However, if any SMTP deliveries are required for domains that match
16647 &%queue_smtp_domains%&, they are not immediately delivered, but instead the
16648 message waits in the queue for the next queue run. Since routing of the message
16649 has taken place, Exim knows to which remote hosts it must be delivered, and so
16650 when the queue run happens, multiple messages for the same host are delivered
16651 over a single SMTP connection. The &%-odqs%& command line option causes all
16652 SMTP deliveries to be queued in this way, and is equivalent to setting
16653 &%queue_smtp_domains%& to &"*"&. See also &%hold_domains%& and
16654 &%queue_domains%&.
16655
16656
16657 .option receive_timeout main time 0s
16658 .cindex "timeout" "for non-SMTP input"
16659 This option sets the timeout for accepting a non-SMTP message, that is, the
16660 maximum time that Exim waits when reading a message on the standard input. If
16661 the value is zero, it will wait forever. This setting is overridden by the
16662 &%-or%& command line option. The timeout for incoming SMTP messages is
16663 controlled by &%smtp_receive_timeout%&.
16664
16665 .option received_header_text main string&!! "see below"
16666 .cindex "customizing" "&'Received:'& header"
16667 .cindex "&'Received:'& header line" "customizing"
16668 This string defines the contents of the &'Received:'& message header that is
16669 added to each message, except for the timestamp, which is automatically added
16670 on at the end (preceded by a semicolon). The string is expanded each time it is
16671 used. If the expansion yields an empty string, no &'Received:'& header line is
16672 added to the message. Otherwise, the string should start with the text
16673 &"Received:"& and conform to the RFC 2822 specification for &'Received:'&
16674 header lines.
16675 .new
16676 The default setting is:
16677
16678 .code
16679 received_header_text = Received: \
16680 ${if def:sender_rcvhost {from $sender_rcvhost\n\t}\
16681 {${if def:sender_ident \
16682 {from ${quote_local_part:$sender_ident} }}\
16683 ${if def:sender_helo_name {(helo=$sender_helo_name)\n\t}}}}\
16684 by $primary_hostname \
16685 ${if def:received_protocol {with $received_protocol }}\
16686 ${if def:tls_in_cipher_std { tls $tls_in_cipher_std\n\t}}\
16687 (Exim $version_number)\n\t\
16688 ${if def:sender_address \
16689 {(envelope-from <$sender_address>)\n\t}}\
16690 id $message_exim_id\
16691 ${if def:received_for {\n\tfor $received_for}}
16692 .endd
16693 .wen
16694
16695 The reference to the TLS cipher is omitted when Exim is built without TLS
16696 support. The use of conditional expansions ensures that this works for both
16697 locally generated messages and messages received from remote hosts, giving
16698 header lines such as the following:
16699 .code
16700 Received: from scrooge.carol.example ([192.168.12.25] ident=root)
16701 by marley.carol.example with esmtp (Exim 4.00)
16702 (envelope-from <bob@carol.example>)
16703 id 16IOWa-00019l-00
16704 for chas@dickens.example; Tue, 25 Dec 2001 14:43:44 +0000
16705 Received: by scrooge.carol.example with local (Exim 4.00)
16706 id 16IOWW-000083-00; Tue, 25 Dec 2001 14:43:41 +0000
16707 .endd
16708 Until the body of the message has been received, the timestamp is the time when
16709 the message started to be received. Once the body has arrived, and all policy
16710 checks have taken place, the timestamp is updated to the time at which the
16711 message was accepted.
16712
16713
16714 .option received_headers_max main integer 30
16715 .cindex "loop" "prevention"
16716 .cindex "mail loop prevention"
16717 .cindex "&'Received:'& header line" "counting"
16718 When a message is to be delivered, the number of &'Received:'& headers is
16719 counted, and if it is greater than this parameter, a mail loop is assumed to
16720 have occurred, the delivery is abandoned, and an error message is generated.
16721 This applies to both local and remote deliveries.
16722
16723
16724 .option recipient_unqualified_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16725 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
16726 .cindex "host" "unqualified addresses from"
16727 This option lists those hosts from which Exim is prepared to accept unqualified
16728 recipient addresses in message envelopes. The addresses are made fully
16729 qualified by the addition of the &%qualify_recipient%& value. This option also
16730 affects message header lines. Exim does not reject unqualified recipient
16731 addresses in headers, but it qualifies them only if the message came from a
16732 host that matches &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&,
16733 or if the message was submitted locally (not using TCP/IP), and the &%-bnq%&
16734 option was not set.
16735
16736
16737 .option recipients_max main integer 0
16738 .cindex "limit" "number of recipients"
16739 .cindex "recipient" "maximum number"
16740 If this option is set greater than zero, it specifies the maximum number of
16741 original recipients for any message. Additional recipients that are generated
16742 by aliasing or forwarding do not count. SMTP messages get a 452 response for
16743 all recipients over the limit; earlier recipients are delivered as normal.
16744 Non-SMTP messages with too many recipients are failed, and no deliveries are
16745 done.
16746
16747 .cindex "RCPT" "maximum number of incoming"
16748 &*Note*&: The RFCs specify that an SMTP server should accept at least 100
16749 RCPT commands in a single message.
16750
16751
16752 .option recipients_max_reject main boolean false
16753 If this option is set true, Exim rejects SMTP messages containing too many
16754 recipients by giving 552 errors to the surplus RCPT commands, and a 554
16755 error to the eventual DATA command. Otherwise (the default) it gives a 452
16756 error to the surplus RCPT commands and accepts the message on behalf of the
16757 initial set of recipients. The remote server should then re-send the message
16758 for the remaining recipients at a later time.
16759
16760
16761 .option remote_max_parallel main integer 2
16762 .cindex "delivery" "parallelism for remote"
16763 This option controls parallel delivery of one message to a number of remote
16764 hosts. If the value is less than 2, parallel delivery is disabled, and Exim
16765 does all the remote deliveries for a message one by one. Otherwise, if a single
16766 message has to be delivered to more than one remote host, or if several copies
16767 have to be sent to the same remote host, up to &%remote_max_parallel%&
16768 deliveries are done simultaneously. If more than &%remote_max_parallel%&
16769 deliveries are required, the maximum number of processes are started, and as
16770 each one finishes, another is begun. The order of starting processes is the
16771 same as if sequential delivery were being done, and can be controlled by the
16772 &%remote_sort_domains%& option. If parallel delivery takes place while running
16773 with debugging turned on, the debugging output from each delivery process is
16774 tagged with its process id.
16775
16776 This option controls only the maximum number of parallel deliveries for one
16777 message in one Exim delivery process. Because Exim has no central queue
16778 manager, there is no way of controlling the total number of simultaneous
16779 deliveries if the configuration allows a delivery attempt as soon as a message
16780 is received.
16781
16782 .cindex "number of deliveries"
16783 .cindex "delivery" "maximum number of"
16784 If you want to control the total number of deliveries on the system, you
16785 need to set the &%queue_only%& option. This ensures that all incoming messages
16786 are added to the queue without starting a delivery process. Then set up an Exim
16787 daemon to start queue runner processes at appropriate intervals (probably
16788 fairly often, for example, every minute), and limit the total number of queue
16789 runners by setting the &%queue_run_max%& parameter. Because each queue runner
16790 delivers only one message at a time, the maximum number of deliveries that can
16791 then take place at once is &%queue_run_max%& multiplied by
16792 &%remote_max_parallel%&.
16793
16794 If it is purely remote deliveries you want to control, use
16795 &%queue_smtp_domains%& instead of &%queue_only%&. This has the added benefit of
16796 doing the SMTP routing before queueing, so that several messages for the same
16797 host will eventually get delivered down the same connection.
16798
16799
16800 .option remote_sort_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
16801 .cindex "sorting remote deliveries"
16802 .cindex "delivery" "sorting remote"
16803 When there are a number of remote deliveries for a message, they are sorted by
16804 domain into the order given by this list. For example,
16805 .code
16806 remote_sort_domains = *.cam.ac.uk:*.uk
16807 .endd
16808 would attempt to deliver to all addresses in the &'cam.ac.uk'& domain first,
16809 then to those in the &%uk%& domain, then to any others.
16810
16811
16812 .option retry_data_expire main time 7d
16813 .cindex "hints database" "data expiry"
16814 This option sets a &"use before"& time on retry information in Exim's hints
16815 database. Any older retry data is ignored. This means that, for example, once a
16816 host has not been tried for 7 days, Exim behaves as if it has no knowledge of
16817 past failures.
16818
16819
16820 .option retry_interval_max main time 24h
16821 .cindex "retry" "limit on interval"
16822 .cindex "limit" "on retry interval"
16823 Chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& describes Exim's mechanisms for controlling the
16824 intervals between delivery attempts for messages that cannot be delivered
16825 straight away. This option sets an overall limit to the length of time between
16826 retries. It cannot be set greater than 24 hours; any attempt to do so forces
16827 the default value.
16828
16829
16830 .option return_path_remove main boolean true
16831 .cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line" "removing"
16832 RFC 2821, section 4.4, states that an SMTP server must insert a
16833 &'Return-path:'& header line into a message when it makes a &"final delivery"&.
16834 The &'Return-path:'& header preserves the sender address as received in the
16835 MAIL command. This description implies that this header should not be present
16836 in an incoming message. If &%return_path_remove%& is true, any existing
16837 &'Return-path:'& headers are removed from messages at the time they are
16838 received. Exim's transports have options for adding &'Return-path:'& headers at
16839 the time of delivery. They are normally used only for final local deliveries.
16840
16841
16842 .option return_size_limit main integer 100K
16843 This option is an obsolete synonym for &%bounce_return_size_limit%&.
16844
16845
16846 .option rfc1413_hosts main "host list&!!" @[]
16847 .cindex "RFC 1413"
16848 .cindex "host" "for RFC 1413 calls"
16849 RFC 1413 identification calls are made to any client host which matches
16850 an item in the list.
16851 The default value specifies just this host, being any local interface
16852 for the system.
16853
16854 .option rfc1413_query_timeout main time 0s
16855 .cindex "RFC 1413" "query timeout"
16856 .cindex "timeout" "for RFC 1413 call"
16857 This sets the timeout on RFC 1413 identification calls. If it is set to zero,
16858 no RFC 1413 calls are ever made.
16859
16860
16861 .option sender_unqualified_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16862 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
16863 .cindex "host" "unqualified addresses from"
16864 This option lists those hosts from which Exim is prepared to accept unqualified
16865 sender addresses. The addresses are made fully qualified by the addition of
16866 &%qualify_domain%&. This option also affects message header lines. Exim does
16867 not reject unqualified addresses in headers that contain sender addresses, but
16868 it qualifies them only if the message came from a host that matches
16869 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%&, or if the message was submitted locally (not
16870 using TCP/IP), and the &%-bnq%& option was not set.
16871
16872 .option set_environment main "string list" empty
16873 .cindex "environment"
16874 This option allows to set individual environment variables that the
16875 currently linked libraries and programs in child processes use. The
16876 default list is empty,
16877
16878
16879 .option slow_lookup_log main integer 0
16880 .cindex "logging" "slow lookups"
16881 .cindex "dns" "logging slow lookups"
16882 This option controls logging of slow lookups.
16883 If the value is nonzero it is taken as a number of milliseconds
16884 and lookups taking longer than this are logged.
16885 Currently this applies only to DNS lookups.
16886
16887
16888
16889 .option smtp_accept_keepalive main boolean true
16890 .cindex "keepalive" "on incoming connection"
16891 This option controls the setting of the SO_KEEPALIVE option on incoming
16892 TCP/IP socket connections. When set, it causes the kernel to probe idle
16893 connections periodically, by sending packets with &"old"& sequence numbers. The
16894 other end of the connection should send an acknowledgment if the connection is
16895 still okay or a reset if the connection has been aborted. The reason for doing
16896 this is that it has the beneficial effect of freeing up certain types of
16897 connection that can get stuck when the remote host is disconnected without
16898 tidying up the TCP/IP call properly. The keepalive mechanism takes several
16899 hours to detect unreachable hosts.
16900
16901
16902
16903 .option smtp_accept_max main integer 20
16904 .cindex "limit" "incoming SMTP connections"
16905 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming connection count"
16906 .cindex "inetd"
16907 This option specifies the maximum number of simultaneous incoming SMTP calls
16908 that Exim will accept. It applies only to the listening daemon; there is no
16909 control (in Exim) when incoming SMTP is being handled by &'inetd'&. If the
16910 value is set to zero, no limit is applied. However, it is required to be
16911 non-zero if either &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& or &%smtp_accept_queue%& is
16912 set. See also &%smtp_accept_reserve%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
16913
16914 A new SMTP connection is immediately rejected if the &%smtp_accept_max%& limit
16915 has been reached. If not, Exim first checks &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%&. If
16916 that limit has not been reached for the client host, &%smtp_accept_reserve%&
16917 and &%smtp_load_reserve%& are then checked before accepting the connection.
16918
16919
16920 .option smtp_accept_max_nonmail main integer 10
16921 .cindex "limit" "non-mail SMTP commands"
16922 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting non-mail commands"
16923 Exim counts the number of &"non-mail"& commands in an SMTP session, and drops
16924 the connection if there are too many. This option defines &"too many"&. The
16925 check catches some denial-of-service attacks, repeated failing AUTHs, or a mad
16926 client looping sending EHLO, for example. The check is applied only if the
16927 client host matches &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%&.
16928
16929 When a new message is expected, one occurrence of RSET is not counted. This
16930 allows a client to send one RSET between messages (this is not necessary,
16931 but some clients do it). Exim also allows one uncounted occurrence of HELO
16932 or EHLO, and one occurrence of STARTTLS between messages. After
16933 starting up a TLS session, another EHLO is expected, and so it too is not
16934 counted. The first occurrence of AUTH in a connection, or immediately
16935 following STARTTLS is not counted. Otherwise, all commands other than
16936 MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and QUIT are counted.
16937
16938
16939 .option smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts main "host list&!!" *
16940 You can control which hosts are subject to the &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&
16941 check by setting this option. The default value makes it apply to all hosts. By
16942 changing the value, you can exclude any badly-behaved hosts that you have to
16943 live with.
16944
16945
16946 . Allow this long option name to split; give it unsplit as a fifth argument
16947 . for the automatic .oindex that is generated by .option.
16948 . We insert " &~&~" which is both pretty nasty visually and results in
16949 . non-searchable text. HowItWorks.txt mentions an option for inserting
16950 . zero-width-space, which would be nicer visually and results in (at least)
16951 . html that Firefox will split on when it's forced to reflow (rather than
16952 . inserting a horizontal scrollbar). However, the text is still not
16953 . searchable. NM changed this occurrence for bug 1197 to no longer allow
16954 . the option name to split.
16955
16956 .option "smtp_accept_max_per_connection" main integer 1000 &&&
16957 smtp_accept_max_per_connection
16958 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting incoming message count"
16959 .cindex "limit" "messages per SMTP connection"
16960 The value of this option limits the number of MAIL commands that Exim is
16961 prepared to accept over a single SMTP connection, whether or not each command
16962 results in the transfer of a message. After the limit is reached, a 421
16963 response is given to subsequent MAIL commands. This limit is a safety
16964 precaution against a client that goes mad (incidents of this type have been
16965 seen).
16966
16967
16968 .option smtp_accept_max_per_host main string&!! unset
16969 .cindex "limit" "SMTP connections from one host"
16970 .cindex "host" "limiting SMTP connections from"
16971 This option restricts the number of simultaneous IP connections from a single
16972 host (strictly, from a single IP address) to the Exim daemon. The option is
16973 expanded, to enable different limits to be applied to different hosts by
16974 reference to &$sender_host_address$&. Once the limit is reached, additional
16975 connection attempts from the same host are rejected with error code 421. This
16976 is entirely independent of &%smtp_accept_reserve%&. The option's default value
16977 of zero imposes no limit. If this option is set greater than zero, it is
16978 required that &%smtp_accept_max%& be non-zero.
16979
16980 &*Warning*&: When setting this option you should not use any expansion
16981 constructions that take an appreciable amount of time. The expansion and test
16982 happen in the main daemon loop, in order to reject additional connections
16983 without forking additional processes (otherwise a denial-of-service attack
16984 could cause a vast number or processes to be created). While the daemon is
16985 doing this processing, it cannot accept any other incoming connections.
16986
16987
16988
16989 .option smtp_accept_queue main integer 0
16990 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming connection count"
16991 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16992 .cindex "message" "queueing by SMTP connection count"
16993 If the number of simultaneous incoming SMTP connections being handled via the
16994 listening daemon exceeds this value, messages received by SMTP are just placed
16995 in the queue; no delivery processes are started automatically. The count is
16996 fixed at the start of an SMTP connection. It cannot be updated in the
16997 subprocess that receives messages, and so the queueing or not queueing applies
16998 to all messages received in the same connection.
16999
17000 A value of zero implies no limit, and clearly any non-zero value is useful only
17001 if it is less than the &%smtp_accept_max%& value (unless that is zero). See
17002 also &%queue_only%&, &%queue_only_load%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&, and the
17003 various &%-od%&&'x'& command line options.
17004
17005
17006 . See the comment on smtp_accept_max_per_connection
17007
17008 .option "smtp_accept_queue_per_connection" main integer 10 &&&
17009 smtp_accept_queue_per_connection
17010 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
17011 .cindex "message" "queueing by message count"
17012 This option limits the number of delivery processes that Exim starts
17013 automatically when receiving messages via SMTP, whether via the daemon or by
17014 the use of &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&. If the value of the option is greater than zero,
17015 and the number of messages received in a single SMTP session exceeds this
17016 number, subsequent messages are placed in the queue, but no delivery processes
17017 are started. This helps to limit the number of Exim processes when a server
17018 restarts after downtime and there is a lot of mail waiting for it on other
17019 systems. On large systems, the default should probably be increased, and on
17020 dial-in client systems it should probably be set to zero (that is, disabled).
17021
17022
17023 .option smtp_accept_reserve main integer 0
17024 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming call count"
17025 .cindex "host" "reserved"
17026 When &%smtp_accept_max%& is set greater than zero, this option specifies a
17027 number of SMTP connections that are reserved for connections from the hosts
17028 that are specified in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&. The value set in
17029 &%smtp_accept_max%& includes this reserve pool. The specified hosts are not
17030 restricted to this number of connections; the option specifies a minimum number
17031 of connection slots for them, not a maximum. It is a guarantee that this group
17032 of hosts can always get at least &%smtp_accept_reserve%& connections. However,
17033 the limit specified by &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& is still applied to each
17034 individual host.
17035
17036 For example, if &%smtp_accept_max%& is set to 50 and &%smtp_accept_reserve%& is
17037 set to 5, once there are 45 active connections (from any hosts), new
17038 connections are accepted only from hosts listed in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&,
17039 provided the other criteria for acceptance are met.
17040
17041
17042 .option smtp_active_hostname main string&!! unset
17043 .cindex "host" "name in SMTP responses"
17044 .cindex "SMTP" "host name in responses"
17045 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
17046 This option is provided for multi-homed servers that want to masquerade as
17047 several different hosts. At the start of an incoming SMTP connection, its value
17048 is expanded and used instead of the value of &$primary_hostname$& in SMTP
17049 responses. For example, it is used as domain name in the response to an
17050 incoming HELO or EHLO command.
17051
17052 .vindex "&$smtp_active_hostname$&"
17053 The active hostname is placed in the &$smtp_active_hostname$& variable, which
17054 is saved with any messages that are received. It is therefore available for use
17055 in routers and transports when the message is later delivered.
17056
17057 If this option is unset, or if its expansion is forced to fail, or if the
17058 expansion results in an empty string, the value of &$primary_hostname$& is
17059 used. Other expansion failures cause a message to be written to the main and
17060 panic logs, and the SMTP command receives a temporary error. Typically, the
17061 value of &%smtp_active_hostname%& depends on the incoming interface address.
17062 For example:
17063 .code
17064 smtp_active_hostname = ${if eq{$received_ip_address}{10.0.0.1}\
17065 {cox.mydomain}{box.mydomain}}
17066 .endd
17067
17068 Although &$smtp_active_hostname$& is primarily concerned with incoming
17069 messages, it is also used as the default for HELO commands in callout
17070 verification if there is no remote transport from which to obtain a
17071 &%helo_data%& value.
17072
17073 .option smtp_banner main string&!! "see below"
17074 .cindex "SMTP" "welcome banner"
17075 .cindex "banner for SMTP"
17076 .cindex "welcome banner for SMTP"
17077 .cindex "customizing" "SMTP banner"
17078 This string, which is expanded every time it is used, is output as the initial
17079 positive response to an SMTP connection. The default setting is:
17080 .code
17081 smtp_banner = $smtp_active_hostname ESMTP Exim \
17082 $version_number $tod_full
17083 .endd
17084 Failure to expand the string causes a panic error. If you want to create a
17085 multiline response to the initial SMTP connection, use &"\n"& in the string at
17086 appropriate points, but not at the end. Note that the 220 code is not included
17087 in this string. Exim adds it automatically (several times in the case of a
17088 multiline response).
17089
17090
17091 .option smtp_check_spool_space main boolean true
17092 .cindex "checking disk space"
17093 .cindex "disk space, checking"
17094 .cindex "spool directory" "checking space"
17095 When this option is set, if an incoming SMTP session encounters the SIZE
17096 option on a MAIL command, it checks that there is enough space in the
17097 spool directory's partition to accept a message of that size, while still
17098 leaving free the amount specified by &%check_spool_space%& (even if that value
17099 is zero). If there isn't enough space, a temporary error code is returned.
17100
17101
17102 .option smtp_connect_backlog main integer 20
17103 .cindex "connection backlog"
17104 .cindex "SMTP" "connection backlog"
17105 .cindex "backlog of connections"
17106 This option specifies a maximum number of waiting SMTP connections. Exim passes
17107 this value to the TCP/IP system when it sets up its listener. Once this number
17108 of connections are waiting for the daemon's attention, subsequent connection
17109 attempts are refused at the TCP/IP level. At least, that is what the manuals
17110 say; in some circumstances such connection attempts have been observed to time
17111 out instead. For large systems it is probably a good idea to increase the
17112 value (to 50, say). It also gives some protection against denial-of-service
17113 attacks by SYN flooding.
17114
17115
17116 .option smtp_enforce_sync main boolean true
17117 .cindex "SMTP" "synchronization checking"
17118 .cindex "synchronization checking in SMTP"
17119 The SMTP protocol specification requires the client to wait for a response from
17120 the server at certain points in the dialogue. Without PIPELINING these
17121 synchronization points are after every command; with PIPELINING they are
17122 fewer, but they still exist.
17123
17124 Some spamming sites send out a complete set of SMTP commands without waiting
17125 for any response. Exim protects against this by rejecting a message if the
17126 client has sent further input when it should not have. The error response &"554
17127 SMTP synchronization error"& is sent, and the connection is dropped. Testing
17128 for this error cannot be perfect because of transmission delays (unexpected
17129 input may be on its way but not yet received when Exim checks). However, it
17130 does detect many instances.
17131
17132 The check can be globally disabled by setting &%smtp_enforce_sync%& false.
17133 If you want to disable the check selectively (for example, only for certain
17134 hosts), you can do so by an appropriate use of a &%control%& modifier in an ACL
17135 (see section &<<SECTcontrols>>&). See also &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&.
17136
17137
17138
17139 .option smtp_etrn_command main string&!! unset
17140 .cindex "ETRN" "command to be run"
17141 .vindex "&$domain$&"
17142 If this option is set, the given command is run whenever an SMTP ETRN
17143 command is received from a host that is permitted to issue such commands (see
17144 chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). The string is split up into separate arguments which
17145 are independently expanded. The expansion variable &$domain$& is set to the
17146 argument of the ETRN command, and no syntax checking is done on it. For
17147 example:
17148 .code
17149 smtp_etrn_command = /etc/etrn_command $domain \
17150 $sender_host_address
17151 .endd
17152 A new process is created to run the command, but Exim does not wait for it to
17153 complete. Consequently, its status cannot be checked. If the command cannot be
17154 run, a line is written to the panic log, but the ETRN caller still receives
17155 a 250 success response. Exim is normally running under its own uid when
17156 receiving SMTP, so it is not possible for it to change the uid before running
17157 the command.
17158
17159
17160 .option smtp_etrn_serialize main boolean true
17161 .cindex "ETRN" "serializing"
17162 When this option is set, it prevents the simultaneous execution of more than
17163 one identical command as a result of ETRN in an SMTP connection. See
17164 section &<<SECTETRN>>& for details.
17165
17166
17167 .option smtp_load_reserve main fixed-point unset
17168 .cindex "load average"
17169 If the system load average ever gets higher than this, incoming SMTP calls are
17170 accepted only from those hosts that match an entry in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&.
17171 If &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& is not set, no incoming SMTP calls are accepted when
17172 the load is over the limit. The option has no effect on ancient operating
17173 systems on which Exim cannot determine the load average. See also
17174 &%deliver_queue_load_max%& and &%queue_only_load%&.
17175
17176
17177
17178 .option smtp_max_synprot_errors main integer 3
17179 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting syntax and protocol errors"
17180 .cindex "limit" "SMTP syntax and protocol errors"
17181 Exim rejects SMTP commands that contain syntax or protocol errors. In
17182 particular, a syntactically invalid email address, as in this command:
17183 .code
17184 RCPT TO:<abc xyz@a.b.c>
17185 .endd
17186 causes immediate rejection of the command, before any other tests are done.
17187 (The ACL cannot be run if there is no valid address to set up for it.) An
17188 example of a protocol error is receiving RCPT before MAIL. If there are
17189 too many syntax or protocol errors in one SMTP session, the connection is
17190 dropped. The limit is set by this option.
17191
17192 .cindex "PIPELINING" "expected errors"
17193 When the PIPELINING extension to SMTP is in use, some protocol errors are
17194 &"expected"&, for instance, a RCPT command after a rejected MAIL command.
17195 Exim assumes that PIPELINING will be used if it advertises it (see
17196 &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&), and in this situation, &"expected"& errors do
17197 not count towards the limit.
17198
17199
17200
17201 .option smtp_max_unknown_commands main integer 3
17202 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting unknown commands"
17203 .cindex "limit" "unknown SMTP commands"
17204 If there are too many unrecognized commands in an incoming SMTP session, an
17205 Exim server drops the connection. This is a defence against some kinds of abuse
17206 that subvert web
17207 clients
17208 into making connections to SMTP ports; in these circumstances, a number of
17209 non-SMTP command lines are sent first.
17210
17211
17212
17213 .option smtp_ratelimit_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
17214 .cindex "SMTP" "rate limiting"
17215 .cindex "limit" "rate of message arrival"
17216 .cindex "RCPT" "rate limiting"
17217 Some sites find it helpful to be able to limit the rate at which certain hosts
17218 can send them messages, and the rate at which an individual message can specify
17219 recipients.
17220
17221 Exim has two rate-limiting facilities. This section describes the older
17222 facility, which can limit rates within a single connection. The newer
17223 &%ratelimit%& ACL condition can limit rates across all connections. See section
17224 &<<SECTratelimiting>>& for details of the newer facility.
17225
17226 When a host matches &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%&, the values of
17227 &%smtp_ratelimit_mail%& and &%smtp_ratelimit_rcpt%& are used to control the
17228 rate of acceptance of MAIL and RCPT commands in a single SMTP session,
17229 respectively. Each option, if set, must contain a set of four comma-separated
17230 values:
17231
17232 .ilist
17233 A threshold, before which there is no rate limiting.
17234 .next
17235 An initial time delay. Unlike other times in Exim, numbers with decimal
17236 fractional parts are allowed here.
17237 .next
17238 A factor by which to increase the delay each time.
17239 .next
17240 A maximum value for the delay. This should normally be less than 5 minutes,
17241 because after that time, the client is liable to timeout the SMTP command.
17242 .endlist
17243
17244 For example, these settings have been used successfully at the site which
17245 first suggested this feature, for controlling mail from their customers:
17246 .code
17247 smtp_ratelimit_mail = 2,0.5s,1.05,4m
17248 smtp_ratelimit_rcpt = 4,0.25s,1.015,4m
17249 .endd
17250 The first setting specifies delays that are applied to MAIL commands after
17251 two have been received over a single connection. The initial delay is 0.5
17252 seconds, increasing by a factor of 1.05 each time. The second setting applies
17253 delays to RCPT commands when more than four occur in a single message.
17254
17255
17256 .option smtp_ratelimit_mail main string unset
17257 See &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& above.
17258
17259
17260 .option smtp_ratelimit_rcpt main string unset
17261 See &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& above.
17262
17263
17264 .option smtp_receive_timeout main time&!! 5m
17265 .cindex "timeout" "for SMTP input"
17266 .cindex "SMTP" "input timeout"
17267 This sets a timeout value for SMTP reception. It applies to all forms of SMTP
17268 input, including batch SMTP. If a line of input (either an SMTP command or a
17269 data line) is not received within this time, the SMTP connection is dropped and
17270 the message is abandoned.
17271 A line is written to the log containing one of the following messages:
17272 .code
17273 SMTP command timeout on connection from...
17274 SMTP data timeout on connection from...
17275 .endd
17276 The former means that Exim was expecting to read an SMTP command; the latter
17277 means that it was in the DATA phase, reading the contents of a message.
17278
17279 If the first character of the option is a &"$"& the option is
17280 expanded before use and may depend on
17281 &$sender_host_name$&, &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_host_port$&.
17282
17283
17284 .oindex "&%-os%&"
17285 The value set by this option can be overridden by the
17286 &%-os%& command-line option. A setting of zero time disables the timeout, but
17287 this should never be used for SMTP over TCP/IP. (It can be useful in some cases
17288 of local input using &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&.) For non-SMTP input, the reception
17289 timeout is controlled by &%receive_timeout%& and &%-or%&.
17290
17291
17292 .option smtp_reserve_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
17293 This option defines hosts for which SMTP connections are reserved; see
17294 &%smtp_accept_reserve%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%& above.
17295
17296
17297 .option smtp_return_error_details main boolean false
17298 .cindex "SMTP" "details policy failures"
17299 .cindex "policy control" "rejection, returning details"
17300 In the default state, Exim uses bland messages such as
17301 &"Administrative prohibition"& when it rejects SMTP commands for policy
17302 reasons. Many sysadmins like this because it gives away little information
17303 to spammers. However, some other sysadmins who are applying strict checking
17304 policies want to give out much fuller information about failures. Setting
17305 &%smtp_return_error_details%& true causes Exim to be more forthcoming. For
17306 example, instead of &"Administrative prohibition"&, it might give:
17307 .code
17308 550-Rejected after DATA: '>' missing at end of address:
17309 550 failing address in "From" header is: <user@dom.ain
17310 .endd
17311
17312
17313 .option smtputf8_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
17314 .cindex "SMTPUTF8" "advertising"
17315 When Exim is built with support for internationalised mail names,
17316 the availability thereof is advertised in
17317 response to EHLO only to those client hosts that match this option. See
17318 chapter &<<CHAPi18n>>& for details of Exim's support for internationalisation.
17319
17320
17321 .option spamd_address main string "127.0.0.1 783"
17322 This option is available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning
17323 extension. It specifies how Exim connects to SpamAssassin's &%spamd%& daemon.
17324 See section &<<SECTscanspamass>>& for more details.
17325
17326
17327
17328 .option spf_guess main string "v=spf1 a/24 mx/24 ptr ?all"
17329 This option is available when Exim is compiled with SPF support.
17330 See section &<<SECSPF>>& for more details.
17331
17332
17333
17334 .option split_spool_directory main boolean false
17335 .cindex "multiple spool directories"
17336 .cindex "spool directory" "split"
17337 .cindex "directories, multiple"
17338 If this option is set, it causes Exim to split its input directory into 62
17339 subdirectories, each with a single alphanumeric character as its name. The
17340 sixth character of the message id is used to allocate messages to
17341 subdirectories; this is the least significant base-62 digit of the time of
17342 arrival of the message.
17343
17344 Splitting up the spool in this way may provide better performance on systems
17345 where there are long mail queues, by reducing the number of files in any one
17346 directory. The msglog directory is also split up in a similar way to the input
17347 directory; however, if &%preserve_message_logs%& is set, all old msglog files
17348 are still placed in the single directory &_msglog.OLD_&.
17349
17350 It is not necessary to take any special action for existing messages when
17351 changing &%split_spool_directory%&. Exim notices messages that are in the
17352 &"wrong"& place, and continues to process them. If the option is turned off
17353 after a period of being on, the subdirectories will eventually empty and be
17354 automatically deleted.
17355
17356 When &%split_spool_directory%& is set, the behaviour of queue runner processes
17357 changes. Instead of creating a list of all messages in the queue, and then
17358 trying to deliver each one, in turn, it constructs a list of those in one
17359 sub-directory and tries to deliver them, before moving on to the next
17360 sub-directory. The sub-directories are processed in a random order. This
17361 spreads out the scanning of the input directories, and uses less memory. It is
17362 particularly beneficial when there are lots of messages in the queue. However,
17363 if &%queue_run_in_order%& is set, none of this new processing happens. The
17364 entire queue has to be scanned and sorted before any deliveries can start.
17365
17366
17367 .option spool_directory main string&!! "set at compile time"
17368 .cindex "spool directory" "path to"
17369 This defines the directory in which Exim keeps its spool, that is, the messages
17370 it is waiting to deliver. The default value is taken from the compile-time
17371 configuration setting, if there is one. If not, this option must be set. The
17372 string is expanded, so it can contain, for example, a reference to
17373 &$primary_hostname$&.
17374
17375 If the spool directory name is fixed on your installation, it is recommended
17376 that you set it at build time rather than from this option, particularly if the
17377 log files are being written to the spool directory (see &%log_file_path%&).
17378 Otherwise log files cannot be used for errors that are detected early on, such
17379 as failures in the configuration file.
17380
17381 By using this option to override the compiled-in path, it is possible to run
17382 tests of Exim without using the standard spool.
17383
17384 .option spool_wireformat main boolean false
17385 .cindex "spool directory" "file formats"
17386 If this option is set, Exim may for some messages use an alternative format
17387 for data-files in the spool which matches the wire format.
17388 Doing this permits more efficient message reception and transmission.
17389 Currently it is only done for messages received using the ESMTP CHUNKING
17390 option.
17391
17392 The following variables will not have useful values:
17393 .code
17394 $max_received_linelength
17395 $body_linecount
17396 $body_zerocount
17397 .endd
17398
17399 Users of the local_scan() API (see &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&),
17400 and any external programs which are passed a reference to a message data file
17401 (except via the &"regex"&, &"malware"& or &"spam"&) ACL conditions)
17402 will need to be aware of the different formats potentially available.
17403
17404 Using any of the ACL conditions noted will negate the reception benefit
17405 (as a Unix-mbox-format file is constructed for them).
17406 The transmission benefit is maintained.
17407
17408 .option sqlite_lock_timeout main time 5s
17409 .cindex "sqlite lookup type" "lock timeout"
17410 This option controls the timeout that the &(sqlite)& lookup uses when trying to
17411 access an SQLite database. See section &<<SECTsqlite>>& for more details.
17412
17413 .option strict_acl_vars main boolean false
17414 .cindex "&ACL;" "variables, handling unset"
17415 This option controls what happens if a syntactically valid but undefined ACL
17416 variable is referenced. If it is false (the default), an empty string
17417 is substituted; if it is true, an error is generated. See section
17418 &<<SECTaclvariables>>& for details of ACL variables.
17419
17420 .option strip_excess_angle_brackets main boolean false
17421 .cindex "angle brackets, excess"
17422 If this option is set, redundant pairs of angle brackets round &"route-addr"&
17423 items in addresses are stripped. For example, &'<<xxx@a.b.c.d>>'& is
17424 treated as &'<xxx@a.b.c.d>'&. If this is in the envelope and the message is
17425 passed on to another MTA, the excess angle brackets are not passed on. If this
17426 option is not set, multiple pairs of angle brackets cause a syntax error.
17427
17428
17429 .option strip_trailing_dot main boolean false
17430 .cindex "trailing dot on domain"
17431 .cindex "dot" "trailing on domain"
17432 If this option is set, a trailing dot at the end of a domain in an address is
17433 ignored. If this is in the envelope and the message is passed on to another
17434 MTA, the dot is not passed on. If this option is not set, a dot at the end of a
17435 domain causes a syntax error.
17436 However, addresses in header lines are checked only when an ACL requests header
17437 syntax checking.
17438
17439
17440 .option syslog_duplication main boolean true
17441 .cindex "syslog" "duplicate log lines; suppressing"
17442 When Exim is logging to syslog, it writes the log lines for its three
17443 separate logs at different syslog priorities so that they can in principle
17444 be separated on the logging hosts. Some installations do not require this
17445 separation, and in those cases, the duplication of certain log lines is a
17446 nuisance. If &%syslog_duplication%& is set false, only one copy of any
17447 particular log line is written to syslog. For lines that normally go to
17448 both the main log and the reject log, the reject log version (possibly
17449 containing message header lines) is written, at LOG_NOTICE priority.
17450 Lines that normally go to both the main and the panic log are written at
17451 the LOG_ALERT priority.
17452
17453
17454 .option syslog_facility main string unset
17455 .cindex "syslog" "facility; setting"
17456 This option sets the syslog &"facility"& name, used when Exim is logging to
17457 syslog. The value must be one of the strings &"mail"&, &"user"&, &"news"&,
17458 &"uucp"&, &"daemon"&, or &"local&'x'&"& where &'x'& is a digit between 0 and 7.
17459 If this option is unset, &"mail"& is used. See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for
17460 details of Exim's logging.
17461
17462
17463 .option syslog_pid main boolean true
17464 .cindex "syslog" "pid"
17465 If &%syslog_pid%& is set false, the PID on Exim's log lines are
17466 omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. (Syslog normally prefixes
17467 the log lines with the PID of the logging process automatically.) You need
17468 to enable the &`+pid`& log selector item, if you want Exim to write it's PID
17469 into the logs.) See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of Exim's logging.
17470
17471
17472
17473 .option syslog_processname main string &`exim`&
17474 .cindex "syslog" "process name; setting"
17475 This option sets the syslog &"ident"& name, used when Exim is logging to
17476 syslog. The value must be no longer than 32 characters. See chapter
17477 &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of Exim's logging.
17478
17479
17480
17481 .option syslog_timestamp main boolean true
17482 .cindex "syslog" "timestamps"
17483 If &%syslog_timestamp%& is set false, the timestamps on Exim's log lines are
17484 omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for
17485 details of Exim's logging.
17486
17487
17488 .option system_filter main string&!! unset
17489 .cindex "filter" "system filter"
17490 .cindex "system filter" "specifying"
17491 .cindex "Sieve filter" "not available for system filter"
17492 This option specifies an Exim filter file that is applied to all messages at
17493 the start of each delivery attempt, before any routing is done. System filters
17494 must be Exim filters; they cannot be Sieve filters. If the system filter
17495 generates any deliveries to files or pipes, or any new mail messages, the
17496 appropriate &%system_filter_..._transport%& option(s) must be set, to define
17497 which transports are to be used. Details of this facility are given in chapter
17498 &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>&.
17499 A forced expansion failure results in no filter operation.
17500
17501
17502 .option system_filter_directory_transport main string&!! unset
17503 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
17504 This sets the name of the transport driver that is to be used when the
17505 &%save%& command in a system message filter specifies a path ending in &"/"&,
17506 implying delivery of each message into a separate file in some directory.
17507 During the delivery, the variable &$address_file$& contains the path name.
17508
17509
17510 .option system_filter_file_transport main string&!! unset
17511 .cindex "file" "transport for system filter"
17512 This sets the name of the transport driver that is to be used when the &%save%&
17513 command in a system message filter specifies a path not ending in &"/"&. During
17514 the delivery, the variable &$address_file$& contains the path name.
17515
17516 .option system_filter_group main string unset
17517 .cindex "gid (group id)" "system filter"
17518 This option is used only when &%system_filter_user%& is also set. It sets the
17519 gid under which the system filter is run, overriding any gid that is associated
17520 with the user. The value may be numerical or symbolic.
17521
17522 .option system_filter_pipe_transport main string&!! unset
17523 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "for system filter"
17524 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
17525 This specifies the transport driver that is to be used when a &%pipe%& command
17526 is used in a system filter. During the delivery, the variable &$address_pipe$&
17527 contains the pipe command.
17528
17529
17530 .option system_filter_reply_transport main string&!! unset
17531 .cindex "&(autoreply)& transport" "for system filter"
17532 This specifies the transport driver that is to be used when a &%mail%& command
17533 is used in a system filter.
17534
17535
17536 .option system_filter_user main string unset
17537 .cindex "uid (user id)" "system filter"
17538 If this option is set to root, the system filter is run in the main Exim
17539 delivery process, as root. Otherwise, the system filter runs in a separate
17540 process, as the given user, defaulting to the Exim run-time user.
17541 Unless the string consists entirely of digits, it
17542 is looked up in the password data. Failure to find the named user causes a
17543 configuration error. The gid is either taken from the password data, or
17544 specified by &%system_filter_group%&. When the uid is specified numerically,
17545 &%system_filter_group%& is required to be set.
17546
17547 If the system filter generates any pipe, file, or reply deliveries, the uid
17548 under which the filter is run is used when transporting them, unless a
17549 transport option overrides.
17550
17551
17552 .option tcp_nodelay main boolean true
17553 .cindex "daemon" "TCP_NODELAY on sockets"
17554 .cindex "Nagle algorithm"
17555 .cindex "TCP_NODELAY on listening sockets"
17556 If this option is set false, it stops the Exim daemon setting the
17557 TCP_NODELAY option on its listening sockets. Setting TCP_NODELAY
17558 turns off the &"Nagle algorithm"&, which is a way of improving network
17559 performance in interactive (character-by-character) situations. Turning it off
17560 should improve Exim's performance a bit, so that is what happens by default.
17561 However, it appears that some broken clients cannot cope, and time out. Hence
17562 this option. It affects only those sockets that are set up for listening by the
17563 daemon. Sockets created by the smtp transport for delivering mail always set
17564 TCP_NODELAY.
17565
17566
17567 .option timeout_frozen_after main time 0s
17568 .cindex "frozen messages" "timing out"
17569 .cindex "timeout" "frozen messages"
17570 If &%timeout_frozen_after%& is set to a time greater than zero, a frozen
17571 message of any kind that has been in the queue for longer than the given time
17572 is automatically cancelled at the next queue run. If the frozen message is a
17573 bounce message, it is just discarded; otherwise, a bounce is sent to the
17574 sender, in a similar manner to cancellation by the &%-Mg%& command line option.
17575 If you want to timeout frozen bounce messages earlier than other kinds of
17576 frozen message, see &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&.
17577
17578 &*Note:*& the default value of zero means no timeouts; with this setting,
17579 frozen messages remain in the queue forever (except for any frozen bounce
17580 messages that are released by &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&).
17581
17582
17583 .option timezone main string unset
17584 .cindex "timezone, setting"
17585 .cindex "environment" "values from"
17586 The value of &%timezone%& is used to set the environment variable TZ while
17587 running Exim (if it is different on entry). This ensures that all timestamps
17588 created by Exim are in the required timezone. If you want all your timestamps
17589 to be in UTC (aka GMT) you should set
17590 .code
17591 timezone = UTC
17592 .endd
17593 The default value is taken from TIMEZONE_DEFAULT in &_Local/Makefile_&,
17594 or, if that is not set, from the value of the TZ environment variable when Exim
17595 is built. If &%timezone%& is set to the empty string, either at build or run
17596 time, any existing TZ variable is removed from the environment when Exim
17597 runs. This is appropriate behaviour for obtaining wall-clock time on some, but
17598 unfortunately not all, operating systems.
17599
17600
17601 .option tls_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
17602 .cindex "TLS" "advertising"
17603 .cindex "encryption" "on SMTP connection"
17604 .cindex "SMTP" "encrypted connection"
17605 When Exim is built with support for TLS encrypted connections, the availability
17606 of the STARTTLS command to set up an encrypted session is advertised in
17607 response to EHLO only to those client hosts that match this option. See
17608 chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of Exim's support for TLS.
17609 Note that the default value requires that a certificate be supplied
17610 using the &%tls_certificate%& option. If TLS support for incoming connections
17611 is not required the &%tls_advertise_hosts%& option should be set empty.
17612
17613
17614 .option tls_certificate main string list&!! unset
17615 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate; location of"
17616 .cindex "certificate" "server, location of"
17617 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be a list of absolute paths to
17618 files which contains the server's certificates. Commonly only one file is
17619 needed.
17620 The server's private key is also
17621 assumed to be in this file if &%tls_privatekey%& is unset. See chapter
17622 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
17623
17624 &*Note*&: The certificates defined by this option are used only when Exim is
17625 receiving incoming messages as a server. If you want to supply certificates for
17626 use when sending messages as a client, you must set the &%tls_certificate%&
17627 option in the relevant &(smtp)& transport.
17628
17629 &*Note*&: If you use filenames based on IP addresses, change the list
17630 separator in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&) to avoid confusion under IPv6.
17631
17632 &*Note*&: Under versions of OpenSSL preceding 1.1.1,
17633 when a list of more than one
17634 file is used, the &$tls_in_ourcert$& variable is unreliable.
17635
17636 &*Note*&: OCSP stapling is not usable under OpenSSL
17637 when a list of more than one file is used.
17638
17639 If the option contains &$tls_out_sni$& and Exim is built against OpenSSL, then
17640 if the OpenSSL build supports TLS extensions and the TLS client sends the
17641 Server Name Indication extension, then this option and others documented in
17642 &<<SECTtlssni>>& will be re-expanded.
17643
17644 If this option is unset or empty a fresh self-signed certificate will be
17645 generated for every connection.
17646
17647 .option tls_crl main string&!! unset
17648 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate revocation list"
17649 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list for server"
17650 This option specifies a certificate revocation list. The expanded value must
17651 be the name of a file that contains CRLs in PEM format.
17652
17653 Under OpenSSL the option can specify a directory with CRL files.
17654
17655 &*Note:*& Under OpenSSL the option must, if given, supply a CRL
17656 for each signing element of the certificate chain (i.e. all but the leaf).
17657 For the file variant this can be multiple PEM blocks in the one file.
17658
17659 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
17660
17661
17662 .option tls_dh_max_bits main integer 2236
17663 .cindex "TLS" "D-H bit count"
17664 The number of bits used for Diffie-Hellman key-exchange may be suggested by
17665 the chosen TLS library. That value might prove to be too high for
17666 interoperability. This option provides a maximum clamp on the value
17667 suggested, trading off security for interoperability.
17668
17669 The value must be at least 1024.
17670
17671 The value 2236 was chosen because, at time of adding the option, it was the
17672 hard-coded maximum value supported by the NSS cryptographic library, as used
17673 by Thunderbird, while GnuTLS was suggesting 2432 bits as normal.
17674
17675 If you prefer more security and are willing to break some clients, raise this
17676 number.
17677
17678 Note that the value passed to GnuTLS for *generating* a new prime may be a
17679 little less than this figure, because GnuTLS is inexact and may produce a
17680 larger prime than requested.
17681
17682
17683 .option tls_dhparam main string&!! unset
17684 .cindex "TLS" "D-H parameters for server"
17685 The value of this option is expanded and indicates the source of DH parameters
17686 to be used by Exim.
17687
17688 &*Note: The Exim Maintainers strongly recommend using a filename with site-generated
17689 local DH parameters*&, which has been supported across all versions of Exim. The
17690 other specific constants available are a fallback so that even when
17691 "unconfigured", Exim can offer Perfect Forward Secrecy in older ciphersuites in TLS.
17692
17693 If &%tls_dhparam%& is a filename starting with a &`/`&,
17694 then it names a file from which DH
17695 parameters should be loaded. If the file exists, it should hold a PEM-encoded
17696 PKCS#3 representation of the DH prime. If the file does not exist, for
17697 OpenSSL it is an error. For GnuTLS, Exim will attempt to create the file and
17698 fill it with a generated DH prime. For OpenSSL, if the DH bit-count from
17699 loading the file is greater than &%tls_dh_max_bits%& then it will be ignored,
17700 and treated as though the &%tls_dhparam%& were set to "none".
17701
17702 If this option expands to the string "none", then no DH parameters will be
17703 loaded by Exim.
17704
17705 If this option expands to the string "historic" and Exim is using GnuTLS, then
17706 Exim will attempt to load a file from inside the spool directory. If the file
17707 does not exist, Exim will attempt to create it.
17708 See section &<<SECTgnutlsparam>>& for further details.
17709
17710 If Exim is using OpenSSL and this option is empty or unset, then Exim will load
17711 a default DH prime; the default is Exim-specific but lacks verifiable provenance.
17712
17713 In older versions of Exim the default was the 2048 bit prime described in section
17714 2.2 of RFC 5114, "2048-bit MODP Group with 224-bit Prime Order Subgroup", which
17715 in IKE is assigned number 23.
17716
17717 Otherwise, the option must expand to the name used by Exim for any of a number
17718 of DH primes specified in RFC 2409, RFC 3526, RFC 5114, RFC 7919, or from other
17719 sources. As names, Exim uses a standard specified name, else "ike" followed by
17720 the number used by IKE, or "default" which corresponds to
17721 &`exim.dev.20160529.3`&.
17722
17723 The available standard primes are:
17724 &`ffdhe2048`&, &`ffdhe3072`&, &`ffdhe4096`&, &`ffdhe6144`&, &`ffdhe8192`&,
17725 &`ike1`&, &`ike2`&, &`ike5`&,
17726 &`ike14`&, &`ike15`&, &`ike16`&, &`ike17`&, &`ike18`&,
17727 &`ike22`&, &`ike23`& and &`ike24`&.
17728
17729 The available additional primes are:
17730 &`exim.dev.20160529.1`&, &`exim.dev.20160529.2`& and &`exim.dev.20160529.3`&.
17731
17732 Some of these will be too small to be accepted by clients.
17733 Some may be too large to be accepted by clients.
17734 The open cryptographic community has suspicions about the integrity of some
17735 of the later IKE values, which led into RFC7919 providing new fixed constants
17736 (the "ffdhe" identifiers).
17737
17738 At this point, all of the "ike" values should be considered obsolete;
17739 they're still in Exim to avoid breaking unusual configurations, but are
17740 candidates for removal the next time we have backwards-incompatible changes.
17741
17742 The TLS protocol does not negotiate an acceptable size for this; clients tend
17743 to hard-drop connections if what is offered by the server is unacceptable,
17744 whether too large or too small, and there's no provision for the client to
17745 tell the server what these constraints are. Thus, as a server operator, you
17746 need to make an educated guess as to what is most likely to work for your
17747 userbase.
17748
17749 Some known size constraints suggest that a bit-size in the range 2048 to 2236
17750 is most likely to maximise interoperability. The upper bound comes from
17751 applications using the Mozilla Network Security Services (NSS) library, which
17752 used to set its &`DH_MAX_P_BITS`& upper-bound to 2236. This affects many
17753 mail user agents (MUAs). The lower bound comes from Debian installs of Exim4
17754 prior to the 4.80 release, as Debian used to patch Exim to raise the minimum
17755 acceptable bound from 1024 to 2048.
17756
17757
17758 .option tls_eccurve main string&!! &`auto`&
17759 .cindex TLS "EC cryptography"
17760 This option selects a EC curve for use by Exim when used with OpenSSL.
17761 It has no effect when Exim is used with GnuTLS.
17762
17763 After expansion it must contain a valid EC curve parameter, such as
17764 &`prime256v1`&, &`secp384r1`&, or &`P-512`&. Consult your OpenSSL manual
17765 for valid selections.
17766
17767 For OpenSSL versions before (and not including) 1.0.2, the string
17768 &`auto`& selects &`prime256v1`&. For more recent OpenSSL versions
17769 &`auto`& tells the library to choose.
17770
17771 If the option expands to an empty string, no EC curves will be enabled.
17772
17773
17774 .option tls_ocsp_file main string&!! unset
17775 .cindex TLS "certificate status"
17776 .cindex TLS "OCSP proof file"
17777 This option
17778 must if set expand to the absolute path to a file which contains a current
17779 status proof for the server's certificate, as obtained from the
17780 Certificate Authority.
17781
17782 Usable for GnuTLS 3.4.4 or 3.3.17 or OpenSSL 1.1.0 (or later).
17783
17784 For GnuTLS 3.5.6 or later the expanded value of this option can be a list
17785 of files, to match a list given for the &%tls_certificate%& option.
17786 The ordering of the two lists must match.
17787
17788
17789 .option tls_on_connect_ports main "string list" unset
17790 .cindex SSMTP
17791 .cindex SMTPS
17792 This option specifies a list of incoming SSMTP (aka SMTPS) ports that should
17793 operate the SSMTP (SMTPS) protocol, where a TLS session is immediately
17794 set up without waiting for the client to issue a STARTTLS command. For
17795 further details, see section &<<SECTsupobssmt>>&.
17796
17797
17798
17799 .option tls_privatekey main string list&!! unset
17800 .cindex "TLS" "server private key; location of"
17801 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be a list of absolute paths to
17802 files which contains the server's private keys.
17803 If this option is unset, or if
17804 the expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string, the private
17805 key is assumed to be in the same file as the server's certificates. See chapter
17806 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
17807
17808 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
17809
17810
17811 .option tls_remember_esmtp main boolean false
17812 .cindex "TLS" "esmtp state; remembering"
17813 .cindex "TLS" "broken clients"
17814 If this option is set true, Exim violates the RFCs by remembering that it is in
17815 &"esmtp"& state after successfully negotiating a TLS session. This provides
17816 support for broken clients that fail to send a new EHLO after starting a
17817 TLS session.
17818
17819
17820 .option tls_require_ciphers main string&!! unset
17821 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers"
17822 .cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
17823 This option controls which ciphers can be used for incoming TLS connections.
17824 The &(smtp)& transport has an option of the same name for controlling outgoing
17825 connections. This option is expanded for each connection, so can be varied for
17826 different clients if required. The value of this option must be a list of
17827 permitted cipher suites. The OpenSSL and GnuTLS libraries handle cipher control
17828 in somewhat different ways. If GnuTLS is being used, the client controls the
17829 preference order of the available ciphers. Details are given in sections
17830 &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
17831
17832
17833 .option tls_try_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
17834 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
17835 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
17836 See &%tls_verify_hosts%& below.
17837
17838
17839 .option tls_verify_certificates main string&!! system
17840 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
17841 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
17842 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be either the
17843 word "system"
17844 or the absolute path to
17845 a file or directory containing permitted certificates for clients that
17846 match &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&.
17847
17848 The "system" value for the option will use a
17849 system default location compiled into the SSL library.
17850 This is not available for GnuTLS versions preceding 3.0.20,
17851 and will be taken as empty; an explicit location
17852 must be specified.
17853
17854 The use of a directory for the option value is not available for GnuTLS versions
17855 preceding 3.3.6 and a single file must be used.
17856
17857 With OpenSSL the certificates specified
17858 explicitly
17859 either by file or directory
17860 are added to those given by the system default location.
17861
17862 These certificates should be for the certificate authorities trusted, rather
17863 than the public cert of individual clients. With both OpenSSL and GnuTLS, if
17864 the value is a file then the certificates are sent by Exim as a server to
17865 connecting clients, defining the list of accepted certificate authorities.
17866 Thus the values defined should be considered public data. To avoid this,
17867 use the explicit directory version.
17868
17869 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
17870
17871 A forced expansion failure or setting to an empty string is equivalent to
17872 being unset.
17873
17874
17875 .option tls_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
17876 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
17877 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
17878 This option, along with &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&, controls the checking of
17879 certificates from clients. The expected certificates are defined by
17880 &%tls_verify_certificates%&, which must be set. A configuration error occurs if
17881 either &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& is set and
17882 &%tls_verify_certificates%& is not set.
17883
17884 Any client that matches &%tls_verify_hosts%& is constrained by
17885 &%tls_verify_certificates%&. When the client initiates a TLS session, it must
17886 present one of the listed certificates. If it does not, the connection is
17887 aborted. &*Warning*&: Including a host in &%tls_verify_hosts%& does not require
17888 the host to use TLS. It can still send SMTP commands through unencrypted
17889 connections. Forcing a client to use TLS has to be done separately using an
17890 ACL to reject inappropriate commands when the connection is not encrypted.
17891
17892 A weaker form of checking is provided by &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. If a client
17893 matches this option (but not &%tls_verify_hosts%&), Exim requests a
17894 certificate and checks it against &%tls_verify_certificates%&, but does not
17895 abort the connection if there is no certificate or if it does not match. This
17896 state can be detected in an ACL, which makes it possible to implement policies
17897 such as &"accept for relay only if a verified certificate has been received,
17898 but accept for local delivery if encrypted, even without a verified
17899 certificate"&.
17900
17901 Client hosts that match neither of these lists are not asked to present
17902 certificates.
17903
17904
17905 .option trusted_groups main "string list&!!" unset
17906 .cindex "trusted groups"
17907 .cindex "groups" "trusted"
17908 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If this
17909 option is set, any process that is running in one of the listed groups, or
17910 which has one of them as a supplementary group, is trusted. The groups can be
17911 specified numerically or by name. See section &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for
17912 details of what trusted callers are permitted to do. If neither
17913 &%trusted_groups%& nor &%trusted_users%& is set, only root and the Exim user
17914 are trusted.
17915
17916 .option trusted_users main "string list&!!" unset
17917 .cindex "trusted users"
17918 .cindex "user" "trusted"
17919 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If this
17920 option is set, any process that is running as one of the listed users is
17921 trusted. The users can be specified numerically or by name. See section
17922 &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for details of what trusted callers are permitted to do.
17923 If neither &%trusted_groups%& nor &%trusted_users%& is set, only root and the
17924 Exim user are trusted.
17925
17926 .option unknown_login main string&!! unset
17927 .cindex "uid (user id)" "unknown caller"
17928 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
17929 This is a specialized feature for use in unusual configurations. By default, if
17930 the uid of the caller of Exim cannot be looked up using &[getpwuid()]&, Exim
17931 gives up. The &%unknown_login%& option can be used to set a login name to be
17932 used in this circumstance. It is expanded, so values like &%user$caller_uid%&
17933 can be set. When &%unknown_login%& is used, the value of &%unknown_username%&
17934 is used for the user's real name (gecos field), unless this has been set by the
17935 &%-F%& option.
17936
17937 .option unknown_username main string unset
17938 See &%unknown_login%&.
17939
17940 .option untrusted_set_sender main "address list&!!" unset
17941 .cindex "trusted users"
17942 .cindex "sender" "setting by untrusted user"
17943 .cindex "untrusted user setting sender"
17944 .cindex "user" "untrusted setting sender"
17945 .cindex "envelope from"
17946 .cindex "envelope sender"
17947 When an untrusted user submits a message to Exim using the standard input, Exim
17948 normally creates an envelope sender address from the user's login and the
17949 default qualification domain. Data from the &%-f%& option (for setting envelope
17950 senders on non-SMTP messages) or the SMTP MAIL command (if &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&
17951 is used) is ignored.
17952
17953 However, untrusted users are permitted to set an empty envelope sender address,
17954 to declare that a message should never generate any bounces. For example:
17955 .code
17956 exim -f '<>' user@domain.example
17957 .endd
17958 .vindex "&$sender_ident$&"
17959 The &%untrusted_set_sender%& option allows you to permit untrusted users to set
17960 other envelope sender addresses in a controlled way. When it is set, untrusted
17961 users are allowed to set envelope sender addresses that match any of the
17962 patterns in the list. Like all address lists, the string is expanded. The
17963 identity of the user is in &$sender_ident$&, so you can, for example, restrict
17964 users to setting senders that start with their login ids
17965 followed by a hyphen
17966 by a setting like this:
17967 .code
17968 untrusted_set_sender = ^$sender_ident-
17969 .endd
17970 If you want to allow untrusted users to set envelope sender addresses without
17971 restriction, you can use
17972 .code
17973 untrusted_set_sender = *
17974 .endd
17975 The &%untrusted_set_sender%& option applies to all forms of local input, but
17976 only to the setting of the envelope sender. It does not permit untrusted users
17977 to use the other options which trusted user can use to override message
17978 parameters. Furthermore, it does not stop Exim from removing an existing
17979 &'Sender:'& header in the message, or from adding a &'Sender:'& header if
17980 necessary. See &%local_sender_retain%& and &%local_from_check%& for ways of
17981 overriding these actions. The handling of the &'Sender:'& header is also
17982 described in section &<<SECTthesenhea>>&.
17983
17984 The log line for a message's arrival shows the envelope sender following
17985 &"<="&. For local messages, the user's login always follows, after &"U="&. In
17986 &%-bp%& displays, and in the Exim monitor, if an untrusted user sets an
17987 envelope sender address, the user's login is shown in parentheses after the
17988 sender address.
17989
17990
17991 .option uucp_from_pattern main string "see below"
17992 .cindex "&""From""& line"
17993 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
17994 Some applications that pass messages to an MTA via a command line interface use
17995 an initial line starting with &"From&~"& to pass the envelope sender. In
17996 particular, this is used by UUCP software. Exim recognizes such a line by means
17997 of a regular expression that is set in &%uucp_from_pattern%&. When the pattern
17998 matches, the sender address is constructed by expanding the contents of
17999 &%uucp_from_sender%&, provided that the caller of Exim is a trusted user. The
18000 default pattern recognizes lines in the following two forms:
18001 .code
18002 From ph10 Fri Jan 5 12:35 GMT 1996
18003 From ph10 Fri, 7 Jan 97 14:00:00 GMT
18004 .endd
18005 The pattern can be seen by running
18006 .code
18007 exim -bP uucp_from_pattern
18008 .endd
18009 It checks only up to the hours and minutes, and allows for a 2-digit or 4-digit
18010 year in the second case. The first word after &"From&~"& is matched in the
18011 regular expression by a parenthesized subpattern. The default value for
18012 &%uucp_from_sender%& is &"$1"&, which therefore just uses this first word
18013 (&"ph10"& in the example above) as the message's sender. See also
18014 &%ignore_fromline_hosts%&.
18015
18016
18017 .option uucp_from_sender main string&!! &`$1`&
18018 See &%uucp_from_pattern%& above.
18019
18020
18021 .option warn_message_file main string unset
18022 .cindex "warning of delay" "customizing the message"
18023 .cindex "customizing" "warning message"
18024 This option defines a template file containing paragraphs of text to be used
18025 for constructing the warning message which is sent by Exim when a message has
18026 been in the queue for a specified amount of time, as specified by
18027 &%delay_warning%&. Details of the file's contents are given in chapter
18028 &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&. See also &%bounce_message_file%&.
18029
18030
18031 .option write_rejectlog main boolean true
18032 .cindex "reject log" "disabling"
18033 If this option is set false, Exim no longer writes anything to the reject log.
18034 See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of what Exim writes to its logs.
18035 .ecindex IIDconfima
18036 .ecindex IIDmaiconf
18037
18038
18039
18040
18041 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18042 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18043
18044 .chapter "Generic options for routers" "CHAProutergeneric"
18045 .scindex IIDgenoprou1 "options" "generic; for routers"
18046 .scindex IIDgenoprou2 "generic options" "router"
18047 This chapter describes the generic options that apply to all routers.
18048 Those that are preconditions are marked with &Dagger; in the &"use"& field.
18049
18050 For a general description of how a router operates, see sections
18051 &<<SECTrunindrou>>& and &<<SECTrouprecon>>&. The latter specifies the order in
18052 which the preconditions are tested. The order of expansion of the options that
18053 provide data for a transport is: &%errors_to%&, &%headers_add%&,
18054 &%headers_remove%&, &%transport%&.
18055
18056
18057
18058 .option address_data routers string&!! unset
18059 .cindex "router" "data attached to address"
18060 The string is expanded just before the router is run, that is, after all the
18061 precondition tests have succeeded. If the expansion is forced to fail, the
18062 router declines, the value of &%address_data%& remains unchanged, and the
18063 &%more%& option controls what happens next. Other expansion failures cause
18064 delivery of the address to be deferred.
18065
18066 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
18067 When the expansion succeeds, the value is retained with the address, and can be
18068 accessed using the variable &$address_data$& in the current router, subsequent
18069 routers, and the eventual transport.
18070
18071 &*Warning*&: If the current or any subsequent router is a &(redirect)& router
18072 that runs a user's filter file, the contents of &$address_data$& are accessible
18073 in the filter. This is not normally a problem, because such data is usually
18074 either not confidential or it &"belongs"& to the current user, but if you do
18075 put confidential data into &$address_data$& you need to remember this point.
18076
18077 Even if the router declines or passes, the value of &$address_data$& remains
18078 with the address, though it can be changed by another &%address_data%& setting
18079 on a subsequent router. If a router generates child addresses, the value of
18080 &$address_data$& propagates to them. This also applies to the special kind of
18081 &"child"& that is generated by a router with the &%unseen%& option.
18082
18083 The idea of &%address_data%& is that you can use it to look up a lot of data
18084 for the address once, and then pick out parts of the data later. For example,
18085 you could use a single LDAP lookup to return a string of the form
18086 .code
18087 uid=1234 gid=5678 mailbox=/mail/xyz forward=/home/xyz/.forward
18088 .endd
18089 In the transport you could pick out the mailbox by a setting such as
18090 .code
18091 file = ${extract{mailbox}{$address_data}}
18092 .endd
18093 This makes the configuration file less messy, and also reduces the number of
18094 lookups (though Exim does cache lookups).
18095
18096 .new
18097 See also the &%set%& option below.
18098 .wen
18099
18100 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
18101 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
18102 The &%address_data%& facility is also useful as a means of passing information
18103 from one router to another, and from a router to a transport. In addition, if
18104 &$address_data$& is set by a router when verifying a recipient address from an
18105 ACL, it remains available for use in the rest of the ACL statement. After
18106 verifying a sender, the value is transferred to &$sender_address_data$&.
18107
18108
18109
18110 .option address_test routers&!? boolean true
18111 .oindex "&%-bt%&"
18112 .cindex "router" "skipping when address testing"
18113 If this option is set false, the router is skipped when routing is being tested
18114 by means of the &%-bt%& command line option. This can be a convenience when
18115 your first router sends messages to an external scanner, because it saves you
18116 having to set the &"already scanned"& indicator when testing real address
18117 routing.
18118
18119
18120
18121 .option cannot_route_message routers string&!! unset
18122 .cindex "router" "customizing &""cannot route""& message"
18123 .cindex "customizing" "&""cannot route""& message"
18124 This option specifies a text message that is used when an address cannot be
18125 routed because Exim has run out of routers. The default message is
18126 &"Unrouteable address"&. This option is useful only on routers that have
18127 &%more%& set false, or on the very last router in a configuration, because the
18128 value that is used is taken from the last router that is considered. This
18129 includes a router that is skipped because its preconditions are not met, as
18130 well as a router that declines. For example, using the default configuration,
18131 you could put:
18132 .code
18133 cannot_route_message = Remote domain not found in DNS
18134 .endd
18135 on the first router, which is a &(dnslookup)& router with &%more%& set false,
18136 and
18137 .code
18138 cannot_route_message = Unknown local user
18139 .endd
18140 on the final router that checks for local users. If string expansion fails for
18141 this option, the default message is used. Unless the expansion failure was
18142 explicitly forced, a message about the failure is written to the main and panic
18143 logs, in addition to the normal message about the routing failure.
18144
18145
18146 .option caseful_local_part routers boolean false
18147 .cindex "case of local parts"
18148 .cindex "router" "case of local parts"
18149 By default, routers handle the local parts of addresses in a case-insensitive
18150 manner, though the actual case is preserved for transmission with the message.
18151 If you want the case of letters to be significant in a router, you must set
18152 this option true. For individual router options that contain address or local
18153 part lists (for example, &%local_parts%&), case-sensitive matching can be
18154 turned on by &"+caseful"& as a list item. See section &<<SECTcasletadd>>& for
18155 more details.
18156
18157 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
18158 .vindex "&$original_local_part$&"
18159 .vindex "&$parent_local_part$&"
18160 The value of the &$local_part$& variable is forced to lower case while a
18161 router is running unless &%caseful_local_part%& is set. When a router assigns
18162 an address to a transport, the value of &$local_part$& when the transport runs
18163 is the same as it was in the router. Similarly, when a router generates child
18164 addresses by aliasing or forwarding, the values of &$original_local_part$&
18165 and &$parent_local_part$& are those that were used by the redirecting router.
18166
18167 This option applies to the processing of an address by a router. When a
18168 recipient address is being processed in an ACL, there is a separate &%control%&
18169 modifier that can be used to specify case-sensitive processing within the ACL
18170 (see section &<<SECTcontrols>>&).
18171
18172
18173
18174 .option check_local_user routers&!? boolean false
18175 .cindex "local user, checking in router"
18176 .cindex "router" "checking for local user"
18177 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&"
18178 .vindex "&$home$&"
18179 When this option is true, Exim checks that the local part of the recipient
18180 address (with affixes removed if relevant) is the name of an account on the
18181 local system. The check is done by calling the &[getpwnam()]& function rather
18182 than trying to read &_/etc/passwd_& directly. This means that other methods of
18183 holding password data (such as NIS) are supported. If the local part is a local
18184 user, &$home$& is set from the password data, and can be tested in other
18185 preconditions that are evaluated after this one (the order of evaluation is
18186 given in section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). However, the value of &$home$& can be
18187 overridden by &%router_home_directory%&. If the local part is not a local user,
18188 the router is skipped.
18189
18190 If you want to check that the local part is either the name of a local user
18191 or matches something else, you cannot combine &%check_local_user%& with a
18192 setting of &%local_parts%&, because that specifies the logical &'and'& of the
18193 two conditions. However, you can use a &(passwd)& lookup in a &%local_parts%&
18194 setting to achieve this. For example:
18195 .code
18196 local_parts = passwd;$local_part : lsearch;/etc/other/users
18197 .endd
18198 Note, however, that the side effects of &%check_local_user%& (such as setting
18199 up a home directory) do not occur when a &(passwd)& lookup is used in a
18200 &%local_parts%& (or any other) precondition.
18201
18202
18203
18204 .option condition routers&!? string&!! unset
18205 .cindex "router" "customized precondition"
18206 This option specifies a general precondition test that has to succeed for the
18207 router to be called. The &%condition%& option is the last precondition to be
18208 evaluated (see section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). The string is expanded, and if the
18209 result is a forced failure, or an empty string, or one of the strings &"0"& or
18210 &"no"& or &"false"& (checked without regard to the case of the letters), the
18211 router is skipped, and the address is offered to the next one.
18212
18213 If the result is any other value, the router is run (as this is the last
18214 precondition to be evaluated, all the other preconditions must be true).
18215
18216 This option is unusual in that multiple &%condition%& options may be present.
18217 All &%condition%& options must succeed.
18218
18219 The &%condition%& option provides a means of applying custom conditions to the
18220 running of routers. Note that in the case of a simple conditional expansion,
18221 the default expansion values are exactly what is wanted. For example:
18222 .code
18223 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}}
18224 .endd
18225 Because of the default behaviour of the string expansion, this is equivalent to
18226 .code
18227 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}{true}{}}
18228 .endd
18229
18230 A multiple condition example, which succeeds:
18231 .code
18232 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}}
18233 condition = ${if !eq{${lc:$local_part}}{postmaster}}
18234 condition = foobar
18235 .endd
18236
18237 If the expansion fails (other than forced failure) delivery is deferred. Some
18238 of the other precondition options are common special cases that could in fact
18239 be specified using &%condition%&.
18240
18241 Historical note: We have &%condition%& on ACLs and on Routers. Routers
18242 are far older, and use one set of semantics. ACLs are newer and when
18243 they were created, the ACL &%condition%& process was given far stricter
18244 parse semantics. The &%bool{}%& expansion condition uses the same rules as
18245 ACLs. The &%bool_lax{}%& expansion condition uses the same rules as
18246 Routers. More pointedly, the &%bool_lax{}%& was written to match the existing
18247 Router rules processing behavior.
18248
18249 This is best illustrated in an example:
18250 .code
18251 # If used in an ACL condition will fail with a syntax error, but
18252 # in a router condition any extra characters are treated as a string
18253
18254 $ exim -be '${if eq {${lc:GOOGLE.com}} {google.com}} {yes} {no}}'
18255 true {yes} {no}}
18256
18257 $ exim -be '${if eq {${lc:WHOIS.com}} {google.com}} {yes} {no}}'
18258 {yes} {no}}
18259 .endd
18260 In each example above, the &%if%& statement actually ends after
18261 &"{google.com}}"&. Since no true or false braces were defined, the
18262 default &%if%& behavior is to return a boolean true or a null answer
18263 (which evaluates to false). The rest of the line is then treated as a
18264 string. So the first example resulted in the boolean answer &"true"&
18265 with the string &" {yes} {no}}"& appended to it. The second example
18266 resulted in the null output (indicating false) with the string
18267 &" {yes} {no}}"& appended to it.
18268
18269 In fact you can put excess forward braces in too. In the router
18270 &%condition%&, Exim's parser only looks for &"{"& symbols when they
18271 mean something, like after a &"$"& or when required as part of a
18272 conditional. But otherwise &"{"& and &"}"& are treated as ordinary
18273 string characters.
18274
18275 Thus, in a Router, the above expansion strings will both always evaluate
18276 true, as the result of expansion is a non-empty string which doesn't
18277 match an explicit false value. This can be tricky to debug. By
18278 contrast, in an ACL either of those strings will always result in an
18279 expansion error because the result doesn't look sufficiently boolean.
18280
18281
18282 .option debug_print routers string&!! unset
18283 .cindex "testing" "variables in drivers"
18284 If this option is set and debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%& command line
18285 option) or in address-testing mode (see the &%-bt%& command line option),
18286 the string is expanded and included in the debugging output.
18287 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
18288 output, and Exim carries on processing.
18289 This option is provided to help with checking out the values of variables and
18290 so on when debugging router configurations. For example, if a &%condition%&
18291 option appears not to be working, &%debug_print%& can be used to output the
18292 variables it references. The output happens after checks for &%domains%&,
18293 &%local_parts%&, and &%check_local_user%& but before any other preconditions
18294 are tested. A newline is added to the text if it does not end with one.
18295 The variable &$router_name$& contains the name of the router.
18296
18297
18298
18299 .option disable_logging routers boolean false
18300 If this option is set true, nothing is logged for any routing errors
18301 or for any deliveries caused by this router. You should not set this option
18302 unless you really, really know what you are doing. See also the generic
18303 transport option of the same name.
18304
18305 .option dnssec_request_domains routers "domain list&!!" unset
18306 .cindex "MX record" "security"
18307 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
18308 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
18309 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
18310 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_request_domains%& will be done with
18311 the dnssec request bit set.
18312 This applies to all of the SRV, MX, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
18313
18314 .option dnssec_require_domains routers "domain list&!!" unset
18315 .cindex "MX record" "security"
18316 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
18317 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
18318 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
18319 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_require_domains%& will be done with
18320 the dnssec request bit set. Any returns not having the Authenticated Data bit
18321 (AD bit) set will be ignored and logged as a host-lookup failure.
18322 This applies to all of the SRV, MX, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
18323
18324
18325 .option domains routers&!? "domain list&!!" unset
18326 .cindex "router" "restricting to specific domains"
18327 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
18328 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the current domain matches
18329 the list. If the match is achieved by means of a file lookup, the data that the
18330 lookup returned for the domain is placed in &$domain_data$& for use in string
18331 expansions of the driver's private options. See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for
18332 a list of the order in which preconditions are evaluated.
18333
18334
18335
18336 .option driver routers string unset
18337 This option must always be set. It specifies which of the available routers is
18338 to be used.
18339
18340
18341 .option dsn_lasthop routers boolean false
18342 .cindex "DSN" "success"
18343 .cindex "Delivery Status Notification" "success"
18344 If this option is set true, and extended DSN (RFC3461) processing is in effect,
18345 Exim will not pass on DSN requests to downstream DSN-aware hosts but will
18346 instead send a success DSN as if the next hop does not support DSN.
18347 Not effective on redirect routers.
18348
18349
18350
18351 .option errors_to routers string&!! unset
18352 .cindex "envelope from"
18353 .cindex "envelope sender"
18354 .cindex "router" "changing address for errors"
18355 If a router successfully handles an address, it may assign the address to a
18356 transport for delivery or it may generate child addresses. In both cases, if
18357 there is a delivery problem during later processing, the resulting bounce
18358 message is sent to the address that results from expanding this string,
18359 provided that the address verifies successfully. The &%errors_to%& option is
18360 expanded before &%headers_add%&, &%headers_remove%&, and &%transport%&.
18361
18362 The &%errors_to%& setting associated with an address can be overridden if it
18363 subsequently passes through other routers that have their own &%errors_to%&
18364 settings, or if the message is delivered by a transport with a &%return_path%&
18365 setting.
18366
18367 If &%errors_to%& is unset, or the expansion is forced to fail, or the result of
18368 the expansion fails to verify, the errors address associated with the incoming
18369 address is used. At top level, this is the envelope sender. A non-forced
18370 expansion failure causes delivery to be deferred.
18371
18372 If an address for which &%errors_to%& has been set ends up being delivered over
18373 SMTP, the envelope sender for that delivery is the &%errors_to%& value, so that
18374 any bounces that are generated by other MTAs on the delivery route are also
18375 sent there. You can set &%errors_to%& to the empty string by either of these
18376 settings:
18377 .code
18378 errors_to =
18379 errors_to = ""
18380 .endd
18381 An expansion item that yields an empty string has the same effect. If you do
18382 this, a locally detected delivery error for addresses processed by this router
18383 no longer gives rise to a bounce message; the error is discarded. If the
18384 address is delivered to a remote host, the return path is set to &`<>`&, unless
18385 overridden by the &%return_path%& option on the transport.
18386
18387 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
18388 If for some reason you want to discard local errors, but use a non-empty
18389 MAIL command for remote delivery, you can preserve the original return
18390 path in &$address_data$& in the router, and reinstate it in the transport by
18391 setting &%return_path%&.
18392
18393 The most common use of &%errors_to%& is to direct mailing list bounces to the
18394 manager of the list, as described in section &<<SECTmailinglists>>&, or to
18395 implement VERP (Variable Envelope Return Paths) (see section &<<SECTverp>>&).
18396
18397
18398
18399 .option expn routers&!? boolean true
18400 .cindex "address" "testing"
18401 .cindex "testing" "addresses"
18402 .cindex "EXPN" "router skipping"
18403 .cindex "router" "skipping for EXPN"
18404 If this option is turned off, the router is skipped when testing an address
18405 as a result of processing an SMTP EXPN command. You might, for example,
18406 want to turn it off on a router for users' &_.forward_& files, while leaving it
18407 on for the system alias file.
18408 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
18409 are evaluated.
18410
18411 The use of the SMTP EXPN command is controlled by an ACL (see chapter
18412 &<<CHAPACL>>&). When Exim is running an EXPN command, it is similar to testing
18413 an address with &%-bt%&. Compare VRFY, whose counterpart is &%-bv%&.
18414
18415
18416
18417 .option fail_verify routers boolean false
18418 .cindex "router" "forcing verification failure"
18419 Setting this option has the effect of setting both &%fail_verify_sender%& and
18420 &%fail_verify_recipient%& to the same value.
18421
18422
18423
18424 .option fail_verify_recipient routers boolean false
18425 If this option is true and an address is accepted by this router when
18426 verifying a recipient, verification fails.
18427
18428
18429
18430 .option fail_verify_sender routers boolean false
18431 If this option is true and an address is accepted by this router when
18432 verifying a sender, verification fails.
18433
18434
18435
18436 .option fallback_hosts routers "string list" unset
18437 .cindex "router" "fallback hosts"
18438 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on router"
18439 String expansion is not applied to this option. The argument must be a
18440 colon-separated list of host names or IP addresses. The list separator can be
18441 changed (see section &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&), and a port can be specified with
18442 each name or address. In fact, the format of each item is exactly the same as
18443 defined for the list of hosts in a &(manualroute)& router (see section
18444 &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&).
18445
18446 If a router queues an address for a remote transport, this host list is
18447 associated with the address, and used instead of the transport's fallback host
18448 list. If &%hosts_randomize%& is set on the transport, the order of the list is
18449 randomized for each use. See the &%fallback_hosts%& option of the &(smtp)&
18450 transport for further details.
18451
18452
18453 .option group routers string&!! "see below"
18454 .cindex "gid (group id)" "local delivery"
18455 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
18456 .cindex "transport" "local"
18457 .cindex "router" "setting group"
18458 When a router queues an address for a transport, and the transport does not
18459 specify a group, the group given here is used when running the delivery
18460 process.
18461 The group may be specified numerically or by name. If expansion fails, the
18462 error is logged and delivery is deferred.
18463 The default is unset, unless &%check_local_user%& is set, when the default
18464 is taken from the password information. See also &%initgroups%& and &%user%&
18465 and the discussion in chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
18466
18467
18468
18469 .option headers_add routers list&!! unset
18470 .cindex "header lines" "adding"
18471 .cindex "router" "adding header lines"
18472 This option specifies a list of text headers,
18473 newline-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&),
18474 that is associated with any addresses that are accepted by the router.
18475 Each item is separately expanded, at routing time. However, this
18476 option has no effect when an address is just being verified. The way in which
18477 the text is used to add header lines at transport time is described in section
18478 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. New header lines are not actually added until the
18479 message is in the process of being transported. This means that references to
18480 header lines in string expansions in the transport's configuration do not
18481 &"see"& the added header lines.
18482
18483 The &%headers_add%& option is expanded after &%errors_to%&, but before
18484 &%headers_remove%& and &%transport%&. If an item is empty, or if
18485 an item expansion is forced to fail, the item has no effect. Other expansion
18486 failures are treated as configuration errors.
18487
18488 Unlike most options, &%headers_add%& can be specified multiple times
18489 for a router; all listed headers are added.
18490
18491 &*Warning 1*&: The &%headers_add%& option cannot be used for a &(redirect)&
18492 router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
18493
18494 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
18495 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
18496 &*Warning 2*&: If the &%unseen%& option is set on the router, all header
18497 additions are deleted when the address is passed on to subsequent routers.
18498 For a &%redirect%& router, if a generated address is the same as the incoming
18499 address, this can lead to duplicate addresses with different header
18500 modifications. Exim does not do duplicate deliveries (except, in certain
18501 circumstances, to pipes -- see section &<<SECTdupaddr>>&), but it is undefined
18502 which of the duplicates is discarded, so this ambiguous situation should be
18503 avoided. The &%repeat_use%& option of the &%redirect%& router may be of help.
18504
18505
18506
18507 .option headers_remove routers list&!! unset
18508 .cindex "header lines" "removing"
18509 .cindex "router" "removing header lines"
18510 This option specifies a list of text headers,
18511 colon-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&),
18512 that is associated with any addresses that are accepted by the router.
18513 Each item is separately expanded, at routing time. However, this
18514 option has no effect when an address is just being verified. The way in which
18515 the text is used to remove header lines at transport time is described in
18516 section &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Header lines are not actually removed until
18517 the message is in the process of being transported. This means that references
18518 to header lines in string expansions in the transport's configuration still
18519 &"see"& the original header lines.
18520
18521 The &%headers_remove%& option is expanded after &%errors_to%& and
18522 &%headers_add%&, but before &%transport%&. If an item expansion is forced to fail,
18523 the item has no effect. Other expansion failures are treated as configuration
18524 errors.
18525
18526 Unlike most options, &%headers_remove%& can be specified multiple times
18527 for a router; all listed headers are removed.
18528
18529 &*Warning 1*&: The &%headers_remove%& option cannot be used for a &(redirect)&
18530 router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
18531
18532 &*Warning 2*&: If the &%unseen%& option is set on the router, all header
18533 removal requests are deleted when the address is passed on to subsequent
18534 routers, and this can lead to problems with duplicates -- see the similar
18535 warning for &%headers_add%& above.
18536
18537 &*Warning 3*&: Because of the separate expansion of the list items,
18538 items that contain a list separator must have it doubled.
18539 To avoid this, change the list separator (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
18540
18541
18542
18543 .option ignore_target_hosts routers "host list&!!" unset
18544 .cindex "IP address" "discarding"
18545 .cindex "router" "discarding IP addresses"
18546 Although this option is a host list, it should normally contain IP address
18547 entries rather than names. If any host that is looked up by the router has an
18548 IP address that matches an item in this list, Exim behaves as if that IP
18549 address did not exist. This option allows you to cope with rogue DNS entries
18550 like
18551 .code
18552 remote.domain.example. A 127.0.0.1
18553 .endd
18554 by setting
18555 .code
18556 ignore_target_hosts = 127.0.0.1
18557 .endd
18558 on the relevant router. If all the hosts found by a &(dnslookup)& router are
18559 discarded in this way, the router declines. In a conventional configuration, an
18560 attempt to mail to such a domain would normally provoke the &"unrouteable
18561 domain"& error, and an attempt to verify an address in the domain would fail.
18562 Similarly, if &%ignore_target_hosts%& is set on an &(ipliteral)& router, the
18563 router declines if presented with one of the listed addresses.
18564
18565 You can use this option to disable the use of IPv4 or IPv6 for mail delivery by
18566 means of the first or the second of the following settings, respectively:
18567 .code
18568 ignore_target_hosts = 0.0.0.0/0
18569 ignore_target_hosts = <; 0::0/0
18570 .endd
18571 The pattern in the first line matches all IPv4 addresses, whereas the pattern
18572 in the second line matches all IPv6 addresses.
18573
18574 This option may also be useful for ignoring link-local and site-local IPv6
18575 addresses. Because, like all host lists, the value of &%ignore_target_hosts%&
18576 is expanded before use as a list, it is possible to make it dependent on the
18577 domain that is being routed.
18578
18579 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
18580 During its expansion, &$host_address$& is set to the IP address that is being
18581 checked.
18582
18583 .option initgroups routers boolean false
18584 .cindex "additional groups"
18585 .cindex "groups" "additional"
18586 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
18587 .cindex "transport" "local"
18588 If the router queues an address for a transport, and this option is true, and
18589 the uid supplied by the router is not overridden by the transport, the
18590 &[initgroups()]& function is called when running the transport to ensure that
18591 any additional groups associated with the uid are set up. See also &%group%&
18592 and &%user%& and the discussion in chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
18593
18594
18595
18596 .option local_part_prefix routers&!? "string list" unset
18597 .cindex affix "router precondition"
18598 .cindex "router" "prefix for local part"
18599 .cindex "prefix" "for local part, used in router"
18600 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the local part starts with
18601 one of the given strings, or &%local_part_prefix_optional%& is true. See
18602 section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions are
18603 evaluated.
18604
18605 The list is scanned from left to right, and the first prefix that matches is
18606 used. A limited form of wildcard is available; if the prefix begins with an
18607 asterisk, it matches the longest possible sequence of arbitrary characters at
18608 the start of the local part. An asterisk should therefore always be followed by
18609 some character that does not occur in normal local parts.
18610 .cindex "multiple mailboxes"
18611 .cindex "mailbox" "multiple"
18612 Wildcarding can be used to set up multiple user mailboxes, as described in
18613 section &<<SECTmulbox>>&.
18614
18615 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
18616 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
18617 During the testing of the &%local_parts%& option, and while the router is
18618 running, the prefix is removed from the local part, and is available in the
18619 expansion variable &$local_part_prefix$&. When a message is being delivered, if
18620 the router accepts the address, this remains true during subsequent delivery by
18621 a transport. In particular, the local part that is transmitted in the RCPT
18622 command for LMTP, SMTP, and BSMTP deliveries has the prefix removed by default.
18623 This behaviour can be overridden by setting &%rcpt_include_affixes%& true on
18624 the relevant transport.
18625
18626 When an address is being verified, &%local_part_prefix%& affects only the
18627 behaviour of the router. If the callout feature of verification is in use, this
18628 means that the full address, including the prefix, will be used during the
18629 callout.
18630
18631 The prefix facility is commonly used to handle local parts of the form
18632 &%owner-something%&. Another common use is to support local parts of the form
18633 &%real-username%& to bypass a user's &_.forward_& file &-- helpful when trying
18634 to tell a user their forwarding is broken &-- by placing a router like this one
18635 immediately before the router that handles &_.forward_& files:
18636 .code
18637 real_localuser:
18638 driver = accept
18639 local_part_prefix = real-
18640 check_local_user
18641 transport = local_delivery
18642 .endd
18643 For security, it would probably be a good idea to restrict the use of this
18644 router to locally-generated messages, using a condition such as this:
18645 .code
18646 condition = ${if match {$sender_host_address}\
18647 {\N^(|127\.0\.0\.1)$\N}}
18648 .endd
18649
18650 If both &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& are set for a router,
18651 both conditions must be met if not optional. Care must be taken if wildcards
18652 are used in both a prefix and a suffix on the same router. Different
18653 separator characters must be used to avoid ambiguity.
18654
18655
18656 .option local_part_prefix_optional routers boolean false
18657 See &%local_part_prefix%& above.
18658
18659
18660
18661 .option local_part_suffix routers&!? "string list" unset
18662 .cindex "router" "suffix for local part"
18663 .cindex "suffix for local part" "used in router"
18664 This option operates in the same way as &%local_part_prefix%&, except that the
18665 local part must end (rather than start) with the given string, the
18666 &%local_part_suffix_optional%& option determines whether the suffix is
18667 mandatory, and the wildcard * character, if present, must be the last
18668 character of the suffix. This option facility is commonly used to handle local
18669 parts of the form &%something-request%& and multiple user mailboxes of the form
18670 &%username-foo%&.
18671
18672
18673 .option local_part_suffix_optional routers boolean false
18674 See &%local_part_suffix%& above.
18675
18676
18677
18678 .option local_parts routers&!? "local part list&!!" unset
18679 .cindex "router" "restricting to specific local parts"
18680 .cindex "local part" "checking in router"
18681 The router is run only if the local part of the address matches the list.
18682 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
18683 are evaluated, and
18684 section &<<SECTlocparlis>>& for a discussion of local part lists. Because the
18685 string is expanded, it is possible to make it depend on the domain, for
18686 example:
18687 .code
18688 local_parts = dbm;/usr/local/specials/$domain
18689 .endd
18690 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
18691 If the match is achieved by a lookup, the data that the lookup returned
18692 for the local part is placed in the variable &$local_part_data$& for use in
18693 expansions of the router's private options. You might use this option, for
18694 example, if you have a large number of local virtual domains, and you want to
18695 send all postmaster mail to the same place without having to set up an alias in
18696 each virtual domain:
18697 .code
18698 postmaster:
18699 driver = redirect
18700 local_parts = postmaster
18701 data = postmaster@real.domain.example
18702 .endd
18703
18704
18705 .option log_as_local routers boolean "see below"
18706 .cindex "log" "delivery line"
18707 .cindex "delivery" "log line format"
18708 Exim has two logging styles for delivery, the idea being to make local
18709 deliveries stand out more visibly from remote ones. In the &"local"& style, the
18710 recipient address is given just as the local part, without a domain. The use of
18711 this style is controlled by this option. It defaults to true for the &(accept)&
18712 router, and false for all the others. This option applies only when a
18713 router assigns an address to a transport. It has no effect on routers that
18714 redirect addresses.
18715
18716
18717
18718 .option more routers boolean&!! true
18719 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value,
18720 that is, one of the strings &"yes"&, &"no"&, &"true"&, or &"false"&. Any other
18721 result causes an error, and delivery is deferred. If the expansion is forced to
18722 fail, the default value for the option (true) is used. Other failures cause
18723 delivery to be deferred.
18724
18725 If this option is set false, and the router declines to handle the address, no
18726 further routers are tried, routing fails, and the address is bounced.
18727 .oindex "&%self%&"
18728 However, if the router explicitly passes an address to the following router by
18729 means of the setting
18730 .code
18731 self = pass
18732 .endd
18733 or otherwise, the setting of &%more%& is ignored. Also, the setting of &%more%&
18734 does not affect the behaviour if one of the precondition tests fails. In that
18735 case, the address is always passed to the next router.
18736
18737 Note that &%address_data%& is not considered to be a precondition. If its
18738 expansion is forced to fail, the router declines, and the value of &%more%&
18739 controls what happens next.
18740
18741
18742 .option pass_on_timeout routers boolean false
18743 .cindex "timeout" "of router"
18744 .cindex "router" "timeout"
18745 If a router times out during a host lookup, it normally causes deferral of the
18746 address. If &%pass_on_timeout%& is set, the address is passed on to the next
18747 router, overriding &%no_more%&. This may be helpful for systems that are
18748 intermittently connected to the Internet, or those that want to pass to a smart
18749 host any messages that cannot immediately be delivered.
18750
18751 There are occasional other temporary errors that can occur while doing DNS
18752 lookups. They are treated in the same way as a timeout, and this option
18753 applies to all of them.
18754
18755
18756
18757 .option pass_router routers string unset
18758 .cindex "router" "go to after &""pass""&"
18759 Routers that recognize the generic &%self%& option (&(dnslookup)&,
18760 &(ipliteral)&, and &(manualroute)&) are able to return &"pass"&, forcing
18761 routing to continue, and overriding a false setting of &%more%&. When one of
18762 these routers returns &"pass"&, the address is normally handed on to the next
18763 router in sequence. This can be changed by setting &%pass_router%& to the name
18764 of another router. However (unlike &%redirect_router%&) the named router must
18765 be below the current router, to avoid loops. Note that this option applies only
18766 to the special case of &"pass"&. It does not apply when a router returns
18767 &"decline"& because it cannot handle an address.
18768
18769
18770
18771 .option redirect_router routers string unset
18772 .cindex "router" "start at after redirection"
18773 Sometimes an administrator knows that it is pointless to reprocess addresses
18774 generated from alias or forward files with the same router again. For
18775 example, if an alias file translates real names into login ids there is no
18776 point searching the alias file a second time, especially if it is a large file.
18777
18778 The &%redirect_router%& option can be set to the name of any router instance.
18779 It causes the routing of any generated addresses to start at the named router
18780 instead of at the first router. This option has no effect if the router in
18781 which it is set does not generate new addresses.
18782
18783
18784
18785 .option require_files routers&!? "string list&!!" unset
18786 .cindex "file" "requiring for router"
18787 .cindex "router" "requiring file existence"
18788 This option provides a general mechanism for predicating the running of a
18789 router on the existence or non-existence of certain files or directories.
18790 Before running a router, as one of its precondition tests, Exim works its way
18791 through the &%require_files%& list, expanding each item separately.
18792
18793 Because the list is split before expansion, any colons in expansion items must
18794 be doubled, or the facility for using a different list separator must be used
18795 (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
18796 If any expansion is forced to fail, the item is ignored. Other expansion
18797 failures cause routing of the address to be deferred.
18798
18799 If any expanded string is empty, it is ignored. Otherwise, except as described
18800 below, each string must be a fully qualified file path, optionally preceded by
18801 &"!"&. The paths are passed to the &[stat()]& function to test for the
18802 existence of the files or directories. The router is skipped if any paths not
18803 preceded by &"!"& do not exist, or if any paths preceded by &"!"& do exist.
18804
18805 .cindex "NFS"
18806 If &[stat()]& cannot determine whether a file exists or not, delivery of
18807 the message is deferred. This can happen when NFS-mounted filesystems are
18808 unavailable.
18809
18810 This option is checked after the &%domains%&, &%local_parts%&, and &%senders%&
18811 options, so you cannot use it to check for the existence of a file in which to
18812 look up a domain, local part, or sender. (See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a
18813 full list of the order in which preconditions are evaluated.) However, as
18814 these options are all expanded, you can use the &%exists%& expansion condition
18815 to make such tests. The &%require_files%& option is intended for checking files
18816 that the router may be going to use internally, or which are needed by a
18817 transport (e.g., &_.procmailrc_&).
18818
18819 During delivery, the &[stat()]& function is run as root, but there is a
18820 facility for some checking of the accessibility of a file by another user.
18821 This is not a proper permissions check, but just a &"rough"& check that
18822 operates as follows:
18823
18824 If an item in a &%require_files%& list does not contain any forward slash
18825 characters, it is taken to be the user (and optional group, separated by a
18826 comma) to be checked for subsequent files in the list. If no group is specified
18827 but the user is specified symbolically, the gid associated with the uid is
18828 used. For example:
18829 .code
18830 require_files = mail:/some/file
18831 require_files = $local_part:$home/.procmailrc
18832 .endd
18833 If a user or group name in a &%require_files%& list does not exist, the
18834 &%require_files%& condition fails.
18835
18836 Exim performs the check by scanning along the components of the file path, and
18837 checking the access for the given uid and gid. It checks for &"x"& access on
18838 directories, and &"r"& access on the final file. Note that this means that file
18839 access control lists, if the operating system has them, are ignored.
18840
18841 &*Warning 1*&: When the router is being run to verify addresses for an
18842 incoming SMTP message, Exim is not running as root, but under its own uid. This
18843 may affect the result of a &%require_files%& check. In particular, &[stat()]&
18844 may yield the error EACCES (&"Permission denied"&). This means that the Exim
18845 user is not permitted to read one of the directories on the file's path.
18846
18847 &*Warning 2*&: Even when Exim is running as root while delivering a message,
18848 &[stat()]& can yield EACCES for a file in an NFS directory that is mounted
18849 without root access. In this case, if a check for access by a particular user
18850 is requested, Exim creates a subprocess that runs as that user, and tries the
18851 check again in that process.
18852
18853 The default action for handling an unresolved EACCES is to consider it to
18854 be caused by a configuration error, and routing is deferred because the
18855 existence or non-existence of the file cannot be determined. However, in some
18856 circumstances it may be desirable to treat this condition as if the file did
18857 not exist. If the filename (or the exclamation mark that precedes the filename
18858 for non-existence) is preceded by a plus sign, the EACCES error is treated
18859 as if the file did not exist. For example:
18860 .code
18861 require_files = +/some/file
18862 .endd
18863 If the router is not an essential part of verification (for example, it
18864 handles users' &_.forward_& files), another solution is to set the &%verify%&
18865 option false so that the router is skipped when verifying.
18866
18867
18868
18869 .option retry_use_local_part routers boolean "see below"
18870 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
18871 .cindex "local part" "in retry keys"
18872 When a delivery suffers a temporary routing failure, a retry record is created
18873 in Exim's hints database. For addresses whose routing depends only on the
18874 domain, the key for the retry record should not involve the local part, but for
18875 other addresses, both the domain and the local part should be included.
18876 Usually, remote routing is of the former kind, and local routing is of the
18877 latter kind.
18878
18879 This option controls whether the local part is used to form the key for retry
18880 hints for addresses that suffer temporary errors while being handled by this
18881 router. The default value is true for any router that has &%check_local_user%&
18882 set, and false otherwise. Note that this option does not apply to hints keys
18883 for transport delays; they are controlled by a generic transport option of the
18884 same name.
18885
18886 The setting of &%retry_use_local_part%& applies only to the router on which it
18887 appears. If the router generates child addresses, they are routed
18888 independently; this setting does not become attached to them.
18889
18890
18891
18892 .option router_home_directory routers string&!! unset
18893 .cindex "router" "home directory for"
18894 .cindex "home directory" "for router"
18895 .vindex "&$home$&"
18896 This option sets a home directory for use while the router is running. (Compare
18897 &%transport_home_directory%&, which sets a home directory for later
18898 transporting.) In particular, if used on a &(redirect)& router, this option
18899 sets a value for &$home$& while a filter is running. The value is expanded;
18900 forced expansion failure causes the option to be ignored &-- other failures
18901 cause the router to defer.
18902
18903 Expansion of &%router_home_directory%& happens immediately after the
18904 &%check_local_user%& test (if configured), before any further expansions take
18905 place.
18906 (See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
18907 are evaluated.)
18908 While the router is running, &%router_home_directory%& overrides the value of
18909 &$home$& that came from &%check_local_user%&.
18910
18911 When a router accepts an address and assigns it to a local transport (including
18912 the cases when a &(redirect)& router generates a pipe, file, or autoreply
18913 delivery), the home directory setting for the transport is taken from the first
18914 of these values that is set:
18915
18916 .ilist
18917 The &%home_directory%& option on the transport;
18918 .next
18919 The &%transport_home_directory%& option on the router;
18920 .next
18921 The password data if &%check_local_user%& is set on the router;
18922 .next
18923 The &%router_home_directory%& option on the router.
18924 .endlist
18925
18926 In other words, &%router_home_directory%& overrides the password data for the
18927 router, but not for the transport.
18928
18929
18930
18931 .option self routers string freeze
18932 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to local host"
18933 .cindex "local host" "MX pointing to"
18934 This option applies to those routers that use a recipient address to find a
18935 list of remote hosts. Currently, these are the &(dnslookup)&, &(ipliteral)&,
18936 and &(manualroute)& routers.
18937 Certain configurations of the &(queryprogram)& router can also specify a list
18938 of remote hosts.
18939 Usually such routers are configured to send the message to a remote host via an
18940 &(smtp)& transport. The &%self%& option specifies what happens when the first
18941 host on the list turns out to be the local host.
18942 The way in which Exim checks for the local host is described in section
18943 &<<SECTreclocipadd>>&.
18944
18945 Normally this situation indicates either an error in Exim's configuration (for
18946 example, the router should be configured not to process this domain), or an
18947 error in the DNS (for example, the MX should not point to this host). For this
18948 reason, the default action is to log the incident, defer the address, and
18949 freeze the message. The following alternatives are provided for use in special
18950 cases:
18951
18952 .vlist
18953 .vitem &%defer%&
18954 Delivery of the message is tried again later, but the message is not frozen.
18955
18956 .vitem "&%reroute%&: <&'domain'&>"
18957 The domain is changed to the given domain, and the address is passed back to
18958 be reprocessed by the routers. No rewriting of headers takes place. This
18959 behaviour is essentially a redirection.
18960
18961 .vitem "&%reroute: rewrite:%& <&'domain'&>"
18962 The domain is changed to the given domain, and the address is passed back to be
18963 reprocessed by the routers. Any headers that contain the original domain are
18964 rewritten.
18965
18966 .vitem &%pass%&
18967 .oindex "&%more%&"
18968 .vindex "&$self_hostname$&"
18969 The router passes the address to the next router, or to the router named in the
18970 &%pass_router%& option if it is set. This overrides &%no_more%&. During
18971 subsequent routing and delivery, the variable &$self_hostname$& contains the
18972 name of the local host that the router encountered. This can be used to
18973 distinguish between different cases for hosts with multiple names. The
18974 combination
18975 .code
18976 self = pass
18977 no_more
18978 .endd
18979 ensures that only those addresses that routed to the local host are passed on.
18980 Without &%no_more%&, addresses that were declined for other reasons would also
18981 be passed to the next router.
18982
18983 .vitem &%fail%&
18984 Delivery fails and an error report is generated.
18985
18986 .vitem &%send%&
18987 .cindex "local host" "sending to"
18988 The anomaly is ignored and the address is queued for the transport. This
18989 setting should be used with extreme caution. For an &(smtp)& transport, it
18990 makes sense only in cases where the program that is listening on the SMTP port
18991 is not this version of Exim. That is, it must be some other MTA, or Exim with a
18992 different configuration file that handles the domain in another way.
18993 .endlist
18994
18995
18996
18997 .option senders routers&!? "address list&!!" unset
18998 .cindex "router" "checking senders"
18999 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the message's sender
19000 address matches something on the list.
19001 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
19002 are evaluated.
19003
19004 There are issues concerning verification when the running of routers is
19005 dependent on the sender. When Exim is verifying the address in an &%errors_to%&
19006 setting, it sets the sender to the null string. When using the &%-bt%& option
19007 to check a configuration file, it is necessary also to use the &%-f%& option to
19008 set an appropriate sender. For incoming mail, the sender is unset when
19009 verifying the sender, but is available when verifying any recipients. If the
19010 SMTP VRFY command is enabled, it must be used after MAIL if the sender address
19011 matters.
19012
19013
19014 .new
19015 .option set routers "string list" unset
19016 .cindex router variables
19017 This option may be used multiple times on a router;
19018 because of this the list aspect is mostly irrelevant.
19019 The list separator is a semicolon but can be changed in the
19020 usual way.
19021
19022 Each list-element given must be of the form $"name = value"$
19023 and the names used must start with the string &"r_"&.
19024 Values containing a list-separator should have them doubled.
19025 When a router runs, the strings are evaluated in order,
19026 to create variables which are added to the set associated with
19027 the address.
19028 The variable is set with the expansion of the value.
19029 The variables can be used by the router options
19030 (not including any preconditions)
19031 and by the transport.
19032 Later definitions of a given named variable will override former ones.
19033 Varible use is via the usual &$r_...$& syntax.
19034
19035 This is similar to the &%address_data%& option, except that
19036 many independent variables can be used, with choice of naming.
19037 .wen
19038
19039
19040 .option translate_ip_address routers string&!! unset
19041 .cindex "IP address" "translating"
19042 .cindex "packet radio"
19043 .cindex "router" "IP address translation"
19044 There exist some rare networking situations (for example, packet radio) where
19045 it is helpful to be able to translate IP addresses generated by normal routing
19046 mechanisms into other IP addresses, thus performing a kind of manual IP
19047 routing. This should be done only if the normal IP routing of the TCP/IP stack
19048 is inadequate or broken. Because this is an extremely uncommon requirement, the
19049 code to support this option is not included in the Exim binary unless
19050 SUPPORT_TRANSLATE_IP_ADDRESS=yes is set in &_Local/Makefile_&.
19051
19052 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
19053 The &%translate_ip_address%& string is expanded for every IP address generated
19054 by the router, with the generated address set in &$host_address$&. If the
19055 expansion is forced to fail, no action is taken.
19056 For any other expansion error, delivery of the message is deferred.
19057 If the result of the expansion is an IP address, that replaces the original
19058 address; otherwise the result is assumed to be a host name &-- this is looked
19059 up using &[gethostbyname()]& (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available) to
19060 produce one or more replacement IP addresses. For example, to subvert all IP
19061 addresses in some specific networks, this could be added to a router:
19062 .code
19063 translate_ip_address = \
19064 ${lookup{${mask:$host_address/26}}lsearch{/some/file}\
19065 {$value}fail}}
19066 .endd
19067 The file would contain lines like
19068 .code
19069 10.2.3.128/26 some.host
19070 10.8.4.34/26 10.44.8.15
19071 .endd
19072 You should not make use of this facility unless you really understand what you
19073 are doing.
19074
19075
19076
19077 .option transport routers string&!! unset
19078 This option specifies the transport to be used when a router accepts an address
19079 and sets it up for delivery. A transport is never needed if a router is used
19080 only for verification. The value of the option is expanded at routing time,
19081 after the expansion of &%errors_to%&, &%headers_add%&, and &%headers_remove%&,
19082 and result must be the name of one of the configured transports. If it is not,
19083 delivery is deferred.
19084
19085 The &%transport%& option is not used by the &(redirect)& router, but it does
19086 have some private options that set up transports for pipe and file deliveries
19087 (see chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>&).
19088
19089
19090
19091 .option transport_current_directory routers string&!! unset
19092 .cindex "current directory for local transport"
19093 This option associates a current directory with any address that is routed
19094 to a local transport. This can happen either because a transport is
19095 explicitly configured for the router, or because it generates a delivery to a
19096 file or a pipe. During the delivery process (that is, at transport time), this
19097 option string is expanded and is set as the current directory, unless
19098 overridden by a setting on the transport.
19099 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
19100 logged, and delivery is deferred.
19101 See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for details of the local delivery
19102 environment.
19103
19104
19105
19106
19107 .option transport_home_directory routers string&!! "see below"
19108 .cindex "home directory" "for local transport"
19109 This option associates a home directory with any address that is routed to a
19110 local transport. This can happen either because a transport is explicitly
19111 configured for the router, or because it generates a delivery to a file or a
19112 pipe. During the delivery process (that is, at transport time), the option
19113 string is expanded and is set as the home directory, unless overridden by a
19114 setting of &%home_directory%& on the transport.
19115 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
19116 logged, and delivery is deferred.
19117
19118 If the transport does not specify a home directory, and
19119 &%transport_home_directory%& is not set for the router, the home directory for
19120 the transport is taken from the password data if &%check_local_user%& is set for
19121 the router. Otherwise it is taken from &%router_home_directory%& if that option
19122 is set; if not, no home directory is set for the transport.
19123
19124 See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for further details of the local delivery
19125 environment.
19126
19127
19128
19129
19130 .option unseen routers boolean&!! false
19131 .cindex "router" "carrying on after success"
19132 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value,
19133 that is, one of the strings &"yes"&, &"no"&, &"true"&, or &"false"&. Any other
19134 result causes an error, and delivery is deferred. If the expansion is forced to
19135 fail, the default value for the option (false) is used. Other failures cause
19136 delivery to be deferred.
19137
19138 When this option is set true, routing does not cease if the router accepts the
19139 address. Instead, a copy of the incoming address is passed to the next router,
19140 overriding a false setting of &%more%&. There is little point in setting
19141 &%more%& false if &%unseen%& is always true, but it may be useful in cases when
19142 the value of &%unseen%& contains expansion items (and therefore, presumably, is
19143 sometimes true and sometimes false).
19144
19145 .cindex "copy of message (&%unseen%& option)"
19146 Setting the &%unseen%& option has a similar effect to the &%unseen%& command
19147 qualifier in filter files. It can be used to cause copies of messages to be
19148 delivered to some other destination, while also carrying out a normal delivery.
19149 In effect, the current address is made into a &"parent"& that has two children
19150 &-- one that is delivered as specified by this router, and a clone that goes on
19151 to be routed further. For this reason, &%unseen%& may not be combined with the
19152 &%one_time%& option in a &(redirect)& router.
19153
19154 &*Warning*&: Header lines added to the address (or specified for removal) by
19155 this router or by previous routers affect the &"unseen"& copy of the message
19156 only. The clone that continues to be processed by further routers starts with
19157 no added headers and none specified for removal. For a &%redirect%& router, if
19158 a generated address is the same as the incoming address, this can lead to
19159 duplicate addresses with different header modifications. Exim does not do
19160 duplicate deliveries (except, in certain circumstances, to pipes -- see section
19161 &<<SECTdupaddr>>&), but it is undefined which of the duplicates is discarded,
19162 so this ambiguous situation should be avoided. The &%repeat_use%& option of the
19163 &%redirect%& router may be of help.
19164
19165 Unlike the handling of header modifications, any data that was set by the
19166 &%address_data%& option in the current or previous routers &'is'& passed on to
19167 subsequent routers.
19168
19169
19170 .option user routers string&!! "see below"
19171 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
19172 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
19173 .cindex "transport" "local"
19174 .cindex "router" "user for filter processing"
19175 .cindex "filter" "user for processing"
19176 When a router queues an address for a transport, and the transport does not
19177 specify a user, the user given here is used when running the delivery process.
19178 The user may be specified numerically or by name. If expansion fails, the
19179 error is logged and delivery is deferred.
19180 This user is also used by the &(redirect)& router when running a filter file.
19181 The default is unset, except when &%check_local_user%& is set. In this case,
19182 the default is taken from the password information. If the user is specified as
19183 a name, and &%group%& is not set, the group associated with the user is used.
19184 See also &%initgroups%& and &%group%& and the discussion in chapter
19185 &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
19186
19187
19188
19189 .option verify routers&!? boolean true
19190 Setting this option has the effect of setting &%verify_sender%& and
19191 &%verify_recipient%& to the same value.
19192
19193
19194 .option verify_only routers&!? boolean false
19195 .cindex "EXPN" "with &%verify_only%&"
19196 .oindex "&%-bv%&"
19197 .cindex "router" "used only when verifying"
19198 If this option is set, the router is used only when verifying an address,
19199 delivering in cutthrough mode or
19200 testing with the &%-bv%& option, not when actually doing a delivery, testing
19201 with the &%-bt%& option, or running the SMTP EXPN command. It can be further
19202 restricted to verifying only senders or recipients by means of
19203 &%verify_sender%& and &%verify_recipient%&.
19204
19205 &*Warning*&: When the router is being run to verify addresses for an incoming
19206 SMTP message, Exim is not running as root, but under its own uid. If the router
19207 accesses any files, you need to make sure that they are accessible to the Exim
19208 user or group.
19209
19210
19211 .option verify_recipient routers&!? boolean true
19212 If this option is false, the router is skipped when verifying recipient
19213 addresses,
19214 delivering in cutthrough mode
19215 or testing recipient verification using &%-bv%&.
19216 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
19217 are evaluated.
19218 See also the &$verify_mode$& variable.
19219
19220
19221 .option verify_sender routers&!? boolean true
19222 If this option is false, the router is skipped when verifying sender addresses
19223 or testing sender verification using &%-bvs%&.
19224 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
19225 are evaluated.
19226 See also the &$verify_mode$& variable.
19227 .ecindex IIDgenoprou1
19228 .ecindex IIDgenoprou2
19229
19230
19231
19232
19233
19234
19235 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19236 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19237
19238 .chapter "The accept router" "CHID4"
19239 .cindex "&(accept)& router"
19240 .cindex "routers" "&(accept)&"
19241 The &(accept)& router has no private options of its own. Unless it is being
19242 used purely for verification (see &%verify_only%&) a transport is required to
19243 be defined by the generic &%transport%& option. If the preconditions that are
19244 specified by generic options are met, the router accepts the address and queues
19245 it for the given transport. The most common use of this router is for setting
19246 up deliveries to local mailboxes. For example:
19247 .code
19248 localusers:
19249 driver = accept
19250 domains = mydomain.example
19251 check_local_user
19252 transport = local_delivery
19253 .endd
19254 The &%domains%& condition in this example checks the domain of the address, and
19255 &%check_local_user%& checks that the local part is the login of a local user.
19256 When both preconditions are met, the &(accept)& router runs, and queues the
19257 address for the &(local_delivery)& transport.
19258
19259
19260
19261
19262
19263
19264 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19265 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19266
19267 .chapter "The dnslookup router" "CHAPdnslookup"
19268 .scindex IIDdnsrou1 "&(dnslookup)& router"
19269 .scindex IIDdnsrou2 "routers" "&(dnslookup)&"
19270 The &(dnslookup)& router looks up the hosts that handle mail for the
19271 recipient's domain in the DNS. A transport must always be set for this router,
19272 unless &%verify_only%& is set.
19273
19274 If SRV support is configured (see &%check_srv%& below), Exim first searches for
19275 SRV records. If none are found, or if SRV support is not configured,
19276 MX records are looked up. If no MX records exist, address records are sought.
19277 However, &%mx_domains%& can be set to disable the direct use of address
19278 records.
19279
19280 MX records of equal priority are sorted by Exim into a random order. Exim then
19281 looks for address records for the host names obtained from MX or SRV records.
19282 When a host has more than one IP address, they are sorted into a random order,
19283 except that IPv6 addresses are sorted before IPv4 addresses. If all the
19284 IP addresses found are discarded by a setting of the &%ignore_target_hosts%&
19285 generic option, the router declines.
19286
19287 Unless they have the highest priority (lowest MX value), MX records that point
19288 to the local host, or to any host name that matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&,
19289 are discarded, together with any other MX records of equal or lower priority.
19290
19291 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to local host"
19292 .cindex "local host" "MX pointing to"
19293 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(dnslookup)& router"
19294 If the host pointed to by the highest priority MX record, or looked up as an
19295 address record, is the local host, or matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, what
19296 happens is controlled by the generic &%self%& option.
19297
19298
19299 .section "Problems with DNS lookups" "SECTprowitdnsloo"
19300 There have been problems with DNS servers when SRV records are looked up.
19301 Some misbehaving servers return a DNS error or timeout when a non-existent
19302 SRV record is sought. Similar problems have in the past been reported for
19303 MX records. The global &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& option can help with this
19304 problem, but it is heavy-handed because it is a global option.
19305
19306 For this reason, there are two options, &%srv_fail_domains%& and
19307 &%mx_fail_domains%&, that control what happens when a DNS lookup in a
19308 &(dnslookup)& router results in a DNS failure or a &"try again"& response. If
19309 an attempt to look up an SRV or MX record causes one of these results, and the
19310 domain matches the relevant list, Exim behaves as if the DNS had responded &"no
19311 such record"&. In the case of an SRV lookup, this means that the router
19312 proceeds to look for MX records; in the case of an MX lookup, it proceeds to
19313 look for A or AAAA records, unless the domain matches &%mx_domains%&, in which
19314 case routing fails.
19315
19316
19317 .section "Declining addresses by dnslookup" "SECTdnslookupdecline"
19318 .cindex "&(dnslookup)& router" "declines"
19319 There are a few cases where a &(dnslookup)& router will decline to accept
19320 an address; if such a router is expected to handle "all remaining non-local
19321 domains", then it is important to set &%no_more%&.
19322
19323 The router will defer rather than decline if the domain
19324 is found in the &%fail_defer_domains%& router option.
19325
19326 Reasons for a &(dnslookup)& router to decline currently include:
19327 .ilist
19328 The domain does not exist in DNS
19329 .next
19330 The domain exists but the MX record's host part is just "."; this is a common
19331 convention (borrowed from SRV) used to indicate that there is no such service
19332 for this domain and to not fall back to trying A/AAAA records.
19333 .next
19334 Ditto, but for SRV records, when &%check_srv%& is set on this router.
19335 .next
19336 MX record points to a non-existent host.
19337 .next
19338 MX record points to an IP address and the main section option
19339 &%allow_mx_to_ip%& is not set.
19340 .next
19341 MX records exist and point to valid hosts, but all hosts resolve only to
19342 addresses blocked by the &%ignore_target_hosts%& generic option on this router.
19343 .next
19344 The domain is not syntactically valid (see also &%allow_utf8_domains%& and
19345 &%dns_check_names_pattern%& for handling one variant of this)
19346 .next
19347 &%check_secondary_mx%& is set on this router but the local host can
19348 not be found in the MX records (see below)
19349 .endlist
19350
19351
19352
19353
19354 .section "Private options for dnslookup" "SECID118"
19355 .cindex "options" "&(dnslookup)& router"
19356 The private options for the &(dnslookup)& router are as follows:
19357
19358 .option check_secondary_mx dnslookup boolean false
19359 .cindex "MX record" "checking for secondary"
19360 If this option is set, the router declines unless the local host is found in
19361 (and removed from) the list of hosts obtained by MX lookup. This can be used to
19362 process domains for which the local host is a secondary mail exchanger
19363 differently to other domains. The way in which Exim decides whether a host is
19364 the local host is described in section &<<SECTreclocipadd>>&.
19365
19366
19367 .option check_srv dnslookup string&!! unset
19368 .cindex "SRV record" "enabling use of"
19369 The &(dnslookup)& router supports the use of SRV records (see RFC 2782) in
19370 addition to MX and address records. The support is disabled by default. To
19371 enable SRV support, set the &%check_srv%& option to the name of the service
19372 required. For example,
19373 .code
19374 check_srv = smtp
19375 .endd
19376 looks for SRV records that refer to the normal smtp service. The option is
19377 expanded, so the service name can vary from message to message or address
19378 to address. This might be helpful if SRV records are being used for a
19379 submission service. If the expansion is forced to fail, the &%check_srv%&
19380 option is ignored, and the router proceeds to look for MX records in the
19381 normal way.
19382
19383 When the expansion succeeds, the router searches first for SRV records for
19384 the given service (it assumes TCP protocol). A single SRV record with a
19385 host name that consists of just a single dot indicates &"no such service for
19386 this domain"&; if this is encountered, the router declines. If other kinds of
19387 SRV record are found, they are used to construct a host list for delivery
19388 according to the rules of RFC 2782. MX records are not sought in this case.
19389
19390 When no SRV records are found, MX records (and address records) are sought in
19391 the traditional way. In other words, SRV records take precedence over MX
19392 records, just as MX records take precedence over address records. Note that
19393 this behaviour is not sanctioned by RFC 2782, though a previous draft RFC
19394 defined it. It is apparently believed that MX records are sufficient for email
19395 and that SRV records should not be used for this purpose. However, SRV records
19396 have an additional &"weight"& feature which some people might find useful when
19397 trying to split an SMTP load between hosts of different power.
19398
19399 See section &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& above for a discussion of Exim's behaviour
19400 when there is a DNS lookup error.
19401
19402
19403
19404
19405 .option fail_defer_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
19406 .cindex "MX record" "not found"
19407 DNS lookups for domains matching &%fail_defer_domains%&
19408 which find no matching record will cause the router to defer
19409 rather than the default behaviour of decline.
19410 This maybe be useful for queueing messages for a newly created
19411 domain while the DNS configuration is not ready.
19412 However, it will result in any message with mistyped domains
19413 also being queued.
19414
19415
19416 .option ipv4_only "string&!!" unset
19417 .cindex IPv6 disabling
19418 .cindex DNS "IPv6 disabling"
19419 The string is expanded, and if the result is anything but a forced failure,
19420 or an empty string, or one of the strings “0” or “no” or “false”
19421 (checked without regard to the case of the letters),
19422 only A records are used.
19423
19424 .option ipv4_prefer "string&!!" unset
19425 .cindex IPv4 preference
19426 .cindex DNS "IPv4 preference"
19427 The string is expanded, and if the result is anything but a forced failure,
19428 or an empty string, or one of the strings “0” or “no” or “false”
19429 (checked without regard to the case of the letters),
19430 A records are sorted before AAAA records (inverting the default).
19431
19432 .option mx_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
19433 .cindex "MX record" "required to exist"
19434 .cindex "SRV record" "required to exist"
19435 A domain that matches &%mx_domains%& is required to have either an MX or an SRV
19436 record in order to be recognized. (The name of this option could be improved.)
19437 For example, if all the mail hosts in &'fict.example'& are known to have MX
19438 records, except for those in &'discworld.fict.example'&, you could use this
19439 setting:
19440 .code
19441 mx_domains = ! *.discworld.fict.example : *.fict.example
19442 .endd
19443 This specifies that messages addressed to a domain that matches the list but
19444 has no MX record should be bounced immediately instead of being routed using
19445 the address record.
19446
19447
19448 .option mx_fail_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
19449 If the DNS lookup for MX records for one of the domains in this list causes a
19450 DNS lookup error, Exim behaves as if no MX records were found. See section
19451 &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& for more discussion.
19452
19453
19454
19455
19456 .option qualify_single dnslookup boolean true
19457 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
19458 .cindex "DNS" "qualifying single-component names"
19459 When this option is true, the resolver option RES_DEFNAMES is set for DNS
19460 lookups. Typically, but not standardly, this causes the resolver to qualify
19461 single-component names with the default domain. For example, on a machine
19462 called &'dictionary.ref.example'&, the domain &'thesaurus'& would be changed to
19463 &'thesaurus.ref.example'& inside the resolver. For details of what your
19464 resolver actually does, consult your man pages for &'resolver'& and
19465 &'resolv.conf'&.
19466
19467
19468
19469 .option rewrite_headers dnslookup boolean true
19470 .cindex "rewriting" "header lines"
19471 .cindex "header lines" "rewriting"
19472 If the domain name in the address that is being processed is not fully
19473 qualified, it may be expanded to its full form by a DNS lookup. For example, if
19474 an address is specified as &'dormouse@teaparty'&, the domain might be
19475 expanded to &'teaparty.wonderland.fict.example'&. Domain expansion can also
19476 occur as a result of setting the &%widen_domains%& option. If
19477 &%rewrite_headers%& is true, all occurrences of the abbreviated domain name in
19478 any &'Bcc:'&, &'Cc:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-to:'&, &'Sender:'&, and &'To:'&
19479 header lines of the message are rewritten with the full domain name.
19480
19481 This option should be turned off only when it is known that no message is
19482 ever going to be sent outside an environment where the abbreviation makes
19483 sense.
19484
19485 When an MX record is looked up in the DNS and matches a wildcard record, name
19486 servers normally return a record containing the name that has been looked up,
19487 making it impossible to detect whether a wildcard was present or not. However,
19488 some name servers have recently been seen to return the wildcard entry. If the
19489 name returned by a DNS lookup begins with an asterisk, it is not used for
19490 header rewriting.
19491
19492
19493 .option same_domain_copy_routing dnslookup boolean false
19494 .cindex "address" "copying routing"
19495 Addresses with the same domain are normally routed by the &(dnslookup)& router
19496 to the same list of hosts. However, this cannot be presumed, because the router
19497 options and preconditions may refer to the local part of the address. By
19498 default, therefore, Exim routes each address in a message independently. DNS
19499 servers run caches, so repeated DNS lookups are not normally expensive, and in
19500 any case, personal messages rarely have more than a few recipients.
19501
19502 If you are running mailing lists with large numbers of subscribers at the same
19503 domain, and you are using a &(dnslookup)& router which is independent of the
19504 local part, you can set &%same_domain_copy_routing%& to bypass repeated DNS
19505 lookups for identical domains in one message. In this case, when &(dnslookup)&
19506 routes an address to a remote transport, any other unrouted addresses in the
19507 message that have the same domain are automatically given the same routing
19508 without processing them independently,
19509 provided the following conditions are met:
19510
19511 .ilist
19512 No router that processed the address specified &%headers_add%& or
19513 &%headers_remove%&.
19514 .next
19515 The router did not change the address in any way, for example, by &"widening"&
19516 the domain.
19517 .endlist
19518
19519
19520
19521
19522 .option search_parents dnslookup boolean false
19523 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
19524 When this option is true, the resolver option RES_DNSRCH is set for DNS
19525 lookups. This is different from the &%qualify_single%& option in that it
19526 applies to domains containing dots. Typically, but not standardly, it causes
19527 the resolver to search for the name in the current domain and in parent
19528 domains. For example, on a machine in the &'fict.example'& domain, if looking
19529 up &'teaparty.wonderland'& failed, the resolver would try
19530 &'teaparty.wonderland.fict.example'&. For details of what your resolver
19531 actually does, consult your man pages for &'resolver'& and &'resolv.conf'&.
19532
19533 Setting this option true can cause problems in domains that have a wildcard MX
19534 record, because any domain that does not have its own MX record matches the
19535 local wildcard.
19536
19537
19538
19539 .option srv_fail_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
19540 If the DNS lookup for SRV records for one of the domains in this list causes a
19541 DNS lookup error, Exim behaves as if no SRV records were found. See section
19542 &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& for more discussion.
19543
19544
19545
19546
19547 .option widen_domains dnslookup "string list" unset
19548 .cindex "domain" "partial; widening"
19549 If a DNS lookup fails and this option is set, each of its strings in turn is
19550 added onto the end of the domain, and the lookup is tried again. For example,
19551 if
19552 .code
19553 widen_domains = fict.example:ref.example
19554 .endd
19555 is set and a lookup of &'klingon.dictionary'& fails,
19556 &'klingon.dictionary.fict.example'& is looked up, and if this fails,
19557 &'klingon.dictionary.ref.example'& is tried. Note that the &%qualify_single%&
19558 and &%search_parents%& options can cause some widening to be undertaken inside
19559 the DNS resolver. &%widen_domains%& is not applied to sender addresses
19560 when verifying, unless &%rewrite_headers%& is false (not the default).
19561
19562
19563 .section "Effect of qualify_single and search_parents" "SECID119"
19564 When a domain from an envelope recipient is changed by the resolver as a result
19565 of the &%qualify_single%& or &%search_parents%& options, Exim rewrites the
19566 corresponding address in the message's header lines unless &%rewrite_headers%&
19567 is set false. Exim then re-routes the address, using the full domain.
19568
19569 These two options affect only the DNS lookup that takes place inside the router
19570 for the domain of the address that is being routed. They do not affect lookups
19571 such as that implied by
19572 .code
19573 domains = @mx_any
19574 .endd
19575 that may happen while processing a router precondition before the router is
19576 entered. No widening ever takes place for these lookups.
19577 .ecindex IIDdnsrou1
19578 .ecindex IIDdnsrou2
19579
19580
19581
19582
19583
19584
19585
19586
19587
19588 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19589 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19590
19591 .chapter "The ipliteral router" "CHID5"
19592 .cindex "&(ipliteral)& router"
19593 .cindex "domain literal" "routing"
19594 .cindex "routers" "&(ipliteral)&"
19595 This router has no private options. Unless it is being used purely for
19596 verification (see &%verify_only%&) a transport is required to be defined by the
19597 generic &%transport%& option. The router accepts the address if its domain part
19598 takes the form of an RFC 2822 domain literal. For example, the &(ipliteral)&
19599 router handles the address
19600 .code
19601 root@[192.168.1.1]
19602 .endd
19603 by setting up delivery to the host with that IP address. IPv4 domain literals
19604 consist of an IPv4 address enclosed in square brackets. IPv6 domain literals
19605 are similar, but the address is preceded by &`ipv6:`&. For example:
19606 .code
19607 postmaster@[ipv6:fe80::a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678]
19608 .endd
19609 Exim allows &`ipv4:`& before IPv4 addresses, for consistency, and on the
19610 grounds that sooner or later somebody will try it.
19611
19612 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(ipliteral)& router"
19613 If the IP address matches something in &%ignore_target_hosts%&, the router
19614 declines. If an IP literal turns out to refer to the local host, the generic
19615 &%self%& option determines what happens.
19616
19617 The RFCs require support for domain literals; however, their use is
19618 controversial in today's Internet. If you want to use this router, you must
19619 also set the main configuration option &%allow_domain_literals%&. Otherwise,
19620 Exim will not recognize the domain literal syntax in addresses.
19621
19622
19623
19624 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19625 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19626
19627 .chapter "The iplookup router" "CHID6"
19628 .cindex "&(iplookup)& router"
19629 .cindex "routers" "&(iplookup)&"
19630 The &(iplookup)& router was written to fulfil a specific requirement in
19631 Cambridge University (which in fact no longer exists). For this reason, it is
19632 not included in the binary of Exim by default. If you want to include it, you
19633 must set
19634 .code
19635 ROUTER_IPLOOKUP=yes
19636 .endd
19637 in your &_Local/Makefile_& configuration file.
19638
19639 The &(iplookup)& router routes an address by sending it over a TCP or UDP
19640 connection to one or more specific hosts. The host can then return the same or
19641 a different address &-- in effect rewriting the recipient address in the
19642 message's envelope. The new address is then passed on to subsequent routers. If
19643 this process fails, the address can be passed on to other routers, or delivery
19644 can be deferred. Since &(iplookup)& is just a rewriting router, a transport
19645 must not be specified for it.
19646
19647 .cindex "options" "&(iplookup)& router"
19648 .option hosts iplookup string unset
19649 This option must be supplied. Its value is a colon-separated list of host
19650 names. The hosts are looked up using &[gethostbyname()]&
19651 (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available)
19652 and are tried in order until one responds to the query. If none respond, what
19653 happens is controlled by &%optional%&.
19654
19655
19656 .option optional iplookup boolean false
19657 If &%optional%& is true, if no response is obtained from any host, the address
19658 is passed to the next router, overriding &%no_more%&. If &%optional%& is false,
19659 delivery to the address is deferred.
19660
19661
19662 .option port iplookup integer 0
19663 .cindex "port" "&(iplookup)& router"
19664 This option must be supplied. It specifies the port number for the TCP or UDP
19665 call.
19666
19667
19668 .option protocol iplookup string udp
19669 This option can be set to &"udp"& or &"tcp"& to specify which of the two
19670 protocols is to be used.
19671
19672
19673 .option query iplookup string&!! "see below"
19674 This defines the content of the query that is sent to the remote hosts. The
19675 default value is:
19676 .code
19677 $local_part@$domain $local_part@$domain
19678 .endd
19679 The repetition serves as a way of checking that a response is to the correct
19680 query in the default case (see &%response_pattern%& below).
19681
19682
19683 .option reroute iplookup string&!! unset
19684 If this option is not set, the rerouted address is precisely the byte string
19685 returned by the remote host, up to the first white space, if any. If set, the
19686 string is expanded to form the rerouted address. It can include parts matched
19687 in the response by &%response_pattern%& by means of numeric variables such as
19688 &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. The variable &$0$& refers to the entire input string,
19689 whether or not a pattern is in use. In all cases, the rerouted address must end
19690 up in the form &'local_part@domain'&.
19691
19692
19693 .option response_pattern iplookup string unset
19694 This option can be set to a regular expression that is applied to the string
19695 returned from the remote host. If the pattern does not match the response, the
19696 router declines. If &%response_pattern%& is not set, no checking of the
19697 response is done, unless the query was defaulted, in which case there is a
19698 check that the text returned after the first white space is the original
19699 address. This checks that the answer that has been received is in response to
19700 the correct question. For example, if the response is just a new domain, the
19701 following could be used:
19702 .code
19703 response_pattern = ^([^@]+)$
19704 reroute = $local_part@$1
19705 .endd
19706
19707 .option timeout iplookup time 5s
19708 This specifies the amount of time to wait for a response from the remote
19709 machine. The same timeout is used for the &[connect()]& function for a TCP
19710 call. It does not apply to UDP.
19711
19712
19713
19714
19715 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19716 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19717
19718 .chapter "The manualroute router" "CHID7"
19719 .scindex IIDmanrou1 "&(manualroute)& router"
19720 .scindex IIDmanrou2 "routers" "&(manualroute)&"
19721 .cindex "domain" "manually routing"
19722 The &(manualroute)& router is so-called because it provides a way of manually
19723 routing an address according to its domain. It is mainly used when you want to
19724 route addresses to remote hosts according to your own rules, bypassing the
19725 normal DNS routing that looks up MX records. However, &(manualroute)& can also
19726 route to local transports, a facility that may be useful if you want to save
19727 messages for dial-in hosts in local files.
19728
19729 The &(manualroute)& router compares a list of domain patterns with the domain
19730 it is trying to route. If there is no match, the router declines. Each pattern
19731 has associated with it a list of hosts and some other optional data, which may
19732 include a transport. The combination of a pattern and its data is called a
19733 &"routing rule"&. For patterns that do not have an associated transport, the
19734 generic &%transport%& option must specify a transport, unless the router is
19735 being used purely for verification (see &%verify_only%&).
19736
19737 .vindex "&$host$&"
19738 In the case of verification, matching the domain pattern is sufficient for the
19739 router to accept the address. When actually routing an address for delivery,
19740 an address that matches a domain pattern is queued for the associated
19741 transport. If the transport is not a local one, a host list must be associated
19742 with the pattern; IP addresses are looked up for the hosts, and these are
19743 passed to the transport along with the mail address. For local transports, a
19744 host list is optional. If it is present, it is passed in &$host$& as a single
19745 text string.
19746
19747 The list of routing rules can be provided as an inline string in
19748 &%route_list%&, or the data can be obtained by looking up the domain in a file
19749 or database by setting &%route_data%&. Only one of these settings may appear in
19750 any one instance of &(manualroute)&. The format of routing rules is described
19751 below, following the list of private options.
19752
19753
19754 .section "Private options for manualroute" "SECTprioptman"
19755
19756 .cindex "options" "&(manualroute)& router"
19757 The private options for the &(manualroute)& router are as follows:
19758
19759 .option host_all_ignored manualroute string defer
19760 See &%host_find_failed%&.
19761
19762 .option host_find_failed manualroute string freeze
19763 This option controls what happens when &(manualroute)& tries to find an IP
19764 address for a host, and the host does not exist. The option can be set to one
19765 of the following values:
19766 .code
19767 decline
19768 defer
19769 fail
19770 freeze
19771 ignore
19772 pass
19773 .endd
19774 The default (&"freeze"&) assumes that this state is a serious configuration
19775 error. The difference between &"pass"& and &"decline"& is that the former
19776 forces the address to be passed to the next router (or the router defined by
19777 &%pass_router%&),
19778 .oindex "&%more%&"
19779 overriding &%no_more%&, whereas the latter passes the address to the next
19780 router only if &%more%& is true.
19781
19782 The value &"ignore"& causes Exim to completely ignore a host whose IP address
19783 cannot be found. If all the hosts in the list are ignored, the behaviour is
19784 controlled by the &%host_all_ignored%& option. This takes the same values
19785 as &%host_find_failed%&, except that it cannot be set to &"ignore"&.
19786
19787 The &%host_find_failed%& option applies only to a definite &"does not exist"&
19788 state; if a host lookup gets a temporary error, delivery is deferred unless the
19789 generic &%pass_on_timeout%& option is set.
19790
19791
19792 .option hosts_randomize manualroute boolean false
19793 .cindex "randomized host list"
19794 .cindex "host" "list of; randomized"
19795 If this option is set, the order of the items in a host list in a routing rule
19796 is randomized each time the list is used, unless an option in the routing rule
19797 overrides (see below). Randomizing the order of a host list can be used to do
19798 crude load sharing. However, if more than one mail address is routed by the
19799 same router to the same host list, the host lists are considered to be the same
19800 (even though they may be randomized into different orders) for the purpose of
19801 deciding whether to batch the deliveries into a single SMTP transaction.
19802
19803 When &%hosts_randomize%& is true, a host list may be split
19804 into groups whose order is separately randomized. This makes it possible to
19805 set up MX-like behaviour. The boundaries between groups are indicated by an
19806 item that is just &`+`& in the host list. For example:
19807 .code
19808 route_list = * host1:host2:host3:+:host4:host5
19809 .endd
19810 The order of the first three hosts and the order of the last two hosts is
19811 randomized for each use, but the first three always end up before the last two.
19812 If &%hosts_randomize%& is not set, a &`+`& item in the list is ignored. If a
19813 randomized host list is passed to an &(smtp)& transport that also has
19814 &%hosts_randomize set%&, the list is not re-randomized.
19815
19816
19817 .option route_data manualroute string&!! unset
19818 If this option is set, it must expand to yield the data part of a routing rule.
19819 Typically, the expansion string includes a lookup based on the domain. For
19820 example:
19821 .code
19822 route_data = ${lookup{$domain}dbm{/etc/routes}}
19823 .endd
19824 If the expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string, the
19825 router declines. Other kinds of expansion failure cause delivery to be
19826 deferred.
19827
19828
19829 .option route_list manualroute "string list" unset
19830 This string is a list of routing rules, in the form defined below. Note that,
19831 unlike most string lists, the items are separated by semicolons. This is so
19832 that they may contain colon-separated host lists.
19833
19834
19835 .option same_domain_copy_routing manualroute boolean false
19836 .cindex "address" "copying routing"
19837 Addresses with the same domain are normally routed by the &(manualroute)&
19838 router to the same list of hosts. However, this cannot be presumed, because the
19839 router options and preconditions may refer to the local part of the address. By
19840 default, therefore, Exim routes each address in a message independently. DNS
19841 servers run caches, so repeated DNS lookups are not normally expensive, and in
19842 any case, personal messages rarely have more than a few recipients.
19843
19844 If you are running mailing lists with large numbers of subscribers at the same
19845 domain, and you are using a &(manualroute)& router which is independent of the
19846 local part, you can set &%same_domain_copy_routing%& to bypass repeated DNS
19847 lookups for identical domains in one message. In this case, when
19848 &(manualroute)& routes an address to a remote transport, any other unrouted
19849 addresses in the message that have the same domain are automatically given the
19850 same routing without processing them independently. However, this is only done
19851 if &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& are unset.
19852
19853
19854
19855
19856 .section "Routing rules in route_list" "SECID120"
19857 The value of &%route_list%& is a string consisting of a sequence of routing
19858 rules, separated by semicolons. If a semicolon is needed in a rule, it can be
19859 entered as two semicolons. Alternatively, the list separator can be changed as
19860 described (for colon-separated lists) in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&.
19861 Empty rules are ignored. The format of each rule is
19862 .display
19863 <&'domain pattern'&> <&'list of hosts'&> <&'options'&>
19864 .endd
19865 The following example contains two rules, each with a simple domain pattern and
19866 no options:
19867 .code
19868 route_list = \
19869 dict.ref.example mail-1.ref.example:mail-2.ref.example ; \
19870 thes.ref.example mail-3.ref.example:mail-4.ref.example
19871 .endd
19872 The three parts of a rule are separated by white space. The pattern and the
19873 list of hosts can be enclosed in quotes if necessary, and if they are, the
19874 usual quoting rules apply. Each rule in a &%route_list%& must start with a
19875 single domain pattern, which is the only mandatory item in the rule. The
19876 pattern is in the same format as one item in a domain list (see section
19877 &<<SECTdomainlist>>&),
19878 except that it may not be the name of an interpolated file.
19879 That is, it may be wildcarded, or a regular expression, or a file or database
19880 lookup (with semicolons doubled, because of the use of semicolon as a separator
19881 in a &%route_list%&).
19882
19883 The rules in &%route_list%& are searched in order until one of the patterns
19884 matches the domain that is being routed. The list of hosts and then options are
19885 then used as described below. If there is no match, the router declines. When
19886 &%route_list%& is set, &%route_data%& must not be set.
19887
19888
19889
19890 .section "Routing rules in route_data" "SECID121"
19891 The use of &%route_list%& is convenient when there are only a small number of
19892 routing rules. For larger numbers, it is easier to use a file or database to
19893 hold the routing information, and use the &%route_data%& option instead.
19894 The value of &%route_data%& is a list of hosts, followed by (optional) options.
19895 Most commonly, &%route_data%& is set as a string that contains an
19896 expansion lookup. For example, suppose we place two routing rules in a file
19897 like this:
19898 .code
19899 dict.ref.example: mail-1.ref.example:mail-2.ref.example
19900 thes.ref.example: mail-3.ref.example:mail-4.ref.example
19901 .endd
19902 This data can be accessed by setting
19903 .code
19904 route_data = ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/the/file/name}}
19905 .endd
19906 Failure of the lookup results in an empty string, causing the router to
19907 decline. However, you do not have to use a lookup in &%route_data%&. The only
19908 requirement is that the result of expanding the string is a list of hosts,
19909 possibly followed by options, separated by white space. The list of hosts must
19910 be enclosed in quotes if it contains white space.
19911
19912
19913
19914
19915 .section "Format of the list of hosts" "SECID122"
19916 A list of hosts, whether obtained via &%route_data%& or &%route_list%&, is
19917 always separately expanded before use. If the expansion fails, the router
19918 declines. The result of the expansion must be a colon-separated list of names
19919 and/or IP addresses, optionally also including ports.
19920 If the list is written with spaces, it must be protected with quotes.
19921 The format of each item
19922 in the list is described in the next section. The list separator can be changed
19923 as described in section &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&.
19924
19925 If the list of hosts was obtained from a &%route_list%& item, the following
19926 variables are set during its expansion:
19927
19928 .ilist
19929 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(manualroute)& router"
19930 If the domain was matched against a regular expression, the numeric variables
19931 &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. may be set. For example:
19932 .code
19933 route_list = ^domain(\d+) host-$1.text.example
19934 .endd
19935 .next
19936 &$0$& is always set to the entire domain.
19937 .next
19938 &$1$& is also set when partial matching is done in a file lookup.
19939
19940 .next
19941 .vindex "&$value$&"
19942 If the pattern that matched the domain was a lookup item, the data that was
19943 looked up is available in the expansion variable &$value$&. For example:
19944 .code
19945 route_list = lsearch;;/some/file.routes $value
19946 .endd
19947 .endlist
19948
19949 Note the doubling of the semicolon in the pattern that is necessary because
19950 semicolon is the default route list separator.
19951
19952
19953
19954 .section "Format of one host item" "SECTformatonehostitem"
19955 Each item in the list of hosts is either a host name or an IP address,
19956 optionally with an attached port number. When no port is given, an IP address
19957 is not enclosed in brackets. When a port is specified, it overrides the port
19958 specification on the transport. The port is separated from the name or address
19959 by a colon. This leads to some complications:
19960
19961 .ilist
19962 Because colon is the default separator for the list of hosts, either
19963 the colon that specifies a port must be doubled, or the list separator must
19964 be changed. The following two examples have the same effect:
19965 .code
19966 route_list = * "host1.tld::1225 : host2.tld::1226"
19967 route_list = * "<+ host1.tld:1225 + host2.tld:1226"
19968 .endd
19969 .next
19970 When IPv6 addresses are involved, it gets worse, because they contain
19971 colons of their own. To make this case easier, it is permitted to
19972 enclose an IP address (either v4 or v6) in square brackets if a port
19973 number follows. For example:
19974 .code
19975 route_list = * "</ [10.1.1.1]:1225 / [::1]:1226"
19976 .endd
19977 .endlist
19978
19979 .section "How the list of hosts is used" "SECThostshowused"
19980 When an address is routed to an &(smtp)& transport by &(manualroute)&, each of
19981 the hosts is tried, in the order specified, when carrying out the SMTP
19982 delivery. However, the order can be changed by setting the &%hosts_randomize%&
19983 option, either on the router (see section &<<SECTprioptman>>& above), or on the
19984 transport.
19985
19986 Hosts may be listed by name or by IP address. An unadorned name in the list of
19987 hosts is interpreted as a host name. A name that is followed by &`/MX`& is
19988 interpreted as an indirection to a sublist of hosts obtained by looking up MX
19989 records in the DNS. For example:
19990 .code
19991 route_list = * x.y.z:p.q.r/MX:e.f.g
19992 .endd
19993 If this feature is used with a port specifier, the port must come last. For
19994 example:
19995 .code
19996 route_list = * dom1.tld/mx::1225
19997 .endd
19998 If the &%hosts_randomize%& option is set, the order of the items in the list is
19999 randomized before any lookups are done. Exim then scans the list; for any name
20000 that is not followed by &`/MX`& it looks up an IP address. If this turns out to
20001 be an interface on the local host and the item is not the first in the list,
20002 Exim discards it and any subsequent items. If it is the first item, what
20003 happens is controlled by the
20004 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(manualroute)& router"
20005 &%self%& option of the router.
20006
20007 A name on the list that is followed by &`/MX`& is replaced with the list of
20008 hosts obtained by looking up MX records for the name. This is always a DNS
20009 lookup; the &%bydns%& and &%byname%& options (see section &<<SECThowoptused>>&
20010 below) are not relevant here. The order of these hosts is determined by the
20011 preference values in the MX records, according to the usual rules. Because
20012 randomizing happens before the MX lookup, it does not affect the order that is
20013 defined by MX preferences.
20014
20015 If the local host is present in the sublist obtained from MX records, but is
20016 not the most preferred host in that list, it and any equally or less
20017 preferred hosts are removed before the sublist is inserted into the main list.
20018
20019 If the local host is the most preferred host in the MX list, what happens
20020 depends on where in the original list of hosts the &`/MX`& item appears. If it
20021 is not the first item (that is, there are previous hosts in the main list),
20022 Exim discards this name and any subsequent items in the main list.
20023
20024 If the MX item is first in the list of hosts, and the local host is the
20025 most preferred host, what happens is controlled by the &%self%& option of the
20026 router.
20027
20028 DNS failures when lookup up the MX records are treated in the same way as DNS
20029 failures when looking up IP addresses: &%pass_on_timeout%& and
20030 &%host_find_failed%& are used when relevant.
20031
20032 The generic &%ignore_target_hosts%& option applies to all hosts in the list,
20033 whether obtained from an MX lookup or not.
20034
20035
20036
20037 .section "How the options are used" "SECThowoptused"
20038 The options are a sequence of words, space-separated.
20039 One of the words can be the name of a transport; this overrides the
20040 &%transport%& option on the router for this particular routing rule only. The
20041 other words (if present) control randomization of the list of hosts on a
20042 per-rule basis, and how the IP addresses of the hosts are to be found when
20043 routing to a remote transport. These options are as follows:
20044
20045 .ilist
20046 &%randomize%&: randomize the order of the hosts in this list, overriding the
20047 setting of &%hosts_randomize%& for this routing rule only.
20048 .next
20049 &%no_randomize%&: do not randomize the order of the hosts in this list,
20050 overriding the setting of &%hosts_randomize%& for this routing rule only.
20051 .next
20052 &%byname%&: use &[getipnodebyname()]& (&[gethostbyname()]& on older systems) to
20053 find IP addresses. This function may ultimately cause a DNS lookup, but it may
20054 also look in &_/etc/hosts_& or other sources of information.
20055 .next
20056 &%bydns%&: look up address records for the hosts directly in the DNS; fail if
20057 no address records are found. If there is a temporary DNS error (such as a
20058 timeout), delivery is deferred.
20059 .next
20060 &%ipv4_only%&: in direct DNS lookups, look up only A records.
20061 .next
20062 &%ipv4_prefer%&: in direct DNS lookups, sort A records before AAAA records.
20063 .endlist
20064
20065 For example:
20066 .code
20067 route_list = domain1 host1:host2:host3 randomize bydns;\
20068 domain2 host4:host5
20069 .endd
20070 If neither &%byname%& nor &%bydns%& is given, Exim behaves as follows: First, a
20071 DNS lookup is done. If this yields anything other than HOST_NOT_FOUND, that
20072 result is used. Otherwise, Exim goes on to try a call to &[getipnodebyname()]&
20073 or &[gethostbyname()]&, and the result of the lookup is the result of that
20074 call.
20075
20076 &*Warning*&: It has been discovered that on some systems, if a DNS lookup
20077 called via &[getipnodebyname()]& times out, HOST_NOT_FOUND is returned
20078 instead of TRY_AGAIN. That is why the default action is to try a DNS
20079 lookup first. Only if that gives a definite &"no such host"& is the local
20080 function called.
20081
20082 &*Compatibility*&: From Exim 4.85 until fixed for 4.90, there was an
20083 inadvertent constraint that a transport name as an option had to be the last
20084 option specified.
20085
20086
20087
20088 If no IP address for a host can be found, what happens is controlled by the
20089 &%host_find_failed%& option.
20090
20091 .vindex "&$host$&"
20092 When an address is routed to a local transport, IP addresses are not looked up.
20093 The host list is passed to the transport in the &$host$& variable.
20094
20095
20096
20097 .section "Manualroute examples" "SECID123"
20098 In some of the examples that follow, the presence of the &%remote_smtp%&
20099 transport, as defined in the default configuration file, is assumed:
20100
20101 .ilist
20102 .cindex "smart host" "example router"
20103 The &(manualroute)& router can be used to forward all external mail to a
20104 &'smart host'&. If you have set up, in the main part of the configuration, a
20105 named domain list that contains your local domains, for example:
20106 .code
20107 domainlist local_domains = my.domain.example
20108 .endd
20109 You can arrange for all other domains to be routed to a smart host by making
20110 your first router something like this:
20111 .code
20112 smart_route:
20113 driver = manualroute
20114 domains = !+local_domains
20115 transport = remote_smtp
20116 route_list = * smarthost.ref.example
20117 .endd
20118 This causes all non-local addresses to be sent to the single host
20119 &'smarthost.ref.example'&. If a colon-separated list of smart hosts is given,
20120 they are tried in order
20121 (but you can use &%hosts_randomize%& to vary the order each time).
20122 Another way of configuring the same thing is this:
20123 .code
20124 smart_route:
20125 driver = manualroute
20126 transport = remote_smtp
20127 route_list = !+local_domains smarthost.ref.example
20128 .endd
20129 There is no difference in behaviour between these two routers as they stand.
20130 However, they behave differently if &%no_more%& is added to them. In the first
20131 example, the router is skipped if the domain does not match the &%domains%&
20132 precondition; the following router is always tried. If the router runs, it
20133 always matches the domain and so can never decline. Therefore, &%no_more%&
20134 would have no effect. In the second case, the router is never skipped; it
20135 always runs. However, if it doesn't match the domain, it declines. In this case
20136 &%no_more%& would prevent subsequent routers from running.
20137
20138 .next
20139 .cindex "mail hub example"
20140 A &'mail hub'& is a host which receives mail for a number of domains via MX
20141 records in the DNS and delivers it via its own private routing mechanism. Often
20142 the final destinations are behind a firewall, with the mail hub being the one
20143 machine that can connect to machines both inside and outside the firewall. The
20144 &(manualroute)& router is usually used on a mail hub to route incoming messages
20145 to the correct hosts. For a small number of domains, the routing can be inline,
20146 using the &%route_list%& option, but for a larger number a file or database
20147 lookup is easier to manage.
20148
20149 If the domain names are in fact the names of the machines to which the mail is
20150 to be sent by the mail hub, the configuration can be quite simple. For
20151 example:
20152 .code
20153 hub_route:
20154 driver = manualroute
20155 transport = remote_smtp
20156 route_list = *.rhodes.tvs.example $domain
20157 .endd
20158 This configuration routes domains that match &`*.rhodes.tvs.example`& to hosts
20159 whose names are the same as the mail domains. A similar approach can be taken
20160 if the host name can be obtained from the domain name by a string manipulation
20161 that the expansion facilities can handle. Otherwise, a lookup based on the
20162 domain can be used to find the host:
20163 .code
20164 through_firewall:
20165 driver = manualroute
20166 transport = remote_smtp
20167 route_data = ${lookup {$domain} cdb {/internal/host/routes}}
20168 .endd
20169 The result of the lookup must be the name or IP address of the host (or
20170 hosts) to which the address is to be routed. If the lookup fails, the route
20171 data is empty, causing the router to decline. The address then passes to the
20172 next router.
20173
20174 .next
20175 .cindex "batched SMTP output example"
20176 .cindex "SMTP" "batched outgoing; example"
20177 You can use &(manualroute)& to deliver messages to pipes or files in batched
20178 SMTP format for onward transportation by some other means. This is one way of
20179 storing mail for a dial-up host when it is not connected. The route list entry
20180 can be as simple as a single domain name in a configuration like this:
20181 .code
20182 save_in_file:
20183 driver = manualroute
20184 transport = batchsmtp_appendfile
20185 route_list = saved.domain.example
20186 .endd
20187 though often a pattern is used to pick up more than one domain. If there are
20188 several domains or groups of domains with different transport requirements,
20189 different transports can be listed in the routing information:
20190 .code
20191 save_in_file:
20192 driver = manualroute
20193 route_list = \
20194 *.saved.domain1.example $domain batch_appendfile; \
20195 *.saved.domain2.example \
20196 ${lookup{$domain}dbm{/domain2/hosts}{$value}fail} \
20197 batch_pipe
20198 .endd
20199 .vindex "&$domain$&"
20200 .vindex "&$host$&"
20201 The first of these just passes the domain in the &$host$& variable, which
20202 doesn't achieve much (since it is also in &$domain$&), but the second does a
20203 file lookup to find a value to pass, causing the router to decline to handle
20204 the address if the lookup fails.
20205
20206 .next
20207 .cindex "UUCP" "example of router for"
20208 Routing mail directly to UUCP software is a specific case of the use of
20209 &(manualroute)& in a gateway to another mail environment. This is an example of
20210 one way it can be done:
20211 .code
20212 # Transport
20213 uucp:
20214 driver = pipe
20215 user = nobody
20216 command = /usr/local/bin/uux -r - \
20217 ${substr_-5:$host}!rmail ${local_part}
20218 return_fail_output = true
20219
20220 # Router
20221 uucphost:
20222 transport = uucp
20223 driver = manualroute
20224 route_data = \
20225 ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/usr/local/exim/uucphosts}}
20226 .endd
20227 The file &_/usr/local/exim/uucphosts_& contains entries like
20228 .code
20229 darksite.ethereal.example: darksite.UUCP
20230 .endd
20231 It can be set up more simply without adding and removing &".UUCP"& but this way
20232 makes clear the distinction between the domain name
20233 &'darksite.ethereal.example'& and the UUCP host name &'darksite'&.
20234 .endlist
20235 .ecindex IIDmanrou1
20236 .ecindex IIDmanrou2
20237
20238
20239
20240
20241
20242
20243
20244
20245 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20246 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20247
20248 .chapter "The queryprogram router" "CHAPdriverlast"
20249 .scindex IIDquerou1 "&(queryprogram)& router"
20250 .scindex IIDquerou2 "routers" "&(queryprogram)&"
20251 .cindex "routing" "by external program"
20252 The &(queryprogram)& router routes an address by running an external command
20253 and acting on its output. This is an expensive way to route, and is intended
20254 mainly for use in lightly-loaded systems, or for performing experiments.
20255 However, if it is possible to use the precondition options (&%domains%&,
20256 &%local_parts%&, etc) to skip this router for most addresses, it could sensibly
20257 be used in special cases, even on a busy host. There are the following private
20258 options:
20259 .cindex "options" "&(queryprogram)& router"
20260
20261 .option command queryprogram string&!! unset
20262 This option must be set. It specifies the command that is to be run. The
20263 command is split up into a command name and arguments, and then each is
20264 expanded separately (exactly as for a &(pipe)& transport, described in chapter
20265 &<<CHAPpipetransport>>&).
20266
20267
20268 .option command_group queryprogram string unset
20269 .cindex "gid (group id)" "in &(queryprogram)& router"
20270 This option specifies a gid to be set when running the command while routing an
20271 address for deliver. It must be set if &%command_user%& specifies a numerical
20272 uid. If it begins with a digit, it is interpreted as the numerical value of the
20273 gid. Otherwise it is looked up using &[getgrnam()]&.
20274
20275
20276 .option command_user queryprogram string unset
20277 .cindex "uid (user id)" "for &(queryprogram)&"
20278 This option must be set. It specifies the uid which is set when running the
20279 command while routing an address for delivery. If the value begins with a digit,
20280 it is interpreted as the numerical value of the uid. Otherwise, it is looked up
20281 using &[getpwnam()]& to obtain a value for the uid and, if &%command_group%& is
20282 not set, a value for the gid also.
20283
20284 &*Warning:*& Changing uid and gid is possible only when Exim is running as
20285 root, which it does during a normal delivery in a conventional configuration.
20286 However, when an address is being verified during message reception, Exim is
20287 usually running as the Exim user, not as root. If the &(queryprogram)& router
20288 is called from a non-root process, Exim cannot change uid or gid before running
20289 the command. In this circumstance the command runs under the current uid and
20290 gid.
20291
20292
20293 .option current_directory queryprogram string /
20294 This option specifies an absolute path which is made the current directory
20295 before running the command.
20296
20297
20298 .option timeout queryprogram time 1h
20299 If the command does not complete within the timeout period, its process group
20300 is killed and the message is frozen. A value of zero time specifies no
20301 timeout.
20302
20303
20304 The standard output of the command is connected to a pipe, which is read when
20305 the command terminates. It should consist of a single line of output,
20306 containing up to five fields, separated by white space. The maximum length of
20307 the line is 1023 characters. Longer lines are silently truncated. The first
20308 field is one of the following words (case-insensitive):
20309
20310 .ilist
20311 &'Accept'&: routing succeeded; the remaining fields specify what to do (see
20312 below).
20313 .next
20314 &'Decline'&: the router declines; pass the address to the next router, unless
20315 &%no_more%& is set.
20316 .next
20317 &'Fail'&: routing failed; do not pass the address to any more routers. Any
20318 subsequent text on the line is an error message. If the router is run as part
20319 of address verification during an incoming SMTP message, the message is
20320 included in the SMTP response.
20321 .next
20322 &'Defer'&: routing could not be completed at this time; try again later. Any
20323 subsequent text on the line is an error message which is logged. It is not
20324 included in any SMTP response.
20325 .next
20326 &'Freeze'&: the same as &'defer'&, except that the message is frozen.
20327 .next
20328 &'Pass'&: pass the address to the next router (or the router specified by
20329 &%pass_router%&), overriding &%no_more%&.
20330 .next
20331 &'Redirect'&: the message is redirected. The remainder of the line is a list of
20332 new addresses, which are routed independently, starting with the first router,
20333 or the router specified by &%redirect_router%&, if set.
20334 .endlist
20335
20336 When the first word is &'accept'&, the remainder of the line consists of a
20337 number of keyed data values, as follows (split into two lines here, to fit on
20338 the page):
20339 .code
20340 ACCEPT TRANSPORT=<transport> HOSTS=<list of hosts>
20341 LOOKUP=byname|bydns DATA=<text>
20342 .endd
20343 The data items can be given in any order, and all are optional. If no transport
20344 is included, the transport specified by the generic &%transport%& option is
20345 used. The list of hosts and the lookup type are needed only if the transport is
20346 an &(smtp)& transport that does not itself supply a list of hosts.
20347
20348 The format of the list of hosts is the same as for the &(manualroute)& router.
20349 As well as host names and IP addresses with optional port numbers, as described
20350 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&, it may contain names followed by
20351 &`/MX`& to specify sublists of hosts that are obtained by looking up MX records
20352 (see section &<<SECThostshowused>>&).
20353
20354 If the lookup type is not specified, Exim behaves as follows when trying to
20355 find an IP address for each host: First, a DNS lookup is done. If this yields
20356 anything other than HOST_NOT_FOUND, that result is used. Otherwise, Exim
20357 goes on to try a call to &[getipnodebyname()]& or &[gethostbyname()]&, and the
20358 result of the lookup is the result of that call.
20359
20360 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
20361 If the DATA field is set, its value is placed in the &$address_data$&
20362 variable. For example, this return line
20363 .code
20364 accept hosts=x1.y.example:x2.y.example data="rule1"
20365 .endd
20366 routes the address to the default transport, passing a list of two hosts. When
20367 the transport runs, the string &"rule1"& is in &$address_data$&.
20368 .ecindex IIDquerou1
20369 .ecindex IIDquerou2
20370
20371
20372
20373
20374 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20375 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20376
20377 .chapter "The redirect router" "CHAPredirect"
20378 .scindex IIDredrou1 "&(redirect)& router"
20379 .scindex IIDredrou2 "routers" "&(redirect)&"
20380 .cindex "alias file" "in a &(redirect)& router"
20381 .cindex "address redirection" "&(redirect)& router"
20382 The &(redirect)& router handles several kinds of address redirection. Its most
20383 common uses are for resolving local part aliases from a central alias file
20384 (usually called &_/etc/aliases_&) and for handling users' personal &_.forward_&
20385 files, but it has many other potential uses. The incoming address can be
20386 redirected in several different ways:
20387
20388 .ilist
20389 It can be replaced by one or more new addresses which are themselves routed
20390 independently.
20391 .next
20392 It can be routed to be delivered to a given file or directory.
20393 .next
20394 It can be routed to be delivered to a specified pipe command.
20395 .next
20396 It can cause an automatic reply to be generated.
20397 .next
20398 It can be forced to fail, optionally with a custom error message.
20399 .next
20400 It can be temporarily deferred, optionally with a custom message.
20401 .next
20402 It can be discarded.
20403 .endlist
20404
20405 The generic &%transport%& option must not be set for &(redirect)& routers.
20406 However, there are some private options which define transports for delivery to
20407 files and pipes, and for generating autoreplies. See the &%file_transport%&,
20408 &%pipe_transport%& and &%reply_transport%& descriptions below.
20409
20410 If success DSNs have been requested
20411 .cindex "DSN" "success"
20412 .cindex "Delivery Status Notification" "success"
20413 redirection triggers one and the DSN options are not passed any further.
20414
20415
20416
20417 .section "Redirection data" "SECID124"
20418 The router operates by interpreting a text string which it obtains either by
20419 expanding the contents of the &%data%& option, or by reading the entire
20420 contents of a file whose name is given in the &%file%& option. These two
20421 options are mutually exclusive. The first is commonly used for handling system
20422 aliases, in a configuration like this:
20423 .code
20424 system_aliases:
20425 driver = redirect
20426 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/aliases}}
20427 .endd
20428 If the lookup fails, the expanded string in this example is empty. When the
20429 expansion of &%data%& results in an empty string, the router declines. A forced
20430 expansion failure also causes the router to decline; other expansion failures
20431 cause delivery to be deferred.
20432
20433 A configuration using &%file%& is commonly used for handling users'
20434 &_.forward_& files, like this:
20435 .code
20436 userforward:
20437 driver = redirect
20438 check_local_user
20439 file = $home/.forward
20440 no_verify
20441 .endd
20442 If the file does not exist, or causes no action to be taken (for example, it is
20443 empty or consists only of comments), the router declines. &*Warning*&: This
20444 is not the case when the file contains syntactically valid items that happen to
20445 yield empty addresses, for example, items containing only RFC 2822 address
20446 comments.
20447
20448
20449
20450 .section "Forward files and address verification" "SECID125"
20451 .cindex "address redirection" "while verifying"
20452 It is usual to set &%no_verify%& on &(redirect)& routers which handle users'
20453 &_.forward_& files, as in the example above. There are two reasons for this:
20454
20455 .ilist
20456 When Exim is receiving an incoming SMTP message from a remote host, it is
20457 running under the Exim uid, not as root. Exim is unable to change uid to read
20458 the file as the user, and it may not be able to read it as the Exim user. So in
20459 practice the router may not be able to operate.
20460 .next
20461 However, even when the router can operate, the existence of a &_.forward_& file
20462 is unimportant when verifying an address. What should be checked is whether the
20463 local part is a valid user name or not. Cutting out the redirection processing
20464 saves some resources.
20465 .endlist
20466
20467
20468
20469
20470
20471
20472 .section "Interpreting redirection data" "SECID126"
20473 .cindex "Sieve filter" "specifying in redirection data"
20474 .cindex "filter" "specifying in redirection data"
20475 The contents of the data string, whether obtained from &%data%& or &%file%&,
20476 can be interpreted in two different ways:
20477
20478 .ilist
20479 If the &%allow_filter%& option is set true, and the data begins with the text
20480 &"#Exim filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"&, it is interpreted as a list of
20481 &'filtering'& instructions in the form of an Exim or Sieve filter file,
20482 respectively. Details of the syntax and semantics of filter files are described
20483 in a separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&; this
20484 document is intended for use by end users.
20485 .next
20486 Otherwise, the data must be a comma-separated list of redirection items, as
20487 described in the next section.
20488 .endlist
20489
20490 When a message is redirected to a file (a &"mail folder"&), the filename given
20491 in a non-filter redirection list must always be an absolute path. A filter may
20492 generate a relative path &-- how this is handled depends on the transport's
20493 configuration. See section &<<SECTfildiropt>>& for a discussion of this issue
20494 for the &(appendfile)& transport.
20495
20496
20497
20498 .section "Items in a non-filter redirection list" "SECTitenonfilred"
20499 .cindex "address redirection" "non-filter list items"
20500 When the redirection data is not an Exim or Sieve filter, for example, if it
20501 comes from a conventional alias or forward file, it consists of a list of
20502 addresses, filenames, pipe commands, or certain special items (see section
20503 &<<SECTspecitredli>>& below). The special items can be individually enabled or
20504 disabled by means of options whose names begin with &%allow_%& or &%forbid_%&,
20505 depending on their default values. The items in the list are separated by
20506 commas or newlines.
20507 If a comma is required in an item, the entire item must be enclosed in double
20508 quotes.
20509
20510 Lines starting with a # character are comments, and are ignored, and # may
20511 also appear following a comma, in which case everything between the # and the
20512 next newline character is ignored.
20513
20514 If an item is entirely enclosed in double quotes, these are removed. Otherwise
20515 double quotes are retained because some forms of mail address require their use
20516 (but never to enclose the entire address). In the following description,
20517 &"item"& refers to what remains after any surrounding double quotes have been
20518 removed.
20519
20520 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
20521 &*Warning*&: If you use an Exim expansion to construct a redirection address,
20522 and the expansion contains a reference to &$local_part$&, you should make use
20523 of the &%quote_local_part%& expansion operator, in case the local part contains
20524 special characters. For example, to redirect all mail for the domain
20525 &'obsolete.example'&, retaining the existing local part, you could use this
20526 setting:
20527 .code
20528 data = ${quote_local_part:$local_part}@newdomain.example
20529 .endd
20530
20531
20532 .section "Redirecting to a local mailbox" "SECTredlocmai"
20533 .cindex "routing" "loops in"
20534 .cindex "loop" "while routing, avoidance of"
20535 .cindex "address redirection" "to local mailbox"
20536 A redirection item may safely be the same as the address currently under
20537 consideration. This does not cause a routing loop, because a router is
20538 automatically skipped if any ancestor of the address that is being processed
20539 is the same as the current address and was processed by the current router.
20540 Such an address is therefore passed to the following routers, so it is handled
20541 as if there were no redirection. When making this loop-avoidance test, the
20542 complete local part, including any prefix or suffix, is used.
20543
20544 .cindex "address redirection" "local part without domain"
20545 Specifying the same local part without a domain is a common usage in personal
20546 filter files when the user wants to have messages delivered to the local
20547 mailbox and also forwarded elsewhere. For example, the user whose login is
20548 &'cleo'& might have a &_.forward_& file containing this:
20549 .code
20550 cleo, cleopatra@egypt.example
20551 .endd
20552 .cindex "backslash in alias file"
20553 .cindex "alias file" "backslash in"
20554 For compatibility with other MTAs, such unqualified local parts may be
20555 preceded by &"\"&, but this is not a requirement for loop prevention. However,
20556 it does make a difference if more than one domain is being handled
20557 synonymously.
20558
20559 If an item begins with &"\"& and the rest of the item parses as a valid RFC
20560 2822 address that does not include a domain, the item is qualified using the
20561 domain of the incoming address. In the absence of a leading &"\"&, unqualified
20562 addresses are qualified using the value in &%qualify_recipient%&, but you can
20563 force the incoming domain to be used by setting &%qualify_preserve_domain%&.
20564
20565 Care must be taken if there are alias names for local users.
20566 Consider an MTA handling a single local domain where the system alias file
20567 contains:
20568 .code
20569 Sam.Reman: spqr
20570 .endd
20571 Now suppose that Sam (whose login id is &'spqr'&) wants to save copies of
20572 messages in the local mailbox, and also forward copies elsewhere. He creates
20573 this forward file:
20574 .code
20575 Sam.Reman, spqr@reme.elsewhere.example
20576 .endd
20577 With these settings, an incoming message addressed to &'Sam.Reman'& fails. The
20578 &(redirect)& router for system aliases does not process &'Sam.Reman'& the
20579 second time round, because it has previously routed it,
20580 and the following routers presumably cannot handle the alias. The forward file
20581 should really contain
20582 .code
20583 spqr, spqr@reme.elsewhere.example
20584 .endd
20585 but because this is such a common error, the &%check_ancestor%& option (see
20586 below) exists to provide a way to get round it. This is normally set on a
20587 &(redirect)& router that is handling users' &_.forward_& files.
20588
20589
20590
20591 .section "Special items in redirection lists" "SECTspecitredli"
20592 In addition to addresses, the following types of item may appear in redirection
20593 lists (that is, in non-filter redirection data):
20594
20595 .ilist
20596 .cindex "pipe" "in redirection list"
20597 .cindex "address redirection" "to pipe"
20598 An item is treated as a pipe command if it begins with &"|"& and does not parse
20599 as a valid RFC 2822 address that includes a domain. A transport for running the
20600 command must be specified by the &%pipe_transport%& option.
20601 Normally, either the router or the transport specifies a user and a group under
20602 which to run the delivery. The default is to use the Exim user and group.
20603
20604 Single or double quotes can be used for enclosing the individual arguments of
20605 the pipe command; no interpretation of escapes is done for single quotes. If
20606 the command contains a comma character, it is necessary to put the whole item
20607 in double quotes, for example:
20608 .code
20609 "|/some/command ready,steady,go"
20610 .endd
20611 since items in redirection lists are terminated by commas. Do not, however,
20612 quote just the command. An item such as
20613 .code
20614 |"/some/command ready,steady,go"
20615 .endd
20616 is interpreted as a pipe with a rather strange command name, and no arguments.
20617
20618 Note that the above example assumes that the text comes from a lookup source
20619 of some sort, so that the quotes are part of the data. If composing a
20620 redirect router with a &%data%& option directly specifying this command, the
20621 quotes will be used by the configuration parser to define the extent of one
20622 string, but will not be passed down into the redirect router itself. There
20623 are two main approaches to get around this: escape quotes to be part of the
20624 data itself, or avoid using this mechanism and instead create a custom
20625 transport with the &%command%& option set and reference that transport from
20626 an &%accept%& router.
20627
20628 .next
20629 .cindex "file" "in redirection list"
20630 .cindex "address redirection" "to file"
20631 An item is interpreted as a path name if it begins with &"/"& and does not
20632 parse as a valid RFC 2822 address that includes a domain. For example,
20633 .code
20634 /home/world/minbari
20635 .endd
20636 is treated as a filename, but
20637 .code
20638 /s=molari/o=babylon/@x400gate.way
20639 .endd
20640 is treated as an address. For a filename, a transport must be specified using
20641 the &%file_transport%& option. However, if the generated path name ends with a
20642 forward slash character, it is interpreted as a directory name rather than a
20643 filename, and &%directory_transport%& is used instead.
20644
20645 Normally, either the router or the transport specifies a user and a group under
20646 which to run the delivery. The default is to use the Exim user and group.
20647
20648 .cindex "&_/dev/null_&"
20649 However, if a redirection item is the path &_/dev/null_&, delivery to it is
20650 bypassed at a high level, and the log entry shows &"**bypassed**"&
20651 instead of a transport name. In this case the user and group are not used.
20652
20653 .next
20654 .cindex "included address list"
20655 .cindex "address redirection" "included external list"
20656 If an item is of the form
20657 .code
20658 :include:<path name>
20659 .endd
20660 a list of further items is taken from the given file and included at that
20661 point. &*Note*&: Such a file can not be a filter file; it is just an
20662 out-of-line addition to the list. The items in the included list are separated
20663 by commas or newlines and are not subject to expansion. If this is the first
20664 item in an alias list in an &(lsearch)& file, a colon must be used to terminate
20665 the alias name. This example is incorrect:
20666 .code
20667 list1 :include:/opt/lists/list1
20668 .endd
20669 It must be given as
20670 .code
20671 list1: :include:/opt/lists/list1
20672 .endd
20673 .next
20674 .cindex "address redirection" "to black hole"
20675 .cindex "delivery" "discard"
20676 .cindex "delivery" "blackhole"
20677 .cindex "black hole"
20678 .cindex "abandoning mail"
20679 Sometimes you want to throw away mail to a particular local part. Making the
20680 &%data%& option expand to an empty string does not work, because that causes
20681 the router to decline. Instead, the alias item
20682 .code
20683 :blackhole:
20684 .endd
20685 can be used. It does what its name implies. No delivery is
20686 done, and no error message is generated. This has the same effect as specifying
20687 &_/dev/null_& as a destination, but it can be independently disabled.
20688
20689 &*Warning*&: If &':blackhole:'& appears anywhere in a redirection list, no
20690 delivery is done for the original local part, even if other redirection items
20691 are present. If you are generating a multi-item list (for example, by reading a
20692 database) and need the ability to provide a no-op item, you must use
20693 &_/dev/null_&.
20694
20695 .next
20696 .cindex "delivery" "forcing failure"
20697 .cindex "delivery" "forcing deferral"
20698 .cindex "failing delivery" "forcing"
20699 .cindex "deferred delivery, forcing"
20700 .cindex "customizing" "failure message"
20701 An attempt to deliver a particular address can be deferred or forced to fail by
20702 redirection items of the form
20703 .code
20704 :defer:
20705 :fail:
20706 .endd
20707 respectively. When a redirection list contains such an item, it applies
20708 to the entire redirection; any other items in the list are ignored. Any
20709 text following &':fail:'& or &':defer:'& is placed in the error text
20710 associated with the failure. For example, an alias file might contain:
20711 .code
20712 X.Employee: :fail: Gone away, no forwarding address
20713 .endd
20714 In the case of an address that is being verified from an ACL or as the subject
20715 of a
20716 .cindex "VRFY" "error text, display of"
20717 VRFY command, the text is included in the SMTP error response by
20718 default.
20719 .cindex "EXPN" "error text, display of"
20720 The text is not included in the response to an EXPN command. In non-SMTP cases
20721 the text is included in the error message that Exim generates.
20722
20723 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
20724 By default, Exim sends a 451 SMTP code for a &':defer:'&, and 550 for
20725 &':fail:'&. However, if the message starts with three digits followed by a
20726 space, optionally followed by an extended code of the form &'n.n.n'&, also
20727 followed by a space, and the very first digit is the same as the default error
20728 code, the code from the message is used instead. If the very first digit is
20729 incorrect, a panic error is logged, and the default code is used. You can
20730 suppress the use of the supplied code in a redirect router by setting the
20731 &%forbid_smtp_code%& option true. In this case, any SMTP code is quietly
20732 ignored.
20733
20734 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
20735 In an ACL, an explicitly provided message overrides the default, but the
20736 default message is available in the variable &$acl_verify_message$& and can
20737 therefore be included in a custom message if this is desired.
20738
20739 Normally the error text is the rest of the redirection list &-- a comma does
20740 not terminate it &-- but a newline does act as a terminator. Newlines are not
20741 normally present in alias expansions. In &(lsearch)& lookups they are removed
20742 as part of the continuation process, but they may exist in other kinds of
20743 lookup and in &':include:'& files.
20744
20745 During routing for message delivery (as opposed to verification), a redirection
20746 containing &':fail:'& causes an immediate failure of the incoming address,
20747 whereas &':defer:'& causes the message to remain in the queue so that a
20748 subsequent delivery attempt can happen at a later time. If an address is
20749 deferred for too long, it will ultimately fail, because the normal retry
20750 rules still apply.
20751
20752 .next
20753 .cindex "alias file" "exception to default"
20754 Sometimes it is useful to use a single-key search type with a default (see
20755 chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&) to look up aliases. However, there may be a need
20756 for exceptions to the default. These can be handled by aliasing them to
20757 &':unknown:'&. This differs from &':fail:'& in that it causes the &(redirect)&
20758 router to decline, whereas &':fail:'& forces routing to fail. A lookup which
20759 results in an empty redirection list has the same effect.
20760 .endlist
20761
20762
20763 .section "Duplicate addresses" "SECTdupaddr"
20764 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
20765 .cindex "address duplicate, discarding"
20766 .cindex "pipe" "duplicated"
20767 Exim removes duplicate addresses from the list to which it is delivering, so as
20768 to deliver just one copy to each address. This does not apply to deliveries
20769 routed to pipes by different immediate parent addresses, but an indirect
20770 aliasing scheme of the type
20771 .code
20772 pipe: |/some/command $local_part
20773 localpart1: pipe
20774 localpart2: pipe
20775 .endd
20776 does not work with a message that is addressed to both local parts, because
20777 when the second is aliased to the intermediate local part &"pipe"& it gets
20778 discarded as being the same as a previously handled address. However, a scheme
20779 such as
20780 .code
20781 localpart1: |/some/command $local_part
20782 localpart2: |/some/command $local_part
20783 .endd
20784 does result in two different pipe deliveries, because the immediate parents of
20785 the pipes are distinct.
20786
20787
20788
20789 .section "Repeated redirection expansion" "SECID128"
20790 .cindex "repeated redirection expansion"
20791 .cindex "address redirection" "repeated for each delivery attempt"
20792 When a message cannot be delivered to all of its recipients immediately,
20793 leading to two or more delivery attempts, redirection expansion is carried out
20794 afresh each time for those addresses whose children were not all previously
20795 delivered. If redirection is being used as a mailing list, this can lead to new
20796 members of the list receiving copies of old messages. The &%one_time%& option
20797 can be used to avoid this.
20798
20799
20800 .section "Errors in redirection lists" "SECID129"
20801 .cindex "address redirection" "errors"
20802 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set, a malformed address that causes a parsing
20803 error is skipped, and an entry is written to the main log. This may be useful
20804 for mailing lists that are automatically managed. Otherwise, if an error is
20805 detected while generating the list of new addresses, the original address is
20806 deferred. See also &%syntax_errors_to%&.
20807
20808
20809
20810 .section "Private options for the redirect router" "SECID130"
20811
20812 .cindex "options" "&(redirect)& router"
20813 The private options for the &(redirect)& router are as follows:
20814
20815
20816 .option allow_defer redirect boolean false
20817 Setting this option allows the use of &':defer:'& in non-filter redirection
20818 data, or the &%defer%& command in an Exim filter file.
20819
20820
20821 .option allow_fail redirect boolean false
20822 .cindex "failing delivery" "from filter"
20823 If this option is true, the &':fail:'& item can be used in a redirection list,
20824 and the &%fail%& command may be used in an Exim filter file.
20825
20826
20827 .option allow_filter redirect boolean false
20828 .cindex "filter" "enabling use of"
20829 .cindex "Sieve filter" "enabling use of"
20830 Setting this option allows Exim to interpret redirection data that starts with
20831 &"#Exim filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"& as a set of filtering instructions. There
20832 are some features of Exim filter files that some administrators may wish to
20833 lock out; see the &%forbid_filter_%&&'xxx'& options below.
20834
20835 It is also possible to lock out Exim filters or Sieve filters while allowing
20836 the other type; see &%forbid_exim_filter%& and &%forbid_sieve_filter%&.
20837
20838
20839 The filter is run using the uid and gid set by the generic &%user%& and
20840 &%group%& options. These take their defaults from the password data if
20841 &%check_local_user%& is set, so in the normal case of users' personal filter
20842 files, the filter is run as the relevant user. When &%allow_filter%& is set
20843 true, Exim insists that either &%check_local_user%& or &%user%& is set.
20844
20845
20846
20847 .option allow_freeze redirect boolean false
20848 .cindex "freezing messages" "allowing in filter"
20849 Setting this option allows the use of the &%freeze%& command in an Exim filter.
20850 This command is more normally encountered in system filters, and is disabled by
20851 default for redirection filters because it isn't something you usually want to
20852 let ordinary users do.
20853
20854
20855
20856 .option check_ancestor redirect boolean false
20857 This option is concerned with handling generated addresses that are the same
20858 as some address in the list of redirection ancestors of the current address.
20859 Although it is turned off by default in the code, it is set in the default
20860 configuration file for handling users' &_.forward_& files. It is recommended
20861 for this use of the &(redirect)& router.
20862
20863 When &%check_ancestor%& is set, if a generated address (including the domain)
20864 is the same as any ancestor of the current address, it is replaced by a copy of
20865 the current address. This helps in the case where local part A is aliased to B,
20866 and B has a &_.forward_& file pointing back to A. For example, within a single
20867 domain, the local part &"Joe.Bloggs"& is aliased to &"jb"& and
20868 &_&~jb/.forward_& contains:
20869 .code
20870 \Joe.Bloggs, <other item(s)>
20871 .endd
20872 Without the &%check_ancestor%& setting, either local part (&"jb"& or
20873 &"joe.bloggs"&) gets processed once by each router and so ends up as it was
20874 originally. If &"jb"& is the real mailbox name, mail to &"jb"& gets delivered
20875 (having been turned into &"joe.bloggs"& by the &_.forward_& file and back to
20876 &"jb"& by the alias), but mail to &"joe.bloggs"& fails. Setting
20877 &%check_ancestor%& on the &(redirect)& router that handles the &_.forward_&
20878 file prevents it from turning &"jb"& back into &"joe.bloggs"& when that was the
20879 original address. See also the &%repeat_use%& option below.
20880
20881
20882 .option check_group redirect boolean "see below"
20883 When the &%file%& option is used, the group owner of the file is checked only
20884 when this option is set. The permitted groups are those listed in the
20885 &%owngroups%& option, together with the user's default group if
20886 &%check_local_user%& is set. If the file has the wrong group, routing is
20887 deferred. The default setting for this option is true if &%check_local_user%&
20888 is set and the &%modemask%& option permits the group write bit, or if the
20889 &%owngroups%& option is set. Otherwise it is false, and no group check occurs.
20890
20891
20892
20893 .option check_owner redirect boolean "see below"
20894 When the &%file%& option is used, the owner of the file is checked only when
20895 this option is set. If &%check_local_user%& is set, the local user is
20896 permitted; otherwise the owner must be one of those listed in the &%owners%&
20897 option. The default value for this option is true if &%check_local_user%& or
20898 &%owners%& is set. Otherwise the default is false, and no owner check occurs.
20899
20900
20901 .option data redirect string&!! unset
20902 This option is mutually exclusive with &%file%&. One or other of them must be
20903 set, but not both. The contents of &%data%& are expanded, and then used as the
20904 list of forwarding items, or as a set of filtering instructions. If the
20905 expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string or a string that
20906 has no effect (consists entirely of comments), the router declines.
20907
20908 When filtering instructions are used, the string must begin with &"#Exim
20909 filter"&, and all comments in the string, including this initial one, must be
20910 terminated with newline characters. For example:
20911 .code
20912 data = #Exim filter\n\
20913 if $h_to: contains Exim then save $home/mail/exim endif
20914 .endd
20915 If you are reading the data from a database where newlines cannot be included,
20916 you can use the &${sg}$& expansion item to turn the escape string of your
20917 choice into a newline.
20918
20919
20920 .option directory_transport redirect string&!! unset
20921 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a directory when a path name
20922 ending with a slash is specified as a new &"address"&. The transport used is
20923 specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a
20924 configured transport. This should normally be an &(appendfile)& transport.
20925
20926
20927 .option file redirect string&!! unset
20928 This option specifies the name of a file that contains the redirection data. It
20929 is mutually exclusive with the &%data%& option. The string is expanded before
20930 use; if the expansion is forced to fail, the router declines. Other expansion
20931 failures cause delivery to be deferred. The result of a successful expansion
20932 must be an absolute path. The entire file is read and used as the redirection
20933 data. If the data is an empty string or a string that has no effect (consists
20934 entirely of comments), the router declines.
20935
20936 .cindex "NFS" "checking for file existence"
20937 If the attempt to open the file fails with a &"does not exist"& error, Exim
20938 runs a check on the containing directory,
20939 unless &%ignore_enotdir%& is true (see below).
20940 If the directory does not appear to exist, delivery is deferred. This can
20941 happen when users' &_.forward_& files are in NFS-mounted directories, and there
20942 is a mount problem. If the containing directory does exist, but the file does
20943 not, the router declines.
20944
20945
20946 .option file_transport redirect string&!! unset
20947 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
20948 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a file when a path name not
20949 ending in a slash is specified as a new &"address"&. The transport used is
20950 specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a
20951 configured transport. This should normally be an &(appendfile)& transport. When
20952 it is running, the filename is in &$address_file$&.
20953
20954
20955 .option filter_prepend_home redirect boolean true
20956 When this option is true, if a &(save)& command in an Exim filter specifies a
20957 relative path, and &$home$& is defined, it is automatically prepended to the
20958 relative path. If this option is set false, this action does not happen. The
20959 relative path is then passed to the transport unmodified.
20960
20961
20962 .option forbid_blackhole redirect boolean false
20963 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20964 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20965 If this option is true, the &':blackhole:'& item may not appear in a
20966 redirection list.
20967
20968
20969 .option forbid_exim_filter redirect boolean false
20970 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20971 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20972 If this option is set true, only Sieve filters are permitted when
20973 &%allow_filter%& is true.
20974
20975
20976
20977
20978 .option forbid_file redirect boolean false
20979 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20980 .cindex "delivery" "to file; forbidding"
20981 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20982 .cindex "Sieve filter" "forbidding delivery to a file"
20983 .cindex "Sieve filter" "&""keep""& facility; disabling"
20984 If this option is true, this router may not generate a new address that
20985 specifies delivery to a local file or directory, either from a filter or from a
20986 conventional forward file. This option is forced to be true if &%one_time%& is
20987 set. It applies to Sieve filters as well as to Exim filters, but if true, it
20988 locks out the Sieve's &"keep"& facility.
20989
20990
20991 .option forbid_filter_dlfunc redirect boolean false
20992 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20993 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20994 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filters are not allowed to
20995 make use of the &%dlfunc%& expansion facility to run dynamically loaded
20996 functions.
20997
20998 .option forbid_filter_existstest redirect boolean false
20999 .cindex "restricting access to features"
21000 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21001 .cindex "expansion" "statting a file"
21002 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filters are not allowed to
21003 make use of the &%exists%& condition or the &%stat%& expansion item.
21004
21005 .option forbid_filter_logwrite redirect boolean false
21006 .cindex "restricting access to features"
21007 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21008 If this option is true, use of the logging facility in Exim filters is not
21009 permitted. Logging is in any case available only if the filter is being run
21010 under some unprivileged uid (which is normally the case for ordinary users'
21011 &_.forward_& files).
21012
21013
21014 .option forbid_filter_lookup redirect boolean false
21015 .cindex "restricting access to features"
21016 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21017 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
21018 to make use of &%lookup%& items.
21019
21020
21021 .option forbid_filter_perl redirect boolean false
21022 .cindex "restricting access to features"
21023 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21024 This option has an effect only if Exim is built with embedded Perl support. If
21025 it is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed to make use
21026 of the embedded Perl support.
21027
21028
21029 .option forbid_filter_readfile redirect boolean false
21030 .cindex "restricting access to features"
21031 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21032 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
21033 to make use of &%readfile%& items.
21034
21035
21036 .option forbid_filter_readsocket redirect boolean false
21037 .cindex "restricting access to features"
21038 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21039 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
21040 to make use of &%readsocket%& items.
21041
21042
21043 .option forbid_filter_reply redirect boolean false
21044 .cindex "restricting access to features"
21045 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21046 If this option is true, this router may not generate an automatic reply
21047 message. Automatic replies can be generated only from Exim or Sieve filter
21048 files, not from traditional forward files. This option is forced to be true if
21049 &%one_time%& is set.
21050
21051
21052 .option forbid_filter_run redirect boolean false
21053 .cindex "restricting access to features"
21054 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21055 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
21056 to make use of &%run%& items.
21057
21058
21059 .option forbid_include redirect boolean false
21060 .cindex "restricting access to features"
21061 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21062 If this option is true, items of the form
21063 .code
21064 :include:<path name>
21065 .endd
21066 are not permitted in non-filter redirection lists.
21067
21068
21069 .option forbid_pipe redirect boolean false
21070 .cindex "restricting access to features"
21071 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21072 .cindex "delivery" "to pipe; forbidding"
21073 If this option is true, this router may not generate a new address which
21074 specifies delivery to a pipe, either from an Exim filter or from a conventional
21075 forward file. This option is forced to be true if &%one_time%& is set.
21076
21077
21078 .option forbid_sieve_filter redirect boolean false
21079 .cindex "restricting access to features"
21080 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21081 If this option is set true, only Exim filters are permitted when
21082 &%allow_filter%& is true.
21083
21084
21085 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
21086 .option forbid_smtp_code redirect boolean false
21087 If this option is set true, any SMTP error codes that are present at the start
21088 of messages specified for &`:defer:`& or &`:fail:`& are quietly ignored, and
21089 the default codes (451 and 550, respectively) are always used.
21090
21091
21092
21093
21094 .option hide_child_in_errmsg redirect boolean false
21095 .cindex "bounce message" "redirection details; suppressing"
21096 If this option is true, it prevents Exim from quoting a child address if it
21097 generates a bounce or delay message for it. Instead it says &"an address
21098 generated from <&'the top level address'&>"&. Of course, this applies only to
21099 bounces generated locally. If a message is forwarded to another host, &'its'&
21100 bounce may well quote the generated address.
21101
21102
21103 .option ignore_eacces redirect boolean false
21104 .cindex "EACCES"
21105 If this option is set and an attempt to open a redirection file yields the
21106 EACCES error (permission denied), the &(redirect)& router behaves as if the
21107 file did not exist.
21108
21109
21110 .option ignore_enotdir redirect boolean false
21111 .cindex "ENOTDIR"
21112 If this option is set and an attempt to open a redirection file yields the
21113 ENOTDIR error (something on the path is not a directory), the &(redirect)&
21114 router behaves as if the file did not exist.
21115
21116 Setting &%ignore_enotdir%& has another effect as well: When a &(redirect)&
21117 router that has the &%file%& option set discovers that the file does not exist
21118 (the ENOENT error), it tries to &[stat()]& the parent directory, as a check
21119 against unmounted NFS directories. If the parent can not be statted, delivery
21120 is deferred. However, it seems wrong to do this check when &%ignore_enotdir%&
21121 is set, because that option tells Exim to ignore &"something on the path is not
21122 a directory"& (the ENOTDIR error). This is a confusing area, because it seems
21123 that some operating systems give ENOENT where others give ENOTDIR.
21124
21125
21126
21127 .option include_directory redirect string unset
21128 If this option is set, the path names of any &':include:'& items in a
21129 redirection list must start with this directory.
21130
21131
21132 .option modemask redirect "octal integer" 022
21133 This specifies mode bits which must not be set for a file specified by the
21134 &%file%& option. If any of the forbidden bits are set, delivery is deferred.
21135
21136
21137 .option one_time redirect boolean false
21138 .cindex "one-time aliasing/forwarding expansion"
21139 .cindex "alias file" "one-time expansion"
21140 .cindex "forward file" "one-time expansion"
21141 .cindex "mailing lists" "one-time expansion"
21142 .cindex "address redirection" "one-time expansion"
21143 Sometimes the fact that Exim re-evaluates aliases and reprocesses redirection
21144 files each time it tries to deliver a message causes a problem when one or more
21145 of the generated addresses fails be delivered at the first attempt. The problem
21146 is not one of duplicate delivery &-- Exim is clever enough to handle that &--
21147 but of what happens when the redirection list changes during the time that the
21148 message is on Exim's queue. This is particularly true in the case of mailing
21149 lists, where new subscribers might receive copies of messages that were posted
21150 before they subscribed.
21151
21152 If &%one_time%& is set and any addresses generated by the router fail to
21153 deliver at the first attempt, the failing addresses are added to the message as
21154 &"top level"& addresses, and the parent address that generated them is marked
21155 &"delivered"&. Thus, redirection does not happen again at the next delivery
21156 attempt.
21157
21158 &*Warning 1*&: Any header line addition or removal that is specified by this
21159 router would be lost if delivery did not succeed at the first attempt. For this
21160 reason, the &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& generic options are not
21161 permitted when &%one_time%& is set.
21162
21163 &*Warning 2*&: To ensure that the router generates only addresses (as opposed
21164 to pipe or file deliveries or auto-replies) &%forbid_file%&, &%forbid_pipe%&,
21165 and &%forbid_filter_reply%& are forced to be true when &%one_time%& is set.
21166
21167 &*Warning 3*&: The &%unseen%& generic router option may not be set with
21168 &%one_time%&.
21169
21170 The original top-level address is remembered with each of the generated
21171 addresses, and is output in any log messages. However, any intermediate parent
21172 addresses are not recorded. This makes a difference to the log only if
21173 &%all_parents%& log selector is set. It is expected that &%one_time%& will
21174 typically be used for mailing lists, where there is normally just one level of
21175 expansion.
21176
21177
21178 .option owners redirect "string list" unset
21179 .cindex "ownership" "alias file"
21180 .cindex "ownership" "forward file"
21181 .cindex "alias file" "ownership"
21182 .cindex "forward file" "ownership"
21183 This specifies a list of permitted owners for the file specified by &%file%&.
21184 This list is in addition to the local user when &%check_local_user%& is set.
21185 See &%check_owner%& above.
21186
21187
21188 .option owngroups redirect "string list" unset
21189 This specifies a list of permitted groups for the file specified by &%file%&.
21190 The list is in addition to the local user's primary group when
21191 &%check_local_user%& is set. See &%check_group%& above.
21192
21193
21194 .option pipe_transport redirect string&!! unset
21195 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
21196 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a pipe when a string
21197 starting with a vertical bar character is specified as a new &"address"&. The
21198 transport used is specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the
21199 name of a configured transport. This should normally be a &(pipe)& transport.
21200 When the transport is run, the pipe command is in &$address_pipe$&.
21201
21202
21203 .option qualify_domain redirect string&!! unset
21204 .vindex "&$qualify_recipient$&"
21205 If this option is set, and an unqualified address (one without a domain) is
21206 generated, and that address would normally be qualified by the global setting
21207 in &%qualify_recipient%&, it is instead qualified with the domain specified by
21208 expanding this string. If the expansion fails, the router declines. If you want
21209 to revert to the default, you can have the expansion generate
21210 &$qualify_recipient$&.
21211
21212 This option applies to all unqualified addresses generated by Exim filters,
21213 but for traditional &_.forward_& files, it applies only to addresses that are
21214 not preceded by a backslash. Sieve filters cannot generate unqualified
21215 addresses.
21216
21217 .option qualify_preserve_domain redirect boolean false
21218 .cindex "domain" "in redirection; preserving"
21219 .cindex "preserving domain in redirection"
21220 .cindex "address redirection" "domain; preserving"
21221 If this option is set, the router's local &%qualify_domain%& option must not be
21222 set (a configuration error occurs if it is). If an unqualified address (one
21223 without a domain) is generated, it is qualified with the domain of the parent
21224 address (the immediately preceding ancestor) instead of the global
21225 &%qualify_recipient%& value. In the case of a traditional &_.forward_& file,
21226 this applies whether or not the address is preceded by a backslash.
21227
21228
21229 .option repeat_use redirect boolean true
21230 If this option is set false, the router is skipped for a child address that has
21231 any ancestor that was routed by this router. This test happens before any of
21232 the other preconditions are tested. Exim's default anti-looping rules skip
21233 only when the ancestor is the same as the current address. See also
21234 &%check_ancestor%& above and the generic &%redirect_router%& option.
21235
21236
21237 .option reply_transport redirect string&!! unset
21238 A &(redirect)& router sets up an automatic reply when a &%mail%& or
21239 &%vacation%& command is used in a filter file. The transport used is specified
21240 by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a configured
21241 transport. This should normally be an &(autoreply)& transport. Other transports
21242 are unlikely to do anything sensible or useful.
21243
21244
21245 .option rewrite redirect boolean true
21246 .cindex "address redirection" "disabling rewriting"
21247 If this option is set false, addresses generated by the router are not
21248 subject to address rewriting. Otherwise, they are treated like new addresses
21249 and are rewritten according to the global rewriting rules.
21250
21251
21252 .option sieve_subaddress redirect string&!! unset
21253 The value of this option is passed to a Sieve filter to specify the
21254 :subaddress part of an address.
21255
21256 .option sieve_useraddress redirect string&!! unset
21257 The value of this option is passed to a Sieve filter to specify the :user part
21258 of an address. However, if it is unset, the entire original local part
21259 (including any prefix or suffix) is used for :user.
21260
21261
21262 .option sieve_vacation_directory redirect string&!! unset
21263 .cindex "Sieve filter" "vacation directory"
21264 To enable the &"vacation"& extension for Sieve filters, you must set
21265 &%sieve_vacation_directory%& to the directory where vacation databases are held
21266 (do not put anything else in that directory), and ensure that the
21267 &%reply_transport%& option refers to an &(autoreply)& transport. Each user
21268 needs their own directory; Exim will create it if necessary.
21269
21270
21271
21272 .option skip_syntax_errors redirect boolean false
21273 .cindex "forward file" "broken"
21274 .cindex "address redirection" "broken files"
21275 .cindex "alias file" "broken"
21276 .cindex "broken alias or forward files"
21277 .cindex "ignoring faulty addresses"
21278 .cindex "skipping faulty addresses"
21279 .cindex "error" "skipping bad syntax"
21280 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set, syntactically malformed addresses in
21281 non-filter redirection data are skipped, and each failing address is logged. If
21282 &%syntax_errors_to%& is set, a message is sent to the address it defines,
21283 giving details of the failures. If &%syntax_errors_text%& is set, its contents
21284 are expanded and placed at the head of the error message generated by
21285 &%syntax_errors_to%&. Usually it is appropriate to set &%syntax_errors_to%& to
21286 be the same address as the generic &%errors_to%& option. The
21287 &%skip_syntax_errors%& option is often used when handling mailing lists.
21288
21289 If all the addresses in a redirection list are skipped because of syntax
21290 errors, the router declines to handle the original address, and it is passed to
21291 the following routers.
21292
21293 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set when an Exim filter is interpreted, any syntax
21294 error in the filter causes filtering to be abandoned without any action being
21295 taken. The incident is logged, and the router declines to handle the address,
21296 so it is passed to the following routers.
21297
21298 .cindex "Sieve filter" "syntax errors in"
21299 Syntax errors in a Sieve filter file cause the &"keep"& action to occur. This
21300 action is specified by RFC 3028. The values of &%skip_syntax_errors%&,
21301 &%syntax_errors_to%&, and &%syntax_errors_text%& are not used.
21302
21303 &%skip_syntax_errors%& can be used to specify that errors in users' forward
21304 lists or filter files should not prevent delivery. The &%syntax_errors_to%&
21305 option, used with an address that does not get redirected, can be used to
21306 notify users of these errors, by means of a router like this:
21307 .code
21308 userforward:
21309 driver = redirect
21310 allow_filter
21311 check_local_user
21312 file = $home/.forward
21313 file_transport = address_file
21314 pipe_transport = address_pipe
21315 reply_transport = address_reply
21316 no_verify
21317 skip_syntax_errors
21318 syntax_errors_to = real-$local_part@$domain
21319 syntax_errors_text = \
21320 This is an automatically generated message. An error has\n\
21321 been found in your .forward file. Details of the error are\n\
21322 reported below. While this error persists, you will receive\n\
21323 a copy of this message for every message that is addressed\n\
21324 to you. If your .forward file is a filter file, or if it is\n\
21325 a non-filter file containing no valid forwarding addresses,\n\
21326 a copy of each incoming message will be put in your normal\n\
21327 mailbox. If a non-filter file contains at least one valid\n\
21328 forwarding address, forwarding to the valid addresses will\n\
21329 happen, and those will be the only deliveries that occur.
21330 .endd
21331 You also need a router to ensure that local addresses that are prefixed by
21332 &`real-`& are recognized, but not forwarded or filtered. For example, you could
21333 put this immediately before the &(userforward)& router:
21334 .code
21335 real_localuser:
21336 driver = accept
21337 check_local_user
21338 local_part_prefix = real-
21339 transport = local_delivery
21340 .endd
21341 For security, it would probably be a good idea to restrict the use of this
21342 router to locally-generated messages, using a condition such as this:
21343 .code
21344 condition = ${if match {$sender_host_address}\
21345 {\N^(|127\.0\.0\.1)$\N}}
21346 .endd
21347
21348
21349 .option syntax_errors_text redirect string&!! unset
21350 See &%skip_syntax_errors%& above.
21351
21352
21353 .option syntax_errors_to redirect string unset
21354 See &%skip_syntax_errors%& above.
21355 .ecindex IIDredrou1
21356 .ecindex IIDredrou2
21357
21358
21359
21360
21361
21362
21363 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21364 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21365
21366 .chapter "Environment for running local transports" "CHAPenvironment" &&&
21367 "Environment for local transports"
21368 .scindex IIDenvlotra1 "local transports" "environment for"
21369 .scindex IIDenvlotra2 "environment" "local transports"
21370 .scindex IIDenvlotra3 "transport" "local; environment for"
21371 Local transports handle deliveries to files and pipes. (The &(autoreply)&
21372 transport can be thought of as similar to a pipe.) Exim always runs transports
21373 in subprocesses, under specified uids and gids. Typical deliveries to local
21374 mailboxes run under the uid and gid of the local user.
21375
21376 Exim also sets a specific current directory while running the transport; for
21377 some transports a home directory setting is also relevant. The &(pipe)&
21378 transport is the only one that sets up environment variables; see section
21379 &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for details.
21380
21381 The values used for the uid, gid, and the directories may come from several
21382 different places. In many cases, the router that handles the address associates
21383 settings with that address as a result of its &%check_local_user%&, &%group%&,
21384 or &%user%& options. However, values may also be given in the transport's own
21385 configuration, and these override anything that comes from the router.
21386
21387
21388
21389 .section "Concurrent deliveries" "SECID131"
21390 .cindex "concurrent deliveries"
21391 .cindex "simultaneous deliveries"
21392 If two different messages for the same local recipient arrive more or less
21393 simultaneously, the two delivery processes are likely to run concurrently. When
21394 the &(appendfile)& transport is used to write to a file, Exim applies locking
21395 rules to stop concurrent processes from writing to the same file at the same
21396 time.
21397
21398 However, when you use a &(pipe)& transport, it is up to you to arrange any
21399 locking that is needed. Here is a silly example:
21400 .code
21401 my_transport:
21402 driver = pipe
21403 command = /bin/sh -c 'cat >>/some/file'
21404 .endd
21405 This is supposed to write the message at the end of the file. However, if two
21406 messages arrive at the same time, the file will be scrambled. You can use the
21407 &%exim_lock%& utility program (see section &<<SECTmailboxmaint>>&) to lock a
21408 file using the same algorithm that Exim itself uses.
21409
21410
21411
21412
21413 .section "Uids and gids" "SECTenvuidgid"
21414 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
21415 .cindex "transport" "local; uid and gid"
21416 All transports have the options &%group%& and &%user%&. If &%group%& is set, it
21417 overrides any group that the router set in the address, even if &%user%& is not
21418 set for the transport. This makes it possible, for example, to run local mail
21419 delivery under the uid of the recipient (set by the router), but in a special
21420 group (set by the transport). For example:
21421 .code
21422 # Routers ...
21423 # User/group are set by check_local_user in this router
21424 local_users:
21425 driver = accept
21426 check_local_user
21427 transport = group_delivery
21428
21429 # Transports ...
21430 # This transport overrides the group
21431 group_delivery:
21432 driver = appendfile
21433 file = /var/spool/mail/$local_part
21434 group = mail
21435 .endd
21436 If &%user%& is set for a transport, its value overrides what is set in the
21437 address by the router. If &%user%& is non-numeric and &%group%& is not set, the
21438 gid associated with the user is used. If &%user%& is numeric, &%group%& must be
21439 set.
21440
21441 .oindex "&%initgroups%&"
21442 When the uid is taken from the transport's configuration, the &[initgroups()]&
21443 function is called for the groups associated with that uid if the
21444 &%initgroups%& option is set for the transport. When the uid is not specified
21445 by the transport, but is associated with the address by a router, the option
21446 for calling &[initgroups()]& is taken from the router configuration.
21447
21448 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "uid for"
21449 The &(pipe)& transport contains the special option &%pipe_as_creator%&. If this
21450 is set and &%user%& is not set, the uid of the process that called Exim to
21451 receive the message is used, and if &%group%& is not set, the corresponding
21452 original gid is also used.
21453
21454 This is the detailed preference order for obtaining a gid; the first of the
21455 following that is set is used:
21456
21457 .ilist
21458 A &%group%& setting of the transport;
21459 .next
21460 A &%group%& setting of the router;
21461 .next
21462 A gid associated with a user setting of the router, either as a result of
21463 &%check_local_user%& or an explicit non-numeric &%user%& setting;
21464 .next
21465 The group associated with a non-numeric &%user%& setting of the transport;
21466 .next
21467 In a &(pipe)& transport, the creator's gid if &%deliver_as_creator%& is set and
21468 the uid is the creator's uid;
21469 .next
21470 The Exim gid if the Exim uid is being used as a default.
21471 .endlist
21472
21473 If, for example, the user is specified numerically on the router and there are
21474 no group settings, no gid is available. In this situation, an error occurs.
21475 This is different for the uid, for which there always is an ultimate default.
21476 The first of the following that is set is used:
21477
21478 .ilist
21479 A &%user%& setting of the transport;
21480 .next
21481 In a &(pipe)& transport, the creator's uid if &%deliver_as_creator%& is set;
21482 .next
21483 A &%user%& setting of the router;
21484 .next
21485 A &%check_local_user%& setting of the router;
21486 .next
21487 The Exim uid.
21488 .endlist
21489
21490 Of course, an error will still occur if the uid that is chosen is on the
21491 &%never_users%& list.
21492
21493
21494
21495
21496
21497 .section "Current and home directories" "SECID132"
21498 .cindex "current directory for local transport"
21499 .cindex "home directory" "for local transport"
21500 .cindex "transport" "local; home directory for"
21501 .cindex "transport" "local; current directory for"
21502 Routers may set current and home directories for local transports by means of
21503 the &%transport_current_directory%& and &%transport_home_directory%& options.
21504 However, if the transport's &%current_directory%& or &%home_directory%& options
21505 are set, they override the router's values. In detail, the home directory
21506 for a local transport is taken from the first of these values that is set:
21507
21508 .ilist
21509 The &%home_directory%& option on the transport;
21510 .next
21511 The &%transport_home_directory%& option on the router;
21512 .next
21513 The password data if &%check_local_user%& is set on the router;
21514 .next
21515 The &%router_home_directory%& option on the router.
21516 .endlist
21517
21518 The current directory is taken from the first of these values that is set:
21519
21520 .ilist
21521 The &%current_directory%& option on the transport;
21522 .next
21523 The &%transport_current_directory%& option on the router.
21524 .endlist
21525
21526
21527 If neither the router nor the transport sets a current directory, Exim uses the
21528 value of the home directory, if it is set. Otherwise it sets the current
21529 directory to &_/_& before running a local transport.
21530
21531
21532
21533 .section "Expansion variables derived from the address" "SECID133"
21534 .vindex "&$domain$&"
21535 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
21536 .vindex "&$original_domain$&"
21537 Normally a local delivery is handling a single address, and in that case the
21538 variables such as &$domain$& and &$local_part$& are set during local
21539 deliveries. However, in some circumstances more than one address may be handled
21540 at once (for example, while writing batch SMTP for onward transmission by some
21541 other means). In this case, the variables associated with the local part are
21542 never set, &$domain$& is set only if all the addresses have the same domain,
21543 and &$original_domain$& is never set.
21544 .ecindex IIDenvlotra1
21545 .ecindex IIDenvlotra2
21546 .ecindex IIDenvlotra3
21547
21548
21549
21550
21551
21552
21553
21554 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21555 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21556
21557 .chapter "Generic options for transports" "CHAPtransportgeneric"
21558 .scindex IIDgenoptra1 "generic options" "transport"
21559 .scindex IIDgenoptra2 "options" "generic; for transports"
21560 .scindex IIDgenoptra3 "transport" "generic options for"
21561 The following generic options apply to all transports:
21562
21563
21564 .option body_only transports boolean false
21565 .cindex "transport" "body only"
21566 .cindex "message" "transporting body only"
21567 .cindex "body of message" "transporting"
21568 If this option is set, the message's headers are not transported. It is
21569 mutually exclusive with &%headers_only%&. If it is used with the &(appendfile)&
21570 or &(pipe)& transports, the settings of &%message_prefix%& and
21571 &%message_suffix%& should be checked, because this option does not
21572 automatically suppress them.
21573
21574
21575 .option current_directory transports string&!! unset
21576 .cindex "transport" "current directory for"
21577 This specifies the current directory that is to be set while running the
21578 transport, overriding any value that may have been set by the router.
21579 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
21580 logged, and delivery is deferred.
21581
21582
21583 .option disable_logging transports boolean false
21584 If this option is set true, nothing is logged for any
21585 deliveries by the transport or for any
21586 transport errors. You should not set this option unless you really, really know
21587 what you are doing.
21588
21589
21590 .option debug_print transports string&!! unset
21591 .cindex "testing" "variables in drivers"
21592 If this option is set and debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%& command line
21593 option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging output when the
21594 transport is run.
21595 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
21596 output, and Exim carries on processing.
21597 This facility is provided to help with checking out the values of variables and
21598 so on when debugging driver configurations. For example, if a &%headers_add%&
21599 option is not working properly, &%debug_print%& could be used to output the
21600 variables it references. A newline is added to the text if it does not end with
21601 one.
21602 The variables &$transport_name$& and &$router_name$& contain the name of the
21603 transport and the router that called it.
21604
21605 .option delivery_date_add transports boolean false
21606 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
21607 If this option is true, a &'Delivery-date:'& header is added to the message.
21608 This gives the actual time the delivery was made. As this is not a standard
21609 header, Exim has a configuration option (&%delivery_date_remove%&) which
21610 requests its removal from incoming messages, so that delivered messages can
21611 safely be resent to other recipients.
21612
21613
21614 .option driver transports string unset
21615 This specifies which of the available transport drivers is to be used.
21616 There is no default, and this option must be set for every transport.
21617
21618
21619 .option envelope_to_add transports boolean false
21620 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
21621 If this option is true, an &'Envelope-to:'& header is added to the message.
21622 This gives the original address(es) in the incoming envelope that caused this
21623 delivery to happen. More than one address may be present if the transport is
21624 configured to handle several addresses at once, or if more than one original
21625 address was redirected to the same final address. As this is not a standard
21626 header, Exim has a configuration option (&%envelope_to_remove%&) which requests
21627 its removal from incoming messages, so that delivered messages can safely be
21628 resent to other recipients.
21629
21630
21631 .option event_action transports string&!! unset
21632 .cindex events
21633 This option declares a string to be expanded for Exim's events mechanism.
21634 For details see chapter &<<CHAPevents>>&.
21635
21636
21637 .option group transports string&!! "Exim group"
21638 .cindex "transport" "group; specifying"
21639 This option specifies a gid for running the transport process, overriding any
21640 value that the router supplies, and also overriding any value associated with
21641 &%user%& (see below).
21642
21643
21644 .option headers_add transports list&!! unset
21645 .cindex "header lines" "adding in transport"
21646 .cindex "transport" "header lines; adding"
21647 This option specifies a list of text headers,
21648 newline-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&),
21649 which are (separately) expanded and added to the header
21650 portion of a message as it is transported, as described in section
21651 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Additional header lines can also be specified by
21652 routers. If the result of the expansion is an empty string, or if the expansion
21653 is forced to fail, no action is taken. Other expansion failures are treated as
21654 errors and cause the delivery to be deferred.
21655
21656 Unlike most options, &%headers_add%& can be specified multiple times
21657 for a transport; all listed headers are added.
21658
21659
21660 .option headers_only transports boolean false
21661 .cindex "transport" "header lines only"
21662 .cindex "message" "transporting headers only"
21663 .cindex "header lines" "transporting"
21664 If this option is set, the message's body is not transported. It is mutually
21665 exclusive with &%body_only%&. If it is used with the &(appendfile)& or &(pipe)&
21666 transports, the settings of &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& should be
21667 checked, since this option does not automatically suppress them.
21668
21669
21670 .option headers_remove transports list&!! unset
21671 .cindex "header lines" "removing"
21672 .cindex "transport" "header lines; removing"
21673 This option specifies a list of header names,
21674 colon-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&);
21675 these headers are omitted from the message as it is transported, as described
21676 in section &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Header removal can also be specified by
21677 routers.
21678 Each list item is separately expanded.
21679 If the result of the expansion is an empty string, or if the expansion
21680 is forced to fail, no action is taken. Other expansion failures are treated as
21681 errors and cause the delivery to be deferred.
21682
21683 Unlike most options, &%headers_remove%& can be specified multiple times
21684 for a transport; all listed headers are removed.
21685
21686 &*Warning*&: Because of the separate expansion of the list items,
21687 items that contain a list separator must have it doubled.
21688 To avoid this, change the list separator (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
21689
21690
21691
21692 .option headers_rewrite transports string unset
21693 .cindex "transport" "header lines; rewriting"
21694 .cindex "rewriting" "at transport time"
21695 This option allows addresses in header lines to be rewritten at transport time,
21696 that is, as the message is being copied to its destination. The contents of the
21697 option are a colon-separated list of rewriting rules. Each rule is in exactly
21698 the same form as one of the general rewriting rules that are applied when a
21699 message is received. These are described in chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&. For
21700 example,
21701 .code
21702 headers_rewrite = a@b c@d f : \
21703 x@y w@z
21704 .endd
21705 changes &'a@b'& into &'c@d'& in &'From:'& header lines, and &'x@y'& into
21706 &'w@z'& in all address-bearing header lines. The rules are applied to the
21707 header lines just before they are written out at transport time, so they affect
21708 only those copies of the message that pass through the transport. However, only
21709 the message's original header lines, and any that were added by a system
21710 filter, are rewritten. If a router or transport adds header lines, they are not
21711 affected by this option. These rewriting rules are &'not'& applied to the
21712 envelope. You can change the return path using &%return_path%&, but you cannot
21713 change envelope recipients at this time.
21714
21715
21716 .option home_directory transports string&!! unset
21717 .cindex "transport" "home directory for"
21718 .vindex "&$home$&"
21719 This option specifies a home directory setting for a local transport,
21720 overriding any value that may be set by the router. The home directory is
21721 placed in &$home$& while expanding the transport's private options. It is also
21722 used as the current directory if no current directory is set by the
21723 &%current_directory%& option on the transport or the
21724 &%transport_current_directory%& option on the router. If the expansion fails
21725 for any reason, including forced failure, an error is logged, and delivery is
21726 deferred.
21727
21728
21729 .option initgroups transports boolean false
21730 .cindex "additional groups"
21731 .cindex "groups" "additional"
21732 .cindex "transport" "group; additional"
21733 If this option is true and the uid for the delivery process is provided by the
21734 transport, the &[initgroups()]& function is called when running the transport
21735 to ensure that any additional groups associated with the uid are set up.
21736
21737
21738 .option max_parallel transports integer&!! unset
21739 .cindex limit "transport parallelism"
21740 .cindex transport "parallel processes"
21741 .cindex transport "concurrency limit"
21742 .cindex "delivery" "parallelism for transport"
21743 If this option is set and expands to an integer greater than zero
21744 it limits the number of concurrent runs of the transport.
21745 The control does not apply to shadow transports.
21746
21747 .cindex "hints database" "transport concurrency control"
21748 Exim implements this control by means of a hints database in which a record is
21749 incremented whenever a transport process is being created. The record
21750 is decremented and possibly removed when the process terminates.
21751 Obviously there is scope for
21752 records to get left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To
21753 guard against this, Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
21754
21755 If you use this option, you should also arrange to delete the
21756 relevant hints database whenever your system reboots. The names of the files
21757 start with &_misc_& and they are kept in the &_spool/db_& directory. There
21758 may be one or two files, depending on the type of DBM in use. The same files
21759 are used for ETRN and smtp transport serialization.
21760
21761
21762 .option message_size_limit transports string&!! 0
21763 .cindex "limit" "message size per transport"
21764 .cindex "size" "of message, limit"
21765 .cindex "transport" "message size; limiting"
21766 This option controls the size of messages passed through the transport. It is
21767 expanded before use; the result of the expansion must be a sequence of decimal
21768 digits, optionally followed by K or M. If the expansion fails for any reason,
21769 including forced failure, or if the result is not of the required form,
21770 delivery is deferred. If the value is greater than zero and the size of a
21771 message exceeds this limit, the address is failed. If there is any chance that
21772 the resulting bounce message could be routed to the same transport, you should
21773 ensure that &%return_size_limit%& is less than the transport's
21774 &%message_size_limit%&, as otherwise the bounce message will fail to get
21775 delivered.
21776
21777
21778
21779 .option rcpt_include_affixes transports boolean false
21780 .cindex "prefix" "for local part, including in envelope"
21781 .cindex "suffix for local part" "including in envelope"
21782 .cindex "local part" "prefix"
21783 .cindex "local part" "suffix"
21784 When this option is false (the default), and an address that has had any
21785 affixes (prefixes or suffixes) removed from the local part is delivered by any
21786 form of SMTP or LMTP, the affixes are not included. For example, if a router
21787 that contains
21788 .code
21789 local_part_prefix = *-
21790 .endd
21791 routes the address &'abc-xyz@some.domain'& to an SMTP transport, the envelope
21792 is delivered with
21793 .code
21794 RCPT TO:<xyz@some.domain>
21795 .endd
21796 This is also the case when an ACL-time callout is being used to verify a
21797 recipient address. However, if &%rcpt_include_affixes%& is set true, the
21798 whole local part is included in the RCPT command. This option applies to BSMTP
21799 deliveries by the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports as well as to the
21800 &(lmtp)& and &(smtp)& transports.
21801
21802
21803 .option retry_use_local_part transports boolean "see below"
21804 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
21805 When a delivery suffers a temporary failure, a retry record is created
21806 in Exim's hints database. For remote deliveries, the key for the retry record
21807 is based on the name and/or IP address of the failing remote host. For local
21808 deliveries, the key is normally the entire address, including both the local
21809 part and the domain. This is suitable for most common cases of local delivery
21810 temporary failure &-- for example, exceeding a mailbox quota should delay only
21811 deliveries to that mailbox, not to the whole domain.
21812
21813 However, in some special cases you may want to treat a temporary local delivery
21814 as a failure associated with the domain, and not with a particular local part.
21815 (For example, if you are storing all mail for some domain in files.) You can do
21816 this by setting &%retry_use_local_part%& false.
21817
21818 For all the local transports, its default value is true. For remote transports,
21819 the default value is false for tidiness, but changing the value has no effect
21820 on a remote transport in the current implementation.
21821
21822
21823 .option return_path transports string&!! unset
21824 .cindex "envelope sender"
21825 .cindex "envelope from"
21826 .cindex "transport" "return path; changing"
21827 .cindex "return path" "changing in transport"
21828 If this option is set, the string is expanded at transport time and replaces
21829 the existing return path (envelope sender) value in the copy of the message
21830 that is being delivered. An empty return path is permitted. This feature is
21831 designed for remote deliveries, where the value of this option is used in the
21832 SMTP MAIL command. If you set &%return_path%& for a local transport, the
21833 only effect is to change the address that is placed in the &'Return-path:'&
21834 header line, if one is added to the message (see the next option).
21835
21836 &*Note:*& A changed return path is not logged unless you add
21837 &%return_path_on_delivery%& to the log selector.
21838
21839 .vindex "&$return_path$&"
21840 The expansion can refer to the existing value via &$return_path$&. This is
21841 either the message's envelope sender, or an address set by the
21842 &%errors_to%& option on a router. If the expansion is forced to fail, no
21843 replacement occurs; if it fails for another reason, delivery is deferred. This
21844 option can be used to support VERP (Variable Envelope Return Paths) &-- see
21845 section &<<SECTverp>>&.
21846
21847 &*Note*&: If a delivery error is detected locally, including the case when a
21848 remote server rejects a message at SMTP time, the bounce message is not sent to
21849 the value of this option. It is sent to the previously set errors address.
21850 This defaults to the incoming sender address, but can be changed by setting
21851 &%errors_to%& in a router.
21852
21853
21854
21855 .option return_path_add transports boolean false
21856 .cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line"
21857 If this option is true, a &'Return-path:'& header is added to the message.
21858 Although the return path is normally available in the prefix line of BSD
21859 mailboxes, this is commonly not displayed by MUAs, and so the user does not
21860 have easy access to it.
21861
21862 RFC 2821 states that the &'Return-path:'& header is added to a message &"when
21863 the delivery SMTP server makes the final delivery"&. This implies that this
21864 header should not be present in incoming messages. Exim has a configuration
21865 option, &%return_path_remove%&, which requests removal of this header from
21866 incoming messages, so that delivered messages can safely be resent to other
21867 recipients.
21868
21869
21870 .option shadow_condition transports string&!! unset
21871 See &%shadow_transport%& below.
21872
21873
21874 .option shadow_transport transports string unset
21875 .cindex "shadow transport"
21876 .cindex "transport" "shadow"
21877 A local transport may set the &%shadow_transport%& option to the name of
21878 another local transport. Shadow remote transports are not supported.
21879
21880 Whenever a delivery to the main transport succeeds, and either
21881 &%shadow_condition%& is unset, or its expansion does not result in the empty
21882 string or one of the strings &"0"& or &"no"& or &"false"&, the message is also
21883 passed to the shadow transport, with the same delivery address or addresses. If
21884 expansion fails, no action is taken except that non-forced expansion failures
21885 cause a log line to be written.
21886
21887 The result of the shadow transport is discarded and does not affect the
21888 subsequent processing of the message. Only a single level of shadowing is
21889 provided; the &%shadow_transport%& option is ignored on any transport when it
21890 is running as a shadow. Options concerned with output from pipes are also
21891 ignored. The log line for the successful delivery has an item added on the end,
21892 of the form
21893 .code
21894 ST=<shadow transport name>
21895 .endd
21896 If the shadow transport did not succeed, the error message is put in
21897 parentheses afterwards. Shadow transports can be used for a number of different
21898 purposes, including keeping more detailed log information than Exim normally
21899 provides, and implementing automatic acknowledgment policies based on message
21900 headers that some sites insist on.
21901
21902
21903 .option transport_filter transports string&!! unset
21904 .cindex "transport" "filter"
21905 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
21906 This option sets up a filtering (in the Unix shell sense) process for messages
21907 at transport time. It should not be confused with mail filtering as set up by
21908 individual users or via a system filter.
21909 If unset, or expanding to an empty string, no filtering is done.
21910
21911 When the message is about to be written out, the command specified by
21912 &%transport_filter%& is started up in a separate, parallel process, and
21913 the entire message, including the header lines, is passed to it on its standard
21914 input (this in fact is done from a third process, to avoid deadlock). The
21915 command must be specified as an absolute path.
21916
21917 The lines of the message that are written to the transport filter are
21918 terminated by newline (&"\n"&). The message is passed to the filter before any
21919 SMTP-specific processing, such as turning &"\n"& into &"\r\n"& and escaping
21920 lines beginning with a dot, and also before any processing implied by the
21921 settings of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& in the &(appendfile)& or
21922 &(pipe)& transports.
21923
21924 The standard error for the filter process is set to the same destination as its
21925 standard output; this is read and written to the message's ultimate
21926 destination. The process that writes the message to the filter, the
21927 filter itself, and the original process that reads the result and delivers it
21928 are all run in parallel, like a shell pipeline.
21929
21930 The filter can perform any transformations it likes, but of course should take
21931 care not to break RFC 2822 syntax. Exim does not check the result, except to
21932 test for a final newline when SMTP is in use. All messages transmitted over
21933 SMTP must end with a newline, so Exim supplies one if it is missing.
21934
21935 .cindex "content scanning" "per user"
21936 A transport filter can be used to provide content-scanning on a per-user basis
21937 at delivery time if the only required effect of the scan is to modify the
21938 message. For example, a content scan could insert a new header line containing
21939 a spam score. This could be interpreted by a filter in the user's MUA. It is
21940 not possible to discard a message at this stage.
21941
21942 .cindex "SMTP" "SIZE"
21943 A problem might arise if the filter increases the size of a message that is
21944 being sent down an SMTP connection. If the receiving SMTP server has indicated
21945 support for the SIZE parameter, Exim will have sent the size of the message
21946 at the start of the SMTP session. If what is actually sent is substantially
21947 more, the server might reject the message. This can be worked round by setting
21948 the &%size_addition%& option on the &(smtp)& transport, either to allow for
21949 additions to the message, or to disable the use of SIZE altogether.
21950
21951 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
21952 The value of the &%transport_filter%& option is the command string for starting
21953 the filter, which is run directly from Exim, not under a shell. The string is
21954 parsed by Exim in the same way as a command string for the &(pipe)& transport:
21955 Exim breaks it up into arguments and then expands each argument separately (see
21956 section &<<SECThowcommandrun>>&). Any kind of expansion failure causes delivery
21957 to be deferred. The special argument &$pipe_addresses$& is replaced by a number
21958 of arguments, one for each address that applies to this delivery. (This isn't
21959 an ideal name for this feature here, but as it was already implemented for the
21960 &(pipe)& transport, it seemed sensible not to change it.)
21961
21962 .vindex "&$host$&"
21963 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
21964 The expansion variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are available when the
21965 transport is a remote one. They contain the name and IP address of the host to
21966 which the message is being sent. For example:
21967 .code
21968 transport_filter = /some/directory/transport-filter.pl \
21969 $host $host_address $sender_address $pipe_addresses
21970 .endd
21971
21972 Two problems arise if you want to use more complicated expansion items to
21973 generate transport filter commands, both of which due to the fact that the
21974 command is split up &'before'& expansion.
21975 .ilist
21976 If an expansion item contains white space, you must quote it, so that it is all
21977 part of the same command item. If the entire option setting is one such
21978 expansion item, you have to take care what kind of quoting you use. For
21979 example:
21980 .code
21981 transport_filter = '/bin/cmd${if eq{$host}{a.b.c}{1}{2}}'
21982 .endd
21983 This runs the command &(/bin/cmd1)& if the host name is &'a.b.c'&, and
21984 &(/bin/cmd2)& otherwise. If double quotes had been used, they would have been
21985 stripped by Exim when it read the option's value. When the value is used, if
21986 the single quotes were missing, the line would be split into two items,
21987 &`/bin/cmd${if`& and &`eq{$host}{a.b.c}{1}{2}`&, and an error would occur when
21988 Exim tried to expand the first one.
21989 .next
21990 Except for the special case of &$pipe_addresses$& that is mentioned above, an
21991 expansion cannot generate multiple arguments, or a command name followed by
21992 arguments. Consider this example:
21993 .code
21994 transport_filter = ${lookup{$host}lsearch{/a/file}\
21995 {$value}{/bin/cat}}
21996 .endd
21997 The result of the lookup is interpreted as the name of the command, even
21998 if it contains white space. The simplest way round this is to use a shell:
21999 .code
22000 transport_filter = /bin/sh -c ${lookup{$host}lsearch{/a/file}\
22001 {$value}{/bin/cat}}
22002 .endd
22003 .endlist
22004
22005 The filter process is run under the same uid and gid as the normal delivery.
22006 For remote deliveries this is the Exim uid/gid by default. The command should
22007 normally yield a zero return code. Transport filters are not supposed to fail.
22008 A non-zero code is taken to mean that the transport filter encountered some
22009 serious problem. Delivery of the message is deferred; the message remains on
22010 the queue and is tried again later. It is not possible to cause a message to be
22011 bounced from a transport filter.
22012
22013 If a transport filter is set on an autoreply transport, the original message is
22014 passed through the filter as it is being copied into the newly generated
22015 message, which happens if the &%return_message%& option is set.
22016
22017
22018 .option transport_filter_timeout transports time 5m
22019 .cindex "transport" "filter, timeout"
22020 When Exim is reading the output of a transport filter, it applies a timeout
22021 that can be set by this option. Exceeding the timeout is normally treated as a
22022 temporary delivery failure. However, if a transport filter is used with a
22023 &(pipe)& transport, a timeout in the transport filter is treated in the same
22024 way as a timeout in the pipe command itself. By default, a timeout is a hard
22025 error, but if the &(pipe)& transport's &%timeout_defer%& option is set true, it
22026 becomes a temporary error.
22027
22028
22029 .option user transports string&!! "Exim user"
22030 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
22031 .cindex "transport" "user, specifying"
22032 This option specifies the user under whose uid the delivery process is to be
22033 run, overriding any uid that may have been set by the router. If the user is
22034 given as a name, the uid is looked up from the password data, and the
22035 associated group is taken as the value of the gid to be used if the &%group%&
22036 option is not set.
22037
22038 For deliveries that use local transports, a user and group are normally
22039 specified explicitly or implicitly (for example, as a result of
22040 &%check_local_user%&) by the router or transport.
22041
22042 .cindex "hints database" "access by remote transport"
22043 For remote transports, you should leave this option unset unless you really are
22044 sure you know what you are doing. When a remote transport is running, it needs
22045 to be able to access Exim's hints databases, because each host may have its own
22046 retry data.
22047 .ecindex IIDgenoptra1
22048 .ecindex IIDgenoptra2
22049 .ecindex IIDgenoptra3
22050
22051
22052
22053
22054
22055
22056 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22057 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22058
22059 .chapter "Address batching in local transports" "CHAPbatching" &&&
22060 "Address batching"
22061 .cindex "transport" "local; address batching in"
22062 The only remote transport (&(smtp)&) is normally configured to handle more than
22063 one address at a time, so that when several addresses are routed to the same
22064 remote host, just one copy of the message is sent. Local transports, however,
22065 normally handle one address at a time. That is, a separate instance of the
22066 transport is run for each address that is routed to the transport. A separate
22067 copy of the message is delivered each time.
22068
22069 .cindex "batched local delivery"
22070 .oindex "&%batch_max%&"
22071 .oindex "&%batch_id%&"
22072 In special cases, it may be desirable to handle several addresses at once in a
22073 local transport, for example:
22074
22075 .ilist
22076 In an &(appendfile)& transport, when storing messages in files for later
22077 delivery by some other means, a single copy of the message with multiple
22078 recipients saves space.
22079 .next
22080 In an &(lmtp)& transport, when delivering over &"local SMTP"& to some process,
22081 a single copy saves time, and is the normal way LMTP is expected to work.
22082 .next
22083 In a &(pipe)& transport, when passing the message
22084 to a scanner program or
22085 to some other delivery mechanism such as UUCP, multiple recipients may be
22086 acceptable.
22087 .endlist
22088
22089 These three local transports all have the same options for controlling multiple
22090 (&"batched"&) deliveries, namely &%batch_max%& and &%batch_id%&. To save
22091 repeating the information for each transport, these options are described here.
22092
22093 The &%batch_max%& option specifies the maximum number of addresses that can be
22094 delivered together in a single run of the transport. Its default value is one
22095 (no batching). When more than one address is routed to a transport that has a
22096 &%batch_max%& value greater than one, the addresses are delivered in a batch
22097 (that is, in a single run of the transport with multiple recipients), subject
22098 to certain conditions:
22099
22100 .ilist
22101 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
22102 If any of the transport's options contain a reference to &$local_part$&, no
22103 batching is possible.
22104 .next
22105 .vindex "&$domain$&"
22106 If any of the transport's options contain a reference to &$domain$&, only
22107 addresses with the same domain are batched.
22108 .next
22109 .cindex "customizing" "batching condition"
22110 If &%batch_id%& is set, it is expanded for each address, and only those
22111 addresses with the same expanded value are batched. This allows you to specify
22112 customized batching conditions. Failure of the expansion for any reason,
22113 including forced failure, disables batching, but it does not stop the delivery
22114 from taking place.
22115 .next
22116 Batched addresses must also have the same errors address (where to send
22117 delivery errors), the same header additions and removals, the same user and
22118 group for the transport, and if a host list is present, the first host must
22119 be the same.
22120 .endlist
22121
22122 In the case of the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports, batching applies
22123 both when the file or pipe command is specified in the transport, and when it
22124 is specified by a &(redirect)& router, but all the batched addresses must of
22125 course be routed to the same file or pipe command. These two transports have an
22126 option called &%use_bsmtp%&, which causes them to deliver the message in
22127 &"batched SMTP"& format, with the envelope represented as SMTP commands. The
22128 &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& options are forced to the values
22129 .code
22130 check_string = "."
22131 escape_string = ".."
22132 .endd
22133 when batched SMTP is in use. A full description of the batch SMTP mechanism is
22134 given in section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&. The &(lmtp)& transport does not have a
22135 &%use_bsmtp%& option, because it always delivers using the SMTP protocol.
22136
22137 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
22138 If the generic &%envelope_to_add%& option is set for a batching transport, the
22139 &'Envelope-to:'& header that is added to the message contains all the addresses
22140 that are being processed together. If you are using a batching &(appendfile)&
22141 transport without &%use_bsmtp%&, the only way to preserve the recipient
22142 addresses is to set the &%envelope_to_add%& option.
22143
22144 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "with multiple addresses"
22145 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
22146 If you are using a &(pipe)& transport without BSMTP, and setting the
22147 transport's &%command%& option, you can include &$pipe_addresses$& as part of
22148 the command. This is not a true variable; it is a bit of magic that causes each
22149 of the recipient addresses to be inserted into the command as a separate
22150 argument. This provides a way of accessing all the addresses that are being
22151 delivered in the batch. &*Note:*& This is not possible for pipe commands that
22152 are specified by a &(redirect)& router.
22153
22154
22155
22156
22157 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22158 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22159
22160 .chapter "The appendfile transport" "CHAPappendfile"
22161 .scindex IIDapptra1 "&(appendfile)& transport"
22162 .scindex IIDapptra2 "transports" "&(appendfile)&"
22163 .cindex "directory creation"
22164 .cindex "creating directories"
22165 The &(appendfile)& transport delivers a message by appending it to an existing
22166 file, or by creating an entirely new file in a specified directory. Single
22167 files to which messages are appended can be in the traditional Unix mailbox
22168 format, or optionally in the MBX format supported by the Pine MUA and
22169 University of Washington IMAP daemon, &'inter alia'&. When each message is
22170 being delivered as a separate file, &"maildir"& format can optionally be used
22171 to give added protection against failures that happen part-way through the
22172 delivery. A third form of separate-file delivery known as &"mailstore"& is also
22173 supported. For all file formats, Exim attempts to create as many levels of
22174 directory as necessary, provided that &%create_directory%& is set.
22175
22176 The code for the optional formats is not included in the Exim binary by
22177 default. It is necessary to set SUPPORT_MBX, SUPPORT_MAILDIR and/or
22178 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE in &_Local/Makefile_& to have the appropriate code
22179 included.
22180
22181 .cindex "quota" "system"
22182 Exim recognizes system quota errors, and generates an appropriate message. Exim
22183 also supports its own quota control within the transport, for use when the
22184 system facility is unavailable or cannot be used for some reason.
22185
22186 If there is an error while appending to a file (for example, quota exceeded or
22187 partition filled), Exim attempts to reset the file's length and last
22188 modification time back to what they were before. If there is an error while
22189 creating an entirely new file, the new file is removed.
22190
22191 Before appending to a file, a number of security checks are made, and the
22192 file is locked. A detailed description is given below, after the list of
22193 private options.
22194
22195 The &(appendfile)& transport is most commonly used for local deliveries to
22196 users' mailboxes. However, it can also be used as a pseudo-remote transport for
22197 putting messages into files for remote delivery by some means other than Exim.
22198 &"Batch SMTP"& format is often used in this case (see the &%use_bsmtp%&
22199 option).
22200
22201
22202
22203 .section "The file and directory options" "SECTfildiropt"
22204 The &%file%& option specifies a single file, to which the message is appended;
22205 the &%directory%& option specifies a directory, in which a new file containing
22206 the message is created. Only one of these two options can be set, and for
22207 normal deliveries to mailboxes, one of them &'must'& be set.
22208
22209 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
22210 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
22211 However, &(appendfile)& is also used for delivering messages to files or
22212 directories whose names (or parts of names) are obtained from alias,
22213 forwarding, or filtering operations (for example, a &%save%& command in a
22214 user's Exim filter). When such a transport is running, &$local_part$& contains
22215 the local part that was aliased or forwarded, and &$address_file$& contains the
22216 name (or partial name) of the file or directory generated by the redirection
22217 operation. There are two cases:
22218
22219 .ilist
22220 If neither &%file%& nor &%directory%& is set, the redirection operation
22221 must specify an absolute path (one that begins with &`/`&). This is the most
22222 common case when users with local accounts use filtering to sort mail into
22223 different folders. See for example, the &(address_file)& transport in the
22224 default configuration. If the path ends with a slash, it is assumed to be the
22225 name of a directory. A delivery to a directory can also be forced by setting
22226 &%maildir_format%& or &%mailstore_format%&.
22227 .next
22228 If &%file%& or &%directory%& is set for a delivery from a redirection, it is
22229 used to determine the file or directory name for the delivery. Normally, the
22230 contents of &$address_file$& are used in some way in the string expansion.
22231 .endlist
22232
22233
22234 .cindex "Sieve filter" "configuring &(appendfile)&"
22235 .cindex "Sieve filter" "relative mailbox path handling"
22236 As an example of the second case, consider an environment where users do not
22237 have home directories. They may be permitted to use Exim filter commands of the
22238 form:
22239 .code
22240 save folder23
22241 .endd
22242 or Sieve filter commands of the form:
22243 .code
22244 require "fileinto";
22245 fileinto "folder23";
22246 .endd
22247 In this situation, the expansion of &%file%& or &%directory%& in the transport
22248 must transform the relative path into an appropriate absolute filename. In the
22249 case of Sieve filters, the name &'inbox'& must be handled. It is the name that
22250 is used as a result of a &"keep"& action in the filter. This example shows one
22251 way of handling this requirement:
22252 .code
22253 file = ${if eq{$address_file}{inbox} \
22254 {/var/mail/$local_part} \
22255 {${if eq{${substr_0_1:$address_file}}{/} \
22256 {$address_file} \
22257 {$home/mail/$address_file} \
22258 }} \
22259 }
22260 .endd
22261 With this setting of &%file%&, &'inbox'& refers to the standard mailbox
22262 location, absolute paths are used without change, and other folders are in the
22263 &_mail_& directory within the home directory.
22264
22265 &*Note 1*&: While processing an Exim filter, a relative path such as
22266 &_folder23_& is turned into an absolute path if a home directory is known to
22267 the router. In particular, this is the case if &%check_local_user%& is set. If
22268 you want to prevent this happening at routing time, you can set
22269 &%router_home_directory%& empty. This forces the router to pass the relative
22270 path to the transport.
22271
22272 &*Note 2*&: An absolute path in &$address_file$& is not treated specially;
22273 the &%file%& or &%directory%& option is still used if it is set.
22274
22275
22276
22277
22278 .section "Private options for appendfile" "SECID134"
22279 .cindex "options" "&(appendfile)& transport"
22280
22281
22282
22283 .option allow_fifo appendfile boolean false
22284 .cindex "fifo (named pipe)"
22285 .cindex "named pipe (fifo)"
22286 .cindex "pipe" "named (fifo)"
22287 Setting this option permits delivery to named pipes (FIFOs) as well as to
22288 regular files. If no process is reading the named pipe at delivery time, the
22289 delivery is deferred.
22290
22291
22292 .option allow_symlink appendfile boolean false
22293 .cindex "symbolic link" "to mailbox"
22294 .cindex "mailbox" "symbolic link"
22295 By default, &(appendfile)& will not deliver if the path name for the file is
22296 that of a symbolic link. Setting this option relaxes that constraint, but there
22297 are security issues involved in the use of symbolic links. Be sure you know
22298 what you are doing if you set this. Details of exactly what this option affects
22299 are included in the discussion which follows this list of options.
22300
22301
22302 .option batch_id appendfile string&!! unset
22303 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
22304 However, batching is automatically disabled for &(appendfile)& deliveries that
22305 happen as a result of forwarding or aliasing or other redirection directly to a
22306 file.
22307
22308
22309 .option batch_max appendfile integer 1
22310 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
22311
22312
22313 .option check_group appendfile boolean false
22314 When this option is set, the group owner of the file defined by the &%file%&
22315 option is checked to see that it is the same as the group under which the
22316 delivery process is running. The default setting is false because the default
22317 file mode is 0600, which means that the group is irrelevant.
22318
22319
22320 .option check_owner appendfile boolean true
22321 When this option is set, the owner of the file defined by the &%file%& option
22322 is checked to ensure that it is the same as the user under which the delivery
22323 process is running.
22324
22325
22326 .option check_string appendfile string "see below"
22327 .cindex "&""From""& line"
22328 As &(appendfile)& writes the message, the start of each line is tested for
22329 matching &%check_string%&, and if it does, the initial matching characters are
22330 replaced by the contents of &%escape_string%&. The value of &%check_string%& is
22331 a literal string, not a regular expression, and the case of any letters it
22332 contains is significant.
22333
22334 If &%use_bsmtp%& is set the values of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%&
22335 are forced to &"."& and &".."& respectively, and any settings in the
22336 configuration are ignored. Otherwise, they default to &"From&~"& and
22337 &">From&~"& when the &%file%& option is set, and unset when any of the
22338 &%directory%&, &%maildir%&, or &%mailstore%& options are set.
22339
22340 The default settings, along with &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%&, are
22341 suitable for traditional &"BSD"& mailboxes, where a line beginning with
22342 &"From&~"& indicates the start of a new message. All four options need changing
22343 if another format is used. For example, to deliver to mailboxes in MMDF format:
22344 .cindex "MMDF format mailbox"
22345 .cindex "mailbox" "MMDF format"
22346 .code
22347 check_string = "\1\1\1\1\n"
22348 escape_string = "\1\1\1\1 \n"
22349 message_prefix = "\1\1\1\1\n"
22350 message_suffix = "\1\1\1\1\n"
22351 .endd
22352 .option create_directory appendfile boolean true
22353 .cindex "directory creation"
22354 When this option is true, Exim attempts to create any missing superior
22355 directories for the file that it is about to write. A created directory's mode
22356 is given by the &%directory_mode%& option.
22357
22358 The group ownership of a newly created directory is highly dependent on the
22359 operating system (and possibly the file system) that is being used. For
22360 example, in Solaris, if the parent directory has the setgid bit set, its group
22361 is propagated to the child; if not, the currently set group is used. However,
22362 in FreeBSD, the parent's group is always used.
22363
22364
22365
22366 .option create_file appendfile string anywhere
22367 This option constrains the location of files and directories that are created
22368 by this transport. It applies to files defined by the &%file%& option and
22369 directories defined by the &%directory%& option. In the case of maildir
22370 delivery, it applies to the top level directory, not the maildir directories
22371 beneath.
22372
22373 The option must be set to one of the words &"anywhere"&, &"inhome"&, or
22374 &"belowhome"&. In the second and third cases, a home directory must have been
22375 set for the transport. This option is not useful when an explicit filename is
22376 given for normal mailbox deliveries. It is intended for the case when filenames
22377 are generated from users' &_.forward_& files. These are usually handled
22378 by an &(appendfile)& transport called &%address_file%&. See also
22379 &%file_must_exist%&.
22380
22381
22382 .option directory appendfile string&!! unset
22383 This option is mutually exclusive with the &%file%& option, but one of &%file%&
22384 or &%directory%& must be set, unless the delivery is the direct result of a
22385 redirection (see section &<<SECTfildiropt>>&).
22386
22387 When &%directory%& is set, the string is expanded, and the message is delivered
22388 into a new file or files in or below the given directory, instead of being
22389 appended to a single mailbox file. A number of different formats are provided
22390 (see &%maildir_format%& and &%mailstore_format%&), and see section
22391 &<<SECTopdir>>& for further details of this form of delivery.
22392
22393
22394 .option directory_file appendfile string&!! "see below"
22395 .cindex "base62"
22396 .vindex "&$inode$&"
22397 When &%directory%& is set, but neither &%maildir_format%& nor
22398 &%mailstore_format%& is set, &(appendfile)& delivers each message into a file
22399 whose name is obtained by expanding this string. The default value is:
22400 .code
22401 q${base62:$tod_epoch}-$inode
22402 .endd
22403 This generates a unique name from the current time, in base 62 form, and the
22404 inode of the file. The variable &$inode$& is available only when expanding this
22405 option.
22406
22407
22408 .option directory_mode appendfile "octal integer" 0700
22409 If &(appendfile)& creates any directories as a result of the
22410 &%create_directory%& option, their mode is specified by this option.
22411
22412
22413 .option escape_string appendfile string "see description"
22414 See &%check_string%& above.
22415
22416
22417 .option file appendfile string&!! unset
22418 This option is mutually exclusive with the &%directory%& option, but one of
22419 &%file%& or &%directory%& must be set, unless the delivery is the direct result
22420 of a redirection (see section &<<SECTfildiropt>>&). The &%file%& option
22421 specifies a single file, to which the message is appended. One or more of
22422 &%use_fcntl_lock%&, &%use_flock_lock%&, or &%use_lockfile%& must be set with
22423 &%file%&.
22424
22425 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
22426 .cindex "locking files"
22427 .cindex "lock files"
22428 If you are using more than one host to deliver over NFS into the same
22429 mailboxes, you should always use lock files.
22430
22431 The string value is expanded for each delivery, and must yield an absolute
22432 path. The most common settings of this option are variations on one of these
22433 examples:
22434 .code
22435 file = /var/spool/mail/$local_part
22436 file = /home/$local_part/inbox
22437 file = $home/inbox
22438 .endd
22439 .cindex "&""sticky""& bit"
22440 In the first example, all deliveries are done into the same directory. If Exim
22441 is configured to use lock files (see &%use_lockfile%& below) it must be able to
22442 create a file in the directory, so the &"sticky"& bit must be turned on for
22443 deliveries to be possible, or alternatively the &%group%& option can be used to
22444 run the delivery under a group id which has write access to the directory.
22445
22446
22447
22448 .option file_format appendfile string unset
22449 .cindex "file" "mailbox; checking existing format"
22450 This option requests the transport to check the format of an existing file
22451 before adding to it. The check consists of matching a specific string at the
22452 start of the file. The value of the option consists of an even number of
22453 colon-separated strings. The first of each pair is the test string, and the
22454 second is the name of a transport. If the transport associated with a matched
22455 string is not the current transport, control is passed over to the other
22456 transport. For example, suppose the standard &(local_delivery)& transport has
22457 this added to it:
22458 .code
22459 file_format = "From : local_delivery :\
22460 \1\1\1\1\n : local_mmdf_delivery"
22461 .endd
22462 Mailboxes that begin with &"From"& are still handled by this transport, but if
22463 a mailbox begins with four binary ones followed by a newline, control is passed
22464 to a transport called &%local_mmdf_delivery%&, which presumably is configured
22465 to do the delivery in MMDF format. If a mailbox does not exist or is empty, it
22466 is assumed to match the current transport. If the start of a mailbox doesn't
22467 match any string, or if the transport named for a given string is not defined,
22468 delivery is deferred.
22469
22470
22471 .option file_must_exist appendfile boolean false
22472 If this option is true, the file specified by the &%file%& option must exist.
22473 A temporary error occurs if it does not, causing delivery to be deferred.
22474 If this option is false, the file is created if it does not exist.
22475
22476
22477 .option lock_fcntl_timeout appendfile time 0s
22478 .cindex "timeout" "mailbox locking"
22479 .cindex "mailbox" "locking, blocking and non-blocking"
22480 .cindex "locking files"
22481 By default, the &(appendfile)& transport uses non-blocking calls to &[fcntl()]&
22482 when locking an open mailbox file. If the call fails, the delivery process
22483 sleeps for &%lock_interval%& and tries again, up to &%lock_retries%& times.
22484 Non-blocking calls are used so that the file is not kept open during the wait
22485 for the lock; the reason for this is to make it as safe as possible for
22486 deliveries over NFS in the case when processes might be accessing an NFS
22487 mailbox without using a lock file. This should not be done, but
22488 misunderstandings and hence misconfigurations are not unknown.
22489
22490 On a busy system, however, the performance of a non-blocking lock approach is
22491 not as good as using a blocking lock with a timeout. In this case, the waiting
22492 is done inside the system call, and Exim's delivery process acquires the lock
22493 and can proceed as soon as the previous lock holder releases it.
22494
22495 If &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& is set to a non-zero time, blocking locks, with that
22496 timeout, are used. There may still be some retrying: the maximum number of
22497 retries is
22498 .code
22499 (lock_retries * lock_interval) / lock_fcntl_timeout
22500 .endd
22501 rounded up to the next whole number. In other words, the total time during
22502 which &(appendfile)& is trying to get a lock is roughly the same, unless
22503 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& is set very large.
22504
22505 You should consider setting this option if you are getting a lot of delayed
22506 local deliveries because of errors of the form
22507 .code
22508 failed to lock mailbox /some/file (fcntl)
22509 .endd
22510
22511 .option lock_flock_timeout appendfile time 0s
22512 This timeout applies to file locking when using &[flock()]& (see
22513 &%use_flock%&); the timeout operates in a similar manner to
22514 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%&.
22515
22516
22517 .option lock_interval appendfile time 3s
22518 This specifies the time to wait between attempts to lock the file. See below
22519 for details of locking.
22520
22521
22522 .option lock_retries appendfile integer 10
22523 This specifies the maximum number of attempts to lock the file. A value of zero
22524 is treated as 1. See below for details of locking.
22525
22526
22527 .option lockfile_mode appendfile "octal integer" 0600
22528 This specifies the mode of the created lock file, when a lock file is being
22529 used (see &%use_lockfile%& and &%use_mbx_lock%&).
22530
22531
22532 .option lockfile_timeout appendfile time 30m
22533 .cindex "timeout" "mailbox locking"
22534 When a lock file is being used (see &%use_lockfile%&), if a lock file already
22535 exists and is older than this value, it is assumed to have been left behind by
22536 accident, and Exim attempts to remove it.
22537
22538
22539 .option mailbox_filecount appendfile string&!! unset
22540 .cindex "mailbox" "specifying size of"
22541 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
22542 If this option is set, it is expanded, and the result is taken as the current
22543 number of files in the mailbox. It must be a decimal number, optionally
22544 followed by K or M. This provides a way of obtaining this information from an
22545 external source that maintains the data.
22546
22547
22548 .option mailbox_size appendfile string&!! unset
22549 .cindex "mailbox" "specifying size of"
22550 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
22551 If this option is set, it is expanded, and the result is taken as the current
22552 size the mailbox. It must be a decimal number, optionally followed by K or M.
22553 This provides a way of obtaining this information from an external source that
22554 maintains the data. This is likely to be helpful for maildir deliveries where
22555 it is computationally expensive to compute the size of a mailbox.
22556
22557
22558
22559 .option maildir_format appendfile boolean false
22560 .cindex "maildir format" "specifying"
22561 If this option is set with the &%directory%& option, the delivery is into a new
22562 file, in the &"maildir"& format that is used by other mail software. When the
22563 transport is activated directly from a &(redirect)& router (for example, the
22564 &(address_file)& transport in the default configuration), setting
22565 &%maildir_format%& causes the path received from the router to be treated as a
22566 directory, whether or not it ends with &`/`&. This option is available only if
22567 SUPPORT_MAILDIR is present in &_Local/Makefile_&. See section
22568 &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below for further details.
22569
22570
22571 .option maildir_quota_directory_regex appendfile string "See below"
22572 .cindex "maildir format" "quota; directories included in"
22573 .cindex "quota" "maildir; directories included in"
22574 This option is relevant only when &%maildir_use_size_file%& is set. It defines
22575 a regular expression for specifying directories, relative to the quota
22576 directory (see &%quota_directory%&), that should be included in the quota
22577 calculation. The default value is:
22578 .code
22579 maildir_quota_directory_regex = ^(?:cur|new|\..*)$
22580 .endd
22581 This includes the &_cur_& and &_new_& directories, and any maildir++ folders
22582 (directories whose names begin with a dot). If you want to exclude the
22583 &_Trash_&
22584 folder from the count (as some sites do), you need to change this setting to
22585 .code
22586 maildir_quota_directory_regex = ^(?:cur|new|\.(?!Trash).*)$
22587 .endd
22588 This uses a negative lookahead in the regular expression to exclude the
22589 directory whose name is &_.Trash_&. When a directory is excluded from quota
22590 calculations, quota processing is bypassed for any messages that are delivered
22591 directly into that directory.
22592
22593
22594 .option maildir_retries appendfile integer 10
22595 This option specifies the number of times to retry when writing a file in
22596 &"maildir"& format. See section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below.
22597
22598
22599 .option maildir_tag appendfile string&!! unset
22600 This option applies only to deliveries in maildir format, and is described in
22601 section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below.
22602
22603
22604 .option maildir_use_size_file appendfile&!! boolean false
22605 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirsize_& file"
22606 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value.
22607 If it is true, it enables support for &_maildirsize_& files. Exim
22608 creates a &_maildirsize_& file in a maildir if one does not exist, taking the
22609 quota from the &%quota%& option of the transport. If &%quota%& is unset, the
22610 value is zero. See &%maildir_quota_directory_regex%& above and section
22611 &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below for further details.
22612
22613 .option maildirfolder_create_regex appendfile string unset
22614 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirfolder_& file"
22615 .cindex "&_maildirfolder_&, creating"
22616 The value of this option is a regular expression. If it is unset, it has no
22617 effect. Otherwise, before a maildir delivery takes place, the pattern is
22618 matched against the name of the maildir directory, that is, the directory
22619 containing the &_new_& and &_tmp_& subdirectories that will be used for the
22620 delivery. If there is a match, Exim checks for the existence of a file called
22621 &_maildirfolder_& in the directory, and creates it if it does not exist.
22622 See section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& for more details.
22623
22624
22625 .option mailstore_format appendfile boolean false
22626 .cindex "mailstore format" "specifying"
22627 If this option is set with the &%directory%& option, the delivery is into two
22628 new files in &"mailstore"& format. The option is available only if
22629 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE is present in &_Local/Makefile_&. See section &<<SECTopdir>>&
22630 below for further details.
22631
22632
22633 .option mailstore_prefix appendfile string&!! unset
22634 This option applies only to deliveries in mailstore format, and is described in
22635 section &<<SECTopdir>>& below.
22636
22637
22638 .option mailstore_suffix appendfile string&!! unset
22639 This option applies only to deliveries in mailstore format, and is described in
22640 section &<<SECTopdir>>& below.
22641
22642
22643 .option mbx_format appendfile boolean false
22644 .cindex "locking files"
22645 .cindex "file" "locking"
22646 .cindex "file" "MBX format"
22647 .cindex "MBX format, specifying"
22648 This option is available only if Exim has been compiled with SUPPORT_MBX
22649 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. If &%mbx_format%& is set with the &%file%& option,
22650 the message is appended to the mailbox file in MBX format instead of
22651 traditional Unix format. This format is supported by Pine4 and its associated
22652 IMAP and POP daemons, by means of the &'c-client'& library that they all use.
22653
22654 &*Note*&: The &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options are not
22655 automatically changed by the use of &%mbx_format%&. They should normally be set
22656 empty when using MBX format, so this option almost always appears in this
22657 combination:
22658 .code
22659 mbx_format = true
22660 message_prefix =
22661 message_suffix =
22662 .endd
22663 If none of the locking options are mentioned in the configuration,
22664 &%use_mbx_lock%& is assumed and the other locking options default to false. It
22665 is possible to specify the other kinds of locking with &%mbx_format%&, but
22666 &%use_fcntl_lock%& and &%use_mbx_lock%& are mutually exclusive. MBX locking
22667 interworks with &'c-client'&, providing for shared access to the mailbox. It
22668 should not be used if any program that does not use this form of locking is
22669 going to access the mailbox, nor should it be used if the mailbox file is NFS
22670 mounted, because it works only when the mailbox is accessed from a single host.
22671
22672 If you set &%use_fcntl_lock%& with an MBX-format mailbox, you cannot use
22673 the standard version of &'c-client'&, because as long as it has a mailbox open
22674 (this means for the whole of a Pine or IMAP session), Exim will not be able to
22675 append messages to it.
22676
22677
22678 .option message_prefix appendfile string&!! "see below"
22679 .cindex "&""From""& line"
22680 The string specified here is expanded and output at the start of every message.
22681 The default is unset unless &%file%& is specified and &%use_bsmtp%& is not set,
22682 in which case it is:
22683 .code
22684 message_prefix = "From ${if def:return_path{$return_path}\
22685 {MAILER-DAEMON}} $tod_bsdinbox\n"
22686 .endd
22687 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
22688 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_prefix%&.
22689
22690 .option message_suffix appendfile string&!! "see below"
22691 The string specified here is expanded and output at the end of every message.
22692 The default is unset unless &%file%& is specified and &%use_bsmtp%& is not set,
22693 in which case it is a single newline character. The suffix can be suppressed by
22694 setting
22695 .code
22696 message_suffix =
22697 .endd
22698 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
22699 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_suffix%&.
22700
22701 .option mode appendfile "octal integer" 0600
22702 If the output file is created, it is given this mode. If it already exists and
22703 has wider permissions, they are reduced to this mode. If it has narrower
22704 permissions, an error occurs unless &%mode_fail_narrower%& is false. However,
22705 if the delivery is the result of a &%save%& command in a filter file specifying
22706 a particular mode, the mode of the output file is always forced to take that
22707 value, and this option is ignored.
22708
22709
22710 .option mode_fail_narrower appendfile boolean true
22711 This option applies in the case when an existing mailbox file has a narrower
22712 mode than that specified by the &%mode%& option. If &%mode_fail_narrower%& is
22713 true, the delivery is deferred (&"mailbox has the wrong mode"&); otherwise Exim
22714 continues with the delivery attempt, using the existing mode of the file.
22715
22716
22717 .option notify_comsat appendfile boolean false
22718 If this option is true, the &'comsat'& daemon is notified after every
22719 successful delivery to a user mailbox. This is the daemon that notifies logged
22720 on users about incoming mail.
22721
22722
22723 .option quota appendfile string&!! unset
22724 .cindex "quota" "imposed by Exim"
22725 This option imposes a limit on the size of the file to which Exim is appending,
22726 or to the total space used in the directory tree when the &%directory%& option
22727 is set. In the latter case, computation of the space used is expensive, because
22728 all the files in the directory (and any sub-directories) have to be
22729 individually inspected and their sizes summed. (See &%quota_size_regex%& and
22730 &%maildir_use_size_file%& for ways to avoid this in environments where users
22731 have no shell access to their mailboxes).
22732
22733 As there is no interlock against two simultaneous deliveries into a
22734 multi-file mailbox, it is possible for the quota to be overrun in this case.
22735 For single-file mailboxes, of course, an interlock is a necessity.
22736
22737 A file's size is taken as its &'used'& value. Because of blocking effects, this
22738 may be a lot less than the actual amount of disk space allocated to the file.
22739 If the sizes of a number of files are being added up, the rounding effect can
22740 become quite noticeable, especially on systems that have large block sizes.
22741 Nevertheless, it seems best to stick to the &'used'& figure, because this is
22742 the obvious value which users understand most easily.
22743
22744 The value of the option is expanded, and must then be a numerical value
22745 (decimal point allowed), optionally followed by one of the letters K, M, or G,
22746 for kilobytes, megabytes, or gigabytes, optionally followed by a slash
22747 and further option modifiers. If Exim is running on a system with
22748 large file support (Linux and FreeBSD have this), mailboxes larger than 2G can
22749 be handled.
22750
22751 The option modifier &%no_check%& can be used to force delivery even if the over
22752 quota condition is met. The quota gets updated as usual.
22753
22754 &*Note*&: A value of zero is interpreted as &"no quota"&.
22755
22756 The expansion happens while Exim is running as root, before it changes uid for
22757 the delivery. This means that files that are inaccessible to the end user can
22758 be used to hold quota values that are looked up in the expansion. When delivery
22759 fails because this quota is exceeded, the handling of the error is as for
22760 system quota failures.
22761
22762 By default, Exim's quota checking mimics system quotas, and restricts the
22763 mailbox to the specified maximum size, though the value is not accurate to the
22764 last byte, owing to separator lines and additional headers that may get added
22765 during message delivery. When a mailbox is nearly full, large messages may get
22766 refused even though small ones are accepted, because the size of the current
22767 message is added to the quota when the check is made. This behaviour can be
22768 changed by setting &%quota_is_inclusive%& false. When this is done, the check
22769 for exceeding the quota does not include the current message. Thus, deliveries
22770 continue until the quota has been exceeded; thereafter, no further messages are
22771 delivered. See also &%quota_warn_threshold%&.
22772
22773
22774 .option quota_directory appendfile string&!! unset
22775 This option defines the directory to check for quota purposes when delivering
22776 into individual files. The default is the delivery directory, or, if a file
22777 called &_maildirfolder_& exists in a maildir directory, the parent of the
22778 delivery directory.
22779
22780
22781 .option quota_filecount appendfile string&!! 0
22782 This option applies when the &%directory%& option is set. It limits the total
22783 number of files in the directory (compare the inode limit in system quotas). It
22784 can only be used if &%quota%& is also set. The value is expanded; an expansion
22785 failure causes delivery to be deferred. A value of zero is interpreted as
22786 &"no quota"&.
22787
22788 The option modifier &%no_check%& can be used to force delivery even if the over
22789 quota condition is met. The quota gets updated as usual.
22790
22791 .option quota_is_inclusive appendfile boolean true
22792 See &%quota%& above.
22793
22794
22795 .option quota_size_regex appendfile string unset
22796 This option applies when one of the delivery modes that writes a separate file
22797 for each message is being used. When Exim wants to find the size of one of
22798 these files in order to test the quota, it first checks &%quota_size_regex%&.
22799 If this is set to a regular expression that matches the filename, and it
22800 captures one string, that string is interpreted as a representation of the
22801 file's size. The value of &%quota_size_regex%& is not expanded.
22802
22803 This feature is useful only when users have no shell access to their mailboxes
22804 &-- otherwise they could defeat the quota simply by renaming the files. This
22805 facility can be used with maildir deliveries, by setting &%maildir_tag%& to add
22806 the file length to the filename. For example:
22807 .code
22808 maildir_tag = ,S=$message_size
22809 quota_size_regex = ,S=(\d+)
22810 .endd
22811 An alternative to &$message_size$& is &$message_linecount$&, which contains the
22812 number of lines in the message.
22813
22814 The regular expression should not assume that the length is at the end of the
22815 filename (even though &%maildir_tag%& puts it there) because maildir MUAs
22816 sometimes add other information onto the ends of message filenames.
22817
22818 Section &<<SECID136>>& contains further information.
22819
22820
22821 .option quota_warn_message appendfile string&!! "see below"
22822 See below for the use of this option. If it is not set when
22823 &%quota_warn_threshold%& is set, it defaults to
22824 .code
22825 quota_warn_message = "\
22826 To: $local_part@$domain\n\
22827 Subject: Your mailbox\n\n\
22828 This message is automatically created \
22829 by mail delivery software.\n\n\
22830 The size of your mailbox has exceeded \
22831 a warning threshold that is\n\
22832 set by the system administrator.\n"
22833 .endd
22834
22835
22836 .option quota_warn_threshold appendfile string&!! 0
22837 .cindex "quota" "warning threshold"
22838 .cindex "mailbox" "size warning"
22839 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
22840 This option is expanded in the same way as &%quota%& (see above). If the
22841 resulting value is greater than zero, and delivery of the message causes the
22842 size of the file or total space in the directory tree to cross the given
22843 threshold, a warning message is sent. If &%quota%& is also set, the threshold
22844 may be specified as a percentage of it by following the value with a percent
22845 sign. For example:
22846 .code
22847 quota = 10M
22848 quota_warn_threshold = 75%
22849 .endd
22850 If &%quota%& is not set, a setting of &%quota_warn_threshold%& that ends with a
22851 percent sign is ignored.
22852
22853 The warning message itself is specified by the &%quota_warn_message%& option,
22854 and it must start with a &'To:'& header line containing the recipient(s) of the
22855 warning message. These do not necessarily have to include the recipient(s) of
22856 the original message. A &'Subject:'& line should also normally be supplied. You
22857 can include any other header lines that you want. If you do not include a
22858 &'From:'& line, the default is:
22859 .code
22860 From: Mail Delivery System <mailer-daemon@$qualify_domain_sender>
22861 .endd
22862 .oindex &%errors_reply_to%&
22863 If you supply a &'Reply-To:'& line, it overrides the global &%errors_reply_to%&
22864 option.
22865
22866 The &%quota%& option does not have to be set in order to use this option; they
22867 are independent of one another except when the threshold is specified as a
22868 percentage.
22869
22870
22871 .option use_bsmtp appendfile boolean false
22872 .cindex "envelope from"
22873 .cindex "envelope sender"
22874 If this option is set true, &(appendfile)& writes messages in &"batch SMTP"&
22875 format, with the envelope sender and recipient(s) included as SMTP commands. If
22876 you want to include a leading HELO command with such messages, you can do
22877 so by setting the &%message_prefix%& option. See section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&
22878 for details of batch SMTP.
22879
22880
22881 .option use_crlf appendfile boolean false
22882 .cindex "carriage return"
22883 .cindex "linefeed"
22884 This option causes lines to be terminated with the two-character CRLF sequence
22885 (carriage return, linefeed) instead of just a linefeed character. In the case
22886 of batched SMTP, the byte sequence written to the file is then an exact image
22887 of what would be sent down a real SMTP connection.
22888
22889 &*Note:*& The contents of the &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options
22890 (which are used to supply the traditional &"From&~"& and blank line separators
22891 in Berkeley-style mailboxes) are written verbatim, so must contain their own
22892 carriage return characters if these are needed. In cases where these options
22893 have non-empty defaults, the values end with a single linefeed, so they must be
22894 changed to end with &`\r\n`& if &%use_crlf%& is set.
22895
22896
22897 .option use_fcntl_lock appendfile boolean "see below"
22898 This option controls the use of the &[fcntl()]& function to lock a file for
22899 exclusive use when a message is being appended. It is set by default unless
22900 &%use_flock_lock%& is set. Otherwise, it should be turned off only if you know
22901 that all your MUAs use lock file locking. When both &%use_fcntl_lock%& and
22902 &%use_flock_lock%& are unset, &%use_lockfile%& must be set.
22903
22904
22905 .option use_flock_lock appendfile boolean false
22906 This option is provided to support the use of &[flock()]& for file locking, for
22907 the few situations where it is needed. Most modern operating systems support
22908 &[fcntl()]& and &[lockf()]& locking, and these two functions interwork with
22909 each other. Exim uses &[fcntl()]& locking by default.
22910
22911 This option is required only if you are using an operating system where
22912 &[flock()]& is used by programs that access mailboxes (typically MUAs), and
22913 where &[flock()]& does not correctly interwork with &[fcntl()]&. You can use
22914 both &[fcntl()]& and &[flock()]& locking simultaneously if you want.
22915
22916 .cindex "Solaris" "&[flock()]& support"
22917 Not all operating systems provide &[flock()]&. Some versions of Solaris do not
22918 have it (and some, I think, provide a not quite right version built on top of
22919 &[lockf()]&). If the OS does not have &[flock()]&, Exim will be built without
22920 the ability to use it, and any attempt to do so will cause a configuration
22921 error.
22922
22923 &*Warning*&: &[flock()]& locks do not work on NFS files (unless &[flock()]&
22924 is just being mapped onto &[fcntl()]& by the OS).
22925
22926
22927 .option use_lockfile appendfile boolean "see below"
22928 If this option is turned off, Exim does not attempt to create a lock file when
22929 appending to a mailbox file. In this situation, the only locking is by
22930 &[fcntl()]&. You should only turn &%use_lockfile%& off if you are absolutely
22931 sure that every MUA that is ever going to look at your users' mailboxes uses
22932 &[fcntl()]& rather than a lock file, and even then only when you are not
22933 delivering over NFS from more than one host.
22934
22935 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
22936 In order to append to an NFS file safely from more than one host, it is
22937 necessary to take out a lock &'before'& opening the file, and the lock file
22938 achieves this. Otherwise, even with &[fcntl()]& locking, there is a risk of
22939 file corruption.
22940
22941 The &%use_lockfile%& option is set by default unless &%use_mbx_lock%& is set.
22942 It is not possible to turn both &%use_lockfile%& and &%use_fcntl_lock%& off,
22943 except when &%mbx_format%& is set.
22944
22945
22946 .option use_mbx_lock appendfile boolean "see below"
22947 This option is available only if Exim has been compiled with SUPPORT_MBX
22948 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. Setting the option specifies that special MBX
22949 locking rules be used. It is set by default if &%mbx_format%& is set and none
22950 of the locking options are mentioned in the configuration. The locking rules
22951 are the same as are used by the &'c-client'& library that underlies Pine and
22952 the IMAP4 and POP daemons that come with it (see the discussion below). The
22953 rules allow for shared access to the mailbox. However, this kind of locking
22954 does not work when the mailbox is NFS mounted.
22955
22956 You can set &%use_mbx_lock%& with either (or both) of &%use_fcntl_lock%& and
22957 &%use_flock_lock%& to control what kind of locking is used in implementing the
22958 MBX locking rules. The default is to use &[fcntl()]& if &%use_mbx_lock%& is set
22959 without &%use_fcntl_lock%& or &%use_flock_lock%&.
22960
22961
22962
22963
22964 .section "Operational details for appending" "SECTopappend"
22965 .cindex "appending to a file"
22966 .cindex "file" "appending"
22967 Before appending to a file, the following preparations are made:
22968
22969 .ilist
22970 If the name of the file is &_/dev/null_&, no action is taken, and a success
22971 return is given.
22972
22973 .next
22974 .cindex "directory creation"
22975 If any directories on the file's path are missing, Exim creates them if the
22976 &%create_directory%& option is set. A created directory's mode is given by the
22977 &%directory_mode%& option.
22978
22979 .next
22980 If &%file_format%& is set, the format of an existing file is checked. If this
22981 indicates that a different transport should be used, control is passed to that
22982 transport.
22983
22984 .next
22985 .cindex "file" "locking"
22986 .cindex "locking files"
22987 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
22988 If &%use_lockfile%& is set, a lock file is built in a way that will work
22989 reliably over NFS, as follows:
22990
22991 .olist
22992 Create a &"hitching post"& file whose name is that of the lock file with the
22993 current time, primary host name, and process id added, by opening for writing
22994 as a new file. If this fails with an access error, delivery is deferred.
22995 .next
22996 Close the hitching post file, and hard link it to the lock filename.
22997 .next
22998 If the call to &[link()]& succeeds, creation of the lock file has succeeded.
22999 Unlink the hitching post name.
23000 .next
23001 Otherwise, use &[stat()]& to get information about the hitching post file, and
23002 then unlink hitching post name. If the number of links is exactly two, creation
23003 of the lock file succeeded but something (for example, an NFS server crash and
23004 restart) caused this fact not to be communicated to the &[link()]& call.
23005 .next
23006 If creation of the lock file failed, wait for &%lock_interval%& and try again,
23007 up to &%lock_retries%& times. However, since any program that writes to a
23008 mailbox should complete its task very quickly, it is reasonable to time out old
23009 lock files that are normally the result of user agent and system crashes. If an
23010 existing lock file is older than &%lockfile_timeout%& Exim attempts to unlink
23011 it before trying again.
23012 .endlist olist
23013
23014 .next
23015 A call is made to &[lstat()]& to discover whether the main file exists, and if
23016 so, what its characteristics are. If &[lstat()]& fails for any reason other
23017 than non-existence, delivery is deferred.
23018
23019 .next
23020 .cindex "symbolic link" "to mailbox"
23021 .cindex "mailbox" "symbolic link"
23022 If the file does exist and is a symbolic link, delivery is deferred, unless the
23023 &%allow_symlink%& option is set, in which case the ownership of the link is
23024 checked, and then &[stat()]& is called to find out about the real file, which
23025 is then subjected to the checks below. The check on the top-level link
23026 ownership prevents one user creating a link for another's mailbox in a sticky
23027 directory, though allowing symbolic links in this case is definitely not a good
23028 idea. If there is a chain of symbolic links, the intermediate ones are not
23029 checked.
23030
23031 .next
23032 If the file already exists but is not a regular file, or if the file's owner
23033 and group (if the group is being checked &-- see &%check_group%& above) are
23034 different from the user and group under which the delivery is running,
23035 delivery is deferred.
23036
23037 .next
23038 If the file's permissions are more generous than specified, they are reduced.
23039 If they are insufficient, delivery is deferred, unless &%mode_fail_narrower%&
23040 is set false, in which case the delivery is tried using the existing
23041 permissions.
23042
23043 .next
23044 The file's inode number is saved, and the file is then opened for appending.
23045 If this fails because the file has vanished, &(appendfile)& behaves as if it
23046 hadn't existed (see below). For any other failures, delivery is deferred.
23047
23048 .next
23049 If the file is opened successfully, check that the inode number hasn't
23050 changed, that it is still a regular file, and that the owner and permissions
23051 have not changed. If anything is wrong, defer delivery and freeze the message.
23052
23053 .next
23054 If the file did not exist originally, defer delivery if the &%file_must_exist%&
23055 option is set. Otherwise, check that the file is being created in a permitted
23056 directory if the &%create_file%& option is set (deferring on failure), and then
23057 open for writing as a new file, with the O_EXCL and O_CREAT options,
23058 except when dealing with a symbolic link (the &%allow_symlink%& option must be
23059 set). In this case, which can happen if the link points to a non-existent file,
23060 the file is opened for writing using O_CREAT but not O_EXCL, because
23061 that prevents link following.
23062
23063 .next
23064 .cindex "loop" "while file testing"
23065 If opening fails because the file exists, obey the tests given above for
23066 existing files. However, to avoid looping in a situation where the file is
23067 being continuously created and destroyed, the exists/not-exists loop is broken
23068 after 10 repetitions, and the message is then frozen.
23069
23070 .next
23071 If opening fails with any other error, defer delivery.
23072
23073 .next
23074 .cindex "file" "locking"
23075 .cindex "locking files"
23076 Once the file is open, unless both &%use_fcntl_lock%& and &%use_flock_lock%&
23077 are false, it is locked using &[fcntl()]& or &[flock()]& or both. If
23078 &%use_mbx_lock%& is false, an exclusive lock is requested in each case.
23079 However, if &%use_mbx_lock%& is true, Exim takes out a shared lock on the open
23080 file, and an exclusive lock on the file whose name is
23081 .code
23082 /tmp/.<device-number>.<inode-number>
23083 .endd
23084 using the device and inode numbers of the open mailbox file, in accordance with
23085 the MBX locking rules. This file is created with a mode that is specified by
23086 the &%lockfile_mode%& option.
23087
23088 If Exim fails to lock the file, there are two possible courses of action,
23089 depending on the value of the locking timeout. This is obtained from
23090 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& or &%lock_flock_timeout%&, as appropriate.
23091
23092 If the timeout value is zero, the file is closed, Exim waits for
23093 &%lock_interval%&, and then goes back and re-opens the file as above and tries
23094 to lock it again. This happens up to &%lock_retries%& times, after which the
23095 delivery is deferred.
23096
23097 If the timeout has a value greater than zero, blocking calls to &[fcntl()]& or
23098 &[flock()]& are used (with the given timeout), so there has already been some
23099 waiting involved by the time locking fails. Nevertheless, Exim does not give up
23100 immediately. It retries up to
23101 .code
23102 (lock_retries * lock_interval) / <timeout>
23103 .endd
23104 times (rounded up).
23105 .endlist
23106
23107 At the end of delivery, Exim closes the file (which releases the &[fcntl()]&
23108 and/or &[flock()]& locks) and then deletes the lock file if one was created.
23109
23110
23111 .section "Operational details for delivery to a new file" "SECTopdir"
23112 .cindex "delivery" "to single file"
23113 .cindex "&""From""& line"
23114 When the &%directory%& option is set instead of &%file%&, each message is
23115 delivered into a newly-created file or set of files. When &(appendfile)& is
23116 activated directly from a &(redirect)& router, neither &%file%& nor
23117 &%directory%& is normally set, because the path for delivery is supplied by the
23118 router. (See for example, the &(address_file)& transport in the default
23119 configuration.) In this case, delivery is to a new file if either the path name
23120 ends in &`/`&, or the &%maildir_format%& or &%mailstore_format%& option is set.
23121
23122 No locking is required while writing the message to a new file, so the various
23123 locking options of the transport are ignored. The &"From"& line that by default
23124 separates messages in a single file is not normally needed, nor is the escaping
23125 of message lines that start with &"From"&, and there is no need to ensure a
23126 newline at the end of each message. Consequently, the default values for
23127 &%check_string%&, &%message_prefix%&, and &%message_suffix%& are all unset when
23128 any of &%directory%&, &%maildir_format%&, or &%mailstore_format%& is set.
23129
23130 If Exim is required to check a &%quota%& setting, it adds up the sizes of all
23131 the files in the delivery directory by default. However, you can specify a
23132 different directory by setting &%quota_directory%&. Also, for maildir
23133 deliveries (see below) the &_maildirfolder_& convention is honoured.
23134
23135
23136 .cindex "maildir format"
23137 .cindex "mailstore format"
23138 There are three different ways in which delivery to individual files can be
23139 done, controlled by the settings of the &%maildir_format%& and
23140 &%mailstore_format%& options. Note that code to support maildir or mailstore
23141 formats is not included in the binary unless SUPPORT_MAILDIR or
23142 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE, respectively, is set in &_Local/Makefile_&.
23143
23144 .cindex "directory creation"
23145 In all three cases an attempt is made to create the directory and any necessary
23146 sub-directories if they do not exist, provided that the &%create_directory%&
23147 option is set (the default). The location of a created directory can be
23148 constrained by setting &%create_file%&. A created directory's mode is given by
23149 the &%directory_mode%& option. If creation fails, or if the
23150 &%create_directory%& option is not set when creation is required, delivery is
23151 deferred.
23152
23153
23154
23155 .section "Maildir delivery" "SECTmaildirdelivery"
23156 .cindex "maildir format" "description of"
23157 If the &%maildir_format%& option is true, Exim delivers each message by writing
23158 it to a file whose name is &_tmp/<stime>.H<mtime>P<pid>.<host>_& in the
23159 directory that is defined by the &%directory%& option (the &"delivery
23160 directory"&). If the delivery is successful, the file is renamed into the
23161 &_new_& subdirectory.
23162
23163 In the filename, <&'stime'&> is the current time of day in seconds, and
23164 <&'mtime'&> is the microsecond fraction of the time. After a maildir delivery,
23165 Exim checks that the time-of-day clock has moved on by at least one microsecond
23166 before terminating the delivery process. This guarantees uniqueness for the
23167 filename. However, as a precaution, Exim calls &[stat()]& for the file before
23168 opening it. If any response other than ENOENT (does not exist) is given,
23169 Exim waits 2 seconds and tries again, up to &%maildir_retries%& times.
23170
23171 Before Exim carries out a maildir delivery, it ensures that subdirectories
23172 called &_new_&, &_cur_&, and &_tmp_& exist in the delivery directory. If they
23173 do not exist, Exim tries to create them and any superior directories in their
23174 path, subject to the &%create_directory%& and &%create_file%& options. If the
23175 &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& option is set, and the regular expression it
23176 contains matches the delivery directory, Exim also ensures that a file called
23177 &_maildirfolder_& exists in the delivery directory. If a missing directory or
23178 &_maildirfolder_& file cannot be created, delivery is deferred.
23179
23180 These features make it possible to use Exim to create all the necessary files
23181 and directories in a maildir mailbox, including subdirectories for maildir++
23182 folders. Consider this example:
23183 .code
23184 maildir_format = true
23185 directory = /var/mail/$local_part\
23186 ${if eq{$local_part_suffix}{}{}\
23187 {/.${substr_1:$local_part_suffix}}}
23188 maildirfolder_create_regex = /\.[^/]+$
23189 .endd
23190 If &$local_part_suffix$& is empty (there was no suffix for the local part),
23191 delivery is into a toplevel maildir with a name like &_/var/mail/pimbo_& (for
23192 the user called &'pimbo'&). The pattern in &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& does
23193 not match this name, so Exim will not look for or create the file
23194 &_/var/mail/pimbo/maildirfolder_&, though it will create
23195 &_/var/mail/pimbo/{cur,new,tmp}_& if necessary.
23196
23197 However, if &$local_part_suffix$& contains &`-eximusers`& (for example),
23198 delivery is into the maildir++ folder &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers_&, which
23199 does match &%maildirfolder_create_regex%&. In this case, Exim will create
23200 &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers/maildirfolder_& as well as the three maildir
23201 directories &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers/{cur,new,tmp}_&.
23202
23203 &*Warning:*& Take care when setting &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& that it does
23204 not inadvertently match the toplevel maildir directory, because a
23205 &_maildirfolder_& file at top level would completely break quota calculations.
23206
23207 .cindex "quota" "in maildir delivery"
23208 .cindex "maildir++"
23209 If Exim is required to check a &%quota%& setting before a maildir delivery, and
23210 &%quota_directory%& is not set, it looks for a file called &_maildirfolder_& in
23211 the maildir directory (alongside &_new_&, &_cur_&, &_tmp_&). If this exists,
23212 Exim assumes the directory is a maildir++ folder directory, which is one level
23213 down from the user's top level mailbox directory. This causes it to start at
23214 the parent directory instead of the current directory when calculating the
23215 amount of space used.
23216
23217 One problem with delivering into a multi-file mailbox is that it is
23218 computationally expensive to compute the size of the mailbox for quota
23219 checking. Various approaches have been taken to reduce the amount of work
23220 needed. The next two sections describe two of them. A third alternative is to
23221 use some external process for maintaining the size data, and use the expansion
23222 of the &%mailbox_size%& option as a way of importing it into Exim.
23223
23224
23225
23226
23227 .section "Using tags to record message sizes" "SECID135"
23228 If &%maildir_tag%& is set, the string is expanded for each delivery.
23229 When the maildir file is renamed into the &_new_& sub-directory, the
23230 tag is added to its name. However, if adding the tag takes the length of the
23231 name to the point where the test &[stat()]& call fails with ENAMETOOLONG,
23232 the tag is dropped and the maildir file is created with no tag.
23233
23234
23235 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
23236 Tags can be used to encode the size of files in their names; see
23237 &%quota_size_regex%& above for an example. The expansion of &%maildir_tag%&
23238 happens after the message has been written. The value of the &$message_size$&
23239 variable is set to the number of bytes actually written. If the expansion is
23240 forced to fail, the tag is ignored, but a non-forced failure causes delivery to
23241 be deferred. The expanded tag may contain any printing characters except &"/"&.
23242 Non-printing characters in the string are ignored; if the resulting string is
23243 empty, it is ignored. If it starts with an alphanumeric character, a leading
23244 colon is inserted; this default has not proven to be the path that popular
23245 maildir implementations have chosen (but changing it in Exim would break
23246 backwards compatibility).
23247
23248 For one common implementation, you might set:
23249 .code
23250 maildir_tag = ,S=${message_size}
23251 .endd
23252 but you should check the documentation of the other software to be sure.
23253
23254 It is advisable to also set &%quota_size_regex%& when setting &%maildir_tag%&
23255 as this allows Exim to extract the size from your tag, instead of having to
23256 &[stat()]& each message file.
23257
23258
23259 .section "Using a maildirsize file" "SECID136"
23260 .cindex "quota" "in maildir delivery"
23261 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirsize_& file"
23262 If &%maildir_use_size_file%& is true, Exim implements the maildir++ rules for
23263 storing quota and message size information in a file called &_maildirsize_&
23264 within the toplevel maildir directory. If this file does not exist, Exim
23265 creates it, setting the quota from the &%quota%& option of the transport. If
23266 the maildir directory itself does not exist, it is created before any attempt
23267 to write a &_maildirsize_& file.
23268
23269 The &_maildirsize_& file is used to hold information about the sizes of
23270 messages in the maildir, thus speeding up quota calculations. The quota value
23271 in the file is just a cache; if the quota is changed in the transport, the new
23272 value overrides the cached value when the next message is delivered. The cache
23273 is maintained for the benefit of other programs that access the maildir and
23274 need to know the quota.
23275
23276 If the &%quota%& option in the transport is unset or zero, the &_maildirsize_&
23277 file is maintained (with a zero quota setting), but no quota is imposed.
23278
23279 A regular expression is available for controlling which directories in the
23280 maildir participate in quota calculations when a &_maildirsizefile_& is in use.
23281 See the description of the &%maildir_quota_directory_regex%& option above for
23282 details.
23283
23284
23285 .section "Mailstore delivery" "SECID137"
23286 .cindex "mailstore format" "description of"
23287 If the &%mailstore_format%& option is true, each message is written as two
23288 files in the given directory. A unique base name is constructed from the
23289 message id and the current delivery process, and the files that are written use
23290 this base name plus the suffixes &_.env_& and &_.msg_&. The &_.env_& file
23291 contains the message's envelope, and the &_.msg_& file contains the message
23292 itself. The base name is placed in the variable &$mailstore_basename$&.
23293
23294 During delivery, the envelope is first written to a file with the suffix
23295 &_.tmp_&. The &_.msg_& file is then written, and when it is complete, the
23296 &_.tmp_& file is renamed as the &_.env_& file. Programs that access messages in
23297 mailstore format should wait for the presence of both a &_.msg_& and a &_.env_&
23298 file before accessing either of them. An alternative approach is to wait for
23299 the absence of a &_.tmp_& file.
23300
23301 The envelope file starts with any text defined by the &%mailstore_prefix%&
23302 option, expanded and terminated by a newline if there isn't one. Then follows
23303 the sender address on one line, then all the recipient addresses, one per line.
23304 There can be more than one recipient only if the &%batch_max%& option is set
23305 greater than one. Finally, &%mailstore_suffix%& is expanded and the result
23306 appended to the file, followed by a newline if it does not end with one.
23307
23308 If expansion of &%mailstore_prefix%& or &%mailstore_suffix%& ends with a forced
23309 failure, it is ignored. Other expansion errors are treated as serious
23310 configuration errors, and delivery is deferred. The variable
23311 &$mailstore_basename$& is available for use during these expansions.
23312
23313
23314 .section "Non-special new file delivery" "SECID138"
23315 If neither &%maildir_format%& nor &%mailstore_format%& is set, a single new
23316 file is created directly in the named directory. For example, when delivering
23317 messages into files in batched SMTP format for later delivery to some host (see
23318 section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&), a setting such as
23319 .code
23320 directory = /var/bsmtp/$host
23321 .endd
23322 might be used. A message is written to a file with a temporary name, which is
23323 then renamed when the delivery is complete. The final name is obtained by
23324 expanding the contents of the &%directory_file%& option.
23325 .ecindex IIDapptra1
23326 .ecindex IIDapptra2
23327
23328
23329
23330
23331
23332
23333 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23334 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23335
23336 .chapter "The autoreply transport" "CHID8"
23337 .scindex IIDauttra1 "transports" "&(autoreply)&"
23338 .scindex IIDauttra2 "&(autoreply)& transport"
23339 The &(autoreply)& transport is not a true transport in that it does not cause
23340 the message to be transmitted. Instead, it generates a new mail message as an
23341 automatic reply to the incoming message. &'References:'& and
23342 &'Auto-Submitted:'& header lines are included. These are constructed according
23343 to the rules in RFCs 2822 and 3834, respectively.
23344
23345 If the router that passes the message to this transport does not have the
23346 &%unseen%& option set, the original message (for the current recipient) is not
23347 delivered anywhere. However, when the &%unseen%& option is set on the router
23348 that passes the message to this transport, routing of the address continues, so
23349 another router can set up a normal message delivery.
23350
23351
23352 The &(autoreply)& transport is usually run as the result of mail filtering, a
23353 &"vacation"& message being the standard example. However, it can also be run
23354 directly from a router like any other transport. To reduce the possibility of
23355 message cascades, messages created by the &(autoreply)& transport always have
23356 empty envelope sender addresses, like bounce messages.
23357
23358 The parameters of the message to be sent can be specified in the configuration
23359 by options described below. However, these are used only when the address
23360 passed to the transport does not contain its own reply information. When the
23361 transport is run as a consequence of a
23362 &%mail%&
23363 or &%vacation%& command in a filter file, the parameters of the message are
23364 supplied by the filter, and passed with the address. The transport's options
23365 that define the message are then ignored (so they are not usually set in this
23366 case). The message is specified entirely by the filter or by the transport; it
23367 is never built from a mixture of options. However, the &%file_optional%&,
23368 &%mode%&, and &%return_message%& options apply in all cases.
23369
23370 &(Autoreply)& is implemented as a local transport. When used as a result of a
23371 command in a user's filter file, &(autoreply)& normally runs under the uid and
23372 gid of the user, and with appropriate current and home directories (see chapter
23373 &<<CHAPenvironment>>&).
23374
23375 There is a subtle difference between routing a message to a &(pipe)& transport
23376 that generates some text to be returned to the sender, and routing it to an
23377 &(autoreply)& transport. This difference is noticeable only if more than one
23378 address from the same message is so handled. In the case of a pipe, the
23379 separate outputs from the different addresses are gathered up and returned to
23380 the sender in a single message, whereas if &(autoreply)& is used, a separate
23381 message is generated for each address that is passed to it.
23382
23383 Non-printing characters are not permitted in the header lines generated for the
23384 message that &(autoreply)& creates, with the exception of newlines that are
23385 immediately followed by white space. If any non-printing characters are found,
23386 the transport defers.
23387 Whether characters with the top bit set count as printing characters or not is
23388 controlled by the &%print_topbitchars%& global option.
23389
23390 If any of the generic options for manipulating headers (for example,
23391 &%headers_add%&) are set on an &(autoreply)& transport, they apply to the copy
23392 of the original message that is included in the generated message when
23393 &%return_message%& is set. They do not apply to the generated message itself.
23394
23395 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
23396 If the &(autoreply)& transport receives return code 2 from Exim when it submits
23397 the message, indicating that there were no recipients, it does not treat this
23398 as an error. This means that autoreplies sent to &$sender_address$& when this
23399 is empty (because the incoming message is a bounce message) do not cause
23400 problems. They are just discarded.
23401
23402
23403
23404 .section "Private options for autoreply" "SECID139"
23405 .cindex "options" "&(autoreply)& transport"
23406
23407 .option bcc autoreply string&!! unset
23408 This specifies the addresses that are to receive &"blind carbon copies"& of the
23409 message when the message is specified by the transport.
23410
23411
23412 .option cc autoreply string&!! unset
23413 This specifies recipients of the message and the contents of the &'Cc:'& header
23414 when the message is specified by the transport.
23415
23416
23417 .option file autoreply string&!! unset
23418 The contents of the file are sent as the body of the message when the message
23419 is specified by the transport. If both &%file%& and &%text%& are set, the text
23420 string comes first.
23421
23422
23423 .option file_expand autoreply boolean false
23424 If this is set, the contents of the file named by the &%file%& option are
23425 subjected to string expansion as they are added to the message.
23426
23427
23428 .option file_optional autoreply boolean false
23429 If this option is true, no error is generated if the file named by the &%file%&
23430 option or passed with the address does not exist or cannot be read.
23431
23432
23433 .option from autoreply string&!! unset
23434 This specifies the contents of the &'From:'& header when the message is
23435 specified by the transport.
23436
23437
23438 .option headers autoreply string&!! unset
23439 This specifies additional RFC 2822 headers that are to be added to the message
23440 when the message is specified by the transport. Several can be given by using
23441 &"\n"& to separate them. There is no check on the format.
23442
23443
23444 .option log autoreply string&!! unset
23445 This option names a file in which a record of every message sent is logged when
23446 the message is specified by the transport.
23447
23448
23449 .option mode autoreply "octal integer" 0600
23450 If either the log file or the &"once"& file has to be created, this mode is
23451 used.
23452
23453
23454 .option never_mail autoreply "address list&!!" unset
23455 If any run of the transport creates a message with a recipient that matches any
23456 item in the list, that recipient is quietly discarded. If all recipients are
23457 discarded, no message is created. This applies both when the recipients are
23458 generated by a filter and when they are specified in the transport.
23459
23460
23461
23462 .option once autoreply string&!! unset
23463 This option names a file or DBM database in which a record of each &'To:'&
23464 recipient is kept when the message is specified by the transport. &*Note*&:
23465 This does not apply to &'Cc:'& or &'Bcc:'& recipients.
23466
23467 If &%once%& is unset, or is set to an empty string, the message is always sent.
23468 By default, if &%once%& is set to a non-empty filename, the message
23469 is not sent if a potential recipient is already listed in the database.
23470 However, if the &%once_repeat%& option specifies a time greater than zero, the
23471 message is sent if that much time has elapsed since a message was last sent to
23472 this recipient. A setting of zero time for &%once_repeat%& (the default)
23473 prevents a message from being sent a second time &-- in this case, zero means
23474 infinity.
23475
23476 If &%once_file_size%& is zero, a DBM database is used to remember recipients,
23477 and it is allowed to grow as large as necessary. If &%once_file_size%& is set
23478 greater than zero, it changes the way Exim implements the &%once%& option.
23479 Instead of using a DBM file to record every recipient it sends to, it uses a
23480 regular file, whose size will never get larger than the given value.
23481
23482 In the file, Exim keeps a linear list of recipient addresses and the times at
23483 which they were sent messages. If the file is full when a new address needs to
23484 be added, the oldest address is dropped. If &%once_repeat%& is not set, this
23485 means that a given recipient may receive multiple messages, but at
23486 unpredictable intervals that depend on the rate of turnover of addresses in the
23487 file. If &%once_repeat%& is set, it specifies a maximum time between repeats.
23488
23489
23490 .option once_file_size autoreply integer 0
23491 See &%once%& above.
23492
23493
23494 .option once_repeat autoreply time&!! 0s
23495 See &%once%& above.
23496 After expansion, the value of this option must be a valid time value.
23497
23498
23499 .option reply_to autoreply string&!! unset
23500 This specifies the contents of the &'Reply-To:'& header when the message is
23501 specified by the transport.
23502
23503
23504 .option return_message autoreply boolean false
23505 If this is set, a copy of the original message is returned with the new
23506 message, subject to the maximum size set in the &%return_size_limit%& global
23507 configuration option.
23508
23509
23510 .option subject autoreply string&!! unset
23511 This specifies the contents of the &'Subject:'& header when the message is
23512 specified by the transport. It is tempting to quote the original subject in
23513 automatic responses. For example:
23514 .code
23515 subject = Re: $h_subject:
23516 .endd
23517 There is a danger in doing this, however. It may allow a third party to
23518 subscribe your users to an opt-in mailing list, provided that the list accepts
23519 bounce messages as subscription confirmations. Well-managed lists require a
23520 non-bounce message to confirm a subscription, so the danger is relatively
23521 small.
23522
23523
23524
23525 .option text autoreply string&!! unset
23526 This specifies a single string to be used as the body of the message when the
23527 message is specified by the transport. If both &%text%& and &%file%& are set,
23528 the text comes first.
23529
23530
23531 .option to autoreply string&!! unset
23532 This specifies recipients of the message and the contents of the &'To:'& header
23533 when the message is specified by the transport.
23534 .ecindex IIDauttra1
23535 .ecindex IIDauttra2
23536
23537
23538
23539
23540 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23541 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23542
23543 .chapter "The lmtp transport" "CHAPLMTP"
23544 .cindex "transports" "&(lmtp)&"
23545 .cindex "&(lmtp)& transport"
23546 .cindex "LMTP" "over a pipe"
23547 .cindex "LMTP" "over a socket"
23548 The &(lmtp)& transport runs the LMTP protocol (RFC 2033) over a pipe to a
23549 specified command
23550 or by interacting with a Unix domain socket.
23551 This transport is something of a cross between the &(pipe)& and &(smtp)&
23552 transports. Exim also has support for using LMTP over TCP/IP; this is
23553 implemented as an option for the &(smtp)& transport. Because LMTP is expected
23554 to be of minority interest, the default build-time configure in &_src/EDITME_&
23555 has it commented out. You need to ensure that
23556 .code
23557 TRANSPORT_LMTP=yes
23558 .endd
23559 .cindex "options" "&(lmtp)& transport"
23560 is present in your &_Local/Makefile_& in order to have the &(lmtp)& transport
23561 included in the Exim binary. The private options of the &(lmtp)& transport are
23562 as follows:
23563
23564 .option batch_id lmtp string&!! unset
23565 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
23566
23567
23568 .option batch_max lmtp integer 1
23569 This limits the number of addresses that can be handled in a single delivery.
23570 Most LMTP servers can handle several addresses at once, so it is normally a
23571 good idea to increase this value. See the description of local delivery
23572 batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
23573
23574
23575 .option command lmtp string&!! unset
23576 This option must be set if &%socket%& is not set. The string is a command which
23577 is run in a separate process. It is split up into a command name and list of
23578 arguments, each of which is separately expanded (so expansion cannot change the
23579 number of arguments). The command is run directly, not via a shell. The message
23580 is passed to the new process using the standard input and output to operate the
23581 LMTP protocol.
23582
23583 .option ignore_quota lmtp boolean false
23584 .cindex "LMTP" "ignoring quota errors"
23585 If this option is set true, the string &`IGNOREQUOTA`& is added to RCPT
23586 commands, provided that the LMTP server has advertised support for IGNOREQUOTA
23587 in its response to the LHLO command.
23588
23589 .option socket lmtp string&!! unset
23590 This option must be set if &%command%& is not set. The result of expansion must
23591 be the name of a Unix domain socket. The transport connects to the socket and
23592 delivers the message to it using the LMTP protocol.
23593
23594
23595 .option timeout lmtp time 5m
23596 The transport is aborted if the created process or Unix domain socket does not
23597 respond to LMTP commands or message input within this timeout. Delivery
23598 is deferred, and will be tried again later. Here is an example of a typical
23599 LMTP transport:
23600 .code
23601 lmtp:
23602 driver = lmtp
23603 command = /some/local/lmtp/delivery/program
23604 batch_max = 20
23605 user = exim
23606 .endd
23607 This delivers up to 20 addresses at a time, in a mixture of domains if
23608 necessary, running as the user &'exim'&.
23609
23610
23611
23612 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23613 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23614
23615 .chapter "The pipe transport" "CHAPpipetransport"
23616 .scindex IIDpiptra1 "transports" "&(pipe)&"
23617 .scindex IIDpiptra2 "&(pipe)& transport"
23618 The &(pipe)& transport is used to deliver messages via a pipe to a command
23619 running in another process. One example is the use of &(pipe)& as a
23620 pseudo-remote transport for passing messages to some other delivery mechanism
23621 (such as UUCP). Another is the use by individual users to automatically process
23622 their incoming messages. The &(pipe)& transport can be used in one of the
23623 following ways:
23624
23625 .ilist
23626 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
23627 A router routes one address to a transport in the normal way, and the
23628 transport is configured as a &(pipe)& transport. In this case, &$local_part$&
23629 contains the local part of the address (as usual), and the command that is run
23630 is specified by the &%command%& option on the transport.
23631 .next
23632 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
23633 If the &%batch_max%& option is set greater than 1 (the default is 1), the
23634 transport can handle more than one address in a single run. In this case, when
23635 more than one address is routed to the transport, &$local_part$& is not set
23636 (because it is not unique). However, the pseudo-variable &$pipe_addresses$&
23637 (described in section &<<SECThowcommandrun>>& below) contains all the addresses
23638 that are routed to the transport.
23639 .next
23640 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
23641 A router redirects an address directly to a pipe command (for example, from an
23642 alias or forward file). In this case, &$address_pipe$& contains the text of the
23643 pipe command, and the &%command%& option on the transport is ignored unless
23644 &%force_command%& is set. If only one address is being transported
23645 (&%batch_max%& is not greater than one, or only one address was redirected to
23646 this pipe command), &$local_part$& contains the local part that was redirected.
23647 .endlist
23648
23649
23650 The &(pipe)& transport is a non-interactive delivery method. Exim can also
23651 deliver messages over pipes using the LMTP interactive protocol. This is
23652 implemented by the &(lmtp)& transport.
23653
23654 In the case when &(pipe)& is run as a consequence of an entry in a local user's
23655 &_.forward_& file, the command runs under the uid and gid of that user. In
23656 other cases, the uid and gid have to be specified explicitly, either on the
23657 transport or on the router that handles the address. Current and &"home"&
23658 directories are also controllable. See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for
23659 details of the local delivery environment and chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&
23660 for a discussion of local delivery batching.
23661
23662
23663 .section "Concurrent delivery" "SECID140"
23664 If two messages arrive at almost the same time, and both are routed to a pipe
23665 delivery, the two pipe transports may be run concurrently. You must ensure that
23666 any pipe commands you set up are robust against this happening. If the commands
23667 write to a file, the &%exim_lock%& utility might be of use.
23668 Alternatively the &%max_parallel%& option could be used with a value
23669 of "1" to enforce serialization.
23670
23671
23672
23673
23674 .section "Returned status and data" "SECID141"
23675 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "returned data"
23676 If the command exits with a non-zero return code, the delivery is deemed to
23677 have failed, unless either the &%ignore_status%& option is set (in which case
23678 the return code is treated as zero), or the return code is one of those listed
23679 in the &%temp_errors%& option, which are interpreted as meaning &"try again
23680 later"&. In this case, delivery is deferred. Details of a permanent failure are
23681 logged, but are not included in the bounce message, which merely contains
23682 &"local delivery failed"&.
23683
23684 If the command exits on a signal and the &%freeze_signal%& option is set then
23685 the message will be frozen in the queue. If that option is not set, a bounce
23686 will be sent as normal.
23687
23688 If the return code is greater than 128 and the command being run is a shell
23689 script, it normally means that the script was terminated by a signal whose
23690 value is the return code minus 128. The &%freeze_signal%& option does not
23691 apply in this case.
23692
23693 If Exim is unable to run the command (that is, if &[execve()]& fails), the
23694 return code is set to 127. This is the value that a shell returns if it is
23695 asked to run a non-existent command. The wording for the log line suggests that
23696 a non-existent command may be the problem.
23697
23698 The &%return_output%& option can affect the result of a pipe delivery. If it is
23699 set and the command produces any output on its standard output or standard
23700 error streams, the command is considered to have failed, even if it gave a zero
23701 return code or if &%ignore_status%& is set. The output from the command is
23702 included as part of the bounce message. The &%return_fail_output%& option is
23703 similar, except that output is returned only when the command exits with a
23704 failure return code, that is, a value other than zero or a code that matches
23705 &%temp_errors%&.
23706
23707
23708
23709 .section "How the command is run" "SECThowcommandrun"
23710 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "path for command"
23711 The command line is (by default) broken down into a command name and arguments
23712 by the &(pipe)& transport itself. The &%allow_commands%& and
23713 &%restrict_to_path%& options can be used to restrict the commands that may be
23714 run.
23715
23716 .cindex "quoting" "in pipe command"
23717 Unquoted arguments are delimited by white space. If an argument appears in
23718 double quotes, backslash is interpreted as an escape character in the usual
23719 way. If an argument appears in single quotes, no escaping is done.
23720
23721 String expansion is applied to the command line except when it comes from a
23722 traditional &_.forward_& file (commands from a filter file are expanded). The
23723 expansion is applied to each argument in turn rather than to the whole line.
23724 For this reason, any string expansion item that contains white space must be
23725 quoted so as to be contained within a single argument. A setting such as
23726 .code
23727 command = /some/path ${if eq{$local_part}{postmaster}{xx}{yy}}
23728 .endd
23729 will not work, because the expansion item gets split between several
23730 arguments. You have to write
23731 .code
23732 command = /some/path "${if eq{$local_part}{postmaster}{xx}{yy}}"
23733 .endd
23734 to ensure that it is all in one argument. The expansion is done in this way,
23735 argument by argument, so that the number of arguments cannot be changed as a
23736 result of expansion, and quotes or backslashes in inserted variables do not
23737 interact with external quoting. However, this leads to problems if you want to
23738 generate multiple arguments (or the command name plus arguments) from a single
23739 expansion. In this situation, the simplest solution is to use a shell. For
23740 example:
23741 .code
23742 command = /bin/sh -c ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/some/file}}
23743 .endd
23744
23745 .cindex "transport" "filter"
23746 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
23747 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
23748 Special handling takes place when an argument consists of precisely the text
23749 &`$pipe_addresses`& (no quotes).
23750 This is not a general expansion variable; the only
23751 place this string is recognized is when it appears as an argument for a pipe or
23752 transport filter command. It causes each address that is being handled to be
23753 inserted in the argument list at that point &'as a separate argument'&. This
23754 avoids any problems with spaces or shell metacharacters, and is of use when a
23755 &(pipe)& transport is handling groups of addresses in a batch.
23756
23757 If &%force_command%& is enabled on the transport, special handling takes place
23758 for an argument that consists of precisely the text &`$address_pipe`&. It
23759 is handled similarly to &$pipe_addresses$& above. It is expanded and each
23760 argument is inserted in the argument list at that point
23761 &'as a separate argument'&. The &`$address_pipe`& item does not need to be
23762 the only item in the argument; in fact, if it were then &%force_command%&
23763 should behave as a no-op. Rather, it should be used to adjust the command
23764 run while preserving the argument vector separation.
23765
23766 After splitting up into arguments and expansion, the resulting command is run
23767 in a subprocess directly from the transport, &'not'& under a shell. The
23768 message that is being delivered is supplied on the standard input, and the
23769 standard output and standard error are both connected to a single pipe that is
23770 read by Exim. The &%max_output%& option controls how much output the command
23771 may produce, and the &%return_output%& and &%return_fail_output%& options
23772 control what is done with it.
23773
23774 Not running the command under a shell (by default) lessens the security risks
23775 in cases when a command from a user's filter file is built out of data that was
23776 taken from an incoming message. If a shell is required, it can of course be
23777 explicitly specified as the command to be run. However, there are circumstances
23778 where existing commands (for example, in &_.forward_& files) expect to be run
23779 under a shell and cannot easily be modified. To allow for these cases, there is
23780 an option called &%use_shell%&, which changes the way the &(pipe)& transport
23781 works. Instead of breaking up the command line as just described, it expands it
23782 as a single string and passes the result to &_/bin/sh_&. The
23783 &%restrict_to_path%& option and the &$pipe_addresses$& facility cannot be used
23784 with &%use_shell%&, and the whole mechanism is inherently less secure.
23785
23786
23787
23788 .section "Environment variables" "SECTpipeenv"
23789 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "environment for command"
23790 .cindex "environment" "&(pipe)& transport"
23791 The environment variables listed below are set up when the command is invoked.
23792 This list is a compromise for maximum compatibility with other MTAs. Note that
23793 the &%environment%& option can be used to add additional variables to this
23794 environment. The environment for the &(pipe)& transport is not subject
23795 to the &%add_environment%& and &%keep_environment%& main config options.
23796 .display
23797 &`DOMAIN `& the domain of the address
23798 &`HOME `& the home directory, if set
23799 &`HOST `& the host name when called from a router (see below)
23800 &`LOCAL_PART `& see below
23801 &`LOCAL_PART_PREFIX `& see below
23802 &`LOCAL_PART_SUFFIX `& see below
23803 &`LOGNAME `& see below
23804 &`MESSAGE_ID `& Exim's local ID for the message
23805 &`PATH `& as specified by the &%path%& option below
23806 &`QUALIFY_DOMAIN `& the sender qualification domain
23807 &`RECIPIENT `& the complete recipient address
23808 &`SENDER `& the sender of the message (empty if a bounce)
23809 &`SHELL `& &`/bin/sh`&
23810 &`TZ `& the value of the &%timezone%& option, if set
23811 &`USER `& see below
23812 .endd
23813 When a &(pipe)& transport is called directly from (for example) an &(accept)&
23814 router, LOCAL_PART is set to the local part of the address. When it is
23815 called as a result of a forward or alias expansion, LOCAL_PART is set to
23816 the local part of the address that was expanded. In both cases, any affixes are
23817 removed from the local part, and made available in LOCAL_PART_PREFIX and
23818 LOCAL_PART_SUFFIX, respectively. LOGNAME and USER are set to the
23819 same value as LOCAL_PART for compatibility with other MTAs.
23820
23821 .cindex "HOST"
23822 HOST is set only when a &(pipe)& transport is called from a router that
23823 associates hosts with an address, typically when using &(pipe)& as a
23824 pseudo-remote transport. HOST is set to the first host name specified by
23825 the router.
23826
23827 .cindex "HOME"
23828 If the transport's generic &%home_directory%& option is set, its value is used
23829 for the HOME environment variable. Otherwise, a home directory may be set
23830 by the router's &%transport_home_directory%& option, which defaults to the
23831 user's home directory if &%check_local_user%& is set.
23832
23833
23834 .section "Private options for pipe" "SECID142"
23835 .cindex "options" "&(pipe)& transport"
23836
23837
23838
23839 .option allow_commands pipe "string list&!!" unset
23840 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "permitted commands"
23841 The string is expanded, and is then interpreted as a colon-separated list of
23842 permitted commands. If &%restrict_to_path%& is not set, the only commands
23843 permitted are those in the &%allow_commands%& list. They need not be absolute
23844 paths; the &%path%& option is still used for relative paths. If
23845 &%restrict_to_path%& is set with &%allow_commands%&, the command must either be
23846 in the &%allow_commands%& list, or a name without any slashes that is found on
23847 the path. In other words, if neither &%allow_commands%& nor
23848 &%restrict_to_path%& is set, there is no restriction on the command, but
23849 otherwise only commands that are permitted by one or the other are allowed. For
23850 example, if
23851 .code
23852 allow_commands = /usr/bin/vacation
23853 .endd
23854 and &%restrict_to_path%& is not set, the only permitted command is
23855 &_/usr/bin/vacation_&. The &%allow_commands%& option may not be set if
23856 &%use_shell%& is set.
23857
23858
23859 .option batch_id pipe string&!! unset
23860 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
23861
23862
23863 .option batch_max pipe integer 1
23864 This limits the number of addresses that can be handled in a single delivery.
23865 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
23866
23867
23868 .option check_string pipe string unset
23869 As &(pipe)& writes the message, the start of each line is tested for matching
23870 &%check_string%&, and if it does, the initial matching characters are replaced
23871 by the contents of &%escape_string%&, provided both are set. The value of
23872 &%check_string%& is a literal string, not a regular expression, and the case of
23873 any letters it contains is significant. When &%use_bsmtp%& is set, the contents
23874 of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& are forced to values that implement
23875 the SMTP escaping protocol. Any settings made in the configuration file are
23876 ignored.
23877
23878
23879 .option command pipe string&!! unset
23880 This option need not be set when &(pipe)& is being used to deliver to pipes
23881 obtained directly from address redirections. In other cases, the option must be
23882 set, to provide a command to be run. It need not yield an absolute path (see
23883 the &%path%& option below). The command is split up into separate arguments by
23884 Exim, and each argument is separately expanded, as described in section
23885 &<<SECThowcommandrun>>& above.
23886
23887
23888 .option environment pipe string&!! unset
23889 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "environment for command"
23890 .cindex "environment" "&(pipe)& transport"
23891 This option is used to add additional variables to the environment in which the
23892 command runs (see section &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for the default list). Its value is
23893 a string which is expanded, and then interpreted as a colon-separated list of
23894 environment settings of the form <&'name'&>=<&'value'&>.
23895
23896
23897 .option escape_string pipe string unset
23898 See &%check_string%& above.
23899
23900
23901 .option freeze_exec_fail pipe boolean false
23902 .cindex "exec failure"
23903 .cindex "failure of exec"
23904 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "failure of exec"
23905 Failure to exec the command in a pipe transport is by default treated like
23906 any other failure while running the command. However, if &%freeze_exec_fail%&
23907 is set, failure to exec is treated specially, and causes the message to be
23908 frozen, whatever the setting of &%ignore_status%&.
23909
23910
23911 .option freeze_signal pipe boolean false
23912 .cindex "signal exit"
23913 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport", "signal exit"
23914 Normally if the process run by a command in a pipe transport exits on a signal,
23915 a bounce message is sent. If &%freeze_signal%& is set, the message will be
23916 frozen in Exim's queue instead.
23917
23918
23919 .option force_command pipe boolean false
23920 .cindex "force command"
23921 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport", "force command"
23922 Normally when a router redirects an address directly to a pipe command
23923 the &%command%& option on the transport is ignored. If &%force_command%&
23924 is set, the &%command%& option will used. This is especially
23925 useful for forcing a wrapper or additional argument to be added to the
23926 command. For example:
23927 .code
23928 command = /usr/bin/remote_exec myhost -- $address_pipe
23929 force_command
23930 .endd
23931
23932 Note that &$address_pipe$& is handled specially in &%command%& when
23933 &%force_command%& is set, expanding out to the original argument vector as
23934 separate items, similarly to a Unix shell &`"$@"`& construct.
23935
23936
23937 .option ignore_status pipe boolean false
23938 If this option is true, the status returned by the subprocess that is set up to
23939 run the command is ignored, and Exim behaves as if zero had been returned.
23940 Otherwise, a non-zero status or termination by signal causes an error return
23941 from the transport unless the status value is one of those listed in
23942 &%temp_errors%&; these cause the delivery to be deferred and tried again later.
23943
23944 &*Note*&: This option does not apply to timeouts, which do not return a status.
23945 See the &%timeout_defer%& option for how timeouts are handled.
23946
23947
23948 .option log_defer_output pipe boolean false
23949 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "logging output"
23950 If this option is set, and the status returned by the command is
23951 one of the codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that is, delivery was deferred),
23952 and any output was produced on stdout or stderr, the first line of it is
23953 written to the main log.
23954
23955
23956 .option log_fail_output pipe boolean false
23957 If this option is set, and the command returns any output on stdout or
23958 stderr, and also ends with a return code that is neither zero nor one of
23959 the return codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that is, the delivery
23960 failed), the first line of output is written to the main log. This
23961 option and &%log_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one of them may
23962 be set.
23963
23964
23965 .option log_output pipe boolean false
23966 If this option is set and the command returns any output on stdout or
23967 stderr, the first line of output is written to the main log, whatever
23968 the return code. This option and &%log_fail_output%& are mutually
23969 exclusive. Only one of them may be set.
23970
23971
23972 .option max_output pipe integer 20K
23973 This specifies the maximum amount of output that the command may produce on its
23974 standard output and standard error file combined. If the limit is exceeded, the
23975 process running the command is killed. This is intended as a safety measure to
23976 catch runaway processes. The limit is applied independently of the settings of
23977 the options that control what is done with such output (for example,
23978 &%return_output%&). Because of buffering effects, the amount of output may
23979 exceed the limit by a small amount before Exim notices.
23980
23981
23982 .option message_prefix pipe string&!! "see below"
23983 The string specified here is expanded and output at the start of every message.
23984 The default is unset if &%use_bsmtp%& is set. Otherwise it is
23985 .code
23986 message_prefix = \
23987 From ${if def:return_path{$return_path}{MAILER-DAEMON}}\
23988 ${tod_bsdinbox}\n
23989 .endd
23990 .cindex "Cyrus"
23991 .cindex "&%tmail%&"
23992 .cindex "&""From""& line"
23993 This is required by the commonly used &_/usr/bin/vacation_& program.
23994 However, it must &'not'& be present if delivery is to the Cyrus IMAP server,
23995 or to the &%tmail%& local delivery agent. The prefix can be suppressed by
23996 setting
23997 .code
23998 message_prefix =
23999 .endd
24000 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
24001 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_prefix%&.
24002
24003
24004 .option message_suffix pipe string&!! "see below"
24005 The string specified here is expanded and output at the end of every message.
24006 The default is unset if &%use_bsmtp%& is set. Otherwise it is a single newline.
24007 The suffix can be suppressed by setting
24008 .code
24009 message_suffix =
24010 .endd
24011 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
24012 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_suffix%&.
24013
24014
24015 .option path pipe string&!! "/bin:/usr/bin"
24016 This option is expanded and
24017 specifies the string that is set up in the PATH environment
24018 variable of the subprocess.
24019 If the &%command%& option does not yield an absolute path name, the command is
24020 sought in the PATH directories, in the usual way. &*Warning*&: This does not
24021 apply to a command specified as a transport filter.
24022
24023
24024 .option permit_coredump pipe boolean false
24025 Normally Exim inhibits core-dumps during delivery. If you have a need to get
24026 a core-dump of a pipe command, enable this command. This enables core-dumps
24027 during delivery and affects both the Exim binary and the pipe command run.
24028 It is recommended that this option remain off unless and until you have a need
24029 for it and that this only be enabled when needed, as the risk of excessive
24030 resource consumption can be quite high. Note also that Exim is typically
24031 installed as a setuid binary and most operating systems will inhibit coredumps
24032 of these by default, so further OS-specific action may be required.
24033
24034
24035 .option pipe_as_creator pipe boolean false
24036 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
24037 If the generic &%user%& option is not set and this option is true, the delivery
24038 process is run under the uid that was in force when Exim was originally called
24039 to accept the message. If the group id is not otherwise set (via the generic
24040 &%group%& option), the gid that was in force when Exim was originally called to
24041 accept the message is used.
24042
24043
24044 .option restrict_to_path pipe boolean false
24045 When this option is set, any command name not listed in &%allow_commands%& must
24046 contain no slashes. The command is searched for only in the directories listed
24047 in the &%path%& option. This option is intended for use in the case when a pipe
24048 command has been generated from a user's &_.forward_& file. This is usually
24049 handled by a &(pipe)& transport called &%address_pipe%&.
24050
24051
24052 .option return_fail_output pipe boolean false
24053 If this option is true, and the command produced any output and ended with a
24054 return code other than zero or one of the codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that
24055 is, the delivery failed), the output is returned in the bounce message.
24056 However, if the message has a null sender (that is, it is itself a bounce
24057 message), output from the command is discarded. This option and
24058 &%return_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one of them may be set.
24059
24060
24061
24062 .option return_output pipe boolean false
24063 If this option is true, and the command produced any output, the delivery is
24064 deemed to have failed whatever the return code from the command, and the output
24065 is returned in the bounce message. Otherwise, the output is just discarded.
24066 However, if the message has a null sender (that is, it is a bounce message),
24067 output from the command is always discarded, whatever the setting of this
24068 option. This option and &%return_fail_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one
24069 of them may be set.
24070
24071
24072
24073 .option temp_errors pipe "string list" "see below"
24074 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "temporary failure"
24075 This option contains either a colon-separated list of numbers, or a single
24076 asterisk. If &%ignore_status%& is false
24077 and &%return_output%& is not set,
24078 and the command exits with a non-zero return code, the failure is treated as
24079 temporary and the delivery is deferred if the return code matches one of the
24080 numbers, or if the setting is a single asterisk. Otherwise, non-zero return
24081 codes are treated as permanent errors. The default setting contains the codes
24082 defined by EX_TEMPFAIL and EX_CANTCREAT in &_sysexits.h_&. If Exim is
24083 compiled on a system that does not define these macros, it assumes values of 75
24084 and 73, respectively.
24085
24086
24087 .option timeout pipe time 1h
24088 If the command fails to complete within this time, it is killed. This normally
24089 causes the delivery to fail (but see &%timeout_defer%&). A zero time interval
24090 specifies no timeout. In order to ensure that any subprocesses created by the
24091 command are also killed, Exim makes the initial process a process group leader,
24092 and kills the whole process group on a timeout. However, this can be defeated
24093 if one of the processes starts a new process group.
24094
24095 .option timeout_defer pipe boolean false
24096 A timeout in a &(pipe)& transport, either in the command that the transport
24097 runs, or in a transport filter that is associated with it, is by default
24098 treated as a hard error, and the delivery fails. However, if &%timeout_defer%&
24099 is set true, both kinds of timeout become temporary errors, causing the
24100 delivery to be deferred.
24101
24102 .option umask pipe "octal integer" 022
24103 This specifies the umask setting for the subprocess that runs the command.
24104
24105
24106 .option use_bsmtp pipe boolean false
24107 .cindex "envelope sender"
24108 If this option is set true, the &(pipe)& transport writes messages in &"batch
24109 SMTP"& format, with the envelope sender and recipient(s) included as SMTP
24110 commands. If you want to include a leading HELO command with such messages,
24111 you can do so by setting the &%message_prefix%& option. See section
24112 &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>& for details of batch SMTP.
24113
24114 .option use_classresources pipe boolean false
24115 .cindex "class resources (BSD)"
24116 This option is available only when Exim is running on FreeBSD, NetBSD, or
24117 BSD/OS. If it is set true, the &[setclassresources()]& function is used to set
24118 resource limits when a &(pipe)& transport is run to perform a delivery. The
24119 limits for the uid under which the pipe is to run are obtained from the login
24120 class database.
24121
24122
24123 .option use_crlf pipe boolean false
24124 .cindex "carriage return"
24125 .cindex "linefeed"
24126 This option causes lines to be terminated with the two-character CRLF sequence
24127 (carriage return, linefeed) instead of just a linefeed character. In the case
24128 of batched SMTP, the byte sequence written to the pipe is then an exact image
24129 of what would be sent down a real SMTP connection.
24130
24131 The contents of the &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options are
24132 written verbatim, so must contain their own carriage return characters if these
24133 are needed. When &%use_bsmtp%& is not set, the default values for both
24134 &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& end with a single linefeed, so their
24135 values must be changed to end with &`\r\n`& if &%use_crlf%& is set.
24136
24137
24138 .option use_shell pipe boolean false
24139 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
24140 If this option is set, it causes the command to be passed to &_/bin/sh_&
24141 instead of being run directly from the transport, as described in section
24142 &<<SECThowcommandrun>>&. This is less secure, but is needed in some situations
24143 where the command is expected to be run under a shell and cannot easily be
24144 modified. The &%allow_commands%& and &%restrict_to_path%& options, and the
24145 &`$pipe_addresses`& facility are incompatible with &%use_shell%&. The
24146 command is expanded as a single string, and handed to &_/bin/sh_& as data for
24147 its &%-c%& option.
24148
24149
24150
24151 .section "Using an external local delivery agent" "SECID143"
24152 .cindex "local delivery" "using an external agent"
24153 .cindex "&'procmail'&"
24154 .cindex "external local delivery"
24155 .cindex "delivery" "&'procmail'&"
24156 .cindex "delivery" "by external agent"
24157 The &(pipe)& transport can be used to pass all messages that require local
24158 delivery to a separate local delivery agent such as &%procmail%&. When doing
24159 this, care must be taken to ensure that the pipe is run under an appropriate
24160 uid and gid. In some configurations one wants this to be a uid that is trusted
24161 by the delivery agent to supply the correct sender of the message. It may be
24162 necessary to recompile or reconfigure the delivery agent so that it trusts an
24163 appropriate user. The following is an example transport and router
24164 configuration for &%procmail%&:
24165 .code
24166 # transport
24167 procmail_pipe:
24168 driver = pipe
24169 command = /usr/local/bin/procmail -d $local_part
24170 return_path_add
24171 delivery_date_add
24172 envelope_to_add
24173 check_string = "From "
24174 escape_string = ">From "
24175 umask = 077
24176 user = $local_part
24177 group = mail
24178
24179 # router
24180 procmail:
24181 driver = accept
24182 check_local_user
24183 transport = procmail_pipe
24184 .endd
24185 In this example, the pipe is run as the local user, but with the group set to
24186 &'mail'&. An alternative is to run the pipe as a specific user such as &'mail'&
24187 or &'exim'&, but in this case you must arrange for &%procmail%& to trust that
24188 user to supply a correct sender address. If you do not specify either a
24189 &%group%& or a &%user%& option, the pipe command is run as the local user. The
24190 home directory is the user's home directory by default.
24191
24192 &*Note*&: The command that the pipe transport runs does &'not'& begin with
24193 .code
24194 IFS=" "
24195 .endd
24196 as shown in some &%procmail%& documentation, because Exim does not by default
24197 use a shell to run pipe commands.
24198
24199 .cindex "Cyrus"
24200 The next example shows a transport and a router for a system where local
24201 deliveries are handled by the Cyrus IMAP server.
24202 .code
24203 # transport
24204 local_delivery_cyrus:
24205 driver = pipe
24206 command = /usr/cyrus/bin/deliver \
24207 -m ${substr_1:$local_part_suffix} -- $local_part
24208 user = cyrus
24209 group = mail
24210 return_output
24211 log_output
24212 message_prefix =
24213 message_suffix =
24214
24215 # router
24216 local_user_cyrus:
24217 driver = accept
24218 check_local_user
24219 local_part_suffix = .*
24220 transport = local_delivery_cyrus
24221 .endd
24222 Note the unsetting of &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%&, and the use of
24223 &%return_output%& to cause any text written by Cyrus to be returned to the
24224 sender.
24225 .ecindex IIDpiptra1
24226 .ecindex IIDpiptra2
24227
24228
24229 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24230 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24231
24232 .chapter "The smtp transport" "CHAPsmtptrans"
24233 .scindex IIDsmttra1 "transports" "&(smtp)&"
24234 .scindex IIDsmttra2 "&(smtp)& transport"
24235 The &(smtp)& transport delivers messages over TCP/IP connections using the SMTP
24236 or LMTP protocol. The list of hosts to try can either be taken from the address
24237 that is being processed (having been set up by the router), or specified
24238 explicitly for the transport. Timeout and retry processing (see chapter
24239 &<<CHAPretry>>&) is applied to each IP address independently.
24240
24241
24242 .section "Multiple messages on a single connection" "SECID144"
24243 The sending of multiple messages over a single TCP/IP connection can arise in
24244 two ways:
24245
24246 .ilist
24247 If a message contains more than &%max_rcpt%& (see below) addresses that are
24248 routed to the same host, more than one copy of the message has to be sent to
24249 that host. In this situation, multiple copies may be sent in a single run of
24250 the &(smtp)& transport over a single TCP/IP connection. (What Exim actually
24251 does when it has too many addresses to send in one message also depends on the
24252 value of the global &%remote_max_parallel%& option. Details are given in
24253 section &<<SECToutSMTPTCP>>&.)
24254 .next
24255 .cindex "hints database" "remembering routing"
24256 When a message has been successfully delivered over a TCP/IP connection, Exim
24257 looks in its hints database to see if there are any other messages awaiting a
24258 connection to the same host. If there are, a new delivery process is started
24259 for one of them, and the current TCP/IP connection is passed on to it. The new
24260 process may in turn send multiple copies and possibly create yet another
24261 process.
24262 .endlist
24263
24264
24265 For each copy sent over the same TCP/IP connection, a sequence counter is
24266 incremented, and if it ever gets to the value of &%connection_max_messages%&,
24267 no further messages are sent over that connection.
24268
24269
24270
24271 .section "Use of the $host and $host_address variables" "SECID145"
24272 .vindex "&$host$&"
24273 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
24274 At the start of a run of the &(smtp)& transport, the values of &$host$& and
24275 &$host_address$& are the name and IP address of the first host on the host list
24276 passed by the router. However, when the transport is about to connect to a
24277 specific host, and while it is connected to that host, &$host$& and
24278 &$host_address$& are set to the values for that host. These are the values
24279 that are in force when the &%helo_data%&, &%hosts_try_auth%&, &%interface%&,
24280 &%serialize_hosts%&, and the various TLS options are expanded.
24281
24282
24283 .section "Use of $tls_cipher and $tls_peerdn" "usecippeer"
24284 .vindex &$tls_bits$&
24285 .vindex &$tls_cipher$&
24286 .vindex &$tls_peerdn$&
24287 .vindex &$tls_sni$&
24288 At the start of a run of the &(smtp)& transport, the values of &$tls_bits$&,
24289 &$tls_cipher$&, &$tls_peerdn$& and &$tls_sni$&
24290 are the values that were set when the message was received.
24291 These are the values that are used for options that are expanded before any
24292 SMTP connections are made. Just before each connection is made, these four
24293 variables are emptied. If TLS is subsequently started, they are set to the
24294 appropriate values for the outgoing connection, and these are the values that
24295 are in force when any authenticators are run and when the
24296 &%authenticated_sender%& option is expanded.
24297
24298 These variables are deprecated in favour of &$tls_in_cipher$& et. al.
24299 and will be removed in a future release.
24300
24301
24302 .section "Private options for smtp" "SECID146"
24303 .cindex "options" "&(smtp)& transport"
24304 The private options of the &(smtp)& transport are as follows:
24305
24306
24307 .option address_retry_include_sender smtp boolean true
24308 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "retrying after"
24309 When an address is delayed because of a 4&'xx'& response to a RCPT command, it
24310 is the combination of sender and recipient that is delayed in subsequent queue
24311 runs until the retry time is reached. You can delay the recipient without
24312 reference to the sender (which is what earlier versions of Exim did), by
24313 setting &%address_retry_include_sender%& false. However, this can lead to
24314 problems with servers that regularly issue 4&'xx'& responses to RCPT commands.
24315
24316 .option allow_localhost smtp boolean false
24317 .cindex "local host" "sending to"
24318 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on transport"
24319 When a host specified in &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& (see below) turns out
24320 to be the local host, or is listed in &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, delivery is
24321 deferred by default. However, if &%allow_localhost%& is set, Exim goes on to do
24322 the delivery anyway. This should be used only in special cases when the
24323 configuration ensures that no looping will result (for example, a differently
24324 configured Exim is listening on the port to which the message is sent).
24325
24326
24327 .option authenticated_sender smtp string&!! unset
24328 .cindex "Cyrus"
24329 When Exim has authenticated as a client, or if &%authenticated_sender_force%&
24330 is true, this option sets a value for the AUTH= item on outgoing MAIL commands,
24331 overriding any existing authenticated sender value. If the string expansion is
24332 forced to fail, the option is ignored. Other expansion failures cause delivery
24333 to be deferred. If the result of expansion is an empty string, that is also
24334 ignored.
24335
24336 The expansion happens after the outgoing connection has been made and TLS
24337 started, if required. This means that the &$host$&, &$host_address$&,
24338 &$tls_out_cipher$&, and &$tls_out_peerdn$& variables are set according to the
24339 particular connection.
24340
24341 If the SMTP session is not authenticated, the expansion of
24342 &%authenticated_sender%& still happens (and can cause the delivery to be
24343 deferred if it fails), but no AUTH= item is added to MAIL commands
24344 unless &%authenticated_sender_force%& is true.
24345
24346 This option allows you to use the &(smtp)& transport in LMTP mode to
24347 deliver mail to Cyrus IMAP and provide the proper local part as the
24348 &"authenticated sender"&, via a setting such as:
24349 .code
24350 authenticated_sender = $local_part
24351 .endd
24352 This removes the need for IMAP subfolders to be assigned special ACLs to
24353 allow direct delivery to those subfolders.
24354
24355 Because of expected uses such as that just described for Cyrus (when no
24356 domain is involved), there is no checking on the syntax of the provided
24357 value.
24358
24359
24360 .option authenticated_sender_force smtp boolean false
24361 If this option is set true, the &%authenticated_sender%& option's value
24362 is used for the AUTH= item on outgoing MAIL commands, even if Exim has not
24363 authenticated as a client.
24364
24365
24366 .option command_timeout smtp time 5m
24367 This sets a timeout for receiving a response to an SMTP command that has been
24368 sent out. It is also used when waiting for the initial banner line from the
24369 remote host. Its value must not be zero.
24370
24371
24372 .option connect_timeout smtp time 5m
24373 This sets a timeout for the &[connect()]& function, which sets up a TCP/IP call
24374 to a remote host. A setting of zero allows the system timeout (typically
24375 several minutes) to act. To have any effect, the value of this option must be
24376 less than the system timeout. However, it has been observed that on some
24377 systems there is no system timeout, which is why the default value for this
24378 option is 5 minutes, a value recommended by RFC 1123.
24379
24380
24381 .option connection_max_messages smtp integer 500
24382 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
24383 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
24384 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
24385 This controls the maximum number of separate message deliveries that are sent
24386 over a single TCP/IP connection. If the value is zero, there is no limit.
24387 For testing purposes, this value can be overridden by the &%-oB%& command line
24388 option.
24389
24390
24391 .option dane_require_tls_ciphers smtp string&!! unset
24392 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers for DANE"
24393 .cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
24394 .cindex DANE "TLS ciphers"
24395 This option may be used to override &%tls_require_ciphers%& for connections
24396 where DANE has been determined to be in effect.
24397 If not set, then &%tls_require_ciphers%& will be used.
24398 Normal SMTP delivery is not able to make strong demands of TLS cipher
24399 configuration, because delivery will fall back to plaintext. Once DANE has
24400 been determined to be in effect, there is no plaintext fallback and making the
24401 TLS cipherlist configuration stronger will increase security, rather than
24402 counter-intuitively decreasing it.
24403 If the option expands to be empty or is forced to fail, then it will
24404 be treated as unset and &%tls_require_ciphers%& will be used instead.
24405
24406
24407 .option data_timeout smtp time 5m
24408 This sets a timeout for the transmission of each block in the data portion of
24409 the message. As a result, the overall timeout for a message depends on the size
24410 of the message. Its value must not be zero. See also &%final_timeout%&.
24411
24412
24413 .option dkim_canon smtp string&!! unset
24414 .option dkim_domain smtp string list&!! unset
24415 .option dkim_hash smtp string&!! sha256
24416 .option dkim_identity smtp string&!! unset
24417 .option dkim_private_key smtp string&!! unset
24418 .option dkim_selector smtp string&!! unset
24419 .option dkim_strict smtp string&!! unset
24420 .option dkim_sign_headers smtp string&!! "per RFC"
24421 .option dkim_timestamps smtp string&!! unset
24422 DKIM signing options. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
24423
24424
24425 .option delay_after_cutoff smtp boolean true
24426 .cindex "final cutoff" "retries, controlling"
24427 .cindex retry "final cutoff"
24428 This option controls what happens when all remote IP addresses for a given
24429 domain have been inaccessible for so long that they have passed their retry
24430 cutoff times.
24431
24432 In the default state, if the next retry time has not been reached for any of
24433 them, the address is bounced without trying any deliveries. In other words,
24434 Exim delays retrying an IP address after the final cutoff time until a new
24435 retry time is reached, and can therefore bounce an address without ever trying
24436 a delivery, when machines have been down for a long time. Some people are
24437 unhappy at this prospect, so...
24438
24439 If &%delay_after_cutoff%& is set false, Exim behaves differently. If all IP
24440 addresses are past their final cutoff time, Exim tries to deliver to those
24441 IP addresses that have not been tried since the message arrived. If there are
24442 none, of if they all fail, the address is bounced. In other words, it does not
24443 delay when a new message arrives, but immediately tries those expired IP
24444 addresses that haven't been tried since the message arrived. If there is a
24445 continuous stream of messages for the dead hosts, unsetting
24446 &%delay_after_cutoff%& means that there will be many more attempts to deliver
24447 to them.
24448
24449
24450 .option dns_qualify_single smtp boolean true
24451 If the &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& option is being used,
24452 and the &%gethostbyname%& option is false,
24453 the RES_DEFNAMES resolver option is set. See the &%qualify_single%& option
24454 in chapter &<<CHAPdnslookup>>& for more details.
24455
24456
24457 .option dns_search_parents smtp boolean false
24458 If the &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& option is being used, and the
24459 &%gethostbyname%& option is false, the RES_DNSRCH resolver option is set.
24460 See the &%search_parents%& option in chapter &<<CHAPdnslookup>>& for more
24461 details.
24462
24463
24464 .option dnssec_request_domains smtp "domain list&!!" unset
24465 .cindex "MX record" "security"
24466 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
24467 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
24468 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
24469 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_request_domains%& will be done with
24470 the dnssec request bit set.
24471 This applies to all of the SRV, MX, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
24472
24473
24474
24475 .option dnssec_require_domains smtp "domain list&!!" unset
24476 .cindex "MX record" "security"
24477 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
24478 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
24479 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
24480 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_require_domains%& will be done with
24481 the dnssec request bit set. Any returns not having the Authenticated Data bit
24482 (AD bit) set will be ignored and logged as a host-lookup failure.
24483 This applies to all of the SRV, MX, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
24484
24485
24486
24487 .option dscp smtp string&!! unset
24488 .cindex "DCSP" "outbound"
24489 This option causes the DSCP value associated with a socket to be set to one
24490 of a number of fixed strings or to numeric value.
24491 The &%-bI:dscp%& option may be used to ask Exim which names it knows of.
24492 Common values include &`throughput`&, &`mincost`&, and on newer systems
24493 &`ef`&, &`af41`&, etc. Numeric values may be in the range 0 to 0x3F.
24494
24495 The outbound packets from Exim will be marked with this value in the header
24496 (for IPv4, the TOS field; for IPv6, the TCLASS field); there is no guarantee
24497 that these values will have any effect, not be stripped by networking
24498 equipment, or do much of anything without cooperation with your Network
24499 Engineer and those of all network operators between the source and destination.
24500
24501
24502 .option fallback_hosts smtp "string list" unset
24503 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on transport"
24504 String expansion is not applied to this option. The argument must be a
24505 colon-separated list of host names or IP addresses, optionally also including
24506 port numbers, though the separator can be changed, as described in section
24507 &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. Each individual item in the list is the same as an
24508 item in a &%route_list%& setting for the &(manualroute)& router, as described
24509 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&.
24510
24511 Fallback hosts can also be specified on routers, which associate them with the
24512 addresses they process. As for the &%hosts%& option without &%hosts_override%&,
24513 &%fallback_hosts%& specified on the transport is used only if the address does
24514 not have its own associated fallback host list. Unlike &%hosts%&, a setting of
24515 &%fallback_hosts%& on an address is not overridden by &%hosts_override%&.
24516 However, &%hosts_randomize%& does apply to fallback host lists.
24517
24518 If Exim is unable to deliver to any of the hosts for a particular address, and
24519 the errors are not permanent rejections, the address is put on a separate
24520 transport queue with its host list replaced by the fallback hosts, unless the
24521 address was routed via MX records and the current host was in the original MX
24522 list. In that situation, the fallback host list is not used.
24523
24524 Once normal deliveries are complete, the fallback queue is delivered by
24525 re-running the same transports with the new host lists. If several failing
24526 addresses have the same fallback hosts (and &%max_rcpt%& permits it), a single
24527 copy of the message is sent.
24528
24529 The resolution of the host names on the fallback list is controlled by the
24530 &%gethostbyname%& option, as for the &%hosts%& option. Fallback hosts apply
24531 both to cases when the host list comes with the address and when it is taken
24532 from &%hosts%&. This option provides a &"use a smart host only if delivery
24533 fails"& facility.
24534
24535
24536 .option final_timeout smtp time 10m
24537 This is the timeout that applies while waiting for the response to the final
24538 line containing just &"."& that terminates a message. Its value must not be
24539 zero.
24540
24541 .option gethostbyname smtp boolean false
24542 If this option is true when the &%hosts%& and/or &%fallback_hosts%& options are
24543 being used, names are looked up using &[gethostbyname()]&
24544 (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available)
24545 instead of using the DNS. Of course, that function may in fact use the DNS, but
24546 it may also consult other sources of information such as &_/etc/hosts_&.
24547
24548 .option gnutls_compat_mode smtp boolean unset
24549 This option controls whether GnuTLS is used in compatibility mode in an Exim
24550 server. This reduces security slightly, but improves interworking with older
24551 implementations of TLS.
24552
24553 .option helo_data smtp string&!! "see below"
24554 .cindex "HELO" "argument, setting"
24555 .cindex "EHLO" "argument, setting"
24556 .cindex "LHLO argument setting"
24557 The value of this option is expanded after a connection to a another host has
24558 been set up. The result is used as the argument for the EHLO, HELO, or LHLO
24559 command that starts the outgoing SMTP or LMTP session. The default value of the
24560 option is:
24561 .code
24562 $primary_hostname
24563 .endd
24564 During the expansion, the variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are set to
24565 the identity of the remote host, and the variables &$sending_ip_address$& and
24566 &$sending_port$& are set to the local IP address and port number that are being
24567 used. These variables can be used to generate different values for different
24568 servers or different local IP addresses. For example, if you want the string
24569 that is used for &%helo_data%& to be obtained by a DNS lookup of the outgoing
24570 interface address, you could use this:
24571 .code
24572 helo_data = ${lookup dnsdb{ptr=$sending_ip_address}{$value}\
24573 {$primary_hostname}}
24574 .endd
24575 The use of &%helo_data%& applies both to sending messages and when doing
24576 callouts.
24577
24578 .option hosts smtp "string list&!!" unset
24579 Hosts are associated with an address by a router such as &(dnslookup)&, which
24580 finds the hosts by looking up the address domain in the DNS, or by
24581 &(manualroute)&, which has lists of hosts in its configuration. However,
24582 email addresses can be passed to the &(smtp)& transport by any router, and not
24583 all of them can provide an associated list of hosts.
24584
24585 The &%hosts%& option specifies a list of hosts to be used if the address being
24586 processed does not have any hosts associated with it. The hosts specified by
24587 &%hosts%& are also used, whether or not the address has its own hosts, if
24588 &%hosts_override%& is set.
24589
24590 The string is first expanded, before being interpreted as a colon-separated
24591 list of host names or IP addresses, possibly including port numbers. The
24592 separator may be changed to something other than colon, as described in section
24593 &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. Each individual item in the list is the same as an
24594 item in a &%route_list%& setting for the &(manualroute)& router, as described
24595 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&. However, note that the &`/MX`& facility
24596 of the &(manualroute)& router is not available here.
24597
24598 If the expansion fails, delivery is deferred. Unless the failure was caused by
24599 the inability to complete a lookup, the error is logged to the panic log as
24600 well as the main log. Host names are looked up either by searching directly for
24601 address records in the DNS or by calling &[gethostbyname()]& (or
24602 &[getipnodebyname()]& when available), depending on the setting of the
24603 &%gethostbyname%& option. When Exim is compiled with IPv6 support, if a host
24604 that is looked up in the DNS has both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses, both types of
24605 address are used.
24606
24607 During delivery, the hosts are tried in order, subject to their retry status,
24608 unless &%hosts_randomize%& is set.
24609
24610
24611 .option hosts_avoid_esmtp smtp "host list&!!" unset
24612 .cindex "ESMTP, avoiding use of"
24613 .cindex "HELO" "forcing use of"
24614 .cindex "EHLO" "avoiding use of"
24615 .cindex "PIPELINING" "avoiding the use of"
24616 This option is for use with broken hosts that announce ESMTP facilities (for
24617 example, PIPELINING) and then fail to implement them properly. When a host
24618 matches &%hosts_avoid_esmtp%&, Exim sends HELO rather than EHLO at the
24619 start of the SMTP session. This means that it cannot use any of the ESMTP
24620 facilities such as AUTH, PIPELINING, SIZE, and STARTTLS.
24621
24622
24623 .option hosts_avoid_pipelining smtp "host list&!!" unset
24624 .cindex "PIPELINING" "avoiding the use of"
24625 Exim will not use the SMTP PIPELINING extension when delivering to any host
24626 that matches this list, even if the server host advertises PIPELINING support.
24627
24628 .new
24629 .option hosts_pipe_connect smtp "host list&!!" unset
24630 .cindex "pipelining" "early connection"
24631 .cindex "pipelining" PIPE_CONNECT
24632 If Exim is built with the SUPPORT_PIPE_CONNECT build option
24633 this option controls which to hosts the facility watched for
24634 and recorded, and used for subsequent connections.
24635
24636 The retry hints database is used for the record,
24637 and records are subject to the &%retry_data_expire%& option.
24638 When used, the pipelining saves on roundtrip times.
24639 It also turns SMTP into a client-first protocol
24640 so combines well with TCP Fast Open.
24641
24642 Note:
24643 When the facility is used, the transport &%helo_data%& option
24644 will be expanded before the &$sending_ip_address$& variable
24645 is filled in.
24646 A check is made for the use of that variable, without the
24647 presence of a &"def:"& test on it, but suitably complex coding
24648 can avoid the check and produce unexpected results.
24649 You have been warned.
24650 .wen
24651
24652
24653 .option hosts_avoid_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
24654 .cindex "TLS" "avoiding for certain hosts"
24655 Exim will not try to start a TLS session when delivering to any host that
24656 matches this list. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
24657
24658 .option hosts_verify_avoid_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
24659 .cindex "TLS" "avoiding for certain hosts"
24660 Exim will not try to start a TLS session for a verify callout,
24661 or when delivering in cutthrough mode,
24662 to any host that matches this list.
24663
24664
24665 .option hosts_max_try smtp integer 5
24666 .cindex "host" "maximum number to try"
24667 .cindex "limit" "number of hosts tried"
24668 .cindex "limit" "number of MX tried"
24669 .cindex "MX record" "maximum tried"
24670 This option limits the number of IP addresses that are tried for any one
24671 delivery in cases where there are temporary delivery errors. Section
24672 &<<SECTvalhosmax>>& describes in detail how the value of this option is used.
24673
24674
24675 .option hosts_max_try_hardlimit smtp integer 50
24676 This is an additional check on the maximum number of IP addresses that Exim
24677 tries for any one delivery. Section &<<SECTvalhosmax>>& describes its use and
24678 why it exists.
24679
24680
24681
24682 .option hosts_nopass_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
24683 .cindex "TLS" "passing connection"
24684 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
24685 .cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
24686 For any host that matches this list, a connection on which a TLS session has
24687 been started will not be passed to a new delivery process for sending another
24688 message on the same connection. See section &<<SECTmulmessam>>& for an
24689 explanation of when this might be needed.
24690
24691 .new
24692 .option hosts_noproxy_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
24693 .cindex "TLS" "passing connection"
24694 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
24695 .cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
24696 For any host that matches this list, a TLS session which has
24697 been started will not be passed to a new delivery process for sending another
24698 message on the same session.
24699 .wen
24700
24701 The traditional implementation closes down TLS and re-starts it in the new
24702 process, on the same open TCP connection, for each successive message
24703 sent. If permitted by this option a pipe to to the new process is set up
24704 instead, and the original process maintains the TLS connection and proxies
24705 the SMTP connection from and to the new process and any subsequents.
24706 The new process has no access to TLS information, so cannot include it in
24707 logging.
24708
24709
24710
24711 .option hosts_override smtp boolean false
24712 If this option is set and the &%hosts%& option is also set, any hosts that are
24713 attached to the address are ignored, and instead the hosts specified by the
24714 &%hosts%& option are always used. This option does not apply to
24715 &%fallback_hosts%&.
24716
24717
24718 .option hosts_randomize smtp boolean false
24719 .cindex "randomized host list"
24720 .cindex "host" "list of; randomized"
24721 .cindex "fallback" "randomized hosts"
24722 If this option is set, and either the list of hosts is taken from the
24723 &%hosts%& or the &%fallback_hosts%& option, or the hosts supplied by the router
24724 were not obtained from MX records (this includes fallback hosts from the
24725 router), and were not randomized by the router, the order of trying the hosts
24726 is randomized each time the transport runs. Randomizing the order of a host
24727 list can be used to do crude load sharing.
24728
24729 When &%hosts_randomize%& is true, a host list may be split into groups whose
24730 order is separately randomized. This makes it possible to set up MX-like
24731 behaviour. The boundaries between groups are indicated by an item that is just
24732 &`+`& in the host list. For example:
24733 .code
24734 hosts = host1:host2:host3:+:host4:host5
24735 .endd
24736 The order of the first three hosts and the order of the last two hosts is
24737 randomized for each use, but the first three always end up before the last two.
24738 If &%hosts_randomize%& is not set, a &`+`& item in the list is ignored.
24739
24740 .option hosts_require_auth smtp "host list&!!" unset
24741 .cindex "authentication" "required by client"
24742 This option provides a list of servers for which authentication must succeed
24743 before Exim will try to transfer a message. If authentication fails for
24744 servers which are not in this list, Exim tries to send unauthenticated. If
24745 authentication fails for one of these servers, delivery is deferred. This
24746 temporary error is detectable in the retry rules, so it can be turned into a
24747 hard failure if required. See also &%hosts_try_auth%&, and chapter
24748 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
24749
24750
24751 .option hosts_request_ocsp smtp "host list&!!" *
24752 .cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
24753 Exim will request a Certificate Status on a
24754 TLS session for any host that matches this list.
24755 &%tls_verify_certificates%& should also be set for the transport.
24756
24757 .option hosts_require_dane smtp "host list&!!" unset
24758 .cindex DANE "transport options"
24759 .cindex DANE "requiring for certain servers"
24760 If built with DANE support, Exim will require that a DNSSEC-validated
24761 TLSA record is present for any host matching the list,
24762 and that a DANE-verified TLS connection is made.
24763 There will be no fallback to in-clear communication.
24764 See section &<<SECDANE>>&.
24765
24766 .option hosts_require_ocsp smtp "host list&!!" unset
24767 .cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
24768 Exim will request, and check for a valid Certificate Status being given, on a
24769 TLS session for any host that matches this list.
24770 &%tls_verify_certificates%& should also be set for the transport.
24771
24772 .option hosts_require_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
24773 .cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
24774 Exim will insist on using a TLS session when delivering to any host that
24775 matches this list. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
24776 &*Note*&: This option affects outgoing mail only. To insist on TLS for
24777 incoming messages, use an appropriate ACL.
24778
24779 .option hosts_try_auth smtp "host list&!!" unset
24780 .cindex "authentication" "optional in client"
24781 This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
24782 authentication support, Exim will attempt to authenticate as a client when it
24783 connects. If authentication fails, Exim will try to transfer the message
24784 unauthenticated. See also &%hosts_require_auth%&, and chapter
24785 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
24786
24787 .option hosts_try_chunking smtp "host list&!!" *
24788 .cindex CHUNKING "enabling, in client"
24789 .cindex BDAT "SMTP command"
24790 .cindex "RFC 3030" "CHUNKING"
24791 This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
24792 CHUNKING support, Exim will attempt to use BDAT commands rather than DATA.
24793 BDAT will not be used in conjunction with a transport filter.
24794
24795 .option hosts_try_dane smtp "host list&!!" *
24796 .cindex DANE "transport options"
24797 .cindex DANE "attempting for certain servers"
24798 If built with DANE support, Exim will lookup a
24799 TLSA record for any host matching the list.
24800 If found and verified by DNSSEC,
24801 a DANE-verified TLS connection is made to that host;
24802 there will be no fallback to in-clear communication.
24803 See section &<<SECDANE>>&.
24804
24805 .option hosts_try_fastopen smtp "host list&!!" *
24806 .cindex "fast open, TCP" "enabling, in client"
24807 .cindex "TCP Fast Open" "enabling, in client"
24808 .cindex "RFC 7413" "TCP Fast Open"
24809 This option provides a list of servers to which, provided
24810 the facility is supported by this system, Exim will attempt to
24811 perform a TCP Fast Open.
24812 No data is sent on the SYN segment but, if the remote server also
24813 supports the facility, it can send its SMTP banner immediately after
24814 the SYN,ACK segment. This can save up to one round-trip time.
24815
24816 The facility is only active for previously-contacted servers,
24817 as the initiator must present a cookie in the SYN segment.
24818
24819 On (at least some) current Linux distributions the facility must be enabled
24820 in the kernel by the sysadmin before the support is usable.
24821 There is no option for control of the server side; if the system supports
24822 it it is always enabled. Note that lengthy operations in the connect ACL,
24823 such as DNSBL lookups, will still delay the emission of the SMTP banner.
24824
24825 .option hosts_try_prdr smtp "host list&!!" *
24826 .cindex "PRDR" "enabling, optional in client"
24827 This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
24828 PRDR support, Exim will attempt to negotiate PRDR
24829 for multi-recipient messages.
24830 The option can usually be left as default.
24831
24832 .option interface smtp "string list&!!" unset
24833 .cindex "bind IP address"
24834 .cindex "IP address" "binding"
24835 .vindex "&$host$&"
24836 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
24837 This option specifies which interface to bind to when making an outgoing SMTP
24838 call. The value is an IP address, not an interface name such as
24839 &`eth0`&. Do not confuse this with the interface address that was used when a
24840 message was received, which is in &$received_ip_address$&, formerly known as
24841 &$interface_address$&. The name was changed to minimize confusion with the
24842 outgoing interface address. There is no variable that contains an outgoing
24843 interface address because, unless it is set by this option, its value is
24844 unknown.
24845
24846 During the expansion of the &%interface%& option the variables &$host$& and
24847 &$host_address$& refer to the host to which a connection is about to be made
24848 during the expansion of the string. Forced expansion failure, or an empty
24849 string result causes the option to be ignored. Otherwise, after expansion, the
24850 string must be a list of IP addresses, colon-separated by default, but the
24851 separator can be changed in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
24852 For example:
24853 .code
24854 interface = <; 192.168.123.123 ; 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061
24855 .endd
24856 The first interface of the correct type (IPv4 or IPv6) is used for the outgoing
24857 connection. If none of them are the correct type, the option is ignored. If
24858 &%interface%& is not set, or is ignored, the system's IP functions choose which
24859 interface to use if the host has more than one.
24860
24861
24862 .option keepalive smtp boolean true
24863 .cindex "keepalive" "on outgoing connection"
24864 This option controls the setting of SO_KEEPALIVE on outgoing TCP/IP socket
24865 connections. When set, it causes the kernel to probe idle connections
24866 periodically, by sending packets with &"old"& sequence numbers. The other end
24867 of the connection should send a acknowledgment if the connection is still okay
24868 or a reset if the connection has been aborted. The reason for doing this is
24869 that it has the beneficial effect of freeing up certain types of connection
24870 that can get stuck when the remote host is disconnected without tidying up the
24871 TCP/IP call properly. The keepalive mechanism takes several hours to detect
24872 unreachable hosts.
24873
24874
24875 .option lmtp_ignore_quota smtp boolean false
24876 .cindex "LMTP" "ignoring quota errors"
24877 If this option is set true when the &%protocol%& option is set to &"lmtp"&, the
24878 string &`IGNOREQUOTA`& is added to RCPT commands, provided that the LMTP server
24879 has advertised support for IGNOREQUOTA in its response to the LHLO command.
24880
24881 .option max_rcpt smtp integer 100
24882 .cindex "RCPT" "maximum number of outgoing"
24883 This option limits the number of RCPT commands that are sent in a single
24884 SMTP message transaction. Each set of addresses is treated independently, and
24885 so can cause parallel connections to the same host if &%remote_max_parallel%&
24886 permits this.
24887
24888
24889 .option multi_domain smtp boolean&!! true
24890 .vindex "&$domain$&"
24891 When this option is set, the &(smtp)& transport can handle a number of
24892 addresses containing a mixture of different domains provided they all resolve
24893 to the same list of hosts. Turning the option off restricts the transport to
24894 handling only one domain at a time. This is useful if you want to use
24895 &$domain$& in an expansion for the transport, because it is set only when there
24896 is a single domain involved in a remote delivery.
24897
24898 It is expanded per-address and can depend on any of
24899 &$address_data$&, &$domain_data$&, &$local_part_data$&,
24900 &$host$&, &$host_address$& and &$host_port$&.
24901
24902 .option port smtp string&!! "see below"
24903 .cindex "port" "sending TCP/IP"
24904 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting outgoing port"
24905 This option specifies the TCP/IP port on the server to which Exim connects.
24906 &*Note:*& Do not confuse this with the port that was used when a message was
24907 received, which is in &$received_port$&, formerly known as &$interface_port$&.
24908 The name was changed to minimize confusion with the outgoing port. There is no
24909 variable that contains an outgoing port.
24910
24911 If the value of this option begins with a digit it is taken as a port number;
24912 otherwise it is looked up using &[getservbyname()]&. The default value is
24913 normally &"smtp"&,
24914 but if &%protocol%& is set to &"lmtp"& the default is &"lmtp"&
24915 and if &%protocol%& is set to &"smtps"& the default is &"smtps"&.
24916 If the expansion fails, or if a port number cannot be found, delivery
24917 is deferred.
24918
24919 Note that at least one Linux distribution has been seen failing
24920 to put &"smtps"& in its &"/etc/services"& file, resulting is such deferrals.
24921
24922
24923
24924 .option protocol smtp string smtp
24925 .cindex "LMTP" "over TCP/IP"
24926 .cindex "ssmtp protocol" "outbound"
24927 .cindex "TLS" "SSL-on-connect outbound"
24928 .vindex "&$port$&"
24929 If this option is set to &"lmtp"& instead of &"smtp"&, the default value for
24930 the &%port%& option changes to &"lmtp"&, and the transport operates the LMTP
24931 protocol (RFC 2033) instead of SMTP. This protocol is sometimes used for local
24932 deliveries into closed message stores. Exim also has support for running LMTP
24933 over a pipe to a local process &-- see chapter &<<CHAPLMTP>>&.
24934
24935 If this option is set to &"smtps"&, the default value for the &%port%& option
24936 changes to &"smtps"&, and the transport initiates TLS immediately after
24937 connecting, as an outbound SSL-on-connect, instead of using STARTTLS to upgrade.
24938 The Internet standards bodies used to strongly discourage use of this mode,
24939 but as of RFC 8314 it is perferred over STARTTLS for message submission
24940 (as distinct from MTA-MTA communication).
24941
24942
24943 .option retry_include_ip_address smtp boolean&!! true
24944 Exim normally includes both the host name and the IP address in the key it
24945 constructs for indexing retry data after a temporary delivery failure. This
24946 means that when one of several IP addresses for a host is failing, it gets
24947 tried periodically (controlled by the retry rules), but use of the other IP
24948 addresses is not affected.
24949
24950 However, in some dialup environments hosts are assigned a different IP address
24951 each time they connect. In this situation the use of the IP address as part of
24952 the retry key leads to undesirable behaviour. Setting this option false causes
24953 Exim to use only the host name.
24954 Since it is expanded it can be made to depend on the host or domain.
24955
24956
24957 .option serialize_hosts smtp "host list&!!" unset
24958 .cindex "serializing connections"
24959 .cindex "host" "serializing connections"
24960 Because Exim operates in a distributed manner, if several messages for the same
24961 host arrive at around the same time, more than one simultaneous connection to
24962 the remote host can occur. This is not usually a problem except when there is a
24963 slow link between the hosts. In that situation it may be helpful to restrict
24964 Exim to one connection at a time. This can be done by setting
24965 &%serialize_hosts%& to match the relevant hosts.
24966
24967 .cindex "hints database" "serializing deliveries to a host"
24968 Exim implements serialization by means of a hints database in which a record is
24969 written whenever a process connects to one of the restricted hosts. The record
24970 is deleted when the connection is completed. Obviously there is scope for
24971 records to get left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To
24972 guard against this, Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
24973
24974 If you set up this kind of serialization, you should also arrange to delete the
24975 relevant hints database whenever your system reboots. The names of the files
24976 start with &_misc_& and they are kept in the &_spool/db_& directory. There
24977 may be one or two files, depending on the type of DBM in use. The same files
24978 are used for ETRN serialization.
24979
24980 See also the &%max_parallel%& generic transport option.
24981
24982
24983 .option size_addition smtp integer 1024
24984 .cindex "SMTP" "SIZE"
24985 .cindex "message" "size issue for transport filter"
24986 .cindex "size" "of message"
24987 .cindex "transport" "filter"
24988 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
24989 If a remote SMTP server indicates that it supports the SIZE option of the
24990 MAIL command, Exim uses this to pass over the message size at the start of
24991 an SMTP transaction. It adds the value of &%size_addition%& to the value it
24992 sends, to allow for headers and other text that may be added during delivery by
24993 configuration options or in a transport filter. It may be necessary to increase
24994 this if a lot of text is added to messages.
24995
24996 Alternatively, if the value of &%size_addition%& is set negative, it disables
24997 the use of the SIZE option altogether.
24998
24999
25000 .option socks_proxy smtp string&!! unset
25001 .cindex proxy SOCKS
25002 This option enables use of SOCKS proxies for connections made by the
25003 transport. For details see section &<<SECTproxySOCKS>>&.
25004
25005
25006 .option tls_certificate smtp string&!! unset
25007 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate, location of"
25008 .cindex "certificate" "client, location of"
25009 .vindex "&$host$&"
25010 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
25011 The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file which contains the
25012 client's certificate, for possible use when sending a message over an encrypted
25013 connection. The values of &$host$& and &$host_address$& are set to the name and
25014 address of the server during the expansion. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for
25015 details of TLS.
25016
25017 &*Note*&: This option must be set if you want Exim to be able to use a TLS
25018 certificate when sending messages as a client. The global option of the same
25019 name specifies the certificate for Exim as a server; it is not automatically
25020 assumed that the same certificate should be used when Exim is operating as a
25021 client.
25022
25023
25024 .option tls_crl smtp string&!! unset
25025 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate revocation list"
25026 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list for client"
25027 This option specifies a certificate revocation list. The expanded value must
25028 be the name of a file that contains a CRL in PEM format.
25029
25030
25031 .option tls_dh_min_bits smtp integer 1024
25032 .cindex "TLS" "Diffie-Hellman minimum acceptable size"
25033 When establishing a TLS session, if a ciphersuite which uses Diffie-Hellman
25034 key agreement is negotiated, the server will provide a large prime number
25035 for use. This option establishes the minimum acceptable size of that number.
25036 If the parameter offered by the server is too small, then the TLS handshake
25037 will fail.
25038
25039 Only supported when using GnuTLS.
25040
25041
25042 .option tls_privatekey smtp string&!! unset
25043 .cindex "TLS" "client private key, location of"
25044 .vindex "&$host$&"
25045 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
25046 The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file which contains the
25047 client's private key. This is used when sending a message over an encrypted
25048 connection using a client certificate. The values of &$host$& and
25049 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
25050 expansion. If this option is unset, or the expansion is forced to fail, or the
25051 result is an empty string, the private key is assumed to be in the same file as
25052 the certificate. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
25053
25054
25055 .option tls_require_ciphers smtp string&!! unset
25056 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers"
25057 .cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
25058 .vindex "&$host$&"
25059 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
25060 The value of this option must be a list of permitted cipher suites, for use
25061 when setting up an outgoing encrypted connection. (There is a global option of
25062 the same name for controlling incoming connections.) The values of &$host$& and
25063 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
25064 expansion. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS; note that this option
25065 is used in different ways by OpenSSL and GnuTLS (see sections
25066 &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&). For GnuTLS, the order of the
25067 ciphers is a preference order.
25068
25069
25070
25071 .option tls_sni smtp string&!! unset
25072 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
25073 .vindex "&$tls_sni$&"
25074 If this option is set then it sets the $tls_out_sni variable and causes any
25075 TLS session to pass this value as the Server Name Indication extension to
25076 the remote side, which can be used by the remote side to select an appropriate
25077 certificate and private key for the session.
25078
25079 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for more information.
25080
25081 Note that for OpenSSL, this feature requires a build of OpenSSL that supports
25082 TLS extensions.
25083
25084
25085
25086
25087 .option tls_tempfail_tryclear smtp boolean true
25088 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "to STARTTLS"
25089 When the server host is not in &%hosts_require_tls%&, and there is a problem in
25090 setting up a TLS session, this option determines whether or not Exim should try
25091 to deliver the message unencrypted. If it is set false, delivery to the
25092 current host is deferred; if there are other hosts, they are tried. If this
25093 option is set true, Exim attempts to deliver unencrypted after a 4&'xx'&
25094 response to STARTTLS. Also, if STARTTLS is accepted, but the subsequent
25095 TLS negotiation fails, Exim closes the current connection (because it is in an
25096 unknown state), opens a new one to the same host, and then tries the delivery
25097 in clear.
25098
25099
25100 .option tls_try_verify_hosts smtp "host list&!!" *
25101 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
25102 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
25103 This option gives a list of hosts for which, on encrypted connections,
25104 certificate verification will be tried but need not succeed.
25105 The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option must also be set.
25106 Note that unless the host is in this list
25107 TLS connections will be denied to hosts using self-signed certificates
25108 when &%tls_verify_certificates%& is matched.
25109 The &$tls_out_certificate_verified$& variable is set when
25110 certificate verification succeeds.
25111
25112
25113 .option tls_verify_cert_hostnames smtp "host list&!!" *
25114 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate hostname verification"
25115 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
25116 This option give a list of hosts for which,
25117 while verifying the server certificate,
25118 checks will be included on the host name
25119 (note that this will generally be the result of a DNS MX lookup)
25120 versus Subject and Subject-Alternate-Name fields. Wildcard names are permitted
25121 limited to being the initial component of a 3-or-more component FQDN.
25122
25123 There is no equivalent checking on client certificates.
25124
25125
25126 .option tls_verify_certificates smtp string&!! system
25127 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
25128 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
25129 .vindex "&$host$&"
25130 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
25131 The value of this option must be either the
25132 word "system"
25133 or the absolute path to
25134 a file or directory containing permitted certificates for servers,
25135 for use when setting up an encrypted connection.
25136
25137 The "system" value for the option will use a location compiled into the SSL library.
25138 This is not available for GnuTLS versions preceding 3.0.20; a value of "system"
25139 is taken as empty and an explicit location
25140 must be specified.
25141
25142 The use of a directory for the option value is not available for GnuTLS versions
25143 preceding 3.3.6 and a single file must be used.
25144
25145 With OpenSSL the certificates specified
25146 explicitly
25147 either by file or directory
25148 are added to those given by the system default location.
25149
25150 The values of &$host$& and
25151 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
25152 expansion of this option. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
25153
25154 For back-compatibility,
25155 if neither tls_verify_hosts nor tls_try_verify_hosts are set
25156 (a single-colon empty list counts as being set)
25157 and certificate verification fails the TLS connection is closed.
25158
25159
25160 .option tls_verify_hosts smtp "host list&!!" unset
25161 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
25162 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
25163 This option gives a list of hosts for which, on encrypted connections,
25164 certificate verification must succeed.
25165 The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option must also be set.
25166 If both this option and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& are unset
25167 operation is as if this option selected all hosts.
25168
25169 .option utf8_downconvert smtp integer!! unset
25170 .cindex utf8 "address downconversion"
25171 .cindex i18n "utf8 address downconversion"
25172 If built with internationalization support,
25173 this option controls conversion of UTF-8 in message addresses
25174 to a-label form.
25175 For details see section &<<SECTi18nMTA>>&.
25176
25177
25178
25179
25180 .section "How the limits for the number of hosts to try are used" &&&
25181 "SECTvalhosmax"
25182 .cindex "host" "maximum number to try"
25183 .cindex "limit" "hosts; maximum number tried"
25184 There are two options that are concerned with the number of hosts that are
25185 tried when an SMTP delivery takes place. They are &%hosts_max_try%& and
25186 &%hosts_max_try_hardlimit%&.
25187
25188
25189 The &%hosts_max_try%& option limits the number of hosts that are tried
25190 for a single delivery. However, despite the term &"host"& in its name, the
25191 option actually applies to each IP address independently. In other words, a
25192 multihomed host is treated as several independent hosts, just as it is for
25193 retrying.
25194
25195 Many of the larger ISPs have multiple MX records which often point to
25196 multihomed hosts. As a result, a list of a dozen or more IP addresses may be
25197 created as a result of routing one of these domains.
25198
25199 Trying every single IP address on such a long list does not seem sensible; if
25200 several at the top of the list fail, it is reasonable to assume there is some
25201 problem that is likely to affect all of them. Roughly speaking, the value of
25202 &%hosts_max_try%& is the maximum number that are tried before deferring the
25203 delivery. However, the logic cannot be quite that simple.
25204
25205 Firstly, IP addresses that are skipped because their retry times have not
25206 arrived do not count, and in addition, addresses that are past their retry
25207 limits are also not counted, even when they are tried. This means that when
25208 some IP addresses are past their retry limits, more than the value of
25209 &%hosts_max_retry%& may be tried. The reason for this behaviour is to ensure
25210 that all IP addresses are considered before timing out an email address (but
25211 see below for an exception).
25212
25213 Secondly, when the &%hosts_max_try%& limit is reached, Exim looks down the host
25214 list to see if there is a subsequent host with a different (higher valued) MX.
25215 If there is, that host is considered next, and the current IP address is used
25216 but not counted. This behaviour helps in the case of a domain with a retry rule
25217 that hardly ever delays any hosts, as is now explained:
25218
25219 Consider the case of a long list of hosts with one MX value, and a few with a
25220 higher MX value. If &%hosts_max_try%& is small (the default is 5) only a few
25221 hosts at the top of the list are tried at first. With the default retry rule,
25222 which specifies increasing retry times, the higher MX hosts are eventually
25223 tried when those at the top of the list are skipped because they have not
25224 reached their retry times.
25225
25226 However, it is common practice to put a fixed short retry time on domains for
25227 large ISPs, on the grounds that their servers are rarely down for very long.
25228 Unfortunately, these are exactly the domains that tend to resolve to long lists
25229 of hosts. The short retry time means that the lowest MX hosts are tried every
25230 time. The attempts may be in a different order because of random sorting, but
25231 without the special MX check, the higher MX hosts would never be tried until
25232 all the lower MX hosts had timed out (which might be several days), because
25233 there are always some lower MX hosts that have reached their retry times. With
25234 the special check, Exim considers at least one IP address from each MX value at
25235 every delivery attempt, even if the &%hosts_max_try%& limit has already been
25236 reached.
25237
25238 The above logic means that &%hosts_max_try%& is not a hard limit, and in
25239 particular, Exim normally eventually tries all the IP addresses before timing
25240 out an email address. When &%hosts_max_try%& was implemented, this seemed a
25241 reasonable thing to do. Recently, however, some lunatic DNS configurations have
25242 been set up with hundreds of IP addresses for some domains. It can
25243 take a very long time indeed for an address to time out in these cases.
25244
25245 The &%hosts_max_try_hardlimit%& option was added to help with this problem.
25246 Exim never tries more than this number of IP addresses; if it hits this limit
25247 and they are all timed out, the email address is bounced, even though not all
25248 possible IP addresses have been tried.
25249 .ecindex IIDsmttra1
25250 .ecindex IIDsmttra2
25251
25252
25253
25254
25255
25256 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25257 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25258
25259 .chapter "Address rewriting" "CHAPrewrite"
25260 .scindex IIDaddrew "rewriting" "addresses"
25261 There are some circumstances in which Exim automatically rewrites domains in
25262 addresses. The two most common are when an address is given without a domain
25263 (referred to as an &"unqualified address"&) or when an address contains an
25264 abbreviated domain that is expanded by DNS lookup.
25265
25266 Unqualified envelope addresses are accepted only for locally submitted
25267 messages, or for messages that are received from hosts matching
25268 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&, as
25269 appropriate. Unqualified addresses in header lines are qualified if they are in
25270 locally submitted messages, or messages from hosts that are permitted to send
25271 unqualified envelope addresses. Otherwise, unqualified addresses in header
25272 lines are neither qualified nor rewritten.
25273
25274 One situation in which Exim does &'not'& automatically rewrite a domain is
25275 when it is the name of a CNAME record in the DNS. The older RFCs suggest that
25276 such a domain should be rewritten using the &"canonical"& name, and some MTAs
25277 do this. The new RFCs do not contain this suggestion.
25278
25279
25280 .section "Explicitly configured address rewriting" "SECID147"
25281 This chapter describes the rewriting rules that can be used in the
25282 main rewrite section of the configuration file, and also in the generic
25283 &%headers_rewrite%& option that can be set on any transport.
25284
25285 Some people believe that configured address rewriting is a Mortal Sin.
25286 Others believe that life is not possible without it. Exim provides the
25287 facility; you do not have to use it.
25288
25289 The main rewriting rules that appear in the &"rewrite"& section of the
25290 configuration file are applied to addresses in incoming messages, both envelope
25291 addresses and addresses in header lines. Each rule specifies the types of
25292 address to which it applies.
25293
25294 Whether or not addresses in header lines are rewritten depends on the origin of
25295 the headers and the type of rewriting. Global rewriting, that is, rewriting
25296 rules from the rewrite section of the configuration file, is applied only to
25297 those headers that were received with the message. Header lines that are added
25298 by ACLs or by a system filter or by individual routers or transports (which
25299 are specific to individual recipient addresses) are not rewritten by the global
25300 rules.
25301
25302 Rewriting at transport time, by means of the &%headers_rewrite%& option,
25303 applies all headers except those added by routers and transports. That is, as
25304 well as the headers that were received with the message, it also applies to
25305 headers that were added by an ACL or a system filter.
25306
25307
25308 In general, rewriting addresses from your own system or domain has some
25309 legitimacy. Rewriting other addresses should be done only with great care and
25310 in special circumstances. The author of Exim believes that rewriting should be
25311 used sparingly, and mainly for &"regularizing"& addresses in your own domains.
25312 Although it can sometimes be used as a routing tool, this is very strongly
25313 discouraged.
25314
25315 There are two commonly encountered circumstances where rewriting is used, as
25316 illustrated by these examples:
25317
25318 .ilist
25319 The company whose domain is &'hitch.fict.example'& has a number of hosts that
25320 exchange mail with each other behind a firewall, but there is only a single
25321 gateway to the outer world. The gateway rewrites &'*.hitch.fict.example'& as
25322 &'hitch.fict.example'& when sending mail off-site.
25323 .next
25324 A host rewrites the local parts of its own users so that, for example,
25325 &'fp42@hitch.fict.example'& becomes &'Ford.Prefect@hitch.fict.example'&.
25326 .endlist
25327
25328
25329
25330 .section "When does rewriting happen?" "SECID148"
25331 .cindex "rewriting" "timing of"
25332 .cindex "&ACL;" "rewriting addresses in"
25333 Configured address rewriting can take place at several different stages of a
25334 message's processing.
25335
25336 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
25337 At the start of an ACL for MAIL, the sender address may have been rewritten
25338 by a special SMTP-time rewrite rule (see section &<<SECTrewriteS>>&), but no
25339 ordinary rewrite rules have yet been applied. If, however, the sender address
25340 is verified in the ACL, it is rewritten before verification, and remains
25341 rewritten thereafter. The subsequent value of &$sender_address$& is the
25342 rewritten address. This also applies if sender verification happens in a
25343 RCPT ACL. Otherwise, when the sender address is not verified, it is
25344 rewritten as soon as a message's header lines have been received.
25345
25346 .vindex "&$domain$&"
25347 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
25348 Similarly, at the start of an ACL for RCPT, the current recipient's address
25349 may have been rewritten by a special SMTP-time rewrite rule, but no ordinary
25350 rewrite rules have yet been applied to it. However, the behaviour is different
25351 from the sender address when a recipient is verified. The address is rewritten
25352 for the verification, but the rewriting is not remembered at this stage. The
25353 value of &$local_part$& and &$domain$& after verification are always the same
25354 as they were before (that is, they contain the unrewritten &-- except for
25355 SMTP-time rewriting &-- address).
25356
25357 As soon as a message's header lines have been received, all the envelope
25358 recipient addresses are permanently rewritten, and rewriting is also applied to
25359 the addresses in the header lines (if configured). This happens before adding
25360 any header lines that were specified in MAIL or RCPT ACLs, and
25361 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "address rewriting; timing of"
25362 before the DATA ACL and &[local_scan()]& functions are run.
25363
25364 When an address is being routed, either for delivery or for verification,
25365 rewriting is applied immediately to child addresses that are generated by
25366 redirection, unless &%no_rewrite%& is set on the router.
25367
25368 .cindex "envelope from"
25369 .cindex "envelope sender" "rewriting at transport time"
25370 .cindex "rewriting" "at transport time"
25371 .cindex "header lines" "rewriting at transport time"
25372 At transport time, additional rewriting of addresses in header lines can be
25373 specified by setting the generic &%headers_rewrite%& option on a transport.
25374 This option contains rules that are identical in form to those in the rewrite
25375 section of the configuration file. They are applied to the original message
25376 header lines and any that were added by ACLs or a system filter. They are not
25377 applied to header lines that are added by routers or the transport.
25378
25379 The outgoing envelope sender can be rewritten by means of the &%return_path%&
25380 transport option. However, it is not possible to rewrite envelope recipients at
25381 transport time.
25382
25383
25384
25385
25386 .section "Testing the rewriting rules that apply on input" "SECID149"
25387 .cindex "rewriting" "testing"
25388 .cindex "testing" "rewriting"
25389 Exim's input rewriting configuration appears in a part of the runtime
25390 configuration file headed by &"begin rewrite"&. It can be tested by the
25391 &%-brw%& command line option. This takes an address (which can be a full RFC
25392 2822 address) as its argument. The output is a list of how the address would be
25393 transformed by the rewriting rules for each of the different places it might
25394 appear in an incoming message, that is, for each different header and for the
25395 envelope sender and recipient fields. For example,
25396 .code
25397 exim -brw ph10@exim.workshop.example
25398 .endd
25399 might produce the output
25400 .code
25401 sender: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
25402 from: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
25403 to: ph10@exim.workshop.example
25404 cc: ph10@exim.workshop.example
25405 bcc: ph10@exim.workshop.example
25406 reply-to: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
25407 env-from: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
25408 env-to: ph10@exim.workshop.example
25409 .endd
25410 which shows that rewriting has been set up for that address when used in any of
25411 the source fields, but not when it appears as a recipient address. At the
25412 present time, there is no equivalent way of testing rewriting rules that are
25413 set for a particular transport.
25414
25415
25416 .section "Rewriting rules" "SECID150"
25417 .cindex "rewriting" "rules"
25418 The rewrite section of the configuration file consists of lines of rewriting
25419 rules in the form
25420 .display
25421 <&'source pattern'&> <&'replacement'&> <&'flags'&>
25422 .endd
25423 Rewriting rules that are specified for the &%headers_rewrite%& generic
25424 transport option are given as a colon-separated list. Each item in the list
25425 takes the same form as a line in the main rewriting configuration (except that
25426 any colons must be doubled, of course).
25427
25428 The formats of source patterns and replacement strings are described below.
25429 Each is terminated by white space, unless enclosed in double quotes, in which
25430 case normal quoting conventions apply inside the quotes. The flags are single
25431 characters which may appear in any order. Spaces and tabs between them are
25432 ignored.
25433
25434 For each address that could potentially be rewritten, the rules are scanned in
25435 order, and replacements for the address from earlier rules can themselves be
25436 replaced by later rules (but see the &"q"& and &"R"& flags).
25437
25438 The order in which addresses are rewritten is undefined, may change between
25439 releases, and must not be relied on, with one exception: when a message is
25440 received, the envelope sender is always rewritten first, before any header
25441 lines are rewritten. For example, the replacement string for a rewrite of an
25442 address in &'To:'& must not assume that the message's address in &'From:'& has
25443 (or has not) already been rewritten. However, a rewrite of &'From:'& may assume
25444 that the envelope sender has already been rewritten.
25445
25446 .vindex "&$domain$&"
25447 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
25448 The variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$& can be used in the replacement
25449 string to refer to the address that is being rewritten. Note that lookup-driven
25450 rewriting can be done by a rule of the form
25451 .code
25452 *@* ${lookup ...
25453 .endd
25454 where the lookup key uses &$1$& and &$2$& or &$local_part$& and &$domain$& to
25455 refer to the address that is being rewritten.
25456
25457
25458 .section "Rewriting patterns" "SECID151"
25459 .cindex "rewriting" "patterns"
25460 .cindex "address list" "in a rewriting pattern"
25461 The source pattern in a rewriting rule is any item which may appear in an
25462 address list (see section &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). It is in fact processed as a
25463 single-item address list, which means that it is expanded before being tested
25464 against the address. As always, if you use a regular expression as a pattern,
25465 you must take care to escape dollar and backslash characters, or use the &`\N`&
25466 facility to suppress string expansion within the regular expression.
25467
25468 Domains in patterns should be given in lower case. Local parts in patterns are
25469 case-sensitive. If you want to do case-insensitive matching of local parts, you
25470 can use a regular expression that starts with &`^(?i)`&.
25471
25472 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in rewriting rules"
25473 After matching, the numerical variables &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. may be set,
25474 depending on the type of match which occurred. These can be used in the
25475 replacement string to insert portions of the incoming address. &$0$& always
25476 refers to the complete incoming address. When a regular expression is used, the
25477 numerical variables are set from its capturing subexpressions. For other types
25478 of pattern they are set as follows:
25479
25480 .ilist
25481 If a local part or domain starts with an asterisk, the numerical variables
25482 refer to the character strings matched by asterisks, with &$1$& associated with
25483 the first asterisk, and &$2$& with the second, if present. For example, if the
25484 pattern
25485 .code
25486 *queen@*.fict.example
25487 .endd
25488 is matched against the address &'hearts-queen@wonderland.fict.example'& then
25489 .code
25490 $0 = hearts-queen@wonderland.fict.example
25491 $1 = hearts-
25492 $2 = wonderland
25493 .endd
25494 Note that if the local part does not start with an asterisk, but the domain
25495 does, it is &$1$& that contains the wild part of the domain.
25496
25497 .next
25498 If the domain part of the pattern is a partial lookup, the wild and fixed parts
25499 of the domain are placed in the next available numerical variables. Suppose,
25500 for example, that the address &'foo@bar.baz.example'& is processed by a
25501 rewriting rule of the form
25502 .display
25503 &`*@partial-dbm;/some/dbm/file`& <&'replacement string'&>
25504 .endd
25505 and the key in the file that matches the domain is &`*.baz.example`&. Then
25506 .code
25507 $1 = foo
25508 $2 = bar
25509 $3 = baz.example
25510 .endd
25511 If the address &'foo@baz.example'& is looked up, this matches the same
25512 wildcard file entry, and in this case &$2$& is set to the empty string, but
25513 &$3$& is still set to &'baz.example'&. If a non-wild key is matched in a
25514 partial lookup, &$2$& is again set to the empty string and &$3$& is set to the
25515 whole domain. For non-partial domain lookups, no numerical variables are set.
25516 .endlist
25517
25518
25519 .section "Rewriting replacements" "SECID152"
25520 .cindex "rewriting" "replacements"
25521 If the replacement string for a rule is a single asterisk, addresses that
25522 match the pattern and the flags are &'not'& rewritten, and no subsequent
25523 rewriting rules are scanned. For example,
25524 .code
25525 hatta@lookingglass.fict.example * f
25526 .endd
25527 specifies that &'hatta@lookingglass.fict.example'& is never to be rewritten in
25528 &'From:'& headers.
25529
25530 .vindex "&$domain$&"
25531 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
25532 If the replacement string is not a single asterisk, it is expanded, and must
25533 yield a fully qualified address. Within the expansion, the variables
25534 &$local_part$& and &$domain$& refer to the address that is being rewritten.
25535 Any letters they contain retain their original case &-- they are not lower
25536 cased. The numerical variables are set up according to the type of pattern that
25537 matched the address, as described above. If the expansion is forced to fail by
25538 the presence of &"fail"& in a conditional or lookup item, rewriting by the
25539 current rule is abandoned, but subsequent rules may take effect. Any other
25540 expansion failure causes the entire rewriting operation to be abandoned, and an
25541 entry written to the panic log.
25542
25543
25544
25545 .section "Rewriting flags" "SECID153"
25546 There are three different kinds of flag that may appear on rewriting rules:
25547
25548 .ilist
25549 Flags that specify which headers and envelope addresses to rewrite: E, F, T, b,
25550 c, f, h, r, s, t.
25551 .next
25552 A flag that specifies rewriting at SMTP time: S.
25553 .next
25554 Flags that control the rewriting process: Q, q, R, w.
25555 .endlist
25556
25557 For rules that are part of the &%headers_rewrite%& generic transport option,
25558 E, F, T, and S are not permitted.
25559
25560
25561
25562 .section "Flags specifying which headers and envelope addresses to rewrite" &&&
25563 "SECID154"
25564 .cindex "rewriting" "flags"
25565 If none of the following flag letters, nor the &"S"& flag (see section
25566 &<<SECTrewriteS>>&) are present, a main rewriting rule applies to all headers
25567 and to both the sender and recipient fields of the envelope, whereas a
25568 transport-time rewriting rule just applies to all headers. Otherwise, the
25569 rewriting rule is skipped unless the relevant addresses are being processed.
25570 .display
25571 &`E`& rewrite all envelope fields
25572 &`F`& rewrite the envelope From field
25573 &`T`& rewrite the envelope To field
25574 &`b`& rewrite the &'Bcc:'& header
25575 &`c`& rewrite the &'Cc:'& header
25576 &`f`& rewrite the &'From:'& header
25577 &`h`& rewrite all headers
25578 &`r`& rewrite the &'Reply-To:'& header
25579 &`s`& rewrite the &'Sender:'& header
25580 &`t`& rewrite the &'To:'& header
25581 .endd
25582 "All headers" means all of the headers listed above that can be selected
25583 individually, plus their &'Resent-'& versions. It does not include
25584 other headers such as &'Subject:'& etc.
25585
25586 You should be particularly careful about rewriting &'Sender:'& headers, and
25587 restrict this to special known cases in your own domains.
25588
25589
25590 .section "The SMTP-time rewriting flag" "SECTrewriteS"
25591 .cindex "SMTP" "rewriting malformed addresses"
25592 .cindex "RCPT" "rewriting argument of"
25593 .cindex "MAIL" "rewriting argument of"
25594 The rewrite flag &"S"& specifies a rewrite of incoming envelope addresses at
25595 SMTP time, as soon as an address is received in a MAIL or RCPT command, and
25596 before any other processing; even before syntax checking. The pattern is
25597 required to be a regular expression, and it is matched against the whole of the
25598 data for the command, including any surrounding angle brackets.
25599
25600 .vindex "&$domain$&"
25601 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
25602 This form of rewrite rule allows for the handling of addresses that are not
25603 compliant with RFCs 2821 and 2822 (for example, &"bang paths"& in batched SMTP
25604 input). Because the input is not required to be a syntactically valid address,
25605 the variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$& are not available during the
25606 expansion of the replacement string. The result of rewriting replaces the
25607 original address in the MAIL or RCPT command.
25608
25609
25610 .section "Flags controlling the rewriting process" "SECID155"
25611 There are four flags which control the way the rewriting process works. These
25612 take effect only when a rule is invoked, that is, when the address is of the
25613 correct type (matches the flags) and matches the pattern:
25614
25615 .ilist
25616 If the &"Q"& flag is set on a rule, the rewritten address is permitted to be an
25617 unqualified local part. It is qualified with &%qualify_recipient%&. In the
25618 absence of &"Q"& the rewritten address must always include a domain.
25619 .next
25620 If the &"q"& flag is set on a rule, no further rewriting rules are considered,
25621 even if no rewriting actually takes place because of a &"fail"& in the
25622 expansion. The &"q"& flag is not effective if the address is of the wrong type
25623 (does not match the flags) or does not match the pattern.
25624 .next
25625 The &"R"& flag causes a successful rewriting rule to be re-applied to the new
25626 address, up to ten times. It can be combined with the &"q"& flag, to stop
25627 rewriting once it fails to match (after at least one successful rewrite).
25628 .next
25629 .cindex "rewriting" "whole addresses"
25630 When an address in a header is rewritten, the rewriting normally applies only
25631 to the working part of the address, with any comments and RFC 2822 &"phrase"&
25632 left unchanged. For example, rewriting might change
25633 .code
25634 From: Ford Prefect <fp42@restaurant.hitch.fict.example>
25635 .endd
25636 into
25637 .code
25638 From: Ford Prefect <prefectf@hitch.fict.example>
25639 .endd
25640 .cindex "RFC 2047"
25641 Sometimes there is a need to replace the whole address item, and this can be
25642 done by adding the flag letter &"w"& to a rule. If this is set on a rule that
25643 causes an address in a header line to be rewritten, the entire address is
25644 replaced, not just the working part. The replacement must be a complete RFC
25645 2822 address, including the angle brackets if necessary. If text outside angle
25646 brackets contains a character whose value is greater than 126 or less than 32
25647 (except for tab), the text is encoded according to RFC 2047. The character set
25648 is taken from &%headers_charset%&, which gets its default at build time.
25649
25650 When the &"w"& flag is set on a rule that causes an envelope address to be
25651 rewritten, all but the working part of the replacement address is discarded.
25652 .endlist
25653
25654
25655 .section "Rewriting examples" "SECID156"
25656 Here is an example of the two common rewriting paradigms:
25657 .code
25658 *@*.hitch.fict.example $1@hitch.fict.example
25659 *@hitch.fict.example ${lookup{$1}dbm{/etc/realnames}\
25660 {$value}fail}@hitch.fict.example bctfrF
25661 .endd
25662 Note the use of &"fail"& in the lookup expansion in the second rule, forcing
25663 the string expansion to fail if the lookup does not succeed. In this context it
25664 has the effect of leaving the original address unchanged, but Exim goes on to
25665 consider subsequent rewriting rules, if any, because the &"q"& flag is not
25666 present in that rule. An alternative to &"fail"& would be to supply &$1$&
25667 explicitly, which would cause the rewritten address to be the same as before,
25668 at the cost of a small bit of processing. Not supplying either of these is an
25669 error, since the rewritten address would then contain no local part.
25670
25671 The first example above replaces the domain with a superior, more general
25672 domain. This may not be desirable for certain local parts. If the rule
25673 .code
25674 root@*.hitch.fict.example *
25675 .endd
25676 were inserted before the first rule, rewriting would be suppressed for the
25677 local part &'root'& at any domain ending in &'hitch.fict.example'&.
25678
25679 Rewriting can be made conditional on a number of tests, by making use of
25680 &${if$& in the expansion item. For example, to apply a rewriting rule only to
25681 messages that originate outside the local host:
25682 .code
25683 *@*.hitch.fict.example "${if !eq {$sender_host_address}{}\
25684 {$1@hitch.fict.example}fail}"
25685 .endd
25686 The replacement string is quoted in this example because it contains white
25687 space.
25688
25689 .cindex "rewriting" "bang paths"
25690 .cindex "bang paths" "rewriting"
25691 Exim does not handle addresses in the form of &"bang paths"&. If it sees such
25692 an address it treats it as an unqualified local part which it qualifies with
25693 the local qualification domain (if the source of the message is local or if the
25694 remote host is permitted to send unqualified addresses). Rewriting can
25695 sometimes be used to handle simple bang paths with a fixed number of
25696 components. For example, the rule
25697 .code
25698 \N^([^!]+)!(.*)@your.domain.example$\N $2@$1
25699 .endd
25700 rewrites a two-component bang path &'host.name!user'& as the domain address
25701 &'user@host.name'&. However, there is a security implication in using this as
25702 a global rewriting rule for envelope addresses. It can provide a backdoor
25703 method for using your system as a relay, because the incoming addresses appear
25704 to be local. If the bang path addresses are received via SMTP, it is safer to
25705 use the &"S"& flag to rewrite them as they are received, so that relay checking
25706 can be done on the rewritten addresses.
25707 .ecindex IIDaddrew
25708
25709
25710
25711
25712
25713 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25714 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25715
25716 .chapter "Retry configuration" "CHAPretry"
25717 .scindex IIDretconf1 "retry" "configuration, description of"
25718 .scindex IIDregconf2 "configuration file" "retry section"
25719 The &"retry"& section of the runtime configuration file contains a list of
25720 retry rules that control how often Exim tries to deliver messages that cannot
25721 be delivered at the first attempt. If there are no retry rules (the section is
25722 empty or not present), there are no retries. In this situation, temporary
25723 errors are treated as permanent. The default configuration contains a single,
25724 general-purpose retry rule (see section &<<SECID57>>&). The &%-brt%& command
25725 line option can be used to test which retry rule will be used for a given
25726 address, domain and error.
25727
25728 The most common cause of retries is temporary failure to deliver to a remote
25729 host because the host is down, or inaccessible because of a network problem.
25730 Exim's retry processing in this case is applied on a per-host (strictly, per IP
25731 address) basis, not on a per-message basis. Thus, if one message has recently
25732 been delayed, delivery of a new message to the same host is not immediately
25733 tried, but waits for the host's retry time to arrive. If the &%retry_defer%&
25734 log selector is set, the message
25735 .cindex "retry" "time not reached"
25736 &"retry time not reached"& is written to the main log whenever a delivery is
25737 skipped for this reason. Section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>& contains more details of
25738 the handling of errors during remote deliveries.
25739
25740 Retry processing applies to routing as well as to delivering, except as covered
25741 in the next paragraph. The retry rules do not distinguish between these
25742 actions. It is not possible, for example, to specify different behaviour for
25743 failures to route the domain &'snark.fict.example'& and failures to deliver to
25744 the host &'snark.fict.example'&. I didn't think anyone would ever need this
25745 added complication, so did not implement it. However, although they share the
25746 same retry rule, the actual retry times for routing and transporting a given
25747 domain are maintained independently.
25748
25749 When a delivery is not part of a queue run (typically an immediate delivery on
25750 receipt of a message), the routers are always run, and local deliveries are
25751 always attempted, even if retry times are set for them. This makes for better
25752 behaviour if one particular message is causing problems (for example, causing
25753 quota overflow, or provoking an error in a filter file). If such a delivery
25754 suffers a temporary failure, the retry data is updated as normal, and
25755 subsequent delivery attempts from queue runs occur only when the retry time for
25756 the local address is reached.
25757
25758 .section "Changing retry rules" "SECID157"
25759 If you change the retry rules in your configuration, you should consider
25760 whether or not to delete the retry data that is stored in Exim's spool area in
25761 files with names like &_db/retry_&. Deleting any of Exim's hints files is
25762 always safe; that is why they are called &"hints"&.
25763
25764 The hints retry data contains suggested retry times based on the previous
25765 rules. In the case of a long-running problem with a remote host, it might
25766 record the fact that the host has timed out. If your new rules increase the
25767 timeout time for such a host, you should definitely remove the old retry data
25768 and let Exim recreate it, based on the new rules. Otherwise Exim might bounce
25769 messages that it should now be retaining.
25770
25771
25772
25773 .section "Format of retry rules" "SECID158"
25774 .cindex "retry" "rules"
25775 Each retry rule occupies one line and consists of three or four parts,
25776 separated by white space: a pattern, an error name, an optional list of sender
25777 addresses, and a list of retry parameters. The pattern and sender lists must be
25778 enclosed in double quotes if they contain white space. The rules are searched
25779 in order until one is found where the pattern, error name, and sender list (if
25780 present) match the failing host or address, the error that occurred, and the
25781 message's sender, respectively.
25782
25783
25784 The pattern is any single item that may appear in an address list (see section
25785 &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). It is in fact processed as a one-item address list,
25786 which means that it is expanded before being tested against the address that
25787 has been delayed. A negated address list item is permitted. Address
25788 list processing treats a plain domain name as if it were preceded by &"*@"&,
25789 which makes it possible for many retry rules to start with just a domain. For
25790 example,
25791 .code
25792 lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
25793 .endd
25794 provides a rule for any address in the &'lookingglass.fict.example'& domain,
25795 whereas
25796 .code
25797 alice@lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
25798 .endd
25799 applies only to temporary failures involving the local part &%alice%&.
25800 In practice, almost all rules start with a domain name pattern without a local
25801 part.
25802
25803 .cindex "regular expressions" "in retry rules"
25804 &*Warning*&: If you use a regular expression in a retry rule pattern, it
25805 must match a complete address, not just a domain, because that is how regular
25806 expressions work in address lists.
25807 .display
25808 &`^\Nxyz\d+\.abc\.example$\N * G,1h,10m,2`& &%Wrong%&
25809 &`^\N[^@]+@xyz\d+\.abc\.example$\N * G,1h,10m,2`& &%Right%&
25810 .endd
25811
25812
25813 .section "Choosing which retry rule to use for address errors" "SECID159"
25814 When Exim is looking for a retry rule after a routing attempt has failed (for
25815 example, after a DNS timeout), each line in the retry configuration is tested
25816 against the complete address only if &%retry_use_local_part%& is set for the
25817 router. Otherwise, only the domain is used, except when matching against a
25818 regular expression, when the local part of the address is replaced with &"*"&.
25819 A domain on its own can match a domain pattern, or a pattern that starts with
25820 &"*@"&. By default, &%retry_use_local_part%& is true for routers where
25821 &%check_local_user%& is true, and false for other routers.
25822
25823 Similarly, when Exim is looking for a retry rule after a local delivery has
25824 failed (for example, after a mailbox full error), each line in the retry
25825 configuration is tested against the complete address only if
25826 &%retry_use_local_part%& is set for the transport (it defaults true for all
25827 local transports).
25828
25829 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "retry rules for"
25830 However, when Exim is looking for a retry rule after a remote delivery attempt
25831 suffers an address error (a 4&'xx'& SMTP response for a recipient address), the
25832 whole address is always used as the key when searching the retry rules. The
25833 rule that is found is used to create a retry time for the combination of the
25834 failing address and the message's sender. It is the combination of sender and
25835 recipient that is delayed in subsequent queue runs until its retry time is
25836 reached. You can delay the recipient without regard to the sender by setting
25837 &%address_retry_include_sender%& false in the &(smtp)& transport but this can
25838 lead to problems with servers that regularly issue 4&'xx'& responses to RCPT
25839 commands.
25840
25841
25842
25843 .section "Choosing which retry rule to use for host and message errors" &&&
25844 "SECID160"
25845 For a temporary error that is not related to an individual address (for
25846 example, a connection timeout), each line in the retry configuration is checked
25847 twice. First, the name of the remote host is used as a domain name (preceded by
25848 &"*@"& when matching a regular expression). If this does not match the line,
25849 the domain from the email address is tried in a similar fashion. For example,
25850 suppose the MX records for &'a.b.c.example'& are
25851 .code
25852 a.b.c.example MX 5 x.y.z.example
25853 MX 6 p.q.r.example
25854 MX 7 m.n.o.example
25855 .endd
25856 and the retry rules are
25857 .code
25858 p.q.r.example * F,24h,30m;
25859 a.b.c.example * F,4d,45m;
25860 .endd
25861 and a delivery to the host &'x.y.z.example'& suffers a connection failure. The
25862 first rule matches neither the host nor the domain, so Exim looks at the second
25863 rule. This does not match the host, but it does match the domain, so it is used
25864 to calculate the retry time for the host &'x.y.z.example'&. Meanwhile, Exim
25865 tries to deliver to &'p.q.r.example'&. If this also suffers a host error, the
25866 first retry rule is used, because it matches the host.
25867
25868 In other words, temporary failures to deliver to host &'p.q.r.example'& use the
25869 first rule to determine retry times, but for all the other hosts for the domain
25870 &'a.b.c.example'&, the second rule is used. The second rule is also used if
25871 routing to &'a.b.c.example'& suffers a temporary failure.
25872
25873 &*Note*&: The host name is used when matching the patterns, not its IP address.
25874 However, if a message is routed directly to an IP address without the use of a
25875 host name, for example, if a &(manualroute)& router contains a setting such as:
25876 .code
25877 route_list = *.a.example 192.168.34.23
25878 .endd
25879 then the &"host name"& that is used when searching for a retry rule is the
25880 textual form of the IP address.
25881
25882 .section "Retry rules for specific errors" "SECID161"
25883 .cindex "retry" "specific errors; specifying"
25884 The second field in a retry rule is the name of a particular error, or an
25885 asterisk, which matches any error. The errors that can be tested for are:
25886
25887 .vlist
25888 .vitem &%auth_failed%&
25889 Authentication failed when trying to send to a host in the
25890 &%hosts_require_auth%& list in an &(smtp)& transport.
25891
25892 .vitem &%data_4xx%&
25893 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing DATA command, either immediately
25894 after the command, or after sending the message's data.
25895
25896 .vitem &%mail_4xx%&
25897 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing MAIL command.
25898
25899 .vitem &%rcpt_4xx%&
25900 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing RCPT command.
25901 .endlist
25902
25903 For the three 4&'xx'& errors, either the first or both of the x's can be given
25904 as specific digits, for example: &`mail_45x`& or &`rcpt_436`&. For example, to
25905 recognize 452 errors given to RCPT commands for addresses in a certain domain,
25906 and have retries every ten minutes with a one-hour timeout, you could set up a
25907 retry rule of this form:
25908 .code
25909 the.domain.name rcpt_452 F,1h,10m
25910 .endd
25911 These errors apply to both outgoing SMTP (the &(smtp)& transport) and outgoing
25912 LMTP (either the &(lmtp)& transport, or the &(smtp)& transport in LMTP mode).
25913
25914 .vlist
25915 .vitem &%lost_connection%&
25916 A server unexpectedly closed the SMTP connection. There may, of course,
25917 legitimate reasons for this (host died, network died), but if it repeats a lot
25918 for the same host, it indicates something odd.
25919
25920 .vitem &%lookup%&
25921 A DNS lookup for a host failed.
25922 Note that a &%dnslookup%& router will need to have matched
25923 its &%fail_defer_domains%& option for this retry type to be usable.
25924 Also note that a &%manualroute%& router will probably need
25925 its &%host_find_failed%& option set to &%defer%&.
25926
25927 .vitem &%refused_MX%&
25928 A connection to a host obtained from an MX record was refused.
25929
25930 .vitem &%refused_A%&
25931 A connection to a host not obtained from an MX record was refused.
25932
25933 .vitem &%refused%&
25934 A connection was refused.
25935
25936 .vitem &%timeout_connect_MX%&
25937 A connection attempt to a host obtained from an MX record timed out.
25938
25939 .vitem &%timeout_connect_A%&
25940 A connection attempt to a host not obtained from an MX record timed out.
25941
25942 .vitem &%timeout_connect%&
25943 A connection attempt timed out.
25944
25945 .vitem &%timeout_MX%&
25946 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session with a host
25947 obtained from an MX record.
25948
25949 .vitem &%timeout_A%&
25950 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session with a host not
25951 obtained from an MX record.
25952
25953 .vitem &%timeout%&
25954 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session.
25955
25956 .vitem &%tls_required%&
25957 The server was required to use TLS (it matched &%hosts_require_tls%& in the
25958 &(smtp)& transport), but either did not offer TLS, or it responded with 4&'xx'&
25959 to STARTTLS, or there was a problem setting up the TLS connection.
25960
25961 .vitem &%quota%&
25962 A mailbox quota was exceeded in a local delivery by the &(appendfile)&
25963 transport.
25964
25965 .vitem &%quota_%&<&'time'&>
25966 .cindex "quota" "error testing in retry rule"
25967 .cindex "retry" "quota error testing"
25968 A mailbox quota was exceeded in a local delivery by the &(appendfile)&
25969 transport, and the mailbox has not been accessed for <&'time'&>. For example,
25970 &'quota_4d'& applies to a quota error when the mailbox has not been accessed
25971 for four days.
25972 .endlist
25973
25974 .cindex "mailbox" "time of last read"
25975 The idea of &%quota_%&<&'time'&> is to make it possible to have shorter
25976 timeouts when the mailbox is full and is not being read by its owner. Ideally,
25977 it should be based on the last time that the user accessed the mailbox.
25978 However, it is not always possible to determine this. Exim uses the following
25979 heuristic rules:
25980
25981 .ilist
25982 If the mailbox is a single file, the time of last access (the &"atime"&) is
25983 used. As no new messages are being delivered (because the mailbox is over
25984 quota), Exim does not access the file, so this is the time of last user access.
25985 .next
25986 .cindex "maildir format" "time of last read"
25987 For a maildir delivery, the time of last modification of the &_new_&
25988 subdirectory is used. As the mailbox is over quota, no new files are created in
25989 the &_new_& subdirectory, because no new messages are being delivered. Any
25990 change to the &_new_& subdirectory is therefore assumed to be the result of an
25991 MUA moving a new message to the &_cur_& directory when it is first read. The
25992 time that is used is therefore the last time that the user read a new message.
25993 .next
25994 For other kinds of multi-file mailbox, the time of last access cannot be
25995 obtained, so a retry rule that uses this type of error field is never matched.
25996 .endlist
25997
25998 The quota errors apply both to system-enforced quotas and to Exim's own quota
25999 mechanism in the &(appendfile)& transport. The &'quota'& error also applies
26000 when a local delivery is deferred because a partition is full (the ENOSPC
26001 error).
26002
26003
26004
26005 .section "Retry rules for specified senders" "SECID162"
26006 .cindex "retry" "rules; sender-specific"
26007 You can specify retry rules that apply only when the failing message has a
26008 specific sender. In particular, this can be used to define retry rules that
26009 apply only to bounce messages. The third item in a retry rule can be of this
26010 form:
26011 .display
26012 &`senders=`&<&'address list'&>
26013 .endd
26014 The retry timings themselves are then the fourth item. For example:
26015 .code
26016 * rcpt_4xx senders=: F,1h,30m
26017 .endd
26018 matches recipient 4&'xx'& errors for bounce messages sent to any address at any
26019 host. If the address list contains white space, it must be enclosed in quotes.
26020 For example:
26021 .code
26022 a.domain rcpt_452 senders="xb.dom : yc.dom" G,8h,10m,1.5
26023 .endd
26024 &*Warning*&: This facility can be unhelpful if it is used for host errors
26025 (which do not depend on the recipient). The reason is that the sender is used
26026 only to match the retry rule. Once the rule has been found for a host error,
26027 its contents are used to set a retry time for the host, and this will apply to
26028 all messages, not just those with specific senders.
26029
26030 When testing retry rules using &%-brt%&, you can supply a sender using the
26031 &%-f%& command line option, like this:
26032 .code
26033 exim -f "" -brt user@dom.ain
26034 .endd
26035 If you do not set &%-f%& with &%-brt%&, a retry rule that contains a senders
26036 list is never matched.
26037
26038
26039
26040
26041
26042 .section "Retry parameters" "SECID163"
26043 .cindex "retry" "parameters in rules"
26044 The third (or fourth, if a senders list is present) field in a retry rule is a
26045 sequence of retry parameter sets, separated by semicolons. Each set consists of
26046 .display
26047 <&'letter'&>,<&'cutoff time'&>,<&'arguments'&>
26048 .endd
26049 The letter identifies the algorithm for computing a new retry time; the cutoff
26050 time is the time beyond which this algorithm no longer applies, and the
26051 arguments vary the algorithm's action. The cutoff time is measured from the
26052 time that the first failure for the domain (combined with the local part if
26053 relevant) was detected, not from the time the message was received.
26054
26055 .cindex "retry" "algorithms"
26056 .cindex "retry" "fixed intervals"
26057 .cindex "retry" "increasing intervals"
26058 .cindex "retry" "random intervals"
26059 The available algorithms are:
26060
26061 .ilist
26062 &'F'&: retry at fixed intervals. There is a single time parameter specifying
26063 the interval.
26064 .next
26065 &'G'&: retry at geometrically increasing intervals. The first argument
26066 specifies a starting value for the interval, and the second a multiplier, which
26067 is used to increase the size of the interval at each retry.
26068 .next
26069 &'H'&: retry at randomized intervals. The arguments are as for &'G'&. For each
26070 retry, the previous interval is multiplied by the factor in order to get a
26071 maximum for the next interval. The minimum interval is the first argument of
26072 the parameter, and an actual interval is chosen randomly between them. Such a
26073 rule has been found to be helpful in cluster configurations when all the
26074 members of the cluster restart at once, and may therefore synchronize their
26075 queue processing times.
26076 .endlist
26077
26078 When computing the next retry time, the algorithm definitions are scanned in
26079 order until one whose cutoff time has not yet passed is reached. This is then
26080 used to compute a new retry time that is later than the current time. In the
26081 case of fixed interval retries, this simply means adding the interval to the
26082 current time. For geometrically increasing intervals, retry intervals are
26083 computed from the rule's parameters until one that is greater than the previous
26084 interval is found. The main configuration variable
26085 .cindex "limit" "retry interval"
26086 .cindex "retry" "interval, maximum"
26087 .oindex "&%retry_interval_max%&"
26088 &%retry_interval_max%& limits the maximum interval between retries. It
26089 cannot be set greater than &`24h`&, which is its default value.
26090
26091 A single remote domain may have a number of hosts associated with it, and each
26092 host may have more than one IP address. Retry algorithms are selected on the
26093 basis of the domain name, but are applied to each IP address independently. If,
26094 for example, a host has two IP addresses and one is unusable, Exim will
26095 generate retry times for it and will not try to use it until its next retry
26096 time comes. Thus the good IP address is likely to be tried first most of the
26097 time.
26098
26099 .cindex "hints database" "use for retrying"
26100 Retry times are hints rather than promises. Exim does not make any attempt to
26101 run deliveries exactly at the computed times. Instead, a queue runner process
26102 starts delivery processes for delayed messages periodically, and these attempt
26103 new deliveries only for those addresses that have passed their next retry time.
26104 If a new message arrives for a deferred address, an immediate delivery attempt
26105 occurs only if the address has passed its retry time. In the absence of new
26106 messages, the minimum time between retries is the interval between queue runner
26107 processes. There is not much point in setting retry times of five minutes if
26108 your queue runners happen only once an hour, unless there are a significant
26109 number of incoming messages (which might be the case on a system that is
26110 sending everything to a smart host, for example).
26111
26112 The data in the retry hints database can be inspected by using the
26113 &'exim_dumpdb'& or &'exim_fixdb'& utility programs (see chapter
26114 &<<CHAPutils>>&). The latter utility can also be used to change the data. The
26115 &'exinext'& utility script can be used to find out what the next retry times
26116 are for the hosts associated with a particular mail domain, and also for local
26117 deliveries that have been deferred.
26118
26119
26120 .section "Retry rule examples" "SECID164"
26121 Here are some example retry rules:
26122 .code
26123 alice@wonderland.fict.example quota_5d F,7d,3h
26124 wonderland.fict.example quota_5d
26125 wonderland.fict.example * F,1h,15m; G,2d,1h,2;
26126 lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
26127 * refused_A F,2h,20m;
26128 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,5d,8h
26129 .endd
26130 The first rule sets up special handling for mail to
26131 &'alice@wonderland.fict.example'& when there is an over-quota error and the
26132 mailbox has not been read for at least 5 days. Retries continue every three
26133 hours for 7 days. The second rule handles over-quota errors for all other local
26134 parts at &'wonderland.fict.example'&; the absence of a local part has the same
26135 effect as supplying &"*@"&. As no retry algorithms are supplied, messages that
26136 fail are bounced immediately if the mailbox has not been read for at least 5
26137 days.
26138
26139 The third rule handles all other errors at &'wonderland.fict.example'&; retries
26140 happen every 15 minutes for an hour, then with geometrically increasing
26141 intervals until two days have passed since a delivery first failed. After the
26142 first hour there is a delay of one hour, then two hours, then four hours, and
26143 so on (this is a rather extreme example).
26144
26145 The fourth rule controls retries for the domain &'lookingglass.fict.example'&.
26146 They happen every 30 minutes for 24 hours only. The remaining two rules handle
26147 all other domains, with special action for connection refusal from hosts that
26148 were not obtained from an MX record.
26149
26150 The final rule in a retry configuration should always have asterisks in the
26151 first two fields so as to provide a general catch-all for any addresses that do
26152 not have their own special handling. This example tries every 15 minutes for 2
26153 hours, then with intervals starting at one hour and increasing by a factor of
26154 1.5 up to 16 hours, then every 8 hours up to 5 days.
26155
26156
26157
26158 .section "Timeout of retry data" "SECID165"
26159 .cindex "timeout" "of retry data"
26160 .oindex "&%retry_data_expire%&"
26161 .cindex "hints database" "data expiry"
26162 .cindex "retry" "timeout of data"
26163 Exim timestamps the data that it writes to its retry hints database. When it
26164 consults the data during a delivery it ignores any that is older than the value
26165 set in &%retry_data_expire%& (default 7 days). If, for example, a host hasn't
26166 been tried for 7 days, Exim will try to deliver to it immediately a message
26167 arrives, and if that fails, it will calculate a retry time as if it were
26168 failing for the first time.
26169
26170 This improves the behaviour for messages routed to rarely-used hosts such as MX
26171 backups. If such a host was down at one time, and happens to be down again when
26172 Exim tries a month later, using the old retry data would imply that it had been
26173 down all the time, which is not a justified assumption.
26174
26175 If a host really is permanently dead, this behaviour causes a burst of retries
26176 every now and again, but only if messages routed to it are rare. If there is a
26177 message at least once every 7 days the retry data never expires.
26178
26179
26180
26181
26182 .section "Long-term failures" "SECID166"
26183 .cindex "delivery failure, long-term"
26184 .cindex "retry" "after long-term failure"
26185 Special processing happens when an email address has been failing for so long
26186 that the cutoff time for the last algorithm is reached. For example, using the
26187 default retry rule:
26188 .code
26189 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,4d,6h
26190 .endd
26191 the cutoff time is four days. Reaching the retry cutoff is independent of how
26192 long any specific message has been failing; it is the length of continuous
26193 failure for the recipient address that counts.
26194
26195 When the cutoff time is reached for a local delivery, or for all the IP
26196 addresses associated with a remote delivery, a subsequent delivery failure
26197 causes Exim to give up on the address, and a bounce message is generated.
26198 In order to cater for new messages that use the failing address, a next retry
26199 time is still computed from the final algorithm, and is used as follows:
26200
26201 For local deliveries, one delivery attempt is always made for any subsequent
26202 messages. If this delivery fails, the address fails immediately. The
26203 post-cutoff retry time is not used.
26204
26205 .cindex "final cutoff" "retries, controlling"
26206 .cindex retry "final cutoff"
26207 If the delivery is remote, there are two possibilities, controlled by the
26208 .oindex "&%delay_after_cutoff%&"
26209 &%delay_after_cutoff%& option of the &(smtp)& transport. The option is true by
26210 default. Until the post-cutoff retry time for one of the IP addresses,
26211 as set by the &%retry_data_expire%& option, is
26212 reached, the failing email address is bounced immediately, without a delivery
26213 attempt taking place. After that time, one new delivery attempt is made to
26214 those IP addresses that are past their retry times, and if that still fails,
26215 the address is bounced and new retry times are computed.
26216
26217 In other words, when all the hosts for a given email address have been failing
26218 for a long time, Exim bounces rather then defers until one of the hosts' retry
26219 times is reached. Then it tries once, and bounces if that attempt fails. This
26220 behaviour ensures that few resources are wasted in repeatedly trying to deliver
26221 to a broken destination, but if the host does recover, Exim will eventually
26222 notice.
26223
26224 If &%delay_after_cutoff%& is set false, Exim behaves differently. If all IP
26225 addresses are past their final cutoff time, Exim tries to deliver to those IP
26226 addresses that have not been tried since the message arrived. If there are
26227 no suitable IP addresses, or if they all fail, the address is bounced. In other
26228 words, it does not delay when a new message arrives, but tries the expired
26229 addresses immediately, unless they have been tried since the message arrived.
26230 If there is a continuous stream of messages for the failing domains, setting
26231 &%delay_after_cutoff%& false means that there will be many more attempts to
26232 deliver to permanently failing IP addresses than when &%delay_after_cutoff%& is
26233 true.
26234
26235 .section "Deliveries that work intermittently" "SECID167"
26236 .cindex "retry" "intermittently working deliveries"
26237 Some additional logic is needed to cope with cases where a host is
26238 intermittently available, or when a message has some attribute that prevents
26239 its delivery when others to the same address get through. In this situation,
26240 because some messages are successfully delivered, the &"retry clock"& for the
26241 host or address keeps getting reset by the successful deliveries, and so
26242 failing messages remain in the queue for ever because the cutoff time is never
26243 reached.
26244
26245 Two exceptional actions are applied to prevent this happening. The first
26246 applies to errors that are related to a message rather than a remote host.
26247 Section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>& has a discussion of the different kinds of error;
26248 examples of message-related errors are 4&'xx'& responses to MAIL or DATA
26249 commands, and quota failures. For this type of error, if a message's arrival
26250 time is earlier than the &"first failed"& time for the error, the earlier time
26251 is used when scanning the retry rules to decide when to try next and when to
26252 time out the address.
26253
26254 The exceptional second action applies in all cases. If a message has been on
26255 the queue for longer than the cutoff time of any applicable retry rule for a
26256 given address, a delivery is attempted for that address, even if it is not yet
26257 time, and if this delivery fails, the address is timed out. A new retry time is
26258 not computed in this case, so that other messages for the same address are
26259 considered immediately.
26260 .ecindex IIDretconf1
26261 .ecindex IIDregconf2
26262
26263
26264
26265
26266
26267
26268 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26269 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26270
26271 .chapter "SMTP authentication" "CHAPSMTPAUTH"
26272 .scindex IIDauthconf1 "SMTP" "authentication configuration"
26273 .scindex IIDauthconf2 "authentication"
26274 The &"authenticators"& section of Exim's runtime configuration is concerned
26275 with SMTP authentication. This facility is an extension to the SMTP protocol,
26276 described in RFC 2554, which allows a client SMTP host to authenticate itself
26277 to a server. This is a common way for a server to recognize clients that are
26278 permitted to use it as a relay. SMTP authentication is not of relevance to the
26279 transfer of mail between servers that have no managerial connection with each
26280 other.
26281
26282 .cindex "AUTH" "description of"
26283 Very briefly, the way SMTP authentication works is as follows:
26284
26285 .ilist
26286 The server advertises a number of authentication &'mechanisms'& in response to
26287 the client's EHLO command.
26288 .next
26289 The client issues an AUTH command, naming a specific mechanism. The command
26290 may, optionally, contain some authentication data.
26291 .next
26292 The server may issue one or more &'challenges'&, to which the client must send
26293 appropriate responses. In simple authentication mechanisms, the challenges are
26294 just prompts for user names and passwords. The server does not have to issue
26295 any challenges &-- in some mechanisms the relevant data may all be transmitted
26296 with the AUTH command.
26297 .next
26298 The server either accepts or denies authentication.
26299 .next
26300 If authentication succeeds, the client may optionally make use of the AUTH
26301 option on the MAIL command to pass an authenticated sender in subsequent
26302 mail transactions. Authentication lasts for the remainder of the SMTP
26303 connection.
26304 .next
26305 If authentication fails, the client may give up, or it may try a different
26306 authentication mechanism, or it may try transferring mail over the
26307 unauthenticated connection.
26308 .endlist
26309
26310 If you are setting up a client, and want to know which authentication
26311 mechanisms the server supports, you can use Telnet to connect to port 25 (the
26312 SMTP port) on the server, and issue an EHLO command. The response to this
26313 includes the list of supported mechanisms. For example:
26314 .display
26315 &`$ `&&*&`telnet server.example 25`&*&
26316 &`Trying 192.168.34.25...`&
26317 &`Connected to server.example.`&
26318 &`Escape character is &#x0027;^]&#x0027;.`&
26319 &`220 server.example ESMTP Exim 4.20 ...`&
26320 &*&`ehlo client.example`&*&
26321 &`250-server.example Hello client.example [10.8.4.5]`&
26322 &`250-SIZE 52428800`&
26323 &`250-PIPELINING`&
26324 &`250-AUTH PLAIN`&
26325 &`250 HELP`&
26326 .endd
26327 The second-last line of this example output shows that the server supports
26328 authentication using the PLAIN mechanism. In Exim, the different authentication
26329 mechanisms are configured by specifying &'authenticator'& drivers. Like the
26330 routers and transports, which authenticators are included in the binary is
26331 controlled by build-time definitions. The following are currently available,
26332 included by setting
26333 .code
26334 AUTH_CRAM_MD5=yes
26335 AUTH_CYRUS_SASL=yes
26336 AUTH_DOVECOT=yes
26337 AUTH_EXTERNAL=yes
26338 AUTH_GSASL=yes
26339 AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI=yes
26340 AUTH_PLAINTEXT=yes
26341 AUTH_SPA=yes
26342 AUTH_TLS=yes
26343 .endd
26344 in &_Local/Makefile_&, respectively. The first of these supports the CRAM-MD5
26345 authentication mechanism (RFC 2195), and the second provides an interface to
26346 the Cyrus SASL authentication library.
26347 The third is an interface to Dovecot's authentication system, delegating the
26348 work via a socket interface.
26349 .new
26350 The fourth provides for negotiation of authentication done via non-SMTP means,
26351 as defined by RFC 4422 Appendix A.
26352 .wen
26353 The fifth provides an interface to the GNU SASL authentication library, which
26354 provides mechanisms but typically not data sources.
26355 The sixth provides direct access to Heimdal GSSAPI, geared for Kerberos, but
26356 supporting setting a server keytab.
26357 The seventh can be configured to support
26358 the PLAIN authentication mechanism (RFC 2595) or the LOGIN mechanism, which is
26359 not formally documented, but used by several MUAs.
26360 The eighth authenticator
26361 supports Microsoft's &'Secure Password Authentication'& mechanism.
26362 The last is an Exim authenticator but not an SMTP one;
26363 instead it can use information from a TLS negotiation.
26364
26365 The authenticators are configured using the same syntax as other drivers (see
26366 section &<<SECTfordricon>>&). If no authenticators are required, no
26367 authentication section need be present in the configuration file. Each
26368 authenticator can in principle have both server and client functions. When Exim
26369 is receiving SMTP mail, it is acting as a server; when it is sending out
26370 messages over SMTP, it is acting as a client. Authenticator configuration
26371 options are provided for use in both these circumstances.
26372
26373 To make it clear which options apply to which situation, the prefixes
26374 &%server_%& and &%client_%& are used on option names that are specific to
26375 either the server or the client function, respectively. Server and client
26376 functions are disabled if none of their options are set. If an authenticator is
26377 to be used for both server and client functions, a single definition, using
26378 both sets of options, is required. For example:
26379 .code
26380 cram:
26381 driver = cram_md5
26382 public_name = CRAM-MD5
26383 server_secret = ${if eq{$auth1}{ph10}{secret1}fail}
26384 client_name = ph10
26385 client_secret = secret2
26386 .endd
26387 The &%server_%& option is used when Exim is acting as a server, and the
26388 &%client_%& options when it is acting as a client.
26389
26390 Descriptions of the individual authenticators are given in subsequent chapters.
26391 The remainder of this chapter covers the generic options for the
26392 authenticators, followed by general discussion of the way authentication works
26393 in Exim.
26394
26395 &*Beware:*& the meaning of &$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, ... varies on a per-driver and
26396 per-mechanism basis. Please read carefully to determine which variables hold
26397 account labels such as usercodes and which hold passwords or other
26398 authenticating data.
26399
26400 Note that some mechanisms support two different identifiers for accounts: the
26401 &'authentication id'& and the &'authorization id'&. The contractions &'authn'&
26402 and &'authz'& are commonly encountered. The American spelling is standard here.
26403 Conceptually, authentication data such as passwords are tied to the identifier
26404 used to authenticate; servers may have rules to permit one user to act as a
26405 second user, so that after login the session is treated as though that second
26406 user had logged in. That second user is the &'authorization id'&. A robust
26407 configuration might confirm that the &'authz'& field is empty or matches the
26408 &'authn'& field. Often this is just ignored. The &'authn'& can be considered
26409 as verified data, the &'authz'& as an unverified request which the server might
26410 choose to honour.
26411
26412 A &'realm'& is a text string, typically a domain name, presented by a server
26413 to a client to help it select an account and credentials to use. In some
26414 mechanisms, the client and server provably agree on the realm, but clients
26415 typically can not treat the realm as secure data to be blindly trusted.
26416
26417
26418
26419 .section "Generic options for authenticators" "SECID168"
26420 .cindex "authentication" "generic options"
26421 .cindex "options" "generic; for authenticators"
26422
26423 .option client_condition authenticators string&!! unset
26424 When Exim is authenticating as a client, it skips any authenticator whose
26425 &%client_condition%& expansion yields &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&. This can be
26426 used, for example, to skip plain text authenticators when the connection is not
26427 encrypted by a setting such as:
26428 .code
26429 client_condition = ${if !eq{$tls_out_cipher}{}}
26430 .endd
26431
26432
26433 .option client_set_id authenticators string&!! unset
26434 When client authentication succeeds, this condition is expanded; the
26435 result is used in the log lines for outbound messages.
26436 Typically it will be the user name used for authentication.
26437
26438
26439 .option driver authenticators string unset
26440 This option must always be set. It specifies which of the available
26441 authenticators is to be used.
26442
26443
26444 .option public_name authenticators string unset
26445 This option specifies the name of the authentication mechanism that the driver
26446 implements, and by which it is known to the outside world. These names should
26447 contain only upper case letters, digits, underscores, and hyphens (RFC 2222),
26448 but Exim in fact matches them caselessly. If &%public_name%& is not set, it
26449 defaults to the driver's instance name.
26450
26451
26452 .option server_advertise_condition authenticators string&!! unset
26453 When a server is about to advertise an authentication mechanism, the condition
26454 is expanded. If it yields the empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, the
26455 mechanism is not advertised.
26456 If the expansion fails, the mechanism is not advertised. If the failure was not
26457 forced, and was not caused by a lookup defer, the incident is logged.
26458 See section &<<SECTauthexiser>>& below for further discussion.
26459
26460
26461 .option server_condition authenticators string&!! unset
26462 This option must be set for a &%plaintext%& server authenticator, where it
26463 is used directly to control authentication. See section &<<SECTplainserver>>&
26464 for details.
26465
26466 For the &(gsasl)& authenticator, this option is required for various
26467 mechanisms; see chapter &<<CHAPgsasl>>& for details.
26468
26469 For the other authenticators, &%server_condition%& can be used as an additional
26470 authentication or authorization mechanism that is applied after the other
26471 authenticator conditions succeed. If it is set, it is expanded when the
26472 authenticator would otherwise return a success code. If the expansion is forced
26473 to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary
26474 error code to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty
26475 string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
26476 expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds. For any
26477 other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded string as
26478 the error text.
26479
26480
26481 .option server_debug_print authenticators string&!! unset
26482 If this option is set and authentication debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%&
26483 command line option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging
26484 output when the authenticator is run as a server. This can help with checking
26485 out the values of variables.
26486 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
26487 output, and Exim carries on processing.
26488
26489
26490 .option server_set_id authenticators string&!! unset
26491 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
26492 .vindex "&$authenticated_fail_id$&"
26493 When an Exim server successfully authenticates a client, this string is
26494 expanded using data from the authentication, and preserved for any incoming
26495 messages in the variable &$authenticated_id$&. It is also included in the log
26496 lines for incoming messages. For example, a user/password authenticator
26497 configuration might preserve the user name that was used to authenticate, and
26498 refer to it subsequently during delivery of the message.
26499 On a failing authentication the expansion result is instead saved in
26500 the &$authenticated_fail_id$& variable.
26501 If expansion fails, the option is ignored.
26502
26503
26504 .option server_mail_auth_condition authenticators string&!! unset
26505 This option allows a server to discard authenticated sender addresses supplied
26506 as part of MAIL commands in SMTP connections that are authenticated by the
26507 driver on which &%server_mail_auth_condition%& is set. The option is not used
26508 as part of the authentication process; instead its (unexpanded) value is
26509 remembered for later use.
26510 How it is used is described in the following section.
26511
26512
26513
26514
26515
26516 .section "The AUTH parameter on MAIL commands" "SECTauthparamail"
26517 .cindex "authentication" "sender; authenticated"
26518 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
26519 When a client supplied an AUTH= item on a MAIL command, Exim applies
26520 the following checks before accepting it as the authenticated sender of the
26521 message:
26522
26523 .ilist
26524 If the connection is not using extended SMTP (that is, HELO was used rather
26525 than EHLO), the use of AUTH= is a syntax error.
26526 .next
26527 If the value of the AUTH= parameter is &"<>"&, it is ignored.
26528 .next
26529 .vindex "&$authenticated_sender$&"
26530 If &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& is defined, the ACL it specifies is run. While it is
26531 running, the value of &$authenticated_sender$& is set to the value obtained
26532 from the AUTH= parameter. If the ACL does not yield &"accept"&, the value of
26533 &$authenticated_sender$& is deleted. The &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& ACL may not
26534 return &"drop"& or &"discard"&. If it defers, a temporary error code (451) is
26535 given for the MAIL command.
26536 .next
26537 If &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& is not defined, the value of the AUTH= parameter
26538 is accepted and placed in &$authenticated_sender$& only if the client has
26539 authenticated.
26540 .next
26541 If the AUTH= value was accepted by either of the two previous rules, and
26542 the client has authenticated, and the authenticator has a setting for the
26543 &%server_mail_auth_condition%&, the condition is checked at this point. The
26544 valued that was saved from the authenticator is expanded. If the expansion
26545 fails, or yields an empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, the value of
26546 &$authenticated_sender$& is deleted. If the expansion yields any other value,
26547 the value of &$authenticated_sender$& is retained and passed on with the
26548 message.
26549 .endlist
26550
26551
26552 When &$authenticated_sender$& is set for a message, it is passed on to other
26553 hosts to which Exim authenticates as a client. Do not confuse this value with
26554 &$authenticated_id$&, which is a string obtained from the authentication
26555 process, and which is not usually a complete email address.
26556
26557 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
26558 Whenever an AUTH= value is ignored, the incident is logged. The ACL for
26559 MAIL, if defined, is run after AUTH= is accepted or ignored. It can
26560 therefore make use of &$authenticated_sender$&. The converse is not true: the
26561 value of &$sender_address$& is not yet set up when the &%acl_smtp_mailauth%&
26562 ACL is run.
26563
26564
26565
26566 .section "Authentication on an Exim server" "SECTauthexiser"
26567 .cindex "authentication" "on an Exim server"
26568 When Exim receives an EHLO command, it advertises the public names of those
26569 authenticators that are configured as servers, subject to the following
26570 conditions:
26571
26572 .ilist
26573 The client host must match &%auth_advertise_hosts%& (default *).
26574 .next
26575 It the &%server_advertise_condition%& option is set, its expansion must not
26576 yield the empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&.
26577 .endlist
26578
26579 The order in which the authenticators are defined controls the order in which
26580 the mechanisms are advertised.
26581
26582 Some mail clients (for example, some versions of Netscape) require the user to
26583 provide a name and password for authentication whenever AUTH is advertised,
26584 even though authentication may not in fact be needed (for example, Exim may be
26585 set up to allow unconditional relaying from the client by an IP address check).
26586 You can make such clients more friendly by not advertising AUTH to them.
26587 For example, if clients on the 10.9.8.0/24 network are permitted (by the ACL
26588 that runs for RCPT) to relay without authentication, you should set
26589 .code
26590 auth_advertise_hosts = ! 10.9.8.0/24
26591 .endd
26592 so that no authentication mechanisms are advertised to them.
26593
26594 The &%server_advertise_condition%& controls the advertisement of individual
26595 authentication mechanisms. For example, it can be used to restrict the
26596 advertisement of a particular mechanism to encrypted connections, by a setting
26597 such as:
26598 .code
26599 server_advertise_condition = ${if eq{$tls_in_cipher}{}{no}{yes}}
26600 .endd
26601 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
26602 If the session is encrypted, &$tls_in_cipher$& is not empty, and so the expansion
26603 yields &"yes"&, which allows the advertisement to happen.
26604
26605 When an Exim server receives an AUTH command from a client, it rejects it
26606 immediately if AUTH was not advertised in response to an earlier EHLO
26607 command. This is the case if
26608
26609 .ilist
26610 The client host does not match &%auth_advertise_hosts%&; or
26611 .next
26612 No authenticators are configured with server options; or
26613 .next
26614 Expansion of &%server_advertise_condition%& blocked the advertising of all the
26615 server authenticators.
26616 .endlist
26617
26618
26619 Otherwise, Exim runs the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_auth%& in order
26620 to decide whether to accept the command. If &%acl_smtp_auth%& is not set,
26621 AUTH is accepted from any client host.
26622
26623 If AUTH is not rejected by the ACL, Exim searches its configuration for a
26624 server authentication mechanism that was advertised in response to EHLO and
26625 that matches the one named in the AUTH command. If it finds one, it runs
26626 the appropriate authentication protocol, and authentication either succeeds or
26627 fails. If there is no matching advertised mechanism, the AUTH command is
26628 rejected with a 504 error.
26629
26630 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
26631 .vindex "&$sender_host_authenticated$&"
26632 When a message is received from an authenticated host, the value of
26633 &$received_protocol$& is set to &"esmtpa"& or &"esmtpsa"& instead of &"esmtp"&
26634 or &"esmtps"&, and &$sender_host_authenticated$& contains the name (not the
26635 public name) of the authenticator driver that successfully authenticated the
26636 client from which the message was received. This variable is empty if there was
26637 no successful authentication.
26638
26639 .cindex authentication "expansion item"
26640 Successful authentication sets up information used by the
26641 &$authresults$& expansion item.
26642
26643
26644
26645
26646 .section "Testing server authentication" "SECID169"
26647 .cindex "authentication" "testing a server"
26648 .cindex "AUTH" "testing a server"
26649 .cindex "base64 encoding" "creating authentication test data"
26650 Exim's &%-bh%& option can be useful for testing server authentication
26651 configurations. The data for the AUTH command has to be sent using base64
26652 encoding. A quick way to produce such data for testing is the following Perl
26653 script:
26654 .code
26655 use MIME::Base64;
26656 printf ("%s", encode_base64(eval "\"$ARGV[0]\""));
26657 .endd
26658 .cindex "binary zero" "in authentication data"
26659 This interprets its argument as a Perl string, and then encodes it. The
26660 interpretation as a Perl string allows binary zeros, which are required for
26661 some kinds of authentication, to be included in the data. For example, a
26662 command line to run this script on such data might be
26663 .code
26664 encode '\0user\0password'
26665 .endd
26666 Note the use of single quotes to prevent the shell interpreting the
26667 backslashes, so that they can be interpreted by Perl to specify characters
26668 whose code value is zero.
26669
26670 &*Warning 1*&: If either of the user or password strings starts with an octal
26671 digit, you must use three zeros instead of one after the leading backslash. If
26672 you do not, the octal digit that starts your string will be incorrectly
26673 interpreted as part of the code for the first character.
26674
26675 &*Warning 2*&: If there are characters in the strings that Perl interprets
26676 specially, you must use a Perl escape to prevent them being misinterpreted. For
26677 example, a command such as
26678 .code
26679 encode '\0user@domain.com\0pas$$word'
26680 .endd
26681 gives an incorrect answer because of the unescaped &"@"& and &"$"& characters.
26682
26683 If you have the &%mimencode%& command installed, another way to do produce
26684 base64-encoded strings is to run the command
26685 .code
26686 echo -e -n `\0user\0password' | mimencode
26687 .endd
26688 The &%-e%& option of &%echo%& enables the interpretation of backslash escapes
26689 in the argument, and the &%-n%& option specifies no newline at the end of its
26690 output. However, not all versions of &%echo%& recognize these options, so you
26691 should check your version before relying on this suggestion.
26692
26693
26694
26695 .section "Authentication by an Exim client" "SECID170"
26696 .cindex "authentication" "on an Exim client"
26697 The &(smtp)& transport has two options called &%hosts_require_auth%& and
26698 &%hosts_try_auth%&. When the &(smtp)& transport connects to a server that
26699 announces support for authentication, and the host matches an entry in either
26700 of these options, Exim (as a client) tries to authenticate as follows:
26701
26702 .ilist
26703 For each authenticator that is configured as a client, in the order in which
26704 they are defined in the configuration, it searches the authentication
26705 mechanisms announced by the server for one whose name matches the public name
26706 of the authenticator.
26707 .next
26708 .vindex "&$host$&"
26709 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
26710 When it finds one that matches, it runs the authenticator's client code. The
26711 variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are available for any string expansions
26712 that the client might do. They are set to the server's name and IP address. If
26713 any expansion is forced to fail, the authentication attempt is abandoned, and
26714 Exim moves on to the next authenticator. Otherwise an expansion failure causes
26715 delivery to be deferred.
26716 .next
26717 If the result of the authentication attempt is a temporary error or a timeout,
26718 Exim abandons trying to send the message to the host for the moment. It will
26719 try again later. If there are any backup hosts available, they are tried in the
26720 usual way.
26721 .next
26722 If the response to authentication is a permanent error (5&'xx'& code), Exim
26723 carries on searching the list of authenticators and tries another one if
26724 possible. If all authentication attempts give permanent errors, or if there are
26725 no attempts because no mechanisms match (or option expansions force failure),
26726 what happens depends on whether the host matches &%hosts_require_auth%& or
26727 &%hosts_try_auth%&. In the first case, a temporary error is generated, and
26728 delivery is deferred. The error can be detected in the retry rules, and thereby
26729 turned into a permanent error if you wish. In the second case, Exim tries to
26730 deliver the message unauthenticated.
26731 .endlist
26732
26733 Note that the hostlist test for whether to do authentication can be
26734 confused if name-IP lookups change between the time the peer is decided
26735 upon and the time that the transport runs. For example, with a manualroute
26736 router given a host name, and with DNS "round-robin" used by that name: if
26737 the local resolver cache times out between the router and the transport
26738 running, the transport may get an IP for the name for its authentication
26739 check which does not match the connection peer IP.
26740 No authentication will then be done, despite the names being identical.
26741
26742 For such cases use a separate transport which always authenticates.
26743
26744 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
26745 When Exim has authenticated itself to a remote server, it adds the AUTH
26746 parameter to the MAIL commands it sends, if it has an authenticated sender for
26747 the message. If the message came from a remote host, the authenticated sender
26748 is the one that was receiving on an incoming MAIL command, provided that the
26749 incoming connection was authenticated and the &%server_mail_auth%& condition
26750 allowed the authenticated sender to be retained. If a local process calls Exim
26751 to send a message, the sender address that is built from the login name and
26752 &%qualify_domain%& is treated as authenticated. However, if the
26753 &%authenticated_sender%& option is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it overrides
26754 the authenticated sender that was received with the message.
26755 .ecindex IIDauthconf1
26756 .ecindex IIDauthconf2
26757
26758
26759
26760
26761
26762
26763 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26764 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26765
26766 .chapter "The plaintext authenticator" "CHAPplaintext"
26767 .scindex IIDplaiauth1 "&(plaintext)& authenticator"
26768 .scindex IIDplaiauth2 "authenticators" "&(plaintext)&"
26769 The &(plaintext)& authenticator can be configured to support the PLAIN and
26770 LOGIN authentication mechanisms, both of which transfer authentication data as
26771 plain (unencrypted) text (though base64 encoded). The use of plain text is a
26772 security risk; you are strongly advised to insist on the use of SMTP encryption
26773 (see chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&) if you use the PLAIN or LOGIN mechanisms. If you do
26774 use unencrypted plain text, you should not use the same passwords for SMTP
26775 connections as you do for login accounts.
26776
26777 .section "Plaintext options" "SECID171"
26778 .cindex "options" "&(plaintext)& authenticator (server)"
26779 When configured as a server, &(plaintext)& uses the following options:
26780
26781 .option server_condition authenticators string&!! unset
26782 This is actually a global authentication option, but it must be set in order to
26783 configure the &(plaintext)& driver as a server. Its use is described below.
26784
26785 .option server_prompts plaintext string&!! unset
26786 The contents of this option, after expansion, must be a colon-separated list of
26787 prompt strings. If expansion fails, a temporary authentication rejection is
26788 given.
26789
26790 .section "Using plaintext in a server" "SECTplainserver"
26791 .cindex "AUTH" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
26792 .cindex "binary zero" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
26793 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" &&&
26794 "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
26795 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
26796 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
26797
26798 When running as a server, &(plaintext)& performs the authentication test by
26799 expanding a string. The data sent by the client with the AUTH command, or in
26800 response to subsequent prompts, is base64 encoded, and so may contain any byte
26801 values when decoded. If any data is supplied with the command, it is treated as
26802 a list of strings, separated by NULs (binary zeros), the first three of which
26803 are placed in the expansion variables &$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, and &$auth3$&
26804 (neither LOGIN nor PLAIN uses more than three strings).
26805
26806 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the values are also placed in
26807 the expansion variables &$1$&, &$2$&, and &$3$&. However, the use of these
26808 variables for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in
26809 string expansions that also use them for other things.
26810
26811 If there are more strings in &%server_prompts%& than the number of strings
26812 supplied with the AUTH command, the remaining prompts are used to obtain more
26813 data. Each response from the client may be a list of NUL-separated strings.
26814
26815 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
26816 Once a sufficient number of data strings have been received,
26817 &%server_condition%& is expanded. If the expansion is forced to fail,
26818 authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary error code
26819 to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty string,
26820 &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
26821 expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds and the
26822 generic &%server_set_id%& option is expanded and saved in &$authenticated_id$&.
26823 For any other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded
26824 string as the error text.
26825
26826 &*Warning*&: If you use a lookup in the expansion to find the user's
26827 password, be sure to make the authentication fail if the user is unknown.
26828 There are good and bad examples at the end of the next section.
26829
26830
26831
26832 .section "The PLAIN authentication mechanism" "SECID172"
26833 .cindex "PLAIN authentication mechanism"
26834 .cindex "authentication" "PLAIN mechanism"
26835 .cindex "binary zero" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
26836 The PLAIN authentication mechanism (RFC 2595) specifies that three strings be
26837 sent as one item of data (that is, one combined string containing two NUL
26838 separators). The data is sent either as part of the AUTH command, or
26839 subsequently in response to an empty prompt from the server.
26840
26841 The second and third strings are a user name and a corresponding password.
26842 Using a single fixed user name and password as an example, this could be
26843 configured as follows:
26844 .code
26845 fixed_plain:
26846 driver = plaintext
26847 public_name = PLAIN
26848 server_prompts = :
26849 server_condition = \
26850 ${if and {{eq{$auth2}{username}}{eq{$auth3}{mysecret}}}}
26851 server_set_id = $auth2
26852 .endd
26853 Note that the default result strings from &%if%& (&"true"& or an empty string)
26854 are exactly what we want here, so they need not be specified. Obviously, if the
26855 password contains expansion-significant characters such as dollar, backslash,
26856 or closing brace, they have to be escaped.
26857
26858 The &%server_prompts%& setting specifies a single, empty prompt (empty items at
26859 the end of a string list are ignored). If all the data comes as part of the
26860 AUTH command, as is commonly the case, the prompt is not used. This
26861 authenticator is advertised in the response to EHLO as
26862 .code
26863 250-AUTH PLAIN
26864 .endd
26865 and a client host can authenticate itself by sending the command
26866 .code
26867 AUTH PLAIN AHVzZXJuYW1lAG15c2VjcmV0
26868 .endd
26869 As this contains three strings (more than the number of prompts), no further
26870 data is required from the client. Alternatively, the client may just send
26871 .code
26872 AUTH PLAIN
26873 .endd
26874 to initiate authentication, in which case the server replies with an empty
26875 prompt. The client must respond with the combined data string.
26876
26877 The data string is base64 encoded, as required by the RFC. This example,
26878 when decoded, is <&'NUL'&>&`username`&<&'NUL'&>&`mysecret`&, where <&'NUL'&>
26879 represents a zero byte. This is split up into three strings, the first of which
26880 is empty. The &%server_condition%& option in the authenticator checks that the
26881 second two are &`username`& and &`mysecret`& respectively.
26882
26883 Having just one fixed user name and password, as in this example, is not very
26884 realistic, though for a small organization with only a handful of
26885 authenticating clients it could make sense.
26886
26887 A more sophisticated instance of this authenticator could use the user name in
26888 &$auth2$& to look up a password in a file or database, and maybe do an encrypted
26889 comparison (see &%crypteq%& in chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&). Here is a example of
26890 this approach, where the passwords are looked up in a DBM file. &*Warning*&:
26891 This is an incorrect example:
26892 .code
26893 server_condition = \
26894 ${if eq{$auth3}{${lookup{$auth2}dbm{/etc/authpwd}}}}
26895 .endd
26896 The expansion uses the user name (&$auth2$&) as the key to look up a password,
26897 which it then compares to the supplied password (&$auth3$&). Why is this example
26898 incorrect? It works fine for existing users, but consider what happens if a
26899 non-existent user name is given. The lookup fails, but as no success/failure
26900 strings are given for the lookup, it yields an empty string. Thus, to defeat
26901 the authentication, all a client has to do is to supply a non-existent user
26902 name and an empty password. The correct way of writing this test is:
26903 .code
26904 server_condition = ${lookup{$auth2}dbm{/etc/authpwd}\
26905 {${if eq{$value}{$auth3}}} {false}}
26906 .endd
26907 In this case, if the lookup succeeds, the result is checked; if the lookup
26908 fails, &"false"& is returned and authentication fails. If &%crypteq%& is being
26909 used instead of &%eq%&, the first example is in fact safe, because &%crypteq%&
26910 always fails if its second argument is empty. However, the second way of
26911 writing the test makes the logic clearer.
26912
26913
26914 .section "The LOGIN authentication mechanism" "SECID173"
26915 .cindex "LOGIN authentication mechanism"
26916 .cindex "authentication" "LOGIN mechanism"
26917 The LOGIN authentication mechanism is not documented in any RFC, but is in use
26918 in a number of programs. No data is sent with the AUTH command. Instead, a
26919 user name and password are supplied separately, in response to prompts. The
26920 plaintext authenticator can be configured to support this as in this example:
26921 .code
26922 fixed_login:
26923 driver = plaintext
26924 public_name = LOGIN
26925 server_prompts = User Name : Password
26926 server_condition = \
26927 ${if and {{eq{$auth1}{username}}{eq{$auth2}{mysecret}}}}
26928 server_set_id = $auth1
26929 .endd
26930 Because of the way plaintext operates, this authenticator accepts data supplied
26931 with the AUTH command (in contravention of the specification of LOGIN), but
26932 if the client does not supply it (as is the case for LOGIN clients), the prompt
26933 strings are used to obtain two data items.
26934
26935 Some clients are very particular about the precise text of the prompts. For
26936 example, Outlook Express is reported to recognize only &"Username:"& and
26937 &"Password:"&. Here is an example of a LOGIN authenticator that uses those
26938 strings. It uses the &%ldapauth%& expansion condition to check the user
26939 name and password by binding to an LDAP server:
26940 .code
26941 login:
26942 driver = plaintext
26943 public_name = LOGIN
26944 server_prompts = Username:: : Password::
26945 server_condition = ${if and{{ \
26946 !eq{}{$auth1} }{ \
26947 ldapauth{\
26948 user="uid=${quote_ldap_dn:$auth1},ou=people,o=example.org" \
26949 pass=${quote:$auth2} \
26950 ldap://ldap.example.org/} }} }
26951 server_set_id = uid=$auth1,ou=people,o=example.org
26952 .endd
26953 We have to check that the username is not empty before using it, because LDAP
26954 does not permit empty DN components. We must also use the &%quote_ldap_dn%&
26955 operator to correctly quote the DN for authentication. However, the basic
26956 &%quote%& operator, rather than any of the LDAP quoting operators, is the
26957 correct one to use for the password, because quoting is needed only to make
26958 the password conform to the Exim syntax. At the LDAP level, the password is an
26959 uninterpreted string.
26960
26961
26962 .section "Support for different kinds of authentication" "SECID174"
26963 A number of string expansion features are provided for the purpose of
26964 interfacing to different ways of user authentication. These include checking
26965 traditionally encrypted passwords from &_/etc/passwd_& (or equivalent), PAM,
26966 Radius, &%ldapauth%&, &'pwcheck'&, and &'saslauthd'&. For details see section
26967 &<<SECTexpcond>>&.
26968
26969
26970
26971
26972 .section "Using plaintext in a client" "SECID175"
26973 .cindex "options" "&(plaintext)& authenticator (client)"
26974 The &(plaintext)& authenticator has two client options:
26975
26976 .option client_ignore_invalid_base64 plaintext boolean false
26977 If the client receives a server prompt that is not a valid base64 string,
26978 authentication is abandoned by default. However, if this option is set true,
26979 the error in the challenge is ignored and the client sends the response as
26980 usual.
26981
26982 .option client_send plaintext string&!! unset
26983 The string is a colon-separated list of authentication data strings. Each
26984 string is independently expanded before being sent to the server. The first
26985 string is sent with the AUTH command; any more strings are sent in response
26986 to prompts from the server. Before each string is expanded, the value of the
26987 most recent prompt is placed in the next &$auth$&<&'n'&> variable, starting
26988 with &$auth1$& for the first prompt. Up to three prompts are stored in this
26989 way. Thus, the prompt that is received in response to sending the first string
26990 (with the AUTH command) can be used in the expansion of the second string, and
26991 so on. If an invalid base64 string is received when
26992 &%client_ignore_invalid_base64%& is set, an empty string is put in the
26993 &$auth$&<&'n'&> variable.
26994
26995 &*Note*&: You cannot use expansion to create multiple strings, because
26996 splitting takes priority and happens first.
26997
26998 Because the PLAIN authentication mechanism requires NUL (binary zero) bytes in
26999 the data, further processing is applied to each string before it is sent. If
27000 there are any single circumflex characters in the string, they are converted to
27001 NULs. Should an actual circumflex be required as data, it must be doubled in
27002 the string.
27003
27004 This is an example of a client configuration that implements the PLAIN
27005 authentication mechanism with a fixed user name and password:
27006 .code
27007 fixed_plain:
27008 driver = plaintext
27009 public_name = PLAIN
27010 client_send = ^username^mysecret
27011 .endd
27012 The lack of colons means that the entire text is sent with the AUTH
27013 command, with the circumflex characters converted to NULs. A similar example
27014 that uses the LOGIN mechanism is:
27015 .code
27016 fixed_login:
27017 driver = plaintext
27018 public_name = LOGIN
27019 client_send = : username : mysecret
27020 .endd
27021 The initial colon means that the first string is empty, so no data is sent with
27022 the AUTH command itself. The remaining strings are sent in response to
27023 prompts.
27024 .ecindex IIDplaiauth1
27025 .ecindex IIDplaiauth2
27026
27027
27028
27029
27030 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27031 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27032
27033 .chapter "The cram_md5 authenticator" "CHID9"
27034 .scindex IIDcramauth1 "&(cram_md5)& authenticator"
27035 .scindex IIDcramauth2 "authenticators" "&(cram_md5)&"
27036 .cindex "CRAM-MD5 authentication mechanism"
27037 .cindex "authentication" "CRAM-MD5 mechanism"
27038 The CRAM-MD5 authentication mechanism is described in RFC 2195. The server
27039 sends a challenge string to the client, and the response consists of a user
27040 name and the CRAM-MD5 digest of the challenge string combined with a secret
27041 string (password) which is known to both server and client. Thus, the secret
27042 is not sent over the network as plain text, which makes this authenticator more
27043 secure than &(plaintext)&. However, the downside is that the secret has to be
27044 available in plain text at either end.
27045
27046
27047 .section "Using cram_md5 as a server" "SECID176"
27048 .cindex "options" "&(cram_md5)& authenticator (server)"
27049 This authenticator has one server option, which must be set to configure the
27050 authenticator as a server:
27051
27052 .option server_secret cram_md5 string&!! unset
27053 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(cram_md5)& authenticator"
27054 When the server receives the client's response, the user name is placed in
27055 the expansion variable &$auth1$&, and &%server_secret%& is expanded to
27056 obtain the password for that user. The server then computes the CRAM-MD5 digest
27057 that the client should have sent, and checks that it received the correct
27058 string. If the expansion of &%server_secret%& is forced to fail, authentication
27059 fails. If the expansion fails for some other reason, a temporary error code is
27060 returned to the client.
27061
27062 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the user name is also placed
27063 in &$1$&. However, the use of this variables for this purpose is now
27064 deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in string expansions that also use
27065 numeric variables for other things.
27066
27067 For example, the following authenticator checks that the user name given by the
27068 client is &"ph10"&, and if so, uses &"secret"& as the password. For any other
27069 user name, authentication fails.
27070 .code
27071 fixed_cram:
27072 driver = cram_md5
27073 public_name = CRAM-MD5
27074 server_secret = ${if eq{$auth1}{ph10}{secret}fail}
27075 server_set_id = $auth1
27076 .endd
27077 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
27078 If authentication succeeds, the setting of &%server_set_id%& preserves the user
27079 name in &$authenticated_id$&. A more typical configuration might look up the
27080 secret string in a file, using the user name as the key. For example:
27081 .code
27082 lookup_cram:
27083 driver = cram_md5
27084 public_name = CRAM-MD5
27085 server_secret = ${lookup{$auth1}lsearch{/etc/authpwd}\
27086 {$value}fail}
27087 server_set_id = $auth1
27088 .endd
27089 Note that this expansion explicitly forces failure if the lookup fails
27090 because &$auth1$& contains an unknown user name.
27091
27092 As another example, if you wish to re-use a Cyrus SASL sasldb2 file without
27093 using the relevant libraries, you need to know the realm to specify in the
27094 lookup and then ask for the &"userPassword"& attribute for that user in that
27095 realm, with:
27096 .code
27097 cyrusless_crammd5:
27098 driver = cram_md5
27099 public_name = CRAM-MD5
27100 server_secret = ${lookup{$auth1:mail.example.org:userPassword}\
27101 dbmjz{/etc/sasldb2}{$value}fail}
27102 server_set_id = $auth1
27103 .endd
27104
27105 .section "Using cram_md5 as a client" "SECID177"
27106 .cindex "options" "&(cram_md5)& authenticator (client)"
27107 When used as a client, the &(cram_md5)& authenticator has two options:
27108
27109
27110
27111 .option client_name cram_md5 string&!! "the primary host name"
27112 This string is expanded, and the result used as the user name data when
27113 computing the response to the server's challenge.
27114
27115
27116 .option client_secret cram_md5 string&!! unset
27117 This option must be set for the authenticator to work as a client. Its value is
27118 expanded and the result used as the secret string when computing the response.
27119
27120
27121 .vindex "&$host$&"
27122 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
27123 Different user names and secrets can be used for different servers by referring
27124 to &$host$& or &$host_address$& in the options. Forced failure of either
27125 expansion string is treated as an indication that this authenticator is not
27126 prepared to handle this case. Exim moves on to the next configured client
27127 authenticator. Any other expansion failure causes Exim to give up trying to
27128 send the message to the current server.
27129
27130 A simple example configuration of a &(cram_md5)& authenticator, using fixed
27131 strings, is:
27132 .code
27133 fixed_cram:
27134 driver = cram_md5
27135 public_name = CRAM-MD5
27136 client_name = ph10
27137 client_secret = secret
27138 .endd
27139 .ecindex IIDcramauth1
27140 .ecindex IIDcramauth2
27141
27142
27143
27144 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27145 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27146
27147 .chapter "The cyrus_sasl authenticator" "CHID10"
27148 .scindex IIDcyrauth1 "&(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator"
27149 .scindex IIDcyrauth2 "authenticators" "&(cyrus_sasl)&"
27150 .cindex "Cyrus" "SASL library"
27151 .cindex "Kerberos"
27152 The code for this authenticator was provided by Matthew Byng-Maddick while
27153 at A L Digital Ltd.
27154
27155 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator provides server support for the Cyrus SASL
27156 library implementation of the RFC 2222 (&"Simple Authentication and Security
27157 Layer"&). This library supports a number of authentication mechanisms,
27158 including PLAIN and LOGIN, but also several others that Exim does not support
27159 directly. In particular, there is support for Kerberos authentication.
27160
27161 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator provides a gatewaying mechanism directly to
27162 the Cyrus interface, so if your Cyrus library can do, for example, CRAM-MD5,
27163 then so can the &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator. By default it uses the public
27164 name of the driver to determine which mechanism to support.
27165
27166 Where access to some kind of secret file is required, for example, in GSSAPI
27167 or CRAM-MD5, it is worth noting that the authenticator runs as the Exim
27168 user, and that the Cyrus SASL library has no way of escalating privileges
27169 by default. You may also find you need to set environment variables,
27170 depending on the driver you are using.
27171
27172 The application name provided by Exim is &"exim"&, so various SASL options may
27173 be set in &_exim.conf_& in your SASL directory. If you are using GSSAPI for
27174 Kerberos, note that because of limitations in the GSSAPI interface,
27175 changing the server keytab might need to be communicated down to the Kerberos
27176 layer independently. The mechanism for doing so is dependent upon the Kerberos
27177 implementation.
27178
27179 For example, for older releases of Heimdal, the environment variable KRB5_KTNAME
27180 may be set to point to an alternative keytab file. Exim will pass this
27181 variable through from its own inherited environment when started as root or the
27182 Exim user. The keytab file needs to be readable by the Exim user.
27183 With newer releases of Heimdal, a setuid Exim may cause Heimdal to discard the
27184 environment variable. In practice, for those releases, the Cyrus authenticator
27185 is not a suitable interface for GSSAPI (Kerberos) support. Instead, consider
27186 the &(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator, described in chapter &<<CHAPheimdalgss>>&
27187
27188
27189 .section "Using cyrus_sasl as a server" "SECID178"
27190 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator has four private options. It puts the username
27191 (on a successful authentication) into &$auth1$&. For compatibility with
27192 previous releases of Exim, the username is also placed in &$1$&. However, the
27193 use of this variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to
27194 confusion in string expansions that also use numeric variables for other
27195 things.
27196
27197
27198 .option server_hostname cyrus_sasl string&!! "see below"
27199 This option selects the hostname that is used when communicating with the
27200 library. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&. It is up to the underlying
27201 SASL plug-in what it does with this data.
27202
27203
27204 .option server_mech cyrus_sasl string "see below"
27205 This option selects the authentication mechanism this driver should use. The
27206 default is the value of the generic &%public_name%& option. This option allows
27207 you to use a different underlying mechanism from the advertised name. For
27208 example:
27209 .code
27210 sasl:
27211 driver = cyrus_sasl
27212 public_name = X-ANYTHING
27213 server_mech = CRAM-MD5
27214 server_set_id = $auth1
27215 .endd
27216
27217 .option server_realm cyrus_sasl string&!! unset
27218 This specifies the SASL realm that the server claims to be in.
27219
27220
27221 .option server_service cyrus_sasl string &`smtp`&
27222 This is the SASL service that the server claims to implement.
27223
27224
27225 For straightforward cases, you do not need to set any of the authenticator's
27226 private options. All you need to do is to specify an appropriate mechanism as
27227 the public name. Thus, if you have a SASL library that supports CRAM-MD5 and
27228 PLAIN, you could have two authenticators as follows:
27229 .code
27230 sasl_cram_md5:
27231 driver = cyrus_sasl
27232 public_name = CRAM-MD5
27233 server_set_id = $auth1
27234
27235 sasl_plain:
27236 driver = cyrus_sasl
27237 public_name = PLAIN
27238 server_set_id = $auth2
27239 .endd
27240 Cyrus SASL does implement the LOGIN authentication method, even though it is
27241 not a standard method. It is disabled by default in the source distribution,
27242 but it is present in many binary distributions.
27243 .ecindex IIDcyrauth1
27244 .ecindex IIDcyrauth2
27245
27246
27247
27248
27249 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27250 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27251 .chapter "The dovecot authenticator" "CHAPdovecot"
27252 .scindex IIDdcotauth1 "&(dovecot)& authenticator"
27253 .scindex IIDdcotauth2 "authenticators" "&(dovecot)&"
27254 This authenticator is an interface to the authentication facility of the
27255 Dovecot POP/IMAP server, which can support a number of authentication methods.
27256 Note that Dovecot must be configured to use auth-client not auth-userdb.
27257 If you are using Dovecot to authenticate POP/IMAP clients, it might be helpful
27258 to use the same mechanisms for SMTP authentication. This is a server
27259 authenticator only. There is only one option:
27260
27261 .option server_socket dovecot string unset
27262
27263 This option must specify the UNIX socket that is the interface to Dovecot
27264 authentication. The &%public_name%& option must specify an authentication
27265 mechanism that Dovecot is configured to support. You can have several
27266 authenticators for different mechanisms. For example:
27267 .code
27268 dovecot_plain:
27269 driver = dovecot
27270 public_name = PLAIN
27271 server_socket = /var/run/dovecot/auth-client
27272 server_set_id = $auth1
27273
27274 dovecot_ntlm:
27275 driver = dovecot
27276 public_name = NTLM
27277 server_socket = /var/run/dovecot/auth-client
27278 server_set_id = $auth1
27279 .endd
27280 If the SMTP connection is encrypted, or if &$sender_host_address$& is equal to
27281 &$received_ip_address$& (that is, the connection is local), the &"secured"&
27282 option is passed in the Dovecot authentication command. If, for a TLS
27283 connection, a client certificate has been verified, the &"valid-client-cert"&
27284 option is passed. When authentication succeeds, the identity of the user
27285 who authenticated is placed in &$auth1$&.
27286 .ecindex IIDdcotauth1
27287 .ecindex IIDdcotauth2
27288
27289
27290 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27291 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27292 .chapter "The gsasl authenticator" "CHAPgsasl"
27293 .scindex IIDgsaslauth1 "&(gsasl)& authenticator"
27294 .scindex IIDgsaslauth2 "authenticators" "&(gsasl)&"
27295 .cindex "authentication" "GNU SASL"
27296 .cindex "authentication" "SASL"
27297 .cindex "authentication" "EXTERNAL"
27298 .cindex "authentication" "ANONYMOUS"
27299 .cindex "authentication" "PLAIN"
27300 .cindex "authentication" "LOGIN"
27301 .cindex "authentication" "DIGEST-MD5"
27302 .cindex "authentication" "CRAM-MD5"
27303 .cindex "authentication" "SCRAM-SHA-1"
27304 The &(gsasl)& authenticator provides server integration for the GNU SASL
27305 library and the mechanisms it provides. This is new as of the 4.80 release
27306 and there are a few areas where the library does not let Exim smoothly
27307 scale to handle future authentication mechanisms, so no guarantee can be
27308 made that any particular new authentication mechanism will be supported
27309 without code changes in Exim.
27310
27311 Exim's &(gsasl)& authenticator does not have client-side support at this
27312 time; only the server-side support is implemented. Patches welcome.
27313
27314
27315 .option server_channelbinding gsasl boolean false
27316 Do not set this true without consulting a cryptographic engineer.
27317
27318 Some authentication mechanisms are able to use external context at both ends
27319 of the session to bind the authentication to that context, and fail the
27320 authentication process if that context differs. Specifically, some TLS
27321 ciphersuites can provide identifying information about the cryptographic
27322 context.
27323
27324 This should have meant that certificate identity and verification becomes a
27325 non-issue, as a man-in-the-middle attack will cause the correct client and
27326 server to see different identifiers and authentication will fail.
27327
27328 This is currently only supported when using the GnuTLS library. This is
27329 only usable by mechanisms which support "channel binding"; at time of
27330 writing, that's the SCRAM family.
27331
27332 This defaults off to ensure smooth upgrade across Exim releases, in case
27333 this option causes some clients to start failing. Some future release
27334 of Exim might have switched the default to be true.
27335
27336 However, Channel Binding in TLS has proven to be broken in current versions.
27337 Do not plan to rely upon this feature for security, ever, without consulting
27338 with a subject matter expert (a cryptographic engineer).
27339
27340
27341 .option server_hostname gsasl string&!! "see below"
27342 This option selects the hostname that is used when communicating with the
27343 library. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&.
27344 Some mechanisms will use this data.
27345
27346
27347 .option server_mech gsasl string "see below"
27348 This option selects the authentication mechanism this driver should use. The
27349 default is the value of the generic &%public_name%& option. This option allows
27350 you to use a different underlying mechanism from the advertised name. For
27351 example:
27352 .code
27353 sasl:
27354 driver = gsasl
27355 public_name = X-ANYTHING
27356 server_mech = CRAM-MD5
27357 server_set_id = $auth1
27358 .endd
27359
27360
27361 .option server_password gsasl string&!! unset
27362 Various mechanisms need access to the cleartext password on the server, so
27363 that proof-of-possession can be demonstrated on the wire, without sending
27364 the password itself.
27365
27366 The data available for lookup varies per mechanism.
27367 In all cases, &$auth1$& is set to the &'authentication id'&.
27368 The &$auth2$& variable will always be the &'authorization id'& (&'authz'&)
27369 if available, else the empty string.
27370 The &$auth3$& variable will always be the &'realm'& if available,
27371 else the empty string.
27372
27373 A forced failure will cause authentication to defer.
27374
27375 If using this option, it may make sense to set the &%server_condition%&
27376 option to be simply "true".
27377
27378
27379 .option server_realm gsasl string&!! unset
27380 This specifies the SASL realm that the server claims to be in.
27381 Some mechanisms will use this data.
27382
27383
27384 .option server_scram_iter gsasl string&!! unset
27385 This option provides data for the SCRAM family of mechanisms.
27386 &$auth1$& is not available at evaluation time.
27387 (This may change, as we receive feedback on use)
27388
27389
27390 .option server_scram_salt gsasl string&!! unset
27391 This option provides data for the SCRAM family of mechanisms.
27392 &$auth1$& is not available at evaluation time.
27393 (This may change, as we receive feedback on use)
27394
27395
27396 .option server_service gsasl string &`smtp`&
27397 This is the SASL service that the server claims to implement.
27398 Some mechanisms will use this data.
27399
27400
27401 .section "&(gsasl)& auth variables" "SECTgsaslauthvar"
27402 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
27403 These may be set when evaluating specific options, as detailed above.
27404 They will also be set when evaluating &%server_condition%&.
27405
27406 Unless otherwise stated below, the &(gsasl)& integration will use the following
27407 meanings for these variables:
27408
27409 .ilist
27410 .vindex "&$auth1$&"
27411 &$auth1$&: the &'authentication id'&
27412 .next
27413 .vindex "&$auth2$&"
27414 &$auth2$&: the &'authorization id'&
27415 .next
27416 .vindex "&$auth3$&"
27417 &$auth3$&: the &'realm'&
27418 .endlist
27419
27420 On a per-mechanism basis:
27421
27422 .ilist
27423 .cindex "authentication" "EXTERNAL"
27424 EXTERNAL: only &$auth1$& is set, to the possibly empty &'authorization id'&;
27425 the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
27426 .next
27427 .cindex "authentication" "ANONYMOUS"
27428 ANONYMOUS: only &$auth1$& is set, to the possibly empty &'anonymous token'&;
27429 the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
27430 .next
27431 .cindex "authentication" "GSSAPI"
27432 GSSAPI: &$auth1$& will be set to the &'GSSAPI Display Name'&;
27433 &$auth2$& will be set to the &'authorization id'&,
27434 the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
27435 .endlist
27436
27437 An &'anonymous token'& is something passed along as an unauthenticated
27438 identifier; this is analogous to FTP anonymous authentication passing an
27439 email address, or software-identifier@, as the "password".
27440
27441
27442 An example showing the password having the realm specified in the callback
27443 and demonstrating a Cyrus SASL to GSASL migration approach is:
27444 .code
27445 gsasl_cyrusless_crammd5:
27446 driver = gsasl
27447 public_name = CRAM-MD5
27448 server_realm = imap.example.org
27449 server_password = ${lookup{$auth1:$auth3:userPassword}\
27450 dbmjz{/etc/sasldb2}{$value}fail}
27451 server_set_id = ${quote:$auth1}
27452 server_condition = yes
27453 .endd
27454
27455
27456 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27457 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27458
27459 .chapter "The heimdal_gssapi authenticator" "CHAPheimdalgss"
27460 .scindex IIDheimdalgssauth1 "&(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator"
27461 .scindex IIDheimdalgssauth2 "authenticators" "&(heimdal_gssapi)&"
27462 .cindex "authentication" "GSSAPI"
27463 .cindex "authentication" "Kerberos"
27464 The &(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator provides server integration for the
27465 Heimdal GSSAPI/Kerberos library, permitting Exim to set a keytab pathname
27466 reliably.
27467
27468 .option server_hostname heimdal_gssapi string&!! "see below"
27469 This option selects the hostname that is used, with &%server_service%&,
27470 for constructing the GSS server name, as a &'GSS_C_NT_HOSTBASED_SERVICE'&
27471 identifier. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&.
27472
27473 .option server_keytab heimdal_gssapi string&!! unset
27474 If set, then Heimdal will not use the system default keytab (typically
27475 &_/etc/krb5.keytab_&) but instead the pathname given in this option.
27476 The value should be a pathname, with no &"file:"& prefix.
27477
27478 .option server_service heimdal_gssapi string&!! "smtp"
27479 This option specifies the service identifier used, in conjunction with
27480 &%server_hostname%&, for building the identifier for finding credentials
27481 from the keytab.
27482
27483
27484 .section "&(heimdal_gssapi)& auth variables" "SECTheimdalgssauthvar"
27485 Beware that these variables will typically include a realm, thus will appear
27486 to be roughly like an email address already. The &'authzid'& in &$auth2$& is
27487 not verified, so a malicious client can set it to anything.
27488
27489 The &$auth1$& field should be safely trustable as a value from the Key
27490 Distribution Center. Note that these are not quite email addresses.
27491 Each identifier is for a role, and so the left-hand-side may include a
27492 role suffix. For instance, &"joe/admin@EXAMPLE.ORG"&.
27493
27494 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
27495 .ilist
27496 .vindex "&$auth1$&"
27497 &$auth1$&: the &'authentication id'&, set to the GSS Display Name.
27498 .next
27499 .vindex "&$auth2$&"
27500 &$auth2$&: the &'authorization id'&, sent within SASL encapsulation after
27501 authentication. If that was empty, this will also be set to the
27502 GSS Display Name.
27503 .endlist
27504
27505
27506 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27507 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27508
27509 .chapter "The spa authenticator" "CHAPspa"
27510 .scindex IIDspaauth1 "&(spa)& authenticator"
27511 .scindex IIDspaauth2 "authenticators" "&(spa)&"
27512 .cindex "authentication" "Microsoft Secure Password"
27513 .cindex "authentication" "NTLM"
27514 .cindex "Microsoft Secure Password Authentication"
27515 .cindex "NTLM authentication"
27516 The &(spa)& authenticator provides client support for Microsoft's &'Secure
27517 Password Authentication'& mechanism,
27518 which is also sometimes known as NTLM (NT LanMan). The code for client side of
27519 this authenticator was contributed by Marc Prud'hommeaux, and much of it is
27520 taken from the Samba project (&url(https://www.samba.org/)). The code for the
27521 server side was subsequently contributed by Tom Kistner. The mechanism works as
27522 follows:
27523
27524 .ilist
27525 After the AUTH command has been accepted, the client sends an SPA
27526 authentication request based on the user name and optional domain.
27527 .next
27528 The server sends back a challenge.
27529 .next
27530 The client builds a challenge response which makes use of the user's password
27531 and sends it to the server, which then accepts or rejects it.
27532 .endlist
27533
27534 Encryption is used to protect the password in transit.
27535
27536
27537
27538 .section "Using spa as a server" "SECID179"
27539 .cindex "options" "&(spa)& authenticator (server)"
27540 The &(spa)& authenticator has just one server option:
27541
27542 .option server_password spa string&!! unset
27543 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(spa)& authenticator"
27544 This option is expanded, and the result must be the cleartext password for the
27545 authenticating user, whose name is at this point in &$auth1$&. For
27546 compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the user name is also placed in
27547 &$1$&. However, the use of this variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as
27548 it can lead to confusion in string expansions that also use numeric variables
27549 for other things. For example:
27550 .code
27551 spa:
27552 driver = spa
27553 public_name = NTLM
27554 server_password = \
27555 ${lookup{$auth1}lsearch{/etc/exim/spa_clearpass}{$value}fail}
27556 .endd
27557 If the expansion is forced to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion
27558 failure causes a temporary error code to be returned.
27559
27560
27561
27562
27563
27564 .section "Using spa as a client" "SECID180"
27565 .cindex "options" "&(spa)& authenticator (client)"
27566 The &(spa)& authenticator has the following client options:
27567
27568
27569
27570 .option client_domain spa string&!! unset
27571 This option specifies an optional domain for the authentication.
27572
27573
27574 .option client_password spa string&!! unset
27575 This option specifies the user's password, and must be set.
27576
27577
27578 .option client_username spa string&!! unset
27579 This option specifies the user name, and must be set. Here is an example of a
27580 configuration of this authenticator for use with the mail servers at
27581 &'msn.com'&:
27582 .code
27583 msn:
27584 driver = spa
27585 public_name = MSN
27586 client_username = msn/msn_username
27587 client_password = msn_plaintext_password
27588 client_domain = DOMAIN_OR_UNSET
27589 .endd
27590 .ecindex IIDspaauth1
27591 .ecindex IIDspaauth2
27592
27593
27594
27595
27596
27597 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27598 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27599
27600 .chapter "The external authenticator" "CHAPexternauth"
27601 .scindex IIDexternauth1 "&(external)& authenticator"
27602 .scindex IIDexternauth2 "authenticators" "&(external)&"
27603 .cindex "authentication" "Client Certificate"
27604 .cindex "authentication" "X509"
27605 .cindex "Certificate-based authentication"
27606 The &(external)& authenticator provides support for
27607 authentication based on non-SMTP information.
27608 The specification is in RFC 4422 Appendix A
27609 (&url(https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4422)).
27610 It is only a transport and negotiation mechanism;
27611 the process of authentication is entirely controlled
27612 by the server configuration.
27613
27614 The client presents an identity in-clear.
27615 It is probably wise for a server to only advertise,
27616 and for clients to only attempt,
27617 this authentication method on a secure (eg. under TLS) connection.
27618
27619 One possible use, compatible with the
27620 K-9 Mail Andoid client (&url(https://k9mail.github.io/)),
27621 is for using X509 client certificates.
27622
27623 It thus overlaps in function with the TLS authenticator
27624 (see &<<CHAPtlsauth>>&)
27625 but is a full SMTP SASL authenticator
27626 rather than being implicit for TLS-connection carried
27627 client certificates only.
27628
27629 The examples and discussion in this chapter assume that
27630 client-certificate authentication is being done.
27631
27632 The client must present a certificate,
27633 for which it must have been requested via the
27634 &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& main options
27635 (see &<<CHAPTLS>>&).
27636 For authentication to be effective the certificate should be
27637 verifiable against a trust-anchor certificate known to the server.
27638
27639 .section "External options" "SECTexternsoptions"
27640 .cindex "options" "&(external)& authenticator (server)"
27641 The &(external)& authenticator has two server options:
27642
27643 .option server_param2 external string&!! unset
27644 .option server_param3 external string&!! unset
27645 .cindex "variables (&$auth1$& &$auth2$& etc)" "in &(external)& authenticator"
27646 These options are expanded before the &%server_condition%& option
27647 and the result are placed in &$auth2$& and &$auth3$& resectively.
27648 If the expansion is forced to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion
27649 failure causes a temporary error code to be returned.
27650
27651 They can be used to clarify the coding of a complex &%server_condition%&.
27652
27653 .section "Using external in a server" "SECTexternserver"
27654 .cindex "AUTH" "in &(external)& authenticator"
27655 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" &&&
27656 "in &(external)& authenticator"
27657 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
27658 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in &(external)& authenticator"
27659
27660 When running as a server, &(external)& performs the authentication test by
27661 expanding a string. The data sent by the client with the AUTH command, or in
27662 response to subsequent prompts, is base64 encoded, and so may contain any byte
27663 values when decoded. The decoded value is treated as
27664 an identity for authentication and
27665 placed in the expansion variable &$auth1$&.
27666
27667 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the value is also placed in
27668 the expansion variable &$1$&. However, the use of this
27669 variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in
27670 string expansions that also use them for other things.
27671
27672 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
27673 Once an identity has been received,
27674 &%server_condition%& is expanded. If the expansion is forced to fail,
27675 authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary error code
27676 to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty string,
27677 &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
27678 expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds and the
27679 generic &%server_set_id%& option is expanded and saved in &$authenticated_id$&.
27680 For any other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded
27681 string as the error text.
27682
27683 Example:
27684 .code
27685 ext_ccert_san_mail:
27686 driver = external
27687 public_name = EXTERNAL
27688
27689 server_advertise_condition = $tls_in_certificate_verified
27690 server_param2 = ${certextract {subj_altname,mail,>:} \
27691 {$tls_in_peercert}}
27692 server_condition = ${if forany {$auth2} \
27693 {eq {$item}{$auth1}}}
27694 server_set_id = $auth1
27695 .endd
27696 This accepts a client certificate that is verifiable against any
27697 of your configured trust-anchors
27698 (which usually means the full set of public CAs)
27699 and which has a mail-SAN matching the claimed identity sent by the client.
27700
27701 Note that, up to TLS1.2, the client cert is on the wire in-clear, including the SAN,
27702 The account name is therefore guessable by an opponent.
27703 TLS 1.3 protects both server and client certificates, and is not vulnerable
27704 in this way.
27705 Likewise, a traditional plaintext SMTP AUTH done inside TLS is not.
27706
27707
27708 .section "Using external in a client" "SECTexternclient"
27709 .cindex "options" "&(external)& authenticator (client)"
27710 The &(external)& authenticator has one client option:
27711
27712 .option client_send external string&!! unset
27713 This option is expanded and sent with the AUTH command as the
27714 identity being asserted.
27715
27716 Example:
27717 .code
27718 ext_ccert:
27719 driver = external
27720 public_name = EXTERNAL
27721
27722 client_condition = ${if !eq{$tls_out_cipher}{}}
27723 client_send = myaccount@smarthost.example.net
27724 .endd
27725
27726
27727 .ecindex IIDexternauth1
27728 .ecindex IIDexternauth2
27729
27730
27731
27732
27733
27734 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27735 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27736
27737 .chapter "The tls authenticator" "CHAPtlsauth"
27738 .scindex IIDtlsauth1 "&(tls)& authenticator"
27739 .scindex IIDtlsauth2 "authenticators" "&(tls)&"
27740 .cindex "authentication" "Client Certificate"
27741 .cindex "authentication" "X509"
27742 .cindex "Certificate-based authentication"
27743 The &(tls)& authenticator provides server support for
27744 authentication based on client certificates.
27745
27746 It is not an SMTP authentication mechanism and is not
27747 advertised by the server as part of the SMTP EHLO response.
27748 It is an Exim authenticator in the sense that it affects
27749 the protocol element of the log line, can be tested for
27750 by the &%authenticated%& ACL condition, and can set
27751 the &$authenticated_id$& variable.
27752
27753 The client must present a verifiable certificate,
27754 for which it must have been requested via the
27755 &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& main options
27756 (see &<<CHAPTLS>>&).
27757
27758 If an authenticator of this type is configured it is
27759 run before any SMTP-level communication is done,
27760 and can authenticate the connection.
27761 If it does, SMTP authentication is not offered.
27762
27763 A maximum of one authenticator of this type may be present.
27764
27765
27766 .cindex "options" "&(tls)& authenticator (server)"
27767 The &(tls)& authenticator has three server options:
27768
27769 .option server_param1 tls string&!! unset
27770 .cindex "variables (&$auth1$& &$auth2$& etc)" "in &(tls)& authenticator"
27771 This option is expanded after the TLS negotiation and
27772 the result is placed in &$auth1$&.
27773 If the expansion is forced to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion
27774 failure causes a temporary error code to be returned.
27775
27776 .option server_param2 tls string&!! unset
27777 .option server_param3 tls string&!! unset
27778 As above, for &$auth2$& and &$auth3$&.
27779
27780 &%server_param1%& may also be spelled &%server_param%&.
27781
27782
27783 Example:
27784 .code
27785 tls:
27786 driver = tls
27787 server_param1 = ${certextract {subj_altname,mail,>:} \
27788 {$tls_in_peercert}}
27789 server_condition = ${if and { {eq{$tls_in_certificate_verified}{1}} \
27790 {forany {$auth1} \
27791 {!= {0} \
27792 {${lookup ldap{ldap:///\
27793 mailname=${quote_ldap_dn:${lc:$item}},\
27794 ou=users,LDAP_DC?mailid} {$value}{0} \
27795 } } } }}}
27796 server_set_id = ${if = {1}{${listcount:$auth1}} {$auth1}{}}
27797 .endd
27798 This accepts a client certificate that is verifiable against any
27799 of your configured trust-anchors
27800 (which usually means the full set of public CAs)
27801 and which has a SAN with a good account name.
27802
27803 Note that, up to TLS1.2, the client cert is on the wire in-clear, including the SAN,
27804 The account name is therefore guessable by an opponent.
27805 TLS 1.3 protects both server and client certificates, and is not vulnerable
27806 in this way.
27807 Likewise, a traditional plaintext SMTP AUTH done inside TLS is not.
27808
27809 . An alternative might use
27810 . .code
27811 . server_param1 = ${sha256:$tls_in_peercert}
27812 . .endd
27813 . to require one of a set of specific certs that define a given account
27814 . (the verification is still required, but mostly irrelevant).
27815 . This would help for per-device use.
27816 .
27817 . However, for the future we really need support for checking a
27818 . user cert in LDAP - which probably wants a base-64 DER.
27819
27820 .ecindex IIDtlsauth1
27821 .ecindex IIDtlsauth2
27822
27823
27824 Note that because authentication is traditionally an SMTP operation,
27825 the &%authenticated%& ACL condition cannot be used in
27826 a connect- or helo-ACL.
27827
27828
27829
27830 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27831 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27832
27833 .chapter "Encrypted SMTP connections using TLS/SSL" "CHAPTLS" &&&
27834 "Encrypted SMTP connections"
27835 .scindex IIDencsmtp1 "encryption" "on SMTP connection"
27836 .scindex IIDencsmtp2 "SMTP" "encryption"
27837 .cindex "TLS" "on SMTP connection"
27838 .cindex "OpenSSL"
27839 .cindex "GnuTLS"
27840 Support for TLS (Transport Layer Security), formerly known as SSL (Secure
27841 Sockets Layer), is implemented by making use of the OpenSSL library or the
27842 GnuTLS library (Exim requires GnuTLS release 1.0 or later). There is no
27843 cryptographic code in the Exim distribution itself for implementing TLS. In
27844 order to use this feature you must install OpenSSL or GnuTLS, and then build a
27845 version of Exim that includes TLS support (see section &<<SECTinctlsssl>>&).
27846 You also need to understand the basic concepts of encryption at a managerial
27847 level, and in particular, the way that public keys, private keys, and
27848 certificates are used.
27849
27850 RFC 3207 defines how SMTP connections can make use of encryption. Once a
27851 connection is established, the client issues a STARTTLS command. If the
27852 server accepts this, the client and the server negotiate an encryption
27853 mechanism. If the negotiation succeeds, the data that subsequently passes
27854 between them is encrypted.
27855
27856 Exim's ACLs can detect whether the current SMTP session is encrypted or not,
27857 and if so, what cipher suite is in use, whether the client supplied a
27858 certificate, and whether or not that certificate was verified. This makes it
27859 possible for an Exim server to deny or accept certain commands based on the
27860 encryption state.
27861
27862 &*Warning*&: Certain types of firewall and certain anti-virus products can
27863 disrupt TLS connections. You need to turn off SMTP scanning for these products
27864 in order to get TLS to work.
27865
27866
27867
27868 .section "Support for the &""submissions""& (aka &""ssmtp""& and &""smtps""&) protocol" &&&
27869 "SECID284"
27870 .cindex "submissions protocol"
27871 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
27872 .cindex "smtps protocol"
27873 .cindex "SMTP" "submissions protocol"
27874 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
27875 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
27876 The history of port numbers for TLS in SMTP is a little messy and has been
27877 contentious. As of RFC 8314, the common practice of using the historically
27878 allocated port 465 for "email submission but with TLS immediately upon connect
27879 instead of using STARTTLS" is officially blessed by the IETF, and recommended
27880 by them in preference to STARTTLS.
27881
27882 The name originally assigned to the port was &"ssmtp"& or &"smtps"&, but as
27883 clarity emerged over the dual roles of SMTP, for MX delivery and Email
27884 Submission, nomenclature has shifted. The modern name is now &"submissions"&.
27885
27886 This approach was, for a while, officially abandoned when encrypted SMTP was
27887 standardized, but many clients kept using it, even as the TCP port number was
27888 reassigned for other use.
27889 Thus you may encounter guidance claiming that you shouldn't enable use of
27890 this port.
27891 In practice, a number of mail-clients have only ever supported submissions,
27892 not submission with STARTTLS upgrade.
27893 Ideally, offer both submission (587) and submissions (465) service.
27894
27895 Exim supports TLS-on-connect by means of the &%tls_on_connect_ports%&
27896 global option. Its value must be a list of port numbers;
27897 the most common use is expected to be:
27898 .code
27899 tls_on_connect_ports = 465
27900 .endd
27901 The port numbers specified by this option apply to all SMTP connections, both
27902 via the daemon and via &'inetd'&. You still need to specify all the ports that
27903 the daemon uses (by setting &%daemon_smtp_ports%& or &%local_interfaces%& or
27904 the &%-oX%& command line option) because &%tls_on_connect_ports%& does not add
27905 an extra port &-- rather, it specifies different behaviour on a port that is
27906 defined elsewhere.
27907
27908 There is also a &%-tls-on-connect%& command line option. This overrides
27909 &%tls_on_connect_ports%&; it forces the TLS-only behaviour for all ports.
27910
27911
27912
27913
27914
27915
27916 .section "OpenSSL vs GnuTLS" "SECTopenvsgnu"
27917 .cindex "TLS" "OpenSSL &'vs'& GnuTLS"
27918 The first TLS support in Exim was implemented using OpenSSL. Support for GnuTLS
27919 followed later, when the first versions of GnuTLS were released. To build Exim
27920 to use GnuTLS, you need to set
27921 .code
27922 USE_GNUTLS=yes
27923 .endd
27924 in Local/Makefile, in addition to
27925 .code
27926 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
27927 .endd
27928 You must also set TLS_LIBS and TLS_INCLUDE appropriately, so that the
27929 include files and libraries for GnuTLS can be found.
27930
27931 There are some differences in usage when using GnuTLS instead of OpenSSL:
27932
27933 .ilist
27934 The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option
27935 cannot be the path of a directory
27936 for GnuTLS versions before 3.3.6
27937 (for later versions, or OpenSSL, it can be either).
27938 .next
27939 The default value for &%tls_dhparam%& differs for historical reasons.
27940 .next
27941 .vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
27942 .vindex "&$tls_out_peerdn$&"
27943 Distinguished Name (DN) strings reported by the OpenSSL library use a slash for
27944 separating fields; GnuTLS uses commas, in accordance with RFC 2253. This
27945 affects the value of the &$tls_in_peerdn$& and &$tls_out_peerdn$& variables.
27946 .next
27947 OpenSSL identifies cipher suites using hyphens as separators, for example:
27948 DES-CBC3-SHA. GnuTLS historically used underscores, for example:
27949 RSA_ARCFOUR_SHA. What is more, OpenSSL complains if underscores are present
27950 in a cipher list. To make life simpler, Exim changes underscores to hyphens
27951 for OpenSSL and passes the string unchanged to GnuTLS (expecting the library
27952 to handle its own older variants) when processing lists of cipher suites in the
27953 &%tls_require_ciphers%& options (the global option and the &(smtp)& transport
27954 option).
27955 .next
27956 The &%tls_require_ciphers%& options operate differently, as described in the
27957 sections &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
27958 .next
27959 The &%tls_dh_min_bits%& SMTP transport option is only honoured by GnuTLS.
27960 When using OpenSSL, this option is ignored.
27961 (If an API is found to let OpenSSL be configured in this way,
27962 let the Exim Maintainers know and we'll likely use it).
27963 .next
27964 With GnuTLS, if an explicit list is used for the &%tls_privatekey%& main option
27965 main option, it must be ordered to match the &%tls_certificate%& list.
27966 .next
27967 Some other recently added features may only be available in one or the other.
27968 This should be documented with the feature. If the documentation does not
27969 explicitly state that the feature is infeasible in the other TLS
27970 implementation, then patches are welcome.
27971 .endlist
27972
27973
27974 .section "GnuTLS parameter computation" "SECTgnutlsparam"
27975 This section only applies if &%tls_dhparam%& is set to &`historic`& or to
27976 an explicit path; if the latter, then the text about generation still applies,
27977 but not the chosen filename.
27978 By default, as of Exim 4.80 a hard-coded D-H prime is used.
27979 See the documentation of &%tls_dhparam%& for more information.
27980
27981 GnuTLS uses D-H parameters that may take a substantial amount of time
27982 to compute. It is unreasonable to re-compute them for every TLS session.
27983 Therefore, Exim keeps this data in a file in its spool directory, called
27984 &_gnutls-params-NNNN_& for some value of NNNN, corresponding to the number
27985 of bits requested.
27986 The file is owned by the Exim user and is readable only by
27987 its owner. Every Exim process that start up GnuTLS reads the D-H
27988 parameters from this file. If the file does not exist, the first Exim process
27989 that needs it computes the data and writes it to a temporary file which is
27990 renamed once it is complete. It does not matter if several Exim processes do
27991 this simultaneously (apart from wasting a few resources). Once a file is in
27992 place, new Exim processes immediately start using it.
27993
27994 For maximum security, the parameters that are stored in this file should be
27995 recalculated periodically, the frequency depending on your paranoia level.
27996 If you are avoiding using the fixed D-H primes published in RFCs, then you
27997 are concerned about some advanced attacks and will wish to do this; if you do
27998 not regenerate then you might as well stick to the standard primes.
27999
28000 Arranging this is easy in principle; just delete the file when you want new
28001 values to be computed. However, there may be a problem. The calculation of new
28002 parameters needs random numbers, and these are obtained from &_/dev/random_&.
28003 If the system is not very active, &_/dev/random_& may delay returning data
28004 until enough randomness (entropy) is available. This may cause Exim to hang for
28005 a substantial amount of time, causing timeouts on incoming connections.
28006
28007 The solution is to generate the parameters externally to Exim. They are stored
28008 in &_gnutls-params-N_& in PEM format, which means that they can be
28009 generated externally using the &(certtool)& command that is part of GnuTLS.
28010
28011 To replace the parameters with new ones, instead of deleting the file
28012 and letting Exim re-create it, you can generate new parameters using
28013 &(certtool)& and, when this has been done, replace Exim's cache file by
28014 renaming. The relevant commands are something like this:
28015 .code
28016 # ls
28017 [ look for file; assume gnutls-params-2236 is the most recent ]
28018 # rm -f new-params
28019 # touch new-params
28020 # chown exim:exim new-params
28021 # chmod 0600 new-params
28022 # certtool --generate-dh-params --bits 2236 >>new-params
28023 # openssl dhparam -noout -text -in new-params | head
28024 [ check the first line, make sure it's not more than 2236;
28025 if it is, then go back to the start ("rm") and repeat
28026 until the size generated is at most the size requested ]
28027 # chmod 0400 new-params
28028 # mv new-params gnutls-params-2236
28029 .endd
28030 If Exim never has to generate the parameters itself, the possibility of
28031 stalling is removed.
28032
28033 The filename changed in Exim 4.80, to gain the -bits suffix. The value which
28034 Exim will choose depends upon the version of GnuTLS in use. For older GnuTLS,
28035 the value remains hard-coded in Exim as 1024. As of GnuTLS 2.12.x, there is
28036 a way for Exim to ask for the "normal" number of bits for D-H public-key usage,
28037 and Exim does so. This attempt to remove Exim from TLS policy decisions
28038 failed, as GnuTLS 2.12 returns a value higher than the current hard-coded limit
28039 of the NSS library. Thus Exim gains the &%tls_dh_max_bits%& global option,
28040 which applies to all D-H usage, client or server. If the value returned by
28041 GnuTLS is greater than &%tls_dh_max_bits%& then the value will be clamped down
28042 to &%tls_dh_max_bits%&. The default value has been set at the current NSS
28043 limit, which is still much higher than Exim historically used.
28044
28045 The filename and bits used will change as the GnuTLS maintainers change the
28046 value for their parameter &`GNUTLS_SEC_PARAM_NORMAL`&, as clamped by
28047 &%tls_dh_max_bits%&. At the time of writing (mid 2012), GnuTLS 2.12 recommends
28048 2432 bits, while NSS is limited to 2236 bits.
28049
28050 In fact, the requested value will be *lower* than &%tls_dh_max_bits%&, to
28051 increase the chance of the generated prime actually being within acceptable
28052 bounds, as GnuTLS has been observed to overshoot. Note the check step in the
28053 procedure above. There is no sane procedure available to Exim to double-check
28054 the size of the generated prime, so it might still be too large.
28055
28056
28057 .section "Requiring specific ciphers in OpenSSL" "SECTreqciphssl"
28058 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers (OpenSSL)"
28059 .oindex "&%tls_require_ciphers%&" "OpenSSL"
28060 There is a function in the OpenSSL library that can be passed a list of cipher
28061 suites before the cipher negotiation takes place. This specifies which ciphers
28062 are acceptable for TLS versions prior to 1.3.
28063 The list is colon separated and may contain names like
28064 DES-CBC3-SHA. Exim passes the expanded value of &%tls_require_ciphers%&
28065 directly to this function call.
28066 Many systems will install the OpenSSL manual-pages, so you may have
28067 &'ciphers(1)'& available to you.
28068 The following quotation from the OpenSSL
28069 documentation specifies what forms of item are allowed in the cipher string:
28070
28071 .ilist
28072 It can consist of a single cipher suite such as RC4-SHA.
28073 .next
28074 It can represent a list of cipher suites containing a certain algorithm,
28075 or cipher suites of a certain type. For example SHA1 represents all
28076 ciphers suites using the digest algorithm SHA1 and SSLv3 represents all
28077 SSL v3 algorithms.
28078 .next
28079 Lists of cipher suites can be combined in a single cipher string using
28080 the + character. This is used as a logical and operation. For example
28081 SHA1+DES represents all cipher suites containing the SHA1 and the DES
28082 algorithms.
28083 .endlist
28084
28085 Each cipher string can be optionally preceded by one of the characters &`!`&,
28086 &`-`& or &`+`&.
28087 .ilist
28088 If &`!`& is used, the ciphers are permanently deleted from the list. The
28089 ciphers deleted can never reappear in the list even if they are explicitly
28090 stated.
28091 .next
28092 If &`-`& is used, the ciphers are deleted from the list, but some or all
28093 of the ciphers can be added again by later options.
28094 .next
28095 If &`+`& is used, the ciphers are moved to the end of the list. This
28096 option does not add any new ciphers; it just moves matching existing ones.
28097 .endlist
28098
28099 If none of these characters is present, the string is interpreted as
28100 a list of ciphers to be appended to the current preference list. If the list
28101 includes any ciphers already present they will be ignored: that is, they will
28102 not be moved to the end of the list.
28103 .endlist
28104
28105 The OpenSSL &'ciphers(1)'& command may be used to test the results of a given
28106 string:
28107 .code
28108 # note single-quotes to get ! past any shell history expansion
28109 $ openssl ciphers 'HIGH:!MD5:!SHA1'
28110 .endd
28111
28112 This example will let the library defaults be permitted on the MX port, where
28113 there's probably no identity verification anyway, but ups the ante on the
28114 submission ports where the administrator might have some influence on the
28115 choice of clients used:
28116 .code
28117 # OpenSSL variant; see man ciphers(1)
28118 tls_require_ciphers = ${if =={$received_port}{25}\
28119 {DEFAULT}\
28120 {HIGH:!MD5:!SHA1}}
28121 .endd
28122
28123 This example will prefer ECDSA-authenticated ciphers over RSA ones:
28124 .code
28125 tls_require_ciphers = ECDSA:RSA:!COMPLEMENTOFDEFAULT
28126 .endd
28127
28128 For TLS version 1.3 the control available is less fine-grained
28129 and Exim does not provide access to it at present.
28130 The value of the &%tls_require_ciphers%& option is ignored when
28131 TLS version 1.3 is negotiated.
28132
28133 As of writing the library default cipher suite list for TLSv1.3 is
28134 .code
28135 TLS_AES_256_GCM_SHA384:TLS_CHACHA20_POLY1305_SHA256:TLS_AES_128_GCM_SHA256
28136 .endd
28137
28138
28139 .section "Requiring specific ciphers or other parameters in GnuTLS" &&&
28140 "SECTreqciphgnu"
28141 .cindex "GnuTLS" "specifying parameters for"
28142 .cindex "TLS" "specifying ciphers (GnuTLS)"
28143 .cindex "TLS" "specifying key exchange methods (GnuTLS)"
28144 .cindex "TLS" "specifying MAC algorithms (GnuTLS)"
28145 .cindex "TLS" "specifying protocols (GnuTLS)"
28146 .cindex "TLS" "specifying priority string (GnuTLS)"
28147 .oindex "&%tls_require_ciphers%&" "GnuTLS"
28148 The GnuTLS library allows the caller to provide a "priority string", documented
28149 as part of the &[gnutls_priority_init]& function. This is very similar to the
28150 ciphersuite specification in OpenSSL.
28151
28152 The &%tls_require_ciphers%& option is treated as the GnuTLS priority string
28153 and controls both protocols and ciphers.
28154
28155 The &%tls_require_ciphers%& option is available both as an global option,
28156 controlling how Exim behaves as a server, and also as an option of the
28157 &(smtp)& transport, controlling how Exim behaves as a client. In both cases
28158 the value is string expanded. The resulting string is not an Exim list and
28159 the string is given to the GnuTLS library, so that Exim does not need to be
28160 aware of future feature enhancements of GnuTLS.
28161
28162 Documentation of the strings accepted may be found in the GnuTLS manual, under
28163 "Priority strings". This is online as
28164 &url(https://www.gnutls.org/manual/html_node/Priority-Strings.html),
28165 but beware that this relates to GnuTLS 3, which may be newer than the version
28166 installed on your system. If you are using GnuTLS 3,
28167 then the example code
28168 &url(https://www.gnutls.org/manual/gnutls.html#Listing-the-ciphersuites-in-a-priority-string)
28169 on that site can be used to test a given string.
28170
28171 For example:
28172 .code
28173 # Disable older versions of protocols
28174 tls_require_ciphers = NORMAL:%LATEST_RECORD_VERSION:-VERS-SSL3.0
28175 .endd
28176
28177 Prior to Exim 4.80, an older API of GnuTLS was used, and Exim supported three
28178 additional options, "&%gnutls_require_kx%&", "&%gnutls_require_mac%&" and
28179 "&%gnutls_require_protocols%&". &%tls_require_ciphers%& was an Exim list.
28180
28181 This example will let the library defaults be permitted on the MX port, where
28182 there's probably no identity verification anyway, and lowers security further
28183 by increasing compatibility; but this ups the ante on the submission ports
28184 where the administrator might have some influence on the choice of clients
28185 used:
28186 .code
28187 # GnuTLS variant
28188 tls_require_ciphers = ${if =={$received_port}{25}\
28189 {NORMAL:%COMPAT}\
28190 {SECURE128}}
28191 .endd
28192
28193
28194 .section "Configuring an Exim server to use TLS" "SECID182"
28195 .cindex "TLS" "configuring an Exim server"
28196 When Exim has been built with TLS support, it advertises the availability of
28197 the STARTTLS command to client hosts that match &%tls_advertise_hosts%&,
28198 but not to any others. The default value of this option is *, which means
28199 that STARTTLS is always advertised. Set it to blank to never advertise;
28200 this is reasonable for systems that want to use TLS only as a client.
28201
28202 If STARTTLS is to be used you
28203 need to set some other options in order to make TLS available.
28204
28205 If a client issues a STARTTLS command and there is some configuration
28206 problem in the server, the command is rejected with a 454 error. If the client
28207 persists in trying to issue SMTP commands, all except QUIT are rejected
28208 with the error
28209 .code
28210 554 Security failure
28211 .endd
28212 If a STARTTLS command is issued within an existing TLS session, it is
28213 rejected with a 554 error code.
28214
28215 To enable TLS operations on a server, the &%tls_advertise_hosts%& option
28216 must be set to match some hosts. The default is * which matches all hosts.
28217
28218 If this is all you do, TLS encryption will be enabled but not authentication -
28219 meaning that the peer has no assurance it is actually you he is talking to.
28220 You gain protection from a passive sniffer listening on the wire but not
28221 from someone able to intercept the communication.
28222
28223 Further protection requires some further configuration at the server end.
28224
28225 To make TLS work you need to set, in the server,
28226 .code
28227 tls_certificate = /some/file/name
28228 tls_privatekey = /some/file/name
28229 .endd
28230 These options are, in fact, expanded strings, so you can make them depend on
28231 the identity of the client that is connected if you wish. The first file
28232 contains the server's X509 certificate, and the second contains the private key
28233 that goes with it. These files need to be
28234 PEM format and readable by the Exim user, and must
28235 always be given as full path names.
28236 The key must not be password-protected.
28237 They can be the same file if both the
28238 certificate and the key are contained within it. If &%tls_privatekey%& is not
28239 set, or if its expansion is forced to fail or results in an empty string, this
28240 is assumed to be the case. The certificate file may also contain intermediate
28241 certificates that need to be sent to the client to enable it to authenticate
28242 the server's certificate.
28243
28244 For dual-stack (eg. RSA and ECDSA) configurations, these options can be
28245 colon-separated lists of file paths. Ciphers using given authentication
28246 algorithms require the presence of a suitable certificate to supply the
28247 public-key. The server selects among the certificates to present to the
28248 client depending on the selected cipher, hence the priority ordering for
28249 ciphers will affect which certificate is used.
28250
28251 If you do not understand about certificates and keys, please try to find a
28252 source of this background information, which is not Exim-specific. (There are a
28253 few comments below in section &<<SECTcerandall>>&.)
28254
28255 &*Note*&: These options do not apply when Exim is operating as a client &--
28256 they apply only in the case of a server. If you need to use a certificate in an
28257 Exim client, you must set the options of the same names in an &(smtp)&
28258 transport.
28259
28260 With just these options, an Exim server will be able to use TLS. It does not
28261 require the client to have a certificate (but see below for how to insist on
28262 this). There is one other option that may be needed in other situations. If
28263 .code
28264 tls_dhparam = /some/file/name
28265 .endd
28266 is set, the SSL library is initialized for the use of Diffie-Hellman ciphers
28267 with the parameters contained in the file.
28268 Set this to &`none`& to disable use of DH entirely, by making no prime
28269 available:
28270 .code
28271 tls_dhparam = none
28272 .endd
28273 This may also be set to a string identifying a standard prime to be used for
28274 DH; if it is set to &`default`& or, for OpenSSL, is unset, then the prime
28275 used is &`ike23`&. There are a few standard primes available, see the
28276 documentation for &%tls_dhparam%& for the complete list.
28277
28278 See the command
28279 .code
28280 openssl dhparam
28281 .endd
28282 for a way of generating file data.
28283
28284 The strings supplied for these three options are expanded every time a client
28285 host connects. It is therefore possible to use different certificates and keys
28286 for different hosts, if you so wish, by making use of the client's IP address
28287 in &$sender_host_address$& to control the expansion. If a string expansion is
28288 forced to fail, Exim behaves as if the option is not set.
28289
28290 .cindex "cipher" "logging"
28291 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
28292 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
28293 The variable &$tls_in_cipher$& is set to the cipher suite that was negotiated for
28294 an incoming TLS connection. It is included in the &'Received:'& header of an
28295 incoming message (by default &-- you can, of course, change this), and it is
28296 also included in the log line that records a message's arrival, keyed by
28297 &"X="&, unless the &%tls_cipher%& log selector is turned off. The &%encrypted%&
28298 condition can be used to test for specific cipher suites in ACLs.
28299
28300 Once TLS has been established, the ACLs that run for subsequent SMTP commands
28301 can check the name of the cipher suite and vary their actions accordingly. The
28302 cipher suite names vary, depending on which TLS library is being used. For
28303 example, OpenSSL uses the name DES-CBC3-SHA for the cipher suite which in other
28304 contexts is known as TLS_RSA_WITH_3DES_EDE_CBC_SHA. Check the OpenSSL or GnuTLS
28305 documentation for more details.
28306
28307 For outgoing SMTP deliveries, &$tls_out_cipher$& is used and logged
28308 (again depending on the &%tls_cipher%& log selector).
28309
28310
28311 .section "Requesting and verifying client certificates" "SECID183"
28312 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
28313 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
28314 If you want an Exim server to request a certificate when negotiating a TLS
28315 session with a client, you must set either &%tls_verify_hosts%& or
28316 &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. You can, of course, set either of them to * to
28317 apply to all TLS connections. For any host that matches one of these options,
28318 Exim requests a certificate as part of the setup of the TLS session. The
28319 contents of the certificate are verified by comparing it with a list of
28320 expected trust-anchors or certificates.
28321 These may be the system default set (depending on library version),
28322 an explicit file or,
28323 depending on library version, a directory, identified by
28324 &%tls_verify_certificates%&.
28325
28326 A file can contain multiple certificates, concatenated end to end. If a
28327 directory is used
28328 (OpenSSL only),
28329 each certificate must be in a separate file, with a name (or a symbolic link)
28330 of the form <&'hash'&>.0, where <&'hash'&> is a hash value constructed from the
28331 certificate. You can compute the relevant hash by running the command
28332 .code
28333 openssl x509 -hash -noout -in /cert/file
28334 .endd
28335 where &_/cert/file_& contains a single certificate.
28336
28337 There is no checking of names of the client against the certificate
28338 Subject Name or Subject Alternate Names.
28339
28340 The difference between &%tls_verify_hosts%& and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& is
28341 what happens if the client does not supply a certificate, or if the certificate
28342 does not match any of the certificates in the collection named by
28343 &%tls_verify_certificates%&. If the client matches &%tls_verify_hosts%&, the
28344 attempt to set up a TLS session is aborted, and the incoming connection is
28345 dropped. If the client matches &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&, the (encrypted) SMTP
28346 session continues. ACLs that run for subsequent SMTP commands can detect the
28347 fact that no certificate was verified, and vary their actions accordingly. For
28348 example, you can insist on a certificate before accepting a message for
28349 relaying, but not when the message is destined for local delivery.
28350
28351 .vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
28352 When a client supplies a certificate (whether it verifies or not), the value of
28353 the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the variable
28354 &$tls_in_peerdn$& during subsequent processing of the message.
28355
28356 .cindex "log" "distinguished name"
28357 Because it is often a long text string, it is not included in the log line or
28358 &'Received:'& header by default. You can arrange for it to be logged, keyed by
28359 &"DN="&, by setting the &%tls_peerdn%& log selector, and you can use
28360 &%received_header_text%& to change the &'Received:'& header. When no
28361 certificate is supplied, &$tls_in_peerdn$& is empty.
28362
28363
28364 .section "Revoked certificates" "SECID184"
28365 .cindex "TLS" "revoked certificates"
28366 .cindex "revocation list"
28367 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list"
28368 .cindex "OCSP" "stapling"
28369 Certificate issuing authorities issue Certificate Revocation Lists (CRLs) when
28370 certificates are revoked. If you have such a list, you can pass it to an Exim
28371 server using the global option called &%tls_crl%& and to an Exim client using
28372 an identically named option for the &(smtp)& transport. In each case, the value
28373 of the option is expanded and must then be the name of a file that contains a
28374 CRL in PEM format.
28375 The downside is that clients have to periodically re-download a potentially huge
28376 file from every certificate authority they know of.
28377
28378 The way with most moving parts at query time is Online Certificate
28379 Status Protocol (OCSP), where the client verifies the certificate
28380 against an OCSP server run by the CA. This lets the CA track all
28381 usage of the certs. It requires running software with access to the
28382 private key of the CA, to sign the responses to the OCSP queries. OCSP
28383 is based on HTTP and can be proxied accordingly.
28384
28385 The only widespread OCSP server implementation (known to this writer)
28386 comes as part of OpenSSL and aborts on an invalid request, such as
28387 connecting to the port and then disconnecting. This requires
28388 re-entering the passphrase each time some random client does this.
28389
28390 The third way is OCSP Stapling; in this, the server using a certificate
28391 issued by the CA periodically requests an OCSP proof of validity from
28392 the OCSP server, then serves it up inline as part of the TLS
28393 negotiation. This approach adds no extra round trips, does not let the
28394 CA track users, scales well with number of certs issued by the CA and is
28395 resilient to temporary OCSP server failures, as long as the server
28396 starts retrying to fetch an OCSP proof some time before its current
28397 proof expires. The downside is that it requires server support.
28398
28399 Unless Exim is built with the support disabled,
28400 or with GnuTLS earlier than version 3.3.16 / 3.4.8
28401 support for OCSP stapling is included.
28402
28403 There is a global option called &%tls_ocsp_file%&.
28404 The file specified therein is expected to be in DER format, and contain
28405 an OCSP proof. Exim will serve it as part of the TLS handshake. This
28406 option will be re-expanded for SNI, if the &%tls_certificate%& option
28407 contains &`tls_in_sni`&, as per other TLS options.
28408
28409 Exim does not at this time implement any support for fetching a new OCSP
28410 proof. The burden is on the administrator to handle this, outside of
28411 Exim. The file specified should be replaced atomically, so that the
28412 contents are always valid. Exim will expand the &%tls_ocsp_file%& option
28413 on each connection, so a new file will be handled transparently on the
28414 next connection.
28415
28416 When built with OpenSSL Exim will check for a valid next update timestamp
28417 in the OCSP proof; if not present, or if the proof has expired, it will be
28418 ignored.
28419
28420 For the client to be able to verify the stapled OCSP the server must
28421 also supply, in its stapled information, any intermediate
28422 certificates for the chain leading to the OCSP proof from the signer
28423 of the server certificate. There may be zero or one such. These
28424 intermediate certificates should be added to the server OCSP stapling
28425 file named by &%tls_ocsp_file%&.
28426
28427 Note that the proof only covers the terminal server certificate,
28428 not any of the chain from CA to it.
28429
28430 There is no current way to staple a proof for a client certificate.
28431
28432 .code
28433 A helper script "ocsp_fetch.pl" for fetching a proof from a CA
28434 OCSP server is supplied. The server URL may be included in the
28435 server certificate, if the CA is helpful.
28436
28437 One failure mode seen was the OCSP Signer cert expiring before the end
28438 of validity of the OCSP proof. The checking done by Exim/OpenSSL
28439 noted this as invalid overall, but the re-fetch script did not.
28440 .endd
28441
28442
28443
28444
28445 .section "Configuring an Exim client to use TLS" "SECTclientTLS"
28446 .cindex "cipher" "logging"
28447 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
28448 .cindex "log" "distinguished name"
28449 .cindex "TLS" "configuring an Exim client"
28450 The &%tls_cipher%& and &%tls_peerdn%& log selectors apply to outgoing SMTP
28451 deliveries as well as to incoming, the latter one causing logging of the
28452 server certificate's DN. The remaining client configuration for TLS is all
28453 within the &(smtp)& transport.
28454
28455 It is not necessary to set any options to have TLS work in the &(smtp)&
28456 transport. If Exim is built with TLS support, and TLS is advertised by a
28457 server, the &(smtp)& transport always tries to start a TLS session. However,
28458 this can be prevented by setting &%hosts_avoid_tls%& (an option of the
28459 transport) to a list of server hosts for which TLS should not be used.
28460
28461 If you do not want Exim to attempt to send messages unencrypted when an attempt
28462 to set up an encrypted connection fails in any way, you can set
28463 &%hosts_require_tls%& to a list of hosts for which encryption is mandatory. For
28464 those hosts, delivery is always deferred if an encrypted connection cannot be
28465 set up. If there are any other hosts for the address, they are tried in the
28466 usual way.
28467
28468 When the server host is not in &%hosts_require_tls%&, Exim may try to deliver
28469 the message unencrypted. It always does this if the response to STARTTLS is
28470 a 5&'xx'& code. For a temporary error code, or for a failure to negotiate a TLS
28471 session after a success response code, what happens is controlled by the
28472 &%tls_tempfail_tryclear%& option of the &(smtp)& transport. If it is false,
28473 delivery to this host is deferred, and other hosts (if available) are tried. If
28474 it is true, Exim attempts to deliver unencrypted after a 4&'xx'& response to
28475 STARTTLS, and if STARTTLS is accepted, but the subsequent TLS
28476 negotiation fails, Exim closes the current connection (because it is in an
28477 unknown state), opens a new one to the same host, and then tries the delivery
28478 unencrypted.
28479
28480 The &%tls_certificate%& and &%tls_privatekey%& options of the &(smtp)&
28481 transport provide the client with a certificate, which is passed to the server
28482 if it requests it. If the server is Exim, it will request a certificate only if
28483 &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& matches the client.
28484
28485 .new
28486 Do not use a certificate which has the OCSP-must-staple extension,
28487 for client use (they are usable for server use).
28488 As TLS has no means for the client to staple before TLS 1.3 it will result
28489 in failed connections.
28490 .wen
28491
28492 If the &%tls_verify_certificates%& option is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it
28493 specifies a collection of expected server certificates.
28494 These may be
28495 the system default set (depending on library version),
28496 a file,
28497 or (depending on library version) a directory.
28498 The client verifies the server's certificate
28499 against this collection, taking into account any revoked certificates that are
28500 in the list defined by &%tls_crl%&.
28501 Failure to verify fails the TLS connection unless either of the
28502 &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& options are set.
28503
28504 The &%tls_verify_hosts%& and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& options restrict
28505 certificate verification to the listed servers. Verification either must
28506 or need not succeed respectively.
28507
28508 The &%tls_verify_cert_hostnames%& option lists hosts for which additional
28509 checks are made: that the host name (the one in the DNS A record)
28510 is valid for the certificate.
28511 The option defaults to always checking.
28512
28513 The &(smtp)& transport has two OCSP-related options:
28514 &%hosts_require_ocsp%&; a host-list for which a Certificate Status
28515 is requested and required for the connection to proceed. The default
28516 value is empty.
28517 &%hosts_request_ocsp%&; a host-list for which (additionally)
28518 a Certificate Status is requested (but not necessarily verified). The default
28519 value is "*" meaning that requests are made unless configured
28520 otherwise.
28521
28522 The host(s) should also be in &%hosts_require_tls%&, and
28523 &%tls_verify_certificates%& configured for the transport,
28524 for OCSP to be relevant.
28525
28526 If
28527 &%tls_require_ciphers%& is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it must contain a
28528 list of permitted cipher suites. If either of these checks fails, delivery to
28529 the current host is abandoned, and the &(smtp)& transport tries to deliver to
28530 alternative hosts, if any.
28531
28532 &*Note*&:
28533 These options must be set in the &(smtp)& transport for Exim to use TLS when it
28534 is operating as a client. Exim does not assume that a server certificate (set
28535 by the global options of the same name) should also be used when operating as a
28536 client.
28537
28538 .vindex "&$host$&"
28539 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
28540 All the TLS options in the &(smtp)& transport are expanded before use, with
28541 &$host$& and &$host_address$& containing the name and address of the server to
28542 which the client is connected. Forced failure of an expansion causes Exim to
28543 behave as if the relevant option were unset.
28544
28545 .vindex &$tls_out_bits$&
28546 .vindex &$tls_out_cipher$&
28547 .vindex &$tls_out_peerdn$&
28548 .vindex &$tls_out_sni$&
28549 Before an SMTP connection is established, the
28550 &$tls_out_bits$&, &$tls_out_cipher$&, &$tls_out_peerdn$& and &$tls_out_sni$&
28551 variables are emptied. (Until the first connection, they contain the values
28552 that were set when the message was received.) If STARTTLS is subsequently
28553 successfully obeyed, these variables are set to the relevant values for the
28554 outgoing connection.
28555
28556
28557
28558 .section "Use of TLS Server Name Indication" "SECTtlssni"
28559 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
28560 .vindex "&$tls_in_sni$&"
28561 .oindex "&%tls_in_sni%&"
28562 With TLS1.0 or above, there is an extension mechanism by which extra
28563 information can be included at various points in the protocol. One of these
28564 extensions, documented in RFC 6066 (and before that RFC 4366) is
28565 &"Server Name Indication"&, commonly &"SNI"&. This extension is sent by the
28566 client in the initial handshake, so that the server can examine the servername
28567 within and possibly choose to use different certificates and keys (and more)
28568 for this session.
28569
28570 This is analogous to HTTP's &"Host:"& header, and is the main mechanism by
28571 which HTTPS-enabled web-sites can be virtual-hosted, many sites to one IP
28572 address.
28573
28574 With SMTP to MX, there are the same problems here as in choosing the identity
28575 against which to validate a certificate: you can't rely on insecure DNS to
28576 provide the identity which you then cryptographically verify. So this will
28577 be of limited use in that environment.
28578
28579 With SMTP to Submission, there is a well-defined hostname which clients are
28580 connecting to and can validate certificates against. Thus clients &*can*&
28581 choose to include this information in the TLS negotiation. If this becomes
28582 wide-spread, then hosters can choose to present different certificates to
28583 different clients. Or even negotiate different cipher suites.
28584
28585 The &%tls_sni%& option on an SMTP transport is an expanded string; the result,
28586 if not empty, will be sent on a TLS session as part of the handshake. There's
28587 nothing more to it. Choosing a sensible value not derived insecurely is the
28588 only point of caution. The &$tls_out_sni$& variable will be set to this string
28589 for the lifetime of the client connection (including during authentication).
28590
28591 Except during SMTP client sessions, if &$tls_in_sni$& is set then it is a string
28592 received from a client.
28593 It can be logged with the &%log_selector%& item &`+tls_sni`&.
28594
28595 If the string &`tls_in_sni`& appears in the main section's &%tls_certificate%&
28596 option (prior to expansion) then the following options will be re-expanded
28597 during TLS session handshake, to permit alternative values to be chosen:
28598
28599 .ilist
28600 &%tls_certificate%&
28601 .next
28602 &%tls_crl%&
28603 .next
28604 &%tls_privatekey%&
28605 .next
28606 &%tls_verify_certificates%&
28607 .next
28608 &%tls_ocsp_file%&
28609 .endlist
28610
28611 Great care should be taken to deal with matters of case, various injection
28612 attacks in the string (&`../`& or SQL), and ensuring that a valid filename
28613 can always be referenced; it is important to remember that &$tls_in_sni$& is
28614 arbitrary unverified data provided prior to authentication.
28615 Further, the initial certificate is loaded before SNI is arrived, so
28616 an expansion for &%tls_certificate%& must have a default which is used
28617 when &$tls_in_sni$& is empty.
28618
28619 The Exim developers are proceeding cautiously and so far no other TLS options
28620 are re-expanded.
28621
28622 When Exim is built against OpenSSL, OpenSSL must have been built with support
28623 for TLS Extensions. This holds true for OpenSSL 1.0.0+ and 0.9.8+ with
28624 enable-tlsext in EXTRACONFIGURE. If you invoke &(openssl s_client -h)& and
28625 see &`-servername`& in the output, then OpenSSL has support.
28626
28627 When Exim is built against GnuTLS, SNI support is available as of GnuTLS
28628 0.5.10. (Its presence predates the current API which Exim uses, so if Exim
28629 built, then you have SNI support).
28630
28631
28632
28633 .section "Multiple messages on the same encrypted TCP/IP connection" &&&
28634 "SECTmulmessam"
28635 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries with TLS"
28636 .cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
28637 Exim sends multiple messages down the same TCP/IP connection by starting up
28638 an entirely new delivery process for each message, passing the socket from
28639 one process to the next. This implementation does not fit well with the use
28640 of TLS, because there is quite a lot of state information associated with a TLS
28641 connection, not just a socket identification. Passing all the state information
28642 to a new process is not feasible. Consequently, for sending using TLS Exim
28643 starts an additional proxy process for handling the encryption, piping the
28644 unencrypted data stream from and to the delivery processes.
28645
28646 An older mode of operation can be enabled on a per-host basis by the
28647 &%hosts_noproxy_tls%& option on the &(smtp)& transport. If the host matches
28648 this list the proxy process described above is not used; instead Exim
28649 shuts down an existing TLS session being run by the delivery process
28650 before passing the socket to a new process. The new process may then
28651 try to start a new TLS session, and if successful, may try to re-authenticate
28652 if AUTH is in use, before sending the next message.
28653
28654 The RFC is not clear as to whether or not an SMTP session continues in clear
28655 after TLS has been shut down, or whether TLS may be restarted again later, as
28656 just described. However, if the server is Exim, this shutdown and
28657 reinitialization works. It is not known which (if any) other servers operate
28658 successfully if the client closes a TLS session and continues with unencrypted
28659 SMTP, but there are certainly some that do not work. For such servers, Exim
28660 should not pass the socket to another process, because the failure of the
28661 subsequent attempt to use it would cause Exim to record a temporary host error,
28662 and delay other deliveries to that host.
28663
28664 To test for this case, Exim sends an EHLO command to the server after
28665 closing down the TLS session. If this fails in any way, the connection is
28666 closed instead of being passed to a new delivery process, but no retry
28667 information is recorded.
28668
28669 There is also a manual override; you can set &%hosts_nopass_tls%& on the
28670 &(smtp)& transport to match those hosts for which Exim should not pass
28671 connections to new processes if TLS has been used.
28672
28673
28674
28675
28676 .section "Certificates and all that" "SECTcerandall"
28677 .cindex "certificate" "references to discussion"
28678 In order to understand fully how TLS works, you need to know about
28679 certificates, certificate signing, and certificate authorities.
28680 This is a large topic and an introductory guide is unsuitable for the Exim
28681 reference manual, so instead we provide pointers to existing documentation.
28682
28683 The Apache web-server was for a long time the canonical guide, so their
28684 documentation is a good place to start; their SSL module's Introduction
28685 document is currently at
28686 .display
28687 &url(https://httpd.apache.org/docs/current/ssl/ssl_intro.html)
28688 .endd
28689 and their FAQ is at
28690 .display
28691 &url(https://httpd.apache.org/docs/current/ssl/ssl_faq.html)
28692 .endd
28693
28694 Eric Rescorla's book, &'SSL and TLS'&, published by Addison-Wesley (ISBN
28695 0-201-61598-3) in 2001, contains both introductory and more in-depth
28696 descriptions.
28697 More recently Ivan Ristić's book &'Bulletproof SSL and TLS'&,
28698 published by Feisty Duck (ISBN 978-1907117046) in 2013 is good.
28699 Ivan is the author of the popular TLS testing tools at
28700 &url(https://www.ssllabs.com/).
28701
28702
28703 .section "Certificate chains" "SECID186"
28704 The file named by &%tls_certificate%& may contain more than one
28705 certificate. This is useful in the case where the certificate that is being
28706 sent is validated by an intermediate certificate which the other end does
28707 not have. Multiple certificates must be in the correct order in the file.
28708 First the host's certificate itself, then the first intermediate
28709 certificate to validate the issuer of the host certificate, then the next
28710 intermediate certificate to validate the issuer of the first intermediate
28711 certificate, and so on, until finally (optionally) the root certificate.
28712 The root certificate must already be trusted by the recipient for
28713 validation to succeed, of course, but if it's not preinstalled, sending the
28714 root certificate along with the rest makes it available for the user to
28715 install if the receiving end is a client MUA that can interact with a user.
28716
28717 Note that certificates using MD5 are unlikely to work on today's Internet;
28718 even if your libraries allow loading them for use in Exim when acting as a
28719 server, increasingly clients will not accept such certificates. The error
28720 diagnostics in such a case can be frustratingly vague.
28721
28722
28723
28724 .section "Self-signed certificates" "SECID187"
28725 .cindex "certificate" "self-signed"
28726 You can create a self-signed certificate using the &'req'& command provided
28727 with OpenSSL, like this:
28728 . ==== Do not shorten the duration here without reading and considering
28729 . ==== the text below. Please leave it at 9999 days.
28730 .code
28731 openssl req -x509 -newkey rsa:1024 -keyout file1 -out file2 \
28732 -days 9999 -nodes
28733 .endd
28734 &_file1_& and &_file2_& can be the same file; the key and the certificate are
28735 delimited and so can be identified independently. The &%-days%& option
28736 specifies a period for which the certificate is valid. The &%-nodes%& option is
28737 important: if you do not set it, the key is encrypted with a passphrase
28738 that you are prompted for, and any use that is made of the key causes more
28739 prompting for the passphrase. This is not helpful if you are going to use
28740 this certificate and key in an MTA, where prompting is not possible.
28741
28742 . ==== I expect to still be working 26 years from now. The less technical
28743 . ==== debt I create, in terms of storing up trouble for my later years, the
28744 . ==== happier I will be then. We really have reached the point where we
28745 . ==== should start, at the very least, provoking thought and making folks
28746 . ==== pause before proceeding, instead of leaving all the fixes until two
28747 . ==== years before 2^31 seconds after the 1970 Unix epoch.
28748 . ==== -pdp, 2012
28749 NB: we are now past the point where 9999 days takes us past the 32-bit Unix
28750 epoch. If your system uses unsigned time_t (most do) and is 32-bit, then
28751 the above command might produce a date in the past. Think carefully about
28752 the lifetime of the systems you're deploying, and either reduce the duration
28753 of the certificate or reconsider your platform deployment. (At time of
28754 writing, reducing the duration is the most likely choice, but the inexorable
28755 progression of time takes us steadily towards an era where this will not
28756 be a sensible resolution).
28757
28758 A self-signed certificate made in this way is sufficient for testing, and
28759 may be adequate for all your requirements if you are mainly interested in
28760 encrypting transfers, and not in secure identification.
28761
28762 However, many clients require that the certificate presented by the server be a
28763 user (also called &"leaf"& or &"site"&) certificate, and not a self-signed
28764 certificate. In this situation, the self-signed certificate described above
28765 must be installed on the client host as a trusted root &'certification
28766 authority'& (CA), and the certificate used by Exim must be a user certificate
28767 signed with that self-signed certificate.
28768
28769 For information on creating self-signed CA certificates and using them to sign
28770 user certificates, see the &'General implementation overview'& chapter of the
28771 Open-source PKI book, available online at
28772 &url(https://sourceforge.net/projects/ospkibook/).
28773 .ecindex IIDencsmtp1
28774 .ecindex IIDencsmtp2
28775
28776
28777
28778 .section DANE "SECDANE"
28779 .cindex DANE
28780 DNS-based Authentication of Named Entities, as applied to SMTP over TLS, provides assurance to a client that
28781 it is actually talking to the server it wants to rather than some attacker operating a Man In The Middle (MITM)
28782 operation. The latter can terminate the TLS connection you make, and make another one to the server (so both
28783 you and the server still think you have an encrypted connection) and, if one of the "well known" set of
28784 Certificate Authorities has been suborned - something which *has* been seen already (2014), a verifiable
28785 certificate (if you're using normal root CAs, eg. the Mozilla set, as your trust anchors).
28786
28787 What DANE does is replace the CAs with the DNS as the trust anchor. The assurance is limited to a) the possibility
28788 that the DNS has been suborned, b) mistakes made by the admins of the target server. The attack surface presented
28789 by (a) is thought to be smaller than that of the set of root CAs.
28790
28791 It also allows the server to declare (implicitly) that connections to it should use TLS. An MITM could simply
28792 fail to pass on a server's STARTTLS.
28793
28794 DANE scales better than having to maintain (and side-channel communicate) copies of server certificates
28795 for every possible target server. It also scales (slightly) better than having to maintain on an SMTP
28796 client a copy of the standard CAs bundle. It also means not having to pay a CA for certificates.
28797
28798 DANE requires a server operator to do three things: 1) run DNSSEC. This provides assurance to clients
28799 that DNS lookups they do for the server have not been tampered with. The domain MX record applying
28800 to this server, its A record, its TLSA record and any associated CNAME records must all be covered by
28801 DNSSEC.
28802 2) add TLSA DNS records. These say what the server certificate for a TLS connection should be.
28803 3) offer a server certificate, or certificate chain, in TLS connections which is is anchored by one of the TLSA records.
28804
28805 There are no changes to Exim specific to server-side operation of DANE.
28806 Support for client-side operation of DANE can be included at compile time by defining SUPPORT_DANE=yes
28807 in &_Local/Makefile_&.
28808 If it has been included, the macro "_HAVE_DANE" will be defined.
28809
28810 The TLSA record for the server may have "certificate usage" of DANE-TA(2) or DANE-EE(3).
28811 These are the "Trust Anchor" and "End Entity" variants.
28812 The latter specifies the End Entity directly, i.e. the certificate involved is that of the server
28813 (and if only DANE-EE is used then it should be the sole one transmitted during the TLS handshake);
28814 this is appropriate for a single system, using a self-signed certificate.
28815 DANE-TA usage is effectively declaring a specific CA to be used; this might be a private CA or a public,
28816 well-known one.
28817 A private CA at simplest is just a self-signed certificate (with certain
28818 attributes) which is used to sign server certificates, but running one securely
28819 does require careful arrangement.
28820 With DANE-TA, as implemented in Exim and commonly in other MTAs,
28821 the server TLS handshake must transmit the entire certificate chain from CA to server-certificate.
28822 DANE-TA is commonly used for several services and/or servers, each having a TLSA query-domain CNAME record,
28823 all of which point to a single TLSA record.
28824 DANE-TA and DANE-EE can both be used together.
28825
28826 Our recommendation is to use DANE with a certificate from a public CA,
28827 because this enables a variety of strategies for remote clients to verify
28828 your certificate.
28829 You can then publish information both via DANE and another technology,
28830 "MTA-STS", described below.
28831
28832 When you use DANE-TA to publish trust anchor information, you ask entities
28833 outside your administrative control to trust the Certificate Authority for
28834 connections to you.
28835 If using a private CA then you should expect others to still apply the
28836 technical criteria they'd use for a public CA to your certificates.
28837 In particular, you should probably try to follow current best practices for CA
28838 operation around hash algorithms and key sizes.
28839 Do not expect other organizations to lower their security expectations just
28840 because a particular profile might be reasonable for your own internal use.
28841
28842 When this text was last updated, this in practice means to avoid use of SHA-1
28843 and MD5; if using RSA to use key sizes of at least 2048 bits (and no larger
28844 than 4096, for interoperability); to use keyUsage fields correctly; to use
28845 random serial numbers.
28846 The list of requirements is subject to change as best practices evolve.
28847 If you're not already using a private CA, or it doesn't meet these
28848 requirements, then we encourage you to avoid all these issues and use a public
28849 CA such as &url(https://letsencrypt.org/,Let's Encrypt) instead.
28850
28851 The TLSA record should have a Selector field of SPKI(1) and a Matching Type field of SHA2-512(2).
28852
28853 At the time of writing, &url(https://www.huque.com/bin/gen_tlsa)
28854 is useful for quickly generating TLSA records; and commands like
28855
28856 .code
28857 openssl x509 -in -pubkey -noout <certificate.pem \
28858 | openssl rsa -outform der -pubin 2>/dev/null \
28859 | openssl sha512 \
28860 | awk '{print $2}'
28861 .endd
28862
28863 are workable for 4th-field hashes.
28864
28865 For use with the DANE-TA model, server certificates must have a correct name (SubjectName or SubjectAltName).
28866
28867 The Certificate issued by the CA published in the DANE-TA model should be
28868 issued using a strong hash algorithm.
28869 Exim, and importantly various other MTAs sending to you, will not
28870 re-enable hash algorithms which have been disabled by default in TLS
28871 libraries.
28872 This means no MD5 and no SHA-1. SHA2-256 is the minimum for reliable
28873 interoperability (and probably the maximum too, in 2018).
28874
28875 The use of OCSP-stapling should be considered, allowing for fast revocation of certificates (which would otherwise
28876 be limited by the DNS TTL on the TLSA records). However, this is likely to only be usable with DANE-TA. NOTE: the
28877 default of requesting OCSP for all hosts is modified iff DANE is in use, to:
28878
28879 .code
28880 hosts_request_ocsp = ${if or { {= {0}{$tls_out_tlsa_usage}} \
28881 {= {4}{$tls_out_tlsa_usage}} } \
28882 {*}{}}
28883 .endd
28884
28885 The (new) variable &$tls_out_tlsa_usage$& is a bitfield with numbered bits set for TLSA record usage codes.
28886 The zero above means DANE was not in use, the four means that only DANE-TA usage TLSA records were
28887 found. If the definition of &%hosts_request_ocsp%& includes the
28888 string "tls_out_tlsa_usage", they are re-expanded in time to
28889 control the OCSP request.
28890
28891 This modification of hosts_request_ocsp is only done if it has the default value of "*". Admins who change it, and
28892 those who use &%hosts_require_ocsp%&, should consider the interaction with DANE in their OCSP settings.
28893
28894
28895 For client-side DANE there are three new smtp transport options, &%hosts_try_dane%&, &%hosts_require_dane%&
28896 and &%dane_require_tls_ciphers%&.
28897 The require variant will result in failure if the target host is not DNSSEC-secured.
28898
28899 DANE will only be usable if the target host has DNSSEC-secured MX, A and TLSA records.
28900
28901 A TLSA lookup will be done if either of the above options match and the host-lookup succeeded using dnssec.
28902 If a TLSA lookup is done and succeeds, a DANE-verified TLS connection
28903 will be required for the host. If it does not, the host will not
28904 be used; there is no fallback to non-DANE or non-TLS.
28905
28906 If DANE is requested and usable, then the TLS cipher list configuration
28907 prefers to use the option &%dane_require_tls_ciphers%& and falls
28908 back to &%tls_require_ciphers%& only if that is unset.
28909 This lets you configure "decent crypto" for DANE and "better than nothing
28910 crypto" as the default. Note though that while GnuTLS lets the string control
28911 which versions of TLS/SSL will be negotiated, OpenSSL does not and you're
28912 limited to ciphersuite constraints.
28913
28914 If DANE is requested and useable (see above) the following transport options are ignored:
28915 .code
28916 hosts_require_tls
28917 tls_verify_hosts
28918 tls_try_verify_hosts
28919 tls_verify_certificates
28920 tls_crl
28921 tls_verify_cert_hostnames
28922 .endd
28923
28924 If DANE is not usable, whether requested or not, and CA-anchored
28925 verification evaluation is wanted, the above variables should be set appropriately.
28926
28927 Currently the &%dnssec_request_domains%& must be active and &%dnssec_require_domains%& is ignored.
28928
28929 If verification was successful using DANE then the "CV" item in the delivery log line will show as "CV=dane".
28930
28931 There is a new variable &$tls_out_dane$& which will have "yes" if
28932 verification succeeded using DANE and "no" otherwise (only useful
28933 in combination with events; see &<<CHAPevents>>&),
28934 and a new variable &$tls_out_tlsa_usage$& (detailed above).
28935
28936 .cindex DANE reporting
28937 An event (see &<<CHAPevents>>&) of type "dane:fail" will be raised on failures
28938 to achieve DANE-verified connection, if one was either requested and offered, or
28939 required. This is intended to support TLS-reporting as defined in
28940 &url(https://tools.ietf.org/html/draft-ietf-uta-smtp-tlsrpt-17).
28941 The &$event_data$& will be one of the Result Types defined in
28942 Section 4.3 of that document.
28943
28944 Under GnuTLS, DANE is only supported from version 3.0.0 onwards.
28945
28946 DANE is specified in published RFCs and decouples certificate authority trust
28947 selection from a "race to the bottom" of "you must trust everything for mail
28948 to get through". There is an alternative technology called MTA-STS, which
28949 instead publishes MX trust anchor information on an HTTPS website. At the
28950 time this text was last updated, MTA-STS was still a draft, not yet an RFC.
28951 Exim has no support for MTA-STS as a client, but Exim mail server operators
28952 can choose to publish information describing their TLS configuration using
28953 MTA-STS to let those clients who do use that protocol derive trust
28954 information.
28955
28956 The MTA-STS design requires a certificate from a public Certificate Authority
28957 which is recognized by clients sending to you.
28958 That selection of which CAs are trusted by others is outside your control.
28959
28960 The most interoperable course of action is probably to use
28961 &url(https://letsencrypt.org/,Let's Encrypt), with automated certificate
28962 renewal; to publish the anchor information in DNSSEC-secured DNS via TLSA
28963 records for DANE clients (such as Exim and Postfix) and to publish anchor
28964 information for MTA-STS as well. This is what is done for the &'exim.org'&
28965 domain itself (with caveats around occasionally broken MTA-STS because of
28966 incompatible specification changes prior to reaching RFC status).
28967
28968
28969
28970 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28971 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28972
28973 .chapter "Access control lists" "CHAPACL"
28974 .scindex IIDacl "&ACL;" "description"
28975 .cindex "control of incoming mail"
28976 .cindex "message" "controlling incoming"
28977 .cindex "policy control" "access control lists"
28978 Access Control Lists (ACLs) are defined in a separate section of the runtime
28979 configuration file, headed by &"begin acl"&. Each ACL definition starts with a
28980 name, terminated by a colon. Here is a complete ACL section that contains just
28981 one very small ACL:
28982 .code
28983 begin acl
28984 small_acl:
28985 accept hosts = one.host.only
28986 .endd
28987 You can have as many lists as you like in the ACL section, and the order in
28988 which they appear does not matter. The lists are self-terminating.
28989
28990 The majority of ACLs are used to control Exim's behaviour when it receives
28991 certain SMTP commands. This applies both to incoming TCP/IP connections, and
28992 when a local process submits a message using SMTP by specifying the &%-bs%&
28993 option. The most common use is for controlling which recipients are accepted
28994 in incoming messages. In addition, you can define an ACL that is used to check
28995 local non-SMTP messages. The default configuration file contains an example of
28996 a realistic ACL for checking RCPT commands. This is discussed in chapter
28997 &<<CHAPdefconfil>>&.
28998
28999
29000 .section "Testing ACLs" "SECID188"
29001 The &%-bh%& command line option provides a way of testing your ACL
29002 configuration locally by running a fake SMTP session with which you interact.
29003
29004
29005 .section "Specifying when ACLs are used" "SECID189"
29006 .cindex "&ACL;" "options for specifying"
29007 In order to cause an ACL to be used, you have to name it in one of the relevant
29008 options in the main part of the configuration. These options are:
29009 .cindex "AUTH" "ACL for"
29010 .cindex "DATA" "ACLs for"
29011 .cindex "ETRN" "ACL for"
29012 .cindex "EXPN" "ACL for"
29013 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
29014 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
29015 .cindex "DKIM" "ACL for"
29016 .cindex "MAIL" "ACL for"
29017 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
29018 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
29019 .cindex "STARTTLS, ACL for"
29020 .cindex "VRFY" "ACL for"
29021 .cindex "SMTP" "connection, ACL for"
29022 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
29023 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "ACL for"
29024 .cindex "PRDR" "ACL for"
29025
29026 .table2 140pt
29027 .irow &%acl_not_smtp%& "ACL for non-SMTP messages"
29028 .irow &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& "ACL for non-SMTP MIME parts"
29029 .irow &%acl_not_smtp_start%& "ACL at start of non-SMTP message"
29030 .irow &%acl_smtp_auth%& "ACL for AUTH"
29031 .irow &%acl_smtp_connect%& "ACL for start of SMTP connection"
29032 .irow &%acl_smtp_data%& "ACL after DATA is complete"
29033 .irow &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& "ACL for each recipient, after DATA is complete"
29034 .irow &%acl_smtp_dkim%& "ACL for each DKIM signer"
29035 .irow &%acl_smtp_etrn%& "ACL for ETRN"
29036 .irow &%acl_smtp_expn%& "ACL for EXPN"
29037 .irow &%acl_smtp_helo%& "ACL for HELO or EHLO"
29038 .irow &%acl_smtp_mail%& "ACL for MAIL"
29039 .irow &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& "ACL for the AUTH parameter of MAIL"
29040 .irow &%acl_smtp_mime%& "ACL for content-scanning MIME parts"
29041 .irow &%acl_smtp_notquit%& "ACL for non-QUIT terminations"
29042 .irow &%acl_smtp_predata%& "ACL at start of DATA command"
29043 .irow &%acl_smtp_quit%& "ACL for QUIT"
29044 .irow &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& "ACL for RCPT"
29045 .irow &%acl_smtp_starttls%& "ACL for STARTTLS"
29046 .irow &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& "ACL for VRFY"
29047 .endtable
29048
29049 For example, if you set
29050 .code
29051 acl_smtp_rcpt = small_acl
29052 .endd
29053 the little ACL defined above is used whenever Exim receives a RCPT command
29054 in an SMTP dialogue. The majority of policy tests on incoming messages can be
29055 done when RCPT commands arrive. A rejection of RCPT should cause the
29056 sending MTA to give up on the recipient address contained in the RCPT
29057 command, whereas rejection at other times may cause the client MTA to keep on
29058 trying to deliver the message. It is therefore recommended that you do as much
29059 testing as possible at RCPT time.
29060
29061
29062 .section "The non-SMTP ACLs" "SECID190"
29063 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
29064 The non-SMTP ACLs apply to all non-interactive incoming messages, that is, they
29065 apply to batched SMTP as well as to non-SMTP messages. (Batched SMTP is not
29066 really SMTP.) Many of the ACL conditions (for example, host tests, and tests on
29067 the state of the SMTP connection such as encryption and authentication) are not
29068 relevant and are forbidden in these ACLs. However, the sender and recipients
29069 are known, so the &%senders%& and &%sender_domains%& conditions and the
29070 &$sender_address$& and &$recipients$& variables can be used. Variables such as
29071 &$authenticated_sender$& are also available. You can specify added header lines
29072 in any of these ACLs.
29073
29074 The &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACL is run right at the start of receiving a
29075 non-SMTP message, before any of the message has been read. (This is the
29076 analogue of the &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL for SMTP input.) In the case of
29077 batched SMTP input, it runs after the DATA command has been reached. The
29078 result of this ACL is ignored; it cannot be used to reject a message. If you
29079 really need to, you could set a value in an ACL variable here and reject based
29080 on that in the &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL. However, this ACL can be used to set
29081 controls, and in particular, it can be used to set
29082 .code
29083 control = suppress_local_fixups
29084 .endd
29085 This cannot be used in the other non-SMTP ACLs because by the time they are
29086 run, it is too late.
29087
29088 The &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled with the
29089 content-scanning extension. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
29090
29091 The &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL is run just before the &[local_scan()]& function. Any
29092 kind of rejection is treated as permanent, because there is no way of sending a
29093 temporary error for these kinds of message.
29094
29095
29096 .section "The SMTP connect ACL" "SECID191"
29097 .cindex "SMTP" "connection, ACL for"
29098 .oindex &%smtp_banner%&
29099 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_connect%& happens at the start of an SMTP
29100 session, after the test specified by &%host_reject_connection%& (which is now
29101 an anomaly) and any TCP Wrappers testing (if configured). If the connection is
29102 accepted by an &%accept%& verb that has a &%message%& modifier, the contents of
29103 the message override the banner message that is otherwise specified by the
29104 &%smtp_banner%& option.
29105
29106
29107 .section "The EHLO/HELO ACL" "SECID192"
29108 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
29109 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
29110 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_helo%& happens when the client issues an
29111 EHLO or HELO command, after the tests specified by &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%&,
29112 &%helo_allow_chars%&, &%helo_verify_hosts%&, and &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&.
29113 Note that a client may issue more than one EHLO or HELO command in an SMTP
29114 session, and indeed is required to issue a new EHLO or HELO after successfully
29115 setting up encryption following a STARTTLS command.
29116
29117 Note also that a deny neither forces the client to go away nor means that
29118 mail will be refused on the connection. Consider checking for
29119 &$sender_helo_name$& being defined in a MAIL or RCPT ACL to do that.
29120
29121 If the command is accepted by an &%accept%& verb that has a &%message%&
29122 modifier, the message may not contain more than one line (it will be truncated
29123 at the first newline and a panic logged if it does). Such a message cannot
29124 affect the EHLO options that are listed on the second and subsequent lines of
29125 an EHLO response.
29126
29127
29128 .section "The DATA ACLs" "SECID193"
29129 .cindex "DATA" "ACLs for"
29130 Two ACLs are associated with the DATA command, because it is two-stage
29131 command, with two responses being sent to the client.
29132 When the DATA command is received, the ACL defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&
29133 is obeyed. This gives you control after all the RCPT commands, but before
29134 the message itself is received. It offers the opportunity to give a negative
29135 response to the DATA command before the data is transmitted. Header lines
29136 added by MAIL or RCPT ACLs are not visible at this time, but any that
29137 are defined here are visible when the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is run.
29138
29139 You cannot test the contents of the message, for example, to verify addresses
29140 in the headers, at RCPT time or when the DATA command is received. Such
29141 tests have to appear in the ACL that is run after the message itself has been
29142 received, before the final response to the DATA command is sent. This is
29143 the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%&, which is the second ACL that is
29144 associated with the DATA command.
29145
29146 .cindex CHUNKING "BDAT command"
29147 .cindex BDAT "SMTP command"
29148 .cindex "RFC 3030" CHUNKING
29149 If CHUNKING was advertised and a BDAT command sequence is received,
29150 the &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL is not run.
29151 . XXX why not? It should be possible, for the first BDAT.
29152 The &%acl_smtp_data%& is run after the last BDAT command and all of
29153 the data specified is received.
29154
29155 For both of these ACLs, it is not possible to reject individual recipients. An
29156 error response rejects the entire message. Unfortunately, it is known that some
29157 MTAs do not treat hard (5&'xx'&) responses to the DATA command (either
29158 before or after the data) correctly &-- they keep the message on their queues
29159 and try again later, but that is their problem, though it does waste some of
29160 your resources.
29161
29162 The &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is run after
29163 the &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%&,
29164 the &%acl_smtp_dkim%&
29165 and the &%acl_smtp_mime%& ACLs.
29166
29167 .section "The SMTP DKIM ACL" "SECTDKIMACL"
29168 The &%acl_smtp_dkim%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled with DKIM support
29169 enabled (which is the default).
29170
29171 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_dkim%& happens after a message has been
29172 received, and is executed for each DKIM signature found in a message. If not
29173 otherwise specified, the default action is to accept.
29174
29175 This ACL is evaluated before &%acl_smtp_mime%& and &%acl_smtp_data%&.
29176
29177 For details on the operation of DKIM, see section &<<SECDKIM>>&.
29178
29179
29180 .section "The SMTP MIME ACL" "SECID194"
29181 The &%acl_smtp_mime%& option is available only when Exim is compiled with the
29182 content-scanning extension. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
29183
29184 This ACL is evaluated after &%acl_smtp_dkim%& but before &%acl_smtp_data%&.
29185
29186
29187 .section "The SMTP PRDR ACL" "SECTPRDRACL"
29188 .cindex "PRDR" "ACL for"
29189 .oindex "&%prdr_enable%&"
29190 The &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled
29191 with PRDR support enabled (which is the default).
29192 It becomes active only when the PRDR feature is negotiated between
29193 client and server for a message, and more than one recipient
29194 has been accepted.
29195
29196 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& happens after a message
29197 has been received, and is executed once for each recipient of the message
29198 with &$local_part$& and &$domain$& valid.
29199 The test may accept, defer or deny for individual recipients.
29200 The &%acl_smtp_data%& will still be called after this ACL and
29201 can reject the message overall, even if this ACL has accepted it
29202 for some or all recipients.
29203
29204 PRDR may be used to support per-user content filtering. Without it
29205 one must defer any recipient after the first that has a different
29206 content-filter configuration. With PRDR, the RCPT-time check
29207 .cindex "PRDR" "variable for"
29208 for this can be disabled when the variable &$prdr_requested$&
29209 is &"yes"&.
29210 Any required difference in behaviour of the main DATA-time
29211 ACL should however depend on the PRDR-time ACL having run, as Exim
29212 will avoid doing so in some situations (e.g. single-recipient mails).
29213
29214 See also the &%prdr_enable%& global option
29215 and the &%hosts_try_prdr%& smtp transport option.
29216
29217 This ACL is evaluated after &%acl_smtp_dkim%& but before &%acl_smtp_data%&.
29218 If the ACL is not defined, processing completes as if
29219 the feature was not requested by the client.
29220
29221 .section "The QUIT ACL" "SECTQUITACL"
29222 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
29223 The ACL for the SMTP QUIT command is anomalous, in that the outcome of the ACL
29224 does not affect the response code to QUIT, which is always 221. Thus, the ACL
29225 does not in fact control any access.
29226 For this reason, it may only accept
29227 or warn as its final result.
29228
29229 This ACL can be used for tasks such as custom logging at the end of an SMTP
29230 session. For example, you can use ACL variables in other ACLs to count
29231 messages, recipients, etc., and log the totals at QUIT time using one or
29232 more &%logwrite%& modifiers on a &%warn%& verb.
29233
29234 &*Warning*&: Only the &$acl_c$&&'x'& variables can be used for this, because
29235 the &$acl_m$&&'x'& variables are reset at the end of each incoming message.
29236
29237 You do not need to have a final &%accept%&, but if you do, you can use a
29238 &%message%& modifier to specify custom text that is sent as part of the 221
29239 response to QUIT.
29240
29241 This ACL is run only for a &"normal"& QUIT. For certain kinds of disastrous
29242 failure (for example, failure to open a log file, or when Exim is bombing out
29243 because it has detected an unrecoverable error), all SMTP commands from the
29244 client are given temporary error responses until QUIT is received or the
29245 connection is closed. In these special cases, the QUIT ACL does not run.
29246
29247
29248 .section "The not-QUIT ACL" "SECTNOTQUITACL"
29249 .vindex &$acl_smtp_notquit$&
29250 The not-QUIT ACL, specified by &%acl_smtp_notquit%&, is run in most cases when
29251 an SMTP session ends without sending QUIT. However, when Exim itself is in bad
29252 trouble, such as being unable to write to its log files, this ACL is not run,
29253 because it might try to do things (such as write to log files) that make the
29254 situation even worse.
29255
29256 Like the QUIT ACL, this ACL is provided to make it possible to do customized
29257 logging or to gather statistics, and its outcome is ignored. The &%delay%&
29258 modifier is forbidden in this ACL, and the only permitted verbs are &%accept%&
29259 and &%warn%&.
29260
29261 .vindex &$smtp_notquit_reason$&
29262 When the not-QUIT ACL is running, the variable &$smtp_notquit_reason$& is set
29263 to a string that indicates the reason for the termination of the SMTP
29264 connection. The possible values are:
29265 .table2
29266 .irow &`acl-drop`& "Another ACL issued a &%drop%& command"
29267 .irow &`bad-commands`& "Too many unknown or non-mail commands"
29268 .irow &`command-timeout`& "Timeout while reading SMTP commands"
29269 .irow &`connection-lost`& "The SMTP connection has been lost"
29270 .irow &`data-timeout`& "Timeout while reading message data"
29271 .irow &`local-scan-error`& "The &[local_scan()]& function crashed"
29272 .irow &`local-scan-timeout`& "The &[local_scan()]& function timed out"
29273 .irow &`signal-exit`& "SIGTERM or SIGINT"
29274 .irow &`synchronization-error`& "SMTP synchronization error"
29275 .irow &`tls-failed`& "TLS failed to start"
29276 .endtable
29277 In most cases when an SMTP connection is closed without having received QUIT,
29278 Exim sends an SMTP response message before actually closing the connection.
29279 With the exception of the &`acl-drop`& case, the default message can be
29280 overridden by the &%message%& modifier in the not-QUIT ACL. In the case of a
29281 &%drop%& verb in another ACL, it is the message from the other ACL that is
29282 used.
29283
29284
29285 .section "Finding an ACL to use" "SECID195"
29286 .cindex "&ACL;" "finding which to use"
29287 The value of an &%acl_smtp_%&&'xxx'& option is expanded before use, so
29288 you can use different ACLs in different circumstances. For example,
29289 .code
29290 acl_smtp_rcpt = ${if ={25}{$interface_port} \
29291 {acl_check_rcpt} {acl_check_rcpt_submit} }
29292 .endd
29293 In the default configuration file there are some example settings for
29294 providing an RFC 4409 message &"submission"& service on port 587 and
29295 an RFC 8314 &"submissions"& service on port 465. You can use a string
29296 expansion like this to choose an ACL for MUAs on these ports which is
29297 more appropriate for this purpose than the default ACL on port 25.
29298
29299 The expanded string does not have to be the name of an ACL in the
29300 configuration file; there are other possibilities. Having expanded the
29301 string, Exim searches for an ACL as follows:
29302
29303 .ilist
29304 If the string begins with a slash, Exim uses it as a filename, and reads its
29305 contents as an ACL. The lines are processed in the same way as lines in the
29306 Exim configuration file. In particular, continuation lines are supported, blank
29307 lines are ignored, as are lines whose first non-whitespace character is &"#"&.
29308 If the file does not exist or cannot be read, an error occurs (typically
29309 causing a temporary failure of whatever caused the ACL to be run). For example:
29310 .code
29311 acl_smtp_data = /etc/acls/\
29312 ${lookup{$sender_host_address}lsearch\
29313 {/etc/acllist}{$value}{default}}
29314 .endd
29315 This looks up an ACL file to use on the basis of the host's IP address, falling
29316 back to a default if the lookup fails. If an ACL is successfully read from a
29317 file, it is retained in memory for the duration of the Exim process, so that it
29318 can be re-used without having to re-read the file.
29319 .next
29320 If the string does not start with a slash, and does not contain any spaces,
29321 Exim searches the ACL section of the configuration for an ACL whose name
29322 matches the string.
29323 .next
29324 If no named ACL is found, or if the string contains spaces, Exim parses
29325 the string as an inline ACL. This can save typing in cases where you just
29326 want to have something like
29327 .code
29328 acl_smtp_vrfy = accept
29329 .endd
29330 in order to allow free use of the VRFY command. Such a string may contain
29331 newlines; it is processed in the same way as an ACL that is read from a file.
29332 .endlist
29333
29334
29335
29336
29337 .section "ACL return codes" "SECID196"
29338 .cindex "&ACL;" "return codes"
29339 Except for the QUIT ACL, which does not affect the SMTP return code (see
29340 section &<<SECTQUITACL>>& above), the result of running an ACL is either
29341 &"accept"& or &"deny"&, or, if some test cannot be completed (for example, if a
29342 database is down), &"defer"&. These results cause 2&'xx'&, 5&'xx'&, and 4&'xx'&
29343 return codes, respectively, to be used in the SMTP dialogue. A fourth return,
29344 &"error"&, occurs when there is an error such as invalid syntax in the ACL.
29345 This also causes a 4&'xx'& return code.
29346
29347 For the non-SMTP ACL, &"defer"& and &"error"& are treated in the same way as
29348 &"deny"&, because there is no mechanism for passing temporary errors to the
29349 submitters of non-SMTP messages.
29350
29351
29352 ACLs that are relevant to message reception may also return &"discard"&. This
29353 has the effect of &"accept"&, but causes either the entire message or an
29354 individual recipient address to be discarded. In other words, it is a
29355 blackholing facility. Use it with care.
29356
29357 If the ACL for MAIL returns &"discard"&, all recipients are discarded, and no
29358 ACL is run for subsequent RCPT commands. The effect of &"discard"& in a
29359 RCPT ACL is to discard just the one recipient address. If there are no
29360 recipients left when the message's data is received, the DATA ACL is not
29361 run. A &"discard"& return from the DATA or the non-SMTP ACL discards all the
29362 remaining recipients. The &"discard"& return is not permitted for the
29363 &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL.
29364
29365 If the ACL for VRFY returns &"accept"&, a recipient verify (without callout)
29366 is done on the address and the result determines the SMTP response.
29367
29368
29369 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "when all recipients discarded"
29370 The &[local_scan()]& function is always run, even if there are no remaining
29371 recipients; it may create new recipients.
29372
29373
29374
29375 .section "Unset ACL options" "SECID197"
29376 .cindex "&ACL;" "unset options"
29377 The default actions when any of the &%acl_%&&'xxx'& options are unset are not
29378 all the same. &*Note*&: These defaults apply only when the relevant ACL is
29379 not defined at all. For any defined ACL, the default action when control
29380 reaches the end of the ACL statements is &"deny"&.
29381
29382 For &%acl_smtp_quit%& and &%acl_not_smtp_start%& there is no default because
29383 these two are ACLs that are used only for their side effects. They cannot be
29384 used to accept or reject anything.
29385
29386 For &%acl_not_smtp%&, &%acl_smtp_auth%&, &%acl_smtp_connect%&,
29387 &%acl_smtp_data%&, &%acl_smtp_helo%&, &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_mailauth%&,
29388 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&, and &%acl_smtp_starttls%&, the action
29389 when the ACL is not defined is &"accept"&.
29390
29391 For the others (&%acl_smtp_etrn%&, &%acl_smtp_expn%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, and
29392 &%acl_smtp_vrfy%&), the action when the ACL is not defined is &"deny"&.
29393 This means that &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& must be defined in order to receive any
29394 messages over an SMTP connection. For an example, see the ACL in the default
29395 configuration file.
29396
29397
29398
29399
29400 .section "Data for message ACLs" "SECID198"
29401 .cindex "&ACL;" "data for message ACL"
29402 .vindex &$domain$&
29403 .vindex &$local_part$&
29404 .vindex &$sender_address$&
29405 .vindex &$sender_host_address$&
29406 .vindex &$smtp_command$&
29407 When a MAIL or RCPT ACL, or either of the DATA ACLs, is running, the variables
29408 that contain information about the host and the message's sender (for example,
29409 &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_address$&) are set, and can be used in ACL
29410 statements. In the case of RCPT (but not MAIL or DATA), &$domain$& and
29411 &$local_part$& are set from the argument address. The entire SMTP command
29412 is available in &$smtp_command$&.
29413
29414 When an ACL for the AUTH parameter of MAIL is running, the variables that
29415 contain information about the host are set, but &$sender_address$& is not yet
29416 set. Section &<<SECTauthparamail>>& contains a discussion of this parameter and
29417 how it is used.
29418
29419 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
29420 The &$message_size$& variable is set to the value of the SIZE parameter on
29421 the MAIL command at MAIL, RCPT and pre-data time, or to -1 if
29422 that parameter is not given. The value is updated to the true message size by
29423 the time the final DATA ACL is run (after the message data has been
29424 received).
29425
29426 .vindex "&$rcpt_count$&"
29427 .vindex "&$recipients_count$&"
29428 The &$rcpt_count$& variable increases by one for each RCPT command received.
29429 The &$recipients_count$& variable increases by one each time a RCPT command is
29430 accepted, so while an ACL for RCPT is being processed, it contains the number
29431 of previously accepted recipients. At DATA time (for both the DATA ACLs),
29432 &$rcpt_count$& contains the total number of RCPT commands, and
29433 &$recipients_count$& contains the total number of accepted recipients.
29434
29435
29436
29437
29438
29439 .section "Data for non-message ACLs" "SECTdatfornon"
29440 .cindex "&ACL;" "data for non-message ACL"
29441 .vindex &$smtp_command_argument$&
29442 .vindex &$smtp_command$&
29443 When an ACL is being run for AUTH, EHLO, ETRN, EXPN, HELO, STARTTLS, or VRFY,
29444 the remainder of the SMTP command line is placed in &$smtp_command_argument$&,
29445 and the entire SMTP command is available in &$smtp_command$&.
29446 These variables can be tested using a &%condition%& condition. For example,
29447 here is an ACL for use with AUTH, which insists that either the session is
29448 encrypted, or the CRAM-MD5 authentication method is used. In other words, it
29449 does not permit authentication methods that use cleartext passwords on
29450 unencrypted connections.
29451 .code
29452 acl_check_auth:
29453 accept encrypted = *
29454 accept condition = ${if eq{${uc:$smtp_command_argument}}\
29455 {CRAM-MD5}}
29456 deny message = TLS encryption or CRAM-MD5 required
29457 .endd
29458 (Another way of applying this restriction is to arrange for the authenticators
29459 that use cleartext passwords not to be advertised when the connection is not
29460 encrypted. You can use the generic &%server_advertise_condition%& authenticator
29461 option to do this.)
29462
29463
29464
29465 .section "Format of an ACL" "SECID199"
29466 .cindex "&ACL;" "format of"
29467 .cindex "&ACL;" "verbs, definition of"
29468 An individual ACL consists of a number of statements. Each statement starts
29469 with a verb, optionally followed by a number of conditions and &"modifiers"&.
29470 Modifiers can change the way the verb operates, define error and log messages,
29471 set variables, insert delays, and vary the processing of accepted messages.
29472
29473 If all the conditions are met, the verb is obeyed. The same condition may be
29474 used (with different arguments) more than once in the same statement. This
29475 provides a means of specifying an &"and"& conjunction between conditions. For
29476 example:
29477 .code
29478 deny dnslists = list1.example
29479 dnslists = list2.example
29480 .endd
29481 If there are no conditions, the verb is always obeyed. Exim stops evaluating
29482 the conditions and modifiers when it reaches a condition that fails. What
29483 happens then depends on the verb (and in one case, on a special modifier). Not
29484 all the conditions make sense at every testing point. For example, you cannot
29485 test a sender address in the ACL that is run for a VRFY command.
29486
29487
29488 .section "ACL verbs" "SECID200"
29489 The ACL verbs are as follows:
29490
29491 .ilist
29492 .cindex "&%accept%& ACL verb"
29493 &%accept%&: If all the conditions are met, the ACL returns &"accept"&. If any
29494 of the conditions are not met, what happens depends on whether &%endpass%&
29495 appears among the conditions (for syntax see below). If the failing condition
29496 is before &%endpass%&, control is passed to the next ACL statement; if it is
29497 after &%endpass%&, the ACL returns &"deny"&. Consider this statement, used to
29498 check a RCPT command:
29499 .code
29500 accept domains = +local_domains
29501 endpass
29502 verify = recipient
29503 .endd
29504 If the recipient domain does not match the &%domains%& condition, control
29505 passes to the next statement. If it does match, the recipient is verified, and
29506 the command is accepted if verification succeeds. However, if verification
29507 fails, the ACL yields &"deny"&, because the failing condition is after
29508 &%endpass%&.
29509
29510 The &%endpass%& feature has turned out to be confusing to many people, so its
29511 use is not recommended nowadays. It is always possible to rewrite an ACL so
29512 that &%endpass%& is not needed, and it is no longer used in the default
29513 configuration.
29514
29515 .cindex "&%message%& ACL modifier" "with &%accept%&"
29516 If a &%message%& modifier appears on an &%accept%& statement, its action
29517 depends on whether or not &%endpass%& is present. In the absence of &%endpass%&
29518 (when an &%accept%& verb either accepts or passes control to the next
29519 statement), &%message%& can be used to vary the message that is sent when an
29520 SMTP command is accepted. For example, in a RCPT ACL you could have:
29521 .display
29522 &`accept `&<&'some conditions'&>
29523 &` message = OK, I will allow you through today`&
29524 .endd
29525 You can specify an SMTP response code, optionally followed by an &"extended
29526 response code"& at the start of the message, but the first digit must be the
29527 same as would be sent by default, which is 2 for an &%accept%& verb.
29528
29529 If &%endpass%& is present in an &%accept%& statement, &%message%& specifies
29530 an error message that is used when access is denied. This behaviour is retained
29531 for backward compatibility, but current &"best practice"& is to avoid the use
29532 of &%endpass%&.
29533
29534
29535 .next
29536 .cindex "&%defer%& ACL verb"
29537 &%defer%&: If all the conditions are true, the ACL returns &"defer"& which, in
29538 an SMTP session, causes a 4&'xx'& response to be given. For a non-SMTP ACL,
29539 &%defer%& is the same as &%deny%&, because there is no way of sending a
29540 temporary error. For a RCPT command, &%defer%& is much the same as using a
29541 &(redirect)& router and &`:defer:`& while verifying, but the &%defer%& verb can
29542 be used in any ACL, and even for a recipient it might be a simpler approach.
29543
29544
29545 .next
29546 .cindex "&%deny%& ACL verb"
29547 &%deny%&: If all the conditions are met, the ACL returns &"deny"&. If any of
29548 the conditions are not met, control is passed to the next ACL statement. For
29549 example,
29550 .code
29551 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
29552 .endd
29553 rejects commands from hosts that are on a DNS black list.
29554
29555
29556 .next
29557 .cindex "&%discard%& ACL verb"
29558 &%discard%&: This verb behaves like &%accept%&, except that it returns
29559 &"discard"& from the ACL instead of &"accept"&. It is permitted only on ACLs
29560 that are concerned with receiving messages. When all the conditions are true,
29561 the sending entity receives a &"success"& response. However, &%discard%& causes
29562 recipients to be discarded. If it is used in an ACL for RCPT, just the one
29563 recipient is discarded; if used for MAIL, DATA or in the non-SMTP ACL, all the
29564 message's recipients are discarded. Recipients that are discarded before DATA
29565 do not appear in the log line when the &%received_recipients%& log selector is set.
29566
29567 If the &%log_message%& modifier is set when &%discard%& operates,
29568 its contents are added to the line that is automatically written to the log.
29569 The &%message%& modifier operates exactly as it does for &%accept%&.
29570
29571
29572 .next
29573 .cindex "&%drop%& ACL verb"
29574 &%drop%&: This verb behaves like &%deny%&, except that an SMTP connection is
29575 forcibly closed after the 5&'xx'& error message has been sent. For example:
29576 .code
29577 drop message = I don't take more than 20 RCPTs
29578 condition = ${if > {$rcpt_count}{20}}
29579 .endd
29580 There is no difference between &%deny%& and &%drop%& for the connect-time ACL.
29581 The connection is always dropped after sending a 550 response.
29582
29583 .next
29584 .cindex "&%require%& ACL verb"
29585 &%require%&: If all the conditions are met, control is passed to the next ACL
29586 statement. If any of the conditions are not met, the ACL returns &"deny"&. For
29587 example, when checking a RCPT command,
29588 .code
29589 require message = Sender did not verify
29590 verify = sender
29591 .endd
29592 passes control to subsequent statements only if the message's sender can be
29593 verified. Otherwise, it rejects the command. Note the positioning of the
29594 &%message%& modifier, before the &%verify%& condition. The reason for this is
29595 discussed in section &<<SECTcondmodproc>>&.
29596
29597 .next
29598 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb"
29599 &%warn%&: If all the conditions are true, a line specified by the
29600 &%log_message%& modifier is written to Exim's main log. Control always passes
29601 to the next ACL statement. If any condition is false, the log line is not
29602 written. If an identical log line is requested several times in the same
29603 message, only one copy is actually written to the log. If you want to force
29604 duplicates to be written, use the &%logwrite%& modifier instead.
29605
29606 If &%log_message%& is not present, a &%warn%& verb just checks its conditions
29607 and obeys any &"immediate"& modifiers (such as &%control%&, &%set%&,
29608 &%logwrite%&, &%add_header%&, and &%remove_header%&) that appear before the
29609 first failing condition. There is more about adding header lines in section
29610 &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&.
29611
29612 If any condition on a &%warn%& statement cannot be completed (that is, there is
29613 some sort of defer), the log line specified by &%log_message%& is not written.
29614 This does not include the case of a forced failure from a lookup, which
29615 is considered to be a successful completion. After a defer, no further
29616 conditions or modifiers in the &%warn%& statement are processed. The incident
29617 is logged, and the ACL continues to be processed, from the next statement
29618 onwards.
29619
29620
29621 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
29622 When one of the &%warn%& conditions is an address verification that fails, the
29623 text of the verification failure message is in &$acl_verify_message$&. If you
29624 want this logged, you must set it up explicitly. For example:
29625 .code
29626 warn !verify = sender
29627 log_message = sender verify failed: $acl_verify_message
29628 .endd
29629 .endlist
29630
29631 At the end of each ACL there is an implicit unconditional &%deny%&.
29632
29633 As you can see from the examples above, the conditions and modifiers are
29634 written one to a line, with the first one on the same line as the verb, and
29635 subsequent ones on following lines. If you have a very long condition, you can
29636 continue it onto several physical lines by the usual backslash continuation
29637 mechanism. It is conventional to align the conditions vertically.
29638
29639
29640
29641 .section "ACL variables" "SECTaclvariables"
29642 .cindex "&ACL;" "variables"
29643 There are some special variables that can be set during ACL processing. They
29644 can be used to pass information between different ACLs, different invocations
29645 of the same ACL in the same SMTP connection, and between ACLs and the routers,
29646 transports, and filters that are used to deliver a message. The names of these
29647 variables must begin with &$acl_c$& or &$acl_m$&, followed either by a digit or
29648 an underscore, but the remainder of the name can be any sequence of
29649 alphanumeric characters and underscores that you choose. There is no limit on
29650 the number of ACL variables. The two sets act as follows:
29651 .ilist
29652 The values of those variables whose names begin with &$acl_c$& persist
29653 throughout an SMTP connection. They are never reset. Thus, a value that is set
29654 while receiving one message is still available when receiving the next message
29655 on the same SMTP connection.
29656 .next
29657 The values of those variables whose names begin with &$acl_m$& persist only
29658 while a message is being received. They are reset afterwards. They are also
29659 reset by MAIL, RSET, EHLO, HELO, and after starting up a TLS session.
29660 .endlist
29661
29662 When a message is accepted, the current values of all the ACL variables are
29663 preserved with the message and are subsequently made available at delivery
29664 time. The ACL variables are set by a modifier called &%set%&. For example:
29665 .code
29666 accept hosts = whatever
29667 set acl_m4 = some value
29668 accept authenticated = *
29669 set acl_c_auth = yes
29670 .endd
29671 &*Note*&: A leading dollar sign is not used when naming a variable that is to
29672 be set. If you want to set a variable without taking any action, you can use a
29673 &%warn%& verb without any other modifiers or conditions.
29674
29675 .oindex &%strict_acl_vars%&
29676 What happens if a syntactically valid but undefined ACL variable is
29677 referenced depends on the setting of the &%strict_acl_vars%& option. If it is
29678 false (the default), an empty string is substituted; if it is true, an
29679 error is generated.
29680
29681 Versions of Exim before 4.64 have a limited set of numbered variables, but
29682 their names are compatible, so there is no problem with upgrading.
29683
29684
29685 .section "Condition and modifier processing" "SECTcondmodproc"
29686 .cindex "&ACL;" "conditions; processing"
29687 .cindex "&ACL;" "modifiers; processing"
29688 An exclamation mark preceding a condition negates its result. For example:
29689 .code
29690 deny domains = *.dom.example
29691 !verify = recipient
29692 .endd
29693 causes the ACL to return &"deny"& if the recipient domain ends in
29694 &'dom.example'& and the recipient address cannot be verified. Sometimes
29695 negation can be used on the right-hand side of a condition. For example, these
29696 two statements are equivalent:
29697 .code
29698 deny hosts = !192.168.3.4
29699 deny !hosts = 192.168.3.4
29700 .endd
29701 However, for many conditions (&%verify%& being a good example), only left-hand
29702 side negation of the whole condition is possible.
29703
29704 The arguments of conditions and modifiers are expanded. A forced failure
29705 of an expansion causes a condition to be ignored, that is, it behaves as if the
29706 condition is true. Consider these two statements:
29707 .code
29708 accept senders = ${lookup{$host_name}lsearch\
29709 {/some/file}{$value}fail}
29710 accept senders = ${lookup{$host_name}lsearch\
29711 {/some/file}{$value}{}}
29712 .endd
29713 Each attempts to look up a list of acceptable senders. If the lookup succeeds,
29714 the returned list is searched, but if the lookup fails the behaviour is
29715 different in the two cases. The &%fail%& in the first statement causes the
29716 condition to be ignored, leaving no further conditions. The &%accept%& verb
29717 therefore succeeds. The second statement, however, generates an empty list when
29718 the lookup fails. No sender can match an empty list, so the condition fails,
29719 and therefore the &%accept%& also fails.
29720
29721 ACL modifiers appear mixed in with conditions in ACL statements. Some of them
29722 specify actions that are taken as the conditions for a statement are checked;
29723 others specify text for messages that are used when access is denied or a
29724 warning is generated. The &%control%& modifier affects the way an incoming
29725 message is handled.
29726
29727 The positioning of the modifiers in an ACL statement is important, because the
29728 processing of a verb ceases as soon as its outcome is known. Only those
29729 modifiers that have already been encountered will take effect. For example,
29730 consider this use of the &%message%& modifier:
29731 .code
29732 require message = Can't verify sender
29733 verify = sender
29734 message = Can't verify recipient
29735 verify = recipient
29736 message = This message cannot be used
29737 .endd
29738 If sender verification fails, Exim knows that the result of the statement is
29739 &"deny"&, so it goes no further. The first &%message%& modifier has been seen,
29740 so its text is used as the error message. If sender verification succeeds, but
29741 recipient verification fails, the second message is used. If recipient
29742 verification succeeds, the third message becomes &"current"&, but is never used
29743 because there are no more conditions to cause failure.
29744
29745 For the &%deny%& verb, on the other hand, it is always the last &%message%&
29746 modifier that is used, because all the conditions must be true for rejection to
29747 happen. Specifying more than one &%message%& modifier does not make sense, and
29748 the message can even be specified after all the conditions. For example:
29749 .code
29750 deny hosts = ...
29751 !senders = *@my.domain.example
29752 message = Invalid sender from client host
29753 .endd
29754 The &"deny"& result does not happen until the end of the statement is reached,
29755 by which time Exim has set up the message.
29756
29757
29758
29759 .section "ACL modifiers" "SECTACLmodi"
29760 .cindex "&ACL;" "modifiers; list of"
29761 The ACL modifiers are as follows:
29762
29763 .vlist
29764 .vitem &*add_header*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
29765 This modifier specifies one or more header lines that are to be added to an
29766 incoming message, assuming, of course, that the message is ultimately
29767 accepted. For details, see section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&.
29768
29769 .vitem &*continue*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
29770 .cindex "&%continue%& ACL modifier"
29771 .cindex "database" "updating in ACL"
29772 This modifier does nothing of itself, and processing of the ACL always
29773 continues with the next condition or modifier. The value of &%continue%& is in
29774 the side effects of expanding its argument. Typically this could be used to
29775 update a database. It is really just a syntactic tidiness, to avoid having to
29776 write rather ugly lines like this:
29777 .display
29778 &`condition = ${if eq{0}{`&<&'some expansion'&>&`}{true}{true}}`&
29779 .endd
29780 Instead, all you need is
29781 .display
29782 &`continue = `&<&'some expansion'&>
29783 .endd
29784
29785 .vitem &*control*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
29786 .cindex "&%control%& ACL modifier"
29787 This modifier affects the subsequent processing of the SMTP connection or of an
29788 incoming message that is accepted. The effect of the first type of control
29789 lasts for the duration of the connection, whereas the effect of the second type
29790 lasts only until the current message has been received. The message-specific
29791 controls always apply to the whole message, not to individual recipients,
29792 even if the &%control%& modifier appears in a RCPT ACL.
29793
29794 As there are now quite a few controls that can be applied, they are described
29795 separately in section &<<SECTcontrols>>&. The &%control%& modifier can be used
29796 in several different ways. For example:
29797
29798 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
29799 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left. That comment applies only
29800 . ==== when xmlto and fop are used; formatting with sdop gets it right either
29801 . ==== way.
29802
29803 .ilist
29804 It can be at the end of an &%accept%& statement:
29805 .code
29806 accept ...some conditions
29807 control = queue_only
29808 .endd
29809 In this case, the control is applied when this statement yields &"accept"&, in
29810 other words, when the conditions are all true.
29811
29812 .next
29813 It can be in the middle of an &%accept%& statement:
29814 .code
29815 accept ...some conditions...
29816 control = queue_only
29817 ...some more conditions...
29818 .endd
29819 If the first set of conditions are true, the control is applied, even if the
29820 statement does not accept because one of the second set of conditions is false.
29821 In this case, some subsequent statement must yield &"accept"& for the control
29822 to be relevant.
29823
29824 .next
29825 It can be used with &%warn%& to apply the control, leaving the
29826 decision about accepting or denying to a subsequent verb. For
29827 example:
29828 .code
29829 warn ...some conditions...
29830 control = freeze
29831 accept ...
29832 .endd
29833 This example of &%warn%& does not contain &%message%&, &%log_message%&, or
29834 &%logwrite%&, so it does not add anything to the message and does not write a
29835 log entry.
29836
29837 .next
29838 If you want to apply a control unconditionally, you can use it with a
29839 &%require%& verb. For example:
29840 .code
29841 require control = no_multiline_responses
29842 .endd
29843 .endlist
29844
29845 .vitem &*delay*&&~=&~<&'time'&>
29846 .cindex "&%delay%& ACL modifier"
29847 .oindex "&%-bh%&"
29848 This modifier may appear in any ACL except notquit. It causes Exim to wait for
29849 the time interval before proceeding. However, when testing Exim using the
29850 &%-bh%& option, the delay is not actually imposed (an appropriate message is
29851 output instead). The time is given in the usual Exim notation, and the delay
29852 happens as soon as the modifier is processed. In an SMTP session, pending
29853 output is flushed before the delay is imposed.
29854
29855 Like &%control%&, &%delay%& can be used with &%accept%& or &%deny%&, for
29856 example:
29857 .code
29858 deny ...some conditions...
29859 delay = 30s
29860 .endd
29861 The delay happens if all the conditions are true, before the statement returns
29862 &"deny"&. Compare this with:
29863 .code
29864 deny delay = 30s
29865 ...some conditions...
29866 .endd
29867 which waits for 30s before processing the conditions. The &%delay%& modifier
29868 can also be used with &%warn%& and together with &%control%&:
29869 .code
29870 warn ...some conditions...
29871 delay = 2m
29872 control = freeze
29873 accept ...
29874 .endd
29875
29876 If &%delay%& is encountered when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in use,
29877 responses to several commands are no longer buffered and sent in one packet (as
29878 they would normally be) because all output is flushed before imposing the
29879 delay. This optimization is disabled so that a number of small delays do not
29880 appear to the client as one large aggregated delay that might provoke an
29881 unwanted timeout. You can, however, disable output flushing for &%delay%& by
29882 using a &%control%& modifier to set &%no_delay_flush%&.
29883
29884
29885 .vitem &*endpass*&
29886 .cindex "&%endpass%& ACL modifier"
29887 This modifier, which has no argument, is recognized only in &%accept%& and
29888 &%discard%& statements. It marks the boundary between the conditions whose
29889 failure causes control to pass to the next statement, and the conditions whose
29890 failure causes the ACL to return &"deny"&. This concept has proved to be
29891 confusing to some people, so the use of &%endpass%& is no longer recommended as
29892 &"best practice"&. See the description of &%accept%& above for more details.
29893
29894
29895 .vitem &*log_message*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
29896 .cindex "&%log_message%& ACL modifier"
29897 This modifier sets up a message that is used as part of the log message if the
29898 ACL denies access or a &%warn%& statement's conditions are true. For example:
29899 .code
29900 require log_message = wrong cipher suite $tls_in_cipher
29901 encrypted = DES-CBC3-SHA
29902 .endd
29903 &%log_message%& is also used when recipients are discarded by &%discard%&. For
29904 example:
29905 .display
29906 &`discard `&<&'some conditions'&>
29907 &` log_message = Discarded $local_part@$domain because...`&
29908 .endd
29909 When access is denied, &%log_message%& adds to any underlying error message
29910 that may exist because of a condition failure. For example, while verifying a
29911 recipient address, a &':fail:'& redirection might have already set up a
29912 message.
29913
29914 The message may be defined before the conditions to which it applies, because
29915 the string expansion does not happen until Exim decides that access is to be
29916 denied. This means that any variables that are set by the condition are
29917 available for inclusion in the message. For example, the &$dnslist_$&<&'xxx'&>
29918 variables are set after a DNS black list lookup succeeds. If the expansion of
29919 &%log_message%& fails, or if the result is an empty string, the modifier is
29920 ignored.
29921
29922 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
29923 If you want to use a &%warn%& statement to log the result of an address
29924 verification, you can use &$acl_verify_message$& to include the verification
29925 error message.
29926
29927 If &%log_message%& is used with a &%warn%& statement, &"Warning:"& is added to
29928 the start of the logged message. If the same warning log message is requested
29929 more than once while receiving a single email message, only one copy is
29930 actually logged. If you want to log multiple copies, use &%logwrite%& instead
29931 of &%log_message%&. In the absence of &%log_message%& and &%logwrite%&, nothing
29932 is logged for a successful &%warn%& statement.
29933
29934 If &%log_message%& is not present and there is no underlying error message (for
29935 example, from the failure of address verification), but &%message%& is present,
29936 the &%message%& text is used for logging rejections. However, if any text for
29937 logging contains newlines, only the first line is logged. In the absence of
29938 both &%log_message%& and &%message%&, a default built-in message is used for
29939 logging rejections.
29940
29941
29942 .vitem "&*log_reject_target*&&~=&~<&'log name list'&>"
29943 .cindex "&%log_reject_target%& ACL modifier"
29944 .cindex "logging in ACL" "specifying which log"
29945 This modifier makes it possible to specify which logs are used for messages
29946 about ACL rejections. Its argument is a colon-separated list of words that can
29947 be &"main"&, &"reject"&, or &"panic"&. The default is &`main:reject`&. The list
29948 may be empty, in which case a rejection is not logged at all. For example, this
29949 ACL fragment writes no logging information when access is denied:
29950 .display
29951 &`deny `&<&'some conditions'&>
29952 &` log_reject_target =`&
29953 .endd
29954 This modifier can be used in SMTP and non-SMTP ACLs. It applies to both
29955 permanent and temporary rejections. Its effect lasts for the rest of the
29956 current ACL.
29957
29958
29959 .vitem &*logwrite*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
29960 .cindex "&%logwrite%& ACL modifier"
29961 .cindex "logging in ACL" "immediate"
29962 This modifier writes a message to a log file as soon as it is encountered when
29963 processing an ACL. (Compare &%log_message%&, which, except in the case of
29964 &%warn%& and &%discard%&, is used only if the ACL statement denies
29965 access.) The &%logwrite%& modifier can be used to log special incidents in
29966 ACLs. For example:
29967 .display
29968 &`accept `&<&'some special conditions'&>
29969 &` control = freeze`&
29970 &` logwrite = froze message because ...`&
29971 .endd
29972 By default, the message is written to the main log. However, it may begin
29973 with a colon, followed by a comma-separated list of log names, and then
29974 another colon, to specify exactly which logs are to be written. For
29975 example:
29976 .code
29977 logwrite = :main,reject: text for main and reject logs
29978 logwrite = :panic: text for panic log only
29979 .endd
29980
29981
29982 .vitem &*message*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
29983 .cindex "&%message%& ACL modifier"
29984 This modifier sets up a text string that is expanded and used as a response
29985 message when an ACL statement terminates the ACL with an &"accept"&, &"deny"&,
29986 or &"defer"& response. (In the case of the &%accept%& and &%discard%& verbs,
29987 there is some complication if &%endpass%& is involved; see the description of
29988 &%accept%& for details.)
29989
29990 The expansion of the message happens at the time Exim decides that the ACL is
29991 to end, not at the time it processes &%message%&. If the expansion fails, or
29992 generates an empty string, the modifier is ignored. Here is an example where
29993 &%message%& must be specified first, because the ACL ends with a rejection if
29994 the &%hosts%& condition fails:
29995 .code
29996 require message = Host not recognized
29997 hosts = 10.0.0.0/8
29998 .endd
29999 (Once a condition has failed, no further conditions or modifiers are
30000 processed.)
30001
30002 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
30003 .oindex "&%smtp_banner%&
30004 For ACLs that are triggered by SMTP commands, the message is returned as part
30005 of the SMTP response. The use of &%message%& with &%accept%& (or &%discard%&)
30006 is meaningful only for SMTP, as no message is returned when a non-SMTP message
30007 is accepted. In the case of the connect ACL, accepting with a message modifier
30008 overrides the value of &%smtp_banner%&. For the EHLO/HELO ACL, a customized
30009 accept message may not contain more than one line (otherwise it will be
30010 truncated at the first newline and a panic logged), and it cannot affect the
30011 EHLO options.
30012
30013 When SMTP is involved, the message may begin with an overriding response code,
30014 consisting of three digits optionally followed by an &"extended response code"&
30015 of the form &'n.n.n'&, each code being followed by a space. For example:
30016 .code
30017 deny message = 599 1.2.3 Host not welcome
30018 hosts = 192.168.34.0/24
30019 .endd
30020 The first digit of the supplied response code must be the same as would be sent
30021 by default. A panic occurs if it is not. Exim uses a 550 code when it denies
30022 access, but for the predata ACL, note that the default success code is 354, not
30023 2&'xx'&.
30024
30025 Notwithstanding the previous paragraph, for the QUIT ACL, unlike the others,
30026 the message modifier cannot override the 221 response code.
30027
30028 The text in a &%message%& modifier is literal; any quotes are taken as
30029 literals, but because the string is expanded, backslash escapes are processed
30030 anyway. If the message contains newlines, this gives rise to a multi-line SMTP
30031 response.
30032
30033 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
30034 For ACLs that are called by an &%acl =%& ACL condition, the message is
30035 stored in &$acl_verify_message$&, from which the calling ACL may use it.
30036
30037 If &%message%& is used on a statement that verifies an address, the message
30038 specified overrides any message that is generated by the verification process.
30039 However, the original message is available in the variable
30040 &$acl_verify_message$&, so you can incorporate it into your message if you
30041 wish. In particular, if you want the text from &%:fail:%& items in &(redirect)&
30042 routers to be passed back as part of the SMTP response, you should either not
30043 use a &%message%& modifier, or make use of &$acl_verify_message$&.
30044
30045 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, a &%message%& modifier that
30046 is used with a &%warn%& verb behaves in a similar way to the &%add_header%&
30047 modifier, but this usage is now deprecated. However, &%message%& acts only when
30048 all the conditions are true, wherever it appears in an ACL command, whereas
30049 &%add_header%& acts as soon as it is encountered. If &%message%& is used with
30050 &%warn%& in an ACL that is not concerned with receiving a message, it has no
30051 effect.
30052
30053
30054 .vitem &*queue*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
30055 .cindex "&%queue%& ACL modifier"
30056 .cindex "named queues" "selecting in ACL"
30057 This modifier specifies the use of a named queue for spool files
30058 for the message.
30059 It can only be used before the message is received (i.e. not in
30060 the DATA ACL).
30061 This could be used, for example, for known high-volume burst sources
30062 of traffic, or for quarantine of messages.
30063 Separate queue-runner processes will be needed for named queues.
30064 If the text after expansion is empty, the default queue is used.
30065
30066
30067 .vitem &*remove_header*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
30068 This modifier specifies one or more header names in a colon-separated list
30069 that are to be removed from an incoming message, assuming, of course, that
30070 the message is ultimately accepted. For details, see section &<<SECTremoveheadacl>>&.
30071
30072
30073 .vitem &*set*&&~<&'acl_name'&>&~=&~<&'value'&>
30074 .cindex "&%set%& ACL modifier"
30075 This modifier puts a value into one of the ACL variables (see section
30076 &<<SECTaclvariables>>&).
30077
30078
30079 .vitem &*udpsend*&&~=&~<&'parameters'&>
30080 .cindex "UDP communications"
30081 This modifier sends a UDP packet, for purposes such as statistics
30082 collection or behaviour monitoring. The parameters are expanded, and
30083 the result of the expansion must be a colon-separated list consisting
30084 of a destination server, port number, and the packet contents. The
30085 server can be specified as a host name or IPv4 or IPv6 address. The
30086 separator can be changed with the usual angle bracket syntax. For
30087 example, you might want to collect information on which hosts connect
30088 when:
30089 .code
30090 udpsend = <; 2001:dB8::dead:beef ; 1234 ;\
30091 $tod_zulu $sender_host_address
30092 .endd
30093 .endlist
30094
30095
30096
30097
30098 .section "Use of the control modifier" "SECTcontrols"
30099 .cindex "&%control%& ACL modifier"
30100 The &%control%& modifier supports the following settings:
30101
30102 .vlist
30103 .vitem &*control&~=&~allow_auth_unadvertised*&
30104 This modifier allows a client host to use the SMTP AUTH command even when it
30105 has not been advertised in response to EHLO. Furthermore, because there are
30106 apparently some really broken clients that do this, Exim will accept AUTH after
30107 HELO (rather than EHLO) when this control is set. It should be used only if you
30108 really need it, and you should limit its use to those broken clients that do
30109 not work without it. For example:
30110 .code
30111 warn hosts = 192.168.34.25
30112 control = allow_auth_unadvertised
30113 .endd
30114 Normally, when an Exim server receives an AUTH command, it checks the name of
30115 the authentication mechanism that is given in the command to ensure that it
30116 matches an advertised mechanism. When this control is set, the check that a
30117 mechanism has been advertised is bypassed. Any configured mechanism can be used
30118 by the client. This control is permitted only in the connection and HELO ACLs.
30119
30120
30121 .vitem &*control&~=&~caseful_local_part*& &&&
30122 &*control&~=&~caselower_local_part*&
30123 .cindex "&ACL;" "case of local part in"
30124 .cindex "case of local parts"
30125 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
30126 These two controls are permitted only in the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&
30127 (that is, during RCPT processing). By default, the contents of &$local_part$&
30128 are lower cased before ACL processing. If &"caseful_local_part"& is specified,
30129 any uppercase letters in the original local part are restored in &$local_part$&
30130 for the rest of the ACL, or until a control that sets &"caselower_local_part"&
30131 is encountered.
30132
30133 These controls affect only the current recipient. Moreover, they apply only to
30134 local part handling that takes place directly in the ACL (for example, as a key
30135 in lookups). If a test to verify the recipient is obeyed, the case-related
30136 handling of the local part during the verification is controlled by the router
30137 configuration (see the &%caseful_local_part%& generic router option).
30138
30139 This facility could be used, for example, to add a spam score to local parts
30140 containing upper case letters. For example, using &$acl_m4$& to accumulate the
30141 spam score:
30142 .code
30143 warn control = caseful_local_part
30144 set acl_m4 = ${eval:\
30145 $acl_m4 + \
30146 ${if match{$local_part}{[A-Z]}{1}{0}}\
30147 }
30148 control = caselower_local_part
30149 .endd
30150 Notice that we put back the lower cased version afterwards, assuming that
30151 is what is wanted for subsequent tests.
30152
30153
30154 .vitem &*control&~=&~cutthrough_delivery/*&<&'options'&>
30155 .cindex "&ACL;" "cutthrough routing"
30156 .cindex "cutthrough" "requesting"
30157 This option requests delivery be attempted while the item is being received.
30158
30159 The option is usable in the RCPT ACL.
30160 If enabled for a message received via smtp and routed to an smtp transport,
30161 and only one transport, interface, destination host and port combination
30162 is used for all recipients of the message,
30163 then the delivery connection is made while the receiving connection is open
30164 and data is copied from one to the other.
30165
30166 An attempt to set this option for any recipient but the first
30167 for a mail will be quietly ignored.
30168 If a recipient-verify callout
30169 (with use_sender)
30170 connection is subsequently
30171 requested in the same ACL it is held open and used for
30172 any subsequent recipients and the data,
30173 otherwise one is made after the initial RCPT ACL completes.
30174
30175 Note that routers are used in verify mode,
30176 and cannot depend on content of received headers.
30177 Note also that headers cannot be
30178 modified by any of the post-data ACLs (DATA, MIME and DKIM).
30179 Headers may be modified by routers (subject to the above) and transports.
30180 The &'Received-By:'& header is generated as soon as the body reception starts,
30181 rather than the traditional time after the full message is received;
30182 this will affect the timestamp.
30183
30184 All the usual ACLs are called; if one results in the message being
30185 rejected, all effort spent in delivery (including the costs on
30186 the ultimate destination) will be wasted.
30187 Note that in the case of data-time ACLs this includes the entire
30188 message body.
30189
30190 Cutthrough delivery is not supported via transport-filters or when DKIM signing
30191 of outgoing messages is done, because it sends data to the ultimate destination
30192 before the entire message has been received from the source.
30193 It is not supported for messages received with the SMTP PRDR
30194 or CHUNKING
30195 options in use.
30196
30197 Should the ultimate destination system positively accept or reject the mail,
30198 a corresponding indication is given to the source system and nothing is queued.
30199 If the item is successfully delivered in cutthrough mode
30200 the delivery log lines are tagged with ">>" rather than "=>" and appear
30201 before the acceptance "<=" line.
30202
30203 If there is a temporary error the item is queued for later delivery in the
30204 usual fashion.
30205 This behaviour can be adjusted by appending the option &*defer=*&<&'value'&>
30206 to the control; the default value is &"spool"& and the alternate value
30207 &"pass"& copies an SMTP defer response from the target back to the initiator
30208 and does not queue the message.
30209 Note that this is independent of any recipient verify conditions in the ACL.
30210
30211 Delivery in this mode avoids the generation of a bounce mail to a
30212 (possibly faked)
30213 sender when the destination system is doing content-scan based rejection.
30214
30215
30216 .vitem &*control&~=&~debug/*&<&'options'&>
30217 .cindex "&ACL;" "enabling debug logging"
30218 .cindex "debugging" "enabling from an ACL"
30219 This control turns on debug logging, almost as though Exim had been invoked
30220 with &`-d`&, with the output going to a new logfile in the usual logs directory,
30221 by default called &'debuglog'&.
30222 The filename can be adjusted with the &'tag'& option, which
30223 may access any variables already defined. The logging may be adjusted with
30224 the &'opts'& option, which takes the same values as the &`-d`& command-line
30225 option.
30226 Logging started this way may be stopped, and the file removed,
30227 with the &'kill'& option.
30228 Some examples (which depend on variables that don't exist in all
30229 contexts):
30230 .code
30231 control = debug
30232 control = debug/tag=.$sender_host_address
30233 control = debug/opts=+expand+acl
30234 control = debug/tag=.$message_exim_id/opts=+expand
30235 control = debug/kill
30236 .endd
30237
30238
30239 .vitem &*control&~=&~dkim_disable_verify*&
30240 .cindex "disable DKIM verify"
30241 .cindex "DKIM" "disable verify"
30242 This control turns off DKIM verification processing entirely. For details on
30243 the operation and configuration of DKIM, see section &<<SECDKIM>>&.
30244
30245
30246 .vitem &*control&~=&~dscp/*&<&'value'&>
30247 .cindex "&ACL;" "setting DSCP value"
30248 .cindex "DSCP" "inbound"
30249 This option causes the DSCP value associated with the socket for the inbound
30250 connection to be adjusted to a given value, given as one of a number of fixed
30251 strings or to numeric value.
30252 The &%-bI:dscp%& option may be used to ask Exim which names it knows of.
30253 Common values include &`throughput`&, &`mincost`&, and on newer systems
30254 &`ef`&, &`af41`&, etc. Numeric values may be in the range 0 to 0x3F.
30255
30256 The outbound packets from Exim will be marked with this value in the header
30257 (for IPv4, the TOS field; for IPv6, the TCLASS field); there is no guarantee
30258 that these values will have any effect, not be stripped by networking
30259 equipment, or do much of anything without cooperation with your Network
30260 Engineer and those of all network operators between the source and destination.
30261
30262
30263 .vitem &*control&~=&~enforce_sync*& &&&
30264 &*control&~=&~no_enforce_sync*&
30265 .cindex "SMTP" "synchronization checking"
30266 .cindex "synchronization checking in SMTP"
30267 These controls make it possible to be selective about when SMTP synchronization
30268 is enforced. The global option &%smtp_enforce_sync%& specifies the initial
30269 state of the switch (it is true by default). See the description of this option
30270 in chapter &<<CHAPmainconfig>>& for details of SMTP synchronization checking.
30271
30272 The effect of these two controls lasts for the remainder of the SMTP
30273 connection. They can appear in any ACL except the one for the non-SMTP
30274 messages. The most straightforward place to put them is in the ACL defined by
30275 &%acl_smtp_connect%&, which is run at the start of an incoming SMTP connection,
30276 before the first synchronization check. The expected use is to turn off the
30277 synchronization checks for badly-behaved hosts that you nevertheless need to
30278 work with.
30279
30280
30281 .vitem &*control&~=&~fakedefer/*&<&'message'&>
30282 .cindex "fake defer"
30283 .cindex "defer, fake"
30284 This control works in exactly the same way as &%fakereject%& (described below)
30285 except that it causes an SMTP 450 response after the message data instead of a
30286 550 response. You must take care when using &%fakedefer%& because it causes the
30287 messages to be duplicated when the sender retries. Therefore, you should not
30288 use &%fakedefer%& if the message is to be delivered normally.
30289
30290 .vitem &*control&~=&~fakereject/*&<&'message'&>
30291 .cindex "fake rejection"
30292 .cindex "rejection, fake"
30293 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, and DATA ACLs, in other
30294 words, only when an SMTP message is being received. If Exim accepts the
30295 message, instead the final 250 response, a 550 rejection message is sent.
30296 However, Exim proceeds to deliver the message as normal. The control applies
30297 only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in
30298 the same SMTP connection.
30299
30300 The text for the 550 response is taken from the &%control%& modifier. If no
30301 message is supplied, the following is used:
30302 .code
30303 550-Your message has been rejected but is being
30304 550-kept for evaluation.
30305 550-If it was a legitimate message, it may still be
30306 550 delivered to the target recipient(s).
30307 .endd
30308 This facility should be used with extreme caution.
30309
30310 .vitem &*control&~=&~freeze*&
30311 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing in ACL"
30312 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and non-SMTP ACLs, in
30313 other words, only when a message is being received. If the message is accepted,
30314 it is placed on Exim's queue and frozen. The control applies only to the
30315 current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in the same
30316 SMTP connection.
30317
30318 This modifier can optionally be followed by &`/no_tell`&. If the global option
30319 &%freeze_tell%& is set, it is ignored for the current message (that is, nobody
30320 is told about the freezing), provided all the &*control=freeze*& modifiers that
30321 are obeyed for the current message have the &`/no_tell`& option.
30322
30323 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_delay_flush*&
30324 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for delay"
30325 Exim normally flushes SMTP output before implementing a delay in an ACL, to
30326 avoid unexpected timeouts in clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in
30327 use. This control, as long as it is encountered before the &%delay%& modifier,
30328 disables such output flushing.
30329
30330 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_callout_flush*&
30331 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for callout"
30332 Exim normally flushes SMTP output before performing a callout in an ACL, to
30333 avoid unexpected timeouts in clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in
30334 use. This control, as long as it is encountered before the &%verify%& condition
30335 that causes the callout, disables such output flushing.
30336
30337 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_mbox_unspool*&
30338 This control is available when Exim is compiled with the content scanning
30339 extension. Content scanning may require a copy of the current message, or parts
30340 of it, to be written in &"mbox format"& to a spool file, for passing to a virus
30341 or spam scanner. Normally, such copies are deleted when they are no longer
30342 needed. If this control is set, the copies are not deleted. The control applies
30343 only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in
30344 the same SMTP connection. It is provided for debugging purposes and is unlikely
30345 to be useful in production.
30346
30347 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_multiline_responses*&
30348 .cindex "multiline responses, suppressing"
30349 This control is permitted for any ACL except the one for non-SMTP messages.
30350 It seems that there are broken clients in use that cannot handle multiline
30351 SMTP responses, despite the fact that RFC 821 defined them over 20 years ago.
30352
30353 If this control is set, multiline SMTP responses from ACL rejections are
30354 suppressed. One way of doing this would have been to put out these responses as
30355 one long line. However, RFC 2821 specifies a maximum of 512 bytes per response
30356 (&"use multiline responses for more"& it says &-- ha!), and some of the
30357 responses might get close to that. So this facility, which is after all only a
30358 sop to broken clients, is implemented by doing two very easy things:
30359
30360 .ilist
30361 Extra information that is normally output as part of a rejection caused by
30362 sender verification failure is omitted. Only the final line (typically &"sender
30363 verification failed"&) is sent.
30364 .next
30365 If a &%message%& modifier supplies a multiline response, only the first
30366 line is output.
30367 .endlist
30368
30369 The setting of the switch can, of course, be made conditional on the
30370 calling host. Its effect lasts until the end of the SMTP connection.
30371
30372 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_pipelining*&
30373 .cindex "PIPELINING" "suppressing advertising"
30374 This control turns off the advertising of the PIPELINING extension to SMTP in
30375 the current session. To be useful, it must be obeyed before Exim sends its
30376 response to an EHLO command. Therefore, it should normally appear in an ACL
30377 controlled by &%acl_smtp_connect%& or &%acl_smtp_helo%&. See also
30378 &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&.
30379
30380 .vitem &*control&~=&~queue_only*&
30381 .oindex "&%queue_only%&"
30382 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
30383 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and non-SMTP ACLs, in
30384 other words, only when a message is being received. If the message is accepted,
30385 it is placed on Exim's queue and left there for delivery by a subsequent queue
30386 runner. No immediate delivery process is started. In other words, it has the
30387 effect as the &%queue_only%& global option. However, the control applies only
30388 to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in the
30389 same SMTP connection.
30390
30391 .vitem &*control&~=&~submission/*&<&'options'&>
30392 .cindex "message" "submission"
30393 .cindex "submission mode"
30394 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, and start of data ACLs (the
30395 latter is the one defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&). Setting it tells Exim that
30396 the current message is a submission from a local MUA. In this case, Exim
30397 operates in &"submission mode"&, and applies certain fixups to the message if
30398 necessary. For example, it adds a &'Date:'& header line if one is not present.
30399 This control is not permitted in the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL, because that is too
30400 late (the message has already been created).
30401
30402 Chapter &<<CHAPmsgproc>>& describes the processing that Exim applies to
30403 messages. Section &<<SECTsubmodnon>>& covers the processing that happens in
30404 submission mode; the available options for this control are described there.
30405 The control applies only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones
30406 that may be received in the same SMTP connection.
30407
30408 .vitem &*control&~=&~suppress_local_fixups*&
30409 .cindex "submission fixups, suppressing"
30410 This control applies to locally submitted (non TCP/IP) messages, and is the
30411 complement of &`control = submission`&. It disables the fixups that are
30412 normally applied to locally-submitted messages. Specifically:
30413
30414 .ilist
30415 Any &'Sender:'& header line is left alone (in this respect, it is a
30416 dynamic version of &%local_sender_retain%&).
30417 .next
30418 No &'Message-ID:'&, &'From:'&, or &'Date:'& header lines are added.
30419 .next
30420 There is no check that &'From:'& corresponds to the actual sender.
30421 .endlist ilist
30422
30423 This control may be useful when a remotely-originated message is accepted,
30424 passed to some scanning program, and then re-submitted for delivery. It can be
30425 used only in the &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&,
30426 and &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACLs, because it has to be set before the message's
30427 data is read.
30428
30429 &*Note:*& This control applies only to the current message, not to any others
30430 that are being submitted at the same time using &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&.
30431
30432 .vitem &*control&~=&~utf8_downconvert*&
30433 This control enables conversion of UTF-8 in message addresses
30434 to a-label form.
30435 For details see section &<<SECTi18nMTA>>&.
30436 .endlist vlist
30437
30438
30439 .section "Summary of message fixup control" "SECTsummesfix"
30440 All four possibilities for message fixups can be specified:
30441
30442 .ilist
30443 Locally submitted, fixups applied: the default.
30444 .next
30445 Locally submitted, no fixups applied: use
30446 &`control = suppress_local_fixups`&.
30447 .next
30448 Remotely submitted, no fixups applied: the default.
30449 .next
30450 Remotely submitted, fixups applied: use &`control = submission`&.
30451 .endlist
30452
30453
30454
30455 .section "Adding header lines in ACLs" "SECTaddheadacl"
30456 .cindex "header lines" "adding in an ACL"
30457 .cindex "header lines" "position of added lines"
30458 .cindex "&%add_header%& ACL modifier"
30459 The &%add_header%& modifier can be used to add one or more extra header lines
30460 to an incoming message, as in this example:
30461 .code
30462 warn dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
30463 dialup.mail-abuse.org
30464 add_header = X-blacklisted-at: $dnslist_domain
30465 .endd
30466 The &%add_header%& modifier is permitted in the MAIL, RCPT, PREDATA, DATA,
30467 MIME, DKIM, and non-SMTP ACLs (in other words, those that are concerned with
30468 receiving a message). The message must ultimately be accepted for
30469 &%add_header%& to have any significant effect. You can use &%add_header%& with
30470 any ACL verb, including &%deny%& (though this is potentially useful only in a
30471 RCPT ACL).
30472
30473 Headers will not be added to the message if the modifier is used in
30474 DATA, MIME or DKIM ACLs for a message delivered by cutthrough routing.
30475
30476 Leading and trailing newlines are removed from
30477 the data for the &%add_header%& modifier; if it then
30478 contains one or more newlines that
30479 are not followed by a space or a tab, it is assumed to contain multiple header
30480 lines. Each one is checked for valid syntax; &`X-ACL-Warn:`& is added to the
30481 front of any line that is not a valid header line.
30482
30483 Added header lines are accumulated during the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs.
30484 They are added to the message before processing the DATA and MIME ACLs.
30485 However, if an identical header line is requested more than once, only one copy
30486 is actually added to the message. Further header lines may be accumulated
30487 during the DATA and MIME ACLs, after which they are added to the message, again
30488 with duplicates suppressed. Thus, it is possible to add two identical header
30489 lines to an SMTP message, but only if one is added before DATA and one after.
30490 In the case of non-SMTP messages, new headers are accumulated during the
30491 non-SMTP ACLs, and are added to the message after all the ACLs have run. If a
30492 message is rejected after DATA or by the non-SMTP ACL, all added header lines
30493 are included in the entry that is written to the reject log.
30494
30495 .cindex "header lines" "added; visibility of"
30496 Header lines are not visible in string expansions
30497 of message headers
30498 until they are added to the
30499 message. It follows that header lines defined in the MAIL, RCPT, and predata
30500 ACLs are not visible until the DATA ACL and MIME ACLs are run. Similarly,
30501 header lines that are added by the DATA or MIME ACLs are not visible in those
30502 ACLs. Because of this restriction, you cannot use header lines as a way of
30503 passing data between (for example) the MAIL and RCPT ACLs. If you want to do
30504 this, you can use ACL variables, as described in section
30505 &<<SECTaclvariables>>&.
30506
30507 The list of headers yet to be added is given by the &%$headers_added%& variable.
30508
30509 The &%add_header%& modifier acts immediately as it is encountered during the
30510 processing of an ACL. Notice the difference between these two cases:
30511 .display
30512 &`accept add_header = ADDED: some text`&
30513 &` `&<&'some condition'&>
30514
30515 &`accept `&<&'some condition'&>
30516 &` add_header = ADDED: some text`&
30517 .endd
30518 In the first case, the header line is always added, whether or not the
30519 condition is true. In the second case, the header line is added only if the
30520 condition is true. Multiple occurrences of &%add_header%& may occur in the same
30521 ACL statement. All those that are encountered before a condition fails are
30522 honoured.
30523
30524 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb"
30525 For compatibility with previous versions of Exim, a &%message%& modifier for a
30526 &%warn%& verb acts in the same way as &%add_header%&, except that it takes
30527 effect only if all the conditions are true, even if it appears before some of
30528 them. Furthermore, only the last occurrence of &%message%& is honoured. This
30529 usage of &%message%& is now deprecated. If both &%add_header%& and &%message%&
30530 are present on a &%warn%& verb, both are processed according to their
30531 specifications.
30532
30533 By default, new header lines are added to a message at the end of the existing
30534 header lines. However, you can specify that any particular header line should
30535 be added right at the start (before all the &'Received:'& lines), immediately
30536 after the first block of &'Received:'& lines, or immediately before any line
30537 that is not a &'Received:'& or &'Resent-something:'& header.
30538
30539 This is done by specifying &":at_start:"&, &":after_received:"&, or
30540 &":at_start_rfc:"& (or, for completeness, &":at_end:"&) before the text of the
30541 header line, respectively. (Header text cannot start with a colon, as there has
30542 to be a header name first.) For example:
30543 .code
30544 warn add_header = \
30545 :after_received:X-My-Header: something or other...
30546 .endd
30547 If more than one header line is supplied in a single &%add_header%& modifier,
30548 each one is treated independently and can therefore be placed differently. If
30549 you add more than one line at the start, or after the Received: block, they end
30550 up in reverse order.
30551
30552 &*Warning*&: This facility currently applies only to header lines that are
30553 added in an ACL. It does NOT work for header lines that are added in a
30554 system filter or in a router or transport.
30555
30556
30557
30558 .section "Removing header lines in ACLs" "SECTremoveheadacl"
30559 .cindex "header lines" "removing in an ACL"
30560 .cindex "header lines" "position of removed lines"
30561 .cindex "&%remove_header%& ACL modifier"
30562 The &%remove_header%& modifier can be used to remove one or more header lines
30563 from an incoming message, as in this example:
30564 .code
30565 warn message = Remove internal headers
30566 remove_header = x-route-mail1 : x-route-mail2
30567 .endd
30568 The &%remove_header%& modifier is permitted in the MAIL, RCPT, PREDATA, DATA,
30569 MIME, DKIM, and non-SMTP ACLs (in other words, those that are concerned with
30570 receiving a message). The message must ultimately be accepted for
30571 &%remove_header%& to have any significant effect. You can use &%remove_header%&
30572 with any ACL verb, including &%deny%&, though this is really not useful for
30573 any verb that doesn't result in a delivered message.
30574
30575 Headers will not be removed from the message if the modifier is used in
30576 DATA, MIME or DKIM ACLs for a message delivered by cutthrough routing.
30577
30578 More than one header can be removed at the same time by using a colon separated
30579 list of header names. The header matching is case insensitive. Wildcards are
30580 not permitted, nor is list expansion performed, so you cannot use hostlists to
30581 create a list of headers, however both connection and message variable expansion
30582 are performed (&%$acl_c_*%& and &%$acl_m_*%&), illustrated in this example:
30583 .code
30584 warn hosts = +internal_hosts
30585 set acl_c_ihdrs = x-route-mail1 : x-route-mail2
30586 warn message = Remove internal headers
30587 remove_header = $acl_c_ihdrs
30588 .endd
30589 Header names for removal are accumulated during the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs.
30590 Matching header lines are removed from the message before processing the DATA and MIME ACLs.
30591 If multiple header lines match, all are removed.
30592 There is no harm in attempting to remove the same header twice nor in removing
30593 a non-existent header. Further header lines to be removed may be accumulated
30594 during the DATA and MIME ACLs, after which they are removed from the message,
30595 if present. In the case of non-SMTP messages, headers to be removed are
30596 accumulated during the non-SMTP ACLs, and are removed from the message after
30597 all the ACLs have run. If a message is rejected after DATA or by the non-SMTP
30598 ACL, there really is no effect because there is no logging of what headers
30599 would have been removed.
30600
30601 .cindex "header lines" "removed; visibility of"
30602 Header lines are not visible in string expansions until the DATA phase when it
30603 is received. Any header lines removed in the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs are
30604 not visible in the DATA ACL and MIME ACLs. Similarly, header lines that are
30605 removed by the DATA or MIME ACLs are still visible in those ACLs. Because of
30606 this restriction, you cannot use header lines as a way of controlling data
30607 passed between (for example) the MAIL and RCPT ACLs. If you want to do this,
30608 you should instead use ACL variables, as described in section
30609 &<<SECTaclvariables>>&.
30610
30611 The &%remove_header%& modifier acts immediately as it is encountered during the
30612 processing of an ACL. Notice the difference between these two cases:
30613 .display
30614 &`accept remove_header = X-Internal`&
30615 &` `&<&'some condition'&>
30616
30617 &`accept `&<&'some condition'&>
30618 &` remove_header = X-Internal`&
30619 .endd
30620 In the first case, the header line is always removed, whether or not the
30621 condition is true. In the second case, the header line is removed only if the
30622 condition is true. Multiple occurrences of &%remove_header%& may occur in the
30623 same ACL statement. All those that are encountered before a condition fails
30624 are honoured.
30625
30626 &*Warning*&: This facility currently applies only to header lines that are
30627 present during ACL processing. It does NOT remove header lines that are added
30628 in a system filter or in a router or transport.
30629
30630
30631
30632
30633 .section "ACL conditions" "SECTaclconditions"
30634 .cindex "&ACL;" "conditions; list of"
30635 Some of the conditions listed in this section are available only when Exim is
30636 compiled with the content-scanning extension. They are included here briefly
30637 for completeness. More detailed descriptions can be found in the discussion on
30638 content scanning in chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
30639
30640 Not all conditions are relevant in all circumstances. For example, testing
30641 senders and recipients does not make sense in an ACL that is being run as the
30642 result of the arrival of an ETRN command, and checks on message headers can be
30643 done only in the ACLs specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& and &%acl_not_smtp%&. You
30644 can use the same condition (with different parameters) more than once in the
30645 same ACL statement. This provides a way of specifying an &"and"& conjunction.
30646 The conditions are as follows:
30647
30648
30649 .vlist
30650 .vitem &*acl&~=&~*&<&'name&~of&~acl&~or&~ACL&~string&~or&~file&~name&~'&>
30651 .cindex "&ACL;" "nested"
30652 .cindex "&ACL;" "indirect"
30653 .cindex "&ACL;" "arguments"
30654 .cindex "&%acl%& ACL condition"
30655 The possible values of the argument are the same as for the
30656 &%acl_smtp_%&&'xxx'& options. The named or inline ACL is run. If it returns
30657 &"accept"& the condition is true; if it returns &"deny"& the condition is
30658 false. If it returns &"defer"&, the current ACL returns &"defer"& unless the
30659 condition is on a &%warn%& verb. In that case, a &"defer"& return makes the
30660 condition false. This means that further processing of the &%warn%& verb
30661 ceases, but processing of the ACL continues.
30662
30663 If the argument is a named ACL, up to nine space-separated optional values
30664 can be appended; they appear within the called ACL in $acl_arg1 to $acl_arg9,
30665 and $acl_narg is set to the count of values.
30666 Previous values of these variables are restored after the call returns.
30667 The name and values are expanded separately.
30668 Note that spaces in complex expansions which are used as arguments
30669 will act as argument separators.
30670
30671 If the nested &%acl%& returns &"drop"& and the outer condition denies access,
30672 the connection is dropped. If it returns &"discard"&, the verb must be
30673 &%accept%& or &%discard%&, and the action is taken immediately &-- no further
30674 conditions are tested.
30675
30676 ACLs may be nested up to 20 deep; the limit exists purely to catch runaway
30677 loops. This condition allows you to use different ACLs in different
30678 circumstances. For example, different ACLs can be used to handle RCPT commands
30679 for different local users or different local domains.
30680
30681 .vitem &*authenticated&~=&~*&<&'string&~list'&>
30682 .cindex "&%authenticated%& ACL condition"
30683 .cindex "authentication" "ACL checking"
30684 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing for authentication"
30685 If the SMTP connection is not authenticated, the condition is false. Otherwise,
30686 the name of the authenticator is tested against the list. To test for
30687 authentication by any authenticator, you can set
30688 .code
30689 authenticated = *
30690 .endd
30691
30692 .vitem &*condition&~=&~*&<&'string'&>
30693 .cindex "&%condition%& ACL condition"
30694 .cindex "customizing" "ACL condition"
30695 .cindex "&ACL;" "customized test"
30696 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing, customized"
30697 This feature allows you to make up custom conditions. If the result of
30698 expanding the string is an empty string, the number zero, or one of the strings
30699 &"no"& or &"false"&, the condition is false. If the result is any non-zero
30700 number, or one of the strings &"yes"& or &"true"&, the condition is true. For
30701 any other value, some error is assumed to have occurred, and the ACL returns
30702 &"defer"&. However, if the expansion is forced to fail, the condition is
30703 ignored. The effect is to treat it as true, whether it is positive or
30704 negative.
30705
30706 .vitem &*decode&~=&~*&<&'location'&>
30707 .cindex "&%decode%& ACL condition"
30708 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
30709 content-scanning extension, and it is allowed only in the ACL defined by
30710 &%acl_smtp_mime%&. It causes the current MIME part to be decoded into a file.
30711 If all goes well, the condition is true. It is false only if there are
30712 problems such as a syntax error or a memory shortage. For more details, see
30713 chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
30714
30715 .vitem &*dnslists&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~domain&~names&~and&~other&~data'&>
30716 .cindex "&%dnslists%& ACL condition"
30717 .cindex "DNS list" "in ACL"
30718 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
30719 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a DNS list"
30720 This condition checks for entries in DNS black lists. These are also known as
30721 &"RBL lists"&, after the original Realtime Blackhole List, but note that the
30722 use of the lists at &'mail-abuse.org'& now carries a charge. There are too many
30723 different variants of this condition to describe briefly here. See sections
30724 &<<SECTmorednslists>>&&--&<<SECTmorednslistslast>>& for details.
30725
30726 .vitem &*domains&~=&~*&<&'domain&~list'&>
30727 .cindex "&%domains%& ACL condition"
30728 .cindex "domain" "ACL checking"
30729 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a recipient domain"
30730 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
30731 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks that the domain
30732 of the recipient address is in the domain list. If percent-hack processing is
30733 enabled, it is done before this test is done. If the check succeeds with a
30734 lookup, the result of the lookup is placed in &$domain_data$& until the next
30735 &%domains%& test.
30736
30737 &*Note carefully*& (because many people seem to fall foul of this): you cannot
30738 use &%domains%& in a DATA ACL.
30739
30740
30741 .vitem &*encrypted&~=&~*&<&'string&~list'&>
30742 .cindex "&%encrypted%& ACL condition"
30743 .cindex "encryption" "checking in an ACL"
30744 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing for encryption"
30745 If the SMTP connection is not encrypted, the condition is false. Otherwise, the
30746 name of the cipher suite in use is tested against the list. To test for
30747 encryption without testing for any specific cipher suite(s), set
30748 .code
30749 encrypted = *
30750 .endd
30751
30752
30753 .vitem &*hosts&~=&~*&<&'host&~list'&>
30754 .cindex "&%hosts%& ACL condition"
30755 .cindex "host" "ACL checking"
30756 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing the client host"
30757 This condition tests that the calling host matches the host list. If you have
30758 name lookups or wildcarded host names and IP addresses in the same host list,
30759 you should normally put the IP addresses first. For example, you could have:
30760 .code
30761 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7 : dbm;/etc/friendly/hosts
30762 .endd
30763 The lookup in this example uses the host name for its key. This is implied by
30764 the lookup type &"dbm"&. (For a host address lookup you would use &"net-dbm"&
30765 and it wouldn't matter which way round you had these two items.)
30766
30767 The reason for the problem with host names lies in the left-to-right way that
30768 Exim processes lists. It can test IP addresses without doing any DNS lookups,
30769 but when it reaches an item that requires a host name, it fails if it cannot
30770 find a host name to compare with the pattern. If the above list is given in the
30771 opposite order, the &%accept%& statement fails for a host whose name cannot be
30772 found, even if its IP address is 10.9.8.7.
30773
30774 If you really do want to do the name check first, and still recognize the IP
30775 address even if the name lookup fails, you can rewrite the ACL like this:
30776 .code
30777 accept hosts = dbm;/etc/friendly/hosts
30778 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7
30779 .endd
30780 The default action on failing to find the host name is to assume that the host
30781 is not in the list, so the first &%accept%& statement fails. The second
30782 statement can then check the IP address.
30783
30784 .vindex "&$host_data$&"
30785 If a &%hosts%& condition is satisfied by means of a lookup, the result
30786 of the lookup is made available in the &$host_data$& variable. This
30787 allows you, for example, to set up a statement like this:
30788 .code
30789 deny hosts = net-lsearch;/some/file
30790 message = $host_data
30791 .endd
30792 which gives a custom error message for each denied host.
30793
30794 .vitem &*local_parts&~=&~*&<&'local&~part&~list'&>
30795 .cindex "&%local_parts%& ACL condition"
30796 .cindex "local part" "ACL checking"
30797 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a local part"
30798 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
30799 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks that the local
30800 part of the recipient address is in the list. If percent-hack processing is
30801 enabled, it is done before this test. If the check succeeds with a lookup, the
30802 result of the lookup is placed in &$local_part_data$&, which remains set until
30803 the next &%local_parts%& test.
30804
30805 .vitem &*malware&~=&~*&<&'option'&>
30806 .cindex "&%malware%& ACL condition"
30807 .cindex "&ACL;" "virus scanning"
30808 .cindex "&ACL;" "scanning for viruses"
30809 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
30810 content-scanning extension. It causes the incoming message to be scanned for
30811 viruses. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
30812
30813 .vitem &*mime_regex&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~regular&~expressions'&>
30814 .cindex "&%mime_regex%& ACL condition"
30815 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing by regex matching"
30816 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
30817 content-scanning extension, and it is allowed only in the ACL defined by
30818 &%acl_smtp_mime%&. It causes the current MIME part to be scanned for a match
30819 with any of the regular expressions. For details, see chapter
30820 &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
30821
30822 .vitem &*ratelimit&~=&~*&<&'parameters'&>
30823 .cindex "rate limiting"
30824 This condition can be used to limit the rate at which a user or host submits
30825 messages. Details are given in section &<<SECTratelimiting>>&.
30826
30827 .vitem &*recipients&~=&~*&<&'address&~list'&>
30828 .cindex "&%recipients%& ACL condition"
30829 .cindex "recipient" "ACL checking"
30830 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a recipient"
30831 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks the entire
30832 recipient address against a list of recipients.
30833
30834 .vitem &*regex&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~regular&~expressions'&>
30835 .cindex "&%regex%& ACL condition"
30836 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing by regex matching"
30837 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
30838 content-scanning extension, and is available only in the DATA, MIME, and
30839 non-SMTP ACLs. It causes the incoming message to be scanned for a match with
30840 any of the regular expressions. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
30841
30842 .vitem &*sender_domains&~=&~*&<&'domain&~list'&>
30843 .cindex "&%sender_domains%& ACL condition"
30844 .cindex "sender" "ACL checking"
30845 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a sender domain"
30846 .vindex "&$domain$&"
30847 .vindex "&$sender_address_domain$&"
30848 This condition tests the domain of the sender of the message against the given
30849 domain list. &*Note*&: The domain of the sender address is in
30850 &$sender_address_domain$&. It is &'not'& put in &$domain$& during the testing
30851 of this condition. This is an exception to the general rule for testing domain
30852 lists. It is done this way so that, if this condition is used in an ACL for a
30853 RCPT command, the recipient's domain (which is in &$domain$&) can be used to
30854 influence the sender checking.
30855
30856 &*Warning*&: It is a bad idea to use this condition on its own as a control on
30857 relaying, because sender addresses are easily, and commonly, forged.
30858
30859 .vitem &*senders&~=&~*&<&'address&~list'&>
30860 .cindex "&%senders%& ACL condition"
30861 .cindex "sender" "ACL checking"
30862 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a sender"
30863 This condition tests the sender of the message against the given list. To test
30864 for a bounce message, which has an empty sender, set
30865 .code
30866 senders = :
30867 .endd
30868 &*Warning*&: It is a bad idea to use this condition on its own as a control on
30869 relaying, because sender addresses are easily, and commonly, forged.
30870
30871 .vitem &*spam&~=&~*&<&'username'&>
30872 .cindex "&%spam%& ACL condition"
30873 .cindex "&ACL;" "scanning for spam"
30874 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
30875 content-scanning extension. It causes the incoming message to be scanned by
30876 SpamAssassin. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
30877
30878 .vitem &*verify&~=&~certificate*&
30879 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
30880 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
30881 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
30882 .cindex "&ACL;" "certificate verification"
30883 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a TLS certificate"
30884 This condition is true in an SMTP session if the session is encrypted, and a
30885 certificate was received from the client, and the certificate was verified. The
30886 server requests a certificate only if the client matches &%tls_verify_hosts%&
30887 or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& (see chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&).
30888
30889 .vitem &*verify&~=&~csa*&
30890 .cindex "CSA verification"
30891 This condition checks whether the sending host (the client) is authorized to
30892 send email. Details of how this works are given in section
30893 &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
30894
30895 .vitem &*verify&~=&~header_names_ascii*&
30896 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
30897 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying header names only ASCII"
30898 .cindex "header lines" "verifying header names only ASCII"
30899 .cindex "verifying" "header names only ASCII"
30900 This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
30901 received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
30902 &%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks all header names (not the content) to make sure
30903 there are no non-ASCII characters, also excluding control characters. The
30904 allowable characters are decimal ASCII values 33 through 126.
30905
30906 Exim itself will handle headers with non-ASCII characters, but it can cause
30907 problems for downstream applications, so this option will allow their
30908 detection and rejection in the DATA ACL's.
30909
30910 .vitem &*verify&~=&~header_sender/*&<&'options'&>
30911 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
30912 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying sender in the header"
30913 .cindex "header lines" "verifying the sender in"
30914 .cindex "sender" "verifying in header"
30915 .cindex "verifying" "sender in header"
30916 This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
30917 received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
30918 &%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks that there is a verifiable address in at least one
30919 of the &'Sender:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, or &'From:'& header lines. Such an address
30920 is loosely thought of as a &"sender"& address (hence the name of the test).
30921 However, an address that appears in one of these headers need not be an address
30922 that accepts bounce messages; only sender addresses in envelopes are required
30923 to accept bounces. Therefore, if you use the callout option on this check, you
30924 might want to arrange for a non-empty address in the MAIL command.
30925
30926 Details of address verification and the options are given later, starting at
30927 section &<<SECTaddressverification>>& (callouts are described in section
30928 &<<SECTcallver>>&). You can combine this condition with the &%senders%&
30929 condition to restrict it to bounce messages only:
30930 .code
30931 deny senders = :
30932 message = A valid sender header is required for bounces
30933 !verify = header_sender
30934 .endd
30935
30936 .vitem &*verify&~=&~header_syntax*&
30937 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
30938 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying header syntax"
30939 .cindex "header lines" "verifying syntax"
30940 .cindex "verifying" "header syntax"
30941 This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
30942 received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
30943 &%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks the syntax of all header lines that can contain
30944 lists of addresses (&'Sender:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&,
30945 and &'Bcc:'&), returning true if there are no problems.
30946 Unqualified addresses (local parts without domains) are
30947 permitted only in locally generated messages and from hosts that match
30948 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&, as
30949 appropriate.
30950
30951 Note that this condition is a syntax check only. However, a common spamming
30952 ploy used to be to send syntactically invalid headers such as
30953 .code
30954 To: @
30955 .endd
30956 and this condition can be used to reject such messages, though they are not as
30957 common as they used to be.
30958
30959 .vitem &*verify&~=&~helo*&
30960 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
30961 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying HELO/EHLO"
30962 .cindex "HELO" "verifying"
30963 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying"
30964 .cindex "verifying" "EHLO"
30965 .cindex "verifying" "HELO"
30966 This condition is true if a HELO or EHLO command has been received from the
30967 client host, and its contents have been verified. If there has been no previous
30968 attempt to verify the HELO/EHLO contents, it is carried out when this
30969 condition is encountered. See the description of the &%helo_verify_hosts%& and
30970 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& options for details of how to request verification
30971 independently of this condition, and for detail of the verification.
30972
30973 For SMTP input that does not come over TCP/IP (the &%-bs%& command line
30974 option), this condition is always true.
30975
30976
30977 .vitem &*verify&~=&~not_blind/*&<&'options'&>
30978 .cindex "verifying" "not blind"
30979 .cindex "bcc recipients, verifying none"
30980 This condition checks that there are no blind (bcc) recipients in the message.
30981 Every envelope recipient must appear either in a &'To:'& header line or in a
30982 &'Cc:'& header line for this condition to be true. Local parts are checked
30983 case-sensitively; domains are checked case-insensitively. If &'Resent-To:'& or
30984 &'Resent-Cc:'& header lines exist, they are also checked. This condition can be
30985 used only in a DATA or non-SMTP ACL.
30986
30987 .new
30988 There is one possible option, &`case_insensitive`&. If this is present then
30989 local parts are checked case-insensitively.
30990 .wen
30991
30992 There are, of course, many legitimate messages that make use of blind (bcc)
30993 recipients. This check should not be used on its own for blocking messages.
30994
30995
30996 .vitem &*verify&~=&~recipient/*&<&'options'&>
30997 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
30998 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying recipient"
30999 .cindex "recipient" "verifying"
31000 .cindex "verifying" "recipient"
31001 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
31002 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It verifies the current
31003 recipient. Details of address verification are given later, starting at section
31004 &<<SECTaddressverification>>&. After a recipient has been verified, the value
31005 of &$address_data$& is the last value that was set while routing the address.
31006 This applies even if the verification fails. When an address that is being
31007 verified is redirected to a single address, verification continues with the new
31008 address, and in that case, the subsequent value of &$address_data$& is the
31009 value for the child address.
31010
31011 .vitem &*verify&~=&~reverse_host_lookup/*&<&'options'&>
31012 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
31013 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying host reverse lookup"
31014 .cindex "host" "verifying reverse lookup"
31015 This condition ensures that a verified host name has been looked up from the IP
31016 address of the client host. (This may have happened already if the host name
31017 was needed for checking a host list, or if the host matched &%host_lookup%&.)
31018 Verification ensures that the host name obtained from a reverse DNS lookup, or
31019 one of its aliases, does, when it is itself looked up in the DNS, yield the
31020 original IP address.
31021
31022 There is one possible option, &`defer_ok`&. If this is present and a
31023 DNS operation returns a temporary error, the verify condition succeeds.
31024
31025 If this condition is used for a locally generated message (that is, when there
31026 is no client host involved), it always succeeds.
31027
31028 .vitem &*verify&~=&~sender/*&<&'options'&>
31029 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
31030 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying sender"
31031 .cindex "sender" "verifying"
31032 .cindex "verifying" "sender"
31033 This condition is relevant only after a MAIL or RCPT command, or after a
31034 message has been received (the &%acl_smtp_data%& or &%acl_not_smtp%& ACLs). If
31035 the message's sender is empty (that is, this is a bounce message), the
31036 condition is true. Otherwise, the sender address is verified.
31037
31038 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
31039 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
31040 If there is data in the &$address_data$& variable at the end of routing, its
31041 value is placed in &$sender_address_data$& at the end of verification. This
31042 value can be used in subsequent conditions and modifiers in the same ACL
31043 statement. It does not persist after the end of the current statement. If you
31044 want to preserve the value for longer, you can save it in an ACL variable.
31045
31046 Details of verification are given later, starting at section
31047 &<<SECTaddressverification>>&. Exim caches the result of sender verification,
31048 to avoid doing it more than once per message.
31049
31050 .vitem &*verify&~=&~sender=*&<&'address'&>&*/*&<&'options'&>
31051 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
31052 This is a variation of the previous option, in which a modified address is
31053 verified as a sender.
31054
31055 Note that '/' is legal in local-parts; if the address may have such
31056 (eg. is generated from the received message)
31057 they must be protected from the options parsing by doubling:
31058 .code
31059 verify = sender=${sg{${address:$h_sender:}}{/}{//}}
31060 .endd
31061 .endlist
31062
31063
31064
31065 .section "Using DNS lists" "SECTmorednslists"
31066 .cindex "DNS list" "in ACL"
31067 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
31068 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a DNS list"
31069 In its simplest form, the &%dnslists%& condition tests whether the calling host
31070 is on at least one of a number of DNS lists by looking up the inverted IP
31071 address in one or more DNS domains. (Note that DNS list domains are not mail
31072 domains, so the &`+`& syntax for named lists doesn't work - it is used for
31073 special options instead.) For example, if the calling host's IP
31074 address is 192.168.62.43, and the ACL statement is
31075 .code
31076 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org : \
31077 dialups.mail-abuse.org
31078 .endd
31079 the following records are looked up:
31080 .code
31081 43.62.168.192.blackholes.mail-abuse.org
31082 43.62.168.192.dialups.mail-abuse.org
31083 .endd
31084 As soon as Exim finds an existing DNS record, processing of the list stops.
31085 Thus, multiple entries on the list provide an &"or"& conjunction. If you want
31086 to test that a host is on more than one list (an &"and"& conjunction), you can
31087 use two separate conditions:
31088 .code
31089 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
31090 dnslists = dialups.mail-abuse.org
31091 .endd
31092 If a DNS lookup times out or otherwise fails to give a decisive answer, Exim
31093 behaves as if the host does not match the list item, that is, as if the DNS
31094 record does not exist. If there are further items in the DNS list, they are
31095 processed.
31096
31097 This is usually the required action when &%dnslists%& is used with &%deny%&
31098 (which is the most common usage), because it prevents a DNS failure from
31099 blocking mail. However, you can change this behaviour by putting one of the
31100 following special items in the list:
31101 .display
31102 &`+include_unknown `& behave as if the item is on the list
31103 &`+exclude_unknown `& behave as if the item is not on the list (default)
31104 &`+defer_unknown `& give a temporary error
31105 .endd
31106 .cindex "&`+include_unknown`&"
31107 .cindex "&`+exclude_unknown`&"
31108 .cindex "&`+defer_unknown`&"
31109 Each of these applies to any subsequent items on the list. For example:
31110 .code
31111 deny dnslists = +defer_unknown : foo.bar.example
31112 .endd
31113 Testing the list of domains stops as soon as a match is found. If you want to
31114 warn for one list and block for another, you can use two different statements:
31115 .code
31116 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
31117 warn message = X-Warn: sending host is on dialups list
31118 dnslists = dialups.mail-abuse.org
31119 .endd
31120 .cindex caching "of dns lookup"
31121 .cindex DNS TTL
31122 DNS list lookups are cached by Exim for the duration of the SMTP session
31123 (but limited by the DNS return TTL value),
31124 so a lookup based on the IP address is done at most once for any incoming
31125 connection (assuming long-enough TTL).
31126 Exim does not share information between multiple incoming
31127 connections (but your local name server cache should be active).
31128
31129 There are a number of DNS lists to choose from, some commercial, some free,
31130 or free for small deployments. An overview can be found at
31131 &url(https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Comparison_of_DNS_blacklists).
31132
31133
31134
31135 .section "Specifying the IP address for a DNS list lookup" "SECID201"
31136 .cindex "DNS list" "keyed by explicit IP address"
31137 By default, the IP address that is used in a DNS list lookup is the IP address
31138 of the calling host. However, you can specify another IP address by listing it
31139 after the domain name, introduced by a slash. For example:
31140 .code
31141 deny dnslists = black.list.tld/192.168.1.2
31142 .endd
31143 This feature is not very helpful with explicit IP addresses; it is intended for
31144 use with IP addresses that are looked up, for example, the IP addresses of the
31145 MX hosts or nameservers of an email sender address. For an example, see section
31146 &<<SECTmulkeyfor>>& below.
31147
31148
31149
31150
31151 .section "DNS lists keyed on domain names" "SECID202"
31152 .cindex "DNS list" "keyed by domain name"
31153 There are some lists that are keyed on domain names rather than inverted IP
31154 addresses (see, e.g., the &'domain based zones'& link at
31155 &url(http://www.rfc-ignorant.org/)). No reversing of components is used
31156 with these lists. You can change the name that is looked up in a DNS list by
31157 listing it after the domain name, introduced by a slash. For example,
31158 .code
31159 deny message = Sender's domain is listed at $dnslist_domain
31160 dnslists = dsn.rfc-ignorant.org/$sender_address_domain
31161 .endd
31162 This particular example is useful only in ACLs that are obeyed after the
31163 RCPT or DATA commands, when a sender address is available. If (for
31164 example) the message's sender is &'user@tld.example'& the name that is looked
31165 up by this example is
31166 .code
31167 tld.example.dsn.rfc-ignorant.org
31168 .endd
31169 A single &%dnslists%& condition can contain entries for both names and IP
31170 addresses. For example:
31171 .code
31172 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
31173 dsn.rfc-ignorant.org/$sender_address_domain
31174 .endd
31175 The first item checks the sending host's IP address; the second checks a domain
31176 name. The whole condition is true if either of the DNS lookups succeeds.
31177
31178
31179
31180
31181 .section "Multiple explicit keys for a DNS list" "SECTmulkeyfor"
31182 .cindex "DNS list" "multiple keys for"
31183 The syntax described above for looking up explicitly-defined values (either
31184 names or IP addresses) in a DNS blacklist is a simplification. After the domain
31185 name for the DNS list, what follows the slash can in fact be a list of items.
31186 As with all lists in Exim, the default separator is a colon. However, because
31187 this is a sublist within the list of DNS blacklist domains, it is necessary
31188 either to double the separators like this:
31189 .code
31190 dnslists = black.list.tld/name.1::name.2
31191 .endd
31192 or to change the separator character, like this:
31193 .code
31194 dnslists = black.list.tld/<;name.1;name.2
31195 .endd
31196 If an item in the list is an IP address, it is inverted before the DNS
31197 blacklist domain is appended. If it is not an IP address, no inversion
31198 occurs. Consider this condition:
31199 .code
31200 dnslists = black.list.tld/<;192.168.1.2;a.domain
31201 .endd
31202 The DNS lookups that occur are:
31203 .code
31204 2.1.168.192.black.list.tld
31205 a.domain.black.list.tld
31206 .endd
31207 Once a DNS record has been found (that matches a specific IP return
31208 address, if specified &-- see section &<<SECTaddmatcon>>&), no further lookups
31209 are done. If there is a temporary DNS error, the rest of the sublist of domains
31210 or IP addresses is tried. A temporary error for the whole dnslists item occurs
31211 only if no other DNS lookup in this sublist succeeds. In other words, a
31212 successful lookup for any of the items in the sublist overrides a temporary
31213 error for a previous item.
31214
31215 The ability to supply a list of items after the slash is in some sense just a
31216 syntactic convenience. These two examples have the same effect:
31217 .code
31218 dnslists = black.list.tld/a.domain : black.list.tld/b.domain
31219 dnslists = black.list.tld/a.domain::b.domain
31220 .endd
31221 However, when the data for the list is obtained from a lookup, the second form
31222 is usually much more convenient. Consider this example:
31223 .code
31224 deny message = The mail servers for the domain \
31225 $sender_address_domain \
31226 are listed at $dnslist_domain ($dnslist_value); \
31227 see $dnslist_text.
31228 dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org/<|${lookup dnsdb {>|a=<|\
31229 ${lookup dnsdb {>|mxh=\
31230 $sender_address_domain} }} }
31231 .endd
31232 Note the use of &`>|`& in the dnsdb lookup to specify the separator for
31233 multiple DNS records. The inner dnsdb lookup produces a list of MX hosts
31234 and the outer dnsdb lookup finds the IP addresses for these hosts. The result
31235 of expanding the condition might be something like this:
31236 .code
31237 dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org/<|192.168.2.3|192.168.5.6|...
31238 .endd
31239 Thus, this example checks whether or not the IP addresses of the sender
31240 domain's mail servers are on the Spamhaus black list.
31241
31242 The key that was used for a successful DNS list lookup is put into the variable
31243 &$dnslist_matched$& (see section &<<SECID204>>&).
31244
31245
31246
31247
31248 .section "Data returned by DNS lists" "SECID203"
31249 .cindex "DNS list" "data returned from"
31250 DNS lists are constructed using address records in the DNS. The original RBL
31251 just used the address 127.0.0.1 on the right hand side of each record, but the
31252 RBL+ list and some other lists use a number of values with different meanings.
31253 The values used on the RBL+ list are:
31254 .display
31255 127.1.0.1 RBL
31256 127.1.0.2 DUL
31257 127.1.0.3 DUL and RBL
31258 127.1.0.4 RSS
31259 127.1.0.5 RSS and RBL
31260 127.1.0.6 RSS and DUL
31261 127.1.0.7 RSS and DUL and RBL
31262 .endd
31263 Section &<<SECTaddmatcon>>& below describes how you can distinguish between
31264 different values. Some DNS lists may return more than one address record;
31265 see section &<<SECThanmuldnsrec>>& for details of how they are checked.
31266
31267
31268 .section "Variables set from DNS lists" "SECID204"
31269 .cindex "expansion" "variables, set from DNS list"
31270 .cindex "DNS list" "variables set from"
31271 .vindex "&$dnslist_domain$&"
31272 .vindex "&$dnslist_matched$&"
31273 .vindex "&$dnslist_text$&"
31274 .vindex "&$dnslist_value$&"
31275 When an entry is found in a DNS list, the variable &$dnslist_domain$& contains
31276 the name of the overall domain that matched (for example,
31277 &`spamhaus.example`&), &$dnslist_matched$& contains the key within that domain
31278 (for example, &`192.168.5.3`&), and &$dnslist_value$& contains the data from
31279 the DNS record. When the key is an IP address, it is not reversed in
31280 &$dnslist_matched$& (though it is, of course, in the actual lookup). In simple
31281 cases, for example:
31282 .code
31283 deny dnslists = spamhaus.example
31284 .endd
31285 the key is also available in another variable (in this case,
31286 &$sender_host_address$&). In more complicated cases, however, this is not true.
31287 For example, using a data lookup (as described in section &<<SECTmulkeyfor>>&)
31288 might generate a dnslists lookup like this:
31289 .code
31290 deny dnslists = spamhaus.example/<|192.168.1.2|192.168.6.7|...
31291 .endd
31292 If this condition succeeds, the value in &$dnslist_matched$& might be
31293 &`192.168.6.7`& (for example).
31294
31295 If more than one address record is returned by the DNS lookup, all the IP
31296 addresses are included in &$dnslist_value$&, separated by commas and spaces.
31297 The variable &$dnslist_text$& contains the contents of any associated TXT
31298 record. For lists such as RBL+ the TXT record for a merged entry is often not
31299 very meaningful. See section &<<SECTmordetinf>>& for a way of obtaining more
31300 information.
31301
31302 You can use the DNS list variables in &%message%& or &%log_message%& modifiers
31303 &-- although these appear before the condition in the ACL, they are not
31304 expanded until after it has failed. For example:
31305 .code
31306 deny hosts = !+local_networks
31307 message = $sender_host_address is listed \
31308 at $dnslist_domain
31309 dnslists = rbl-plus.mail-abuse.example
31310 .endd
31311
31312
31313
31314 .section "Additional matching conditions for DNS lists" "SECTaddmatcon"
31315 .cindex "DNS list" "matching specific returned data"
31316 You can add an equals sign and an IP address after a &%dnslists%& domain name
31317 in order to restrict its action to DNS records with a matching right hand side.
31318 For example,
31319 .code
31320 deny dnslists = rblplus.mail-abuse.org=127.0.0.2
31321 .endd
31322 rejects only those hosts that yield 127.0.0.2. Without this additional data,
31323 any address record is considered to be a match. For the moment, we assume
31324 that the DNS lookup returns just one record. Section &<<SECThanmuldnsrec>>&
31325 describes how multiple records are handled.
31326
31327 More than one IP address may be given for checking, using a comma as a
31328 separator. These are alternatives &-- if any one of them matches, the
31329 &%dnslists%& condition is true. For example:
31330 .code
31331 deny dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
31332 .endd
31333 If you want to specify a constraining address list and also specify names or IP
31334 addresses to be looked up, the constraining address list must be specified
31335 first. For example:
31336 .code
31337 deny dnslists = dsn.rfc-ignorant.org\
31338 =127.0.0.2/$sender_address_domain
31339 .endd
31340
31341 If the character &`&&`& is used instead of &`=`&, the comparison for each
31342 listed IP address is done by a bitwise &"and"& instead of by an equality test.
31343 In other words, the listed addresses are used as bit masks. The comparison is
31344 true if all the bits in the mask are present in the address that is being
31345 tested. For example:
31346 .code
31347 dnslists = a.b.c&0.0.0.3
31348 .endd
31349 matches if the address is &'x.x.x.'&3, &'x.x.x.'&7, &'x.x.x.'&11, etc. If you
31350 want to test whether one bit or another bit is present (as opposed to both
31351 being present), you must use multiple values. For example:
31352 .code
31353 dnslists = a.b.c&0.0.0.1,0.0.0.2
31354 .endd
31355 matches if the final component of the address is an odd number or two times
31356 an odd number.
31357
31358
31359
31360 .section "Negated DNS matching conditions" "SECID205"
31361 You can supply a negative list of IP addresses as part of a &%dnslists%&
31362 condition. Whereas
31363 .code
31364 deny dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
31365 .endd
31366 means &"deny if the host is in the black list at the domain &'a.b.c'& and the
31367 IP address yielded by the list is either 127.0.0.2 or 127.0.0.3"&,
31368 .code
31369 deny dnslists = a.b.c!=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
31370 .endd
31371 means &"deny if the host is in the black list at the domain &'a.b.c'& and the
31372 IP address yielded by the list is not 127.0.0.2 and not 127.0.0.3"&. In other
31373 words, the result of the test is inverted if an exclamation mark appears before
31374 the &`=`& (or the &`&&`&) sign.
31375
31376 &*Note*&: This kind of negation is not the same as negation in a domain,
31377 host, or address list (which is why the syntax is different).
31378
31379 If you are using just one list, the negation syntax does not gain you much. The
31380 previous example is precisely equivalent to
31381 .code
31382 deny dnslists = a.b.c
31383 !dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
31384 .endd
31385 However, if you are using multiple lists, the negation syntax is clearer.
31386 Consider this example:
31387 .code
31388 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
31389 list.dsbl.org : \
31390 dnsbl.njabl.org!=127.0.0.3 : \
31391 relays.ordb.org
31392 .endd
31393 Using only positive lists, this would have to be:
31394 .code
31395 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
31396 list.dsbl.org
31397 deny dnslists = dnsbl.njabl.org
31398 !dnslists = dnsbl.njabl.org=127.0.0.3
31399 deny dnslists = relays.ordb.org
31400 .endd
31401 which is less clear, and harder to maintain.
31402
31403
31404
31405
31406 .section "Handling multiple DNS records from a DNS list" "SECThanmuldnsrec"
31407 A DNS lookup for a &%dnslists%& condition may return more than one DNS record,
31408 thereby providing more than one IP address. When an item in a &%dnslists%& list
31409 is followed by &`=`& or &`&&`& and a list of IP addresses, in order to restrict
31410 the match to specific results from the DNS lookup, there are two ways in which
31411 the checking can be handled. For example, consider the condition:
31412 .code
31413 dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.1
31414 .endd
31415 What happens if the DNS lookup for the incoming IP address yields both
31416 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2 by means of two separate DNS records? Is the
31417 condition true because at least one given value was found, or is it false
31418 because at least one of the found values was not listed? And how does this
31419 affect negated conditions? Both possibilities are provided for with the help of
31420 additional separators &`==`& and &`=&&`&.
31421
31422 .ilist
31423 If &`=`& or &`&&`& is used, the condition is true if any one of the looked up
31424 IP addresses matches one of the listed addresses. For the example above, the
31425 condition is true because 127.0.0.1 matches.
31426 .next
31427 If &`==`& or &`=&&`& is used, the condition is true only if every one of the
31428 looked up IP addresses matches one of the listed addresses. If the condition is
31429 changed to:
31430 .code
31431 dnslists = a.b.c==127.0.0.1
31432 .endd
31433 and the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
31434 false because 127.0.0.2 is not listed. You would need to have:
31435 .code
31436 dnslists = a.b.c==127.0.0.1,127.0.0.2
31437 .endd
31438 for the condition to be true.
31439 .endlist
31440
31441 When &`!`& is used to negate IP address matching, it inverts the result, giving
31442 the precise opposite of the behaviour above. Thus:
31443 .ilist
31444 If &`!=`& or &`!&&`& is used, the condition is true if none of the looked up IP
31445 addresses matches one of the listed addresses. Consider:
31446 .code
31447 dnslists = a.b.c!&0.0.0.1
31448 .endd
31449 If the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
31450 false because 127.0.0.1 matches.
31451 .next
31452 If &`!==`& or &`!=&&`& is used, the condition is true if there is at least one
31453 looked up IP address that does not match. Consider:
31454 .code
31455 dnslists = a.b.c!=&0.0.0.1
31456 .endd
31457 If the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
31458 true, because 127.0.0.2 does not match. You would need to have:
31459 .code
31460 dnslists = a.b.c!=&0.0.0.1,0.0.0.2
31461 .endd
31462 for the condition to be false.
31463 .endlist
31464 When the DNS lookup yields only a single IP address, there is no difference
31465 between &`=`& and &`==`& and between &`&&`& and &`=&&`&.
31466
31467
31468
31469
31470 .section "Detailed information from merged DNS lists" "SECTmordetinf"
31471 .cindex "DNS list" "information from merged"
31472 When the facility for restricting the matching IP values in a DNS list is used,
31473 the text from the TXT record that is set in &$dnslist_text$& may not reflect
31474 the true reason for rejection. This happens when lists are merged and the IP
31475 address in the A record is used to distinguish them; unfortunately there is
31476 only one TXT record. One way round this is not to use merged lists, but that
31477 can be inefficient because it requires multiple DNS lookups where one would do
31478 in the vast majority of cases when the host of interest is not on any of the
31479 lists.
31480
31481 A less inefficient way of solving this problem is available. If
31482 two domain names, comma-separated, are given, the second is used first to
31483 do an initial check, making use of any IP value restrictions that are set.
31484 If there is a match, the first domain is used, without any IP value
31485 restrictions, to get the TXT record. As a byproduct of this, there is also
31486 a check that the IP being tested is indeed on the first list. The first
31487 domain is the one that is put in &$dnslist_domain$&. For example:
31488 .code
31489 deny message = \
31490 rejected because $sender_host_address is blacklisted \
31491 at $dnslist_domain\n$dnslist_text
31492 dnslists = \
31493 sbl.spamhaus.org,sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org=127.0.0.2 : \
31494 dul.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.10
31495 .endd
31496 For the first blacklist item, this starts by doing a lookup in
31497 &'sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org'& and testing for a 127.0.0.2 return. If there is a
31498 match, it then looks in &'sbl.spamhaus.org'&, without checking the return
31499 value, and as long as something is found, it looks for the corresponding TXT
31500 record. If there is no match in &'sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org'&, nothing more is done.
31501 The second blacklist item is processed similarly.
31502
31503 If you are interested in more than one merged list, the same list must be
31504 given several times, but because the results of the DNS lookups are cached,
31505 the DNS calls themselves are not repeated. For example:
31506 .code
31507 deny dnslists = \
31508 http.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.2 : \
31509 socks.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.3 : \
31510 misc.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.4 : \
31511 dul.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.10
31512 .endd
31513 In this case there is one lookup in &'dnsbl.sorbs.net'&, and if none of the IP
31514 values matches (or if no record is found), this is the only lookup that is
31515 done. Only if there is a match is one of the more specific lists consulted.
31516
31517
31518
31519 .section "DNS lists and IPv6" "SECTmorednslistslast"
31520 .cindex "IPv6" "DNS black lists"
31521 .cindex "DNS list" "IPv6 usage"
31522 If Exim is asked to do a dnslist lookup for an IPv6 address, it inverts it
31523 nibble by nibble. For example, if the calling host's IP address is
31524 3ffe:ffff:836f:0a00:000a:0800:200a:c031, Exim might look up
31525 .code
31526 1.3.0.c.a.0.0.2.0.0.8.0.a.0.0.0.0.0.a.0.f.6.3.8.
31527 f.f.f.f.e.f.f.3.blackholes.mail-abuse.org
31528 .endd
31529 (split over two lines here to fit on the page). Unfortunately, some of the DNS
31530 lists contain wildcard records, intended for IPv4, that interact badly with
31531 IPv6. For example, the DNS entry
31532 .code
31533 *.3.some.list.example. A 127.0.0.1
31534 .endd
31535 is probably intended to put the entire 3.0.0.0/8 IPv4 network on the list.
31536 Unfortunately, it also matches the entire 3::/4 IPv6 network.
31537
31538 You can exclude IPv6 addresses from DNS lookups by making use of a suitable
31539 &%condition%& condition, as in this example:
31540 .code
31541 deny condition = ${if isip4{$sender_host_address}}
31542 dnslists = some.list.example
31543 .endd
31544
31545 If an explicit key is being used for a DNS lookup and it may be an IPv6
31546 address you should specify alternate list separators for both the outer
31547 (DNS list name) list and inner (lookup keys) list:
31548 .code
31549 dnslists = <; dnsbl.example.com/<|$acl_m_addrslist
31550 .endd
31551
31552 .section "Rate limiting incoming messages" "SECTratelimiting"
31553 .cindex "rate limiting" "client sending"
31554 .cindex "limiting client sending rates"
31555 .oindex "&%smtp_ratelimit_*%&"
31556 The &%ratelimit%& ACL condition can be used to measure and control the rate at
31557 which clients can send email. This is more powerful than the
31558 &%smtp_ratelimit_*%& options, because those options control the rate of
31559 commands in a single SMTP session only, whereas the &%ratelimit%& condition
31560 works across all connections (concurrent and sequential) from the same client
31561 host. The syntax of the &%ratelimit%& condition is:
31562 .display
31563 &`ratelimit =`& <&'m'&> &`/`& <&'p'&> &`/`& <&'options'&> &`/`& <&'key'&>
31564 .endd
31565 If the average client sending rate is less than &'m'& messages per time
31566 period &'p'& then the condition is false; otherwise it is true.
31567
31568 As a side-effect, the &%ratelimit%& condition sets the expansion variable
31569 &$sender_rate$& to the client's computed rate, &$sender_rate_limit$& to the
31570 configured value of &'m'&, and &$sender_rate_period$& to the configured value
31571 of &'p'&.
31572
31573 The parameter &'p'& is the smoothing time constant, in the form of an Exim
31574 time interval, for example, &`8h`& for eight hours. A larger time constant
31575 means that it takes Exim longer to forget a client's past behaviour. The
31576 parameter &'m'& is the maximum number of messages that a client is permitted to
31577 send in each time interval. It also specifies the number of messages permitted
31578 in a fast burst. By increasing both &'m'& and &'p'& but keeping &'m/p'&
31579 constant, you can allow a client to send more messages in a burst without
31580 changing its long-term sending rate limit. Conversely, if &'m'& and &'p'& are
31581 both small, messages must be sent at an even rate.
31582
31583 There is a script in &_util/ratelimit.pl_& which extracts sending rates from
31584 log files, to assist with choosing appropriate settings for &'m'& and &'p'&
31585 when deploying the &%ratelimit%& ACL condition. The script prints usage
31586 instructions when it is run with no arguments.
31587
31588 The key is used to look up the data for calculating the client's average
31589 sending rate. This data is stored in Exim's spool directory, alongside the
31590 retry and other hints databases. The default key is &$sender_host_address$&,
31591 which means Exim computes the sending rate of each client host IP address.
31592 By changing the key you can change how Exim identifies clients for the purpose
31593 of ratelimiting. For example, to limit the sending rate of each authenticated
31594 user, independent of the computer they are sending from, set the key to
31595 &$authenticated_id$&. You must ensure that the lookup key is meaningful; for
31596 example, &$authenticated_id$& is only meaningful if the client has
31597 authenticated (which you can check with the &%authenticated%& ACL condition).
31598
31599 The lookup key does not have to identify clients: If you want to limit the
31600 rate at which a recipient receives messages, you can use the key
31601 &`$local_part@$domain`& with the &%per_rcpt%& option (see below) in a RCPT
31602 ACL.
31603
31604 Each &%ratelimit%& condition can have up to four options. A &%per_*%& option
31605 specifies what Exim measures the rate of, for example, messages or recipients
31606 or bytes. You can adjust the measurement using the &%unique=%& and/or
31607 &%count=%& options. You can also control when Exim updates the recorded rate
31608 using a &%strict%&, &%leaky%&, or &%readonly%& option. The options are
31609 separated by a slash, like the other parameters. They may appear in any order.
31610
31611 Internally, Exim appends the smoothing constant &'p'& onto the lookup key with
31612 any options that alter the meaning of the stored data. The limit &'m'& is not
31613 stored, so you can alter the configured maximum rate and Exim will still
31614 remember clients' past behaviour. If you change the &%per_*%& mode or add or
31615 remove the &%unique=%& option, the lookup key changes so Exim will forget past
31616 behaviour. The lookup key is not affected by changes to the update mode and
31617 the &%count=%& option.
31618
31619
31620 .section "Ratelimit options for what is being measured" "ratoptmea"
31621 .cindex "rate limiting" "per_* options"
31622 The &%per_conn%& option limits the client's connection rate. It is not
31623 normally used in the &%acl_not_smtp%&, &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&, or
31624 &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACLs.
31625
31626 The &%per_mail%& option limits the client's rate of sending messages. This is
31627 the default if none of the &%per_*%& options is specified. It can be used in
31628 &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&, &%acl_smtp_mime%&,
31629 &%acl_smtp_data%&, or &%acl_not_smtp%&.
31630
31631 The &%per_byte%& option limits the sender's email bandwidth. It can be used in
31632 the same ACLs as the &%per_mail%& option, though it is best to use this option
31633 in the &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_data%& or &%acl_not_smtp%& ACLs; if it is
31634 used in an earlier ACL, Exim relies on the SIZE parameter given by the client
31635 in its MAIL command, which may be inaccurate or completely missing. You can
31636 follow the limit &'m'& in the configuration with K, M, or G to specify limits
31637 in kilobytes, megabytes, or gigabytes, respectively.
31638
31639 The &%per_rcpt%& option causes Exim to limit the rate at which recipients are
31640 accepted. It can be used in the &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&,
31641 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_data%&, or &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& ACLs. In
31642 &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& the rate is updated one recipient at a time; in the other
31643 ACLs the rate is updated with the total (accepted) recipient count in one go. Note that
31644 in either case the rate limiting engine will see a message with many
31645 recipients as a large high-speed burst.
31646
31647 The &%per_addr%& option is like the &%per_rcpt%& option, except it counts the
31648 number of different recipients that the client has sent messages to in the
31649 last time period. That is, if the client repeatedly sends messages to the same
31650 recipient, its measured rate is not increased. This option can only be used in
31651 &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&.
31652
31653 The &%per_cmd%& option causes Exim to recompute the rate every time the
31654 condition is processed. This can be used to limit the rate of any SMTP
31655 command. If it is used in multiple ACLs it can limit the aggregate rate of
31656 multiple different commands.
31657
31658 The &%count=%& option can be used to alter how much Exim adds to the client's
31659 measured rate. For example, the &%per_byte%& option is equivalent to
31660 &`per_mail/count=$message_size`&. If there is no &%count=%& option, Exim
31661 increases the measured rate by one (except for the &%per_rcpt%& option in ACLs
31662 other than &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&). The count does not have to be an integer.
31663
31664 The &%unique=%& option is described in section &<<ratoptuniq>>& below.
31665
31666
31667 .section "Ratelimit update modes" "ratoptupd"
31668 .cindex "rate limiting" "reading data without updating"
31669 You can specify one of three options with the &%ratelimit%& condition to
31670 control when its database is updated. This section describes the &%readonly%&
31671 mode, and the next section describes the &%strict%& and &%leaky%& modes.
31672
31673 If the &%ratelimit%& condition is used in &%readonly%& mode, Exim looks up a
31674 previously-computed rate to check against the limit.
31675
31676 For example, you can test the client's sending rate and deny it access (when
31677 it is too fast) in the connect ACL. If the client passes this check then it
31678 can go on to send a message, in which case its recorded rate will be updated
31679 in the MAIL ACL. Subsequent connections from the same client will check this
31680 new rate.
31681 .code
31682 acl_check_connect:
31683 deny ratelimit = 100 / 5m / readonly
31684 log_message = RATE CHECK: $sender_rate/$sender_rate_period \
31685 (max $sender_rate_limit)
31686 # ...
31687 acl_check_mail:
31688 warn ratelimit = 100 / 5m / strict
31689 log_message = RATE UPDATE: $sender_rate/$sender_rate_period \
31690 (max $sender_rate_limit)
31691 .endd
31692
31693 If Exim encounters multiple &%ratelimit%& conditions with the same key when
31694 processing a message then it may increase the client's measured rate more than
31695 it should. For example, this will happen if you check the &%per_rcpt%& option
31696 in both &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& and &%acl_smtp_data%&. However it's OK to check the
31697 same &%ratelimit%& condition multiple times in the same ACL. You can avoid any
31698 multiple update problems by using the &%readonly%& option on later ratelimit
31699 checks.
31700
31701 The &%per_*%& options described above do not make sense in some ACLs. If you
31702 use a &%per_*%& option in an ACL where it is not normally permitted then the
31703 update mode defaults to &%readonly%& and you cannot specify the &%strict%& or
31704 &%leaky%& modes. In other ACLs the default update mode is &%leaky%& (see the
31705 next section) so you must specify the &%readonly%& option explicitly.
31706
31707
31708 .section "Ratelimit options for handling fast clients" "ratoptfast"
31709 .cindex "rate limiting" "strict and leaky modes"
31710 If a client's average rate is greater than the maximum, the rate limiting
31711 engine can react in two possible ways, depending on the presence of the
31712 &%strict%& or &%leaky%& update modes. This is independent of the other
31713 counter-measures (such as rejecting the message) that may be specified by the
31714 rest of the ACL.
31715
31716 The &%leaky%& (default) option means that the client's recorded rate is not
31717 updated if it is above the limit. The effect of this is that Exim measures the
31718 client's average rate of successfully sent email,
31719 up to the given limit.
31720 This is appropriate if the countermeasure when the condition is true
31721 consists of refusing the message, and
31722 is generally the better choice if you have clients that retry automatically.
31723 If the action when true is anything more complex then this option is
31724 likely not what is wanted.
31725
31726 The &%strict%& option means that the client's recorded rate is always
31727 updated. The effect of this is that Exim measures the client's average rate
31728 of attempts to send email, which can be much higher than the maximum it is
31729 actually allowed. If the client is over the limit it may be subjected to
31730 counter-measures by the ACL. It must slow down and allow sufficient time to
31731 pass that its computed rate falls below the maximum before it can send email
31732 again. The time (the number of smoothing periods) it must wait and not
31733 attempt to send mail can be calculated with this formula:
31734 .code
31735 ln(peakrate/maxrate)
31736 .endd
31737
31738
31739 .section "Limiting the rate of different events" "ratoptuniq"
31740 .cindex "rate limiting" "counting unique events"
31741 The &%ratelimit%& &%unique=%& option controls a mechanism for counting the
31742 rate of different events. For example, the &%per_addr%& option uses this
31743 mechanism to count the number of different recipients that the client has
31744 sent messages to in the last time period; it is equivalent to
31745 &`per_rcpt/unique=$local_part@$domain`&. You could use this feature to
31746 measure the rate that a client uses different sender addresses with the
31747 options &`per_mail/unique=$sender_address`&.
31748
31749 For each &%ratelimit%& key Exim stores the set of &%unique=%& values that it
31750 has seen for that key. The whole set is thrown away when it is older than the
31751 rate smoothing period &'p'&, so each different event is counted at most once
31752 per period. In the &%leaky%& update mode, an event that causes the client to
31753 go over the limit is not added to the set, in the same way that the client's
31754 recorded rate is not updated in the same situation.
31755
31756 When you combine the &%unique=%& and &%readonly%& options, the specific
31757 &%unique=%& value is ignored, and Exim just retrieves the client's stored
31758 rate.
31759
31760 The &%unique=%& mechanism needs more space in the ratelimit database than the
31761 other &%ratelimit%& options in order to store the event set. The number of
31762 unique values is potentially as large as the rate limit, so the extra space
31763 required increases with larger limits.
31764
31765 The uniqueification is not perfect: there is a small probability that Exim
31766 will think a new event has happened before. If the sender's rate is less than
31767 the limit, Exim should be more than 99.9% correct. However in &%strict%& mode
31768 the measured rate can go above the limit, in which case Exim may under-count
31769 events by a significant margin. Fortunately, if the rate is high enough (2.7
31770 times the limit) that the false positive rate goes above 9%, then Exim will
31771 throw away the over-full event set before the measured rate falls below the
31772 limit. Therefore the only harm should be that exceptionally high sending rates
31773 are logged incorrectly; any countermeasures you configure will be as effective
31774 as intended.
31775
31776
31777 .section "Using rate limiting" "useratlim"
31778 Exim's other ACL facilities are used to define what counter-measures are taken
31779 when the rate limit is exceeded. This might be anything from logging a warning
31780 (for example, while measuring existing sending rates in order to define
31781 policy), through time delays to slow down fast senders, up to rejecting the
31782 message. For example:
31783 .code
31784 # Log all senders' rates
31785 warn ratelimit = 0 / 1h / strict
31786 log_message = Sender rate $sender_rate / $sender_rate_period
31787
31788 # Slow down fast senders; note the need to truncate $sender_rate
31789 # at the decimal point.
31790 warn ratelimit = 100 / 1h / per_rcpt / strict
31791 delay = ${eval: ${sg{$sender_rate}{[.].*}{}} - \
31792 $sender_rate_limit }s
31793
31794 # Keep authenticated users under control
31795 deny authenticated = *
31796 ratelimit = 100 / 1d / strict / $authenticated_id
31797
31798 # System-wide rate limit
31799 defer message = Sorry, too busy. Try again later.
31800 ratelimit = 10 / 1s / $primary_hostname
31801
31802 # Restrict incoming rate from each host, with a default
31803 # set using a macro and special cases looked up in a table.
31804 defer message = Sender rate exceeds $sender_rate_limit \
31805 messages per $sender_rate_period
31806 ratelimit = ${lookup {$sender_host_address} \
31807 cdb {DB/ratelimits.cdb} \
31808 {$value} {RATELIMIT} }
31809 .endd
31810 &*Warning*&: If you have a busy server with a lot of &%ratelimit%& tests,
31811 especially with the &%per_rcpt%& option, you may suffer from a performance
31812 bottleneck caused by locking on the ratelimit hints database. Apart from
31813 making your ACLs less complicated, you can reduce the problem by using a
31814 RAM disk for Exim's hints directory (usually &_/var/spool/exim/db/_&). However
31815 this means that Exim will lose its hints data after a reboot (including retry
31816 hints, the callout cache, and ratelimit data).
31817
31818
31819
31820 .section "Address verification" "SECTaddressverification"
31821 .cindex "verifying address" "options for"
31822 .cindex "policy control" "address verification"
31823 Several of the &%verify%& conditions described in section
31824 &<<SECTaclconditions>>& cause addresses to be verified. Section
31825 &<<SECTsenaddver>>& discusses the reporting of sender verification failures.
31826 The verification conditions can be followed by options that modify the
31827 verification process. The options are separated from the keyword and from each
31828 other by slashes, and some of them contain parameters. For example:
31829 .code
31830 verify = sender/callout
31831 verify = recipient/defer_ok/callout=10s,defer_ok
31832 .endd
31833 The first stage of address verification, which always happens, is to run the
31834 address through the routers, in &"verify mode"&. Routers can detect the
31835 difference between verification and routing for delivery, and their actions can
31836 be varied by a number of generic options such as &%verify%& and &%verify_only%&
31837 (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&). If routing fails, verification fails.
31838 The available options are as follows:
31839
31840 .ilist
31841 If the &%callout%& option is specified, successful routing to one or more
31842 remote hosts is followed by a &"callout"& to those hosts as an additional
31843 check. Callouts and their sub-options are discussed in the next section.
31844 .next
31845 If there is a defer error while doing verification routing, the ACL
31846 normally returns &"defer"&. However, if you include &%defer_ok%& in the
31847 options, the condition is forced to be true instead. Note that this is a main
31848 verification option as well as a suboption for callouts.
31849 .next
31850 The &%no_details%& option is covered in section &<<SECTsenaddver>>&, which
31851 discusses the reporting of sender address verification failures.
31852 .next
31853 The &%success_on_redirect%& option causes verification always to succeed
31854 immediately after a successful redirection. By default, if a redirection
31855 generates just one address, that address is also verified. See further
31856 discussion in section &<<SECTredirwhilveri>>&.
31857 .endlist
31858
31859 .cindex "verifying address" "differentiating failures"
31860 .vindex "&$recipient_verify_failure$&"
31861 .vindex "&$sender_verify_failure$&"
31862 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
31863 After an address verification failure, &$acl_verify_message$& contains the
31864 error message that is associated with the failure. It can be preserved by
31865 coding like this:
31866 .code
31867 warn !verify = sender
31868 set acl_m0 = $acl_verify_message
31869 .endd
31870 If you are writing your own custom rejection message or log message when
31871 denying access, you can use this variable to include information about the
31872 verification failure.
31873
31874 In addition, &$sender_verify_failure$& or &$recipient_verify_failure$& (as
31875 appropriate) contains one of the following words:
31876
31877 .ilist
31878 &%qualify%&: The address was unqualified (no domain), and the message
31879 was neither local nor came from an exempted host.
31880 .next
31881 &%route%&: Routing failed.
31882 .next
31883 &%mail%&: Routing succeeded, and a callout was attempted; rejection
31884 occurred at or before the MAIL command (that is, on initial
31885 connection, HELO, or MAIL).
31886 .next
31887 &%recipient%&: The RCPT command in a callout was rejected.
31888 .next
31889 &%postmaster%&: The postmaster check in a callout was rejected.
31890 .endlist
31891
31892 The main use of these variables is expected to be to distinguish between
31893 rejections of MAIL and rejections of RCPT in callouts.
31894
31895 The above variables may also be set after a &*successful*&
31896 address verification to:
31897
31898 .ilist
31899 &%random%&: A random local-part callout succeeded
31900 .endlist
31901
31902
31903
31904
31905 .section "Callout verification" "SECTcallver"
31906 .cindex "verifying address" "by callout"
31907 .cindex "callout" "verification"
31908 .cindex "SMTP" "callout verification"
31909 For non-local addresses, routing verifies the domain, but is unable to do any
31910 checking of the local part. There are situations where some means of verifying
31911 the local part is desirable. One way this can be done is to make an SMTP
31912 &'callback'& to a delivery host for the sender address or a &'callforward'& to
31913 a subsequent host for a recipient address, to see if the host accepts the
31914 address. We use the term &'callout'& to cover both cases. Note that for a
31915 sender address, the callback is not to the client host that is trying to
31916 deliver the message, but to one of the hosts that accepts incoming mail for the
31917 sender's domain.
31918
31919 Exim does not do callouts by default. If you want them to happen, you must
31920 request them by setting appropriate options on the &%verify%& condition, as
31921 described below. This facility should be used with care, because it can add a
31922 lot of resource usage to the cost of verifying an address. However, Exim does
31923 cache the results of callouts, which helps to reduce the cost. Details of
31924 caching are in section &<<SECTcallvercache>>&.
31925
31926 Recipient callouts are usually used only between hosts that are controlled by
31927 the same administration. For example, a corporate gateway host could use
31928 callouts to check for valid recipients on an internal mailserver. A successful
31929 callout does not guarantee that a real delivery to the address would succeed;
31930 on the other hand, a failing callout does guarantee that a delivery would fail.
31931
31932 If the &%callout%& option is present on a condition that verifies an address, a
31933 second stage of verification occurs if the address is successfully routed to
31934 one or more remote hosts. The usual case is routing by a &(dnslookup)& or a
31935 &(manualroute)& router, where the router specifies the hosts. However, if a
31936 router that does not set up hosts routes to an &(smtp)& transport with a
31937 &%hosts%& setting, the transport's hosts are used. If an &(smtp)& transport has
31938 &%hosts_override%& set, its hosts are always used, whether or not the router
31939 supplies a host list.
31940 Callouts are only supported on &(smtp)& transports.
31941
31942 The port that is used is taken from the transport, if it is specified and is a
31943 remote transport. (For routers that do verification only, no transport need be
31944 specified.) Otherwise, the default SMTP port is used. If a remote transport
31945 specifies an outgoing interface, this is used; otherwise the interface is not
31946 specified. Likewise, the text that is used for the HELO command is taken from
31947 the transport's &%helo_data%& option; if there is no transport, the value of
31948 &$smtp_active_hostname$& is used.
31949
31950 For a sender callout check, Exim makes SMTP connections to the remote hosts, to
31951 test whether a bounce message could be delivered to the sender address. The
31952 following SMTP commands are sent:
31953 .display
31954 &`HELO `&<&'local host name'&>
31955 &`MAIL FROM:<>`&
31956 &`RCPT TO:`&<&'the address to be tested'&>
31957 &`QUIT`&
31958 .endd
31959 LHLO is used instead of HELO if the transport's &%protocol%& option is
31960 set to &"lmtp"&.
31961
31962 The callout may use EHLO, AUTH and/or STARTTLS given appropriate option
31963 settings.
31964
31965 A recipient callout check is similar. By default, it also uses an empty address
31966 for the sender. This default is chosen because most hosts do not make use of
31967 the sender address when verifying a recipient. Using the same address means
31968 that a single cache entry can be used for each recipient. Some sites, however,
31969 do make use of the sender address when verifying. These are catered for by the
31970 &%use_sender%& and &%use_postmaster%& options, described in the next section.
31971
31972 If the response to the RCPT command is a 2&'xx'& code, the verification
31973 succeeds. If it is 5&'xx'&, the verification fails. For any other condition,
31974 Exim tries the next host, if any. If there is a problem with all the remote
31975 hosts, the ACL yields &"defer"&, unless the &%defer_ok%& parameter of the
31976 &%callout%& option is given, in which case the condition is forced to succeed.
31977
31978 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for callout"
31979 A callout may take a little time. For this reason, Exim normally flushes SMTP
31980 output before performing a callout in an ACL, to avoid unexpected timeouts in
31981 clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in use. The flushing can be
31982 disabled by using a &%control%& modifier to set &%no_callout_flush%&.
31983
31984
31985
31986
31987 .section "Additional parameters for callouts" "CALLaddparcall"
31988 .cindex "callout" "additional parameters for"
31989 The &%callout%& option can be followed by an equals sign and a number of
31990 optional parameters, separated by commas. For example:
31991 .code
31992 verify = recipient/callout=10s,defer_ok
31993 .endd
31994 The old syntax, which had &%callout_defer_ok%& and &%check_postmaster%& as
31995 separate verify options, is retained for backwards compatibility, but is now
31996 deprecated. The additional parameters for &%callout%& are as follows:
31997
31998
31999 .vlist
32000 .vitem <&'a&~time&~interval'&>
32001 .cindex "callout" "timeout, specifying"
32002 This specifies the timeout that applies for the callout attempt to each host.
32003 For example:
32004 .code
32005 verify = sender/callout=5s
32006 .endd
32007 The default is 30 seconds. The timeout is used for each response from the
32008 remote host. It is also used for the initial connection, unless overridden by
32009 the &%connect%& parameter.
32010
32011
32012 .vitem &*connect&~=&~*&<&'time&~interval'&>
32013 .cindex "callout" "connection timeout, specifying"
32014 This parameter makes it possible to set a different (usually smaller) timeout
32015 for making the SMTP connection. For example:
32016 .code
32017 verify = sender/callout=5s,connect=1s
32018 .endd
32019 If not specified, this timeout defaults to the general timeout value.
32020
32021 .vitem &*defer_ok*&
32022 .cindex "callout" "defer, action on"
32023 When this parameter is present, failure to contact any host, or any other kind
32024 of temporary error, is treated as success by the ACL. However, the cache is not
32025 updated in this circumstance.
32026
32027 .vitem &*fullpostmaster*&
32028 .cindex "callout" "full postmaster check"
32029 This operates like the &%postmaster%& option (see below), but if the check for
32030 &'postmaster@domain'& fails, it tries just &'postmaster'&, without a domain, in
32031 accordance with the specification in RFC 2821. The RFC states that the
32032 unqualified address &'postmaster'& should be accepted.
32033
32034
32035 .vitem &*mailfrom&~=&~*&<&'email&~address'&>
32036 .cindex "callout" "sender when verifying header"
32037 When verifying addresses in header lines using the &%header_sender%&
32038 verification option, Exim behaves by default as if the addresses are envelope
32039 sender addresses from a message. Callout verification therefore tests to see
32040 whether a bounce message could be delivered, by using an empty address in the
32041 MAIL command. However, it is arguable that these addresses might never be used
32042 as envelope senders, and could therefore justifiably reject bounce messages
32043 (empty senders). The &%mailfrom%& callout parameter allows you to specify what
32044 address to use in the MAIL command. For example:
32045 .code
32046 require verify = header_sender/callout=mailfrom=abcd@x.y.z
32047 .endd
32048 This parameter is available only for the &%header_sender%& verification option.
32049
32050
32051 .vitem &*maxwait&~=&~*&<&'time&~interval'&>
32052 .cindex "callout" "overall timeout, specifying"
32053 This parameter sets an overall timeout for performing a callout verification.
32054 For example:
32055 .code
32056 verify = sender/callout=5s,maxwait=30s
32057 .endd
32058 This timeout defaults to four times the callout timeout for individual SMTP
32059 commands. The overall timeout applies when there is more than one host that can
32060 be tried. The timeout is checked before trying the next host. This prevents
32061 very long delays if there are a large number of hosts and all are timing out
32062 (for example, when network connections are timing out).
32063
32064
32065 .vitem &*no_cache*&
32066 .cindex "callout" "cache, suppressing"
32067 .cindex "caching callout, suppressing"
32068 When this parameter is given, the callout cache is neither read nor updated.
32069
32070 .vitem &*postmaster*&
32071 .cindex "callout" "postmaster; checking"
32072 When this parameter is set, a successful callout check is followed by a similar
32073 check for the local part &'postmaster'& at the same domain. If this address is
32074 rejected, the callout fails (but see &%fullpostmaster%& above). The result of
32075 the postmaster check is recorded in a cache record; if it is a failure, this is
32076 used to fail subsequent callouts for the domain without a connection being
32077 made, until the cache record expires.
32078
32079 .vitem &*postmaster_mailfrom&~=&~*&<&'email&~address'&>
32080 The postmaster check uses an empty sender in the MAIL command by default.
32081 You can use this parameter to do a postmaster check using a different address.
32082 For example:
32083 .code
32084 require verify = sender/callout=postmaster_mailfrom=abc@x.y.z
32085 .endd
32086 If both &%postmaster%& and &%postmaster_mailfrom%& are present, the rightmost
32087 one overrides. The &%postmaster%& parameter is equivalent to this example:
32088 .code
32089 require verify = sender/callout=postmaster_mailfrom=
32090 .endd
32091 &*Warning*&: The caching arrangements for postmaster checking do not take
32092 account of the sender address. It is assumed that either the empty address or
32093 a fixed non-empty address will be used. All that Exim remembers is that the
32094 postmaster check for the domain succeeded or failed.
32095
32096
32097 .vitem &*random*&
32098 .cindex "callout" "&""random""& check"
32099 When this parameter is set, before doing the normal callout check, Exim does a
32100 check for a &"random"& local part at the same domain. The local part is not
32101 really random &-- it is defined by the expansion of the option
32102 &%callout_random_local_part%&, which defaults to
32103 .code
32104 $primary_hostname-$tod_epoch-testing
32105 .endd
32106 The idea here is to try to determine whether the remote host accepts all local
32107 parts without checking. If it does, there is no point in doing callouts for
32108 specific local parts. If the &"random"& check succeeds, the result is saved in
32109 a cache record, and used to force the current and subsequent callout checks to
32110 succeed without a connection being made, until the cache record expires.
32111
32112 .vitem &*use_postmaster*&
32113 .cindex "callout" "sender for recipient check"
32114 This parameter applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
32115 .code
32116 deny !verify = recipient/callout=use_postmaster
32117 .endd
32118 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
32119 It causes a non-empty postmaster address to be used in the MAIL command when
32120 performing the callout for the recipient, and also for a &"random"& check if
32121 that is configured. The local part of the address is &`postmaster`& and the
32122 domain is the contents of &$qualify_domain$&.
32123
32124 .vitem &*use_sender*&
32125 This option applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
32126 .code
32127 require verify = recipient/callout=use_sender
32128 .endd
32129 It causes the message's actual sender address to be used in the MAIL
32130 command when performing the callout, instead of an empty address. There is no
32131 need to use this option unless you know that the called hosts make use of the
32132 sender when checking recipients. If used indiscriminately, it reduces the
32133 usefulness of callout caching.
32134
32135 .vitem &*hold*&
32136 This option applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
32137 .code
32138 require verify = recipient/callout=use_sender,hold
32139 .endd
32140 It causes the connection to be held open and used for any further recipients
32141 and for eventual delivery (should that be done quickly).
32142 Doing this saves on TCP and SMTP startup costs, and TLS costs also
32143 when that is used for the connections.
32144 The advantage is only gained if there are no callout cache hits
32145 (which could be enforced by the no_cache option),
32146 if the use_sender option is used,
32147 if neither the random nor the use_postmaster option is used,
32148 and if no other callouts intervene.
32149 .endlist
32150
32151 If you use any of the parameters that set a non-empty sender for the MAIL
32152 command (&%mailfrom%&, &%postmaster_mailfrom%&, &%use_postmaster%&, or
32153 &%use_sender%&), you should think about possible loops. Recipient checking is
32154 usually done between two hosts that are under the same management, and the host
32155 that receives the callouts is not normally configured to do callouts itself.
32156 Therefore, it is normally safe to use &%use_postmaster%& or &%use_sender%& in
32157 these circumstances.
32158
32159 However, if you use a non-empty sender address for a callout to an arbitrary
32160 host, there is the likelihood that the remote host will itself initiate a
32161 callout check back to your host. As it is checking what appears to be a message
32162 sender, it is likely to use an empty address in MAIL, thus avoiding a
32163 callout loop. However, to be on the safe side it would be best to set up your
32164 own ACLs so that they do not do sender verification checks when the recipient
32165 is the address you use for header sender or postmaster callout checking.
32166
32167 Another issue to think about when using non-empty senders for callouts is
32168 caching. When you set &%mailfrom%& or &%use_sender%&, the cache record is keyed
32169 by the sender/recipient combination; thus, for any given recipient, many more
32170 actual callouts are performed than when an empty sender or postmaster is used.
32171
32172
32173
32174
32175 .section "Callout caching" "SECTcallvercache"
32176 .cindex "hints database" "callout cache"
32177 .cindex "callout" "cache, description of"
32178 .cindex "caching" "callout"
32179 Exim caches the results of callouts in order to reduce the amount of resources
32180 used, unless you specify the &%no_cache%& parameter with the &%callout%&
32181 option. A hints database called &"callout"& is used for the cache. Two
32182 different record types are used: one records the result of a callout check for
32183 a specific address, and the other records information that applies to the
32184 entire domain (for example, that it accepts the local part &'postmaster'&).
32185
32186 When an original callout fails, a detailed SMTP error message is given about
32187 the failure. However, for subsequent failures use the cache data, this message
32188 is not available.
32189
32190 The expiry times for negative and positive address cache records are
32191 independent, and can be set by the global options &%callout_negative_expire%&
32192 (default 2h) and &%callout_positive_expire%& (default 24h), respectively.
32193
32194 If a host gives a negative response to an SMTP connection, or rejects any
32195 commands up to and including
32196 .code
32197 MAIL FROM:<>
32198 .endd
32199 (but not including the MAIL command with a non-empty address),
32200 any callout attempt is bound to fail. Exim remembers such failures in a
32201 domain cache record, which it uses to fail callouts for the domain without
32202 making new connections, until the domain record times out. There are two
32203 separate expiry times for domain cache records:
32204 &%callout_domain_negative_expire%& (default 3h) and
32205 &%callout_domain_positive_expire%& (default 7d).
32206
32207 Domain records expire when the negative expiry time is reached if callouts
32208 cannot be made for the domain, or if the postmaster check failed.
32209 Otherwise, they expire when the positive expiry time is reached. This
32210 ensures that, for example, a host that stops accepting &"random"& local parts
32211 will eventually be noticed.
32212
32213 The callout caching mechanism is based on the domain of the address that is
32214 being tested. If the domain routes to several hosts, it is assumed that their
32215 behaviour will be the same.
32216
32217
32218
32219 .section "Sender address verification reporting" "SECTsenaddver"
32220 .cindex "verifying" "suppressing error details"
32221 See section &<<SECTaddressverification>>& for a general discussion of
32222 verification. When sender verification fails in an ACL, the details of the
32223 failure are given as additional output lines before the 550 response to the
32224 relevant SMTP command (RCPT or DATA). For example, if sender callout is in use,
32225 you might see:
32226 .code
32227 MAIL FROM:<xyz@abc.example>
32228 250 OK
32229 RCPT TO:<pqr@def.example>
32230 550-Verification failed for <xyz@abc.example>
32231 550-Called: 192.168.34.43
32232 550-Sent: RCPT TO:<xyz@abc.example>
32233 550-Response: 550 Unknown local part xyz in <xyz@abc.example>
32234 550 Sender verification failed
32235 .endd
32236 If more than one RCPT command fails in the same way, the details are given
32237 only for the first of them. However, some administrators do not want to send
32238 out this much information. You can suppress the details by adding
32239 &`/no_details`& to the ACL statement that requests sender verification. For
32240 example:
32241 .code
32242 verify = sender/no_details
32243 .endd
32244
32245 .section "Redirection while verifying" "SECTredirwhilveri"
32246 .cindex "verifying" "redirection while"
32247 .cindex "address redirection" "while verifying"
32248 A dilemma arises when a local address is redirected by aliasing or forwarding
32249 during verification: should the generated addresses themselves be verified,
32250 or should the successful expansion of the original address be enough to verify
32251 it? By default, Exim takes the following pragmatic approach:
32252
32253 .ilist
32254 When an incoming address is redirected to just one child address, verification
32255 continues with the child address, and if that fails to verify, the original
32256 verification also fails.
32257 .next
32258 When an incoming address is redirected to more than one child address,
32259 verification does not continue. A success result is returned.
32260 .endlist
32261
32262 This seems the most reasonable behaviour for the common use of aliasing as a
32263 way of redirecting different local parts to the same mailbox. It means, for
32264 example, that a pair of alias entries of the form
32265 .code
32266 A.Wol: aw123
32267 aw123: :fail: Gone away, no forwarding address
32268 .endd
32269 work as expected, with both local parts causing verification failure. When a
32270 redirection generates more than one address, the behaviour is more like a
32271 mailing list, where the existence of the alias itself is sufficient for
32272 verification to succeed.
32273
32274 It is possible, however, to change the default behaviour so that all successful
32275 redirections count as successful verifications, however many new addresses are
32276 generated. This is specified by the &%success_on_redirect%& verification
32277 option. For example:
32278 .code
32279 require verify = recipient/success_on_redirect/callout=10s
32280 .endd
32281 In this example, verification succeeds if a router generates a new address, and
32282 the callout does not occur, because no address was routed to a remote host.
32283
32284 When verification is being tested via the &%-bv%& option, the treatment of
32285 redirections is as just described, unless the &%-v%& or any debugging option is
32286 also specified. In that case, full verification is done for every generated
32287 address and a report is output for each of them.
32288
32289
32290
32291 .section "Client SMTP authorization (CSA)" "SECTverifyCSA"
32292 .cindex "CSA" "verifying"
32293 Client SMTP Authorization is a system that allows a site to advertise
32294 which machines are and are not permitted to send email. This is done by placing
32295 special SRV records in the DNS; these are looked up using the client's HELO
32296 domain. At the time of writing, CSA is still an Internet Draft. Client SMTP
32297 Authorization checks in Exim are performed by the ACL condition:
32298 .code
32299 verify = csa
32300 .endd
32301 This fails if the client is not authorized. If there is a DNS problem, or if no
32302 valid CSA SRV record is found, or if the client is authorized, the condition
32303 succeeds. These three cases can be distinguished using the expansion variable
32304 &$csa_status$&, which can take one of the values &"fail"&, &"defer"&,
32305 &"unknown"&, or &"ok"&. The condition does not itself defer because that would
32306 be likely to cause problems for legitimate email.
32307
32308 The error messages produced by the CSA code include slightly more
32309 detail. If &$csa_status$& is &"defer"&, this may be because of problems
32310 looking up the CSA SRV record, or problems looking up the CSA target
32311 address record. There are four reasons for &$csa_status$& being &"fail"&:
32312
32313 .ilist
32314 The client's host name is explicitly not authorized.
32315 .next
32316 The client's IP address does not match any of the CSA target IP addresses.
32317 .next
32318 The client's host name is authorized but it has no valid target IP addresses
32319 (for example, the target's addresses are IPv6 and the client is using IPv4).
32320 .next
32321 The client's host name has no CSA SRV record but a parent domain has asserted
32322 that all subdomains must be explicitly authorized.
32323 .endlist
32324
32325 The &%csa%& verification condition can take an argument which is the domain to
32326 use for the DNS query. The default is:
32327 .code
32328 verify = csa/$sender_helo_name
32329 .endd
32330 This implementation includes an extension to CSA. If the query domain
32331 is an address literal such as [192.0.2.95], or if it is a bare IP
32332 address, Exim searches for CSA SRV records in the reverse DNS as if
32333 the HELO domain was (for example) &'95.2.0.192.in-addr.arpa'&. Therefore it is
32334 meaningful to say:
32335 .code
32336 verify = csa/$sender_host_address
32337 .endd
32338 In fact, this is the check that Exim performs if the client does not say HELO.
32339 This extension can be turned off by setting the main configuration option
32340 &%dns_csa_use_reverse%& to be false.
32341
32342 If a CSA SRV record is not found for the domain itself, a search
32343 is performed through its parent domains for a record which might be
32344 making assertions about subdomains. The maximum depth of this search is limited
32345 using the main configuration option &%dns_csa_search_limit%&, which is 5 by
32346 default. Exim does not look for CSA SRV records in a top level domain, so the
32347 default settings handle HELO domains as long as seven
32348 (&'hostname.five.four.three.two.one.com'&). This encompasses the vast majority
32349 of legitimate HELO domains.
32350
32351 The &'dnsdb'& lookup also has support for CSA. Although &'dnsdb'& also supports
32352 direct SRV lookups, this is not sufficient because of the extra parent domain
32353 search behaviour of CSA, and (as with PTR lookups) &'dnsdb'& also turns IP
32354 addresses into lookups in the reverse DNS space. The result of a successful
32355 lookup such as:
32356 .code
32357 ${lookup dnsdb {csa=$sender_helo_name}}
32358 .endd
32359 has two space-separated fields: an authorization code and a target host name.
32360 The authorization code can be &"Y"& for yes, &"N"& for no, &"X"& for explicit
32361 authorization required but absent, or &"?"& for unknown.
32362
32363
32364
32365
32366 .section "Bounce address tag validation" "SECTverifyPRVS"
32367 .cindex "BATV, verifying"
32368 Bounce address tag validation (BATV) is a scheme whereby the envelope senders
32369 of outgoing messages have a cryptographic, timestamped &"tag"& added to them.
32370 Genuine incoming bounce messages should therefore always be addressed to
32371 recipients that have a valid tag. This scheme is a way of detecting unwanted
32372 bounce messages caused by sender address forgeries (often called &"collateral
32373 spam"&), because the recipients of such messages do not include valid tags.
32374
32375 There are two expansion items to help with the implementation of the BATV
32376 &"prvs"& (private signature) scheme in an Exim configuration. This scheme signs
32377 the original envelope sender address by using a simple key to add a hash of the
32378 address and some time-based randomizing information. The &%prvs%& expansion
32379 item creates a signed address, and the &%prvscheck%& expansion item checks one.
32380 The syntax of these expansion items is described in section
32381 &<<SECTexpansionitems>>&.
32382 The validity period on signed addresses is seven days.
32383
32384 As an example, suppose the secret per-address keys are stored in an MySQL
32385 database. A query to look up the key for an address could be defined as a macro
32386 like this:
32387 .code
32388 PRVSCHECK_SQL = ${lookup mysql{SELECT secret FROM batv_prvs \
32389 WHERE sender='${quote_mysql:$prvscheck_address}'\
32390 }{$value}}
32391 .endd
32392 Suppose also that the senders who make use of BATV are defined by an address
32393 list called &%batv_senders%&. Then, in the ACL for RCPT commands, you could
32394 use this:
32395 .code
32396 # Bounces: drop unsigned addresses for BATV senders
32397 deny message = This address does not send an unsigned reverse path
32398 senders = :
32399 recipients = +batv_senders
32400
32401 # Bounces: In case of prvs-signed address, check signature.
32402 deny message = Invalid reverse path signature.
32403 senders = :
32404 condition = ${prvscheck {$local_part@$domain}\
32405 {PRVSCHECK_SQL}{1}}
32406 !condition = $prvscheck_result
32407 .endd
32408 The first statement rejects recipients for bounce messages that are addressed
32409 to plain BATV sender addresses, because it is known that BATV senders do not
32410 send out messages with plain sender addresses. The second statement rejects
32411 recipients that are prvs-signed, but with invalid signatures (either because
32412 the key is wrong, or the signature has timed out).
32413
32414 A non-prvs-signed address is not rejected by the second statement, because the
32415 &%prvscheck%& expansion yields an empty string if its first argument is not a
32416 prvs-signed address, thus causing the &%condition%& condition to be false. If
32417 the first argument is a syntactically valid prvs-signed address, the yield is
32418 the third string (in this case &"1"&), whether or not the cryptographic and
32419 timeout checks succeed. The &$prvscheck_result$& variable contains the result
32420 of the checks (empty for failure, &"1"& for success).
32421
32422 There is one more issue you must consider when implementing prvs-signing:
32423 you have to ensure that the routers accept prvs-signed addresses and
32424 deliver them correctly. The easiest way to handle this is to use a &(redirect)&
32425 router to remove the signature with a configuration along these lines:
32426 .code
32427 batv_redirect:
32428 driver = redirect
32429 data = ${prvscheck {$local_part@$domain}{PRVSCHECK_SQL}}
32430 .endd
32431 This works because, if the third argument of &%prvscheck%& is empty, the result
32432 of the expansion of a prvs-signed address is the decoded value of the original
32433 address. This router should probably be the first of your routers that handles
32434 local addresses.
32435
32436 To create BATV-signed addresses in the first place, a transport of this form
32437 can be used:
32438 .code
32439 external_smtp_batv:
32440 driver = smtp
32441 return_path = ${prvs {$return_path} \
32442 {${lookup mysql{SELECT \
32443 secret FROM batv_prvs WHERE \
32444 sender='${quote_mysql:$sender_address}'} \
32445 {$value}fail}}}
32446 .endd
32447 If no key can be found for the existing return path, no signing takes place.
32448
32449
32450
32451 .section "Using an ACL to control relaying" "SECTrelaycontrol"
32452 .cindex "&ACL;" "relay control"
32453 .cindex "relaying" "control by ACL"
32454 .cindex "policy control" "relay control"
32455 An MTA is said to &'relay'& a message if it receives it from some host and
32456 delivers it directly to another host as a result of a remote address contained
32457 within it. Redirecting a local address via an alias or forward file and then
32458 passing the message on to another host is not relaying,
32459 .cindex "&""percent hack""&"
32460 but a redirection as a result of the &"percent hack"& is.
32461
32462 Two kinds of relaying exist, which are termed &"incoming"& and &"outgoing"&.
32463 A host which is acting as a gateway or an MX backup is concerned with incoming
32464 relaying from arbitrary hosts to a specific set of domains. On the other hand,
32465 a host which is acting as a smart host for a number of clients is concerned
32466 with outgoing relaying from those clients to the Internet at large. Often the
32467 same host is fulfilling both functions,
32468 . ///
32469 . as illustrated in the diagram below,
32470 . ///
32471 but in principle these two kinds of relaying are entirely independent. What is
32472 not wanted is the transmission of mail from arbitrary remote hosts through your
32473 system to arbitrary domains.
32474
32475
32476 You can implement relay control by means of suitable statements in the ACL that
32477 runs for each RCPT command. For convenience, it is often easiest to use
32478 Exim's named list facility to define the domains and hosts involved. For
32479 example, suppose you want to do the following:
32480
32481 .ilist
32482 Deliver a number of domains to mailboxes on the local host (or process them
32483 locally in some other way). Let's say these are &'my.dom1.example'& and
32484 &'my.dom2.example'&.
32485 .next
32486 Relay mail for a number of other domains for which you are the secondary MX.
32487 These might be &'friend1.example'& and &'friend2.example'&.
32488 .next
32489 Relay mail from the hosts on your local LAN, to whatever domains are involved.
32490 Suppose your LAN is 192.168.45.0/24.
32491 .endlist
32492
32493
32494 In the main part of the configuration, you put the following definitions:
32495 .code
32496 domainlist local_domains = my.dom1.example : my.dom2.example
32497 domainlist relay_to_domains = friend1.example : friend2.example
32498 hostlist relay_from_hosts = 192.168.45.0/24
32499 .endd
32500 Now you can use these definitions in the ACL that is run for every RCPT
32501 command:
32502 .code
32503 acl_check_rcpt:
32504 accept domains = +local_domains : +relay_to_domains
32505 accept hosts = +relay_from_hosts
32506 .endd
32507 The first statement accepts any RCPT command that contains an address in
32508 the local or relay domains. For any other domain, control passes to the second
32509 statement, which accepts the command only if it comes from one of the relay
32510 hosts. In practice, you will probably want to make your ACL more sophisticated
32511 than this, for example, by including sender and recipient verification. The
32512 default configuration includes a more comprehensive example, which is described
32513 in chapter &<<CHAPdefconfil>>&.
32514
32515
32516
32517 .section "Checking a relay configuration" "SECTcheralcon"
32518 .cindex "relaying" "checking control of"
32519 You can check the relay characteristics of your configuration in the same way
32520 that you can test any ACL behaviour for an incoming SMTP connection, by using
32521 the &%-bh%& option to run a fake SMTP session with which you interact.
32522 .ecindex IIDacl
32523
32524
32525
32526 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32527 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32528
32529 .chapter "Content scanning at ACL time" "CHAPexiscan"
32530 .scindex IIDcosca "content scanning" "at ACL time"
32531 The extension of Exim to include content scanning at ACL time, formerly known
32532 as &"exiscan"&, was originally implemented as a patch by Tom Kistner. The code
32533 was integrated into the main source for Exim release 4.50, and Tom continues to
32534 maintain it. Most of the wording of this chapter is taken from Tom's
32535 specification.
32536
32537 It is also possible to scan the content of messages at other times. The
32538 &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&) allows for content
32539 scanning after all the ACLs have run. A transport filter can be used to scan
32540 messages at delivery time (see the &%transport_filter%& option, described in
32541 chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
32542
32543 If you want to include the ACL-time content-scanning features when you compile
32544 Exim, you need to arrange for WITH_CONTENT_SCAN to be defined in your
32545 &_Local/Makefile_&. When you do that, the Exim binary is built with:
32546
32547 .ilist
32548 Two additional ACLs (&%acl_smtp_mime%& and &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&) that are run
32549 for all MIME parts for SMTP and non-SMTP messages, respectively.
32550 .next
32551 Additional ACL conditions and modifiers: &%decode%&, &%malware%&,
32552 &%mime_regex%&, &%regex%&, and &%spam%&. These can be used in the ACL that is
32553 run at the end of message reception (the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL).
32554 .next
32555 An additional control feature (&"no_mbox_unspool"&) that saves spooled copies
32556 of messages, or parts of messages, for debugging purposes.
32557 .next
32558 Additional expansion variables that are set in the new ACL and by the new
32559 conditions.
32560 .next
32561 Two new main configuration options: &%av_scanner%& and &%spamd_address%&.
32562 .endlist
32563
32564 Content-scanning is continually evolving, and new features are still being
32565 added. While such features are still unstable and liable to incompatible
32566 changes, they are made available in Exim by setting options whose names begin
32567 EXPERIMENTAL_ in &_Local/Makefile_&. Such features are not documented in
32568 this manual. You can find out about them by reading the file called
32569 &_doc/experimental.txt_&.
32570
32571 All the content-scanning facilities work on a MBOX copy of the message that is
32572 temporarily created in a file called:
32573 .display
32574 <&'spool_directory'&>&`/scan/`&<&'message_id'&>/<&'message_id'&>&`.eml`&
32575 .endd
32576 The &_.eml_& extension is a friendly hint to virus scanners that they can
32577 expect an MBOX-like structure inside that file. The file is created when the
32578 first content scanning facility is called. Subsequent calls to content
32579 scanning conditions open the same file again. The directory is recursively
32580 removed when the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL has finished running, unless
32581 .code
32582 control = no_mbox_unspool
32583 .endd
32584 has been encountered. When the MIME ACL decodes files, they are put into the
32585 same directory by default.
32586
32587
32588
32589 .section "Scanning for viruses" "SECTscanvirus"
32590 .cindex "virus scanning"
32591 .cindex "content scanning" "for viruses"
32592 .cindex "content scanning" "the &%malware%& condition"
32593 The &%malware%& ACL condition lets you connect virus scanner software to Exim.
32594 It supports a &"generic"& interface to scanners called via the shell, and
32595 specialized interfaces for &"daemon"& type virus scanners, which are resident
32596 in memory and thus are much faster.
32597
32598 A timeout of 2 minutes is applied to a scanner call (by default);
32599 if it expires then a defer action is taken.
32600
32601 .oindex "&%av_scanner%&"
32602 You can set the &%av_scanner%& option in the main part of the configuration
32603 to specify which scanner to use, together with any additional options that
32604 are needed. The basic syntax is as follows:
32605 .display
32606 &`av_scanner = <`&&'scanner-type'&&`>:<`&&'option1'&&`>:<`&&'option2'&&`>:[...]`&
32607 .endd
32608 If you do not set &%av_scanner%&, it defaults to
32609 .code
32610 av_scanner = sophie:/var/run/sophie
32611 .endd
32612 If the value of &%av_scanner%& starts with a dollar character, it is expanded
32613 before use.
32614 The usual list-parsing of the content (see &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&) applies.
32615 The following scanner types are supported in this release,
32616 though individual ones can be included or not at build time:
32617
32618 .vlist
32619 .vitem &%avast%&
32620 .cindex "virus scanners" "avast"
32621 This is the scanner daemon of Avast. It has been tested with Avast Core
32622 Security (currently at version 2.2.0).
32623 You can get a trial version at &url(https://www.avast.com) or for Linux
32624 at &url(https://www.avast.com/linux-server-antivirus).
32625 This scanner type takes one option,
32626 which can be either a full path to a UNIX socket,
32627 or host and port specifiers separated by white space.
32628 The host may be a name or an IP address; the port is either a
32629 single number or a pair of numbers with a dash between.
32630 A list of options may follow. These options are interpreted on the
32631 Exim's side of the malware scanner, or are given on separate lines to
32632 the daemon as options before the main scan command.
32633
32634 .cindex &`pass_unscanned`& "avast"
32635 If &`pass_unscanned`&
32636 is set, any files the Avast scanner can't scan (e.g.
32637 decompression bombs, or invalid archives) are considered clean. Use with
32638 care.
32639
32640 For example:
32641 .code
32642 av_scanner = avast:/var/run/avast/scan.sock:FLAGS -fullfiles:SENSITIVITY -pup
32643 av_scanner = avast:/var/run/avast/scan.sock:pass_unscanned:FLAGS -fullfiles:SENSITIVITY -pup
32644 av_scanner = avast:192.168.2.22 5036
32645 .endd
32646 If you omit the argument, the default path
32647 &_/var/run/avast/scan.sock_&
32648 is used.
32649 If you use a remote host,
32650 you need to make Exim's spool directory available to it,
32651 as the scanner is passed a file path, not file contents.
32652 For information about available commands and their options you may use
32653 .code
32654 $ socat UNIX:/var/run/avast/scan.sock STDIO:
32655 FLAGS
32656 SENSITIVITY
32657 PACK
32658 .endd
32659
32660 If the scanner returns a temporary failure (e.g. license issues, or
32661 permission problems), the message is deferred and a paniclog entry is
32662 written. The usual &`defer_ok`& option is available.
32663
32664 .vitem &%aveserver%&
32665 .cindex "virus scanners" "Kaspersky"
32666 This is the scanner daemon of Kaspersky Version 5. You can get a trial version
32667 at &url(https://www.kaspersky.com/). This scanner type takes one option,
32668 which is the path to the daemon's UNIX socket. The default is shown in this
32669 example:
32670 .code
32671 av_scanner = aveserver:/var/run/aveserver
32672 .endd
32673
32674
32675 .vitem &%clamd%&
32676 .cindex "virus scanners" "clamd"
32677 This daemon-type scanner is GPL and free. You can get it at
32678 &url(https://www.clamav.net/). Some older versions of clamd do not seem to
32679 unpack MIME containers, so it used to be recommended to unpack MIME attachments
32680 in the MIME ACL. This is no longer believed to be necessary.
32681
32682 The options are a list of server specifiers, which may be
32683 a UNIX socket specification,
32684 a TCP socket specification,
32685 or a (global) option.
32686
32687 A socket specification consists of a space-separated list.
32688 For a Unix socket the first element is a full path for the socket,
32689 for a TCP socket the first element is the IP address
32690 and the second a port number,
32691 Any further elements are per-server (non-global) options.
32692 These per-server options are supported:
32693 .code
32694 retry=<timespec> Retry on connect fail
32695 .endd
32696
32697 The &`retry`& option specifies a time after which a single retry for
32698 a failed connect is made. The default is to not retry.
32699
32700 If a Unix socket file is specified, only one server is supported.
32701
32702 Examples:
32703 .code
32704 av_scanner = clamd:/opt/clamd/socket
32705 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234
32706 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234:local
32707 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234 retry=10s
32708 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234 : 192.0.2.4 1234
32709 .endd
32710 If the value of av_scanner points to a UNIX socket file or contains the
32711 &`local`&
32712 option, then the ClamAV interface will pass a filename containing the data
32713 to be scanned, which should normally result in less I/O happening and be
32714 more efficient. Normally in the TCP case, the data is streamed to ClamAV as
32715 Exim does not assume that there is a common filesystem with the remote host.
32716
32717 The final example shows that multiple TCP targets can be specified. Exim will
32718 randomly use one for each incoming email (i.e. it load balances them). Note
32719 that only TCP targets may be used if specifying a list of scanners; a UNIX
32720 socket cannot be mixed in with TCP targets. If one of the servers becomes
32721 unavailable, Exim will try the remaining one(s) until it finds one that works.
32722 When a clamd server becomes unreachable, Exim will log a message. Exim does
32723 not keep track of scanner state between multiple messages, and the scanner
32724 selection is random, so the message will get logged in the mainlog for each
32725 email that the down scanner gets chosen first (message wrapped to be readable):
32726 .code
32727 2013-10-09 14:30:39 1VTumd-0000Y8-BQ malware acl condition:
32728 clamd: connection to localhost, port 3310 failed
32729 (Connection refused)
32730 .endd
32731
32732 If the option is unset, the default is &_/tmp/clamd_&. Thanks to David Saez for
32733 contributing the code for this scanner.
32734
32735 .vitem &%cmdline%&
32736 .cindex "virus scanners" "command line interface"
32737 This is the keyword for the generic command line scanner interface. It can be
32738 used to attach virus scanners that are invoked from the shell. This scanner
32739 type takes 3 mandatory options:
32740
32741 .olist
32742 The full path and name of the scanner binary, with all command line options,
32743 and a placeholder (&`%s`&) for the directory to scan.
32744
32745 .next
32746 A regular expression to match against the STDOUT and STDERR output of the
32747 virus scanner. If the expression matches, a virus was found. You must make
32748 absolutely sure that this expression matches on &"virus found"&. This is called
32749 the &"trigger"& expression.
32750
32751 .next
32752 Another regular expression, containing exactly one pair of parentheses, to
32753 match the name of the virus found in the scanners output. This is called the
32754 &"name"& expression.
32755 .endlist olist
32756
32757 For example, Sophos Sweep reports a virus on a line like this:
32758 .code
32759 Virus 'W32/Magistr-B' found in file ./those.bat
32760 .endd
32761 For the trigger expression, we can match the phrase &"found in file"&. For the
32762 name expression, we want to extract the W32/Magistr-B string, so we can match
32763 for the single quotes left and right of it. Altogether, this makes the
32764 configuration setting:
32765 .code
32766 av_scanner = cmdline:\
32767 /path/to/sweep -ss -all -rec -archive %s:\
32768 found in file:'(.+)'
32769 .endd
32770 .vitem &%drweb%&
32771 .cindex "virus scanners" "DrWeb"
32772 The DrWeb daemon scanner (&url(https://www.sald.ru/)) interface
32773 takes one option,
32774 either a full path to a UNIX socket,
32775 or host and port specifiers separated by white space.
32776 The host may be a name or an IP address; the port is either a
32777 single number or a pair of numbers with a dash between.
32778 For example:
32779 .code
32780 av_scanner = drweb:/var/run/drwebd.sock
32781 av_scanner = drweb:192.168.2.20 31337
32782 .endd
32783 If you omit the argument, the default path &_/usr/local/drweb/run/drwebd.sock_&
32784 is used. Thanks to Alex Miller for contributing the code for this scanner.
32785
32786 .vitem &%f-protd%&
32787 .cindex "virus scanners" "f-protd"
32788 The f-protd scanner is accessed via HTTP over TCP.
32789 One argument is taken, being a space-separated hostname and port number
32790 (or port-range).
32791 For example:
32792 .code
32793 av_scanner = f-protd:localhost 10200-10204
32794 .endd
32795 If you omit the argument, the default values shown above are used.
32796
32797 .vitem &%f-prot6d%&
32798 .cindex "virus scanners" "f-prot6d"
32799 The f-prot6d scanner is accessed using the FPSCAND protocol over TCP.
32800 One argument is taken, being a space-separated hostname and port number.
32801 For example:
32802 .code
32803 av_scanner = f-prot6d:localhost 10200
32804 .endd
32805 If you omit the argument, the default values show above are used.
32806
32807 .vitem &%fsecure%&
32808 .cindex "virus scanners" "F-Secure"
32809 The F-Secure daemon scanner (&url(https://www.f-secure.com/)) takes one
32810 argument which is the path to a UNIX socket. For example:
32811 .code
32812 av_scanner = fsecure:/path/to/.fsav
32813 .endd
32814 If no argument is given, the default is &_/var/run/.fsav_&. Thanks to Johan
32815 Thelmen for contributing the code for this scanner.
32816
32817 .vitem &%kavdaemon%&
32818 .cindex "virus scanners" "Kaspersky"
32819 This is the scanner daemon of Kaspersky Version 4. This version of the
32820 Kaspersky scanner is outdated. Please upgrade (see &%aveserver%& above). This
32821 scanner type takes one option, which is the path to the daemon's UNIX socket.
32822 For example:
32823 .code
32824 av_scanner = kavdaemon:/opt/AVP/AvpCtl
32825 .endd
32826 The default path is &_/var/run/AvpCtl_&.
32827
32828 .vitem &%mksd%&
32829 .cindex "virus scanners" "mksd"
32830 This was a daemon type scanner that is aimed mainly at Polish users,
32831 though some documentation was available in English.
32832 The history can be shown at &url(https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Mks_vir)
32833 and this appears to be a candidate for removal from Exim, unless
32834 we are informed of other virus scanners which use the same protocol
32835 to integrate.
32836 The only option for this scanner type is
32837 the maximum number of processes used simultaneously to scan the attachments,
32838 provided that mksd has
32839 been run with at least the same number of child processes. For example:
32840 .code
32841 av_scanner = mksd:2
32842 .endd
32843 You can safely omit this option (the default value is 1).
32844
32845 .vitem &%sock%&
32846 .cindex "virus scanners" "simple socket-connected"
32847 This is a general-purpose way of talking to simple scanner daemons
32848 running on the local machine.
32849 There are four options:
32850 an address (which may be an IP address and port, or the path of a Unix socket),
32851 a commandline to send (may include a single %s which will be replaced with
32852 the path to the mail file to be scanned),
32853 an RE to trigger on from the returned data,
32854 and an RE to extract malware_name from the returned data.
32855 For example:
32856 .code
32857 av_scanner = sock:127.0.0.1 6001:%s:(SPAM|VIRUS):(.*)$
32858 .endd
32859 Note that surrounding whitespace is stripped from each option, meaning
32860 there is no way to specify a trailing newline.
32861 The socket specifier and both regular-expressions are required.
32862 Default for the commandline is &_%s\n_& (note this does have a trailing newline);
32863 specify an empty element to get this.
32864
32865 .vitem &%sophie%&
32866 .cindex "virus scanners" "Sophos and Sophie"
32867 Sophie is a daemon that uses Sophos' &%libsavi%& library to scan for viruses.
32868 You can get Sophie at &url(http://sophie.sourceforge.net/). The only option
32869 for this scanner type is the path to the UNIX socket that Sophie uses for
32870 client communication. For example:
32871 .code
32872 av_scanner = sophie:/tmp/sophie
32873 .endd
32874 The default path is &_/var/run/sophie_&, so if you are using this, you can omit
32875 the option.
32876 .endlist
32877
32878 When &%av_scanner%& is correctly set, you can use the &%malware%& condition in
32879 the DATA ACL. &*Note*&: You cannot use the &%malware%& condition in the MIME
32880 ACL.
32881
32882 The &%av_scanner%& option is expanded each time &%malware%& is called. This
32883 makes it possible to use different scanners. See further below for an example.
32884 The &%malware%& condition caches its results, so when you use it multiple times
32885 for the same message, the actual scanning process is only carried out once.
32886 However, using expandable items in &%av_scanner%& disables this caching, in
32887 which case each use of the &%malware%& condition causes a new scan of the
32888 message.
32889
32890 The &%malware%& condition takes a right-hand argument that is expanded before
32891 use and taken as a list, slash-separated by default.
32892 The first element can then be one of
32893
32894 .ilist
32895 &"true"&, &"*"&, or &"1"&, in which case the message is scanned for viruses.
32896 The condition succeeds if a virus was found, and fail otherwise. This is the
32897 recommended usage.
32898 .next
32899 &"false"& or &"0"& or an empty string, in which case no scanning is done and
32900 the condition fails immediately.
32901 .next
32902 A regular expression, in which case the message is scanned for viruses. The
32903 condition succeeds if a virus is found and its name matches the regular
32904 expression. This allows you to take special actions on certain types of virus.
32905 Note that &"/"& characters in the RE must be doubled due to the list-processing,
32906 unless the separator is changed (in the usual way &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
32907 .endlist
32908
32909 You can append a &`defer_ok`& element to the &%malware%& argument list to accept
32910 messages even if there is a problem with the virus scanner.
32911 Otherwise, such a problem causes the ACL to defer.
32912
32913 You can append a &`tmo=<val>`& element to the &%malware%& argument list to
32914 specify a non-default timeout. The default is two minutes.
32915 For example:
32916 .code
32917 malware = * / defer_ok / tmo=10s
32918 .endd
32919 A timeout causes the ACL to defer.
32920
32921 .vindex "&$callout_address$&"
32922 When a connection is made to the scanner the expansion variable &$callout_address$&
32923 is set to record the actual address used.
32924
32925 .vindex "&$malware_name$&"
32926 When a virus is found, the condition sets up an expansion variable called
32927 &$malware_name$& that contains the name of the virus. You can use it in a
32928 &%message%& modifier that specifies the error returned to the sender, and/or in
32929 logging data.
32930
32931 Beware the interaction of Exim's &%message_size_limit%& with any size limits
32932 imposed by your anti-virus scanner.
32933
32934 Here is a very simple scanning example:
32935 .code
32936 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
32937 malware = *
32938 .endd
32939 The next example accepts messages when there is a problem with the scanner:
32940 .code
32941 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
32942 malware = */defer_ok
32943 .endd
32944 The next example shows how to use an ACL variable to scan with both sophie and
32945 aveserver. It assumes you have set:
32946 .code
32947 av_scanner = $acl_m0
32948 .endd
32949 in the main Exim configuration.
32950 .code
32951 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
32952 set acl_m0 = sophie
32953 malware = *
32954
32955 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
32956 set acl_m0 = aveserver
32957 malware = *
32958 .endd
32959
32960
32961 .section "Scanning with SpamAssassin and Rspamd" "SECTscanspamass"
32962 .cindex "content scanning" "for spam"
32963 .cindex "spam scanning"
32964 .cindex "SpamAssassin"
32965 .cindex "Rspamd"
32966 The &%spam%& ACL condition calls SpamAssassin's &%spamd%& daemon to get a spam
32967 score and a report for the message.
32968 Support is also provided for Rspamd.
32969
32970 For more information about installation and configuration of SpamAssassin or
32971 Rspamd refer to their respective websites at
32972 &url(https://spamassassin.apache.org/) and &url(https://www.rspamd.com/)
32973
32974 SpamAssassin can be installed with CPAN by running:
32975 .code
32976 perl -MCPAN -e 'install Mail::SpamAssassin'
32977 .endd
32978 SpamAssassin has its own set of configuration files. Please review its
32979 documentation to see how you can tweak it. The default installation should work
32980 nicely, however.
32981
32982 .oindex "&%spamd_address%&"
32983 By default, SpamAssassin listens on 127.0.0.1, TCP port 783 and if you
32984 intend to use an instance running on the local host you do not need to set
32985 &%spamd_address%&. If you intend to use another host or port for SpamAssassin,
32986 you must set the &%spamd_address%& option in the global part of the Exim
32987 configuration as follows (example):
32988 .code
32989 spamd_address = 192.168.99.45 783
32990 .endd
32991 The SpamAssassin protocol relies on a TCP half-close from the client.
32992 If your SpamAssassin client side is running a Linux system with an
32993 iptables firewall, consider setting
32994 &%net.netfilter.nf_conntrack_tcp_timeout_close_wait%& to at least the
32995 timeout, Exim uses when waiting for a response from the SpamAssassin
32996 server (currently defaulting to 120s). With a lower value the Linux
32997 connection tracking may consider your half-closed connection as dead too
32998 soon.
32999
33000
33001 To use Rspamd (which by default listens on all local addresses
33002 on TCP port 11333)
33003 you should add &%variant=rspamd%& after the address/port pair, for example:
33004 .code
33005 spamd_address = 127.0.0.1 11333 variant=rspamd
33006 .endd
33007
33008 As of version 2.60, &%SpamAssassin%& also supports communication over UNIX
33009 sockets. If you want to us these, supply &%spamd_address%& with an absolute
33010 filename instead of an address/port pair:
33011 .code
33012 spamd_address = /var/run/spamd_socket
33013 .endd
33014 You can have multiple &%spamd%& servers to improve scalability. These can
33015 reside on other hardware reachable over the network. To specify multiple
33016 &%spamd%& servers, put multiple address/port pairs in the &%spamd_address%&
33017 option, separated with colons (the separator can be changed in the usual way &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&):
33018 .code
33019 spamd_address = 192.168.2.10 783 : \
33020 192.168.2.11 783 : \
33021 192.168.2.12 783
33022 .endd
33023 Up to 32 &%spamd%& servers are supported.
33024 When a server fails to respond to the connection attempt, all other
33025 servers are tried until one succeeds. If no server responds, the &%spam%&
33026 condition defers.
33027
33028 Unix and TCP socket specifications may be mixed in any order.
33029 Each element of the list is a list itself, space-separated by default
33030 and changeable in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&);
33031 take care to not double the separator.
33032
33033 For TCP socket specifications a host name or IP (v4 or v6, but
33034 subject to list-separator quoting rules) address can be used,
33035 and the port can be one or a dash-separated pair.
33036 In the latter case, the range is tried in strict order.
33037
33038 Elements after the first for Unix sockets, or second for TCP socket,
33039 are options.
33040 The supported options are:
33041 .code
33042 pri=<priority> Selection priority
33043 weight=<value> Selection bias
33044 time=<start>-<end> Use only between these times of day
33045 retry=<timespec> Retry on connect fail
33046 tmo=<timespec> Connection time limit
33047 variant=rspamd Use Rspamd rather than SpamAssassin protocol
33048 .endd
33049
33050 The &`pri`& option specifies a priority for the server within the list,
33051 higher values being tried first.
33052 The default priority is 1.
33053
33054 The &`weight`& option specifies a selection bias.
33055 Within a priority set
33056 servers are queried in a random fashion, weighted by this value.
33057 The default value for selection bias is 1.
33058
33059 Time specifications for the &`time`& option are <hour>.<minute>.<second>
33060 in the local time zone; each element being one or more digits.
33061 Either the seconds or both minutes and seconds, plus the leading &`.`&
33062 characters, may be omitted and will be taken as zero.
33063
33064 Timeout specifications for the &`retry`& and &`tmo`& options
33065 are the usual Exim time interval standard, e.g. &`20s`& or &`1m`&.
33066
33067 The &`tmo`& option specifies an overall timeout for communication.
33068 The default value is two minutes.
33069
33070 The &`retry`& option specifies a time after which a single retry for
33071 a failed connect is made.
33072 The default is to not retry.
33073
33074 The &%spamd_address%& variable is expanded before use if it starts with
33075 a dollar sign. In this case, the expansion may return a string that is
33076 used as the list so that multiple spamd servers can be the result of an
33077 expansion.
33078
33079 .vindex "&$callout_address$&"
33080 When a connection is made to the server the expansion variable &$callout_address$&
33081 is set to record the actual address used.
33082
33083 .section "Calling SpamAssassin from an Exim ACL" "SECID206"
33084 Here is a simple example of the use of the &%spam%& condition in a DATA ACL:
33085 .code
33086 deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
33087 spam = joe
33088 .endd
33089 The right-hand side of the &%spam%& condition specifies a name. This is
33090 relevant if you have set up multiple SpamAssassin profiles. If you do not want
33091 to scan using a specific profile, but rather use the SpamAssassin system-wide
33092 default profile, you can scan for an unknown name, or simply use &"nobody"&.
33093 Rspamd does not use this setting. However, you must put something on the
33094 right-hand side.
33095
33096 The name allows you to use per-domain or per-user antispam profiles in
33097 principle, but this is not straightforward in practice, because a message may
33098 have multiple recipients, not necessarily all in the same domain. Because the
33099 &%spam%& condition has to be called from a DATA-time ACL in order to be able to
33100 read the contents of the message, the variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$&
33101 are not set.
33102 Careful enforcement of single-recipient messages
33103 (e.g. by responding with defer in the recipient ACL for all recipients
33104 after the first),
33105 or the use of PRDR,
33106 .cindex "PRDR" "use for per-user SpamAssassin profiles"
33107 are needed to use this feature.
33108
33109 The right-hand side of the &%spam%& condition is expanded before being used, so
33110 you can put lookups or conditions there. When the right-hand side evaluates to
33111 &"0"& or &"false"&, no scanning is done and the condition fails immediately.
33112
33113
33114 Scanning with SpamAssassin uses a lot of resources. If you scan every message,
33115 large ones may cause significant performance degradation. As most spam messages
33116 are quite small, it is recommended that you do not scan the big ones. For
33117 example:
33118 .code
33119 deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
33120 condition = ${if < {$message_size}{10K}}
33121 spam = nobody
33122 .endd
33123
33124 The &%spam%& condition returns true if the threshold specified in the user's
33125 SpamAssassin profile has been matched or exceeded. If you want to use the
33126 &%spam%& condition for its side effects (see the variables below), you can make
33127 it always return &"true"& by appending &`:true`& to the username.
33128
33129 .cindex "spam scanning" "returned variables"
33130 When the &%spam%& condition is run, it sets up a number of expansion
33131 variables.
33132 Except for &$spam_report$&,
33133 these variables are saved with the received message so are
33134 available for use at delivery time.
33135
33136 .vlist
33137 .vitem &$spam_score$&
33138 The spam score of the message, for example, &"3.4"& or &"30.5"&. This is useful
33139 for inclusion in log or reject messages.
33140
33141 .vitem &$spam_score_int$&
33142 The spam score of the message, multiplied by ten, as an integer value. For
33143 example &"34"& or &"305"&. It may appear to disagree with &$spam_score$&
33144 because &$spam_score$& is rounded and &$spam_score_int$& is truncated.
33145 The integer value is useful for numeric comparisons in conditions.
33146
33147 .vitem &$spam_bar$&
33148 A string consisting of a number of &"+"& or &"-"& characters, representing the
33149 integer part of the spam score value. A spam score of 4.4 would have a
33150 &$spam_bar$& value of &"++++"&. This is useful for inclusion in warning
33151 headers, since MUAs can match on such strings. The maximum length of the
33152 spam bar is 50 characters.
33153
33154 .vitem &$spam_report$&
33155 A multiline text table, containing the full SpamAssassin report for the
33156 message. Useful for inclusion in headers or reject messages.
33157 This variable is only usable in a DATA-time ACL.
33158 Beware that SpamAssassin may return non-ASCII characters, especially
33159 when running in country-specific locales, which are not legal
33160 unencoded in headers.
33161
33162 .vitem &$spam_action$&
33163 For SpamAssassin either 'reject' or 'no action' depending on the
33164 spam score versus threshold.
33165 For Rspamd, the recommended action.
33166
33167 .endlist
33168
33169 The &%spam%& condition caches its results unless expansion in
33170 spamd_address was used. If you call it again with the same user name, it
33171 does not scan again, but rather returns the same values as before.
33172
33173 The &%spam%& condition returns DEFER if there is any error while running
33174 the message through SpamAssassin or if the expansion of spamd_address
33175 failed. If you want to treat DEFER as FAIL (to pass on to the next ACL
33176 statement block), append &`/defer_ok`& to the right-hand side of the
33177 spam condition, like this:
33178 .code
33179 deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
33180 spam = joe/defer_ok
33181 .endd
33182 This causes messages to be accepted even if there is a problem with &%spamd%&.
33183
33184 Here is a longer, commented example of the use of the &%spam%&
33185 condition:
33186 .code
33187 # put headers in all messages (no matter if spam or not)
33188 warn spam = nobody:true
33189 add_header = X-Spam-Score: $spam_score ($spam_bar)
33190 add_header = X-Spam-Report: $spam_report
33191
33192 # add second subject line with *SPAM* marker when message
33193 # is over threshold
33194 warn spam = nobody
33195 add_header = Subject: *SPAM* $h_Subject:
33196
33197 # reject spam at high scores (> 12)
33198 deny message = This message scored $spam_score spam points.
33199 spam = nobody:true
33200 condition = ${if >{$spam_score_int}{120}{1}{0}}
33201 .endd
33202
33203
33204
33205 .section "Scanning MIME parts" "SECTscanmimepart"
33206 .cindex "content scanning" "MIME parts"
33207 .cindex "MIME content scanning"
33208 .oindex "&%acl_smtp_mime%&"
33209 .oindex "&%acl_not_smtp_mime%&"
33210 The &%acl_smtp_mime%& global option specifies an ACL that is called once for
33211 each MIME part of an SMTP message, including multipart types, in the sequence
33212 of their position in the message. Similarly, the &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& option
33213 specifies an ACL that is used for the MIME parts of non-SMTP messages. These
33214 options may both refer to the same ACL if you want the same processing in both
33215 cases.
33216
33217 These ACLs are called (possibly many times) just before the &%acl_smtp_data%&
33218 ACL in the case of an SMTP message, or just before the &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL in
33219 the case of a non-SMTP message. However, a MIME ACL is called only if the
33220 message contains a &'Content-Type:'& header line. When a call to a MIME
33221 ACL does not yield &"accept"&, ACL processing is aborted and the appropriate
33222 result code is sent to the client. In the case of an SMTP message, the
33223 &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is not called when this happens.
33224
33225 You cannot use the &%malware%& or &%spam%& conditions in a MIME ACL; these can
33226 only be used in the DATA or non-SMTP ACLs. However, you can use the &%regex%&
33227 condition to match against the raw MIME part. You can also use the
33228 &%mime_regex%& condition to match against the decoded MIME part (see section
33229 &<<SECTscanregex>>&).
33230
33231 At the start of a MIME ACL, a number of variables are set from the header
33232 information for the relevant MIME part. These are described below. The contents
33233 of the MIME part are not by default decoded into a disk file except for MIME
33234 parts whose content-type is &"message/rfc822"&. If you want to decode a MIME
33235 part into a disk file, you can use the &%decode%& condition. The general
33236 syntax is:
33237 .display
33238 &`decode = [/`&<&'path'&>&`/]`&<&'filename'&>
33239 .endd
33240 The right hand side is expanded before use. After expansion,
33241 the value can be:
33242
33243 .olist
33244 &"0"& or &"false"&, in which case no decoding is done.
33245 .next
33246 The string &"default"&. In that case, the file is put in the temporary
33247 &"default"& directory <&'spool_directory'&>&_/scan/_&<&'message_id'&>&_/_& with
33248 a sequential filename consisting of the message id and a sequence number. The
33249 full path and name is available in &$mime_decoded_filename$& after decoding.
33250 .next
33251 A full path name starting with a slash. If the full name is an existing
33252 directory, it is used as a replacement for the default directory. The filename
33253 is then sequentially assigned. If the path does not exist, it is used as
33254 the full path and filename.
33255 .next
33256 If the string does not start with a slash, it is used as the
33257 filename, and the default path is then used.
33258 .endlist
33259 The &%decode%& condition normally succeeds. It is only false for syntax
33260 errors or unusual circumstances such as memory shortages. You can easily decode
33261 a file with its original, proposed filename using
33262 .code
33263 decode = $mime_filename
33264 .endd
33265 However, you should keep in mind that &$mime_filename$& might contain
33266 anything. If you place files outside of the default path, they are not
33267 automatically unlinked.
33268
33269 For RFC822 attachments (these are messages attached to messages, with a
33270 content-type of &"message/rfc822"&), the ACL is called again in the same manner
33271 as for the primary message, only that the &$mime_is_rfc822$& expansion
33272 variable is set (see below). Attached messages are always decoded to disk
33273 before being checked, and the files are unlinked once the check is done.
33274
33275 The MIME ACL supports the &%regex%& and &%mime_regex%& conditions. These can be
33276 used to match regular expressions against raw and decoded MIME parts,
33277 respectively. They are described in section &<<SECTscanregex>>&.
33278
33279 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "returned variables"
33280 The following list describes all expansion variables that are
33281 available in the MIME ACL:
33282
33283 .vlist
33284 .vitem &$mime_boundary$&
33285 If the current part is a multipart (see &$mime_is_multipart$&) below, it should
33286 have a boundary string, which is stored in this variable. If the current part
33287 has no boundary parameter in the &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable
33288 contains the empty string.
33289
33290 .vitem &$mime_charset$&
33291 This variable contains the character set identifier, if one was found in the
33292 &'Content-Type:'& header. Examples for charset identifiers are:
33293 .code
33294 us-ascii
33295 gb2312 (Chinese)
33296 iso-8859-1
33297 .endd
33298 Please note that this value is not normalized, so you should do matches
33299 case-insensitively.
33300
33301 .vitem &$mime_content_description$&
33302 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-Description:'&
33303 header. It can contain a human-readable description of the parts content. Some
33304 implementations repeat the filename for attachments here, but they are usually
33305 only used for display purposes.
33306
33307 .vitem &$mime_content_disposition$&
33308 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-Disposition:'&
33309 header. You can expect strings like &"attachment"& or &"inline"& here.
33310
33311 .vitem &$mime_content_id$&
33312 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-ID:'& header.
33313 This is a unique ID that can be used to reference a part from another part.
33314
33315 .vitem &$mime_content_size$&
33316 This variable is set only after the &%decode%& modifier (see above) has been
33317 successfully run. It contains the size of the decoded part in kilobytes. The
33318 size is always rounded up to full kilobytes, so only a completely empty part
33319 has a &$mime_content_size$& of zero.
33320
33321 .vitem &$mime_content_transfer_encoding$&
33322 This variable contains the normalized content of the
33323 &'Content-transfer-encoding:'& header. This is a symbolic name for an encoding
33324 type. Typical values are &"base64"& and &"quoted-printable"&.
33325
33326 .vitem &$mime_content_type$&
33327 If the MIME part has a &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable contains its
33328 value, lowercased, and without any options (like &"name"& or &"charset"&). Here
33329 are some examples of popular MIME types, as they may appear in this variable:
33330 .code
33331 text/plain
33332 text/html
33333 application/octet-stream
33334 image/jpeg
33335 audio/midi
33336 .endd
33337 If the MIME part has no &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable contains the
33338 empty string.
33339
33340 .vitem &$mime_decoded_filename$&
33341 This variable is set only after the &%decode%& modifier (see above) has been
33342 successfully run. It contains the full path and filename of the file
33343 containing the decoded data.
33344 .endlist
33345
33346 .cindex "RFC 2047"
33347 .vlist
33348 .vitem &$mime_filename$&
33349 This is perhaps the most important of the MIME variables. It contains a
33350 proposed filename for an attachment, if one was found in either the
33351 &'Content-Type:'& or &'Content-Disposition:'& headers. The filename will be
33352 RFC2047
33353 or RFC2231
33354 decoded, but no additional sanity checks are done.
33355 If no filename was
33356 found, this variable contains the empty string.
33357
33358 .vitem &$mime_is_coverletter$&
33359 This variable attempts to differentiate the &"cover letter"& of an e-mail from
33360 attached data. It can be used to clamp down on flashy or unnecessarily encoded
33361 content in the cover letter, while not restricting attachments at all.
33362
33363 The variable contains 1 (true) for a MIME part believed to be part of the
33364 cover letter, and 0 (false) for an attachment. At present, the algorithm is as
33365 follows:
33366
33367 .olist
33368 The outermost MIME part of a message is always a cover letter.
33369
33370 .next
33371 If a multipart/alternative or multipart/related MIME part is a cover letter,
33372 so are all MIME subparts within that multipart.
33373
33374 .next
33375 If any other multipart is a cover letter, the first subpart is a cover letter,
33376 and the rest are attachments.
33377
33378 .next
33379 All parts contained within an attachment multipart are attachments.
33380 .endlist olist
33381
33382 As an example, the following will ban &"HTML mail"& (including that sent with
33383 alternative plain text), while allowing HTML files to be attached. HTML
33384 coverletter mail attached to non-HTML coverletter mail will also be allowed:
33385 .code
33386 deny message = HTML mail is not accepted here
33387 !condition = $mime_is_rfc822
33388 condition = $mime_is_coverletter
33389 condition = ${if eq{$mime_content_type}{text/html}{1}{0}}
33390 .endd
33391 .vitem &$mime_is_multipart$&
33392 This variable has the value 1 (true) when the current part has the main type
33393 &"multipart"&, for example, &"multipart/alternative"& or &"multipart/mixed"&.
33394 Since multipart entities only serve as containers for other parts, you may not
33395 want to carry out specific actions on them.
33396
33397 .vitem &$mime_is_rfc822$&
33398 This variable has the value 1 (true) if the current part is not a part of the
33399 checked message itself, but part of an attached message. Attached message
33400 decoding is fully recursive.
33401
33402 .vitem &$mime_part_count$&
33403 This variable is a counter that is raised for each processed MIME part. It
33404 starts at zero for the very first part (which is usually a multipart). The
33405 counter is per-message, so it is reset when processing RFC822 attachments (see
33406 &$mime_is_rfc822$&). The counter stays set after &%acl_smtp_mime%& is
33407 complete, so you can use it in the DATA ACL to determine the number of MIME
33408 parts of a message. For non-MIME messages, this variable contains the value -1.
33409 .endlist
33410
33411
33412
33413 .section "Scanning with regular expressions" "SECTscanregex"
33414 .cindex "content scanning" "with regular expressions"
33415 .cindex "regular expressions" "content scanning with"
33416 You can specify your own custom regular expression matches on the full body of
33417 the message, or on individual MIME parts.
33418
33419 The &%regex%& condition takes one or more regular expressions as arguments and
33420 matches them against the full message (when called in the DATA ACL) or a raw
33421 MIME part (when called in the MIME ACL). The &%regex%& condition matches
33422 linewise, with a maximum line length of 32K characters. That means you cannot
33423 have multiline matches with the &%regex%& condition.
33424
33425 The &%mime_regex%& condition can be called only in the MIME ACL. It matches up
33426 to 32K of decoded content (the whole content at once, not linewise). If the
33427 part has not been decoded with the &%decode%& modifier earlier in the ACL, it
33428 is decoded automatically when &%mime_regex%& is executed (using default path
33429 and filename values). If the decoded data is larger than 32K, only the first
33430 32K characters are checked.
33431
33432 The regular expressions are passed as a colon-separated list. To include a
33433 literal colon, you must double it. Since the whole right-hand side string is
33434 expanded before being used, you must also escape dollar signs and backslashes
33435 with more backslashes, or use the &`\N`& facility to disable expansion.
33436 Here is a simple example that contains two regular expressions:
33437 .code
33438 deny message = contains blacklisted regex ($regex_match_string)
33439 regex = [Mm]ortgage : URGENT BUSINESS PROPOSAL
33440 .endd
33441 The conditions returns true if any one of the regular expressions matches. The
33442 &$regex_match_string$& expansion variable is then set up and contains the
33443 matching regular expression.
33444 The expansion variables &$regex1$& &$regex2$& etc
33445 are set to any substrings captured by the regular expression.
33446
33447 &*Warning*&: With large messages, these conditions can be fairly
33448 CPU-intensive.
33449
33450 .ecindex IIDcosca
33451
33452
33453
33454
33455 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33456 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33457
33458 .chapter "Adding a local scan function to Exim" "CHAPlocalscan" &&&
33459 "Local scan function"
33460 .scindex IIDlosca "&[local_scan()]& function" "description of"
33461 .cindex "customizing" "input scan using C function"
33462 .cindex "policy control" "by local scan function"
33463 In these days of email worms, viruses, and ever-increasing spam, some sites
33464 want to apply a lot of checking to messages before accepting them.
33465
33466 The content scanning extension (chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&) has facilities for
33467 passing messages to external virus and spam scanning software. You can also do
33468 a certain amount in Exim itself through string expansions and the &%condition%&
33469 condition in the ACL that runs after the SMTP DATA command or the ACL for
33470 non-SMTP messages (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), but this has its limitations.
33471
33472 To allow for further customization to a site's own requirements, there is the
33473 possibility of linking Exim with a private message scanning function, written
33474 in C. If you want to run code that is written in something other than C, you
33475 can of course use a little C stub to call it.
33476
33477 The local scan function is run once for every incoming message, at the point
33478 when Exim is just about to accept the message.
33479 It can therefore be used to control non-SMTP messages from local processes as
33480 well as messages arriving via SMTP.
33481
33482 Exim applies a timeout to calls of the local scan function, and there is an
33483 option called &%local_scan_timeout%& for setting it. The default is 5 minutes.
33484 Zero means &"no timeout"&.
33485 Exim also sets up signal handlers for SIGSEGV, SIGILL, SIGFPE, and SIGBUS
33486 before calling the local scan function, so that the most common types of crash
33487 are caught. If the timeout is exceeded or one of those signals is caught, the
33488 incoming message is rejected with a temporary error if it is an SMTP message.
33489 For a non-SMTP message, the message is dropped and Exim ends with a non-zero
33490 code. The incident is logged on the main and reject logs.
33491
33492
33493
33494 .section "Building Exim to use a local scan function" "SECID207"
33495 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "building Exim to use"
33496 To make use of the local scan function feature, you must tell Exim where your
33497 function is before building Exim, by setting
33498 both HAVE_LOCAL_SCAN and
33499 LOCAL_SCAN_SOURCE in your
33500 &_Local/Makefile_&. A recommended place to put it is in the &_Local_&
33501 directory, so you might set
33502 .code
33503 HAVE_LOCAL_SCAN=yes
33504 LOCAL_SCAN_SOURCE=Local/local_scan.c
33505 .endd
33506 for example. The function must be called &[local_scan()]&. It is called by
33507 Exim after it has received a message, when the success return code is about to
33508 be sent. This is after all the ACLs have been run. The return code from your
33509 function controls whether the message is actually accepted or not. There is a
33510 commented template function (that just accepts the message) in the file
33511 _src/local_scan.c_.
33512
33513 If you want to make use of Exim's runtime configuration file to set options
33514 for your &[local_scan()]& function, you must also set
33515 .code
33516 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
33517 .endd
33518 in &_Local/Makefile_& (see section &<<SECTconoptloc>>& below).
33519
33520
33521
33522
33523 .section "API for local_scan()" "SECTapiforloc"
33524 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "API description"
33525 .cindex &%dlfunc%& "API description"
33526 You must include this line near the start of your code:
33527 .code
33528 #include "local_scan.h"
33529 .endd
33530 This header file defines a number of variables and other values, and the
33531 prototype for the function itself. Exim is coded to use unsigned char values
33532 almost exclusively, and one of the things this header defines is a shorthand
33533 for &`unsigned char`& called &`uschar`&.
33534 It also contains the following macro definitions, to simplify casting character
33535 strings and pointers to character strings:
33536 .code
33537 #define CS (char *)
33538 #define CCS (const char *)
33539 #define CSS (char **)
33540 #define US (unsigned char *)
33541 #define CUS (const unsigned char *)
33542 #define USS (unsigned char **)
33543 .endd
33544 The function prototype for &[local_scan()]& is:
33545 .code
33546 extern int local_scan(int fd, uschar **return_text);
33547 .endd
33548 The arguments are as follows:
33549
33550 .ilist
33551 &%fd%& is a file descriptor for the file that contains the body of the message
33552 (the -D file). The file is open for reading and writing, but updating it is not
33553 recommended. &*Warning*&: You must &'not'& close this file descriptor.
33554
33555 The descriptor is positioned at character 19 of the file, which is the first
33556 character of the body itself, because the first 19 characters are the message
33557 id followed by &`-D`& and a newline. If you rewind the file, you should use the
33558 macro SPOOL_DATA_START_OFFSET to reset to the start of the data, just in
33559 case this changes in some future version.
33560 .next
33561 &%return_text%& is an address which you can use to return a pointer to a text
33562 string at the end of the function. The value it points to on entry is NULL.
33563 .endlist
33564
33565 The function must return an &%int%& value which is one of the following macros:
33566
33567 .vlist
33568 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT`&
33569 .vindex "&$local_scan_data$&"
33570 The message is accepted. If you pass back a string of text, it is saved with
33571 the message, and made available in the variable &$local_scan_data$&. No
33572 newlines are permitted (if there are any, they are turned into spaces) and the
33573 maximum length of text is 1000 characters.
33574
33575 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT_FREEZE`&
33576 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT, except that the accepted message is
33577 queued without immediate delivery, and is frozen.
33578
33579 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT_QUEUE`&
33580 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT, except that the accepted message is
33581 queued without immediate delivery.
33582
33583 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT`&
33584 The message is rejected; the returned text is used as an error message which is
33585 passed back to the sender and which is also logged. Newlines are permitted &--
33586 they cause a multiline response for SMTP rejections, but are converted to
33587 &`\n`& in log lines. If no message is given, &"Administrative prohibition"& is
33588 used.
33589
33590 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT`&
33591 The message is temporarily rejected; the returned text is used as an error
33592 message as for LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT. If no message is given, &"Temporary local
33593 problem"& is used.
33594
33595 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT_NOLOGHDR`&
33596 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT, except that the header of the rejected
33597 message is not written to the reject log. It has the effect of unsetting the
33598 &%rejected_header%& log selector for just this rejection. If
33599 &%rejected_header%& is already unset (see the discussion of the
33600 &%log_selection%& option in section &<<SECTlogselector>>&), this code is the
33601 same as LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT.
33602
33603 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT_NOLOGHDR`&
33604 This code is a variation of LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT in the same way that
33605 LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT_NOLOGHDR is a variation of LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT.
33606 .endlist
33607
33608 If the message is not being received by interactive SMTP, rejections are
33609 reported by writing to &%stderr%& or by sending an email, as configured by the
33610 &%-oe%& command line options.
33611
33612
33613
33614 .section "Configuration options for local_scan()" "SECTconoptloc"
33615 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "configuration options"
33616 It is possible to have option settings in the main configuration file
33617 that set values in static variables in the &[local_scan()]& module. If you
33618 want to do this, you must have the line
33619 .code
33620 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
33621 .endd
33622 in your &_Local/Makefile_& when you build Exim. (This line is in
33623 &_OS/Makefile-Default_&, commented out). Then, in the &[local_scan()]& source
33624 file, you must define static variables to hold the option values, and a table
33625 to define them.
33626
33627 The table must be a vector called &%local_scan_options%&, of type
33628 &`optionlist`&. Each entry is a triplet, consisting of a name, an option type,
33629 and a pointer to the variable that holds the value. The entries must appear in
33630 alphabetical order. Following &%local_scan_options%& you must also define a
33631 variable called &%local_scan_options_count%& that contains the number of
33632 entries in the table. Here is a short example, showing two kinds of option:
33633 .code
33634 static int my_integer_option = 42;
33635 static uschar *my_string_option = US"a default string";
33636
33637 optionlist local_scan_options[] = {
33638 { "my_integer", opt_int, &my_integer_option },
33639 { "my_string", opt_stringptr, &my_string_option }
33640 };
33641
33642 int local_scan_options_count =
33643 sizeof(local_scan_options)/sizeof(optionlist);
33644 .endd
33645 The values of the variables can now be changed from Exim's runtime
33646 configuration file by including a local scan section as in this example:
33647 .code
33648 begin local_scan
33649 my_integer = 99
33650 my_string = some string of text...
33651 .endd
33652 The available types of option data are as follows:
33653
33654 .vlist
33655 .vitem &*opt_bool*&
33656 This specifies a boolean (true/false) option. The address should point to a
33657 variable of type &`BOOL`&, which will be set to TRUE or FALSE, which are macros
33658 that are defined as &"1"& and &"0"&, respectively. If you want to detect
33659 whether such a variable has been set at all, you can initialize it to
33660 TRUE_UNSET. (BOOL variables are integers underneath, so can hold more than two
33661 values.)
33662
33663 .vitem &*opt_fixed*&
33664 This specifies a fixed point number, such as is used for load averages.
33665 The address should point to a variable of type &`int`&. The value is stored
33666 multiplied by 1000, so, for example, 1.4142 is truncated and stored as 1414.
33667
33668 .vitem &*opt_int*&
33669 This specifies an integer; the address should point to a variable of type
33670 &`int`&. The value may be specified in any of the integer formats accepted by
33671 Exim.
33672
33673 .vitem &*opt_mkint*&
33674 This is the same as &%opt_int%&, except that when such a value is output in a
33675 &%-bP%& listing, if it is an exact number of kilobytes or megabytes, it is
33676 printed with the suffix K or M.
33677
33678 .vitem &*opt_octint*&
33679 This also specifies an integer, but the value is always interpreted as an
33680 octal integer, whether or not it starts with the digit zero, and it is
33681 always output in octal.
33682
33683 .vitem &*opt_stringptr*&
33684 This specifies a string value; the address must be a pointer to a
33685 variable that points to a string (for example, of type &`uschar *`&).
33686
33687 .vitem &*opt_time*&
33688 This specifies a time interval value. The address must point to a variable of
33689 type &`int`&. The value that is placed there is a number of seconds.
33690 .endlist
33691
33692 If the &%-bP%& command line option is followed by &`local_scan`&, Exim prints
33693 out the values of all the &[local_scan()]& options.
33694
33695
33696
33697 .section "Available Exim variables" "SECID208"
33698 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "available Exim variables"
33699 The header &_local_scan.h_& gives you access to a number of C variables. These
33700 are the only ones that are guaranteed to be maintained from release to release.
33701 Note, however, that you can obtain the value of any Exim expansion variable,
33702 including &$recipients$&, by calling &'expand_string()'&. The exported
33703 C variables are as follows:
33704
33705 .vlist
33706 .vitem &*int&~body_linecount*&
33707 This variable contains the number of lines in the message's body.
33708 It is not valid if the &%spool_files_wireformat%& option is used.
33709
33710 .vitem &*int&~body_zerocount*&
33711 This variable contains the number of binary zero bytes in the message's body.
33712 It is not valid if the &%spool_files_wireformat%& option is used.
33713
33714 .vitem &*unsigned&~int&~debug_selector*&
33715 This variable is set to zero when no debugging is taking place. Otherwise, it
33716 is a bitmap of debugging selectors. Two bits are identified for use in
33717 &[local_scan()]&; they are defined as macros:
33718
33719 .ilist
33720 The &`D_v`& bit is set when &%-v%& was present on the command line. This is a
33721 testing option that is not privileged &-- any caller may set it. All the
33722 other selector bits can be set only by admin users.
33723
33724 .next
33725 The &`D_local_scan`& bit is provided for use by &[local_scan()]&; it is set
33726 by the &`+local_scan`& debug selector. It is not included in the default set
33727 of debugging bits.
33728 .endlist ilist
33729
33730 Thus, to write to the debugging output only when &`+local_scan`& has been
33731 selected, you should use code like this:
33732 .code
33733 if ((debug_selector & D_local_scan) != 0)
33734 debug_printf("xxx", ...);
33735 .endd
33736 .vitem &*uschar&~*expand_string_message*&
33737 After a failing call to &'expand_string()'& (returned value NULL), the
33738 variable &%expand_string_message%& contains the error message, zero-terminated.
33739
33740 .vitem &*header_line&~*header_list*&
33741 A pointer to a chain of header lines. The &%header_line%& structure is
33742 discussed below.
33743
33744 .vitem &*header_line&~*header_last*&
33745 A pointer to the last of the header lines.
33746
33747 .vitem &*uschar&~*headers_charset*&
33748 The value of the &%headers_charset%& configuration option.
33749
33750 .vitem &*BOOL&~host_checking*&
33751 This variable is TRUE during a host checking session that is initiated by the
33752 &%-bh%& command line option.
33753
33754 .vitem &*uschar&~*interface_address*&
33755 The IP address of the interface that received the message, as a string. This
33756 is NULL for locally submitted messages.
33757
33758 .vitem &*int&~interface_port*&
33759 The port on which this message was received. When testing with the &%-bh%&
33760 command line option, the value of this variable is -1 unless a port has been
33761 specified via the &%-oMi%& option.
33762
33763 .vitem &*uschar&~*message_id*&
33764 This variable contains Exim's message id for the incoming message (the value of
33765 &$message_exim_id$&) as a zero-terminated string.
33766
33767 .vitem &*uschar&~*received_protocol*&
33768 The name of the protocol by which the message was received.
33769
33770 .vitem &*int&~recipients_count*&
33771 The number of accepted recipients.
33772
33773 .vitem &*recipient_item&~*recipients_list*&
33774 .cindex "recipient" "adding in local scan"
33775 .cindex "recipient" "removing in local scan"
33776 The list of accepted recipients, held in a vector of length
33777 &%recipients_count%&. The &%recipient_item%& structure is discussed below. You
33778 can add additional recipients by calling &'receive_add_recipient()'& (see
33779 below). You can delete recipients by removing them from the vector and
33780 adjusting the value in &%recipients_count%&. In particular, by setting
33781 &%recipients_count%& to zero you remove all recipients. If you then return the
33782 value &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT`&, the message is accepted, but immediately
33783 blackholed. To replace the recipients, you can set &%recipients_count%& to zero
33784 and then call &'receive_add_recipient()'& as often as needed.
33785
33786 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_address*&
33787 The envelope sender address. For bounce messages this is the empty string.
33788
33789 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_address*&
33790 The IP address of the sending host, as a string. This is NULL for
33791 locally-submitted messages.
33792
33793 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_authenticated*&
33794 The name of the authentication mechanism that was used, or NULL if the message
33795 was not received over an authenticated SMTP connection.
33796
33797 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_name*&
33798 The name of the sending host, if known.
33799
33800 .vitem &*int&~sender_host_port*&
33801 The port on the sending host.
33802
33803 .vitem &*BOOL&~smtp_input*&
33804 This variable is TRUE for all SMTP input, including BSMTP.
33805
33806 .vitem &*BOOL&~smtp_batched_input*&
33807 This variable is TRUE for BSMTP input.
33808
33809 .vitem &*int&~store_pool*&
33810 The contents of this variable control which pool of memory is used for new
33811 requests. See section &<<SECTmemhanloc>>& for details.
33812 .endlist
33813
33814
33815 .section "Structure of header lines" "SECID209"
33816 The &%header_line%& structure contains the members listed below.
33817 You can add additional header lines by calling the &'header_add()'& function
33818 (see below). You can cause header lines to be ignored (deleted) by setting
33819 their type to *.
33820
33821
33822 .vlist
33823 .vitem &*struct&~header_line&~*next*&
33824 A pointer to the next header line, or NULL for the last line.
33825
33826 .vitem &*int&~type*&
33827 A code identifying certain headers that Exim recognizes. The codes are printing
33828 characters, and are documented in chapter &<<CHAPspool>>& of this manual.
33829 Notice in particular that any header line whose type is * is not transmitted
33830 with the message. This flagging is used for header lines that have been
33831 rewritten, or are to be removed (for example, &'Envelope-sender:'& header
33832 lines.) Effectively, * means &"deleted"&.
33833
33834 .vitem &*int&~slen*&
33835 The number of characters in the header line, including the terminating and any
33836 internal newlines.
33837
33838 .vitem &*uschar&~*text*&
33839 A pointer to the text of the header. It always ends with a newline, followed by
33840 a zero byte. Internal newlines are preserved.
33841 .endlist
33842
33843
33844
33845 .section "Structure of recipient items" "SECID210"
33846 The &%recipient_item%& structure contains these members:
33847
33848 .vlist
33849 .vitem &*uschar&~*address*&
33850 This is a pointer to the recipient address as it was received.
33851
33852 .vitem &*int&~pno*&
33853 This is used in later Exim processing when top level addresses are created by
33854 the &%one_time%& option. It is not relevant at the time &[local_scan()]& is run
33855 and must always contain -1 at this stage.
33856
33857 .vitem &*uschar&~*errors_to*&
33858 If this value is not NULL, bounce messages caused by failing to deliver to the
33859 recipient are sent to the address it contains. In other words, it overrides the
33860 envelope sender for this one recipient. (Compare the &%errors_to%& generic
33861 router option.) If a &[local_scan()]& function sets an &%errors_to%& field to
33862 an unqualified address, Exim qualifies it using the domain from
33863 &%qualify_recipient%&. When &[local_scan()]& is called, the &%errors_to%& field
33864 is NULL for all recipients.
33865 .endlist
33866
33867
33868
33869 .section "Available Exim functions" "SECID211"
33870 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "available Exim functions"
33871 The header &_local_scan.h_& gives you access to a number of Exim functions.
33872 These are the only ones that are guaranteed to be maintained from release to
33873 release:
33874
33875 .vlist
33876 .vitem "&*pid_t&~child_open(uschar&~**argv,&~uschar&~**envp,&~int&~newumask,&&&
33877 &~int&~*infdptr,&~int&~*outfdptr, &~&~BOOL&~make_leader)*&"
33878
33879 This function creates a child process that runs the command specified by
33880 &%argv%&. The environment for the process is specified by &%envp%&, which can
33881 be NULL if no environment variables are to be passed. A new umask is supplied
33882 for the process in &%newumask%&.
33883
33884 Pipes to the standard input and output of the new process are set up
33885 and returned to the caller via the &%infdptr%& and &%outfdptr%& arguments. The
33886 standard error is cloned to the standard output. If there are any file
33887 descriptors &"in the way"& in the new process, they are closed. If the final
33888 argument is TRUE, the new process is made into a process group leader.
33889
33890 The function returns the pid of the new process, or -1 if things go wrong.
33891
33892 .vitem &*int&~child_close(pid_t&~pid,&~int&~timeout)*&
33893 This function waits for a child process to terminate, or for a timeout (in
33894 seconds) to expire. A timeout value of zero means wait as long as it takes. The
33895 return value is as follows:
33896
33897 .ilist
33898 >= 0
33899
33900 The process terminated by a normal exit and the value is the process
33901 ending status.
33902
33903 .next
33904 < 0 and > &--256
33905
33906 The process was terminated by a signal and the value is the negation of the
33907 signal number.
33908
33909 .next
33910 &--256
33911
33912 The process timed out.
33913 .next
33914 &--257
33915
33916 The was some other error in wait(); &%errno%& is still set.
33917 .endlist
33918
33919 .vitem &*pid_t&~child_open_exim(int&~*fd)*&
33920 This function provide you with a means of submitting a new message to
33921 Exim. (Of course, you can also call &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& yourself if you
33922 want, but this packages it all up for you.) The function creates a pipe,
33923 forks a subprocess that is running
33924 .code
33925 exim -t -oem -oi -f <>
33926 .endd
33927 and returns to you (via the &`int *`& argument) a file descriptor for the pipe
33928 that is connected to the standard input. The yield of the function is the PID
33929 of the subprocess. You can then write a message to the file descriptor, with
33930 recipients in &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and/or &'Bcc:'& header lines.
33931
33932 When you have finished, call &'child_close()'& to wait for the process to
33933 finish and to collect its ending status. A timeout value of zero is usually
33934 fine in this circumstance. Unless you have made a mistake with the recipient
33935 addresses, you should get a return code of zero.
33936
33937
33938 .vitem &*pid_t&~child_open_exim2(int&~*fd,&~uschar&~*sender,&~uschar&~&&&
33939 *sender_authentication)*&
33940 This function is a more sophisticated version of &'child_open()'&. The command
33941 that it runs is:
33942 .display
33943 &`exim -t -oem -oi -f `&&'sender'&&` -oMas `&&'sender_authentication'&
33944 .endd
33945 The third argument may be NULL, in which case the &%-oMas%& option is omitted.
33946
33947
33948 .vitem &*void&~debug_printf(char&~*,&~...)*&
33949 This is Exim's debugging function, with arguments as for &'(printf()'&. The
33950 output is written to the standard error stream. If no debugging is selected,
33951 calls to &'debug_printf()'& have no effect. Normally, you should make calls
33952 conditional on the &`local_scan`& debug selector by coding like this:
33953 .code
33954 if ((debug_selector & D_local_scan) != 0)
33955 debug_printf("xxx", ...);
33956 .endd
33957
33958 .vitem &*uschar&~*expand_string(uschar&~*string)*&
33959 This is an interface to Exim's string expansion code. The return value is the
33960 expanded string, or NULL if there was an expansion failure.
33961 The C variable &%expand_string_message%& contains an error message after an
33962 expansion failure. If expansion does not change the string, the return value is
33963 the pointer to the input string. Otherwise, the return value points to a new
33964 block of memory that was obtained by a call to &'store_get()'&. See section
33965 &<<SECTmemhanloc>>& below for a discussion of memory handling.
33966
33967 .vitem &*void&~header_add(int&~type,&~char&~*format,&~...)*&
33968 This function allows you to an add additional header line at the end of the
33969 existing ones. The first argument is the type, and should normally be a space
33970 character. The second argument is a format string and any number of
33971 substitution arguments as for &[sprintf()]&. You may include internal newlines
33972 if you want, and you must ensure that the string ends with a newline.
33973
33974 .vitem "&*void&~header_add_at_position(BOOL&~after,&~uschar&~*name,&~&&&
33975 BOOL&~topnot,&~int&~type,&~char&~*format, &~&~...)*&"
33976 This function adds a new header line at a specified point in the header
33977 chain. The header itself is specified as for &'header_add()'&.
33978
33979 If &%name%& is NULL, the new header is added at the end of the chain if
33980 &%after%& is true, or at the start if &%after%& is false. If &%name%& is not
33981 NULL, the header lines are searched for the first non-deleted header that
33982 matches the name. If one is found, the new header is added before it if
33983 &%after%& is false. If &%after%& is true, the new header is added after the
33984 found header and any adjacent subsequent ones with the same name (even if
33985 marked &"deleted"&). If no matching non-deleted header is found, the &%topnot%&
33986 option controls where the header is added. If it is true, addition is at the
33987 top; otherwise at the bottom. Thus, to add a header after all the &'Received:'&
33988 headers, or at the top if there are no &'Received:'& headers, you could use
33989 .code
33990 header_add_at_position(TRUE, US"Received", TRUE,
33991 ' ', "X-xxx: ...");
33992 .endd
33993 Normally, there is always at least one non-deleted &'Received:'& header, but
33994 there may not be if &%received_header_text%& expands to an empty string.
33995
33996
33997 .vitem &*void&~header_remove(int&~occurrence,&~uschar&~*name)*&
33998 This function removes header lines. If &%occurrence%& is zero or negative, all
33999 occurrences of the header are removed. If occurrence is greater than zero, that
34000 particular instance of the header is removed. If no header(s) can be found that
34001 match the specification, the function does nothing.
34002
34003
34004 .vitem "&*BOOL&~header_testname(header_line&~*hdr,&~uschar&~*name,&~&&&
34005 int&~length,&~BOOL&~notdel)*&"
34006 This function tests whether the given header has the given name. It is not just
34007 a string comparison, because white space is permitted between the name and the
34008 colon. If the &%notdel%& argument is true, a false return is forced for all
34009 &"deleted"& headers; otherwise they are not treated specially. For example:
34010 .code
34011 if (header_testname(h, US"X-Spam", 6, TRUE)) ...
34012 .endd
34013 .vitem &*uschar&~*lss_b64encode(uschar&~*cleartext,&~int&~length)*&
34014 .cindex "base64 encoding" "functions for &[local_scan()]& use"
34015 This function base64-encodes a string, which is passed by address and length.
34016 The text may contain bytes of any value, including zero. The result is passed
34017 back in dynamic memory that is obtained by calling &'store_get()'&. It is
34018 zero-terminated.
34019
34020 .vitem &*int&~lss_b64decode(uschar&~*codetext,&~uschar&~**cleartext)*&
34021 This function decodes a base64-encoded string. Its arguments are a
34022 zero-terminated base64-encoded string and the address of a variable that is set
34023 to point to the result, which is in dynamic memory. The length of the decoded
34024 string is the yield of the function. If the input is invalid base64 data, the
34025 yield is -1. A zero byte is added to the end of the output string to make it
34026 easy to interpret as a C string (assuming it contains no zeros of its own). The
34027 added zero byte is not included in the returned count.
34028
34029 .vitem &*int&~lss_match_domain(uschar&~*domain,&~uschar&~*list)*&
34030 This function checks for a match in a domain list. Domains are always
34031 matched caselessly. The return value is one of the following:
34032 .display
34033 &`OK `& match succeeded
34034 &`FAIL `& match failed
34035 &`DEFER `& match deferred
34036 .endd
34037 DEFER is usually caused by some kind of lookup defer, such as the
34038 inability to contact a database.
34039
34040 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_local_part(uschar&~*localpart,&~uschar&~*list,&~&&&
34041 BOOL&~caseless)*&"
34042 This function checks for a match in a local part list. The third argument
34043 controls case-sensitivity. The return values are as for
34044 &'lss_match_domain()'&.
34045
34046 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_address(uschar&~*address,&~uschar&~*list,&~&&&
34047 BOOL&~caseless)*&"
34048 This function checks for a match in an address list. The third argument
34049 controls the case-sensitivity of the local part match. The domain is always
34050 matched caselessly. The return values are as for &'lss_match_domain()'&.
34051
34052 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_host(uschar&~*host_name,&~uschar&~*host_address,&~&&&
34053 uschar&~*list)*&"
34054 This function checks for a match in a host list. The most common usage is
34055 expected to be
34056 .code
34057 lss_match_host(sender_host_name, sender_host_address, ...)
34058 .endd
34059 .vindex "&$sender_host_address$&"
34060 An empty address field matches an empty item in the host list. If the host name
34061 is NULL, the name corresponding to &$sender_host_address$& is automatically
34062 looked up if a host name is required to match an item in the list. The return
34063 values are as for &'lss_match_domain()'&, but in addition, &'lss_match_host()'&
34064 returns ERROR in the case when it had to look up a host name, but the lookup
34065 failed.
34066
34067 .vitem "&*void&~log_write(unsigned&~int&~selector,&~int&~which,&~char&~&&&
34068 *format,&~...)*&"
34069 This function writes to Exim's log files. The first argument should be zero (it
34070 is concerned with &%log_selector%&). The second argument can be &`LOG_MAIN`& or
34071 &`LOG_REJECT`& or &`LOG_PANIC`& or the inclusive &"or"& of any combination of
34072 them. It specifies to which log or logs the message is written. The remaining
34073 arguments are a format and relevant insertion arguments. The string should not
34074 contain any newlines, not even at the end.
34075
34076
34077 .vitem &*void&~receive_add_recipient(uschar&~*address,&~int&~pno)*&
34078 This function adds an additional recipient to the message. The first argument
34079 is the recipient address. If it is unqualified (has no domain), it is qualified
34080 with the &%qualify_recipient%& domain. The second argument must always be -1.
34081
34082 This function does not allow you to specify a private &%errors_to%& address (as
34083 described with the structure of &%recipient_item%& above), because it pre-dates
34084 the addition of that field to the structure. However, it is easy to add such a
34085 value afterwards. For example:
34086 .code
34087 receive_add_recipient(US"monitor@mydom.example", -1);
34088 recipients_list[recipients_count-1].errors_to =
34089 US"postmaster@mydom.example";
34090 .endd
34091
34092 .vitem &*BOOL&~receive_remove_recipient(uschar&~*recipient)*&
34093 This is a convenience function to remove a named recipient from the list of
34094 recipients. It returns true if a recipient was removed, and false if no
34095 matching recipient could be found. The argument must be a complete email
34096 address.
34097 .endlist
34098
34099
34100 .cindex "RFC 2047"
34101 .vlist
34102 .vitem "&*uschar&~rfc2047_decode(uschar&~*string,&~BOOL&~lencheck,&&&
34103 &~uschar&~*target,&~int&~zeroval,&~int&~*lenptr, &~&~uschar&~**error)*&"
34104 This function decodes strings that are encoded according to RFC 2047. Typically
34105 these are the contents of header lines. First, each &"encoded word"& is decoded
34106 from the Q or B encoding into a byte-string. Then, if provided with the name of
34107 a charset encoding, and if the &[iconv()]& function is available, an attempt is
34108 made to translate the result to the named character set. If this fails, the
34109 binary string is returned with an error message.
34110
34111 The first argument is the string to be decoded. If &%lencheck%& is TRUE, the
34112 maximum MIME word length is enforced. The third argument is the target
34113 encoding, or NULL if no translation is wanted.
34114
34115 .cindex "binary zero" "in RFC 2047 decoding"
34116 .cindex "RFC 2047" "binary zero in"
34117 If a binary zero is encountered in the decoded string, it is replaced by the
34118 contents of the &%zeroval%& argument. For use with Exim headers, the value must
34119 not be 0 because header lines are handled as zero-terminated strings.
34120
34121 The function returns the result of processing the string, zero-terminated; if
34122 &%lenptr%& is not NULL, the length of the result is set in the variable to
34123 which it points. When &%zeroval%& is 0, &%lenptr%& should not be NULL.
34124
34125 If an error is encountered, the function returns NULL and uses the &%error%&
34126 argument to return an error message. The variable pointed to by &%error%& is
34127 set to NULL if there is no error; it may be set non-NULL even when the function
34128 returns a non-NULL value if decoding was successful, but there was a problem
34129 with translation.
34130
34131
34132 .vitem &*int&~smtp_fflush(void)*&
34133 This function is used in conjunction with &'smtp_printf()'&, as described
34134 below.
34135
34136 .vitem &*void&~smtp_printf(char&~*,&~...)*&
34137 The arguments of this function are like &[printf()]&; it writes to the SMTP
34138 output stream. You should use this function only when there is an SMTP output
34139 stream, that is, when the incoming message is being received via interactive
34140 SMTP. This is the case when &%smtp_input%& is TRUE and &%smtp_batched_input%&
34141 is FALSE. If you want to test for an incoming message from another host (as
34142 opposed to a local process that used the &%-bs%& command line option), you can
34143 test the value of &%sender_host_address%&, which is non-NULL when a remote host
34144 is involved.
34145
34146 If an SMTP TLS connection is established, &'smtp_printf()'& uses the TLS
34147 output function, so it can be used for all forms of SMTP connection.
34148
34149 Strings that are written by &'smtp_printf()'& from within &[local_scan()]&
34150 must start with an appropriate response code: 550 if you are going to return
34151 LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT, 451 if you are going to return
34152 LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT, and 250 otherwise. Because you are writing the
34153 initial lines of a multi-line response, the code must be followed by a hyphen
34154 to indicate that the line is not the final response line. You must also ensure
34155 that the lines you write terminate with CRLF. For example:
34156 .code
34157 smtp_printf("550-this is some extra info\r\n");
34158 return LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT;
34159 .endd
34160 Note that you can also create multi-line responses by including newlines in
34161 the data returned via the &%return_text%& argument. The added value of using
34162 &'smtp_printf()'& is that, for instance, you could introduce delays between
34163 multiple output lines.
34164
34165 The &'smtp_printf()'& function does not return any error indication, because it
34166 does not automatically flush pending output, and therefore does not test
34167 the state of the stream. (In the main code of Exim, flushing and error
34168 detection is done when Exim is ready for the next SMTP input command.) If
34169 you want to flush the output and check for an error (for example, the
34170 dropping of a TCP/IP connection), you can call &'smtp_fflush()'&, which has no
34171 arguments. It flushes the output stream, and returns a non-zero value if there
34172 is an error.
34173
34174 .vitem &*void&~*store_get(int)*&
34175 This function accesses Exim's internal store (memory) manager. It gets a new
34176 chunk of memory whose size is given by the argument. Exim bombs out if it ever
34177 runs out of memory. See the next section for a discussion of memory handling.
34178
34179 .vitem &*void&~*store_get_perm(int)*&
34180 This function is like &'store_get()'&, but it always gets memory from the
34181 permanent pool. See the next section for a discussion of memory handling.
34182
34183 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_copy(uschar&~*string)*&
34184 See below.
34185
34186 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_copyn(uschar&~*string,&~int&~length)*&
34187 See below.
34188
34189 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_sprintf(char&~*format,&~...)*&
34190 These three functions create strings using Exim's dynamic memory facilities.
34191 The first makes a copy of an entire string. The second copies up to a maximum
34192 number of characters, indicated by the second argument. The third uses a format
34193 and insertion arguments to create a new string. In each case, the result is a
34194 pointer to a new string in the current memory pool. See the next section for
34195 more discussion.
34196 .endlist
34197
34198
34199
34200 .section "More about Exim's memory handling" "SECTmemhanloc"
34201 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "memory handling"
34202 No function is provided for freeing memory, because that is never needed.
34203 The dynamic memory that Exim uses when receiving a message is automatically
34204 recycled if another message is received by the same process (this applies only
34205 to incoming SMTP connections &-- other input methods can supply only one
34206 message at a time). After receiving the last message, a reception process
34207 terminates.
34208
34209 Because it is recycled, the normal dynamic memory cannot be used for holding
34210 data that must be preserved over a number of incoming messages on the same SMTP
34211 connection. However, Exim in fact uses two pools of dynamic memory; the second
34212 one is not recycled, and can be used for this purpose.
34213
34214 If you want to allocate memory that remains available for subsequent messages
34215 in the same SMTP connection, you should set
34216 .code
34217 store_pool = POOL_PERM
34218 .endd
34219 before calling the function that does the allocation. There is no need to
34220 restore the value if you do not need to; however, if you do want to revert to
34221 the normal pool, you can either restore the previous value of &%store_pool%& or
34222 set it explicitly to POOL_MAIN.
34223
34224 The pool setting applies to all functions that get dynamic memory, including
34225 &'expand_string()'&, &'store_get()'&, and the &'string_xxx()'& functions.
34226 There is also a convenience function called &'store_get_perm()'& that gets a
34227 block of memory from the permanent pool while preserving the value of
34228 &%store_pool%&.
34229 .ecindex IIDlosca
34230
34231
34232
34233
34234 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34235 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34236
34237 .chapter "System-wide message filtering" "CHAPsystemfilter"
34238 .scindex IIDsysfil1 "filter" "system filter"
34239 .scindex IIDsysfil2 "filtering all mail"
34240 .scindex IIDsysfil3 "system filter"
34241 The previous chapters (on ACLs and the local scan function) describe checks
34242 that can be applied to messages before they are accepted by a host. There is
34243 also a mechanism for checking messages once they have been received, but before
34244 they are delivered. This is called the &'system filter'&.
34245
34246 The system filter operates in a similar manner to users' filter files, but it
34247 is run just once per message (however many recipients the message has).
34248 It should not normally be used as a substitute for routing, because &%deliver%&
34249 commands in a system router provide new envelope recipient addresses.
34250 The system filter must be an Exim filter. It cannot be a Sieve filter.
34251
34252 The system filter is run at the start of a delivery attempt, before any routing
34253 is done. If a message fails to be completely delivered at the first attempt,
34254 the system filter is run again at the start of every retry.
34255 If you want your filter to do something only once per message, you can make use
34256 of the &%first_delivery%& condition in an &%if%& command in the filter to
34257 prevent it happening on retries.
34258
34259 .vindex "&$domain$&"
34260 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
34261 &*Warning*&: Because the system filter runs just once, variables that are
34262 specific to individual recipient addresses, such as &$local_part$& and
34263 &$domain$&, are not set, and the &"personal"& condition is not meaningful. If
34264 you want to run a centrally-specified filter for each recipient address
34265 independently, you can do so by setting up a suitable &(redirect)& router, as
34266 described in section &<<SECTperaddfil>>& below.
34267
34268
34269 .section "Specifying a system filter" "SECID212"
34270 .cindex "uid (user id)" "system filter"
34271 .cindex "gid (group id)" "system filter"
34272 The name of the file that contains the system filter must be specified by
34273 setting &%system_filter%&. If you want the filter to run under a uid and gid
34274 other than root, you must also set &%system_filter_user%& and
34275 &%system_filter_group%& as appropriate. For example:
34276 .code
34277 system_filter = /etc/mail/exim.filter
34278 system_filter_user = exim
34279 .endd
34280 If a system filter generates any deliveries directly to files or pipes (via the
34281 &%save%& or &%pipe%& commands), transports to handle these deliveries must be
34282 specified by setting &%system_filter_file_transport%& and
34283 &%system_filter_pipe_transport%&, respectively. Similarly,
34284 &%system_filter_reply_transport%& must be set to handle any messages generated
34285 by the &%reply%& command.
34286
34287
34288 .section "Testing a system filter" "SECID213"
34289 You can run simple tests of a system filter in the same way as for a user
34290 filter, but you should use &%-bF%& rather than &%-bf%&, so that features that
34291 are permitted only in system filters are recognized.
34292
34293 If you want to test the combined effect of a system filter and a user filter,
34294 you can use both &%-bF%& and &%-bf%& on the same command line.
34295
34296
34297
34298 .section "Contents of a system filter" "SECID214"
34299 The language used to specify system filters is the same as for users' filter
34300 files. It is described in the separate end-user document &'Exim's interface to
34301 mail filtering'&. However, there are some additional features that are
34302 available only in system filters; these are described in subsequent sections.
34303 If they are encountered in a user's filter file or when testing with &%-bf%&,
34304 they cause errors.
34305
34306 .cindex "frozen messages" "manual thaw; testing in filter"
34307 There are two special conditions which, though available in users' filter
34308 files, are designed for use in system filters. The condition &%first_delivery%&
34309 is true only for the first attempt at delivering a message, and
34310 &%manually_thawed%& is true only if the message has been frozen, and
34311 subsequently thawed by an admin user. An explicit forced delivery counts as a
34312 manual thaw, but thawing as a result of the &%auto_thaw%& setting does not.
34313
34314 &*Warning*&: If a system filter uses the &%first_delivery%& condition to
34315 specify an &"unseen"& (non-significant) delivery, and that delivery does not
34316 succeed, it will not be tried again.
34317 If you want Exim to retry an unseen delivery until it succeeds, you should
34318 arrange to set it up every time the filter runs.
34319
34320 When a system filter finishes running, the values of the variables &$n0$& &--
34321 &$n9$& are copied into &$sn0$& &-- &$sn9$& and are thereby made available to
34322 users' filter files. Thus a system filter can, for example, set up &"scores"&
34323 to which users' filter files can refer.
34324
34325
34326
34327 .section "Additional variable for system filters" "SECID215"
34328 .vindex "&$recipients$&"
34329 The expansion variable &$recipients$&, containing a list of all the recipients
34330 of the message (separated by commas and white space), is available in system
34331 filters. It is not available in users' filters for privacy reasons.
34332
34333
34334
34335 .section "Defer, freeze, and fail commands for system filters" "SECID216"
34336 .cindex "freezing messages"
34337 .cindex "message" "freezing"
34338 .cindex "message" "forced failure"
34339 .cindex "&%fail%&" "in system filter"
34340 .cindex "&%freeze%& in system filter"
34341 .cindex "&%defer%& in system filter"
34342 There are three extra commands (&%defer%&, &%freeze%& and &%fail%&) which are
34343 always available in system filters, but are not normally enabled in users'
34344 filters. (See the &%allow_defer%&, &%allow_freeze%& and &%allow_fail%& options
34345 for the &(redirect)& router.) These commands can optionally be followed by the
34346 word &%text%& and a string containing an error message, for example:
34347 .code
34348 fail text "this message looks like spam to me"
34349 .endd
34350 The keyword &%text%& is optional if the next character is a double quote.
34351
34352 The &%defer%& command defers delivery of the original recipients of the
34353 message. The &%fail%& command causes all the original recipients to be failed,
34354 and a bounce message to be created. The &%freeze%& command suspends all
34355 delivery attempts for the original recipients. In all cases, any new deliveries
34356 that are specified by the filter are attempted as normal after the filter has
34357 run.
34358
34359 The &%freeze%& command is ignored if the message has been manually unfrozen and
34360 not manually frozen since. This means that automatic freezing by a system
34361 filter can be used as a way of checking out suspicious messages. If a message
34362 is found to be all right, manually unfreezing it allows it to be delivered.
34363
34364 .cindex "log" "&%fail%& command log line"
34365 .cindex "&%fail%&" "log line; reducing"
34366 The text given with a fail command is used as part of the bounce message as
34367 well as being written to the log. If the message is quite long, this can fill
34368 up a lot of log space when such failures are common. To reduce the size of the
34369 log message, Exim interprets the text in a special way if it starts with the
34370 two characters &`<<`& and contains &`>>`& later. The text between these two
34371 strings is written to the log, and the rest of the text is used in the bounce
34372 message. For example:
34373 .code
34374 fail "<<filter test 1>>Your message is rejected \
34375 because it contains attachments that we are \
34376 not prepared to receive."
34377 .endd
34378
34379 .cindex "loop" "caused by &%fail%&"
34380 Take great care with the &%fail%& command when basing the decision to fail on
34381 the contents of the message, because the bounce message will of course include
34382 the contents of the original message and will therefore trigger the &%fail%&
34383 command again (causing a mail loop) unless steps are taken to prevent this.
34384 Testing the &%error_message%& condition is one way to prevent this. You could
34385 use, for example
34386 .code
34387 if $message_body contains "this is spam" and not error_message
34388 then fail text "spam is not wanted here" endif
34389 .endd
34390 though of course that might let through unwanted bounce messages. The
34391 alternative is clever checking of the body and/or headers to detect bounces
34392 generated by the filter.
34393
34394 The interpretation of a system filter file ceases after a
34395 &%defer%&,
34396 &%freeze%&, or &%fail%& command is obeyed. However, any deliveries that were
34397 set up earlier in the filter file are honoured, so you can use a sequence such
34398 as
34399 .code
34400 mail ...
34401 freeze
34402 .endd
34403 to send a specified message when the system filter is freezing (or deferring or
34404 failing) a message. The normal deliveries for the message do not, of course,
34405 take place.
34406
34407
34408
34409 .section "Adding and removing headers in a system filter" "SECTaddremheasys"
34410 .cindex "header lines" "adding; in system filter"
34411 .cindex "header lines" "removing; in system filter"
34412 .cindex "filter" "header lines; adding/removing"
34413 Two filter commands that are available only in system filters are:
34414 .code
34415 headers add <string>
34416 headers remove <string>
34417 .endd
34418 The argument for the &%headers add%& is a string that is expanded and then
34419 added to the end of the message's headers. It is the responsibility of the
34420 filter maintainer to make sure it conforms to RFC 2822 syntax. Leading white
34421 space is ignored, and if the string is otherwise empty, or if the expansion is
34422 forced to fail, the command has no effect.
34423
34424 You can use &"\n"& within the string, followed by white space, to specify
34425 continued header lines. More than one header may be added in one command by
34426 including &"\n"& within the string without any following white space. For
34427 example:
34428 .code
34429 headers add "X-header-1: ....\n \
34430 continuation of X-header-1 ...\n\
34431 X-header-2: ...."
34432 .endd
34433 Note that the header line continuation white space after the first newline must
34434 be placed before the backslash that continues the input string, because white
34435 space after input continuations is ignored.
34436
34437 The argument for &%headers remove%& is a colon-separated list of header names.
34438 This command applies only to those headers that are stored with the message;
34439 those that are added at delivery time (such as &'Envelope-To:'& and
34440 &'Return-Path:'&) cannot be removed by this means. If there is more than one
34441 header with the same name, they are all removed.
34442
34443 The &%headers%& command in a system filter makes an immediate change to the set
34444 of header lines that was received with the message (with possible additions
34445 from ACL processing). Subsequent commands in the system filter operate on the
34446 modified set, which also forms the basis for subsequent message delivery.
34447 Unless further modified during routing or transporting, this set of headers is
34448 used for all recipients of the message.
34449
34450 During routing and transporting, the variables that refer to the contents of
34451 header lines refer only to those lines that are in this set. Thus, header lines
34452 that are added by a system filter are visible to users' filter files and to all
34453 routers and transports. This contrasts with the manipulation of header lines by
34454 routers and transports, which is not immediate, but which instead is saved up
34455 until the message is actually being written (see section
34456 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&).
34457
34458 If the message is not delivered at the first attempt, header lines that were
34459 added by the system filter are stored with the message, and so are still
34460 present at the next delivery attempt. Header lines that were removed are still
34461 present, but marked &"deleted"& so that they are not transported with the
34462 message. For this reason, it is usual to make the &%headers%& command
34463 conditional on &%first_delivery%& so that the set of header lines is not
34464 modified more than once.
34465
34466 Because header modification in a system filter acts immediately, you have to
34467 use an indirect approach if you want to modify the contents of a header line.
34468 For example:
34469 .code
34470 headers add "Old-Subject: $h_subject:"
34471 headers remove "Subject"
34472 headers add "Subject: new subject (was: $h_old-subject:)"
34473 headers remove "Old-Subject"
34474 .endd
34475
34476
34477
34478 .section "Setting an errors address in a system filter" "SECID217"
34479 .cindex "envelope from"
34480 .cindex "envelope sender"
34481 In a system filter, if a &%deliver%& command is followed by
34482 .code
34483 errors_to <some address>
34484 .endd
34485 in order to change the envelope sender (and hence the error reporting) for that
34486 delivery, any address may be specified. (In a user filter, only the current
34487 user's address can be set.) For example, if some mail is being monitored, you
34488 might use
34489 .code
34490 unseen deliver monitor@spying.example errors_to root@local.example
34491 .endd
34492 to take a copy which would not be sent back to the normal error reporting
34493 address if its delivery failed.
34494
34495
34496
34497 .section "Per-address filtering" "SECTperaddfil"
34498 .vindex "&$domain$&"
34499 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
34500 In contrast to the system filter, which is run just once per message for each
34501 delivery attempt, it is also possible to set up a system-wide filtering
34502 operation that runs once for each recipient address. In this case, variables
34503 such as &$local_part$& and &$domain$& can be used, and indeed, the choice of
34504 filter file could be made dependent on them. This is an example of a router
34505 which implements such a filter:
34506 .code
34507 central_filter:
34508 check_local_user
34509 driver = redirect
34510 domains = +local_domains
34511 file = /central/filters/$local_part
34512 no_verify
34513 allow_filter
34514 allow_freeze
34515 .endd
34516 The filter is run in a separate process under its own uid. Therefore, either
34517 &%check_local_user%& must be set (as above), in which case the filter is run as
34518 the local user, or the &%user%& option must be used to specify which user to
34519 use. If both are set, &%user%& overrides.
34520
34521 Care should be taken to ensure that none of the commands in the filter file
34522 specify a significant delivery if the message is to go on to be delivered to
34523 its intended recipient. The router will not then claim to have dealt with the
34524 address, so it will be passed on to subsequent routers to be delivered in the
34525 normal way.
34526 .ecindex IIDsysfil1
34527 .ecindex IIDsysfil2
34528 .ecindex IIDsysfil3
34529
34530
34531
34532
34533
34534
34535 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34536 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34537
34538 .chapter "Message processing" "CHAPmsgproc"
34539 .scindex IIDmesproc "message" "general processing"
34540 Exim performs various transformations on the sender and recipient addresses of
34541 all messages that it handles, and also on the messages' header lines. Some of
34542 these are optional and configurable, while others always take place. All of
34543 this processing, except rewriting as a result of routing, and the addition or
34544 removal of header lines while delivering, happens when a message is received,
34545 before it is placed on Exim's queue.
34546
34547 Some of the automatic processing takes place by default only for
34548 &"locally-originated"& messages. This adjective is used to describe messages
34549 that are not received over TCP/IP, but instead are passed to an Exim process on
34550 its standard input. This includes the interactive &"local SMTP"& case that is
34551 set up by the &%-bs%& command line option.
34552
34553 &*Note*&: Messages received over TCP/IP on the loopback interface (127.0.0.1
34554 or ::1) are not considered to be locally-originated. Exim does not treat the
34555 loopback interface specially in any way.
34556
34557 If you want the loopback interface to be treated specially, you must ensure
34558 that there are appropriate entries in your ACLs.
34559
34560
34561
34562
34563 .section "Submission mode for non-local messages" "SECTsubmodnon"
34564 .cindex "message" "submission"
34565 .cindex "submission mode"
34566 Processing that happens automatically for locally-originated messages (unless
34567 &%suppress_local_fixups%& is set) can also be requested for messages that are
34568 received over TCP/IP. The term &"submission mode"& is used to describe this
34569 state. Submission mode is set by the modifier
34570 .code
34571 control = submission
34572 .endd
34573 in a MAIL, RCPT, or pre-data ACL for an incoming message (see sections
34574 &<<SECTACLmodi>>& and &<<SECTcontrols>>&). This makes Exim treat the message as
34575 a local submission, and is normally used when the source of the message is
34576 known to be an MUA running on a client host (as opposed to an MTA). For
34577 example, to set submission mode for messages originating on the IPv4 loopback
34578 interface, you could include the following in the MAIL ACL:
34579 .code
34580 warn hosts = 127.0.0.1
34581 control = submission
34582 .endd
34583 .cindex "&%sender_retain%& submission option"
34584 There are some options that can be used when setting submission mode. A slash
34585 is used to separate options. For example:
34586 .code
34587 control = submission/sender_retain
34588 .endd
34589 Specifying &%sender_retain%& has the effect of setting &%local_sender_retain%&
34590 true and &%local_from_check%& false for the current incoming message. The first
34591 of these allows an existing &'Sender:'& header in the message to remain, and
34592 the second suppresses the check to ensure that &'From:'& matches the
34593 authenticated sender. With this setting, Exim still fixes up messages by adding
34594 &'Date:'& and &'Message-ID:'& header lines if they are missing, but makes no
34595 attempt to check sender authenticity in header lines.
34596
34597 When &%sender_retain%& is not set, a submission mode setting may specify a
34598 domain to be used when generating a &'From:'& or &'Sender:'& header line. For
34599 example:
34600 .code
34601 control = submission/domain=some.domain
34602 .endd
34603 The domain may be empty. How this value is used is described in sections
34604 &<<SECTthefrohea>>& and &<<SECTthesenhea>>&. There is also a &%name%& option
34605 that allows you to specify the user's full name for inclusion in a created
34606 &'Sender:'& or &'From:'& header line. For example:
34607 .code
34608 accept authenticated = *
34609 control = submission/domain=wonderland.example/\
34610 name=${lookup {$authenticated_id} \
34611 lsearch {/etc/exim/namelist}}
34612 .endd
34613 Because the name may contain any characters, including slashes, the &%name%&
34614 option must be given last. The remainder of the string is used as the name. For
34615 the example above, if &_/etc/exim/namelist_& contains:
34616 .code
34617 bigegg: Humpty Dumpty
34618 .endd
34619 then when the sender has authenticated as &'bigegg'&, the generated &'Sender:'&
34620 line would be:
34621 .code
34622 Sender: Humpty Dumpty <bigegg@wonderland.example>
34623 .endd
34624 .cindex "return path" "in submission mode"
34625 By default, submission mode forces the return path to the same address as is
34626 used to create the &'Sender:'& header. However, if &%sender_retain%& is
34627 specified, the return path is also left unchanged.
34628
34629 &*Note*&: The changes caused by submission mode take effect after the predata
34630 ACL. This means that any sender checks performed before the fix-ups use the
34631 untrusted sender address specified by the user, not the trusted sender address
34632 specified by submission mode. Although this might be slightly unexpected, it
34633 does mean that you can configure ACL checks to spot that a user is trying to
34634 spoof another's address.
34635
34636 .section "Line endings" "SECTlineendings"
34637 .cindex "line endings"
34638 .cindex "carriage return"
34639 .cindex "linefeed"
34640 RFC 2821 specifies that CRLF (two characters: carriage-return, followed by
34641 linefeed) is the line ending for messages transmitted over the Internet using
34642 SMTP over TCP/IP. However, within individual operating systems, different
34643 conventions are used. For example, Unix-like systems use just LF, but others
34644 use CRLF or just CR.
34645
34646 Exim was designed for Unix-like systems, and internally, it stores messages
34647 using the system's convention of a single LF as a line terminator. When
34648 receiving a message, all line endings are translated to this standard format.
34649 Originally, it was thought that programs that passed messages directly to an
34650 MTA within an operating system would use that system's convention. Experience
34651 has shown that this is not the case; for example, there are Unix applications
34652 that use CRLF in this circumstance. For this reason, and for compatibility with
34653 other MTAs, the way Exim handles line endings for all messages is now as
34654 follows:
34655
34656 .ilist
34657 LF not preceded by CR is treated as a line ending.
34658 .next
34659 CR is treated as a line ending; if it is immediately followed by LF, the LF
34660 is ignored.
34661 .next
34662 The sequence &"CR, dot, CR"& does not terminate an incoming SMTP message,
34663 nor a local message in the state where a line containing only a dot is a
34664 terminator.
34665 .next
34666 If a bare CR is encountered within a header line, an extra space is added after
34667 the line terminator so as not to end the header line. The reasoning behind this
34668 is that bare CRs in header lines are most likely either to be mistakes, or
34669 people trying to play silly games.
34670 .next
34671 If the first header line received in a message ends with CRLF, a subsequent
34672 bare LF in a header line is treated in the same way as a bare CR in a header
34673 line.
34674 .endlist
34675
34676
34677
34678
34679
34680 .section "Unqualified addresses" "SECID218"
34681 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
34682 .cindex "address" "qualification"
34683 By default, Exim expects every envelope address it receives from an external
34684 host to be fully qualified. Unqualified addresses cause negative responses to
34685 SMTP commands. However, because SMTP is used as a means of transporting
34686 messages from MUAs running on personal workstations, there is sometimes a
34687 requirement to accept unqualified addresses from specific hosts or IP networks.
34688
34689 Exim has two options that separately control which hosts may send unqualified
34690 sender or recipient addresses in SMTP commands, namely
34691 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& and &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&. In both
34692 cases, if an unqualified address is accepted, it is qualified by adding the
34693 value of &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate.
34694
34695 .oindex "&%qualify_domain%&"
34696 .oindex "&%qualify_recipient%&"
34697 Unqualified addresses in header lines are automatically qualified for messages
34698 that are locally originated, unless the &%-bnq%& option is given on the command
34699 line. For messages received over SMTP, unqualified addresses in header lines
34700 are qualified only if unqualified addresses are permitted in SMTP commands. In
34701 other words, such qualification is also controlled by
34702 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& and &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&,
34703
34704
34705
34706
34707 .section "The UUCP From line" "SECID219"
34708 .cindex "&""From""& line"
34709 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
34710 .cindex "sender" "address"
34711 .oindex "&%uucp_from_pattern%&"
34712 .oindex "&%uucp_from_sender%&"
34713 .cindex "envelope from"
34714 .cindex "envelope sender"
34715 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
34716 Messages that have come from UUCP (and some other applications) often begin
34717 with a line containing the envelope sender and a timestamp, following the word
34718 &"From"&. Examples of two common formats are:
34719 .code
34720 From a.oakley@berlin.mus Fri Jan 5 12:35 GMT 1996
34721 From f.butler@berlin.mus Fri, 7 Jan 97 14:00:00 GMT
34722 .endd
34723 This line precedes the RFC 2822 header lines. For compatibility with Sendmail,
34724 Exim recognizes such lines at the start of messages that are submitted to it
34725 via the command line (that is, on the standard input). It does not recognize
34726 such lines in incoming SMTP messages, unless the sending host matches
34727 &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& or the &%-bs%& option was used for a local message
34728 and &%ignore_fromline_local%& is set. The recognition is controlled by a
34729 regular expression that is defined by the &%uucp_from_pattern%& option, whose
34730 default value matches the two common cases shown above and puts the address
34731 that follows &"From"& into &$1$&.
34732
34733 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &""From ""& line handling"
34734 When the caller of Exim for a non-SMTP message that contains a &"From"& line is
34735 a trusted user, the message's sender address is constructed by expanding the
34736 contents of &%uucp_sender_address%&, whose default value is &"$1"&. This is
34737 then parsed as an RFC 2822 address. If there is no domain, the local part is
34738 qualified with &%qualify_domain%& unless it is the empty string. However, if
34739 the command line &%-f%& option is used, it overrides the &"From"& line.
34740
34741 If the caller of Exim is not trusted, the &"From"& line is recognized, but the
34742 sender address is not changed. This is also the case for incoming SMTP messages
34743 that are permitted to contain &"From"& lines.
34744
34745 Only one &"From"& line is recognized. If there is more than one, the second is
34746 treated as a data line that starts the body of the message, as it is not valid
34747 as a header line. This also happens if a &"From"& line is present in an
34748 incoming SMTP message from a source that is not permitted to send them.
34749
34750
34751
34752 .section "Resent- header lines" "SECID220"
34753 .cindex "&%Resent-%& header lines"
34754 .cindex "header lines" "Resent-"
34755 RFC 2822 makes provision for sets of header lines starting with the string
34756 &`Resent-`& to be added to a message when it is resent by the original
34757 recipient to somebody else. These headers are &'Resent-Date:'&,
34758 &'Resent-From:'&, &'Resent-Sender:'&, &'Resent-To:'&, &'Resent-Cc:'&,
34759 &'Resent-Bcc:'& and &'Resent-Message-ID:'&. The RFC says:
34760
34761 .blockquote
34762 &'Resent fields are strictly informational. They MUST NOT be used in the normal
34763 processing of replies or other such automatic actions on messages.'&
34764 .endblockquote
34765
34766 This leaves things a bit vague as far as other processing actions such as
34767 address rewriting are concerned. Exim treats &%Resent-%& header lines as
34768 follows:
34769
34770 .ilist
34771 A &'Resent-From:'& line that just contains the login id of the submitting user
34772 is automatically rewritten in the same way as &'From:'& (see below).
34773 .next
34774 If there's a rewriting rule for a particular header line, it is also applied to
34775 &%Resent-%& header lines of the same type. For example, a rule that rewrites
34776 &'From:'& also rewrites &'Resent-From:'&.
34777 .next
34778 For local messages, if &'Sender:'& is removed on input, &'Resent-Sender:'& is
34779 also removed.
34780 .next
34781 For a locally-submitted message,
34782 if there are any &%Resent-%& header lines but no &'Resent-Date:'&,
34783 &'Resent-From:'&, or &'Resent-Message-Id:'&, they are added as necessary. It is
34784 the contents of &'Resent-Message-Id:'& (rather than &'Message-Id:'&) which are
34785 included in log lines in this case.
34786 .next
34787 The logic for adding &'Sender:'& is duplicated for &'Resent-Sender:'& when any
34788 &%Resent-%& header lines are present.
34789 .endlist
34790
34791
34792
34793
34794 .section "The Auto-Submitted: header line" "SECID221"
34795 Whenever Exim generates an autoreply, a bounce, or a delay warning message, it
34796 includes the header line:
34797 .code
34798 Auto-Submitted: auto-replied
34799 .endd
34800
34801 .section "The Bcc: header line" "SECID222"
34802 .cindex "&'Bcc:'& header line"
34803 If Exim is called with the &%-t%& option, to take recipient addresses from a
34804 message's header, it removes any &'Bcc:'& header line that may exist (after
34805 extracting its addresses). If &%-t%& is not present on the command line, any
34806 existing &'Bcc:'& is not removed.
34807
34808
34809 .section "The Date: header line" "SECID223"
34810 .cindex "&'Date:'& header line"
34811 .cindex "header lines" "Date:"
34812 If a locally-generated or submission-mode message has no &'Date:'& header line,
34813 Exim adds one, using the current date and time, unless the
34814 &%suppress_local_fixups%& control has been specified.
34815
34816 .section "The Delivery-date: header line" "SECID224"
34817 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
34818 .oindex "&%delivery_date_remove%&"
34819 &'Delivery-date:'& header lines are not part of the standard RFC 2822 header
34820 set. Exim can be configured to add them to the final delivery of messages. (See
34821 the generic &%delivery_date_add%& transport option.) They should not be present
34822 in messages in transit. If the &%delivery_date_remove%& configuration option is
34823 set (the default), Exim removes &'Delivery-date:'& header lines from incoming
34824 messages.
34825
34826
34827 .section "The Envelope-to: header line" "SECID225"
34828 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
34829 .cindex "header lines" "Envelope-to:"
34830 .oindex "&%envelope_to_remove%&"
34831 &'Envelope-to:'& header lines are not part of the standard RFC 2822 header set.
34832 Exim can be configured to add them to the final delivery of messages. (See the
34833 generic &%envelope_to_add%& transport option.) They should not be present in
34834 messages in transit. If the &%envelope_to_remove%& configuration option is set
34835 (the default), Exim removes &'Envelope-to:'& header lines from incoming
34836 messages.
34837
34838
34839 .section "The From: header line" "SECTthefrohea"
34840 .cindex "&'From:'& header line"
34841 .cindex "header lines" "From:"
34842 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
34843 .cindex "message" "submission"
34844 .cindex "submission mode"
34845 If a submission-mode message does not contain a &'From:'& header line, Exim
34846 adds one if either of the following conditions is true:
34847
34848 .ilist
34849 The envelope sender address is not empty (that is, this is not a bounce
34850 message). The added header line copies the envelope sender address.
34851 .next
34852 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
34853 The SMTP session is authenticated and &$authenticated_id$& is not empty.
34854 .olist
34855 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
34856 If no domain is specified by the submission control, the local part is
34857 &$authenticated_id$& and the domain is &$qualify_domain$&.
34858 .next
34859 If a non-empty domain is specified by the submission control, the local
34860 part is &$authenticated_id$&, and the domain is the specified domain.
34861 .next
34862 If an empty domain is specified by the submission control,
34863 &$authenticated_id$& is assumed to be the complete address.
34864 .endlist
34865 .endlist
34866
34867 A non-empty envelope sender takes precedence.
34868
34869 If a locally-generated incoming message does not contain a &'From:'& header
34870 line, and the &%suppress_local_fixups%& control is not set, Exim adds one
34871 containing the sender's address. The calling user's login name and full name
34872 are used to construct the address, as described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&.
34873 They are obtained from the password data by calling &[getpwuid()]& (but see the
34874 &%unknown_login%& configuration option). The address is qualified with
34875 &%qualify_domain%&.
34876
34877 For compatibility with Sendmail, if an incoming, non-SMTP message has a
34878 &'From:'& header line containing just the unqualified login name of the calling
34879 user, this is replaced by an address containing the user's login name and full
34880 name as described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&.
34881
34882
34883 .section "The Message-ID: header line" "SECID226"
34884 .cindex "&'Message-ID:'& header line"
34885 .cindex "header lines" "Message-ID:"
34886 .cindex "message" "submission"
34887 .oindex "&%message_id_header_text%&"
34888 If a locally-generated or submission-mode incoming message does not contain a
34889 &'Message-ID:'& or &'Resent-Message-ID:'& header line, and the
34890 &%suppress_local_fixups%& control is not set, Exim adds a suitable header line
34891 to the message. If there are any &'Resent-:'& headers in the message, it
34892 creates &'Resent-Message-ID:'&. The id is constructed from Exim's internal
34893 message id, preceded by the letter E to ensure it starts with a letter, and
34894 followed by @ and the primary host name. Additional information can be included
34895 in this header line by setting the &%message_id_header_text%& and/or
34896 &%message_id_header_domain%& options.
34897
34898
34899 .section "The Received: header line" "SECID227"
34900 .cindex "&'Received:'& header line"
34901 .cindex "header lines" "Received:"
34902 A &'Received:'& header line is added at the start of every message. The
34903 contents are defined by the &%received_header_text%& configuration option, and
34904 Exim automatically adds a semicolon and a timestamp to the configured string.
34905
34906 The &'Received:'& header is generated as soon as the message's header lines
34907 have been received. At this stage, the timestamp in the &'Received:'& header
34908 line is the time that the message started to be received. This is the value
34909 that is seen by the DATA ACL and by the &[local_scan()]& function.
34910
34911 Once a message is accepted, the timestamp in the &'Received:'& header line is
34912 changed to the time of acceptance, which is (apart from a small delay while the
34913 -H spool file is written) the earliest time at which delivery could start.
34914
34915
34916 .section "The References: header line" "SECID228"
34917 .cindex "&'References:'& header line"
34918 .cindex "header lines" "References:"
34919 Messages created by the &(autoreply)& transport include a &'References:'&
34920 header line. This is constructed according to the rules that are described in
34921 section 3.64 of RFC 2822 (which states that replies should contain such a
34922 header line), and section 3.14 of RFC 3834 (which states that automatic
34923 responses are not different in this respect). However, because some mail
34924 processing software does not cope well with very long header lines, no more
34925 than 12 message IDs are copied from the &'References:'& header line in the
34926 incoming message. If there are more than 12, the first one and then the final
34927 11 are copied, before adding the message ID of the incoming message.
34928
34929
34930
34931 .section "The Return-path: header line" "SECID229"
34932 .cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line"
34933 .cindex "header lines" "Return-path:"
34934 .oindex "&%return_path_remove%&"
34935 &'Return-path:'& header lines are defined as something an MTA may insert when
34936 it does the final delivery of messages. (See the generic &%return_path_add%&
34937 transport option.) Therefore, they should not be present in messages in
34938 transit. If the &%return_path_remove%& configuration option is set (the
34939 default), Exim removes &'Return-path:'& header lines from incoming messages.
34940
34941
34942
34943 .section "The Sender: header line" "SECTthesenhea"
34944 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line"
34945 .cindex "message" "submission"
34946 .cindex "header lines" "Sender:"
34947 For a locally-originated message from an untrusted user, Exim may remove an
34948 existing &'Sender:'& header line, and it may add a new one. You can modify
34949 these actions by setting the &%local_sender_retain%& option true, the
34950 &%local_from_check%& option false, or by using the &%suppress_local_fixups%&
34951 control setting.
34952
34953 When a local message is received from an untrusted user and
34954 &%local_from_check%& is true (the default), and the &%suppress_local_fixups%&
34955 control has not been set, a check is made to see if the address given in the
34956 &'From:'& header line is the correct (local) sender of the message. The address
34957 that is expected has the login name as the local part and the value of
34958 &%qualify_domain%& as the domain. Prefixes and suffixes for the local part can
34959 be permitted by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%&
34960 appropriately. If &'From:'& does not contain the correct sender, a &'Sender:'&
34961 line is added to the message.
34962
34963 If you set &%local_from_check%& false, this checking does not occur. However,
34964 the removal of an existing &'Sender:'& line still happens, unless you also set
34965 &%local_sender_retain%& to be true. It is not possible to set both of these
34966 options true at the same time.
34967
34968 .cindex "submission mode"
34969 By default, no processing of &'Sender:'& header lines is done for messages
34970 received over TCP/IP or for messages submitted by trusted users. However, when
34971 a message is received over TCP/IP in submission mode, and &%sender_retain%& is
34972 not specified on the submission control, the following processing takes place:
34973
34974 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
34975 First, any existing &'Sender:'& lines are removed. Then, if the SMTP session is
34976 authenticated, and &$authenticated_id$& is not empty, a sender address is
34977 created as follows:
34978
34979 .ilist
34980 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
34981 If no domain is specified by the submission control, the local part is
34982 &$authenticated_id$& and the domain is &$qualify_domain$&.
34983 .next
34984 If a non-empty domain is specified by the submission control, the local part
34985 is &$authenticated_id$&, and the domain is the specified domain.
34986 .next
34987 If an empty domain is specified by the submission control,
34988 &$authenticated_id$& is assumed to be the complete address.
34989 .endlist
34990
34991 This address is compared with the address in the &'From:'& header line. If they
34992 are different, a &'Sender:'& header line containing the created address is
34993 added. Prefixes and suffixes for the local part in &'From:'& can be permitted
34994 by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%& appropriately.
34995
34996 .cindex "return path" "created from &'Sender:'&"
34997 &*Note*&: Whenever a &'Sender:'& header line is created, the return path for
34998 the message (the envelope sender address) is changed to be the same address,
34999 except in the case of submission mode when &%sender_retain%& is specified.
35000
35001
35002
35003 .section "Adding and removing header lines in routers and transports" &&&
35004 "SECTheadersaddrem"
35005 .cindex "header lines" "adding; in router or transport"
35006 .cindex "header lines" "removing; in router or transport"
35007 When a message is delivered, the addition and removal of header lines can be
35008 specified in a system filter, or on any of the routers and transports that
35009 process the message. Section &<<SECTaddremheasys>>& contains details about
35010 modifying headers in a system filter. Header lines can also be added in an ACL
35011 as a message is received (see section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&).
35012
35013 In contrast to what happens in a system filter, header modifications that are
35014 specified on routers and transports apply only to the particular recipient
35015 addresses that are being processed by those routers and transports. These
35016 changes do not actually take place until a copy of the message is being
35017 transported. Therefore, they do not affect the basic set of header lines, and
35018 they do not affect the values of the variables that refer to header lines.
35019
35020 &*Note*&: In particular, this means that any expansions in the configuration of
35021 the transport cannot refer to the modified header lines, because such
35022 expansions all occur before the message is actually transported.
35023
35024 For both routers and transports, the argument of a &%headers_add%&
35025 option must be in the form of one or more RFC 2822 header lines, separated by
35026 newlines (coded as &"\n"&). For example:
35027 .code
35028 headers_add = X-added-header: added by $primary_hostname\n\
35029 X-added-second: another added header line
35030 .endd
35031 Exim does not check the syntax of these added header lines.
35032
35033 Multiple &%headers_add%& options for a single router or transport can be
35034 specified; the values will append to a single list of header lines.
35035 Each header-line is separately expanded.
35036
35037 The argument of a &%headers_remove%& option must consist of a colon-separated
35038 list of header names. This is confusing, because header names themselves are
35039 often terminated by colons. In this case, the colons are the list separators,
35040 not part of the names. For example:
35041 .code
35042 headers_remove = return-receipt-to:acknowledge-to
35043 .endd
35044
35045 Multiple &%headers_remove%& options for a single router or transport can be
35046 specified; the arguments will append to a single header-names list.
35047 Each item is separately expanded.
35048 Note that colons in complex expansions which are used to
35049 form all or part of a &%headers_remove%& list
35050 will act as list separators.
35051
35052 When &%headers_add%& or &%headers_remove%& is specified on a router,
35053 items are expanded at routing time,
35054 and then associated with all addresses that are
35055 accepted by that router, and also with any new addresses that it generates. If
35056 an address passes through several routers as a result of aliasing or
35057 forwarding, the changes are cumulative.
35058
35059 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
35060 However, this does not apply to multiple routers that result from the use of
35061 the &%unseen%& option. Any header modifications that were specified by the
35062 &"unseen"& router or its predecessors apply only to the &"unseen"& delivery.
35063
35064 Addresses that end up with different &%headers_add%& or &%headers_remove%&
35065 settings cannot be delivered together in a batch, so a transport is always
35066 dealing with a set of addresses that have the same header-processing
35067 requirements.
35068
35069 The transport starts by writing the original set of header lines that arrived
35070 with the message, possibly modified by the system filter. As it writes out
35071 these lines, it consults the list of header names that were attached to the
35072 recipient address(es) by &%headers_remove%& options in routers, and it also
35073 consults the transport's own &%headers_remove%& option. Header lines whose
35074 names are on either of these lists are not written out. If there are multiple
35075 instances of any listed header, they are all skipped.
35076
35077 After the remaining original header lines have been written, new header
35078 lines that were specified by routers' &%headers_add%& options are written, in
35079 the order in which they were attached to the address. These are followed by any
35080 header lines specified by the transport's &%headers_add%& option.
35081
35082 This way of handling header line modifications in routers and transports has
35083 the following consequences:
35084
35085 .ilist
35086 The original set of header lines, possibly modified by the system filter,
35087 remains &"visible"&, in the sense that the &$header_$&&'xxx'& variables refer
35088 to it, at all times.
35089 .next
35090 Header lines that are added by a router's
35091 &%headers_add%& option are not accessible by means of the &$header_$&&'xxx'&
35092 expansion syntax in subsequent routers or the transport.
35093 .next
35094 Conversely, header lines that are specified for removal by &%headers_remove%&
35095 in a router remain visible to subsequent routers and the transport.
35096 .next
35097 Headers added to an address by &%headers_add%& in a router cannot be removed by
35098 a later router or by a transport.
35099 .next
35100 An added header can refer to the contents of an original header that is to be
35101 removed, even it has the same name as the added header. For example:
35102 .code
35103 headers_remove = subject
35104 headers_add = Subject: new subject (was: $h_subject:)
35105 .endd
35106 .endlist
35107
35108 &*Warning*&: The &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& options cannot be used
35109 for a &(redirect)& router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
35110
35111
35112
35113
35114
35115 .section "Constructed addresses" "SECTconstr"
35116 .cindex "address" "constructed"
35117 .cindex "constructed address"
35118 When Exim constructs a sender address for a locally-generated message, it uses
35119 the form
35120 .display
35121 <&'user name'&>&~&~<&'login'&&`@`&&'qualify_domain'&>
35122 .endd
35123 For example:
35124 .code
35125 Zaphod Beeblebrox <zaphod@end.univ.example>
35126 .endd
35127 The user name is obtained from the &%-F%& command line option if set, or
35128 otherwise by looking up the calling user by &[getpwuid()]& and extracting the
35129 &"gecos"& field from the password entry. If the &"gecos"& field contains an
35130 ampersand character, this is replaced by the login name with the first letter
35131 upper cased, as is conventional in a number of operating systems. See the
35132 &%gecos_name%& option for a way to tailor the handling of the &"gecos"& field.
35133 The &%unknown_username%& option can be used to specify user names in cases when
35134 there is no password file entry.
35135
35136 .cindex "RFC 2047"
35137 In all cases, the user name is made to conform to RFC 2822 by quoting all or
35138 parts of it if necessary. In addition, if it contains any non-printing
35139 characters, it is encoded as described in RFC 2047, which defines a way of
35140 including non-ASCII characters in header lines. The value of the
35141 &%headers_charset%& option specifies the name of the encoding that is used (the
35142 characters are assumed to be in this encoding). The setting of
35143 &%print_topbitchars%& controls whether characters with the top bit set (that
35144 is, with codes greater than 127) count as printing characters or not.
35145
35146
35147
35148 .section "Case of local parts" "SECID230"
35149 .cindex "case of local parts"
35150 .cindex "local part" "case of"
35151 RFC 2822 states that the case of letters in the local parts of addresses cannot
35152 be assumed to be non-significant. Exim preserves the case of local parts of
35153 addresses, but by default it uses a lower-cased form when it is routing,
35154 because on most Unix systems, usernames are in lower case and case-insensitive
35155 routing is required. However, any particular router can be made to use the
35156 original case for local parts by setting the &%caseful_local_part%& generic
35157 router option.
35158
35159 .cindex "mixed-case login names"
35160 If you must have mixed-case user names on your system, the best way to proceed,
35161 assuming you want case-independent handling of incoming email, is to set up
35162 your first router to convert incoming local parts in your domains to the
35163 correct case by means of a file lookup. For example:
35164 .code
35165 correct_case:
35166 driver = redirect
35167 domains = +local_domains
35168 data = ${lookup{$local_part}cdb\
35169 {/etc/usercased.cdb}{$value}fail}\
35170 @$domain
35171 .endd
35172 For this router, the local part is forced to lower case by the default action
35173 (&%caseful_local_part%& is not set). The lower-cased local part is used to look
35174 up a new local part in the correct case. If you then set &%caseful_local_part%&
35175 on any subsequent routers which process your domains, they will operate on
35176 local parts with the correct case in a case-sensitive manner.
35177
35178
35179
35180 .section "Dots in local parts" "SECID231"
35181 .cindex "dot" "in local part"
35182 .cindex "local part" "dots in"
35183 RFC 2822 forbids empty components in local parts. That is, an unquoted local
35184 part may not begin or end with a dot, nor have two consecutive dots in the
35185 middle. However, it seems that many MTAs do not enforce this, so Exim permits
35186 empty components for compatibility.
35187
35188
35189
35190 .section "Rewriting addresses" "SECID232"
35191 .cindex "rewriting" "addresses"
35192 Rewriting of sender and recipient addresses, and addresses in headers, can
35193 happen automatically, or as the result of configuration options, as described
35194 in chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&. The headers that may be affected by this are
35195 &'Bcc:'&, &'Cc:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, &'Sender:'&, and &'To:'&.
35196
35197 Automatic rewriting includes qualification, as mentioned above. The other case
35198 in which it can happen is when an incomplete non-local domain is given. The
35199 routing process may cause this to be expanded into the full domain name. For
35200 example, a header such as
35201 .code
35202 To: hare@teaparty
35203 .endd
35204 might get rewritten as
35205 .code
35206 To: hare@teaparty.wonderland.fict.example
35207 .endd
35208 Rewriting as a result of routing is the one kind of message processing that
35209 does not happen at input time, as it cannot be done until the address has
35210 been routed.
35211
35212 Strictly, one should not do &'any'& deliveries of a message until all its
35213 addresses have been routed, in case any of the headers get changed as a
35214 result of routing. However, doing this in practice would hold up many
35215 deliveries for unreasonable amounts of time, just because one address could not
35216 immediately be routed. Exim therefore does not delay other deliveries when
35217 routing of one or more addresses is deferred.
35218 .ecindex IIDmesproc
35219
35220
35221
35222 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35223 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35224
35225 .chapter "SMTP processing" "CHAPSMTP"
35226 .scindex IIDsmtpproc1 "SMTP" "processing details"
35227 .scindex IIDsmtpproc2 "LMTP" "processing details"
35228 Exim supports a number of different ways of using the SMTP protocol, and its
35229 LMTP variant, which is an interactive protocol for transferring messages into a
35230 closed mail store application. This chapter contains details of how SMTP is
35231 processed. For incoming mail, the following are available:
35232
35233 .ilist
35234 SMTP over TCP/IP (Exim daemon or &'inetd'&);
35235 .next
35236 SMTP over the standard input and output (the &%-bs%& option);
35237 .next
35238 Batched SMTP on the standard input (the &%-bS%& option).
35239 .endlist
35240
35241 For mail delivery, the following are available:
35242
35243 .ilist
35244 SMTP over TCP/IP (the &(smtp)& transport);
35245 .next
35246 LMTP over TCP/IP (the &(smtp)& transport with the &%protocol%& option set to
35247 &"lmtp"&);
35248 .next
35249 LMTP over a pipe to a process running in the local host (the &(lmtp)&
35250 transport);
35251 .next
35252 Batched SMTP to a file or pipe (the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports with
35253 the &%use_bsmtp%& option set).
35254 .endlist
35255
35256 &'Batched SMTP'& is the name for a process in which batches of messages are
35257 stored in or read from files (or pipes), in a format in which SMTP commands are
35258 used to contain the envelope information.
35259
35260
35261
35262 .section "Outgoing SMTP and LMTP over TCP/IP" "SECToutSMTPTCP"
35263 .cindex "SMTP" "outgoing over TCP/IP"
35264 .cindex "outgoing SMTP over TCP/IP"
35265 .cindex "LMTP" "over TCP/IP"
35266 .cindex "outgoing LMTP over TCP/IP"
35267 .cindex "EHLO"
35268 .cindex "HELO"
35269 .cindex "SIZE option on MAIL command"
35270 Outgoing SMTP and LMTP over TCP/IP is implemented by the &(smtp)& transport.
35271 The &%protocol%& option selects which protocol is to be used, but the actual
35272 processing is the same in both cases.
35273
35274 If, in response to its EHLO command, Exim is told that the SIZE
35275 parameter is supported, it adds SIZE=<&'n'&> to each subsequent MAIL
35276 command. The value of <&'n'&> is the message size plus the value of the
35277 &%size_addition%& option (default 1024) to allow for additions to the message
35278 such as per-transport header lines, or changes made in a
35279 .cindex "transport" "filter"
35280 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
35281 transport filter. If &%size_addition%& is set negative, the use of SIZE is
35282 suppressed.
35283
35284 If the remote server advertises support for PIPELINING, Exim uses the
35285 pipelining extension to SMTP (RFC 2197) to reduce the number of TCP/IP packets
35286 required for the transaction.
35287
35288 If the remote server advertises support for the STARTTLS command, and Exim
35289 was built to support TLS encryption, it tries to start a TLS session unless the
35290 server matches &%hosts_avoid_tls%&. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for more details.
35291 Either a match in that or &%hosts_verify_avoid_tls%& apply when the transport
35292 is called for verification.
35293
35294 If the remote server advertises support for the AUTH command, Exim scans
35295 the authenticators configuration for any suitable client settings, as described
35296 in chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&.
35297
35298 .cindex "carriage return"
35299 .cindex "linefeed"
35300 Responses from the remote host are supposed to be terminated by CR followed by
35301 LF. However, there are known to be hosts that do not send CR characters, so in
35302 order to be able to interwork with such hosts, Exim treats LF on its own as a
35303 line terminator.
35304
35305 If a message contains a number of different addresses, all those with the same
35306 characteristics (for example, the same envelope sender) that resolve to the
35307 same set of hosts, in the same order, are sent in a single SMTP transaction,
35308 even if they are for different domains, unless there are more than the setting
35309 of the &%max_rcpt%&s option in the &(smtp)& transport allows, in which case
35310 they are split into groups containing no more than &%max_rcpt%&s addresses
35311 each. If &%remote_max_parallel%& is greater than one, such groups may be sent
35312 in parallel sessions. The order of hosts with identical MX values is not
35313 significant when checking whether addresses can be batched in this way.
35314
35315 When the &(smtp)& transport suffers a temporary failure that is not
35316 message-related, Exim updates its transport-specific database, which contains
35317 records indexed by host name that remember which messages are waiting for each
35318 particular host. It also updates the retry database with new retry times.
35319
35320 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
35321 Exim's retry hints are based on host name plus IP address, so if one address of
35322 a multi-homed host is broken, it will soon be skipped most of the time.
35323 See the next section for more detail about error handling.
35324
35325 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
35326 .cindex "SMTP" "batching over TCP/IP"
35327 When a message is successfully delivered over a TCP/IP SMTP connection, Exim
35328 looks in the hints database for the transport to see if there are any queued
35329 messages waiting for the host to which it is connected. If it finds one, it
35330 creates a new Exim process using the &%-MC%& option (which can only be used by
35331 a process running as root or the Exim user) and passes the TCP/IP socket to it
35332 so that it can deliver another message using the same socket. The new process
35333 does only those deliveries that are routed to the connected host, and may in
35334 turn pass the socket on to a third process, and so on.
35335
35336 The &%connection_max_messages%& option of the &(smtp)& transport can be used to
35337 limit the number of messages sent down a single TCP/IP connection.
35338
35339 .cindex "asterisk" "after IP address"
35340 The second and subsequent messages delivered down an existing connection are
35341 identified in the main log by the addition of an asterisk after the closing
35342 square bracket of the IP address.
35343
35344
35345
35346
35347 .section "Errors in outgoing SMTP" "SECToutSMTPerr"
35348 .cindex "error" "in outgoing SMTP"
35349 .cindex "SMTP" "errors in outgoing"
35350 .cindex "host" "error"
35351 Three different kinds of error are recognized for outgoing SMTP: host errors,
35352 message errors, and recipient errors.
35353
35354 .vlist
35355 .vitem "&*Host errors*&"
35356 A host error is not associated with a particular message or with a
35357 particular recipient of a message. The host errors are:
35358
35359 .ilist
35360 Connection refused or timed out,
35361 .next
35362 Any error response code on connection,
35363 .next
35364 Any error response code to EHLO or HELO,
35365 .next
35366 Loss of connection at any time, except after &"."&,
35367 .next
35368 I/O errors at any time,
35369 .next
35370 Timeouts during the session, other than in response to MAIL, RCPT or
35371 the &"."& at the end of the data.
35372 .endlist ilist
35373
35374 For a host error, a permanent error response on connection, or in response to
35375 EHLO, causes all addresses routed to the host to be failed. Any other host
35376 error causes all addresses to be deferred, and retry data to be created for the
35377 host. It is not tried again, for any message, until its retry time arrives. If
35378 the current set of addresses are not all delivered in this run (to some
35379 alternative host), the message is added to the list of those waiting for this
35380 host, so if it is still undelivered when a subsequent successful delivery is
35381 made to the host, it will be sent down the same SMTP connection.
35382
35383 .vitem "&*Message errors*&"
35384 .cindex "message" "error"
35385 A message error is associated with a particular message when sent to a
35386 particular host, but not with a particular recipient of the message. The
35387 message errors are:
35388
35389 .ilist
35390 Any error response code to MAIL, DATA, or the &"."& that terminates
35391 the data,
35392 .next
35393 Timeout after MAIL,
35394 .next
35395 Timeout or loss of connection after the &"."& that terminates the data. A
35396 timeout after the DATA command itself is treated as a host error, as is loss of
35397 connection at any other time.
35398 .endlist ilist
35399
35400 For a message error, a permanent error response (5&'xx'&) causes all addresses
35401 to be failed, and a delivery error report to be returned to the sender. A
35402 temporary error response (4&'xx'&), or one of the timeouts, causes all
35403 addresses to be deferred. Retry data is not created for the host, but instead,
35404 a retry record for the combination of host plus message id is created. The
35405 message is not added to the list of those waiting for this host. This ensures
35406 that the failing message will not be sent to this host again until the retry
35407 time arrives. However, other messages that are routed to the host are not
35408 affected, so if it is some property of the message that is causing the error,
35409 it will not stop the delivery of other mail.
35410
35411 If the remote host specified support for the SIZE parameter in its response
35412 to EHLO, Exim adds SIZE=&'nnn'& to the MAIL command, so an
35413 over-large message will cause a message error because the error arrives as a
35414 response to MAIL.
35415
35416 .vitem "&*Recipient errors*&"
35417 .cindex "recipient" "error"
35418 A recipient error is associated with a particular recipient of a message. The
35419 recipient errors are:
35420
35421 .ilist
35422 Any error response to RCPT,
35423 .next
35424 Timeout after RCPT.
35425 .endlist
35426
35427 For a recipient error, a permanent error response (5&'xx'&) causes the
35428 recipient address to be failed, and a bounce message to be returned to the
35429 sender. A temporary error response (4&'xx'&) or a timeout causes the failing
35430 address to be deferred, and routing retry data to be created for it. This is
35431 used to delay processing of the address in subsequent queue runs, until its
35432 routing retry time arrives. This applies to all messages, but because it
35433 operates only in queue runs, one attempt will be made to deliver a new message
35434 to the failing address before the delay starts to operate. This ensures that,
35435 if the failure is really related to the message rather than the recipient
35436 (&"message too big for this recipient"& is a possible example), other messages
35437 have a chance of getting delivered. If a delivery to the address does succeed,
35438 the retry information gets cleared, so all stuck messages get tried again, and
35439 the retry clock is reset.
35440
35441 The message is not added to the list of those waiting for this host. Use of the
35442 host for other messages is unaffected, and except in the case of a timeout,
35443 other recipients are processed independently, and may be successfully delivered
35444 in the current SMTP session. After a timeout it is of course impossible to
35445 proceed with the session, so all addresses get deferred. However, those other
35446 than the one that failed do not suffer any subsequent retry delays. Therefore,
35447 if one recipient is causing trouble, the others have a chance of getting
35448 through when a subsequent delivery attempt occurs before the failing
35449 recipient's retry time.
35450 .endlist
35451
35452 In all cases, if there are other hosts (or IP addresses) available for the
35453 current set of addresses (for example, from multiple MX records), they are
35454 tried in this run for any undelivered addresses, subject of course to their
35455 own retry data. In other words, recipient error retry data does not take effect
35456 until the next delivery attempt.
35457
35458 Some hosts have been observed to give temporary error responses to every
35459 MAIL command at certain times (&"insufficient space"& has been seen). It
35460 would be nice if such circumstances could be recognized, and defer data for the
35461 host itself created, but this is not possible within the current Exim design.
35462 What actually happens is that retry data for every (host, message) combination
35463 is created.
35464
35465 The reason that timeouts after MAIL and RCPT are treated specially is that
35466 these can sometimes arise as a result of the remote host's verification
35467 procedures. Exim makes this assumption, and treats them as if a temporary error
35468 response had been received. A timeout after &"."& is treated specially because
35469 it is known that some broken implementations fail to recognize the end of the
35470 message if the last character of the last line is a binary zero. Thus, it is
35471 helpful to treat this case as a message error.
35472
35473 Timeouts at other times are treated as host errors, assuming a problem with the
35474 host, or the connection to it. If a timeout after MAIL, RCPT,
35475 or &"."& is really a connection problem, the assumption is that at the next try
35476 the timeout is likely to occur at some other point in the dialogue, causing it
35477 then to be treated as a host error.
35478
35479 There is experimental evidence that some MTAs drop the connection after the
35480 terminating &"."& if they do not like the contents of the message for some
35481 reason, in contravention of the RFC, which indicates that a 5&'xx'& response
35482 should be given. That is why Exim treats this case as a message rather than a
35483 host error, in order not to delay other messages to the same host.
35484
35485
35486
35487
35488 .section "Incoming SMTP messages over TCP/IP" "SECID233"
35489 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming over TCP/IP"
35490 .cindex "incoming SMTP over TCP/IP"
35491 .cindex "inetd"
35492 .cindex "daemon"
35493 Incoming SMTP messages can be accepted in one of two ways: by running a
35494 listening daemon, or by using &'inetd'&. In the latter case, the entry in
35495 &_/etc/inetd.conf_& should be like this:
35496 .code
35497 smtp stream tcp nowait exim /opt/exim/bin/exim in.exim -bs
35498 .endd
35499 Exim distinguishes between this case and the case of a locally running user
35500 agent using the &%-bs%& option by checking whether or not the standard input is
35501 a socket. When it is, either the port must be privileged (less than 1024), or
35502 the caller must be root or the Exim user. If any other user passes a socket
35503 with an unprivileged port number, Exim prints a message on the standard error
35504 stream and exits with an error code.
35505
35506 By default, Exim does not make a log entry when a remote host connects or
35507 disconnects (either via the daemon or &'inetd'&), unless the disconnection is
35508 unexpected. It can be made to write such log entries by setting the
35509 &%smtp_connection%& log selector.
35510
35511 .cindex "carriage return"
35512 .cindex "linefeed"
35513 Commands from the remote host are supposed to be terminated by CR followed by
35514 LF. However, there are known to be hosts that do not send CR characters. In
35515 order to be able to interwork with such hosts, Exim treats LF on its own as a
35516 line terminator.
35517 Furthermore, because common code is used for receiving messages from all
35518 sources, a CR on its own is also interpreted as a line terminator. However, the
35519 sequence &"CR, dot, CR"& does not terminate incoming SMTP data.
35520
35521 .cindex "EHLO" "invalid data"
35522 .cindex "HELO" "invalid data"
35523 One area that sometimes gives rise to problems concerns the EHLO or
35524 HELO commands. Some clients send syntactically invalid versions of these
35525 commands, which Exim rejects by default. (This is nothing to do with verifying
35526 the data that is sent, so &%helo_verify_hosts%& is not relevant.) You can tell
35527 Exim not to apply a syntax check by setting &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& to
35528 match the broken hosts that send invalid commands.
35529
35530 .cindex "SIZE option on MAIL command"
35531 .cindex "MAIL" "SIZE option"
35532 The amount of disk space available is checked whenever SIZE is received on
35533 a MAIL command, independently of whether &%message_size_limit%& or
35534 &%check_spool_space%& is configured, unless &%smtp_check_spool_space%& is set
35535 false. A temporary error is given if there is not enough space. If
35536 &%check_spool_space%& is set, the check is for that amount of space plus the
35537 value given with SIZE, that is, it checks that the addition of the incoming
35538 message will not reduce the space below the threshold.
35539
35540 When a message is successfully received, Exim includes the local message id in
35541 its response to the final &"."& that terminates the data. If the remote host
35542 logs this text it can help with tracing what has happened to a message.
35543
35544 The Exim daemon can limit the number of simultaneous incoming connections it is
35545 prepared to handle (see the &%smtp_accept_max%& option). It can also limit the
35546 number of simultaneous incoming connections from a single remote host (see the
35547 &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& option). Additional connection attempts are
35548 rejected using the SMTP temporary error code 421.
35549
35550 The Exim daemon does not rely on the SIGCHLD signal to detect when a
35551 subprocess has finished, as this can get lost at busy times. Instead, it looks
35552 for completed subprocesses every time it wakes up. Provided there are other
35553 things happening (new incoming calls, starts of queue runs), completed
35554 processes will be noticed and tidied away. On very quiet systems you may
35555 sometimes see a &"defunct"& Exim process hanging about. This is not a problem;
35556 it will be noticed when the daemon next wakes up.
35557
35558 When running as a daemon, Exim can reserve some SMTP slots for specific hosts,
35559 and can also be set up to reject SMTP calls from non-reserved hosts at times of
35560 high system load &-- for details see the &%smtp_accept_reserve%&,
35561 &%smtp_load_reserve%&, and &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& options. The load check
35562 applies in both the daemon and &'inetd'& cases.
35563
35564 Exim normally starts a delivery process for each message received, though this
35565 can be varied by means of the &%-odq%& command line option and the
35566 &%queue_only%&, &%queue_only_file%&, and &%queue_only_load%& options. The
35567 number of simultaneously running delivery processes started in this way from
35568 SMTP input can be limited by the &%smtp_accept_queue%& and
35569 &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& options. When either limit is reached,
35570 subsequently received messages are just put on the input queue without starting
35571 a delivery process.
35572
35573 The controls that involve counts of incoming SMTP calls (&%smtp_accept_max%&,
35574 &%smtp_accept_queue%&, &%smtp_accept_reserve%&) are not available when Exim is
35575 started up from the &'inetd'& daemon, because in that case each connection is
35576 handled by an entirely independent Exim process. Control by load average is,
35577 however, available with &'inetd'&.
35578
35579 Exim can be configured to verify addresses in incoming SMTP commands as they
35580 are received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details. It can also be configured
35581 to rewrite addresses at this time &-- before any syntax checking is done. See
35582 section &<<SECTrewriteS>>&.
35583
35584 Exim can also be configured to limit the rate at which a client host submits
35585 MAIL and RCPT commands in a single SMTP session. See the
35586 &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& option.
35587
35588
35589
35590 .section "Unrecognized SMTP commands" "SECID234"
35591 .cindex "SMTP" "unrecognized commands"
35592 If Exim receives more than &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& unrecognized SMTP
35593 commands during a single SMTP connection, it drops the connection after sending
35594 the error response to the last command. The default value for
35595 &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& is 3. This is a defence against some kinds of
35596 abuse that subvert web servers into making connections to SMTP ports; in these
35597 circumstances, a number of non-SMTP lines are sent first.
35598
35599
35600 .section "Syntax and protocol errors in SMTP commands" "SECID235"
35601 .cindex "SMTP" "syntax errors"
35602 .cindex "SMTP" "protocol errors"
35603 A syntax error is detected if an SMTP command is recognized, but there is
35604 something syntactically wrong with its data, for example, a malformed email
35605 address in a RCPT command. Protocol errors include invalid command
35606 sequencing such as RCPT before MAIL. If Exim receives more than
35607 &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%& such commands during a single SMTP connection, it
35608 drops the connection after sending the error response to the last command. The
35609 default value for &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%& is 3. This is a defence against
35610 broken clients that loop sending bad commands (yes, it has been seen).
35611
35612
35613
35614 .section "Use of non-mail SMTP commands" "SECID236"
35615 .cindex "SMTP" "non-mail commands"
35616 The &"non-mail"& SMTP commands are those other than MAIL, RCPT, and
35617 DATA. Exim counts such commands, and drops the connection if there are too
35618 many of them in a single SMTP session. This action catches some
35619 denial-of-service attempts and things like repeated failing AUTHs, or a mad
35620 client looping sending EHLO. The global option &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&
35621 defines what &"too many"& means. Its default value is 10.
35622
35623 When a new message is expected, one occurrence of RSET is not counted. This
35624 allows a client to send one RSET between messages (this is not necessary,
35625 but some clients do it). Exim also allows one uncounted occurrence of HELO
35626 or EHLO, and one occurrence of STARTTLS between messages. After
35627 starting up a TLS session, another EHLO is expected, and so it too is not
35628 counted.
35629
35630 The first occurrence of AUTH in a connection, or immediately following
35631 STARTTLS is also not counted. Otherwise, all commands other than MAIL,
35632 RCPT, DATA, and QUIT are counted.
35633
35634 You can control which hosts are subject to the limit set by
35635 &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& by setting
35636 &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%&. The default value is &`*`&, which makes
35637 the limit apply to all hosts. This option means that you can exclude any
35638 specific badly-behaved hosts that you have to live with.
35639
35640
35641
35642
35643 .section "The VRFY and EXPN commands" "SECID237"
35644 When Exim receives a VRFY or EXPN command on a TCP/IP connection, it
35645 runs the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& or &%acl_smtp_expn%& (as
35646 appropriate) in order to decide whether the command should be accepted or not.
35647
35648 .cindex "VRFY" "processing"
35649 When no ACL is defined for VRFY, or if it rejects without
35650 setting an explicit response code, the command is accepted
35651 (with a 252 SMTP response code)
35652 in order to support awkward clients that do a VRFY before every RCPT.
35653 When VRFY is accepted, it runs exactly the same code as when Exim is
35654 called with the &%-bv%& option, and returns 250/451/550
35655 SMTP response codes.
35656
35657 .cindex "EXPN" "processing"
35658 If no ACL for EXPN is defined, the command is rejected.
35659 When EXPN is accepted, a single-level expansion of the address is done.
35660 EXPN is treated as an &"address test"& (similar to the &%-bt%& option) rather
35661 than a verification (the &%-bv%& option). If an unqualified local part is given
35662 as the argument to EXPN, it is qualified with &%qualify_domain%&. Rejections
35663 of VRFY and EXPN commands are logged on the main and reject logs, and
35664 VRFY verification failures are logged on the main log for consistency with
35665 RCPT failures.
35666
35667
35668
35669 .section "The ETRN command" "SECTETRN"
35670 .cindex "ETRN" "processing"
35671 RFC 1985 describes an SMTP command called ETRN that is designed to
35672 overcome the security problems of the TURN command (which has fallen into
35673 disuse). When Exim receives an ETRN command on a TCP/IP connection, it runs
35674 the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_etrn%& in order to decide whether the command
35675 should be accepted or not. If no ACL is defined, the command is rejected.
35676
35677 The ETRN command is concerned with &"releasing"& messages that are awaiting
35678 delivery to certain hosts. As Exim does not organize its message queue by host,
35679 the only form of ETRN that is supported by default is the one where the
35680 text starts with the &"#"& prefix, in which case the remainder of the text is
35681 specific to the SMTP server. A valid ETRN command causes a run of Exim with
35682 the &%-R%& option to happen, with the remainder of the ETRN text as its
35683 argument. For example,
35684 .code
35685 ETRN #brigadoon
35686 .endd
35687 runs the command
35688 .code
35689 exim -R brigadoon
35690 .endd
35691 which causes a delivery attempt on all messages with undelivered addresses
35692 containing the text &"brigadoon"&. When &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& is set (the
35693 default), Exim prevents the simultaneous execution of more than one queue run
35694 for the same argument string as a result of an ETRN command. This stops
35695 a misbehaving client from starting more than one queue runner at once.
35696
35697 .cindex "hints database" "ETRN serialization"
35698 Exim implements the serialization by means of a hints database in which a
35699 record is written whenever a process is started by ETRN, and deleted when
35700 the process completes. However, Exim does not keep the SMTP session waiting for
35701 the ETRN process to complete. Once ETRN is accepted, the client is sent
35702 a &"success"& return code. Obviously there is scope for hints records to get
35703 left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To guard against this,
35704 Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
35705
35706 .oindex "&%smtp_etrn_command%&"
35707 For more control over what ETRN does, the &%smtp_etrn_command%& option can
35708 used. This specifies a command that is run whenever ETRN is received,
35709 whatever the form of its argument. For
35710 example:
35711 .code
35712 smtp_etrn_command = /etc/etrn_command $domain \
35713 $sender_host_address
35714 .endd
35715 .vindex "&$domain$&"
35716 The string is split up into arguments which are independently expanded. The
35717 expansion variable &$domain$& is set to the argument of the ETRN command,
35718 and no syntax checking is done on the contents of this argument. Exim does not
35719 wait for the command to complete, so its status code is not checked. Exim runs
35720 under its own uid and gid when receiving incoming SMTP, so it is not possible
35721 for it to change them before running the command.
35722
35723
35724
35725 .section "Incoming local SMTP" "SECID238"
35726 .cindex "SMTP" "local incoming"
35727 Some user agents use SMTP to pass messages to their local MTA using the
35728 standard input and output, as opposed to passing the envelope on the command
35729 line and writing the message to the standard input. This is supported by the
35730 &%-bs%& option. This form of SMTP is handled in the same way as incoming
35731 messages over TCP/IP (including the use of ACLs), except that the envelope
35732 sender given in a MAIL command is ignored unless the caller is trusted. In
35733 an ACL you can detect this form of SMTP input by testing for an empty host
35734 identification. It is common to have this as the first line in the ACL that
35735 runs for RCPT commands:
35736 .code
35737 accept hosts = :
35738 .endd
35739 This accepts SMTP messages from local processes without doing any other tests.
35740
35741
35742
35743 .section "Outgoing batched SMTP" "SECTbatchSMTP"
35744 .cindex "SMTP" "batched outgoing"
35745 .cindex "batched SMTP output"
35746 Both the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports can be used for handling
35747 batched SMTP. Each has an option called &%use_bsmtp%& which causes messages to
35748 be output in BSMTP format. No SMTP responses are possible for this form of
35749 delivery. All it is doing is using SMTP commands as a way of transmitting the
35750 envelope along with the message.
35751
35752 The message is written to the file or pipe preceded by the SMTP commands
35753 MAIL and RCPT, and followed by a line containing a single dot. Lines in
35754 the message that start with a dot have an extra dot added. The SMTP command
35755 HELO is not normally used. If it is required, the &%message_prefix%& option
35756 can be used to specify it.
35757
35758 Because &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& are both local transports, they accept only
35759 one recipient address at a time by default. However, you can arrange for them
35760 to handle several addresses at once by setting the &%batch_max%& option. When
35761 this is done for BSMTP, messages may contain multiple RCPT commands. See
35762 chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>& for more details.
35763
35764 .vindex "&$host$&"
35765 When one or more addresses are routed to a BSMTP transport by a router that
35766 sets up a host list, the name of the first host on the list is available to the
35767 transport in the variable &$host$&. Here is an example of such a transport and
35768 router:
35769 .code
35770 begin routers
35771 route_append:
35772 driver = manualroute
35773 transport = smtp_appendfile
35774 route_list = domain.example batch.host.example
35775
35776 begin transports
35777 smtp_appendfile:
35778 driver = appendfile
35779 directory = /var/bsmtp/$host
35780 batch_max = 1000
35781 use_bsmtp
35782 user = exim
35783 .endd
35784 This causes messages addressed to &'domain.example'& to be written in BSMTP
35785 format to &_/var/bsmtp/batch.host.example_&, with only a single copy of each
35786 message (unless there are more than 1000 recipients).
35787
35788
35789
35790 .section "Incoming batched SMTP" "SECTincomingbatchedSMTP"
35791 .cindex "SMTP" "batched incoming"
35792 .cindex "batched SMTP input"
35793 The &%-bS%& command line option causes Exim to accept one or more messages by
35794 reading SMTP on the standard input, but to generate no responses. If the caller
35795 is trusted, the senders in the MAIL commands are believed; otherwise the
35796 sender is always the caller of Exim. Unqualified senders and receivers are not
35797 rejected (there seems little point) but instead just get qualified. HELO
35798 and EHLO act as RSET; VRFY, EXPN, ETRN and HELP, act
35799 as NOOP; QUIT quits.
35800
35801 Minimal policy checking is done for BSMTP input. Only the non-SMTP
35802 ACL is run in the same way as for non-SMTP local input.
35803
35804 If an error is detected while reading a message, including a missing &"."& at
35805 the end, Exim gives up immediately. It writes details of the error to the
35806 standard output in a stylized way that the calling program should be able to
35807 make some use of automatically, for example:
35808 .code
35809 554 Unexpected end of file
35810 Transaction started in line 10
35811 Error detected in line 14
35812 .endd
35813 It writes a more verbose version, for human consumption, to the standard error
35814 file, for example:
35815 .code
35816 An error was detected while processing a file of BSMTP input.
35817 The error message was:
35818
35819 501 '>' missing at end of address
35820
35821 The SMTP transaction started in line 10.
35822 The error was detected in line 12.
35823 The SMTP command at fault was:
35824
35825 rcpt to:<malformed@in.com.plete
35826
35827 1 previous message was successfully processed.
35828 The rest of the batch was abandoned.
35829 .endd
35830 The return code from Exim is zero only if there were no errors. It is 1 if some
35831 messages were accepted before an error was detected, and 2 if no messages were
35832 accepted.
35833 .ecindex IIDsmtpproc1
35834 .ecindex IIDsmtpproc2
35835
35836
35837
35838 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35839 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35840
35841 .chapter "Customizing bounce and warning messages" "CHAPemsgcust" &&&
35842 "Customizing messages"
35843 When a message fails to be delivered, or remains in the queue for more than a
35844 configured amount of time, Exim sends a message to the original sender, or
35845 to an alternative configured address. The text of these messages is built into
35846 the code of Exim, but it is possible to change it, either by adding a single
35847 string, or by replacing each of the paragraphs by text supplied in a file.
35848
35849 The &'From:'& and &'To:'& header lines are automatically generated; you can
35850 cause a &'Reply-To:'& line to be added by setting the &%errors_reply_to%&
35851 option. Exim also adds the line
35852 .code
35853 Auto-Submitted: auto-generated
35854 .endd
35855 to all warning and bounce messages,
35856
35857
35858 .section "Customizing bounce messages" "SECID239"
35859 .cindex "customizing" "bounce message"
35860 .cindex "bounce message" "customizing"
35861 If &%bounce_message_text%& is set, its contents are included in the default
35862 message immediately after &"This message was created automatically by mail
35863 delivery software."& The string is not expanded. It is not used if
35864 &%bounce_message_file%& is set.
35865
35866 When &%bounce_message_file%& is set, it must point to a template file for
35867 constructing error messages. The file consists of a series of text items,
35868 separated by lines consisting of exactly four asterisks. If the file cannot be
35869 opened, default text is used and a message is written to the main and panic
35870 logs. If any text item in the file is empty, default text is used for that
35871 item.
35872
35873 .vindex "&$bounce_recipient$&"
35874 .vindex "&$bounce_return_size_limit$&"
35875 Each item of text that is read from the file is expanded, and there are two
35876 expansion variables which can be of use here: &$bounce_recipient$& is set to
35877 the recipient of an error message while it is being created, and
35878 &$bounce_return_size_limit$& contains the value of the &%return_size_limit%&
35879 option, rounded to a whole number.
35880
35881 The items must appear in the file in the following order:
35882
35883 .ilist
35884 The first item is included in the headers, and should include at least a
35885 &'Subject:'& header. Exim does not check the syntax of these headers.
35886 .next
35887 The second item forms the start of the error message. After it, Exim lists the
35888 failing addresses with their error messages.
35889 .next
35890 The third item is used to introduce any text from pipe transports that is to be
35891 returned to the sender. It is omitted if there is no such text.
35892 .next
35893 The fourth, fifth and sixth items will be ignored and may be empty.
35894 The fields exist for back-compatibility
35895 .endlist
35896
35897 The default state (&%bounce_message_file%& unset) is equivalent to the
35898 following file, in which the sixth item is empty. The &'Subject:'& and some
35899 other lines have been split in order to fit them on the page:
35900 .code
35901 Subject: Mail delivery failed
35902 ${if eq{$sender_address}{$bounce_recipient}
35903 {: returning message to sender}}
35904 ****
35905 This message was created automatically by mail delivery software.
35906
35907 A message ${if eq{$sender_address}{$bounce_recipient}
35908 {that you sent }{sent by
35909
35910 <$sender_address>
35911
35912 }}could not be delivered to all of its recipients.
35913 This is a permanent error. The following address(es) failed:
35914 ****
35915 The following text was generated during the delivery attempt(s):
35916 ****
35917 ------ This is a copy of the message, including all the headers.
35918 ------
35919 ****
35920 ------ The body of the message is $message_size characters long;
35921 only the first
35922 ------ $bounce_return_size_limit or so are included here.
35923 ****
35924 .endd
35925 .section "Customizing warning messages" "SECTcustwarn"
35926 .cindex "customizing" "warning message"
35927 .cindex "warning of delay" "customizing the message"
35928 The option &%warn_message_file%& can be pointed at a template file for use when
35929 warnings about message delays are created. In this case there are only three
35930 text sections:
35931
35932 .ilist
35933 The first item is included in the headers, and should include at least a
35934 &'Subject:'& header. Exim does not check the syntax of these headers.
35935 .next
35936 The second item forms the start of the warning message. After it, Exim lists
35937 the delayed addresses.
35938 .next
35939 The third item then ends the message.
35940 .endlist
35941
35942 The default state is equivalent to the following file, except that some lines
35943 have been split here, in order to fit them on the page:
35944 .code
35945 Subject: Warning: message $message_exim_id delayed
35946 $warn_message_delay
35947 ****
35948 This message was created automatically by mail delivery software.
35949
35950 A message ${if eq{$sender_address}{$warn_message_recipients}
35951 {that you sent }{sent by
35952
35953 <$sender_address>
35954
35955 }}has not been delivered to all of its recipients after
35956 more than $warn_message_delay in the queue on $primary_hostname.
35957
35958 The message identifier is: $message_exim_id
35959 The subject of the message is: $h_subject
35960 The date of the message is: $h_date
35961
35962 The following address(es) have not yet been delivered:
35963 ****
35964 No action is required on your part. Delivery attempts will
35965 continue for some time, and this warning may be repeated at
35966 intervals if the message remains undelivered. Eventually the
35967 mail delivery software will give up, and when that happens,
35968 the message will be returned to you.
35969 .endd
35970 .vindex "&$warn_message_delay$&"
35971 .vindex "&$warn_message_recipients$&"
35972 However, in the default state the subject and date lines are omitted if no
35973 appropriate headers exist. During the expansion of this file,
35974 &$warn_message_delay$& is set to the delay time in one of the forms &"<&'n'&>
35975 minutes"& or &"<&'n'&> hours"&, and &$warn_message_recipients$& contains a list
35976 of recipients for the warning message. There may be more than one if there are
35977 multiple addresses with different &%errors_to%& settings on the routers that
35978 handled them.
35979
35980
35981
35982
35983 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35984 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35985
35986 .chapter "Some common configuration settings" "CHAPcomconreq"
35987 This chapter discusses some configuration settings that seem to be fairly
35988 common. More examples and discussion can be found in the Exim book.
35989
35990
35991
35992 .section "Sending mail to a smart host" "SECID240"
35993 .cindex "smart host" "example router"
35994 If you want to send all mail for non-local domains to a &"smart host"&, you
35995 should replace the default &(dnslookup)& router with a router which does the
35996 routing explicitly:
35997 .code
35998 send_to_smart_host:
35999 driver = manualroute
36000 route_list = !+local_domains smart.host.name
36001 transport = remote_smtp
36002 .endd
36003 You can use the smart host's IP address instead of the name if you wish.
36004 If you are using Exim only to submit messages to a smart host, and not for
36005 receiving incoming messages, you can arrange for it to do the submission
36006 synchronously by setting the &%mua_wrapper%& option (see chapter
36007 &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&).
36008
36009
36010
36011
36012 .section "Using Exim to handle mailing lists" "SECTmailinglists"
36013 .cindex "mailing lists"
36014 Exim can be used to run simple mailing lists, but for large and/or complicated
36015 requirements, the use of additional specialized mailing list software such as
36016 Majordomo or Mailman is recommended.
36017
36018 The &(redirect)& router can be used to handle mailing lists where each list
36019 is maintained in a separate file, which can therefore be managed by an
36020 independent manager. The &%domains%& router option can be used to run these
36021 lists in a separate domain from normal mail. For example:
36022 .code
36023 lists:
36024 driver = redirect
36025 domains = lists.example
36026 file = /usr/lists/$local_part
36027 forbid_pipe
36028 forbid_file
36029 errors_to = $local_part-request@lists.example
36030 no_more
36031 .endd
36032 This router is skipped for domains other than &'lists.example'&. For addresses
36033 in that domain, it looks for a file that matches the local part. If there is no
36034 such file, the router declines, but because &%no_more%& is set, no subsequent
36035 routers are tried, and so the whole delivery fails.
36036
36037 The &%forbid_pipe%& and &%forbid_file%& options prevent a local part from being
36038 expanded into a filename or a pipe delivery, which is usually inappropriate in
36039 a mailing list.
36040
36041 .oindex "&%errors_to%&"
36042 The &%errors_to%& option specifies that any delivery errors caused by addresses
36043 taken from a mailing list are to be sent to the given address rather than the
36044 original sender of the message. However, before acting on this, Exim verifies
36045 the error address, and ignores it if verification fails.
36046
36047 For example, using the configuration above, mail sent to
36048 &'dicts@lists.example'& is passed on to those addresses contained in
36049 &_/usr/lists/dicts_&, with error reports directed to
36050 &'dicts-request@lists.example'&, provided that this address can be verified.
36051 There could be a file called &_/usr/lists/dicts-request_& containing
36052 the address(es) of this particular list's manager(s), but other approaches,
36053 such as setting up an earlier router (possibly using the &%local_part_prefix%&
36054 or &%local_part_suffix%& options) to handle addresses of the form
36055 &%owner-%&&'xxx'& or &%xxx-%&&'request'&, are also possible.
36056
36057
36058
36059 .section "Syntax errors in mailing lists" "SECID241"
36060 .cindex "mailing lists" "syntax errors in"
36061 If an entry in redirection data contains a syntax error, Exim normally defers
36062 delivery of the original address. That means that a syntax error in a mailing
36063 list holds up all deliveries to the list. This may not be appropriate when a
36064 list is being maintained automatically from data supplied by users, and the
36065 addresses are not rigorously checked.
36066
36067 If the &%skip_syntax_errors%& option is set, the &(redirect)& router just skips
36068 entries that fail to parse, noting the incident in the log. If in addition
36069 &%syntax_errors_to%& is set to a verifiable address, a message is sent to it
36070 whenever a broken address is skipped. It is usually appropriate to set
36071 &%syntax_errors_to%& to the same address as &%errors_to%&.
36072
36073
36074
36075 .section "Re-expansion of mailing lists" "SECID242"
36076 .cindex "mailing lists" "re-expansion of"
36077 Exim remembers every individual address to which a message has been delivered,
36078 in order to avoid duplication, but it normally stores only the original
36079 recipient addresses with a message. If all the deliveries to a mailing list
36080 cannot be done at the first attempt, the mailing list is re-expanded when the
36081 delivery is next tried. This means that alterations to the list are taken into
36082 account at each delivery attempt, so addresses that have been added to
36083 the list since the message arrived will therefore receive a copy of the
36084 message, even though it pre-dates their subscription.
36085
36086 If this behaviour is felt to be undesirable, the &%one_time%& option can be set
36087 on the &(redirect)& router. If this is done, any addresses generated by the
36088 router that fail to deliver at the first attempt are added to the message as
36089 &"top level"& addresses, and the parent address that generated them is marked
36090 &"delivered"&. Thus, expansion of the mailing list does not happen again at the
36091 subsequent delivery attempts. The disadvantage of this is that if any of the
36092 failing addresses are incorrect, correcting them in the file has no effect on
36093 pre-existing messages.
36094
36095 The original top-level address is remembered with each of the generated
36096 addresses, and is output in any log messages. However, any intermediate parent
36097 addresses are not recorded. This makes a difference to the log only if the
36098 &%all_parents%& selector is set, but for mailing lists there is normally only
36099 one level of expansion anyway.
36100
36101
36102
36103 .section "Closed mailing lists" "SECID243"
36104 .cindex "mailing lists" "closed"
36105 The examples so far have assumed open mailing lists, to which anybody may
36106 send mail. It is also possible to set up closed lists, where mail is accepted
36107 from specified senders only. This is done by making use of the generic
36108 &%senders%& option to restrict the router that handles the list.
36109
36110 The following example uses the same file as a list of recipients and as a list
36111 of permitted senders. It requires three routers:
36112 .code
36113 lists_request:
36114 driver = redirect
36115 domains = lists.example
36116 local_part_suffix = -request
36117 file = /usr/lists/$local_part$local_part_suffix
36118 no_more
36119
36120 lists_post:
36121 driver = redirect
36122 domains = lists.example
36123 senders = ${if exists {/usr/lists/$local_part}\
36124 {lsearch;/usr/lists/$local_part}{*}}
36125 file = /usr/lists/$local_part
36126 forbid_pipe
36127 forbid_file
36128 errors_to = $local_part-request@lists.example
36129 no_more
36130
36131 lists_closed:
36132 driver = redirect
36133 domains = lists.example
36134 allow_fail
36135 data = :fail: $local_part@lists.example is a closed mailing list
36136 .endd
36137 All three routers have the same &%domains%& setting, so for any other domains,
36138 they are all skipped. The first router runs only if the local part ends in
36139 &%-request%&. It handles messages to the list manager(s) by means of an open
36140 mailing list.
36141
36142 The second router runs only if the &%senders%& precondition is satisfied. It
36143 checks for the existence of a list that corresponds to the local part, and then
36144 checks that the sender is on the list by means of a linear search. It is
36145 necessary to check for the existence of the file before trying to search it,
36146 because otherwise Exim thinks there is a configuration error. If the file does
36147 not exist, the expansion of &%senders%& is *, which matches all senders. This
36148 means that the router runs, but because there is no list, declines, and
36149 &%no_more%& ensures that no further routers are run. The address fails with an
36150 &"unrouteable address"& error.
36151
36152 The third router runs only if the second router is skipped, which happens when
36153 a mailing list exists, but the sender is not on it. This router forcibly fails
36154 the address, giving a suitable error message.
36155
36156
36157
36158
36159 .section "Variable Envelope Return Paths (VERP)" "SECTverp"
36160 .cindex "VERP"
36161 .cindex "Variable Envelope Return Paths"
36162 .cindex "envelope from"
36163 .cindex "envelope sender"
36164 Variable Envelope Return Paths &-- see &url(https://cr.yp.to/proto/verp.txt) &--
36165 are a way of helping mailing list administrators discover which subscription
36166 address is the cause of a particular delivery failure. The idea is to encode
36167 the original recipient address in the outgoing envelope sender address, so that
36168 if the message is forwarded by another host and then subsequently bounces, the
36169 original recipient can be extracted from the recipient address of the bounce.
36170
36171 .oindex &%errors_to%&
36172 .oindex &%return_path%&
36173 Envelope sender addresses can be modified by Exim using two different
36174 facilities: the &%errors_to%& option on a router (as shown in previous mailing
36175 list examples), or the &%return_path%& option on a transport. The second of
36176 these is effective only if the message is successfully delivered to another
36177 host; it is not used for errors detected on the local host (see the description
36178 of &%return_path%& in chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&). Here is an example
36179 of the use of &%return_path%& to implement VERP on an &(smtp)& transport:
36180 .code
36181 verp_smtp:
36182 driver = smtp
36183 max_rcpt = 1
36184 return_path = \
36185 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}\
36186 {$1-request+$local_part=$domain@your.dom.example}fail}
36187 .endd
36188 This has the effect of rewriting the return path (envelope sender) on outgoing
36189 SMTP messages, if the local part of the original return path ends in
36190 &"-request"&, and the domain is &'your.dom.example'&. The rewriting inserts the
36191 local part and domain of the recipient into the return path. Suppose, for
36192 example, that a message whose return path has been set to
36193 &'somelist-request@your.dom.example'& is sent to
36194 &'subscriber@other.dom.example'&. In the transport, the return path is
36195 rewritten as
36196 .code
36197 somelist-request+subscriber=other.dom.example@your.dom.example
36198 .endd
36199 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
36200 For this to work, you must tell Exim to send multiple copies of messages that
36201 have more than one recipient, so that each copy has just one recipient. This is
36202 achieved by setting &%max_rcpt%& to 1. Without this, a single copy of a message
36203 might be sent to several different recipients in the same domain, in which case
36204 &$local_part$& is not available in the transport, because it is not unique.
36205
36206 Unless your host is doing nothing but mailing list deliveries, you should
36207 probably use a separate transport for the VERP deliveries, so as not to use
36208 extra resources in making one-per-recipient copies for other deliveries. This
36209 can easily be done by expanding the &%transport%& option in the router:
36210 .code
36211 dnslookup:
36212 driver = dnslookup
36213 domains = ! +local_domains
36214 transport = \
36215 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}\
36216 {verp_smtp}{remote_smtp}}
36217 no_more
36218 .endd
36219 If you want to change the return path using &%errors_to%& in a router instead
36220 of using &%return_path%& in the transport, you need to set &%errors_to%& on all
36221 routers that handle mailing list addresses. This will ensure that all delivery
36222 errors, including those detected on the local host, are sent to the VERP
36223 address.
36224
36225 On a host that does no local deliveries and has no manual routing, only the
36226 &(dnslookup)& router needs to be changed. A special transport is not needed for
36227 SMTP deliveries. Every mailing list recipient has its own return path value,
36228 and so Exim must hand them to the transport one at a time. Here is an example
36229 of a &(dnslookup)& router that implements VERP:
36230 .code
36231 verp_dnslookup:
36232 driver = dnslookup
36233 domains = ! +local_domains
36234 transport = remote_smtp
36235 errors_to = \
36236 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}}
36237 {$1-request+$local_part=$domain@your.dom.example}fail}
36238 no_more
36239 .endd
36240 Before you start sending out messages with VERPed return paths, you must also
36241 configure Exim to accept the bounce messages that come back to those paths.
36242 Typically this is done by setting a &%local_part_suffix%& option for a
36243 router, and using this to route the messages to wherever you want to handle
36244 them.
36245
36246 The overhead incurred in using VERP depends very much on the size of the
36247 message, the number of recipient addresses that resolve to the same remote
36248 host, and the speed of the connection over which the message is being sent. If
36249 a lot of addresses resolve to the same host and the connection is slow, sending
36250 a separate copy of the message for each address may take substantially longer
36251 than sending a single copy with many recipients (for which VERP cannot be
36252 used).
36253
36254
36255
36256
36257
36258
36259 .section "Virtual domains" "SECTvirtualdomains"
36260 .cindex "virtual domains"
36261 .cindex "domain" "virtual"
36262 The phrase &'virtual domain'& is unfortunately used with two rather different
36263 meanings:
36264
36265 .ilist
36266 A domain for which there are no real mailboxes; all valid local parts are
36267 aliases for other email addresses. Common examples are organizational
36268 top-level domains and &"vanity"& domains.
36269 .next
36270 One of a number of independent domains that are all handled by the same host,
36271 with mailboxes on that host, but where the mailbox owners do not necessarily
36272 have login accounts on that host.
36273 .endlist
36274
36275 The first usage is probably more common, and does seem more &"virtual"& than
36276 the second. This kind of domain can be handled in Exim with a straightforward
36277 aliasing router. One approach is to create a separate alias file for each
36278 virtual domain. Exim can test for the existence of the alias file to determine
36279 whether the domain exists. The &(dsearch)& lookup type is useful here, leading
36280 to a router of this form:
36281 .code
36282 virtual:
36283 driver = redirect
36284 domains = dsearch;/etc/mail/virtual
36285 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/mail/virtual/$domain}}
36286 no_more
36287 .endd
36288 The &%domains%& option specifies that the router is to be skipped, unless there
36289 is a file in the &_/etc/mail/virtual_& directory whose name is the same as the
36290 domain that is being processed. When the router runs, it looks up the local
36291 part in the file to find a new address (or list of addresses). The &%no_more%&
36292 setting ensures that if the lookup fails (leading to &%data%& being an empty
36293 string), Exim gives up on the address without trying any subsequent routers.
36294
36295 This one router can handle all the virtual domains because the alias filenames
36296 follow a fixed pattern. Permissions can be arranged so that appropriate people
36297 can edit the different alias files. A successful aliasing operation results in
36298 a new envelope recipient address, which is then routed from scratch.
36299
36300 The other kind of &"virtual"& domain can also be handled in a straightforward
36301 way. One approach is to create a file for each domain containing a list of
36302 valid local parts, and use it in a router like this:
36303 .code
36304 my_domains:
36305 driver = accept
36306 domains = dsearch;/etc/mail/domains
36307 local_parts = lsearch;/etc/mail/domains/$domain
36308 transport = my_mailboxes
36309 .endd
36310 The address is accepted if there is a file for the domain, and the local part
36311 can be found in the file. The &%domains%& option is used to check for the
36312 file's existence because &%domains%& is tested before the &%local_parts%&
36313 option (see section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). You cannot use &%require_files%&,
36314 because that option is tested after &%local_parts%&. The transport is as
36315 follows:
36316 .code
36317 my_mailboxes:
36318 driver = appendfile
36319 file = /var/mail/$domain/$local_part
36320 user = mail
36321 .endd
36322 This uses a directory of mailboxes for each domain. The &%user%& setting is
36323 required, to specify which uid is to be used for writing to the mailboxes.
36324
36325 The configuration shown here is just one example of how you might support this
36326 requirement. There are many other ways this kind of configuration can be set
36327 up, for example, by using a database instead of separate files to hold all the
36328 information about the domains.
36329
36330
36331
36332 .section "Multiple user mailboxes" "SECTmulbox"
36333 .cindex "multiple mailboxes"
36334 .cindex "mailbox" "multiple"
36335 .cindex "local part" "prefix"
36336 .cindex "local part" "suffix"
36337 Heavy email users often want to operate with multiple mailboxes, into which
36338 incoming mail is automatically sorted. A popular way of handling this is to
36339 allow users to use multiple sender addresses, so that replies can easily be
36340 identified. Users are permitted to add prefixes or suffixes to their local
36341 parts for this purpose. The wildcard facility of the generic router options
36342 &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& can be used for this. For
36343 example, consider this router:
36344 .code
36345 userforward:
36346 driver = redirect
36347 check_local_user
36348 file = $home/.forward
36349 local_part_suffix = -*
36350 local_part_suffix_optional
36351 allow_filter
36352 .endd
36353 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
36354 It runs a user's &_.forward_& file for all local parts of the form
36355 &'username-*'&. Within the filter file the user can distinguish different
36356 cases by testing the variable &$local_part_suffix$&. For example:
36357 .code
36358 if $local_part_suffix contains -special then
36359 save /home/$local_part/Mail/special
36360 endif
36361 .endd
36362 If the filter file does not exist, or does not deal with such addresses, they
36363 fall through to subsequent routers, and, assuming no subsequent use of the
36364 &%local_part_suffix%& option is made, they presumably fail. Thus, users have
36365 control over which suffixes are valid.
36366
36367 Alternatively, a suffix can be used to trigger the use of a different
36368 &_.forward_& file &-- which is the way a similar facility is implemented in
36369 another MTA:
36370 .code
36371 userforward:
36372 driver = redirect
36373 check_local_user
36374 file = $home/.forward$local_part_suffix
36375 local_part_suffix = -*
36376 local_part_suffix_optional
36377 allow_filter
36378 .endd
36379 If there is no suffix, &_.forward_& is used; if the suffix is &'-special'&, for
36380 example, &_.forward-special_& is used. Once again, if the appropriate file
36381 does not exist, or does not deal with the address, it is passed on to
36382 subsequent routers, which could, if required, look for an unqualified
36383 &_.forward_& file to use as a default.
36384
36385
36386
36387 .section "Simplified vacation processing" "SECID244"
36388 .cindex "vacation processing"
36389 The traditional way of running the &'vacation'& program is for a user to set up
36390 a pipe command in a &_.forward_& file
36391 (see section &<<SECTspecitredli>>& for syntax details).
36392 This is prone to error by inexperienced users. There are two features of Exim
36393 that can be used to make this process simpler for users:
36394
36395 .ilist
36396 A local part prefix such as &"vacation-"& can be specified on a router which
36397 can cause the message to be delivered directly to the &'vacation'& program, or
36398 alternatively can use Exim's &(autoreply)& transport. The contents of a user's
36399 &_.forward_& file are then much simpler. For example:
36400 .code
36401 spqr, vacation-spqr
36402 .endd
36403 .next
36404 The &%require_files%& generic router option can be used to trigger a
36405 vacation delivery by checking for the existence of a certain file in the
36406 user's home directory. The &%unseen%& generic option should also be used, to
36407 ensure that the original delivery also proceeds. In this case, all the user has
36408 to do is to create a file called, say, &_.vacation_&, containing a vacation
36409 message.
36410 .endlist
36411
36412 Another advantage of both these methods is that they both work even when the
36413 use of arbitrary pipes by users is locked out.
36414
36415
36416
36417 .section "Taking copies of mail" "SECID245"
36418 .cindex "message" "copying every"
36419 Some installations have policies that require archive copies of all messages to
36420 be made. A single copy of each message can easily be taken by an appropriate
36421 command in a system filter, which could, for example, use a different file for
36422 each day's messages.
36423
36424 There is also a shadow transport mechanism that can be used to take copies of
36425 messages that are successfully delivered by local transports, one copy per
36426 delivery. This could be used, &'inter alia'&, to implement automatic
36427 notification of delivery by sites that insist on doing such things.
36428
36429
36430
36431 .section "Intermittently connected hosts" "SECID246"
36432 .cindex "intermittently connected hosts"
36433 It has become quite common (because it is cheaper) for hosts to connect to the
36434 Internet periodically rather than remain connected all the time. The normal
36435 arrangement is that mail for such hosts accumulates on a system that is
36436 permanently connected.
36437
36438 Exim was designed for use on permanently connected hosts, and so it is not
36439 particularly well-suited to use in an intermittently connected environment.
36440 Nevertheless there are some features that can be used.
36441
36442
36443 .section "Exim on the upstream server host" "SECID247"
36444 It is tempting to arrange for incoming mail for the intermittently connected
36445 host to remain in Exim's queue until the client connects. However, this
36446 approach does not scale very well. Two different kinds of waiting message are
36447 being mixed up in the same queue &-- those that cannot be delivered because of
36448 some temporary problem, and those that are waiting for their destination host
36449 to connect. This makes it hard to manage the queue, as well as wasting
36450 resources, because each queue runner scans the entire queue.
36451
36452 A better approach is to separate off those messages that are waiting for an
36453 intermittently connected host. This can be done by delivering these messages
36454 into local files in batch SMTP, &"mailstore"&, or other envelope-preserving
36455 format, from where they are transmitted by other software when their
36456 destination connects. This makes it easy to collect all the mail for one host
36457 in a single directory, and to apply local timeout rules on a per-message basis
36458 if required.
36459
36460 On a very small scale, leaving the mail on Exim's queue can be made to work. If
36461 you are doing this, you should configure Exim with a long retry period for the
36462 intermittent host. For example:
36463 .code
36464 cheshire.wonderland.fict.example * F,5d,24h
36465 .endd
36466 This stops a lot of failed delivery attempts from occurring, but Exim remembers
36467 which messages it has queued up for that host. Once the intermittent host comes
36468 online, forcing delivery of one message (either by using the &%-M%& or &%-R%&
36469 options, or by using the ETRN SMTP command (see section &<<SECTETRN>>&)
36470 causes all the queued up messages to be delivered, often down a single SMTP
36471 connection. While the host remains connected, any new messages get delivered
36472 immediately.
36473
36474 If the connecting hosts do not have fixed IP addresses, that is, if a host is
36475 issued with a different IP address each time it connects, Exim's retry
36476 mechanisms on the holding host get confused, because the IP address is normally
36477 used as part of the key string for holding retry information. This can be
36478 avoided by unsetting &%retry_include_ip_address%& on the &(smtp)& transport.
36479 Since this has disadvantages for permanently connected hosts, it is best to
36480 arrange a separate transport for the intermittently connected ones.
36481
36482
36483
36484 .section "Exim on the intermittently connected client host" "SECID248"
36485 The value of &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& should probably be
36486 increased, or even set to zero (that is, disabled) on the intermittently
36487 connected host, so that all incoming messages down a single connection get
36488 delivered immediately.
36489
36490 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
36491 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
36492 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
36493 Mail waiting to be sent from an intermittently connected host will probably
36494 not have been routed, because without a connection DNS lookups are not
36495 possible. This means that if a normal queue run is done at connection time,
36496 each message is likely to be sent in a separate SMTP session. This can be
36497 avoided by starting the queue run with a command line option beginning with
36498 &%-qq%& instead of &%-q%&. In this case, the queue is scanned twice. In the
36499 first pass, routing is done but no deliveries take place. The second pass is a
36500 normal queue run; since all the messages have been previously routed, those
36501 destined for the same host are likely to get sent as multiple deliveries in a
36502 single SMTP connection.
36503
36504
36505
36506 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36507 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36508
36509 .chapter "Using Exim as a non-queueing client" "CHAPnonqueueing" &&&
36510 "Exim as a non-queueing client"
36511 .cindex "client, non-queueing"
36512 .cindex "smart host" "suppressing queueing"
36513 On a personal computer, it is a common requirement for all
36514 email to be sent to a &"smart host"&. There are plenty of MUAs that can be
36515 configured to operate that way, for all the popular operating systems.
36516 However, there are some MUAs for Unix-like systems that cannot be so
36517 configured: they submit messages using the command line interface of
36518 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&. Furthermore, utility programs such as &'cron'& submit
36519 messages this way.
36520
36521 If the personal computer runs continuously, there is no problem, because it can
36522 run a conventional MTA that handles delivery to the smart host, and deal with
36523 any delays via its queueing mechanism. However, if the computer does not run
36524 continuously or runs different operating systems at different times, queueing
36525 email is not desirable.
36526
36527 There is therefore a requirement for something that can provide the
36528 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& interface but deliver messages to a smart host without
36529 any queueing or retrying facilities. Furthermore, the delivery to the smart
36530 host should be synchronous, so that if it fails, the sending MUA is immediately
36531 informed. In other words, we want something that extends an MUA that submits
36532 to a local MTA via the command line so that it behaves like one that submits
36533 to a remote smart host using TCP/SMTP.
36534
36535 There are a number of applications (for example, there is one called &'ssmtp'&)
36536 that do this job. However, people have found them to be lacking in various
36537 ways. For instance, you might want to allow aliasing and forwarding to be done
36538 before sending a message to the smart host.
36539
36540 Exim already had the necessary infrastructure for doing this job. Just a few
36541 tweaks were needed to make it behave as required, though it is somewhat of an
36542 overkill to use a fully-featured MTA for this purpose.
36543
36544 .oindex "&%mua_wrapper%&"
36545 There is a Boolean global option called &%mua_wrapper%&, defaulting false.
36546 Setting &%mua_wrapper%& true causes Exim to run in a special mode where it
36547 assumes that it is being used to &"wrap"& a command-line MUA in the manner
36548 just described. As well as setting &%mua_wrapper%&, you also need to provide a
36549 compatible router and transport configuration. Typically there will be just one
36550 router and one transport, sending everything to a smart host.
36551
36552 When run in MUA wrapping mode, the behaviour of Exim changes in the
36553 following ways:
36554
36555 .ilist
36556 A daemon cannot be run, nor will Exim accept incoming messages from &'inetd'&.
36557 In other words, the only way to submit messages is via the command line.
36558 .next
36559 Each message is synchronously delivered as soon as it is received (&%-odi%& is
36560 assumed). All queueing options (&%queue_only%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&,
36561 &%control%& in an ACL, etc.) are quietly ignored. The Exim reception process
36562 does not finish until the delivery attempt is complete. If the delivery is
36563 successful, a zero return code is given.
36564 .next
36565 Address redirection is permitted, but the final routing for all addresses must
36566 be to the same remote transport, and to the same list of hosts. Furthermore,
36567 the return address (envelope sender) must be the same for all recipients, as
36568 must any added or deleted header lines. In other words, it must be possible to
36569 deliver the message in a single SMTP transaction, however many recipients there
36570 are.
36571 .next
36572 If these conditions are not met, or if routing any address results in a
36573 failure or defer status, or if Exim is unable to deliver all the recipients
36574 successfully to one of the smart hosts, delivery of the entire message fails.
36575 .next
36576 Because no queueing is allowed, all failures are treated as permanent; there
36577 is no distinction between 4&'xx'& and 5&'xx'& SMTP response codes from the
36578 smart host. Furthermore, because only a single yes/no response can be given to
36579 the caller, it is not possible to deliver to some recipients and not others. If
36580 there is an error (temporary or permanent) for any recipient, all are failed.
36581 .next
36582 If more than one smart host is listed, Exim will try another host after a
36583 connection failure or a timeout, in the normal way. However, if this kind of
36584 failure happens for all the hosts, the delivery fails.
36585 .next
36586 When delivery fails, an error message is written to the standard error stream
36587 (as well as to Exim's log), and Exim exits to the caller with a return code
36588 value 1. The message is expunged from Exim's spool files. No bounce messages
36589 are ever generated.
36590 .next
36591 No retry data is maintained, and any retry rules are ignored.
36592 .next
36593 A number of Exim options are overridden: &%deliver_drop_privilege%& is forced
36594 true, &%max_rcpt%& in the &(smtp)& transport is forced to &"unlimited"&,
36595 &%remote_max_parallel%& is forced to one, and fallback hosts are ignored.
36596 .endlist
36597
36598 The overall effect is that Exim makes a single synchronous attempt to deliver
36599 the message, failing if there is any kind of problem. Because no local
36600 deliveries are done and no daemon can be run, Exim does not need root
36601 privilege. It should be possible to run it setuid to &'exim'& instead of setuid
36602 to &'root'&. See section &<<SECTrunexiwitpri>>& for a general discussion about
36603 the advantages and disadvantages of running without root privilege.
36604
36605
36606
36607
36608 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36609 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36610
36611 .chapter "Log files" "CHAPlog"
36612 .scindex IIDloggen "log" "general description"
36613 .cindex "log" "types of"
36614 Exim writes three different logs, referred to as the main log, the reject log,
36615 and the panic log:
36616
36617 .ilist
36618 .cindex "main log"
36619 The main log records the arrival of each message and each delivery in a single
36620 line in each case. The format is as compact as possible, in an attempt to keep
36621 down the size of log files. Two-character flag sequences make it easy to pick
36622 out these lines. A number of other events are recorded in the main log. Some of
36623 them are optional, in which case the &%log_selector%& option controls whether
36624 they are included or not. A Perl script called &'eximstats'&, which does simple
36625 analysis of main log files, is provided in the Exim distribution (see section
36626 &<<SECTmailstat>>&).
36627 .next
36628 .cindex "reject log"
36629 The reject log records information from messages that are rejected as a result
36630 of a configuration option (that is, for policy reasons).
36631 The first line of each rejection is a copy of the line that is also written to
36632 the main log. Then, if the message's header has been read at the time the log
36633 is written, its contents are written to this log. Only the original header
36634 lines are available; header lines added by ACLs are not logged. You can use the
36635 reject log to check that your policy controls are working correctly; on a busy
36636 host this may be easier than scanning the main log for rejection messages. You
36637 can suppress the writing of the reject log by setting &%write_rejectlog%&
36638 false.
36639 .next
36640 .cindex "panic log"
36641 .cindex "system log"
36642 When certain serious errors occur, Exim writes entries to its panic log. If the
36643 error is sufficiently disastrous, Exim bombs out afterwards. Panic log entries
36644 are usually written to the main log as well, but can get lost amid the mass of
36645 other entries. The panic log should be empty under normal circumstances. It is
36646 therefore a good idea to check it (or to have a &'cron'& script check it)
36647 regularly, in order to become aware of any problems. When Exim cannot open its
36648 panic log, it tries as a last resort to write to the system log (syslog). This
36649 is opened with LOG_PID+LOG_CONS and the facility code of LOG_MAIL. The
36650 message itself is written at priority LOG_CRIT.
36651 .endlist
36652
36653 Every log line starts with a timestamp, in the format shown in the following
36654 example. Note that many of the examples shown in this chapter are line-wrapped.
36655 In the log file, this would be all on one line:
36656 .code
36657 2001-09-16 16:09:47 SMTP connection from [127.0.0.1] closed
36658 by QUIT
36659 .endd
36660 By default, the timestamps are in the local timezone. There are two
36661 ways of changing this:
36662
36663 .ilist
36664 You can set the &%timezone%& option to a different time zone; in particular, if
36665 you set
36666 .code
36667 timezone = UTC
36668 .endd
36669 the timestamps will be in UTC (aka GMT).
36670 .next
36671 If you set &%log_timezone%& true, the time zone is added to the timestamp, for
36672 example:
36673 .code
36674 2003-04-25 11:17:07 +0100 Start queue run: pid=12762
36675 .endd
36676 .endlist
36677
36678 .cindex "log" "process ids in"
36679 .cindex "pid (process id)" "in log lines"
36680 Exim does not include its process id in log lines by default, but you can
36681 request that it does so by specifying the &`pid`& log selector (see section
36682 &<<SECTlogselector>>&). When this is set, the process id is output, in square
36683 brackets, immediately after the time and date.
36684
36685
36686
36687
36688 .section "Where the logs are written" "SECTwhelogwri"
36689 .cindex "log" "destination"
36690 .cindex "log" "to file"
36691 .cindex "log" "to syslog"
36692 .cindex "syslog"
36693 The logs may be written to local files, or to syslog, or both. However, it
36694 should be noted that many syslog implementations use UDP as a transport, and
36695 are therefore unreliable in the sense that messages are not guaranteed to
36696 arrive at the loghost, nor is the ordering of messages necessarily maintained.
36697 It has also been reported that on large log files (tens of megabytes) you may
36698 need to tweak syslog to prevent it syncing the file with each write &-- on
36699 Linux this has been seen to make syslog take 90% plus of CPU time.
36700
36701 The destination for Exim's logs is configured by setting LOG_FILE_PATH in
36702 &_Local/Makefile_& or by setting &%log_file_path%& in the runtime
36703 configuration. This latter string is expanded, so it can contain, for example,
36704 references to the host name:
36705 .code
36706 log_file_path = /var/log/$primary_hostname/exim_%slog
36707 .endd
36708 It is generally advisable, however, to set the string in &_Local/Makefile_&
36709 rather than at runtime, because then the setting is available right from the
36710 start of Exim's execution. Otherwise, if there's something it wants to log
36711 before it has read the configuration file (for example, an error in the
36712 configuration file) it will not use the path you want, and may not be able to
36713 log at all.
36714
36715 The value of LOG_FILE_PATH or &%log_file_path%& is a colon-separated
36716 list, currently limited to at most two items. This is one option where the
36717 facility for changing a list separator may not be used. The list must always be
36718 colon-separated. If an item in the list is &"syslog"& then syslog is used;
36719 otherwise the item must either be an absolute path, containing &`%s`& at the
36720 point where &"main"&, &"reject"&, or &"panic"& is to be inserted, or be empty,
36721 implying the use of a default path.
36722
36723 When Exim encounters an empty item in the list, it searches the list defined by
36724 LOG_FILE_PATH, and uses the first item it finds that is neither empty nor
36725 &"syslog"&. This means that an empty item in &%log_file_path%& can be used to
36726 mean &"use the path specified at build time"&. It no such item exists, log
36727 files are written in the &_log_& subdirectory of the spool directory. This is
36728 equivalent to the setting:
36729 .code
36730 log_file_path = $spool_directory/log/%slog
36731 .endd
36732 If you do not specify anything at build time or runtime,
36733 or if you unset the option at runtime (i.e. &`log_file_path = `&),
36734 that is where the logs are written.
36735
36736 A log file path may also contain &`%D`& or &`%M`& if datestamped log filenames
36737 are in use &-- see section &<<SECTdatlogfil>>& below.
36738
36739 Here are some examples of possible settings:
36740 .display
36741 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=syslog `& syslog only
36742 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=:syslog `& syslog and default path
36743 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=syslog : /usr/log/exim_%s `& syslog and specified path
36744 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=/usr/log/exim_%s `& specified path only
36745 .endd
36746 If there are more than two paths in the list, the first is used and a panic
36747 error is logged.
36748
36749
36750
36751 .section "Logging to local files that are periodically &""cycled""&" "SECID285"
36752 .cindex "log" "cycling local files"
36753 .cindex "cycling logs"
36754 .cindex "&'exicyclog'&"
36755 .cindex "log" "local files; writing to"
36756 Some operating systems provide centralized and standardized methods for cycling
36757 log files. For those that do not, a utility script called &'exicyclog'& is
36758 provided (see section &<<SECTcyclogfil>>&). This renames and compresses the
36759 main and reject logs each time it is called. The maximum number of old logs to
36760 keep can be set. It is suggested this script is run as a daily &'cron'& job.
36761
36762 An Exim delivery process opens the main log when it first needs to write to it,
36763 and it keeps the file open in case subsequent entries are required &-- for
36764 example, if a number of different deliveries are being done for the same
36765 message. However, remote SMTP deliveries can take a long time, and this means
36766 that the file may be kept open long after it is renamed if &'exicyclog'& or
36767 something similar is being used to rename log files on a regular basis. To
36768 ensure that a switch of log files is noticed as soon as possible, Exim calls
36769 &[stat()]& on the main log's name before reusing an open file, and if the file
36770 does not exist, or its inode has changed, the old file is closed and Exim
36771 tries to open the main log from scratch. Thus, an old log file may remain open
36772 for quite some time, but no Exim processes should write to it once it has been
36773 renamed.
36774
36775
36776
36777 .section "Datestamped log files" "SECTdatlogfil"
36778 .cindex "log" "datestamped files"
36779 Instead of cycling the main and reject log files by renaming them
36780 periodically, some sites like to use files whose names contain a datestamp,
36781 for example, &_mainlog-20031225_&. The datestamp is in the form &_yyyymmdd_& or
36782 &_yyyymm_&. Exim has support for this way of working. It is enabled by setting
36783 the &%log_file_path%& option to a path that includes &`%D`& or &`%M`& at the
36784 point where the datestamp is required. For example:
36785 .code
36786 log_file_path = /var/spool/exim/log/%slog-%D
36787 log_file_path = /var/log/exim-%s-%D.log
36788 log_file_path = /var/spool/exim/log/%D-%slog
36789 log_file_path = /var/log/exim/%s.%M
36790 .endd
36791 As before, &`%s`& is replaced by &"main"& or &"reject"&; the following are
36792 examples of names generated by the above examples:
36793 .code
36794 /var/spool/exim/log/mainlog-20021225
36795 /var/log/exim-reject-20021225.log
36796 /var/spool/exim/log/20021225-mainlog
36797 /var/log/exim/main.200212
36798 .endd
36799 When this form of log file is specified, Exim automatically switches to new
36800 files at midnight. It does not make any attempt to compress old logs; you
36801 will need to write your own script if you require this. You should not
36802 run &'exicyclog'& with this form of logging.
36803
36804 The location of the panic log is also determined by &%log_file_path%&, but it
36805 is not datestamped, because rotation of the panic log does not make sense.
36806 When generating the name of the panic log, &`%D`& or &`%M`& are removed from
36807 the string. In addition, if it immediately follows a slash, a following
36808 non-alphanumeric character is removed; otherwise a preceding non-alphanumeric
36809 character is removed. Thus, the four examples above would give these panic
36810 log names:
36811 .code
36812 /var/spool/exim/log/paniclog
36813 /var/log/exim-panic.log
36814 /var/spool/exim/log/paniclog
36815 /var/log/exim/panic
36816 .endd
36817
36818
36819 .section "Logging to syslog" "SECID249"
36820 .cindex "log" "syslog; writing to"
36821 The use of syslog does not change what Exim logs or the format of its messages,
36822 except in one respect. If &%syslog_timestamp%& is set false, the timestamps on
36823 Exim's log lines are omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. Apart from
36824 that, the same strings are written to syslog as to log files. The syslog
36825 &"facility"& is set to LOG_MAIL, and the program name to &"exim"&
36826 by default, but you can change these by setting the &%syslog_facility%& and
36827 &%syslog_processname%& options, respectively. If Exim was compiled with
36828 SYSLOG_LOG_PID set in &_Local/Makefile_& (this is the default in
36829 &_src/EDITME_&), then, on systems that permit it (all except ULTRIX), the
36830 LOG_PID flag is set so that the &[syslog()]& call adds the pid as well as
36831 the time and host name to each line.
36832 The three log streams are mapped onto syslog priorities as follows:
36833
36834 .ilist
36835 &'mainlog'& is mapped to LOG_INFO
36836 .next
36837 &'rejectlog'& is mapped to LOG_NOTICE
36838 .next
36839 &'paniclog'& is mapped to LOG_ALERT
36840 .endlist
36841
36842 Many log lines are written to both &'mainlog'& and &'rejectlog'&, and some are
36843 written to both &'mainlog'& and &'paniclog'&, so there will be duplicates if
36844 these are routed by syslog to the same place. You can suppress this duplication
36845 by setting &%syslog_duplication%& false.
36846
36847 Exim's log lines can sometimes be very long, and some of its &'rejectlog'&
36848 entries contain multiple lines when headers are included. To cope with both
36849 these cases, entries written to syslog are split into separate &[syslog()]&
36850 calls at each internal newline, and also after a maximum of
36851 870 data characters. (This allows for a total syslog line length of 1024, when
36852 additions such as timestamps are added.) If you are running a syslog
36853 replacement that can handle lines longer than the 1024 characters allowed by
36854 RFC 3164, you should set
36855 .code
36856 SYSLOG_LONG_LINES=yes
36857 .endd
36858 in &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim. That stops Exim from splitting long
36859 lines, but it still splits at internal newlines in &'reject'& log entries.
36860
36861 To make it easy to re-assemble split lines later, each component of a split
36862 entry starts with a string of the form [<&'n'&>/<&'m'&>] or [<&'n'&>\<&'m'&>]
36863 where <&'n'&> is the component number and <&'m'&> is the total number of
36864 components in the entry. The / delimiter is used when the line was split
36865 because it was too long; if it was split because of an internal newline, the \
36866 delimiter is used. For example, supposing the length limit to be 50 instead of
36867 870, the following would be the result of a typical rejection message to
36868 &'mainlog'& (LOG_INFO), each line in addition being preceded by the time, host
36869 name, and pid as added by syslog:
36870 .code
36871 [1/5] 2002-09-16 16:09:43 16RdAL-0006pc-00 rejected from
36872 [2/5] [127.0.0.1] (ph10): syntax error in 'From' header
36873 [3/5] when scanning for sender: missing or malformed lo
36874 [4/5] cal part in "<>" (envelope sender is <ph10@cam.exa
36875 [5/5] mple>)
36876 .endd
36877 The same error might cause the following lines to be written to &"rejectlog"&
36878 (LOG_NOTICE):
36879 .code
36880 [1/18] 2002-09-16 16:09:43 16RdAL-0006pc-00 rejected fro
36881 [2/18] m [127.0.0.1] (ph10): syntax error in 'From' head
36882 [3/18] er when scanning for sender: missing or malformed
36883 [4/18] local part in "<>" (envelope sender is <ph10@cam
36884 [5\18] .example>)
36885 [6\18] Recipients: ph10@some.domain.cam.example
36886 [7\18] P Received: from [127.0.0.1] (ident=ph10)
36887 [8\18] by xxxxx.cam.example with smtp (Exim 4.00)
36888 [9\18] id 16RdAL-0006pc-00
36889 [10/18] for ph10@cam.example; Mon, 16 Sep 2002 16:
36890 [11\18] 09:43 +0100
36891 [12\18] F From: <>
36892 [13\18] Subject: this is a test header
36893 [18\18] X-something: this is another header
36894 [15/18] I Message-Id: <E16RdAL-0006pc-00@xxxxx.cam.examp
36895 [16\18] le>
36896 [17\18] B Bcc:
36897 [18/18] Date: Mon, 16 Sep 2002 16:09:43 +0100
36898 .endd
36899 Log lines that are neither too long nor contain newlines are written to syslog
36900 without modification.
36901
36902 If only syslog is being used, the Exim monitor is unable to provide a log tail
36903 display, unless syslog is routing &'mainlog'& to a file on the local host and
36904 the environment variable EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH is set to tell the monitor
36905 where it is.
36906
36907
36908
36909 .section "Log line flags" "SECID250"
36910 One line is written to the main log for each message received, and for each
36911 successful, unsuccessful, and delayed delivery. These lines can readily be
36912 picked out by the distinctive two-character flags that immediately follow the
36913 timestamp. The flags are:
36914 .display
36915 &`<=`& message arrival
36916 &`(=`& message fakereject
36917 &`=>`& normal message delivery
36918 &`->`& additional address in same delivery
36919 &`>>`& cutthrough message delivery
36920 &`*>`& delivery suppressed by &%-N%&
36921 &`**`& delivery failed; address bounced
36922 &`==`& delivery deferred; temporary problem
36923 .endd
36924
36925
36926 .section "Logging message reception" "SECID251"
36927 .cindex "log" "reception line"
36928 The format of the single-line entry in the main log that is written for every
36929 message received is shown in the basic example below, which is split over
36930 several lines in order to fit it on the page:
36931 .code
36932 2002-10-31 08:57:53 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 <= kryten@dwarf.fict.example
36933 H=mailer.fict.example [192.168.123.123] U=exim
36934 P=smtp S=5678 id=<incoming message id>
36935 .endd
36936 The address immediately following &"<="& is the envelope sender address. A
36937 bounce message is shown with the sender address &"<>"&, and if it is locally
36938 generated, this is followed by an item of the form
36939 .code
36940 R=<message id>
36941 .endd
36942 which is a reference to the message that caused the bounce to be sent.
36943
36944 .cindex "HELO"
36945 .cindex "EHLO"
36946 For messages from other hosts, the H and U fields identify the remote host and
36947 record the RFC 1413 identity of the user that sent the message, if one was
36948 received. The number given in square brackets is the IP address of the sending
36949 host. If there is a single, unparenthesized host name in the H field, as
36950 above, it has been verified to correspond to the IP address (see the
36951 &%host_lookup%& option). If the name is in parentheses, it was the name quoted
36952 by the remote host in the SMTP HELO or EHLO command, and has not been
36953 verified. If verification yields a different name to that given for HELO or
36954 EHLO, the verified name appears first, followed by the HELO or EHLO
36955 name in parentheses.
36956
36957 Misconfigured hosts (and mail forgers) sometimes put an IP address, with or
36958 without brackets, in the HELO or EHLO command, leading to entries in
36959 the log containing text like these examples:
36960 .code
36961 H=(10.21.32.43) [192.168.8.34]
36962 H=([10.21.32.43]) [192.168.8.34]
36963 .endd
36964 This can be confusing. Only the final address in square brackets can be relied
36965 on.
36966
36967 For locally generated messages (that is, messages not received over TCP/IP),
36968 the H field is omitted, and the U field contains the login name of the caller
36969 of Exim.
36970
36971 .cindex "authentication" "logging"
36972 .cindex "AUTH" "logging"
36973 For all messages, the P field specifies the protocol used to receive the
36974 message. This is the value that is stored in &$received_protocol$&. In the case
36975 of incoming SMTP messages, the value indicates whether or not any SMTP
36976 extensions (ESMTP), encryption, or authentication were used. If the SMTP
36977 session was encrypted, there is an additional X field that records the cipher
36978 suite that was used.
36979
36980 .cindex log protocol
36981 The protocol is set to &"esmtpsa"& or &"esmtpa"& for messages received from
36982 hosts that have authenticated themselves using the SMTP AUTH command. The first
36983 value is used when the SMTP connection was encrypted (&"secure"&). In this case
36984 there is an additional item A= followed by the name of the authenticator that
36985 was used. If an authenticated identification was set up by the authenticator's
36986 &%server_set_id%& option, this is logged too, separated by a colon from the
36987 authenticator name.
36988
36989 .cindex "size" "of message"
36990 The id field records the existing message id, if present. The size of the
36991 received message is given by the S field. When the message is delivered,
36992 headers may be removed or added, so that the size of delivered copies of the
36993 message may not correspond with this value (and indeed may be different to each
36994 other).
36995
36996 The &%log_selector%& option can be used to request the logging of additional
36997 data when a message is received. See section &<<SECTlogselector>>& below.
36998
36999
37000
37001 .section "Logging deliveries" "SECID252"
37002 .cindex "log" "delivery line"
37003 The format of the single-line entry in the main log that is written for every
37004 delivery is shown in one of the examples below, for local and remote
37005 deliveries, respectively. Each example has been split into multiple lines in order
37006 to fit it on the page:
37007 .code
37008 2002-10-31 08:59:13 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 => marv
37009 <marv@hitch.fict.example> R=localuser T=local_delivery
37010 2002-10-31 09:00:10 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 =>
37011 monk@holistic.fict.example R=dnslookup T=remote_smtp
37012 H=holistic.fict.example [192.168.234.234]
37013 .endd
37014 For ordinary local deliveries, the original address is given in angle brackets
37015 after the final delivery address, which might be a pipe or a file. If
37016 intermediate address(es) exist between the original and the final address, the
37017 last of these is given in parentheses after the final address. The R and T
37018 fields record the router and transport that were used to process the address.
37019
37020 If SMTP AUTH was used for the delivery there is an additional item A=
37021 followed by the name of the authenticator that was used.
37022 If an authenticated identification was set up by the authenticator's &%client_set_id%&
37023 option, this is logged too, separated by a colon from the authenticator name.
37024
37025 If a shadow transport was run after a successful local delivery, the log line
37026 for the successful delivery has an item added on the end, of the form
37027 .display
37028 &`ST=<`&&'shadow transport name'&&`>`&
37029 .endd
37030 If the shadow transport did not succeed, the error message is put in
37031 parentheses afterwards.
37032
37033 .cindex "asterisk" "after IP address"
37034 When more than one address is included in a single delivery (for example, two
37035 SMTP RCPT commands in one transaction) the second and subsequent addresses are
37036 flagged with &`->`& instead of &`=>`&. When two or more messages are delivered
37037 down a single SMTP connection, an asterisk follows the IP address in the log
37038 lines for the second and subsequent messages.
37039 When two or more messages are delivered down a single TLS connection, the
37040 DNS and some TLS-related information logged for the first message delivered
37041 will not be present in the log lines for the second and subsequent messages.
37042 TLS cipher information is still available.
37043
37044 .cindex "delivery" "cutthrough; logging"
37045 .cindex "cutthrough" "logging"
37046 When delivery is done in cutthrough mode it is flagged with &`>>`& and the log
37047 line precedes the reception line, since cutthrough waits for a possible
37048 rejection from the destination in case it can reject the sourced item.
37049
37050 The generation of a reply message by a filter file gets logged as a
37051 &"delivery"& to the addressee, preceded by &">"&.
37052
37053 The &%log_selector%& option can be used to request the logging of additional
37054 data when a message is delivered. See section &<<SECTlogselector>>& below.
37055
37056
37057 .section "Discarded deliveries" "SECID253"
37058 .cindex "discarded messages"
37059 .cindex "message" "discarded"
37060 .cindex "delivery" "discarded; logging"
37061 When a message is discarded as a result of the command &"seen finish"& being
37062 obeyed in a filter file which generates no deliveries, a log entry of the form
37063 .code
37064 2002-12-10 00:50:49 16auJc-0001UB-00 => discarded
37065 <low.club@bridge.example> R=userforward
37066 .endd
37067 is written, to record why no deliveries are logged. When a message is discarded
37068 because it is aliased to &":blackhole:"& the log line is like this:
37069 .code
37070 1999-03-02 09:44:33 10HmaX-0005vi-00 => :blackhole:
37071 <hole@nowhere.example> R=blackhole_router
37072 .endd
37073
37074
37075 .section "Deferred deliveries" "SECID254"
37076 When a delivery is deferred, a line of the following form is logged:
37077 .code
37078 2002-12-19 16:20:23 16aiQz-0002Q5-00 == marvin@endrest.example
37079 R=dnslookup T=smtp defer (146): Connection refused
37080 .endd
37081 In the case of remote deliveries, the error is the one that was given for the
37082 last IP address that was tried. Details of individual SMTP failures are also
37083 written to the log, so the above line would be preceded by something like
37084 .code
37085 2002-12-19 16:20:23 16aiQz-0002Q5-00 Failed to connect to
37086 mail1.endrest.example [192.168.239.239]: Connection refused
37087 .endd
37088 When a deferred address is skipped because its retry time has not been reached,
37089 a message is written to the log, but this can be suppressed by setting an
37090 appropriate value in &%log_selector%&.
37091
37092
37093
37094 .section "Delivery failures" "SECID255"
37095 .cindex "delivery" "failure; logging"
37096 If a delivery fails because an address cannot be routed, a line of the
37097 following form is logged:
37098 .code
37099 1995-12-19 16:20:23 0tRiQz-0002Q5-00 ** jim@trek99.example
37100 <jim@trek99.example>: unknown mail domain
37101 .endd
37102 If a delivery fails at transport time, the router and transport are shown, and
37103 the response from the remote host is included, as in this example:
37104 .code
37105 2002-07-11 07:14:17 17SXDU-000189-00 ** ace400@pb.example
37106 R=dnslookup T=remote_smtp: SMTP error from remote mailer
37107 after pipelined RCPT TO:<ace400@pb.example>: host
37108 pbmail3.py.example [192.168.63.111]: 553 5.3.0
37109 <ace400@pb.example>...Addressee unknown
37110 .endd
37111 The word &"pipelined"& indicates that the SMTP PIPELINING extension was being
37112 used. See &%hosts_avoid_esmtp%& in the &(smtp)& transport for a way of
37113 disabling PIPELINING. The log lines for all forms of delivery failure are
37114 flagged with &`**`&.
37115
37116
37117
37118 .section "Fake deliveries" "SECID256"
37119 .cindex "delivery" "fake; logging"
37120 If a delivery does not actually take place because the &%-N%& option has been
37121 used to suppress it, a normal delivery line is written to the log, except that
37122 &"=>"& is replaced by &"*>"&.
37123
37124
37125
37126 .section "Completion" "SECID257"
37127 A line of the form
37128 .code
37129 2002-10-31 09:00:11 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 Completed
37130 .endd
37131 is written to the main log when a message is about to be removed from the spool
37132 at the end of its processing.
37133
37134
37135
37136
37137 .section "Summary of Fields in Log Lines" "SECID258"
37138 .cindex "log" "summary of fields"
37139 A summary of the field identifiers that are used in log lines is shown in
37140 the following table:
37141 .display
37142 &`A `& authenticator name (and optional id and sender)
37143 &`C `& SMTP confirmation on delivery
37144 &` `& command list for &"no mail in SMTP session"&
37145 &`CV `& certificate verification status
37146 &`D `& duration of &"no mail in SMTP session"&
37147 &`DKIM`& domain verified in incoming message
37148 &`DN `& distinguished name from peer certificate
37149 &`DS `& DNSSEC secured lookups
37150 &`DT `& on &`=>`& lines: time taken for a delivery
37151 &`F `& sender address (on delivery lines)
37152 &`H `& host name and IP address
37153 &`I `& local interface used
37154 &`id `& message id (from header) for incoming message
37155 &`K `& CHUNKING extension used
37156 &`L `& on &`<=`& and &`=>`& lines: PIPELINING extension used
37157 &`M8S `& 8BITMIME status for incoming message
37158 &`P `& on &`<=`& lines: protocol used
37159 &` `& on &`=>`& and &`**`& lines: return path
37160 &`PRDR`& PRDR extension used
37161 &`PRX `& on &`<=`& and &`=>`& lines: proxy address
37162 &`Q `& alternate queue name
37163 &`QT `& on &`=>`& lines: time spent on queue so far
37164 &` `& on &"Completed"& lines: time spent on queue
37165 &`R `& on &`<=`& lines: reference for local bounce
37166 &` `& on &`=>`& &`>>`& &`**`& and &`==`& lines: router name
37167 &`RT `& on &`<=`& lines: time taken for reception
37168 &`S `& size of message in bytes
37169 &`SNI `& server name indication from TLS client hello
37170 &`ST `& shadow transport name
37171 &`T `& on &`<=`& lines: message subject (topic)
37172 &`TFO `& connection took advantage of TCP Fast Open
37173 &` `& on &`=>`& &`**`& and &`==`& lines: transport name
37174 &`U `& local user or RFC 1413 identity
37175 &`X `& TLS cipher suite
37176 .endd
37177
37178
37179 .section "Other log entries" "SECID259"
37180 Various other types of log entry are written from time to time. Most should be
37181 self-explanatory. Among the more common are:
37182
37183 .ilist
37184 .cindex "retry" "time not reached"
37185 &'retry time not reached'&&~&~An address previously suffered a temporary error
37186 during routing or local delivery, and the time to retry has not yet arrived.
37187 This message is not written to an individual message log file unless it happens
37188 during the first delivery attempt.
37189 .next
37190 &'retry time not reached for any host'&&~&~An address previously suffered
37191 temporary errors during remote delivery, and the retry time has not yet arrived
37192 for any of the hosts to which it is routed.
37193 .next
37194 .cindex "spool directory" "file locked"
37195 &'spool file locked'&&~&~An attempt to deliver a message cannot proceed because
37196 some other Exim process is already working on the message. This can be quite
37197 common if queue running processes are started at frequent intervals. The
37198 &'exiwhat'& utility script can be used to find out what Exim processes are
37199 doing.
37200 .next
37201 .cindex "error" "ignored"
37202 &'error ignored'&&~&~There are several circumstances that give rise to this
37203 message:
37204 .olist
37205 Exim failed to deliver a bounce message whose age was greater than
37206 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&. The bounce was discarded.
37207 .next
37208 A filter file set up a delivery using the &"noerror"& option, and the delivery
37209 failed. The delivery was discarded.
37210 .next
37211 A delivery set up by a router configured with
37212 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
37213 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
37214 .code
37215 errors_to = <>
37216 .endd
37217 failed. The delivery was discarded.
37218 .endlist olist
37219 .next
37220 .cindex DKIM "log line"
37221 &'DKIM: d='&&~&~Verbose results of a DKIM verification attempt, if enabled for
37222 logging and the message has a DKIM signature header.
37223 .endlist ilist
37224
37225
37226
37227
37228
37229 .section "Reducing or increasing what is logged" "SECTlogselector"
37230 .cindex "log" "selectors"
37231 By setting the &%log_selector%& global option, you can disable some of Exim's
37232 default logging, or you can request additional logging. The value of
37233 &%log_selector%& is made up of names preceded by plus or minus characters. For
37234 example:
37235 .code
37236 log_selector = +arguments -retry_defer
37237 .endd
37238 The list of optional log items is in the following table, with the default
37239 selection marked by asterisks:
37240 .display
37241 &` 8bitmime `& received 8BITMIME status
37242 &`*acl_warn_skipped `& skipped &%warn%& statement in ACL
37243 &` address_rewrite `& address rewriting
37244 &` all_parents `& all parents in => lines
37245 &` arguments `& command line arguments
37246 &`*connection_reject `& connection rejections
37247 &`*delay_delivery `& immediate delivery delayed
37248 &` deliver_time `& time taken to perform delivery
37249 &` delivery_size `& add &`S=`&&'nnn'& to => lines
37250 &`*dkim `& DKIM verified domain on <= lines
37251 &` dkim_verbose `& separate full DKIM verification result line, per signature
37252 &`*dnslist_defer `& defers of DNS list (aka RBL) lookups
37253 &` dnssec `& DNSSEC secured lookups
37254 &`*etrn `& ETRN commands
37255 &`*host_lookup_failed `& as it says
37256 &` ident_timeout `& timeout for ident connection
37257 &` incoming_interface `& local interface on <= and => lines
37258 &` incoming_port `& remote port on <= lines
37259 &`*lost_incoming_connection `& as it says (includes timeouts)
37260 &` millisec `& millisecond timestamps and RT,QT,DT,D times
37261 &`*msg_id `& on <= lines, Message-ID: header value
37262 &` msg_id_created `& on <= lines, Message-ID: header value when one had to be added
37263 &` outgoing_interface `& local interface on => lines
37264 &` outgoing_port `& add remote port to => lines
37265 &`*queue_run `& start and end queue runs
37266 &` queue_time `& time on queue for one recipient
37267 &` queue_time_overall `& time on queue for whole message
37268 &` pid `& Exim process id
37269 &` pipelining `& PIPELINING use, on <= and => lines
37270 &` proxy `& proxy address on <= and => lines
37271 &` receive_time `& time taken to receive message
37272 &` received_recipients `& recipients on <= lines
37273 &` received_sender `& sender on <= lines
37274 &`*rejected_header `& header contents on reject log
37275 &`*retry_defer `& &"retry time not reached"&
37276 &` return_path_on_delivery `& put return path on => and ** lines
37277 &` sender_on_delivery `& add sender to => lines
37278 &`*sender_verify_fail `& sender verification failures
37279 &`*size_reject `& rejection because too big
37280 &`*skip_delivery `& delivery skipped in a queue run
37281 &`*smtp_confirmation `& SMTP confirmation on => lines
37282 &` smtp_connection `& incoming SMTP connections
37283 &` smtp_incomplete_transaction`& incomplete SMTP transactions
37284 &` smtp_mailauth `& AUTH argument to MAIL commands
37285 &` smtp_no_mail `& session with no MAIL commands
37286 &` smtp_protocol_error `& SMTP protocol errors
37287 &` smtp_syntax_error `& SMTP syntax errors
37288 &` subject `& contents of &'Subject:'& on <= lines
37289 &`*tls_certificate_verified `& certificate verification status
37290 &`*tls_cipher `& TLS cipher suite on <= and => lines
37291 &` tls_peerdn `& TLS peer DN on <= and => lines
37292 &` tls_sni `& TLS SNI on <= lines
37293 &` unknown_in_list `& DNS lookup failed in list match
37294
37295 &` all `& all of the above
37296 .endd
37297 See also the &%slow_lookup_log%& main configuration option,
37298 section &<<SECID99>>&
37299
37300 More details on each of these items follows:
37301
37302 .ilist
37303 .cindex "8BITMIME"
37304 .cindex "log" "8BITMIME"
37305 &%8bitmime%&: This causes Exim to log any 8BITMIME status of received messages,
37306 which may help in tracking down interoperability issues with ancient MTAs
37307 that are not 8bit clean. This is added to the &"<="& line, tagged with
37308 &`M8S=`& and a value of &`0`&, &`7`& or &`8`&, corresponding to "not given",
37309 &`7BIT`& and &`8BITMIME`& respectively.
37310 .next
37311 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb" "log when skipping"
37312 &%acl_warn_skipped%&: When an ACL &%warn%& statement is skipped because one of
37313 its conditions cannot be evaluated, a log line to this effect is written if
37314 this log selector is set.
37315 .next
37316 .cindex "log" "rewriting"
37317 .cindex "rewriting" "logging"
37318 &%address_rewrite%&: This applies both to global rewrites and per-transport
37319 rewrites, but not to rewrites in filters run as an unprivileged user (because
37320 such users cannot access the log).
37321 .next
37322 .cindex "log" "full parentage"
37323 &%all_parents%&: Normally only the original and final addresses are logged on
37324 delivery lines; with this selector, intermediate parents are given in
37325 parentheses between them.
37326 .next
37327 .cindex "log" "Exim arguments"
37328 .cindex "Exim arguments, logging"
37329 &%arguments%&: This causes Exim to write the arguments with which it was called
37330 to the main log, preceded by the current working directory. This is a debugging
37331 feature, added to make it easier to find out how certain MUAs call
37332 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&. The logging does not happen if Exim has given up root
37333 privilege because it was called with the &%-C%& or &%-D%& options. Arguments
37334 that are empty or that contain white space are quoted. Non-printing characters
37335 are shown as escape sequences. This facility cannot log unrecognized arguments,
37336 because the arguments are checked before the configuration file is read. The
37337 only way to log such cases is to interpose a script such as &_util/logargs.sh_&
37338 between the caller and Exim.
37339 .next
37340 .cindex "log" "connection rejections"
37341 &%connection_reject%&: A log entry is written whenever an incoming SMTP
37342 connection is rejected, for whatever reason.
37343 .next
37344 .cindex "log" "delayed delivery"
37345 .cindex "delayed delivery, logging"
37346 &%delay_delivery%&: A log entry is written whenever a delivery process is not
37347 started for an incoming message because the load is too high or too many
37348 messages were received on one connection. Logging does not occur if no delivery
37349 process is started because &%queue_only%& is set or &%-odq%& was used.
37350 .next
37351 .cindex "log" "delivery duration"
37352 &%deliver_time%&: For each delivery, the amount of real time it has taken to
37353 perform the actual delivery is logged as DT=<&'time'&>, for example, &`DT=1s`&.
37354 If millisecond logging is enabled, short times will be shown with greater
37355 precision, eg. &`DT=0.304s`&.
37356 .next
37357 .cindex "log" "message size on delivery"
37358 .cindex "size" "of message"
37359 &%delivery_size%&: For each delivery, the size of message delivered is added to
37360 the &"=>"& line, tagged with S=.
37361 .next
37362 .cindex log "DKIM verification"
37363 .cindex DKIM "verification logging"
37364 &%dkim%&: For message acceptance log lines, when an DKIM signature in the header
37365 verifies successfully a tag of DKIM is added, with one of the verified domains.
37366 .next
37367 .cindex log "DKIM verification"
37368 .cindex DKIM "verification logging"
37369 &%dkim_verbose%&: A log entry is written for each attempted DKIM verification.
37370 .next
37371 .cindex "log" "dnslist defer"
37372 .cindex "DNS list" "logging defer"
37373 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
37374 &%dnslist_defer%&: A log entry is written if an attempt to look up a host in a
37375 DNS black list suffers a temporary error.
37376 .next
37377 .cindex log dnssec
37378 .cindex dnssec logging
37379 &%dnssec%&: For message acceptance and (attempted) delivery log lines, when
37380 dns lookups gave secure results a tag of DS is added.
37381 For acceptance this covers the reverse and forward lookups for host name verification.
37382 It does not cover helo-name verification.
37383 For delivery this covers the SRV, MX, A and/or AAAA lookups.
37384 .next
37385 .cindex "log" "ETRN commands"
37386 .cindex "ETRN" "logging"
37387 &%etrn%&: Every valid ETRN command that is received is logged, before the ACL
37388 is run to determine whether or not it is actually accepted. An invalid ETRN
37389 command, or one received within a message transaction is not logged by this
37390 selector (see &%smtp_syntax_error%& and &%smtp_protocol_error%&).
37391 .next
37392 .cindex "log" "host lookup failure"
37393 &%host_lookup_failed%&: When a lookup of a host's IP addresses fails to find
37394 any addresses, or when a lookup of an IP address fails to find a host name, a
37395 log line is written. This logging does not apply to direct DNS lookups when
37396 routing email addresses, but it does apply to &"byname"& lookups.
37397 .next
37398 .cindex "log" "ident timeout"
37399 .cindex "RFC 1413" "logging timeout"
37400 &%ident_timeout%&: A log line is written whenever an attempt to connect to a
37401 client's ident port times out.
37402 .next
37403 .cindex "log" "incoming interface"
37404 .cindex "log" "local interface"
37405 .cindex "log" "local address and port"
37406 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging local address and port"
37407 .cindex "interface" "logging"
37408 &%incoming_interface%&: The interface on which a message was received is added
37409 to the &"<="& line as an IP address in square brackets, tagged by I= and
37410 followed by a colon and the port number. The local interface and port are also
37411 added to other SMTP log lines, for example, &"SMTP connection from"&, to
37412 rejection lines, and (despite the name) to outgoing &"=>"& and &"->"& lines.
37413 The latter can be disabled by turning off the &%outgoing_interface%& option.
37414 .next
37415 .cindex log "incoming proxy address"
37416 .cindex proxy "logging proxy address"
37417 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging proxy address"
37418 &%proxy%&: The internal (closest to the system running Exim) IP address
37419 of the proxy, tagged by PRX=, on the &"<="& line for a message accepted
37420 on a proxied connection
37421 or the &"=>"& line for a message delivered on a proxied connection.
37422 See &<<SECTproxyInbound>>& for more information.
37423 .next
37424 .cindex "log" "incoming remote port"
37425 .cindex "port" "logging remote"
37426 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging incoming remote port"
37427 .vindex "&$sender_fullhost$&"
37428 .vindex "&$sender_rcvhost$&"
37429 &%incoming_port%&: The remote port number from which a message was received is
37430 added to log entries and &'Received:'& header lines, following the IP address
37431 in square brackets, and separated from it by a colon. This is implemented by
37432 changing the value that is put in the &$sender_fullhost$& and
37433 &$sender_rcvhost$& variables. Recording the remote port number has become more
37434 important with the widening use of NAT (see RFC 2505).
37435 .next
37436 .cindex "log" "dropped connection"
37437 &%lost_incoming_connection%&: A log line is written when an incoming SMTP
37438 connection is unexpectedly dropped.
37439 .next
37440 .cindex "log" "millisecond timestamps"
37441 .cindex millisecond logging
37442 .cindex timestamps "millisecond, in logs"
37443 &%millisec%&: Timestamps have a period and three decimal places of finer granularity
37444 appended to the seconds value.
37445 .next
37446 .new
37447 .cindex "log" "message id"
37448 &%msg_id%&: The value of the Message-ID: header.
37449 .next
37450 &%msg_id_created%&: The value of the Message-ID: header, when one had to be created.
37451 This will be either because the message is a bounce, or was submitted locally
37452 (submission mode) without one.
37453 The field identifier will have an asterix appended: &"id*="&.
37454 .wen
37455 .next
37456 .cindex "log" "outgoing interface"
37457 .cindex "log" "local interface"
37458 .cindex "log" "local address and port"
37459 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging local address and port"
37460 .cindex "interface" "logging"
37461 &%outgoing_interface%&: If &%incoming_interface%& is turned on, then the
37462 interface on which a message was sent is added to delivery lines as an I= tag
37463 followed by IP address in square brackets. You can disable this by turning
37464 off the &%outgoing_interface%& option.
37465 .next
37466 .cindex "log" "outgoing remote port"
37467 .cindex "port" "logging outgoing remote"
37468 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging outgoing remote port"
37469 &%outgoing_port%&: The remote port number is added to delivery log lines (those
37470 containing => tags) following the IP address.
37471 The local port is also added if &%incoming_interface%& and
37472 &%outgoing_interface%& are both enabled.
37473 This option is not included in the default setting, because for most ordinary
37474 configurations, the remote port number is always 25 (the SMTP port), and the
37475 local port is a random ephemeral port.
37476 .next
37477 .cindex "log" "process ids in"
37478 .cindex "pid (process id)" "in log lines"
37479 &%pid%&: The current process id is added to every log line, in square brackets,
37480 immediately after the time and date.
37481 .next
37482 .cindex log pipelining
37483 .cindex pipelining "logging outgoing"
37484 &%pipelining%&: A field is added to delivery and accept
37485 log lines when the ESMTP PIPELINING extension was used.
37486 The field is a single "L".
37487
37488 On accept lines, where PIPELINING was offered but not used by the client,
37489 the field has a minus appended.
37490
37491 .new
37492 .cindex "pipelining" "early connection"
37493 If Exim is built with the SUPPORT_PIPE_CONNECT build option
37494 accept "L" fields have a period appended if the feature was
37495 offered but not used, or an asterisk appended if used.
37496 Delivery "L" fields have an asterisk appended if used.
37497 .wen
37498
37499 .next
37500 .cindex "log" "queue run"
37501 .cindex "queue runner" "logging"
37502 &%queue_run%&: The start and end of every queue run are logged.
37503 .next
37504 .cindex "log" "queue time"
37505 &%queue_time%&: The amount of time the message has been in the queue on the
37506 local host is logged as QT=<&'time'&> on delivery (&`=>`&) lines, for example,
37507 &`QT=3m45s`&. The clock starts when Exim starts to receive the message, so it
37508 includes reception time as well as the delivery time for the current address.
37509 This means that it may be longer than the difference between the arrival and
37510 delivery log line times, because the arrival log line is not written until the
37511 message has been successfully received.
37512 If millisecond logging is enabled, short times will be shown with greater
37513 precision, eg. &`QT=1.578s`&.
37514 .next
37515 &%queue_time_overall%&: The amount of time the message has been in the queue on
37516 the local host is logged as QT=<&'time'&> on &"Completed"& lines, for
37517 example, &`QT=3m45s`&. The clock starts when Exim starts to receive the
37518 message, so it includes reception time as well as the total delivery time.
37519 .next
37520 .cindex "log" "receive duration"
37521 &%receive_time%&: For each message, the amount of real time it has taken to
37522 perform the reception is logged as RT=<&'time'&>, for example, &`RT=1s`&.
37523 If millisecond logging is enabled, short times will be shown with greater
37524 precision, eg. &`RT=0.204s`&.
37525 .next
37526 .cindex "log" "recipients"
37527 &%received_recipients%&: The recipients of a message are listed in the main log
37528 as soon as the message is received. The list appears at the end of the log line
37529 that is written when a message is received, preceded by the word &"for"&. The
37530 addresses are listed after they have been qualified, but before any rewriting
37531 has taken place.
37532 Recipients that were discarded by an ACL for MAIL or RCPT do not appear
37533 in the list.
37534 .next
37535 .cindex "log" "sender reception"
37536 &%received_sender%&: The unrewritten original sender of a message is added to
37537 the end of the log line that records the message's arrival, after the word
37538 &"from"& (before the recipients if &%received_recipients%& is also set).
37539 .next
37540 .cindex "log" "header lines for rejection"
37541 &%rejected_header%&: If a message's header has been received at the time a
37542 rejection is written to the reject log, the complete header is added to the
37543 log. Header logging can be turned off individually for messages that are
37544 rejected by the &[local_scan()]& function (see section &<<SECTapiforloc>>&).
37545 .next
37546 .cindex "log" "retry defer"
37547 &%retry_defer%&: A log line is written if a delivery is deferred because a
37548 retry time has not yet been reached. However, this &"retry time not reached"&
37549 message is always omitted from individual message logs after the first delivery
37550 attempt.
37551 .next
37552 .cindex "log" "return path"
37553 &%return_path_on_delivery%&: The return path that is being transmitted with
37554 the message is included in delivery and bounce lines, using the tag P=.
37555 This is omitted if no delivery actually happens, for example, if routing fails,
37556 or if delivery is to &_/dev/null_& or to &`:blackhole:`&.
37557 .next
37558 .cindex "log" "sender on delivery"
37559 &%sender_on_delivery%&: The message's sender address is added to every delivery
37560 and bounce line, tagged by F= (for &"from"&).
37561 This is the original sender that was received with the message; it is not
37562 necessarily the same as the outgoing return path.
37563 .next
37564 .cindex "log" "sender verify failure"
37565 &%sender_verify_fail%&: If this selector is unset, the separate log line that
37566 gives details of a sender verification failure is not written. Log lines for
37567 the rejection of SMTP commands contain just &"sender verify failed"&, so some
37568 detail is lost.
37569 .next
37570 .cindex "log" "size rejection"
37571 &%size_reject%&: A log line is written whenever a message is rejected because
37572 it is too big.
37573 .next
37574 .cindex "log" "frozen messages; skipped"
37575 .cindex "frozen messages" "logging skipping"
37576 &%skip_delivery%&: A log line is written whenever a message is skipped during a
37577 queue run because it is frozen or because another process is already delivering
37578 it.
37579 .cindex "&""spool file is locked""&"
37580 The message that is written is &"spool file is locked"&.
37581 .next
37582 .cindex "log" "smtp confirmation"
37583 .cindex "SMTP" "logging confirmation"
37584 .cindex "LMTP" "logging confirmation"
37585 &%smtp_confirmation%&: The response to the final &"."& in the SMTP or LMTP dialogue for
37586 outgoing messages is added to delivery log lines in the form &`C=`&<&'text'&>.
37587 A number of MTAs (including Exim) return an identifying string in this
37588 response.
37589 .next
37590 .cindex "log" "SMTP connections"
37591 .cindex "SMTP" "logging connections"
37592 &%smtp_connection%&: A log line is written whenever an incoming SMTP connection is
37593 established or closed, unless the connection is from a host that matches
37594 &%hosts_connection_nolog%&. (In contrast, &%lost_incoming_connection%& applies
37595 only when the closure is unexpected.) This applies to connections from local
37596 processes that use &%-bs%& as well as to TCP/IP connections. If a connection is
37597 dropped in the middle of a message, a log line is always written, whether or
37598 not this selector is set, but otherwise nothing is written at the start and end
37599 of connections unless this selector is enabled.
37600
37601 For TCP/IP connections to an Exim daemon, the current number of connections is
37602 included in the log message for each new connection, but note that the count is
37603 reset if the daemon is restarted.
37604 Also, because connections are closed (and the closure is logged) in
37605 subprocesses, the count may not include connections that have been closed but
37606 whose termination the daemon has not yet noticed. Thus, while it is possible to
37607 match up the opening and closing of connections in the log, the value of the
37608 logged counts may not be entirely accurate.
37609 .next
37610 .cindex "log" "SMTP transaction; incomplete"
37611 .cindex "SMTP" "logging incomplete transactions"
37612 &%smtp_incomplete_transaction%&: When a mail transaction is aborted by
37613 RSET, QUIT, loss of connection, or otherwise, the incident is logged,
37614 and the message sender plus any accepted recipients are included in the log
37615 line. This can provide evidence of dictionary attacks.
37616 .next
37617 .cindex "log" "non-MAIL SMTP sessions"
37618 .cindex "MAIL" "logging session without"
37619 &%smtp_no_mail%&: A line is written to the main log whenever an accepted SMTP
37620 connection terminates without having issued a MAIL command. This includes both
37621 the case when the connection is dropped, and the case when QUIT is used. It
37622 does not include cases where the connection is rejected right at the start (by
37623 an ACL, or because there are too many connections, or whatever). These cases
37624 already have their own log lines.
37625
37626 The log line that is written contains the identity of the client in the usual
37627 way, followed by D= and a time, which records the duration of the connection.
37628 If the connection was authenticated, this fact is logged exactly as it is for
37629 an incoming message, with an A= item. If the connection was encrypted, CV=,
37630 DN=, and X= items may appear as they do for an incoming message, controlled by
37631 the same logging options.
37632
37633 Finally, if any SMTP commands were issued during the connection, a C= item
37634 is added to the line, listing the commands that were used. For example,
37635 .code
37636 C=EHLO,QUIT
37637 .endd
37638 shows that the client issued QUIT straight after EHLO. If there were fewer
37639 than 20 commands, they are all listed. If there were more than 20 commands,
37640 the last 20 are listed, preceded by &"..."&. However, with the default
37641 setting of 10 for &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&, the connection will in any case
37642 have been aborted before 20 non-mail commands are processed.
37643 .next
37644 &%smtp_mailauth%&: A third subfield with the authenticated sender,
37645 colon-separated, is appended to the A= item for a message arrival or delivery
37646 log line, if an AUTH argument to the SMTP MAIL command (see &<<SECTauthparamail>>&)
37647 was accepted or used.
37648 .next
37649 .cindex "log" "SMTP protocol error"
37650 .cindex "SMTP" "logging protocol error"
37651 &%smtp_protocol_error%&: A log line is written for every SMTP protocol error
37652 encountered. Exim does not have perfect detection of all protocol errors
37653 because of transmission delays and the use of pipelining. If PIPELINING has
37654 been advertised to a client, an Exim server assumes that the client will use
37655 it, and therefore it does not count &"expected"& errors (for example, RCPT
37656 received after rejecting MAIL) as protocol errors.
37657 .next
37658 .cindex "SMTP" "logging syntax errors"
37659 .cindex "SMTP" "syntax errors; logging"
37660 .cindex "SMTP" "unknown command; logging"
37661 .cindex "log" "unknown SMTP command"
37662 .cindex "log" "SMTP syntax error"
37663 &%smtp_syntax_error%&: A log line is written for every SMTP syntax error
37664 encountered. An unrecognized command is treated as a syntax error. For an
37665 external connection, the host identity is given; for an internal connection
37666 using &%-bs%& the sender identification (normally the calling user) is given.
37667 .next
37668 .cindex "log" "subject"
37669 .cindex "subject, logging"
37670 &%subject%&: The subject of the message is added to the arrival log line,
37671 preceded by &"T="& (T for &"topic"&, since S is already used for &"size"&).
37672 Any MIME &"words"& in the subject are decoded. The &%print_topbitchars%& option
37673 specifies whether characters with values greater than 127 should be logged
37674 unchanged, or whether they should be rendered as escape sequences.
37675 .next
37676 .cindex "log" "certificate verification"
37677 .cindex log DANE
37678 .cindex DANE logging
37679 &%tls_certificate_verified%&: An extra item is added to <= and => log lines
37680 when TLS is in use. The item is &`CV=yes`& if the peer's certificate was
37681 verified
37682 using a CA trust anchor,
37683 &`CA=dane`& if using a DNS trust anchor,
37684 and &`CV=no`& if not.
37685 .next
37686 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
37687 .cindex "TLS" "logging cipher"
37688 &%tls_cipher%&: When a message is sent or received over an encrypted
37689 connection, the cipher suite used is added to the log line, preceded by X=.
37690 .next
37691 .cindex "log" "TLS peer DN"
37692 .cindex "TLS" "logging peer DN"
37693 &%tls_peerdn%&: When a message is sent or received over an encrypted
37694 connection, and a certificate is supplied by the remote host, the peer DN is
37695 added to the log line, preceded by DN=.
37696 .next
37697 .cindex "log" "TLS SNI"
37698 .cindex "TLS" "logging SNI"
37699 &%tls_sni%&: When a message is received over an encrypted connection, and
37700 the remote host provided the Server Name Indication extension, the SNI is
37701 added to the log line, preceded by SNI=.
37702 .next
37703 .cindex "log" "DNS failure in list"
37704 &%unknown_in_list%&: This setting causes a log entry to be written when the
37705 result of a list match is failure because a DNS lookup failed.
37706 .endlist
37707
37708
37709 .section "Message log" "SECID260"
37710 .cindex "message" "log file for"
37711 .cindex "log" "message log; description of"
37712 .cindex "&_msglog_& directory"
37713 .oindex "&%preserve_message_logs%&"
37714 In addition to the general log files, Exim writes a log file for each message
37715 that it handles. The names of these per-message logs are the message ids, and
37716 they are kept in the &_msglog_& sub-directory of the spool directory. Each
37717 message log contains copies of the log lines that apply to the message. This
37718 makes it easier to inspect the status of an individual message without having
37719 to search the main log. A message log is deleted when processing of the message
37720 is complete, unless &%preserve_message_logs%& is set, but this should be used
37721 only with great care because they can fill up your disk very quickly.
37722
37723 On a heavily loaded system, it may be desirable to disable the use of
37724 per-message logs, in order to reduce disk I/O. This can be done by setting the
37725 &%message_logs%& option false.
37726 .ecindex IIDloggen
37727
37728
37729
37730
37731 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37732 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37733
37734 .chapter "Exim utilities" "CHAPutils"
37735 .scindex IIDutils "utilities"
37736 A number of utility scripts and programs are supplied with Exim and are
37737 described in this chapter. There is also the Exim Monitor, which is covered in
37738 the next chapter. The utilities described here are:
37739
37740 .itable none 0 0 3 7* left 15* left 40* left
37741 .irow &<<SECTfinoutwha>>& &'exiwhat'& &&&
37742 "list what Exim processes are doing"
37743 .irow &<<SECTgreptheque>>& &'exiqgrep'& "grep the queue"
37744 .irow &<<SECTsumtheque>>& &'exiqsumm'& "summarize the queue"
37745 .irow &<<SECTextspeinf>>& &'exigrep'& "search the main log"
37746 .irow &<<SECTexipick>>& &'exipick'& "select messages on &&&
37747 various criteria"
37748 .irow &<<SECTcyclogfil>>& &'exicyclog'& "cycle (rotate) log files"
37749 .irow &<<SECTmailstat>>& &'eximstats'& &&&
37750 "extract statistics from the log"
37751 .irow &<<SECTcheckaccess>>& &'exim_checkaccess'& &&&
37752 "check address acceptance from given IP"
37753 .irow &<<SECTdbmbuild>>& &'exim_dbmbuild'& "build a DBM file"
37754 .irow &<<SECTfinindret>>& &'exinext'& "extract retry information"
37755 .irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_dumpdb'& "dump a hints database"
37756 .irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_tidydb'& "clean up a hints database"
37757 .irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_fixdb'& "patch a hints database"
37758 .irow &<<SECTmailboxmaint>>& &'exim_lock'& "lock a mailbox file"
37759 .endtable
37760
37761 Another utility that might be of use to sites with many MTAs is Tom Kistner's
37762 &'exilog'&. It provides log visualizations across multiple Exim servers. See
37763 &url(https://duncanthrax.net/exilog/) for details.
37764
37765
37766
37767
37768 .section "Finding out what Exim processes are doing (exiwhat)" "SECTfinoutwha"
37769 .cindex "&'exiwhat'&"
37770 .cindex "process, querying"
37771 .cindex "SIGUSR1"
37772 On operating systems that can restart a system call after receiving a signal
37773 (most modern OS), an Exim process responds to the SIGUSR1 signal by writing
37774 a line describing what it is doing to the file &_exim-process.info_& in the
37775 Exim spool directory. The &'exiwhat'& script sends the signal to all Exim
37776 processes it can find, having first emptied the file. It then waits for one
37777 second to allow the Exim processes to react before displaying the results. In
37778 order to run &'exiwhat'& successfully you have to have sufficient privilege to
37779 send the signal to the Exim processes, so it is normally run as root.
37780
37781 &*Warning*&: This is not an efficient process. It is intended for occasional
37782 use by system administrators. It is not sensible, for example, to set up a
37783 script that sends SIGUSR1 signals to Exim processes at short intervals.
37784
37785
37786 Unfortunately, the &'ps'& command that &'exiwhat'& uses to find Exim processes
37787 varies in different operating systems. Not only are different options used,
37788 but the format of the output is different. For this reason, there are some
37789 system configuration options that configure exactly how &'exiwhat'& works. If
37790 it doesn't seem to be working for you, check the following compile-time
37791 options:
37792 .display
37793 &`EXIWHAT_PS_CMD `& the command for running &'ps'&
37794 &`EXIWHAT_PS_ARG `& the argument for &'ps'&
37795 &`EXIWHAT_EGREP_ARG `& the argument for &'egrep'& to select from &'ps'& output
37796 &`EXIWHAT_KILL_ARG `& the argument for the &'kill'& command
37797 .endd
37798 An example of typical output from &'exiwhat'& is
37799 .code
37800 164 daemon: -q1h, listening on port 25
37801 10483 running queue: waiting for 0tAycK-0002ij-00 (10492)
37802 10492 delivering 0tAycK-0002ij-00 to mail.ref.example
37803 [10.19.42.42] (editor@ref.example)
37804 10592 handling incoming call from [192.168.243.242]
37805 10628 accepting a local non-SMTP message
37806 .endd
37807 The first number in the output line is the process number. The third line has
37808 been split here, in order to fit it on the page.
37809
37810
37811
37812 .section "Selective queue listing (exiqgrep)" "SECTgreptheque"
37813 .cindex "&'exiqgrep'&"
37814 .cindex "queue" "grepping"
37815 This utility is a Perl script contributed by Matt Hubbard. It runs
37816 .code
37817 exim -bpu
37818 .endd
37819 or (in case &*-a*& switch is specified)
37820 .code
37821 exim -bp
37822 .endd
37823 The &*-C*& option is used to specify an alternate &_exim.conf_& which might
37824 contain alternate exim configuration the queue management might be using.
37825
37826 to obtain a queue listing, and then greps the output to select messages
37827 that match given criteria. The following selection options are available:
37828
37829 .vlist
37830 .vitem &*-f*&&~<&'regex'&>
37831 Match the sender address using a case-insensitive search. The field that is
37832 tested is enclosed in angle brackets, so you can test for bounce messages with
37833 .code
37834 exiqgrep -f '^<>$'
37835 .endd
37836 .vitem &*-r*&&~<&'regex'&>
37837 Match a recipient address using a case-insensitive search. The field that is
37838 tested is not enclosed in angle brackets.
37839
37840 .vitem &*-s*&&~<&'regex'&>
37841 Match against the size field.
37842
37843 .vitem &*-y*&&~<&'seconds'&>
37844 Match messages that are younger than the given time.
37845
37846 .vitem &*-o*&&~<&'seconds'&>
37847 Match messages that are older than the given time.
37848
37849 .vitem &*-z*&
37850 Match only frozen messages.
37851
37852 .vitem &*-x*&
37853 Match only non-frozen messages.
37854
37855 .new
37856 .vitem &*-G*&&~<&'queuename'&>
37857 Match only messages in the given queue. Without this, the default queue is searched.
37858 .wen
37859 .endlist
37860
37861 The following options control the format of the output:
37862
37863 .vlist
37864 .vitem &*-c*&
37865 Display only the count of matching messages.
37866
37867 .vitem &*-l*&
37868 Long format &-- display the full message information as output by Exim. This is
37869 the default.
37870
37871 .vitem &*-i*&
37872 Display message ids only.
37873
37874 .vitem &*-b*&
37875 Brief format &-- one line per message.
37876
37877 .vitem &*-R*&
37878 Display messages in reverse order.
37879
37880 .vitem &*-a*&
37881 Include delivered recipients in queue listing.
37882 .endlist
37883
37884 There is one more option, &%-h%&, which outputs a list of options.
37885
37886
37887
37888 .section "Summarizing the queue (exiqsumm)" "SECTsumtheque"
37889 .cindex "&'exiqsumm'&"
37890 .cindex "queue" "summary"
37891 The &'exiqsumm'& utility is a Perl script which reads the output of &`exim
37892 -bp`& and produces a summary of the messages in the queue. Thus, you use it by
37893 running a command such as
37894 .code
37895 exim -bp | exiqsumm
37896 .endd
37897 The output consists of one line for each domain that has messages waiting for
37898 it, as in the following example:
37899 .code
37900 3 2322 74m 66m msn.com.example
37901 .endd
37902 Each line lists the number of pending deliveries for a domain, their total
37903 volume, and the length of time that the oldest and the newest messages have
37904 been waiting. Note that the number of pending deliveries is greater than the
37905 number of messages when messages have more than one recipient.
37906
37907 A summary line is output at the end. By default the output is sorted on the
37908 domain name, but &'exiqsumm'& has the options &%-a%& and &%-c%&, which cause
37909 the output to be sorted by oldest message and by count of messages,
37910 respectively. There are also three options that split the messages for each
37911 domain into two or more subcounts: &%-b%& separates bounce messages, &%-f%&
37912 separates frozen messages, and &%-s%& separates messages according to their
37913 sender.
37914
37915 The output of &'exim -bp'& contains the original addresses in the message, so
37916 this also applies to the output from &'exiqsumm'&. No domains from addresses
37917 generated by aliasing or forwarding are included (unless the &%one_time%&
37918 option of the &(redirect)& router has been used to convert them into &"top
37919 level"& addresses).
37920
37921
37922
37923
37924 .section "Extracting specific information from the log (exigrep)" &&&
37925 "SECTextspeinf"
37926 .cindex "&'exigrep'&"
37927 .cindex "log" "extracts; grepping for"
37928 The &'exigrep'& utility is a Perl script that searches one or more main log
37929 files for entries that match a given pattern. When it finds a match, it
37930 extracts all the log entries for the relevant message, not just those that
37931 match the pattern. Thus, &'exigrep'& can extract complete log entries for a
37932 given message, or all mail for a given user, or for a given host, for example.
37933 The input files can be in Exim log format or syslog format.
37934 If a matching log line is not associated with a specific message, it is
37935 included in &'exigrep'&'s output without any additional lines. The usage is:
37936 .display
37937 &`exigrep [-t<`&&'n'&&`>] [-I] [-l] [-M] [-v] <`&&'pattern'&&`> [<`&&'log file'&&`>] ...`&
37938 .endd
37939 If no log filenames are given on the command line, the standard input is read.
37940
37941 The &%-t%& argument specifies a number of seconds. It adds an additional
37942 condition for message selection. Messages that are complete are shown only if
37943 they spent more than <&'n'&> seconds in the queue.
37944
37945 By default, &'exigrep'& does case-insensitive matching. The &%-I%& option
37946 makes it case-sensitive. This may give a performance improvement when searching
37947 large log files. Without &%-I%&, the Perl pattern matches use Perl's &`/i`&
37948 option; with &%-I%& they do not. In both cases it is possible to change the
37949 case sensitivity within the pattern by using &`(?i)`& or &`(?-i)`&.
37950
37951 The &%-l%& option means &"literal"&, that is, treat all characters in the
37952 pattern as standing for themselves. Otherwise the pattern must be a Perl
37953 regular expression.
37954
37955 The &%-v%& option inverts the matching condition. That is, a line is selected
37956 if it does &'not'& match the pattern.
37957
37958 The &%-M%& options means &"related messages"&. &'exigrep'& will show messages
37959 that are generated as a result/response to a message that &'exigrep'& matched
37960 normally.
37961
37962 Example of &%-M%&:
37963 user_a sends a message to user_b, which generates a bounce back to user_b. If
37964 &'exigrep'& is used to search for &"user_a"&, only the first message will be
37965 displayed. But if &'exigrep'& is used to search for &"user_b"&, the first and
37966 the second (bounce) message will be displayed. Using &%-M%& with &'exigrep'&
37967 when searching for &"user_a"& will show both messages since the bounce is
37968 &"related"& to or a &"result"& of the first message that was found by the
37969 search term.
37970
37971 If the location of a &'zcat'& command is known from the definition of
37972 ZCAT_COMMAND in &_Local/Makefile_&, &'exigrep'& automatically passes any file
37973 whose name ends in COMPRESS_SUFFIX through &'zcat'& as it searches it.
37974 If the ZCAT_COMMAND is not executable, &'exigrep'& tries to use
37975 autodetection of some well known compression extensions.
37976
37977
37978 .section "Selecting messages by various criteria (exipick)" "SECTexipick"
37979 .cindex "&'exipick'&"
37980 John Jetmore's &'exipick'& utility is included in the Exim distribution. It
37981 lists messages from the queue according to a variety of criteria. For details
37982 of &'exipick'&'s facilities, run &'exipick'& with
37983 the &%--help%& option.
37984
37985
37986 .section "Cycling log files (exicyclog)" "SECTcyclogfil"
37987 .cindex "log" "cycling local files"
37988 .cindex "cycling logs"
37989 .cindex "&'exicyclog'&"
37990 The &'exicyclog'& script can be used to cycle (rotate) &'mainlog'& and
37991 &'rejectlog'& files. This is not necessary if only syslog is being used, or if
37992 you are using log files with datestamps in their names (see section
37993 &<<SECTdatlogfil>>&). Some operating systems have their own standard mechanisms
37994 for log cycling, and these can be used instead of &'exicyclog'& if preferred.
37995 There are two command line options for &'exicyclog'&:
37996 .ilist
37997 &%-k%& <&'count'&> specifies the number of log files to keep, overriding the
37998 default that is set when Exim is built. The default default is 10.
37999 .next
38000 &%-l%& <&'path'&> specifies the log file path, in the same format as Exim's
38001 &%log_file_path%& option (for example, &`/var/log/exim_%slog`&), again
38002 overriding the script's default, which is to find the setting from Exim's
38003 configuration.
38004 .endlist
38005
38006 Each time &'exicyclog'& is run the filenames get &"shuffled down"& by one. If
38007 the main log filename is &_mainlog_& (the default) then when &'exicyclog'& is
38008 run &_mainlog_& becomes &_mainlog.01_&, the previous &_mainlog.01_& becomes
38009 &_mainlog.02_& and so on, up to the limit that is set in the script or by the
38010 &%-k%& option. Log files whose numbers exceed the limit are discarded. Reject
38011 logs are handled similarly.
38012
38013 If the limit is greater than 99, the script uses 3-digit numbers such as
38014 &_mainlog.001_&, &_mainlog.002_&, etc. If you change from a number less than 99
38015 to one that is greater, or &'vice versa'&, you will have to fix the names of
38016 any existing log files.
38017
38018 If no &_mainlog_& file exists, the script does nothing. Files that &"drop off"&
38019 the end are deleted. All files with numbers greater than 01 are compressed,
38020 using a compression command which is configured by the COMPRESS_COMMAND
38021 setting in &_Local/Makefile_&. It is usual to run &'exicyclog'& daily from a
38022 root &%crontab%& entry of the form
38023 .code
38024 1 0 * * * su exim -c /usr/exim/bin/exicyclog
38025 .endd
38026 assuming you have used the name &"exim"& for the Exim user. You can run
38027 &'exicyclog'& as root if you wish, but there is no need.
38028
38029
38030
38031 .section "Mail statistics (eximstats)" "SECTmailstat"
38032 .cindex "statistics"
38033 .cindex "&'eximstats'&"
38034 A Perl script called &'eximstats'& is provided for extracting statistical
38035 information from log files. The output is either plain text, or HTML.
38036 . --- 2018-09-07: LogReport's Lire appears to be dead; website is a Yahoo Japan
38037 . --- 404 error and everything else points to that.
38038
38039 The &'eximstats'& script has been hacked about quite a bit over time. The
38040 latest version is the result of some extensive revision by Steve Campbell. A
38041 lot of information is given by default, but there are options for suppressing
38042 various parts of it. Following any options, the arguments to the script are a
38043 list of files, which should be main log files. For example:
38044 .code
38045 eximstats -nr /var/spool/exim/log/mainlog.01
38046 .endd
38047 By default, &'eximstats'& extracts information about the number and volume of
38048 messages received from or delivered to various hosts. The information is sorted
38049 both by message count and by volume, and the top fifty hosts in each category
38050 are listed on the standard output. Similar information, based on email
38051 addresses or domains instead of hosts can be requested by means of various
38052 options. For messages delivered and received locally, similar statistics are
38053 also produced per user.
38054
38055 The output also includes total counts and statistics about delivery errors, and
38056 histograms showing the number of messages received and deliveries made in each
38057 hour of the day. A delivery with more than one address in its envelope (for
38058 example, an SMTP transaction with more than one RCPT command) is counted
38059 as a single delivery by &'eximstats'&.
38060
38061 Though normally more deliveries than receipts are reported (as messages may
38062 have multiple recipients), it is possible for &'eximstats'& to report more
38063 messages received than delivered, even though the queue is empty at the start
38064 and end of the period in question. If an incoming message contains no valid
38065 recipients, no deliveries are recorded for it. A bounce message is handled as
38066 an entirely separate message.
38067
38068 &'eximstats'& always outputs a grand total summary giving the volume and number
38069 of messages received and deliveries made, and the number of hosts involved in
38070 each case. It also outputs the number of messages that were delayed (that is,
38071 not completely delivered at the first attempt), and the number that had at
38072 least one address that failed.
38073
38074 The remainder of the output is in sections that can be independently disabled
38075 or modified by various options. It consists of a summary of deliveries by
38076 transport, histograms of messages received and delivered per time interval
38077 (default per hour), information about the time messages spent in the queue,
38078 a list of relayed messages, lists of the top fifty sending hosts, local
38079 senders, destination hosts, and destination local users by count and by volume,
38080 and a list of delivery errors that occurred.
38081
38082 The relay information lists messages that were actually relayed, that is, they
38083 came from a remote host and were directly delivered to some other remote host,
38084 without being processed (for example, for aliasing or forwarding) locally.
38085
38086 There are quite a few options for &'eximstats'& to control exactly what it
38087 outputs. These are documented in the Perl script itself, and can be extracted
38088 by running the command &(perldoc)& on the script. For example:
38089 .code
38090 perldoc /usr/exim/bin/eximstats
38091 .endd
38092
38093 .section "Checking access policy (exim_checkaccess)" "SECTcheckaccess"
38094 .cindex "&'exim_checkaccess'&"
38095 .cindex "policy control" "checking access"
38096 .cindex "checking access"
38097 The &%-bh%& command line argument allows you to run a fake SMTP session with
38098 debugging output, in order to check what Exim is doing when it is applying
38099 policy controls to incoming SMTP mail. However, not everybody is sufficiently
38100 familiar with the SMTP protocol to be able to make full use of &%-bh%&, and
38101 sometimes you just want to answer the question &"Does this address have
38102 access?"& without bothering with any further details.
38103
38104 The &'exim_checkaccess'& utility is a &"packaged"& version of &%-bh%&. It takes
38105 two arguments, an IP address and an email address:
38106 .code
38107 exim_checkaccess 10.9.8.7 A.User@a.domain.example
38108 .endd
38109 The utility runs a call to Exim with the &%-bh%& option, to test whether the
38110 given email address would be accepted in a RCPT command in a TCP/IP
38111 connection from the host with the given IP address. The output of the utility
38112 is either the word &"accepted"&, or the SMTP error response, for example:
38113 .code
38114 Rejected:
38115 550 Relay not permitted
38116 .endd
38117 When running this test, the utility uses &`<>`& as the envelope sender address
38118 for the MAIL command, but you can change this by providing additional
38119 options. These are passed directly to the Exim command. For example, to specify
38120 that the test is to be run with the sender address &'himself@there.example'&
38121 you can use:
38122 .code
38123 exim_checkaccess 10.9.8.7 A.User@a.domain.example \
38124 -f himself@there.example
38125 .endd
38126 Note that these additional Exim command line items must be given after the two
38127 mandatory arguments.
38128
38129 Because the &%exim_checkaccess%& uses &%-bh%&, it does not perform callouts
38130 while running its checks. You can run checks that include callouts by using
38131 &%-bhc%&, but this is not yet available in a &"packaged"& form.
38132
38133
38134
38135 .section "Making DBM files (exim_dbmbuild)" "SECTdbmbuild"
38136 .cindex "DBM" "building dbm files"
38137 .cindex "building DBM files"
38138 .cindex "&'exim_dbmbuild'&"
38139 .cindex "lower casing"
38140 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
38141 The &'exim_dbmbuild'& program reads an input file containing keys and data in
38142 the format used by the &(lsearch)& lookup (see section
38143 &<<SECTsinglekeylookups>>&). It writes a DBM file using the lower-cased alias
38144 names as keys and the remainder of the information as data. The lower-casing
38145 can be prevented by calling the program with the &%-nolc%& option.
38146
38147 A terminating zero is included as part of the key string. This is expected by
38148 the &(dbm)& lookup type. However, if the option &%-nozero%& is given,
38149 &'exim_dbmbuild'& creates files without terminating zeroes in either the key
38150 strings or the data strings. The &(dbmnz)& lookup type can be used with such
38151 files.
38152
38153 The program requires two arguments: the name of the input file (which can be a
38154 single hyphen to indicate the standard input), and the name of the output file.
38155 It creates the output under a temporary name, and then renames it if all went
38156 well.
38157
38158 .cindex "USE_DB"
38159 If the native DB interface is in use (USE_DB is set in a compile-time
38160 configuration file &-- this is common in free versions of Unix) the two
38161 filenames must be different, because in this mode the Berkeley DB functions
38162 create a single output file using exactly the name given. For example,
38163 .code
38164 exim_dbmbuild /etc/aliases /etc/aliases.db
38165 .endd
38166 reads the system alias file and creates a DBM version of it in
38167 &_/etc/aliases.db_&.
38168
38169 In systems that use the &'ndbm'& routines (mostly proprietary versions of
38170 Unix), two files are used, with the suffixes &_.dir_& and &_.pag_&. In this
38171 environment, the suffixes are added to the second argument of
38172 &'exim_dbmbuild'&, so it can be the same as the first. This is also the case
38173 when the Berkeley functions are used in compatibility mode (though this is not
38174 recommended), because in that case it adds a &_.db_& suffix to the filename.
38175
38176 If a duplicate key is encountered, the program outputs a warning, and when it
38177 finishes, its return code is 1 rather than zero, unless the &%-noduperr%&
38178 option is used. By default, only the first of a set of duplicates is used &--
38179 this makes it compatible with &(lsearch)& lookups. There is an option
38180 &%-lastdup%& which causes it to use the data for the last duplicate instead.
38181 There is also an option &%-nowarn%&, which stops it listing duplicate keys to
38182 &%stderr%&. For other errors, where it doesn't actually make a new file, the
38183 return code is 2.
38184
38185
38186
38187
38188 .section "Finding individual retry times (exinext)" "SECTfinindret"
38189 .cindex "retry" "times"
38190 .cindex "&'exinext'&"
38191 A utility called &'exinext'& (mostly a Perl script) provides the ability to
38192 fish specific information out of the retry database. Given a mail domain (or a
38193 complete address), it looks up the hosts for that domain, and outputs any retry
38194 information for the hosts or for the domain. At present, the retry information
38195 is obtained by running &'exim_dumpdb'& (see below) and post-processing the
38196 output. For example:
38197 .code
38198 $ exinext piglet@milne.fict.example
38199 kanga.milne.example:192.168.8.1 error 146: Connection refused
38200 first failed: 21-Feb-1996 14:57:34
38201 last tried: 21-Feb-1996 14:57:34
38202 next try at: 21-Feb-1996 15:02:34
38203 roo.milne.example:192.168.8.3 error 146: Connection refused
38204 first failed: 20-Jan-1996 13:12:08
38205 last tried: 21-Feb-1996 11:42:03
38206 next try at: 21-Feb-1996 19:42:03
38207 past final cutoff time
38208 .endd
38209 You can also give &'exinext'& a local part, without a domain, and it
38210 will give any retry information for that local part in your default domain.
38211 A message id can be used to obtain retry information pertaining to a specific
38212 message. This exists only when an attempt to deliver a message to a remote host
38213 suffers a message-specific error (see section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>&).
38214 &'exinext'& is not particularly efficient, but then it is not expected to be
38215 run very often.
38216
38217 The &'exinext'& utility calls Exim to find out information such as the location
38218 of the spool directory. The utility has &%-C%& and &%-D%& options, which are
38219 passed on to the &'exim'& commands. The first specifies an alternate Exim
38220 configuration file, and the second sets macros for use within the configuration
38221 file. These features are mainly to help in testing, but might also be useful in
38222 environments where more than one configuration file is in use.
38223
38224
38225
38226 .section "Hints database maintenance" "SECThindatmai"
38227 .cindex "hints database" "maintenance"
38228 .cindex "maintaining Exim's hints database"
38229 Three utility programs are provided for maintaining the DBM files that Exim
38230 uses to contain its delivery hint information. Each program requires two
38231 arguments. The first specifies the name of Exim's spool directory, and the
38232 second is the name of the database it is to operate on. These are as follows:
38233
38234 .ilist
38235 &'retry'&: the database of retry information
38236 .next
38237 &'wait-'&<&'transport name'&>: databases of information about messages waiting
38238 for remote hosts
38239 .next
38240 &'callout'&: the callout cache
38241 .next
38242 &'ratelimit'&: the data for implementing the ratelimit ACL condition
38243 .next
38244 &'misc'&: other hints data
38245 .endlist
38246
38247 The &'misc'& database is used for
38248
38249 .ilist
38250 Serializing ETRN runs (when &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& is set)
38251 .next
38252 Serializing delivery to a specific host (when &%serialize_hosts%& is set in an
38253 &(smtp)& transport)
38254 .next
38255 Limiting the concurrency of specific transports (when &%max_parallel%& is set
38256 in a transport)
38257 .endlist
38258
38259
38260
38261 .section "exim_dumpdb" "SECID261"
38262 .cindex "&'exim_dumpdb'&"
38263 The entire contents of a database are written to the standard output by the
38264 &'exim_dumpdb'& program, which has no options or arguments other than the
38265 spool and database names. For example, to dump the retry database:
38266 .code
38267 exim_dumpdb /var/spool/exim retry
38268 .endd
38269 Two lines of output are produced for each entry:
38270 .code
38271 T:mail.ref.example:192.168.242.242 146 77 Connection refused
38272 31-Oct-1995 12:00:12 02-Nov-1995 12:21:39 02-Nov-1995 20:21:39 *
38273 .endd
38274 The first item on the first line is the key of the record. It starts with one
38275 of the letters R, or T, depending on whether it refers to a routing or
38276 transport retry. For a local delivery, the next part is the local address; for
38277 a remote delivery it is the name of the remote host, followed by its failing IP
38278 address (unless &%retry_include_ip_address%& is set false on the &(smtp)&
38279 transport). If the remote port is not the standard one (port 25), it is added
38280 to the IP address. Then there follows an error code, an additional error code,
38281 and a textual description of the error.
38282
38283 The three times on the second line are the time of first failure, the time of
38284 the last delivery attempt, and the computed time for the next attempt. The line
38285 ends with an asterisk if the cutoff time for the last retry rule has been
38286 exceeded.
38287
38288 Each output line from &'exim_dumpdb'& for the &'wait-xxx'& databases
38289 consists of a host name followed by a list of ids for messages that are or were
38290 waiting to be delivered to that host. If there are a very large number for any
38291 one host, continuation records, with a sequence number added to the host name,
38292 may be seen. The data in these records is often out of date, because a message
38293 may be routed to several alternative hosts, and Exim makes no effort to keep
38294 cross-references.
38295
38296
38297
38298 .section "exim_tidydb" "SECID262"
38299 .cindex "&'exim_tidydb'&"
38300 The &'exim_tidydb'& utility program is used to tidy up the contents of a hints
38301 database. If run with no options, it removes all records that are more than 30
38302 days old. The age is calculated from the date and time that the record was last
38303 updated. Note that, in the case of the retry database, it is &'not'& the time
38304 since the first delivery failure. Information about a host that has been down
38305 for more than 30 days will remain in the database, provided that the record is
38306 updated sufficiently often.
38307
38308 The cutoff date can be altered by means of the &%-t%& option, which must be
38309 followed by a time. For example, to remove all records older than a week from
38310 the retry database:
38311 .code
38312 exim_tidydb -t 7d /var/spool/exim retry
38313 .endd
38314 Both the &'wait-xxx'& and &'retry'& databases contain items that involve
38315 message ids. In the former these appear as data in records keyed by host &--
38316 they were messages that were waiting for that host &-- and in the latter they
38317 are the keys for retry information for messages that have suffered certain
38318 types of error. When &'exim_tidydb'& is run, a check is made to ensure that
38319 message ids in database records are those of messages that are still on the
38320 queue. Message ids for messages that no longer exist are removed from
38321 &'wait-xxx'& records, and if this leaves any records empty, they are deleted.
38322 For the &'retry'& database, records whose keys are non-existent message ids are
38323 removed. The &'exim_tidydb'& utility outputs comments on the standard output
38324 whenever it removes information from the database.
38325
38326 Certain records are automatically removed by Exim when they are no longer
38327 needed, but others are not. For example, if all the MX hosts for a domain are
38328 down, a retry record is created for each one. If the primary MX host comes back
38329 first, its record is removed when Exim successfully delivers to it, but the
38330 records for the others remain because Exim has not tried to use those hosts.
38331
38332 It is important, therefore, to run &'exim_tidydb'& periodically on all the
38333 hints databases. You should do this at a quiet time of day, because it requires
38334 a database to be locked (and therefore inaccessible to Exim) while it does its
38335 work. Removing records from a DBM file does not normally make the file smaller,
38336 but all the common DBM libraries are able to re-use the space that is released.
38337 After an initial phase of increasing in size, the databases normally reach a
38338 point at which they no longer get any bigger, as long as they are regularly
38339 tidied.
38340
38341 &*Warning*&: If you never run &'exim_tidydb'&, the space used by the hints
38342 databases is likely to keep on increasing.
38343
38344
38345
38346
38347 .section "exim_fixdb" "SECID263"
38348 .cindex "&'exim_fixdb'&"
38349 The &'exim_fixdb'& program is a utility for interactively modifying databases.
38350 Its main use is for testing Exim, but it might also be occasionally useful for
38351 getting round problems in a live system. It has no options, and its interface
38352 is somewhat crude. On entry, it prompts for input with a right angle-bracket. A
38353 key of a database record can then be entered, and the data for that record is
38354 displayed.
38355
38356 If &"d"& is typed at the next prompt, the entire record is deleted. For all
38357 except the &'retry'& database, that is the only operation that can be carried
38358 out. For the &'retry'& database, each field is output preceded by a number, and
38359 data for individual fields can be changed by typing the field number followed
38360 by new data, for example:
38361 .code
38362 > 4 951102:1000
38363 .endd
38364 resets the time of the next delivery attempt. Time values are given as a
38365 sequence of digit pairs for year, month, day, hour, and minute. Colons can be
38366 used as optional separators.
38367
38368
38369
38370
38371 .section "Mailbox maintenance (exim_lock)" "SECTmailboxmaint"
38372 .cindex "mailbox" "maintenance"
38373 .cindex "&'exim_lock'&"
38374 .cindex "locking mailboxes"
38375 The &'exim_lock'& utility locks a mailbox file using the same algorithm as
38376 Exim. For a discussion of locking issues, see section &<<SECTopappend>>&.
38377 &'Exim_lock'& can be used to prevent any modification of a mailbox by Exim or
38378 a user agent while investigating a problem. The utility requires the name of
38379 the file as its first argument. If the locking is successful, the second
38380 argument is run as a command (using C's &[system()]& function); if there is no
38381 second argument, the value of the SHELL environment variable is used; if this
38382 is unset or empty, &_/bin/sh_& is run. When the command finishes, the mailbox
38383 is unlocked and the utility ends. The following options are available:
38384
38385 .vlist
38386 .vitem &%-fcntl%&
38387 Use &[fcntl()]& locking on the open mailbox.
38388
38389 .vitem &%-flock%&
38390 Use &[flock()]& locking on the open mailbox, provided the operating system
38391 supports it.
38392
38393 .vitem &%-interval%&
38394 This must be followed by a number, which is a number of seconds; it sets the
38395 interval to sleep between retries (default 3).
38396
38397 .vitem &%-lockfile%&
38398 Create a lock file before opening the mailbox.
38399
38400 .vitem &%-mbx%&
38401 Lock the mailbox using MBX rules.
38402
38403 .vitem &%-q%&
38404 Suppress verification output.
38405
38406 .vitem &%-retries%&
38407 This must be followed by a number; it sets the number of times to try to get
38408 the lock (default 10).
38409
38410 .vitem &%-restore_time%&
38411 This option causes &%exim_lock%& to restore the modified and read times to the
38412 locked file before exiting. This allows you to access a locked mailbox (for
38413 example, to take a backup copy) without disturbing the times that the user
38414 subsequently sees.
38415
38416 .vitem &%-timeout%&
38417 This must be followed by a number, which is a number of seconds; it sets a
38418 timeout to be used with a blocking &[fcntl()]& lock. If it is not set (the
38419 default), a non-blocking call is used.
38420
38421 .vitem &%-v%&
38422 Generate verbose output.
38423 .endlist
38424
38425 If none of &%-fcntl%&, &%-flock%&, &%-lockfile%& or &%-mbx%& are given, the
38426 default is to create a lock file and also to use &[fcntl()]& locking on the
38427 mailbox, which is the same as Exim's default. The use of &%-flock%& or
38428 &%-fcntl%& requires that the file be writeable; the use of &%-lockfile%&
38429 requires that the directory containing the file be writeable. Locking by lock
38430 file does not last forever; Exim assumes that a lock file is expired if it is
38431 more than 30 minutes old.
38432
38433 The &%-mbx%& option can be used with either or both of &%-fcntl%& or
38434 &%-flock%&. It assumes &%-fcntl%& by default. MBX locking causes a shared lock
38435 to be taken out on the open mailbox, and an exclusive lock on the file
38436 &_/tmp/.n.m_& where &'n'& and &'m'& are the device number and inode
38437 number of the mailbox file. When the locking is released, if an exclusive lock
38438 can be obtained for the mailbox, the file in &_/tmp_& is deleted.
38439
38440 The default output contains verification of the locking that takes place. The
38441 &%-v%& option causes some additional information to be given. The &%-q%& option
38442 suppresses all output except error messages.
38443
38444 A command such as
38445 .code
38446 exim_lock /var/spool/mail/spqr
38447 .endd
38448 runs an interactive shell while the file is locked, whereas
38449 .display
38450 &`exim_lock -q /var/spool/mail/spqr <<End`&
38451 <&'some commands'&>
38452 &`End`&
38453 .endd
38454 runs a specific non-interactive sequence of commands while the file is locked,
38455 suppressing all verification output. A single command can be run by a command
38456 such as
38457 .code
38458 exim_lock -q /var/spool/mail/spqr \
38459 "cp /var/spool/mail/spqr /some/where"
38460 .endd
38461 Note that if a command is supplied, it must be entirely contained within the
38462 second argument &-- hence the quotes.
38463 .ecindex IIDutils
38464
38465
38466 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38467 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38468
38469 .chapter "The Exim monitor" "CHAPeximon"
38470 .scindex IIDeximon "Exim monitor" "description"
38471 .cindex "X-windows"
38472 .cindex "&'eximon'&"
38473 .cindex "Local/eximon.conf"
38474 .cindex "&_exim_monitor/EDITME_&"
38475 The Exim monitor is an application which displays in an X window information
38476 about the state of Exim's queue and what Exim is doing. An admin user can
38477 perform certain operations on messages from this GUI interface; however all
38478 such facilities are also available from the command line, and indeed, the
38479 monitor itself makes use of the command line to perform any actions requested.
38480
38481
38482
38483 .section "Running the monitor" "SECID264"
38484 The monitor is started by running the script called &'eximon'&. This is a shell
38485 script that sets up a number of environment variables, and then runs the
38486 binary called &_eximon.bin_&. The default appearance of the monitor window can
38487 be changed by editing the &_Local/eximon.conf_& file created by editing
38488 &_exim_monitor/EDITME_&. Comments in that file describe what the various
38489 parameters are for.
38490
38491 The parameters that get built into the &'eximon'& script can be overridden for
38492 a particular invocation by setting up environment variables of the same names,
38493 preceded by &`EXIMON_`&. For example, a shell command such as
38494 .code
38495 EXIMON_LOG_DEPTH=400 eximon
38496 .endd
38497 (in a Bourne-compatible shell) runs &'eximon'& with an overriding setting of
38498 the LOG_DEPTH parameter. If EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH is set in the environment, it
38499 overrides the Exim log file configuration. This makes it possible to have
38500 &'eximon'& tailing log data that is written to syslog, provided that MAIL.INFO
38501 syslog messages are routed to a file on the local host.
38502
38503 X resources can be used to change the appearance of the window in the normal
38504 way. For example, a resource setting of the form
38505 .code
38506 Eximon*background: gray94
38507 .endd
38508 changes the colour of the background to light grey rather than white. The
38509 stripcharts are drawn with both the data lines and the reference lines in
38510 black. This means that the reference lines are not visible when on top of the
38511 data. However, their colour can be changed by setting a resource called
38512 &"highlight"& (an odd name, but that's what the Athena stripchart widget uses).
38513 For example, if your X server is running Unix, you could set up lighter
38514 reference lines in the stripcharts by obeying
38515 .code
38516 xrdb -merge <<End
38517 Eximon*highlight: gray
38518 End
38519 .endd
38520 .cindex "admin user"
38521 In order to see the contents of messages in the queue, and to operate on them,
38522 &'eximon'& must either be run as root or by an admin user.
38523
38524 The command-line parameters of &'eximon'& are passed to &_eximon.bin_& and may
38525 contain X11 resource parameters interpreted by the X11 library. In addition,
38526 if the first parameter starts with the string "gdb" then it is removed and the
38527 binary is invoked under gdb (the parameter is used as the gdb command-name, so
38528 versioned variants of gdb can be invoked).
38529
38530 The monitor's window is divided into three parts. The first contains one or
38531 more stripcharts and two action buttons, the second contains a &"tail"& of the
38532 main log file, and the third is a display of the queue of messages awaiting
38533 delivery, with two more action buttons. The following sections describe these
38534 different parts of the display.
38535
38536
38537
38538
38539 .section "The stripcharts" "SECID265"
38540 .cindex "stripchart"
38541 The first stripchart is always a count of messages in the queue. Its name can
38542 be configured by setting QUEUE_STRIPCHART_NAME in the
38543 &_Local/eximon.conf_& file. The remaining stripcharts are defined in the
38544 configuration script by regular expression matches on log file entries, making
38545 it possible to display, for example, counts of messages delivered to certain
38546 hosts or using certain transports. The supplied defaults display counts of
38547 received and delivered messages, and of local and SMTP deliveries. The default
38548 period between stripchart updates is one minute; this can be adjusted by a
38549 parameter in the &_Local/eximon.conf_& file.
38550
38551 The stripchart displays rescale themselves automatically as the value they are
38552 displaying changes. There are always 10 horizontal lines in each chart; the
38553 title string indicates the value of each division when it is greater than one.
38554 For example, &"x2"& means that each division represents a value of 2.
38555
38556 It is also possible to have a stripchart which shows the percentage fullness of
38557 a particular disk partition, which is useful when local deliveries are confined
38558 to a single partition.
38559
38560 .cindex "&%statvfs%& function"
38561 This relies on the availability of the &[statvfs()]& function or equivalent in
38562 the operating system. Most, but not all versions of Unix that support Exim have
38563 this. For this particular stripchart, the top of the chart always represents
38564 100%, and the scale is given as &"x10%"&. This chart is configured by setting
38565 SIZE_STRIPCHART and (optionally) SIZE_STRIPCHART_NAME in the
38566 &_Local/eximon.conf_& file.
38567
38568
38569
38570
38571 .section "Main action buttons" "SECID266"
38572 .cindex "size" "of monitor window"
38573 .cindex "Exim monitor" "window size"
38574 .cindex "window size"
38575 Below the stripcharts there is an action button for quitting the monitor. Next
38576 to this is another button marked &"Size"&. They are placed here so that
38577 shrinking the window to its default minimum size leaves just the queue count
38578 stripchart and these two buttons visible. Pressing the &"Size"& button causes
38579 the window to expand to its maximum size, unless it is already at the maximum,
38580 in which case it is reduced to its minimum.
38581
38582 When expanding to the maximum, if the window cannot be fully seen where it
38583 currently is, it is moved back to where it was the last time it was at full
38584 size. When it is expanding from its minimum size, the old position is
38585 remembered, and next time it is reduced to the minimum it is moved back there.
38586
38587 The idea is that you can keep a reduced window just showing one or two
38588 stripcharts at a convenient place on your screen, easily expand it to show
38589 the full window when required, and just as easily put it back to what it was.
38590 The idea is copied from what the &'twm'& window manager does for its
38591 &'f.fullzoom'& action. The minimum size of the window can be changed by setting
38592 the MIN_HEIGHT and MIN_WIDTH values in &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
38593
38594 Normally, the monitor starts up with the window at its full size, but it can be
38595 built so that it starts up with the window at its smallest size, by setting
38596 START_SMALL=yes in &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
38597
38598
38599
38600 .section "The log display" "SECID267"
38601 .cindex "log" "tail of; in monitor"
38602 The second section of the window is an area in which a display of the tail of
38603 the main log is maintained.
38604 To save space on the screen, the timestamp on each log line is shortened by
38605 removing the date and, if &%log_timezone%& is set, the timezone.
38606 The log tail is not available when the only destination for logging data is
38607 syslog, unless the syslog lines are routed to a local file whose name is passed
38608 to &'eximon'& via the EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH environment variable.
38609
38610 The log sub-window has a scroll bar at its lefthand side which can be used to
38611 move back to look at earlier text, and the up and down arrow keys also have a
38612 scrolling effect. The amount of log that is kept depends on the setting of
38613 LOG_BUFFER in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, which specifies the amount of memory
38614 to use. When this is full, the earlier 50% of data is discarded &-- this is
38615 much more efficient than throwing it away line by line. The sub-window also has
38616 a horizontal scroll bar for accessing the ends of long log lines. This is the
38617 only means of horizontal scrolling; the right and left arrow keys are not
38618 available. Text can be cut from this part of the window using the mouse in the
38619 normal way. The size of this subwindow is controlled by parameters in the
38620 configuration file &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
38621
38622 Searches of the text in the log window can be carried out by means of the ^R
38623 and ^S keystrokes, which default to a reverse and a forward search,
38624 respectively. The search covers only the text that is displayed in the window.
38625 It cannot go further back up the log.
38626
38627 The point from which the search starts is indicated by a caret marker. This is
38628 normally at the end of the text in the window, but can be positioned explicitly
38629 by pointing and clicking with the left mouse button, and is moved automatically
38630 by a successful search. If new text arrives in the window when it is scrolled
38631 back, the caret remains where it is, but if the window is not scrolled back,
38632 the caret is moved to the end of the new text.
38633
38634 Pressing ^R or ^S pops up a window into which the search text can be typed.
38635 There are buttons for selecting forward or reverse searching, for carrying out
38636 the search, and for cancelling. If the &"Search"& button is pressed, the search
38637 happens and the window remains so that further searches can be done. If the
38638 &"Return"& key is pressed, a single search is done and the window is closed. If
38639 ^C is typed the search is cancelled.
38640
38641 The searching facility is implemented using the facilities of the Athena text
38642 widget. By default this pops up a window containing both &"search"& and
38643 &"replace"& options. In order to suppress the unwanted &"replace"& portion for
38644 eximon, a modified version of the &%TextPop%& widget is distributed with Exim.
38645 However, the linkers in BSDI and HP-UX seem unable to handle an externally
38646 provided version of &%TextPop%& when the remaining parts of the text widget
38647 come from the standard libraries. The compile-time option EXIMON_TEXTPOP can be
38648 unset to cut out the modified &%TextPop%&, making it possible to build Eximon
38649 on these systems, at the expense of having unwanted items in the search popup
38650 window.
38651
38652
38653
38654 .section "The queue display" "SECID268"
38655 .cindex "queue" "display in monitor"
38656 The bottom section of the monitor window contains a list of all messages that
38657 are in the queue, which includes those currently being received or delivered,
38658 as well as those awaiting delivery. The size of this subwindow is controlled by
38659 parameters in the configuration file &_Local/eximon.conf_&, and the frequency
38660 at which it is updated is controlled by another parameter in the same file &--
38661 the default is 5 minutes, since queue scans can be quite expensive. However,
38662 there is an &"Update"& action button just above the display which can be used
38663 to force an update of the queue display at any time.
38664
38665 When a host is down for some time, a lot of pending mail can build up for it,
38666 and this can make it hard to deal with other messages in the queue. To help
38667 with this situation there is a button next to &"Update"& called &"Hide"&. If
38668 pressed, a dialogue box called &"Hide addresses ending with"& is put up. If you
38669 type anything in here and press &"Return"&, the text is added to a chain of
38670 such texts, and if every undelivered address in a message matches at least one
38671 of the texts, the message is not displayed.
38672
38673 If there is an address that does not match any of the texts, all the addresses
38674 are displayed as normal. The matching happens on the ends of addresses so, for
38675 example, &'cam.ac.uk'& specifies all addresses in Cambridge, while
38676 &'xxx@foo.com.example'& specifies just one specific address. When any hiding
38677 has been set up, a button called &"Unhide"& is displayed. If pressed, it
38678 cancels all hiding. Also, to ensure that hidden messages do not get forgotten,
38679 a hide request is automatically cancelled after one hour.
38680
38681 While the dialogue box is displayed, you can't press any buttons or do anything
38682 else to the monitor window. For this reason, if you want to cut text from the
38683 queue display to use in the dialogue box, you have to do the cutting before
38684 pressing the &"Hide"& button.
38685
38686 The queue display contains, for each unhidden queued message, the length of
38687 time it has been in the queue, the size of the message, the message id, the
38688 message sender, and the first undelivered recipient, all on one line. If it is
38689 a bounce message, the sender is shown as &"<>"&. If there is more than one
38690 recipient to which the message has not yet been delivered, subsequent ones are
38691 listed on additional lines, up to a maximum configured number, following which
38692 an ellipsis is displayed. Recipients that have already received the message are
38693 not shown.
38694
38695 .cindex "frozen messages" "display"
38696 If a message is frozen, an asterisk is displayed at the left-hand side.
38697
38698 The queue display has a vertical scroll bar, and can also be scrolled by means
38699 of the arrow keys. Text can be cut from it using the mouse in the normal way.
38700 The text searching facilities, as described above for the log window, are also
38701 available, but the caret is always moved to the end of the text when the queue
38702 display is updated.
38703
38704
38705
38706 .section "The queue menu" "SECID269"
38707 .cindex "queue" "menu in monitor"
38708 If the &%shift%& key is held down and the left button is clicked when the mouse
38709 pointer is over the text for any message, an action menu pops up, and the first
38710 line of the queue display for the message is highlighted. This does not affect
38711 any selected text.
38712
38713 If you want to use some other event for popping up the menu, you can set the
38714 MENU_EVENT parameter in &_Local/eximon.conf_& to change the default, or
38715 set EXIMON_MENU_EVENT in the environment before starting the monitor. The
38716 value set in this parameter is a standard X event description. For example, to
38717 run eximon using &%ctrl%& rather than &%shift%& you could use
38718 .code
38719 EXIMON_MENU_EVENT='Ctrl<Btn1Down>' eximon
38720 .endd
38721 The title of the menu is the message id, and it contains entries which act as
38722 follows:
38723
38724 .ilist
38725 &'message log'&: The contents of the message log for the message are displayed
38726 in a new text window.
38727 .next
38728 &'headers'&: Information from the spool file that contains the envelope
38729 information and headers is displayed in a new text window. See chapter
38730 &<<CHAPspool>>& for a description of the format of spool files.
38731 .next
38732 &'body'&: The contents of the spool file containing the body of the message are
38733 displayed in a new text window. There is a default limit of 20,000 bytes to the
38734 amount of data displayed. This can be changed by setting the BODY_MAX
38735 option at compile time, or the EXIMON_BODY_MAX option at runtime.
38736 .next
38737 &'deliver message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-M%& option to request
38738 delivery of the message. This causes an automatic thaw if the message is
38739 frozen. The &%-v%& option is also set, and the output from Exim is displayed in
38740 a new text window. The delivery is run in a separate process, to avoid holding
38741 up the monitor while the delivery proceeds.
38742 .next
38743 &'freeze message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mf%& option to request
38744 that the message be frozen.
38745 .next
38746 .cindex "thawing messages"
38747 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
38748 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
38749 &'thaw message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mt%& option to request
38750 that the message be thawed.
38751 .next
38752 .cindex "delivery" "forcing failure"
38753 &'give up on msg'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mg%& option to request
38754 that Exim gives up trying to deliver the message. A bounce message is generated
38755 for any remaining undelivered addresses.
38756 .next
38757 &'remove message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mrm%& option to request
38758 that the message be deleted from the system without generating a bounce
38759 message.
38760 .next
38761 &'add recipient'&: A dialog box is displayed into which a recipient address can
38762 be typed. If the address is not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter
38763 is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, the address is qualified with that domain.
38764 Otherwise it must be entered as a fully qualified address. Pressing RETURN
38765 causes a call to Exim to be made using the &%-Mar%& option to request that an
38766 additional recipient be added to the message, unless the entry box is empty, in
38767 which case no action is taken.
38768 .next
38769 &'mark delivered'&: A dialog box is displayed into which a recipient address
38770 can be typed. If the address is not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter
38771 is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, the address is qualified with that domain.
38772 Otherwise it must be entered as a fully qualified address. Pressing RETURN
38773 causes a call to Exim to be made using the &%-Mmd%& option to mark the given
38774 recipient address as already delivered, unless the entry box is empty, in which
38775 case no action is taken.
38776 .next
38777 &'mark all delivered'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mmad%& option to
38778 mark all recipient addresses as already delivered.
38779 .next
38780 &'edit sender'&: A dialog box is displayed initialized with the current
38781 sender's address. Pressing RETURN causes a call to Exim to be made using the
38782 &%-Mes%& option to replace the sender address, unless the entry box is empty,
38783 in which case no action is taken. If you want to set an empty sender (as in
38784 bounce messages), you must specify it as &"<>"&. Otherwise, if the address is
38785 not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&,
38786 the address is qualified with that domain.
38787 .endlist
38788
38789 When a delivery is forced, a window showing the &%-v%& output is displayed. In
38790 other cases when a call to Exim is made, if there is any output from Exim (in
38791 particular, if the command fails) a window containing the command and the
38792 output is displayed. Otherwise, the results of the action are normally apparent
38793 from the log and queue displays. However, if you set ACTION_OUTPUT=yes in
38794 &_Local/eximon.conf_&, a window showing the Exim command is always opened, even
38795 if no output is generated.
38796
38797 The queue display is automatically updated for actions such as freezing and
38798 thawing, unless ACTION_QUEUE_UPDATE=no has been set in
38799 &_Local/eximon.conf_&. In this case the &"Update"& button has to be used to
38800 force an update of the display after one of these actions.
38801
38802 In any text window that is displayed as result of a menu action, the normal
38803 cut-and-paste facility is available, and searching can be carried out using ^R
38804 and ^S, as described above for the log tail window.
38805 .ecindex IIDeximon
38806
38807
38808
38809
38810
38811 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38812 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38813
38814 .chapter "Security considerations" "CHAPsecurity"
38815 .scindex IIDsecurcon "security" "discussion of"
38816 This chapter discusses a number of issues concerned with security, some of
38817 which are also covered in other parts of this manual.
38818
38819 For reasons that this author does not understand, some people have promoted
38820 Exim as a &"particularly secure"& mailer. Perhaps it is because of the
38821 existence of this chapter in the documentation. However, the intent of the
38822 chapter is simply to describe the way Exim works in relation to certain
38823 security concerns, not to make any specific claims about the effectiveness of
38824 its security as compared with other MTAs.
38825
38826 What follows is a description of the way Exim is supposed to be. Best efforts
38827 have been made to try to ensure that the code agrees with the theory, but an
38828 absence of bugs can never be guaranteed. Any that are reported will get fixed
38829 as soon as possible.
38830
38831
38832 .section "Building a more &""hardened""& Exim" "SECID286"
38833 .cindex "security" "build-time features"
38834 There are a number of build-time options that can be set in &_Local/Makefile_&
38835 to create Exim binaries that are &"harder"& to attack, in particular by a rogue
38836 Exim administrator who does not have the root password, or by someone who has
38837 penetrated the Exim (but not the root) account. These options are as follows:
38838
38839 .ilist
38840 ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX can be set to a string that is required to match the
38841 start of any filenames used with the &%-C%& option. When it is set, these
38842 filenames are also not allowed to contain the sequence &"/../"&. (However, if
38843 the value of the &%-C%& option is identical to the value of CONFIGURE_FILE in
38844 &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim ignores &%-C%& and proceeds as usual.) There is no
38845 default setting for &%ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX%&.
38846
38847 If the permitted configuration files are confined to a directory to
38848 which only root has access, this guards against someone who has broken
38849 into the Exim account from running a privileged Exim with an arbitrary
38850 configuration file, and using it to break into other accounts.
38851 .next
38852
38853 If a non-trusted configuration file (i.e. not the default configuration file
38854 or one which is trusted by virtue of being listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST
38855 file) is specified with &%-C%&, or if macros are given with &%-D%& (but see
38856 the next item), then root privilege is retained only if the caller of Exim is
38857 root. This locks out the possibility of testing a configuration using &%-C%&
38858 right through message reception and delivery, even if the caller is root. The
38859 reception works, but by that time, Exim is running as the Exim user, so when
38860 it re-execs to regain privilege for the delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes
38861 privilege to be lost. However, root can test reception and delivery using two
38862 separate commands.
38863
38864 .next
38865 The WHITELIST_D_MACROS build option declares some macros to be safe to override
38866 with &%-D%& if the real uid is one of root, the Exim run-time user or the
38867 CONFIGURE_OWNER, if defined. The potential impact of this option is limited by
38868 requiring the run-time value supplied to &%-D%& to match a regex that errs on
38869 the restrictive side. Requiring build-time selection of safe macros is onerous
38870 but this option is intended solely as a transition mechanism to permit
38871 previously-working configurations to continue to work after release 4.73.
38872 .next
38873 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined, the use of the &%-D%& command line option
38874 is disabled.
38875 .next
38876 FIXED_NEVER_USERS can be set to a colon-separated list of users that are
38877 never to be used for any deliveries. This is like the &%never_users%& runtime
38878 option, but it cannot be overridden; the runtime option adds additional users
38879 to the list. The default setting is &"root"&; this prevents a non-root user who
38880 is permitted to modify the runtime file from using Exim as a way to get root.
38881 .endlist
38882
38883
38884
38885 .section "Root privilege" "SECID270"
38886 .cindex "setuid"
38887 .cindex "root privilege"
38888 The Exim binary is normally setuid to root, which means that it gains root
38889 privilege (runs as root) when it starts execution. In some special cases (for
38890 example, when the daemon is not in use and there are no local deliveries), it
38891 may be possible to run Exim setuid to some user other than root. This is
38892 discussed in the next section. However, in most installations, root privilege
38893 is required for two things:
38894
38895 .ilist
38896 To set up a socket connected to the standard SMTP port (25) when initialising
38897 the listening daemon. If Exim is run from &'inetd'&, this privileged action is
38898 not required.
38899 .next
38900 To be able to change uid and gid in order to read users' &_.forward_& files and
38901 perform local deliveries as the receiving user or as specified in the
38902 configuration.
38903 .endlist
38904
38905 It is not necessary to be root to do any of the other things Exim does, such as
38906 receiving messages and delivering them externally over SMTP, and it is
38907 obviously more secure if Exim does not run as root except when necessary.
38908 For this reason, a user and group for Exim to use must be defined in
38909 &_Local/Makefile_&. These are known as &"the Exim user"& and &"the Exim
38910 group"&. Their values can be changed by the runtime configuration, though this
38911 is not recommended. Often a user called &'exim'& is used, but some sites use
38912 &'mail'& or another user name altogether.
38913
38914 Exim uses &[setuid()]& whenever it gives up root privilege. This is a permanent
38915 abdication; the process cannot regain root afterwards. Prior to release 4.00,
38916 &[seteuid()]& was used in some circumstances, but this is no longer the case.
38917
38918 After a new Exim process has interpreted its command line options, it changes
38919 uid and gid in the following cases:
38920
38921 .ilist
38922 .oindex "&%-C%&"
38923 .oindex "&%-D%&"
38924 If the &%-C%& option is used to specify an alternate configuration file, or if
38925 the &%-D%& option is used to define macro values for the configuration, and the
38926 calling process is not running as root, the uid and gid are changed to those of
38927 the calling process.
38928 However, if DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the &%-D%&
38929 option may not be used at all.
38930 If WHITELIST_D_MACROS is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, then some macro values
38931 can be supplied if the calling process is running as root, the Exim run-time
38932 user or CONFIGURE_OWNER, if defined.
38933 .next
38934 .oindex "&%-be%&"
38935 .oindex "&%-bf%&"
38936 .oindex "&%-bF%&"
38937 If the expansion test option (&%-be%&) or one of the filter testing options
38938 (&%-bf%& or &%-bF%&) are used, the uid and gid are changed to those of the
38939 calling process.
38940 .next
38941 If the process is not a daemon process or a queue runner process or a delivery
38942 process or a process for testing address routing (started with &%-bt%&), the
38943 uid and gid are changed to the Exim user and group. This means that Exim always
38944 runs under its own uid and gid when receiving messages. This also applies when
38945 testing address verification
38946 .oindex "&%-bv%&"
38947 .oindex "&%-bh%&"
38948 (the &%-bv%& option) and testing incoming message policy controls (the &%-bh%&
38949 option).
38950 .next
38951 For a daemon, queue runner, delivery, or address testing process, the uid
38952 remains as root at this stage, but the gid is changed to the Exim group.
38953 .endlist
38954
38955 The processes that initially retain root privilege behave as follows:
38956
38957 .ilist
38958 A daemon process changes the gid to the Exim group and the uid to the Exim
38959 user after setting up one or more listening sockets. The &[initgroups()]&
38960 function is called, so that if the Exim user is in any additional groups, they
38961 will be used during message reception.
38962 .next
38963 A queue runner process retains root privilege throughout its execution. Its
38964 job is to fork a controlled sequence of delivery processes.
38965 .next
38966 A delivery process retains root privilege throughout most of its execution,
38967 but any actual deliveries (that is, the transports themselves) are run in
38968 subprocesses which always change to a non-root uid and gid. For local
38969 deliveries this is typically the uid and gid of the owner of the mailbox; for
38970 remote deliveries, the Exim uid and gid are used. Once all the delivery
38971 subprocesses have been run, a delivery process changes to the Exim uid and gid
38972 while doing post-delivery tidying up such as updating the retry database and
38973 generating bounce and warning messages.
38974
38975 While the recipient addresses in a message are being routed, the delivery
38976 process runs as root. However, if a user's filter file has to be processed,
38977 this is done in a subprocess that runs under the individual user's uid and
38978 gid. A system filter is run as root unless &%system_filter_user%& is set.
38979 .next
38980 A process that is testing addresses (the &%-bt%& option) runs as root so that
38981 the routing is done in the same environment as a message delivery.
38982 .endlist
38983
38984
38985
38986
38987 .section "Running Exim without privilege" "SECTrunexiwitpri"
38988 .cindex "privilege, running without"
38989 .cindex "unprivileged running"
38990 .cindex "root privilege" "running without"
38991 Some installations like to run Exim in an unprivileged state for more of its
38992 operation, for added security. Support for this mode of operation is provided
38993 by the global option &%deliver_drop_privilege%&. When this is set, the uid and
38994 gid are changed to the Exim user and group at the start of a delivery process
38995 (and also queue runner and address testing processes). This means that address
38996 routing is no longer run as root, and the deliveries themselves cannot change
38997 to any other uid.
38998
38999 .cindex SIGHUP
39000 .cindex "daemon" "restarting"
39001 Leaving the binary setuid to root, but setting &%deliver_drop_privilege%& means
39002 that the daemon can still be started in the usual way, and it can respond
39003 correctly to SIGHUP because the re-invocation regains root privilege.
39004
39005 An alternative approach is to make Exim setuid to the Exim user and also setgid
39006 to the Exim group. If you do this, the daemon must be started from a root
39007 process. (Calling Exim from a root process makes it behave in the way it does
39008 when it is setuid root.) However, the daemon cannot restart itself after a
39009 SIGHUP signal because it cannot regain privilege.
39010
39011 It is still useful to set &%deliver_drop_privilege%& in this case, because it
39012 stops Exim from trying to re-invoke itself to do a delivery after a message has
39013 been received. Such a re-invocation is a waste of resources because it has no
39014 effect.
39015
39016 If restarting the daemon is not an issue (for example, if &%mua_wrapper%& is
39017 set, or &'inetd'& is being used instead of a daemon), having the binary setuid
39018 to the Exim user seems a clean approach, but there is one complication:
39019
39020 In this style of operation, Exim is running with the real uid and gid set to
39021 those of the calling process, and the effective uid/gid set to Exim's values.
39022 Ideally, any association with the calling process' uid/gid should be dropped,
39023 that is, the real uid/gid should be reset to the effective values so as to
39024 discard any privileges that the caller may have. While some operating systems
39025 have a function that permits this action for a non-root effective uid, quite a
39026 number of them do not. Because of this lack of standardization, Exim does not
39027 address this problem at this time.
39028
39029 For this reason, the recommended approach for &"mostly unprivileged"& running
39030 is to keep the Exim binary setuid to root, and to set
39031 &%deliver_drop_privilege%&. This also has the advantage of allowing a daemon to
39032 be used in the most straightforward way.
39033
39034 If you configure Exim not to run delivery processes as root, there are a
39035 number of restrictions on what you can do:
39036
39037 .ilist
39038 You can deliver only as the Exim user/group. You should explicitly use the
39039 &%user%& and &%group%& options to override routers or local transports that
39040 normally deliver as the recipient. This makes sure that configurations that
39041 work in this mode function the same way in normal mode. Any implicit or
39042 explicit specification of another user causes an error.
39043 .next
39044 Use of &_.forward_& files is severely restricted, such that it is usually
39045 not worthwhile to include them in the configuration.
39046 .next
39047 Users who wish to use &_.forward_& would have to make their home directory and
39048 the file itself accessible to the Exim user. Pipe and append-to-file entries,
39049 and their equivalents in Exim filters, cannot be used. While they could be
39050 enabled in the Exim user's name, that would be insecure and not very useful.
39051 .next
39052 Unless the local user mailboxes are all owned by the Exim user (possible in
39053 some POP3 or IMAP-only environments):
39054
39055 .olist
39056 They must be owned by the Exim group and be writeable by that group. This
39057 implies you must set &%mode%& in the appendfile configuration, as well as the
39058 mode of the mailbox files themselves.
39059 .next
39060 You must set &%no_check_owner%&, since most or all of the files will not be
39061 owned by the Exim user.
39062 .next
39063 You must set &%file_must_exist%&, because Exim cannot set the owner correctly
39064 on a newly created mailbox when unprivileged. This also implies that new
39065 mailboxes need to be created manually.
39066 .endlist olist
39067 .endlist ilist
39068
39069
39070 These restrictions severely restrict what can be done in local deliveries.
39071 However, there are no restrictions on remote deliveries. If you are running a
39072 gateway host that does no local deliveries, setting &%deliver_drop_privilege%&
39073 gives more security at essentially no cost.
39074
39075 If you are using the &%mua_wrapper%& facility (see chapter
39076 &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&), &%deliver_drop_privilege%& is forced to be true.
39077
39078
39079
39080
39081 .section "Delivering to local files" "SECID271"
39082 Full details of the checks applied by &(appendfile)& before it writes to a file
39083 are given in chapter &<<CHAPappendfile>>&.
39084
39085
39086
39087 .section "Running local commands" "SECTsecconslocalcmds"
39088 .cindex "security" "local commands"
39089 .cindex "security" "command injection attacks"
39090 There are a number of ways in which an administrator can configure Exim to run
39091 commands based upon received, untrustworthy, data. Further, in some
39092 configurations a user who can control a &_.forward_& file can also arrange to
39093 run commands. Configuration to check includes, but is not limited to:
39094
39095 .ilist
39096 Use of &%use_shell%& in the pipe transport: various forms of shell command
39097 injection may be possible with this option present. It is dangerous and should
39098 be used only with considerable caution. Consider constraints which whitelist
39099 allowed characters in a variable which is to be used in a pipe transport that
39100 has &%use_shell%& enabled.
39101 .next
39102 A number of options such as &%forbid_filter_run%&, &%forbid_filter_perl%&,
39103 &%forbid_filter_dlfunc%& and so forth which restrict facilities available to
39104 &_.forward_& files in a redirect router. If Exim is running on a central mail
39105 hub to which ordinary users do not have shell access, but home directories are
39106 NFS mounted (for instance) then administrators should review the list of these
39107 forbid options available, and should bear in mind that the options that may
39108 need forbidding can change as new features are added between releases.
39109 .next
39110 The &%${run...}%& expansion item does not use a shell by default, but
39111 administrators can configure use of &_/bin/sh_& as part of the command.
39112 Such invocations should be viewed with prejudicial suspicion.
39113 .next
39114 Administrators who use embedded Perl are advised to explore how Perl's
39115 taint checking might apply to their usage.
39116 .next
39117 Use of &%${expand...}%& is somewhat analogous to shell's eval builtin and
39118 administrators are well advised to view its use with suspicion, in case (for
39119 instance) it allows a local-part to contain embedded Exim directives.
39120 .next
39121 Use of &%${match_local_part...}%& and friends becomes more dangerous if
39122 Exim was built with EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS defined: the second string in
39123 each can reference arbitrary lists and files, rather than just being a list
39124 of opaque strings.
39125 The EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option was added and set false by default because of
39126 real-world security vulnerabilities caused by its use with untrustworthy data
39127 injected in, for SQL injection attacks.
39128 Consider the use of the &%inlisti%& expansion condition instead.
39129 .endlist
39130
39131
39132
39133
39134 .section "Trust in configuration data" "SECTsecconfdata"
39135 .cindex "security" "data sources"
39136 .cindex "security" "regular expressions"
39137 .cindex "regular expressions" "security"
39138 .cindex "PCRE" "security"
39139 If configuration data for Exim can come from untrustworthy sources, there
39140 are some issues to be aware of:
39141
39142 .ilist
39143 Use of &%${expand...}%& may provide a path for shell injection attacks.
39144 .next
39145 Letting untrusted data provide a regular expression is unwise.
39146 .next
39147 Using &%${match...}%& to apply a fixed regular expression against untrusted
39148 data may result in pathological behaviour within PCRE. Be aware of what
39149 "backtracking" means and consider options for being more strict with a regular
39150 expression. Avenues to explore include limiting what can match (avoiding &`.`&
39151 when &`[a-z0-9]`& or other character class will do), use of atomic grouping and
39152 possessive quantifiers or just not using regular expressions against untrusted
39153 data.
39154 .next
39155 It can be important to correctly use &%${quote:...}%&,
39156 &%${quote_local_part:...}%& and &%${quote_%&<&'lookup-type'&>&%:...}%& expansion
39157 items to ensure that data is correctly constructed.
39158 .next
39159 Some lookups might return multiple results, even though normal usage is only
39160 expected to yield one result.
39161 .endlist
39162
39163
39164
39165
39166 .section "IPv4 source routing" "SECID272"
39167 .cindex "source routing" "in IP packets"
39168 .cindex "IP source routing"
39169 Many operating systems suppress IP source-routed packets in the kernel, but
39170 some cannot be made to do this, so Exim does its own check. It logs incoming
39171 IPv4 source-routed TCP calls, and then drops them. Things are all different in
39172 IPv6. No special checking is currently done.
39173
39174
39175
39176 .section "The VRFY, EXPN, and ETRN commands in SMTP" "SECID273"
39177 Support for these SMTP commands is disabled by default. If required, they can
39178 be enabled by defining suitable ACLs.
39179
39180
39181
39182
39183 .section "Privileged users" "SECID274"
39184 .cindex "trusted users"
39185 .cindex "admin user"
39186 .cindex "privileged user"
39187 .cindex "user" "trusted"
39188 .cindex "user" "admin"
39189 Exim recognizes two sets of users with special privileges. Trusted users are
39190 able to submit new messages to Exim locally, but supply their own sender
39191 addresses and information about a sending host. For other users submitting
39192 local messages, Exim sets up the sender address from the uid, and doesn't
39193 permit a remote host to be specified.
39194
39195 .oindex "&%-f%&"
39196 However, an untrusted user is permitted to use the &%-f%& command line option
39197 in the special form &%-f <>%& to indicate that a delivery failure for the
39198 message should not cause an error report. This affects the message's envelope,
39199 but it does not affect the &'Sender:'& header. Untrusted users may also be
39200 permitted to use specific forms of address with the &%-f%& option by setting
39201 the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option.
39202
39203 Trusted users are used to run processes that receive mail messages from some
39204 other mail domain and pass them on to Exim for delivery either locally, or over
39205 the Internet. Exim trusts a caller that is running as root, as the Exim user,
39206 as any user listed in the &%trusted_users%& configuration option, or under any
39207 group listed in the &%trusted_groups%& option.
39208
39209 Admin users are permitted to do things to the messages on Exim's queue. They
39210 can freeze or thaw messages, cause them to be returned to their senders, remove
39211 them entirely, or modify them in various ways. In addition, admin users can run
39212 the Exim monitor and see all the information it is capable of providing, which
39213 includes the contents of files on the spool.
39214
39215 .oindex "&%-M%&"
39216 .oindex "&%-q%&"
39217 By default, the use of the &%-M%& and &%-q%& options to cause Exim to attempt
39218 delivery of messages on its queue is restricted to admin users. This
39219 restriction can be relaxed by setting the &%no_prod_requires_admin%& option.
39220 Similarly, the use of &%-bp%& (and its variants) to list the contents of the
39221 queue is also restricted to admin users. This restriction can be relaxed by
39222 setting &%no_queue_list_requires_admin%&.
39223
39224 Exim recognizes an admin user if the calling process is running as root or as
39225 the Exim user or if any of the groups associated with the calling process is
39226 the Exim group. It is not necessary actually to be running under the Exim
39227 group. However, if admin users who are not root or the Exim user are to access
39228 the contents of files on the spool via the Exim monitor (which runs
39229 unprivileged), Exim must be built to allow group read access to its spool
39230 files.
39231
39232 By default, regular users are trusted to perform basic testing and
39233 introspection commands, as themselves. This setting can be tightened by
39234 setting the &%commandline_checks_require_admin%& option.
39235 This affects most of the checking options,
39236 such as &%-be%& and anything else &%-b*%&.
39237
39238
39239 .section "Spool files" "SECID275"
39240 .cindex "spool directory" "files"
39241 Exim's spool directory and everything it contains is owned by the Exim user and
39242 set to the Exim group. The mode for spool files is defined in the
39243 &_Local/Makefile_& configuration file, and defaults to 0640. This means that
39244 any user who is a member of the Exim group can access these files.
39245
39246
39247
39248 .section "Use of argv[0]" "SECID276"
39249 Exim examines the last component of &%argv[0]%&, and if it matches one of a set
39250 of specific strings, Exim assumes certain options. For example, calling Exim
39251 with the last component of &%argv[0]%& set to &"rsmtp"& is exactly equivalent
39252 to calling it with the option &%-bS%&. There are no security implications in
39253 this.
39254
39255
39256
39257 .section "Use of %f formatting" "SECID277"
39258 The only use made of &"%f"& by Exim is in formatting load average values. These
39259 are actually stored in integer variables as 1000 times the load average.
39260 Consequently, their range is limited and so therefore is the length of the
39261 converted output.
39262
39263
39264
39265 .section "Embedded Exim path" "SECID278"
39266 Exim uses its own path name, which is embedded in the code, only when it needs
39267 to re-exec in order to regain root privilege. Therefore, it is not root when it
39268 does so. If some bug allowed the path to get overwritten, it would lead to an
39269 arbitrary program's being run as exim, not as root.
39270
39271
39272
39273 .section "Dynamic module directory" "SECTdynmoddir"
39274 Any dynamically loadable modules must be installed into the directory
39275 defined in &`LOOKUP_MODULE_DIR`& in &_Local/Makefile_& for Exim to permit
39276 loading it.
39277
39278
39279 .section "Use of sprintf()" "SECID279"
39280 .cindex "&[sprintf()]&"
39281 A large number of occurrences of &"sprintf"& in the code are actually calls to
39282 &'string_sprintf()'&, a function that returns the result in malloc'd store.
39283 The intermediate formatting is done into a large fixed buffer by a function
39284 that runs through the format string itself, and checks the length of each
39285 conversion before performing it, thus preventing buffer overruns.
39286
39287 The remaining uses of &[sprintf()]& happen in controlled circumstances where
39288 the output buffer is known to be sufficiently long to contain the converted
39289 string.
39290
39291
39292
39293 .section "Use of debug_printf() and log_write()" "SECID280"
39294 Arbitrary strings are passed to both these functions, but they do their
39295 formatting by calling the function &'string_vformat()'&, which runs through
39296 the format string itself, and checks the length of each conversion.
39297
39298
39299
39300 .section "Use of strcat() and strcpy()" "SECID281"
39301 These are used only in cases where the output buffer is known to be large
39302 enough to hold the result.
39303 .ecindex IIDsecurcon
39304
39305
39306
39307
39308 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39309 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39310
39311 .chapter "Format of spool files" "CHAPspool"
39312 .scindex IIDforspo1 "format" "spool files"
39313 .scindex IIDforspo2 "spool directory" "format of files"
39314 .scindex IIDforspo3 "spool files" "format of"
39315 .cindex "spool files" "editing"
39316 A message on Exim's queue consists of two files, whose names are the message id
39317 followed by -D and -H, respectively. The data portion of the message is kept in
39318 the -D file on its own. The message's envelope, status, and headers are all
39319 kept in the -H file, whose format is described in this chapter. Each of these
39320 two files contains the final component of its own name as its first line. This
39321 is insurance against disk crashes where the directory is lost but the files
39322 themselves are recoverable.
39323
39324 The file formats may be changed, or new formats added, at any release.
39325 Spool files are not intended as an interface to other programs
39326 and should not be used as such.
39327
39328 Some people are tempted into editing -D files in order to modify messages. You
39329 need to be extremely careful if you do this; it is not recommended and you are
39330 on your own if you do it. Here are some of the pitfalls:
39331
39332 .ilist
39333 You must ensure that Exim does not try to deliver the message while you are
39334 fiddling with it. The safest way is to take out a write lock on the -D file,
39335 which is what Exim itself does, using &[fcntl()]&. If you update the file in
39336 place, the lock will be retained. If you write a new file and rename it, the
39337 lock will be lost at the instant of rename.
39338 .next
39339 .vindex "&$body_linecount$&"
39340 If you change the number of lines in the file, the value of
39341 &$body_linecount$&, which is stored in the -H file, will be incorrect and can
39342 cause incomplete transmission of messages or undeliverable messages.
39343 .next
39344 If the message is in MIME format, you must take care not to break it.
39345 .next
39346 If the message is cryptographically signed, any change will invalidate the
39347 signature.
39348 .endlist
39349 All in all, modifying -D files is fraught with danger.
39350
39351 Files whose names end with -J may also be seen in the &_input_& directory (or
39352 its subdirectories when &%split_spool_directory%& is set). These are journal
39353 files, used to record addresses to which the message has been delivered during
39354 the course of a delivery attempt. If there are still undelivered recipients at
39355 the end, the -H file is updated, and the -J file is deleted. If, however, there
39356 is some kind of crash (for example, a power outage) before this happens, the -J
39357 file remains in existence. When Exim next processes the message, it notices the
39358 -J file and uses it to update the -H file before starting the next delivery
39359 attempt.
39360
39361 Files whose names end with -K or .eml may also be seen in the spool.
39362 These are temporaries used for DKIM or malware processing, when that is used.
39363 They should be tidied up by normal operations; any old ones are probably
39364 relics of crashes and can be removed.
39365
39366 .section "Format of the -H file" "SECID282"
39367 .cindex "uid (user id)" "in spool file"
39368 .cindex "gid (group id)" "in spool file"
39369 The second line of the -H file contains the login name for the uid of the
39370 process that called Exim to read the message, followed by the numerical uid and
39371 gid. For a locally generated message, this is normally the user who sent the
39372 message. For a message received over TCP/IP via the daemon, it is
39373 normally the Exim user.
39374
39375 The third line of the file contains the address of the message's sender as
39376 transmitted in the envelope, contained in angle brackets. The sender address is
39377 empty for bounce messages. For incoming SMTP mail, the sender address is given
39378 in the MAIL command. For locally generated mail, the sender address is
39379 created by Exim from the login name of the current user and the configured
39380 &%qualify_domain%&. However, this can be overridden by the &%-f%& option or a
39381 leading &"From&~"& line if the caller is trusted, or if the supplied address is
39382 &"<>"& or an address that matches &%untrusted_set_senders%&.
39383
39384 The fourth line contains two numbers. The first is the time that the message
39385 was received, in the conventional Unix form &-- the number of seconds since the
39386 start of the epoch. The second number is a count of the number of messages
39387 warning of delayed delivery that have been sent to the sender.
39388
39389 There follow a number of lines starting with a hyphen. These can appear in any
39390 order, and are omitted when not relevant:
39391
39392 .vlist
39393 .vitem "&%-acl%&&~<&'number'&>&~<&'length'&>"
39394 This item is obsolete, and is not generated from Exim release 4.61 onwards;
39395 &%-aclc%& and &%-aclm%& are used instead. However, &%-acl%& is still
39396 recognized, to provide backward compatibility. In the old format, a line of
39397 this form is present for every ACL variable that is not empty. The number
39398 identifies the variable; the &%acl_c%&&*x*& variables are numbered 0&--9 and
39399 the &%acl_m%&&*x*& variables are numbered 10&--19. The length is the length of
39400 the data string for the variable. The string itself starts at the beginning of
39401 the next line, and is followed by a newline character. It may contain internal
39402 newlines.
39403
39404 .vitem "&%-aclc%&&~<&'rest-of-name'&>&~<&'length'&>"
39405 A line of this form is present for every ACL connection variable that is
39406 defined. Note that there is a space between &%-aclc%& and the rest of the name.
39407 The length is the length of the data string for the variable. The string itself
39408 starts at the beginning of the next line, and is followed by a newline
39409 character. It may contain internal newlines.
39410
39411 .vitem "&%-aclm%&&~<&'rest-of-name'&>&~<&'length'&>"
39412 A line of this form is present for every ACL message variable that is defined.
39413 Note that there is a space between &%-aclm%& and the rest of the name. The
39414 length is the length of the data string for the variable. The string itself
39415 starts at the beginning of the next line, and is followed by a newline
39416 character. It may contain internal newlines.
39417
39418 .vitem "&%-active_hostname%&&~<&'hostname'&>"
39419 This is present if, when the message was received over SMTP, the value of
39420 &$smtp_active_hostname$& was different to the value of &$primary_hostname$&.
39421
39422 .vitem &%-allow_unqualified_recipient%&
39423 This is present if unqualified recipient addresses are permitted in header
39424 lines (to stop such addresses from being qualified if rewriting occurs at
39425 transport time). Local messages that were input using &%-bnq%& and remote
39426 messages from hosts that match &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& set this flag.
39427
39428 .vitem &%-allow_unqualified_sender%&
39429 This is present if unqualified sender addresses are permitted in header lines
39430 (to stop such addresses from being qualified if rewriting occurs at transport
39431 time). Local messages that were input using &%-bnq%& and remote messages from
39432 hosts that match &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& set this flag.
39433
39434 .vitem "&%-auth_id%&&~<&'text'&>"
39435 The id information for a message received on an authenticated SMTP connection
39436 &-- the value of the &$authenticated_id$& variable.
39437
39438 .vitem "&%-auth_sender%&&~<&'address'&>"
39439 The address of an authenticated sender &-- the value of the
39440 &$authenticated_sender$& variable.
39441
39442 .vitem "&%-body_linecount%&&~<&'number'&>"
39443 This records the number of lines in the body of the message, and is
39444 present unless &%-spool_file_wireformat%& is.
39445
39446 .vitem "&%-body_zerocount%&&~<&'number'&>"
39447 This records the number of binary zero bytes in the body of the message, and is
39448 present if the number is greater than zero.
39449
39450 .vitem &%-deliver_firsttime%&
39451 This is written when a new message is first added to the spool. When the spool
39452 file is updated after a deferral, it is omitted.
39453
39454 .vitem "&%-frozen%&&~<&'time'&>"
39455 .cindex "frozen messages" "spool data"
39456 The message is frozen, and the freezing happened at <&'time'&>.
39457
39458 .vitem "&%-helo_name%&&~<&'text'&>"
39459 This records the host name as specified by a remote host in a HELO or EHLO
39460 command.
39461
39462 .vitem "&%-host_address%&&~<&'address'&>.<&'port'&>"
39463 This records the IP address of the host from which the message was received and
39464 the remote port number that was used. It is omitted for locally generated
39465 messages.
39466
39467 .vitem "&%-host_auth%&&~<&'text'&>"
39468 If the message was received on an authenticated SMTP connection, this records
39469 the name of the authenticator &-- the value of the
39470 &$sender_host_authenticated$& variable.
39471
39472 .vitem &%-host_lookup_failed%&
39473 This is present if an attempt to look up the sending host's name from its IP
39474 address failed. It corresponds to the &$host_lookup_failed$& variable.
39475
39476 .vitem "&%-host_name%&&~<&'text'&>"
39477 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
39478 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
39479 This records the name of the remote host from which the message was received,
39480 if the host name was looked up from the IP address when the message was being
39481 received. It is not present if no reverse lookup was done.
39482
39483 .vitem "&%-ident%&&~<&'text'&>"
39484 For locally submitted messages, this records the login of the originating user,
39485 unless it was a trusted user and the &%-oMt%& option was used to specify an
39486 ident value. For messages received over TCP/IP, this records the ident string
39487 supplied by the remote host, if any.
39488
39489 .vitem "&%-interface_address%&&~<&'address'&>.<&'port'&>"
39490 This records the IP address of the local interface and the port number through
39491 which a message was received from a remote host. It is omitted for locally
39492 generated messages.
39493
39494 .vitem &%-local%&
39495 The message is from a local sender.
39496
39497 .vitem &%-localerror%&
39498 The message is a locally-generated bounce message.
39499
39500 .vitem "&%-local_scan%&&~<&'string'&>"
39501 This records the data string that was returned by the &[local_scan()]& function
39502 when the message was received &-- the value of the &$local_scan_data$&
39503 variable. It is omitted if no data was returned.
39504
39505 .vitem &%-manual_thaw%&
39506 The message was frozen but has been thawed manually, that is, by an explicit
39507 Exim command rather than via the auto-thaw process.
39508
39509 .vitem &%-N%&
39510 A testing delivery process was started using the &%-N%& option to suppress any
39511 actual deliveries, but delivery was deferred. At any further delivery attempts,
39512 &%-N%& is assumed.
39513
39514 .vitem &%-received_protocol%&
39515 This records the value of the &$received_protocol$& variable, which contains
39516 the name of the protocol by which the message was received.
39517
39518 .vitem &%-sender_set_untrusted%&
39519 The envelope sender of this message was set by an untrusted local caller (used
39520 to ensure that the caller is displayed in queue listings).
39521
39522 .vitem "&%-spam_score_int%&&~<&'number'&>"
39523 If a message was scanned by SpamAssassin, this is present. It records the value
39524 of &$spam_score_int$&.
39525
39526 .vitem &%-spool_file_wireformat%&
39527 The -D file for this message is in wire-format (for ESMTP CHUNKING)
39528 rather than Unix-format.
39529 The line-ending is CRLF rather than newline.
39530 There is still, however, no leading-dot-stuffing.
39531
39532 .vitem &%-tls_certificate_verified%&
39533 A TLS certificate was received from the client that sent this message, and the
39534 certificate was verified by the server.
39535
39536 .vitem "&%-tls_cipher%&&~<&'cipher name'&>"
39537 When the message was received over an encrypted connection, this records the
39538 name of the cipher suite that was used.
39539
39540 .vitem "&%-tls_peerdn%&&~<&'peer DN'&>"
39541 When the message was received over an encrypted connection, and a certificate
39542 was received from the client, this records the Distinguished Name from that
39543 certificate.
39544 .endlist
39545
39546 Following the options there is a list of those addresses to which the message
39547 is not to be delivered. This set of addresses is initialized from the command
39548 line when the &%-t%& option is used and &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%&
39549 is set; otherwise it starts out empty. Whenever a successful delivery is made,
39550 the address is added to this set. The addresses are kept internally as a
39551 balanced binary tree, and it is a representation of that tree which is written
39552 to the spool file. If an address is expanded via an alias or forward file, the
39553 original address is added to the tree when deliveries to all its child
39554 addresses are complete.
39555
39556 If the tree is empty, there is a single line in the spool file containing just
39557 the text &"XX"&. Otherwise, each line consists of two letters, which are either
39558 Y or N, followed by an address. The address is the value for the node of the
39559 tree, and the letters indicate whether the node has a left branch and/or a
39560 right branch attached to it, respectively. If branches exist, they immediately
39561 follow. Here is an example of a three-node tree:
39562 .code
39563 YY darcy@austen.fict.example
39564 NN alice@wonderland.fict.example
39565 NN editor@thesaurus.ref.example
39566 .endd
39567 After the non-recipients tree, there is a list of the message's recipients.
39568 This is a simple list, preceded by a count. It includes all the original
39569 recipients of the message, including those to whom the message has already been
39570 delivered. In the simplest case, the list contains one address per line. For
39571 example:
39572 .code
39573 4
39574 editor@thesaurus.ref.example
39575 darcy@austen.fict.example
39576 rdo@foundation
39577 alice@wonderland.fict.example
39578 .endd
39579 However, when a child address has been added to the top-level addresses as a
39580 result of the use of the &%one_time%& option on a &(redirect)& router, each
39581 line is of the following form:
39582 .display
39583 <&'top-level address'&> <&'errors_to address'&> &&&
39584 <&'length'&>,<&'parent number'&>#<&'flag bits'&>
39585 .endd
39586 The 01 flag bit indicates the presence of the three other fields that follow
39587 the top-level address. Other bits may be used in future to support additional
39588 fields. The <&'parent number'&> is the offset in the recipients list of the
39589 original parent of the &"one time"& address. The first two fields are the
39590 envelope sender that is associated with this address and its length. If the
39591 length is zero, there is no special envelope sender (there are then two space
39592 characters in the line). A non-empty field can arise from a &(redirect)& router
39593 that has an &%errors_to%& setting.
39594
39595
39596 A blank line separates the envelope and status information from the headers
39597 which follow. A header may occupy several lines of the file, and to save effort
39598 when reading it in, each header is preceded by a number and an identifying
39599 character. The number is the number of characters in the header, including any
39600 embedded newlines and the terminating newline. The character is one of the
39601 following:
39602
39603 .table2 50pt
39604 .row <&'blank'&> "header in which Exim has no special interest"
39605 .row &`B`& "&'Bcc:'& header"
39606 .row &`C`& "&'Cc:'& header"
39607 .row &`F`& "&'From:'& header"
39608 .row &`I`& "&'Message-id:'& header"
39609 .row &`P`& "&'Received:'& header &-- P for &""postmark""&"
39610 .row &`R`& "&'Reply-To:'& header"
39611 .row &`S`& "&'Sender:'& header"
39612 .row &`T`& "&'To:'& header"
39613 .row &`*`& "replaced or deleted header"
39614 .endtable
39615
39616 Deleted or replaced (rewritten) headers remain in the spool file for debugging
39617 purposes. They are not transmitted when the message is delivered. Here is a
39618 typical set of headers:
39619 .code
39620 111P Received: by hobbit.fict.example with local (Exim 4.00)
39621 id 14y9EI-00026G-00; Fri, 11 May 2001 10:28:59 +0100
39622 049 Message-Id: <E14y9EI-00026G-00@hobbit.fict.example>
39623 038* X-rewrote-sender: bb@hobbit.fict.example
39624 042* From: Bilbo Baggins <bb@hobbit.fict.example>
39625 049F From: Bilbo Baggins <B.Baggins@hobbit.fict.example>
39626 099* To: alice@wonderland.fict.example, rdo@foundation,
39627 darcy@austen.fict.example, editor@thesaurus.ref.example
39628 104T To: alice@wonderland.fict.example, rdo@foundation.example,
39629 darcy@austen.fict.example, editor@thesaurus.ref.example
39630 038 Date: Fri, 11 May 2001 10:28:59 +0100
39631 .endd
39632 The asterisked headers indicate that the envelope sender, &'From:'& header, and
39633 &'To:'& header have been rewritten, the last one because routing expanded the
39634 unqualified domain &'foundation'&.
39635 .ecindex IIDforspo1
39636 .ecindex IIDforspo2
39637 .ecindex IIDforspo3
39638
39639 .section "Format of the -D file" "SECID282a"
39640 The data file is traditionally in Unix-standard format: lines are ended with
39641 an ASCII newline character.
39642 However, when the &%spool_wireformat%& main option is used some -D files
39643 can have an alternate format.
39644 This is flagged by a &%-spool_file_wireformat%& line in the corresponding -H file.
39645 The -D file lines (not including the first name-component line) are
39646 suitable for direct copying to the wire when transmitting using the
39647 ESMTP CHUNKING option, meaning lower processing overhead.
39648 Lines are terminated with an ASCII CRLF pair.
39649 There is no dot-stuffing (and no dot-termination).
39650
39651 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39652 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39653
39654 .chapter "DKIM and SPF" "CHAPdkim" &&&
39655 "DKIM and SPF Support"
39656 .cindex "DKIM"
39657
39658 .section "DKIM (DomainKeys Identified Mail)" SECDKIM
39659
39660 DKIM is a mechanism by which messages sent by some entity can be provably
39661 linked to a domain which that entity controls. It permits reputation to
39662 be tracked on a per-domain basis, rather than merely upon source IP address.
39663 DKIM is documented in RFC 6376.
39664
39665 As DKIM relies on the message being unchanged in transit, messages handled
39666 by a mailing-list (which traditionally adds to the message) will not match
39667 any original DKIM signature.
39668
39669 DKIM support is compiled into Exim by default if TLS support is present.
39670 It can be disabled by setting DISABLE_DKIM=yes in &_Local/Makefile_&.
39671
39672 Exim's DKIM implementation allows for
39673 .olist
39674 Signing outgoing messages: This function is implemented in the SMTP transport.
39675 It can co-exist with all other Exim features
39676 (including transport filters)
39677 except cutthrough delivery.
39678 .next
39679 Verifying signatures in incoming messages: This is implemented by an additional
39680 ACL (acl_smtp_dkim), which can be called several times per message, with
39681 different signature contexts.
39682 .endlist
39683
39684 In typical Exim style, the verification implementation does not include any
39685 default "policy". Instead it enables you to build your own policy using
39686 Exim's standard controls.
39687
39688 Please note that verification of DKIM signatures in incoming mail is turned
39689 on by default for logging (in the <= line) purposes.
39690
39691 Additional log detail can be enabled using the &%dkim_verbose%& log_selector.
39692 When set, for each signature in incoming email,
39693 exim will log a line displaying the most important signature details, and the
39694 signature status. Here is an example (with line-breaks added for clarity):
39695 .code
39696 2009-09-09 10:22:28 1MlIRf-0003LU-U3 DKIM:
39697 d=facebookmail.com s=q1-2009b
39698 c=relaxed/relaxed a=rsa-sha1
39699 i=@facebookmail.com t=1252484542 [verification succeeded]
39700 .endd
39701
39702 You might want to turn off DKIM verification processing entirely for internal
39703 or relay mail sources. To do that, set the &%dkim_disable_verify%& ACL
39704 control modifier. This should typically be done in the RCPT ACL, at points
39705 where you accept mail from relay sources (internal hosts or authenticated
39706 senders).
39707
39708
39709 .section "Signing outgoing messages" "SECDKIMSIGN"
39710 .cindex "DKIM" "signing"
39711
39712 For signing to be usable you must have published a DKIM record in DNS.
39713 Note that RFC 8301 (which does not cover EC keys) says:
39714 .code
39715 rsa-sha1 MUST NOT be used for signing or verifying.
39716
39717 Signers MUST use RSA keys of at least 1024 bits for all keys.
39718 Signers SHOULD use RSA keys of at least 2048 bits.
39719 .endd
39720
39721 Note also that the key content (the 'p=' field)
39722 in the DNS record is different between RSA and EC keys;
39723 for the former it is the base64 of the ASN.1 for the RSA public key
39724 (equivalent to the private-key .pem with the header/trailer stripped)
39725 but for EC keys it is the base64 of the pure key; no ASN.1 wrapping.
39726
39727 Signing is enabled by setting private options on the SMTP transport.
39728 These options take (expandable) strings as arguments.
39729
39730 .option dkim_domain smtp string list&!! unset
39731 The domain(s) you want to sign with.
39732 After expansion, this can be a list.
39733 Each element in turn,
39734 .new
39735 lowercased,
39736 .wen
39737 is put into the &%$dkim_domain%& expansion variable
39738 while expanding the remaining signing options.
39739 If it is empty after expansion, DKIM signing is not done,
39740 and no error will result even if &%dkim_strict%& is set.
39741
39742 .option dkim_selector smtp string list&!! unset
39743 This sets the key selector string.
39744 After expansion, which can use &$dkim_domain$&, this can be a list.
39745 Each element in turn is put in the expansion
39746 variable &%$dkim_selector%& which may be used in the &%dkim_private_key%&
39747 option along with &%$dkim_domain%&.
39748 If the option is empty after expansion, DKIM signing is not done for this domain,
39749 and no error will result even if &%dkim_strict%& is set.
39750
39751 .option dkim_private_key smtp string&!! unset
39752 This sets the private key to use.
39753 You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& and
39754 &%$dkim_selector%& expansion variables to determine the private key to use.
39755 The result can either
39756 .ilist
39757 be a valid RSA private key in ASCII armor (.pem file), including line breaks
39758 .next
39759 with GnuTLS 3.6.0 or OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later,
39760 be a valid Ed25519 private key (same format as above)
39761 .next
39762 start with a slash, in which case it is treated as a file that contains
39763 the private key
39764 .next
39765 be "0", "false" or the empty string, in which case the message will not
39766 be signed. This case will not result in an error, even if &%dkim_strict%&
39767 is set.
39768 .endlist
39769
39770 To generate keys under OpenSSL:
39771 .code
39772 openssl genrsa -out dkim_rsa.private 2048
39773 openssl rsa -in dkim_rsa.private -out /dev/stdout -pubout -outform PEM
39774 .endd
39775 Take the base-64 lines from the output of the second command, concatenated,
39776 for the DNS TXT record.
39777 See section 3.6 of RFC6376 for the record specification.
39778
39779 Under GnuTLS:
39780 .code
39781 certtool --generate-privkey --rsa --bits=2048 --password='' -8 --outfile=dkim_rsa.private
39782 certtool --load-privkey=dkim_rsa.private --pubkey-info
39783 .endd
39784
39785 Note that RFC 8301 says:
39786 .code
39787 Signers MUST use RSA keys of at least 1024 bits for all keys.
39788 Signers SHOULD use RSA keys of at least 2048 bits.
39789 .endd
39790
39791 .new
39792 EC keys for DKIM are defined by RFC 8463.
39793 .wen
39794 They are considerably smaller than RSA keys for equivalent protection.
39795 As they are a recent development, users should consider dual-signing
39796 (by setting a list of selectors, and an expansion for this option)
39797 for some transition period.
39798 The "_CRYPTO_SIGN_ED25519" macro will be defined if support is present
39799 for EC keys.
39800
39801 OpenSSL 1.1.1 and GnuTLS 3.6.0 can create Ed25519 private keys:
39802 .code
39803 openssl genpkey -algorithm ed25519 -out dkim_ed25519.private
39804 certtool --generate-privkey --key-type=ed25519 --outfile=dkim_ed25519.private
39805 .endd
39806
39807 To produce the required public key value for a DNS record:
39808 .code
39809 openssl pkey -outform DER -pubout -in dkim_ed25519.private | tail -c +13 | base64
39810 certtool --load_privkey=dkim_ed25519.private --pubkey_info --outder | tail -c +13 | base64
39811 .endd
39812
39813 .new
39814 Exim also supports an alternate format
39815 of Ed25519 keys in DNS which was a candidate during development
39816 of the standard, but not adopted.
39817 A future release will probably drop that support.
39818 .wen
39819
39820 .option dkim_hash smtp string&!! sha256
39821 Can be set to any one of the supported hash methods, which are:
39822 .ilist
39823 &`sha1`& &-- should not be used, is old and insecure
39824 .next
39825 &`sha256`& &-- the default
39826 .next
39827 &`sha512`& &-- possibly more secure but less well supported
39828 .endlist
39829
39830 Note that RFC 8301 says:
39831 .code
39832 rsa-sha1 MUST NOT be used for signing or verifying.
39833 .endd
39834
39835 .option dkim_identity smtp string&!! unset
39836 If set after expansion, the value is used to set an "i=" tag in
39837 the signing header. The DKIM standards restrict the permissible
39838 syntax of this optional tag to a mail address, with possibly-empty
39839 local part, an @, and a domain identical to or subdomain of the "d="
39840 tag value. Note that Exim does not check the value.
39841
39842 .option dkim_canon smtp string&!! unset
39843 This option sets the canonicalization method used when signing a message.
39844 The DKIM RFC currently supports two methods: "simple" and "relaxed".
39845 The option defaults to "relaxed" when unset. Note: the current implementation
39846 only supports signing with the same canonicalization method for both headers and body.
39847
39848 .option dkim_strict smtp string&!! unset
39849 This option defines how Exim behaves when signing a message that
39850 should be signed fails for some reason. When the expansion evaluates to
39851 either "1" or "true", Exim will defer. Otherwise Exim will send the message
39852 unsigned. You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& and &%$dkim_selector%& expansion
39853 variables here.
39854
39855 .option dkim_sign_headers smtp string&!! "see below"
39856 If set, this option must expand to a colon-separated
39857 list of header names.
39858 Headers with these names, or the absence or such a header, will be included
39859 in the message signature.
39860 When unspecified, the header names listed in RFC4871 will be used,
39861 whether or not each header is present in the message.
39862 The default list is available for the expansion in the macro
39863 "_DKIM_SIGN_HEADERS".
39864
39865 If a name is repeated, multiple headers by that name (or the absence thereof)
39866 will be signed. The textually later headers in the headers part of the
39867 message are signed first, if there are multiples.
39868
39869 A name can be prefixed with either an '=' or a '+' character.
39870 If an '=' prefix is used, all headers that are present with this name
39871 will be signed.
39872 If a '+' prefix if used, all headers that are present with this name
39873 will be signed, and one signature added for a missing header with the
39874 name will be appended.
39875
39876 .option dkim_timestamps smtp integer&!! unset
39877 This option controls the inclusion of timestamp information in the signature.
39878 If not set, no such information will be included.
39879 Otherwise, must be an unsigned number giving an offset in seconds from the current time
39880 for the expiry tag
39881 (eg. 1209600 for two weeks);
39882 both creation (t=) and expiry (x=) tags will be included.
39883
39884 RFC 6376 lists these tags as RECOMMENDED.
39885
39886
39887 .section "Verifying DKIM signatures in incoming mail" "SECDKIMVFY"
39888 .cindex "DKIM" "verification"
39889
39890 Verification of DKIM signatures in SMTP incoming email is done for all
39891 messages for which an ACL control &%dkim_disable_verify%& has not been set.
39892 .cindex authentication "expansion item"
39893 Performing verification sets up information used by the
39894 &$authresults$& expansion item.
39895
39896 The results of that verification are then made available to the
39897 &%acl_smtp_dkim%& ACL, which can examine and modify them.
39898 By default, this ACL is called once for each
39899 syntactically(!) correct signature in the incoming message.
39900 A missing ACL definition defaults to accept.
39901 If any ACL call does not accept, the message is not accepted.
39902 If a cutthrough delivery was in progress for the message, that is
39903 summarily dropped (having wasted the transmission effort).
39904
39905 To evaluate the verification result in the ACL
39906 a large number of expansion variables
39907 containing the signature status and its details are set up during the
39908 runtime of the ACL.
39909
39910 Calling the ACL only for existing signatures is not sufficient to build
39911 more advanced policies. For that reason, the global option
39912 &%dkim_verify_signers%&, and a global expansion variable
39913 &%$dkim_signers%& exist.
39914
39915 The global option &%dkim_verify_signers%& can be set to a colon-separated
39916 list of DKIM domains or identities for which the ACL &%acl_smtp_dkim%& is
39917 called. It is expanded when the message has been received. At this point,
39918 the expansion variable &%$dkim_signers%& already contains a colon-separated
39919 list of signer domains and identities for the message. When
39920 &%dkim_verify_signers%& is not specified in the main configuration,
39921 it defaults as:
39922 .code
39923 dkim_verify_signers = $dkim_signers
39924 .endd
39925 This leads to the default behaviour of calling &%acl_smtp_dkim%& for each
39926 DKIM signature in the message. Current DKIM verifiers may want to explicitly
39927 call the ACL for known domains or identities. This would be achieved as follows:
39928 .code
39929 dkim_verify_signers = paypal.com:ebay.com:$dkim_signers
39930 .endd
39931 This would result in &%acl_smtp_dkim%& always being called for "paypal.com"
39932 and "ebay.com", plus all domains and identities that have signatures in the message.
39933 You can also be more creative in constructing your policy. For example:
39934 .code
39935 dkim_verify_signers = $sender_address_domain:$dkim_signers
39936 .endd
39937
39938 If a domain or identity is listed several times in the (expanded) value of
39939 &%dkim_verify_signers%&, the ACL is only called once for that domain or identity.
39940
39941 .new
39942 Note that if the option is set using untrustworthy data
39943 (such as the From: header)
39944 care should be taken to force lowercase for domains
39945 and for the domain part if identities.
39946 The default setting can be regarded as trustworthy in this respect.
39947 .wen
39948
39949 If multiple signatures match a domain (or identity), the ACL is called once
39950 for each matching signature.
39951
39952
39953 Inside the &%acl_smtp_dkim%&, the following expansion variables are
39954 available (from most to least important):
39955
39956
39957 .vlist
39958 .vitem &%$dkim_cur_signer%&
39959 The signer that is being evaluated in this ACL run. This can be a domain or
39960 an identity. This is one of the list items from the expanded main option
39961 &%dkim_verify_signers%& (see above).
39962
39963 .vitem &%$dkim_verify_status%&
39964 Within the DKIM ACL,
39965 a string describing the general status of the signature. One of
39966 .ilist
39967 &%none%&: There is no signature in the message for the current domain or
39968 identity (as reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
39969 .next
39970 &%invalid%&: The signature could not be verified due to a processing error.
39971 More detail is available in &%$dkim_verify_reason%&.
39972 .next
39973 &%fail%&: Verification of the signature failed. More detail is
39974 available in &%$dkim_verify_reason%&.
39975 .next
39976 &%pass%&: The signature passed verification. It is valid.
39977 .endlist
39978
39979 This variable can be overwritten using an ACL 'set' modifier.
39980 This might, for instance, be done to enforce a policy restriction on
39981 hash-method or key-size:
39982 .code
39983 warn condition = ${if eq {$dkim_verify_status}{pass}}
39984 condition = ${if eq {${length_3:$dkim_algo}}{rsa}}
39985 condition = ${if or {{eq {$dkim_algo}{rsa-sha1}} \
39986 {< {$dkim_key_length}{1024}}}}
39987 logwrite = NOTE: forcing DKIM verify fail (was pass)
39988 set dkim_verify_status = fail
39989 set dkim_verify_reason = hash too weak or key too short
39990 .endd
39991
39992 So long as a DKIM ACL is defined (it need do no more than accept),
39993 after all the DKIM ACL runs have completed, the value becomes a
39994 colon-separated list of the values after each run.
39995 This is maintained for the mime, prdr and data ACLs.
39996
39997 .vitem &%$dkim_verify_reason%&
39998 A string giving a little bit more detail when &%$dkim_verify_status%& is either
39999 "fail" or "invalid". One of
40000 .ilist
40001 &%pubkey_unavailable%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="invalid"): The public
40002 key for the domain could not be retrieved. This may be a temporary problem.
40003 .next
40004 &%pubkey_syntax%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="invalid"): The public key
40005 record for the domain is syntactically invalid.
40006 .next
40007 &%bodyhash_mismatch%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="fail"): The calculated
40008 body hash does not match the one specified in the signature header. This
40009 means that the message body was modified in transit.
40010 .next
40011 &%signature_incorrect%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="fail"): The signature
40012 could not be verified. This may mean that headers were modified,
40013 re-written or otherwise changed in a way which is incompatible with
40014 DKIM verification. It may of course also mean that the signature is forged.
40015 .endlist
40016
40017 This variable can be overwritten, with any value, using an ACL 'set' modifier.
40018
40019 .vitem &%$dkim_domain%&
40020 The signing domain. IMPORTANT: This variable is only populated if there is
40021 an actual signature in the message for the current domain or identity (as
40022 reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
40023
40024 .vitem &%$dkim_identity%&
40025 The signing identity, if present. IMPORTANT: This variable is only populated
40026 if there is an actual signature in the message for the current domain or
40027 identity (as reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
40028
40029 .vitem &%$dkim_selector%&
40030 The key record selector string.
40031
40032 .vitem &%$dkim_algo%&
40033 The algorithm used. One of 'rsa-sha1' or 'rsa-sha256'.
40034 If running under GnuTLS 3.6.0 or OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later,
40035 may also be 'ed25519-sha256'.
40036 The "_CRYPTO_SIGN_ED25519" macro will be defined if support is present
40037 for EC keys.
40038
40039 Note that RFC 8301 says:
40040 .code
40041 rsa-sha1 MUST NOT be used for signing or verifying.
40042
40043 DKIM signatures identified as having been signed with historic
40044 algorithms (currently, rsa-sha1) have permanently failed evaluation
40045 .endd
40046
40047 To enforce this you must have a DKIM ACL which checks this variable
40048 and overwrites the &$dkim_verify_status$& variable as discussed above.
40049
40050 .vitem &%$dkim_canon_body%&
40051 The body canonicalization method. One of 'relaxed' or 'simple'.
40052
40053 .vitem &%$dkim_canon_headers%&
40054 The header canonicalization method. One of 'relaxed' or 'simple'.
40055
40056 .vitem &%$dkim_copiedheaders%&
40057 A transcript of headers and their values which are included in the signature
40058 (copied from the 'z=' tag of the signature).
40059 Note that RFC6376 requires that verification fail if the From: header is
40060 not included in the signature. Exim does not enforce this; sites wishing
40061 strict enforcement should code the check explicitly.
40062
40063 .vitem &%$dkim_bodylength%&
40064 The number of signed body bytes. If zero ("0"), the body is unsigned. If no
40065 limit was set by the signer, "9999999999999" is returned. This makes sure
40066 that this variable always expands to an integer value.
40067 &*Note:*& The presence of the signature tag specifying a signing body length
40068 is one possible route to spoofing of valid DKIM signatures.
40069 A paranoid implementation might wish to regard signature where this variable
40070 shows less than the "no limit" return as being invalid.
40071
40072 .vitem &%$dkim_created%&
40073 UNIX timestamp reflecting the date and time when the signature was created.
40074 When this was not specified by the signer, "0" is returned.
40075
40076 .vitem &%$dkim_expires%&
40077 UNIX timestamp reflecting the date and time when the signer wants the
40078 signature to be treated as "expired". When this was not specified by the
40079 signer, "9999999999999" is returned. This makes it possible to do useful
40080 integer size comparisons against this value.
40081 Note that Exim does not check this value.
40082
40083 .vitem &%$dkim_headernames%&
40084 A colon-separated list of names of headers included in the signature.
40085
40086 .vitem &%$dkim_key_testing%&
40087 "1" if the key record has the "testing" flag set, "0" if not.
40088
40089 .vitem &%$dkim_key_nosubdomains%&
40090 "1" if the key record forbids subdomaining, "0" otherwise.
40091
40092 .vitem &%$dkim_key_srvtype%&
40093 Service type (tag s=) from the key record. Defaults to "*" if not specified
40094 in the key record.
40095
40096 .vitem &%$dkim_key_granularity%&
40097 Key granularity (tag g=) from the key record. Defaults to "*" if not specified
40098 in the key record.
40099
40100 .vitem &%$dkim_key_notes%&
40101 Notes from the key record (tag n=).
40102
40103 .vitem &%$dkim_key_length%&
40104 Number of bits in the key.
40105
40106 Note that RFC 8301 says:
40107 .code
40108 Verifiers MUST NOT consider signatures using RSA keys of
40109 less than 1024 bits as valid signatures.
40110 .endd
40111
40112 To enforce this you must have a DKIM ACL which checks this variable
40113 and overwrites the &$dkim_verify_status$& variable as discussed above.
40114 As EC keys are much smaller, the check should only do this for RSA keys.
40115
40116 .endlist
40117
40118 In addition, two ACL conditions are provided:
40119
40120 .vlist
40121 .vitem &%dkim_signers%&
40122 ACL condition that checks a colon-separated list of domains or identities
40123 for a match against the domain or identity that the ACL is currently verifying
40124 (reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&). This is typically used to restrict an ACL
40125 verb to a group of domains or identities. For example:
40126
40127 .code
40128 # Warn when Mail purportedly from GMail has no gmail signature
40129 warn log_message = GMail sender without gmail.com DKIM signature
40130 sender_domains = gmail.com
40131 dkim_signers = gmail.com
40132 dkim_status = none
40133 .endd
40134
40135 Note that the above does not check for a total lack of DKIM signing;
40136 for that check for empty &$h_DKIM-Signature:$& in the data ACL.
40137
40138 .vitem &%dkim_status%&
40139 ACL condition that checks a colon-separated list of possible DKIM verification
40140 results against the actual result of verification. This is typically used
40141 to restrict an ACL verb to a list of verification outcomes, for example:
40142
40143 .code
40144 deny message = Mail from Paypal with invalid/missing signature
40145 sender_domains = paypal.com:paypal.de
40146 dkim_signers = paypal.com:paypal.de
40147 dkim_status = none:invalid:fail
40148 .endd
40149
40150 The possible status keywords are: 'none','invalid','fail' and 'pass'. Please
40151 see the documentation of the &%$dkim_verify_status%& expansion variable above
40152 for more information of what they mean.
40153 .endlist
40154
40155
40156
40157
40158 .section "SPF (Sender Policy Framework)" SECSPF
40159 .cindex SPF verification
40160
40161 SPF is a mechanism whereby a domain may assert which IP addresses may transmit
40162 messages with its domain in the envelope from, documented by RFC 7208.
40163 For more information on SPF see &url(http://www.openspf.org).
40164 . --- 2018-09-07: still not https
40165
40166 Messages sent by a system not authorised will fail checking of such assertions.
40167 This includes retransmissions done by traditional forwarders.
40168
40169 SPF verification support is built into Exim if SUPPORT_SPF=yes is set in
40170 &_Local/Makefile_&. The support uses the &_libspf2_& library
40171 &url(https://www.libspf2.org/).
40172 There is no Exim involvement in the transmission of messages;
40173 publishing certain DNS records is all that is required.
40174
40175 For verification, an ACL condition and an expansion lookup are provided.
40176 .cindex authentication "expansion item"
40177 Performing verification sets up information used by the
40178 &$authresults$& expansion item.
40179
40180
40181 .cindex SPF "ACL condition"
40182 .cindex ACL "spf condition"
40183 The ACL condition "spf" can be used at or after the MAIL ACL.
40184 It takes as an argument a list of strings giving the outcome of the SPF check,
40185 and will succeed for any matching outcome.
40186 Valid strings are:
40187 .vlist
40188 .vitem &%pass%&
40189 The SPF check passed, the sending host is positively verified by SPF.
40190
40191 .vitem &%fail%&
40192 The SPF check failed, the sending host is NOT allowed to send mail for the
40193 domain in the envelope-from address.
40194
40195 .vitem &%softfail%&
40196 The SPF check failed, but the queried domain can't absolutely confirm that this
40197 is a forgery.
40198
40199 .vitem &%none%&
40200 The queried domain does not publish SPF records.
40201
40202 .vitem &%neutral%&
40203 The SPF check returned a "neutral" state. This means the queried domain has
40204 published a SPF record, but wants to allow outside servers to send mail under
40205 its domain as well. This should be treated like "none".
40206
40207 .vitem &%permerror%&
40208 This indicates a syntax error in the SPF record of the queried domain.
40209 You may deny messages when this occurs.
40210
40211 .vitem &%temperror%&
40212 This indicates a temporary error during all processing, including Exim's
40213 SPF processing. You may defer messages when this occurs.
40214 .endlist
40215
40216 You can prefix each string with an exclamation mark to invert
40217 its meaning, for example "!fail" will match all results but
40218 "fail". The string list is evaluated left-to-right, in a
40219 short-circuit fashion.
40220
40221 Example:
40222 .code
40223 deny spf = fail
40224 message = $sender_host_address is not allowed to send mail from \
40225 ${if def:sender_address_domain \
40226 {$sender_address_domain}{$sender_helo_name}}. \
40227 Please see http://www.openspf.org/Why?scope=\
40228 ${if def:sender_address_domain {mfrom}{helo}};\
40229 identity=${if def:sender_address_domain \
40230 {$sender_address}{$sender_helo_name}};\
40231 ip=$sender_host_address
40232 .endd
40233
40234 When the spf condition has run, it sets up several expansion
40235 variables:
40236
40237 .cindex SPF "verification variables"
40238 .vlist
40239 .vitem &$spf_header_comment$&
40240 .vindex &$spf_header_comment$&
40241 This contains a human-readable string describing the outcome
40242 of the SPF check. You can add it to a custom header or use
40243 it for logging purposes.
40244
40245 .vitem &$spf_received$&
40246 .vindex &$spf_received$&
40247 This contains a complete Received-SPF: header that can be
40248 added to the message. Please note that according to the SPF
40249 draft, this header must be added at the top of the header
40250 list. Please see section 10 on how you can do this.
40251
40252 Note: in case of "Best-guess" (see below), the convention is
40253 to put this string in a header called X-SPF-Guess: instead.
40254
40255 .vitem &$spf_result$&
40256 .vindex &$spf_result$&
40257 This contains the outcome of the SPF check in string form,
40258 one of pass, fail, softfail, none, neutral, permerror or
40259 temperror.
40260
40261 .vitem &$spf_result_guessed$&
40262 .vindex &$spf_result_guessed$&
40263 This boolean is true only if a best-guess operation was used
40264 and required in order to obtain a result.
40265
40266 .vitem &$spf_smtp_comment$&
40267 .vindex &$spf_smtp_comment$&
40268 This contains a string that can be used in a SMTP response
40269 to the calling party. Useful for "fail".
40270 .endlist
40271
40272
40273 .cindex SPF "ACL condition"
40274 .cindex ACL "spf_guess condition"
40275 .cindex SPF "best guess"
40276 In addition to SPF, you can also perform checks for so-called
40277 "Best-guess". Strictly speaking, "Best-guess" is not standard
40278 SPF, but it is supported by the same framework that enables SPF
40279 capability.
40280 Refer to &url(http://www.openspf.org/FAQ/Best_guess_record)
40281 for a description of what it means.
40282 . --- 2018-09-07: still not https:
40283
40284 To access this feature, simply use the spf_guess condition in place
40285 of the spf one. For example:
40286
40287 .code
40288 deny spf_guess = fail
40289 message = $sender_host_address doesn't look trustworthy to me
40290 .endd
40291
40292 In case you decide to reject messages based on this check, you
40293 should note that although it uses the same framework, "Best-guess"
40294 is not SPF, and therefore you should not mention SPF at all in your
40295 reject message.
40296
40297 When the spf_guess condition has run, it sets up the same expansion
40298 variables as when spf condition is run, described above.
40299
40300 Additionally, since Best-guess is not standardized, you may redefine
40301 what "Best-guess" means to you by redefining the main configuration
40302 &%spf_guess%& option.
40303 For example, the following:
40304
40305 .code
40306 spf_guess = v=spf1 a/16 mx/16 ptr ?all
40307 .endd
40308
40309 would relax host matching rules to a broader network range.
40310
40311
40312 .cindex SPF "lookup expansion"
40313 .cindex lookup spf
40314 A lookup expansion is also available. It takes an email
40315 address as the key and an IP address as the database:
40316
40317 .code
40318 ${lookup {username@domain} spf {ip.ip.ip.ip}}
40319 .endd
40320
40321 The lookup will return the same result strings as can appear in
40322 &$spf_result$& (pass,fail,softfail,neutral,none,err_perm,err_temp).
40323 Currently, only IPv4 addresses are supported.
40324
40325
40326
40327
40328 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40329 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40330
40331 .chapter "Proxies" "CHAPproxies" &&&
40332 "Proxy support"
40333 .cindex "proxy support"
40334 .cindex "proxy" "access via"
40335
40336 A proxy is an intermediate system through which communication is passed.
40337 Proxies may provide a security, availability or load-distribution function.
40338
40339
40340 .section "Inbound proxies" SECTproxyInbound
40341 .cindex proxy inbound
40342 .cindex proxy "server side"
40343 .cindex proxy "Proxy protocol"
40344 .cindex "Proxy protocol" proxy
40345
40346 Exim has support for receiving inbound SMTP connections via a proxy
40347 that uses &"Proxy Protocol"& to speak to it.
40348 To include this support, include &"SUPPORT_PROXY=yes"&
40349 in Local/Makefile.
40350
40351 It was built on the HAProxy specification, found at
40352 &url(https://www.haproxy.org/download/1.8/doc/proxy-protocol.txt).
40353
40354 The purpose of this facility is so that an application load balancer,
40355 such as HAProxy, can sit in front of several Exim servers
40356 to distribute load.
40357 Exim uses the local protocol communication with the proxy to obtain
40358 the remote SMTP system IP address and port information.
40359 There is no logging if a host passes or
40360 fails Proxy Protocol negotiation, but it can easily be determined and
40361 recorded in an ACL (example is below).
40362
40363 Use of a proxy is enabled by setting the &%hosts_proxy%&
40364 main configuration option to a hostlist; connections from these
40365 hosts will use Proxy Protocol.
40366 Exim supports both version 1 and version 2 of the Proxy Protocol and
40367 automatically determines which version is in use.
40368
40369 The Proxy Protocol header is the first data received on a TCP connection
40370 and is inserted before any TLS-on-connect handshake from the client; Exim
40371 negotiates TLS between Exim-as-server and the remote client, not between
40372 Exim and the proxy server.
40373
40374 The following expansion variables are usable
40375 (&"internal"& and &"external"& here refer to the interfaces
40376 of the proxy):
40377 .display
40378 &'proxy_external_address '& IP of host being proxied or IP of remote interface of proxy
40379 &'proxy_external_port '& Port of host being proxied or Port on remote interface of proxy
40380 &'proxy_local_address '& IP of proxy server inbound or IP of local interface of proxy
40381 &'proxy_local_port '& Port of proxy server inbound or Port on local interface of proxy
40382 &'proxy_session '& boolean: SMTP connection via proxy
40383 .endd
40384 If &$proxy_session$& is set but &$proxy_external_address$& is empty
40385 there was a protocol error.
40386 The variables &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_host_port$&
40387 will have values for the actual client system, not the proxy.
40388
40389 Since the real connections are all coming from the proxy, and the
40390 per host connection tracking is done before Proxy Protocol is
40391 evaluated, &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& must be set high enough to
40392 handle all of the parallel volume you expect per inbound proxy.
40393 With the option set so high, you lose the ability
40394 to protect your server from many connections from one IP.
40395 In order to prevent your server from overload, you
40396 need to add a per connection ratelimit to your connect ACL.
40397 A possible solution is:
40398 .display
40399 # Set max number of connections per host
40400 LIMIT = 5
40401 # Or do some kind of IP lookup in a flat file or database
40402 # LIMIT = ${lookup{$sender_host_address}iplsearch{/etc/exim/proxy_limits}}
40403
40404 defer message = Too many connections from this IP right now
40405 ratelimit = LIMIT / 5s / per_conn / strict
40406 .endd
40407
40408
40409
40410 .section "Outbound proxies" SECTproxySOCKS
40411 .cindex proxy outbound
40412 .cindex proxy "client side"
40413 .cindex proxy SOCKS
40414 .cindex SOCKS proxy
40415 Exim has support for sending outbound SMTP via a proxy
40416 using a protocol called SOCKS5 (defined by RFC1928).
40417 The support can be optionally included by defining SUPPORT_SOCKS=yes in
40418 Local/Makefile.
40419
40420 Use of a proxy is enabled by setting the &%socks_proxy%& option
40421 on an smtp transport.
40422 The option value is expanded and should then be a list
40423 (colon-separated by default) of proxy specifiers.
40424 Each proxy specifier is a list
40425 (space-separated by default) where the initial element
40426 is an IP address and any subsequent elements are options.
40427
40428 Options are a string <name>=<value>.
40429 The list of options is in the following table:
40430 .display
40431 &'auth '& authentication method
40432 &'name '& authentication username
40433 &'pass '& authentication password
40434 &'port '& tcp port
40435 &'tmo '& connection timeout
40436 &'pri '& priority
40437 &'weight '& selection bias
40438 .endd
40439
40440 More details on each of these options follows:
40441
40442 .ilist
40443 .cindex authentication "to proxy"
40444 .cindex proxy authentication
40445 &%auth%&: Either &"none"& (default) or &"name"&.
40446 Using &"name"& selects username/password authentication per RFC 1929
40447 for access to the proxy.
40448 Default is &"none"&.
40449 .next
40450 &%name%&: sets the username for the &"name"& authentication method.
40451 Default is empty.
40452 .next
40453 &%pass%&: sets the password for the &"name"& authentication method.
40454 Default is empty.
40455 .next
40456 &%port%&: the TCP port number to use for the connection to the proxy.
40457 Default is 1080.
40458 .next
40459 &%tmo%&: sets a connection timeout in seconds for this proxy.
40460 Default is 5.
40461 .next
40462 &%pri%&: specifies a priority for the proxy within the list,
40463 higher values being tried first.
40464 The default priority is 1.
40465 .next
40466 &%weight%&: specifies a selection bias.
40467 Within a priority set servers are queried in a random fashion,
40468 weighted by this value.
40469 The default value for selection bias is 1.
40470 .endlist
40471
40472 Proxies from the list are tried according to their priority
40473 and weight settings until one responds. The timeout for the
40474 overall connection applies to the set of proxied attempts.
40475
40476 .section Logging SECTproxyLog
40477 To log the (local) IP of a proxy in the incoming or delivery logline,
40478 add &"+proxy"& to the &%log_selector%& option.
40479 This will add a component tagged with &"PRX="& to the line.
40480
40481 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40482 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40483
40484 .chapter "Internationalisation" "CHAPi18n" &&&
40485 "Internationalisation""
40486 .cindex internationalisation "email address"
40487 .cindex EAI
40488 .cindex i18n
40489 .cindex utf8 "mail name handling"
40490
40491 Exim has support for Internationalised mail names.
40492 To include this it must be built with SUPPORT_I18N and the libidn library.
40493 Standards supported are RFCs 2060, 5890, 6530 and 6533.
40494
40495 If Exim is built with SUPPORT_I18N_2008 (in addition to SUPPORT_I18N, not
40496 instead of it) then IDNA2008 is supported; this adds an extra library
40497 requirement, upon libidn2.
40498
40499 .section "MTA operations" SECTi18nMTA
40500 .cindex SMTPUTF8 "ESMTP option"
40501 The main configuration option &%smtputf8_advertise_hosts%& specifies
40502 a host list. If this matches the sending host and
40503 accept_8bitmime is true (the default) then the ESMTP option
40504 SMTPUTF8 will be advertised.
40505
40506 If the sender specifies the SMTPUTF8 option on a MAIL command
40507 international handling for the message is enabled and
40508 the expansion variable &$message_smtputf8$& will have value TRUE.
40509
40510 The option &%allow_utf8_domains%& is set to true for this
40511 message. All DNS lookups are converted to a-label form
40512 whatever the setting of &%allow_utf8_domains%&
40513 when Exim is built with SUPPORT_I18N.
40514
40515 Both localparts and domain are maintained as the original
40516 UTF-8 form internally; any comparison or regular-expression use will
40517 require appropriate care. Filenames created, eg. by
40518 the appendfile transport, will have UTF-8 names.
40519
40520 HELO names sent by the smtp transport will have any UTF-8
40521 components expanded to a-label form,
40522 and any certificate name checks will be done using the a-label
40523 form of the name.
40524
40525 .cindex log protocol
40526 .cindex SMTPUTF8 logging
40527 .cindex i18n logging
40528 Log lines and Received-by: header lines will acquire a "utf8"
40529 prefix on the protocol element, eg. utf8esmtp.
40530
40531 The following expansion operators can be used:
40532 .code
40533 ${utf8_domain_to_alabel:str}
40534 ${utf8_domain_from_alabel:str}
40535 ${utf8_localpart_to_alabel:str}
40536 ${utf8_localpart_from_alabel:str}
40537 .endd
40538
40539 .cindex utf8 "address downconversion"
40540 .cindex i18n "utf8 address downconversion"
40541 The RCPT ACL
40542 may use the following modifier:
40543 .display
40544 control = utf8_downconvert
40545 control = utf8_downconvert/<value>
40546 .endd
40547 This sets a flag requiring that addresses are converted to
40548 a-label form before smtp delivery, for use in a
40549 Message Submission Agent context.
40550 If a value is appended it may be:
40551 .display
40552 &`1 `& (default) mandatory downconversion
40553 &`0 `& no downconversion
40554 &`-1 `& if SMTPUTF8 not supported by destination host
40555 .endd
40556
40557 If mua_wrapper is set, the utf8_downconvert control
40558 is initially set to -1.
40559
40560 The smtp transport has an option &%utf8_downconvert%&.
40561 If set it must expand to one of the three values described above,
40562 and it overrides any previously set value.
40563
40564
40565 There is no explicit support for VRFY and EXPN.
40566 Configurations supporting these should inspect
40567 &$smtp_command_argument$& for an SMTPUTF8 argument.
40568
40569 There is no support for LMTP on Unix sockets.
40570 Using the "lmtp" protocol option on an smtp transport,
40571 for LMTP over TCP, should work as expected.
40572
40573 There is no support for DSN unitext handling,
40574 and no provision for converting logging from or to UTF-8.
40575
40576
40577
40578 .section "MDA operations" SECTi18nMDA
40579 To aid in constructing names suitable for IMAP folders
40580 the following expansion operator can be used:
40581 .code
40582 ${imapfolder {<string>} {<sep>} {<specials>}}
40583 .endd
40584
40585 The string is converted from the charset specified by
40586 the "headers charset" command (in a filter file)
40587 or &%headers_charset%& main configuration option (otherwise),
40588 to the
40589 modified UTF-7 encoding specified by RFC 2060,
40590 with the following exception: All occurrences of <sep>
40591 (which has to be a single character)
40592 are replaced with periods ("."), and all periods and slashes that are not
40593 <sep> and are not in the <specials> string are BASE64 encoded.
40594
40595 The third argument can be omitted, defaulting to an empty string.
40596 The second argument can be omitted, defaulting to "/".
40597
40598 This is the encoding used by Courier for Maildir names on disk, and followed
40599 by many other IMAP servers.
40600
40601 Examples:
40602 .display
40603 &`${imapfolder {Foo/Bar}} `& yields &`Foo.Bar`&
40604 &`${imapfolder {Foo/Bar}{.}{/}} `& yields &`Foo&&AC8-Bar`&
40605 &`${imapfolder {Räksmörgås}} `& yields &`R&&AOQ-ksm&&APY-rg&&AOU-s`&
40606 .endd
40607
40608 Note that the source charset setting is vital, and also that characters
40609 must be representable in UTF-16.
40610
40611
40612 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40613 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40614
40615 .chapter "Events" "CHAPevents" &&&
40616 "Events"
40617 .cindex events
40618
40619 The events mechanism in Exim can be used to intercept processing at a number
40620 of points. It was originally invented to give a way to do customised logging
40621 actions (for example, to a database) but can also be used to modify some
40622 processing actions.
40623
40624 Most installations will never need to use Events.
40625 The support can be left out of a build by defining DISABLE_EVENT=yes
40626 in &_Local/Makefile_&.
40627
40628 There are two major classes of events: main and transport.
40629 The main configuration option &%event_action%& controls reception events;
40630 a transport option &%event_action%& controls delivery events.
40631
40632 Both options are a string which is expanded when the event fires.
40633 An example might look like:
40634 .cindex logging custom
40635 .code
40636 event_action = ${if eq {msg:delivery}{$event_name} \
40637 {${lookup pgsql {SELECT * FROM record_Delivery( \
40638 '${quote_pgsql:$sender_address_domain}',\
40639 '${quote_pgsql:${lc:$sender_address_local_part}}', \
40640 '${quote_pgsql:$domain}', \
40641 '${quote_pgsql:${lc:$local_part}}', \
40642 '${quote_pgsql:$host_address}', \
40643 '${quote_pgsql:${lc:$host}}', \
40644 '${quote_pgsql:$message_exim_id}')}} \
40645 } {}}
40646 .endd
40647
40648 Events have names which correspond to the point in process at which they fire.
40649 The name is placed in the variable &$event_name$& and the event action
40650 expansion must check this, as it will be called for every possible event type.
40651
40652 The current list of events is:
40653 .display
40654 &`dane:fail after transport `& per connection
40655 &`msg:complete after main `& per message
40656 &`msg:delivery after transport `& per recipient
40657 &`msg:rcpt:host:defer after transport `& per recipient per host
40658 &`msg:rcpt:defer after transport `& per recipient
40659 &`msg:host:defer after transport `& per attempt
40660 &`msg:fail:delivery after transport `& per recipient
40661 &`msg:fail:internal after main `& per recipient
40662 &`tcp:connect before transport `& per connection
40663 &`tcp:close after transport `& per connection
40664 &`tls:cert before both `& per certificate in verification chain
40665 &`smtp:connect after transport `& per connection
40666 .endd
40667 New event types may be added in future.
40668
40669 The event name is a colon-separated list, defining the type of
40670 event in a tree of possibilities. It may be used as a list
40671 or just matched on as a whole. There will be no spaces in the name.
40672
40673 The second column in the table above describes whether the event fires
40674 before or after the action is associates with. Those which fire before
40675 can be used to affect that action (more on this below).
40676
40677 The third column in the table above says what section of the configuration
40678 should define the event action.
40679
40680 An additional variable, &$event_data$&, is filled with information varying
40681 with the event type:
40682 .display
40683 &`dane:fail `& failure reason
40684 &`msg:delivery `& smtp confirmation message
40685 &`msg:fail:internal `& failure reason
40686 &`msg:fail:delivery `& smtp error message
40687 &`msg:rcpt:host:defer `& error string
40688 &`msg:rcpt:defer `& error string
40689 &`msg:host:defer `& error string
40690 &`tls:cert `& verification chain depth
40691 &`smtp:connect `& smtp banner
40692 .endd
40693
40694 The :defer events populate one extra variable: &$event_defer_errno$&.
40695
40696 For complex operations an ACL expansion can be used in &%event_action%&
40697 however due to the multiple contexts that Exim operates in during
40698 the course of its processing:
40699 .ilist
40700 variables set in transport events will not be visible outside that
40701 transport call
40702 .next
40703 acl_m variables in a server context are lost on a new connection,
40704 and after smtp helo/ehlo/mail/starttls/rset commands
40705 .endlist
40706 Using an ACL expansion with the logwrite modifier can be
40707 a useful way of writing to the main log.
40708
40709 The expansion of the event_action option should normally
40710 return an empty string. Should it return anything else the
40711 following will be forced:
40712 .display
40713 &`tcp:connect `& do not connect
40714 &`tls:cert `& refuse verification
40715 &`smtp:connect `& close connection
40716 .endd
40717 All other message types ignore the result string, and
40718 no other use is made of it.
40719
40720 For a tcp:connect event, if the connection is being made to a proxy
40721 then the address and port variables will be that of the proxy and not
40722 the target system.
40723
40724 For tls:cert events, if GnuTLS is in use this will trigger only per
40725 chain element received on the connection.
40726 For OpenSSL it will trigger for every chain element including those
40727 loaded locally.
40728
40729 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40730 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40731
40732 .chapter "Adding new drivers or lookup types" "CHID13" &&&
40733 "Adding drivers or lookups"
40734 .cindex "adding drivers"
40735 .cindex "new drivers, adding"
40736 .cindex "drivers" "adding new"
40737 The following actions have to be taken in order to add a new router, transport,
40738 authenticator, or lookup type to Exim:
40739
40740 .olist
40741 Choose a name for the driver or lookup type that does not conflict with any
40742 existing name; I will use &"newdriver"& in what follows.
40743 .next
40744 Add to &_src/EDITME_& the line:
40745 .display
40746 <&'type'&>&`_NEWDRIVER=yes`&
40747 .endd
40748 where <&'type'&> is ROUTER, TRANSPORT, AUTH, or LOOKUP. If the
40749 code is not to be included in the binary by default, comment this line out. You
40750 should also add any relevant comments about the driver or lookup type.
40751 .next
40752 Add to &_src/config.h.defaults_& the line:
40753 .code
40754 #define <type>_NEWDRIVER
40755 .endd
40756 .next
40757 Edit &_src/drtables.c_&, adding conditional code to pull in the private header
40758 and create a table entry as is done for all the other drivers and lookup types.
40759 .next
40760 Edit &_scripts/lookups-Makefile_& if this is a new lookup; there is a for-loop
40761 near the bottom, ranging the &`name_mod`& variable over a list of all lookups.
40762 Add your &`NEWDRIVER`& to that list.
40763 As long as the dynamic module would be named &_newdriver.so_&, you can use the
40764 simple form that most lookups have.
40765 .next
40766 Edit &_Makefile_& in the appropriate sub-directory (&_src/routers_&,
40767 &_src/transports_&, &_src/auths_&, or &_src/lookups_&); add a line for the new
40768 driver or lookup type and add it to the definition of OBJ.
40769 .next
40770 Edit &_OS/Makefile-Base_& adding a &_.o_& file for the predefined-macros, to the
40771 definition of OBJ_MACRO. Add a set of line to do the compile also.
40772 .next
40773 Create &_newdriver.h_& and &_newdriver.c_& in the appropriate sub-directory of
40774 &_src_&.
40775 .next
40776 Edit &_scripts/MakeLinks_& and add commands to link the &_.h_& and &_.c_& files
40777 as for other drivers and lookups.
40778 .endlist
40779
40780 Then all you need to do is write the code! A good way to start is to make a
40781 proforma by copying an existing module of the same type, globally changing all
40782 occurrences of the name, and cutting out most of the code. Note that any
40783 options you create must be listed in alphabetical order, because the tables are
40784 searched using a binary chop procedure.
40785
40786 There is a &_README_& file in each of the sub-directories of &_src_& describing
40787 the interface that is expected.
40788
40789
40790
40791
40792 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40793 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40794
40795 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40796 . These lines are processing instructions for the Simple DocBook Processor that
40797 . Philip Hazel has developed as a less cumbersome way of making PostScript and
40798 . PDFs than using xmlto and fop. They will be ignored by all other XML
40799 . processors.
40800 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40801
40802 .literal xml
40803 <?sdop
40804 format="newpage"
40805 foot_right_recto="&chaptertitle;"
40806 foot_right_verso="&chaptertitle;"
40807 ?>
40808 .literal off
40809
40810 .makeindex "Options index" "option"
40811 .makeindex "Variables index" "variable"
40812 .makeindex "Concept index" "concept"
40813
40814
40815 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40816 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////